summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 05:19:17 -0700
committerRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 05:19:17 -0700
commit38e62cd3b10e9d67f46d1255105a52d161012513 (patch)
treeb1a234d86e80c8d8d5c11d4c9b02a330ed80cab7
initial commit of ebook 2519HEADmain
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--2519-h.zipbin0 -> 312370 bytes
-rw-r--r--2519-h/2519-h.htm11959
-rw-r--r--2519.txt12198
-rw-r--r--2519.zipbin0 -> 309167 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/zambs10.txt12719
-rw-r--r--old/zambs10.zipbin0 -> 307609 bytes
9 files changed, 36892 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/2519-h.zip b/2519-h.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..08f62d4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/2519-h.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/2519-h/2519-h.htm b/2519-h/2519-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..35b9dca
--- /dev/null
+++ b/2519-h/2519-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,11959 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html
+ PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
+ "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
+<html>
+<head>
+<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=US-ASCII" />
+<title>A Popular Account of Dr. Livingstone's Expedition to the Zambesi and Its Tributaries</title>
+ <style type="text/css">
+/*<![CDATA[ XML blockout */
+<!--
+ P { margin-top: .75em;
+ margin-bottom: .75em;
+ }
+ H1, H2 {
+ text-align: center;
+ margin-top: 2em;
+ margin-bottom: 2em;
+ }
+ H3, H4 {
+ text-align: left;
+ margin-top: 1em;
+ margin-bottom: 1em;
+ }
+ BODY{margin-left: 10%;
+ margin-right: 10%;
+ }
+ .blkquot {margin-left: 4em; margin-right: 4em;} /* block indent */
+ // -->
+ /* XML end ]]>*/
+ </style>
+</head>
+<body>
+<h2>
+<a href="#startoftext">A Popular Account of Dr. Livingstone's Expedition to the Zambesi and Its Tributaries, by David Livingstone</a>
+</h2>
+<pre>
+The Project Gutenberg eBook, A Popular Account of Dr. Livingstone's
+Expedition to the Zambesi and Its Tributaries, by David Livingstone
+
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+
+
+
+Title: A Popular Account of Dr. Livingstone's Expedition to the Zambesi and Its Tributaries
+ And of the Discovery of the Lakes Shirwa and Nyassa (1858-1864)
+
+
+Author: David Livingstone
+
+Release Date: May 13, 2005 [eBook #2519]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-646-US (US-ASCII)
+
+
+***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A POPULAR ACCOUNT OF DR.
+LIVINGSTONE'S EXPEDITION TO THE ZAMBESI AND ITS TRIBUTARIES***
+</pre>
+<p><a name="startoftext"></a></p>
+<p>Transcribed from the 1894 John Murray edition by David Price, email
+ccx074@coventry.ac.uk</p>
+<h1>A POPULAR ACCOUNT OF<br />
+DR. LIVINGSTONE&rsquo;S EXPEDITION TO THE ZAMBESI AND ITS TRIBUTARIES:<br />
+AND THE DISCOVERY OF LAKES SHIRWA AND NYASSA<br />
+1858-1864</h1>
+<p>TO THE RIGHT HON. LORD PALMERSTON,<br />
+K.G., G.C.B.</p>
+<p>My Lord,</p>
+<p>I beg leave to dedicate this Volume to your Lordship, as a tribute
+justly due to the great Statesman who has ever had at heart the amelioration
+of the African race; and as a token of admiration of the beneficial
+effects of that policy which he has so long laboured to establish on
+the West Coast of Africa; and which, in improving that region, has most
+forcibly shown the need of some similar system on the opposite side
+of the Continent.</p>
+<p>DAVID LIVINGSTONE.</p>
+<h2>NOTICE TO THIS WORK.</h2>
+<p>The name of the late Mr. Charles Livingstone takes a prominent place
+amongst those who acted under the leadership of Dr. Livingstone during
+the adventurous sojourn of the &ldquo;Zambesi Expedition&rdquo; in East
+Africa.&nbsp; In laying the result of their discoveries before the public,
+it was arranged that Mr. Charles Livingstone should place his voluminous
+notes at the disposal of his brother: they are incorporated in the present
+work, but in a necessarily abridged form.</p>
+<h2>PREFACE.</h2>
+<p>It has been my object in this work to give as clear an account as
+I was able of tracts of country previously unexplored, with their river
+systems, natural productions, and capabilities; and to bring before
+my countrymen, and all others interested in the cause of humanity, the
+misery entailed by the slave-trade in its inland phases; a subject on
+which I and my companions are the first who have had any opportunities
+of forming a judgment.&nbsp; The eight years spent in Africa, since
+my last work was published, have not, I fear, improved my power of writing
+English; but I hope that, whatever my descriptions want in clearness,
+or literary skill, may in a measure be compensated by the novelty of
+the scenes described, and the additional information afforded on that
+curse of Africa, and that shame, even now, in the 19th century, of an
+European nation,&mdash;the slave-trade.</p>
+<p>I took the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; to Bombay for the express purpose
+of selling her, and might without any difficulty have done so; but with
+the thought of parting with her arose, more strongly than ever, the
+feeling of disinclination to abandon the East Coast of Africa to the
+Portuguese and slave-trading, and I determined to run home and consult
+my friends before I allowed the little vessel to pass from my hands.&nbsp;
+After, therefore, having put two Ajawa lads, Chuma and Wakatani, to
+school under the eminent missionary the Rev. Dr. Wilson, and having
+provided satisfactorily for the native crew, I started homewards with
+the three white sailors, and reached London July 20th, 1864.&nbsp; Mr.
+and Mrs. Webb, my much-loved friends, wrote to Bombay inviting me, in
+the event of my coming to England, to make Newstead Abbey my headquarters,
+and on my arrival renewed their invitation: and though, when I accepted
+it, I had no intention of remaining so long with my kind-hearted generous
+friends, I stayed with them until April, 1865, and under their roof
+transcribed from my own and my brother&rsquo;s journal the whole of
+this present book.&nbsp; It is with heartfelt gratitude I would record
+their unwearied kindness.&nbsp; My acquaintance with Mr. Webb began
+in Africa, where he was a daring and successful hunter, and his continued
+friendship is most valuable because he has seen missionary work, and
+he would not accord his respect and esteem to me had he not believed
+that I, and my brethren also, were to be looked on as honest men earnestly
+trying to do our duty.</p>
+<p>The Government have supported the proposal of the Royal Geographical
+Society made by my friend Sir Roderick Murchison, and have united with
+that body to aid me in another attempt to open Africa to civilizing
+influences, and a valued private friend has given a thousand pounds
+for the same object.&nbsp; I propose to go inland, north of the territory
+which the Portuguese in Europe claim, and endeavour to commence that
+system on the East which has been so eminently successful on the West
+Coast; a system combining the repressive efforts of H.M. cruisers with
+lawful trade and Christian Missions&mdash;the moral and material results
+of which have been so gratifying.&nbsp; I hope to ascend the Rovuma,
+or some other river North of Cape Delgado, and, in addition to my other
+work, shall strive, by passing along the Northern end of Lake Nyassa
+and round the Southern end of Lake Tanganyika, to ascertain the watershed
+of that part of Africa.&nbsp; In so doing, I have no wish to unsettle
+what with so much toil and danger was accomplished by Speke and Grant,
+but rather to confirm their illustrious discoveries.</p>
+<p>I have to acknowledge the obliging readiness of Lord Russell in lending
+me the drawings taken by the artist who was in the first instance attached
+to the Expedition.&nbsp; These sketches, with photographs by Charles
+Livingstone and Dr. Kirk, have materially assisted in the illustrations.&nbsp;
+I would also very sincerely thank my friends Professor Owen and Mr.
+Oswell for many valuable hints and other aid in the preparation of this
+volume.</p>
+<p>Newstead Abbey,</p>
+<p>April 16, 1865.</p>
+<h2>THE ZAMBESI AND ITS TRIBUTARIES.</h2>
+<h3>INTRODUCTION.</h3>
+<p>Objects of the Expedition&mdash;Personal Interest shown by Naval
+Authorities&mdash;Members of the Zambesi Expedition.</p>
+<p>When first I determined on publishing the narrative of my &ldquo;Missionary
+Travels,&rdquo; I had a great misgiving as to whether the criticism
+my endeavours might provoke would be friendly or the reverse, more particularly
+as I felt that I had then been so long a sojourner in the wilderness,
+as to be quite a stranger to the British public.&nbsp; But I am now
+in this, my second essay at authorship, cheered by the conviction that
+very many readers, who are personally unknown to me, will receive this
+narrative with the kindly consideration and allowances of friends; and
+that many more, under the genial influences of an innate love of liberty,
+and of a desire to see the same social and religious blessings they
+themselves enjoy, disseminated throughout the world, will sympathize
+with me in the efforts by which I have striven, however imperfectly,
+to elevate the position and character of our fellow-men in Africa.&nbsp;
+This knowledge makes me doubly anxious to render my narrative acceptable
+to all my readers; but, in the absence of any excellence in literary
+composition, the natural consequence of my pursuits, I have to offer
+only a simple account of a mission which, with respect to the objects
+proposed to be thereby accomplished, formed a noble contrast to some
+of the earlier expeditions to Eastern Africa.&nbsp; I believe that the
+information it will give, respecting the people visited and the countries
+traversed, will not be materially gainsaid by any future commonplace
+traveller like myself, who may be blest with fair health and a gleam
+of sunshine in his breast.&nbsp; This account is written in the earnest
+hope that it may contribute to that information which will yet cause
+the great and fertile continent of Africa to be no longer kept wantonly
+sealed, but made available as the scene of European enterprise, and
+will enable its people to take a place among the nations of the earth,
+thus securing the happiness and prosperity of tribes now sunk in barbarism
+or debased by slavery; and, above all, I cherish the hope that it may
+lead to the introduction of the blessings of the Gospel.</p>
+<p>In order that the following narrative may be clearly understood,
+it is necessary to call to mind some things which took place previous
+to the Zambesi Expedition being sent out.&nbsp; Most geographers are
+aware that, before the discovery of Lake Ngami and the well-watered
+country in which the Makololo dwell, the idea prevailed that a large
+part of the interior of Africa consisted of sandy deserts, into which
+rivers ran and were lost.&nbsp; During my journey in 1852-6, from sea
+to sea, across the south intertropical part of the continent, it was
+found to be a well-watered country, with large tracts of fine fertile
+soil covered with forest, and beautiful grassy valleys, occupied by
+a considerable population; and one of the most wonderful waterfalls
+in the world was brought to light.&nbsp; The peculiar form of the continent
+was then ascertained to be an elevated plateau, somewhat depressed in
+the centre, and with fissures in the sides by which the rivers escaped
+to the sea; and this great fact in physical geography can never be referred
+to without calling to mind the remarkable hypothesis by which the distinguished
+President of the Royal Geographical Society (Sir Roderick I. Murchison)
+clearly indicated this peculiarity, before it was verified by actual
+observation of the altitudes of the country and by the courses of the
+rivers.&nbsp; New light was thrown on other portions of the continent
+by the famous travels of Dr. Barth, by the researches of the Church
+of England missionaries Krapf, Erkhardt, and Rebman, by the persevering
+efforts of Dr. Baikie, the last martyr to the climate and English enterprise,
+by the journey of Francis Galton, and by the most interesting discoveries
+of Lakes Tanganyika and Victoria Nyanza by Captain Burton, and by Captain
+Speke, whose untimely end we all so deeply deplore.&nbsp; Then followed
+the researches of Van der Decken, Thornton, and others; and last of
+all the grand discovery of the main source of the Nile, which every
+Englishman must feel an honest pride in knowing was accomplished by
+our gallant countrymen, Speke and Grant.&nbsp; The fabulous torrid zone,
+of parched and burning sand, was now proved to be a well-watered region
+resembling North America in its fresh-water lakes, and India in its
+hot humid lowlands, jungles, ghauts, and cool highland plains.</p>
+<p>The main object of this Zambesi Expedition, as our instructions from
+Her Majesty&rsquo;s Government explicitly stated, was to extend the
+knowledge already attained of the geography and mineral and agricultural
+resources of Eastern and Central Africa&mdash;to improve our acquaintance
+with the inhabitants, and to endeavour to engage them to apply themselves
+to industrial pursuits and to the cultivation of their lands, with a
+view to the production of raw material to be exported to England in
+return for British manufactures; and it was hoped that, by encouraging
+the natives to occupy themselves in the development of the resources
+of the country, a considerable advance might be made towards the extinction
+of the slave-trade, as they would not be long in discovering that the
+former would eventually be a more certain source of profit than the
+latter.&nbsp; The Expedition was sent in accordance with the settled
+policy of the English Government; and the Earl of Clarendon, being then
+at the head of the Foreign Office, the Mission was organized under his
+immediate care.&nbsp; When a change of Government ensued, we experienced
+the same generous countenance and sympathy from the Earl of Malmesbury,
+as we had previously received from Lord Clarendon; and, on the accession
+of Earl Russell to the high office he has so long filled, we were always
+favoured with equally ready attention and the same prompt assistance.&nbsp;
+Thus the conviction was produced that our work embodied the principles,
+not of any one party, but of the hearts of the statesmen and of the
+people of England generally.&nbsp; The Expedition owes great obligations
+to the Lords of the Admiralty for their unvarying readiness to render
+us every assistance in their power; and to the warm-hearted and ever-obliging
+hydrographer to the Admiralty, the late Admiral Washington, as a subordinate,
+but most effective agent, our heartfelt gratitude is also due; and we
+must ever thankfully acknowledge that our efficiency was mainly due
+to the kind services of Admirals Sir Frederick Grey, Sir Baldwin Walker,
+and all the naval officers serving under them on the East Coast.&nbsp;
+Nor must I omit to record our obligations to Mr. Skead, R.N.&nbsp; The
+Luaw&eacute; was carefully sounded and surveyed by this officer, whose
+skilful and zealous labours, both on that river, and afterwards on the
+Lower Zambesi, were deserving of all praise.</p>
+<p>In speaking of what has been done by the Expedition, it should always
+be understood that Dr. Kirk, Mr. Charles Livingstone, Mr. R. Thornton,
+and others composed it.&nbsp; In using the plural number they are meant,
+and I wish to bear testimony to the untiring zeal, energy, courage,
+and perseverance with which my companions laboured; undaunted by difficulties,
+dangers, or hard fare.&nbsp; It is my firm belief that, were their services
+required in any other capacity, they might be implicitly relied on to
+perform their duty like men.&nbsp; The reason why Dr. Kirk&rsquo;s name
+does not appear on the title-page of this narrative is, because it is
+hoped that he may give an account of the botany and natural history
+of the Expedition in a separate work from his own pen.&nbsp; He collected
+above four thousand species of plants, specimens of most of the valuable
+woods, of the different native manufactures, of the articles of food,
+and of the different kinds of cotton from every spot we visited, and
+a great variety of birds and insects; besides making meteorological
+observations, and affording, as our instructions required, medical assistance
+to the natives in every case where he could be of any use.</p>
+<p>Charles Livingstone was also fully occupied in his duties in following
+out the general objects of our mission, in encouraging the culture of
+cotton, in making many magnetic and meteorological observations, in
+photographing so long as the materials would serve, and in collecting
+a large number of birds, insects, and other objects of interest.&nbsp;
+The collections, being Government property, have been forwarded to the
+British Museum, and to the Royal Botanic, Gardens at Kew; and should
+Dr. Kirk undertake their description, three or four years will be required
+for the purpose.</p>
+<p>Though collections were made, it was always distinctly understood
+that, however desirable these and our explorations might be, &ldquo;Her
+Majesty&rsquo;s Government attached more importance to the moral influence
+that might be exerted on the minds of the natives by a well-regulated
+and orderly household of Europeans setting an example of consistent
+moral conduct to all who might witness it; treating the people with
+kindness, and relieving their wants, teaching them to make experiments
+in agriculture, explaining to them the more simple arts, imparting to
+them religious instruction as far as they are capable of receiving it,
+and inculcating peace and good will to each other.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>It would be tiresome to enumerate in detail all the little acts which
+were performed by us while following out our instructions.&nbsp; As
+a rule, whenever the steamer stopped to take in wood, or for any other
+purpose, Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone went ashore to their duties:
+one of our party, who it was intended should navigate the vessel and
+lay down the geographical positions, having failed to answer the expectations
+formed of him, these duties fell chiefly to my share.&nbsp; They involved
+a considerable amount of night work, in which I was always cheerfully
+aided by my companions, and the results were regularly communicated
+to our warm and ever-ready friend, Sir Thomas Maclear of the Royal Observatory,
+Cape of Good Hope.&nbsp; While this work was going through the press,
+we were favoured with the longitudes of several stations determined
+from observed occultations of stars by the moon, and from eclipses and
+reappearances of Jupiter&rsquo;s satellites, by Mr. Mann, the able Assistant
+to the Cape Astronomer Royal; the lunars are still in the hands of Mr.
+G. W. H. Maclear of the same Observatory.&nbsp; In addition to these,
+the altitudes, variations of the compass, latitudes and longitudes,
+as calculated on the spot, appear in the map by Mr. Arrowsmith, and
+it is hoped may not differ much from the results of the same data in
+abler bands.&nbsp; The office of &ldquo;skipper,&rdquo; which, rather
+than let the Expedition come to a stand, I undertook, required no great
+ability in one &ldquo;not too old to learn:&rdquo; it saved a salary,
+and, what was much more valuable than gold, saved the Expedition from
+the drawback of any one thinking that he was indispensable to its further
+progress.&nbsp; The office required attention to the vessel both at
+rest and in motion.&nbsp; It also involved considerable exposure to
+the sun; and to my regret kept me from much anticipated intercourse
+with the natives, and the formation of full vocabularies of their dialects.</p>
+<p>I may add that all wearisome repetitions are as much as possible
+avoided in the narrative; and, our movements and operations having previously
+been given in a series of despatches, the attempt is now made to give
+as fairly as possible just what would most strike any person of ordinary
+intelligence in passing through the country.&nbsp; For the sake of the
+freshness which usually attaches to first impressions, the Journal of
+Charles Livingstone has been incorporated in the narrative; and many
+remarks made by the natives, which ho put down at the moment of translation,
+will convey to others the same ideas as they did to ourselves.&nbsp;
+Some are no doubt trivial; but it is by the little acts and words of
+every-day life that character is truly and best known.&nbsp; And doubtless
+many will prefer to draw their own conclusions from them rather than
+to be schooled by us.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER I.</h3>
+<p>Arrival at the Zambesi&mdash;Rebel Warfare&mdash;Wild Animals&mdash;Shupanga&mdash;Hippopotamus
+Hunters&mdash;The Makololo&mdash;Crocodiles.</p>
+<p>The Expedition left England on the 10th of March, 1858, in Her Majesty&rsquo;s
+Colonial Steamer &ldquo;Pearl,&rdquo; commanded by Captain Duncan; and,
+after enjoying the generous hospitality of our friends at Cape Town,
+with the obliging attentions of Sir George Grey, and receiving on board
+Mr. Francis Skead, R.N., as surveyor, we reached the East Coast in the
+following May.</p>
+<p>Our first object was to explore the Zambesi, its mouths and tributaries,
+with a view to their being used as highways for commerce and Christianity
+to pass into the vast interior of Africa.&nbsp; When we came within
+five or six miles of the land, the yellowish-green tinge of the sea
+in soundings was suddenly succeeded by muddy water with wrack, as of
+a river in flood.&nbsp; The two colours did not intermingle, but the
+line of contact was as sharply defined as when the ocean meets the land.&nbsp;
+It was observed that under the wrack&mdash;consisting of reeds, sticks,
+and leaves,&mdash;and even under floating cuttlefish bones and Portuguese
+&ldquo;men-of-war&rdquo; (Physalia), numbers of small fish screen themselves
+from the eyes of birds of prey, and from the rays of the torrid sun.</p>
+<p>We entered the river Luaw&eacute; first, because its entrance is
+so smooth and deep, that the &ldquo;Pearl,&rdquo; drawing 9 feet 7 inches,
+went in without a boat sounding ahead.&nbsp; A small steam launch having
+been brought out from England in three sections on the deck of the &ldquo;Pearl&rdquo;
+was hoisted out and screwed together at the anchorage, and with her
+aid the exploration was commenced.&nbsp; She was called the &ldquo;Ma
+Robert,&rdquo; after Mrs. Livingstone, to whom the natives, according
+to their custom, gave the name Ma (mother) of her eldest son.&nbsp;
+The harbour is deep, but shut in by mangrove swamps; and though the
+water a few miles up is fresh, it is only a tidal river; for, after
+ascending some seventy miles, it was found to end in marshes blocked
+up with reeds and succulent aquatic plants.&nbsp; As the Luaw&eacute;
+had been called &ldquo;West Luabo,&rdquo; it was supposed to be a branch
+of the Zambesi, the main stream of which is called &ldquo;Luabo,&rdquo;
+or &ldquo;East Luabo.&rdquo;&nbsp; The &ldquo;Ma Robert&rdquo; and &ldquo;Pearl&rdquo;
+then went to what proved to be a real mouth of the river we sought.</p>
+<p>The Zambesi pours its waters into the ocean by four mouths, namely,
+the Milamb&eacute;, which is the most westerly, the Kongon&eacute;,
+the Luabo, and the Timbw&eacute; (or Muselo).&nbsp; When the river is
+in flood, a natural canal running parallel with the coast, and winding
+very much among the swamps, forms a secret way for conveying slaves
+from Quillimane to the bays Massangano and Nameara, or to the Zambesi
+itself.&nbsp; The Kwakwa, or river of Quillimane, some sixty miles distant
+from the mouth of the Zambesi, has long been represented as the principal
+entrance to the Zambesi, in order, as the Portuguese now maintain, that
+the English cruisers might be induced to watch the false mouth, while
+slaves were quietly shipped from the true one; and, strange to say,
+this error has lately been propagated by a map issued by the colonial
+minister of Portugal.</p>
+<p>After the examination of three branches by the able and energetic
+surveyor, Francis Skead, R.N., the Kongon&eacute; was found to be the
+best entrance.&nbsp; The immense amount of sand brought down by the
+Zambesi has in the course of ages formed a sort of promontory, against
+which the long swell of the Indian Ocean, beating during the prevailing
+winds, has formed bars, which, acting against the waters of the delta,
+may have led to their exit sideways.&nbsp; The Kongon&eacute; is one
+of those lateral branches, and the safest; inasmuch as the bar has nearly
+two fathoms on it at low water, and the rise at spring tides is from
+twelve to fourteen feet.&nbsp; The bar is narrow, the passage nearly
+straight, and, were it buoyed and a beacon placed on Pearl Island, would
+always be safe to a steamer.&nbsp; When the wind is from the east or
+north, the bar is smooth; if from the south and south-east, it has a
+heavy break on it, and is not to be attempted in boats.&nbsp; A strong
+current setting to the east when the tide is flowing, and to the west
+when ebbing, may drag a boat or ship into the breakers.&nbsp; If one
+is doubtful of his longitude and runs east, he will soon see the land
+at Timbw&eacute; disappear away to the north; and coming west again,
+he can easily make out East Luabo from its great size; and Kongon&eacute;
+follows several miles west.&nbsp; East Luabo has a good but long bar,
+and not to be attempted unless the wind be north-east or east.&nbsp;
+It has sometimes been called &ldquo;Barra Catrina,&rdquo; and was used
+in the embarkations of slaves.&nbsp; This may have been the &ldquo;River
+of Good Signs,&rdquo; of Vasco da Gama, as the mouth is more easily
+seen from the seaward than any other; but the absence of the pillar
+dedicated by that navigator to &ldquo;St. Raphael,&rdquo; leaves the
+matter in doubt.&nbsp; No Portuguese live within eighty miles of any
+mouth of the Zambesi.</p>
+<p>The Kongon&eacute; is five miles east of the Milamb&eacute;, or western
+branch, and seven miles west from East Luabo, which again is five miles
+from the Timbw&eacute;.&nbsp; We saw but few natives, and these, by
+escaping from their canoes into the mangrove thickets the moment they
+caught sight of us, gave unmistakeable indications that they had no
+very favourable opinion of white men.&nbsp; They were probably fugitives
+from Portuguese slavery.&nbsp; In the grassy glades buffaloes, wart-hogs,
+and three kinds of antelope were abundant, and the latter easily obtained.&nbsp;
+A few hours&rsquo; hunting usually provided venison enough for a score
+of men for several days.</p>
+<p>On proceeding up the Kongon&eacute; branch it was found that, by
+keeping well in the bends, which the current had worn deep, shoals were
+easily avoided.&nbsp; The first twenty miles are straight and deep;
+then a small and rather tortuous natural canal leads off to the right,
+and, after about five miles, during which the paddles almost touch the
+floating grass of the sides, ends in the broad Zambesi.&nbsp; The rest
+of the Kongon&eacute; branch comes out of the main stream considerably
+higher up as the outgoing branch called Doto.</p>
+<p>The first twenty miles of the Kongon&eacute; are enclosed in mangrove
+jungle; some of the trees are ornamented with orchilla weed, which appears
+never to have been gathered.&nbsp; Huge ferns, palm bushes, and occasionally
+wild date-palms peer out in the forest, which consists of different
+species of mangroves; the bunches of bright yellow, though scarcely
+edible fruit, contrasting prettily with the graceful green leaves.&nbsp;
+In some spots the Milola, an umbrageous hibiscus, with large yellowish
+flowers, grows in masses along the bank.&nbsp; Its bark is made into
+cordage, and is especially valuable for the manufacture of ropes attached
+to harpoons for killing the hippopotamus.&nbsp; The Pandanus or screw-palm,
+from which sugar bags are made in the Mauritius, also appears, and on
+coming out of the canal into the Zambesi many are so tall as in the
+distance to remind us of the steeples of our native land, and make us
+relish the remark of an old sailor, &ldquo;that but one thing was wanting
+to complete the picture, and that was a &lsquo;grog-shop near the church.&rsquo;&rdquo;&nbsp;
+We find also a few guava and lime-trees growing wild, but the natives
+claim the crops.&nbsp; The dark woods resound with the lively and exultant
+song of the kinghunter (<i>Halcyon striolata</i>), as he sits perched
+on high among the trees.&nbsp; As the steamer moves on through the winding
+channel, a pretty little heron or bright kingfisher darts out in alarm
+from the edge of the bank, flies on ahead a short distance, and settles
+quietly down to be again frightened off in a few seconds as we approach.&nbsp;
+The magnificent fishhawk (<i>Halietus vocifer</i>) sits on the top of
+a mangrove-tree, digesting his morning meal of fresh fish, and is clearly
+unwilling to stir until the imminence of the danger compels him at last
+to spread his great wings for flight.&nbsp; The glossy ibis, acute of
+ear to a remarkable degree, hears from afar the unwonted sound of the
+paddles, and, springing from the mud where his family has been quietly
+feasting, is off, screaming out his loud, harsh, and defiant Ha! ha!
+ha! long before the danger is near.</p>
+<p>Several native huts now peep out from the bananas and cocoa-palms
+on the right bank; they stand on piles a few feet above the low damp
+ground, and their owners enter them by means of ladders.&nbsp; The soil
+is wonderfully rich, and the gardens are really excellent.&nbsp; Rice
+is cultivated largely; sweet potatoes, pumpkins, tomatoes, cabbages,
+onions (shalots), peas, a little cotton, and sugar-cane are also raised.&nbsp;
+It is said that English potatoes, when planted at Quillimane on soil
+resembling this, in the course of two years become in taste like sweet
+potatoes (<i>Convolvulus batatas</i>), and are like our potato frosted.&nbsp;
+The whole of the fertile region extending from the Kongon&eacute; canal
+to beyond Mazaro, some eighty miles in length, and fifty in breadth,
+is admirably adapted for the growth of sugar-cane; and were it in the
+hands of our friends at the Cape, would supply all Europe with sugar.&nbsp;
+The remarkably few people seen appear to be tolerably well fed, but
+there was a dearth of clothing among them; all were blacks, and nearly
+all Portuguese &ldquo;colonos&rdquo; or serfs.&nbsp; They manifested
+no fear of white men, and stood in groups on the bank gazing in astonishment
+at the steamers, especially at the &ldquo;Pearl,&rdquo; which accompanied
+us thus far up the river.&nbsp; One old man who came on board remarked
+that never before had he seen any vessel so large as the &ldquo;Pearl,&rdquo;
+it was like a village, &ldquo;Was it made out of one tree?&rdquo;&nbsp;
+All were eager traders, and soon came off to the ship in light swift
+canoes with every kind of fruit and food they possessed; a few brought
+honey and beeswax, which are found in quantities in the mangrove forests.&nbsp;
+As the ships steamed off, many anxious sellers ran along the bank, holding
+up fowls, baskets of rice and meal, and shouting &ldquo;Malonda, Malonda,&rdquo;
+&ldquo;things for sale,&rdquo; while others followed in canoes, which
+they sent through the water with great velocity by means of short broad-bladed
+paddles.</p>
+<p>Finding the &ldquo;Pearl&rsquo;s&rdquo; draught too great for that
+part of the river near the island of Simbo, where the branch called
+the Doto is given off to the Kongon&eacute; on the right bank, and another
+named Chind&eacute; departs to the secret canal already mentioned on
+the left, the goods belonging to the expedition were taken out of her,
+and placed on one of the grassy islands about forty miles from the bar.&nbsp;
+The &ldquo;Pearl&rdquo; then left us, and we had to part with our good
+friends Duncan and Skead; the former for Ceylon, the latter to return
+to his duties as Government Surveyor at the Cape.</p>
+<p>Of those who eventually did the work of the expedition the majority
+took a sober common-sense view of the enterprise in which we were engaged.&nbsp;
+Some remained on Expedition Island from the 18th June until the 13th
+August, while the launch and pinnace were carrying the goods up to Shupanga
+and Senna.&nbsp; The country was in a state of war, our luggage was
+in danger, and several of our party were exposed to disease from inactivity
+in the malaria of the delta.&nbsp; Here some had their first introduction
+to African life, and African fever.&nbsp; Those alone were safe who
+were actively employed with the vessels, and of course, remembering
+the perilous position of their fellows, they strained every nerve to
+finish the work and take them away.</p>
+<p>Large columns of smoke rose daily from different points of the horizon,
+showing that the natives were burning off the immense crops of tall
+grass, here a nuisance, however valuable elsewhere.&nbsp; A white cloud
+was often observed to rest on the head of the column, as if a current
+of hot damp air was sent up by the heat of the flames and its moisture
+was condensed at the top.&nbsp; Rain did not follow, though theorists
+have imagined that in such cases it ought.</p>
+<p>Large game, buffaloes, and zebras, were abundant abreast the island,
+but no men could be seen.&nbsp; On the mainland, over on the right bank
+of the river, we were amused by the eccentric gyrations and evolutions
+of flocks of small seed-eating birds, who in their flight wheeled into
+compact columns with such military precision as to give us the impression
+that they must be guided by a leader, and all directed by the same signal.&nbsp;
+Several other kinds of small birds now go in flocks, and among others
+the large Senegal swallow.&nbsp; The presence of this bird, being clearly
+in a state of migration from the north, while the common swallow of
+the country, and the brown kite are away beyond the equator, leads to
+the conjecture that there may be a double migration, namely, of birds
+from torrid climates to the more temperate, as this now is, as well
+as from severe winters to sunny regions; but this could not be verified
+by such birds of passage as ourselves.</p>
+<p>On reaching Mazaro, the mouth of a narrow creek which in floods communicates
+with the Quillimane river, we found that the Portuguese were at war
+with a half-caste named Mariano <i>alias</i> Matakenya, from whom they
+had generally fled, and who, having built a stockade near the mouth
+of the Shir&eacute;, owned all the country between that river and Mazaro.&nbsp;
+Mariano was best known by his native name Matakenya, which in their
+tongue means &ldquo;trembling,&rdquo; or quivering as trees do in a
+storm.&nbsp; He was a keen slave-hunter, and kept a large number of
+men, well armed with muskets.&nbsp; It is an entire mistake to suppose
+that the slave trade is one of buying and selling alone; or that engagements
+can be made with labourers in Africa as they are in India; Mariano,
+like other Portuguese, had no labour to spare.&nbsp; He had been in
+the habit of sending out armed parties on slave-hunting forays among
+the helpless tribes to the north-east, and carrying down the kidnapped
+victims in chains to Quillimane, where they were sold by his brother-in-law
+Cruz Coimbra, and shipped as &ldquo;Free emigrants&rdquo; to the French
+island of Bourbon.&nbsp; So long as his robberies and murders were restricted
+to the natives at a distance, the authorities did not interfere; but
+his men, trained to deeds of violence and bloodshed in their slave forays,
+naturally began to practise on the people nearer at hand, though belonging
+to the Portuguese, and even in the village of Senna, under the guns
+of the fort.&nbsp; A gentleman of the highest standing told us that,
+while at dinner with his family, it was no uncommon event for a slave
+to rush into the room pursued by one of Mariano&rsquo;s men with spear
+in hand to murder him.</p>
+<p>The atrocities of this villain, aptly termed by the late governor
+of Quillimane a &ldquo;notorious robber and murderer,&rdquo; became
+at length intolerable.&nbsp; All the Portuguese spoke of him as a rare
+monster of inhumanity.&nbsp; It is unaccountable why half-castes, such
+as he, are so much more cruel than the Portuguese, but such is undoubtedly
+the case.</p>
+<p>It was asserted that one of his favourite modes of creating an impression
+in the country, and making his name dreaded, was to spear his captives
+with his own hands.&nbsp; On one occasion he is reported to have thus
+killed forty poor wretches placed in a row before him.&nbsp; We did
+not at first credit these statements, and thought that they were merely
+exaggerations of the incensed Portuguese, who naturally enough were
+exasperated with him for stopping their trade, and harbouring their
+runaway slaves; but we learned afterwards from the natives, that the
+accounts given us by the Portuguese had not exceeded the truth; and
+that Mariano was quite as great a ruffian as they had described him.&nbsp;
+One expects slave-owners to treat their human chattels as well as men
+do other animals of value, but the slave-trade seems always to engender
+an unreasoning ferocity, if not blood-thirstiness.</p>
+<p>War was declared against Mariano, and a force sent to take him; he
+resisted for a time; but seeing that he was likely to get the worst
+of it, and knowing that the Portuguese governors have small salaries,
+and are therefore &ldquo;disposed to be reasonable,&rdquo; he went down
+to Quillimane to &ldquo;arrange&rdquo; with the Governor, as it is termed
+here; but Colonel da Silva put him in prison, and then sent him for
+trial to Mozambique.&nbsp; When we came into the country, his people
+were fighting under his brother Bonga.&nbsp; The war had lasted six
+months and stopped all trade on the river during that period.&nbsp;
+On the 15th June we first came into contact with the &ldquo;rebels.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+They appeared as a crowd of well-armed and fantastically-dressed people
+under the trees at Mazaro.&nbsp; On explaining that we were English,
+some at once came on board and called to those on shore to lay aside
+their arms.&nbsp; On landing among them we saw that many had the branded
+marks of slaves on their chests, but they warmly approved our objects,
+and knew well the distinctive character of our nation on the slave question.&nbsp;
+The shout at our departure contrasted strongly with the suspicious questioning
+on our approach.&nbsp; Hence-forward we were recognized as friends by
+both parties.</p>
+<p>At a later period we were taking in wood within a mile of the scene
+of action, but a dense fog prevented our hearing the noise of a battle
+at Mazaro; and on arriving there, immediately after, many natives and
+Portuguese appeared on the bank.</p>
+<p>Dr. Livingstone, landing to salute some of his old friends among
+the latter, found himself in the sickening smell, and among the mutilated
+bodies of the slain; he was requested to take the Governor, who was
+very ill of fever, across to Shupanga, and just as he gave his assent,
+the rebels renewed the fight, and the balls began to whistle about in
+all directions.&nbsp; After trying in vain to get some one to assist
+the Governor down to the steamer, and unwilling to leave him in such
+danger, as the officer sent to bring our Kroomen did not appear, he
+went into the hut, and dragged along his Excellency to the ship.&nbsp;
+He was a very tall man, and as he swayed hither and thither from weakness,
+weighing down Dr. Livingstone, it must have appeared like one drunken
+man helping another.&nbsp; Some of the Portuguese white soldiers stood
+fighting with great bravery against the enemy in front, while a few
+were coolly shooting at their own slaves for fleeing into the river
+behind.&nbsp; The rebels soon retired, and the Portuguese escaped to
+a sandbank in the Zambesi, and thence to an island opposite Shupanga,
+where they lay for some weeks, looking at the rebels on the mainland
+opposite.&nbsp; This state of inactivity on the part of the Portuguese
+could not well be helped, as they had expended all their ammunition
+and were waiting anxiously for supplies; hoping, no doubt sincerely,
+that the enemy might not hear that their powder had failed.&nbsp; Luckily
+their hopes were not disappointed; the rebels waited until a supply
+came, and were then repulsed after three-and-a-half hours&rsquo; hard
+fighting.&nbsp; Two months afterwards Mariano&rsquo;s stockade was burned,
+the garrison having fled in a panic; and as Bonga declared that he did
+not wish to fight with this Governor, with whom he had no quarrel, the
+war soon came to an end.&nbsp; His Excellency meanwhile, being a disciple
+of Raspail, had taken nothing for the fever but a little camphor, and
+after he was taken to Shupanga became comatose.&nbsp; More potent remedies
+were administered to him, to his intense disgust, and he soon recovered.&nbsp;
+The Colonel in attendance, whom he never afterwards forgave, encouraged
+the treatment.&nbsp; &ldquo;Give what is right; never mind him; he is
+very (<i>muito</i>) impertinent:&rdquo; and all night long, with every
+draught of water the Colonel gave a quantity of quinine: the consequence
+was, next morning the patient was cinchonized and better.</p>
+<p>For sixty or seventy miles before reaching Mazaro, the scenery is
+tame and uninteresting.&nbsp; On either hand is a dreary uninhabited
+expanse, of the same level grassy plains, with merely a few trees to
+relieve the painful monotony.&nbsp; The round green top of the stately
+palm-tree looks at a distance, when its grey trunk cannot be seen, as
+though hung in mid-air.&nbsp; Many flocks of busy sand-martins, which
+here, and as far south as the Orange River, do not migrate, have perforated
+the banks two or three feet horizontally, in order to place their nests
+at the ends, and are now chasing on restless wing the myriads of tropical
+insects.&nbsp; The broad river has many low islands, on which are seen
+various kinds of waterfowl, such as geese, spoonbills, herons, and flamingoes.&nbsp;
+Repulsive crocodiles, as with open jaws they sleep and bask in the sun
+on the low banks, soon catch the sound of the revolving paddles and
+glide quietly into the stream.&nbsp; The hippopotamus, having selected
+some still reach of the river to spend the day, rises out of the bottom,
+where he has been enjoying his morning bath after the labours of the
+night on shore, blows a puff of spray from his nostrils, shakes the
+water out of his ears, puts his enormous snout up straight and yawns,
+sounding a loud alarm to the rest of the herd, with notes as of a monster
+bassoon.</p>
+<p>As we approach Mazaro the scenery improves.&nbsp; We see the well-wooded
+Shupanga ridge stretching to the left, and in front blue hills rise
+dimly far in the distance.&nbsp; There is no trade whatever on the Zambesi
+below Mazaro.&nbsp; All the merchandise of Senna and Tette is brought
+to that point in large canoes, and thence carried six miles across the
+country on men&rsquo;s heads to be reshipped on a small stream that
+flows into the Kwakwa, or Quillimane river, which is entirely distinct
+from the Zambesi.&nbsp; Only on rare occasions and during the highest
+floods can canoes pass from the Zambesi to the Quillimane river through
+the narrow natural canal <i>Mutu</i>.&nbsp; The natives of Maruru, or
+the country around Mazaro, the word Mazaro meaning the &ldquo;mouth
+of the creek&rdquo; Mutu, have a bad name among the Portuguese; they
+are said to be expert thieves, and the merchants sometimes suffer from
+their adroitness while the goods are in transit from one river to the
+other.&nbsp; In general they are trained canoe-men, and man many of
+the canoes that ply thence to Senna and Tette; their pay is small, and,
+not trusting the traders, they must always have it before they start.&nbsp;
+Africans being prone to assign plausible reasons for their conduct,
+like white men in more enlightened lands, it is possible they may be
+good-humouredly giving their reason for insisting on being invariably
+paid in advance in the words of their favourite canoe-song, &ldquo;Uachinger&eacute;,
+Uachinger&eacute; Kal&eacute;,&rdquo; &ldquo;You cheated me of old;&rdquo;
+or, &ldquo;Thou art slippery slippery truly.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>The Landeens or Zulus are lords of the right bank of the Zambesi;
+and the Portuguese, by paying this fighting tribe a pretty heavy annual
+tribute, practically admit this.&nbsp; Regularly every year come the
+Zulus in force to Senna and Shupanga for the accustomed tribute.&nbsp;
+The few wealthy merchants of Senna groan under the burden, for it falls
+chiefly on them.&nbsp; They submit to pay annually 200 pieces of cloth,
+of sixteen yards each, besides beads and brass wire, knowing that refusal
+involves war, which might end in the loss of all they possess.&nbsp;
+The Zulus appear to keep as sharp a look out on the Senna and Shupanga
+people as ever landlord did on tenant; the more they cultivate, the
+more tribute they have to pay.&nbsp; On asking some of them why they
+did not endeavour to raise certain highly profitable products, we were
+answered, &ldquo;What&rsquo;s the use of our cultivating any more than
+we do? the Landeens would only come down on us for more tribute.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>In the forests of Shupanga the Mokundu-kundu tree abounds; its bright
+yellow wood makes good boat-masts, and yields a strong bitter medicine
+for fever; the Gunda-tree attains to an immense size; its timber is
+hard, rather cross-grained, with masses of silica deposited in its substance;
+the large canoes, capable of carrying three or four tons, are made of
+its wood.&nbsp; For permission to cut these trees, a Portuguese gentleman
+of Quillimane was paying the Zulus, in 1858, two hundred dollars a year,
+and his successor now pays three hundred.</p>
+<p>At Shupanga, a one-storied stone house stands on the prettiest site
+on the river.&nbsp; In front a sloping lawn, with a fine mango orchard
+at its southern end, leads down to the broad Zambesi, whose green islands
+repose on the sunny bosom of the tranquil waters.&nbsp; Beyond, northwards,
+lie vast fields and forests of palm and tropical trees, with the massive
+mountain of Morambala towering amidst the white clouds; and further
+away more distant hills appear in the blue horizon.&nbsp; This beautifully
+situated house possesses a melancholy interest from having been associated
+in a most mournful manner with the history of two English expeditions.&nbsp;
+Here, in 1826, poor Kirkpatrick, of Captain Owen&rsquo;s Surveying Expedition,
+died of fever; and here, in 1862, died, of the same fatal disease, the
+beloved wife of Dr. Livingstone.&nbsp; A hundred yards east of the house,
+under a large Baobab-tree, far from their native land, both are buried.</p>
+<p>The Shupanga-house was the head-quarters of the Governor during the
+Mariano war.&nbsp; He told us that the province of Mosambique costs
+the Home Government between 5000<i>l</i>. and 6000<i>l</i>. annually,
+and East Africa yields no reward in return to the mother country.&nbsp;
+We met there several other influential Portuguese.&nbsp; All seemed
+friendly, and expressed their willingness to assist the expedition in
+every way in their power; and better still, Colonel Nunes and Major
+Sicard put their good-will into action, by cutting wood for the steamer
+and sending men to help in unloading.&nbsp; It was observable that not
+one of them knew anything about the Kongon&eacute; Mouth; all thought
+that we had come in by the &ldquo;Barra Catrina,&rdquo; or East Luabo.&nbsp;
+Dr. Kirk remained here a few weeks; and, besides exploring a small lake
+twenty miles to the south-west, had the sole medical care of the sick
+and wounded soldiers, for which valuable services he received the thanks
+of the Portuguese Government.&nbsp; We wooded up at this place with
+African ebony or black wood, and lignum vit&aelig;; the latter tree
+attains an immense size, sometimes as much as four feet in diameter;
+our engineer, knowing what ebony and lignum vit&aelig; cost at home,
+said it made his heart sore to burn wood so valuable.&nbsp; Though botanically
+different, they are extremely alike; the black wood as grown in some
+districts is superior, and the lignum vit&aelig; inferior in quality,
+to these timbers brought from other countries.&nbsp; Caoutchouc, or
+India-rubber, is found in abundance inland from Shupanga-house, and
+calumba-root is plentiful in the district; indigo, in quantities, propagates
+itself close to the banks of the Aver, and was probably at some time
+cultivated, for manufactured indigo was once exported.&nbsp; The India-rubber
+is made into balls for a game resembling &ldquo;fives,&rdquo; and calumba-root
+is said to be used as a mordant for certain colours, but not as a dye
+itself.</p>
+<p>We started for Tette on the 17th August, 1858; the navigation was
+rather difficult, the Zambesi from Shupanga to Senna being wide and
+full of islands; our black pilot, John Scisssors, a serf, sometimes
+took the wrong channel and ran us aground.&nbsp; Nothing abashed, he
+would exclaim in an aggrieved tone, &ldquo;This is not the path, it
+is back yonder.&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;Then why didn&rsquo;t you go yonder
+at first?&rdquo; growled out our Kroomen, who had the work of getting
+the vessel off.&nbsp; When they spoke roughly to poor Scissors, the
+weak cringing slave-spirit came forth in, &ldquo;Those men scold me
+so, I am ready to run away.&rdquo;&nbsp; This mode of finishing up an
+engagement is not at all uncommon on the Zambesi; several cases occurred,
+when we were on the river, of hired crews decamping with most of the
+goods in their charge.&nbsp; If the trader cannot redress his own wrongs,
+he has to endure them.&nbsp; The Landeens will not surrender a fugitive
+slave, even to his master.&nbsp; One belonging to Mr. Azevedo fled,
+and was, as a great favour only, returned after a present of much more
+than his value.</p>
+<p>We landed to wood at Shamoara, just below the confluence of the Shir&eacute;.&nbsp;
+Its quartz hills are covered with trees and gigantic grasses; the buaz&eacute;,
+a small forest-tree, grows abundantly; it is a species of polygala;
+its beautiful clusters of sweet-scented pinkish flowers perfume the
+air with a rich fragrance; its seeds produce a fine drying oil, and
+the bark of the smaller branches yields a fibre finer and stronger than
+flax; with which the natives make their nets for fishing.&nbsp; Bonga,
+the brother of the rebel Mariano, and now at the head of the revolted
+natives, with some of his principal men came to see us, and were perfectly
+friendly, though told of our having carried the sick Governor across
+to Shupanga, and of our having cured him of fever.&nbsp; On our acquainting
+Bonga with the object of the expedition, he remarked that we should
+suffer no hindrance from his people in our good work.&nbsp; He sent
+us a present of rice, two sheep, and a quantity of firewood.&nbsp; He
+never tried to make any use of us in the strife; the other side showed
+less confidence, by carefully cross-questioning our pilot whether we
+had sold any powder to the enemy.&nbsp; We managed, however, to keep
+on good terms with both rebels and Portuguese.</p>
+<p>Senna is built on a low plain, on the right bank of the Zambesi,
+with some pretty detached hills in the background; it is surrounded
+by a stockade of living trees to protect its inhabitants from their
+troublesome and rebellious neighbours.&nbsp; It contains a few large
+houses, some ruins of others, and a weather-beaten cross, where once
+stood a church; a mound shows the site of an ancient monastery, and
+a mud fort by the river is so dilapidated, that cows were grazing peacefully
+over its prostrate walls.</p>
+<p>The few Senna merchants, having little or no trade in the village,
+send parties of trusted slaves into the interior to hunt for and purchase
+ivory.&nbsp; It is a dull place, and very conducive to sleep.&nbsp;
+One is sure to take fever in Senna on the second day, if by chance one
+escapes it on the first day of a sojourn there; but no place is entirely
+bad.&nbsp; Senna has one redeeming feature: it is the native village
+of the large-hearted and hospitable Senhor H. A. Ferr&atilde;o.&nbsp;
+The benevolence of this gentleman is unbounded.&nbsp; The poor black
+stranger passing through the town goes to him almost as a matter of
+course for food, and is never sent away hungry.&nbsp; In times of famine
+the starving natives are fed by his generosity; hundreds of his own
+people he never sees except on these occasions; and the only benefit
+derived from being their master is, that they lean on him as a patriarchal
+chief, and he has the satisfaction of settling their differences, and
+of saving their lives in seasons of drought and scarcity.</p>
+<p>Senhor Ferr&atilde;o received us with his usual kindness, and gave
+us a bountiful breakfast.&nbsp; During the day the principal men of
+the place called, and were unanimously of opinion that the free natives
+would willingly cultivate large quantities of cotton, could they find
+purchasers.&nbsp; They had in former times exported largely both cotton
+and cloth to Manica and even to Brazil.&nbsp; &ldquo;On their own soil,&rdquo;
+they declared, &ldquo;the natives are willing to labour and trade, provided
+only they can do so to advantage: when it is for their interest, blacks
+work very hard.&rdquo;&nbsp; We often remarked subsequently that this
+was the opinion of men of energy; and that all settlers of activity,
+enterprise, and sober habits had become rich, while those who were much
+addicted to lying on their backs smoking, invariably complained of the
+laziness of the negroes, and were poor, proud, and despicable.</p>
+<p>Beyond Pita lies the little island Nyamotobsi, where we met a small
+fugitive tribe of hippopotamus hunters, who had been driven by war from
+their own island in front.&nbsp; All were busy at work; some were making
+gigantic baskets for grain, the men plaiting from the inside.&nbsp;
+With the civility so common among them the chief ordered a mat to be
+spread for us under a shed, and then showed us the weapon with which
+they kill the hippopotamus; it is a short iron harpoon inserted in the
+end of a long pole, but being intended to unship, it is made fast to
+a strong cord of milola, or hibiscus, bark, which is wound closely round
+the entire length of the shaft, and secured at its opposite end.&nbsp;
+Two men in a swift canoe steal quietly down on the sleeping animal.&nbsp;
+The bowman dashes the harpoon into the unconscious victim, while the
+quick steersman sweeps the light craft back with his broad paddle; the
+force of the blow separates the harpoon from its corded handle, which,
+appearing on the surface, sometimes with an inflated bladder attached,
+guides the hunters to where the wounded beast hides below until they
+despatch it.</p>
+<p>These hippopotamus hunters form a separate people, called Akombwi,
+or Mapodzo, and rarely&mdash;the women it is said never&mdash;intermarry
+with any other tribe.&nbsp; The reason for their keeping aloof from
+certain of the natives on the Zambesi is obvious enough, some having
+as great an abhorrence of hippopotamus meat as Mahomedans have of swine&rsquo;s
+flesh.&nbsp; Our pilot, Scissors, was one of this class; he would not
+even cook his food in a pot which had contained hippopotamus meat, preferring
+to go hungry till he could find another; and yet he traded eagerly in
+the animal&rsquo;s tusks, and ate with great relish the flesh of the
+foul-feeding marabout.&nbsp; These hunters go out frequently on long
+expeditions, taking in their canoes their wives and children, cooking-pots,
+and sleeping-mats.&nbsp; When they reach a good game district, they
+erect temporary huts on the bank, and there dry the meat they have killed.&nbsp;
+They are rather a comely-looking race, with very black smooth skins,
+and never disfigure themselves with the frightful ornaments of some
+of the other tribes.&nbsp; The chief declined to sell a harpoon, because
+they could not now get the milola bark from the coast on account of
+Mariano&rsquo;s war.&nbsp; He expressed some doubts about our being
+children of the same Almighty Father, remarking that &ldquo;they could
+not become white, let them wash ever so much.&rdquo;&nbsp; We made him
+a present of a bit of cloth, and he very generously gave us in return
+some fine fresh fish and Indian corn.</p>
+<p>The heat of the weather steadily increases during this month (August),
+and foggy mornings are now rare.&nbsp; A strong breeze ending in a gale
+blows up stream every night.&nbsp; It came in the afternoon a few weeks
+ago, then later, and at present its arrival is near midnight; it makes
+our frail cabin-doors fly open before it, but continues only for a short
+time, and is succeeded by a dead calm.&nbsp; Game becomes more abundant;
+near our wooding-places we see herds of zebras, both Burchell&rsquo;s
+and the mountain variety, pallahs (<i>Antelope melampus</i>), waterbuck,
+and wild hogs, with the spoor of buffaloes and elephants.</p>
+<p>Shiramba Demb&eacute;, on the right bank, is deserted; a few old
+iron guns show where a rebel stockade once stood; near the river above
+this, stands a magnificent Baobab hollowed out into a good-sized hut,
+with bark inside as well as without.&nbsp; The old oaks in Sherwood
+Forest, when hollow, have the inside dead or rotten; but the Baobab,
+though stripped of its bark outside, and hollowed to a cavity inside,
+has the power of exuding new bark from its substance to both the outer
+and inner surfaces; so, a hut made like that in the oak called the &ldquo;Forest
+Queen,&rdquo; in Sherwood, would soon all be lined with bark.</p>
+<p>The portions of the river called Shigogo and Shipanga are bordered
+by a low level expanse of marshy country, with occasional clumps of
+palm-trees and a few thorny acacias.&nbsp; The river itself spreads
+out to a width of from three to four miles, with many islands, among
+which it is difficult to navigate, except when the river is in flood.&nbsp;
+In front, a range of high hills from the north-east crosses and compresses
+it into a deep narrow channel, called the Lupata Gorge.&nbsp; The Portuguese
+thought the steamer would not stem the current here; but as it was not
+more than about three knots, and as there was a strong breeze in our
+favour, steam and sails got her through with ease.&nbsp; Heavy-laden
+canoes take two days to go up this pass.&nbsp; A current sweeps round
+the little rocky promontories Chifura and Kangomba, forming whirlpools
+and eddies dangerous for the clumsy craft, which are dragged past with
+long ropes.</p>
+<p>The paddlers place meal on these rocks as an offering to the turbulent
+deities, which they believe preside over spots fatal to many a large
+canoe.&nbsp; We were slily told that native Portuguese take off their
+hats to these river gods, and pass in solemn silence; when safely beyond
+the promontories, they fire muskets, and, as we ought to do, give the
+canoe-men grog.&nbsp; From the spoor of buffaloes and elephants it appears
+that these animals frequent Lupata in considerable numbers, and&mdash;we
+have often observed the association&mdash;the tsetse fly is common.&nbsp;
+A horse for the Governor of Tette was sent in a canoe from Quillimane;
+and, lest it should be wrecked on the Chifura and Kangomba rocks, it
+was put on shore and sent in the daytime through the pass.&nbsp; It
+was of course bitten by the tsetse, and died soon after; it was thought
+that the <i>air</i> of Tette had not agreed with it.&nbsp; The currents
+above Lupata are stronger than those below; the country becomes more
+picturesque and hilly, and there is a larger population.</p>
+<p>The ship anchored in the stream, off Tette, on the 8th September,
+1858, and Dr. Livingstone went ashore in the boat.&nbsp; No sooner did
+the Makololo recognize him, than they rushed to the water&rsquo;s edge,
+and manifested great joy at seeing him again.&nbsp; Some were hastening
+to embrace him, but others cried out, &ldquo;Don&rsquo;t touch him,
+you will spoil his new clothes.&rdquo;&nbsp; The five headmen came on
+board and listened in quiet sadness to the story of poor Sekwebu, who
+died at the Mauritius on his way to England.&nbsp; &ldquo;Men die in
+any country,&rdquo; they observed, and then told us that thirty of their
+own number had died of smallpox, having been bewitched by the people
+of Tette, who envied them because, during the first year, none of their
+party had died.&nbsp; Six of their young men, becoming tired of cutting
+firewood for a meagre pittance, proposed to go and dance for gain before
+some of the neighbouring chiefs.&nbsp; &ldquo;Don&rsquo;t go,&rdquo;
+said the others, &ldquo;we don&rsquo;t know the people of this country;&rdquo;
+but the young men set out and visited an independent half-caste chief,
+a few miles to the north, named Chisaka, who some years ago burned all
+the Portuguese villas on the north bank of the river; afterwards the
+young men went to Bonga, son of another half-caste chief, who bade defiance
+to the Tette authorities, and had a stockade at the confluence of the
+Zambesi and Luenya, a few miles below that village.&nbsp; Asking the
+Makololo whence they came, Bonga rejoined, &ldquo;Why do you come from
+my enemy to me?&nbsp; You have brought witchcraft medicine to kill me.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+In vain they protested that they did not belong to the country; they
+were strangers, and had come from afar with an Englishman.&nbsp; The
+superstitious savage put them all to death.&nbsp; &ldquo;We do not grieve,&rdquo;
+said their companions, &ldquo;for the thirty victims of the smallpox,
+who were taken away by Morimo (God); but our hearts are sore for the
+six youths who were murdered by Bonga.&rdquo;&nbsp; Any hope of obtaining
+justice on the murderer was out of the question.&nbsp; Bonga once caught
+a captain of the Portuguese army, and forced him to perform the menial
+labour of pounding maize in a wooden mortar.&nbsp; No punishment followed
+on this outrage.&nbsp; The Government of Lisbon has since given Bonga
+the honorary title of Captain, by way of coaxing him to own their authority;
+but he still holds his stockade.</p>
+<p>Tette stands on a succession of low sandstone ridges on the right
+bank of the Zambesi, which is here nearly a thousand yards wide (960
+yards).&nbsp; Shallow ravines, running parallel with the river, form
+the streets, the houses being built on the ridges.&nbsp; The whole surface
+of the streets, except narrow footpaths, were overrun with self-sown
+indigo, and tons of it might have been collected.&nbsp; In fact indigo,
+senna, and stramonium, with a species of cassia, form the weeds of the
+place, which are annually hoed off and burned.&nbsp; A wall of stone
+and mud surrounds the village, and the native population live in huts
+outside.&nbsp; The fort and the church, near the river, are the strongholds;
+the natives having a salutary dread of the guns of the one, and a superstitious
+fear of the unknown power of the other.&nbsp; The number of white inhabitants
+is small, and rather select, many of them having been considerately
+sent out of Portugal &ldquo;for their country&rsquo;s good.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+The military element preponderates in society; the convict and &ldquo;incorrigible&rdquo;
+class of soldiers, receiving very little pay, depend in great measure
+on the produce of the gardens of their black wives; the moral condition
+of the resulting population may be imagined.</p>
+<p>Droughts are of frequent occurrence at Tette, and the crops suffer
+severely.&nbsp; This may arise partly from the position of the town
+between the ranges of hills north and south, which appear to have a
+strong attraction for the rain-clouds.&nbsp; It is often seen to rain
+on these hills when not a drop falls at Tette.&nbsp; Our first season
+was one of drought.&nbsp; Thrice had the women planted their gardens
+in vain, the seed, after just vegetating, was killed by the intense
+dry heat.&nbsp; A fourth planting shared the same hard fate, and then
+some of the knowing ones discovered the cause of the clouds being frightened
+away: our unlucky rain-gauge in the garden.&nbsp; We got a bad name
+through that same rain-gauge, and were regarded by many as a species
+of evil omen.&nbsp; The Makololo in turn blamed the people of Tette
+for drought: &ldquo;A number of witches live here, who won&rsquo;t let
+it rain.&rdquo;&nbsp; Africans in general are sufficiently superstitious,
+but those of Tette are in this particular pre-eminent above their fellows.&nbsp;
+Coming from many different tribes, all the rays of the separate superstitions
+converge into a focus at Tette, and burn out common sense from the minds
+of the mixed breed.&nbsp; They believe that many evil spirits live in
+the air, the earth, and the water.&nbsp; These invisible malicious beings
+are thought to inflict much suffering on the human race; but, as they
+have a weakness for beer and a craving for food, they may be propitiated
+from time to time by offerings of meat and drink.&nbsp; The serpent
+is an object of worship, and hideous little images are hung in the huts
+of the sick and dying.&nbsp; The uncontaminated Africans believe that
+Morungo, the Great Spirit who formed all things, lives above the stars;
+but they never pray to him, and know nothing of their relation to him,
+or of his interest in them.&nbsp; The spirits of their departed ancestors
+are all good, according to their ideas, and on special occasions aid
+them in their enterprises.&nbsp; When a man has his hair cut, he is
+careful to burn it, or bury it secretly, lest, falling into the hands
+of one who has an evil eye, or is a witch, it should be used as a charm
+to afflict him with headache.&nbsp; They believe, too, that they will
+live after the death of the body, but do not know anything of the state
+of the Barimo (gods, or departed spirits).</p>
+<p>The mango-tree grows luxuriantly above Lupata, and furnishes a grateful
+shade.&nbsp; Its delicious fruit is superior to that on the coast.&nbsp;
+For weeks the natives who have charge of the mangoes live entirely on
+the fruit, and, as some trees bear in November and some in March, while
+the main crop comes between, fruit in abundance may easily be obtained
+during four months of the year; but no native can be induced to plant
+a mango.&nbsp; A wide-spread superstition has become riveted in the
+native mind, that if any one plants this tree he will soon die.&nbsp;
+The Makololo, like other natives, were very fond of the fruit; but when
+told to take up some mango-stones, on their return, and plant them in
+their own country&mdash;they too having become deeply imbued with the
+belief that it was a suicidal act to do so&mdash;replied &ldquo;they
+did not wish to die too soon.&rdquo;&nbsp; There is also a superstition
+even among the native Portuguese of Tette, that if a man plants coffee
+he will never afterwards be happy: they drink it, however, and seem
+the happier for it.</p>
+<p>The Portuguese of Tette have many slaves, with all the usual vices
+of their class, as theft, lying, and impurity.&nbsp; As a general rule
+the real Portuguese are tolerably humane masters and rarely treat a
+slave cruelly; this may be due as much to natural kindness of heart
+as to a fear of losing the slaves by their running away.&nbsp; When
+they purchase an adult slave they buy at the same time, if possible,
+all his relations along with him.&nbsp; They thus contrive to secure
+him to his new home by domestic ties.&nbsp; Running away then would
+be to forsake all who hold a place in his heart, for the mere chance
+of acquiring a freedom, which would probably be forfeited on his entrance
+into the first native village, for the chief might, without compunction,
+again sell him into slavery.</p>
+<p>A rather singular case of voluntary slavery came to our knowledge:
+a free black, an intelligent active young fellow, called Chibanti, who
+had been our pilot on the river, told us that he had sold himself into
+slavery.&nbsp; On asking why he had done this, he replied that he was
+all alone in the world, had neither father nor mother, nor any one else
+to give him water when sick, or food when hungry; so he sold himself
+to Major Sicard, a notoriously kind master, whose slaves had little
+to do, and plenty to eat.&nbsp; &ldquo;And how much did you get for
+yourself?&rdquo; we asked.&nbsp; &ldquo;Three thirty-yard pieces of
+cotton cloth,&rdquo; he replied; &ldquo;and I forthwith bought a man,
+a woman, and child, who cost me two of the pieces, and I had one piece
+left.&rdquo;&nbsp; This, at all events, showed a cool and calculating
+spirit; he afterwards bought more slaves, and in two years owned a sufficient
+number to man one of the large canoes.&nbsp; His master subsequently
+employed him in carrying ivory to Quillimane, and gave him cloth to
+hire mariners for the voyage; he took his own slaves, of course, and
+thus drove a thriving business; and was fully convinced that he had
+made a good speculation by the sale of himself, for had he been sick
+his master must have supported him.&nbsp; Occasionally some of the free
+blacks become slaves voluntarily by going through the simple but significant
+ceremony of breaking a spear in the presence of their future master.&nbsp;
+A Portuguese officer, since dead, persuaded one of the Makololo to remain
+in Tette, instead of returning to his own country, and tried also to
+induce him to break a spear before him, and thus acknowledge himself
+his slave, but the man was too shrewd for this; he was a great elephant
+doctor, who accompanied the hunters, told them when to attack the huge
+beast, and gave them medicine to ensure success.&nbsp; Unlike the real
+Portuguese, many of the half-castes are merciless slave-holders; their
+brutal treatment of the wretched slaves is notorious.&nbsp; What a humane
+native of Portugal once said of them is appropriate if not true: &ldquo;God
+made white men, and God made black men, but the devil made half-castes.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>The officers and merchants send parties of slaves under faithful
+headmen to hunt elephants and to trade in ivory, providing them with
+a certain quantity of cloth, beads, etc., and requiring so much ivory
+in return.&nbsp; These slaves think that they have made a good thing
+of it, when they kill an elephant near a village, as the natives give
+them beer and meal in exchange for some of the elephant&rsquo;s meat,
+and over every tusk that is brought there is expended a vast amount
+of time, talk, and beer.&nbsp; Most of the Africans are natural-born
+traders, they love trade more for the sake of trading than for what
+they make by it.&nbsp; An intelligent gentleman of Tette told us that
+native traders often come to him with a tusk for sale, consider the
+price he offers, demand more, talk over it, retire to consult about
+it, and at length go away without selling it; next day they try another
+merchant, talk, consider, get puzzled and go off as on the previous
+day, and continue this course daily until they have perhaps seen every
+merchant in the village, and then at last end by selling the precious
+tusk to some one for even less than the first merchant had offered.&nbsp;
+Their love of dawdling in the transaction arises from the self-importance
+conferred on them by their being the object of the wheedling and coaxing
+of eager merchants, a feeling to which even the love of gain is subordinate.</p>
+<p>The native medical profession is reasonably well represented.&nbsp;
+In addition to the regular practitioners, who are a really useful class,
+and know something of their profession, and the nature and power of
+certain medicines, there are others who devote their talents to some
+speciality.&nbsp; The elephant doctor prepares a medicine which is considered
+indispensable to the hunters when attacking that noble and sagacious
+beast; no hunter is willing to venture out before investing in this
+precious nostrum.&nbsp; The crocodile doctor sells a charm which is
+believed to possess the singular virtue of protecting its owner from
+crocodiles.&nbsp; Unwittingly we offended the crocodile school of medicine
+while at Tette, by shooting one of these huge reptiles as it lay basking
+in the sun on a sandbank; the doctors came to the Makololo in wrath,
+clamouring to know why the white man had shot their crocodile.</p>
+<p>A shark&rsquo;s hook was baited one evening with a dog, of which
+the crocodile is said to be particularly fond; but the doctors removed
+the bait, on the principle that the more crocodiles the more demand
+for medicine, or perhaps because they preferred to eat the dog themselves.&nbsp;
+Many of the natives of this quarter are known, as in the South Seas,
+to eat the dog without paying any attention to its feeding.&nbsp; The
+dice doctor or diviner is an important member of the community, being
+consulted by Portuguese and natives alike.&nbsp; Part of his business
+is that of a detective, it being his duty to discover thieves.&nbsp;
+When goods are stolen, he goes and looks at the place, casts his dice,
+and waits a few days, and then, for a consideration, tells who is the
+thief: he is generally correct, for he trusts not to his dice alone;
+he has confidential agents all over the village, by whose inquiries
+and information he is enabled to detect the culprit.&nbsp; Since the
+introduction of muskets, gun doctors have sprung up, and they sell the
+medicine which professes to make good marksmen; others are rain doctors,
+etc., etc.&nbsp; The various schools deal in little charms, which are
+hung round the purchaser&rsquo;s neck to avert evil: some of them contain
+the medicine, others increase its power.</p>
+<p>Indigo, about three or four feet high, grows in great luxuriance
+in the streets of Tette, and so does the senna plant.&nbsp; The leaves
+are undistinguishable from those imported in England.&nbsp; A small
+amount of first-rate cotton is cultivated by the native population for
+the manufacture of a coarse cloth.&nbsp; A neighbouring tribe raises
+the sugar-cane, and makes a little sugar; but they use most primitive
+wooden rollers, and having no skill in mixing lime with the extracted
+juice, the product is of course of very inferior quality.&nbsp; Plenty
+of magnetic iron ore is found near Tette, and coal also to any amount;
+a single cliff-seam measuring twenty-five feet in thickness.&nbsp; It
+was found to burn well in the steamer on the first trial.&nbsp; Gold
+is washed for in the beds of rivers, within a couple of days of Tette.&nbsp;
+The natives are fully aware of its value, but seldom search for it,
+and never dig deeper than four or five feet.&nbsp; They dread lest the
+falling in of the sand of the river&rsquo;s bed should bury them.&nbsp;
+In former times, when traders went with hundreds of slaves to the washings,
+the produce was considerable.&nbsp; It is now insignificant.&nbsp; The
+gold-producing lands have always been in the hands of independent tribes.&nbsp;
+Deep cuttings near the sources of the gold-yielding streams seem never
+to have been tried here, as in California and Australia, nor has any
+machinery been used save common wooden basins for washing.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER II.</h3>
+<p>Kebrabasa Rapids&mdash;Tette&mdash;African fever&mdash;Exploration
+of the Shir&eacute;&mdash;Discovery of Lake Shirwa.</p>
+<p>Our curiosity had been so much excited by the reports we had heard
+of the Kebrabasa rapids, that we resolved to make a short examination
+of them, and seized the opportunity of the Zambesi being unusually low,
+to endeavour to ascertain their character while uncovered by the water.&nbsp;
+We reached them on the 9th of November.&nbsp; The country between Tette
+and Panda Mokua, where navigation ends, is well wooded and hilly on
+both banks.&nbsp; Panda Mokua is a hill two miles below the rapids,
+capped with dolomite containing copper ore.</p>
+<p>Conspicuous among the trees, for its gigantic size, and bark coloured
+exactly like Egyptian syenite, is the burly Baobab.&nbsp; It often makes
+the other trees of the forest look like mere bushes in comparison.&nbsp;
+A hollow one, already mentioned, is 74 feet in circumference, another
+was 84, and some have been found on the West Coast which measure 100
+feet.&nbsp; The lofty range of Kebrabasa, consisting chiefly of conical
+hills, covered with scraggy trees, crosses the Zambesi, and confines
+it within a narrow, rough, and rocky dell of about a quarter of a mile
+in breadth; over this, which may be called the flood-bed of the river,
+large masses of rock are huddled in indescribable confusion.&nbsp; The
+drawing, for the use of which, and of others, our thanks are due to
+Lord Russell, conveys but a faint idea of the scene, inasmuch as the
+hills which confine the river do not appear in the sketch.&nbsp; The
+chief rock is syenite, some portions of which have a beautiful blue
+tinge like <i>lapis lazuli</i> diffused through them; others are grey.&nbsp;
+Blocks of granite also abound, of a pinkish tinge; and these with metamorphic
+rocks, contorted, twisted, and thrown into every conceivable position,
+afford a picture of dislocation or unconformability which would gladden
+a geological lecturer&rsquo;s heart; but at high flood this rough channel
+is all smoothed over, and it then conforms well with the river below
+it, which is half a mile wide.&nbsp; In the dry season the stream runs
+at the bottom of a narrow and deep groove, whose sides are polished
+and fluted by the boiling action of the water in flood, like the rims
+of ancient Eastern wells by the draw-ropes.&nbsp; The breadth of the
+groove is often not more than from forty to sixty yards, and it has
+some sharp turnings, double channels, and little cataracts in it.&nbsp;
+As we steamed up, the masts of the &ldquo;Ma Robert,&rdquo; though some
+thirty feet high, did not reach the level of the flood-channel above,
+and the man in the chains sung out, &ldquo;No bottom at ten fathoms.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+Huge pot-holes, as large as draw-wells, had been worn in the sides,
+and were so deep that in some instances, when protected from the sun
+by overhanging boulders, the water in them was quite cool.&nbsp; Some
+of these holes had been worn right through, and only the side next the
+rock remained; while the sides of the groove of the flood-channel were
+polished as smooth as if they had gone through the granite-mills of
+Aberdeen.&nbsp; The pressure of the water must be enormous to produce
+this polish.&nbsp; It had wedged round pebbles into chinks and crannies
+of the rocks so firmly that, though they looked quite loose, they could
+not be moved except with a hammer.&nbsp; The mighty power of the water
+here seen gave us an idea of what is going on in thousands of cataracts
+in the world.&nbsp; All the information we had been able to obtain from
+our Portuguese friends amounted to this, that some three or four detached
+rocks jutted out of the river in Kebrabasa, which, though dangerous
+to the cumbersome native canoes, could be easily passed by a steamer,
+and that if one or two of these obstructions were blasted away with
+gunpowder, no difficulty would hereafter be experienced.&nbsp; After
+we had painfully explored seven or eight miles of the rapid, we returned
+to the vessel satisfied that much greater labour was requisite for the
+mere examination of the cataracts than our friends supposed necessary
+to remove them; we therefore went down the river for fresh supplies,
+and made preparation for a more serious survey of this region.</p>
+<p>The steamer having returned from the bar, we set out on the 22nd
+of November to examine the rapids of Kebrabasa.&nbsp; We reached the
+foot of the hills again, late in the afternoon of the 24th, and anchored
+in the stream.&nbsp; Canoe-men never sleep on the river, but always
+spend the night on shore.&nbsp; The natives on the right bank, in the
+country called Shidima, who are Banyai, and even at this short distance
+from Tette, independent, and accustomed to lord it over Portuguese traders,
+wondered what could be our object in remaining afloat, and were naturally
+suspicious at our departing from the universal custom.</p>
+<p>They hailed us from the bank in the evening with &ldquo;Why don&rsquo;t
+you come and sleep onshore like other people?&rdquo;</p>
+<p>The answer they received from our Makololo, who now felt as independent
+as the Banyai, was, &ldquo;We are held to the bottom with iron; you
+may see we are not like your Bazungu.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>This hint, a little amplified, saved us from the usual exactions.&nbsp;
+It is pleasant to give a present, but that pleasure the Banyai usually
+deny to strangers by making it a fine, and demanding it in such a supercilious
+way, that only a sorely cowed trader could bear it.&nbsp; They often
+refuse to touch what is offered&mdash;throw it down and leave it&mdash;sneer
+at the trader&rsquo;s slaves, and refuse a passage until the tribute
+is raised to the utmost extent of his means.</p>
+<p>Leaving the steamer next morning, we proceeded on foot, accompanied
+by a native Portuguese and his men and a dozen Makololo, who carried
+our baggage.&nbsp; The morning was pleasant, the hills on our right
+furnished for a time a delightful shade; but before long the path grew
+frightfully rough, and the hills no longer shielded us from the blazing
+sun.&nbsp; Scarcely a vestige of a track was now visible; and, indeed,
+had not our guide assured us to the contrary, we should have been innocent
+of even the suspicion of a way along the patches of soft yielding sand,
+and on the great rocks over which we so painfully clambered.&nbsp; These
+rocks have a singular appearance, from being dislocated and twisted
+in every direction, and covered with a thin black glaze, as if highly
+polished and coated with lamp-black varnish.&nbsp; This seems to have
+been deposited while the river was in flood, for it covers only those
+rocks which lie between the highest water-mark and a line about four
+feet above the lowest.&nbsp; Travellers who have visited the rapids
+of the Orinoco and the Congo say that the rocks there have a similar
+appearance, and it is attributed to some deposit from the water, formed
+only when the current is strong.&nbsp; This may account for it in part
+here, as it prevails only where the narrow river is confined between
+masses of rock, backed by high hills, and where the current in floods
+is known to be the strongest; and it does not exist where the rocks
+are only on one side, with a sandy beach opposite, and a broad expanse
+of river between.&nbsp; The hot rocks burnt the thick soles of our men&rsquo;s
+feet, and sorely fatigued ourselves.&nbsp; Our first day&rsquo;s march
+did not exceed four miles in a straight line, and that we found more
+than enough to be pleasant.</p>
+<p>The state of insecurity in which the Bad&egrave;ma tribe live is
+indicated by the habit of hiding their provisions in the hills, and
+keeping only a small quantity in their huts; they strip a particular
+species of tree of its bitter bark, to which both mice and monkeys are
+known to have an antipathy, and, turning the bark inside out, sew it
+into cylindrical vessels for their grain, and bury them in holes and
+in crags on the wooded hill-sides.&nbsp; By this means, should a marauding
+party plunder their huts, they save a supply of corn.&nbsp; They &ldquo;could
+give us no information, and they had no food; Chisaka&rsquo;s men had
+robbed them a few weeks before.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>&ldquo;Never mind,&rdquo; said our native Portuguese, &ldquo;they
+will sell you plenty when you return, they are afraid of you now, as
+yet they do not know who you are.&rdquo;&nbsp; We slept under trees
+in the open air, and suffered no inconvenience from either mosquitoes
+or dew: and no prowling wild beast troubled us; though one evening,
+while we were here, a native sitting with some others on the opposite
+bank was killed by a leopard.</p>
+<p>One of the Tette slaves, who wished to be considered a great traveller,
+gave us, as we sat by our evening fire, an interesting account of a
+strange race of men whom he had seen in the interior; they were only
+three feet high, and had horns growing out of their heads; they lived
+in a large town and had plenty of food.&nbsp; The Makololo pooh-poohed
+this story, and roundly told the narrator that he was telling a downright
+lie.&nbsp; &ldquo;<i>We</i> come from the interior,&rdquo; cried out
+a tall fellow, measuring some six feet four, &ldquo;are <i>we</i> dwarfs?
+have <i>we</i> horns on our heads?&rdquo; and thus they laughed the
+fellow to scorn.&nbsp; But he still stoutly maintained that he had seen
+these little people, and had actually been in their town; thus making
+himself the hero of the traditional story, which before and since the
+time of Herodotus has, with curious persistency, clung to the native
+mind.&nbsp; The mere fact that such absurd notions are permanent, even
+in the entire absence of literature, invests the religious ideas of
+these people also with importance, as fragments of the wreck of the
+primitive faith floating down the stream of time.</p>
+<p>We waded across the rapid Luia, which took us up to the waist, and
+was about forty yards wide.&nbsp; The water was discoloured at the time,
+and we were not without apprehension that a crocodile might chance to
+fancy a white man for dinner.&nbsp; Next day one of the men crawled
+over the black rocks to within ten yards of a sleeping hippopotamus,
+and shot him through the brain.&nbsp; The weather being warm, the body
+floated in a few hours, and some of us had our first trial of hippopotamus
+flesh.&nbsp; It is a cross-grained meat, something between pork and
+beef,&mdash;pretty good food when one is hungry and can get nothing
+better.&nbsp; When we reached the foot of the mountain named Chipereziwa,
+whose perpendicular rocky sides are clothed with many-coloured lichens,
+our Portuguese companion informed us there were no more obstructions
+to navigation, the river being all smooth above; he had hunted there
+and knew it well.&nbsp; Supposing that the object of our trip was accomplished
+we turned back; but two natives, who came to our camp at night, assured
+us that a cataract, called Morumbwa, did still exist in front.&nbsp;
+Drs.&nbsp; Livingstone and Kirk then decided to go forward with three
+Makololo and settle the question for themselves.&nbsp; It was as tough
+a bit of travel as they ever had in Africa, and after some painful marching
+the Bad&egrave;ma guides refused to go further; &ldquo;the Banyai,&rdquo;
+they said, &ldquo;would be angry if they showed white men the country;
+and there was besides no practicable approach to the spot, neither elephant,
+nor hippopotamus, nor even a crocodile could reach the cataract.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+The slopes of the mountains on each side of the river, now not 300 yards
+wide, and without the flattish flood-channel and groove, were more than
+3000 feet from the sky-line down, and were covered either with dense
+thornbush or huge black boulders; this deep trough-like shape caused
+the sun&rsquo;s rays to converge as into a focus, making the surface
+so hot that the soles of the feet of the Makololo became blistered.&nbsp;
+Around, and up and down, the party clambered among these heated blocks,
+at a pace not exceeding a mile an hour; the strain upon the muscles
+in jumping from crag to boulder, and wriggling round projections, took
+an enormous deal out of them, and they were often glad to cower in the
+shadow formed by one rock overhanging and resting on another; the shelter
+induced the peculiarly strong and overpowering inclination to sleep,
+which too much sun sometimes causes.&nbsp; This sleep is curative of
+what may be incipient sunstroke: in its first gentle touches, it caused
+the dream to flit over the boiling brain, that they had become lunatics
+and had been sworn in as members of the Alpine club; and then it became
+so heavy that it made them feel as if a portion of existence had been
+cut out from their lives.&nbsp; The sun is excessively hot, and feels
+sharp in Africa; but, probably from the greater dryness of the atmosphere,
+we never heard of a single case of sunstroke, so common in India.&nbsp;
+The Makololo told Dr. Livingstone they &ldquo;always thought he had
+a heart, but now they believed he had none,&rdquo; and tried to persuade
+Dr. Kirk to return, on the ground that it must be evident that, in attempting
+to go where no living foot could tread, his leader had given unmistakeable
+signs of having gone mad.&nbsp; All their efforts of persuasion, however,
+were lost upon Dr. Kirk, as he had not yet learned their language, and
+his leader, knowing his companion to be equally anxious with himself
+to solve the problem of the navigableness of Kebrabasa, was not at pains
+to enlighten him.&nbsp; At one part a bare mountain spur barred the
+way, and had to be surmounted by a perilous and circuitous route, along
+which the crags were so hot that it was scarcely possible for the hand
+to hold on long enough to ensure safety in the passage; and had the
+foremost of the party lost his hold, he would have hurled all behind
+him into the river at the foot of the promontory; yet in this wild hot
+region, as they descended again to the river, they met a fisherman casting
+his hand-net into the boiling eddies, and he pointed out the cataract
+of Morumbwa; within an hour they were trying to measure it from an overhanging
+rock, at a height of about one hundred feet.&nbsp; When you stand facing
+the cataract, on the north bank, you see that it is situated in a sudden
+bend of the river, which is flowing in a short curve; the river above
+it is jammed between two mountains in a channel with perpendicular sides,
+and less than fifty yards wide; one or two masses of rock jut out, and
+then there is a sloping fall of perhaps twenty feet in a distance of
+thirty yards.&nbsp; It would stop all navigation, except during the
+highest floods; the rocks showed that the water then rises upwards of
+eighty feet perpendicularly.</p>
+<p>Still keeping the position facing the cataract, on its right side
+rises Mount Morumbwa from 2000 to 3000 feet high, which gives the name
+to the spot.&nbsp; On the left of the cataract stands a noticeable mountain
+which may be called onion-shaped, for it is partly conical and a large
+concave flake has peeled off, as granite often does, and left a broad,
+smooth convex face as if it were an enormous bulb.&nbsp; These two mountains
+extend their bases northwards about half a mile, and the river in that
+distance, still very narrow, is smooth, with a few detached rocks standing
+out from its bed.&nbsp; They climbed as high up the base of Mount Morumbwa,
+which touches the cataract, as they required.&nbsp; The rocks were all
+water-worn and smooth, with huge potholes, even at 100 feet above low
+water.&nbsp; When at a later period they climbed up the north-western
+base of this same mountain, the familiar face of the onion-shaped one
+opposite was at once recognised; one point of view on the talus of Mount
+Morumbwa was not more than 700 or 800 yards distant from the other,
+and they then completed the survey of Kebrabasa from end to end.</p>
+<p>They did not attempt to return by the way they came, but scaled the
+slope of the mountain on the north.&nbsp; It took them three hours&rsquo;
+hard labour in cutting their way up through the dense thornbush which
+covered the ascent.&nbsp; The face of the slope was often about an angle
+of 70 degrees, yet their guide Shokumbenla, whose hard, horny soles,
+resembling those of elephants, showed that he was accustomed to this
+rough and hot work, carried a pot of water for them nearly all the way
+up.&nbsp; They slept that night at a well in a tufaceous rock on the
+N.W. of Chipereziwa, and never was sleep more sweet.</p>
+<p>A band of native musicians came to our camp one evening, on our own
+way down, and treated us with their wild and not unpleasant music on
+the Marimba, an instrument formed of bars of hard wood of varying breadth
+and thickness, laid on different-sized hollow calabashes, and tuned
+to give the notes; a few pieces of cloth pleased them, and they passed
+on.</p>
+<p>The rainy season of Tette differs a little from that of some of the
+other intertropical regions; the quantity of rain-fall being considerably
+less.&nbsp; It begins in November and ends in April.&nbsp; During our
+first season in that place, only a little over nineteen inches of rain
+fell.&nbsp; In an average year, and when the crops are good, the fall
+amounts to about thirty-five inches.&nbsp; On many days it does not
+rain at all, and rarely is it wet all day; some days have merely a passing
+shower, preceded and followed by hot sunshine; occasionally an interval
+of a week, or even a fortnight, passes without a drop of rain, and then
+the crops suffer from the sun.&nbsp; These partial droughts happen in
+December and January.&nbsp; The heat appears to increase to a certain
+point in the different latitudes so as to necessitate a change, by some
+law similar to that which regulates the intense cold in other countries.&nbsp;
+After several days of progressive heat here, on the hottest of which
+the thermometer probably reaches 103 degrees in the shade, a break occurs
+in the weather, and a thunderstorm cools the air for a time.&nbsp; At
+Kuruman, when the thermometer stood above 84 degrees, rain might be
+expected; at Kolobeng, the point at which we looked for a storm was
+96 degrees.&nbsp; The Zambesi is in flood twice in the course of the
+year; the first flood, a partial one, attains its greatest height about
+the end of December or beginning of January; the second, and greatest,
+occurs after the river inundates the interior, in a manner similar to
+the overflow of the Nile, this rise not taking place at Tette until
+March.&nbsp; The Portuguese say that the greatest height which the March
+floods attain is thirty feet at Tette, and this happens only about every
+fourth year; their observations, however, have never been very accurate
+on anything but ivory, and they have in this case trusted to memory
+alone.&nbsp; The only fluviometer at Tette, or anywhere else on the
+river, was set up at our suggestion; and the first flood was at its
+greatest height of thirteen feet six inches on the 17th January, 1859,
+and then gradually fell a few feet, until succeeded by the greater flood
+of March.&nbsp; The river rises suddenly, the water is highly discoloured
+and impure, and there is a four-knot current in many places; but in
+a day or two after the first rush of waters is passed, the current becomes
+more equally spread over the whole bed of the river, and resumes its
+usual rate in the channel, although continuing in flood.&nbsp; The Zambesi
+water at other times is almost chemically pure, and the photographer
+would find that it is nearly as good as distilled water for the nitrate
+of silver bath.</p>
+<p>A third visit to Kebrabasa was made for the purpose of ascertaining
+whether it might be navigable when the Zambesi was in flood, the chief
+point of interest being of course Morumbwa; it was found that the rapids
+observed in our first trip had disappeared, and that while they were
+smoothed over, in a few places the current had increased in strength.&nbsp;
+As the river fell rapidly while we were on the journey, the cataract
+of Morumbwa did not differ materially from what it was when discovered.&nbsp;
+Some fishermen assured us that it was not visible when the river was
+at its fullest, and that the current was then not very strong.&nbsp;
+On this occasion we travelled on the right bank, and found it, with
+the additional inconvenience of rain, as rough and fatiguing as the
+left had been.&nbsp; Our progress was impeded by the tall wet grass
+and dripping boughs, and consequent fever.&nbsp; During the earlier
+part of the journey we came upon a few deserted hamlets only; but at
+last in a pleasant valley we met some of the people of the country,
+who were miserably poor and hungry.&nbsp; The women were gathering wild
+fruits in the woods.&nbsp; A young man having consented for two yards
+of cotton cloth to show us a short path to the cataract led us up a
+steep hill to a village perched on the edge of one of its precipices;
+a thunderstorm coming on at the time, the headman invited us to take
+shelter in a hut until it had passed.&nbsp; Our guide having informed
+him of what he knew and conceived to be our object, was favoured in
+return with a long reply in well-sounding blank verse; at the end of
+every line the guide, who listened with deep attention, responded with
+a grunt, which soon became so ludicrous that our men burst into a loud
+laugh.&nbsp; Neither the poet nor the responsive guide took the slightest
+notice of their rudeness, but kept on as energetically as ever to the
+end.&nbsp; The speech, or more probably our bad manners, made some impression
+on our guide, for he declined, although offered double pay, to go any
+further.</p>
+<p>A great deal of fever comes in with March and April; in March, if
+considerable intervals take place between the rainy days, and in April
+always, for then large surfaces of mud and decaying vegetation are exposed
+to the hot sun.&nbsp; In general an attack does not continue long, but
+it pulls one down quickly; though when the fever is checked the strength
+is as quickly restored.&nbsp; It had long been observed that those who
+were stationed for any length of time in one spot, and lived sedentary
+lives, suffered more from fever than others who moved about and had
+both mind and body occupied; but we could not all go in the small vessel
+when she made her trips, during which the change of place and scenery
+proved so conducive to health; and some of us were obliged to remain
+in charge of the expedition&rsquo;s property, making occasional branch
+trips to examine objects of interest in the vicinity.&nbsp; Whatever
+may be the cause of the fever, we observed that all were often affected
+at the same time, as if from malaria.&nbsp; This was particularly the
+case during a north wind: it was at first commonly believed that a daily
+dose of quinine would prevent the attack.&nbsp; For a number of months
+all our men, except two, took quinine regularly every morning.&nbsp;
+The fever some times attacked the believers in quinine, while the unbelievers
+in its prophylactic powers escaped.&nbsp; Whether we took it daily,
+or omitted it altogether for months, made no difference; the fever was
+impartial, and seized us on the days of quinine as regularly and as
+severely as when it remained undisturbed in the medicine chest, and
+we finally abandoned the use of it as a prophylactic altogether.&nbsp;
+The best preventive against fever is plenty of interesting work to do,
+and abundance of wholesome food to eat.&nbsp; To a man well housed and
+clothed, who enjoys these advantages, the fever at Tette will not prove
+a more formidable enemy than a common cold; but let one of these be
+wanting&mdash;let him be indolent, or guilty of excesses in eating or
+drinking, or have poor, scanty fare,&mdash;and the fever will probably
+become a more serious matter.&nbsp; It is of a milder type at Tette
+than at Quillimane or on the low sea-coast; and, as in this part of
+Africa one is as liable to fever as to colds in England, it would be
+advisable for strangers always to hasten from the coast to the high
+lands, in order that when the seizure does take place, it may be of
+the mildest type.&nbsp; Although quinine was not found to be a preventive,
+except possibly in the way of acting as a tonic, and rendering the system
+more able to resist the influence of malaria, it was found invaluable
+in the cure of the complaint, as soon as pains in the back, sore bones,
+headache, yawning, quick and sometimes intermittent pulse, noticeable
+pulsations of the jugulars, with suffused eyes, hot skin, and foul tongue,
+began. <a name="citation1"></a><a href="#footnote1">{1}</a></p>
+<p>Very curious are the effects of African fever on certain minds.&nbsp;
+Cheerfulness vanishes, and the whole mental horizon is overcast with
+black clouds of gloom and sadness.&nbsp; The liveliest joke cannot provoke
+even the semblance of a smile.&nbsp; The countenance is grave, the eyes
+suffused, and the few utterances are made in the piping voice of a wailing
+infant.&nbsp; An irritable temper is often the first symptom of approaching
+fever.&nbsp; At such times a man feels very much like a fool, if he
+does not act like one.&nbsp; Nothing is right, nothing pleases the fever-stricken
+victim.&nbsp; He is peevish, prone to find fault and to contradict,
+and think himself insulted, and is exactly what an Irish naval surgeon
+before a court-martial defined a drunken man to be: &ldquo;a man unfit
+for society.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>Finding that it was impossible to take our steamer of only ten-horse
+power through Kebrabasa, and convinced that, in order to force a passage
+when the river was in flood, much greater power was required, due information
+was forwarded to Her Majesty&rsquo;s Government, and application made
+for a more suitable vessel.&nbsp; Our attention was in the mean time
+turned to the exploration of the river Shir&eacute;, a northern tributary
+of the Zambesi, which joins it about a hundred miles from the sea.&nbsp;
+We could learn nothing satisfactory from the Portuguese regarding this
+affluent; no one, they said, had ever been up it, nor could they tell
+whence it came.&nbsp; Years ago a Portuguese expedition is said, however,
+to have attempted the ascent, but to have abandoned it on account of
+the impenetrable duckweed (<i>Pistia stratiotes</i>.)&nbsp; We could
+not learn from any record that the Shir&eacute; had ever been ascended
+by Europeans.&nbsp; As far, therefore, as we were concerned, the exploration
+was absolutely new.&nbsp; All the Portuguese believed the Manganja to
+be brave but bloodthirsty savages; and on our return we found that soon
+after our departure a report was widely spread that our temerity had
+been followed by fatal results, Dr. Livingstone having been shot, and
+Dr. Kirk mortally wounded by poisoned arrows.</p>
+<p>Our first trip to the Shir&eacute; was in January, 1859.&nbsp; A
+considerable quantity of weed floated down the river for the first twenty-five
+miles, but not sufficient to interrupt navigation with canoes or with
+any other craft.&nbsp; Nearly the whole of this aquatic plant proceeds
+from a marsh on the west, and comes into the river a little beyond a
+lofty hill called Mount Morambala.&nbsp; Above that there is hardly
+any.&nbsp; As we approached the villages, the natives collected in large
+numbers, armed with bows and poisoned arrows; and some, dodging behind
+trees, were observed taking aim as if on the point of shooting.&nbsp;
+All the women had been sent out of the way, and the men were evidently
+prepared to resist aggression.&nbsp; At the village of a chief named
+Tingan&eacute;, at least five hundred natives collected and ordered
+us to stop.&nbsp; Dr. Livingstone went ashore; and on his explaining
+that we were English and had come neither to take slaves nor to fight,
+but only to open a path by which our countrymen might follow to purchase
+cotton, or whatever else they might have to sell, except slaves, Tingan&eacute;
+became at once quite friendly.&nbsp; The presence of the steamer, which
+showed that they had an entirely new people to deal with, probably contributed
+to this result; for Tingan&eacute; was notorious for being the barrier
+to all intercourse between the Portuguese black traders and the natives
+further inland; none were allowed to pass him either way.&nbsp; He was
+an elderly, well-made man, grey-headed, and over six feet high.&nbsp;
+Though somewhat excited by our presence, he readily complied with the
+request to call his people together, in order that all might know what
+our objects were.</p>
+<p>In commencing intercourse with any people we almost always referred
+to the English detestation of slavery.&nbsp; Most of them already possess
+some information respecting the efforts made by the English at sea to
+suppress the slave-trade; and our work being to induce them to raise
+and sell cotton, instead of capturing and selling their fellow-men,
+our errand appears quite natural; and as they all have clear ideas of
+their own self-interest, and are keen traders, the reasonableness of
+the proposal is at once admitted; and as a belief in a Supreme Being,
+the Maker and Ruler of all things, and in the continued existence of
+departed spirits, is universal, it becomes quite appropriate to explain
+that we possess a Book containing a Revelation of the will of Him to
+whom in their natural state they recognise no relationship.&nbsp; The
+fact that His Son appeared among men, and left His words in His Book,
+always awakens attention; but the great difficulty is to make them feel
+that they have any relationship to Him, and that He feels any interest
+in them.&nbsp; The numbness of moral perception exhibited, is often
+discouraging; but the mode of communication, either by interpreters,
+or by the imperfect knowledge of the language, which not even missionaries
+of talent can overcome save by the labour of many years, may, in part,
+account for the phenomenon.&nbsp; However, the idea of the Father of
+all being displeased with His children, for selling or killing each
+other, at once gains their ready assent: it harmonizes so exactly with
+their own ideas of right and wrong.&nbsp; But, as in our own case at
+home, nothing less than the instruction and example of many years will
+secure their moral elevation.</p>
+<p>The dialect spoken here closely resembles that used at Senna and
+Tette.&nbsp; We understood it at first only enough to know whether our
+interpreter was saying what we bade him, or was indulging in his own
+version.&nbsp; After stating pretty nearly what he was told, he had
+an inveterate tendency to wind up with &ldquo;The Book says you are
+to grow cotton, and the English are to come and buy it,&rdquo; or with
+some joke of his own, which might have been ludicrous, had it not been
+seriously distressing.</p>
+<p>In the first ascent of the Shir&eacute; our attention was chiefly
+directed to the river itself.&nbsp; The delight of threading out the
+meanderings of upwards of 200 miles of a hitherto unexplored river must
+be felt to be appreciated.&nbsp; All the lower part of the river was
+found to be at least two fathoms in depth.&nbsp; It became shallower
+higher up, where many departing and re-entering branches diminished
+the volume of water, but the absence of sandbanks made it easy of navigation.&nbsp;
+We had to exercise the greatest care lest anything we did should be
+misconstrued by the crowds who watched us.&nbsp; After having made,
+in a straight line, one hundred miles, although the windings of the
+river had fully doubled the distance, we found further progress with
+the steamer arrested, in 15 degrees 55 minutes south, by magnificent
+cataracts, which we called, &ldquo;The Murchison,&rdquo; after one whose
+name has already a world-wide fame, and whose generous kindness we can
+never repay.&nbsp; The native name of that figured in the woodcut is
+Mamvira.&nbsp; It is that at which the progress of the steamer was first
+stopped.&nbsp; The angle of descent is much smaller than that of the
+five cataracts above it; indeed, so small as compared with them, that
+after they were discovered this was not included in the number.</p>
+<p>A few days were spent here in the hope that there might be an opportunity
+of taking observations for longitude, but it rained most of the time,
+or the sky was overcast.&nbsp; It was deemed imprudent to risk a land
+journey whilst the natives were so very suspicious as to have a strong
+guard on the banks of the river night and day; the weather also was
+unfavourable.&nbsp; After sending presents and messages to two of the
+chiefs, we returned to Tette.&nbsp; In going down stream our progress
+was rapid, as we were aided by the current.&nbsp; The hippopotami never
+made a mistake, but got out of our way.&nbsp; The crocodiles, not so
+wise, sometimes rushed with great velocity at us, thinking that we were
+some huge animal swimming.&nbsp; They kept about a foot from the surface,
+but made three well-defined ripples from the feet and body, which marked
+their rapid progress; raising the head out of the water when only a
+few yards from the expected feast, down they went to the bottom like
+a stone, without touching the boat.</p>
+<p>In the middle of March of the same year (1859), we started again
+for a second trip on the Shir&eacute;.&nbsp; The natives were now friendly,
+and readily sold us rice, fowls, and corn.&nbsp; We entered into amicable
+relations with the chief, Chibisa, whose village was about ten miles
+below the cataract.&nbsp; He had sent two men on our first visit to
+invite us to drink beer; but the steamer was such a terrible apparition
+to them, that, after shouting the invitation, they jumped ashore, and
+left their canoe to drift down the stream.&nbsp; Chibisa was a remarkably
+shrewd man, the very image, save his dark hue, of one of our most celebrated
+London actors, <a name="citation2"></a><a href="#footnote2">{2}</a>
+and the most intelligent chief, by far, in this quarter.&nbsp; A great
+deal of fighting had fallen to his lot, he said; but it was always others
+who began; he was invariably in the right, and they alone were to blame.&nbsp;
+He was moreover a firm believer in the divine right of kings.&nbsp;
+He was an ordinary man, he said, when his father died, and left him
+the chieftainship; but directly he succeeded to the high office, he
+was conscious of power passing into his head, and down his back; he
+felt it enter, and knew that he was a chief, clothed with authority,
+and possessed of wisdom; and people then began to fear and reverence
+him.&nbsp; He mentioned this, as one would a fact of natural history,
+any doubt being quite out of the question.&nbsp; His people, too, believed
+in him, for they bathed in the river without the slightest fear of crocodiles,
+the chief having placed a powerful medicine there, which protected them
+from the bite of these terrible reptiles.</p>
+<p>Leaving the vessel opposite Chibisa&rsquo;s village, Drs. Livingstone
+and Kirk and a number of the Makololo started on foot for Lake Shirwa.&nbsp;
+They travelled in a northerly direction over a mountainous country.&nbsp;
+The people were far from being well-disposed to them, and some of their
+guides tried to mislead them, and could not be trusted.&nbsp; Masakasa,
+a Makololo headman, overheard some remarks which satisfied him that
+the guide was leading them into trouble.&nbsp; He was quiet till they
+reached a lonely spot, when he came up to Dr. Livingstone, and said,
+&ldquo;That fellow is bad, he is taking us into mischief; my spear is
+sharp, and there is no one here; shall I cast him into the long grass?&rdquo;&nbsp;
+Had the Doctor given the slightest token of assent, or even kept silence,
+never more would any one have been led by that guide, for in a twinkling
+he would have been where &ldquo;the wicked cease from troubling.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+It was afterwards found that in this case there was no treachery at
+all, but a want of knowledge on their part of the language and of the
+country.&nbsp; They asked to be led to &ldquo;Nyanja Mukulu,&rdquo;
+or Great Lake, meaning, by this, Lake Shirwa; and the guide took them
+round a terribly rough piece of mountainous country, gradually edging
+away towards a long marsh, which from the numbers of those animals we
+had seen there we had called the Elephant Marsh, but which was really
+the place known to him by the name &ldquo;Nyanja Mukulu,&rdquo; or Great
+Lake.&nbsp; Nyanja or Nyanza means, generally, a marsh, lake, river,
+or even a mere rivulet.</p>
+<p>The party pushed on at last without guides, or only with crazy ones;
+for, oddly enough, they were often under great obligations to the madmen
+of the different villages: one of these honoured them, as they slept
+in the open air, by dancing and singing at their feet the whole night.&nbsp;
+These poor fellows sympathized with the explorers, probably in the belief
+that they belonged to their own class; and, uninfluenced by the general
+opinion of their countrymen, they really pitied, and took kindly to
+the strangers, and often guided them faithfully from place to place,
+when no sane man could be hired for love or money.</p>
+<p>The bearing of the Manganja at this time was very independent; a
+striking contrast to the cringing attitude they afterwards assumed,
+when the cruel scourge of slave-hunting passed over their country.&nbsp;
+Signals were given from the different villages by means of drums, and
+notes of defiance and intimidation were sounded in the travellers&rsquo;
+ears by day; and occasionally they were kept awake the whole night,
+in expectation of an instant attack.&nbsp; Drs. Livingstone and Kirk
+were desirous that nothing should occur to make the natives regard them
+as enemies; Masakasa, on the other hand, was anxious to show what he
+could do in the way of fighting them.</p>
+<p>The perseverance of the party was finally crowned with success; for
+on the 18th of April they discovered Lake Shirwa, a considerable body
+of bitter water, containing leeches, fish, crocodiles, and hippopotami.&nbsp;
+From having probably no outlet, the water is slightly brackish, and
+it appears to be deep, with islands like hills rising out of it.&nbsp;
+Their point of view was at the base of Mount Pirimiti or Mopeu-peu,
+on its S.S.W. side.&nbsp; Thence the prospect northwards ended in a
+sea horizon with two small islands in the distance&mdash;a larger one,
+resembling a hill-top and covered with trees, rose more in the foreground.&nbsp;
+Ranges of hills appeared on the east; and on the west stood Mount Chikala,
+which seems to be connected with the great mountain-mass called Zomba.</p>
+<p>The shore, near which they spent two nights, was covered with reeds
+and papyrus.&nbsp; Wishing to obtain the latitude by the natural horizon,
+they waded into the water some distance towards what was reported to
+be a sandbank, but were so assaulted by leeches, they were fain to retreat;
+and a woman told them that in enticing them into the water the men only
+wanted to kill them.&nbsp; The information gathered was that this lake
+was nothing in size compared to another in the north, from which it
+is separated by only a tongue of land.&nbsp; The northern end of Shirwa
+has not been seen, though it has been passed; the length of the lake
+may probably be 60 or 80 miles, and about 20 broad.&nbsp; The height
+above the sea is 1800 feet, and the taste of the water is like a weak
+solution of Epsom salts.&nbsp; The country around is very beautiful,
+and clothed with rich vegetation; and the waves, at the time they were
+there breaking and foaming over a rock on the south-eastern side, added
+to the beauty of the picture.&nbsp; Exceedingly lofty mountains, perhaps
+8000 feet above the sea-level, stand near the eastern shore.&nbsp; When
+their lofty steep-sided summits appear, some above, some below the clouds,
+the scene is grand.&nbsp; This range is called Milanj&eacute;; on the
+west stands Mount Zomba, 7000 feet in height, and some twenty miles
+long.</p>
+<p>Their object being rather to gain the confidence of the people by
+degrees than to explore, they considered that they had advanced far
+enough into the country for one trip; and believing that they could
+secure their end by a repetition of their visit, as they had done on
+the Shir&eacute;, they decided to return to the vessel at Dakanamoio
+island; but, instead of returning by the way they came, they passed
+down southwards close by Mount Chiradzuru, among the relatives of Chibisa,
+and thence by the pass Zedi, down to the Shir&eacute;.&nbsp; The Kroomen
+had, while we were away, cut a good supply of wood for steaming, and
+we soon proceeded down the river.</p>
+<p>The steamer reached Tette on the 23rd of June, and, after undergoing
+repairs, proceeded to the Kongon&eacute; to receive provisions from
+one of H.M. cruisers.&nbsp; We had been very abundantly supplied with
+first-rate stores, but were unfortunate enough to lose a considerable
+portion of them, and had now to bear the privation as best we could.&nbsp;
+On the way down, we purchased a few gigantic cabbages and pumpkins at
+a native village below Mazaro.&nbsp; Our dinners had usually consisted
+of but a single course; but we were surprised the next day by our black
+cook from Sierra Leone bearing in a second course.&nbsp; &ldquo;What
+have you got there?&rdquo; was asked in wonder.&nbsp; &ldquo;A tart,
+sir.&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;A tart! of what is it made?&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;Of
+cabbage, sir.&rdquo;&nbsp; As we had no sugar, and could not &ldquo;make
+believe,&rdquo; as in the days of boyhood, we did not enjoy the feast
+that Tom&rsquo;s genius had prepared.&nbsp; Her Majesty&rsquo;s brig
+&ldquo;Persian,&rdquo; Lieutenant Saumarez commanding, called on her
+way to the Cape; and, though somewhat short of provisions herself, generously
+gave us all she could spare.&nbsp; We now parted with our Kroomen, as,
+from their inability to march, we could not use them in our land journeys.&nbsp;
+A crew was picked out from the Makololo, who, besides being good travellers,
+could cut wood, work the ship, and required only native food.</p>
+<p>While at the Kongon&eacute; it was found necessary to beach the steamer
+for repairs.&nbsp; She was built of a newly invented sort of steel plates,
+only a sixteenth of an inch in thickness, patented, but unfortunately
+never tried before.&nbsp; To build an exploring ship of untried material
+was a mistake.&nbsp; Some chemical action on this preparation of steel
+caused a minute hole; from this point, branches like lichens, or the
+little ragged stars we sometimes see in thawing ice, radiated in all
+directions.&nbsp; Small holes went through wherever a bend occurred
+in these branches.&nbsp; The bottom very soon became like a sieve, completely
+full of minute holes, which leaked perpetually.&nbsp; The engineer stopped
+the larger ones, but the vessel was no sooner afloat, than new ones
+broke out.&nbsp; The first news of a morning was commonly the unpleasant
+announcement of another leak in the forward compartment, or in the middle,
+which was worse still.</p>
+<p>Frequent showers fell on our way up the Zambesi, in the beginning
+of August.&nbsp; On the 8th we had upwards of three inches of rain,
+which large quantity, more than falls in any single rainy day during
+the season at Tette, we owed to being near the sea.&nbsp; Sometimes
+the cabin was nearly flooded; for, in addition to the leakage from below,
+rain poured through the roof, and an umbrella had to be used whenever
+we wished to write: the mode of coupling the compartments, too, was
+a new one, and the action of the hinder compartment on the middle one
+pumped up the water of the river, and sent it in streams over the floor
+and lockers, where lay the cushions which did double duty as chairs
+and beds.&nbsp; In trying to form an opinion of the climate, it must
+be recollected that much of the fever, from which we suffered, was caused
+by sleeping on these wet cushions.&nbsp; Many of the botanical specimens,
+laboriously collected and carefully prepared by Dr. Kirk, were destroyed,
+or double work imposed, by their accidentally falling into wet places
+in the cabin.</p>
+<p>About the middle of August, after cutting wood at Shamoara, we again
+steamed up the Shir&eacute;, with the intention of becoming better acquainted
+with the people, and making another and longer journey on foot to the
+north of Lake Shirwa, in search of Lake Nyassa, of which we had already
+received some information, under the name Nyinyesi (the stars).&nbsp;
+The Shir&eacute; is much narrower than the Zambesi, but deeper, and
+more easily navigated.&nbsp; It drains a low and exceedingly fertile
+valley of from fifteen to twenty miles in breadth.&nbsp; Ranges of wooded
+hills bound this valley on both sides.&nbsp; For the first twenty miles
+the hills on the left bank are close to the river; then comes Morambala,
+a detached mountain 500 yards from the river&rsquo;s brink, which rises,
+with steep sides on the west, to 4000 feet in height, and is about seven
+miles in length.&nbsp; It is wooded up to the very top, and very beautiful.&nbsp;
+The southern end, seen from a distance, has a fine gradual slope, and
+looks as if it might be of easy ascent; but the side which faces the
+Shir&eacute; is steep and rocky, especially in the upper half.&nbsp;
+A small village peeps out about halfway up the mountain; it has a pure
+and bracing atmosphere; and is perched above mosquito range.&nbsp; The
+people on the summit have a very different climate and vegetation from
+those of the plains; but they have to spend a great portion of their
+existence amidst white fleecy clouds, which, in the rainy season, rest
+daily on the top of their favourite mountain.&nbsp; We were kindly treated
+by these mountaineers on our first ascent; before our second they were
+nearly all swept away by Mariano.&nbsp; Dr. Kirk found upwards of thirty
+species of ferns on this and other mountains, and even good-sized tree-ferns;
+though scarcely a single kind is to be met with on the plains.&nbsp;
+Lemon and orange trees grew wild, and pineapples had been planted by
+the people.&nbsp; Many large hornbills, hawks, monkeys, antelopes, and
+rhinoceroses found a home and food among the great trees round its base.&nbsp;
+A hot fountain boils up on the plain near the north end.&nbsp; It bubbles
+out of the earth, clear as crystal, at two points, or eyes, a few yards
+apart from each other, and sends off a fine flowing stream of hot water.&nbsp;
+The temperature was found to be 174 degrees Fahr., and it boiled an
+egg in about the usual time.&nbsp; Our guide threw in a small branch
+to show us how speedily the Mads&eacute;-aw&iacute;ra (boiling water)
+could kill the leaves.&nbsp; Unlucky lizards and insects did not seem
+to understand the nature of a hot-spring, as many of their remains were
+lying at the bottom.&nbsp; A large beetle had alighted on the water,
+and been killed before it had time to fold its wings.&nbsp; An incrustation,
+smelling of sulphur, has been deposited by the water on the stones.&nbsp;
+About a hundred feet from the eye of the fountain the mud is as hot
+as can be borne by the body.&nbsp; In taking a bath there, it makes
+the skin perfectly clean, and none of the mud adheres: it is strange
+that the Portuguese do not resort to it for the numerous cutaneous diseases
+with which they are so often afflicted.</p>
+<p>A few clumps of the palm and acacia trees appear west of Morambala,
+on the rich plain forming the tongue of land between the rivers Shir&eacute;
+and Zambesi.&nbsp; This is a good place for all sorts of game.&nbsp;
+The Zambesi canoe-men were afraid to sleep on it from the idea of lions
+being there; they preferred to pass the night on an island.&nbsp; Some
+black men, who accompanied us as volunteer workmen from Shupanga, called
+out one evening that a lion stood on the bank.&nbsp; It was very dark,
+and we could only see two sparkling lights, said to be the lion&rsquo;s
+eyes looking at us; for here, as elsewhere, they have a theory that
+the lion&rsquo;s eyes always flash fire at night.&nbsp; Not being fireflies&mdash;as
+they did not move when a shot was fired in their direction&mdash;they
+were probably glowworms.</p>
+<p>Beyond Morambala the Shir&eacute; comes winding through an extensive
+marsh.&nbsp; For many miles to the north a broad sea of fresh green
+grass extends, and is so level, that it might be used for taking the
+meridian altitude of the sun.&nbsp; Ten or fifteen miles north of Morambala,
+stands the dome-shaped mountain Makanga, or Chi-kanda; several others
+with granitic-looking peaks stretch away to the north, and form the
+eastern boundary of the valley; another range, but of metamorphic rocks,
+commencing opposite Senna, bounds the valley on the west.&nbsp; After
+streaming through a portion of this marsh, we came to a broad belt of
+palm and other trees, crossing the fine plain on the right bank.&nbsp;
+Marks of large game were abundant.&nbsp; Elephants had been feeding
+on the palm nuts, which have a pleasant fruity taste, and are used as
+food by man.&nbsp; Two pythons were observed coiled together among the
+branches of a large tree, and were both shot.&nbsp; The larger of the
+two, a female, was ten feet long.&nbsp; They are harmless, and said
+to be good eating.&nbsp; The Makololo having set fire to the grass where
+they were cutting wood, a solitary buffalo rushed out of the conflagration,
+and made a furious charge at an active young fellow named Mantlanyan&eacute;.&nbsp;
+Never did his fleet limbs serve him better than during the few seconds
+of his fearful flight before the maddened animal.&nbsp; When he reached
+the bank, and sprang into the river, the infuriated beast was scarcely
+six feet behind him.&nbsp; Towards evening, after the day&rsquo;s labour
+in wood-cutting was over, some of the men went fishing.&nbsp; They followed
+the common African custom of agitating the water, by giving it a few
+sharp strokes with the top of the fishing-rod, immediately after throwing
+in the line, to attract the attention of the fish to the bait.&nbsp;
+Having caught nothing, the reason assigned was the same as would have
+been given in England under like circumstances, namely, that &ldquo;the
+wind made the fish cold, and they would not bite.&rdquo;&nbsp; Many
+gardens of maize, pumpkins, and tobacco, fringed the marshy banks as
+we went on.&nbsp; They belong to natives of the hills, who come down
+in the dry season, and raise a crop on parts at other times flooded.&nbsp;
+While the crops are growing, large quantities of fish are caught, chiefly
+<i>Clarias capensis</i>, and <i>Mugil Africanus</i>; they are dried
+for sale or future consumption.</p>
+<p>As we ascended, we passed a deep stream about thirty yards wide,
+flowing in from a body of open water several miles broad.&nbsp; Numbers
+of men were busy at different parts of it, filling their canoes with
+the lotus root, called <i>Nyika</i>, which, when boiled or roasted,
+resembles our chestnuts, and is extensively used in Africa as food.&nbsp;
+Out of this lagoon, and by this stream, the chief part of the duckweed
+of the Shir&eacute; flows.&nbsp; The lagoon itself is called Nyanja
+ea Motop&eacute; (Lake of Mud).&nbsp; It is also named Nyanja Pangono
+(Little Lake), while the elephant marsh goes by the name of Nyanja Mukulu
+(Great Lake).&nbsp; It is evident from the shore line still to be observed
+on the adjacent hills, that in ancient times these were really lakes,
+and the traditional names thus preserved are only another evidence of
+the general desiccation which Africa has undergone.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER III.</h3>
+<p>The Steamer in difficulties&mdash;Elephant hunting&mdash;Arrival
+at Chibisa&rsquo;s&mdash;Search for Lake Nyassa&mdash;The Manganja country&mdash;Weavers
+and smelters&mdash;Lake Pamalomb&eacute;.</p>
+<p>Late in the afternoon of the first day&rsquo;s steaming, after we
+left the wooding-place, we called at the village of Chikanda-Kadz&eacute;,
+a female chief, to purchase rice for our men; but we were now in the
+blissful region where time is absolutely of no account, and where men
+may sit down and rest themselves when tired; so they requested us to
+wait till next day, and they would then sell us some food.&nbsp; As
+our forty black men, however, had nothing to cook for supper, we were
+obliged to steam on to reach a village a few miles above.&nbsp; When
+we meet those who care not whether we purchase or let it alone, or who
+think men ought only to be in a hurry when fleeing from an enemy, our
+ideas about time being money, and the power of the purse, receives a
+shock.&nbsp; The state of eager competition, which in England wears
+out both mind and body, and makes life bitter, is here happily unknown.&nbsp;
+The cultivated spots are mere dots compared to the broad fields of rich
+soil which is never either grazed or tilled.&nbsp; Pity that the plenty
+in store for all, from our Father&rsquo;s bountiful hands, is not enjoyed
+by more.</p>
+<p>The wretched little steamer could not carry all the hands we needed;
+so, to lighten her, we put some into the boats and towed them astern.&nbsp;
+In the dark, one of the boats was capsized; but all in it, except one
+poor fellow who could not swim, were picked up.&nbsp; His loss threw
+a gloom over us all, and added to the chagrin we often felt at having
+been so ill-served in our sorry craft.</p>
+<p>Next day we arrived at the village of Mboma (16 degrees 56 minutes
+30 seconds S.), where the people raised large quantities of rice, and
+were eager traders; the rice was sold at wonderfully low rates, and
+we could not purchase a tithe of the food brought for sale.</p>
+<p>A native minstrel serenaded us in the evening, playing several quaint
+tunes on a species of one stringed fiddle, accompanied by wild, but
+not unmusical songs.&nbsp; He told the Makololo that he intended to
+play all night to induce us to give him a present.&nbsp; The nights
+being cold, the thermometer falling to 47 degrees, with occasional fogs,
+he was asked if he was not afraid of perishing from cold; but, with
+the genuine spirit of an Italian organ-grinder, he replied, &ldquo;Oh,
+no; I shall spend the night with my white comrades in the big canoe;
+I have often heard of the white men, but have never seen them till now,
+and I must sing and play well to them.&rdquo;&nbsp; A small piece of
+cloth, however, bought him off, and he moved away in good humour.&nbsp;
+The water of the river was 70 degrees at sunrise, which was 23 degrees
+warmer than the air at the same time, and this caused fogs, which rose
+like steam off the river.&nbsp; When this is the case cold bathing in
+the mornings at this time of the year is improper, for, instead of a
+glow on coming out, one is apt to get a chill; the air being so much
+colder than the water.</p>
+<p>A range of hills, commencing opposite Senna, comes to within two
+or three miles of Mboma village, and then runs in a north-westerly direction;
+the principal hill is named Malaw&eacute;; a number of villages stand
+on its tree-covered sides, and coal is found cropping out in the rocks.&nbsp;
+The country improves as we ascend, the rich valley becoming less swampy,
+and adorned with a number of trees.</p>
+<p>Both banks are dotted with hippopotamus traps, over every track which
+these animals have made in going up out of the water to graze.&nbsp;
+The hippopotamus feeds on grass alone, and, where there is any danger,
+only at night.&nbsp; Its enormous lips act like a mowing-machine, and
+form a path of short-cropped grass as it feeds.&nbsp; We never saw it
+eat aquatic plants or reeds.&nbsp; The tusks seem weapons of both offence
+and defence.&nbsp; The hippopotamus trap consists of a beam five or
+six feet long, armed with a spear-head or hard-wood spike, covered with
+poison, and suspended to a forked pole by a cord, which, coming down
+to the path, is held by a catch, to be set free when the beast treads
+on it.&nbsp; Being wary brutes, they are still very numerous.&nbsp;
+One got frightened by the ship, as she was steaming close to the bank.&nbsp;
+In its eager hurry to escape it rushed on shore, and ran directly under
+a trap, when down came the heavy beam on its back, driving the poisoned
+spear-head a foot deep into its flesh.&nbsp; In its agony it plunged
+back into the river, to die in a few hours, and afterwards furnished
+a feast for the natives.&nbsp; The poison on the spear-head does not
+affect the meat, except the part around the wound, and that is thrown
+away.&nbsp; In some places the descending beam is weighted with heavy
+stones, but here the hard heavy wood is sufficient.</p>
+<p>&ldquo;She is leaking worse than ever forward, sir, and there is
+a foot of water in the hold,&rdquo; was our first salutation on the
+morning of the 20th.&nbsp; But we have become accustomed to these things
+now; the cabin-floor is always wet, and one is obliged to mop up the
+water many times a day, giving some countenance to the native idea that
+Englishmen live in or on the water, and have no houses but ships.&nbsp;
+The cabin is now a favourite breeding-place for mosquitoes, and we have
+to support both the ship-bred and shore-bred bloodsuckers, of which
+several species show us their irritating attentions.&nbsp; A large brown
+sort, called by the Portuguese <i>mansos</i> (tame), flies straight
+to its victim, and goes to work at once, as though it were an invited
+guest.&nbsp; Some of the small kinds carry uncommonly sharp lancets,
+and very potent poison.&nbsp; &ldquo;What would these insects eat, if
+we did not pass this way?&rdquo; becomes a natural question.</p>
+<p>The juices of plants, and decaying vegetable matter in the mud, probably
+form the natural food of mosquitoes, and blood is not necessary for
+their existence.&nbsp; They appear so commonly at malarious spots, that
+their presence may be taken as a hint to man to be off to more healthy
+localities.&nbsp; None appear on the high lands.&nbsp; On the low lands
+they swarm in myriads.&nbsp; The females alone are furnished with the
+biting apparatus, and their number appears to be out of all proportion
+in excess of the males.&nbsp; At anchor, on a still evening, they were
+excessively annoying; and the sooner we took refuge under our mosquito
+curtains, the better.&nbsp; The miserable and sleepless night that only
+one mosquito inside the curtain can cause, is so well known, and has
+been so often described, that it is needless to describe it here.&nbsp;
+One soon learns, from experience, that to beat out the curtains thoroughly
+before entering them, so that not one of these pests can possibly be
+harboured within, is the only safeguard against such severe trials to
+one&rsquo;s tranquillity and temper.</p>
+<p>A few miles above Mboma we came again to the village (16 degrees
+44 minutes 30 seconds S.) of the chief Tingan&eacute;, the beat of whose
+war-drums can speedily muster some hundreds of armed men.&nbsp; The
+bows and poisoned arrows here are of superior workmanship to those below.&nbsp;
+Mariano&rsquo;s slave-hunting parties stood in great awe of these barbed
+arrows, and long kept aloof from Tingan&eacute;&rsquo;s villages.&nbsp;
+His people were friendly enough with us now, and covered the banks with
+a variety of articles for sale.&nbsp; The majestic mountain, Chipiron&eacute;,
+to which we have given the name of Mount Clarendon, now looms in sight,
+and further to the N.W. the southern end of the grand Milanj&eacute;
+range rises in the form of an unfinished sphinx looking down on Lake
+Shirwa.&nbsp; The Ruo (16 degrees 31 minutes 0 seconds S.) is said to
+have its source in the Milanj&eacute; mountains, and flows to the S.W.,
+to join the Shir&eacute; some distance above Tingan&eacute;&rsquo;s.&nbsp;
+A short way beyond the Ruo lies the Elephant marsh, or Nyanja Mukulu,
+which is frequented by vast herds of these animals.&nbsp; We believe
+that we counted eight hundred elephants in sight at once.&nbsp; In the
+choice of such a strong hold, they have shown their usual sagacity,
+for no hunter can get near them through the swamps.&nbsp; They now keep
+far from the steamer; but, when she first came up, we steamed into the
+midst of a herd, and some were shot from the ship&rsquo;s deck.&nbsp;
+A single lesson was sufficient to teach them that the steamer was a
+thing to be avoided; and at the first glimpse they are now off two or
+three miles to the midst of the marsh, which is furrowed in every direction
+by wandering branches of the Shir&eacute;.&nbsp; A fine young elephant
+was here caught alive, as he was climbing up the bank to follow his
+retreating dam.&nbsp; When laid hold of, he screamed with so much energy
+that, to escape a visit from the enraged mother, we steamed off, and
+dragged him through the water by the proboscis.&nbsp; As the men were
+holding his trunk over the gunwale, Monga, a brave Makololo elephant-hunter,
+rushed aft, and drew his knife across it in a sort of frenzy peculiar
+to the chase.&nbsp; The wound was skilfully sewn up, and the young animal
+soon became quite tame, but, unfortunately the breathing prevented the
+cut from healing, and he died in a few days from loss of blood.&nbsp;
+Had he lived, and had we been able to bring him home, he would have
+been the first <i>African</i> elephant ever seen in England.&nbsp; The
+African male elephant is from ten to a little over eleven feet in height,
+and differs from the Asiatic species more particularly in the convex
+shape of his forehead, and the enormous size of his ears.&nbsp; In Asia
+many of the males, and all the females, are without tusks, but in Africa
+both sexes are provided with these weapons.&nbsp; The enamel in the
+molar teeth is arranged differently in the two species.&nbsp; By an
+admirable provision, new teeth constantly come up at the part where
+in man the wisdom teeth appear, and these push the others along, and
+out at the front end of the jaws, thus keeping the molars sound by renewal,
+till the animal attains a very great age.&nbsp; The tusks of animals
+from dry rocky countries are very munch more dense and heavier than
+those from wet and marshy districts, but the latter attain much the
+larger size.</p>
+<p>The Shir&eacute; marshes support prodigious numbers of many kinds
+of water-fowl.&nbsp; An hour at the mast-head unfolds novel views of
+life in an African marsh.&nbsp; Near the edge, and on the branches of
+some favourite tree, rest scores of plotuses and cormorants, which stretch
+their snake-like necks, and in mute amazement turn one eye and then
+another towards the approaching monster.&nbsp; By and-by the timid ones
+begin to fly off, or take &ldquo;headers&rdquo; into the stream; but
+a few of the bolder, or more composed, remain, only taking the precaution
+to spread their wings ready for instant flight.&nbsp; The pretty ardetta
+(<i>Herodias bubulcus</i>), of a light yellow colour when at rest, but
+seemingly of a pure white when flying, takes wing, and sweeps across
+the green grass in large numbers, often showing us where buffaloes and
+elephants are, by perching on their backs.&nbsp; Flocks of ducks, of
+which the kind called &ldquo;Soriri&rdquo; (<i>Dendrocygna personata</i>)
+is most abundant, being night feeders, meditate quietly by the small
+lagoons, until startled by the noise of the steam machinery.&nbsp; Pelicans
+glide over the water, catching fish, while the Scopus (<i>Scopus umbretta</i>)
+and large herons peer intently into pools.&nbsp; The large black and
+white spur-winged goose (a constant marauder of native gardens) springs
+up, and circles round to find out what the disturbance can be, and then
+settles down again with a splash.&nbsp; Hundreds of Linongolos (<i>Anastomus
+lamelligerus</i>) rise on the wing from the clumps of reeds, or low
+trees (the <i>Eschinomena</i>, from which pith hats are made), on which
+they build in colonies, and are speedily high in mid-air.&nbsp; Charming
+little red and yellow weavers (<i>Ploceid&aelig;</i>) remind one of
+butterflies, as they fly in and out of the tall grass, or hang to the
+mouths of their pendent nests, chattering briskly to their mates within.&nbsp;
+These weavers seem to have &ldquo;cock nests,&rdquo; built with only
+a roof, and a perch beneath, with a doorway on each side.&nbsp; The
+natives say they are made to protect the bird from the rain.&nbsp; Though
+her husband is very attentive, we have seen the hen bird tearing her
+mate&rsquo;s nest to pieces, but why we cannot tell.&nbsp; Kites and
+vultures are busy overhead, beating the ground for their repast of carrion;
+and the solemn-looking, stately-stepping Marabout, with a taste for
+dead fish, or men, stalks slowly along the almost stagnant channels.&nbsp;
+Groups of men and boys are searching diligently in various places for
+lotus and other roots.&nbsp; Some are standing in canoes, on the weed-covered
+ponds, spearing fish, while others are punting over the small intersecting
+streams, to examine their sunken fish-baskets.</p>
+<p>Towards evening, hundreds of pretty little hawks (<i>Erythropus vespertinus</i>)
+are seen flying in a southerly direction, and feeding on dragon-flies
+and locusts.&nbsp; They come, apparently, from resting on the palm-trees
+during the heat of the day.&nbsp; Flocks of scissor-bills (<i>Rhyncops</i>)
+are then also on the wing, and in search of food, ploughing the water
+with their lower mandibles, which are nearly half an inch longer than
+the upper ones.</p>
+<p>At the north-eastern end of the marsh, and about three miles from
+the river, commences a great forest of palm-trees (<i>Borassus &AElig;thiopium</i>).&nbsp;
+It extends many miles, and at one point comes close to the river.&nbsp;
+The grey trunks and green tops of this immense mass of trees give a
+pleasing tone of colour to the view.&nbsp; The mountain-range, which
+rises close behind the palms, is generally of a cheerful green, and
+has many trees, with patches of a lighter tint among them, as if spots
+of land had once been cultivated.&nbsp; The sharp angular rocks and
+dells on its sides have the appearance of a huge crystal broken; and
+this is so often the case in Africa, that one can guess pretty nearly
+at sight whether a range is of the old crystalline rocks or not.&nbsp;
+The Borassus, though not an oil-bearing palm, is a useful tree.&nbsp;
+The fibrous pulp round the large nuts is of a sweet fruity taste, and
+is eaten by men and elephants.&nbsp; The natives bury the nuts until
+the kernels begin to sprout; when dug up and broken, the inside resembles
+coarse potatoes, and is prized in times of scarcity as nutritious food.&nbsp;
+During several months of the year, palm-wine, or sura, is obtained in
+large quantities; when fresh, it is a pleasant drink, somewhat like
+champagne, and not at all intoxicating; though, after standing a few
+hours, it becomes highly so.&nbsp; Sticks, a foot long, are driven into
+notches in the hard outside of the tree&mdash;the inside being soft
+or hollow&mdash;to serve as a ladder; the top of the fruit-shoot is
+cut off, and the sap, pouring out at the fresh wound, is caught in an
+earthen pot, which is hung at the point.&nbsp; A thin slice is taken
+off the end, to open the pores, and make the juice flow every time the
+owner ascends to empty the pot.&nbsp; Temporary huts are erected in
+the forest, and men and boys remain by their respective trees day and
+night; the nuts, fish, and wine, being their sole food.&nbsp; The Portuguese
+use the palm-wine as yeast, and it makes bread so light, that it melts
+in the mouth like froth.</p>
+<p>Beyond the marsh the country is higher, and has a much larger population.&nbsp;
+We passed a long line of temporary huts, on a plain on the right bank,
+with crowds of men and women hard at work making salt.&nbsp; They obtain
+it by mixing the earth, which is here highly saline, with water, in
+a pot with a small hole in it, and then evaporating the liquid, which
+runs through, in the sun.&nbsp; From the number of women we saw carrying
+it off in bags, we concluded that vast quantities must be made at these
+works.&nbsp; It is worth observing that on soils like this, containing
+salt, the cotton is of larger and finer staple than elsewhere.&nbsp;
+We saw large tracts of this rich brackish soil both in the Shir&eacute;
+and Zambesi valleys, and hence, probably, sea-island cotton would do
+well; a single plant of it, reared by Major Sicard, flourished and produced
+the long staple and peculiar tinge of this celebrated variety, though
+planted only in the street at Tette; and there also a salt efflorescence
+appears, probably from decomposition of the rock, off which the people
+scrape it for use.</p>
+<p>The large village of the chief, Mankokw&eacute;, occupies a site
+on the right bank; he owns a number of fertile islands, and is said
+to be the Rundo, or paramount chief, of a large district.&nbsp; Being
+of an unhappy suspicious disposition, he would not see us; so we thought
+it best to move on, rather than spend time in seeking his favour.</p>
+<p>On the 25th August we reached Dakanamoio island, opposite the perpendicular
+bluff on which Chibisa&rsquo;s village stands; he had gone, with most
+of his people, to live near the Zambesi, but his headman was civil,
+and promised us guides and whatever else we needed.&nbsp; A few of the
+men were busy cleaning, sorting, spinning, and weaving cotton.&nbsp;
+This is a common sight in nearly every village, and each family appears
+to have its patch of cotton, as our own ancestors in Scotland had each
+his patch of flax.&nbsp; Near sunset an immense flock of the large species
+of horn-bill (<i>Buceros cristatus</i>) came here to roost on the great
+trees which skirt the edge of the cliff.&nbsp; They leave early in the
+morning, often before sunrise, for their feeding-places, coming and
+going in pairs.&nbsp; They are evidently of a loving disposition, and
+strongly attached to each other, the male always nestling close beside
+his mate.&nbsp; A fine male fell to the ground, from fear, at the report
+of Dr. Kirk&rsquo;s gun; it was caught and kept on board; the female
+did not go off in the mornings to feed with the others, but flew round
+the ship, anxiously trying, by her plaintive calls, to induce her beloved
+one to follow her: she came again in the evenings to repeat the invitations.&nbsp;
+The poor disconsolate captive soon refused to eat, and in five days
+died of grief, because he could not have her company.&nbsp; No internal
+injury could be detected after death.</p>
+<p>Chibisa and his wife, with a natural show of parental feeling, had
+told the Doctor, on his previous visit, that a few years before some
+of Chisaka&rsquo;s men had kidnapped and sold their little daughter,
+and that she was now a slave to the padr&egrave; at Tette.&nbsp; On
+his return to Tette, the Doctor tried hard to ransom and restore the
+girl to her parents, and offered twice the value of a slave; the padr&egrave;
+seemed willing, but she could not be found.&nbsp; This padr&egrave;
+was better than the average men of the country; and, being always civil
+and obliging, would probably have restored her gratuitously, but she
+had been sold, it might be to the distant tribe Bazizulu, or he could
+not tell where.&nbsp; Custom had rendered his feelings callous, and
+Chibisa had to be told that his child would never return.&nbsp; It is
+this callous state of mind which leads some of our own blood to quote
+Scripture in support of slavery.&nbsp; If we could afford to take a
+backward step in civilization, we might find men among ourselves who
+would in like manner prove Mormonism or any other enormity to be divine.</p>
+<p>We left the ship on the 28th of August, 1859, for the discovery of
+Lake Nyassa.&nbsp; Our party numbered forty-two in all&mdash;four whites,
+thirty-six Makololo, and two guides.&nbsp; We did not actually need
+so many, either for carriage or defence; but took them because we believed
+that, human nature being everywhere the same, blacks are as ready as
+whites to take advantage of the weak, and are as civil and respectful
+to the powerful.&nbsp; We armed our men with muskets, which gave us
+influence, although it did not add much to our strength, as most of
+the men had never drawn a trigger, and in any conflict would in all
+probability have been more dangerous to us than the enemy.</p>
+<p>Our path crossed the valley, in a north-easterly direction, up the
+course of a beautiful flowing stream.&nbsp; Many of the gardens had
+excellent cotton growing in them.&nbsp; An hour&rsquo;s march brought
+us to the foot of the Manganja hills, up which lay the toilsome road.&nbsp;
+The vegetation soon changed; as we rose bamboos appeared, and new trees
+and plants were met with, which gave such incessant employment to Dr.
+Kirk, that he travelled the distance three times over.&nbsp; Remarkably
+fine trees, one of which has oil-yielding seeds, and belongs to the
+mahogany family, grow well in the hollows along the rivulet courses.&nbsp;
+The ascent became very fatiguing, and we were glad of a rest.&nbsp;
+Looking back from an elevation of a thousand feet, we beheld a lovely
+prospect.&nbsp; The eye takes in at a glance the valley beneath, and
+the many windings of its silver stream Makubula, or Kubvula, from the
+shady hill-side, where it emerges in foaming haste, to where it slowly
+glides into the tranquil Shir&eacute;; then the Shir&eacute; itself
+is seen for many a mile above and below Chibisa&rsquo;s, and the great
+level country beyond, with its numerous green woods; until the prospect,
+west and north-west, is bounded far away by masses of peaked and dome-shaped
+blue mountains, that fringe the highlands of the Maravi country.</p>
+<p>After a weary march we halted at Makolongwi, the village of Chitimba.&nbsp;
+It stands in a woody hollow on the first of the three terraces of the
+Manganja hills, and, like all other Manganja villages, is surrounded
+by an impenetrable hedge of poisonous euphorbia.&nbsp; This tree casts
+a deep shade, which would render it difficult for bowmen to take aim
+at the villagers inside.&nbsp; The grass does not grow beneath it, and
+this may be the reason why it is so universally used, for when dry the
+grass would readily convey fire to the huts inside; moreover, the hedge
+acts as a fender to all flying sparks.&nbsp; As strangers are wont to
+do, we sat down under some fine trees near the entrance of the village.&nbsp;
+A couple of mats, made of split reeds, were spread for the white men
+to sit on; and the headman brought a seguati, or present, of a small
+goat and a basket of meal.&nbsp; The full value in beads and cotton
+cloth was handed to him in return.&nbsp; He measured the cloth, doubled
+it, and then measured that again.&nbsp; The beads were scrutinized;
+he had never seen beads of that colour before, and should like to consult
+with his comrades before accepting them, and this, after repeated examinations
+and much anxious talk, he concluded to do.&nbsp; Meal and peas were
+then brought for sale.&nbsp; A fathom of blue cotton cloth, a full dress
+for man or woman, was produced.&nbsp; Our Makololo headman, Sininyan&eacute;,
+thinking a part of it was enough for the meal, was proceeding to tear
+it, when Chitimba remarked that it was a pity to cut such a nice dress
+for his wife, he would rather bring more meal.&nbsp; &ldquo;All right,&rdquo;
+said Sininyan&eacute;; &ldquo;but look, the cloth is very wide, so see
+that the basket which carries the meal be wide too, and add a cock to
+make the meal taste nicely.&rdquo;&nbsp; A brisk trade sprang up at
+once, each being eager to obtain as fine things as his neighbour,&mdash;and
+all were in good humour.&nbsp; Women and girls began to pound and grind
+meal, and men and boys chased the screaming fowls over the village,
+until they ran them down.&nbsp; In a few hours the market was completely
+glutted with every sort of native food; the prices, however, rarely
+fell, as they could easily eat what was not sold.</p>
+<p>We slept under the trees, the air being pheasant, and no mosquitoes
+on the hills.&nbsp; According to our usual plan of marching, by early
+dawn our camp was in motion.&nbsp; After a cup of coffee and a bit of
+biscuit we were on the way.&nbsp; The air was deliciously cool, and
+the path a little easier than that of yesterday.&nbsp; We passed a number
+of villages, occupying very picturesque spots among the hills, and in
+a few hours gained the upper terrace, 3000 feet above the level of the
+sea.&nbsp; The plateau lies west of the Milanj&eacute; mountains, and
+its north-eastern border slopes down to Lake Shirwa.&nbsp; We were all
+charmed with the splendid country, and looked with never-failing delight
+on its fertile plains, its numerous hills, and majestic mountains.&nbsp;
+In some of the passes we saw bramble-berries growing; and the many other
+flowers, though of great beauty, did not remind us of youth and of home
+like the ungainly thorny bramble-bushes.&nbsp; We were a week in crossing
+the highlands in a northerly direction; then we descended into the Upper
+Shir&eacute; Valley, which is nearly 1200 feet above the level of the
+sea.&nbsp; This valley is wonderfully fertile, and supports a large
+population.&nbsp; After leaving the somewhat flat-topped southern portion,
+the most prominent mountain of the Zomba range is Njongon&eacute;, which
+has a fine stream running past its northern base.&nbsp; We were detained
+at the end of the chain some days by one of our companions being laid
+up with fever.&nbsp; One night we were suddenly aroused by buffaloes
+rushing close by the sick-bed.&nbsp; We were encamped by a wood on the
+border of a marsh, but our patient soon recovered, notwithstanding the
+unfavourable situation, and the poor accommodation.</p>
+<p>The Manganja country is delightfully well watered.&nbsp; The clear,
+cool, gushing streams are very numerous.&nbsp; Once we passed seven
+fine brooks and a spring in a single hour, and this, too, near the close
+of the dry season.&nbsp; Mount Zomba, which is twenty miles long, and
+from 7000 to 8000 feet high, has a beautiful stream flowing through
+a verdant valley on its summit, and running away down into Lake Shirwa.&nbsp;
+The highlands are well wooded, and many trees, admirable for their height
+and timber, grow on the various watercourses.&nbsp; &ldquo;Is this country
+good for cattle?&rdquo; we inquired of a Makololo herdsman, whose occupation
+had given him skill in pasturage.&nbsp; &ldquo;Truly,&rdquo; he replied,
+&ldquo;do you not see abundance of those grasses which the cattle love,
+and get fat upon?&rdquo;&nbsp; Yet the people have but few goats, and
+fewer sheep.&nbsp; With the exception of an occasional leopard, there
+are no beasts of prey to disturb domestic animals.&nbsp; Wool-sheep
+would, without doubt, thrive on these highlands.&nbsp; Part of the Upper
+Shir&eacute; valley has a lady paramount, named Nyango; and in her dominions
+women rank higher and receive more respectful treatment than their sisters
+on the hills.</p>
+<p>The hill chief, Mongazi, called his wife to take charge of a present
+we had given him.&nbsp; She dropped down on her knees, clapping her
+hands in reverence, before and after receiving our presents from his
+lordly hands.&nbsp; It was painful to see the abject manner in which
+the women of the hill tribes knelt beside the path as we passed; but
+a great difference took place when we got into Nyango&rsquo;s country.</p>
+<p>On entering a village, we proceeded, as all strangers do, at once
+to the Boalo: mats of split reeds or bamboo were usually spread for
+us to sit on.&nbsp; Our guides then told the men who might be there,
+who we were, whence we had come, whither we wanted to go, and what were
+our objects.&nbsp; This information was duly carried to the chief, who,
+if a sensible man, came at once; but, if he happened to be timid and
+suspicious, waited until he had used divination, and his warriors had
+time to come in from outlying hamlets.&nbsp; When he makes his appearance,
+all the people begin to clap their hands in unison, and continue doing
+so till he sits down opposite to us.&nbsp; His counsellors take their
+places beside him.&nbsp; He makes a remark or two, and is then silent
+for a few seconds.&nbsp; Our guides then sit down in front of the chief
+and his counsellors, and both parties lean forward, looking earnestly
+at each other; the chief repeats a word, such as &ldquo;Ambuiatu&rdquo;
+(our Father, or master)&mdash;or &ldquo;moio&rdquo; (life), and all
+clap their hands.&nbsp; Another word is followed by two claps, a third
+by still more clapping, when each touches the ground with both hands
+placed together.&nbsp; Then all rise and lean forward with measured
+clap, and sit down again with clap, clap, clap, fainter, and still fainter,
+till the last dies away, or is brought to an end by a smart loud clap
+from the chief.&nbsp; They keep perfect time in this species of court
+etiquette.&nbsp; Our guides now tell the chief, often in blank verse,
+all they have already told his people, with the addition perhaps of
+their own suspicions of the visitors.&nbsp; He asks some questions,
+and then converses with us through the guides.&nbsp; Direct communication
+between the chief and the head of the stranger party is not customary.&nbsp;
+In approaching they often ask who is the spokesman, and the spokesman
+of the chief addresses the person indicated exclusively.&nbsp; There
+is no lack of punctilious good manners.&nbsp; The accustomed presents
+are exchanged with civil ceremoniousness; until our men, wearied and
+hungry, call out, &ldquo;English do not buy slaves, they buy food,&rdquo;
+and then the people bring meal, maize, fowls, batatas, yams, beans,
+beer, for sale.</p>
+<p>The Manganja are an industrious race; and in addition to working
+in iron, cotton, and basket-making, they cultivate the soil extensively.&nbsp;
+All the people of a village turn out to labour in the fields.&nbsp;
+It is no uncommon thing to see men, women, and children hard at work,
+with the baby lying close by beneath a shady bush.&nbsp; When a new
+piece of woodland is to be cleared, they proceed exactly as farmers
+do in America.&nbsp; The trees are cut down with their little axes of
+soft native iron; trunks and branches are piled up and burnt, and the
+ashes spread on the soil.&nbsp; The corn is planted among the standing
+stumps which are left to rot.&nbsp; If grass land is to be brought under
+cultivation, as much tall grass as the labourer can conveniently lay
+hold of is collected together and tied into a knot.&nbsp; He then strikes
+his hoe round the tufts to sever the roots, and leaving all standing,
+proceeds until the whole ground assumes the appearance of a field covered
+with little shocks of corn in harvest.&nbsp; A short time before the
+rains begin, these grass shocks are collected in small heaps, covered
+with earth, and burnt, the ashes and burnt soil being used to fertilize
+the ground.&nbsp; Large crops of the mapira, or Egyptian dura (<i>Holcus
+sorghum</i>), are raised, with millet, beans, and ground-nuts; also
+patches of yams, rice, pumpkins, cucumbers, cassava, sweet potatoes,
+tobacco, and hemp, or bang (<i>Cannabis setiva</i>).&nbsp; Maize is
+grown all the year round.&nbsp; Cotton is cultivated at almost every
+village.&nbsp; Three varieties of cotton have been found in the country,
+namely, two foreign and one native.&nbsp; The &ldquo;tonj&eacute; manga,&rdquo;
+or foreign cotton, the name showing that it has been introduced, is
+of excellent quality, and considered at Manchester to be nearly equal
+to the best New Orleans.&nbsp; It is perennial, but requires replanting
+once in three years.&nbsp; A considerable amount of this variety is
+grown in the Upper and Lower Shir&eacute; valleys.&nbsp; Every family
+of any importance owns a cotton patch which, from the entire absence
+of weeds, seemed to be carefully cultivated.&nbsp; Most were small,
+none seen on this journey exceeding half an acre; but on the former
+trip some were observed of more than twice that size.</p>
+<p>The &ldquo;tonj&eacute; cadja,&rdquo; or indigenous cotton, is of
+shorter staple, and feels in the hand like wool.&nbsp; This kind has
+to be planted every season in the highlands; yet, because it makes stronger
+cloth, many of the people prefer it to the foreign cotton; the third
+variety is not found here.&nbsp; It was remarked to a number of men
+near the Shir&eacute; Lakelet, a little further on towards Nyassa, &ldquo;You
+should plant plenty of cotton, and probably the English will come and
+buy it.&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;Truly,&rdquo; replied a far-travelled Babisa
+trader to his fellows, &ldquo;the country is full of cotton, and if
+these people come to buy they will enrich us.&rdquo;&nbsp; Our own observation
+on the cotton cultivated convinced us that this was no empty flourish,
+but a fact.&nbsp; Everywhere we met with it, and scarcely ever entered
+a village without finding a number of men cleaning, spinning, and weaving.&nbsp;
+It is first carefully separated from the seed by the fingers, or by
+an iron roller, on a little block of wood, and rove out into long soft
+bands without twist.&nbsp; Then it receives its first twist on the spindle,
+and becomes about the thickness of coarse candlewick; after being taken
+off and wound into a large ball, it is given the final hard twist, and
+spun into a firm cop on the spindle again: all the processes being painfully
+slow.</p>
+<p>Iron ore is dug out of the hills, and its manufacture is the staple
+trade of the southern highlands.&nbsp; Each village has its smelting-house,
+its charcoal-burners, and blacksmiths.&nbsp; They make good axes, spears,
+needles, arrowheads, bracelets and anklets, which, considering the entire
+absence of machinery, are sold at surprisingly low rates; a hoe over
+two pounds in weight is exchanged for calico of about the value of fourpence.&nbsp;
+In villages near Lake Shirwa and elsewhere, the inhabitants enter pretty
+largely into the manufacture of crockery, or pottery, making by hand
+all sorts of cooking, water, and grain pots, which they ornament with
+plumbago found in the hills.&nbsp; Some find employment in weaving neat
+baskets from split bamboos, and others collect the fibre of the buaz&eacute;,
+which grows abundantly on the hills, and make it into fish-nets.&nbsp;
+These they either use themselves, or exchange with the fishermen on
+the river or lakes for dried fish and salt.&nbsp; A great deal of native
+trade is carried on between the villages, by means of barter in tobacco,
+salt, dried fish, skins, and iron.&nbsp; Many of the men are intelligent-looking,
+with well-shaped heads, agreeable faces, and high foreheads.&nbsp; We
+soon learned to forget colour, and we frequently saw countenances resembling
+those of white people we had known in England, which brought back the
+looks of forgotten ones vividly before the mind.&nbsp; The men take
+a good deal of pride in the arrangement of their hair; the varieties
+of style are endless.&nbsp; One trains his long locks till they take
+the admired form of the buffalo&rsquo;s horns; others prefer to let
+their hair hang in a thick coil down their backs, like that animal&rsquo;s
+tail; while another wears it in twisted cords, which, stiffened by fillets
+of the inner bark of a tree wound spirally round each curl, radiate
+from the head in all directions.&nbsp; Some have it hanging all round
+the shoulders in large masses; others shave it off altogether.&nbsp;
+Many shave part of it into ornamental figures, in which the fancy of
+the barber crops out conspicuously.&nbsp; About as many dandies run
+to seed among the blacks as among the whites.&nbsp; The Man ganja adorn
+their bodies extravagantly, wearing rings on their fingers and thumbs,
+besides throatlets, bracelets, and anklets of brass, copper, or iron.&nbsp;
+But the most wonderful of ornaments, if such it may be called, is the
+pel&eacute;l&eacute;, or upper-lip ring of the women.&nbsp; The middle
+of the upper lip of the girls is pierced close to the septum of the
+nose, and a small pin inserted to prevent the puncture closing up.&nbsp;
+After it has healed, the pin is taken out and a larger one is pressed
+into its place, and so on successively for weeks, and months, and years.&nbsp;
+The process of increasing the size of the lip goes on till its capacity
+becomes so great that a ring of two inches diameter can be introduced
+with ease.&nbsp; All the highland women wear the pel&eacute;l&eacute;,
+and it is common on the Upper and Lower Shir&eacute;.&nbsp; The poorer
+classes make them of hollow or of solid bamboo, but the wealthier of
+ivory or tin.&nbsp; The tin pel&eacute;l&eacute; is often made in the
+form of a small dish.&nbsp; The ivory one is not unlike a napkin-ring.&nbsp;
+No woman ever appears in public without the pel&eacute;l&eacute;, except
+in times of mourning for the dead.&nbsp; It is frightfully ugly to see
+the upper lip projecting two inches beyond the tip of the nose.&nbsp;
+When an old wearer of a hollow bamboo ring smiles, by the action of
+the muscles of the cheeks, the ring and lip outside it are dragged back
+and thrown above the eyebrows.&nbsp; The nose is seen through the middle
+of the ring, amid the exposed teeth show how carefully they have been
+chipped to look like those of a cat or crocodile.&nbsp; The pel&eacute;l&eacute;
+of an old lady, Chikanda Kadz&eacute;, a chieftainess, about twenty
+miles north of Morambala, hung down below her chin, with, of course,
+a piece of the upper lip around its border.&nbsp; The labial letters
+cannot be properly pronounced, but the under lip has to do its best
+for them, against the upper teeth and gum.&nbsp; Tell them it makes
+them ugly; they had better throw it away; they reply, &ldquo;Kodi!&nbsp;
+Really! it is the fashion.&rdquo;&nbsp; How this hideous fashion originated
+is an enigma.&nbsp; Can thick lips ever have been thought beautiful,
+and this mode of artificial enlargement resorted to in consequence?&nbsp;
+The constant twiddling of the pel&eacute;l&eacute; with the tongue by
+the younger women suggested the irreverent idea that it might have been
+invented to give safe employment to that little member.&nbsp; &ldquo;Why
+do the women wear these things?&rdquo; we inquired of the old chief,
+Chinsuns&eacute;.&nbsp; Evidently surprised at such a stupid question,
+he replied, &ldquo;For beauty, to be sure!&nbsp; Men have beards and
+whiskers; women have none; and what kind of creature would a woman be
+without whiskers, and without the pel&eacute;l&eacute;?&nbsp; She would
+have a mouth like a man, and no beard; ha! ha! ha!&rdquo;&nbsp; Afterwards
+on the Rovuma, we found men wearing the pel&eacute;l&eacute;, as well
+as women.&nbsp; An idea suggested itself on seeing the effects of the
+slight but constant pressure exerted on the upper gum and front teeth,
+of which our medical brethren will judge the value.&nbsp; In many cases
+the upper front teeth, instead of the natural curve outwards, which
+the row presents, had been pressed so as to appear as if the line of
+alveoli in which they were planted had an inward curve.&nbsp; As this
+was produced by the slight pressure of the pel&eacute;l&eacute; backwards,
+persons with too prominent teeth might by slight, but long-continued
+pressure, by some appliance only as elastic as the lip, have the upper
+gum and teeth depressed, especially in youth, more easily than is usually
+imagined.&nbsp; The pressure should be applied to the upper gum more
+than to the teeth.</p>
+<p>The Manganja are not a sober people: they brew large quantities of
+beer, and like it well.&nbsp; Having no hops, or other means of checking
+fermentation, they are obliged to drink the whole brew in a few days,
+or it becomes unfit for use.&nbsp; Great merry-makings take place on
+these occasions, and drinking, drumming, and dancing continue day and
+night, till the beer is gone.&nbsp; In crossing the hills we sometimes
+found whole villages enjoying this kind of mirth.&nbsp; The veteran
+traveller of the party remarked, that he had not seen so much drunkenness
+during all the sixteen years he had spent in Africa.&nbsp; As we entered
+a village one afternoon, not a man was to be seen; but some women were
+drinking beer under a tree.&nbsp; In a few moments the native doctor,
+one of the innocents, &ldquo;nobody&rsquo;s enemy but his own,&rdquo;
+staggered out of a hut, with his cupping-horn dangling from his neck,
+and began to scold us for a breach of etiquette.&nbsp; &ldquo;Is this
+the way to come into a man&rsquo;s village, without sending him word
+that you are coming?&rdquo;&nbsp; Our men soon pacified the fuddled
+but good-humoured medico, who, entering his beer-cellar, called on two
+of them to help him to carry out a huge pot of beer, which he generously
+presented to us.&nbsp; While the &ldquo;medical practitioner&rdquo;
+was thus hospitably employed, the chief awoke in a fright, and shouted
+to the women to run away, or they would all be killed.&nbsp; The ladies
+laughed at the idea of their being able to run away, and remained beside
+the beer-pots.&nbsp; We selected a spot for our camp, our men cooked
+the dinner as usual, and we were quietly eating it, when scores of armed
+men, streaming with perspiration, came pouring into the village.&nbsp;
+They looked at us, then at each other, and turning to the chief upbraided
+him for so needlessly sending for them.&nbsp; &ldquo;These people are
+peaceable; they do not hurt you; you are killed with beer:&rdquo; so
+saying, they returned to their homes.</p>
+<p>Native beer has a pinkish colour, and the consistency of gruel.&nbsp;
+The grain is made to vegetate, dried in the sun, pounded into meal,
+and gently boiled.&nbsp; When only a day or two old, the beer is sweet,
+with a slight degree of acidity, which renders it a most grateful beverage
+in a hot climate, or when fever begets a sore craving for acid drinks.&nbsp;
+A single draught of it satisfies this craving at once.&nbsp; Only by
+deep and long-continued potations can intoxication be produced: the
+grain being in a minutely divided state, it is a good way of consuming
+it, and the decoction is very nutritious.&nbsp; At Tette a measure of
+beer is exchanged for an equal-sized pot full of grain.&nbsp; A present
+of this beer, so refreshing to our dark comrades, was brought to us
+in nearly every village.&nbsp; Beer-drinking does not appear to produce
+any disease, or to shorten life on the hills.&nbsp; Never before did
+we see so many old, grey-headed men and women; leaning on their staves
+they came with the others to see the white men.&nbsp; The aged chief,
+Muata Manga, could hardly have been less than ninety years of age; his
+venerable appearance struck the Makololo.&nbsp; &ldquo;He is an old
+man,&rdquo; said they, &ldquo;a very old man; his skin hangs in wrinkles,
+just like that on elephants&rsquo; hips.&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;Did you
+never,&rdquo; he was asked, &ldquo;have a fit of travelling come over
+you; a desire to see other lands and people?&rdquo;&nbsp; No, he had
+never felt that, and had never been far from home in his life.&nbsp;
+For long life they are not indebted to frequent ablutions.&nbsp; An
+old man told us that he remembered to have washed once in his life,
+but it was so long since that he had forgotten how it felt.&nbsp; &ldquo;Why
+do you wash?&rdquo; asked Chinsuns&eacute;&rsquo;s women of the Makololo;
+&ldquo;our men never do.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>The superstitious ordeal, by drinking the poisonous muav&eacute;,
+obtains credit here; and when a person is suspected of crime, this ordeal
+is resorted to.&nbsp; If the stomach rejects the poison, the accused
+is pronounced innocent; but if it is retained, guilt is believed to
+be demonstrated.&nbsp; Their faith is so firm in its discriminating
+power, that the supposed criminal offers of his own accord to drink
+it, and even chiefs are not exempted.&nbsp; Chibisa, relying on its
+efficacy, drank it several times, in order to vindicate his character.&nbsp;
+When asserting that all his wars had been just, it was hinted that,
+as every chief had the same tale of innocence to tell, we ought to suspend
+our judgment.&nbsp; &ldquo;If you doubt my word,&rdquo; said he, &ldquo;give
+me the muav&eacute; to drink.&rdquo;&nbsp; A chief at the foot of Mount
+Zomba successfully went through the ordeal the day we reached his village;
+and his people manifested their joy at his deliverance by drinking beer,
+dancing, and drumming for two days and nights.&nbsp; It is possible
+that the native doctor, who mixes the ingredients of the poisoned bowl,
+may be able to save those whom he considers innocent; but it is difficult
+to get the natives to speak about the matter, and no one is willing
+to tell what the muav&eacute; poison consists of.&nbsp; We have been
+shown trees said to be used, but had always reason to doubt the accuracy
+of our informants.&nbsp; We once found a tree in a village, with many
+pieces of the bark chipped off, closely allied to the Tangena or Tanghina,
+the ordeal poison tree of Madagascar; but we could not ascertain any
+particulars about it.&nbsp; Death is inflicted on those found guilty
+of witchcraft, by the muav&eacute;.</p>
+<p>The women wail for the dead two days.&nbsp; Seated on the ground
+they chant a few plaintive words, and end each verse with the prolonged
+sound of a&mdash;a, or o&mdash;o, or ea-ea-ea&mdash;a.&nbsp; Whatever
+beer is in the house of the deceased, is poured out on the ground with
+the meal, and all cooking and water pots are broken, as being of no
+further use.&nbsp; Both men and women wear signs of mourning for their
+dead relatives.&nbsp; These consist of narrow strips of the palm-leaf
+wound round the head, the arms, legs, neck, and breasts, and worn till
+they drop off from decay.&nbsp; They believe in the existence of a supreme
+being, called Mpamb&egrave;, and also Morungo, and in a future state.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;We live only a few days here,&rdquo; said old Chinsuns&eacute;,
+&ldquo;but we live again after death: we do not know where, or in what
+condition, or with what companions, for the dead never return to tell
+us.&nbsp; Sometimes the dead do come back, and appear to us in dreams;
+but they never speak nor tell us where they have gone, nor how they
+fare.&rdquo;</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER IV.</h3>
+<p>The Upper Shir&eacute;&mdash;Discovery of Lake Nyassa&mdash;Distressing
+exploration&mdash;Return to Zambesi&mdash;Unpleasant visitors&mdash;Start
+for Sekeletu&rsquo;s Country in the interior.</p>
+<p>Our path followed the Shir&eacute; above the cataracts, which is
+now a broad deep river, with but little current.&nbsp; It expands in
+one place into a lakelet, called Pamalomb&eacute;, full of fine fish,
+and ten or twelve miles long by five or six in breadth.&nbsp; Its banks
+are low, and a dense wall of papyrus encircles it.&nbsp; On its western
+shore rises a range of hills running north.&nbsp; On reaching the village
+of the chief Muana-Moesi, and about a day&rsquo;s march distant from
+Nyassa, we were told that no lake had ever been heard of there; that
+the River Shir&eacute; stretched on as we saw it now to a distance of
+&ldquo;two months,&rdquo; and then came out from between perpendicular
+rocks, which towered almost to the skies.&nbsp; Our men looked blank
+at this piece of news, and said, &ldquo;Let us go back to the ship,
+it is of no use trying to find the lake.&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;We shall
+go and see those wonderful rocks at any rate,&rdquo; said the Doctor.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;And when you see them,&rdquo; replied Masakasa, &ldquo;you will
+just want to see something else.&nbsp; But there <i>is</i> a lake,&rdquo;
+rejoined Masakasa, &ldquo;for all their denying it, for it is down in
+a book.&rdquo;&nbsp; Masakasa, having unbounded faith in whatever was
+in a book, went and scolded the natives for telling him an untruth.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;There is a lake,&rdquo; said he, &ldquo;for how could the white
+men know about it in a book if it did not exist?&rdquo;&nbsp; They then
+admitted that there was a lake a few miles off.&nbsp; Subsequent inquiries
+make it probable that the story of the &ldquo;perpendicular rocks&rdquo;
+may have had reference to a fissure, known to both natives and Arabs,
+in the north-eastern portion of the lake.&nbsp; The walls rise so high
+that the path along the bottom is said to be underground.&nbsp; It is
+probably a crack similar to that which made the Victoria Falls, and
+formed the Shir&eacute; Valley.</p>
+<p>The chief brought a small present of meal in the evening, and sat
+with us for a few minutes.&nbsp; On leaving us he said that he wished
+we might sleep well.&nbsp; Scarce had he gone, when a wild sad cry arose
+from the river, followed by the shrieking of women.&nbsp; A crocodile
+had carried off his principal wife, as she was bathing.&nbsp; The Makololo
+snatched up their arms, and rushed to the bank, but it was too late,
+she was gone.&nbsp; The wailing of the women continued all night, and
+next morning we met others coming to the village to join in the general
+mourning.&nbsp; Their grief was evidently heartfelt, as we saw the tears
+coursing down their cheeks.&nbsp; In reporting this misfortune to his
+neighbours, Muana-Moesi said, &ldquo;that white men came to his village;
+washed themselves at the place where his wife drew water and bathed;
+rubbed themselves with a white medicine (soap); and his wife, having
+gone to bathe afterwards, was taken by a crocodile; he did not know
+whether in consequence of the medicine used or not.&rdquo;&nbsp; This
+we could not find fault with.&nbsp; On our return we were viewed with
+awe, and all the men fled at our approach; the women remained; and this
+elicited the remark from our men, &ldquo;The women have the advantage
+of men, in not needing to dread the spear.&rdquo;&nbsp; The practice
+of bathing, which our first contact with Chinsuns&eacute;&rsquo;s people
+led us to believe was unknown to the natives, we afterwards found to
+be common in other parts of the Manganja country.</p>
+<p>We discovered Lake Nyassa a little before noon of the 16th September,
+1859.&nbsp; Its southern end is in 14 degrees 25 minutes S. Lat., and
+35 degrees 30 minutes E. Long.&nbsp; At this point the valley is about
+twelve miles wide.&nbsp; There are hills on both sides of the lake,
+but the haze from burning grass prevented us at the time from seeing
+far.&nbsp; A long time after our return from Nyassa, we received a letter
+from Captain R. B. Oldfield, R.N., then commanding H.M.S. &ldquo;Lyra,&rdquo;
+with the information that Dr. Roscher, an enterprising German who unfortunately
+lost his life in his zeal for exploration, had also reached the Lake,
+but on the 19th November following our discovery; and on his arrival
+had been informed by the natives that a party of white men were at the
+southern extremity.&nbsp; On comparing dates (16th September and 19th
+November) we were about two months before Dr. Roscher.</p>
+<p>It is not known where Dr. Roscher first saw its waters; as the exact
+position of Nusseewa on the borders of the Lake, where he lived some
+time, is unknown.&nbsp; He was three days north-east of Nusseewa, and
+on the Arab road back to the usual crossing-place of the Rovuma, when
+he was murdered.&nbsp; The murderers were seized by one of the chiefs,
+sent to Zanzibar, and executed.&nbsp; He is said to have kept his discoveries
+to himself, with the intention of publishing in Europe the whole at
+once, in a splendid book of travels.</p>
+<p>The chief of the village near the confluence of the Lake and River
+Shir&eacute;, an old man, called Mosauka, hearing that we were sitting
+under a tree, came and kindly invited us to his village.&nbsp; He took
+us to a magnificent banyan-tree, of which he seemed proud.&nbsp; The
+roots had been trained down to the ground into the form of a gigantic
+arm-chair, without the seat.&nbsp; Four of us slept in the space betwixt
+its arms.&nbsp; Mosauka brought us a present of a goat and basket of
+meal &ldquo;to comfort our hearts.&rdquo;&nbsp; He told us that a large
+slave party, led by Arabs, were encamped close by.&nbsp; They had been
+up to Cazembe&rsquo;s country the past year, and were on their way back,
+with plenty of slaves, ivory, and malachite.&nbsp; In a few minutes
+half a dozen of the leaders came over to see us.&nbsp; They were armed
+with long muskets, and, to our mind, were a villanous-looking lot.&nbsp;
+They evidently thought the same of us, for they offered several young
+children for sale, but, when told that we were English, showed signs
+of fear, and decamped during the night.&nbsp; On our return to the Kongon&eacute;,
+we found that H.M.S. &ldquo;Lynx&rdquo; had caught some of these very
+slaves in a dhow; for a woman told us she first saw us at Mosauka&rsquo;s,
+and that the Arabs had fled for fear of an <i>uncanny</i> sort of Basungu.</p>
+<p>This is one of the great slave-paths from the interior, others cross
+the Shir&eacute; a little below, and some on the lake itself.&nbsp;
+We might have released these slaves but did not know what to do with
+them afterwards.&nbsp; On meeting men, led in slave-sticks, the Doctor
+had to bear the reproaches of the Makololo, who never slave, &ldquo;Ay,
+you call us bad, but are we yellow-hearted, like these fellows&mdash;why
+won&rsquo;t you let us choke them?&rdquo;&nbsp; To liberate and leave
+them, would have done but little good, as the people of the surrounding
+villages would soon have seized them, and have sold them again into
+slavery.&nbsp; The Manganja chiefs sell their own people, for we met
+Ajawa and slave-dealers in several highland villages, who had certainly
+been encouraged to come among them for slaves.&nbsp; The chiefs always
+seemed ashamed of the traffic, and tried to excuse themselves.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;We do not sell many, and only those who have committed crimes.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+As a rule the regular trade is supplied by the low and criminal classes,
+and hence the ugliness of slaves.&nbsp; Others are probably sold besides
+criminals, as on the accusation of witchcraft.&nbsp; Friendless orphans
+also sometimes disappear suddenly, and no one inquires what has become
+of them.&nbsp; The temptation to sell their people is peculiarly great,
+as there is but little ivory on the hills, and often the chief has nothing
+but human flesh with which to buy foreign goods.&nbsp; The Ajawa offer
+cloth, brass rings, pottery, and sometimes handsome young women, and
+agree to take the trouble of carrying off by night all those whom the
+chief may point out to them.&nbsp; They give four yards of cotton cloth
+for a man, three for a woman, and two for a boy or girl, to be taken
+to the Portuguese at Mozambique, Iboe, and Quillimane.</p>
+<p>The Manganja were more suspicious and less hospitable than the tribes
+on the Zambesi.&nbsp; They were slow to believe that our object in coming
+into their country was really what we professed it to be.&nbsp; They
+naturally judge us by the motives which govern themselves.&nbsp; A chief
+in the Upper Shir&eacute; Valley, whose scared looks led our men to
+christen him Kitlabolawa (I shall be killed), remarked that parties
+had come before, with as plausible a story as ours, and, after a few
+days, had jumped up and carried off a number of his people as slaves.&nbsp;
+We were not allowed to enter some of the villages in the valley, nor
+would the inhabitants even sell us food; Zimika&rsquo;s men, for instance,
+stood at the entrance of the euphorbia hedge, and declared we should
+not pass in.&nbsp; We sat down under a tree close by.&nbsp; A young
+fellow made an angry oration, dancing from side to side with his bow
+and poisoned arrows, and gesticulating fiercely in our faces.&nbsp;
+He was stopped in the middle of his harangue by an old man, who ordered
+him to sit down, and not talk to strangers in that way; he obeyed reluctantly,
+scowling defiance, and thrusting out his large lips very significantly.&nbsp;
+The women were observed leaving the village; and, suspecting that mischief
+might ensue, we proceeded on our journey, to the great disgust of our
+men.&nbsp; They were very angry with the natives for their want of hospitality
+to strangers, and with us, because we would not allow them to give &ldquo;the
+things a thrashing.&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;This is what comes of going
+with white men,&rdquo; they growled out; &ldquo;had we been with our
+own chief, we should have eaten their goats to-night, and had some of
+themselves to carry the bundles for us to-morrow.&rdquo;&nbsp; On our
+return by a path which left his village on our right, Zimika sent to
+apologize, saying that &ldquo;he was ill, and in another village at
+the time; it was not by his orders we were sent away; his men did not
+know that we were a party wishing the land to dwell in peace.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>We were not able, when hastening back to the men left in the ship,
+to remain in the villages belonging to this chief; but the people came
+after us with things for sale, and invited us to stop, and spend the
+night with them, urging, &ldquo;Are we to have it said that white people
+passed through our country and we did not see them?&rdquo;&nbsp; We
+rested by a rivulet to gratify these sight-seers.&nbsp; We appear to
+them to be red rather than white; and, though light colour is admired
+among themselves, our clothing renders us uncouth in aspect.&nbsp; Blue
+eyes appear savage, and a red beard hideous.&nbsp; From the numbers
+of aged persons we saw on the highlands, and the increase of mental
+and physical vigour we experienced on our ascent from the lowlands,
+we inferred that the climate was salubrious, and that our countrymen
+might there enjoy good health, and also be of signal benefit, by leading
+the multitude of industrious inhabitants to cultivate cotton, buaz&eacute;,
+sugar, and other valuable produce, to exchange for goods of European
+manufacture; at the same time teaching them, by precept and example,
+the great truths of our Holy Religion.</p>
+<p>Our stay at the Lake was necessarily short.&nbsp; We had found that
+the best plan for allaying any suspicions, that might arise in the minds
+of a people accustomed only to slave-traders, was to pay a hasty visit,
+and then leave for a while, and allow the conviction to form among the
+people that, though our course of action was so different from that
+of others, we were not dangerous, but rather disposed to be friendly.&nbsp;
+We had also a party at the vessel, and any indiscretion on their part
+might have proved fatal to the character of the Expedition.</p>
+<p>The trade of Cazemb&eacute; and Katanga&rsquo;s country, and of other
+parts of the interior, crosses Nyassa and the Shir&eacute;, on its way
+to the Arab port, Kilwa, and the Portuguese ports of Iboe and Mozambique.&nbsp;
+At present, slaves, ivory, malachite, and copper ornaments, are the
+only articles of commerce.&nbsp; According to information collected
+by Colonel Rigby at Zanzibar, and from other sources, nearly all the
+slaves shipped from the above-mentioned ports come from the Nyassa district.&nbsp;
+By means of a small steamer, purchasing the ivory of the Lake and River
+above the cataracts, which together have a shore-line of at least 600
+miles, the slave-trade in this quarter would be rendered unprofitable,&mdash;for
+it is only by the ivory being carried by the slaves, that the latter
+do not eat up all the profits of a trip.&nbsp; An influence would be
+exerted over an enormous area of country, for the Mazitu about the north
+end of the Lake will not allow slave-traders to pass round that way
+through their country.&nbsp; They would be most efficient allies to
+the English, and might themselves be benefited by more intercourse.&nbsp;
+As things are now, the native traders in ivory and malachite have to
+submit to heavy exactions; and if we could give them the same prices
+which they at present get after carrying their merchandise 300 miles
+beyond this to the Coast, it might induce them to return without going
+further.&nbsp; It is only by cutting off the supplies in the interior,
+that we can crush the slave-trade on the Coast.&nbsp; The plan proposed
+would stop the slave-trade from the Zambesi on one side and Kilwa on
+the other; and would leave, beyond this tract, only the Portuguese port
+of Inhambane on the south, and a portion of the Sultan of Zanzibar&rsquo;s
+dominion on the north, for our cruisers to look after.&nbsp; The Lake
+people grow abundance of cotton for their own consumption, and can sell
+it for a penny a pound or even less.&nbsp; Water-carriage exists by
+the Shir&eacute; and Zambesi all the way to England, with the single
+exception of a portage of about thirty-five miles past the Murchison
+Cataracts, along which a road of less than forty miles could be made
+at a trifling expense; and it seems feasible that a legitimate and thriving
+trade might, in a short time, take the place of the present unlawful
+traffic.</p>
+<p>Colonel Rigby, Captains Wilson, Oldfield, and Chapman, and all the
+most intelligent officers on the Coast, were unanimous in the belief,
+that one small vessel on the Lake would have decidedly more influence,
+and do more good in suppressing the slave-trade, than half a dozen men-of-war
+on the ocean.&nbsp; By judicious operations, therefore, on a small scale
+inland, little expense would be incurred, and the English slave-trade
+policy on the East would have the same fair chance of success, as on
+the West Coast.</p>
+<p>After a land-journey of forty days, we returned to the ship on the
+6th of October, 1859, in a somewhat exhausted condition, arising more
+from a sort of poisoning, than from the usual fatigue of travel.&nbsp;
+We had taken a little mulligatawney paste, for making soup, in case
+of want of time to cook other food.&nbsp; Late one afternoon, at the
+end of an unusually long march, we reached Mikena, near the base of
+Mount Njongon&eacute; to the north of Zomba, and the cook was directed
+to use a couple of spoonfuls of the paste; but, instead of doing so,
+he put in the whole potful.&nbsp; The soup tasted rather hot, but we
+added boiled rice to it, and, being very hungry, partook freely of it;
+and, in consequence of the overdose, we were delayed several days in
+severe suffering, and some of the party did not recover till after our
+return to the ship.&nbsp; Our illness may partly have arisen from another
+cause.&nbsp; One kind of cassava (<i>Jatropha maligna</i>) is known
+to be, in its raw state, poisonous, but by boiling it carefully in two
+waters, which must be thrown off, the poison is extracted and the cassava
+rendered fit for food.&nbsp; The poisonous sort is easily known by raising
+a bit of the bark of the root, and putting the tongue to it.&nbsp; A
+bitter taste shows poison, but it is probable that even the sweet kind
+contains an injurious principle.&nbsp; The sap, which, like that of
+our potatoes, is injurious as an article of food, is used in the &ldquo;Pepper-pot&rdquo;
+of the West Indies, under the name of &ldquo;Cassereep,&rdquo; as a
+perfect preservative of meat.&nbsp; This juice put into an earthen vessel
+with a little water and Chili pepper is said to keep meat, that is immersed
+in it, good for a great length of time; even for years.&nbsp; No iron
+or steel must touch the mixture, or it will become sour.&nbsp; This
+&ldquo;Pepper-pot,&rdquo; of which we first heard from the late Archbishop
+Whately, is a most economical meat-safe in a hot climate; any beef,
+mutton, pork, or fowl that may be left at dinner, if put into the mixture
+and a little fresh cassereep added, keeps perfectly, though otherwise
+the heat of the climate or flies would spoil it.&nbsp; Our cook, however,
+boiled the cassava root as he was in the habit of cooking meat, namely,
+by filling the pot with it, and then pouring in water, which he allowed
+to stand on the fire until it had become absorbed and boiled away.&nbsp;
+This method did not expel the poisonous properties of the root, or render
+it wholesome; for, notwithstanding our systematic caution in purchasing
+only the harmless sort, we suffered daily from its effects, and it was
+only just before the end of our trip that this pernicious mode of boiling
+it was discovered by us.</p>
+<p>In ascending 3000 feet from the lowlands to the highlands, or on
+reaching the low valley of the Shir&eacute; from the higher grounds,
+the change of climate was very marked.&nbsp; The heat was oppressive
+below, the thermometer standing at from 84 degrees to 103 degrees in
+the shade; and our spirits were as dull and languid as they had been
+exhilarated on the heights in a temperature cooler by some 20 degrees.&nbsp;
+The water of the river was sometimes 84 degrees or higher, whilst that
+we had been drinking in the hill streams was only 65 degrees.</p>
+<p>It was found necessary to send two of our number across from the
+Shir&eacute; to Tette; and Dr. Kirk, with guides from Chibisa, and accompanied
+by Mr. Rae, the engineer, accomplished the journey.&nbsp; We had found
+the country to the north and east so very well watered, that no difficulty
+was anticipated in this respect in a march of less than a hundred miles;
+but on this occasion our friends suffered severely.&nbsp; The little
+water to be had at this time of the year, by digging in the beds of
+dry watercourses, was so brackish as to increase thirst&mdash;some of
+the natives indeed were making salt from it; and when at long intervals
+a less brackish supply was found, it was nauseous and muddy from the
+frequent visits of large game.&nbsp; The tsetse abounded.&nbsp; The
+country was level, and large tracts of it covered with mopane forest,
+the leaves of which afford but scanty shade to the baked earth, so that
+scarcely any grass grows upon it.&nbsp; The sun was so hot, that the
+men frequently jumped from the path, in the vain hope of cooling, for
+a moment, their scorched feet under the almost shadeless bushes; and
+the native who carried the provision of salt pork got lost, and came
+into Tette two days after the rest of the party, with nothing but the
+fibre of the meat left, the fat, melted by the blazing sun, having all
+run down his back.&nbsp; This path was soon made a highway for slaving
+parties by Captain Raposo, the Commandant.&nbsp; The journey nearly
+killed our two active young friends; and what the slaves must have since
+suffered on it no one can conceive; but slaving probably can never be
+conducted without enormous suffering and loss of life.</p>
+<p>Mankokw&eacute; now sent a message to say that he wished us to stop
+at his village on our way down.&nbsp; He came on board on our arrival
+there with a handsome present, and said that his young people had dissuaded
+him from visiting us before; but now he was determined to see what every
+one else was seeing.&nbsp; A bald square-headed man, who had been his
+Prime Minister when we came up, was now out of office, and another old
+man, who had taken his place accompanied the chief.&nbsp; In passing
+the Elephant Marsh, we saw nine large herds of elephants; they sometimes
+formed a line two miles long.</p>
+<p>On the 2nd of November we anchored off Shamoara, and sent the boat
+to Senna for biscuit and other provisions.&nbsp; Senhor Ferr&atilde;o,
+with his wonted generosity, gave us a present of a bullock, which he
+sent to us in a canoe.&nbsp; Wishing to know if a second bullock would
+be acceptable to us, he consulted his Portuguese and English dictionary,
+and asked the sailor in charge if he would take <i>another</i>; but
+Jack, mistaking the Portuguese pronunciation of the letter h, replied,
+&ldquo;Oh no, sir, thank you, I don&rsquo;t want an <i>otter</i> in
+the boat, they are such terrible biters!&rdquo;</p>
+<p>We had to ground the vessel on a shallow sandbank every night; she
+leaked so fast, that in deep water she would have sunk, and the pump
+had to be worked all day to keep her afloat.&nbsp; Heavy rains fell
+daily, producing the usual injurious effects in the cabin; and, unable
+to wait any longer for our associates, who had gone overland from the
+Shir&eacute; to Tette, we ran down the Kongon&eacute; and beached her
+for repairs.&nbsp; Her Majesty&rsquo;s ship &ldquo;Lynx,&rdquo; Lieut.
+Berkeley commanding, called shortly afterwards with supplies; the bar,
+which had been perfectly smooth for some time before, became rather
+rough just before her arrival, so that it was two or three days before
+she could communicate with us.&nbsp; Two of her boats tried to come
+in on the second day, and one of them, mistaking the passage, capsized
+in the heavy breakers abreast of the island.&nbsp; Mr. Hunt, gunner,
+the officer in charge of the second boat, behaved nobly, and by his
+skilful and gallant conduct succeeded in rescuing every one of the first
+boat&rsquo;s crew.&nbsp; Of course the things that they were bringing
+to us were lost, but we were thankful that all the men were saved.&nbsp;
+The loss of the mail-bags, containing Government despatches and our
+friends&rsquo; letters for the past year, was felt severely, as we were
+on the point of starting on an expedition into the interior, which might
+require eight or nine months; and twenty months is a weary time to be
+without news of friends and family.&nbsp; In the repairing of our crazy
+craft, we received kind and efficient aid from Lieutenant Berkeley,
+and we were enabled to leave for Tette on December 16th.</p>
+<p>We had now frequent rains, and the river rose considerably; our progress
+up the stream was distressingly slow, and it was not until the 2nd of
+February, 1860, that we reached Tette.&nbsp; Mr. Thornton returned on
+the same day from a geological tour, by which some Portuguese expected
+that a fabulous silver-mine would be rediscovered.&nbsp; The tradition
+in the country is, that the Jesuits formerly knew and worked a precious
+lode at Chicova.&nbsp; Mr. Thornton had gone beyond Zumbo, in company
+with a trader of colour; he soon after this left the Zambesi and, joining
+the expedition of the Baron van der Decken, explored the snow mountain
+Kilimanjaro, north-west of Zanzibar.&nbsp; Mr. Thornton&rsquo;s companion,
+the trader, brought back much ivory, having found it both abundant and
+cheap.&nbsp; He was obliged, however, to pay heavy fines to the Banyai
+and other tribes, in the country which is coolly claimed in Europe as
+Portuguese.&nbsp; During this trip of six mouths 200 pieces of cotton
+cloth of sixteen yards each, besides beads and brass wire, were paid
+to the different chiefs, for leave to pass through their country.&nbsp;
+In addition to these sufficiently weighty exactions, the natives of
+<i>this dominion</i> have got into the habit of imposing fines for alleged
+milandos, or crimes, which the traders&rsquo; men may have unwittingly
+committed.&nbsp; The merchants, however, submit rather than run the
+risk of fighting.</p>
+<p>The general monotony of existence at Tette is sometimes relieved
+by an occasional death or wedding.&nbsp; When the deceased is a person
+of consequence, the quantity of gunpowder his slaves are allowed to
+expend is enormous.&nbsp; The expense may, in proportion to their means,
+resemble that incurred by foolishly gaudy funerals in England.&nbsp;
+When at Tette, we always joined with sympathizing hearts in aiding,
+by our presence at the last rites, to soothe the sorrows of the surviving
+relatives.&nbsp; We are sure that they would have done the same to us
+had we been the mourners.&nbsp; We never had to complain of want of
+hospitality.&nbsp; Indeed, the great kindness shown by many of whom
+we have often spoken, will never be effaced from our memory till our
+dying day.&nbsp; When we speak of their failings it is in sorrow, not
+in anger.&nbsp; Their trading in slaves is an enormous mistake.&nbsp;
+Their Government places them in a false position by cutting them off
+from the rest of the world; and of this they always speak with a bitterness
+which, were it heard, might alter the tone of the statesmen of Lisbon.&nbsp;
+But here there is no press, no booksellers&rsquo; shops, and scarcely
+a schoolmaster.&nbsp; Had we been born in similar untoward circumstances&mdash;we
+tremble to think of it!</p>
+<p>The weddings are celebrated with as much jollity as weddings are
+anywhere.&nbsp; We witnessed one in the house of our friend the Padre.&nbsp;
+It being the marriage of his goddaughter, he kindly invited us to be
+partakers in his joy; and we there became acquainted with old Donna
+Engenia, who was a married wife and had children, when the slaves came
+from Cassange, before any of us were born.&nbsp; The whole merry-making
+was marked by good taste amid propriety.</p>
+<p>About the only interesting object in the vicinity of Tette is the
+coal a few miles to the north.&nbsp; There, in the feeders of the stream
+Revubu&eacute;, it crops out in cliff sections.&nbsp; The seams are
+from four to seven feet in thickness; one measured was found to be twenty-five
+feet thick.</p>
+<p>Learning that it would be difficult for our party to obtain food
+beyond Kebrabasa before the new crop came in and knowing the difficulty
+of hunting for so many men in the wet season, we decided on deferring
+our departure for the interior until May, and in the mean time to run
+down once more to the Kongon&eacute;, in the hopes of receiving letters
+and despatches from the man-of-war that was to call in March.&nbsp;
+We left Tette on the 10th, and at Senna heard that our lost mail had
+been picked up on the beach by natives, west of the Milamb&eacute;;
+carried to Quillimane, sent thence to Senna, and, passing us somewhere
+on the river, on to Tette.&nbsp; At Shupanga the governor informed us
+that it was a very large mail; no great comfort, seeing it was away
+up the river.</p>
+<p>Mosquitoes were excessively troublesome at the harbour, and especially
+when a light breeze blew from the north over the mangroves.&nbsp; We
+lived for several weeks in small huts, built by our men.&nbsp; Those
+who did the hunting for the party always got wet, and were attacked
+by fever, but generally recovered in time to be out again before the
+meat was all consumed.&nbsp; No ship appearing, we started off on the
+15th of March, and stopped to wood on the Luabo, near an encampment
+of hippopotamus hunters; our men heard again, through them, of the canoe
+path from this place to Quillimane, but they declined to point it out.</p>
+<p>We found our friend Major Sicard at Mazaro with picks, shovels, hurdles,
+and slaves, having come to build a fort and custom-house at the Kongon&eacute;.&nbsp;
+As we had no good reason to hide the harbour, but many for its being
+made known, we supplied him with a chart of the tortuous branches, which,
+running among the mangroves, perplex the search; and with such directions
+as would enable him to find his way down to the river.&nbsp; He had
+brought the relics of our fugitive mail, and it was a disappointment
+to find that all had been lost, with the exception of a bundle of old
+newspapers, two photographs, and three letters, which had been written
+before we left England.</p>
+<p>The distance from Mazaro, on the Zambesi side, to the Kwakwa at Nterra,
+is about six miles, over a surprisingly rich dark soil.&nbsp; We passed
+the night in the long shed, erected at Nterra, on the banks of this
+river, for the use of travellers, who have often to wait several days
+for canoes; we tried to sleep, but the mosquitoes and rats were so troublesome
+as to render sleep impossible.&nbsp; The rats, or rather large mice,
+closely resembling <i>Mus pumilio</i> (Smith), of this region, are quite
+facetious, and, having a great deal of fun in them, often laugh heartily.&nbsp;
+Again and again they woke us up by scampering over our faces, and then
+bursting into a loud laugh of He! he! he! at having performed the feat.&nbsp;
+Their sense of the ludicrous appears to be exquisite; they screamed
+with laughter at the attempts which disturbed and angry human nature
+made in the dark to bring their ill-timed merriment to a close.&nbsp;
+Unlike their prudent European cousins, which are said to leave a sinking
+ship, a party of these took up their quarters in our leaky and sinking
+vessel.&nbsp; Quiet and invisible by day, they emerged at night, and
+cut their funny pranks.&nbsp; No sooner were we all asleep, than they
+made a sudden dash over the lockers and across our faces for the cabin
+door, where all broke out into a loud He! he! he! he! he! he! showing
+how keenly they enjoyed the joke.&nbsp; They next went forward with
+as much delight, and scampered over the men.&nbsp; Every night they
+went fore and aft, rousing with impartial feet every sleeper, and laughing
+to scorn the aimless blows, growls, and deadly rushes of outraged humanity.&nbsp;
+We observed elsewhere a species of large mouse, nearly allied to <i>Euryotis
+unisulcatus</i> (F. Cuvier), escaping up a rough and not very upright
+wall, with six young ones firmly attached to the perineum.&nbsp; They
+were old enough to be well covered with hair, and some were not detached
+by a blow which disabled the dam.&nbsp; We could not decide whether
+any involuntary muscles were brought into play in helping the young
+to adhere.&nbsp; Their weight seemed to require a sort of cataleptic
+state of the muscles of the jaw, to enable them to hold on.</p>
+<p>Scorpions, centipedes, and poisonous spiders also were not unfrequently
+brought into the ship with the wood, and occasionally found their way
+into our beds; but in every instance we were fortunate enough to discover
+and destroy them before they did any harm.&nbsp; Naval officers on this
+coast report that, when scorpions and centipedes remain a few weeks
+after being taken on board in a similar manner, their poison loses nearly
+all its virulence; but this we did not verify.&nbsp; Snakes sometimes
+came in with the wood, but oftener floated down the river to us, climbing
+on board with ease by the chain-cable, and some poisonous ones were
+caught in the cabin.&nbsp; A green snake lived with us several weeks,
+concealing himself behind the casing of the deckhouse in the daytime.&nbsp;
+To be aroused in the dark by five feet of cold green snake gliding over
+one&rsquo;s face is rather unpleasant, however rapid the movement may
+be.&nbsp; Myriads of two varieties of cockroaches infested the vessel;
+they not only ate round the roots of our nails, but even devoured and
+defiled our food, flannels, and boots.&nbsp; Vain were all our efforts
+to extirpate these destructive pests; if you kill one, say the sailors,
+a hundred come down to his funeral!&nbsp; In the work of Commodore Owen
+it is stated that cockroaches, pounded into a paste, form a powerful
+carminative; this has not been confirmed, but when monkeys are fed on
+them they are sure to become lean.</p>
+<p>On coming to Senna, we found that the Zulus had arrived in force
+for their annual tribute.&nbsp; These men are under good discipline,
+and never steal from the people.&nbsp; The tax is claimed on the ground
+of conquest, the Zulus having formerly completely overcome the Senna
+people, and chased them on to the islands in the Zambesi.&nbsp; Fifty-four
+of the Portuguese were slain on the occasion, and, notwithstanding the
+mud fort, the village has never recovered its former power.&nbsp; Fever
+was now very prevalent, and most of the Portuguese were down with it.</p>
+<p>For a good view of the adjacent scenery, the hill, Baramuana, behind
+the village, was ascended.&nbsp; A caution was given about the probability
+of an attack of fever from a plant that grows near the summit.&nbsp;
+Dr. Kirk discovered it to be the <i>P&aelig;devia f&oelig;tida</i>,
+which, when smelt, actually does give headache and fever.&nbsp; It has
+a nasty fetor, as its name indicates.&nbsp; This is one instance in
+which fever and a foul smell coincide.&nbsp; In a number of instances
+offensive effluvia and fever seems to have no connection.&nbsp; Owing
+to the abundant rains, the crops in the Senna district were plentiful;
+this was fortunate, after the partial failure of the past two years.&nbsp;
+It was the 25th of April, 1860, before we reached Tette; here also the
+crops were luxuriant, and the people said that they had not had such
+abundance since 1856, the year when Dr. Livingstone came down the river.&nbsp;
+It is astonishing to any one who has seen the works for irrigation in
+other countries, as at the Cape and in Egypt, that no attempt has ever
+been made to lead out the water either of the Zambesi or any of its
+tributaries; no machinery has ever been used to raise it even from the
+stream, but droughts and starvations are endured, as if they were inevitable
+dispensations of Providence, incapable of being mitigated.</p>
+<p>Feeling in honour bound to return with those who had been the faithful
+companions of Dr. Livingstone, in 1856, and to whose guardianship and
+services was due the accomplishment of a journey which all the Portuguese
+at Tette had previously pronounced impossible, the requisite steps were
+taken to convey them to their homes.</p>
+<p>We laid the ship alongside of the island Kanyimb&eacute;, opposite
+Tette; and, before starting for the country of the Makololo, obtained
+a small plot of land, to form a garden for the two English sailors who
+were to remain in charge during our absence.&nbsp; We furnished them
+with a supply of seeds, and they set to work with such zeal, that they
+certainly merited success.&nbsp; Their first attempt at African horticulture
+met with failure from a most unexpected source; every seed was dug up
+and the inside of it eaten by mice.&nbsp; &ldquo;Yes,&rdquo; said an
+old native, next morning, on seeing the husks, &ldquo;that is what happens
+this month; for it is the mouse month, and the seed should have been
+sown last mouth, when I sowed mine.&rdquo;&nbsp; The sailors, however,
+sowed more next day; and, being determined to outwit the mice, they
+this time covered the beds over with grass.&nbsp; The onions, with other
+seeds of plants cultivated by the Portuguese, are usually planted in
+the beginning of April, in order to have the advantage of the cold season;
+the wheat a little later, for the same reason.&nbsp; If sown at the
+beginning of the rainy season in November, it runs, as before remarked,
+entirely to straw; but as the rains are nearly over in May, advantage
+is taken of low-lying patches, which have been flooded by the river.&nbsp;
+A hole is made in the mud with a hoe, a few seeds dropped in, and the
+earth shoved back with the foot.&nbsp; If not favoured with certain
+misty showers, which, lower down the river, are simply fogs, water is
+borne from the river to the roots of the wheat in earthern pots; and
+in about four months the crop is ready for the sickle.&nbsp; The wheat
+of Tette is exported, as the best grown in the country; but a hollow
+spot at Maruru, close by Mazaro, yielded very good crops, though just
+at the level of the sea, as a few inches rise of tide shows.</p>
+<p>A number of days were spent in busy preparation for our journey;
+the cloth, beads, and brass wire, for the trip were sewn up in old canvas,
+and each package had the bearer&rsquo;s name printed on it.&nbsp; The
+Makololo, who had worked for the Expedition, were paid for their services,
+and every one who had come down with the Doctor from the interior received
+a present of cloth and ornaments, in order to protect them from the
+greater cold of their own country, and to show that they had not come
+in vain.&nbsp; Though called Makololo by courtesy, as they were proud
+of the name, Kanyata, the principal headman, was the only real Makololo
+of the party; and he, in virtue of his birth, had succeeded to the chief
+place on the death of Sekwebu.&nbsp; The others belonged to the conquered
+tribes of the Batoka, Bashubia, Ba-Selea, and Barots&eacute;.&nbsp;
+Some of these men had only added to their own vices those of the Tette
+slaves; others, by toiling during the first two years in navigating
+canoes, and hunting elephants, had often managed to save a little, to
+take back to their own country, but had to part with it all for food
+to support the rest in times of hunger, and, latterly, had fallen into
+the improvident habits of slaves, and spent their surplus earnings in
+beer and agua ardiente.</p>
+<p>Everything being ready on the 15th of May, we started at 2 p.m. from
+the village where the Makololo had dwelt.&nbsp; A number of the men
+did not leave with the goodwill which their talk for months before had
+led us to anticipate; but some proceeded upon being told that they were
+not compelled to go unless they liked, though others altogether declined
+moving.&nbsp; Many had taken up with slave-women, whom they assisted
+in hoeing, and in consuming the produce of their gardens.&nbsp; Some
+fourteen children had been born to them; and in consequence of now having
+no chief to order them, or to claim their services, they thought that
+they were about as well off as they had been in their own country.&nbsp;
+They knew and regretted that they could call neither wives nor children
+their own; the slave-owners claimed the whole; but their natural affections
+had been so enchained, that they clave to the domestic ties.&nbsp; By
+a law of Portugal the baptized children of slave women are all free;
+by the custom of the Zambesi that law is void.&nbsp; When it is referred
+to, the officers laugh and say, &ldquo;These Lisbon-born laws are very
+stringent, but somehow, possibly from the heat of the climate, here
+they lose all their force.&rdquo;&nbsp; Only one woman joined our party&mdash;the
+wife of a Batoka man: she had been given to him, in consideration of
+his skilful dancing, by the chief, Chisaka.&nbsp; A merchant sent three
+of his men along with us, with a present for Sekeletu, and Major Sicard
+also lent us three more to assist us on our return, and two Portuguese
+gentleman kindly gave us the loan of a couple of donkeys.&nbsp; We slept
+four miles above Tette, and hearing that the Banyai, who levy heavy
+fines on the Portuguese traders, lived chiefly on the right bank, we
+crossed over to the left, as we could not fully trust our men.&nbsp;
+If the Banyai had come in a threatening manner, our followers might,
+perhaps, from having homes behind them, have even put down their bundles
+and run.&nbsp; Indeed, two of them at this point made up their minds
+to go no further, and turned back to Tette.&nbsp; Another, Monga, a
+Batoka, was much perplexed, and could not make out what course to pursue,
+as he had, three years previously, wounded Kanyata, the headman, with
+a spear.&nbsp; This is a capital offence among the Makololo, and he
+was afraid of being put to death for it on his return.&nbsp; He tried,
+in vain, to console himself with the facts that he had neither father,
+mother, sisters, nor brothers to mourn for him, and that he could die
+but once.&nbsp; He was good, and would go up to the stars to Yesu, and
+therefore did not care for death.&nbsp; In spite, however, of these
+reflections, he was much cast down, until Kanyata assured him that he
+would never mention his misdeed to the chief; indeed, he had never even
+mentioned it to the Doctor, which he would assuredly have done had it
+lain heavy on his heart.&nbsp; We were right glad of Monga&rsquo;s company,
+for he was a merry good-tempered fellow, and his lithe manly figure
+had always been in the front in danger; and, from being left-handed,
+had been easily recognized in the fight with elephants.</p>
+<p>We commenced, for a certain number of days, with short marches, walking
+gently until broken in to travel.&nbsp; This is of so much importance,
+that it occurs to us that more might be made out of soldiers if the
+first few days&rsquo; marches were easy, and gradually increased in
+length and quickness.&nbsp; The nights were cold, with heavy dews and
+occasional showers, and we had several cases of fever.&nbsp; Some of
+the men deserted every night, and we fully expected that all who had
+children would prefer to return to Tette, for little ones are well known
+to prove the strongest ties, even to slaves.&nbsp; It was useless informing
+them, that if they wanted to return they had only to come and tell us
+so; we should not be angry with them for preferring Tette to their own
+country.&nbsp; Contact with slaves had destroyed their sense of honour;
+they would not go in daylight, but decamped in the night, only in one
+instance, however, taking our goods, though, in two more, they carried
+off their comrades&rsquo; property.&nbsp; By the time we had got well
+into the Kebrabasa hills thirty men, nearly a third of the party, had
+turned back, and it became evident that, if many more left us, Sekeletu&rsquo;s
+goods could not be carried up.&nbsp; At last, when the refuse had fallen
+away, no more desertions took place.</p>
+<p>Stopping one afternoon at a Kebrabasa village, a man, who pretended
+to be able to change himself into a lion, came to salute us.&nbsp; Smelling
+the gunpowder from a gun which had been discharged, he went on one side
+to get out of the wind of the piece, trembling in a most artistic manner,
+but quite overacting his part.&nbsp; The Makololo explained to us that
+he was a Pondoro, or a man who can change his form at will, and added
+that he trembles when he smells gunpowder.&nbsp; &ldquo;Do you not see
+how he is trembling now?&rdquo;&nbsp; We told them to ask him to change
+himself at once into a lion, and we would give him a cloth for the performance.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;Oh no,&rdquo; replied they; &ldquo;if we tell him so, he may
+change himself and come when we are asleep and kill us.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+Having similar superstitions at home, they readily became as firm believers
+in the Pondoro as the natives of the village.&nbsp; We were told that
+he assumes the form of a lion and remains in the woods for days, and
+is sometimes absent for a whole month.&nbsp; His considerate wife had
+built him a hut or den, in which she places food and beer for her transformed
+lord, whose metamorphosis does not impair his human appetite.&nbsp;
+No one ever enters this hut except the Pondoro and his wife, and no
+stranger is allowed even to rest his gun against the baobab-tree beside
+it: the Mfumo, or petty chief, of another small village wished to fine
+our men for placing their muskets against an old tumble-down hut, it
+being that of the Pondoro.&nbsp; At times the Pondoro employs his acquired
+powers in hunting for the benefit of the village; and after an absence
+of a day or two, his wife smells the lion, takes a certain medicine,
+places it in the forest, and there quickly leaves it, lest the lion
+should kill even her.&nbsp; This medicine enables the Pondoro to change
+himself back into a man, return to the village, and say, &ldquo;Go and
+get the game that I have killed for you.&rdquo;&nbsp; Advantage is of
+course taken of what a lion has done, and they go and bring home the
+buffalo or antelope killed when he was a lion, or rather found when
+he was patiently pursuing his course of deception in the forest.&nbsp;
+We saw the Pondoro of another village dressed in a fantastic style,
+with numerous charms hung round him, and followed by a troop of boys
+who were honouring him with rounds of shrill cheering.</p>
+<p>It is believed also that the souls of departed chiefs enter into
+lions, and render them sacred.&nbsp; On one occasion, when we had shot
+a buffalo in the path beyond the Kafu&eacute;, a hungry lion, attracted
+probably by the smell of the meat, came close to our camp, and roused
+up all hands by his roaring.&nbsp; Tuba Mokoro, imbued with the popular
+belief that the beast was a chief in disguise, scolded him roundly during
+his brief intervals of silence.&nbsp; &ldquo;You a chief, eh?&nbsp;
+You call yourself a chief, do you?&nbsp; What kind of chief are you
+to come sneaking about in the dark, trying to steal our buffalo meat!&nbsp;
+Are you not ashamed of yourself?&nbsp; A pretty chief truly; you are
+like the scavenger beetle, and think of yourself only.&nbsp; You have
+not the heart of a chief; why don&rsquo;t you kill your own beef?&nbsp;
+You must have a stone in your chest, and no heart at all, indeed!&rdquo;&nbsp;
+Tuba Mokoro producing no impression on the transformed chief, one of
+the men, the most sedate of the party, who seldom spoke, took up the
+matter, and tried the lion in another strain.&nbsp; In his slow quiet
+way he expostulated with him on the impropriety of such conduct to strangers,
+who had never injured him.&nbsp; &ldquo;We were travelling peaceably
+through the country back to our own chief.&nbsp; We never killed people,
+nor stole anything.&nbsp; The buffalo meat was ours, not his, and it
+did not become a great chief like him to be prowling round in the dark,
+trying, like a hyena, to steal the meat of strangers.&nbsp; He might
+go and hunt for himself, as there was plenty of game in the forest.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+The Pondoro, being deaf to reason, and only roaring the louder, the
+men became angry, and threatened to send a ball through him if he did
+not go away.&nbsp; They snatched up their guns to shoot him, but he
+prudently kept in the dark, outside the luminous circle made by our
+camp fires, and there they did not like to venture.&nbsp; A little strychnine
+was put into a piece of meat, and thrown to him, when he soon departed,
+and we heard no more of the majestic sneaker.</p>
+<p>The Kebrabasa people were now plumper and in better condition than
+on our former visits; the harvest had been abundant; they had plenty
+to eat and drink, and they were enjoying life as much as ever they could.&nbsp;
+At Defw&eacute;&rsquo;s village, near where the ship lay on her first
+ascent, we found two Mfumos or headmen, the son and son-in-law of the
+former chief.&nbsp; A sister&rsquo;s son has much more chance of succeeding
+to a chieftainship than the chief&rsquo;s own offspring, it being unquestionable
+that the sister&rsquo;s child has the family blood.&nbsp; The men are
+all marked across the nose and up the middle of the forehead with short
+horizontal bars or cicatrices; and a single brass earring of two or
+three inches diameter, like the ancient Egyptian, is worn by the men.&nbsp;
+Some wear the hair long like the ancient Assyrians and Egyptians, and
+a few have eyes with the downward and inward slant of the Chinese.</p>
+<p>After fording the rapid Luia, we left our former path on the banks
+of the Zambesi, and struck off in a N.W. direction behind one of the
+hill ranges, the eastern end of which is called Mongwa, the name of
+an acacia, having a peculiarly strong fetor, found on it.&nbsp; Our
+route wound up a valley along a small mountain-stream which was nearly
+dry, and then crossed the rocky spurs of some of the lofty hills.&nbsp;
+The country was all very dry at the time, and no water was found except
+in an occasional spring and a few wells dug in the beds of watercourses.&nbsp;
+The people were poor, and always anxious to convince travellers of the
+fact.&nbsp; The men, unlike those on the plains, spend a good deal of
+their time in hunting; this may be because they have but little ground
+on the hill-sides suitable for gardens, and but little certainty of
+reaping what may be sown in the valleys.&nbsp; No women came forward
+in the hamlet, east of Chiperiziwa, where we halted for the night.&nbsp;
+Two shots had been fired at guinea-fowl a little way off in the valley;
+the women fled into the woods, and the men came to know if war was meant,
+and a few of the old folks only returned after hearing that we were
+for peace.&nbsp; The headman, Kambira, apologized for not having a present
+ready, and afterwards brought us some meal, a roasted coney (<i>Hyrax
+capensis</i>), and a pot of beer; he wished to be thought poor.&nbsp;
+The beer had come to him from a distance; he had none of his own.&nbsp;
+Like the Manganja, these people salute by clapping their hands.&nbsp;
+When a man comes to a place where others are seated, before sitting
+down he claps his hands to each in succession, and they do the same
+to him.&nbsp; If he has anything to tell, both speaker and hearer clap
+their hands at the close of every paragraph, and then again vigorously
+at the end of the speech.&nbsp; The guide, whom the headman gave us,
+thus saluted each of his comrades before he started off with us.&nbsp;
+There is so little difference in the language, that all the tribes of
+this region are virtually of one family.</p>
+<p>We proceeded still in the same direction, and passed only two small
+hamlets during the day.&nbsp; Except the noise our men made on the march,
+everything was still around us: few birds were seen.&nbsp; The appearance
+of a whydahbird showed that he had not yet parted with his fine long
+plumes.&nbsp; We passed immense quantities of ebony and lignum-vit&aelig;,
+and the tree from whose smooth and bitter bark granaries are made for
+corn.&nbsp; The country generally is clothed with a forest of ordinary-sized
+trees.&nbsp; We slept in the little village near Sindabw&eacute;, where
+our men contrived to purchase plenty of beer, and were uncommonly boisterous
+all the evening.&nbsp; We breakfasted next morning under green wild
+date-palms, beside the fine flowery stream, which runs through the charming
+valley of Zibah.&nbsp; We now had Mount Chiperiziwa between us, and
+part of the river near Morumbwa, having in fact come north about in
+order to avoid the difficulties of our former path.&nbsp; The last of
+the deserters, a reputed thief, took French leave of us here.&nbsp;
+He left the bundle of cloth he was carrying in the path a hundred yards
+in front of where we halted, but made off with the musket and most of
+the brass rings and beads of his comrade Shirimba, who had unsuspectingly
+intrusted them to his care.</p>
+<p>Proceeding S.W. up this lovely valley, in about an hour&rsquo;s time
+we reached Sandia&rsquo;s village.&nbsp; The chief was said to be absent
+hunting, and they did not know when he would return.&nbsp; This is such
+a common answer to the inquiry after a headman, that one is inclined
+to think that it only means that they wish to know the stranger&rsquo;s
+object before exposing their superior to danger.&nbsp; As some of our
+men were ill, a halt was made here.</p>
+<p>As we were unable to march next morning, six of our young men, anxious
+to try their muskets, went off to hunt elephants.&nbsp; For several
+hours they saw nothing, and some of them, getting tired, proposed to
+go to a village and buy food.&nbsp; &ldquo;No!&rdquo; said Mantlanyan&eacute;,
+&ldquo;we came to hunt, so let us go on.&rdquo;&nbsp; In a short time
+they fell in with a herd of cow elephants and calves.&nbsp; As soon
+as the first cow caught sight of the hunters on the rocks above her,
+she, with true motherly instinct, placed her young one between her fore-legs
+for protection.&nbsp; The men were for scattering, and firing into the
+herd indiscriminately.&nbsp; &ldquo;That won&rsquo;t do,&rdquo; cried
+Mantlanyan&eacute;, &ldquo;let us all fire at this one.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+The poor beast received a volley, and ran down into the plain, where
+another shot killed her; the young one escaped with the herd.&nbsp;
+The men were wild with excitement, and danced round the fallen queen
+of the forest, with loud shouts and exultant songs.&nbsp; They returned,
+bearing as trophies the tail and part of the trunk, and marched into
+camp as erect as soldiers, and evidently feeling that their stature
+had increased considerably since the morning.</p>
+<p>Sandia&rsquo;s wife was duly informed of their success, as here a
+law decrees that half the elephant belongs to the chief on whose ground
+it has been killed.&nbsp; The Portuguese traders always submit to this
+tax, and, were it of native origin, it could hardly be considered unjust.&nbsp;
+A chief must have some source of revenue; and, as many chiefs can raise
+none except from ivory or slaves, this tax is more free from objections
+than any other that a black Chancellor of the Exchequer could devise.&nbsp;
+It seems, however, to have originated with the Portuguese themselves,
+and then to have spread among the adjacent tribes.&nbsp; The Governors
+look sharply after any elephant that may be slain on the Crown lands,
+and demand one of the tusks from their vassals.&nbsp; We did not find
+the law in operation in any tribe beyond the range of Portuguese traders,
+or further than the sphere of travel of those Arabs who imitated Portuguese
+customs in trade.&nbsp; At the Kafu&eacute; in 1855 the chiefs bought
+the meat we killed, and demanded nothing as their due; and so it was
+up the Shir&eacute; during our visits.&nbsp; The slaves of the Portuguese,
+who are sent by their masters to shoot elephants, probably connive at
+the extension of this law, for they strive to get the good will of the
+chiefs to whose country they come, by advising them to make a demand
+of half of each elephant killed, and for this advice they are well paid
+in beer.&nbsp; When we found that the Portuguese argued in favour of
+this law, we told the natives that they might exact tusks from <i>them</i>,
+but that the English, being different, preferred the pure native custom.&nbsp;
+It was this which made Sandia, as afterwards mentioned, hesitate; but
+we did not care to insist on exemption in our favour, where the prevalence
+of the custom might have been held to justify the exaction.</p>
+<p>The cutting up of an elephant is quite a unique spectacle.&nbsp;
+The men stand remind the animal in dead silence, while the chief of
+the travelling party declares that, according to ancient law, the head
+and right hind-leg belong to him who killed the beast, that is, to him
+who inflicted the first wound; the left leg to bins who delivered the
+second, or first touched the animal after it fell.&nbsp; The meat around
+the eye to the English, or chief of the travellers, and different parts
+to the headmen of the different fires, or groups, of which the camp
+is composed; not forgetting to enjoin the preservation of the fat and
+bowels for a second distribution.&nbsp; This oration finished, the natives
+soon become excited, and scream wildly as they cut away at the carcass
+with a score of spears, whose long handles quiver in the air above their
+heads.&nbsp; Their excitement becomes momentarily more and more intense,
+and reaches the culminating point when, as denoted by a roar of gas,
+the huge mass is laid fairly open.&nbsp; Some jump inside, and roll
+about there in their eagerness to seize the precious fat, while others
+run off, screaming, with pieces of the bloody meat, throw it on the
+grass, and run back for more: all keep talking and shouting at the utmost
+pitch of their voices.&nbsp; Sometimes two or three, regardless of all
+laws, seize the same piece of meat, and have a brief fight of words
+over it.&nbsp; Occasionally an agonized yell bursts forth, and a native
+emerges out of the moving mass of dead elephant and wriggling humanity,
+with his hand badly cut by the spear of his excited friend and neighbour:
+this requires a rag and some soothing words to prevent bad blood.&nbsp;
+In an incredibly short time tons of meat are cut up, and placed in separate
+heaps around.</p>
+<p>Sandia arrived soon after the beast was divided: he is an elderly
+man, and wears a wig made of &ldquo;if&eacute;&rdquo; fibre (<i>sanseviera</i>)
+dyed black, and of a fine glossy appearance.&nbsp; This plant is allied
+to the aloes, and its thick fleshy leaves, in shape somewhat like our
+sedges, when bruised yield much fine strong fibre, which is made into
+ropes, nets, and wigs.&nbsp; It takes dyes readily, and the fibre might
+form a good article of commerce.&nbsp; &ldquo;If&eacute;&rdquo; wigs,
+as we afterwards saw, are not uncommon in this country, though perhaps
+not so common as hair wigs at home.&nbsp; Sandia&rsquo;s mosamela, or
+small carved wooden pillow, exactly resembling the ancient Egyptian
+one, was hung from the back of his neck; this pillow and a sleeping
+mat are usually carried by natives when on hunting excursions.</p>
+<p>We had the elephant&rsquo;s fore-foot cooked for ourselves, in native
+fashion.&nbsp; A large hole was dug in the ground, in which a fire was
+made; and, when the inside was thoroughly heated, the entire foot was
+placed in it, and covered over with the hot ashes and soil; another
+fire was made above the whole, and kept burning all night.&nbsp; We
+had the foot thus cooked for breakfast next morning, and found it delicious.&nbsp;
+It is a whitish mass, slightly gelatinous, and sweet, like marrow.&nbsp;
+A long march, to prevent biliousness, is a wise precaution after a meal
+of elephant&rsquo;s foot.&nbsp; Elephant&rsquo;s trunk and tongue are
+also good, and, after long simmering, much resemble the hump of a buffalo
+and the tongue of an ox; but all the other meat is tough, and, from
+its peculiar flavour, only to be eaten by a hungry man.&nbsp; The quantities
+of meat our men devour is quite astounding.&nbsp; They boil as much
+as their pots will hold, and eat till it becomes physically impossible
+for them to stow away any more.&nbsp; An uproarious dance follows, accompanied
+with stentorian song; and as soon as they have shaken their first course
+down, and washed off the sweat and dust of the after performance, they
+go to work to roast more: a short snatch of sleep succeeds, and they
+are up and at it again; all night long it is boil and eat, roast and
+devour, with a few brief interludes of sleep.&nbsp; Like other carnivora,
+these men can endure hunger for a much longer period than the mere porridge-eating
+tribes.&nbsp; Our men can cook meat as well as any reasonable traveller
+could desire; and, boiled in earthen pots, like Indian chatties, it
+tastes much better than when cooked in iron ones.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER V.</h3>
+<p>Magnificent scenery&mdash;Method of marching&mdash;Hippopotamus killed&mdash;Lions
+and buffalo&mdash;Sequasha the ivory-trader.</p>
+<p>Sandia gave us two guides; and on the 4th of June we left the Elephant
+valley, taking a westerly course; and, after crossing a few ridges,
+entered the Chingerer&eacute; or Paguruguru valley, through which, in
+the rainy season, runs the streamlet Pajodz&eacute;.&nbsp; The mountains
+on our left, between us and the Zambesi, our guides told us have the
+same name as the valley, but that at the confluence of the Pajodz&eacute;
+is called Morumbwa.&nbsp; We struck the river at less than half a mile
+to the north of the cataract Morumbwa.&nbsp; On climbing up the base
+of this mountain at Pajodz&eacute;, we found that we were distant only
+the diameter of the mountain from the cataract.&nbsp; In measuring the
+cataract we formerly stood on its southern flank; now we were perched
+on its northern flank, and at once recognized the onion-shaped mountain,
+here called Zakavuma, whose smooth convex surface overlooks the broken
+water.&nbsp; Its bearing by compass was l80 degrees from the spot to
+which we had climbed, and 700 or 800 yards distant.&nbsp; We now, from
+this standing-point, therefore, completed our inspection of all Kebrabasa,
+and saw what, as a whole, was never before seen by Europeans so far
+as any records show.</p>
+<p>The remainder of the Kebrabasa path, on to Chicova, was close to
+the compressed and rocky river.&nbsp; Ranges of lofty tree-covered mountains,
+with deep narrow valleys, in which are dry watercourses, or flowing
+rivulets, stretch from the north-west, and are prolonged on the opposite
+side of the river in a south-easterly direction.&nbsp; Looking back,
+the mountain scenery in Kebrabasa was magnificent; conspicuous from
+their form and steep sides, are the two gigantic portals of the cataract;
+the vast forests still wore their many brilliant autumnal-coloured tints
+of green, yellow, red, purple, and brown, thrown into relief by the
+grey bark of the trunks in the background.&nbsp; Among these variegated
+trees were some conspicuous for their new livery of fresh light-green
+leaves, as though the winter of others was their spring.&nbsp; The bright
+sunshine in these mountain forests, and the ever-changing forms of the
+cloud shadows, gliding over portions of the surface, added fresh charms
+to scenes already surpassingly beautiful.</p>
+<p>From what we have seen of the Kebrabasa rocks and rapids, it appears
+too evident that they must always form a barrier to navigation at the
+ordinary low water of the river; but the rise of the water in this gorge
+being as much as eighty feet perpendicularly, it is probable that a
+steamer might be taken up at high flood, when all the rapids are smoothed
+over, to run on the Upper Zambesi.&nbsp; The most formidable cataract
+in it, Morumbwa, has only about twenty feet of fall, in a distance of
+thirty yards, and it must entirely disappear when the water stands eighty
+feet higher.&nbsp; Those of the Makololo who worked on board the ship
+were not sorry at the steamer being left below, as they had become heartily
+tired of cutting the wood that the insatiable furnace of the &ldquo;Asthmatic&rdquo;
+required.&nbsp; Mbia, who was a bit of a wag, laughingly exclaimed in
+broken English, &ldquo;Oh, Kebrabasa good, very good; no let shippee
+up to Sekeletu, too muchee work, cuttee woodyee, cuttee woodyee: Kebrabasa
+good.&rdquo;&nbsp; It is currently reported, and commonly believed,
+that once upon a time a Portuguese named Jos&eacute; Pedra,&mdash;by
+the natives called Nyamatimbira,&mdash;chief, or capit&atilde;o mor,
+of Zumbo, a man of large enterprise and small humanity,&mdash;being
+anxious to ascertain if Kebrabasa could be navigated, made two slaves
+fast to a canoe, and launched it from Chicova into Kebrabasa, in order
+to see if it would come out at the other end.&nbsp; As neither slaves
+nor canoe ever appeared again, his Excellency concluded that Kebrabasa
+was unnavigable.&nbsp; A trader had a large canoe swept away by a sudden
+rise of the river, and it was found without damage below; but the most
+satisfactory information was that of old Sandia, who asserted that in
+flood all Kebrabasa became quite smooth, and he had often seen it so.</p>
+<p>We emerged from the thirty-five or forty miles of Kebrabasa hills
+into the Chicova plains on the 7th of June, 1860, having made short
+marches all the way.&nbsp; The cold nights caused some of our men to
+cough badly, and colds in this country almost invariably become fever.&nbsp;
+The Zambesi suddenly expands at Chicova, and assumes the size and appearance
+it has at Tette.&nbsp; Near this point we found a large seam of coal
+exposed in the left bank.</p>
+<p>We met with native travellers occasionally.&nbsp; Those on a long
+journey carry with them a sleeping-mat and wooden pillow, cooking-pot
+and bag of meal, pipe and tobacco-pouch, a knife, bow, and arrows, and
+two small sticks, of from two to three feet in length, for making fire,
+when obliged to sleep away from human habitations.&nbsp; Dry wood is
+always abundant, and they get fire by the following method.&nbsp; A
+notch is cut in one of the sticks, which, with a close-grained outside,
+has a small core of pith, and this notched stick is laid horizontally
+on a knife-blade on the ground; the operator squatting, places his great
+toes on each end to keep all steady, and taking the other wand which
+is of very hard wood cut to a blunt point, fits it into the notch at
+right angles; the upright wand is made to spin rapidly backwards and
+forwards between the palms of the hands, drill fashion, and at the same
+time is pressed downwards; the friction, in the course of a minute or
+so, ignites portions of the pith of the notched stick, which, rolling
+over like live charcoal on to the knife-blade, are lifted into a handful
+of fine dry grass, and carefully blown, by waving backwards and forwards
+in the air.&nbsp; It is hard work for the hands to procure fire by this
+process, as the vigorous drilling and downward pressure requisite soon
+blister soft palms.</p>
+<p>Having now entered a country where lions were numerous, our men began
+to pay greater attention to the arrangements of the camp at night.&nbsp;
+As they are accustomed to do with their chiefs, they place the white
+men in the centre; Kanyata, his men, and the two donkeys, camp on our
+right; Tuba Mokoro&rsquo;s party of Bashubia are in front; Masakasa,
+and Sininyan&eacute;&rsquo;s body of Batoka, on the left; and in the
+rear six Tette men have their fires.&nbsp; In placing their fires they
+are careful to put them where the smoke will not blow in our faces.&nbsp;
+Soon after we halt, the spot for the English is selected, and all regulate
+their places accordingly, and deposit their burdens.&nbsp; The men take
+it by turns to cut some of the tall dry grass, and spread it for our
+beds on a spot, either naturally level, or smoothed by the hoe; some,
+appointed to carry our bedding, then bring our rugs and karosses, and
+place the three rugs in a row on the grass; Dr. Livingstone&rsquo;s
+being in the middle, Dr. Kirk&rsquo;s on the right, and Charles Livingstone&rsquo;s
+on the left.&nbsp; Our bags, rifles, and revolvers are carefully placed
+at our heads, and a fire made near our feet.&nbsp; We have no tent nor
+covering of any kind except the branches of the tree under which we
+may happen to lie; and it is a pretty sight to look up and see every
+branch, leaf, and twig of the tree stand out, reflected against the
+clear star-spangled and moonlit sky.&nbsp; The stars of the first magnitude
+have names which convey the same meaning over very wide tracts of country.&nbsp;
+Here when Venus comes out in the evenings, she is called Ntanda, the
+eldest or first-born, and Manjika, the first-born of morning, at other
+times: she has so much radiance when shining alone, that she casts a
+shadow.&nbsp; Sirius is named Kuewa usiko, &ldquo;drawer of night,&rdquo;
+because supposed to draw the whole night after it.&nbsp; The moon has
+no evil influence in this country, so far as we know.&nbsp; We have
+lain and looked up at her, till sweet sleep closed our eyes, unharmed.&nbsp;
+Four or five of our men were affected with moon-blindness at Tette;
+though they had not slept out of doors there, they became so blind that
+their comrades had to guide their hands to the general dish of food;
+the affection is unknown in their own country.&nbsp; When our posterity
+shall have discovered what it is which, distinct from foul smells, causes
+fever, and what, apart from the moon, causes men to be moon-struck,
+they will pity our dulness of perception.</p>
+<p>The men cut a very small quantity of grass for themselves, and sleep
+in fumbas or sleeping-bags, which are double mats of palm-leaf, six
+feet long by four wide, and sewn together round three parts of the square,
+and left open only on one side.&nbsp; They are used as a protection
+from the cold, wet, and mosquitoes, and are entered as we should get
+into our beds, were the blankets nailed to the top, bottom, and one
+side of the bedstead.</p>
+<p>A dozen fires are nightly kindled in the camp; and these, being replenished
+from time to time by the men who are awakened by the cold, are kept
+burning until daylight.&nbsp; Abundance of dry hard wood is obtained
+with little trouble; and burns beautifully.&nbsp; After the great business
+of cooking and eating is over, all sit round the camp-fires, and engage
+in talking or singing.&nbsp; Every evening one of the Batoka plays his
+&ldquo;sansa,&rdquo; and continues at it until far into the night; he
+accompanies it with an extempore song, in which he rehearses their deeds
+ever since they left their own country.&nbsp; At times animated political
+discussions spring up, and the amount of eloquence expended on these
+occasions is amazing.&nbsp; The whole camp is aroused, and the men shout
+to one another from the different fires; whilst some, whose tongues
+are never heard on any other subject, burst forth into impassioned speech.</p>
+<p>As a specimen of our mode of marching, we rise about five, or as
+soon as dawn appears, take a cup of tea and a bit of biscuit; the servants
+fold up the blankets and stow them away in the bags they carry; the
+others tie their fumbas and cooking-pots to each end of their carrying-sticks,
+which are borne on the shoulder; the cook secures the dishes, and all
+are on the path by sunrise.&nbsp; If a convenient spot can be found
+we halt for breakfast about nine a.m.&nbsp; To save time, this meal
+is generally cooked the night before, and has only to be warmed.&nbsp;
+We continue the march after breakfast, rest a little in the middle of
+the day, and break off early in the afternoon.&nbsp; We average from
+two to two-and-a-half miles an hour in a straight line, or as the crow
+flies, and seldom have more than five or six hours a day of actual travel.&nbsp;
+This in a hot climate is as much as a man can accomplish without being
+oppressed; and we always tried to make our progress more a pleasure
+than a toil.&nbsp; To hurry over the ground, abuse, and look ferocious
+at one&rsquo;s native companions, merely for the foolish vanity of boasting
+how quickly a distance was accomplished, is a combination of silliness
+with absurdity quite odious; while kindly consideration for the feelings
+of even blacks, the pleasure of observing scenery and everything new
+as one moves on at an ordinary pace, and the participation in the most
+delicious rest with our fellows, render travelling delightful.&nbsp;
+Though not given to over haste, we were a little surprised to find that
+we could tire our men out; and even the headman, who carried but little
+more than we did, and never, as we often had to do, hunted in the afternoon,
+was no better than his comrades.&nbsp; Our experience tends to prove
+that the European constitution has a power of endurance, even in the
+tropics, greater than that of the hardiest of the meat-eating Africans.</p>
+<p>After pitching our camp, one or two of us usually go off to hunt,
+more as a matter of necessity than of pleasure, for the men, as well
+as ourselves, must have meat.&nbsp; We prefer to take a man with us
+to carry home the game, or lead the others to where it lies; but as
+they frequently grumble and complain of being tired, we do not particularly
+object to going alone, except that it involves the extra labour of our
+making a second trip to show the men where the animal that has been
+shot is to be found.&nbsp; When it is a couple of miles off it is rather
+fatiguing to have to go twice; more especially on the days when it is
+solely to supply their wants that, instead of resting ourselves, we
+go at all.&nbsp; Like those who perform benevolent deeds at home, the
+tired hunter, though trying hard to live in charity with all men, is
+strongly tempted to give it up by bringing only sufficient meat for
+the three whites and leaving the rest; thus sending the &ldquo;idle
+ungrateful poor&rdquo; supperless to bed.&nbsp; And yet it is only by
+continuance in well-doing, even to the length of what the worldly-wise
+call weakness, that the conviction is produced anywhere, that our motives
+are high enough to secure sincere respect.</p>
+<p>A jungle of mimosa, ebony, and &ldquo;wait-a-bit&rdquo; thorn lies
+between the Chicova flats and the cultivated plain, on which stand the
+villages of the chief, Chitora.&nbsp; He brought us a present of food
+and drink, because, as he, with the innate politeness of an African,
+said, he &ldquo;did not wish us to sleep hungry: he had heard of the
+Doctor when he passed down, and had a great desire to see and converse
+with him; but he was a child then, and could not speak in the presence
+of great men.&nbsp; He was glad that he had seen the English now, and
+was sorry that his people were away, or he should have made them cook
+for us.&rdquo;&nbsp; All his subsequent conduct showed him to be sincere.</p>
+<p>Many of the African women are particular about the water they use
+for drinking and cooking, and prefer that which is filtered through
+sand.&nbsp; To secure this, they scrape holes in the sandbanks beside
+the stream, and scoop up the water, which slowly filters through, rather
+than take it from the equally clear and limpid river.&nbsp; This practice
+is common in the Zambesi, the Rovuma, and Lake Nyassa; and some of the
+Portuguese at Tette have adopted the native custom, and send canoes
+to a low island in the middle of the river for water.&nbsp; Chitora&rsquo;s
+people also obtained their supply from shallow wells in the sandy bed
+of a small rivulet close to the village.&nbsp; The habit may have arisen
+from observing the unhealthiness of the main stream at certain seasons.&nbsp;
+During nearly nine months in the year, ordure is deposited around countless
+villages along the thousands of miles drained by the Zambesi.&nbsp;
+When the heavy rains come down, and sweep the vast fetid accumulation
+into the torrents, the water is polluted with filth; and, but for the
+precaution mentioned, the natives would prove themselves as little fastidious
+as those in London who drink the abomination poured into the Thames
+by Reading and Oxford.&nbsp; It is no wonder that sailors suffered so
+much from fever after drinking African river water, before the present
+admirable system of condensing it was adopted in our navy.</p>
+<p>The scent of man is excessively terrible to game of all kinds, much
+more so, probably, than the sight of him.&nbsp; A herd of antelopes,
+a hundred yards off, gazed at us as we moved along the winding path,
+and timidly stood their ground until half our line had passed, but darted
+off the instant they &ldquo;got the wind,&rdquo; or caught the flavour
+of those who had gone by.&nbsp; The sport is all up with the hunter
+who gets to the windward of the African beast, as it cannot stand even
+the distant aroma of the human race, so much dreaded by all wild animals.&nbsp;
+Is this the fear and the dread of man, which the Almighty said to Noah
+was to be upon every beast of the field?&nbsp; A lion may, while lying
+in wait for his prey, leap on a human being as he would on any other
+animal, save a rhinoceros or an elephant, that happened to pass; or
+a lioness, when she has cubs, might attack a man, who, passing &ldquo;up
+the wind of her,&rdquo; had unconsciously, by his scent, alarmed her
+for the safety of her whelps; or buffaloes, amid other animals, might
+rush at a line of travellers, in apprehension of being surrounded by
+them; but neither beast nor snake will, as a general rule, turn on man
+except when wounded, or by mistake.&nbsp; If gorillas, unwounded, advance
+to do battle with him, and beat their breasts in defiance, they are
+an exception to all wild beasts known to us.&nbsp; From the way an elephant
+runs at the first glance of man, it is inferred that this huge brute,
+though really king of beasts, would run even from a child.</p>
+<p>Our two donkeys caused as much admiration as the three white men.&nbsp;
+Great was the astonishment when one of the donkeys began to bray.&nbsp;
+The timid jumped more than if a lion had roared beside them.&nbsp; All
+were startled, and stared in mute amazement at the harsh-voiced one,
+till the last broken note was uttered; then, on being assured that nothing
+in particular was meant, they looked at each other, and burst into a
+loud laugh at their common surprise.&nbsp; When one donkey stimulated
+the other to try his vocal powers, the interest felt by the startled
+visitors, must have equalled that of the Londoners, when they first
+crowded to see the famous hippopotamus.</p>
+<p>We were now, when we crossed the boundary rivulet Nyamatarara, out
+of Chicova and amongst sandstone rocks, similar to those which prevail
+between Lupata and Kebrabasa.&nbsp; In the latter gorge, as already
+mentioned, igneous and syenitic masses have been acted on by some great
+fiery convulsion of nature; the strata are thrown into a huddled heap
+of confusion.&nbsp; The coal has of course disappeared in Kebrabasa,
+but is found again in Chicova.&nbsp; Tette grey sandstone is common
+about Sinj&eacute;r&eacute;, and wherever it is seen with fossil wood
+upon it, coal lies beneath; and here, as at Chicova, some seams crop
+out on the banks of the Zambesi.&nbsp; Looking southwards, the country
+is open plain and woodland, with detached hills and mountains in the
+distance; but the latter are too far off, the natives say, for them
+to know their names.&nbsp; The principal hills on our right, as we look
+up stream, are from six to twelve miles away, and occasionally they
+send down spurs to the river, with brooks flowing through their narrow
+valleys.&nbsp; The banks of the Zambesi show two well-defined terraces;
+the first, or lowest, being usually narrow, and of great fertility,
+while the upper one is a dry grassy plain, a thorny jungle, or a mopane
+(<i>Bauhinia</i>) forest.&nbsp; One of these plains, near the Kafu&eacute;,
+is covered with the large stumps and trunks of a petrified forest.&nbsp;
+We halted a couple of days by the fine stream Sinj&eacute;r&eacute;,
+which comes from the Chiroby-roby hills, about eight miles to the north.&nbsp;
+Many lumps of coal, brought down by the rapid current, lie in its channel.&nbsp;
+The natives never seem to have discovered that coal would burn, and,
+when informed of the fact, shook their heads, smiled incredulously,
+and said &ldquo;<i>Kodi</i>&rdquo; (really), evidently regarding it
+as a mere traveller&rsquo;s tale.&nbsp; They were astounded to see it
+burning freely on our fire of wood.&nbsp; They told us that plenty of
+it was seen among the hills; but, being long ago aware that we were
+now in an immense coalfield, we did not care to examine it further.</p>
+<p>A dyke of black basaltic rock, called Kakolol&eacute;, crosses the
+river near the mouth of the Sinj&eacute;r&eacute;; but it has two open
+gateways in it of from sixty to eighty yards in breadth, and the channel
+is very deep.</p>
+<p>On a shallow sandbank, under the dyke, lay a herd of hippopotami
+in fancied security.&nbsp; The young ones were playing with each other
+like young puppies, climbing on the backs of their dams, trying to take
+hold of one another by the jaws and tumbling over into the water.&nbsp;
+Mbia, one of the Makololo, waded across to within a dozen yards of the
+drowsy beasts, and shot the father of the herd; who, being very fat,
+soon floated, and was secured at the village below.&nbsp; The headman
+of the village visited us while we were at breakfast.&nbsp; He wore
+a black &ldquo;if&eacute;&rdquo; wig and a printed shirt.&nbsp; After
+a short silence he said to Masakasa, &ldquo;You are with the white people,
+so why do you not tell them to give me a cloth?&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;We
+are strangers,&rdquo; answered Masakasa, &ldquo;why do you not bring
+us some food?&rdquo;&nbsp; He took the plain hint, and brought us two
+fowls, in order that we should not report that in passing him we got
+nothing to eat; and, as usual, we gave a cloth in return.&nbsp; In reference
+to the hippopotamus he would make no demand, but said he would take
+what we chose to give him.&nbsp; The men gorged themselves with meat
+for two days, and cut large quantities into long narrow strips, which
+they half-dried and half-roasted on wooden frames over the fire.&nbsp;
+Much game is taken in this neighbourhood in pitfalls.&nbsp; Sharp-pointed
+stakes are set in the bottom, on which the game tumbles and gets impaled.&nbsp;
+The natives are careful to warn strangers of these traps, and also of
+the poisoned beams suspended on the tall trees for the purpose of killing
+elephants and hippopotami.&nbsp; It is not difficult to detect the pitfalls
+after one&rsquo;s attention has been called to them; but in places where
+they are careful to carry the earth off to a distance, and a person
+is not thinking of such things, a sudden descent of nine feet is an
+experience not easily forgotten by the traveller.&nbsp; The sensations
+of one thus instantaneously swallowed up by the earth are peculiar.&nbsp;
+A momentary suspension of consciousness is followed by the rustling
+sound of a shower of sand and dry grass, and the half-bewildered thought
+of where he is, and how he came into darkness.&nbsp; Reason awakes to
+assure him that he must have come down through that small opening of
+daylight overhead, and that he is now where a hippopotamus ought to
+have been.&nbsp; The descent of a hippopotamus pitfall is easy, but
+to get out again into the upper air is a work of labour.&nbsp; The sides
+are smooth and treacherous, and the cross reeds, which support the covering,
+break in the attempt to get out by clutching them.&nbsp; A cry from
+the depths is unheard by those around, and it is only by repeated and
+most desperate efforts that the buried alive can regain the upper world.&nbsp;
+At Tette we are told of a white hunter, of unusually small stature,
+who plumped into a pit while stalking a guinea-fowl on a tree.&nbsp;
+It was the labour of an entire forenoon to get out; and he was congratulating
+himself on his escape, and brushing off the clay from his clothes, when
+down he went into a second pit, which happened, as is often the case,
+to be close beside the first, and it was evening before he could work
+himself out of <i>that</i>.</p>
+<p>Elephants and buffaloes seldom return to the river by the same path
+on two successive nights, they become so apprehensive of danger from
+this human art.&nbsp; An old elephant will walk in advance of the herd,
+and uncover the pits with his trunk, that the others may see the openings
+and tread on firm ground.&nbsp; Female elephants are generally the victims:
+more timid by nature than the males, and very motherly in their anxiety
+for their calves, they carry their trunks up, trying every breeze for
+fancied danger, which often in reality lies at their feet.&nbsp; The
+tusker, fearing less, keeps his trunk down, and, warned in time by that
+exquisitely sensitive organ, takes heed to his ways.</p>
+<p>Our camp on the Sinj&eacute;r&eacute; stood under a wide-spreading
+wild fig-tree.&nbsp; From the numbers of this family, of large size,
+dotted over the country, the fig or banyan species would seem to have
+been held sacred in Africa from the remotest times.&nbsp; The soil teemed
+with white ants, whose clay tunnels, formed to screen them from the
+eyes of birds, thread over the ground, up the trunks of trees, and along
+the branches, from which the little architects clear away all rotten
+or dead wood.&nbsp; Very often the exact shape of branches is left in
+tunnels on the ground and not a bit of the wood inside.&nbsp; The first
+night we passed here these destructive insects ate through our grass-beds,
+and attacked our blankets, and certain large red-headed ones even bit
+our flesh.</p>
+<p>On some days not a single white ant is to be seen abroad; and on
+others, and during certain hours, they appear out of doors in myriads,
+and work with extraordinary zeal and energy in carrying bits of dried
+grass down into their nests.&nbsp; During these busy reaping-fits the
+lizards and birds have a good time of it, and enjoy a rich feast at
+the expense of thousands of hapless workmen; and when they swarm they
+are caught in countless numbers by the natives, and their roasted bodies
+are spoken of in an unctuous manner as resembling grains of soft rice
+fried in delicious fresh oil.</p>
+<p>A strong marauding party of large black ants attacked a nest of white
+ones near the camp: as the contest took place beneath the surface, we
+could not see the order of the battle; but it soon became apparent that
+the blacks had gained the day, and sacked the white town, for they returned
+in triumph, bearing off the eggs, and choice bits of the bodies of the
+vanquished.&nbsp; A gift, analogous to that of language, has not been
+withheld from ants: if part of their building is destroyed, an official
+is seen coming out to examine the damage; and, after a careful survey
+of the ruins, he chirrups a few clear and distinct notes, and a crowd
+of workers begin at once to repair the breach.&nbsp; When the work is
+completed, another order is given, and the workmen retire, as will appear
+on removing the soft freshly-built portion.&nbsp; We tried to sleep
+one rainy might in a native hut, but could not because of attacks by
+the fighting battalions of a very small species of formica, not more
+than one-sixteenth of an inch in length.&nbsp; It soon became obvious
+that they were under regular discipline, and even attempting to carry
+out the skilful plans and stratagems of some eminent leader.&nbsp; Our
+hands and necks were the first objects of attack.&nbsp; Large bodies
+of these little pests were massed in silence round the point to be assaulted.&nbsp;
+We could hear the sharp shrill word of command two or three times repeated,
+though until then we had not believed in the vocal power of an ant;
+the instant after we felt the storming hosts range over head and neck,
+biting the tender skin, clinging with a death-grip to the hair, and
+parting with their jaws rather than quit their hold.&nbsp; On our lying
+down again in the hope of their having been driven off, no sooner was
+the light out, and all still, than the manoeuvre was repeated.&nbsp;
+Clear and audible orders were issued, and the assault renewed.&nbsp;
+It was as hard to sleep in that hut as in the trenches before Sebastopol.&nbsp;
+The white ant, being a vegetable feeder, devours articles of vegetable
+origin only, and leather, which, by tanning, is imbued with a vegetable
+flavour.&nbsp; &ldquo;A man may be rich to-day and poor to-morrow, from
+the ravages of white ants,&rdquo; said a Portuguese merchant.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;If he gets sick, and unable to look after his goods, his slaves
+neglect them, and they are soon destroyed by these insects.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+The reddish ant, in the west called drivers, crossed our path daily,
+in solid columns an inch wide, and never did the pugnacity of either
+man or beast exceed theirs.&nbsp; It is a sufficient cause of war if
+you only approach them, even by accident.&nbsp; Some turn out of the
+ranks and stand with open mandibles, or, charging with extended jaws,
+bite with savage ferocity.&nbsp; When hunting, we lighted among them
+too often; while we were intent on the game, and without a thought of
+ants, they quietly covered us from head to foot, then all began to bite
+at the same instant; seizing a piece of the skin with their powerful
+pincers, they twisted themselves round with it, as if determined to
+tear it out.&nbsp; Their bites are so terribly sharp that the bravest
+must run, and then strip to pick off those that still cling with their
+hooked jaws, as with steel forceps.&nbsp; This kind abounds in damp
+places, and is usually met with on the banks of streams.&nbsp; We have
+not heard of their actually killing any animal except the Python, and
+that only when gorged and quite lethargic, but they soon clear away
+any dead animal matter; this appears to be their principal food, and
+their use in the economy of nature is clearly in the scavenger line.</p>
+<p>We started from the Sinj&eacute;r&eacute; on the 12th of June, our
+men carrying with them bundles of hippopotamus meat for sale, and for
+future use.&nbsp; We rested for breakfast opposite the Kakolol&eacute;
+dyke, which confines the channel, west of the Manyer&eacute;r&eacute;
+mountain.&nbsp; A rogue monkey, the largest by far that we ever saw,
+and very fat and tame, walked off leisurely from a garden as we approached.&nbsp;
+The monkey is a sacred animal in this region, and is never molested
+or killed, because the people believe devoutly that the souls of their
+ancestors now occupy these degraded forms, and anticipate that they
+themselves must, sooner or later, be transformed in like manner; a future
+as cheerless for the black as the spirit-rapper&rsquo;s heaven is for
+the whites.&nbsp; The gardens are separated from each other by a single
+row of small stones, a few handfuls of grass, or a slight furrow made
+by the hoe.&nbsp; Some are enclosed by a reed fence of the flimsiest
+construction, yet sufficient to keep out the ever wary hippopotamus,
+who dreads a trap.&nbsp; His extreme caution is taken advantage of by
+the women, who hang, as a miniature trap-beam, a kigelia fruit with
+a bit of stick in the end.&nbsp; This protects the maize, of which he
+is excessively fond.</p>
+<p>The quantity of hippopotamus meat eaten by our men made some of them
+ill, and our marches were necessarily short.&nbsp; After three hours&rsquo;
+travel on the 13th, we spent the remainder of the day at the village
+of Chasiribera, on a rivulet flowing through a beautiful valley to the
+north, which is bounded by magnificent mountain-ranges.&nbsp; Pinkw&eacute;,
+or Mbingw&eacute;, otherwise Moeu, forms the south-eastern angle of
+the range.&nbsp; On the 16th June we were at the flourishing village
+of Senga, under the headman Manyam&eacute;, which lies at the foot of
+the mount Motemwa.&nbsp; Nearly all the mountains in this country are
+covered with open forest and grass, in colour, according to the season,
+green or yellow.&nbsp; Many are between 2000 and 3000 feet high, with
+the sky line fringed with trees; the rocks show just sufficiently for
+one to observe their stratification, or their granitic form, and though
+not covered with dense masses of climbing plants, like those in moister
+eastern climates, there is still the idea conveyed that most of the
+steep sides are fertile, and none give the impression of that barrenness
+which, in northern mountains, suggests the idea that the bones of the
+world are sticking through its skin.</p>
+<p>The villagers reported that we were on the footsteps of a Portuguese
+half-caste, who, at Senga, lately tried to purchase ivory, but, in consequence
+of his having murdered a chief near Zumbo and twenty of his men, the
+people declined to trade with him.&nbsp; He threatened to take the ivory
+by force, if they would not sell it; but that same night the ivory and
+the women were spirited out of the village, and only a large body of
+armed men remained.&nbsp; The trader, fearing that he might come off
+second best if it came to blows, immediately departed.&nbsp; Chikwanitsela,
+or Sekuanangila, is the paramount chief of some fifty miles of the northern
+bank of the Zambesi in this locality.&nbsp; He lives on the opposite,
+or southern side, and there his territory is still more extensive.&nbsp;
+We sent him a present from Senga, and were informed by a messenger next
+morning that he had a cough and could not come over to see us.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;And has his present a cough too,&rdquo; remarked one of our party,
+&ldquo;that it does not come to us?&nbsp; Is this the way your chief
+treats strangers, receives their present, and sends them no food in
+return?&rdquo;&nbsp; Our men thought Chikwanitsela an uncommonly stingy
+fellow; but, as it was possible that some of them might yet wish to
+return this way, they did not like to scold him more than this, which
+was sufficiently to the point.</p>
+<p>Men and women were busily engaged in preparing the ground for the
+November planting.&nbsp; Large game was abundant; herds of elephants
+and buffaloes came down to the river in the night, but were a long way
+off by daylight.&nbsp; They soon adopt this habit in places where they
+are hunted.</p>
+<p>The plains we travel over are constantly varying in breadth, according
+as the furrowed and wooded hills approach or recede from the river.&nbsp;
+On the southern side we see the hill Bungw&eacute;, and the long, level,
+wooded ridge Nyangomb&eacute;, the first of a series bending from the
+S.E. to the N.W. past the Zambesi.&nbsp; We shot an old pallah on the
+16th, and found that the poor animal had been visited with more than
+the usual share of animal afflictions.&nbsp; He was stone-blind in both
+eyes, had several tumours, and a broken leg, which showed no symptoms
+of ever having begun to heal.&nbsp; Wild animals sometimes suffer a
+great deal from disease, and wearily drag on a miserable existence before
+relieved of it by some ravenous beast.&nbsp; Once we drove off a maneless
+lion and lioness from a dead buffalo, which had been in the last stage
+of a decline.&nbsp; They had watched him staggering to the river to
+quench his thirst, and sprang on him as he was crawling up the bank.&nbsp;
+One had caught him by the throat, and the other by his high projecting
+backbone, which was broken by the lion&rsquo;s powerful fangs.&nbsp;
+The struggle, if any, must have been short.&nbsp; They had only eaten
+the intestines when we frightened them off.&nbsp; It is curious that
+this is the part that wild animals always begin with, and that it is
+also the first choice of our men.&nbsp; Were it not a wise arrangement
+that only the strongest males should continue the breed, one could hardly
+help pitying the solitary buffalo expelled from the herd for some physical
+blemish, or on account of the weakness of approaching old age.&nbsp;
+Banished from female society, he naturally becomes morose and savage;
+the necessary watchfulness against enemies is now never shared by others;
+disgusted, he passes into a state of chronic war with all who enjoy
+life, and the sooner after his expulsion that he fills the lion&rsquo;s
+or the wild-dog&rsquo;s maw, the better for himself and for the peace
+of the country.</p>
+<p>We encamped on the 20th of June at a spot where Dr. Livingstone,
+on his journey from the West to the East Coast, was formerly menaced
+by a chief named Mpend&eacute;.&nbsp; No offence had been committed
+against him, but he had firearms, and, with the express object of showing
+his power, he threatened to attack the strangers.&nbsp; Mpend&eacute;&rsquo;s
+counsellors having, however, found out that Dr. Livingstone belonged
+to a tribe of whom they had heard that &ldquo;they loved the black man
+and did not make slaves,&rdquo; his conduct at once changed from enmity
+to kindness, and, as the place was one well selected for defence, it
+was perhaps quite as well for Mpend&eacute; that he decided as he did.&nbsp;
+Three of his counsellors now visited us, and we gave them a handsome
+present for their chief, who came himself next morning and made us a
+present of a goat, a basket of boiled maize, and another of vetches.&nbsp;
+A few miles above this the headman, Chilondo of Nyamasusa, apologized
+for not formerly lending us canoes.&nbsp; &ldquo;He was absent, and
+his children were to blame for not telling him when the Doctor passed;
+he did not refuse the canoes.&rdquo;&nbsp; The sight of our men, now
+armed with muskets, had a great effect.&nbsp; Without any bullying,
+firearms command respect, and lead men to be reasonable who might otherwise
+feel disposed to be troublesome.&nbsp; Nothing, however, our fracas
+with Mpend&eacute; excepted, could be more peaceful than our passage
+through this tract of country in 1856.&nbsp; We then had nothing to
+excite the cupidity of the people, and the men maintained themselves,
+either by selling elephant&rsquo;s meat, or by exhibiting feats of foreign
+dancing.&nbsp; Most of the people were very generous and friendly; but
+the Banyai, nearer to Tette than this, stopped our march with a threatening
+war-dance.&nbsp; One of our party, terrified at this, ran away, as we
+thought, insane, and could not, after a painful search of three days,
+be found.&nbsp; The Banyai, evidently touched by our distress, allowed
+us to proceed.&nbsp; Through a man we left on an island a little below
+Mpend&eacute;&rsquo;s, we subsequently learned that poor Monaheng had
+fled thither, and had been murdered by the headman for no reason except
+that he was defenceless.&nbsp; This headman had since become odious
+to his countrymen, and had been put to death by them.</p>
+<p>On the 23rd of June we entered Pangola&rsquo;s principal village,
+which is upwards of a mile from the river.&nbsp; The ruins of a mud
+wall showed that a rude attempt had been made to imitate the Portuguese
+style of building.&nbsp; We established ourselves under a stately wild
+fig-tree, round whose trunk witchcraft medicine had been tied, to protect
+from thieves the honey of the wild bees, which had their hive in one
+of the limbs.&nbsp; This is a common device.&nbsp; The charm, or the
+medicine, is purchased of the dice doctors, and consists of a strip
+of palm-leaf smeared with something, and adorned with a few bits of
+grass, wood, or roots.&nbsp; It is tied round the tree, and is believed
+to have the power of inflicting disease and death on the thief who climbs
+over it.&nbsp; Superstition is thus not without its uses in certain
+states of society; it prevents many crimes and misdemeanours, which
+would occur but for the salutary fear that it produces.</p>
+<p>Pangola arrived, tipsy and talkative.&mdash;&ldquo;We are friends,
+we are great friends; I have brought you a basket of green maize&mdash;here
+it is!&rdquo;&nbsp; We thanked him, and handed him two fathoms of cotton
+cloth, four times the market-value of his present.&nbsp; No, he would
+not take so small a present; he wanted a double-barrelled rifle&mdash;one
+of Dixon&rsquo;s best.&nbsp; &ldquo;We are friends, you know; we are
+all friends together.&rdquo;&nbsp; But although we were willing to admit
+that, we could not give him our best rifle, so he went off in high dudgeon.&nbsp;
+Early next morning, as we were commencing Divine service, Pangola returned,
+sober.&nbsp; We explained to him that we wished to worship God, and
+invited him to remain; he seemed frightened, and retired: but after
+service he again importuned us for the rifle.&nbsp; It was of no use
+telling him that we had a long journey before us, and needed it to kill
+game for ourselves.&mdash;&ldquo;He too must obtain meat for himself
+and people, for they sometimes suffered from hunger.&rdquo;&nbsp; He
+then got sulky, and his people refused to sell food except at extravagant
+prices.&nbsp; Knowing that we had nothing to eat, they felt sure of
+starving us into compliance.&nbsp; But two of our young men, having
+gone off at sunrise, shot a fine waterbuck, and down came the provision
+market to the lower figure; they even became eager to sell, but our
+men were angry with them for trying compulsion, and would not buy.&nbsp;
+Black greed had outwitted itself, as happens often with white cupidity;
+and not only here did the traits of Africans remind us of Anglo-Saxons
+elsewhere: the notoriously ready world-wide disposition to take an unfair
+advantage of a man&rsquo;s necessities shows that the same mean motives
+are pretty widely diffused among all races.&nbsp; It may not be granted
+that the same blood flows in all veins, or that all have descended from
+the same stock; but the traveller has no doubt that, practically, the
+white rogue and black are men and brothers.</p>
+<p>Pangola is the child or vassal of Mpend&eacute;.&nbsp; Sandia and
+Mpend&eacute; are the only independent chiefs from Kebrabasa to Zumbo,
+and belong to the tribe Manganja.&nbsp; The country north of the mountains
+here in sight from the Zambesi is called Senga, and its inhabitants
+Asenga, or Basenga, but all appear to be of the same family as the rest
+of the Manganja and Maravi.&nbsp; Formerly all the Manganja were united
+under the government of their great chief, Undi, whose empire extended
+from Lake Shirwa to the River Loangwa; but after Undi&rsquo;s death
+it fell to pieces, and a large portion of it on the Zambesi was absorbed
+by their powerful southern neighbours the Banyai.&nbsp; This has been
+the inevitable fate of every African empire from time immemorial.&nbsp;
+A chief of more than ordinary ability arises and, subduing all his less
+powerful neighbours, founds a kingdom, which he governs more or less
+wisely till he dies.&nbsp; His successor not having the talents of the
+conqueror cannot retain the dominion, and some of the abler under-chiefs
+set up for themselves, and, in a few years, the remembrance only of
+the empire remains.&nbsp; This, which may be considered as the normal
+state of African society, gives rise to frequent and desolating wars,
+and the people long in vain for a power able to make all dwell in peace.&nbsp;
+In this light, a European colony would be considered by the natives
+as an inestimable boon to intertropical Africa.&nbsp; Thousands of industrious
+natives would gladly settle round it, and engage in that peaceful pursuit
+of agriculture and trade of which they are so fond, and, undistracted
+by wars or rumours of wars, might listen to the purifying and ennobling
+truths of the gospel of Jesus Christ.&nbsp; The Manganja on the Zambesi,
+like their countrymen on the Shir&eacute;, are fond of agriculture;
+and, in addition to the usual varieties of food, cultivate tobacco and
+cotton in quantities more than equal to their wants.&nbsp; To the question,
+&ldquo;Would they work for Europeans?&rdquo; an affirmative answer may
+be given, if the Europeans belong to the class which can pay a reasonable
+price for labour, and not to that of adventurers who want employment
+for themselves.&nbsp; All were particularly well clothed from Sandia&rsquo;s
+to Pangola&rsquo;s; and it was noticed that all the cloth was of native
+manufacture, the product of their own looms.&nbsp; In Senga a great
+deal of iron is obtained from the ore and manufactured very cleverly.</p>
+<p>As is customary when a party of armed strangers visits the village,
+Pangola took the precaution of sleeping in one of the outlying hamlets.&nbsp;
+No one ever knows, or at any rate will tell, where the chief sleeps.&nbsp;
+He came not next morning, so we went our way; but in a few moments we
+saw the rifle-loving chief approaching with some armed men.&nbsp; Before
+meeting us, he left the path and drew up his &ldquo;following&rdquo;
+under a tree, expecting us to halt, and give him a chance of bothering
+us again; but, having already had enough of that, we held right on:
+he seemed dumbfoundered, and could hardly believe his own eyes.&nbsp;
+For a few seconds he was speechless, but at last recovered so far as
+to be able to say, &ldquo;You are passing Pangola.&nbsp; Do you not
+see Pangola?&rdquo;&nbsp; Mbia was just going by at the time with the
+donkey, and, proud of every opportunity of airing his small stock of
+English, shouted in reply, &ldquo;All right! then get on.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+&ldquo;Click, click, click.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>On the 26th June we breakfasted at Zumbo, on the left bank of the
+Loangwa, near the ruins of some ancient Portuguese houses.&nbsp; The
+Loangwa was too deep to be forded, and there were no canoes on our side.&nbsp;
+Seeing two small ones on the opposite shore, near a few recently erected
+huts of two half-castes from Tette, we halted for the ferry-men to come
+over.&nbsp; From their movements it was evident that they were in a
+state of rollicking drunkenness.&nbsp; Having a waterproof cloak, which
+could be inflated into a tiny boat, we sent Mantlanyan&eacute; across
+in it.&nbsp; Three half-intoxicated slaves then brought us the shaky
+canoes, which we lashed together and manned with our own canoe-men.&nbsp;
+Five men were all that we could carry over at a time; and after four
+trips had been made the slaves began to clamour for drink; not receiving
+any, as we had none to give, they grew more insolent, and declared that
+not another man should cross that day.&nbsp; Sininyan&eacute; was remonstrating
+with them, when a loaded musket was presented at him by one of the trio.&nbsp;
+In an instant the gun was out of the rascal&rsquo;s hands, a rattling
+shower of blows fell on his back, and he took an involuntary header
+into the river.&nbsp; He crawled up the bank a sad and sober man, and
+all three at once tumbled from the height of saucy swagger to a low
+depth of slavish abjectness.&nbsp; The musket was found to have an enormous
+charge, and might have blown our man to pieces, but for the promptitude
+with which his companions administered justice in a lawless land.&nbsp;
+We were all ferried safely across by 8 o&rsquo;clock in the evening.</p>
+<p>In illustration of what takes place where no government, or law exists,
+the two half-castes, to whom these men belonged, left Tette, with four
+hundred slaves, armed with the old Sepoy Brown Bess, to hunt elephants
+and trade in ivory.&nbsp; On our way up, we heard from natives of their
+lawless deeds, and again, on our way down, from several, who had been
+eyewitnesses of the principal crime, and all reports substantially agreed.&nbsp;
+The story is a sad one.&nbsp; After the traders reached Zumbo, one of
+them, called by the natives Sequasha, entered into a plot with the disaffected
+headman, Namakusuru, to kill his chief, Mpangw&eacute;, in order that
+Namakusuru might seize upon the chieftainship; and for the murder of
+Mpangw&eacute; the trader agreed to receive ten large tusks of ivory.&nbsp;
+Sequasha, with a picked party of armed slaves, went to visit Mpangw&eacute;
+who received him kindly, and treated him with all the honour and hospitality
+usually shown to distinguished strangers, and the women busied themselves
+in cooking the best of their provisions for the repast to be set before
+him.&nbsp; Of this, and also of the beer, the half-caste partook heartily.&nbsp;
+Mpangw&eacute; was then asked by Sequasha to allow his men to fire their
+guns in amusement.&nbsp; Innocent of any suspicion of treachery, and
+anxious to hear the report of firearms, Mpangw&eacute; at once gave
+his consent; and the slaves rose and poured a murderous volley into
+the merry group of unsuspecting spectators, instantly killing the chief
+and twenty of his people.&nbsp; The survivors fled in horror.&nbsp;
+The children and young women were seized as slaves, and the village
+sacked.&nbsp; Sequasha sent the message to Namakusuru: &ldquo;I have
+killed the lion that troubled you; come and let us talk over the matter.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+He came and brought the ivory.&nbsp; &ldquo;No,&rdquo; said the half-caste,
+&ldquo;let us divide the land:&rdquo; and he took the larger share for
+himself, and compelled the would-be usurper to deliver up his bracelets,
+in token of subjection on becoming the child or vassal of Sequasha.&nbsp;
+These were sent in triumph to the authorities at Tette.&nbsp; The governor
+of Quillimane had told us that he had received orders from Lisbon to
+take advantage of our passing to re-establish Zumbo; and accordingly
+these traders had built a small stockade on the rich plain of the right
+bank of Loangwa, a mile above the site of the ancient mission church
+of Zumbo, as part of the royal policy.&nbsp; The bloodshed was quite
+unnecessary, because, the land at Zumbo having of old been purchased,
+the natives would have always of their own accord acknowledged the right
+thus acquired; they pointed it out to Dr. Livingstone in 1856 that,
+though they were cultivating it, is was not theirs, but white man&rsquo;s
+land.&nbsp; Sequasha and his mate had left their ivory in charge of
+some of their slaves, who, in the absence of their masters, were now
+having a gay time of it, and getting drunk every day with the produce
+of the sacked villages.&nbsp; The head slave came and begged for the
+musket of the delinquent ferryman, which was returned.&nbsp; He thought
+his master did perfectly right to kill Mpangw&eacute;, when asked to
+do it for the fee of ten tusks, and he even justified it thus: &ldquo;If
+a man invites you to eat, will you not partake?&rdquo;</p>
+<p>We continued our journey on the 28th of June.&nbsp; Game was extremely
+abundant, and there were many lions.&nbsp; Mbia drove one off from his
+feast on a wild pig, and appropriated what remained of the pork to his
+own use.&nbsp; Lions are particularly fond of the flesh of wild pigs
+and zebras, and contrive to kill a large number of these animals.&nbsp;
+In the afternoon we arrived at the village of the female chief, Ma-mburuma,
+but she herself was now living on the opposite side of the river.&nbsp;
+Some of her people called, and said she had been frightened by seeing
+her son and other children killed by Sequasha, and had fled to the other
+bank; but when her heart was healed, she would return and live in her
+own village, and among her own people.&nbsp; She constantly inquired
+of the black traders, who came up the river, if they had any news of
+the white man who passed with the oxen.&nbsp; &ldquo;He has gone down
+into the sea,&rdquo; was their reply, &ldquo;but we belong to the same
+people.&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;Oh no; you need not tell me that; he takes
+no slaves, but wishes peace: you are not of his tribe.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+This antislavery character excites such universal attention, that any
+missionary who winked at the gigantic evils involved in the slave-trade
+would certainly fail to produce any good impression on the native mind.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER VI.</h3>
+<p>Illness&mdash;The Honey-guide&mdash;Abundance of game&mdash;The Baenda
+pezi&mdash;The Batoka.</p>
+<p>We left the river here, and proceeded up the valley which leads to
+the Mburuma or Mohango pass.&nbsp; The nights were cold, and on the
+30th of June the thermometer was as low as 39 degrees at sunrise.&nbsp;
+We passed through a village of twenty large huts, which Sequasha had
+attacked on his return from the murder of the chief, Mpangw&eacute;.&nbsp;
+He caught the women and children for slaves, and carried off all the
+food, except a huge basket of bran, which the natives are wont to save
+against a time of famine.&nbsp; His slaves had broken all the water-pots
+and the millstones for grinding meal.</p>
+<p>The buaz&eacute;-trees and bamboos are now seen on the hills; but
+the jujube or zisyphus, which has evidently been introduced from India,
+extends no further up the river.&nbsp; We had been eating this fruit,
+which, having somewhat the taste of apples, the Portuguese call Ma&ccedil;&atilde;&atilde;s,
+all the way from Tette; and here they were larger than usual, though
+immediately beyond they ceased to be found.&nbsp; No mango-tree either
+is to be met with beyond this point, because the Portuguese traders
+never established themselves anywhere beyond Zumbo.&nbsp; Tsetse flies
+are more numerous and troublesome than we have ever before found them.&nbsp;
+They accompany us on the march, often buzzing round our heads like a
+swarm of bees.&nbsp; They are very cunning, and when intending to bite,
+alight so gently that their presence is not perceived till they thrust
+in their lance-like proboscis.&nbsp; The bite is acute, but the pain
+is over in a moment; it is followed by a little of the disagreeable
+itching of the mosquito&rsquo;s bite.&nbsp; This fly invariably kills
+all domestic animals except goats and donkeys; man and the wild animals
+escape.&nbsp; We ourselves were severely bitten on this pass, and so
+were our donkeys, but neither suffered from any after effects.</p>
+<p>Water is scarce in the Mburuma pass, except during the rainy season.&nbsp;
+We however halted beside some fine springs in the bed of the now dry
+rivulet, Pod&eacute;bod&eacute;, which is continued down to the end
+of the pass, and yields water at intervals in pools.&nbsp; Here we remained
+a couple of days in consequence of the severe illness of Dr. Kirk.&nbsp;
+He had several times been attacked by fever; and observed that when
+we were on the cool heights he was comfortable, but when we happened
+to descend from a high to a lower altitude, he felt chilly, though the
+temperature in the latter case was 25 degrees higher than it was above;
+he had been trying different medicines of reputed efficacy with a view
+to ascertain whether other combinations might not be superior to the
+preparation we generally used; in halting by this water he suddenly
+became blind, and unable to stand from faintness.&nbsp; The men, with
+great alacrity, prepared a grassy bed, on which we laid our companion,
+with the sad forebodings which only those who have tended the sick in
+a wild country can realize.&nbsp; We feared that in experimenting he
+had over-drugged himself; but we gave him a dose of our fever pills;
+on the third day he rode the one of the two donkeys that would allow
+itself to be mounted, and on the sixth he marched as well as any of
+us.&nbsp; This case is mentioned in order to illustrate what we have
+often observed, that moving the patient from place to place is most
+conducive to the cure; and the more pluck a man has&mdash;the less he
+gives in to the disease&mdash;the less likely he is to die.</p>
+<p>Supplied with water by the pools in the Pod&eacute;bod&eacute;, we
+again joined the Zambesi at the confluence of the rivulet.&nbsp; When
+passing through a dry district the native hunter knows where to expect
+water by the animals he sees.&nbsp; The presence of the gemsbuck, du&igrave;ker
+or diver, springbucks, or elephants, is no proof that water is near;
+for these animals roam over vast tracts of country, and may be met scores
+of miles from it.&nbsp; Not so, however, the zebra, pallah, buffalo,
+and rhinoceros; their spoor gives assurance that water is not far off,
+as they never stray any distance from its neighbourhood.&nbsp; But when
+amidst the solemn stillness of the woods, the singing of joyous birds
+falls upon the ear, it is certain that water is close at hand.</p>
+<p>Our men in hunting came on an immense herd of buffaloes, quietly
+resting in the long dry grass, and began to blaze away furiously at
+the astonished animals.&nbsp; In the wild excitement of the hunt, which
+heretofore had been conducted with spears, some forgot to load with
+ball, and, firing away vigorously with powder only, wondered for the
+moment that the buffaloes did not fall.&nbsp; The slayer of the young
+elephant, having buried his four bullets in as many buffaloes, fired
+three charges of No. 1 shot he had for killing guinea-fowl.&nbsp; The
+quaint remarks and merriment after these little adventures seemed to
+the listener like the pleasant prattle of children.&nbsp; Mbia and Mantlanyan&eacute;,
+however, killed one buffalo each; both the beasts were in prime condition;
+the meat was like really excellent beef, with a smack of venison.&nbsp;
+A troop of hungry, howling hyenas also thought the savour tempting,
+as they hung round the camp at night, anxious to partake of the feast.&nbsp;
+They are, fortunately, arrant cowards, and never attack either men or
+beasts except they can catch them asleep, sick, or at some other disadvantage.&nbsp;
+With a bright fire at our feet their presence excites no uneasiness.&nbsp;
+A piece of meat hung on a tree, high enough to make him jump to reach
+it, and a short spear, with its handle firmly planted in the ground
+beneath, are used as a device to induce the hyena to commit suicide
+by impalement.</p>
+<p>The honey-guide is an extraordinary bird; how is it that every member
+of its family has learned that all men, white or black, are fond of
+honey?&nbsp; The instant the little fellow gets a glimpse of a man,
+he hastens to greet him with the hearty invitation to come, as Mbia
+translated it, to a bees&rsquo; hive, and take some honey.&nbsp; He
+flies on in the proper direction, perches on a tree, and looks back
+to see if you are following; then on to another and another, until he
+guides you to the spot.&nbsp; If you do not accept his first invitation
+he follows you with pressing importunities, quite as anxious to lure
+the stranger to the bees&rsquo; hive as other birds are to draw him
+away from their own nest.&nbsp; Except while on the march, our men were
+sure to accept the invitation, and manifested the same by a peculiar
+responsive whistle, meaning, as they said, &ldquo;All right, go ahead;
+we are coming.&rdquo;&nbsp; The bird never deceived them, but always
+guided them to a hive of bees, though some had but little honey in store.&nbsp;
+Has this peculiar habit of the honey-guide its origin, as the attachment
+of dogs, in friendship for man, or in love for the sweet pickings of
+the plunder left on the ground?&nbsp; Self-interest aiding in preservation
+from danger seems to be the rule in most cases, as, for instance, in
+the bird that guards the buffalo and rhinoceros.&nbsp; The grass is
+often so tall and dense that one could go close up to these animals
+quite unperceived; but the guardian bird, sitting on the beast, sees
+the approach of danger, flaps its wings and screams, which causes its
+bulky charge to rush off from a foe he has neither seen nor heard; for
+his reward the vigilant little watcher has the pick of the parasites
+on his fat friend.&nbsp; In other cases a chance of escape must be given
+even by the animal itself to its prey; as in the rattle-snake, which,
+when excited to strike, cannot avoid using his rattle, any more than
+the cat can resist curling its tail when excited in the chase of a mouse,
+or the cobra can refrain from inflating the loose skin of the neck and
+extending it laterally, before striking its poison fangs into its victim.&nbsp;
+There are many snakes in parts of this pass; they basked in the warm
+sunshine, but rustled off through the leaves as we approached.&nbsp;
+We observed one morning a small one of a deadly poisonous species, named
+Kakon&eacute;, on a bush by the wayside, quietly resting in a horizontal
+position, digesting a lizard for breakfast.&nbsp; Though openly in view,
+its colours and curves so closely resembled a small branch that some
+failed to see it, even after being asked if they perceived anything
+on the bush.&nbsp; Here also one of our number had a glance at another
+species, rarely seen, and whose swift lightning-like motion has given
+rise to the native proverb, that when a man sees this snake he will
+forthwith become a rich man.</p>
+<p>We slept near the ruined village of the murdered chief, Mpangw&eacute;,
+a lovely spot, with the Zambesi in front, and extensive gardens behind,
+backed by a semicircle of hills receding up to lofty mountains.&nbsp;
+Our path kept these mountains on our right, and crossed several streamlets,
+which seemed to be perennial, and among others the Selol&eacute;, which
+apparently flows past the prominent peak Chiarapela.&nbsp; These rivulets
+have often human dwellings on their banks; but the land can scarcely
+be said to be occupied.&nbsp; The number of all sorts of game increases
+wonderfully every day.&nbsp; As a specimen of what may be met with where
+there are no human habitations, and where no firearms have been introduced,
+we may mention what at times has actually been seen by us.&nbsp; On
+the morning of July 3rd a herd of elephants passed within fifty yards
+of our sleeping-place, going down to the river along the dry bed of
+a rivulet.&nbsp; Starting a few minutes before the main body, we come
+upon large flocks of guinea-fowl, shoot what may be wanted for dinner,
+or next morning&rsquo;s breakfast, and leave them in the path to be
+picked up by the cook and his mates behind.&nbsp; As we proceed, francolins
+of three varieties run across the path, and hundreds of turtle-doves
+rise, with great blatter of wing, and fly off to the trees.&nbsp; Guinea-fowls,
+francolins, turtle-doves, ducks, and geese are the game birds of this
+region.&nbsp; At sunrise a herd of pallahs, standing like a flock of
+sheep, allow the first man of our long Indian file to approach within
+about fifty yards; but having meat, we let them trot off leisurely and
+unmolested.&nbsp; Soon afterwards we come upon a herd of waterbucks,
+which here are very much darker in colour, and drier in flesh, than
+the same species near the sea.&nbsp; They look at us and we at them;
+and we pass on to see a herd of doe koodoos, with a magnificently horned
+buck or two, hurrying off to the dry hill-sides.&nbsp; We have ceased
+shooting antelopes, as our men have been so often gorged with meat that
+they have become fat and dainty.&nbsp; They say that they do not want
+more venison, it is so dry and tasteless, and ask why we do not give
+them shot to shoot the more savoury guinea-fowl.</p>
+<p>About eight o&rsquo;clock the tsetse commence to buzz about us, and
+bite our hands and necks sharply.&nbsp; Just as we are thinking of breakfast,
+we meet some buffaloes grazing by the path; but they make off in a heavy
+gallop at the sight of man.&nbsp; We fire, and the foremost, badly wounded,
+separates from the herd, and is seen to stop amongst the trees; but,
+as it is a matter of great danger to follow a wounded buffalo, we hold
+on our way.&nbsp; It is this losing of wounded animals which makes firearms
+so annihilating to these beasts of the field, and will in time sweep
+them all away.&nbsp; The small Enfield bullet is worse than the old
+round one for this.&nbsp; It often goes through an animal without killing
+him, and he afterwards perishes, when he is of no value to man.&nbsp;
+After breakfast we draw near a pond of water; a couple of elephants
+stand on its bank, and, at a respectful distance behind these monarchs
+of the wilderness, is seen a herd of zebras, and another of waterbucks.&nbsp;
+On getting our wind the royal beasts make off at once; but the zebras
+remain till the foremost man is within eighty yards of them, when old
+and young canter gracefully away.&nbsp; The zebra has a great deal of
+curiosity; and this is often fatal to him, for he has the habit of stopping
+to look at the hunter.&nbsp; In this particular he is the exact opposite
+of the diver antelope, which rushes off like the wind, and never for
+a moment stops to look behind, after having once seen or smelt danger.&nbsp;
+The finest zebra of the herd is sometimes shot, our men having taken
+a sudden fancy to the flesh, which all declare to be the &ldquo;king
+of good meat.&rdquo;&nbsp; On the plains of short grass between us and
+the river many antelopes of different species are calmly grazing, or
+reposing.&nbsp; Wild pigs are common, and walk abroad during the day;
+but are so shy as seldom to allow a close approach.&nbsp; On taking
+alarm they erect their slender tails in the air, and trot off swiftly
+in a straight line, keeping their bodies as steady as a locomotive on
+a railroad.&nbsp; A mile beyond the pool three cow buffaloes with their
+calves come from the woods, and move out into the plain.&nbsp; A troop
+of monkeys, on the edge of the forest, scamper back to its depths on
+hearing the loud song of Singeleka, and old surly fellows, catching
+sight of the human party, insult it with a loud and angry bark.&nbsp;
+Early in the afternoon we may see buffaloes again, or other animals.&nbsp;
+We camp on the dry higher ground, after, as has happened, driving off
+a solitary elephant.&nbsp; The nights are warmer now, and possess nearly
+as much of interest and novelty as the days.&nbsp; A new world awakes
+and comes forth, more numerous, if we may judge by the noise it makes,
+than that which is abroad by sunlight.&nbsp; Lions and hyenas roar around
+us, and sometimes come disagreeably near, though they have never ventured
+into our midst.&nbsp; Strange birds sing their agreeable songs, while
+others scream and call harshly as if in fear or anger.&nbsp; Marvellous
+insect-sounds fall upon the ear; one, said by natives to proceed from
+a large beetle, resembles a succession of measured musical blows upon
+an anvil, while many others are perfectly indescribable.&nbsp; A little
+lemur was once seen to leap about from branch to branch with the agility
+of a frog; it chirruped like a bird, and is not larger than a robin
+red-breast.&nbsp; Reptiles, though numerous, seldom troubled us; only
+two men suffered from stings, and that very slightly, during the entire
+journey, the one supposed that he was bitten by a snake, and the other
+was stung by a scorpion.</p>
+<p>Grass-burning has begun, and is producing the blue hazy atmosphere
+of the American Indian summer, which in Western Africa is called the
+&ldquo;smokes.&rdquo;&nbsp; Miles of fire burn on the mountain-sides
+in the evenings, but go out during the night.&nbsp; From their height
+they resemble a broad zigzag line of fire in the heavens.</p>
+<p>We slept on the night of the 6th of July on the left bank of the
+Chongw&eacute;, which comes through a gap in the hills on our right,
+and is twenty yards wide.&nbsp; A small tribe of the Bazizulu, from
+the south, under Dadanga, have recently settled here and built a village.&nbsp;
+Some of their houses are square, and they seem to be on friendly terms
+with the Bakoa, who own the country.&nbsp; They, like the other natives,
+cultivate cotton, but of a different species from any we have yet seen
+in Africa, the staple being very long, and the boll larger than what
+is usually met with; the seeds cohere as in the Pernambuco kind.&nbsp;
+They brought the seed with them from their own country, the distant
+mountains of which in the south, still inhabited by their fellow-countrymen,
+who possess much cattle and use shields, can be seen from this high
+ground.&nbsp; These people profess to be children of the great paramount
+chief, Kwanyakaromb&eacute;, who is said to be lord of all the Bazizulu.&nbsp;
+The name of this tribe is known to geographers, who derive their information
+from the Portuguese, as the <i>Morusurus</i>, and the hills mentioned
+above are said to have been the country of Changamira, the warrior-chief
+of history, whom no Portuguese ever dared to approach.&nbsp; The Bazizulu
+seem, by report, to be brave mountaineers; nearer the river, the Sidima
+inhabit the plains; just as on the north side, the Babimp&eacute; live
+on the heights, about two days off, and the Makoa on or near the river.&nbsp;
+The chief of the Bazizulu we were now with was hospitable and friendly.&nbsp;
+A herd of buffaloes came trampling through the gardens and roused up
+our men; a feat that roaring lions seldom achieved.</p>
+<p>Our course next day passed over the upper terrace and through a dense
+thorn jungle.&nbsp; Travelling is always difficult where there is no
+path, but it is even more perplexing where the forest is cut up by many
+game-tracks.&nbsp; Here we got separated from one another, and a rhinoceros
+with angry snort dashed at Dr. Livingstone as he stooped to pick up
+a specimen of the wild fruit morula; but she strangely stopped stock-still
+when less than her own length distant, and gave him time to escape;
+a branch pulled out his watch as he ran, and turning half round to grasp
+it, he got a distant glance of her and her calf still standing on the
+selfsame spot, as if arrested in the middle of her charge by an unseen
+hand.&nbsp; When about fifty yards off, thinking his companions close
+behind, he shouted &ldquo;Look out there!&rdquo; when off she rushed,
+snorting loudly, in another direction.&nbsp; The Doctor usually went
+unarmed before this, but never afterwards.</p>
+<p>A fine eland was shot by Dr. Kirk this afternoon, the first we have
+killed.&nbsp; It was in first-rate condition, and remarkably fat; but
+the meat, though so tempting in appearance, severely deranged all who
+partook of it heartily, especially those who ate of the fat.&nbsp; Natives
+who live in game countries, and are acquainted with the different kinds
+of wild animals, have a prejudice against the fat of the eland, the
+pallah, the zebra, hippopotamus, and pig; they never reject it, however,
+the climate making the desire for all animal food very strong; but they
+consider that it causes ulcers and leprosy, while the fat of sheep and
+of oxen never produces any bad effects, unless the animal is diseased.</p>
+<p>On the morning of the 9th, after passing four villages, we breakfasted
+at an old friend&rsquo;s, Tombanyama, who lives now on the mainland,
+having resigned the reedy island, where he was first seen, to the buffaloes,
+which used to take his crops and show fight to his men.&nbsp; He keeps
+a large flock of tame pigeons, and some fine fat capons, one of which
+he gave us, with a basket of meal.&nbsp; They have plenty of salt in
+this part of the country, obtaining it from the plains in the usual
+way.</p>
+<p>The half-caste partner of Sequasha and a number of his men were staying
+near.&nbsp; The fellow was very munch frightened when he saw us, and
+trembled so much when he spoke, that the Makololo and other natives
+noticed and remarked on it.&nbsp; His fears arose from a sense of guilt,
+as we said nothing to frighten him, and did not allude to the murder
+till a few minutes before starting; when it was remarked that Dr. Livingstone
+having been accredited to the murdered chief, it would be his duty to
+report on it; and that not even the Portuguese Government would approve
+of the deed.&nbsp; He defended it by saying that they had put in the
+right man, the other was a usurper.&nbsp; He was evidently greatly relieved
+when we departed.&nbsp; In the afternoon we came to an outlying hamlet
+of Kambadzo, whose own village is on an island, Nyampungo, or Nyangalul&eacute;,
+at the confluence of the Kafu&eacute;.&nbsp; The chief was on a visit
+here, and they had been enjoying a regular jollification.&nbsp; There
+had been much mirth, music, drinking, and dancing.&nbsp; The men, and
+women too, had taken &ldquo;a wee drap too much,&rdquo; but had not
+passed the complimentary stage.&nbsp; The wife of the headman, after
+looking at us a few moments, called out to the others, &ldquo;Black
+traders have come before, calling themselves Bazungu, or white men,
+but now, for the first time, have we seen the real Bazungu.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+Kambadzo also soon appeared; he was sorry that we had not come before
+the beer was all done, but he was going back to see if it was all really
+and entirely finished, and not one little potful left somewhere.</p>
+<p>This was, of course, mere characteristic politeness, as he was perfectly
+aware that every drop had been swallowed; so we proceeded on to the
+Kafu&eacute;, or Kafuj&eacute;, accompanied by the most intelligent
+of his headmen.&nbsp; A high ridge, just before we reached the confluence,
+commands a splendid view of the two great rivers, and the rich country
+beyond.&nbsp; Behind, on the north and east, is the high mountain-range,
+along whose base we have been travelling; the whole range is covered
+with trees, which appear even on the prominent peaks, Chiarapela, Morindi,
+and Chiava; at this last the chain bends away to the N.W., and we could
+see the distant mountains where the chief, Semalembu&eacute;, gained
+all our hearts in 1856.</p>
+<p>On the 9th of July we tried to send Semalembu&eacute; a present,
+but the people here refused to incur the responsibility of carrying
+it.&nbsp; We, who have the art of writing, cannot realize the danger
+one incurs of being accused of purloining a portion of goods sent from
+one person to another, when the carrier cannot prove that he delivered
+all committed to his charge.&nbsp; Rumours of a foray having been made,
+either by Makololo or Batoka, as far as the fork of the Kafu&eacute;,
+were received here by our men with great indignation, as it looked as
+if the marauders were shutting up the country, which they had been trying
+so much to open.&nbsp; Below the junction of the rivers, on a shallow
+sandbank, lay a large herd of hippopotami, their bodies out of the water,
+like masses of black rock.&nbsp; Kambadzo&rsquo;s island, called Nyangalul&eacute;,
+a name which occurs again at the mouth of the Zambesi, has many choice
+Motsikiri (<i>Trachelia</i>) trees on it; and four very conspicuous
+stately palms growing out of a single stem.&nbsp; The Kafu&eacute; reminds
+us a little of the Shir&eacute;, flowing between steep banks, with fertile
+land on both sides.&nbsp; It is a smaller river, and has less current.&nbsp;
+Here it seems to come from the west.&nbsp; The headman of the village,
+near which we encamped, brought a present of meal, fowls, and sweet
+potatoes.&nbsp; They have both the red and white varieties of this potato.&nbsp;
+We have, on several occasions during this journey, felt the want of
+vegetables, in a disagreeable craving which our diet of meat and native
+meal could not satisfy.&nbsp; It became worse and worse till we got
+a meal of potatoes, which allayed it at once.&nbsp; A great scarcity
+of vegetables prevails in these parts of Africa.&nbsp; The natives collect
+several kinds of wild plants in the woods, which they use no doubt for
+the purpose of driving off cravings similar to those we experienced.</p>
+<p>Owing to the strength of the wind, and the cranky state of the canoes,
+it was late in the afternoon of the 11th before our party was ferried
+over the Kafu&eacute;.&nbsp; After crossing, we were in the Baw&eacute;
+country.&nbsp; Fishhooks here, of native workmanship, were observed
+to have barbs like the European hooks: elsewhere the point of the hook
+is merely bent in towards the shank, to have the same effect in keeping
+on the fish as the barb.&nbsp; We slept near a village a short distance
+above the ford.&nbsp; The people here are of Batoka origin, the same
+as many of our men, and call themselves Batonga (independents), or Balengi,
+and their language only differs slightly from that of the Bakoa, who
+live between the two rivers Kafu&eacute; and Loangwa.&nbsp; The paramount
+chief of the district lives to the west of this place, and is called
+Nchomokela&mdash;an hereditary title: the family burying-place is on
+a small hill near this village.&nbsp; The women salute us by clapping
+their hands and lullilooing as we enter and leave a village, and the
+men, as they think, respectfully clap their hands on their hips.&nbsp;
+Immense crops of mapira (<i>holcus sorghum</i>) are raised; one species
+of it forms a natural bend on the seed-stalk, so that the massive ear
+hangs down.&nbsp; The grain was heaped up on wooden stages, and so was
+a variety of other products.&nbsp; The men are skilful hunters, and
+kill elephants and buffaloes with long heavy spears.&nbsp; We halted
+a few minutes on the morning of the 12th July, opposite the narrow island
+of Sikakoa, which has a village on its lower end.&nbsp; We were here
+told that Moselekats&eacute;&rsquo;s chief town is a month&rsquo;s distance
+from this place.&nbsp; They had heard, moreover, that the English had
+come to Moselekats&eacute;, and told him it was wrong to kill men; and
+he had replied that he was born to kill people, but would drop the habit;
+and, since the English came, he had sent out his men, not to kill as
+of yore, but to collect tribute of cloth and ivory.&nbsp; This report
+referred to the arrival of the Rev. R. Moffat, of Kuruman, who, we afterwards
+found, had established a mission.&nbsp; The statement is interesting
+as showing that, though imperfectly expressed, the purport of the missionaries&rsquo;
+teaching had travelled, in a short time, over 300 miles, and we know
+not how far the knowledge of the English operations on the coast spread
+inland.</p>
+<p>When abreast of the high wooded island Kalabi we came in contact
+with one of the game-laws of the country, which has come down from the
+most ancient times.&nbsp; An old buffalo crossed the path a few yards
+in front of us; our guide threw his small spear at its hip, and it was
+going off scarcely hurt, when three rifle balls knocked it over.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;It is mine,&rdquo; said the guide.&nbsp; He had wounded it first,
+and the established native game-law is that the animal belongs to the
+man who first draws blood; the two legs on one side, by the same law,
+belonged to us for killing it.&nbsp; This beast was very old, blind
+of one eye, and scabby; the horns, mere stumps, not a foot long, must
+have atrophied, when by age he lost the strength distinctive of his
+sex; some eighteen or twenty inches of horn could not well be worn down
+by mere rubbing against the trees.&nbsp; We saw many buffaloes next
+day, standing quietly amidst a thick thorn-jungle, through which we
+were passing.&nbsp; They often stood until we were within fifty or a
+hundred yards of them.</p>
+<p>On the 14th July we left the river at the mountain-range, which,
+lying north-east and south-west across the river, forms the Kariba gorge.&nbsp;
+Near the upper end of the Kariba rapids, the stream Sanyati enters from
+the south, and is reported to have Moselekats&eacute;&rsquo;s principal
+cattle-posts at its sources; our route went round the end of the mountains,
+and we encamped beside the village of the generous chief Moloi, who
+brought us three immense baskets of fine mapira meal, ten fowls, and
+two pots of beer.&nbsp; On receiving a present in return, he rose, and,
+with a few dancing gestures, said or sang, &ldquo;Motota, Motota, Motota,&rdquo;
+which our men translated into &ldquo;thanks.&rdquo;&nbsp; He had visited
+Moselekats&eacute; a few months before our arrival, and saw the English
+missionaries, living in their wagons.&nbsp; &ldquo;They told Moselekats&eacute;,&rdquo;
+said he, &ldquo;they were of his family, or friends, and would plough
+the land and live at their own expense;&rdquo; and he had replied, &ldquo;The
+land is before you, and I shall come and see you plough.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+This again was substantially what took place, when Mr. Moffat introduced
+the missionaries to his old friend, and shows still further that the
+notion of losing their country by admitting foreigners does not come
+as the first idea to the native mind.&nbsp; One might imagine that,
+as mechanical powers are unknown to the heathen, the almost magic operations
+of machinery, the discoveries of modern science and art, or the presence
+of the prodigious force which, for instance, is associated with the
+sight of a man-of-war, would have the effect which miracles once had
+of arresting the attention and inspiring awe.&nbsp; But, though we have
+heard the natives exclaim in admiration at the sight of even small illustrations
+of what science enables us to do&mdash;&ldquo;Ye are gods, and not men&rdquo;&mdash;the
+heart is unaffected.&nbsp; In attempting their moral elevation, it is
+always more conducive to the end desired, that the teacher should come
+unaccompanied by any power to cause either jealousy or fear.&nbsp; The
+heathen, who have not become aware of the greed and hate which too often
+characterize the advancing tide of emigration, listen with most attention
+to the message of Divine love when delivered by men who evidently possess
+the same human sympathies with themselves.&nbsp; A chief is rather envied
+his good fortune in first securing foreigners in his town.&nbsp; Jealousy
+of strangers belongs more to the Arab than to the African character;
+and if the women are let alone by the traveller, no danger need be apprehended
+from any save the slave-trading tribes, and not often even from them.</p>
+<p>We passed through a fertile country, covered with open forest, accompanied
+by the friendly Baw&eacute;.&nbsp; They are very hospitable; many of
+them were named, among themselves, &ldquo;the Baenda pezi,&rdquo; or
+&ldquo;Go-nakeds,&rdquo; their only clothing being a coat of red ochre.&nbsp;
+Occasionally stopping at their villages we were duly lullilooed, and
+regaled with sweet new-made beer, which, being yet unfermented, was
+not intoxicating.&nbsp; It is in this state called Liting or Makond&eacute;.&nbsp;
+Some of the men carry large shields of buffalo-hide, and all are well
+supplied with heavy spears.&nbsp; The vicinity of the villages is usually
+cleared and cultivated in large patches; but nowhere can the country
+be said to be stocked with people.&nbsp; At every village stands were
+erected, and piles of the native corn, still unthrashed, placed upon
+them; some had been beaten out, put into oblong parcels made of grass,
+and stacked in wooden frames.</p>
+<p>We crossed several rivulets in our course, as the Mandora, the Lofia,
+the Manzaia (with brackish water), the Rimb&eacute;, the Chibu&eacute;,
+the Chezia, the Chilola (containing fragments of coal), which did little
+more than mark our progress.&nbsp; The island and rapid of Nakansalo,
+of which we had formerly heard, were of no importance, the rapid being
+but half a mile long, and only on one side of the island.&nbsp; The
+island Kaluzi marks one of the numerous places where astronomical observations
+were made; Mozia, a station where a volunteer poet left us; the island
+Mochenya, and Mpand&eacute; island, at the mouth of the Zungw&eacute;
+rivulet, where we left the Zambesi.</p>
+<p>When favoured with the hospitality and company of the &ldquo;Go-nakeds,&rdquo;
+we tried to discover if nudity were the badge of a particular order
+among the Baw&eacute;, but they could only refer to custom.&nbsp; Some
+among them had always liked it for no reason in particular: shame seemed
+to lie dormant, and the sense could not be aroused by our laughing and
+joking them on their appearance.&nbsp; They evidently felt no less decent
+than we did with our clothes on; but, whatever may be said in favour
+of nude statues, it struck us that man, in a state of nature, is a most
+ungainly animal.&nbsp; Could we see a number of the degraded of our
+own lower classes in like guise, it is probable that, without the black
+colour which acts somehow as a dress, they would look worse still.</p>
+<p>In domestic contentions the Baw&eacute; are careful not to kill each
+other; but, when one village goes to war with another, they are not
+so particular.&nbsp; The victorious party are said to quarter one of
+the bodies of the enemies they may have killed, and to perform certain
+ceremonies over the fragments.&nbsp; The vanquished call upon their
+conquerors to give them a portion also; and, when this request is complied
+with, they too perform the same ceremonies, and lament over their dead
+comrade, after which the late combatants may visit each other in peace.&nbsp;
+Sometimes the head of the slain is taken and buried in an ant-hill,
+till all the flesh is gone; and the lower jaw is then worn as a trophy
+by the slayer; but this we never saw, and the foregoing information
+was obtained only through an interpreter.</p>
+<p>We left the Zambesi at the mouth of the Zungw&eacute; or Mozama or
+Dela rivulet, up which we proceeded, first in a westerly and then in
+a north-westerly direction.&nbsp; The Zungw&eacute; at this time had
+no water in its sandy channel for the first eight or ten miles.&nbsp;
+Willows, however, grow on the banks, and water soon began to appear
+in the hollows; and a few miles further up it was a fine flowing stream
+deliciously cold.&nbsp; As in many other streams from Chicova to near
+Sinaman&eacute; shale and coal crop out in the bank; and here the large
+roots of stigmaria or its allied plants were found.&nbsp; We followed
+the course of the Zungw&eacute; to the foot of the Batoka highlands,
+up whose steep and rugged sides of red and white quartz we climbed till
+we attained an altitude of upwards of 3000 feet.&nbsp; Here, on the
+cool and bracing heights, the exhilaration of mind and body was delightful,
+as we looked back at the hollow beneath covered with a hot sultry glare,
+not unpleasant now that we were in the mild radiance above.&nbsp; We
+had a noble view of the great valley in which the Zambesi flows.&nbsp;
+The cultivated portions are so small in comparison to the rest of the
+landscape that the valley appears nearly all forest, with a few grassy
+glades.&nbsp; We spent the night of the 28th July high above the level
+of the sea, by the rivulet Tyotyo, near Tabacheu or Chirebuechina, names
+both signifying white mountain; in the morning hoar frost covered the
+ground, and thin ice was on the pools.&nbsp; Skirting the southern flank
+of Tabacheu, we soon passed from the hills on to the portion of the
+vast table-land called Mataba, and looking back saw all the way across
+the Zambesi valley to the lofty ridge some thirty miles off, which,
+coming from the Mashona, a country in the S.E., runs to the N.W. to
+join the ridge at the angle of which are the Victoria Falls, and then
+bends far to the N.E. from the same point.&nbsp; Only a few years since
+these extensive highlands were peopled by the Batoka; numerous herds
+of cattle furnished abundance of milk, and the rich soil amply repaid
+the labour of the husbandman; now large herds of buffaloes, zebras,
+and antelopes fatten on the excellent pasture; and on that land, which
+formerly supported multitudes, not a man is to been seen.&nbsp; In travelling
+from Monday morning till late on Saturday afternoon, all the way from
+Tabacheu to Moachemba, which is only twenty-one miles of latitude from
+the Victoria Falls, and constantly passing the ruined sites of utterly
+deserted Botoka villages, we did not fall in with a single person.&nbsp;
+The Batoka were driven out of their noble country by the invasions of
+Moselekats&eacute; and Sebetuan&eacute;.&nbsp; Several tribes of Bechuana
+and Basutu, fleeing from the Zulu or Matebel&eacute; chief Moselekats&eacute;
+reached the Zambesi above the Falls.&nbsp; Coming from a land without
+rivers, none of them knew how to swim; and one tribe, called the Bamangwato,
+wishing to cross the Zambesi, was ferried over, men and women separately,
+to different islands, by one of the Batoka chiefs; the men were then
+left to starve and the women appropriated by the ferryman and his people.&nbsp;
+Sekomi, the present chief of the Bamangwato, then an infant in his mother&rsquo;s
+arms, was enabled, through the kindness of a private Batoka, to escape.&nbsp;
+This act seems to have made an indelible impression on Sekomi&rsquo;s
+heart, for though otherwise callous, he still never fails to inquire
+after the welfare of his benefactor.</p>
+<p>Sebetuan&eacute;, with his wonted ability, outwitted the treacherous
+Batoka, by insisting in the politest manner on their chief remaining
+at his own side until the people and cattle were all carried safe across;
+the chief was then handsomely rewarded, both with cattle and brass rings
+off Sebetuan&eacute;&rsquo;s own wives.&nbsp; No sooner were the Makololo,
+then called Basuto, safely over, than they were confronted by the whole
+Batoka nation; and to this day the Makololo point with pride to the
+spot on the Lekon&eacute;, near to which they were encamped, where Sebetuan&eacute;,
+with a mere handful of warriors in comparison to the vast horde that
+surrounded him, stood waiting the onslaught, the warriors in one small
+body, the women and children guarding the cattle behind them.&nbsp;
+The Batoka, of course, melted away before those who had been made veterans
+by years of continual fighting, and Sebetuan&eacute; always justified
+his subsequent conquests in that country by alleging that the Batoka
+had come out to fight with a man fleeing for his life, who had never
+done them any wrong.&nbsp; They seem never to have been a warlike race;
+passing through their country, we once observed a large stone cairn,
+and our guide favoured us with the following account of it:&mdash;&ldquo;Once
+upon a time, our forefathers were going to fight another tribe, and
+here they halted and sat down.&nbsp; After a long consultation, they
+came to the unanimous conclusion that, instead of proceeding to fight
+and kill their neighbours, and perhaps be killed themselves, it would
+be more like men to raise this heap of stones, as their protest against
+the wrong the other tribe had done them, which, having accomplished,
+they returned quietly home.&rdquo;&nbsp; Such men of peace could not
+stand before the Makololo, nor, of course, the more warlike Matebel&eacute;,
+who coming afterwards, drove even their conquerors, the Makololo, out
+of the country.&nbsp; Sebetuan&eacute;, however, profiting by the tactics
+which he had learned of the Batoka, inveigled a large body of this new
+enemy on to another island, and after due starvation there overcame
+the whole.&nbsp; A much greater army of &ldquo;Moselekats&eacute;&rsquo;s
+own&rdquo; followed with canoes, but were now baffled by Sebetuan&eacute;&rsquo;s
+placing all his people and cattle on an island and so guarding it that
+none could approach.&nbsp; Dispirited, famished, borne down by fever,
+they returned to the Falls, and all except five were cut off.</p>
+<p>But though the Batoka appear never to have had much inclination to
+fight with men, they are decidedly brave hunters of buffaloes and elephants.&nbsp;
+They go fearlessly close up to these formidable animals, and kill them
+with large spears.&nbsp; The Banyai, who have long bullied all Portuguese
+traders, were amazed at the daring and bravery of the Batoka in coming
+at once to close quarters with the elephant; and Chisaka, a Portuguese
+rebel, having formerly induced a body of this tribe to settle with him,
+ravaged all the Portuguese villas around Tette.&nbsp; They bear the
+name of Basimilongw&eacute;, and some of our men found relations among
+them.&nbsp; Sininyan&eacute; and Matenga also, two of our party, were
+once inveigled into a Portuguese expedition against Mariano, by the
+assertion that the Doctor had arrived and had sent for them to come
+down to Senna.&nbsp; On finding that they were entrapped to fight, they
+left, after seeing an officer with a large number of Tette slaves killed.</p>
+<p>The Batoka had attained somewhat civilized ideas, in planting and
+protecting various fruit and oil-seed yielding trees of the country.&nbsp;
+No other tribe either plants or abstains from cutting down fruit trees,
+but here we saw some which had been planted in regular rows, and the
+trunks of which were quite two feet in diameter.&nbsp; The grand old
+Mosib&eacute;, a tree yielding a bean with a thin red pellicle, said
+to be very fattening, had probably seen two hundred summers.&nbsp; Dr.
+Kirk found that the Mosib&eacute; is peculiar, in being allied to a
+species met with only in the West Indies.&nbsp; The Motsikiri, sometimes
+called Mafuta, yields a hard fat, and an oil which is exported from
+Inhambane.&nbsp; It is said that two ancient Batoka travellers went
+down as far as the Loangwa, and finding the Ma&ccedil;&atilde;&atilde;
+tree (<i>jujube</i> or <i>zisyphus</i>) in fruit, carried the seed all
+the way back to the great Falls, in order to plant them.&nbsp; Two of
+these trees are still to be seen there, the only specimens of the kind
+in that region.</p>
+<p>The Batoka had made a near approach to the custom of more refined
+nations and had permanent graveyards, either on the sides of hills,
+thus rendered sacred, or under large old shady trees; they reverence
+the tombs of their ancestors, and plant the largest elephants&rsquo;
+tusks, as monuments at the head of the grave, or entirely enclose it
+with the choicest ivory.&nbsp; Some of the other tribes throw the dead
+body into the river to be devoured by crocodiles, or, sewing it up in
+a mat, place it on the branch of a baobab, or cast it in some lonely
+gloomy spot, surrounded by dense tropical vegetation, where it affords
+a meal to the foul hyenas; but the Batoka reverently bury their dead,
+and regard the spot henceforth as sacred.&nbsp; The ordeal by the poison
+of the muav&eacute; is resorted to by the Batoka, as well as by the
+other tribes; but a cock is often made to stand proxy for the supposed
+witch.&nbsp; Near the confluence of the Kafu&eacute; the Mambo, or chief,
+with some of his headmen, came to our sleeping-place with a present;
+their foreheads were smeared with white flour, and an unusual seriousness
+marked their demeanour.&nbsp; Shortly before our arrival they had been
+accused of witchcraft; conscious of innocence, they accepted the ordeal,
+and undertook to drink the poisoned muav&eacute;.&nbsp; For this purpose
+they made a journey to the sacred hill of Nchomokela, on which repose
+the bodies of their ancestors; and, after a solemn appeal to the unseen
+spirits to attest the innocence of their children, they swallowed the
+muav&eacute;, vomited, and were therefore declared not guilty.&nbsp;
+It is evident that they believe that the soul has a continued existence;
+and that the spirits of the departed know what those they have left
+behind them are doing, and are pleased or not according as their deeds
+are good or evil; this belief is universal.&nbsp; The owner of a large
+canoe refused to sell it, because it belonged to the spirit of his father,
+who helped him when he killed the hippopotamus.&nbsp; Another, when
+the bargain for his canoe was nearly completed, seeing a large serpent
+on a branch of the tree overhead, refused to complete the sale, alleging
+that this was the spirit of his father come to protest against it.</p>
+<p>Some of the Batoka chiefs must have been men of considerable enterprise;
+the land of one, in the western part of this country, was protected
+by the Zambesi on the S., and on the N. and E. lay an impassable reedy
+marsh, filled with water all the year round, leaving only his western
+border open to invasion: he conceived the idea of digging a broad and
+deep canal nearly a mile in length, from the reedy marsh to the Zambesi,
+and, having actually carried the scheme into execution, he formed a
+large island, on which his cattle grazed in safety, and his corn ripened
+from year to year secure from all marauders.</p>
+<p>Another chief, who died a number of years ago, believed that he had
+discovered a remedy for tsetse-bitten cattle; his son Moyara showed
+us a plant, which was new to our botanist, and likewise told us how
+the medicine was prepared; the bark of the root, and, what might please
+our homoeopathic friends, a dozen of the tsetse are dried, and ground
+together into a fine powder.&nbsp; This mixture is administered internally;
+and the cattle are fumigated by burning under them the rest of the plant
+collected.&nbsp; The treatment must be continued for weeks, whenever
+the symptoms of poison appear.&nbsp; This medicine, he frankly admitted,
+would not cure all the bitten cattle.&nbsp; &ldquo;For,&rdquo; said
+he, &ldquo;cattle, and men too, die in spite of medicine; but should
+a herd by accident stray into a tsetse district and be bitten, by this
+medicine of my father, Kampa-kampa, some of them could be saved, while,
+without it, all would inevitably die.&rdquo;&nbsp; He stipulated that
+we were not to show the medicine to other people, and if ever we needed
+it in this region we must employ him; but if we were far off we might
+make it ourselves; and when we saw it cure the cattle think of him,
+and send him a present.</p>
+<p>Our men made it known everywhere that we wished the tribes to live
+in peace, and would use our influence to induce Sekeletu to prevent
+the Batoka of Moshobotwan&eacute; and the Makololo under-chiefs making
+forays into their country: they had already suffered severely, and their
+remonstrances with their countryman, Moshobotwan&eacute;, evoked only
+the answer, &ldquo;The Makololo have given me a spear; why should I
+not use it?&rdquo;&nbsp; He, indeed, it was who, being remarkably swift
+of foot, first guided the Makololo in their conquest of the country.&nbsp;
+In the character of peacemakers, therefore, we experienced abundant
+hospitality; and, from the Kafu&eacute; to the Falls, none of our party
+was allowed to suffer hunger.&nbsp; The natives sent to our sleeping-places
+generous presents of the finest white meal, and fat capons to give it
+a relish, great pots of beer to comfort our hearts, together with pumpkins,
+beans, and tobacco, so that we &ldquo;should sleep neither hungry nor
+thirsty.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>In travelling from the Kafu&eacute; to the Zungw&eacute; we frequently
+passed several villages in the course of a day&rsquo;s march.&nbsp;
+In the evening came deputies from the villages, at which we could not
+stay to sleep, with liberal presents of food.&nbsp; It would have pained
+them to have allowed strangers to pass without partaking of their hospitality;
+repeatedly were we hailed from huts, and asked to wait a moment and
+drink a little of the beer, which was brought with alacrity.&nbsp; Our
+march resembled a triumphant procession.&nbsp; We entered and left every
+village amidst the cheers of its inhabitants; the men clapping their
+hands, and the women lullilooing, with the shrill call, &ldquo;Let us
+sleep,&rdquo; or &ldquo;Peace.&rdquo;&nbsp; Passing through a hamlet
+one day, our guide called to the people, &ldquo;Why do you not clap
+your hands and salute when you see men who are wishing to bring peace
+to the land?&rdquo;&nbsp; When we halted for the night it was no uncommon
+thing for the people to prepare our camp entirely of their own accord;
+some with hoes quickly smoothed the ground for our beds, others brought
+dried grass and spread it carefully over the spot; some with their small
+axes speedily made a bush fence to shield us from the wind; and if,
+as occasionally happened, the water was a little distance off, others
+hastened and brought it with firewood to cook our food with.&nbsp; They
+are an industrious people, and very fond of agriculture.&nbsp; For hours
+together we marched through unbroken fields of mapira, or native corn,
+of a great width; but one can give no idea of the extent of land under
+the hoe as compared with any European country.&nbsp; The extent of surface
+is so great that the largest fields under culture, when viewed on a
+wide landscape, dwindle to mere spots.&nbsp; When taken in connection
+with the wants of the people, the cultivation on the whole is most creditable
+to their industry.&nbsp; They erect numerous granaries which give their
+villages the appearance of being large; and, when the water of the Zambesi
+has subsided, they place large quantities of grain, tied up in bundles
+of grass, and well plastered over with clay, on low sand islands for
+protection from the attacks of marauding mice and men.&nbsp; Owing to
+the ravages of the weevil, the native corn can hardly be preserved until
+the following crop comes in.&nbsp; However largely they may cultivate,
+and however abundant the harvest, it must all be consumed in a year.&nbsp;
+This may account for their making so much of it into beer.&nbsp; The
+beer these Batoka or Baw&eacute; brew is not the sour and intoxicating
+boala or pombe found among some other tribes, but sweet, and highly
+nutritive, with only a slight degree of acidity, sufficient to render
+it a pleasant drink.&nbsp; The people were all plump, and in good condition;
+and we never saw a single case of intoxication among them, though all
+drank abundance of this liting, or sweet beer.&nbsp; Both men and boys
+were eager to work for very small pay.&nbsp; Our men could hire any
+number of them to carry their burdens for a few beads a day.&nbsp; Our
+miserly and dirty ex-cook had an old pair of trousers that some one
+had given to him; after he had long worn them himself, with one of the
+sorely decayed legs he hired a man to carry his heavy load a whole day;
+a second man carried it the next day for the other leg, and what remained
+of the old garment, without the buttons, procured the labour of another
+man for the third day.</p>
+<p>Men of remarkable ability have risen up among the Africans from time
+to time, as amongst other portions of the human family.&nbsp; Some have
+attracted the attention, and excited the admiration of large districts
+by their wisdom.&nbsp; Others, apparently by the powers of ventriloquism,
+or by peculiar dexterity in throwing the spear, or shooting with the
+bow, have been the wonder of their generation; but the total absence
+of literature leads to the loss of all former experience, and the wisdom
+of the wise has not been handed down.&nbsp; They have had their minstrels
+too, but mere tradition preserves not their effusions.&nbsp; One of
+these, and apparently a genuine poet, attached himself to our party
+for several days, and whenever we halted, sang our praises to the villagers,
+in smooth and harmonious numbers.&nbsp; It was a sort of blank verse,
+and each line consisted of five syllables.&nbsp; The song was short
+when it first began, but each day he picked up more information about
+us, and added to the poem until our praises became an ode of respectable
+length.&nbsp; When distance from home compelled his return he expressed
+his regret at leaving us, and was, of course, paid for his useful and
+pleasant flatteries.&nbsp; Another, though a less gifted son of song,
+belonged to the Batoka of our own party.&nbsp; Every evening, while
+the others were cooking, talking, or sleeping, he rehearsed his songs,
+containing a history of everything he had seen in the land of the white
+men, and on the way back.&nbsp; In composing, extempore, any new piece,
+he was never at a loss; for if the right word did not come he halted
+not, but eked out the measure with a peculiar musical sound meaning
+nothing at all.&nbsp; He accompanied his recitations on the <i>sansa</i>,
+an instrument figured in the woodcut, the nine iron keys of which are
+played with the thumbs, while the fingers pass behind to hold it.&nbsp;
+The hollow end and ornaments face the breast of the player.&nbsp; Persons
+of a musical turn, if too poor to buy a sansa, may be seen playing vigorously
+on an instrument made with a number of thick corn-stalks sewn together,
+as a sansa frame, and keys of split bamboo, which, though making but
+little sound, seems to soothe the player himself.&nbsp; When the instrument
+is played with a calabash as a sounding board, it emits a greater volume
+of sound.&nbsp; Pieces of shells and tin are added to make a jingling
+accompaniment, and the calabash is also ornamented.</p>
+<p>After we had passed up, a party of slaves, belonging to the two native
+Portuguese who assassinated the chief, Mpangw&eacute;, and took possession
+of his lands at Zumbo, followed on our footsteps, and representing themselves
+to be our &ldquo;children,&rdquo; bought great quantities of ivory from
+the Baw&eacute;, for a few coarse beads a tusk.&nbsp; They also purchased
+ten large new canoes to carry it, at the rate of six strings of red
+or white beads, or two fathoms of grey calico, for each canoe, and,
+at the same cheap rate, a number of good-looking girls.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER VII.</h3>
+<p>The Victoria Falls of the Zambesi&mdash;Marvellous grandeur of the
+Cataracts&mdash;The Makololo&rsquo;s town&mdash;The Chief Sekeletu.</p>
+<p>During the time we remained at Motunta a splendid meteor was observed
+to lighten the whole heavens.&nbsp; The observer&rsquo;s back was turned
+to it, but on looking round the streak of light was seen to remain on
+its path some seconds.&nbsp; This streak is usually explained to be
+only the continuance of the impression made by the shining body on the
+retina.&nbsp; This cannot be, as in this case the meteor was not actually
+seen and yet the streak was clearly perceived.&nbsp; The rays of planets
+and stars also require another explanation than that usually given.</p>
+<p>Fruit-trees and gigantic wild fig-trees, and circles of stones on
+which corn safes were placed, with worn grindstones, point out where
+the villages once stood.&nbsp; The only reason now assigned for this
+fine country remaining desolate is the fear of fresh visitations by
+the Matebel&eacute;.&nbsp; The country now slopes gradually to the west
+into the Makololo Valley.&nbsp; Two days&rsquo; march from the Batoka
+village nearest the highlands, we met with some hunters who were burning
+the dry grass, in order to attract the game by the fresh vegetation
+which speedily springs up afterwards.&nbsp; The grass, as already remarked,
+is excellent for cattle.&nbsp; One species, with leaves having finely
+serrated edges, and of a reddish-brown colour, we noticed our men eating:
+it tastes exactly like liquorice-root, and is named kezu-kezu.&nbsp;
+The tsetse, known to the Batoka by the name &ldquo;ndoka,&rdquo; does
+not exist here, though buffaloes and elephants abound.</p>
+<p>A small trap in the path, baited with a mouse, to catch spotted cats
+(<i>F. Genetta</i>), is usually the first indication that we are drawing
+near to a village; but when we get within the sounds of pounding corn,
+cockcrowing, or the merry shouts of children at play, we know that the
+huts are but a few yards off, though the trees conceal them from view.&nbsp;
+We reached, on the 4th of August, Moachemba, the first of the Batoka
+villages which now owe allegiance to Sekeletu, and could see distinctly
+with the naked eye, in the great valley spread out before us, the columns
+of vapour rising from the Victoria Falls, though upwards of 20 miles
+distant.&nbsp; We were informed that, the rains having failed this year,
+the corn crops had been lost, and great scarcity and much hunger prevailed
+from Seshek&eacute; to Linyanti.&nbsp; Some of the reports which the
+men had heard from the Batoka of the hills concerning their families,
+were here confirmed.&nbsp; Takelang&rsquo;s wife had been killed by
+Mashotlan&eacute;, the headman at the Falls, on a charge, as usual,
+of witchcraft.&nbsp; Inchikola&rsquo;s two wives, believing him to be
+dead, had married again; and Masakasa was intensely disgusted to hear
+that two years ago his friends, upon a report of his death, threw his
+shield over the Falls, slaughtered all his oxen, and held a species
+of wild Irish wake, in honour of his memory: he said he meant to disown
+them, and to say, when they come to salute him, &ldquo;I am dead.&nbsp;
+I am not here.&nbsp; I belong to another world, and should stink if
+I came among you.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>All the sad news we had previously heard, of the disastrous results
+which followed the attempt of a party of missionaries, under the Rev.
+H. Helmore, to plant the gospel at Linyanti, were here fully confirmed.&nbsp;
+Several of the missionaries and their native attendants, from Kuruman,
+had succumbed to the fever, and the survivors had retired some weeks
+before our arrival.&nbsp; We remained the whole of the 7th beside the
+village of the old Batoka chief, Moshobotwan&eacute;, the stoutest man
+we have seen in Africa.&nbsp; The cause of our delay here was a severe
+attack of fever in Charles Livingstone.&nbsp; He took a dose of our
+fever pills; was better on the 8th, and marched three hours; then on
+the 9th marched eight miles to the Great Falls, and spent the rest of
+the day in the fatiguing exercise of sight-seeing.&nbsp; We were in
+the very same valley as Linyanti, and this was the same fever which
+treated, or rather maltreated, with only a little Dover&rsquo;s powder,
+proved so fatal to poor Helmore; the symptoms, too, were identical with
+those afterwards described by non-medical persons as those of poison.</p>
+<p>We gave Moshobotwan&eacute; a present, and a pretty plain exposition
+of what we thought of his bloody forays among his Batoka brethren.&nbsp;
+A scolding does most good to the recipient, when put alongside some
+obliging act.&nbsp; He certainly did not take it ill, as was evident
+from what he gave us in return; which consisted of a liberal supply
+of meal, milk, and an ox.&nbsp; He has a large herd of cattle, and a
+tract of fine pasture-land on the beautiful stream Lekon&eacute;.&nbsp;
+A home-feeling comes over one, even in the interior of Africa, at seeing
+once more cattle grazing peacefully in the meadows.&nbsp; The tsetse
+inhabits the trees which bound the pasture-land on the west; so, should
+the herdsman forget his duty, the cattle straying might be entirely
+lost.&nbsp; The women of this village were more numerous than the men,
+the result of the chief&rsquo;s marauding.&nbsp; The Batoko wife of
+Sima came up from the Falls, to welcome her husband back, bringing a
+present of the best fruits of the country.&nbsp; Her husband was the
+only one of the party who had brought a wife from Tette, namely, the
+girl whom he obtained from Chisaka for his feats of dancing.&nbsp; According
+to our ideas, his first wife could hardly have been pleased at seeing
+the second and younger one; but she took her away home with her, while
+the husband remained with us.&nbsp; In going down to the Fall village
+we met several of the real Makololo.&nbsp; They are lighter in colour
+than the other tribes, being of a rich warm brown; and they speak in
+a slow deliberate manner, distinctly pronouncing every word.&nbsp; On
+reaching the village opposite Kalai, we had an interview with the Makololo
+headman, Mashotlan&eacute;: he came to the shed in which we were seated,
+a little boy carrying his low three-legged stool before him: on this
+he sat down with becoming dignity, looked round him for a few seconds,
+then at us, and, saluting us with &ldquo;Rumela&rdquo; (good morning,
+or hail), he gave us some boiled hippopotamus meat, took a piece himself,
+and then handed the rest to his attendants, who soon ate it up.&nbsp;
+He defended his forays on the ground that, when he went to collect tribute,
+the Batoka attacked him, and killed some of his attendants.&nbsp; The
+excuses made for their little wars are often the very same as those
+made by C&aelig;sar in his &ldquo;Commentaries.&rdquo;&nbsp; Few admit,
+like old Moshobotwan&eacute;, that they fought because they had the
+power, and a fair prospect of conquering.&nbsp; We found here Pitsan&eacute;,
+who had accompanied the Doctor to St. Paul de Loanda.&nbsp; He had been
+sent by Sekeletu to purchase three horses from a trading party of Griquas
+from Kuruman, who charged nine large tusks apiece for very wretched
+animals.</p>
+<p>In the evening, when all was still, one of our men, Takelang, fired
+his musket, and cried out, &ldquo;I am weeping for my wife: my court
+is desolate: I have no home;&rdquo; and then uttered a loud wail of
+anguish.</p>
+<p>We proceeded next morning, 9th August, 1860, to see the Victoria
+Falls.&nbsp; Mosi-oa-tunya is the Makololo name and means smoke sounding;
+Seongo or Chongw&eacute;, meaning the Rainbow, or the place of the Rainbow,
+was the more ancient term they bore.&nbsp; We embarked in canoes, belonging
+to Tuba Mokoro, &ldquo;smasher of canoes,&rdquo; an ominous name; but
+he alone, it seems, knew the medicine which insures one against shipwreck
+in the rapids above the Falls.&nbsp; For some miles the river was smooth
+and tranquil, and we glided pleasantly over water clear as crystal,
+and past lovely islands densely covered with a tropical vegetation.&nbsp;
+Noticeable among the many trees were the lofty Hyph&aelig;ne and Borassus
+palms; the graceful wild date-palm, with its fruit in golden clusters,
+and the umbrageous mokononga, of cypress form, with its dark-green leaves
+and scarlet fruit.&nbsp; Many flowers peeped out near the water&rsquo;s
+edge, some entirely new to us, and others, as the convolvulus, old acquaintances.</p>
+<p>But our attention was quickly called from the charming islands to
+the dangerous rapids, down which Tuba might unintentionally shoot us.&nbsp;
+To confess the truth, the very ugly aspect of these roaring rapids could
+scarcely fail to cause some uneasiness in the minds of new-comers.&nbsp;
+It is only when the river is very low, as it was now, that any one durst
+venture to the island to which we were bound.&nbsp; If one went during
+the period of flood, and fortunately hit the island, he would be obliged
+to remain there till the water subsided again, if he lived so long.&nbsp;
+Both hippopotami and elephants have been known to be swept over the
+Falls, and of course smashed to pulp.</p>
+<p>Before entering the race of waters, we were requested not to speak,
+as our talking might diminish the virtue of the medicine; and no one
+with such boiling eddying rapids before his eyes, would think of disobeying
+the orders of a &ldquo;canoe-smasher.&rdquo;&nbsp; It soon became evident
+that there was sound sense in this request of Tuba&rsquo;s, although
+the reason assigned was not unlike that of the canoe-man from Sesheke,
+who begged one of our party not to whistle, because whistling made the
+wind come.&nbsp; It was the duty of the man at the bow to look out ahead
+for the proper course, and when he saw a rock or snag, to call out to
+the steersman.&nbsp; Tuba doubtless thought that talking on board might
+divert the attention of his steersman, at a time when the neglect of
+an order, or a slight mistake, would be sure to spill us all into the
+chafing river.&nbsp; There were places where the utmost exertions of
+both men had to be put forth in order to force the canoe to the only
+safe part of the rapid, and to prevent it from sweeping down broadside
+on, where in a twinkling we should have found ourselves floundering
+among the plotuses and cormorants, which were engaged in diving for
+their breakfast of small fish.&nbsp; At times it seemed as if nothing
+could save us from dashing in our headlong race against the rocks which,
+now that the river was low, jutted out of the water; but just at the
+very nick of time, Tuba passed the word to the steersman, and then with
+ready pole turned the canoe a little aside, and we glided swiftly past
+the threatened danger.&nbsp; Never was canoe more admirably managed:
+once only did the medicine seem to have lost something of its efficacy.&nbsp;
+We were driving swiftly down, a black rock over which the white foam
+flew, lay directly in our path, the pole was planted against it as readily
+as ever, but it slipped, just as Tuba put forth his strength to turn
+the bow off.&nbsp; We struck hard, and were half-full of water in a
+moment; Tuba recovered himself as speedily, shoved off the bow, and
+shot the canoe into a still shallow place, to bale out the water.&nbsp;
+Here we were given to understand that it was not the medicine which
+was at fault; that had lost none of its virtue; the accident was owing
+entirely to Tuba having started without his breakfast.&nbsp; Need it
+be said we never let Tuba go without that meal again?</p>
+<p>We landed at the head of Garden Island, which is situated near the
+middle of the river and on the lip of the Falls.&nbsp; On reaching that
+lip, and peering over the giddy height, the wondrous and unique character
+of the magnificent cascade at once burst upon us.</p>
+<p>It is rather a hopeless task to endeavour to convey an idea of it
+in words, since, as was remarked on the spot, an accomplished painter,
+even by a number of views, could but impart a faint impression of the
+glorious scene.&nbsp; The probable mode of its formation may perhaps
+help to the conception of its peculiar shape.&nbsp; Niagara has been
+formed by a wearing back of the rock over which the river falls; and
+during a long course of ages, it has gradually receded, and left a broad,
+deep, and pretty straight trough in front.&nbsp; It goes on wearing
+back daily, and may yet discharge the lakes from which its river&mdash;the
+St. Lawrence&mdash;flows.&nbsp; But the Victoria Falls have been formed
+by a crack right across the river, in the hard, black, basaltic rock
+which there formed the bed of the Zambesi.&nbsp; The lips of the crack
+are still quite sharp, save about three feet of the edge over which
+the river rolls.&nbsp; The walls go sheer down from the lips without
+any projecting crag, or symptoms of stratification or dislocation.&nbsp;
+When the mighty rift occurred, no change of level took place in the
+two parts of the bed of the river thus rent asunder, consequently, in
+coming down the river to Garden Island, the water suddenly disappears,
+and we see the opposite side of the cleft, with grass and trees growing
+where once the river ran, on the same level as that part of its bed
+on which we sail.&nbsp; The first crack is, in length, a few yards more
+than the breadth of the Zambesi, which by measurement we found to be
+a little over 1860 yards, but this number we resolved to retain as indicating
+the year in which the Fall was for the first time carefully examined.&nbsp;
+The main stream here runs nearly north and south, and the cleft across
+it is nearly east and west.&nbsp; The depth of the rift was measured
+by lowering a line, to the end of which a few bullets and a foot of
+white cotton cloth were tied.&nbsp; One of us lay with his head over
+a projecting crag, and watched the descending calico, till, after his
+companions had paid out 310 feet, the weight rested on a sloping projection,
+probably 50 feet from the water below, the actual bottom being still
+further down.&nbsp; The white cloth now appeared the size of a crown-piece.&nbsp;
+On measuring the width of this deep cleft by sextant, it was found at
+Garden Island, its narrowest part, to be eighty yards, and at its broadest
+somewhat more.&nbsp; Into this chasm, of twice the depth of Niagara-fall,
+the river, a full mile wide, rolls with a deafening roar; and this is
+Mosi-oa-tunya, or the Victoria Falls.</p>
+<p>Looking from Garden Island, down to the bottom of the abyss, nearly
+half a mile of water, which has fallen over that portion of the Falls
+to our right, or west of our point of view, is seen collected in a narrow
+channel twenty or thirty yards wide, and flowing at exactly right angles
+to its previous course, to our left; while the other half, or that which
+fell over the eastern portion of the Falls, is seen in the left of the
+narrow channel below, coming towards our right.&nbsp; Both waters unite
+midway, in a fearful boiling whirlpool, and find an outlet by a crack
+situated at right angles to the fissure of the Falls.&nbsp; This outlet
+is about 1170 yards from the western end of the chasm, and some 600
+from its eastern end; the whirlpool is at its commencement.&nbsp; The
+Zambesi, now apparently not more than twenty or thirty yards wide, rushes
+and surges south, through the narrow escape-channel for 130 yards; then
+enters a second chasm somewhat deeper, and nearly parallel with the
+first.&nbsp; Abandoning the bottom of the eastern half of this second
+chasm to the growth of large trees, it turns sharply off to the west,
+and forms a promontory, with the escape-channel at its point, of 1170
+yards long, and 416 yards broad at the base.&nbsp; After reaching this
+base, the river runs abruptly round the head of another promontory,
+and flows away to the east, in a third chasm; then glides round a third
+promontory, much narrower than the rest, and away back to the west,
+in a fourth chasm; and we could see in the distance that it appeared
+to round still another promontory, and bend once more in another chasm
+towards the east.&nbsp; In this gigantic, zigzag, yet narrow trough,
+the rocks are all so sharply cut and angular, that the idea at once
+arises that the hard basaltic trap must have been riven into its present
+shape by a force acting from beneath, and that this probably took place
+when the ancient inland seas were let off by similar fissures nearer
+the ocean.</p>
+<p>The land beyond, or on the south of the Falls, retains, as already
+remarked, the same level as before the rent was made.&nbsp; It is as
+if the trough below Niagara were bent right and left, several times
+before it reached the railway bridge.&nbsp; The land in the supposed
+bends being of the same height as that above the Fall, would give standing-places,
+or points of view, of the same nature as that from the railway-bridge,
+but the nearest would be only eighty yards, instead of two miles (the
+distance to the bridge) from the face of the cascade.&nbsp; The tops
+of the promontories are in general flat, smooth, and studded with trees.&nbsp;
+The first, with its base on the east, is at one place so narrow, that
+it would be dangerous to walk to its extremity.&nbsp; On the second,
+however, we found a broad rhinoceros path and a hut; but, unless the
+builder were a hermit, with a pet rhinoceros, we cannot conceive what
+beast or man ever went there for.&nbsp; On reaching the apex of this
+second eastern promontory we saw the great river, of a deep sea-green
+colour, now sorely compressed, gliding away, at least 400 feet below
+us.</p>
+<p>Garden Island, when the river is low, commands the best view of the
+Great Fall chasm, as also of the promontory opposite, with its grove
+of large evergreen trees, and brilliant rainbows of three-quarters of
+a circle, two, three, and sometimes even four in number, resting on
+the face of the vast perpendicular rock, down which tiny streams are
+always running to be swept again back by the upward rushing vapour.&nbsp;
+But as, at Niagara, one has to go over to the Canadian shore to see
+the chief wonder&mdash;the Great Horse-shoe Fall&mdash;so here we have
+to cross over to Moselekats&eacute;&rsquo;s side to the promontory of
+evergreens, for the best view of the principal Falls of Mosi-oa-tunya.&nbsp;
+Beginning, therefore, at the base of this promontory, and facing the
+Cataract, at the west end of the chasm, there is, first, a fall of thirty-six
+yards in breadth, and of course, as they all are, upwards of 310 feet
+in depth.&nbsp; Then Boaruka, a small island, intervenes, and next comes
+a great fall, with a breadth of 573 yards; a projecting rock separates
+this from a second grand fall of 325 yards broad; in all, upwards of
+900 yards of perennial Falls.&nbsp; Further east stands Garden Island;
+then, as the river was at its lowest, came a good deal of the bare rock
+of its bed, with a score of narrow falls, which, at the time of flood,
+constitute one enormous cascade of nearly another half-mile.&nbsp; Near
+the east end of the chasm are two larger falls, but they are nothing
+at low water compared to those between the islands.</p>
+<p>The whole body of water rolls clear over, quite unbroken; but, after
+a descent of ten or more feet, the entire mass suddenly becomes like
+a huge sheet of driven snow.&nbsp; Pieces of water leap off it in the
+form of comets with tails streaming behind, till the whole snowy sheet
+becomes myriads of rushing, leaping, aqueous comets.&nbsp; This peculiarity
+was not observed by Charles Livingstone at Niagara, and here it happens,
+possibly from the dryness of the atmosphere, or whatever the cause may
+be which makes every drop of Zambesi water appear to possess a sort
+of individuality.&nbsp; It runs off the ends of the paddles, and glides
+in beads along the smooth surface, like drops of quicksilver on a table.&nbsp;
+Here we see them in a conglomeration, each with a train of pure white
+vapour, racing down till lost in clouds of spray.&nbsp; A stone dropped
+in became less and less to the eye, and at last disappeared in the dense
+mist below.</p>
+<p>Charles Livingstone had seen Niagara, and gave Mosi-oa-tunya the
+palm, though now at the end of a drought, and the river at its very
+lowest.&nbsp; Many feel a disappointment on first seeing the great American
+Falls, but Mosi-oa-tunya is so strange, it must ever cause wonder.&nbsp;
+In the amount of water, Niagara probably excels, though not during the
+months when the Zambesi is in flood.&nbsp; The vast body of water, separating
+in the comet-like forms described, necessarily encloses in its descent
+a large volume of air, which, forced into the cleft, to an unknown depth,
+rebounds, and rushes up loaded with vapour to form the three or even
+six columns, as if of steam, visible at the Batoka village Moachemba,
+twenty-one miles distant.&nbsp; On attaining a height of 200, or at
+most 300 feet from the level of the river above the cascade, this vapour
+becomes condensed into a perpetual shower of fine rain.&nbsp; Much of
+the spray, rising to the west of Garden Island, falls on the grove of
+evergreen trees opposite; and from their leaves, heavy drops are for
+ever falling, to form sundry little rills, which, in running down the
+steep face of rock, are blown off and turned back, or licked off their
+perpendicular bed, up into the column from which they have just descended.</p>
+<p>The morning sun gilds these columns of watery smoke with all the
+glowing colours of double or treble rainbows.&nbsp; The evening sun,
+from a hot yellow sky, imparts a sulphureous hue, and gives one the
+impression that the yawning gulf might resemble the mouth of the bottomless
+pit.&nbsp; No bird sits and sings on the branches of the grove of perpetual
+showers, or ever builds its nest there.&nbsp; We saw hornbills and flocks
+of little black weavers flying across from the mainland to the islands,
+and from the islands to the points of the promontories and back again,
+but they uniformly shunned the region of perpetual rain, occupied by
+the evergreen grove.&nbsp; The sunshine, elsewhere in this land so overpowering,
+never penetrates the deep gloom of that shade.&nbsp; In the presence
+of the strange Mosi-oa-tunya, we can sympathize with those who, when
+the world was young, peopled earth, air, and river, with beings not
+of mortal form.&nbsp; Sacred to what deity would be this awful chasm
+and that dark grove, over which hovers an ever-abiding &ldquo;pillar
+of cloud&rdquo;?</p>
+<p>The ancient Batoka chieftains used Kazeruka, now Garden Island, and
+Boaruka, the island further west, also on the lip of the Falls, as sacred
+spots for worshipping the Deity.&nbsp; It is no wonder that under the
+cloudy columns, and near the brilliant rainbows, with the ceaseless
+roar of the cataract, with the perpetual flow, as if pouring forth from
+the hand of the Almighty, their souls should be filled with reverential
+awe.&nbsp; It inspired wonder in the native mind throughout the interior.&nbsp;
+Among the first questions asked by Sebituan&eacute; of Mr. Oswell and
+Dr. Livingstone, in 1851, was, &ldquo;Have you any smoke soundings in
+your country,&rdquo; and &ldquo;what causes the smoke to rise for ever
+so high out of water?&rdquo;&nbsp; In that year its fame was heard 200
+miles off, and it was approached within two days; but it was seen by
+no European till 1855, when Dr. Livingstone visited it on his way to
+the East Coast.&nbsp; Being then accompanied as far as this Fall by
+Sekeletu and 200 followers, his stay was necessarily short; and the
+two days there were employed in observations for fixing the geographical
+position of the place, and turning the showers, that at times sweep
+from the columns of vapour across the island, to account, in teaching
+the Makololo arboriculture, and making that garden from which the natives
+named the island; so that he did not visit the opposite sides of the
+cleft, nor see the wonderful course of the river beyond the Falls.&nbsp;
+The hippopotami had destroyed the trees which were then planted; and,
+though a strong stockaded hedge was made again, and living orange-trees,
+cashew-nuts, and coffee seeds put in afresh, we fear that the perseverance
+of the hippopotami will overcome the obstacle of the hedge.&nbsp; It
+would require a resident missionary to rear European fruit-trees.&nbsp;
+The period at which the peach and apricot come into blossom is about
+the end of the dry season, and artificial irrigation is necessary.&nbsp;
+The Batoka, the only arboriculturists in the country, rear native fruit-trees
+alone&mdash;the mosibe, the motsikiri, the boma, and others.&nbsp; When
+a tribe takes an interest in trees, it becomes more attached to the
+spot on which they are planted, and they prove one of the civilizing
+influences.</p>
+<p>Where one Englishman goes, others are sure to follow.&nbsp; Mr. Baldwin,
+a gentleman from Natal, succeeded in reaching the Falls guided by his
+pocket-compass alone.&nbsp; On meeting the second subject of Her Majesty,
+who had ever beheld the greatest of African wonders, we found him a
+sort of prisoner at large.&nbsp; He had called on Mashotlan&eacute;
+to ferry him over to the north side of the river, and, when nearly over,
+he took a bath, by jumping in and swimming ashore.&nbsp; &ldquo;If,&rdquo;
+said Mashotlan&eacute;, &ldquo;he had been devoured by one of the crocodiles
+which abound there, the English would have blamed us for his death.&nbsp;
+He nearly inflicted a great injury upon us, therefore, we said, he must
+pay a fine.&rdquo;&nbsp; As Mr. Baldwin had nothing with him wherewith
+to pay, they were taking care of him till he should receive beads from
+his wagon, two days distant.</p>
+<p>Mashotlan&eacute;&rsquo;s education had been received in the camp
+of Sebituan&eacute;, where but little regard was paid to human life.&nbsp;
+He was not yet in his prime, and his fine open countenance presented
+to us no indication of the evil influences which unhappily, from infancy,
+had been at work on his mind.&nbsp; The native eye was more penetrating
+than ours; for the expression of our men was, &ldquo;He has drunk the
+blood of men&mdash;you may see it in his eyes.&rdquo;&nbsp; He made
+no further difficulty about Mr. Baldwin; but the week after we left
+he inflicted a severe wound on the head of one of his wives with his
+rhinoceros-horn club.&nbsp; She, being of a good family, left him, and
+we subsequently met her and another of his wives proceeding up the country.</p>
+<p>The ground is strewn with agates for a number of miles above the
+Falls; but the fires, which burn off the grass yearly, have injured
+most of those on the surface.&nbsp; Our men were delighted to hear that
+they do as well as flints for muskets; and this with the new ideas of
+the value of gold (<i>dalama</i>) and malachite, that they had acquired
+at Tette, made them conceive that we were not altogether silly in picking
+up and looking at stones.</p>
+<p>Marching up the river, we crossed the Lekon&eacute; at its confluence,
+about eight miles above the island Kalai, and went on to a village opposite
+the Island Chundu.&nbsp; Nambow&eacute;, the headman, is one of the
+Matebel&eacute; or Zulus, who have had to flee from the anger of Moselekats&eacute;,
+to take refuge with the Makololo.</p>
+<p>We spent Sunday, the 12th, at the village of Molel&eacute;, a tall
+old Batoka, who was proud of having formerly been a great favourite
+with Sebituan&eacute;.&nbsp; In coming hither we passed through patches
+of forest abounding in all sorts of game.&nbsp; The elephants&rsquo;
+tusks, placed over graves, are now allowed to decay, and the skulls,
+which the former Batoka stuck on poles to ornament their villages, not
+being renewed, now crumble into dust.&nbsp; Here the famine, of which
+we had heard, became apparent, Molel&eacute;&rsquo;s people being employed
+in digging up the <i>tsitla</i> root out of the marshes, and cutting
+out the soft core of the young palm-trees, for food.</p>
+<p>The village, situated on the side of a wooded ridge, commands an
+extensive view of a great expanse of meadow and marsh lying along the
+bank of the river.&nbsp; On these holmes herds of buffaloes and waterbucks
+daily graze in security, as they have in the reedy marshes a refuge
+into which they can run on the approach of danger.&nbsp; The pretty
+little tianyane or ourebi is abundant further on, and herds of blue
+weldebeests or brindled gnus (<i>Katoblepas Gorgon</i>) amused us by
+their fantastic capers.&nbsp; They present a much more ferocious aspect
+than the lion himself, but are quite timid.&nbsp; We never could, by
+waving a red handkerchief, according to the prescription, induce them
+to venture near to us.&nbsp; It may therefore be that the red colour
+excites their fury only when wounded or hotly pursued.&nbsp; Herds of
+lechee or lechw&eacute; now enliven the meadows; and they and their
+younger brother, the graceful poku, smaller, and of a rounder contour,
+race together towards the grassy fens.&nbsp; We venture to call the
+poku after the late Major Vardon, a noble-hearted African traveller;
+but fully anticipate that some aspiring Nimrod will prefer that his
+own name should go down to posterity on the back of this buck.</p>
+<p>Midway between Tabacheu and the Great Falls the streams begin to
+flow westward.&nbsp; On the other side they begin to flow east.&nbsp;
+Large round masses of granite, somewhat like old castles, tower aloft
+about the Kalomo.&nbsp; The country is an elevated plateau, and our
+men knew and named the different plains as we passed them by.</p>
+<p>On the 13th we met a party from Sekeletu, who was now at Seshek&eacute;.&nbsp;
+Our approach had been reported, and they had been sent to ask the Doctor
+what the price of a horse ought to be; and what he said, that they were
+to give and no more.&nbsp; In reply they were told that by their having
+given nine large tusks for one horse before the Doctor came, the Griquas
+would naturally imagine that the price was already settled.&nbsp; It
+was exceedingly amusing to witness the exact imitation they gave of
+the swagger of a certain white with whom they had been dealing, and
+who had, as they had perceived, evidently wished to assume an air of
+indifference.&nbsp; Holding up the head and scratching the beard it
+was hinted might indicate not indifference, but vermin.&nbsp; It is
+well that we do not always know what they say about us.&nbsp; The remarks
+are often not quite complimentary, and resemble closely what certain
+white travellers say about the blacks.</p>
+<p>We made our camp in the afternoon abreast of the large island called
+Mparira, opposite the mouth of the Chob&eacute;.&nbsp; Francolins, quails,
+and guinea-fowls, as well as larger game, were abundant.&nbsp; The Makololo
+headman, Mokompa, brought us a liberal present; and in the usual way,
+which is considered politeness, regretted he had no milk, as his cows
+were all dry.&nbsp; We got some honey here from the very small stingless
+bee, called, by the Batoka, moandi, and by others, the kokomatsan&eacute;.&nbsp;
+This honey is slightly acid, and has an aromatic flavour.&nbsp; The
+bees are easily known from their habit of buzzing about the eyes, and
+tickling the skin by sucking it as common flies do.&nbsp; The hive has
+a tube of wax like a quill, for its entrance, and is usually in the
+hollows of trees.</p>
+<p>Mokompa feared that the tribe was breaking up, and lamented the condition
+into which they had fallen in consequence of Sekeletu&rsquo;s leprosy;
+he did not know what was to become of them.&nbsp; He sent two canoes
+to take us up to Seshek&eacute;; his best canoe had taken ivory up to
+the chief, to purchase goods of some native traders from Benguela.&nbsp;
+Above the Falls the paddlers always stand in the canoes, using long
+paddles, ten feet in length, and changing from side to side without
+losing the stroke.</p>
+<p>Mochokotsa, a messenger from Sekeletu, met us on the 17th, with another
+request for the Doctor to take ivory and purchase a horse.&nbsp; He
+again declined to interfere.&nbsp; None were to come up to Sekeletu
+but the Doctor; and all the men who had had smallpox at Tette, three
+years ago, were to go back to Moshobotwan&eacute;, and he would sprinkle
+medicine over them, to drive away the infection, and prevent it spreading
+in the tribe.&nbsp; Mochokotsa was told to say to Sekeletu that the
+disease was known of old to white men, and we even knew the medicine
+to prevent it; and, were there any danger now, we should be the first
+to warn him of it.&nbsp; Why did not he go himself to have Moshobotwan&eacute;
+sprinkle medicine to drive away his leprosy.&nbsp; We were not afraid
+of his disease, nor of the fever that had killed the teachers and many
+Makololo at Linyanti.&nbsp; As this attempt at quarantine was evidently
+the suggestion of native doctors to increase their own importance, we
+added that we had no food, and would hunt next day for game, and the
+day after; and, should we be still ordered purification by their medicine,
+we should then return to our own country.</p>
+<p>The message was not all of our dictation, our companions interlarded
+it with their own indignant protests, and said some strong things in
+the Tette dialect about these &ldquo;doctor things&rdquo; keeping them
+back from seeing their father; when to their surprise Mochokotsa told
+them he knew every word they were saying, as he was of the tribe Bazizulu,
+and defied them to deceive him by any dialect, either of the Mashona
+on the east, or of the Mambari on the west.&nbsp; Mochokotsa then repeated
+our message twice, to be sure that he had it every word, and went back
+again.&nbsp; These chiefs&rsquo; messengers have most retentive memories;
+they carry messages of considerable length great distances, and deliver
+them almost word for word.&nbsp; Two or three usually go together, and
+when on the way the message is rehearsed every night, in order that
+the exact words may be kept to.&nbsp; One of the native objections to
+learning to write is, that these men answer the purpose of transmitting
+intelligence to a distance as well as a letter would; and, if a person
+wishes to communicate with any one in the town, the best way to do so
+is either to go to or send for him.&nbsp; And as for corresponding with
+friends very far off, that is all very well for white people, but the
+blacks have no friends to whom to write.&nbsp; The only effective argument
+for the learning to read is, that it is their duty to know the revelation
+from their Father in Heaven, as it stands in the Book.</p>
+<p>Our messenger returned on the evening of the following day with &ldquo;You
+speak truly,&rdquo; says Sekeletu, &ldquo;the disease is old, come on
+at once, do not sleep in the path; for I am greatly desirous (<i>tlologelecoe</i>)
+to see the Doctor.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>After Mochokotsa left us, we met some of Mokompa&rsquo;s men bringing
+back the ivory, as horses were preferred to the West-Coast goods.&nbsp;
+They were the bearers of instructions to Mokompa, and as these instructions
+illustrate the government of people who have learned scarcely anything
+from Europeans, they are inserted, though otherwise of no importance.&nbsp;
+Mashotlan&eacute; had not behaved so civilly to Mr. Baldwin as Sekeletu
+had ordered him to do to all Englishmen.&nbsp; He had been very uncivil
+to the messengers sent by Moselekats&eacute; with letters from Mr. Moffat,
+treated them as spies, and would not land to take the bag until they
+moved off.&nbsp; On our speaking to him about this, he justified his
+conduct on the plea that he was set at the Falls for the very purpose
+of watching these, their natural enemies; and how was he to know that
+they had been sent by Mr. Moffat?&nbsp; Our men thereupon reported at
+head-quarters that Mashotlan&eacute; had cursed the Doctor.&nbsp; The
+instructions to Mokompa, from Sekeletu, were to &ldquo;go and tell Mashotlan&eacute;
+that he had offended greatly.&nbsp; He had not cursed Monar&eacute;
+(Dr. Livingstone) but Sebituan&eacute;, as Monar&eacute; was now in
+the place of Sebituan&eacute;, and he reverenced him as he had done
+his father.&nbsp; Any fine taken from Mr. Baldwin was to be returned
+at once, as he was not a Boer but an Englishman.&nbsp; Sekeletu was
+very angry, and Mokompa must not conceal the message.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>On finding afterwards that Mashotlan&eacute;&rsquo;s conduct had
+been most outrageous to the Batoka, Sekeletu sent for him to come to
+Seshek&eacute;, in order that he might have him more under his own eye;
+but Mashotlan&eacute;, fearing that this meant the punishment of death,
+sent a polite answer, alleging that he was ill and unable to travel.&nbsp;
+Sekeletu tried again to remove Mashotlan&eacute; from the Falls, but
+without success.&nbsp; In theory the chief is absolute and quite despotic;
+in practice his authority is limited, and he cannot, without occasionally
+putting refractory headmen to death, force his subordinates to do his
+will.</p>
+<p>Except the small rapids by Mparira island, near the mouth of the
+Chob&eacute;, the rest of the way to Seshek&eacute; by water is smooth.&nbsp;
+Herds of cattle of two or three varieties graze on the islands in the
+river: the Batoka possessed a very small breed of beautiful shape, and
+remarkably tame, and many may still be seen; a larger kind, many of
+which have horns pendent, and loose at the roots; and a still larger
+sort, with horns of extraordinary dimensions,&mdash;apparently a burden
+for the beast to carry.&nbsp; This breed was found in abundance at Lake
+Ngami.&nbsp; We stopped at noon at one of the cattle-posts of Mokompa,
+and had a refreshing drink of milk.&nbsp; Men of his standing have usually
+several herds placed at different spots, and the owner visits each in
+turn, while his head-quarters are at his village.&nbsp; His son, a boy
+of ten, had charge of the establishment during his father&rsquo;s absence.&nbsp;
+According to Makololo ideas, the cattle-post is the proper school in
+which sons should be brought up.&nbsp; Here they receive the right sort
+of education&mdash;the knowledge of pasture and how to manage cattle.</p>
+<p>Strong easterly winds blow daily from noon till midnight, and continue
+till the October or November rains set in.&nbsp; Whirlwinds, raising
+huge pillars of smoke from burning grass and weeds, are common in the
+forenoon.&nbsp; We were nearly caught in an immense one.&nbsp; It crossed
+about twenty yards in front of us, the wind apparently rushing into
+it from all points of the compass.&nbsp; Whirling round and round in
+great eddies, it swept up hundreds of feet into the air a continuous
+dense dark cloud of the black pulverized soil, mixed with dried grass,
+off the plain.&nbsp; Herds of the new antelopes, lechw&eacute;, and
+poku, with the kokong, or gnus, and zebras stood gazing at us as we
+passed.&nbsp; The mirage lifted them at times halfway to the clouds,
+and twisted them and the clumps of palms into strange unearthly forms.&nbsp;
+The extensive and rich level plains by the banks, along the sides of
+which we paddled, would support a vast population, and might be easily
+irrigated from the Zambesi.&nbsp; If watered, they would yield crops
+all the year round, and never suffer loss by drought.&nbsp; The hippopotamus
+is killed here with long lance-like spears.&nbsp; We saw two men, in
+a light canoe, stealing noiselessly down on one of these animals thought
+to be asleep; but it was on the alert, and they had quickly to retreat.&nbsp;
+Comparatively few of these animals now remain between Seshek&eacute;
+and the Falls, and they are uncommonly wary, as it is certain death
+for one to be caught napping in the daytime.</p>
+<p>On the 18th we entered Seshek&eacute;.&nbsp; The old town, now in
+ruins, stands on the left bank of the river.&nbsp; The people have built
+another on the same side, a quarter of a mile higher up, since their
+headman Moriantsian&eacute; was put to death for bewitching the chief
+with leprosy.&nbsp; Sekeletu was on the right bank, near a number of
+temporary huts.&nbsp; A man hailed us from the chiefs quarters, and
+requested us to rest under the old Kotla, or public meeting-place tree.&nbsp;
+A young Makololo, with the large thighs which Zulus and most of this
+tribe have, crossed over to receive orders from the chief, who had not
+shown himself to the people since he was affected with leprosy.&nbsp;
+On returning he ran for Mokel&eacute;, the headman of the new town,
+who, after going over to Sekeletu, came back and conducted us to a small
+but good hut, and afterwards brought us a fine fat ox, as a present
+from the chief.&nbsp; &ldquo;This is a time of hunger,&rdquo; he said,
+&ldquo;and we have no meat, but we expect some soon from the Barots&eacute;
+Valley.&rdquo;&nbsp; We were entirely out of food when we reached Seshek&eacute;.&nbsp;
+Never was better meat than that of the ox Sekeletu sent, and infinitely
+above the flesh of all kinds of game is beef!</p>
+<p>A constant stream of visitors rolled in on us the day after our arrival.&nbsp;
+Several of them, who had suffered affliction during the Doctor&rsquo;s
+absence, seemed to be much affected on seeing him again.&nbsp; All were
+in low spirits.&nbsp; A severe drought had cut off the crops, and destroyed
+the pasture of Linyanti, and the people were scattered over the country
+in search of wild fruits, and the hospitality of those whose ground-nuts
+(<i>Arachis hypog&oelig;a</i>) had not failed.&nbsp; Sekeletu&rsquo;s
+leprosy brought troops of evils in its train.&nbsp; Believing himself
+bewitched, he had suspected a number of his chief men, and had put some,
+with their families, to death; others had fled to distant tribes, and
+were living in exile.&nbsp; The chief had shut himself up, and allowed
+no one to come into his presence but his uncle Mamir&eacute;.&nbsp;
+Ponwan&eacute;, who had been as &ldquo;head and eyes&rdquo; to him,
+had just died; evidence, he thought, of the potent spells of those who
+hated all who loved the chief.&nbsp; The country was suffering grievously,
+and Sebituan&eacute;&rsquo;s grand empire was crumbling to pieces.&nbsp;
+A large body of young Barots&eacute; had revolted and fled to the north;
+killing a man by the way, in order to put a blood-feud between Masiko,
+the chief to whom they were going, and Sekeletu.&nbsp; The Batoka under
+Sinaman&eacute;, and Muemba, were independent, and Mashotlan&eacute;
+at the Falls was setting Sekeletu&rsquo;s authority virtually at defiance.&nbsp;
+Sebituan&eacute;&rsquo;s wise policy in treating the conquered tribes
+on equal terms with his own Makololo, as all children of the chief,
+and equally eligible to the highest honours, had been abandoned by his
+son, who married none but Makololo women, and appointed to office none
+but Makololo men.&nbsp; He had become unpopular among the black tribes,
+conquered by the spear but more effectually won by the subsequent wise
+and just government of his father.</p>
+<p>Strange rumours were afloat respecting the unseen Sekeletu; his fingers
+were said to have grown like eagle&rsquo;s claws, and his face so frightfully
+distorted that no one could recognize him.&nbsp; Some had begun to hint
+that he might not really be the son of the great Sebituan&eacute;, the
+founder of the nation, strong in battle, and wise in the affairs of
+state.&nbsp; &ldquo;In the days of the Great Lion&rdquo; (Sebituan&eacute;),
+said his only sister, Moriantsian&eacute;&rsquo;s widow, whose husband
+Sekeletu had killed, &ldquo;we had chiefs and little chiefs and elders
+to carry on the government, and the great chief, Sebituan&eacute;, knew
+them all, and everything they did, and the whole country was wisely
+ruled; but now Sekeletu knows nothing of what his underlings do, and
+they care not for him, and the Makololo power is fast passing away.&rdquo;
+<a name="citation3"></a><a href="#footnote3">{3}</a></p>
+<p>The native doctors had given the case of Sekeletu up.&nbsp; They
+could not cure him, and pronounced the disease incurable.&nbsp; An old
+doctress from the Manyeti tribe had come to see what she could do for
+him, and on her skill he now hung his last hopes.&nbsp; She allowed
+no one to see him, except his mother and uncle, making entire seclusion
+from society an essential condition of the much longed-for cure.&nbsp;
+He sent, notwithstanding, for the Doctor; and on the following day we
+all three were permitted to see him.&nbsp; He was sitting in a covered
+wagon, which was enclosed by a high wall of close-set reeds; his face
+was only slightly disfigured by the thickening of the skin in parts,
+where the leprosy had passed over it; and the only peculiarity about
+his hands was the extreme length of his finger-nails, which, however,
+was nothing very much out of the way, as all the Makololo gentlemen
+wear them uncommonly long.&nbsp; He has the quiet, unassuming manners
+of his father, Sebituan&eacute;, speaks distinctly, in a low pleasant
+voice, and appears to be a sensible man, except perhaps on the subject
+of his having been bewitched; and in this, when alluded to, he exhibits
+as firm a belief as if it were his monomania.&nbsp; &ldquo;Moriantsian&eacute;,
+my aunt&rsquo;s husband, tried the bewitching medicine first on his
+wife, and she is leprous, and so is her head-servant; then, seeing that
+it succeeded, he gave me a stronger dose in the cooked flesh of a goat,
+and I have had the disease ever since.&nbsp; They have lately killed
+Ponwan&eacute;, and, as you see, are now killing me.&rdquo;&nbsp; Ponwan&eacute;
+had died of fever a short time previously.&nbsp; Sekeletu asked us for
+medicine and medical attendance, but we did not like to take the case
+out of the hands of the female physician already employed, it being
+bad policy to appear to undervalue any of the profession; and she, being
+anxious to go on with her remedies, said &ldquo;she had not given him
+up yet, but would try for another month; if he was not cured by that
+time, then she would hand him over to the white doctors.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+But we intended to leave the country before a month was up; so Mamir&eacute;,
+with others, induced the old lady to suspend her treatment for a little.&nbsp;
+She remained, as the doctors stipulated, in the chief&rsquo;s establishment,
+and on full pay.</p>
+<p>Sekeletu was told plainly that the disease was unknown in our country,
+and was thought exceedingly obstinate of cure; that we did not believe
+in his being bewitched, and we were willing to do all we could to help
+him.&nbsp; This was a case for disinterested benevolence; no pay was
+expected, but considerable risk incurred; yet we could not decline it,
+as we had the trading in horses.&nbsp; Having, however, none of the
+medicines usually employed in skin diseases with us, we tried the local
+application of lunar caustic, and hydriodate of potash internally; and
+with such gratifying results, that Mamir&eacute; wished the patient
+to be smeared all over with a solution of lunar caustic, which he believed
+to be of the same nature as the blistering fluid formerly applied to
+his own knee by Mr. Oswell.&nbsp; <i>Its</i> power he considered irresistible,
+and he would fain have had anything like it tried on Sekeletu.</p>
+<p>It was a time of great scarcity and hunger, but Sekeletu treated
+us hospitably, preparing tea for us at every visit we paid him.&nbsp;
+With the tea we had excellent American biscuit and preserved fruits,
+which had been brought to him all the way from Benguela.&nbsp; The fruits
+he most relished were those preserved in their own juices; plums, apples,
+pears, strawberries, and peaches, which we have seen only among Portuguese
+and Spaniards.&nbsp; It made us anxious to plant the fruit-tree seeds
+we had brought, and all were pleased with the idea of having these same
+fruits in their own country.</p>
+<p>Mokel&eacute;, the headman of Seshek&eacute;, and Sebituan&eacute;&rsquo;s
+sister, Manchunyan&eacute;, were ordered to provide us with food, as
+Sekeletu&rsquo;s wives, to whom this duty properly belonged, were at
+Linyanti.&nbsp; We found a black trader from the West Coast, and some
+Griqua traders from the South, both in search of ivory.&nbsp; Ivory
+is dear at Seshek&eacute;; but cheaper in the Batoka country, from Sinaman&eacute;&rsquo;s
+to the Kafu&eacute;, than anywhere else.&nbsp; The trader from Benguela
+took orders for goods for his next year&rsquo;s trip, and offered to
+bring tea, coffee, and sugar at cent. per cent. prices.&nbsp; As, in
+consequence of a hint formerly given, the Makololo had secured all the
+ivory in the Batoga country to the east, by purchasing it with hoes,
+the Benguela traders found it unprofitable to go thither for slaves.&nbsp;
+They assured us that without ivory the trade in slaves did not pay.&nbsp;
+In this way, and by the orders of Sekeletu, an extensive slave-mart
+was closed.&nbsp; These orders were never infringed except secretly.&nbsp;
+We discovered only two or three cases of their infraction.</p>
+<p>Sekeletu was well pleased with the various articles we brought for
+him, and inquired if a ship could not bring his sugar-mill and the other
+goods we had been obliged to leave behind at Tette.&nbsp; On hearing
+that there was a possibility of a powerful steamer ascending as far
+as Sinaman&eacute;&rsquo;s, but never above the Grand Victoria Falls,
+he asked, with charming simplicity, if a cannon could not blow away
+the Falls, so as to allow the vessel to come up to Seshek&eacute;.</p>
+<p>To save the tribe from breaking up, by the continual loss of real
+Makololo, it ought at once to remove to the healthy Batoka highlands,
+near the Kafu&eacute;.&nbsp; Fully aware of this, Sekeletu remarked
+that all his people, save two, were convinced that, if they remained
+in the lowlands, a few years would suffice to cut off all the real Makololo;
+they came originally from the healthy South, near the confluence of
+the Likwa and Namagari, where fever is almost unknown, and its ravages
+had been as frightful among them here, as amongst Europeans on the Coast.&nbsp;
+Sebituan&eacute;&rsquo;s sister described its first appearance among
+the tribe, after their settling in the Barots&eacute; Valley on the
+Zambesi.&nbsp; Many of them were seized with a shivering sickness, as
+if from excessive cold; they had never seen the like before.&nbsp; They
+made great fires, and laid the shivering wretches down before them;
+but, pile on wood as they might, they could not raise heat enough to
+drive the cold out of the bodies of the sufferers, and they shivered
+on till they died.&nbsp; But, though all preferred the highlands, they
+were afraid to go there, lest the Matebel&eacute; should come and rob
+them of their much-loved cattle.&nbsp; Sebituan&eacute;, with all his
+veterans, could not withstand that enemy; and how could they be resisted,
+now that most of the brave warriors were dead?&nbsp; The young men would
+break, and run away the moment they saw the terrible Matebel&eacute;,
+being as much afraid of them as the black conquered tribes are of the
+Makololo.&nbsp; &ldquo;But if the Doctor and his wife,&rdquo; said the
+chiefs and counsellors, &ldquo;would come and live with us, we would
+remove to the highlands at once, as Moselekats&eacute; would not attack
+a place where the daughter of his friend, Moffat, was living.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>The Makololo are by far the most intelligent and enterprising of
+the tribes we have met.&nbsp; None but brave and daring men remained
+long with Sebituan&eacute;, his stern discipline soon eradicated cowardice
+from his army.&nbsp; Death was the inevitable doom of the coward.&nbsp;
+If the chief saw a man running away from the fight, he rushed after
+him with amazing speed, and cut him down; or waited till he returned
+to the town, and then summoned the deserter into his presence.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;You did not wish to die on the field, you wished to die at home,
+did you? you shall have your wish!&rdquo; and he was instantly led off
+and executed.&nbsp; The present race of young men are inferior in most
+respects to their fathers.&nbsp; The old Makololo had many manly virtues;
+they were truthful, and never stole, excepting in what they considered
+the honourable way of lifting cattle in fair fight.&nbsp; But this can
+hardly be said of their sons; who, having been brought up among the
+subjected tribes, have acquired some of the vices peculiar to a menial
+and degraded race.&nbsp; A few of the old Makololo cautioned us not
+to leave any of our property exposed, as the blacks were great thieves;
+and some of our own men advised us to be on our guard, as the Makololo
+also would steal.&nbsp; A very few trifling articles were stolen by
+a young Makololo; and he, on being spoken to on the subject, showed
+great ingenuity in excusing himself, by a plausible and untruthful story.&nbsp;
+The Makololo of old were hard workers, and did not consider labour as
+beneath them; but their sons never work, regarding it as fit only for
+the Mashona and Makalaka servants.&nbsp; Sebituan&eacute;, seeing that
+the rival tribes had the advantage over his, in knowing how to manage
+canoes, had his warriors taught to navigate; and his own son, with his
+companions, paddled the chief&rsquo;s canoe.&nbsp; All the dishes, baskets,
+stools, and canoes are made by the black tribes called Manyeti and Matlotlora.&nbsp;
+The houses are built by the women and servants.&nbsp; The Makololo women
+are vastly superior to any we have yet seen.&nbsp; They are of a light
+warm brown complexion, have pleasant countenances, and are remarkably
+quick of apprehension.&nbsp; They dress neatly, wearing a kilt and mantle,
+and have many ornaments.&nbsp; Sebituan&eacute;&rsquo;s sister, the
+head lady of Seshek&eacute;, wore eighteen solid brass rings, as thick
+as one&rsquo;s finger, on each leg, and three of copper under each knee;
+nineteen brass rings on her left arm, and eight of brass and copper
+on her right, also a large ivory ring above each elbow.&nbsp; She had
+a pretty bead necklace, and a bead sash encircled her waist.&nbsp; The
+weight of the bright brass rings round her legs impeded her walking,
+and chafed her ankles; but, as it was the fashion, she did not mind
+the inconvenience, and guarded against the pain by putting soft rag
+round the lower rings.</p>
+<p>Justice appears upon the whole to be pretty fairly administered among
+the Makololo.&nbsp; A headman took some beads and a blanket from one
+of his men who had been with us; the matter was brought before the chief,
+and he immediately ordered the goods to be restored, and decreed, moreover,
+that no headman should take the property of the men who had returned.&nbsp;
+In theory, all the goods brought back belonged to the chief; the men
+laid them at his feet, and made a formal offer of them all; he looked
+at the articles, and told the men to keep them.&nbsp; This is almost
+invariably the case.&nbsp; Tuba Mokoro, however, fearing lest Sekeletu
+might take a fancy to some of his best goods, exhibited only a few of
+his old and least valuable acquisitions.&nbsp; Masakasa had little to
+show; he had committed some breach of native law in one of the villages
+on the way, and paid a heavy fine rather than have the matter brought
+to the Doctor&rsquo;s ears.&nbsp; Each carrier is entitled to a portion
+of the goods in his bundle, though purchased by the chief&rsquo;s ivory,
+and they never hesitate to claim their rights; but no wages can be demanded
+from the chief, if he fails to respond to the first application.</p>
+<p>Our men, accustomed to our ways, thought that the English system
+of paying a man for his labour was the only correct one, and some even
+said it would be better to live under a government where life and labour
+were more secure and valuable than here.&nbsp; While with us, they always
+conducted themselves with propriety during Divine service, and not only
+maintained decorum themselves, but insisted on other natives who might
+be present doing the same.&nbsp; When Moshobotwan&eacute;, the Batoka
+chief, came on one occasion with a number of his men, they listened
+in silence to the reading of the Bible in the Makololo tongue; but,
+as soon as we all knelt down to pray, they commenced a vigorous clapping
+of hands, their mode of asking a favour.&nbsp; Our indignant Makololo
+soon silenced their noisy accompaniment, and looked with great contempt
+on this display of ignorance.&nbsp; Nearly all our men had learned to
+repeat the Lord&rsquo;s Prayer and the Apostles&rsquo; Creed in their
+own language, and felt rather proud of being able to do so; and when
+they reached home, they liked to recite them to groups of admiring friends.&nbsp;
+Their ideas of right and wrong differ in no respect from our own, except
+in their professed inability to see how it can be improper for a man
+to have more than one wife.&nbsp; A year or two ago several of the wives
+of those who had been absent with us petitioned the chief for leave
+to marry again.&nbsp; They thought that it was of no use waiting any
+longer, their husbands must be dead; but Sekeletu refused permission;
+he himself had bet a number of oxen that the Doctor would return with
+their husbands, and he had promised the absent men that their wives
+should be kept for them.&nbsp; The impatient spouses had therefore to
+wait a little longer.&nbsp; Some of them, however, eloped with other
+men; the wife of Mantlanyan&eacute;, for instance, ran off and left
+his little boy among strangers.&nbsp; Mantlanyan&eacute; was very angry
+when he heard of it, not that he cared much about her deserting him,
+for he had two other wives at Tette, but he was indignant at her abandoning
+his boy.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER VIII.</h3>
+<p>Life amongst the Makololo&mdash;Return journey&mdash;Native hospitality&mdash;A
+canoe voyage on the Zambesi.</p>
+<p>While we were at Seshek&eacute;, an ox was killed by a crocodile;
+a man found the carcass floating in the river, and appropriated the
+meat.&nbsp; When the owner heard of this, he requested him to come before
+the chief, as he meant to complain of him; rather than go, the delinquent
+settled the matter by giving one of his own oxen in lieu of the lost
+one.&nbsp; A headman from near Linyanti came with a complaint that all
+his people had run off, owing to the &ldquo;hunger.&rdquo;&nbsp; Sekeletu
+said, &ldquo;You must not be left to grow lean alone, some of them must
+come back to you.&rdquo;&nbsp; He had thus an order to compel their
+return, if he chose to put it in force.&nbsp; Families frequently leave
+their own headman and flee to another village, and sometimes a whole
+village decamps by night, leaving the headman by himself.&nbsp; Sekeletu
+rarely interfered with the liberty of the subject to choose his own
+headman, and, as it is often the fault of the latter which causes the
+people to depart, it is punishment enough for him to be left alone.&nbsp;
+Flagrant disobedience to the chief&rsquo;s orders is punished with death.&nbsp;
+A Moshubia man was ordered to cut some reeds for Sekeletu: he went off,
+and hid himself for two days instead.&nbsp; For this he was doomed to
+die, and was carried in a canoe to the middle of the river, choked,
+and tossed into the stream.&nbsp; The spectators hooted the executioners,
+calling out to them that they too would soon be carried out and strangled.&nbsp;
+Occasionally when a man is sent to beat an offender, he tells him his
+object, returns, and assures the chief he has nearly killed him.&nbsp;
+The transgressor then keeps for a while out of sight, and the matter
+is forgotten.&nbsp; The river here teems with monstrous crocodiles,
+and women are frequently, while drawing water, carried off by these
+reptiles.</p>
+<p>We met a venerable warrior, sole survivor, probably, of the Mantatee
+host which threatened to invade the colony in 1824.&nbsp; He retained
+a vivid recollection of their encounter with the Griquas: &ldquo;As
+we looked at the men and horses, puffs of smoke arose, and some of us
+dropped down dead!&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;Never saw anything like it in
+my life, a man&rsquo;s brains lying in one place and his body in another!&rdquo;&nbsp;
+They could not understand what was killing them; a ball struck a man&rsquo;s
+shield at an angle; knocked his arm out of joint at the shoulder; and
+leaving a mark, or burn, as he said, on the shield, killed another man
+close by.&nbsp; We saw the man with his shoulder still dislocated.&nbsp;
+Sebetuan&eacute; was present at the fight, and had an exalted opinion
+of the power of white people ever afterwards.</p>
+<p>The ancient costume of the Makololo consisted of the skin of a lamb,
+kid, jackal, ocelot, or other small animal, worn round and below the
+loins: and in cold weather a kaross, or skin mantle, was thrown over
+the shoulders.&nbsp; The kaross is now laid aside, and the young men
+of fashion wear a monkey-jacket and a skin round the hips; but no trousers,
+waistcoat, or shirt.&nbsp; The river and lake tribes are in general
+very cleanly, bathing several times a day.&nbsp; The Makololo women
+use water rather sparingly, rubbing themselves with melted butter instead:
+this keeps off parasites, but gives their clothes a rancid odour.&nbsp;
+One stage of civilization often leads of necessity to another&mdash;the
+possession of clothes creates a demand for soap; give a man a needle,
+and he is soon back to you for thread.</p>
+<p>This being a time of mourning, on account of the illness of the chief,
+the men were negligent of their persons, they did not cut their hair,
+or have merry dances, or carry spear and shield when they walked abroad.&nbsp;
+The wife of Pitsan&eacute; was busy making a large hut, while we were
+in the town: she informed us that the men left house-building entirely
+to the women and servants.&nbsp; A round tower of stakes and reeds,
+nine or ten feet high, is raised and plastered; a floor is next made
+of soft tufa, or ant-hill material and cowdung.&nbsp; This plaster prevents
+the poisonous insects, called tumpans, whose bite causes fever in some,
+and painful sores in all, from harbouring in the cracks or soil.&nbsp;
+The roof, which is much larger in diameter than the tower, is made on
+the ground, and then, many persons assisting, lifted up and placed on
+the tower, and thatched.&nbsp; A plastered reed fence is next built
+up to meet the outer part of the roof, which still projects a little
+over this fence, and a space of three feet remains between it and the
+tower.&nbsp; We slept in this space, instead of in the tower, as the
+inner door of the hut we occupied was uncomfortably small, being only
+nineteen inches high, and twenty-two inches wide at the floor.&nbsp;
+A foot from the bottom it measured seventeen inches in breadth, and
+close to the top only twelve inches, so it was a difficult matter to
+get through it.&nbsp; The tower has no light or ventilation, except
+through this small door.&nbsp; The reason a lady assigned for having
+the doors so very small was to keep out the mice!</p>
+<p>The children have merry times, especially in the cool of the evening.&nbsp;
+One of their games consists of a little girl being carried on the shoulders
+of two others.&nbsp; She sits with outstretched arms, as they walk about
+with her, and all the rest clap their hands, and stopping before each
+hut sing pretty airs, some beating time on their little kilts of cowskin,
+others making a curious humming sound between the songs.&nbsp; Excepting
+this and the skipping-rope, the play of the girls consists in imitation
+of the serious work of their mothers, building little huts, making small
+pots, and cooking, pounding corn in miniature mortars, or hoeing tiny
+gardens.&nbsp; The boys play with spears of reeds pointed with wood,
+and small shields, or bows and arrows; or amuse themselves in making
+little cattle-pens, or in moulding cattle in clay; they show great ingenuity
+in the imitation of various-shaped horns.&nbsp; Some too are said to
+use slings, but as soon as they can watch the goats, or calves, they
+are sent to the field.&nbsp; We saw many boys riding on the calves they
+had in charge, but this is an innovation since the arrival of the English
+with their horses.&nbsp; Tselan&eacute;, one of the ladies, on observing
+Dr. Livingstone noting observations on the wet and dry bulb thermometers,
+thought that he too was engaged in play; for on receiving no reply to
+her question, which was rather difficult to answer, as the native tongue
+has no scientific terms, she said with roguish glee, &ldquo;Poor thing,
+playing like a little child!&rdquo;</p>
+<p>Like other Africans, the Makololo have great faith in the power of
+medicine; they believe that there is an especial medicine for every
+ill that flesh is heir to.&nbsp; Mamir&eacute; is anxious to have children;
+he has six wives, and only one boy, and he begs earnestly for &ldquo;child
+medicine.&rdquo;&nbsp; The mother of Sekeletu came from the Barots&eacute;
+Valley to see her son.&nbsp; Thinks she has lost flesh since Dr. Livingstone
+was here before, and asks for &ldquo;the medicine of fatness.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+The Makololo consider plumpness an essential part of beauty in women,
+but the extreme stoutness, mentioned by Captain Speke, in the north,
+would be considered hideous here, for the men have been overheard speaking
+of a lady whom we call &ldquo;inclined to <i>embonpoint</i>,&rdquo;
+as &ldquo;fat unto ugliness.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>Two packages from the Kuruman, containing letters and newspapers,
+reached Linyanti previous to our arrival, and Sekeletu, not knowing
+when we were coming, left them there; but now at once sent a messenger
+for them.&nbsp; This man returned on the seventh day, having travelled
+240 geographical miles.&nbsp; One of the packages was too heavy for
+him, and he left it behind.&nbsp; As the Doctor wished to get some more
+medicine and papers out of the wagon left at Linyanti in 1853, he decided
+upon going thither himself.&nbsp; The chief gave him his own horse,
+now about twelve years old, and some men.&nbsp; He found everything
+in his wagon as safe as when he left it seven years before.&nbsp; The
+headmen, Mosal&eacute; and Pekonyan&eacute;, received him cordially,
+and lamented that they had so little to offer him.&nbsp; Oh! had he
+only arrived the year previous, when there was abundance of milk and
+corn and beer.</p>
+<p>Very early the next morning the old town-crier, Ma-Pulenyan&eacute;,
+of his own accord made a public proclamation, which, in the perfect
+stillness of the town long before dawn, was striking: &ldquo;I have
+dreamed!&nbsp; I have dreamed!&nbsp; I have dreamed!&nbsp; Thou Mosal&eacute;
+and thou Pekonyan&eacute;, my lords, be not faint-hearted, nor let your
+hearts be sore, but believe all the words of Monar&eacute; (the Doctor)
+for his heart is white as milk towards the Makololo.&nbsp; I dreamed
+that he was coming, and that the tribe would live, if you prayed to
+God and give heed to the word of Monar&eacute;.&rdquo;&nbsp; Ma-Pulenyan&eacute;
+showed Dr. Livingstone the burying-place where poor Helmore and seven
+others were laid, distinguishing those whom he had put to rest, and
+those for whom Mafal&eacute; had performed that last office.&nbsp; Nothing
+whatever marked the spot, and with the native idea of <i>hiding</i>
+the dead, it was said, &ldquo;it will soon be all overgrown with bushes,
+for no one will cultivate there.&rdquo;&nbsp; None but Ma-Pulenyan&eacute;
+approached the place, the others stood at a respectful distance; they
+invariably avoid everything connected with the dead, and no such thing
+as taking portions of human bodies to make charms of, as is the custom
+further north, has ever been known among the Makololo.</p>
+<p>Sekeletu&rsquo;s health improved greatly during our visit, the melancholy
+foreboding left his spirits, and he became cheerful, but resolutely
+refused to leave his den, and appear in public till he was perfectly
+cured, and had regained what he considered his good looks.&nbsp; He
+also feared lest some of those who had bewitched him originally might
+still be among the people, and neutralize our remedies. <a name="citation4"></a><a href="#footnote4">{4}</a></p>
+<p>As we expected another steamer to be at Kongon&eacute; in November,
+it was impossible for us to remain in Seshek&eacute; more than one month.&nbsp;
+Before our departure, the chief and his principal men expressed in a
+formal manner their great desire to have English people settled on the
+Batoka highlands.&nbsp; At one time he proposed to go as far as Phori,
+in order to select a place of residence; but as he afterwards saw reasons
+for remaining where he was, till his cure was completed, he gave orders
+to those sent with us, in the event of our getting, on our return, past
+the rapids near Tette, not to bring us to Seshek&eacute;, but to send
+forward a messenger, and he with the whole tribe would come to us.&nbsp;
+Dr. Kirk being of the same age, Sekeletu was particularly anxious that
+he should come and live with him.&nbsp; He said that he would cut off
+a section of the country for the special use of the English; and on
+being told that in all probability their descendants would cause disturbance
+in his country, he replied, &ldquo;These would be only domestic feuds,
+and of no importance.&rdquo;&nbsp; The great extent of uncultivated
+land on the cool and now unpeopled highlands has but to be seen to convince
+the spectator how much room there is, and to spare, for a vastly greater
+population than ever, in our day, can be congregated there.</p>
+<p>On the last occasion of our holding Divine service at Seshek&eacute;,
+the men were invited to converse on the subject on which they had been
+addressed.&nbsp; So many of them had died since we were here before,
+that not much probability existed of our all meeting again, and this
+had naturally led to the subject of a future state.&nbsp; They replied
+that they did not wish to offend the speaker, but they could not believe
+that all the dead would rise again: &ldquo;Can those who have been killed
+in the field and devoured by the vultures; or those who have been eaten
+by the hyenas or lions; or those who have been tossed into the river,
+and eaten by more than one crocodile,&mdash;can they all be raised again
+to life?&rdquo;&nbsp; They were told that men could take a leaden bullet,
+change it into a salt (acetate of lead), which could be dissolved as
+completely in water as our bodies in the stomachs of animals, and then
+reconvert it into lead; or that the bullet could be transformed into
+the red and white paint of our wagons, and again be reconverted into
+the original lead; and that if men exactly like themselves could do
+so much, how much more could He do who has made the eye to see, and
+the ear to hear!&nbsp; We added, however, that we believed in a resurrection,
+not because we understood how it would be brought about, but because
+our Heavenly Father assured us of it in His Book.&nbsp; The reference
+to the truth of the Book and its Author seems always to have more influence
+on the native mind than the cleverness of the illustration.&nbsp; The
+knowledge of the people is scanty, but their reasoning is generally
+clear as far as their information goes.</p>
+<p>We left Seshek&eacute; on the 17th September, 1860, convoyed by Pitsan&eacute;
+and Leshor&eacute; with their men.&nbsp; Pitsan&eacute; was ordered
+by Sekeletu to make a hedge round the garden at the Falls, to protect
+the seeds we had brought; and also to collect some of the tobacco tribute
+below the Falls.&nbsp; Leshor&eacute;, besides acting as a sort of guard
+of honour to us, was sent on a diplomatic mission to Sinaman&eacute;.&nbsp;
+No tribute was exacted by Sekeletu from Sinaman&eacute;; but, as he
+had sent in his adhesion, he was expected to act as a guard in case
+of the Matebel&eacute; wishing to cross and attack the Makololo.&nbsp;
+As we intended to purchase canoes of Sinaman&eacute; in which to descend
+the river, Leshor&eacute; was to commend us to whatever help this Batoka
+chief could render.&nbsp; It must be confessed that Leshor&eacute;&rsquo;s
+men, who were all of the black subject tribes, really needed to be viewed
+by us in the most charitable light; for Leshor&eacute;, on entering
+any village, called out to the inhabitants, &ldquo;Look out for your
+property, and see that my thieves don&rsquo;t steal it.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>Two young Makololo with their Batoka servants accompanied us to see
+if Kebrabasa could be surmounted, and to bring a supply of medicine
+for Sekeletu&rsquo;s leprosy; and half a dozen able canoe-men, under
+Mobito, who had previously gone with Dr. Livingstone to Loanda, were
+sent to help us in our river navigation.&nbsp; Some men on foot drove
+six oxen which Sekeletu had given us as provisions for the journey.&nbsp;
+It was, as before remarked, a time of scarcity; and, considering the
+dearth of food, our treatment had been liberal.</p>
+<p>By day the canoe-men are accustomed to keep close under the river&rsquo;s
+bank from fear of the hippopotami; by night, however, they keep in the
+middle of the stream, as then those animals are usually close to the
+bank on their way to their grazing grounds.&nbsp; Our progress was considerably
+impeded by the high winds, which at this season of the year begin about
+eight in the morning, and blow strongly up the river all day.&nbsp;
+The canoes were poor leaky affairs, and so low in parts of the gunwale,
+that the paddlers were afraid to follow the channel when it crossed
+the river, lest the waves might swamp us.&nbsp; A rough sea is dreaded
+by all these inland canoe-men; but though timid, they are by no means
+unskilful at their work.&nbsp; The ocean rather astonished them afterwards;
+and also the admirable way that the Nyassa men managed their canoes
+on a rough lake, and even amongst the breakers, where no small boat
+could possibly live.</p>
+<p>On the night of the 17th we slept on the left bank of the Majeel&eacute;,
+after having had all the men ferried across.&nbsp; An ox was slaughtered,
+and not an ounce of it was left next morning.&nbsp; Our two young Makololo
+companions, Maloka and Ramakukan&eacute;, having never travelled before,
+naturally clung to some of the luxuries they had been accustomed to
+at home.&nbsp; When they lay down to sleep, their servants were called
+to spread their blankets over their august persons, not forgetting their
+feet.&nbsp; This seems to be the duty of the Makololo wife to her husband,
+and strangers sometimes receive the honour.&nbsp; One of our party,
+having wandered, slept at the village of Nambow&eacute;.&nbsp; When
+he laid down, to his surprise two of Nambow&eacute;&rsquo;s wives came
+at once, and carefully and kindly spread his kaross over him.</p>
+<p>A beautiful silvery fish with reddish fins, called Ngwesi, is very
+abundant in the river; large ones weigh fifteen or twenty pounds each.&nbsp;
+Its teeth are exposed, and so arranged that, when they meet, the edges
+cut a hook like nippers.&nbsp; The Ngwesi seems to be a very ravenous
+fish.&nbsp; It often gulps down the Konokono, a fish armed with serrated
+bones more than an inch in length in the pectoral and dorsal fins, which,
+fitting into a notch at the roots, can be put by the fish on full cock
+or straight out,&mdash;they cannot be folded down, without its will,
+and even break in resisting.&nbsp; The name &ldquo;Konokono,&rdquo;
+elbow-elbow, is given it from a resemblance its extended fins are supposed
+to bear to a man&rsquo;s elbows stuck out from his body.&nbsp; It often
+performs the little trick of cocking its fins in the stomach of the
+Ngwesi, and, the elbows piercing its enemy&rsquo;s sides, he is frequently
+found floating dead.&nbsp; The fin bones seem to have an acrid secretion
+on them, for the wound they make is excessively painful.&nbsp; The Konokono
+barks distinctly when landed with the hook.&nbsp; Our canoe-men invariably
+picked up every dead fish they saw on the surface of the water, however
+far gone.&nbsp; An unfragrant odour was no objection; the fish was boiled
+and eaten, and the water drunk as soup.&nbsp; It is a curious fact that
+many of the Africans keep fish as we do woodcocks, until they are extremely
+offensive, before they consider them fit to eat.&nbsp; Our paddlers
+informed us on our way down that iguanas lay their eggs in July and
+August, and crocodiles in September.&nbsp; The eggs remain a month or
+two under the sand where they are laid, and the young come out when
+the rains have fairly commenced.&nbsp; The canoe-men were quite positive
+that crocodiles frequently stun men by striking them with their tails,
+and then squat on them till they are drowned.&nbsp; We once caught a
+young crocodile, which certainly did use its tail to inflict sharp blows,
+and led us to conclude that the native opinion is correct.&nbsp; They
+believed also that, if a person shuts the beast&rsquo;s eyes, it lets
+go its hold.&nbsp; Crocodiles have been known to unite and kill a large
+one of their own species and eat it.&nbsp; Some fishermen throw the
+bones of the fish into the river but in most of the fishing villages
+there are heaps of them in various places.&nbsp; The villagers can walk
+over them without getting them into their feet; but the Makololo, from
+having softer soles, are unable to do so.&nbsp; The explanation offered
+was, that the fishermen have a medicine against fish-bones, but that
+they will not reveal it to the Makololo.</p>
+<p>We spent a night on Mparira island, which is four miles long and
+about one mile broad.&nbsp; Mokompa, the headman, was away hunting elephants.&nbsp;
+His wife sent for him on our arrival, and he returned next morning before
+we left.&nbsp; Taking advantage of the long-continued drought, he had
+set fire to the reeds between the Chob&eacute; and Zambesi, in such
+a manner as to drive the game out at one corner, where his men laid
+in wait with their spears.&nbsp; He had killed five elephants and three
+buffaloes, wounding several others which escaped.</p>
+<p>On our land party coming up, we were told that the oxen were bitten
+by the tsetse: they could see a great difference in their looks.&nbsp;
+One was already eaten, and they now wished to slaughter another.&nbsp;
+A third fell into a buffalo-pit next day, so our stock was soon reduced.</p>
+<p>The Batoka chief, Moshobotwan&eacute;, again treated us with his
+usual hospitality, giving us an ox, some meal, and milk.&nbsp; We took
+another view of the grand Mosi-oa-tunya, and planted a quantity of seeds
+in the garden on the island; but, as no one will renew the hedge, the
+hippopotami will, doubtless, soon destroy what we planted.&nbsp; Mashotlan&eacute;
+assisted us.&nbsp; So much power was allowed to this under-chief, that
+he appeared as if he had cast off the authority of Sekeletu altogether.&nbsp;
+He did not show much courtesy to his messengers; instead of giving them
+food, as is customary, he took the meat out of a pot in their presence,
+and handed it to his own followers.&nbsp; This may have been because
+Sekeletu&rsquo;s men bore an order to him to remove to Linyanti.&nbsp;
+He had not only insulted Baldwin, but had also driven away the Griqua
+traders; but this may all end in nothing.&nbsp; Some of the natives
+here, and at Seshek&eacute;, know a few of the low tricks of more civilized
+traders.&nbsp; A pot of milk was brought to us one evening, which was
+more indebted to the Zambesi than to any cow.&nbsp; Baskets of fine-looking
+white meal, elsewhere, had occasionally the lower half filled with bran.&nbsp;
+Eggs are always a perilous investment.&nbsp; The native idea of a good
+egg differs as widely from our own as is possible on such a trifling
+subject.&nbsp; An egg is eaten here with apparent relish, though an
+embryo chick be inside.</p>
+<p>We left Mosi-oa-tunya on the 27th, and slept close to the village
+of Bakwini.&nbsp; It is built on a ridge of loose red soil, which produces
+great crops of mapira and ground-nuts; many magnificent mosibe-trees
+stand near the village.&nbsp; Machimisi, the headman of the village,
+possesses a herd of cattle and a large heart; he kept us company for
+a couple of days to guide us on our way.</p>
+<p>We had heard a good deal of a stronghold some miles below the Falls,
+called Kalunda.&nbsp; Our return path was much nearer the Zambesi than
+that of our ascent,&mdash;in fact, as near as the rough country would
+allow,&mdash;but we left it twice before we reached Sinaman&eacute;&rsquo;s,
+in order to see Kalunda and a Fall called Mo&ouml;mba, or Moamba.&nbsp;
+The Makololo had once dispossessed the Batoka of Kalunda, but we could
+not see the fissure, or whatever it is, that rendered it a place of
+security, as it was on the southern bank.&nbsp; The crack of the Great
+Falls was here continued: the rocks are the same as further up, but
+perhaps less weather-worn&mdash;and now partially stratified in great
+thick masses.&nbsp; The country through which we were travelling was
+covered with a cindery-looking volcanic tufa, and might be called &ldquo;Katakaumena.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>The description we received of the Moamba Falls seemed to promise
+something grand.&nbsp; They were said to send up &ldquo;smoke&rdquo;
+in the wet season, like Mosi-oa-tunya; but when we looked down into
+the cleft, in which the dark-green narrow river still rolls, we saw,
+about 800 or 1000 feet below us, what, after Mosi-oa-tunya, seemed two
+insignificant cataracts.&nbsp; It was evident that Pitsan&eacute;, observing
+our delight at the Victoria Falls, wished to increase our pleasure by
+a second wonder.&nbsp; One Mosi-oa-tunya, however, is quite enough for
+a continent.</p>
+<p>We had now an opportunity of seeing more of the Batoka, than we had
+on the highland route to our north.&nbsp; They did not wait till the
+evening before offering food to the strangers.&nbsp; The aged wife of
+the headman of a hamlet, where we rested at midday, at once kindled
+a fire, and put on the cooking-pot to make porridge.&nbsp; Both men
+and women are to be distinguished by greater roundness of feature than
+the other natives, and the custom of knocking out the upper front teeth
+gives at once a distinctive character to the face.&nbsp; Their colour
+attests the greater altitude of the country in which many of them formerly
+lived.&nbsp; Some, however, are as dark as the Bashubia and Barots&eacute;
+of the great valley to their west, in which stands Seshek&eacute;, formerly
+the capital of the Balui, or Bashubia.</p>
+<p>The assertion may seem strange, yet it is none the less true, that
+in all the tribes we have visited we never saw a really black person.&nbsp;
+Different shades of brown prevail, and often with a bright bronze tint,
+which no painter, except Mr. Angus, seems able to catch.&nbsp; Those
+who inhabit elevated, dry situations, and who are not obliged to work
+much in the sun, are frequently of a light warm brown, &ldquo;dark but
+comely.&rdquo;&nbsp; Darkness of colour is probably partly caused by
+the sun, and partly by something in the climate or soil which we do
+not yet know.&nbsp; We see something of the same sort in trout and other
+fish which take their colour from the ponds or streams in which they
+live.&nbsp; The members of our party were much less embrowned by free
+exposure to the sun for years than Dr. Livingstone and his family were
+by passing once from Kuruman to Cape Town, a journey which occupied
+only a couple of months.</p>
+<p>We encamped on the Kalomo, on the 1st of October, and found the weather
+very much warmer than when we crossed this stream in August.&nbsp; At
+3 p.m. the thermometer, four feet from the ground, was 101 degrees in
+the shade; the wet bulb only 61 degrees: a difference of 40 degrees.&nbsp;
+Yet, notwithstanding this extreme dryness of the atmosphere, without
+a drop of rain having fallen for months, and scarcely any dew, many
+of the shrubs and trees were putting forth fresh leaves of various hues,
+while others made a profuse display of lovely blossoms.</p>
+<p>Two old and very savage buffaloes were shot for our companions on
+the 3rd October.&nbsp; Our Volunteers may feel an interest in knowing
+that balls sometimes have but little effect: one buffalo fell, on receiving
+a Jacob&rsquo;s shell; it was hit again twice, and lost a large amount
+of blood; and yet it sprang up, and charged a native, who, by great
+agility, had just time to climb a tree, before the maddened beast struck
+it, battering-ram fashion, hard enough almost to have split both head
+and tree.&nbsp; It paused a few seconds&mdash;drew back several paces&mdash;glared
+up at the man&mdash;and then dashed at the tree again and again, as
+if determined to shake him out of it.&nbsp; It took two more Jacob&rsquo;s
+shells, and five other large solid rifle-balls to finish the beast at
+last.&nbsp; These old surly buffaloes had been wandering about in a
+sort of miserable fellowship; their skins were diseased and scabby,
+as if leprous, and their horns atrophied or worn down to stumps&mdash;the
+first was killed outright, by one Jacob&rsquo;s shell, the second died
+hard.&nbsp; There is so much difference in the tenacity of life in wounded
+animals of the same species, that the inquiry is suggested where the
+seat of life can be?&mdash;We have seen a buffalo live long enough,
+after a large bullet had passed right through the heart, to allow firm
+adherent clots to be formed in the two holes.</p>
+<p>One day&rsquo;s journey above Sinaman&eacute;&rsquo;s, a mass of
+mountain called Gorongu&eacute;, or Golongw&eacute;, is said to cross
+the river, and the rent through which the river passes is, by native
+report, quite fearful to behold.&nbsp; The country round it is so rocky,
+that our companions dreaded the fatigue, and were not much to blame,
+if, as is probably the case, the way be worse than that over which we
+travelled.&nbsp; As we trudged along over the black slag-like rocks,
+the almost leafless trees affording no shade, the heat was quite as
+great as Europeans could bear.&nbsp; It was 102 degrees in the shade,
+and a thermometer placed under the tongue or armpit showed that our
+blood was 99.5 degrees, or 1.5 degrees hotter than that of the natives,
+which stood at 98 degrees.&nbsp; Our shoes, however, enable us to pass
+over the hot burning soil better than they can.&nbsp; Many of those
+who wear sandals have corns on the sides of the feet, and on the heels,
+where the straps pass.&nbsp; We have seen instances, too, where neither
+sandals nor shoes were worn, of corns on the soles of the feet.&nbsp;
+It is, moreover, not at all uncommon to see toes cocked up, as if pressed
+out of their proper places; at home, we should have unhesitatingly ascribed
+this to the vicious fashions perversely followed by our shoemakers.</p>
+<p>On the 5th, after crossing some hills, we rested at the village of
+Simariango.&nbsp; The bellows of the blacksmith here were somewhat different
+from the common goatskin bags, and more like those seen in Madagascar.&nbsp;
+They consisted of two wooden vessels, like a lady&rsquo;s bandbox of
+small dimensions, the upper ends of which were covered with leather,
+and looked something like the heads of drums, except that the leather
+bagged in the centre.&nbsp; They were fitted with long nozzles, through
+which the air was driven by working the loose covering of the tops up
+and down by means of a small piece of wood attached to their centres.&nbsp;
+The blacksmith said that tin was obtained from a people in the north,
+called Marendi, and that he had made it into bracelets; we had never
+heard before of tin being found in the country.</p>
+<p>Our course then lay down the bed of a rivulet, called Mapatizia,
+in which there was much calc spar, with calcareous schist, and then
+the Tette grey sandstone, which usually overlies coal.&nbsp; On the
+6th we arrived at the islet Chilomb&eacute;, belonging to Sinaman&eacute;,
+where the Zambesi runs broad and smooth again, and were well received
+by Sinaman&eacute; himself.&nbsp; Never was Sunday more welcome to the
+weary than this, the last we were to spend with our convoy.</p>
+<p>We now saw many good-looking young men and women.&nbsp; The dresses
+of the ladies are identical with those of Nubian women in Upper Egypt.&nbsp;
+To a belt on the waist a great number of strings are attached to hang
+all round the person.&nbsp; These fringes are about six or eight inches
+long.&nbsp; The matrons wear in addition a skin cut like the tails of
+the coatee formerly worn by our dragoons.&nbsp; The younger girls wear
+the waist-belt exhibited in the woodcut, ornamented with shells, and
+have the fringes only in front.&nbsp; Marauding parties of Batoka, calling
+themselves Makololo, have for some time had a wholesome dread of Sinaman&eacute;&rsquo;s
+&ldquo;long spears.&rdquo;&nbsp; Before going to Tette our Batoka friend,
+Masakasa, was one of a party that came to steal some of the young women;
+but Sinaman&eacute;, to their utter astonishment, attacked them so furiously
+that the survivors barely escaped with their lives.&nbsp; Masakasa had
+to flee so fast that he threw away his shield, his spear, and his clothes,
+and returned home a wiser and a sadder man.</p>
+<p>Sinaman&eacute;&rsquo;s people cultivate large quantities of tobacco,
+which they manufacture into balls for the Makololo market.&nbsp; Twenty
+balls, weighing about three-quarters of a pound each, are sold for a
+hoe.&nbsp; The tobacco is planted on low moist spots on the banks of
+the Zambesi; and was in flower at the time we were there, in October.&nbsp;
+Sinamane&rsquo;s people appear to have abundance of food, and are all
+in good condition.&nbsp; He could sell us only two of his canoes; but
+lent us three more to carry us as far as Moemba&rsquo;s, where he thought
+others might be purchased.&nbsp; They were manned by his own canoe-men,
+who were to bring them back.&nbsp; The river is about 250 yards wide,
+and flows serenely between high banks towards the North-east.&nbsp;
+Below Sinaman&eacute;&rsquo;s the banks are often worn down fifty feet,
+and composed of shingle and gravel of igneous rocks, sometimes set in
+a ferruginous matrix.&nbsp; The bottom is all gravel and shingle, how
+formed we cannot imagine, unless in pot-holes in the deep fissure above.&nbsp;
+The bottom above the Falls, save a few rocks close by them, is generally
+sandy or of soft tufa.&nbsp; Every damp spot is covered with maize,
+pumpkins, water-melons, tobacco, and hemp.&nbsp; There is a pretty numerous
+Batoka population on both sides of the river.&nbsp; As we sailed slowly
+down, the people saluted us from the banks, by clapping their hands.&nbsp;
+A headman even hailed us, and brought a generous present of corn and
+pumpkins.</p>
+<p>Moemba owns a rich island, called Mosanga, a mile in length, on which
+his village stands.&nbsp; He has the reputation of being a brave warrior,
+and is certainly a great talker; but he gave us strangers something
+better than a stream of words.&nbsp; We received a handsome present
+of corn, and the fattest goat we had ever seen; it resembled mutton.&nbsp;
+His people were as liberal as their chief.&nbsp; They brought two large
+baskets of corn, and a lot of tobacco, as a sort of general contribution
+to the travellers.&nbsp; One of Sinaman&eacute;&rsquo;s canoe-men, after
+trying to get his pay, deserted here, and went back before the stipulated
+time, with the story, that the Englishman had stolen the canoes.&nbsp;
+Shortly after sunrise next morning, Sinaman&eacute; came into the village
+with fifty of his &ldquo;long spears,&rdquo; evidently determined to
+retake his property by force; he saw at a glance that his man had deceived
+him.&nbsp; Moemba rallied him for coming on a wildgoose chase.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;Here are your canoes left with me, your men have all been paid,
+and the Englishmen are now asking me to sell my canoes.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+Sinaman&eacute; said little to us; only observing that he had been deceived
+by his follower.&nbsp; A single remark of his chief&rsquo;s caused the
+foolish fellow to leave suddenly, evidently much frightened and crestfallen.&nbsp;
+Sinaman&eacute; had been very kind to us, and, as he was looking on
+when we gave our present to Moemba, we made him also an additional offering
+of some beads, and parted good friends.&nbsp; Moemba, having heard that
+we had called the people of Sinaman&eacute; together to tell them about
+our Saviour&rsquo;s mission to man, and to pray with them, associated
+the idea of Sunday with the meeting, and, before anything of the sort
+was proposed, came and asked that he and his people might be &ldquo;sundayed&rdquo;
+as well as his neighbours; and be given a little seed wheat, and fruit-tree
+seeds; with which request of course we very willingly complied.&nbsp;
+The idea of praying direct to the Supreme Being, though not quite new
+to all, seems to strike their minds so forcibly that it will not be
+forgotten.&nbsp; Sinaman&eacute; said that he prayed to God, Morungo,
+and made drink-offerings to him.&nbsp; Though he had heard of us, he
+had never seen white men before.</p>
+<p>Beautiful crowned cranes, named from their note &ldquo;ma-wang,&rdquo;
+were seen daily, and were beginning to pair.&nbsp; Large flocks of spur-winged
+geese, or machikwe, were common.&nbsp; This goose is said to lay her
+eggs in March.&nbsp; We saw also pairs of Egyptian geese, as well as
+a few of the knob-nosed, or, as they are called in India, combed geese.&nbsp;
+When the Egyptian geese, as at the present time, have young, the goslings
+keep so steadily in the wake of their mother, that they look as if they
+were a part of her tail; and both parents, when on land, simulate lameness
+quite as well as our plovers, to draw off pursuers.&nbsp; The ostrich
+also adopts the lapwing fashion, but no quadrupeds do: they show fight
+to defend their young instead.&nbsp; In some places the steep banks
+were dotted with the holes which lead into the nests of bee-eaters.&nbsp;
+These birds came out in hundreds as we passed.&nbsp; When the red-breasted
+species settle on the trees, they give them the appearance of being
+covered with red foliage.</p>
+<p>On the morning of the 12th October we passed through a wild, hilly
+country, with fine wooded scenery on both sides, but thinly inhabited.&nbsp;
+The largest trees were usually thorny acacias, of great size and beautiful
+forms.&nbsp; As we sailed by several villages without touching, the
+people became alarmed, and ran along the banks, spears in hand.&nbsp;
+We employed one to go forward and tell Mpand&eacute; of our coming.&nbsp;
+This allayed their fears, and we went ashore, and took breakfast near
+the large island with two villages on it, opposite the mouth of the
+Zungw&eacute;, where we had left the Zambesi on our way up.&nbsp; Mpand&eacute;
+was sorry that he had no canoes of his own to sell, but he would lend
+us two.&nbsp; He gave us cooked pumpkins and a water-melon.&nbsp; His
+servant had lateral curvature of the spine.&nbsp; We have often seen
+cases of humpback, but this was the only case of this kind of curvature
+we had met with.&nbsp; Mpand&eacute; accompanied us himself in his own
+vessel, till we had an opportunity of purchasing a fine large canoe
+elsewhere.&nbsp; We paid what was considered a large price for it: twelve
+strings of blue cut glass neck beads, an equal number of large blue
+ones of the size of marbles, and two yards of grey calico.&nbsp; Had
+the beads been coarser, they would have been more valued, because such
+were in fashion.&nbsp; Before concluding the bargain the owner said
+&ldquo;his bowels yearned for his canoe, and we must give a little more
+to stop their yearning.&rdquo;&nbsp; This was irresistible.&nbsp; The
+trading party of Sequasha, which we now met, had purchased ten large
+new canoes for six strings of cheap coarse white beads each, or their
+equivalent, four yards of calico, and had bought for the merest trifle
+ivory enough to load them all.&nbsp; They were driving a trade in slaves
+also, which was something new in this part of Africa, and likely soon
+to change the character of the inhabitants.&nbsp; These men had been
+living in clover, and were uncommonly fat and plump.&nbsp; When sent
+to trade, slaves wisely never stint themselves of beer or anything else,
+which their master&rsquo;s goods can buy.</p>
+<p>The temperature of the Zambesi had increased 10 degrees since August,
+being now 80 degrees.&nbsp; The air was as high as 96 degrees after
+sunset; and, the vicinity of the water being the coolest part, we usually
+made our beds close by the river&rsquo;s brink, though there in danger
+of crocodiles.&nbsp; Africa differs from India in the air always becoming
+cool and refreshing long before the sun returns, and there can be no
+doubt that we can in this country bear exposure to the sun, which would
+be fatal in India.&nbsp; It is probably owing to the greater dryness
+of the African atmosphere that sunstroke is so rarely met with.&nbsp;
+In twenty-two years Dr. Livingstone never met or heard of a single case,
+though the protective head-dresses of India are rarely seen.</p>
+<p>When the water is nearly at its lowest, we occasionally meet with
+small rapids which are probably not in existence during the rest of
+the year.&nbsp; Having slept opposite the rivulet Bume, which comes
+from the south, we passed the island of Nakansalo, and went down the
+rapids of the same name on the 17th, and came on the morning of the
+19th to the more serious ones of Nakabel&eacute;, at the entrance to
+Kariba.&nbsp; The Makololo guided the canoes admirably through the opening
+in the dyke.&nbsp; When we entered the gorge we came on upwards of thirty
+hippopotami: a bank near the entrance stretches two-thirds across the
+narrowed river, and in the still place behind it they were swimming
+about.&nbsp; Several were in the channel, and our canoe-men were afraid
+to venture down among them, because, as they affirm, there is commonly
+an ill-natured one in a herd, which takes a malignant pleasure in upsetting
+canoes.&nbsp; Two or three boys on the rocks opposite amused themselves
+by throwing stones at the frightened animals, and hit several on the
+head.&nbsp; It would have been no difficult matter to have shot the
+whole herd.&nbsp; We fired a few shots to drive them off; the balls
+often glance off the skull, and no more harm is done than when a schoolboy
+gets a bloody nose; we killed one, which floated away down the rapid
+current, followed by a number of men on the bank.&nbsp; A native called
+to us from the left bank, and said that a man on his side knew how to
+pray to the Kariba gods, and advised us to hire him to pray for our
+safety, while we were going down the rapids, or we should certainly
+all be drowned.&nbsp; No one ever risked his life in Kariba without
+first paying the river-doctor, or priest, for his prayers.&nbsp; Our
+men asked if there was a cataract in front, but he declined giving any
+information; they were not on his side of the river; if they would come
+over, then he might be able to tell them.&nbsp; We crossed, but he went
+off to the village.&nbsp; We then landed and walked over the hills to
+have a look at Karaba before trusting our canoes in it.&nbsp; The current
+was strong, and there was broken water in some places, but the channel
+was nearly straight, and had no cataract, so we determined to risk it.&nbsp;
+Our men visited the village while we were gone, and were treated to
+beer and tobacco.&nbsp; The priest who knows how to pray to the god
+that rules the rapids followed us with several of his friends, and they
+were rather surprised to see us pass down in safety, without the aid
+of his intercession.&nbsp; The natives who followed the dead hippopotamus
+caught it a couple of miles below, and, having made it fast to a rock,
+were sitting waiting for us on the bank beside the dead animal.&nbsp;
+As there was a considerable current there, and the rocky banks were
+unfit for our beds, we took the hippopotamus in tow, telling the villagers
+to follow, and we would give them most of the meat.&nbsp; The crocodiles
+tugged so hard at the carcass, that we were soon obliged to cast it
+adrift, to float down in the current, to avoid upsetting the canoe.&nbsp;
+We had to go on so far before finding a suitable spot to spend the night
+in, that the natives concluded we did not intend to share the meat with
+them, and returned to the village.&nbsp; We slept two nights at the
+place where the hippopotamus was cut up.&nbsp; The crocodiles had a
+busy time of it in the dark, tearing away at what was left in the river,
+and thrashing the water furiously with their powerful tails.&nbsp; The
+hills on both sides of Kariba are much like those of Kebrabasa, the
+strata tilted and twisted in every direction, with no level ground.</p>
+<p>Although the hills confine the Zambesi within a narrow channel for
+a number of miles, there are no rapids beyond those near the entrance.&nbsp;
+The river is smooth and apparently very deep.&nbsp; Only one single
+human being was seen in the gorge, the country being too rough for culture.&nbsp;
+Some rocks in the water, near the outlet of Kariba, at a distance look
+like a fort; and such large masses dislocated, bent, and even twisted
+to a remarkable degree, at once attest some tremendous upheaving and
+convulsive action of nature, which probably caused Kebrabasa, Kariba,
+and the Victoria Falls to assume their present forms; it took place
+after the formation of the coal, that mineral having then been tilted
+up.&nbsp; We have probably nothing equal to it in the present quiet
+operations of nature.</p>
+<p>On emerging we pitched our camp by a small stream, the Pendel&eacute;,
+a few miles below the gorge.&nbsp; The Palabi mountain stands on the
+western side of the lower end of the Kariba strait; the range to which
+it belongs crosses the river, and runs to the south-east.&nbsp; Chikumbula,
+a hospitable old headman, under Nchomokela, the paramount chief of a
+large district, whom we did not see, brought us next morning a great
+basket of meal, and four fowls, with some beer, and a cake of salt,
+&ldquo;to make it taste good.&rdquo;&nbsp; Chikumbula said that the
+elephants plagued them, by eating up the cotton-plants; but his people
+seem to be well off.</p>
+<p>A few days before we came, they caught three buffaloes in pitfalls
+in one night, and, unable to eat them all, left one to rot.&nbsp; During
+the night the wind changed and blew from the dead buffalo to our sleeping-place;
+and a hungry lion, not at all dainty in his food, stirred up the putrid
+mass, and growled and gloated over his feast, to the disturbance of
+our slumbers.&nbsp; Game of all kinds is in most extraordinary abundance,
+especially from this point to below the Kafu&eacute;, and so it is on
+Moselekats&oacute;&rsquo;s side, where there are no inhabitants.&nbsp;
+The drought drives all the game to the river to drink.&nbsp; An hour&rsquo;s
+walk on the right bank, morning or evening, reveals a country swarming
+with wild animals: vast herds of pallahs, many waterbucks, koodoos,
+buffaloes, wild pigs, elands, zebras, and monkeys appear; francolins,
+guinea-fowls, and myriads of turtledoves attract the eye in the covers,
+with the fresh spoor of elephants and rhinoceroses, which had been at
+the river during the night.&nbsp; Every few miles we came upon a school
+of hippopotami, asleep on some shallow sandbank; their bodies, nearly
+all out of the water, appeared like masses of black rock in the river.&nbsp;
+When these animals are hunted much, they become proportionably wary,
+but here no hunter ever troubles them, and they repose in security,
+always however taking the precaution of sleeping just above the deep
+channel, into which they can plunge when alarmed.&nbsp; When a shot
+is fired into a sleeping herd, all start up on their feet, and stare
+with peculiar stolid looks of hippopotamic surprise, and wait for another
+shot before dashing into deep water.&nbsp; A few miles below Chikumbula&rsquo;s
+we saw a white hippopotamus in a herd.&nbsp; Our men had never seen
+one like it before.&nbsp; It was of a pinkish white, exactly like the
+colour of the Albino.&nbsp; It seemed to be the father of a number of
+others, for there were many marked with large light patches.&nbsp; The
+so-called <i>white</i> elephant is just such a pinkish Albino as this
+hippopotamus.&nbsp; A few miles above Kariba we observed that, in two
+small hamlets, many of the inhabitants had a similar affection of the
+skin.&nbsp; The same influence appeared to have affected man and beast.&nbsp;
+A dark coloured hippopotamus stood alone, as if expelled from the herd,
+and bit the water, shaking his head from side to side in a most frantic
+manner.&nbsp; When the female has twins, she is said to kill one of
+them.</p>
+<p>We touched at the beautiful tree-covered island of Kalabi, opposite
+where Tuba-mokoro lectured the lion in our way up.&nbsp; The ancestors
+of the people who now inhabit this island possessed cattle.&nbsp; The
+tsetse has taken possession of the country since &ldquo;the beeves were
+lifted.&rdquo;&nbsp; No one knows where these insects breed; at a certain
+season all disappear, and as suddenly come back, no one knows whence.&nbsp;
+The natives are such close observers of nature, that their ignorance
+in this case surprised us.&nbsp; A solitary hippopotamus had selected
+the little bay in which we landed, and where the women drew water, for
+his dwelling-place.&nbsp; Pretty little lizards, with light blue and
+red tails, run among the rocks, catching flies and other insects.&nbsp;
+These harmless&mdash;though to new-comers repulsive&mdash;creatures
+sometimes perform good service to man, by eating great numbers of the
+destructive white ants.</p>
+<p>At noon on the 24th October, we found Sequasha in a village below
+the Kafu&eacute;, with the main body of his people.&nbsp; He said that
+210 elephants had been killed during his trip; many of his men being
+excellent hunters.&nbsp; The numbers of animals we saw renders this
+possible.&nbsp; He reported that, after reaching the Kafu&eacute;, he
+went northwards into the country of the Zulus, whose ancestors formerly
+migrated from the south and set up a sort of Republican form of government.&nbsp;
+Sequasha is the greatest Portuguese traveller we ever became acquainted
+with, and he boasts that he is able to speak a dozen different dialects;
+yet, unfortunately, he can give but a very meagre account of the countries
+and people he has seen, and his statements are not very much to be relied
+on.&nbsp; But considering the influence among which he has been reared,
+and the want of the means of education at Tette, it is a wonder that
+he possesses the good traits that he sometimes exhibits.&nbsp; Among
+his wares were several cheap American clocks; a useless investment rather,
+for a part of Africa where no one cares for the artificial measurement
+of time.&nbsp; These clocks got him into trouble among the Banyai: he
+set them all agoing in the presence of a chief, who became frightened
+at the strange sounds they made, and looked upon them as so many witchcraft
+agencies at work to bring all manner of evils upon himself and his people.&nbsp;
+Sequasha, it was decided, had been guilty of a milando, or crime, and
+he had to pay a heavy fine of cloth and beads for his exhibition.&nbsp;
+He alluded to our having heard that he had killed Mpangw&eacute;, and
+he denied having actually done so; but in his absence his name had got
+mixed up in the affair, in consequence of his slaves, while drinking
+beer one night with Namakusuru, the man who succeeded Mpangw&eacute;,
+saying that they would kill the chief for him.&nbsp; His partner had
+not thought of this when we saw him on the way up, for he tried to excuse
+the murder, by saying that now they had put the right man into the chieftainship.</p>
+<p>After three hours&rsquo; sail, on the morning of the 29th, the river
+was narrowed again by the mountains of Mburuma, called Karivua, into
+one channel, and another rapid dimly appeared.&nbsp; It was formed by
+two currents guided by rocks to the centre.&nbsp; In going down it,
+the men sent by Sekeletu behaved very nobly.&nbsp; The canoes entered
+without previous survey, and the huge jobbling waves of mid-current
+began at once to fill them.&nbsp; With great presence of mind, and without
+a moment&rsquo;s hesitation, two men lightened each by jumping overboard;
+they then ordered a Botoka man to do the same, as &ldquo;the white men
+must be saved.&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;I cannot swim,&rdquo; said the Batoka.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;Jump out, then, and hold on to the canoe;&rdquo; which he instantly
+did.&nbsp; Swimming alongside, they guided the swamping canoes down
+the swift current to the foot of the rapid, and then ran them ashore
+to bale them out.&nbsp; A boat could have passed down safely, but our
+canoes were not a foot above the water at the gunwales.</p>
+<p>Thanks to the bravery of these poor fellows, nothing was lost, although
+everything was well soaked.&nbsp; This rapid is nearly opposite the
+west end of the Mburuma mountains or Karivua.&nbsp; Another soon begins
+below it.&nbsp; They are said to be all smoothed over when the river
+rises.&nbsp; The canoes had to be unloaded at this the worst rapid,
+and the goods carried about a hundred yards.&nbsp; By taking the time
+in which a piece of stick floated past 100 feet, we found the current
+to be running six knots, by far the greatest velocity noted in the river.&nbsp;
+As the men were bringing the last canoe down close to the shore, the
+stern swung round into the current, and all except one man let go, rather
+than be dragged off.&nbsp; He clung to the bow, and was swept out into
+the middle of the stream.&nbsp; Having held on when he ought to have
+let go, he next put his life in jeopardy by letting go when he ought
+to have held on; and was in a few seconds swallowed up by a fearful
+whirlpool.&nbsp; His comrades launched out a canoe below, and caught
+him as he rose the third time to the surface, and saved him, though
+much exhausted and very cold.</p>
+<p>The scenery of this pass reminded us of Kebrabasa, although it is
+much inferior.&nbsp; A band of the same black shining glaze runs along
+the rocks about two feet from the water&rsquo;s edge.&nbsp; There was
+not a blade of grass on some of the hills, it being the end of the usual
+dry season succeeding a previous severe drought; yet the hill-sides
+were dotted over with beautiful green trees.&nbsp; A few antelopes were
+seen on the rugged slopes, where some people too appeared lying down,
+taking a cup of beer.&nbsp; The Karivua narrows are about thirty miles
+in length.&nbsp; They end at the mountain Roganora.&nbsp; Two rocks,
+twelve or fifteen feet above the water at the time we were there, may
+in flood be covered and dangerous.&nbsp; Our chief danger was the wind,
+a very slight ripple being sufficient to swamp canoes.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER IX.</h3>
+<p>The waterbuck&mdash;Disaster in Kebrabasa rapids&mdash;The &ldquo;Ma
+Robert&rdquo; founders&mdash;Arrival of the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; and
+Bishop Mackenzie&rsquo;s party&mdash;Portuguese slave-trade&mdash;Interference
+and liberation.</p>
+<p>We arrived at Zumbo, at the mouth of the Loangwa, on the 1st of November.&nbsp;
+The water being scarcely up to the knee, our land party waded this river
+with ease.&nbsp; A buffalo was shot on an island opposite Pangola&rsquo;s,
+the ball lodging in the spleen.&nbsp; It was found to have been wounded
+in the same organ previously, for an iron bullet was imbedded in it,
+and the wound entirely healed.&nbsp; A great deal of the plant <i>Pistia
+stratiotes</i> was seen floating in the river.&nbsp; Many people inhabit
+the right bank about this part, yet the game is very abundant.</p>
+<p>As we were taking our breakfast on the morning of the 2nd, the Mambo
+Kazai, of whom we knew nothing, and his men came with their muskets
+and large powder-horns to levy a fine, and obtain payment for the wood
+we used in cooking.&nbsp; But on our replying to his demand that we
+were English, &ldquo;Oh! are you?&rdquo; he said; &ldquo;I thought you
+were Bazungu (Portuguese).&nbsp; They are the people I take payments
+from:&rdquo; and he apologized for his mistake.&nbsp; Bazungu, or Azungu,
+is a term applied to all foreigners of a light colour, and to Arabs;
+even to trading slaves if clothed; it probably means foreigners, or
+visitors,&mdash;from <i>zunga</i>, to visit or wander,&mdash;and the
+Portuguese were the only foreigners these men had ever seen.&nbsp; As
+we had no desire to pass for people of that nation&mdash;quite the contrary&mdash;we
+usually made a broad line of demarcation by saying that we were English,
+and the English neither bought, sold, nor held black people as slaves,
+but wished to put a stop to the slave-trade altogether.</p>
+<p>We called upon our friend, Mpend&eacute;, in passing.&nbsp; He provided
+a hut for us, with new mats spread on the floor.&nbsp; Having told him
+that we were hurrying on because the rains were near, &ldquo;Are they
+near?&rdquo; eagerly inquired an old counsellor, &ldquo;and are we to
+have plenty of rain this year?&rdquo;&nbsp; We could only say that it
+was about the usual time for the rains to commence; and that there were
+the usual indications in great abundance of clouds floating westwards,
+but that we knew nothing more than they did themselves.</p>
+<p>The hippopotami are more wary here than higher up, as the natives
+hunt them with guns.&nbsp; Having shot one on a shallow sandbank, our
+men undertook to bring it over to the left bank, in order to cut it
+up with greater ease.&nbsp; It was a fine fat one, and all rejoiced
+in the hope of eating the fat for butter, with our hard dry cakes of
+native meal.&nbsp; Our cook was sent over to cut a choice piece for
+dinner, but returned with the astonishing intelligence that the carcass
+was gone.&nbsp; They had been hoodwinked, and were very much ashamed
+of themselves.&nbsp; A number of Banyai came to assist in rolling it
+ashore, and asserted that it was all shallow water.&nbsp; They rolled
+it over and over towards the land, and, finding the rope we had made
+fast to it, as they said, an encumbrance, it was unloosed.&nbsp; All
+were shouting and talking as loud as they could bawl, when suddenly
+our expected feast plumped into a deep hole, as the Banyai intended
+it should do.&nbsp; When sinking, all the Makololo jumped in after it.&nbsp;
+One caught frantically at the tail; another grasped a foot; a third
+seized the hip; &ldquo;but, by Sebituan&egrave;, it would go down in
+spite of all that we could do.&rdquo;&nbsp; Instead of a fat hippopotamus
+we had only a lean fowl for dinner, and were glad enough to get even
+that.&nbsp; The hippopotamus, however, floated during the night, and
+was found about a mile below.&nbsp; The Banyai then assembled on the
+bank, and disputed our right to the beast: &ldquo;It might have been
+shot by somebody else.&rdquo;&nbsp; Our men took a little of it and
+then left it, rather than come into collision with them.</p>
+<p>A fine waterbuck was shot in the Kakolol&eacute; narrows, at Mount
+Manyerer&eacute;; it dropped beside the creek where it was feeding;
+an enormous crocodile, that had been watching it at the moment, seized
+and dragged it into the water, which was not very deep.&nbsp; The mortally
+wounded animal made a desperate plunge, and hauling the crocodile several
+yards tore itself out of the hideous jaws.&nbsp; To escape the hunter,
+the waterbuck jumped into the river, and was swimming across, when another
+crocodile gave chase, but a ball soon sent it to the bottom.&nbsp; The
+waterbuck swam a little longer, the fine head dropped, the body turned
+over, and one of the canoes dragged it ashore.&nbsp; Below Kakolol&eacute;,
+and still at the base of Manyerer&eacute; mountain, several coal-seams,
+not noticed on our ascent, were now seen to crop out on the right bank
+of the Zambesi.</p>
+<p>Chitora, of Chicova, treated us with his former hospitality.&nbsp;
+Our men were all much pleased with his kindness, and certainly did not
+look upon it as a proof of weakness.&nbsp; They meant to return his
+friendliness when they came this way on a marauding expedition to eat
+the sheep of the Banyai, for insulting them in the affair of the hippopotamus;
+they would then send word to Chitora not to run away, for they, being
+his friends, would do such a good-hearted man no harm.</p>
+<p>We entered Kebrabasa rapids, at the east end of Chicova, in the canoes,
+and went down a number of miles, until the river narrowed into a groove
+of fifty or sixty yards wide, of which we have already spoken in describing
+the flood-bed and channel of low water.&nbsp; The navigation then became
+difficult and dangerous.&nbsp; A fifteen feet fall of the water in our
+absence had developed many cataracts.&nbsp; Two of our canoes passed
+safely down a narrow channel, which, bifurcating, had an ugly whirlpool
+at the rocky partition between the two branches, the deep hole in the
+whirls at times opening and then shutting.&nbsp; The Doctor&rsquo;s
+canoe came next, and seemed to be drifting broadside into the open vortex,
+in spite of the utmost exertions of the paddlers.&nbsp; The rest were
+expecting to have to pull to the rescue; the men saying, &ldquo;Look
+where these people are going!&mdash;look, look!&rdquo;&mdash;when a
+loud crash burst on our ears.&nbsp; Dr. Kirk&rsquo;s canoe was dashed
+on a projection of the perpendicular rocks, by a sudden and mysterious
+boiling up of the river, which occurs at irregular intervals.&nbsp;
+Dr. Kirk was seen resisting the sucking-down action of the water, which
+must have been fifteen fathoms deep, and raising himself by his arms
+on to the ledge, while his steersman, holding on to the same rocks,
+saved the canoe; but nearly all its contents were swept away down the
+stream.&nbsp; Dr. Livingstone&rsquo;s canoe, meanwhile, which had distracted
+the men&rsquo;s attention, was saved by the cavity in the whirlpool
+filling up as the frightful eddy was reached.&nbsp; A few of the things
+in Dr. Kirk&rsquo;s canoe were left; but all that was valuable, including
+a chronometer, a barometer, and, to our great sorrow, his notes of the
+journey and botanical drawings of the fruit-trees of the interior, perished.</p>
+<p>We now left the river, and proceeded on foot, sorry that we had not
+done so the day before.&nbsp; The men were thoroughly frightened, they
+had never seen such perilous navigation.&nbsp; They would carry all
+the loads, rather than risk Kebrabasa any longer; but the fatigue of
+a day&rsquo;s march over the hot rocks and burning sand changed their
+tune before night; and then they regretted having left the canoes; they
+thought they should have dragged them past the dangerous places, and
+then launched them again.&nbsp; One of the two donkeys died from exhaustion
+near the Luia.&nbsp; Though the men eat zebras and quaggas, blood relations
+of the donkey, they were shocked at the idea of eating the ass; &ldquo;it
+would be like eating man himself, because the donkey lives with man,
+and is his bosom companion.&rdquo;&nbsp; We met two large trading parties
+of Tette slaves on their way to Zumbo, leading, to be sold for ivory,
+a number of Manganja women, with ropes round their necks, and all made
+fast to one long rope.</p>
+<p>Panzo, the headman of the village east of Kebrabasa, received us
+with great kindness.&nbsp; After the usual salutation he went up the
+hill, and, in a loud voice, called across the valley to the women of
+several hamlets to cook supper for us.&nbsp; About eight in the evening
+he returned, followed by a procession of women, bringing the food.&nbsp;
+There were eight dishes of nsima, or porridge, six of different sorts
+of very good wild vegetables, with dishes of beans and fowls; all deliciously
+well cooked, and scrupulously clean.&nbsp; The wooden dishes were nearly
+as white as the meal itself: food also was brought for our men.&nbsp;
+Ripe mangoes, which usually indicate the vicinity of the Portuguese,
+were found on the 21st November; and we reached Tette early on the 23rd,
+having been absent a little over six months.</p>
+<p>The two English sailors, left in charge of the steamer, were well,
+had behaved well, and had enjoyed excellent health all the time we were
+away.&nbsp; Their farm had been a failure.&nbsp; We left a few sheep,
+to be slaughtered when they wished for fresh meat, and two dozen fowls.&nbsp;
+Purchasing more, they soon had double the number of the latter, and
+anticipated a good supply of eggs; but they also bought two monkeys,
+and <i>they</i> ate all the eggs.&nbsp; A hippopotamus came up one night,
+and laid waste their vegetable garden; the sheep broke into their cotton
+patch, when it was in flower, and ate it all, except the stems; then
+the crocodiles carried off the sheep, and the natives stole the fowls.&nbsp;
+Nor were they more successful as gun-smiths: a Portuguese trader, having
+an exalted opinion of the ingenuity of English sailors, showed them
+a double-barrelled rifle, and inquired if they could put on the <i>browning</i>,
+which had rusted off.&nbsp; &ldquo;I think I knows how,&rdquo; said
+one, whose father was a blacksmith, &ldquo;it&rsquo;s very easy; you
+have only to put the barrels in the fire.&rdquo;&nbsp; A great fire
+of wood was made on shore, and the unlucky barrels put over it, to secure
+the handsome rifle colour.&nbsp; To Jack&rsquo;s utter amazement the
+barrels came asunder.&nbsp; To get out of the scrape, his companion
+and he stuck the pieces together with resin, and sent it to the owner,
+with the message, &ldquo;It was all they could do for it, and they would
+not charge him anything for the job!&rdquo;&nbsp; They had also invented
+an original mode of settling a bargain; having ascertained the market
+price of provisions, they paid that, but no more.&nbsp; If the traders
+refused to leave the ship till the price was increased, a chameleon,
+of which the natives have a mortal dread, was brought out of the cabin;
+and the moment the natives saw the creature, they at once sprang overboard.&nbsp;
+The chameleon settled every dispute in a twinkling.</p>
+<p>But besides their good-humoured intercourse, they showed humanity
+worthy of English sailors.&nbsp; A terrible scream roused them up one
+night, and they pushed off in a boat to the rescue.&nbsp; A crocodile
+had caught a woman, and was dragging her across a shallow sandbank.&nbsp;
+Just as they came up to her, she gave a fearful shriek: the horrid reptile
+had snapped off her leg at the knee.&nbsp; They took her on board, bandaged
+the limb as well as they could, and, not thinking of any better way
+of showing their sympathy, gave her a glass of rum, and carried her
+to a hut in the village.&nbsp; Next morning they found the bandages
+torn off, and the unfortunate creature left to die.&nbsp; &ldquo;I believe,&rdquo;
+remarked Rowe, one of the sailors, &ldquo;her master was angry with
+us for saving her life, seeing as how she had lost her leg.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>The Zambesi being unusually low, we remained at Tette till it rose
+a little, and then left on the 3rd of December for the Kongon&eacute;.&nbsp;
+It was hard work to keep the vessel afloat; indeed, we never expected
+her to remain above water.&nbsp; New leaks broke out every day; the
+engine pump gave way; the bridge broke down; three compartments filled
+at night; except the cabin and front compartment all was flooded; and
+in a few days we were assured by Rowe that &ldquo;she can&rsquo;t be
+worse than she is, sir.&rdquo;&nbsp; He and Hutchins had spent much
+of their time, while we were away, in patching her bottom, puddling
+it with clay, and shoring it, and it was chiefly to please them that
+we again attempted to make use of her.&nbsp; We had long been fully
+convinced that the steel plates were thoroughly unsuitable.&nbsp; On
+the morning of the 21st the uncomfortable &ldquo;Asthmatic&rdquo; grounded
+on a sandbank and filled.&nbsp; She could neither be emptied nor got
+off.&nbsp; The river rose during the night, and all that was visible
+of the worn-out craft next day was about six feet of her two masts.&nbsp;
+Most of the property we had on board was saved; and we spent the Christmas
+of 1860 encamped on the island of Chimba.&nbsp; Canoes were sent for
+from Senna; and we reached it on the 27th, to be again hospitably entertained
+by our friend, Senhor Ferr&atilde;o.</p>
+<p>We reached the Kongon&eacute; on the 4th of January, 1861.&nbsp;
+A flagstaff and a Custom-house had been erected during our absence;
+a hut, also, for a black lance-corporal and three privates.&nbsp; By
+the kind permission of the lance-corporal, who came to see us as soon
+as he had got into his trousers and shirt, we took up our quarters in
+the Custom-house, which, like the other buildings, is a small square
+floorless hut of mangrove stakes overlaid with reeds.&nbsp; The soldiers
+complained of hunger, they had nothing to eat but a little mapira, and
+were making palm wine to deaden their cravings.&nbsp; While waiting
+for a ship, we had leisure to read the newspapers and periodicals we
+found in the mail which was waiting our arrival at Tette.&nbsp; Several
+were a year and a half old.</p>
+<p>Our provisions began to run short; and towards the end of the month
+there was nothing left but a little bad biscuit and a few ounces of
+sugar.&nbsp; Coffee and tea were expended, but scarcely missed, as our
+sailors discovered a pretty good substitute in roasted mapira.&nbsp;
+Fresh meat was obtained in abundance from our antelope preserves on
+the large island made by a creek between the Kongon&eacute; and East
+Luabo.</p>
+<p>In this focus of decaying vegetation, nothing is so much to be dreaded
+as inactivity.&nbsp; We had, therefore, to find what exercise and amusement
+we could, when hunting was not required, in peering about in the fetid
+swamps; to have gone mooning about, in listless idleness, would have
+ensured fever in its worst form, and probably with fatal results.</p>
+<p>A curious little blenny-fish swarms in the numerous creeks which
+intersect the mangrove topes.&nbsp; When alarmed, it hurries across
+the surface of the water in a series of leaps.&nbsp; It may be considered
+amphibious, as it lives as much out of the water as in it, and its most
+busy time is during low water.&nbsp; Then it appears on the sand or
+mud, near the little pools left by the retiring tide; it raises itself
+on its pectoral fins into something of a standing attitude, and with
+its large projecting eyes keeps a sharp look-out for the light-coloured
+fly, on which it feeds.&nbsp; Should the fly alight at too great a distance
+for even a second leap, the blenny moves slowly towards it like a cat
+to its prey, or like a jumping spider; and, as soon as it gets within
+two or three inches of the insect, by a sudden spring contrives to pop
+its underset mouth directly over the unlucky victim.&nbsp; He is, moreover,
+a pugnacious little fellow; and rather prolonged fights may be observed
+between him and his brethren.&nbsp; One, in fleeing from an apparent
+danger, jumped into a pool a foot square, which the other evidently
+regarded as his by right of prior discovery; in a twinkling the owner,
+with eyes flashing fury, and with dorsal fin bristling up in rage, dashed
+at the intruding foe.&nbsp; The fight waxed furious, no tempest in a
+teapot ever equalled the storm of that miniature sea.&nbsp; The warriors
+were now in the water, and anon out of it, for the battle raged on sea
+and shore.&nbsp; They struck hard, they bit each other; until, becoming
+exhausted, they seized each other by the jaws like two bull-dogs, then
+paused for breath, and at it again as fiercely as before, until the
+combat ended by the precipitate retreat of the invader.</p>
+<p>The muddy ground under the mangrove-trees is covered with soldier-crabs,
+which quickly slink into their holes on any symptom of danger.&nbsp;
+When the ebbing tide retires, myriads of minute crabs emerge from their
+underground quarters, and begin to work like so many busy bees.&nbsp;
+Soon many miles of the smooth sand become rough with the results of
+their labour.&nbsp; They are toiling for their daily bread: a round
+bit of moist sand appears at the little labourer&rsquo;s mouth, and
+is quickly brushed off by one of the claws; a second bit follows the
+first; and another, and still another come as fast as they can be laid
+aside.&nbsp; As these pellets accumulate, the crab moves sideways, and
+the work continues.&nbsp; The first impression one receives is, that
+the little creature has swallowed a great deal of sand, and is getting
+rid of it as speedily as possible: a habit he indulges in of darting
+into his hole at intervals, as if for fresh supplies, tends to strengthen
+this idea; but the size of the heaps formed in a few seconds shows that
+this cannot be the case, and leads to the impression that, although
+not readily seen, at the distance at which he chooses to keep the observer,
+yet that possibly he raises the sand to his mouth, where whatever animalcule
+it may contain is sifted out of it, and the remainder rejected in the
+manner described.&nbsp; At times the larger species of crabs perform
+a sort of concert; and from each subterranean abode strange sounds arise,
+as if, in imitation of the songsters of the groves, for very joy they
+sang!</p>
+<p>We found some natives pounding the woody stems of a poisonous climbing-plant
+(<i>Dirca palustris</i>) called Busungu, or poison, which grows abundantly
+in the swamps.&nbsp; When a good quantity was bruised, it was tied up
+in bundles.&nbsp; The stream above and below was obstructed with bushes,
+and with a sort of rinsing motion the poison was diffused through the
+water.&nbsp; Many fish were soon affected, swain in shore, and died,
+others were only stupefied.&nbsp; The plant has pink, pea-shaped blossoms,
+and smooth, pointed, glossy leaves, and the brown bark is covered with
+minute white points.&nbsp; The knowledge of it might prove of use to
+a shipwrecked party by enabling them to catch the fish.</p>
+<p>The poison is said to be deleterious to man if the water is drunk;
+but not when the fish is cooked.&nbsp; The Busungu is repulsive to some
+insects, and is smeared round the shoots of the palm-trees to prevent
+the ants from getting into the palm wine while it is dropping from the
+tops of the palm-trees into the little pots suspended to collect it.</p>
+<p>We were in the habit of walking from our beds into the salt water
+at sunrise, for a bath, till a large crocodile appeared at the bathing-place,
+and from that time forth we took our dip in the sea, away from the harbour,
+about midday.&nbsp; This is said to be unwholesome, but we did not find
+it so.&nbsp; It is certainly better not to bathe in the mornings, when
+the air is colder than the water&mdash;for then, on returning to the
+cooler air, one is apt to get a chill and fever.&nbsp; In the mouth
+of the river, many saw-fish are found.&nbsp; Rowe saw one while bathing&mdash;caught
+it by the tail, and shoved it, &ldquo;snout on,&rdquo; ashore.&nbsp;
+The saw is from a foot to eighteen inches long.&nbsp; We never heard
+of any one being wounded by this fish; nor, though it goes hundreds
+of miles up the river in fresh water, could we learn that it was eaten
+by the people.&nbsp; The hippopotami delighted to spend the day among
+the breakers, and seemed to enjoy the fun as much as we did.</p>
+<p>Severe gales occurred during our stay on the Coast, and many small
+sea-birds (<i>Prion Banksii</i>, Smith) perished: the beach was strewn
+with their dead bodies, and some were found hundreds of yards inland;
+many were so emaciated as to dry up without putrefying.&nbsp; We were
+plagued with myriads of mosquitoes, and had some touches of fever; the
+men we brought from malarious regions of the interior suffered almost
+as much from it here as we did ourselves.&nbsp; This gives strength
+to the idea that the civilized withstand the evil influences of strange
+climates better than the uncivilized.&nbsp; When negroes return to their
+own country from healthy lands, they suffer as severely as foreigners
+ever do.</p>
+<p>On the 31st of January, 1861, our new ship, the &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo;
+arrived from England, and anchored outside the bar; but the weather
+was stormy, and she did not venture in till the 4th of February.</p>
+<p>Two of H.M. cruisers came at the same time, bringing Bishop Mackenzie,
+and the Oxford and Cambridge Mission to the tribes of the Shir&eacute;
+and Lake Nyassa.&nbsp; The Mission consisted of six Englishmen, and
+five coloured men from the Cape.&nbsp; It was a puzzle to know what
+to do with so many men.&nbsp; The estimable Bishop, anxious to commence
+his work without delay, wished the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; to carry the
+Mission up the Shir&eacute;, as far as Chibisa&rsquo;s, and there leave
+them.&nbsp; But there were grave objections to this.&nbsp; The &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo;
+was under orders to explore the Rovuma, as the Portuguese Government
+had refused to open the Zambesi to the ships of other nations, and their
+officials were very effectually pursuing a system, which, by abstracting
+the labour, was rendering the country of no value either to foreigners
+or to themselves.&nbsp; She was already two months behind her time,
+and the rainy season was half over.&nbsp; Then, if the party were taken
+to Chibisa&rsquo;s, the Mission would he left without a medical attendant,
+in an unhealthy region, at the beginning of the most sickly season of
+the year, and without means of reaching the healthy highlands, or of
+returning to the sea.&nbsp; We dreaded that, in the absence of medical
+aid and all knowledge of the treatment of fever, there might be a repetition
+of the sorrowful fate which befell the similar non-medical Mission at
+Linyanti.</p>
+<p>On the 25th of February the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; anchored in the
+mouth of the Rovuma, which, unlike most African rivers, has a magnificent
+bay and no bar.&nbsp; We wooded, and then waited for the Bishop till
+the 9th of March, when he came in the &ldquo;Lyra.&rdquo;&nbsp; On the
+11th we proceeded up the river, and saw that it had fallen four or five
+feet during our detention.&nbsp; The scenery on the lower part of the
+Rovuma is superior to that on the Zambesi, for we can see the highlands
+from the sea.&nbsp; Eight miles from the mouth the mangroves are left
+behind, and a beautiful range of well-wooded hills on each bank begins.&nbsp;
+On these ridges the tree resembling African blackwood, of finer grain
+than ebony, grows abundantly, and attains a large size.&nbsp; Few people
+were seen, and those were of Arab breed, and did not appear to be very
+well off.&nbsp; The current of the Rovuma was now as strong as that
+of the Zambesi, but the volume of water is very much less.&nbsp; Several
+of the crossings had barely water enough for our ship, drawing five
+feet, to pass.&nbsp; When we were thirty miles up the river, the water
+fell suddenly seven inches in twenty-four hours.&nbsp; As the March
+flood is the last of the season, and it appeared to be expended, it
+was thought prudent to avoid the chance of a year&rsquo;s detention,
+by getting the ship back to the sea without delay.&nbsp; Had the Expedition
+been alone, we would have pushed up in boats, or afoot, and done what
+we could towards the exploration of the river and upper end of the lake;
+but, though the Mission was a private one, and entirely distinct from
+our own, a public one, the objects of both being similar, we felt anxious
+to aid our countrymen in their noble enterprise; and, rather than follow
+our own inclination, decided to return to the Shir&eacute;, see the
+Mission party settled safely, and afterwards explore Lake Nyassa and
+the Rovuma, from the Lake downwards.&nbsp; Fever broke out on board
+the &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo; at the mouth of the Rovuma, as we thought
+from our having anchored close to a creek coming out of the mangroves;
+and it remained in her until we completely isolated the engine-room
+from the rest of the ship.&nbsp; The coal-dust rotting sent out strong
+effluvia, and kept up the disease for more than a twelvemonth.</p>
+<p>Soon after we started the fever put the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; almost
+entirely into the hands of the original Zambesi Expedition, and not
+long afterwards the leader had to navigate the ocean as well as the
+river.&nbsp; The habit of finding the geographical positions on land
+renders it an easy task to steer a steamer with only three or four sails
+at sea; where, if one does not run ashore, no one follows to find out
+an error, and where a current affords a ready excuse for every blunder.</p>
+<p>Touching at Mohilla, one of the Comoro Islands, on our return, we
+found a mixed race of Arabs, Africans, and their conquerors, the natives
+of Madagascar.&nbsp; Being Mahometans, they have mosques and schools,
+in which we were pleased to see girls as well as boys taught to read
+the Koran.&nbsp; The teacher said he was paid by the job, and received
+ten dollars for teaching each child to read.&nbsp; The clever ones learn
+in six months; but the dull ones take a couple of years.&nbsp; We next
+went over to Johanna for our friends; and, after a sojourn of a few
+days at the beautiful Comoro Islands, we sailed for the Kongon&eacute;
+mouth of the Zambesi with Bishop Mackenzie and his party.&nbsp; We reached
+the coast in seven days, and passed up the Zambesi to the Shir&eacute;.</p>
+<p>The &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo; constructed under the skilful supervision
+of Admiral Sir Baldwin Walker and the late Admiral Washington, warm-hearted
+and highly esteemed friends of the Expedition, was a very superior vessel,
+and well suited for our work in every respect, except in her draught
+of water.&nbsp; Five feet were found to be too much for the navigation
+of the upper part of the Shir&eacute;.&nbsp; Designed to draw three
+feet only, the weight necessary to impart extra strength, and fit her
+for the ocean, brought her down two feet more, and caused us a great
+deal of hard and vexatious work, in laying out anchors, and toiling
+at the capstan to get her off sandbanks.&nbsp; We should not have minded
+this much, but for the heavy loss of time which might have been more
+profitably, and infinitely more pleasantly, spent in intercourse with
+the people, exploring new regions, and otherwise carrying out the objects
+of the Expedition.&nbsp; Once we were a fortnight on a bank of soft
+yielding sand, having only two or three inches less water than the ship
+drew; this delay was occasioned by the anchors coming home, and the
+current swinging the ship broadside on the bank, which, immediately
+on our touching, always formed behind us.&nbsp; We did not like to leave
+the ship short of Chibisa&rsquo;s, lest the crew should suffer from
+the malaria of the lowland around; and it would have been difficult
+to have got the Mission goods carried up.&nbsp; We were daily visited
+by crowds of natives, who brought us abundance of provisions far beyond
+our ability to consume.&nbsp; In hauling the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; over
+the shallow places, the Bishop, with Horace Waller and Mr. Scudamore,
+were ever ready and anxious to lend a hand, and worked as hard as any
+on board.&nbsp; Had our fine little ship drawn but three feet, she could
+have run up and down the river at any time of the year with the greatest
+ease, but as it was, having once passed up over a few shallow banks,
+it was impossible to take her down again until the river rose in December.&nbsp;
+She could go up over a bank, but not come down over it, as a heap of
+sand always formed instantly astern, while the current washed it away
+from under her bows.</p>
+<p>On at last reaching Chibisa&rsquo;s, we heard that there was war
+in the Manganja country, and the slave-trade was going on briskly.&nbsp;
+A deputation from a chief near Mount Zomba had just passed on its way
+to Chibisa, who was in a distant village, to implore him to come himself,
+or send medicine, to drive off the Waiao, Waiau, or Ajawa, whose marauding
+parties were desolating the land.&nbsp; A large gang of recently enslaved
+Manganja crossed the river, on their way to Tette, a few days before
+we got the ship up.&nbsp; Chibisa&rsquo;s deputy was civil, and readily
+gave us permission to hire as many men to carry the Bishop&rsquo;s goods
+up to the hills as were willing to go.&nbsp; With a sufficient number,
+therefore, we started for the highlands on the 15th of July, to show
+the Bishop the country, which, from its altitude and coolness, was most
+suitable for a station.&nbsp; Our first day&rsquo;s march was a long
+and fatiguing one.&nbsp; The few hamlets we passed were poor, and had
+no food for our men, and we were obliged to go on till 4 p.m., when
+we entered the small village of Chipindu.&nbsp; The inhabitants complained
+of hunger, and said they had no food to sell, and no hut for us to sleep
+in; but, if we would only go on a little further, we should come to
+a village where they had plenty to eat; but we had travelled far enough,
+and determined to remain where we were.&nbsp; Before sunset as much
+food was brought as we cared to purchase, and, as it threatened to rain,
+huts were provided for the whole party.</p>
+<p>Next forenoon we halted at the village of our old friend Mbam&eacute;,
+to obtain new carriers, because Chibisa&rsquo;s men, never before having
+been hired, and not having yet learned to trust us, did not choose to
+go further.&nbsp; After resting a little, Mbam&eacute; told us that
+a slave party on its way to Tette would presently pass through his village.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;Shall we interfere?&rdquo; we inquired of each other.&nbsp; We
+remembered that all our valuable private baggage was in Tette, which,
+if we freed the slaves, might, together with some Government property,
+be destroyed in retaliation; but this system of slave-hunters dogging
+us where previously they durst not venture, and, on pretence of being
+&ldquo;our children,&rdquo; setting one tribe against another, to furnish
+themselves with slaves, would so inevitably thwart all the efforts,
+for which we had the sanction of the Portuguese Government, that we
+resolved to run all risks, and put a stop, if possible, to the slave-trade,
+which had now followed on the footsteps of our discoveries.&nbsp; A
+few minutes after Mbam&eacute; had spoken to us, the slave party, a
+long line of manacled men, women, and children, came wending their way
+round the hill and into the valley, on the side of which the village
+stood.&nbsp; The black drivers, armed with muskets, and bedecked with
+various articles of finery, marched jauntily in the front, middle, and
+rear of the line; some of them blowing exultant notes out of long tin
+horns.&nbsp; They seemed to feel that they were doing a very noble thing,
+and might proudly march with an air of triumph.&nbsp; But the instant
+the fellows caught a glimpse of the English, they darted off like mad
+into the forest; so fast, indeed, that we caught but a glimpse of their
+red caps and the soles of their feet.&nbsp; The chief of the party alone
+remained; and he, from being in front, had his hand tightly grasped
+by a Makololo!&nbsp; He proved to be a well-known slave of the late
+Commandant at Tette, and for some time our own attendant while there.&nbsp;
+On asking him how he obtained these captives, he replied he had bought
+them; but on our inquiring of the people themselves, all, save four,
+said they had been captured in war.&nbsp; While this inquiry was going
+on, he bolted too.&nbsp; The captives knelt down, and, in their way
+of expressing thanks, clapped their hands with great energy.&nbsp; They
+were thus left entirely on our hands, and knives were soon busy at work
+cutting the women and children loose.&nbsp; It was more difficult to
+cut the men adrift, as each had his neck in the fork of a stout stick,
+six or seven feet long, and was kept in by an iron rod which was riveted
+at both ends across the throat.&nbsp; With a saw, luckily in the Bishop&rsquo;s
+baggage, one by one the men were sawn out into freedom.&nbsp; The women,
+on being told to take the meal they were carrying and cook breakfast
+for themselves and the children, seemed to consider the news too good
+to be true; but after a little coaxing went at it with alacrity, and
+made a capital fire by which to boil their pots with the slave sticks
+and bonds, their old acquaintances through many a sad night and weary
+day.&nbsp; Many were mere children about five years of age and under.&nbsp;
+One little boy, with the simplicity of childhood, said to our men, &ldquo;The
+others tied and starved us, you cut the ropes and tell us to eat; what
+sort of people are you?&mdash;Where did you come from?&rdquo;&nbsp;
+Two of the women had been shot the day before for attempting to untie
+the thongs.&nbsp; This, the rest were told, was to prevent them from
+attempting to escape.&nbsp; One woman had her infant&rsquo;s brains
+knocked out, because she could not carry her load and it.&nbsp; And
+a man was dispatched with an axe, because he had broken down with fatigue.&nbsp;
+Self-interest would have set a watch over the whole rather than commit
+murder; but in this traffic we invariably find self-interest overcome
+by contempt of human life and by bloodthirstiness.</p>
+<p>The Bishop was not present at this scene, having gone to bathe in
+a little stream below the village; but on his return he warmly approved
+of what had been done; he at first had doubts, but now felt that, had
+he been present, he would have joined us in the good work.&nbsp; Logic
+is out of place when the question with a true-hearted man is, whether
+his brother man is to be saved or not.&nbsp; Eighty-four, chiefly women
+and children, were liberated; and on being told that they were now free,
+and might go where they pleased, or remain with us, they all chose to
+stay; and the Bishop wisely attached them to his Mission, to be educated
+as members of a Christian family.&nbsp; In this way a great difficulty
+in the commencement of a Mission was overcome.&nbsp; Years are usually
+required before confidence is so far instilled into the natives&rsquo;
+mind as to induce them, young or old, to submit to the guidance of strangers
+professing to be actuated by motives the reverse of worldly wisdom,
+and inculcating customs strange and unknown to them and their fathers.</p>
+<p>We proceeded next morning to Soch&eacute;&rsquo;s with our liberated
+party, the men cheerfully carrying the Bishop&rsquo;s goods.&nbsp; As
+we had begun, it was of no use to do things by halves, so eight others
+were freed in a hamlet on our path; but a party of traders, with nearly
+a hundred slaves, fled from Soch&eacute;&rsquo;s on hearing of our proceedings.&nbsp;
+Dr. Kirk and four Makololo followed them with great energy, but they
+made clear off to Tette.&nbsp; Six more captives were liberated at Mongazi&rsquo;s,
+and two slave-traders detained for the night, to prevent them from carrying
+information to a large party still in front.&nbsp; Of their own accord
+they volunteered the information that the Governor&rsquo;s servants
+had charge of the next party; but we did not choose to be led by them,
+though they offered to guide us to his Excellency&rsquo;s own agents.&nbsp;
+Two of the Bishop&rsquo;s black men from the Cape, having once been
+slaves, were now zealous emancipators, and volunteered to guard the
+prisoners during the night.&nbsp; So anxious were our heroes to keep
+them safe, that instead of relieving each other, by keeping watch and
+watch, both kept watch together, till towards four o&rsquo;clock in
+the morning, when sleep stole gently over them both; and the wakeful
+prisoners, seizing the opportunity, escaped: one of the guards, perceiving
+the loss, rushed out of the hut, shouting, &ldquo;They are gone, the
+prisoners are off, and they have taken my rifle with them, and the women
+too!&nbsp; Fire! everybody fire!&rdquo;&nbsp; The rifle and the women,
+however, were all safe enough, the slave-traders being only too glad
+to escape alone.&nbsp; Fifty more slaves were freed next day in another
+village; and, the whole party being stark-naked, cloth enough was left
+to clothe them, better probably than they had ever been clothed before.&nbsp;
+The head of this gang, whom we knew as the agent of one of the principal
+merchants of Tette, said that they had the license of the Governor for
+all they did.&nbsp; This we were fully aware of without his stating
+it.&nbsp; It is quite impossible for any enterprise to be undertaken
+there without the Governor&rsquo;s knowledge and connivance.</p>
+<p>The portion of the highlands which the Bishop wished to look at before
+deciding on a settlement belonged to Chiwawa, or Chibaba, the most manly
+and generous Manganja chief we had met with on our previous journey.&nbsp;
+On reaching Nsambo&rsquo;s, near Mount Chiradzuru, we heard that Chibaba
+was dead, and that Chigunda was chief instead.&nbsp; Chigunda, apparently
+of his own accord, though possibly he may have learnt that the Bishop
+intended to settle somewhere in the country, asked him to come and live
+with him at Magomero, adding that there was room enough for both.&nbsp;
+This hearty and spontaneous invitation had considerable influence on
+the Bishop&rsquo;s mind, and seemed to decide the question.&nbsp; A
+place nearer the Shir&eacute; would have been chosen had he expected
+his supplies to come up that river; but the Portuguese, claiming the
+river Shir&eacute;, though never occupying even its mouth, had closed
+it, as well as the Zambesi.</p>
+<p>Our hopes were turned to the Rovuma, as a free highway into Lake
+Nyassa and the vast interior.&nbsp; A steamer was already ordered for
+the Lake, and the Bishop, seeing the advantageous nature of the highlands
+which stretch an immense way to the north, was more anxious to be near
+the Lake and the Rovuma, than the Shir&eacute;.&nbsp; When he decided
+to settle at Magomero, it was thought desirable, to prevent the country
+from being depopulated, to visit the Ajawa chief, and to try and persuade
+him to give up his slaving and kidnapping courses, and turn the energies
+of his people to peaceful pursuits.</p>
+<p>On the morning of the 22nd we were informed that the Ajawa were near,
+and were burning a village a few miles off.&nbsp; Leaving the rescued
+slaves, we moved off to seek an interview with these scourges of the
+country.&nbsp; On our way we met crowds of Manganja fleeing from the
+war in front.&nbsp; These poor fugitives from the slave hunt had, as
+usual, to leave all the food they possessed, except the little they
+could carry on their heads.&nbsp; We passed field after field of Indian
+corn or beans, standing ripe for harvesting, but the owners were away.&nbsp;
+The villages were all deserted: one where we breakfasted two years before,
+and saw a number of men peacefully weaving cloth, and, among ourselves,
+called it the &ldquo;Paisley of the hills,&rdquo; was burnt; the stores
+of corn were poured out in cartloads, and scattered all over the plain,
+and all along the paths, neither conquerors nor conquered having been
+able to convey it away.&nbsp; About two o&rsquo;clock we saw the smoke
+of burning villages, and heard triumphant shouts, mingled with the wail
+of the Manganja women, lamenting over their slain.&nbsp; The Bishop
+then engaged us in fervent prayer; and, on rising from our knees, we
+saw a long line of Ajawa warriors, with their captives, coming round
+the hill-side.&nbsp; The first of the returning conquerors were entering
+their own village below, and we heard women welcoming them back with
+&ldquo;lillilooings.&rdquo;&nbsp; The Ajawa headman left the path on
+seeing us, and stood on an anthill to obtain a complete view of our
+party.&nbsp; We called out that we had come to have an interview with
+them, but some of the Manganja who followed us shouted &ldquo;Our Chibisa
+is come:&rdquo; Chibisa being well known as a great conjurer and general.&nbsp;
+The Ajawa ran off yelling and screaming, &ldquo;Nkondo! Nkondo!&rdquo;
+(War! War!)&nbsp; We heard the words of the Manganja, but they did not
+strike us at the moment as neutralizing all our assertions of peace.&nbsp;
+The captives threw down their loads on the path, and fled to the hills:
+and a large body of armed men came running up from the village, and
+in a few seconds they were all around us, though mostly concealed by
+the projecting rocks and long grass.&nbsp; In vain we protested that
+we had not come to fight, but to talk with them.&nbsp; They would not
+listen, having, as we remembered afterwards, good reason, in the cry
+of &ldquo;Our Chibisa.&rdquo;&nbsp; Flushed with recent victory over
+three villages, and confident of an easy triumph over a mere handful
+of men, they began to shoot their poisoned arrows, sending them with
+great force upwards of a hundred yards, and wounding one of our followers
+through the arm.&nbsp; Our retiring slowly up the ascent from the village
+only made them more eager to prevent our escape; and, in the belief
+that this retreat was evidence of fear, they closed upon us in bloodthirsty
+fury.&nbsp; Some came within fifty yards, dancing hideously; others
+having quite surrounded us, and availing themselves of the rocks and
+long grass hard by, were intent on cutting us off, while others made
+off with their women and a large body of slaves.&nbsp; Four were armed
+with muskets, and we were obliged in self-defence to return their fire
+and drive them off.&nbsp; When they saw the range of rifles, they very
+soon desisted, and ran away; but some shouted to us from the hills the
+consoling intimation, that they would follow, and kill us where we slept.&nbsp;
+Only two of the captives escaped to us, but probably most of those made
+prisoners that day fled elsewhere in the confusion.&nbsp; We returned
+to the village which we had left in the morning, after a hungry, fatiguing,
+and most unpleasant day.</p>
+<p>Though we could not blame ourselves for the course we had followed,
+we felt sorry for what had happened.&nbsp; It was the first time we
+had ever been attacked by the natives or come into collision with them;
+though we had always taken it for granted that we might be called upon
+to act in self-defence, we were on this occasion less prepared than
+usual, no game having been expected here.&nbsp; The men had only a single
+round of cartridge each; their leader had no revolver, and the rifle
+he usually fired with was left at the ship to save it from the damp
+of the season.&nbsp; Had we known better the effect of slavery and murder
+on the temper of these bloodthirsty marauders, we should have tried
+messages and presents before going near them.</p>
+<p>The old chief, Chinsuns&eacute;, came on a visit to us next day,
+and pressed the Bishop to come and live with him.&nbsp; &ldquo;Chigunda,&rdquo;
+he said, &ldquo;is but a child, and the Bishop ought to live with the
+father rather than with the child.&rdquo;&nbsp; But the old man&rsquo;s
+object was so evidently to have the Mission as a shield against the
+Ajawa, that his invitation was declined.&nbsp; While begging us to drive
+away the marauders, that he might live in peace, he adopted the stratagem
+of causing a number of his men to rush into the village, in breathless
+haste, with the news that the Ajawa were close upon us.&nbsp; And having
+been reminded that we never fought, unless attacked, as we were the
+day before, and that we had come among them for the purpose of promoting
+peace, and of teaching them to worship the Supreme, to give up selling
+His children, and to cultivate other objects for barter than each other,
+he replied, in a huff, &ldquo;Then I am dead already.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>The Bishop, feeling, as most Englishmen would, at the prospect of
+the people now in his charge being swept off into slavery by hordes
+of men-stealers, proposed to go at once to the rescue of the captive
+Manganja, and drive the marauding Ajawa out of the country.&nbsp; All
+were warmly in favour of this, save Dr. Livingstone, who opposed it
+on the ground that it would be better for the Bishop to wait, and see
+the effect of the check the slave-hunters had just experienced.&nbsp;
+The Ajawa were evidently goaded on by Portuguese agents from Tette,
+and there was no bond of union among the Manganja on which to work.&nbsp;
+It was possible that the Ajawa might be persuaded to something better,
+though, from having long been in the habit of slaving for the Quilliman&eacute;
+market, it was not very probable.&nbsp; But the Manganja could easily
+be overcome piecemeal by any enemy; old feuds made them glad to see
+calamities befall their next neighbours.&nbsp; We counselled them to
+unite against the common enemies of their country, and added distinctly
+that we English would on no account enter into their quarrels.&nbsp;
+On the Bishop inquiring whether, in the event of the Manganja again
+asking aid against the Ajawa, it would be his duty to accede to their
+request,&mdash;&ldquo;No,&rdquo; replied Dr. Livingstone, &ldquo;you
+will be oppressed by their importunities, but do not interfere in native
+quarrels.&rdquo;&nbsp; This advice the good man honourably mentions
+in his journal.&nbsp; We have been rather minute in relating what occurred
+during the few days of our connection with the Mission of the English
+Universities, on the hills, because, the recorded advice having been
+discarded, blame was thrown on Dr. Livingstone&rsquo;s shoulders, as
+if the missionaries had no individual responsibility for their subsequent
+conduct.&nbsp; This, unquestionably, good Bishop Mackenzie had too much
+manliness to have allowed.&nbsp; The connection of the members of the
+Zambesi Expedition, with the acts of the Bishop&rsquo;s Mission, now
+ceased, for we returned to the ship and prepared for our journey to
+Lake Nyassa.&nbsp; We cheerfully, if necessary, will bear all responsibility
+up to this point; and if the Bishop afterwards made mistakes in certain
+collisions with the slavers, he had the votes of all his party with
+him, and those who best knew the peculiar circumstances, and the loving
+disposition of this good-hearted man, will blame him least.&nbsp; In
+this position, and in these circumstances, we left our friends at the
+Mission Station.</p>
+<p>As a temporary measure the Bishop decided to place his Mission Station
+on a small promontory formed by the windings of the little, clear stream
+of Magomero, which was so cold that the limbs were quite benumbed by
+washing in it in the July mornings.&nbsp; The site chosen was a pleasant
+spot to the eye, and completely surrounded by stately, shady trees.&nbsp;
+It was expected to serve for a residence, till the Bishop had acquired
+an accurate knowledge of the adjacent country, and of the political
+relations of the people, and could select a healthy and commanding situation,
+as a permanent centre of Christian civilization.&nbsp; Everything promised
+fairly.&nbsp; The weather was delightful, resembling the pleasantest
+part of an English summer; provisions poured in very cheap and in great
+abundance.&nbsp; The Bishop, with characteristic ardour, commenced learning
+the language, Mr. Waller began building, and Mr. Scudamore improvised
+a sort of infant school for the children, than which there is no better
+means for acquiring an unwritten tongue.</p>
+<p>On the 6th of August, 1861, a few days after returning from Magomero,
+Drs. Livingstone and Kirk, and Charles Livingstone started for Nyassa
+with a light four-oared gig, a white sailor, and a score of attendants.&nbsp;
+We hired people along the path to carry the boat past the forty miles
+of the Murchison Cataracts for a cubit of cotton cloth a day.&nbsp;
+This being deemed great wages, more than twice the men required eagerly
+offered their services.&nbsp; The chief difficulty was in limiting their
+numbers.&nbsp; Crowds followed us; and, had we not taken down in the
+morning the names of the porters engaged, in the evening claims would
+have been made by those who only helped during the last ten minutes
+of the journey.&nbsp; The men of one village carried the boat to the
+next, and all we had to do was to tell the headman that we wanted fresh
+men in the morning.&nbsp; He saw us pay the first party, and had his
+men ready at the time appointed, so there was no delay in waiting for
+carriers.&nbsp; They often make a loud noise when carrying heavy loads,
+but talking and bawling does not put them out of breath.&nbsp; The country
+was rough and with little soil on it, but covered with grass and open
+forest.&nbsp; A few small trees were cut down to clear a path for our
+shouting assistants, who were good enough to consider the boat as a
+certificate of peaceful intentions at least to them.&nbsp; Several small
+streams were passed, the largest of which were the Mukuru-Mads&eacute;
+and Lesungw&eacute;.&nbsp; The inhabitants on both banks were now civil
+and obliging.&nbsp; Our possession of a boat, and consequent power of
+crossing independently of the canoes, helped to develop their good manners,
+which were not apparent on our previous visit.</p>
+<p>There is often a surprising contrast between neighbouring villages.&nbsp;
+One is well off and thriving, having good huts, plenty of food, and
+native cloth; and its people are frank, trusty, generous, and eager
+to sell provisions; while in the next the inhabitants may be ill-housed,
+disobliging, suspicious, ill-fed, and scantily clad, and with nothing
+for sale, though the land around is as fertile as that of their wealthier
+neighbours.&nbsp; We followed the river for the most part to avail ourselves
+of the still reaches for sailing; but a comparatively smooth country
+lies further inland, over which a good road could be made.&nbsp; Some
+of the five main cataracts are very grand, the river falling 1200 feet
+in the 40 miles.&nbsp; After passing the last of the cataracts, we launched
+our boat for good on the broad and deep waters of the Upper Shir&eacute;,
+and were virtually on the lake, for the gentle current shows but little
+difference of level.&nbsp; The bed is broad and deep, but the course
+is rather tortuous at first, and makes a long bend to the east till
+it comes within five or six miles of the base of Mount Zomba.&nbsp;
+The natives regarded the Upper Shir&eacute; as a prolongation of Lake
+Nyassa; for where what we called the river approaches Lake Shirwa, a
+little north of the mountains, they said that the hippopotami, &ldquo;which
+are great night travellers,&rdquo; pass from <i>one lake into the other</i>.&nbsp;
+There the land is flat, and only a short land journey would be necessary.&nbsp;
+Seldom does the current here exceed a knot an hour, while that of the
+Lower Shir&eacute; is from two to two-and-a-half knots.&nbsp; Our land
+party of Makololo accompanied us along the right bank, and passed thousands
+of Manganja fugitives living in temporary huts on that side, who had
+recently been driven from their villages on the opposite hills by the
+Ajawa.</p>
+<p>The soil was dry and hard, and covered with mopane-trees; but some
+of the Manganja were busy hoeing the ground and planting the little
+corn they had brought with them.&nbsp; The effects of hunger were already
+visible on those whose food had been seized or burned by the Ajawa and
+Portuguese slave-traders.&nbsp; The spokesman or prime minister of one
+of the chiefs, named Kalo&ntilde;jer&eacute;, was a humpbacked dwarf,
+a fluent speaker, who tried hard to make us go over and drive off the
+Ajawa; but he could not deny that by selling people Kalo&ntilde;jer&eacute;
+had invited these slave-hunters to the country.&nbsp; This is the second
+humpbacked dwarf we have found occupying the like important post, the
+other was the prime minister of a Batonga chief on the Zambesi.</p>
+<p>As we sailed along, we disturbed many white-breasted cormorants;
+we had seen the same species fishing between the cataracts.&nbsp; Here,
+with many other wild-fowls, they find subsistence on the smooth water
+by night, and sit sleepily on trees and in the reeds by day.&nbsp; Many
+hippopotami were seen in the river, and one of them stretched its wide
+jaws, as if to swallow the whole stern of the boat, close to Dr. Kirk&rsquo;s
+back; the animal was so near that, in opening its mouth, it lashed a
+quantity of water on to the stern-sheets, but did no damage.&nbsp; To
+avoid large marauding parties of Ajawa, on the left bank of the Shir&eacute;,
+we continued on the right, or western side, with our land party, along
+the shore of the small lake Pamalomb&eacute;.&nbsp; This lakelet is
+ten or twelve miles in length, and five or six broad.&nbsp; It is nearly
+surrounded by a broad belt of papyrus, so dense that we could scarcely
+find an opening to the shore.&nbsp; The plants, ten or twelve feet high,
+grew so closely together that air was excluded, and so much sulphuretted
+hydrogen gas evolved that by one night&rsquo;s exposure the bottom of
+the boat was blackened.&nbsp; Myriads of mosquitoes showed, as probably
+they always do, the presence of malaria.</p>
+<p>We hastened from this sickly spot, trying to take the attentions
+of the mosquitoes as hints to seek more pleasant quarters on the healthy
+shores of Lake Nyassa; and when we sailed into it, on the 2nd September,
+we felt refreshed by the greater coolness of the air off this large
+body of water.&nbsp; The depth was the first point of interest.&nbsp;
+This is indicated by the colour of the water, which, on a belt along
+the shore, varying from a quarter to half a mile in breadth, is light
+green, and this is met by the deep blue or indigo tint of the Indian
+Ocean, which is the colour of the great body of Nyassa.&nbsp; We found
+the Upper Shir&eacute; from nine to fifteen feet in depth; but skirting
+the western side of the lake about a mile from the shore the water deepened
+from nine to fifteen fathoms; then, as we rounded the grand mountainous
+promontory, which we named Cape Maclear, after our excellent friend
+the Astronomer Royal at the Cape of Good Hope, we could get no bottom
+with our lead-line of thirty-five fathoms.&nbsp; We pulled along the
+western shore, which was a succession of bays, and found that where
+the bottom was sandy near the beach, and to a mile out, the depth varied
+from six to fourteen fathoms.&nbsp; In a rocky bay about latitude 11
+degrees 40 minutes we had soundings at 100 fathoms, though outside the
+same bay we found none with a fishing-line of 116 fathoms; but this
+cast was unsatisfactory, as the line broke in coming up.&nbsp; According
+to our present knowledge, a ship could anchor only near the shore.</p>
+<p>Looking back to the southern end of Lake Nyassa, the arm from which
+the Shir&eacute; flows was found to be about thirty miles long and from
+ten to twelve broad.&nbsp; Rounding Cape Maclear, and looking to the
+south-west, we have another arm, which stretches some eighteen miles
+southward, and is from six to twelve miles in breadth.&nbsp; These arms
+give the southern end a forked appearance, and with the help of a little
+imagination it may be likened to the &ldquo;boot-shape&rdquo; of Italy.&nbsp;
+The narrowest part is about the ankle, eighteen or twenty miles.&nbsp;
+From this it widens to the north, and in the upper third or fourth it
+is fifty or sixty miles broad.&nbsp; The length is over 200 miles.&nbsp;
+The direction in which it lies is as near as possible due north and
+south.&nbsp; Nothing of the great bend to the west, shown in all the
+previous maps, could be detected by either compass or chronometer, and
+the watch we used was an excellent one.&nbsp; The season of the year
+was very unfavourable.&nbsp; The &ldquo;smokes&rdquo; filled the air
+with an impenetrable haze, and the equinoctial gales made it impossible
+for us to cross to the eastern side.&nbsp; When we caught a glimpse
+of the sun rising from behind the mountains to the east, we made sketches
+and bearings of them at different latitudes, which enabled us to secure
+approximate measurements of the width.&nbsp; These agreed with the times
+taken by the natives at the different crossing-places&mdash;as Tsenga
+and Molamba.&nbsp; About the beginning of the upper third the lake is
+crossed by taking advantage of the island Chizumara, which name in the
+native tongue means the &ldquo;ending;&rdquo; further north they go
+round the end instead, though that takes several days.</p>
+<p>The lake appeared to be surrounded by mountains, but it was afterwards
+found that these beautiful tree-covered heights were, on the west, only
+the edges of high table-lands.&nbsp; Like all narrow seas encircled
+by highlands, it is visited by sudden and tremendous storms.&nbsp; We
+were on it in September and October, perhaps the stormiest season of
+the year, and were repeatedly detained by gales.&nbsp; At times, while
+sailing pleasantly over the blue water with a gentle breeze, suddenly
+and without any warning was heard the sound of a coming storm, roaring
+on with crowds of angry waves in its wake.&nbsp; We were caught one
+morning with the sea breaking all around us, and, unable either to advance
+or recede, anchored a mile from shore, in seven fathoms.&nbsp; The furious
+surf on the beach would have shivered our boat to atoms, had we tried
+to land.&nbsp; The waves most dreaded came rolling on in threes, with
+their crests, driven into spray, streaming behind them.&nbsp; A short
+lull followed each triple charge.&nbsp; Had one of these seas struck
+our boat, nothing could have saved us; for they came on with resistless
+force; seaward, in shore, and on either side of us, they broke in foam,
+but we escaped.&nbsp; For six weary hours we faced those terrible trios.&nbsp;
+A low, dark, detached, oddly shaped cloud came slowly from the mountains,
+and hung for hours directly over our heads.&nbsp; A flock of night-jars
+(<i>Cometornis vexillarius</i>), which on no other occasion come out
+by day, soared above us in the gale, like birds of evil omen.&nbsp;
+Our black crew became sea-sick and unable to sit up or keep the boat&rsquo;s
+head to the sea.&nbsp; The natives and our land party stood on the high
+cliffs looking at us and exclaiming, as the waves seemed to swallow
+up the boat, &ldquo;They are lost! they are all dead!&rdquo;&nbsp; When
+at last the gale moderated and we got safely ashore, they saluted us
+warmly, as after a long absence.&nbsp; From this time we trusted implicitly
+to the opinions of our seaman, John Neil, who, having been a fisherman
+on the coast of Ireland, understood boating on a stormy coast, and by
+his advice we often sat cowering on the land for days together waiting
+for the surf to go down.&nbsp; He had never seen such waves before.&nbsp;
+We had to beach the boat every night to save her from being swamped
+at anchor; and, did we not believe the gales to be peculiar to one season
+of the year, would call Nyassa the &ldquo;Lake of Storms.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>Distinct white marks on the rocks showed that, for some time during
+the rainy season, the water of the lake is three feet above the point
+to which it falls towards the close of the dry period of the year.&nbsp;
+The rains begin here in November, and the permanent rise of the Shir&eacute;
+does not take place till January.&nbsp; The western side of Lake Nyassa,
+with the exception of the great harbour to the west of Cape Maclear,
+is, as has been said before, a succession of small bays of nearly similar
+form, each having an open sandy beach and pebbly shore, and being separated
+from its neighbour by a rocky headland, with detached rocks extending
+some distance out to sea.&nbsp; The great south-western bay referred
+to would form a magnificent harbour, the only really good one we saw
+to the west.</p>
+<p>The land immediately adjacent to the lake is low and fertile, though
+in some places marshy and tenanted by large flocks of ducks, geese,
+herons, crowned cranes, and other birds.&nbsp; In the southern parts
+we have sometimes ten or a dozen miles of rich plains, bordered by what
+seem high ranges of well-wooded hills, running nearly parallel with
+the lake.&nbsp; Northwards the mountains become loftier and present
+some magnificent views, range towering beyond range, until the dim,
+lofty outlines projected against the sky bound the prospect.&nbsp; Still
+further north the plain becomes more narrow, until, near where we turned,
+it disappears altogether, and the mountains rise abruptly out of the
+lake, forming the north-east boundary of what was described to us as
+an extensive table-land; well suited for pasturage and agriculture,
+and now only partially occupied by a tribe of Zulus, who came from the
+south some years ago.&nbsp; These people own large herds of cattle,
+and are constantly increasing in numbers by annexing other tribes.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER X.</h3>
+<p>The Lake tribes&mdash;The Mazitu&mdash;Quantities of elephants&mdash;Distressing
+journey&mdash;Detention on the Shir&eacute;.</p>
+<p>Never before in Africa have we seen anything like the dense population
+on the shores of Lake Nyassa.&nbsp; In the southern part there was an
+almost unbroken chain of villages.&nbsp; On the beach of wellnigh of
+every little sandy bay, dark crowds were standing, gazing at the novel
+sight of a boat under sail; and wherever we landed we were surrounded
+in a few seconds by hundreds of men, women, and children, who hastened
+to have a stare at the &ldquo;chirombo&rdquo; (wild animals).</p>
+<p>During a portion of the year, the northern dwellers on the lake have
+a harvest which furnishes a singular sort of food.&nbsp; As we approached
+our limit in that direction, clouds, as of smoke rising from miles of
+burning grass, were observed bending in a south-easterly direction,
+and we thought that the unseen land on the opposite side was closing
+in, and that we were near the end of the lake.&nbsp; But next morning
+we sailed through one of the clouds on our own side, and discovered
+that it was neither smoke nor haze, but countless millions of minute
+midges called &ldquo;kungo&rdquo; (a cloud or fog).&nbsp; They filled
+the air to an immense height, and swarmed upon the water, too light
+to sink in it.&nbsp; Eyes and mouth had to be kept closed while passing
+through this living cloud: they struck upon the face like fine drifting
+snow.&nbsp; Thousands lay in the boat when she emerged from the cloud
+of midges.&nbsp; The people gather these minute insects by night, and
+boil them into thick cakes, to be used as a relish&mdash;millions of
+midges in a cake.&nbsp; A kungo cake, an inch thick, and as large as
+the blue bonnet of a Scotch ploughman, was offered to us; it was very
+dark in colour, and tasted not unlike caviare, or salted locusts.</p>
+<p>Abundance of excellent fish is found in the lake, and nearly all
+were new to us.&nbsp; The mpasa, or sanjika, found by Dr. Kirk to be
+a kind of carp, was running up the rivers to spawn, like our salmon
+at home: the largest we saw was over two feet in length; it is a splendid
+fish, and the best we have ever eaten in Africa.&nbsp; They were ascending
+the rivers in August and September, and furnished active and profitable
+employment to many fishermen, who did not mind their being out of season.&nbsp;
+Weirs were constructed full of sluices, in each of which was set a large
+basket-trap, through whose single tortuous opening the fish once in
+has but small chance of escape.&nbsp; A short distance below the weir,
+nets are stretched across from bank to bank, so that it seemed a marvel
+how the most sagacious sanjika could get up at all without being taken.&nbsp;
+Possibly a passage up the river is found at night; but this is not the
+country of Sundays or &ldquo;close times&rdquo; for either men or fish.&nbsp;
+The lake fish are caught chiefly in nets, although men, and even women
+with babies on their backs, are occasionally seen fishing from the rocks
+with hooks.</p>
+<p>A net with small meshes is used for catching the young fry of a silvery
+kind like pickerel, when they are about two inches long; thousands are
+often taken in a single haul.&nbsp; We had a present of a large bucketful
+one day for dinner: they tasted as if they had been cooked with a little
+quinine, probably from their gall-bladders being left in.&nbsp; In deep
+water, some sorts are taken by lowering fish-baskets attached by a long
+cord to a float, around which is often tied a mass of grass or weeds,
+as an alluring shade for the deep-sea fish.&nbsp; Fleets of fine canoes
+are engaged in the fisheries.&nbsp; The men have long paddles, and stand
+erect while using them.&nbsp; They sometimes venture out when a considerable
+sea is running.&nbsp; Our Makololo acknowledge that, in handling canoes,
+the Lake men beat them; they were unwilling to cross the Zambesi even,
+when the wind blew fresh.</p>
+<p>Though there are many crocodiles in the lake, and some of an extraordinary
+size, the fishermen say that it is a rare thing for any one to be carried
+off by these reptiles.&nbsp; When crocodiles can easily obtain abundance
+of fish&mdash;their natural food&mdash;they seldom attack men; but when
+unable to see to catch their prey, from the muddiness of the water in
+floods, they are very dangerous.</p>
+<p>Many men and boys are employed in gathering the buaz&eacute;, in
+preparing the fibre, and in making it into long nets.&nbsp; The knot
+of the net is different from ours, for they invariably use what sailors
+call the reef knot, but they net with a needle like that we use.&nbsp;
+From the amount of native cotton cloth worn in many of the southern
+villages, it is evident that a great number of hands and heads must
+be employed in the cultivation of cotton, and in the various slow processes
+through which it has to pass, before the web is finished in the native
+loom.&nbsp; In addition to this branch of industry, an extensive manufacture
+of cloth, from the inner bark of an undescribed tree, of the botanical
+group, <i>C&aelig;salpine&aelig;</i>, is ever going on, from one end
+of the lake to the other; and both toil and time are required to procure
+the bark, and to prepare it by pounding and steeping it to render it
+soft and pliable.&nbsp; The prodigious amount of the bark clothing worn
+indicates the destruction of an immense number of trees every year;
+yet the adjacent heights seem still well covered with timber.</p>
+<p>The Lake people are by no means handsome: the women are <i>very</i>
+plain; and really make themselves hideous by the means they adopt to
+render themselves attractive.&nbsp; The <i>pelel&eacute;</i>, or ornament
+for the upper lip, is universally worn by the ladies; the most valuable
+is of pure tin, hammered into the shape of a small dish; some are made
+of white quartz, and give the wearer the appearance of having an inch
+or more of one of Price&rsquo;s patent candles thrust through the lip,
+and projecting beyond the tip of the nose.</p>
+<p>In character, the Lake tribes are very much like other people; there
+are decent men among them, while a good many are no better than they
+should be.&nbsp; They are open-handed enough: if one of us, as was often
+the case, went to see a net drawn, a fish was always offered.&nbsp;
+Sailing one day past a number of men, who had just dragged their nets
+ashore, at one of the fine fisheries at Pamalomb&eacute;, we were hailed
+and asked to stop, and received a liberal donation of beautiful fish.&nbsp;
+Arriving late one afternoon at a small village on the lake, a number
+of the inhabitants manned two canoes, took out their seine, dragged
+it, and made us a present of the entire haul.&nbsp; The northern chief,
+Marenga, a tall handsome man, with a fine aquiline nose, whom we found
+living in his stockade in a forest about twenty miles north of the mountain
+Kowirw&eacute;, behaved like a gentleman to us.&nbsp; His land extended
+from Dambo to the north of Makuza hill.&nbsp; He was specially generous,
+and gave us bountiful presents of food and beer.&nbsp; &ldquo;Do they
+wear such things in your country?&rdquo; he asked, pointing to his iron
+bracelet, which was studded with copper, and highly prized.&nbsp; The
+Doctor said he had never seen such in his country, whereupon Marenga
+instantly took it off, and presented it to him, and his wife also did
+the same with hers.&nbsp; On our return south from the mountains near
+the north end of the lake, we reached Marenga&rsquo;s on the 7th October.&nbsp;
+When he could not prevail upon us to forego the advantage of a fair
+wind for his invitation to &ldquo;spend the whole day drinking his beer,
+which was,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;quite ready,&rdquo; he loaded us with
+provisions, all of which he sent for before we gave him any present.&nbsp;
+In allusion to the boat&rsquo;s sail, his people said that they had
+no Bazimo, or none worth having, seeing they had never invented the
+like for them.&nbsp; The chief, Mankambira, likewise treated us with
+kindness; but wherever the slave-trade is carried on, the people are
+dishonest and uncivil; that invariably leaves a blight and a curse in
+its path.&nbsp; The first question put to us at the lake crossing-places,
+was, &ldquo;Have you come to buy slaves?&rdquo;&nbsp; On hearing that
+we were English, and never purchased slaves, the questioners put on
+a supercilious air, and sometimes refused to sell us food.&nbsp; This
+want of respect to us may have been owing to the impressions conveyed
+to them by the Arabs, whose dhows have sometimes been taken by English
+cruisers when engaged in lawful trade.&nbsp; Much foreign cloth, beads,
+and brass-wire were worn by these ferrymen&mdash;and some had muskets.</p>
+<p>By Chitanda, near one of the slave crossing-places, we were robbed
+for the first time in Africa, and learned by experience that these people,
+like more civilized nations, have expert thieves among them.&nbsp; It
+might be only a coincidence; but we never suffered from impudence, loss
+of property, or were endangered, unless among people familiar with slaving.&nbsp;
+We had such a general sense of security, that never, save when we suspected
+treachery, did we set a watch at night.&nbsp; Our native companions
+had, on this occasion, been carousing on beer, and had removed to a
+distance of some thirty yards, that we might not overhear their free
+and easy after-dinner remarks, and two of us had a slight touch of fever;
+between three and four o&rsquo;clock in the morning some thieves came,
+while we slept ingloriously&mdash;rifles and revolvers all ready,&mdash;and
+relieved us of most of our goods.&nbsp; The boat&rsquo;s sail, under
+which we slept, was open all around, so the feat was easy.</p>
+<p>Awaking as honest men do, at the usual hour, the loss of one was
+announced by &ldquo;My bag is gone&mdash;with all my clothes; and my
+boots too!&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;And mine!&rdquo; responded a second.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;And mine also!&rdquo; chimed in the third, &ldquo;with the bag
+of beads, and the rice!&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;Is the cloth taken?&rdquo;
+was the eager inquiry, as that would have been equivalent to all our
+money.&nbsp; It had been used for a pillow that night, and thus saved.&nbsp;
+The rogues left on the beach, close to our beds, the Aneroid Barometer
+and a pair of boots, thinking possibly that they might be of use to
+us, or, at least, that they could be of none to them.&nbsp; They shoved
+back some dried plants and fishes into one bag, but carried off many
+other specimens we had collected; some of our notes also, and nearly
+all our clothing.</p>
+<p>We could not suspect the people of the village near which we lay.&nbsp;
+We had probably been followed for days by the thieves watching for an
+opportunity.&nbsp; And our suspicions fell on some persons who had come
+from the East Coast; but having no evidence, and expecting to hear if
+our goods were exposed for sale in the vicinity, we made no fuss about
+it, and began to make new clothing.&nbsp; That our rifles and revolvers
+were left untouched was greatly to our advantage: yet we felt it was
+most humiliating for armed men to have been so thoroughly fleeced by
+a few black rascals.</p>
+<p>Some of the best fisheries appear to be private property.&nbsp; We
+found shelter from a storm one morning in a spacious lagoon, which communicated
+with the lake by a narrow passage.&nbsp; Across this strait stakes were
+driven in, leaving only spaces for the basket fish-traps.&nbsp; A score
+of men were busily engaged in taking out the fish.&nbsp; We tried to
+purchase some, but they refused to sell.&nbsp; The fish did not belong
+to them, they would send for the proprietor of the place.&nbsp; The
+proprietor arrived in a short time, and readily sold what we wanted.</p>
+<p>Some of the burying-grounds are very well arranged, and well cared
+for; this was noticed at Chitanda, and more particularly at a village
+on the southern shore of the fine harbour at Cape Maclear.&nbsp; Wide
+and neat paths were made in the burying-ground on its eastern and southern
+sides.&nbsp; A grand old fig-tree stood at the north-east corner, and
+its wide-spreading branches threw their kindly shade over the last resting-place
+of the dead.&nbsp; Several other magnificent trees grew around the hallowed
+spot.&nbsp; Mounds were raised as they are at home, but all lay north
+and south, the heads apparently north.&nbsp; The graves of the sexes
+were distinguished by the various implements which the buried dead had
+used in their different employments during life; but they were all broken,
+as if to be employed no more.&nbsp; A piece of fishing-net and a broken
+paddle told where a fisherman lay.&nbsp; The graves of the women had
+the wooden mortar, and the heavy pestle used in pounding the corn, and
+the basket in which the meal is sifted, while all had numerous broken
+calabashes and pots arranged around them.&nbsp; The idea that the future
+life is like the present does not appear to prevail; yet a banana-tree
+had been carefully planted at the head of several of the graves; the
+fruit might be considered an offering to those who still possess human
+tastes.&nbsp; The people of the neighbouring villages were friendly
+and obliging, and willingly brought us food for sale.</p>
+<p>Pursuing our exploration, we found that the northern part of the
+lake was the abode of lawlessness and bloodshed.&nbsp; The Mazit&eacute;,
+or Mazitu, live on the highlands, and make sudden swoops on the villages
+of the plains.&nbsp; They are Zulus who came originally from the south,
+inland of Sofalla and Inhamban&eacute;; and are of the same family as
+those who levy annual tribute from the Portuguese on the Zambesi.&nbsp;
+All the villages north of Mankambira&rsquo;s (lat. 11 degrees 44 minutes
+south) had been recently destroyed by these terrible marauders, but
+they were foiled in their attacks upon that chief and Marenga.&nbsp;
+The thickets and stockades round their villages enabled the bowmen to
+pick off the Mazitu in security, while they were afraid to venture near
+any place where they could not use their shields.&nbsp; Beyond Mankambira&rsquo;s
+we saw burned villages, and the putrid bodies of many who had fallen
+by Mazitu spears only a few days before.&nbsp; Our land party were afraid
+to go further.&nbsp; This reluctance to proceed without the presence
+of a white man was very natural, because bands of the enemy who had
+ravaged the country were supposed to be still roaming about; and if
+these marauders saw none but men of their own colour, our party might
+forthwith be attacked.&nbsp; Compliance with their request led to an
+event which might have been attended by very serious consequences.&nbsp;
+Dr. Livingstone got separated from the party in the boat for four days.&nbsp;
+Having taken the first morning&rsquo;s journey along with them, and
+directing the boat to call for him in a bay in sight, both parties proceeded
+north.&nbsp; In an hour Dr. Livingstone and his party struck inland,
+on approaching the foot of the mountains which rise abruptly from the
+lake.&nbsp; Supposing that they had heard of a path behind the high
+range which there forms the shore, those in the boat held on their course;
+but it soon began to blow so fresh that they had to run ashore for safety.&nbsp;
+While delayed a couple of hours, two men were sent up the hills to look
+for the land party, but they could see nothing of them, and the boat
+party sailed as soon as it was safe to put to sea, with the conviction
+that the missing ones would regain the lake in front.</p>
+<p>In a short time a small island or mass of rocks was passed, on which
+were a number of armed Mazitu with some young women, apparently their
+wives.&nbsp; The headman said that he had been wounded in the foot by
+Mankambira, and that they were staying there till he could walk to his
+chief, who lived over the hills.&nbsp; They had several large canoes,
+and it was evident that this was a nest of lake pirates, who sallied
+out by night to kill and plunder.&nbsp; They reported a path behind
+the hills, and, the crew being reassured, the boat sailed on.&nbsp;
+A few miles further, another and still larger band of pirates were fallen
+in with, and hundreds of crows and kites hovered over and round the
+rocks on which they lived.&nbsp; Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone, though
+ordered in a voice of authority to come ashore, kept on their course.&nbsp;
+A number of canoes then shot out from the rocks and chased them.&nbsp;
+One with nine strong paddlers persevered for some time after all the
+others gave up the chase.&nbsp; A good breeze, however, enabled the
+gig to get away from them with ease.&nbsp; After sailing twelve or fifteen
+miles, north of the point where Dr. Livingstone had left them, it was
+decided that he must be behind; but no sooner had the boat&rsquo;s head
+been turned south, than another gale compelled her to seek shelter in
+a bay.&nbsp; Here a number of wretched fugitives from the slave-trade
+on the opposite shore of the lake were found; the original inhabitants
+of the place had all been swept off the year before by the Mazitu.&nbsp;
+In the deserted gardens beautiful cotton was seen growing, much of it
+had the staple an inch and a half long, and of very fine quality.&nbsp;
+Some of the plants were uncommonly large, deserving to be ranked with
+trees.</p>
+<p>On their trying to purchase food, the natives had nothing to sell
+except a little dried cassava-root, and a few fish: and they demanded
+two yards of calico for the head only of a large fish.&nbsp; When the
+gale admitted of their return, their former pursuers tried to draw them
+ashore by asserting that they had quantities of ivory for sale.&nbsp;
+Owing to a succession of gales, it was the fourth day from parting that
+the boat was found by Dr. Livingstone, who was coming on in search of
+it with only two of his companions.</p>
+<p>After proceeding a short distance up the path in which they had been
+lost sight of, they learned that it would take several days to go round
+the mountains, and rejoin the lake; and they therefore turned down to
+the bay, expecting to find the boat, but only saw it disappearing away
+to the north.&nbsp; They pushed on as briskly as possible after it,
+but the mountain flank which forms the coast proved excessively tedious
+and fatiguing; travelling all day, the distance made, in a straight
+line, was under five miles.&nbsp; As soon as day dawned, the march was
+resumed; and, after hearing at the first inhabited rock that their companions
+had passed it the day before, a goat was slaughtered out of the four
+which they had with them, when suddenly, to the evident consternation
+of the men, seven Mazitu appeared armed with spears and shields, with
+their heads dressed fantastically with feathers.&nbsp; To hold a parley,
+Dr. Livingstone and Moloka, a Makololo man who spoke Zulu, went unarmed
+to meet them.&nbsp; On Dr. Livingstone approaching them, they ordered
+him to stop, and sit down in the sun, while they sat in the shade.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;No, no!&rdquo; was the reply, &ldquo;if you sit in the shade,
+so will we.&rdquo;&nbsp; They then rattled their shields with their
+clubs, a proceeding which usually inspires terror; but Moloka remarked,
+&ldquo;It is not the first time we have heard shields rattled.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+And all sat down together.&nbsp; They asked for a present, to show their
+chief that they had actually met strangers&mdash;something as evidence
+of having seen men who were not Arabs.&nbsp; And they were requested
+in turn to take these strangers to the boat, or to their chief.&nbsp;
+All the goods were in the boat, and to show that no present such as
+they wanted was in his pockets, Dr. Livingstone emptied them, turning
+out, among other things, a note-book: thinking it was a pistol they
+started up, and said, &ldquo;Put that in again.&rdquo;&nbsp; The younger
+men then became boisterous, and demanded a goat.&nbsp; That could not
+be spared, as they were the sole provisions.&nbsp; When they insisted,
+they were asked how many of the party they had killed, that they thus
+began to divide the spoil; this evidently made them ashamed.&nbsp; The
+elders were more reasonable; they dreaded treachery, and were as much
+afraid of Dr. Livingstone and his party as his men were of them; for
+on leaving they sped away up the hills like frightened deer.&nbsp; One
+of them, and probably the leader, was married, as seen by portions of
+his hair sewn into a ring; all were observed by their teeth to be people
+of the country, who had been incorporated into the Zulu tribe.</p>
+<p>The way still led over a succession of steep ridges with ravines
+of from 500 to 1000 feet in depth; some of the sides had to be scaled
+on hands and knees, and no sooner was the top reached than the descent
+began again.&nbsp; Each ravine had a running stream; and the whole country,
+though so very rugged, had all been cultivated, and densely peopled.&nbsp;
+Many banana-trees, uncared for patches of corn, and Congo-bean bushes
+attested former cultivation.&nbsp; The population had all been swept
+away; ruined villages, broken utensils, and human skeletons, met with
+at every turn, told a sad tale.&nbsp; So numerous were the slain, that
+it was thought the inhabitants had been slaughtered in consequence of
+having made raids on the Zulus for cattle.</p>
+<p>Continuing the journey that night as long as light served, they slept
+unconsciously on the edge of a deep precipice, without fire, lest the
+Mazitu should see it.&nbsp; Next morning most of the men were tired
+out, the dread of the apparition of the day before tending probably
+to increase the lameness of which they complained.&nbsp; When told,
+however, that all might return to Mankambira&rsquo;s save two, Moloka
+and Charlie, they would not, till assured that the act would not be
+considered one of cowardice.&nbsp; Giving them one of the goats as provision,
+another was slaughtered for the remainder of the party who, having found
+on the rocks a canoe which had belonged to one of the deserted villages,
+determined to put to sea again; but the craft was very small, and the
+remaining goat, spite of many a threat of having its throat cut, jumped
+and rolled about so, as nearly to capsize it; so Dr. Livingstone took
+to the shore again, and after another night spent without fire, except
+just for cooking, was delighted to see the boat coming back.</p>
+<p>We pulled that day to Mankambira&rsquo;s, a distance that on shore,
+with the most heartbreaking toil, had taken three days to travel.&nbsp;
+This was the last latitude taken, 11 degrees 44 minutes S.&nbsp; The
+boat had gone about 24 minutes further to the north, the land party
+probably half that distance, but fever prevented the instruments being
+used.&nbsp; Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone were therefore furthest
+up the lake, and they saw about 20 minutes beyond their turning-point,
+say into the tenth degree of south latitude.&nbsp; From the heights
+of at least a thousand feet, over which the land party toiled, the dark
+mountain masses on both sides of the lake were seen closing in.&nbsp;
+At this elevation the view extended at least as far as that from the
+boats, and it is believed the end of the lake lies on the southern borders
+of 10 degrees, or the northern limits of 11 degrees south latitude.</p>
+<p>Elephants are numerous on the borders of the lake, and surprisingly
+tame, being often found close to the villages.&nbsp; Hippopotami swarm
+very much at their ease in the creeks and lagoons, and herds are sometimes
+seen in the lake itself.&nbsp; Their tameness arises from the fact that
+poisoned arrows have no effect on either elephant or hippopotamus.&nbsp;
+Five of each were shot for food during our journey.&nbsp; Two of the
+elephants were females, and had only a single tusk apiece, and were
+each killed by the first shot.&nbsp; It is always a case of famine or
+satiety when depending on the rifle for food&mdash;a glut of meat or
+none at all.&nbsp; Most frequently it is scanty fare, except when game
+is abundant, as it is far up the Zambesi.&nbsp; We had one morning two
+hippopotami and an elephant, perhaps in all some eight tons of meat,
+and two days after the last of a few sardines only for dinner.</p>
+<p>One morning when sailing past a pretty thickly-inhabited part, we
+were surprised at seeing nine large bull-elephants standing near the
+beach quietly flapping their gigantic ears.&nbsp; Glad of an opportunity
+of getting some fresh meat, we landed and fired into one.&nbsp; They
+all retreated into a marshy piece of ground between two villages.&nbsp;
+Our men gave chase, and fired into the herd.&nbsp; Standing on a sand
+hummock, we could see the bleeding animals throwing showers of water
+with their trunks over their backs.&nbsp; The herd was soon driven back
+upon us, and a wounded one turned to bay.&nbsp; Yet neither this one,
+nor any of the others, ever attempted to charge.&nbsp; Having broken
+his legs with a rifle-ball, we fired into him at forty yards as rapidly
+as we could load and discharge the rifles.&nbsp; He simply shook his
+head at each shot, and received at least sixty Enfield balls before
+he fell.&nbsp; Our excellent sailor from the north of Ireland happened
+to fire the last, and, as soon as he saw the animal fall, he turned
+with an air of triumph to the Doctor and exclaimed, &ldquo;It was <i>my</i>
+shot that done it, sir!&rdquo;</p>
+<p>In a few minutes upwards of a thousand natives were round the prostrate
+king of beasts; and, after our men had taken all they wanted, an invitation
+was given to the villagers to take the remainder.&nbsp; They rushed
+at it like hungry hyenas, and in an incredibly short time every inch
+of it was carried off.&nbsp; It was only by knowing that the meat would
+all be used that we felt justified in the slaughter of this noble creature.&nbsp;
+The tusks weighed 62 lbs. each.&nbsp; A large amount of ivory might
+be obtained from the people of Nyassa, and we were frequently told of
+their having it in their huts.</p>
+<p>While detained by a storm on the 17th October at the mouth of the
+Kaomb&eacute;, we were visited by several men belonging to an Arab who
+had been for fourteen years in the interior at Katanga&rsquo;s, south
+of Cazembe&rsquo;s.&nbsp; They had just brought down ivory, malachite,
+copper rings, and slaves to exchange for cloth at the lake.&nbsp; The
+malachite was said to be dug out of a large vein on the side of a hill
+near Katanga&rsquo;s.&nbsp; They knew Lake Tanganyika well, but had
+not heard of the Zambesi.&nbsp; They spoke quite positively, saying
+that the water of Lake Tanganyika flowed out by the opposite end to
+that of Nyassa.&nbsp; As they had seen neither of the overflows, we
+took it simply as a piece of Arab geography.&nbsp; We passed their establishment
+of long sheds next day, and were satisfied that the Arabs must be driving
+a good trade.</p>
+<p>The Lake slave-trade was going on at a terrible rate.&nbsp; Two enterprising
+Arabs had built a dhow, and were running her, crowded with slaves, regularly
+across the Lake.&nbsp; We were told she sailed the day before we reached
+their head-quarters.&nbsp; This establishment is in the latitude of
+the Portuguese slave-exporting town of Iboe, and partly supplies that
+vile market; but the greater number of the slaves go to Kilwa.&nbsp;
+We did not see much evidence of a wish to barter.&nbsp; Some ivory was
+offered for sale; but the chief traffic was in human chattels.&nbsp;
+Would that we could give a comprehensive account of the horrors of the
+slave-trade, with an approximation to the number of lives it yearly
+destroys! for we feel sure that were even half the truth told and recognized,
+the feelings of men would be so thoroughly roused, that this devilish
+traffic in human flesh would be put down at all risks; but neither we,
+nor any one else, have the statistics necessary for a work of this kind.&nbsp;
+Let us state what we do know of one portion of Africa, and then every
+reader who believes our tale can apply the ratio of the known misery
+to find out the unknown.&nbsp; We were informed by Colonel Rigby, late
+H.M. Political Agent, and Consul at Zanzibar, that 19,000 slaves from
+this Nyassa country alone pass annually through the Custom-house of
+that island.&nbsp; This is exclusive of course of those sent to Portuguese
+slave-ports.&nbsp; Let it not be supposed for an instant that this number,
+19,000, represents all the victims.&nbsp; Those taken out of the country
+are but a very small section of the sufferers.&nbsp; We never realized
+the atrocious nature of the traffic, until we saw it at the fountain-head.&nbsp;
+There truly &ldquo;Satan has his seat.&rdquo;&nbsp; Besides those actually
+captured, thousands are killed and die of their wounds and famine, driven
+from their villages by the slave raid proper.&nbsp; Thousands perish
+in internecine war waged for slaves with their own clansmen and neighbours,
+slain by the lust of gain, which is stimulated, be it remembered always,
+by the slave purchasers of Cuba and elsewhere.&nbsp; The many skeletons
+we have seen, amongst rocks and woods, by the little pools, and along
+the paths of the wilderness, attest the awful sacrifice of human life,
+which must be attributed, directly or indirectly, to this trade of hell.&nbsp;
+We would ask our countrymen to believe us when we say, as we conscientiously
+can, that it is our deliberate opinion, from what we know and have seen,
+that not one-fifth of the victims of the slave-trade ever become slaves.&nbsp;
+Taking the Shir&eacute; Valley as an average, we should say not even
+one-tenth arrive at their destination.&nbsp; As the system, therefore,
+involves such an awful waste of human life,&mdash;or shall we say of
+human labour?&mdash;and moreover tends directly to perpetuate the barbarism
+of those who remain in the country, the argument for the continuance
+of this wasteful course because, forsooth, a fraction of the enslaved
+may find good masters, seems of no great value.&nbsp; This reasoning,
+if not the result of ignorance, may be of maudlin philanthropy.&nbsp;
+A small armed steamer on Lake Nyassa could easily, by exercising a control,
+and furnishing goods in exchange for ivory and other products, break
+the neck of this infamous traffic in that quarter; for nearly all must
+cross the Lake or the Upper Shir&eacute;.</p>
+<p>Our exploration of the Lake extended from the 2nd September to the
+27th October, 1861; and, having expended or lost most of the goods we
+had brought, it was necessary to go back to the ship.&nbsp; When near
+the southern end, on our return, we were told that a very large slave-party
+had just crossed to the eastern side.&nbsp; We heard the fire of three
+guns in the evening, and judged by the report that they must be at least
+six-pounders.&nbsp; They were said to belong to an Ajawa chief named
+Mukata.</p>
+<p>In descending the Shir&eacute;, we found concealed in the broad belt
+of papyrus round the lakelet Pamalomb&eacute;, into which the river
+expands, a number of Manganja families who had been driven from their
+homes by the Ajawa raids.&nbsp; So thickly did the papyrus grow, that
+when beat down it supported their small temporary huts, though when
+they walked from one hut to another, it heaved and bent beneath their
+feet as thin ice does at home.</p>
+<p>A dense and impenetrable forest of the papyrus was left standing
+between them and the land, and no one passing by on the same side would
+ever have suspected that human beings lived there.&nbsp; They came to
+this spot from the south by means of their canoes, which enabled them
+to obtain a living from the fine fish which abound in the lakelet.&nbsp;
+They had a large quantity of excellent salt sewed up in bark, some of
+which we bought, our own having run out.&nbsp; We anchored for the night
+off their floating camp, and were visited by myriads of mosquitoes.&nbsp;
+Some of the natives show a love of country quite surprising.&nbsp; We
+saw fugitives on the mountains, in the north of the lake, who were persisting
+in clinging to the haunts of their boyhood and youth, in spite of starvation
+and the continual danger of being put to death by the Mazitu.</p>
+<p>A few miles below the lakelet is the last of the great slave-crossings.&nbsp;
+Since the Ajawa invasion the villages on the left bank had been abandoned,
+and the people, as we saw in our ascent, were living on the right or
+western bank.</p>
+<p>As we were resting for a few minutes opposite the valuable fishery
+at Movunguti, a young effeminate-looking man from some sea-coast tribe
+came in great state to have a look at us.&nbsp; He walked under a large
+umbrella, and was followed by five handsome damsels gaily dressed and
+adorned with a view to attract purchasers.&nbsp; One was carrying his
+pipe for smoking bang, here called &ldquo;chamba;&rdquo; another his
+bow and arrows; a third his battle-axe; a fourth one of his robes; while
+the last was ready to take his umbrella when he felt tired.&nbsp; This
+show of his merchandise was to excite the cupidity of any chief who
+had ivory, and may be called the lawful way of carrying on the slave-trade.&nbsp;
+What proportion it bears to the other ways in which we have seen this
+traffic pursued, we never found means of forming a judgment.&nbsp; He
+sat and looked at us for a few minutes, the young ladies kneeling behind
+him; and having satisfied himself that we were not likely to be customers,
+he departed.</p>
+<p>On our first trip we met, at the landing opposite this place, a middle-aged
+woman of considerable intelligence, and possessing more knowledge of
+the country than any of the men.&nbsp; Our first definite information
+about Lake Nyassa was obtained from her.&nbsp; Seeing us taking notes,
+she remarked that she had been to the sea, and had there seen white
+men writing.&nbsp; She had seen camels also, probably among the Arabs.&nbsp;
+She was the only Manganja woman we ever met who was ashamed of wearing
+the &ldquo;pelel&eacute;,&rdquo; or lip-ring.&nbsp; She retired to her
+hut, took it out, and kept her hand before her mouth to hide the hideous
+hole in the lip while conversing with us.&nbsp; All the villagers respected
+her, and even the headmen took a secondary place in her presence.&nbsp;
+On inquiring for her now, we found that she was dead.&nbsp; We never
+obtained sufficient materials to estimate the relative mortality of
+the highlands and lowlands; but, from many very old white-headed blacks
+having been seen on the highlands, we think it probable that even native
+races are longer lived the higher their dwelling-places are.</p>
+<p>We landed below at Mikena&rsquo;s and took observations for longitude,
+to verify those taken two years before.&nbsp; The village was deserted,
+Mikena and his people having fled to the other side of the river.&nbsp;
+A few had come across this morning to work in their old gardens.&nbsp;
+After completing the observations we had breakfast; and, as the last
+of the things were being carried into the boat, a Manganja man came
+running down to his canoe, crying out, &ldquo;The Ajawa have just killed
+my comrade!&rdquo;&nbsp; We shoved off, and in two minutes the advanced
+guard of a large marauding party were standing with their muskets on
+the spot where we had taken breakfast.&nbsp; They were evidently surprised
+at seeing us there, and halted; as did also the main body of perhaps
+a thousand men.&nbsp; &ldquo;Kill them,&rdquo; cried the Manganja; &ldquo;they
+are going up to the hills to kill the English,&rdquo; meaning the missionaries
+we had left at Magomero.&nbsp; But having no prospect of friendly communication
+with them, nor confidence in Manganja&rsquo;s testimony, we proceeded
+down the river; leaving the Ajawa sitting under a large baobab, and
+the Manganja cursing them most energetically across the river.</p>
+<p>On our way up, we had seen that the people of Zimika had taken refuge
+on a long island in the Shir&eacute;, where they had placed stores of
+grain to prevent it falling into the hands of the Ajawa; supposing afterwards
+that the invasion and war were past, they had removed back again to
+the mainland on the east, and were living in fancied security.&nbsp;
+On approaching the chief&rsquo;s village, which was built in the midst
+of a beautiful grove of lofty wild-fig and palm trees, sounds of revelry
+fell upon our ears.&nbsp; The people were having a merry time&mdash;drumming,
+dancing, and drinking beer&mdash;while a powerful enemy was close at
+hand, bringing death or slavery to every one in the village.&nbsp; One
+of our men called out to several who came to the bank to look at us,
+that the Ajawa were coming and were even now at Mikena&rsquo;s village;
+but they were dazed with drinking, and took no notice of the warning.</p>
+<p>Crowds of carriers offered their services after we left the river.&nbsp;
+Several sets of them placed so much confidence in us, as to decline
+receiving payment at the end of the first day; they wished to work another
+day, and so receive both days&rsquo; wages in one piece.&nbsp; The young
+headman of a new village himself came on with his men.&nbsp; The march
+was a pretty long one, and one of the men proposed to lay the burdens
+down beside a hut a mile or more from the next village.&nbsp; The headman
+scolded the fellow for his meanness in wishing to get rid of our goods
+where we could not procure carriers, and made him carry them on.&nbsp;
+The village, at the foot of the cataracts, had increased very much in
+size and wealth since we passed it on our way up.&nbsp; A number of
+large new huts had been built; and the people had a good stock of cloth
+and beads.&nbsp; We could not account for this sudden prosperity, until
+we saw some fine large canoes, instead of the two old, leaky things
+which lay there before.&nbsp; This had become a crossing-place for the
+slaves that the Portuguese agents were carrying to Tette, because they
+were afraid to take them across nearer to where the ship lay, about
+seven miles off.&nbsp; Nothing was more disheartening than this conduct
+of the Manganja, in profiting by the entire breaking up of their nation.</p>
+<p>We reached the ship on the 8th of November, 1861, in a very weak
+condition, having suffered more from hunger than on any previous trip.&nbsp;
+Heavy rains commenced on the 9th, and continued several days; the river
+rose rapidly, and became highly discoloured.&nbsp; Bishop Mackenzie
+came down to the ship on the 14th, with some of the &ldquo;Pioneer&rsquo;s&rdquo;
+men, who had been at Magomero for the benefit of their health, and also
+for the purpose of assisting the Mission.&nbsp; The Bishop appeared
+to be in excellent spirits, and thought that the future promised fair
+for peace and usefulness.&nbsp; The Ajawa having been defeated and driven
+off while we were on the Lake, had sent word that they desired to live
+at peace with the English.&nbsp; Many of the Manganja had settled round
+Magomero, in order to be under the protection of the Bishop; and it
+was hoped that the slave-trade would soon cease in the highlands, and
+the people be left in the secure enjoyment of their industry.&nbsp;
+The Mission, it was also anticipated, might soon become, to a considerable
+degree, self-supporting, and raise certain kinds of food, like the Portuguese
+of Senna and Quillimane.&nbsp; Mr. Burrup, an energetic young man, had
+arrived at Chibisa&rsquo;s the day before the Bishop, having come up
+the Shir&eacute; in a canoe.&nbsp; A surgeon and a lay brother followed
+behind in another canoe.&nbsp; The &ldquo;Pioneer&rsquo;s&rdquo; draught
+being too much for the upper part of the Shir&eacute;, it was not deemed
+advisable to bring her up, on the next trip, further than the Ruo; the
+Bishop, therefore, resolved to explore the country from Magomero to
+the mouth of that river, and to meet the ship with his sisters and Mrs.
+Burrup, in January.&nbsp; This was arranged before parting, and then
+the good Bishop and Burrup, whom we were never to meet again, left us;
+they gave and received three hearty English cheers as they went to the
+shore, and we steamed off.</p>
+<p>The rains ceased on the 14th, and the waters of the Shir&eacute;
+fell, even more rapidly than they had risen.&nbsp; A shoal, twenty miles
+below Chibisa&rsquo;s, checked our further progress, and we lay there
+five weary weeks, till the permanent rise of the river took place.&nbsp;
+During this detention, with a large marsh on each side, the first death
+occurred in the Expedition which had now been three-and-a-half years
+in the country.&nbsp; The carpenter&rsquo;s mate, a fine healthy young
+man, was seized with fever.&nbsp; The usual remedies had no effect;
+he died suddenly while we were at evening prayers, and was buried on
+shore.&nbsp; He came out in the &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo; and, with the
+exception of a slight touch of fever at the mouth of the Rovuma, had
+enjoyed perfect health all the time he had been with us.&nbsp; The Portuguese
+are of opinion that the European who has immunity from this disease
+for any length of time after he enters the country is more likely to
+be cut off by it when it does come, than the man who has it frequently
+at first.</p>
+<p>The rains became pretty general towards the close of December, and
+the Shir&eacute; was in flood in the beginning of January, 1862.&nbsp;
+At our wooding-place, a mile above the Ruo, the water was three feet
+higher than it was when we were here in June; and on the night of the
+6th it rose eighteen inches more, and swept down an immense amount of
+brushwood and logs which swarmed with beetles and the two kinds of shells
+which are common all over the African continent.&nbsp; Natives in canoes
+were busy spearing fish in the meadows and creeks, and appeared to be
+taking them in great numbers.&nbsp; Spur-winged geese, and others of
+the knob-nosed species, took advantage of the low gardens being flooded,
+and came to pilfer the beans.&nbsp; As we passed the Ruo, on the 7th,
+and saw nothing of the Bishop, we concluded that he had heard from his
+surgeon of our detention, and had deferred his journey.&nbsp; He arrived
+there five days after, on the 12th.</p>
+<p>After paying our Senna men, as they wished to go home, we landed
+them here.&nbsp; All were keen traders, and had invested largely in
+native iron-hoes, axes, and ornaments.&nbsp; Many of the hoes and spears
+had been taken from the slaving parties whose captives we liberated;
+for on these occasions our Senna friends were always uncommonly zealous
+and active.&nbsp; The remainder had been purchased with the old clothes
+we had given them and their store of hippopotamus meat: they had no
+fear of losing them, or of being punished for aiding us.&nbsp; The system,
+in which they had been trained, had eradicated the idea of personal
+responsibility from their minds.&nbsp; The Portuguese slaveholders would
+blame the English alone, they said; they were our servants at the time.&nbsp;
+No white man on board could purchase so cheaply as these men could.&nbsp;
+Many a time had their eloquence persuaded a native trader to sell for
+a bit of dirty worn cloth things for which he had, but a little before,
+refused twice the amount of clean new calico.&nbsp; &ldquo;Scissors&rdquo;
+being troubled with a cough at night, received a present of a quilted
+coverlet, which had seen a good deal of service.&nbsp; A few days afterwards,
+a good chance of investing in hoes offering itself, he ripped off both
+sides, tore them into a dozen pieces, and purchased about a dozen hoes
+with them.</p>
+<p>We entered the Zambesi on the 11th of January, and steamed down towards
+the coast, taking the side on which we had come up; but the channel
+had changed to the other side during the summer, as it sometimes does,
+and we soon grounded.&nbsp; A Portuguese gentleman, formerly a lieutenant
+in the army, and now living on Sangwisa, one of the islands of the Zambesi,
+came over with his slaves, to aid us in getting the ship off.&nbsp;
+He said frankly, that his people were all great thieves, and we must
+be on our guard not to leave anything about.&nbsp; He next made a short
+speech to his men, told them he knew what thieves they were, but implored
+them not to steal from us, as we would give them a present of cloth
+when the work was done.&nbsp; &ldquo;The natives of this country,&rdquo;
+he remarked to us, &ldquo;think only of three things, what they shall
+eat and drink, how many wives they can have, and what they may steal
+from their master, if not how they may murder him.&rdquo;&nbsp; He always
+slept with a loaded musket by his side.&nbsp; This opinion may apply
+to slaves, but decidedly does not in our experience apply to freemen.&nbsp;
+We paid his men for helping us, and believe that even they, being paid,
+stole nothing from us.&nbsp; Our friend farms pretty extensively the
+large island called Sangwisa,&mdash;lent him for nothing by Senhor Ferr&atilde;o,&mdash;and
+raises large quantities of mapira and beans, and also beautiful white
+rice, grown from seed brought a few years ago from South Carolina.&nbsp;
+He furnished us with some, which was very acceptable; for though not
+in absolute want, we were living on beans, salt pork, and fowls, all
+the biscuit and flour on board having been expended.</p>
+<p>We fully expected that the owners of the captives we had liberated
+would show their displeasure, at least by their tongues; but they seemed
+ashamed; only one ventured a remark, and he, in the course of common
+conversation, said, with a smile, &ldquo;You took the Governor&rsquo;s
+slaves, didn&rsquo;t you?&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;Yes, we did free several
+gangs that we met in the Manganja country.&rdquo;&nbsp; The Portuguese
+of Tette, from the Governor downwards, were extensively engaged in slaving.&nbsp;
+The trade is partly internal and partly external: they send some of
+the captives, and those bought, into the interior, up the Zambesi: some
+of these we actually met on their way up the river.&nbsp; The young
+women were sold there for ivory: an ordinary-looking one brought two
+arrobas, sixty-four pounds weight, and an extra beauty brought twice
+that amount.&nbsp; The men and boys were kept as carriers, to take the
+ivory down from the interior to Tette, or were retained on farms on
+the Zambesi, ready for export if a slaver should call: of this last
+mode of slaving we were witnesses also.&nbsp; The slaves were sent down
+the river chained, and in large canoes.&nbsp; This went on openly at
+Tette, and more especially so while the French &ldquo;Free Emigration&rdquo;
+system was in full operation.&nbsp; This double mode of disposing of
+the captives pays better than the single system of sending them down
+to the coast for exportation.&nbsp; One merchant at Tette, with whom
+we were well acquainted, sent into the interior three hundred Manganja
+women to be sold for ivory, and another sent a hundred and fifty.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER XI.</h3>
+<p>Arrival of H.M.S. &ldquo;Gorgon&rdquo;&mdash;Dr. Livingstone&rsquo;s
+new steamer and Mrs. Livingstone&mdash;Death of Mrs. Livingstone&mdash;Voyage
+to Johanna and the Rovuma&mdash;An attack upon the &ldquo;Pioneer&rsquo;s&rdquo;
+boats.</p>
+<p>We anchored on the Great Luabo mouth of the Zambesi, because wood
+was much more easily obtained there than at the Kongon&eacute;.</p>
+<p>On the 30th, H.M.S. &ldquo;Gorgon&rdquo; arrived, towing the brig
+which brought Mrs. Livingstone, some ladies about to join their relatives
+in the Universities&rsquo; Mission, and the twenty-four sections of
+a new iron steamer intended for the navigation of Lake Nyassa.&nbsp;
+The &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; steamed out, and towed the brig into the Kongon&eacute;
+harbour.&nbsp; The new steamer was called the &ldquo;Lady of the Lake,&rdquo;
+or the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa,&rdquo; and as much as could be carried of
+her in one trip was placed, by the help of the officers and men of the
+&ldquo;Gorgon,&rdquo; on board the &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo; and the two
+large paddle-box boats of H.M.&rsquo;s ship.&nbsp; We steamed off for
+Ruo on the 10th of February, having on board Captain Wilson, with a
+number of his officers and men to help us to discharge the cargo.&nbsp;
+Our progress up was distressingly slow.&nbsp; The river was in flood,
+and we had a three-knot current against us in many places.&nbsp; These
+delays kept us six months in the delta, instead of, as we anticipated,
+only six days; for, finding it impossible to carry the sections up to
+the Ruo without great loss of time, it was thought best to land them
+at Shupanga, and, putting the hull of the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo;
+together there, to tow her up to the foot of the Murchison Cataracts.</p>
+<p>A few days before the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; reached Shupanga, Captain
+Wilson, seeing the hopeless state of affairs, generously resolved to
+hasten with the Mission ladies up to those who, we thought, were anxiously
+awaiting their arrival, and therefore started in his gig for the Ruo,
+taking Miss Mackenzie, Mrs. Burrup, and his surgeon, Dr. Ramsay.&nbsp;
+They were accompanied by Dr. Kirk and Mr. Sewell, paymaster of the &ldquo;Gorgon,&rdquo;
+in the whale-boat of the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa.&rdquo;&nbsp; As our slow-paced-launch,
+&ldquo;Ma Robert,&rdquo; had formerly gone up to the foot of the cataracts
+in nine days&rsquo; steaming, it was supposed that the boats might easily
+reach the expected meeting-place at the Ruo in a week; but the Shir&eacute;
+was now in flood, and in its most rapid state; and they were longer
+in getting up about half the distance, than it was hoped they would
+be in the whole navigable part of the river.&nbsp; They could hear nothing
+of the Bishop from the chief of the island, Malo, at the mouth of the
+Ruo.&nbsp; &ldquo;No white man had ever come to his village,&rdquo;
+he said.&nbsp; They proceeded on to Chibisa&rsquo;s, suffering terribly
+from mosquitoes at night.&nbsp; Their toil in stemming the rapid current
+made them estimate the distance, by the windings, as nearer 300 than
+200 miles.&nbsp; The Makololo who had remained at Chibisa&rsquo;s told
+them the sad news of the death of the good Bishop and of Mr. Burrup.&nbsp;
+Other information received there awakened fresh anxiety on behalf of
+the survivors; so, leaving the ladies with Dr. Ramsay and the Makololo,
+Captain Wilson and Dr. Kirk went up the hills, in hopes of being able
+to render assistance, and on the way they met some of the Mission party
+at Soch&eacute;&rsquo;s.&nbsp; The excessive fatigue that our friends
+had undergone in the voyage up to Chibisa&rsquo;s in no wise deterred
+them from this further attempt for the benefit of their countrymen,
+but the fresh labour, with diminished rations, was too much for their
+strength.&nbsp; They were reduced to a diet of native beans and an occasional
+fowl.&nbsp; Both became very ill of fever, Captain Wilson so dangerously
+that his fellow-sufferer lost all hopes of his recovery.&nbsp; His strong
+able-bodied cockswain did good service in cheerfully carrying his much-loved
+Commander, and they managed to return to the boat, and brought the two
+bereaved and sorrow-stricken ladies back to the &ldquo;Pioneer.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>We learnt that the Bishop, wishing to find a shorter route down to
+the Shir&eacute;, had sent two men to explore the country between Magomero
+and the junction of the Ruo; and in December Messrs. Proctor and Scudamore,
+with a number of Manganja carriers, left Magomero for the same purpose.&nbsp;
+They were to go close to Mount Choro, and then skirt the Elephant Marsh,
+with Mount Clarendon on their left.&nbsp; Their guides seem to have
+led them away to the east, instead of south; to the upper waters of
+the Ruo in the Shirwa valley, instead of to its mouth.&nbsp; Entering
+an Anguru slave-trading village, they soon began to suspect that the
+people meant mischief, and just before sunset a woman told some of their
+men that if they slept there they would all be killed.&nbsp; On their
+preparing to leave, the Anguru followed them and shot their arrows at
+the retreating party.&nbsp; Two of the carriers were captured, and all
+the goods were taken by these robbers.&nbsp; An arrow-head struck deep
+into the stock of Proctor&rsquo;s gun; and the two missionaries, barely
+escaping with their lives, swam a deep river at night, and returned
+to Magomero famished and exhausted.</p>
+<p>The wives of the captive carriers came to the Bishop day after day
+weeping and imploring him to rescue their husbands from slavery.&nbsp;
+The men had been caught while in his service, no one else could be entreated;
+there was no public law nor any power superior to his own, to which
+an appeal could be made; for in him Church and State were, in the disorganized
+state of the country, virtually united.&nbsp; It seemed to him to be
+clearly his duty to try and rescue these kidnapped members of the Mission
+family.&nbsp; He accordingly invited the veteran Makololo to go with
+him on this somewhat hazardous errand.&nbsp; Nothing could have been
+proposed to them which they would have liked better, and they went with
+alacrity to eat the sheep of the Anguru, only regretting that the enemy
+did not keep cattle as well.&nbsp; Had the matter been left entirely
+in their hands, they would have made a clean sweep of that part of the
+country; but the Bishop restrained them, and went in an open manner,
+thus commending the measure to all the natives, as one of justice.&nbsp;
+This deliberation, however, gave the delinquents a chance of escape.</p>
+<p>The missionaries were successful; the offending village was burned,
+and a few sheep and goats were secured which could not be considered
+other than a very mild punishment for the offence committed; the headman,
+Muana-somba, afraid to retain the prisoners any longer, forthwith liberated
+them, and they returned to their homes.&nbsp; This incident took place
+at the time we were at the Ruo and during the rains, and proved very
+trying to the health of the missionaries; they were frequently wetted,
+and had hardly any food but roasted maize.&nbsp; Mr. Scudamore was never
+well afterwards.&nbsp; Directly on their return to Magomero, the Bishop
+and Mr. Burrup, both suffering from diarrhoea in consequence of wet,
+hunger, and exposure, started for Chibisa&rsquo;s to go down to the
+Ruo by the Shir&eacute;.&nbsp; So fully did the Bishop expect a renewal
+of the soaking wet from which he had just returned, that on leaving
+Magomero he walked through the stream.&nbsp; The rivulets were so swollen
+that it took five days to do a journey that would otherwise have occupied
+only two days and a half.</p>
+<p>None of the Manganja being willing to take them down the river during
+the flood, three Makololo canoe-men agreed to go with them.&nbsp; After
+paddling till near sunset, they decided to stop and sleep on shore;
+but the mosquitoes were so numerous that they insisted on going on again;
+the Bishop, being a week behind the time he had engaged to be at the
+Ruo, reluctantly consented, and in the darkness the canoe was upset
+in one of the strong eddies or whirlpools, which suddenly boil up in
+flood time near the outgoing branches of the river; clothing, medicines,
+tea, coffee, and sugar were all lost.&nbsp; Wet and weary, and tormented
+by mosquitoes, they lay in the canoe till morning dawned, and then proceeded
+to Malo, an island at the mouth of the Ruo, where the Bishop was at
+once seized with fever.</p>
+<p>Had they been in their usual health, they would doubtless have pushed
+on to Shupanga, or to the ship; but fever rapidly prostrates the energies,
+and induces a drowsy stupor, from which, if not roused by medicine,
+the patient gradually sinks into the sleep of death.&nbsp; Still mindful,
+however, of his office, the Bishop consoled himself by thinking that
+he might gain the friendship of the chief, which would be of essential
+service to him in his future labours.&nbsp; That heartless man, however,
+probably suspicious of all foreigners from the knowledge he had acquired
+of white slave-traders, wanted to turn the dying Bishop out of the hut,
+as he required it for his corn, but yielded to the expostulations of
+the Makololo.&nbsp; Day after day for three weeks did these faithful
+fellows remain beside his mat on the floor; till, without medicine or
+even proper food, he died.&nbsp; They dug his grave on the edge of the
+deep dark forest where the natives buried their dead.&nbsp; Mr. Burrup,
+himself far gone with dysentery, staggered from the hut, and, as in
+the dusk of evening they committed the Bishop&rsquo;s body to the grave,
+repeated from memory portions of our beautiful service for the Burial
+of the Dead&mdash;&ldquo;earth to earth, ashes to ashes, dust to dust;
+in sure and certain hope of the resurrection of the dead through our
+Lord Jesus Christ.&rdquo;&nbsp; And in this sad way ended the earthly
+career of one, of whom it can safely be said that for unselfish goodness
+of heart, and earnest devotion to the noble work he had undertaken,
+none of the commendations of his friends can exceed the reality.&nbsp;
+The grave in which his body rests is about a hundred yards from the
+confluence of the Ruo, on the left bank of the Shir&eacute;, and opposite
+the island of Malo.&nbsp; The Makololo then took Mr. Burrup up in the
+canoe as far as they could, and, making a litter of branches, carried
+him themselves, or got others to carry him, all the way back to his
+countrymen at Magomero.&nbsp; They hurried him on lest he should die
+in their hands, and blame be attached to them.&nbsp; Soon after his
+return he expired, from the disease which was on him when he started
+to meet his wife.</p>
+<p>Captain Wilson arrived at Shupanga on the 11th of March, having been
+three weeks on the Shir&eacute;.&nbsp; On the 15th the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo;
+steamed down to the Kongon&eacute;.&nbsp; The &ldquo;Gorgon&rdquo; had
+been driven out to sea in a gale, and had gone to Johanna for provisions,
+and it was the 2nd of April before she returned.&nbsp; It was fortunate
+for us that she had obtained a supply, as our provisions were exhausted,
+and we had to buy some from the master of the brig.&nbsp; The &ldquo;Gorgon&rdquo;
+left for the Cape on the 4th, taking all, except one, of the Mission
+party who had come in January.&nbsp; We take this opportunity of expressing
+our heartfelt gratitude to the gallant Captain I. C. Wilson and his
+officers for innumerable acts of kindness and hearty co-operation.&nbsp;
+Our warmest thanks are also due to Captain R. B. Oldfield and the other
+officers from the Admiral downwards, and we beg to assure them that
+nothing could be more encouraging to us in our difficulties and trials,
+than the knowledge that we possessed their friendship and sympathy in
+our labours.</p>
+<p>The Rev. James Stewart, of the Free Church of Scotland, arrived in
+the &ldquo;Gorgon.&rdquo;&nbsp; He had wisely come out to inspect the
+country, before deciding on the formation of a Mission in the interior.&nbsp;
+To this object he devoted many months of earnest labour.&nbsp; This
+Mission was intended to embrace both the industrial and the religious
+element; and as the route by the Zambesi and Shir&eacute; forms the
+only one at present known, with but a couple of days&rsquo; land journey
+to the highlands, which stretch to an unknown distance into the continent,
+and as no jealousy was likely to be excited in the mind of a man of
+Bishop Mackenzie&rsquo;s enlarged views&mdash;there being moreover room
+for hundreds of Missions&mdash;we gladly extended the little aid in
+our power to an envoy from the energetic body above mentioned, but recommended
+him to examine the field with his own eyes.</p>
+<p>During our subsequent detention at Shupanga, he proceeded as far
+up the Shir&eacute; as the Upper Cataracts, and saw the mere remnants
+of that dense population, which we at first had found living in peace
+and plenty, but which was now scattered and destroyed by famine and
+slave-hunting.&nbsp; The land, which both before and after we found
+so fair and fruitful, was burned up by a severe drought; in fact, it
+was at its very worst.&nbsp; With most praiseworthy energy, and in spite
+of occasional attacks of fever, he then ascended the Zambesi as far
+as Kebrabasa; and, what may be of interest to some, compared it, in
+parts, to the Danube.&nbsp; His estimate of the highlands would naturally
+be lower than ours.&nbsp; The main drawbacks in his opinion, however,
+were the slave-trade, and the power allowed the effete Portuguese of
+shutting up the country from all except a few convicts of their own
+nation.&nbsp; The time of his coming was inopportune; the disasters
+which, from inexperience, had befallen the Mission of the Universities,
+had a depressing effect on the minds of many at home, and rendered a
+new attempt unadvisable; though, had the Scotch perseverance and energy
+been introduced, it is highly probable that they would have reacted,
+most beneficially, on the zeal of our English brethren, and desertion
+would never have been heard of.&nbsp; After examining the country, Mr.
+Stewart descended the Zambesi in the beginning of the following year,
+and proceeded homewards with his report, by Mosambique and the Cape.</p>
+<p>On the 7th of April we had only one man fit for duty; all the rest
+were down with fever, or with the vile spirit secretly sold to them
+by the Portuguese officer of customs, in spite of our earnest request
+to him to refrain from the pernicious traffic.</p>
+<p>We started on the 11th for Shupanga with another load of the &ldquo;Lady
+Nyassa.&rdquo;&nbsp; As we steamed up the delta, we observed many of
+the natives wearing strips of palm-leaf, the signs of sickness and mourning;
+for they too suffer from fever.&nbsp; This is the unhealthy season;
+the rains are over, and the hot sun draws up malaria from the decayed
+vegetation; disease seemed peculiarly severe this year.&nbsp; On our
+way up we met Mr. Waller, who had come from Magomero for provisions;
+the missionaries were suffering severely from want of food; the liberated
+people were starving, and dying of diarrhoea, and loathsome sores.&nbsp;
+The Ajawa, stimulated in their slave raids by supplies of ammunition
+and cloth from the Portuguese, had destroyed the large crops of the
+past year; a drought had followed, and little or no food could be bought.&nbsp;
+With his usual energy, Mr. Waller hired canoes, loaded them with stores,
+and took them up the long weary way to Chibisa&rsquo;s.&nbsp; Before
+he arrived he was informed that the Mission of the Universities, now
+deprived of its brave leader, had retired from the highlands down to
+the Low Shir&eacute; Valley.&nbsp; This appeared to us, who knew the
+danger of leading a sedentary life, the greatest mistake they could
+have made, and was the result of no other counsel or responsibility
+than their own.&nbsp; Waller would have reascended at once to the higher
+altitude, but various objections stood in the way.&nbsp; The loss of
+poor Scudamore and Dickinson, in this low-lying situation, but added
+to the regret that the highlands had not received a fair trial.</p>
+<p>When the news of the Bishop&rsquo;s unfortunate collisions with the
+natives, and of his untimely end, reached England, much blame was imputed
+to him.&nbsp; The policy, which with the formal sanction of all his
+companions he had adopted, being directly contrary to the advice which
+Dr. Livingstone tendered, and to the assurances of the peaceable nature
+of the Mission which the Doctor had given to the natives, a friendly
+disapproval of a bishop&rsquo;s engaging in war was ventured on, when
+we met him at Chibisa&rsquo;s in November.&nbsp; But when we found his
+conduct regarded with so much bitterness in England, whether from a
+disposition to &ldquo;stand by the down man,&rdquo; or from having an
+intimate knowledge of the peculiar circumstances of the country in which
+he was placed, or from the thorough confidence which intimacy caused
+us to repose in his genuine piety, and devout service of God, we came
+to think much more leniently of his proceedings, than his assailants
+did.&nbsp; He never seemed to doubt but that he had done his duty; and
+throughout he had always been supported by his associates.</p>
+<p>The question whether a Bishop, in the event of his flock being torn
+from his bosom, may make war to rescue them, requires serious consideration.&nbsp;
+It seems to narrow itself into whether a Christian man may lawfully
+use the civil power or the sword at all in defensive war, as police
+or otherwise.&nbsp; We would do almost anything to avoid a collision
+with degraded natives; but in case of an invasion&mdash;our blood boils
+at the very thought of our wives, daughters, or sisters being touched&mdash;we,
+as men with human feelings, would unhesitatingly fight to the death,
+with all the fury in our power.</p>
+<p>The good Bishop was as intensely averse to using arms, before he
+met the slave-hunters, as any man in England.&nbsp; In the course he
+pursued he may have made a mistake, but it is a mistake which very few
+Englishmen on meeting bands of helpless captives, or members of his
+family in bonds, would have failed to commit likewise.</p>
+<p>During unhealthy April, the fever was more severe in Shupanga and
+Mazaro than usual.&nbsp; We had several cases on board&mdash;they were
+quickly cured, but, from our being in the delta, as quickly returned.&nbsp;
+About the middle of the month Mrs. Livingstone was prostrated by this
+disease; and it was accompanied by obstinate vomiting.&nbsp; Nothing
+is yet known that can allay this distressing symptom, which of course
+renders medicine of no avail, as it is instantly rejected.&nbsp; She
+received whatever medical aid could be rendered from Dr. Kirk, but became
+unconscious, and her eyes were closed in the sleep of death as the sunset
+on the evening of the Christian Sabbath, the 27th April, 1862.&nbsp;
+A coffin was made during the night, a grave was dug next day under the
+branches of the great baobab-tree, and with sympathizing hearts the
+little band of his countrymen assisted the bereaved husband in burying
+his dead.&nbsp; At his request, the Rev. James Stewart read the burial-service;
+and the seamen kindly volunteered to mount guard for some nights at
+the spot where her body rests in hope.&nbsp; Those who are not aware
+how this brave, good, English wife made a delightful home at Kolobeng,
+a thousand miles inland from the Cape, and as the daughter of Moffat
+and a Christian lady exercised most beneficial influence over the rude
+tribes of the interior, may wonder that she should have braved the dangers
+and toils of this down-trodden land.&nbsp; She knew them all, and, in
+the disinterested and dutiful attempt to renew her labours, was called
+to her rest instead.&nbsp; &ldquo;<i>Fiat, Domine, voluntas tua</i>!&rdquo;</p>
+<p>On the 5th of May Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone started in the
+boat for Tette, in order to see the property of the Expedition brought
+down in canoes.&nbsp; They took four Mazaro canoe-men to manage the
+boat, and a white sailor to cook for them; but, unfortunately, he caught
+fever the very day after leaving the ship, and was ill most of the trip;
+so they had to cook for themselves, and to take care of him besides.</p>
+<p>We now proceeded with preparations for the launch of the &ldquo;Lady
+Nyassa.&rdquo;&nbsp; Ground was levelled on the bank at Shupanga, for
+the purpose of arranging the compartments in order: she was placed on
+palm-trees which were brought from a place lower down the river for
+ways, and the engineer and his assistants were soon busily engaged;
+about a fortnight after they were all brought from Kongon&eacute;, the
+sections were screwed together.&nbsp; The blacks are more addicted to
+stealing where slavery exists than elsewhere.&nbsp; We were annoyed
+by thieves who carried off the iron screw-bolts, but were gratified
+to find that strychnine saved us from the man-thief as well as the hyena-thief.&nbsp;
+A hyena was killed by it, and after the natives saw the dead animal
+and knew how we had destroyed it, they concluded that it was not safe
+to steal from men who possessed a medicine so powerful.&nbsp; The half-caste,
+who kept Shupanga-house, said he wished to have some to give to the
+Zulus, of whom he was mortally afraid, and to whom he had to pay an
+unwilling tribute.</p>
+<p>The &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; made several trips to the Kongon&eacute;,
+and returned with the last load on the 12th of June.&nbsp; On the 23rd
+the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; was safely launched, the work of putting
+her together having been interrupted by fever and dysentery, and many
+other causes which it would only weary the reader to narrate in detail.&nbsp;
+Natives from all parts of the country came to see the launch, most of
+them quite certain that, being made of iron, she must go to the bottom
+as soon as she entered the water.&nbsp; Earnest discussions had taken
+place among them with regard to the propriety of using iron for ship-building.&nbsp;
+The majority affirmed that it would never answer.&nbsp; They said, &ldquo;If
+we put a hoe into the water, or the smallest bit of iron, it sinks immediately.&nbsp;
+How then can such a mass of iron float? it must go to the bottom.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+The minority answered that this might be true with them, but white men
+had medicine for everything.&nbsp; &ldquo;They could even make a woman,
+all except the speaking; look at that one on the figure-head of the
+vessel.&rdquo;&nbsp; The unbelievers were astonished, and could hardly
+believe their eyes, when they saw the ship float lightly and gracefully
+on the river, instead of going to the bottom, as they so confidently
+predicted.&nbsp; &ldquo;Truly,&rdquo; they said, &ldquo;these men have
+powerful medicine.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>Birds are numerous on the Shupanga estate.&nbsp; Some kinds remain
+all the year round, while many others are there only for a few months.&nbsp;
+Flocks of green pigeons come in April to feed on the young fruit of
+the wild fig-trees, which is also eaten by a large species of bat in
+the evenings.&nbsp; The pretty little black weaver, with yellow shoulders,
+appears to enjoy life intensely after assuming his wooing dress.&nbsp;
+A hearty breakfast is eaten in the mornings and then come the hours
+for making merry.&nbsp; A select party of three or four perch on the
+bushes which skirt a small grassy plain, and cheer themselves with the
+music of their own quiet and self-complacent song.&nbsp; A playful performance
+on the wind succeeds.&nbsp; Expanding his soft velvet-like plumage,
+one glides with quivering pinions to the centre of the open space, singing
+as he flies, then turns with a rapid whirring sound from his wings&mdash;somewhat
+like a child&rsquo;s rattle&mdash;and returns to his place again.&nbsp;
+One by one the others perform the same feat, and continue the sport
+for hours, striving which can produce the loudest brattle while turning.&nbsp;
+These games are only played during the season of courting and of the
+gay feathers; the merriment seems never to be thought of while the bird
+wears his winter suit of sober brown.</p>
+<p>We received two mules from the Cape to aid us in transporting the
+pieces of the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; past the cataracts and landed
+them at Shupanga, but they soon perished.&nbsp; A Portuguese gentleman
+kindly informed us, <i>after</i> both the mules were dead, that he knew
+they would die; for the land there had been often tried, and nothing
+would live on it&mdash;not even a pig.&nbsp; He said he had not told
+us so before, because he did not like to appear officious!</p>
+<p>By the time everything had been placed on board the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa,&rdquo;
+the waters of the Zambesi and the Shir&eacute; had fallen so low that
+it was useless to attempt taking her up to the cataracts before the
+rains in December.&nbsp; Draught oxen and provisions also were required,
+and could not be obtained nearer than the Island of Johanna.&nbsp; The
+Portuguese, without refusing positively to let trade enter the Zambesi,
+threw impediments in the way; they only wanted a small duty!&nbsp; They
+were about to establish a river police, and rearrange the Crown lands,
+which have long since become Zulu lands; meanwhile they were making
+the Zambesi, by slaving, of no value to any one.</p>
+<p>The Rovuma, which was reported to come from Lake Nyassa, being out
+of their claims and a free river, we determined to explore it in our
+boats immediately on our return from Johanna, for which place, after
+some delay at the Kongon&eacute;, in repairing engines, paddle-wheel,
+and rudder, we sailed on the 6th of August.&nbsp; A store of naval provisions
+had been formed on a hulk in Pomon&eacute; Bay of that island for the
+supply of the cruisers, and was in charge of Mr. Sunley, the Consul,
+from whom we always received the kindest attentions and assistance.&nbsp;
+He now obliged us by parting with six oxen, trained for his own use
+in sugar-making.&nbsp; Though sadly hampered in his undertaking by being
+obliged to employ slave labour, he has by indomitable energy overcome
+obstacles under which most persons would have sunk.&nbsp; He has done
+all that under the circumstances could be done to infuse a desire for
+freedom, by paying regular wages; and has established a large factory,
+and brought 300 acres of rich soil under cultivation with sugar-cane.&nbsp;
+We trust he will realize the fortune which he so well deserves to earn.&nbsp;
+Had Mr. Sunley performed the same experiment on the mainland, where
+people would have flocked to him for the wages he now gives, he would
+certainly have inaugurated a new era on the East Coast of Africa.&nbsp;
+On a small island where the slaveholders have complete power over the
+slaves, and where there is no free soil such as is everywhere met with
+in Africa, the experiment ought not to be repeated.&nbsp; Were Mr. Sunley
+commencing again, it should neither be in Zanzibar nor Johanna, but
+on African soil, where, if even a slave is ill-treated, he can easily
+by flight become free.&nbsp; On an island under native rule a joint
+manufacture by Arabs and Englishmen might only mean that the latter
+were to escape the odium of flogging the slaves.</p>
+<p>On leaving Johanna and our oxen for a time, H.M.S. &ldquo;Orestes&rdquo;
+towed us thence to the mouth of the Rovuma at the beginning of September.&nbsp;
+Captain Gardner, her commander, and several of his officers, accompanied
+us up the river for two days in the gig and cutter.&nbsp; The water
+was unusually low, and it was rather dull work for a few hours in the
+morning; but the scene became livelier and more animated when the breeze
+began to blow.&nbsp; Our four boats they swept on under full sail, the
+men on the look out in the gig and cutter calling, &ldquo;Port, sir!&rdquo;&nbsp;
+&ldquo;Starboard, sir!&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;As you go, sir!&rdquo; while
+the black men in the bows of the others shouted the practical equivalents,
+&ldquo;Pagomb&eacute;! Pagomb&eacute;!&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;Enda quet&eacute;!&rdquo;&nbsp;
+&ldquo;Beran&eacute;! Beran&eacute;!&rdquo;&nbsp; Presently the leading-boat
+touches on a sandbank; down comes the fluttering sail; the men jump
+out to shove her off, and the other boats, shunning the obstruction,
+shoot on ahead to be brought up each in its turn by mistaking a sandbank
+for the channel, which had often but a very little depth of water.</p>
+<p>A drowsy herd of hippopotami were suddenly startled by a score of
+rifle-shots, and stared in amazement at the strange objects which had
+invaded their peaceful domains, until a few more bullets compelled them
+to seek refuge at the bottom of the deep pool, near which they had been
+quietly reposing.&nbsp; On our return, one of the herd retaliated.&nbsp;
+He followed the boat, came up under it, and twice tried to tear the
+bottom out of it; but fortunately it was too flat for his jaws to get
+a good grip, so he merely damaged one of the planks with his tusks,
+though he lifted the boat right up, with ten men and a ton of ebony
+in it.</p>
+<p>We slept, one of the two nights Captain Gardner was with us, opposite
+the lakelet Chidia, which is connected with the river in flood time,
+and is nearly surrounded by hills some 500 or 600 feet high, dotted
+over with trees.&nbsp; A few small groups of huts stood on the hill-sides,
+with gardens off which the usual native produce had been reaped.&nbsp;
+The people did not seem much alarmed by the presence of the large party
+which had drawn up on the sandbanks below their dwellings.&nbsp; There
+is abundance of large ebony in the neighbourhood.&nbsp; The pretty little
+antelope (<i>Cephalophus c&aelig;ruleus</i>), about the size of a hare,
+seemed to abound, as many of their skins were offered for sale.&nbsp;
+Neat figured date-leaf mats of various colours are woven here, the different
+dyes being obtained from the barks of trees.&nbsp; Cattle could not
+live on the banks of the Rovuma on account of the tsetse, which are
+found from near the mouth, up as far as we could take the boats.&nbsp;
+The navigation did not improve as we ascended; snags, brought down by
+the floods, were common, and left in the channel on the sudden subsidence
+of the water.&nbsp; In many places, where the river divided into two
+or three channels, there was not water enough in any of them for a boat
+drawing three feet, so we had to drag ours over the shoals; but we saw
+the river at its very lowest, and it may be years before it is so dried
+up again.</p>
+<p>The valley of the Rovuma, bounded on each side by a range of highlands,
+is from two to four miles in width, and comes in a pretty straight course
+from the W.S.W.; but the channel of the river is winding, and now at
+its lowest zigzagged so perversely, that frequently the boats had to
+pass over three miles to make one in a straight line.&nbsp; With a full
+stream it must of course be much easier work.&nbsp; Few natives were
+seen during the first week.&nbsp; Their villages are concealed in the
+thick jungle on the hill-sides, for protection from marauding slave-parties.&nbsp;
+Not much of interest was observed on this part of the silent and shallow
+river.&nbsp; Though feeling convinced that it was unfit for navigation,
+except for eight months of the year, we pushed on, resolved to see if,
+further inland, the accounts we had received from different naval officers
+of its great capabilities would prove correct; or if, by communication
+with Lake Nyassa, even the upper part could be turned to account.&nbsp;
+Our exploration showed us that the greatest precaution is required in
+those who visit new countries.</p>
+<p>The reports we received from gentlemen, who had entered the river
+and were well qualified to judge, were that the Rovuma was infinitely
+superior to the Zambesi, in the absence of any bar at its mouth, in
+its greater volume of water, and in the beauty of the adjacent lands.&nbsp;
+We probably came at a different season from that in which they visited
+it, and our account ought to be taken with theirs to arrive at the truth.&nbsp;
+It might be available as a highway for commerce during three quarters
+of each year; but casual visitors, like ourselves and others, are all
+ill able to decide.&nbsp; The absence of animal life was remarkable.&nbsp;
+Occasionally we saw pairs of the stately jabirus, or adjutant-looking
+marabouts, wading among the shoals, and spur-winged geese, and other
+water-fowl, but there was scarcely a crocodile or a hippopotamus to
+be seen.</p>
+<p>At the end of the first week, an old man called at our camp, and
+said he would send a present from his village, which was up among the
+hills.&nbsp; He appeared next morning with a number of his people, bringing
+meal, cassava-root, and yams.&nbsp; The language differs considerably
+from that on the Zambesi, but it is of the same family.&nbsp; The people
+are Makond&eacute;, and are on friendly terms with the Mabiha, and the
+Makoa, who live south of the Rovuma.&nbsp; When taking a walk up the
+slopes of the north bank, we found a great variety of trees we had seen
+nowhere else.&nbsp; Those usually met with far inland seem here to approach
+the coast.&nbsp; African ebony, generally named <i>mpingu</i>, is abundant
+within eight miles of the sea; it attains a larger size, and has more
+of the interior black wood than usual.&nbsp; A good timber tree called
+<i>mosoko</i> is also found; and we saw half-caste Arabs near the coast
+cutting up a large log of it into planks.&nbsp; Before reaching the
+top of the rise we were in a forest of bamboos.&nbsp; On the plateau
+above, large patches were cleared and cultivated.&nbsp; A man invited
+us to take a cup of beer; on our complying with his request, the fear
+previously shown by the bystanders vanished.&nbsp; Our Mazaro men could
+hardly understand what they said.&nbsp; Some of them waded in the river
+and caught a curious fish in holes in the claybank.&nbsp; Its ventral
+fin is peculiar, being unusually large, and of a circular shape, like
+boys&rsquo; playthings called &ldquo;suckers.&rdquo;&nbsp; We were told
+that this fish is found also in the Zambesi, and is called Chirir&eacute;.&nbsp;
+Though all its fins are large, it is asserted that it rarely ventures
+out into the stream, but remains near its hole, where it is readily
+caught by the hand.</p>
+<p>The Zambesi men thoroughly understood the characteristic marks of
+deep or shallow water, and showed great skill in finding out the proper
+channel.&nbsp; The Molimo is the steersman at the helm, the Mokadamo
+is the head canoe-man, and he stands erect on the bows with a long pole
+in his hands, and directs the steersman where to go, aiding the rudder,
+if necessary, with his pole.&nbsp; The others preferred to stand and
+punt our boat, rather than row with our long oars, being able to shove
+her ahead faster than they could pull her.&nbsp; They are accustomed
+to short paddles.&nbsp; Our Mokadamo was affected with moon-blindness,
+and could not see at all at night.&nbsp; His comrades then led him about,
+and handed him his food.&nbsp; They thought that it was only because
+his eyes rested all night, that he could see the channel so well by
+day.&nbsp; At difficult places the Mokadamo sometimes, however, made
+mistakes, and ran us aground; and the others, evidently imbued with
+the spirit of resistance to constituted authority, and led by Jo&atilde;o
+an aspirant for the office, jeered him for his stupidity.&nbsp; &ldquo;Was
+he asleep?&nbsp; Why did he allow the boat to come there?&nbsp; Could
+he not see the channel was somewhere else?&rdquo;&nbsp; At last the
+Mokadamo threw down the pole in disgust, and told Jo&atilde;o he might
+be a Mokadamo himself.&nbsp; The office was accepted with alacrity;
+but in a few minutes he too ran us into a worse difficulty than his
+predecessor ever did, and was at once disrated amidst the derision of
+his comrades.</p>
+<p>On the 16th September, we arrived at the inhabited island of Kichokoman&eacute;.&nbsp;
+The usual way of approaching an unknown people is to call out in a cheerful
+tone &ldquo;Malonda!&rdquo;&nbsp; Things for sale, or do you want to
+sell anything?&nbsp; If we can obtain a man from the last village, he
+is employed, though only useful in explaining to the next that we come
+in a friendly way.&nbsp; The people here were shy of us at first, and
+could not be induced to sell any food; until a woman, more adventurous
+than the rest, sold us a fowl.&nbsp; This opened the market, and crowds
+came with fowls and meal, far beyond our wants.&nbsp; The women are
+as ugly as those on Lake Nyassa, for who can be handsome wearing the
+pelel&eacute;, or upper-lip ring, of large dimensions?&nbsp; We were
+once surprised to see young men wearing the pelel&eacute;, and were
+told that in the tribe of the Mabiha, on the south bank, men as well
+as women wore them.</p>
+<p>Along the left bank, above Kichokoman&eacute;, is an exceedingly
+fertile plain, nearly two miles broad, and studded with a number of
+deserted villages.&nbsp; The inhabitants were living in temporary huts
+on low naked sandbanks; and we found this to be the case as far as we
+went.&nbsp; They leave most of their property and food behind, because
+they are not afraid of these being stolen, but only fear being stolen
+themselves.&nbsp; The great slave-route from Nyassa to Kilwa passes
+to N.E. from S.W., just beyond them; and it is dangerous to remain in
+their villages at this time of year, when the kidnappers are abroad.&nbsp;
+In one of the temporary villages, we saw, in passing, two human heads
+lying on the ground.&nbsp; We slept a couple of miles above this village.</p>
+<p>Before sunrise next morning, a large party armed with bows and arrows
+and muskets came to the camp, two or three of them having a fowl each,
+which we refused to purchase, having bought enough the day before.&nbsp;
+They followed us all the morning, and after breakfast those on the left
+bank swam across and joined the main party on the other side.&nbsp;
+It was evidently their intention to attack us at a chosen spot, where
+we had to pass close to a high bank, but their plan was frustrated by
+a stiff breeze sweeping the boat past, before the majority could get
+to the place.&nbsp; They disappeared then, but came out again ahead
+of us, on a high wooded bank, walking rapidly to the bend, near which
+we were obliged to sail.&nbsp; An arrow was shot at the foremost boat;
+and seeing the force at the bend, we pushed out from the side, as far
+as the shoal water would permit, and tried to bring them to a parley,
+by declaring that we had not come to fight, but to see the river.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;Why did you fire a gun, a little while ago?&rdquo; they asked.&nbsp;
+&ldquo;We shot a large puff-adder, to prevent it from killing men; you
+may see it lying dead on the beach.&rdquo;&nbsp; With great courage,
+our Mokadamo waded to within thirty yards of the bank, and spoke with
+much earnestness, assuring them that we were a peaceable party, and
+had not come for war, but to see the river.&nbsp; We were friends, and
+our countrymen bought cotton and ivory, and wished to come and trade
+with them.&nbsp; All we wanted was to go up quietly to look at the river,
+and then return to the sea.&nbsp; While he was talking with those on
+the shore, the old rogue, who appeared to be the ringleader, stole up
+the bank, and with a dozen others, waded across to the island, near
+which the boats lay, and came down behind us.&nbsp; Wild with excitement,
+they rushed into the water, and danced in our rear, with drawn bows,
+taking aim, and making various savage gesticulations.&nbsp; Their leader
+urged them to get behind some snags, and then shoot at us.&nbsp; The
+party on the bank in front had many muskets&mdash;and those of them,
+who had bows, held them with arrows ready set in the bowstrings.&nbsp;
+They had a mass of thick bush and trees behind them, into which they
+could in a moment dart, after discharging their muskets and arrows,
+and be completely hidden from our sight; a circumstance that always
+gives people who use bows and arrows the greatest confidence.&nbsp;
+Notwithstanding these demonstrations, we were exceedingly loath to come
+to blows.&nbsp; We spent a full half-hour exposed at any moment to be
+struck by a bullet or poisoned arrow.&nbsp; We explained that we were
+better armed than they were, and had plenty of ammunition, the suspected
+want of which often inspires them with courage, but that we did not
+wish to shed the blood of the children of the same Great Father with
+ourselves; that if we must fight, the guilt would be all theirs.</p>
+<p>This being a common mode of expostulation among themselves, we so
+far succeeded, that with great persuasion the leader and others laid
+down their arms, and waded over from the bank to the boats to talk the
+matter over.&nbsp; &ldquo;This was their river; they did not allow white
+men to use it.&nbsp; We must pay toll for leave to pass.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+It was somewhat humiliating to do so, but it was pay or fight; and,
+rather than fight, we submitted to the humiliation of paying for their
+friendship, and gave them thirty yards of cloth.&nbsp; They pledged
+themselves to be our friends ever afterwards, and said they would have
+food cooked for us on our return.&nbsp; We then hoisted sail, and proceeded,
+glad that the affair had been amicably settled.&nbsp; Those on shore
+walked up to the bend above to look at the boat, as we supposed; but
+the moment she was abreast of them, they gave us a volley of musket-balls
+and poisoned arrows, without a word of warning.&nbsp; Fortunately we
+were so near, that all the arrows passed clear over us, but four musket-balls
+went through the sail just above our heads.&nbsp; All our assailants
+bolted into the bushes and long grass the instant after firing, save
+two, one of whom was about to discharge a musket and the other an arrow,
+when arrested by the fire of the second boat.&nbsp; Not one of them
+showed their faces again, till we were a thousand yards away.&nbsp;
+A few shots were then fired over their heads, to give them an idea of
+the range of our rifles, and they all fled into the woods.&nbsp; Those
+on the sandbank rushed off too, with the utmost speed; but as they had
+not shot at us, we did not molest them, and they went off safely with
+their cloth.&nbsp; They probably expected to kill one of our number,
+and in the confusion rob the boats.&nbsp; It is only where the people
+are slavers that the natives of this part of Africa are bloodthirsty.</p>
+<p>These people have a bad name in the country in front, even among
+their own tribe.&nbsp; A slave-trading Arab we met above, thinking we
+were then on our way down the river, advised us not to land at the villages,
+but to stay in the boats, as the inhabitants were treacherous, and attacked
+at once, without any warning or provocation.&nbsp; Our experience of
+their conduct fully confirmed the truth of what he said.&nbsp; There
+was no trade on the river where they lived, but beyond that part there
+was a brisk canoe-trade in rice and salt; those further in the interior
+cultivating rice, and sending it down the river to be exchanged for
+salt, which is extracted from the earth in certain places on the banks.&nbsp;
+Our assailants hardly anticipated resistance, and told a neighbouring
+chief that, if they had known who we were, they would not have attacked
+English, who can &ldquo;bite hard.&rdquo;&nbsp; They offered no molestations
+on our way down, though we were an hour in passing their village.&nbsp;
+Our canoe-men plucked up courage on finding that we had come off unhurt.&nbsp;
+One of them, named Chiku, acknowledging that he had been terribly frightened,
+said.&nbsp; &ldquo;His fear was not the kind which makes a man jump
+overboard and run away; but that which brings the heart up to the mouth,
+and renders the man powerless, and no more able to fight than a woman.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>In the country of Chonga Michi, about 80 or 90 miles up the river,
+we found decent people, though of the same tribe, who treated strangers
+with civility.&nbsp; A body of Makoa had come from their own country
+in the south, and settled here.&nbsp; The Makoa are known by a cicatrice
+in the forehead shaped like the new moon with the horns turned downwards.&nbsp;
+The tribe possesses all the country west of Mosambique; and they will
+not allow any of the Portuguese to pass into their country more than
+two hours&rsquo; distance from the fort.&nbsp; A hill some ten or twelve
+miles distant, called Pau, has been visited during the present generation
+only by one Portuguese and one English officer, and this visit was accomplished
+only by the influence of the private friendship of a chief for this
+Portuguese gentleman.&nbsp; Our allies have occupied the Fort of Mosambique
+for three hundred years, but in this, as in all other cases, have no
+power further than they can see from a gun-carriage.</p>
+<p>The Makoa chief, Matingula, was hospitable and communicative, telling
+us all he knew of the river and country beyond.&nbsp; He had been once
+to Iboe and once at Mosambique with slaves.&nbsp; Our men understood
+his language easily.&nbsp; A useless musket he had bought at one of
+the above places was offered us for a little cloth.&nbsp; Having received
+a present of food from him, a railway rug was handed to him: he looked
+at it&mdash;had never seen cloth like that before&mdash;did not approve
+of it, and would rather have cotton cloth.&nbsp; &ldquo;But this will
+keep you warm at night.&rdquo;&mdash;&ldquo;Oh, I do not wish to be
+kept warm at night.&rdquo;&mdash;We gave him a bit of cotton cloth,
+not one-third the value of the rug, but it was more highly prized.&nbsp;
+His people refused to sell their fowls for our splendid prints and drab
+cloths.&nbsp; They had probably been taken in with gaudy-patterned sham
+prints before.&nbsp; They preferred a very cheap, plain, blue stuff
+of which they had experience.&nbsp; A great quantity of excellent honey
+is collected all along the river, by bark hives being placed for the
+bees on the high trees on both banks.&nbsp; Large pots of it, very good
+and clear, were offered in exchange for a very little cloth.&nbsp; No
+wax was brought for sale; there being no market for this commodity,
+it is probably thrown away as useless.</p>
+<p>At Michi we lose the tableland which, up to this point, bounds the
+view on both sides of the river, as it were, with ranges of flat-topped
+hills, 600 or 800 feet high; and to this plateau a level fertile plain
+succeeds, on which stand detached granite hills.&nbsp; That portion
+of the tableland on the right bank seems to bend away to the south,
+still preserving the appearance of a hill range.&nbsp; The height opposite
+extends a few miles further west, and then branches off in a northerly
+direction.&nbsp; A few small pieces of coal were picked up on the sandbanks,
+showing that this useful mineral exists on the Rovuma, or on some of
+its tributaries: the natives know that it will burn.&nbsp; At the lakelet
+Chidia, we noticed the same sandstone rock, with fossil wood on it,
+which we have on the Zambesi, and knew to be a sure evidence of coal
+beneath.&nbsp; We mentioned this at the time to Captain Gardner, and
+our finding coal now seemed a verification of what we then said; the
+coal-field probably extends from the Zambesi to the Rovuma, if not beyond
+it.&nbsp; Some of the rocks lower down have the permanent water-line
+three feet above the present height of the water.</p>
+<p>A few miles west of the Makoa of Matingula, we came again among the
+Makond&eacute;, but now of good repute.&nbsp; War and slavery have driven
+them to seek refuge on the sand-banks.&nbsp; A venerable-looking old
+man hailed us as we passed, and asked us if we were going by without
+speaking.&nbsp; We landed, and he laid down his gun and came to us;
+he was accompanied by his brother, who shook hands with every one in
+the boat, as he had seen people do at Kilwa.&nbsp; &ldquo;Then you have
+seen white men before?&rdquo; we said.&nbsp; &ldquo;Yes,&rdquo; replied
+the polite African, &ldquo;but never people of your quality.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+These men were very black, and wore but little clothing.&nbsp; A young
+woman, dressed in the highest style of Makond&eacute; fashion, punting
+as dexterously as a man could, brought a canoe full of girls to see
+us.&nbsp; She wore an ornamental head-dress of red beads tied to her
+hair on one side of her head, a necklace of fine beads of various colours,
+two bright figured brass bracelets on her left arm, and scarcely a farthing&rsquo;s
+worth of cloth, though it was at its cheapest.</p>
+<p>As we pushed on westwards, we found that the river makes a little
+southing, and some reaches were deeper than any near the sea; but when
+we had ascended about 140 miles by the river&rsquo;s course from the
+sea, soft tufa rocks began to appear; ten miles beyond, the river became
+more narrow and rocky, and when, according to our measurement, we had
+ascended 156 miles, our further progress was arrested.&nbsp; We were
+rather less than two degrees in a straight line from the Coast.&nbsp;
+The incidents worth noticing were but few: seven canoes with loads of
+salt and rice kept company with us for some days, and the further we
+went inland, the more civil the people became.</p>
+<p>When we came to a stand, just below the island of Nyamatolo, Long.
+38 degrees 36 minutes E., and Lat. 11 degrees 53 minutes, the river
+was narrow, and full of rocks.&nbsp; Near the island there is a rocky
+rapid with narrow passages fit only for native canoes; the fall is small,
+and the banks quite low; but these rocks were an effectual barrier to
+all further progress in boats.&nbsp; Previous reports represented the
+navigable part of this river as extending to the distance of a month&rsquo;s
+sail from its mouth; we found that, at the ordinary heights of the water,
+a boat might reach the obstructions which seem peculiar to all African
+rivers in six or eight days.&nbsp; The Rovuma is remarkable for the
+high lands that flank it for some eighty miles from the ocean.&nbsp;
+The cataracts of other rivers occur in mountains, those of the Rovuma
+are found in a level part, with hills only in the distance.&nbsp; Far
+away in the west and north we could see high blue heights, probably
+of igneous origin from their forms, rising out of a plain.</p>
+<p>The distance from Ngomano, a spot thirty miles further up, to the
+Arab crossing-places of Lake Nyassa Tsenga or Kotakota was said to be
+twelve days.&nbsp; The way we had discovered to Lake Nyassa by Murchison&rsquo;s
+Cataracts had so much less land carriage, that we considered it best
+to take our steamer thither, by the route in which we were well known,
+instead of working where we were strangers; and accordingly we made
+up our minds to return.</p>
+<p>The natives reported a worse place above our turning-point&mdash;the
+passage being still narrower than this.&nbsp; An Arab, they said, once
+built a boat above the rapids, and sent it down full of slaves; but
+it was broken to pieces in these upper narrows.&nbsp; Many still maintained
+that the Rovuma came from Nyassa, and that it is very narrow as it issues
+out of the lake.&nbsp; One man declared that he had seen it with his
+own eyes as it left the lake, and seemed displeased at being cross-questioned,
+as if we doubted his veracity.</p>
+<p>More satisfactory information, as it appeared to us, was obtained
+from others.&nbsp; Two days, or thirty miles, beyond where we turned
+back, the Rovuma is joined by the Liend&eacute;, which, coming from
+the south-west, rises in the mountains on the east side of Nyassa.&nbsp;
+The great slave route to Kilwa runs up the banks of this river, which
+is only ankle-deep at the dry season of the year.&nbsp; The Rovuma itself
+comes from the W.N.W., and after the traveller passes the confluence
+of the Liend&eacute; at Ngomano or &ldquo;meeting-place,&rdquo; the
+chief of which part is named Ndond&eacute;, he finds the river narrow,
+and the people Ajawa.</p>
+<p>Crocodiles in the Rovuma have a sorry time of it.&nbsp; Never before
+were reptiles so persecuted and snubbed.&nbsp; They are hunted with
+spears, and spring traps are set for them.&nbsp; If one of them enters
+an inviting pool after fish, he soon finds a fence thrown round it,
+and a spring trap set in the only path out of the enclosure.&nbsp; Their
+flesh is eaten, and relished.&nbsp; The banks, on which the female lays
+her eggs by night, are carefully searched by day, and all the eggs dug
+out and devoured.&nbsp; The fish-hawk makes havoc among the few young
+ones that escape their other enemies.&nbsp; Our men were constantly
+on the look-out for crocodiles&rsquo; nests.&nbsp; One was found containing
+thirty-five newly-laid eggs, and they declared that the crocodile would
+lay as many more the second night in another place.&nbsp; The eggs were
+a foot deep in the sand on the top of a bank ten feet high.&nbsp; The
+animal digs a hole with its foot, covers the eggs, and leaves them till
+the river rises over the nest in about three months afterwards, when
+she comes back, and assists the young ones out.&nbsp; We once saw opposite
+Tette young crocodiles in December, swimming beside an island in company
+with an old one.&nbsp; The yolk of the egg is nearly as white as the
+real white.&nbsp; In taste they resemble hen&rsquo;s eggs with perhaps
+a smack of custard, and would be as highly relished by whites as by
+blacks, were it not for their unsavoury origin in men-eaters.</p>
+<p>Hunting the Senz&eacute; (<i>Aulacodus Swindernianus</i>), an animal
+the size of a large cat, but in shape more like a pig, was the chief
+business of men and boys as we passed the reedy banks and low islands.&nbsp;
+They set fire to a mass of reeds, and, armed with sticks, spears, bows
+and arrows, stand in groups guarding the outlets through which the seared
+Senz&eacute; may run from the approaching flames.&nbsp; Dark dense volumes
+of impenetrable smoke now roll over on the lee side of the islet, and
+shroud the hunters.&nbsp; At times vast sheets of lurid flames bursting
+forth, roaring, crackling and exploding, leap wildly far above the tall
+reeds.&nbsp; Out rush the terrified animals, and amid the smoke are
+seen the excited hunters dancing about with frantic gesticulations,
+and hurling stick, spear, and arrow at their burned out victims.&nbsp;
+Kites hover over the smoke, ready to pounce on the mantis and locusts
+as they spring from the fire.&nbsp; Small crows and hundreds of swallows
+are on eager wing, darting into the smoke and out again, seizing fugitive
+flies.&nbsp; Scores of insects, in their haste to escape from the fire,
+jump into the river, and the active fish enjoy a rare feast.</p>
+<p>We returned to the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; on the 9th of October, having
+been away one month.&nbsp; The ship&rsquo;s company had used distilled
+water, a condenser having been sent out from England; and there had
+not been a single case of sickness on board since we left, though there
+were so many cases of fever the few days she lay in the same spot last
+year.&nbsp; Our boat party drank the water of the river, and the three
+white sailors, who had never been in an African river before, had some
+slight attacks of fever.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER XII.</h3>
+<p>Return to the Zambesi&mdash;Bishop Mackenzie&rsquo;s grave&mdash;Frightful
+scenes with crocodiles&mdash;Death of Mr. Thornton&mdash;African poisons&mdash;Recall
+of the Expedition.</p>
+<p>We put to sea on the 18th of October, and, again touching at Johanna,
+obtained a crew of Johanna men and some oxen, and sailed for the Zambesi;
+but our fuel failing before we reached it, and the wind being contrary,
+we ran into Quillimane for wood.</p>
+<p>Quillimane must have been built solely for the sake of carrying on
+the slave-trade, for no man in his senses would ever have dreamed of
+placing a village on such a low, muddy, fever-haunted, and mosquito-swarming
+site, had it not been for the facilities it afforded for slaving.&nbsp;
+The bar may at springs and floods be easily crossed by sailing-vessels,
+but, being far from the land, it is always dangerous for boats.&nbsp;
+Slaves, under the name of &ldquo;free emigrants,&rdquo; have gone by
+thousands from Quillimane, during the last six years, to the ports a
+little to the south, particularly to Massangano.&nbsp; Some excellent
+brick-houses still stand in the place, and the owners are generous and
+hospitable: among them our good friend, Colonel Nu&ntilde;ez.&nbsp;
+His disinterested kindness to us and to all our countrymen can never
+be forgotten.&nbsp; He is a noble example of what energy and uprightness
+may accomplish even here.&nbsp; He came out as a cabin-boy, and, without
+a single friend to help him, he has persevered in an honourable course
+until he is the richest man on the East Coast.&nbsp; When Dr. Livingstone
+came down the Zambesi in 1856, Colonel Nu&ntilde;ez was the chief of
+the only four honourable, trustworthy men in the country.&nbsp; But
+while he has risen a whole herd has sunk, making loud lamentations,
+through puffs of cigar-smoke, over negro laziness; they might add, their
+own.</p>
+<p>All agricultural enterprise is virtually discouraged by Quillimane
+Government.&nbsp; A man must purchase a permit from the Governor, when
+he wishes to visit his country farm; and this tax, in a country where
+labour is unpopular, causes the farms to be almost entirely left in
+the hands of a head slave, who makes returns to his master as interest
+or honesty prompts him.&nbsp; A passport must also be bought whenever
+a man wishes to go up the river to Mazaro, Senna, or Tette, or even
+to reside for a month at Quillimane.&nbsp; With a soil and a climate
+well suited for the growth of the cane, abundance of slave labour, and
+water communication to any market in the world, they have never made
+their own sugar.&nbsp; All they use is imported from Bombay.&nbsp; &ldquo;The
+people of Quillimane have no enterprise,&rdquo; said a young European
+Portuguese, &ldquo;they do nothing, and are always wasting their time
+in suffering, or in recovering from fever.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>We entered the Zambesi about the end of November and found it unusually
+low, so we did not get up to Shupanga till the 19th of December.&nbsp;
+The friends of our Mazaro men, who had now become good sailors and very
+attentive servants, turned out and gave them a hearty welcome back from
+the perils of the sea: they had begun to fear that they would never
+return.&nbsp; We hired them at a sixteen-yard piece of cloth a month&mdash;about
+ten shillings&rsquo; worth, the Portuguese market-price of the cloth
+being then sevenpence halfpenny a yard,&mdash;and paid them five pieces
+each, for four-and-a-half months&rsquo; work.&nbsp; A merchant at the
+same time paid other Mazaro men three pieces for seven months, and they
+were with him in the interior.&nbsp; If the merchants do not prosper,
+it is not because labour is dear, but because it is scarce, and because
+they are so eager on every occasion to sell the workmen out of the country.&nbsp;
+Our men had also received quantities of good clothes from the sailors
+of the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; and of the &ldquo;Orestes,&rdquo; and were
+now regarded by their neighbours and by themselves as men of importance.&nbsp;
+Never before had they possessed so much wealth: they believed that they
+might settle in life, being now of sufficient standing to warrant their
+entering the married state; and a wife and a hut were among their first
+investments.&nbsp; Sixteen yards were paid to the wife&rsquo;s parents,
+and a hut cost four yards.&nbsp; We should have liked to have kept them
+in the ship, for they were well-behaved and had learned a great deal
+of the work required.&nbsp; Though they would not themselves go again,
+they engaged others for us; and brought twice as many as we could take,
+of their brothers and cousins, who were eager to join the ship and go
+with us up the Shir&eacute;, or anywhere else.&nbsp; They all agreed
+to take half-pay until they too had learned to work; and we found no
+scarcity of labour, though all that could be exported is now out of
+the country.</p>
+<p>There had been a drought of unusual severity during the past season
+in the country between Lupata and Kebrabasa, and it had extended north-east
+to the Manganja highlands.&nbsp; All the Tette slaves, except a very
+few household ones, had been driven away by hunger, and were now far
+off in the woods, and wherever wild fruit, or the prospect of obtaining
+anything whatever to keep the breath of life in them, was to be found.&nbsp;
+Their masters were said never to expect to see them again.&nbsp; There
+have been two years of great hunger at Tette since we have been in the
+country, and a famine like the present prevailed in 1854, when thousands
+died of starvation.&nbsp; If men like the Cape farmers owned this country,
+their energy and enterprise would soon render the crops independent
+of rain.&nbsp; There being plenty of slope or fall, the land could be
+easily irrigated from the Zambesi and its tributary streams.&nbsp; A
+Portuguese colony can never prosper: it is used as a penal settlement,
+and everything must be done military fashion.&nbsp; &ldquo;What do I
+care for this country?&rdquo; said the most enterprising of the Tette
+merchants, &ldquo;all I want is to make money as soon possible, and
+then go to Bombay and enjoy it.&rdquo;&nbsp; All business at Tette was
+now suspended.&nbsp; Carriers could not be found to take the goods into
+the interior, and the merchants could barely obtain food for their own
+families.&nbsp; At Mazaro more rain had fallen, and a tolerable crop
+followed.&nbsp; The people of Shupanga were collecting and drying different
+wild fruits, nearly all of which are far from palatable to a European
+taste.&nbsp; The root of a small creeper called &ldquo;bis&eacute;&rdquo;
+is dug up and eaten.&nbsp; In appearance it is not unlike the small
+white sweet potato, and has a little of the flavour of our potato.&nbsp;
+It would be very good, if it were only a little larger.&nbsp; From another
+tuber, called &ldquo;ulanga,&rdquo; very good starch can be made.&nbsp;
+A few miles from Shupanga there is an abundance of large game, but the
+people here, though fond enough of meat, are not a hunting race, and
+seldom kill any.</p>
+<p>The Shir&eacute; having risen, we steamed off on the 10th of January,
+1863, with the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; in tow.&nbsp; It was not long
+before we came upon the ravages of the notorious Mariano.&nbsp; The
+survivors of a small hamlet, at the foot of Morambala, were in a state
+of starvation, having lost their food by one of his marauding parties.&nbsp;
+The women were in the fields collecting insects, roots, wild fruits,
+and whatever could be eaten, in order to drag on their lives, if possible,
+till the next crop should be ripe.&nbsp; Two canoes passed us, that
+had been robbed by Mariano&rsquo;s band of everything they had in them;
+the owners were gathering palm-nuts for their subsistence.&nbsp; They
+wore palm-leaf aprons, as the robbers had stripped them of their clothing
+and ornaments.&nbsp; Dead bodies floated past us daily, and in the mornings
+the paddles had to be cleared of corpses, caught by the floats during
+the night.&nbsp; For scores of miles the entire population of the valley
+was swept away by this scourge Mariano, who is again, as he was before,
+the great Portuguese slave-agent.&nbsp; It made the heart ache to see
+the widespread desolation; the river-banks, once so populous, all silent;
+the villages burned down, and an oppressive stillness reigning where
+formerly crowds of eager sellers appeared with the various products
+of their industry.&nbsp; Here and there might be seen on the bank a
+small dreary deserted shed, where had sat, day after day, a starving
+fisherman, until the rising waters drove the fish from their wonted
+haunts, and left him to die.&nbsp; Tingan&eacute; had been defeated;
+his people had been killed, kidnapped, and forced to flee from their
+villages.&nbsp; There were a few wretched survivors in a village above
+the Ruo; but the majority of the population was dead.&nbsp; The sight
+and smell of dead bodies was everywhere.&nbsp; Many skeletons lay beside
+the path, where in their weakness they had fallen and expired.&nbsp;
+Ghastly living forms of boys and girls, with dull dead eyes, were crouching
+beside some of the huts.&nbsp; A few more miserable days of their terrible
+hunger, and they would be with the dead.</p>
+<p>Oppressed with the shocking scenes around, we visited the Bishop&rsquo;s
+grave; and though it matters little where a good Christian&rsquo;s ashes
+rest, yet it was with sadness that we thought over the hopes which had
+clustered around him, as he left the classic grounds of Cambridge, all
+now buried in this wild place.&nbsp; How it would have torn his kindly
+heart to witness the sights we now were forced to see!</p>
+<p>In giving vent to the natural feelings of regret, that a man so eminently
+endowed and learned, as was Bishop Mackenzie, should have been so soon
+cut off, some have expressed an opinion that it was wrong to use an
+instrument so valuable <i>merely</i> to convert the heathen.&nbsp; If
+the attempt is to be made at all, it is &ldquo;penny wise and pound
+foolish&rdquo; to employ any but the very best men, and those who are
+specially educated for the work.&nbsp; An ordinary clergyman, however
+well suited for a parish, will not, without special training, make a
+Missionary; and as to their comparative usefulness, it is like that
+of the man who builds an hospital, as compared with that of the surgeon
+who in after years only administers for a time the remedies which the
+founder had provided in perpetuity.&nbsp; Had the Bishop succeeded in
+introducing Christianity, his converts might have been few, but they
+would have formed a continuous roll for all time to come.</p>
+<p>The Shir&eacute; fell two feet, before we reached the shallow crossing
+where we had formerly such difficulty, and we had now two ships to take
+up.&nbsp; A hippopotamus was shot two miles above a bank on which the
+ship lay a fortnight: it floated in three hours.&nbsp; As the boat was
+towing it down, the crocodiles were attracted by the dead beast, and
+several shots had to be fired to keep them off.&nbsp; The bullet had
+not entered the brain of the animal, but driven a splinter of bone into
+it.&nbsp; A little moisture with some gas issued from the wound, and
+this was all that could tell the crocodiles down the stream of a dead
+hippopotamus; and yet they came up from miles below.&nbsp; Their sense
+of smell must be as acute as their hearing; both are quite extraordinary.&nbsp;
+Dozens fed on the meat we left.&nbsp; Our Krooman, Jumbo, used to assert
+that the crocodile never eats fresh meat, but always keeps it till it
+is high and tender&mdash;and the stronger it smells the better he likes
+it.&nbsp; There seems to be some truth in this.&nbsp; They can swallow
+but small pieces at a time, and find it difficult to tear fresh meat.&nbsp;
+In the act of swallowing, which is like that of a dog, the head is raised
+out of the water.&nbsp; We tried to catch some, and one was soon hooked;
+it required half-a-dozen hands to haul him up the river, and the shark-hook
+straightened, and he got away.&nbsp; A large iron hook was next made,
+but, as the creatures could not swallow it, their jaws soon pressed
+it straight&mdash;and our crocodile-fishing was a failure.&nbsp; As
+one might expect,&mdash;from the power even of a salmon&mdash;the tug
+of a crocodile was terribly strong.</p>
+<p>The corpse of a boy floated past the ship; a monstrous crocodile
+rushed at it with the speed of a greyhound, caught it and shook it,
+as a terrier dog does a rat.&nbsp; Others dashed at the prey, each with
+his powerful tail causing the water to churn and froth, as he furiously
+tore off a piece.&nbsp; In a few seconds it was all gone.&nbsp; The
+sight was frightful to behold.&nbsp; The Shir&eacute; swarmed with crocodiles;
+we counted sixty-seven of these repulsive reptiles on a single bank,
+but they are not as fierce as they are in some rivers.&nbsp; &ldquo;Crocodiles,&rdquo;
+says Captain Tuckey, &ldquo;are so plentiful in the Congo, near the
+rapids, and so frequently carry off the women, who at daylight go down
+to the river for water, that, while they are filling their calabashes,
+one of the party is usually employed in throwing large stones into the
+water outside.&rdquo;&nbsp; Here, either a calabash on a long pole is
+used in drawing water, or a fence is planted.&nbsp; The natives eat
+the crocodile, but to us the idea of tasting the musky-scented, fishy-looking
+flesh carried the idea of cannibalism.&nbsp; Humboldt remarks, that
+in South America the alligators of some rivers are more dangerous than
+in others.&nbsp; Alligators differ from crocodiles in the fourth or
+canine tooth going into a hole or socket in the upper jaw, while in
+the crocodile it fits into a notch.&nbsp; The forefoot of the crocodile
+has five toes not webbed, the hindfoot has four toes which are webbed;
+in the alligator the web is altogether wanting.&nbsp; They are so much
+alike that they would no doubt breed together.</p>
+<p>One of the crocodiles which was shot had a piece snapped off the
+end of his tail, another had lost a forefoot in fighting; we saw actual
+leeches between the teeth, such as are mentioned by Herodotus, but we
+never witnessed the plover picking them out.&nbsp; Their greater fierceness
+in one part of the country than another is doubtless owing to a scarcity
+of fish; in fact, Captain Tuckey says, of that part of the Congo, mentioned
+above, &ldquo;There are no fish here but catfish,&rdquo; and we found
+that the lake crocodiles, living in clear water, and with plenty of
+fish, scarcely ever attacked man.&nbsp; The Shir&eacute; teems with
+fish of many different kinds.&nbsp; The only time, as already remarked,
+when its crocodiles are particularly to be dreaded, is when the river
+is in flood.&nbsp; Then the fish are driven from their usual haunts,
+and no game comes down to the river to drink, water being abundant in
+pools inland.&nbsp; Hunger now impels the crocodile to lie in wait for
+the women who come to draw water, and on the Zambesi numbers are carried
+off every year.&nbsp; The danger is not so great at other seasons; though
+it is never safe to bathe, or to stoop to drink, where one cannot see
+the bottom, especially in the evening.&nbsp; One of the Makololo ran
+down in the dusk of the river; and, as he was busy tossing the water
+to his mouth with his hand, in the manner peculiar to the natives, a
+crocodile rose suddenly from the bottom, and caught him by the hand.&nbsp;
+The limb of a tree was fortunately within reach, and he had presence
+of mind to lay hold of it.&nbsp; Both tugged and pulled; the crocodile
+for his dinner, and the man for dear life.&nbsp; For a time it appeared
+doubtful whether a dinner or a life was to be sacrificed; but the man
+held on, and the monster let the hand go, leaving the deep marks of
+his ugly teeth in it.</p>
+<p>During our detention, in expectation of the permanent rise of the
+river in March, Dr. Kirk and Mr. C. Livingstone collected numbers of
+the wading-birds of the marshes&mdash;and made pleasant additions to
+our salted provisions, in geese, ducks, and hippopotamus flesh.&nbsp;
+One of the comb or knob-nosed geese, on being strangled in order to
+have its skin preserved without injury, continued to breathe audibly
+by the broken humerus, or wing-bone, and other means had to be adopted
+to put it out of pain.&nbsp; This was as if a man on the gallows were
+to continue to breathe by a broken armbone, and afforded us an illustration
+of the fact, that in birds, the vital air penetrates every part of the
+interior of their bodies.&nbsp; The breath passes through and round
+about the lungs&mdash;bathes the surfaces of the viscera, and enters
+the cavities of the bones; it even penetrates into some spaces between
+the muscles of the neck&mdash;and thus not only is the most perfect
+oxygenation of the blood secured, but, the temperature of the blood
+being very high, the air in every part is rarefied, and the great lightness
+and vigour provided for, that the habits of birds require.&nbsp; Several
+birds were found by Dr. Kirk to have marrow in the tibi&aelig;, though
+these bones are generally described as hollow.</p>
+<p>During the period of our detention on the shallow part of the river
+in March, Mr. Thornton came up to us from Shupanga: he had, as before
+narrated, left the Expedition in 1859, and joined Baron van der Decken,
+in the journey to Kilimanjaro, when, by an ascent of the mountain to
+the height of 8000 feet, it was first proved to be covered with perpetual
+snow, and the previous information respecting it, given by the Church
+of England Missionaries, Krapf and Rebman, confirmed.&nbsp; It is now
+well known that the Baron subsequently ascended the Kilimanjaro to 14,000
+feet, and ascertained its highest peak to be at least 20,000 feet above
+the sea.&nbsp; Mr. Thornton made the map of the first journey, at Shupanga,
+from materials collected when with the Baron; and when that work was
+accomplished, followed us.&nbsp; He was then directed to examine geologically
+the Cataract district, but not to expose himself to contact with the
+Ajawa until the feelings of that tribe should be ascertained.</p>
+<p>The members of Bishop Mackenzie&rsquo;s party, on the loss of their
+head, fell back from Magomero on the highlands, to Chibisa&rsquo;s,
+in the low-lying Shir&eacute; Valley; and Thornton, finding them suffering
+from want of animal food, kindly volunteered to go across thence to
+Tette, and bring a supply of goats and sheep.&nbsp; We were not aware
+of this step, to which the generosity of his nature prompted him, till
+two days after he had started.&nbsp; In addition to securing supplies
+for the Universities&rsquo; Mission, he brought some for the Expedition,
+and took bearings, by which he hoped to connect his former work at Tette
+with the mountains in the Shir&eacute; district.&nbsp; The toil of this
+journey was too much for his strength, as with the addition of great
+scarcity of water, it had been for that of Dr. Kirk and Rae, and he
+returned in a sadly haggard and exhausted condition; diarrhoea supervened,
+and that ended in dysentery and fever, which terminated fatally on the
+21st of April, 1863.&nbsp; He received the unremitting attentions of
+Dr. Kirk, and Dr. Meller, surgeon of the &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo; during
+the fortnight of his illness; and as he had suffered very little from
+fever, or any other disease, in Africa, we had entertained strong hopes
+that his youth and unimpaired constitution would have carried him through.&nbsp;
+During the night of the 20th his mind wandered so much, that we could
+not ascertain his last wishes; and on the morning of the 21st, to our
+great sorrow, he died.&nbsp; He was buried on the 22nd, near a large
+tree on the right bank of the Shir&eacute;, about five hundred yards
+from the lowest of the Murchison Cataracts&mdash;and close to a rivulet,
+at which the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; and &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; lay.</p>
+<p>No words can convey an adequate idea of the scene of widespread desolation
+which the once pleasant Shir&eacute; Valley now presented.&nbsp; Instead
+of smiling villages and crowds of people coming with things for sale,
+scarcely a soul was to be seen; and, when by chance one lighted on a
+native, his frame bore the impress of hunger, and his countenance the
+look of a cringing broken-spiritedness.&nbsp; A drought had visited
+the land after the slave-hunting panic swept over it.&nbsp; Had it been
+possible to conceive the thorough depopulation which had ensued, we
+should have avoided coming up the river.&nbsp; Large masses of the people
+had fled down to the Shir&eacute;, only anxious to get the river between
+them and their enemies.&nbsp; Most of the food had been left behind;
+and famine and starvation had cut off so many, that the remainder were
+too few to bury the dead.&nbsp; The corpses we saw floating down the
+river were only a remnant of those that had perished, whom their friends,
+from weakness, could not bury, nor over-gorged crocodiles devour.&nbsp;
+It is true that famine caused a great portion of this waste of human
+life: but the slave-trade must be deemed the chief agent in the ruin,
+because, as we were informed, in former droughts all the people flocked
+from the hills down to the marshes, which are capable of yielding crops
+of maize in less than three months, at any time of the year, and now
+they were afraid to do so.&nbsp; A few, encouraged by the Mission in
+the attempt to cultivate, had their little patches robbed as successive
+swarms of fugitives came from the hills.&nbsp; Who can blame these outcasts
+from house and home for stealing to save their wretched lives, or wonder
+that the owners protected the little all, on which their own lives depended,
+with club and spear?&nbsp; We were informed by Mr. Waller of the dreadful
+blight which had befallen the once smiling Shir&eacute; Valley.&nbsp;
+His words, though strong, failed to impress us with the reality.&nbsp;
+In fact, they were received, as some may accept our own, as tinged with
+exaggeration; but when our eyes beheld the last mere driblets of this
+cup of woe, we for the first time felt that the enormous wrongs inflicted
+on our fellow-men by slaving are beyond exaggeration.</p>
+<p>Wherever we took a walk, human skeletons were seen in every direction,
+and it was painfully interesting to observe the different postures in
+which the poor wretches had breathed their last.&nbsp; A whole heap
+had been thrown down a slope behind a village, where the fugitives often
+crossed the river from the east; and in one hut of the same village
+no fewer than twenty drums had been collected, probably the ferryman&rsquo;s
+fees.&nbsp; Many had ended their misery under shady trees&mdash;others
+under projecting crags in the hills&mdash;while others lay in their
+huts, with closed doors, which when opened disclosed the mouldering
+corpse with the poor rags round the loins&mdash;the skull fallen off
+the pillow&mdash;the little skeleton of the child, that had perished
+first, rolled up in a mat between two large skeletons.&nbsp; The sight
+of this desert, but eighteen months ago a well peopled valley, now literally
+strewn with human bones, forced the conviction upon us, that the destruction
+of human life in the middle passage, however great, constitutes but
+a small portion of the waste, and made us feel that unless the slave-trade&mdash;that
+monster iniquity, which has so long brooded over Africa&mdash;is put
+down, lawful commerce cannot be established.</p>
+<p>We believed that, if it were possible to get a steamer upon the Lake,
+we could by her means put a check on the slavers from the East Coast;
+and aid more effectually still in the suppression of the slave-trade,
+by introducing, by way of the Rovuma, a lawful traffic in ivory.&nbsp;
+We therefore unscrewed the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; at a rivulet about
+five hundred yards below the first cataract, and began to make a road
+over the thirty-five or forty miles of land portage, by which to carry
+her up piecemeal.&nbsp; After mature consideration, we could not imagine
+a more noble work of benevolence, than thus to introduce light and liberty
+into a quarter of this fair earth, which human lust has converted into
+the nearest possible resemblance of what we conceive the infernal regions
+to be&mdash;and we sacrificed much of our private resources as an offering
+for the promotion of so good a cause.</p>
+<p>The chief part of the labour of road-making consisted in cutting
+down trees and removing stones.&nbsp; The country being covered with
+open forest, a small tree had to be cut about every fifty or sixty yards.&nbsp;
+The land near the river was so very much intersected by ravines, that
+search had to be made, a mile from its banks, for more level ground.&nbsp;
+Experienced Hottentot drivers would have taken Cape wagons without any
+other trouble than that of occasionally cutting down a tree.&nbsp; No
+tsetse infested this district, and the cattle brought from Johanna flourished
+on the abundant pasture.&nbsp; The first half-mile of road led up, by
+a gradual slope, to an altitude of two hundred feet above the ship,
+and a sensible difference of climate was felt even there.&nbsp; For
+the remainder of the distance the height increased,&mdash;till, at the
+uppermost cataract, we were more than 1200 feet above the sea.&nbsp;
+The country here, having recovered from the effects of the drought,
+was bright with young green woodland, and mountains of the same refreshing
+hue.&nbsp; But the absence of the crowds, which had attended us as we
+carried up the boat, when the women followed us for miles with fine
+meal, vegetables, and fat fowls for sale, and the boys were ever ready
+for a little job&mdash;and the oppressive stillness bore heavily on
+our spirits.&nbsp; The Portuguese of Tette had very effectually removed
+our labourers.&nbsp; Not an ounce of fresh provisions could be obtained,
+except what could be shot, and even the food for our native crew had
+to be brought one hundred and fifty miles from the Zambesi.</p>
+<p>The diet of salt provisions and preserved meats without vegetables,
+with the depression of spirits caused by seeing how effectually a few
+wretched convicts, aided by the connivance of officials, of whom better
+might have been hoped, could counteract our best efforts, and turn intended
+good to certain evil, brought on attacks of dysentery, which went the
+round of the Expedition&mdash;and, Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone
+having suffered most severely, it was deemed advisable that they should
+go home.&nbsp; This measure was necessary, though much to the regret
+of all&mdash;for having done so much, they were naturally anxious to
+be present, when, by the establishing ourselves on the Lake, all our
+efforts should be crowned with success.&nbsp; After it had been decided
+that these two officers, and all the whites who could be spared, should
+be sent down to the sea for a passage to England, Dr. Livingstone was
+seized in May with a severe attack of dysentery, which continued for
+a month, and reduced him to a shadow.&nbsp; Dr. Kirk kindly remained
+in attendance till the worst was passed.&nbsp; The parting took place
+on the 19th of May.</p>
+<p>After a few miles of road were completed, and the oxen broken in,
+we resolved to try and render ourselves independent of the south for
+fresh provisions, by going in a boat up the Shir&eacute;, above the
+Cataracts, to the tribes at the foot of Lake Nyassa, who were still
+untouched by the Ajawa invasion.&nbsp; In furtherance of this plan Dr.
+Livingstone and Mr. Rae determined to walk up to examine, and, if need
+be, mend the boat which had been left two seasons previously hung up
+to the limb of a large shady tree, before attempting to carry another
+past the Cataracts.&nbsp; The &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo; which was to be
+left in charge of our active and most trustworthy gunner, Mr. Edward
+D. Young, R.N., was thoroughly roofed over with euphorbia branches and
+grass, so as completely to protect her decks from the sun: she also
+received daily a due amount of man-of-war scrubbing and washing; and,
+besides having everything put in shipshape fashion, was every evening
+swung out into the middle of the river, for the sake of the greater
+amount of air which circulated there.&nbsp; In addition to their daily
+routine work of the ship, the three stokers, one sailor, and one carpenter&mdash;now
+our complement&mdash;were encouraged to hunt for guinea-fowl, which
+in June, when the water inland is dried up, come in large flocks to
+the river&rsquo;s banks, and roost on the trees at night.&nbsp; Everything
+that can be done to keep mind and body employed tends to prevent fever.</p>
+<p>While we were employed in these operations, some of the poor starved
+people about had been in the habit of crossing the river, and reaping
+the self-sown mapira, in the old gardens of their countrymen.&nbsp;
+In the afternoon of the 9th, a canoe came floating down empty, and shortly
+after a woman was seen swimming near the other side, which was about
+two hundred yards distant from us.&nbsp; Our native crew manned the
+boat, and rescued her; when brought on board, she was found to have
+an arrow-head, eight or ten inches long, in her back, below the ribs,
+and slanting up through the diaphragm and left lung, towards the heart&mdash;she
+had been shot from behind when stooping.&nbsp; Air was coming out of
+the wound, and, there being but an inch of the barbed arrow-head visible,
+it was thought better not to run the risk of her dying under the operation
+necessary for its removal; so we carried her up to her own hut.&nbsp;
+One of her relatives was less scrupulous, for he cut out the arrow and
+part of the lung.&nbsp; Mr. Young sent her occasionally portions of
+native corn, and strange to say found that she not only became well,
+but stout.&nbsp; The constitution of these people seems to have a wonderful
+power of self-repair&mdash;and it could be no slight privation which
+had cut off the many thousands that we saw dead around us.</p>
+<p>We regretted that, in consequence of Dr. Meller having now sole medical
+charge, we could not have his company in our projected trip; but he
+found employment in botany and natural history, after the annual sickly
+season of March, April, and May was over; and his constant presence
+was not so much required at the ship.&nbsp; Later in the year, when
+he could be well spared, he went down the river to take up an appointment
+he had been offered in Madagascar; but unfortunately was so severely
+tried by illness while detained at the coast, that for nearly two years
+he was not able to turn his abilities as a naturalist to account by
+proceeding to that island.&nbsp; We have no doubt but he will yet distinguish
+himself in that untrodden field.</p>
+<p>On the 16th of June we started for the Upper Cataracts, with a mule-cart,
+our road lying a distance of a mile west from the river.&nbsp; We saw
+many of the deserted dwellings of the people who formerly came to us;
+and were very much struck by the extent of land under cultivation, though
+that, compared with the whole country, is very small.&nbsp; Large patches
+of mapira continued to grow,&mdash;as it is said it does from the roots
+for three years.&nbsp; The mapira was mixed with tall bushes of the
+Congo-bean, castor-oil plants, and cotton.&nbsp; The largest patch of
+this kind we paced, and found it to be six hundred and thirty paces
+on one side&mdash;the rest were from one acre to three, and many not
+more than one-third of an acre.&nbsp; The cotton&mdash;of very superior
+quality&mdash;was now dropping off the bushes, to be left to rot&mdash;there
+was no one to gather what would have been of so much value in Lancashire.&nbsp;
+The huts, in the different villages we entered, were standing quite
+perfect.&nbsp; The mortars for pounding corn&mdash;the stones for grinding
+it&mdash;the water and beer pots&mdash;the empty corn-safes and kitchen
+utensils, were all untouched; and most of the doors were shut, as if
+the starving owners had gone out to wander in search of roots or fruits
+in the forest, and had never returned.&nbsp; When opened, several huts
+revealed a ghastly sight of human skeletons.&nbsp; Some were seen in
+such unnatural positions, as to give the idea that they had expired
+in a faint, when trying to reach something to allay the gnawings of
+hunger.</p>
+<p>We took several of the men as far as the Mukuru-Mads&eacute; for
+the sake of the change of air and for occupation, and also to secure
+for the ships a supply of buffalo meat&mdash;as those animals were reported
+to be in abundance on that stream.&nbsp; But though it was evident from
+the tracks that the report was true, it was impossible to get a glimpse
+of them.&nbsp; The grass being taller than we were, and pretty thickly
+planted, they always knew of our approach before we saw them.&nbsp;
+And the first intimation we had of their being near was the sound they
+made in rushing over the stones, breaking the branches, and knocking
+their horns against each other.&nbsp; Once, when seeking a ford for
+the cart, at sunrise, we saw a herd slowly wending up the hill-side
+from the water.&nbsp; Sending for a rifle, and stalking with intense
+eagerness for a fat beefsteak, instead of our usual fare of salted provisions,
+we got so near that we could hear the bulls uttering their hoarse deep
+low, but could see nothing except the mass of yellow grass in front;
+suddenly the buffalo-birds sounded their alarm-whistle, and away dashed
+the troop, and we got sight of neither birds nor beasts.&nbsp; This
+would be no country for a sportsman except when the grass is short.&nbsp;
+The animals are wary, from the dread they have of the poisoned arrows.&nbsp;
+Those of the natives who do hunt are deeply imbued with the hunting
+spirit, and follow the game with a stealthy perseverance and cunning,
+quite extraordinary.&nbsp; The arrow making no noise, the herd is followed
+up until the poison takes effect, and the wounded animal falls out.&nbsp;
+It is then patiently watched till it drops&mdash;a portion of meat round
+the wound is cut away, and all the rest eaten.</p>
+<p>Poisoned arrows are made in two pieces.&nbsp; An iron barb is firmly
+fastened to one end of a small wand of wood, ten inches or a foot long,
+the other end of which, fined down to a long point, is nicely fitted,
+though not otherwise secured, in the hollow of the reed, which forms
+the arrow shaft.&nbsp; The wood immediately below the iron head is smeared
+with the poison.&nbsp; When the arrow is shot into an animal, the reed
+either falls to the ground at once, or is very soon brushed off by the
+bushes; but the iron barb and poisoned upper part of the wood remain
+in the wound.&nbsp; If made in one piece, the arrow would often be torn
+out, head and all, by the long shaft catching in the underwood, or striking
+against trees.&nbsp; The poison used here, and called <i>kombi</i>,
+is obtained from a species of <i>strophanthus</i>, and is very virulent.&nbsp;
+Dr. Kirk found by an accidental experiment on himself that it acts by
+lowering the pulse.&nbsp; In using his tooth-brush, which had been in
+a pocket containing a little of the poison, he noticed a bitter taste,
+but attributed it to his having sometimes used, the handle in taking
+quinine.&nbsp; Though the quantity was small, it immediately showed
+its power by lowering his pulse which at the time had been raised by
+a cold, and next day he was perfectly restored.&nbsp; Not much can be
+inferred from a single case of this kind, but it is possible that the
+kombi may turn out a valuable remedy; and as Professor Sharpey has conducted
+a series of experiments with this substance, we look with interest for
+the results.&nbsp; An alkaloid has been obtained from it similar to
+strychnine.&nbsp; There is no doubt that all kinds of wild animals die
+from the effects of poisoned arrows, except the elephant and hippopotamus.&nbsp;
+The amount of poison that this little weapon can convey into their systems
+being too small to kill those huge beasts, the hunters resort to the
+beam trap instead.</p>
+<p>Another kind of poison was met with on Lake Nyassa, which was said
+to be used exclusively for killing men.&nbsp; It was put on small wooden
+arrow-heads, and carefully protected by a piece of maize-leaf tied round
+it.&nbsp; It caused numbness of the tongue when the smallest particle
+was tasted.&nbsp; The Bushmen of the northern part of the Kalahari were
+seen applying the entrails of a small caterpillar which they termed
+&lsquo;Ng&atilde; to their arrows.&nbsp; This venom was declared to
+be so powerful in producing delirium, that a man in dying returned in
+imagination to a state of infancy, and would call for his mother&rsquo;s
+breast.&nbsp; Lions when shot with it are said to perish in agonies.&nbsp;
+The poisonous ingredient in this case may be derived from the plant
+on which the caterpillar feeds.&nbsp; It is difficult to conceive by
+what sort of experiments the properties of these poisons, known for
+generations, were proved.&nbsp; Probably the animal instincts, which
+have become so obtuse by civilization, that children in England eat
+the berries of the deadly nightshade (<i>Atropa belladonna</i>) without
+suspicion, were in the early uncivilized state much more keen.&nbsp;
+In some points instinct is still retained among savages.&nbsp; It is
+related that in the celebrated voyage of the French navigator, Bougainville,
+a young lady, who had assumed the male attire, performed all the hard
+duties incident to the calling of a common sailor; and, even as servant
+to the geologist, carried a bag of stones and specimens over hills and
+dales without a complaint, and without having her sex suspected by her
+associates; but on landing among the savages of one of the South Sea
+Islands, she was instantly recognized as a female.&nbsp; They began
+to show their impressions in a way that compelled her to confess her
+sex, and throw herself on the protection of the commander, which of
+course was granted.&nbsp; In like manner, the earlier portions of the
+human family may have had their instincts as to plants more highly developed
+than any of their descendants&mdash;if indeed much more knowledge than
+we usually suppose be not the effect of direct revelation from above.</p>
+<p>The Mukuru-Mads&eacute; has a deep rocky bed.&nbsp; The water is
+generally about four feet deep, and fifteen or twenty yards broad.&nbsp;
+Before reaching it, we passed five or six gullies; but beyond it the
+country, for two or three miles from the river, was comparatively smooth.&nbsp;
+The long grass was overrunning all the native paths, and one species
+(<i>sanu</i>), which has a sharp barbed seed a quarter of an inch in
+length, enters every pore of woollen clothing and highly irritates the
+skin.&nbsp; From its hard, sharp point a series of minute barbs are
+laid back, and give the seed a hold wherever it enters: the slightest
+touch gives it an entering motion, and the little hooks prevent its
+working out.&nbsp; These seeds are so abundant in some spots, that the
+inside of the stocking becomes worse than the roughest hair shirt.&nbsp;
+It is, however, an excellent self-sower, and fine fodder; it rises to
+the height of common meadow-grass in England, and would be a capital
+plant for spreading over a new country not so abundantly supplied with
+grasses as this is.</p>
+<p>We have sometimes noticed two or three leaves together pierced through
+by these seeds, and thus made, as it were, into wings to carry them
+to any soil suited to their growth.</p>
+<p>We always follow the native paths, though they are generally not
+more than fifteen inches broad, and so often have deep little holes
+in them, made for the purpose of setting traps for small animals, and
+are so much obscured by the long grass, that one has to keep one&rsquo;s
+eyes on the ground more than is pleasant.&nbsp; In spite, however, of
+all drawbacks, it is vastly more easy to travel on these tracks than
+to go straight over uncultivated ground, or virgin forest.&nbsp; A path
+usually leads to some village, though sometimes it turns out to be a
+mere game track leading nowhere.</p>
+<p>In going north, we came into a part called Mpemba where Chibisa was
+owned as chief, but the people did not know that he had been assassinated
+by the Portuguese Terera.&nbsp; A great deal of grain was lying round
+the hut, where we spent the night.&nbsp; Very large numbers of turtledoves
+feasted undisturbed on the tall stalked mapira ears, and we easily secured
+plenty of fine fat guinea-fowls&mdash;now allowed to feed leisurely
+in the deserted gardens.&nbsp; The reason assigned for all this listless
+improvidence was &ldquo;There are no women to grind the corn&mdash;all
+are dead.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>The cotton patches in all cases seemed to have been so well cared
+for, and kept so free of weeds formerly, that, though now untended,
+but few weeds had sprung up; and the bushes were thus preserved in the
+annual grass burnings.&nbsp; Many baobab-trees grow in different spots,
+and the few people seen were using the white pulp found between the
+seeds to make a pleasant subacid drink.</p>
+<p>On passing Malango, near the uppermost cataract, not a soul was to
+be seen; but, as we rested opposite a beautiful tree-covered island,
+the merry voices of children at play fell on our ears&mdash;the parents
+had fled thither for protection from the slave-hunting Ajawa, still
+urged on by the occasional visits of the Portuguese agents from Tette.&nbsp;
+The Ajawa, instead of passing below the Cataracts, now avoided us, and
+crossed over to the east side near to the tree on which we had hung
+the boat.&nbsp; Those of the Manganja, to whom we could make ourselves
+known, readily came to us; but the majority had lost all confidence
+in themselves, in each other, and in every one else.&nbsp; The boat
+had been burned about three months previously, and the Manganja were
+very anxious that we should believe that this had been the act of the
+Ajawa; but on scanning the spot we saw that it was more likely to have
+caught fire in the grass-burning of the country.&nbsp; Had we intended
+to be so long in returning to it, we should have hoisted it bottom upwards;
+for, as it was, it is probable that a quantity of dried leaves lay inside,
+and a spark ignited the whole.&nbsp; All the trees within fifty yards
+were scorched and killed, and the nails, iron, and copper sheathing,
+all lay undisturbed beneath.&nbsp; Had the Ajawa done the deed, they
+would have taken away the copper and iron.</p>
+<p>Our hopes of rendering ourselves independent of the south for provisions,
+by means of this boat, being thus disappointed, we turned back with
+the intention of carrying another up to the same spot; and, in order
+to find level ground for this, we passed across from the Shir&eacute;
+at Malango to the upper part of the stream Lesungw&eacute;.&nbsp; A
+fine, active, intelligent fellow, called Pekila, guided us, and was
+remarkable as almost the only one of the population left with any spirit
+in him.&nbsp; The depressing effect which the slave-hunting scourge
+has upon the native mind, though little to be wondered at, is sad, very
+sad to witness.&nbsp; Musical instruments, mats, pillows, mortars for
+pounding meal, were lying about unused, and becoming the prey of the
+white ants.&nbsp; With all their little comforts destroyed, the survivors
+were thrown still further back into barbarism.</p>
+<p>It is of little importance perhaps to any but travellers to notice
+that in occupying one night a well-built hut, which had been shut up
+for some time, the air inside at once gave us a chill, and an attack
+of fever; both of which vanished when the place was well-ventilated
+by means of a fire.&nbsp; We have frequently observed that lighting
+a fire early in the mornings, even in the hottest time of the year,
+gives freshness to the whole house, and removes that feeling of closeness
+and langour, which a hot climate induces.</p>
+<p>On the night of the 1st July, 1863, several loud peals of thunder
+awoke us; the moon was shining brightly, and not a cloud to be seen.&nbsp;
+All the natives remarked on the clearness of the sky at the time, and
+next morning said, &ldquo;We thought it was God&rdquo; (Morungo).</p>
+<p>On arriving at the ship on the 2nd July, we found a despatch from
+Earl Russell, containing instructions for the withdrawal of the Expedition.&nbsp;
+The devastation caused by slave-hunting and famine lay all around.&nbsp;
+The labour had been as completely swept away from the Great Shir&eacute;
+Valley, as it had been from the Zambesi, wherever Portuguese intrigue
+or power extended.&nbsp; The continual forays of Mariano had spread
+ruin and desolation on our south-east as far as Mount Clarendon.</p>
+<p>While this was going on in our rear, the Tette slave-hunters from
+the West had stimulated the Ajawa to sweep all the Manganja off the
+hills on our East; and slaving parties for this purpose were still passing
+the Shir&eacute; above the Cataracts.&nbsp; In addition to the confession
+of the Governor of Tette, of an intention to go on with this slaving
+in accordance with the counsel of his elder brother at Mosambique, we
+had reason to believe that slavery went on under the eye of his Excellency,
+the Governor-General himself; and this was subsequently corroborated
+by our recognizing two women at Mosambique who had lived within a hundred
+yards of the Mission-station at Magomero.&nbsp; They were well known
+to our attendants, and had formed a part of a gang of several hundreds
+taken to Mosambique by the Ajawa at the very time when his Excellency
+was entertaining English officers with anti-slavery palavers.&nbsp;
+To any one who understands how minute the information is, which Portuguese
+governors possess by means of their own slaves, and through gossiping
+traders who seek to curry their favour, it is idle to assert that all
+this slaving goes on without their approval and connivance.</p>
+<p>If more had been wanted to prove the hopelessness of producing any
+change in the system which has prevailed ever since our allies, the
+Portuguese, entered the country, we had it in the impunity with which
+the freebooter, Terera, who had murdered Chibisa, was allowed to carry
+on his forays.&nbsp; Belchoir, another marauder, had been checked, but
+was still allowed to make war, as they term slave-hunting.</p>
+<p>Mr. Horace Waller was living for some five months on Mount Morambala,
+a position from which the whole process of the slave-trade, and depopulation
+of the country around could be well noted.&nbsp; The mountain overlooks
+the Shir&eacute;, the beautiful meanderings of which are distinctly
+seen, on clear days, for thirty miles.&nbsp; This river was for some
+time supposed to be closed against Mariano, who, as a mere matter of
+form, was declared a rebel against the Portuguese flag.&nbsp; When,
+however, it became no longer possible to keep up the sham, the river
+was thrown open to him; and Mr. Waller has seen in a single day from
+fifteen to twenty canoes of different sizes going down, laden with slaves,
+to the Portuguese settlements from the so-called rebel camp.&nbsp; These
+cargoes were composed entirely of women and children.&nbsp; For three
+months this traffic was incessant, and at last, so completely was the
+mask thrown off, that one of the officials came to pay a visit to Bishop
+Tozer on another part of the same mountain, and, combining business
+with pleasure, collected payment for some canoe work done for the Missionary
+party, and with this purchased slaves from the rebels, who had only
+to be hailed from the bank of the river.&nbsp; When he had concluded
+the bargain he trotted the slaves out for inspection in Mr. Waller&rsquo;s
+presence.&nbsp; This official, Senhor Mesquita, was the only officer
+who could be forced to live at the Kongon&eacute;.&nbsp; From certain
+circumstances in his life, he had fallen under the power of the local
+Government; all the other Custom-house officers refused to go to Kongon&eacute;,
+so here poor Mesquita must live on a miserable pittance&mdash;must live,
+and perhaps slave, sorely against his will.&nbsp; His name is not brought
+forward with a view of throwing any odium on his character.&nbsp; The
+disinterested kindness which he showed to Dr. Meller, and others, forbids
+that he should be mentioned by us with anything like unkindness.</p>
+<p>Under all these considerations, with the fact that we had not found
+the Rovuma so favourable for navigation at the time of our visit as
+we expected, it was impossible not to coincide in the wisdom of our
+withdrawal; but we deeply regretted that we had ever given credit to
+the Portuguese Government for any desire to ameliorate the condition
+of the African race; for, with half the labour and expense anywhere
+else, we should have made an indelible mark of improvement on a section
+of the Continent.&nbsp; Viewing Portuguese statesmen in the light of
+the laws they have passed for the suppression of slavery and the slave-trade,
+and by the standard of the high character of our own public men, it
+cannot be considered weakness to have believed in the sincerity of the
+anxiety to aid our enterprise, professed by the Lisbon Ministry.&nbsp;
+We hoped to benefit both Portuguese and Africans by introducing free-trade
+and Christianity.&nbsp; Our allies, unfortunately, cannot see the slightest
+benefit in any measure that does not imply raising themselves up by
+thrusting others down.&nbsp; The official paper of the Lisbon Government
+has since let us know &ldquo;that their policy was directed to frustrating
+the grasping designs of the British Government to the dominion of Eastern
+Africa.&rdquo;&nbsp; We, who were on the spot, and behind the scenes,
+knew that feelings of private benevolence had the chief share in the
+operations undertaken for introducing the reign of peace and good will
+on the Lakes and central regions, which for ages have been the abodes
+of violence and bloodshed.&nbsp; But that great change was not to be
+accomplished.&nbsp; The narrow-minded would ascribe all that was attempted
+to the grasping propensity of the English.&nbsp; But the motives that
+actuate many in England, both in public and private life, are much more
+noble than the world gives them credit for.</p>
+<p>Seeing, then, that we were not yet arrived at &ldquo;the good time
+coming,&rdquo; and that it was quite impossible to take the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo;
+down to the sea till the floods of December, we made arrangements to
+screw the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; together; and, in order to improve
+the time intervening, we resolved to carry a boat past the Cataracts
+a second time, sail along the eastern shore of the Lake, and round the
+northern end, and also collect data by which to verify the information
+collected by Colonel Rigby, that the 19,000 slaves, who go through the
+Custom-house of Zanzibar annually, are chiefly drawn from Lake Nyassa
+and the Valley of the Shir&eacute;.</p>
+<p>Our party consisted of twenty natives, some of whom were Johanna
+men, and were supposed to be capable of managing the six oxen which
+drew the small wagon with a boat on it.&nbsp; A team of twelve Cape
+oxen, with a Hottentot driver and leader, would have taken the wagon
+over the country we had to pass through with the greatest ease; but
+no sooner did we get beyond the part of the road already made, than
+our drivers encountered obstructions in the way of trees and gullies,
+which it would have been a waste of time to have overcome by felling
+timber and hauling out the wagon by block and tackle purchases.&nbsp;
+The Ajawa and Manganja settled at Chibisa&rsquo;s were therefore sent
+for, and they took the boat on their shoulders and carried it briskly,
+in a few days, past all the Cataracts except one; then coming to a comparatively
+still reach of the river, they took advantage of it to haul her up a
+couple of miles.&nbsp; The Makololo had her then entirely in charge;
+for, being accustomed to rapids in their own country, no better boatmen
+could be desired.&nbsp; The river here is very narrow, and even in what
+are called still places, the current is very strong, and often obliged
+them to haul the boat along by the reeds on the banks, or to hand a
+tow-rope ashore.&nbsp; The reeds are full of cowitch (<i>Dolichos pruriens</i>),
+the pods of which are covered with what looks a fine velvety down, but
+is in reality a multitude of fine prickles, which go in by the million,
+and caused an itching and stinging in the naked bodies of those who
+were pulling the tow-rope, that made them wriggle as if stung by a whole
+bed of nettles.&nbsp; Those on board required to be men of ready resource
+with oars and punting-poles, and such they were.&nbsp; But, nevertheless,
+they found, after attempting to pass by a rock, round which the water
+rushed in whirls, that the wiser plan would be to take the boat ashore,
+and carry her past the last Cataract.&nbsp; When this was reported,
+the carriers were called from the various shady trees under which they
+had taken refuge from the sun.&nbsp; This was midwinter, but the sun
+is always hot by day here, though the nights are cold.&nbsp; Five Zambesi
+men, who had been all their lives accustomed to great heavy canoes,&mdash;the
+chief recommendation of which is said to be, that they can be run against
+a rock with the full force of the current without injury&mdash;were
+very desirous to show how much better they could manage our boat than
+the Makololo; three jumped into her when our backs were turned, and
+two hauled her up a little way; the tide caught her bow, we heard a
+shout of distress, the rope was out of their hands in a moment, and
+there she was, bottom upwards; a turn or two in an eddy, and away she
+went, like an arrow, down the Cataracts.&nbsp; One of the men in swimming
+ashore saved a rifle.&nbsp; The whole party ran with all their might
+along the bank, but never more did we see our boat.</p>
+<p>The five performers in this catastrophe approached with penitential
+looks.&nbsp; They had nothing to say, nor had we.&nbsp; They bent down
+slowly, and touched our feet with both hands.&nbsp; &ldquo;Ku kuata
+moendo&rdquo;&mdash;&ldquo;to catch the foot&rdquo;&mdash;is their way
+of asking forgiveness.&nbsp; It was so like what we have seen a little
+child do&mdash;try to bring a dish unbidden to its papa, and letting
+it fall, burst into a cry of distress&mdash;that they were only sentenced
+to go back to the ship, get provisions, and, in the ensuing journey
+on foot, carry as much as they could, and thus make up for the loss
+of the boat.</p>
+<p>It was excessively annoying to lose all this property, and be deprived
+of the means of doing the work proposed, on the east and north of the
+Lake; but it would have been like crying over spilt milk to do otherwise
+now than make the best use we could of our legs.&nbsp; The men were
+sent back to the ship for provisions, cloth, and beads; and while they
+are gone, we may say a little of the Cataracts which proved so fatal
+to our boating plan.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER XIII.</h3>
+<p>Dr. Livingstone&rsquo;s further explorations&mdash;Effects of slave-trade&mdash;Kirk&rsquo;s
+range&mdash;Ajawa migration&mdash;Native fishermen&mdash;Arab slave-crossing&mdash;Splendid
+highlands.</p>
+<p>The Murchison Cataracts of the Shir&eacute; river begin in 15 degrees
+20 minutes S., and end in lat. 15 degrees 55 minutes S., the difference
+of latitude is therefore 35 minutes.&nbsp; The river runs in this space
+nearly north and south, till we pass Malango; so the entire distance
+is under 40 miles.&nbsp; The principal Cataracts are five in number,
+and are called Pamofunda or Pamozima, Morewa, Panoreba or Tedzan&eacute;,
+Pampatamanga, and Papekira.&nbsp; Besides these, three or four smaller
+ones might be mentioned; as, for instance, Mamvira, where in our ascent
+we first met the broken water, and heard that gushing sound which, from
+the interminable windings of some 200 miles of river below, we had come
+to believe the tranquil Shir&eacute; could never make.&nbsp; While these
+lesser cataracts descend at an angle of scarcely 20 degrees, the greater
+fall 100 feet in 100 yards, at an angle of about 45 degrees, and one
+at an angle of 70 degrees.&nbsp; One part of Pamozima is perpendicular,
+and, when the river is in flood, causes a cloud of vapour to ascend,
+which, in our journey to Lake Shirwa, we saw at a distance of at least
+eight miles.&nbsp; The entire descent from the Upper to the Lower Shir&eacute;
+is 1200 feet.&nbsp; Only on one spot in all that distance is the current
+moderate&mdash;namely, above Tedzan&eacute;.&nbsp; The rest is all rapid,
+and much of it being only fifty or eighty yards wide, and rushing like
+a mill-race, it gives the impression of water-power, sufficient to drive
+all the mills in Manchester, running to waste.&nbsp; Pamofunda, or Pamozima,
+has a deep shady grove on its right bank.&nbsp; When we were walking
+alone through its dark shade, we were startled by a shocking smell like
+that of a dissecting-room; and on looking up saw dead bodies in mats
+suspended from the branches of the trees, a mode of burial somewhat
+similar to that which we subsequently saw practised by the Parsees in
+their &ldquo;towers of silence&rdquo; at Poonah, near Bombay.&nbsp;
+The name Pamozima means, &ldquo;the departed spirits or gods&rdquo;&mdash;a
+fit name for a place over which, according to the popular belief, the
+disembodied souls continually hover.</p>
+<p>The rock lowest down in the series is dark reddish-grey syenite.&nbsp;
+This seems to have been an upheaving agent, for the mica schists above
+it are much disturbed.&nbsp; Dark trappean rocks full of hornblende
+have in many places burst through these schists, and appear in nodules
+on the surface.&nbsp; The highest rock seen is a fine sandstone of closer
+grain than that at Tette, and quite metamorphosed where it comes into
+contact with the igneous rocks below it.&nbsp; It sometimes gives place
+to quartz and reddish clay schists, much baked by heat.&nbsp; This is
+the usual geological condition on the right bank of the Cataracts.&nbsp;
+On the other side we pass over masses of porphyritic trap, in contact
+with the same mica schists, and these probably give to the soil the
+great fertility we observed.&nbsp; The great body of the mountains is
+syenite.&nbsp; So much mica is washed into the river, that on looking
+attentively on the stream one sees myriads of particles floating and
+glancing in the sun; and this, too, even at low water.</p>
+<p>It was the 15th of August before the men returned from the ship,
+accompanied by Mr. Rae and the steward of the &ldquo;Pioneer.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+They brought two oxen, one of which was instantly slaughtered to put
+courage into all hearts, and some bottles of wine, a present from Waller
+and Alington.&nbsp; We never carried wine before, but this was precious
+as an expression of kindheartedness on the part of the donors.&nbsp;
+If one attempted to carry either wine or spirits, as a beverage, he
+would require a whole troop of followers for nothing else.&nbsp; Our
+greatest luxury in travelling was tea or coffee.&nbsp; We never once
+carried sugar enough to last a journey, but coffee is always good, while
+the sugarless tea is only bearable, because of the unbearable gnawing
+feeling of want and sinking which ensues if we begin to travel in the
+mornings without something warm in the stomach.&nbsp; Our drink generally
+was water, and if cool, nothing can equal it in a hot climate.&nbsp;
+We usually carried a bottle of brandy rolled up in our blankets, but
+that was used only as a medicine; a spoonful in hot water before going
+to bed, to fend off a chill and fever.&nbsp; Spirits always do harm,
+if the fever has fairly begun; and it is probable that brandy-and-water
+has to answer for a good many of the deaths in Africa.</p>
+<p>Mr. Rae had made gratifying progress in screwing together the &ldquo;Lady
+Nyassa.&rdquo;&nbsp; He had the zealous co-operation of three as fine
+steady workmen as ever handled tools; and, as they were noble specimens
+of English sailors, we would fain mention the names of men who are an
+honour to the British navy&mdash;John Reid, John Pennell, and Richard
+Wilson.&nbsp; The reader will excuse our doing so, but we desire to
+record how much they were esteemed, and how thankful we felt for their
+good behaviour.&nbsp; The weather was delightfully cool; and, with full
+confidence in those left behind, it was with light hearts we turned
+our faces north.&nbsp; Mr. Rae accompanied us a day in front; and, as
+all our party had earnestly advised that at least two Europeans should
+be associated together on the journey, the steward was at the last moment
+taken.&nbsp; Mr. Rae returned to get the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; ready
+for sea; and, as she drew less water than the &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo;
+take her down to the ocean in October.&nbsp; One reason for taking the
+steward is worth recording.&nbsp; Both he and a man named King, <a name="citation5"></a><a href="#footnote5">{5}</a>
+who, though only a leading stoker in the Navy, had been a promising
+student in the University of Aberdeen, had got into that weak bloodless-looking
+state which residence in the lowlands without much to do or think about
+often induces.&nbsp; The best thing for this is change and an active
+life.&nbsp; A couple of days&rsquo; march only as far as the Mukuru-Mads&eacute;,
+infused so much vigour into King that he was able to walk briskly back.&nbsp;
+Consideration for the steward&rsquo;s health led to his being selected
+for this northern journey, and the measure was so completely successful
+that it was often, in the hard march, a subject of regret that King
+had not been taken too.&nbsp; A removal of only a hundred yards is sometimes
+so beneficial that it ought in severe cases never to be omitted.</p>
+<p>Our object now was to get away to the N.N.W., proceed parallel with
+Lake Nyassa, but at a considerable distance west of it, and thus pass
+by the Mazitu or Zulus near its northern end without contact&mdash;ascertain
+whether any large river flowed into the Lake from the west&mdash;visit
+Lake Moelo, if time permitted, and collect information about the trade
+on the great slave route, which crosses the Lake at its southern end,
+and at Tsenga and Kota-kota.&nbsp; The Makololo were eager to travel
+fast, because they wanted to be back in time to hoe their fields before
+the rains, and also because their wives needed looking after.</p>
+<p>In going in the first instance N.E. from the uppermost Cataract,
+we followed in a measure the great bend of the river towards the foot
+of Mount Zomba.&nbsp; Here we had a view of its most imposing side,
+the west, with the plateau some 3000 feet high, stretching away to its
+south, and Mounts Chiradzuru and Mochiru towering aloft to the sky.&nbsp;
+From that goodly highland station, it was once hoped by the noble Mackenzie,
+who, for largeness of heart and loving disposition, really deserved
+to be called the &ldquo;Bishop of Central Africa,&rdquo; that light
+and liberty would spread to all the interior.&nbsp; We still think it
+may be a centre for civilizing influences; for any one descending from
+these cool heights, and stepping into a boat on the Upper Shir&eacute;,
+can sail three hundred miles without a check into the heart of Africa.</p>
+<p>We passed through a tract of country covered with mopane trees, where
+the hard baked soil refused to let the usual thick crops of grass grow;
+and here we came upon very many tracks of buffaloes, elephants, antelopes,
+and the spoor of one lion.&nbsp; An ox we drove along with us, as provision
+for the way, was sorely bitten by the tsetse.&nbsp; The effect of the
+bite was, as usual, quite apparent two days afterwards, in the general
+flaccidity of the muscles, the drooping ears, and looks of illness.&nbsp;
+It always excited our wonder that we, who were frequently much bitten
+too by the same insects, felt no harm from their attacks.&nbsp; Man
+shares the immunity of the wild animals.</p>
+<p>Finding a few people on the evening of the 20th of August, who were
+supporting a wretched existence on tamarinds and mice, we ascertained
+that there was no hope of our being able to buy food anywhere nearer
+than the Lakelet Pamalomb&eacute;, where the Ajawa chief, Kai&ntilde;ka,
+was now living; but that plenty could be found with the Maravi female
+chief, Nyango.&nbsp; We turned away north-westwards, and struck the
+stream Ribv&eacute;-ribv&eacute;, or Rivi-rivi, which rises in the Maravi
+range, and flows into the Shir&eacute;.</p>
+<p>As the Rivi-rivi came from the N.W. we continued to travel along
+its banks, until we came to people who had successfully defended themselves
+against the hordes of the Ajawa.&nbsp; By employing the men of one village
+to go forward and explain who we were to the next, we managed to prevent
+the frightened inhabitants from considering us a fresh party of Ajawa,
+or of Portuguese slaving agents.&nbsp; Here they had cultivated maize,
+and were willing to sell, but no persuasion could induce them to give
+us guides to the chieftainess, Nyango.&nbsp; They evidently felt that
+we were not to be trusted; though, as we had to certify to our own character,
+our companions did not fail &ldquo;to blow our own trumpet,&rdquo; with
+blasts in which modesty was quite out of the question.&nbsp; To allay
+suspicion, we had at last to refrain from mentioning the lady&rsquo;s
+name.</p>
+<p>It would be wearisome to repeat the names of the villages we passed
+on our way to the north-west.&nbsp; One was the largest we ever saw
+in Africa, and quite deserted, with the usual sad sight of many skeletons
+lying about.&nbsp; Another was called Tette.&nbsp; We know three places
+of this name, which fact shows it to be a native word; it seems to mean
+a place where the water rushes over rocks.&nbsp; A third village was
+called Chipanga (a great work), a name identical with the Shupanga of
+the Portuguese.&nbsp; This repetition of names may indicate that the
+same people first took these epithets in their traditional passage from
+north to south.</p>
+<p>At this season of the year the nights are still cold, and the people,
+having no crops to occupy their attention, do not stir out till long
+after the sun is up.&nbsp; At other times they are off to their fields
+before the day dawns, and the first sound one hears is the loud talking
+of men and women, in which they usually indulge in the dark to scare
+off beasts by the sound of the human voice.&nbsp; When no work is to
+be done, the first warning of approaching day is the hemp-smoker&rsquo;s
+loud ringing cough.</p>
+<p>Having been delayed one morning by some negotiation about guides,
+who were used chiefly to introduce us to other villages, we two whites
+walked a little way ahead, taking the direction of the stream.&nbsp;
+The men having been always able to find out our route by the prints
+of our shoes, we went on for a number of miles.&nbsp; This time, however,
+they lost our track, and failed to follow us.&nbsp; The path was well
+marked by elephants, hyenas, pallahs, and zebras, but for many a day
+no human foot had trod it.&nbsp; When the sun went down a deserted hamlet
+was reached, where we made comfortable beds for ourselves of grass.&nbsp;
+Firing muskets to attract the attention of those who have strayed is
+the usual resource in these cases.&nbsp; On this occasion the sound
+of firearms tended to mislead us; for, hearing shots next morning, a
+long weary march led us only to some native hunters, who had been shooting
+buffaloes.&nbsp; Returning to a small village, we met with some people
+who remembered our passing up to the Lake in the boat; they were as
+kind as they could be.&nbsp; The only food they possessed was tamarinds,
+prepared with ashes, and a little cowitch meal.&nbsp; The cowitch, as
+mentioned before, has a velvety brown covering of minute prickles, which,
+if touched, enter the pores of the skin and cause a painful tingling.&nbsp;
+The women in times of scarcity collect the pods, kindle a fire of grass
+over them to destroy the prickles, then steep the beans till they begin
+to sprout, wash them in pure water, and either boil them or pound them
+into meal, which resembles our bean-meal.&nbsp; This plant climbs up
+the long grass, and abounds in all reedy parts, and, though a plague
+to the traveller who touches its pods, it performs good service in times
+of famine by saving many a life from starvation.&nbsp; Its name here
+is Kitedzi.</p>
+<p>Having travelled at least twenty miles in search of our party that
+day, our rest on a mat in the best hut of the village was very sweet.&nbsp;
+We had dined the evening before on a pigeon each, and had eaten only
+a handful of kitedzi porridge this afternoon.&nbsp; The good wife of
+the village took a little corn which she had kept for seed, ground it
+after dark, and made it into porridge.&nbsp; This, and a cup of wild
+vegetables of a sweetish taste for a relish, a little boy brought in
+and put down, with several vigorous claps of his hands, in the manner
+which is esteemed polite, and which is strictly enjoined on all children.</p>
+<p>On the third day of separation, Akosanj&eacute;r&eacute;, the headman
+of this village, conducted us forward to our party who had gone on to
+Ns&eacute;z&eacute;, a district to the westward.&nbsp; This incident
+is mentioned, not for any interest it possesses, apart from the idea
+of the people it conveys.&nbsp; We were completely separated from our
+men for nearly three days, and had nothing wherewith to purchase food.&nbsp;
+The people were sorely pressed by famine and war, and their hospitality,
+poor as it was, did them great credit, and was most grateful to us.&nbsp;
+Our own men had become confused and wandered, but had done their utmost
+to find us; on our rejoining them, the ox was slain, and all, having
+been on short commons, rejoiced in this &ldquo;day of slaughter.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+Akosanj&eacute;r&eacute; was, of course, rewarded to his heart&rsquo;s
+content.</p>
+<p>As we pursued our way, we came close up to a range of mountains,
+the most prominent peak of which is called Mvai.&nbsp; This is a great,
+bare, rounded block of granite shooting up from the rest of the chain.&nbsp;
+It and several other masses of rock are of a light grey colour, with
+white patches, as if of lichens; the sides and summits are generally
+thinly covered with rather scraggy trees.&nbsp; There are several other
+prominent peaks&mdash;one, for instance, still further north, called
+Chirobv&eacute;.&nbsp; Each has a name, but we could never ascertain
+that there was an appellation which applied to the whole.&nbsp; This
+fact, and our wish to commemorate the name of Dr. Kirk, induced us afterwards,
+when we could not discover a particular peak mentioned to us formerly
+as Molomo-ao-koku, or Cock&rsquo;s-bill, to call the whole chain from
+the west of the Cataracts up to the north end of the Lake, &ldquo;Kirk&rsquo;s
+Range.&rdquo;&nbsp; The part we slept at opposite Mvai was named Paudio,
+and was evidently a continuation of the district of one of our stations
+on the Shir&eacute;, at which observations for latitude were formerly
+taken.</p>
+<p>Leaving Paudio, we had Kirk&rsquo;s Range close on our left and at
+least 3000 feet above us, and probably not less than 5000 feet above
+the sea.&nbsp; Far to our right extended a long green wooded country
+rising gradually up to a ridge, ornamented with several detached mountains,
+which bounded the Shir&eacute; Valley.&nbsp; In front, northwards, lay
+a valley as rich and lovely as we ever saw anywhere, terminating at
+the mountains, which, stretched away some thirty miles beyond our range
+of vision and ended at Cape Maclear.&nbsp; The groups of trees had never
+been subjected to the landscape gardener&rsquo;s art; but had been cut
+down mercilessly, just as suited the convenience of the cultivator;
+yet the various combinations of open forest, sloping woodland, grassy
+lawns, and massive clumps of dark green foliage along the running streams,
+formed as beautiful a landscape as could be seen on the Thames.&nbsp;
+This valley is named G&otilde;a or Gova, and as we moved through it
+we found that what was smooth to the eye was very much furrowed by running
+streams winding round innumerable knolls.&nbsp; These little brooklets
+came down from the range on our left, and the water was deliciously
+cool.</p>
+<p>When we came abreast of the peak Chirobv&eacute;, the people would
+no longer give us guides.&nbsp; They were afraid of their enemies, whose
+dwellings we now had on our east; and, proceeding without any one to
+lead us, or to introduce us to the inhabitants, we were perplexed by
+all the paths running zigzag across instead of along the valley.&nbsp;
+They had been made by the villagers going from the hamlets on the slopes
+to their gardens in the meadows below.&nbsp; To add to our difficulties,
+the rivulets and mountain-torrents had worn gullies some thirty or forty
+feet deep, with steep sides that could not be climbed except at certain
+points.&nbsp; The remaining inhabitants on the flank of the range when
+they saw strangers winding from side to side, and often attempting to
+cross these torrent beds at impossible places, screamed out their shrill
+war-alarm, and made the valley ring with their wild outcries.&nbsp;
+It was war, and war alone, and we were too deep down in the valley to
+make our voices heard in explanation.&nbsp; Fortunately, they had burned
+off the long grass to a great extent.&nbsp; It only here and there hid
+them from us.&nbsp; Selecting an open spot, we spent a night regarded
+by all around us as slave-hunters, but were undisturbed, though the
+usual way of treating an enemy in this part of the country is by night
+attack.</p>
+<p>The nights at the altitude of the valley were cool, the lowest temperature
+shown being 37 degrees; at 9 a.m. and 9 p.m. it was 58 degrees, about
+the average temperature of the day; at mid-day 82 degrees, and sunset
+70 degrees.&nbsp; Our march was very much hindered by the imperfectly
+burned corn and grass stalks having fallen across the paths.&nbsp; To
+a reader in England this will seem a very small obstacle.&nbsp; But
+he must fancy the grass stems as thick as his little finger, and the
+corn-stalks like so many walkingsticks lying in one direction, and so
+supporting each other that one has to lift his feet up as when wading
+through deep high heather.&nbsp; The stems of grass showed the causes
+of certain explosions as loud as pistols, which are heard when the annual
+fires come roaring over the land.&nbsp; The heated air inside expanding
+bursts the stalk with a loud report, and strews the fragments on the
+ground.</p>
+<p>A very great deal of native corn had been cultivated here, and we
+saw buffaloes feeding in the deserted gardens, and some women, who ran
+away very much faster than the beasts did.</p>
+<p>On the 29th, seeing some people standing under a tree by a village,
+we sat down, and sent Masego, one of our party, to communicate.&nbsp;
+The headman, Matunda, came back with him, bearing a calabash with water
+for us.&nbsp; He said that all the people had fled from the Ajawa, who
+had only just desisted from their career of pillage on being paid five
+persons as a fine for some offence for which they had commenced the
+invasion.&nbsp; Matunda had plenty of grain to sell, and all the women
+were soon at work grinding it into meal.&nbsp; We secured an abundant
+supply, and four milk goats.&nbsp; The Manganja goat is of a very superior
+breed to the general African animal, being short in the legs and having
+a finely-shaped broad body.&nbsp; By promising the Makololo that, when
+we no longer needed the milk, they should have the goats to improve
+the breed of their own at home, they were induced to take the greatest
+possible care of both goats and kids in driving and pasturing.</p>
+<p>After leaving Matunda, we came to the end of the highland valley;
+and, before descending a steep declivity of a thousand feet towards
+the part which may be called the heel of the Lake, we had the bold mountains
+of Cape Maclear on our right, with the blue water at their base, the
+hills of Tsenga in the distance in front, and Kirk&rsquo;s Range on
+our left, stretching away northwards, and apparently becoming lower.&nbsp;
+As we came down into a fine rich undulating valley, many perennial streams
+running to the east from the hills on our left were crossed, while all
+those behind us on the higher ground seemed to unite in one named Lek&uuml;&eacute;,
+which flowed into the Lake.</p>
+<p>After a long day&rsquo;s march in the valley of the Lake, where the
+temperature was very much higher than in that we had just left, we entered
+the village of Katosa, which is situated on the bank of a stream among
+gigantic timber trees, and found there a large party of Ajawa&mdash;Waiau,
+they called themselves&mdash;all armed with muskets.&nbsp; We sat down
+among them, and were soon called to the chiefs court, and presented
+with an ample mess of porridge, buffalo meat, and beer.&nbsp; Katosa
+was more frank than any Manganja chief we had met, and complimented
+us by saying that &ldquo;we must be his &lsquo;Bazimo&rsquo; (good spirits
+of his ancestors); for when he lived at Pamalomb&eacute;, we lighted
+upon him from above&mdash;men the like of whom he had never seen before,
+and coming he knew not whence.&rdquo;&nbsp; He gave us one of his own
+large and clean huts to sleep in; and we may take this opportunity of
+saying that the impression we received, from our first journey on the
+hills among the villages of Chisuns&eacute;, of the excessive dirtiness
+of the Manganja, was erroneous.&nbsp; This trait was confined to the
+cool highlands.&nbsp; Here crowds of men and women were observed to
+perform their ablutions daily in the stream that ran past their villages;
+and this we have observed elsewhere to be a common custom with both
+Manganja and Ajawa.</p>
+<p>Before we started on the morning of the 1st September, Katosa sent
+an enormous calabash of beer, containing at least three gallons, and
+then came and wished us to &ldquo;stop a day and eat with him.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+On explaining to him the reasons for our haste, he said that he was
+in the way by which travellers usually passed, he never stopped them
+in their journeys, but would like to look at us for a day.&nbsp; On
+our promising to rest a little with him on our return, he gave us about
+two pecks of rice, and three guides to conduct us to a subordinate female
+chief, Nkwinda, living on the borders of the Lake in front.</p>
+<p>The Ajawa, from having taken slaves down to Quillimane and Mosambique,
+knew more of us than Katosa did.&nbsp; Their muskets were carefully
+polished, and never out of these slaver&rsquo;s hands for a moment,
+though in the chiefs presence.&nbsp; We naturally felt apprehensive
+that we should never see Katosa again.&nbsp; A migratory afflatus seems
+to have come over the Ajawa tribes.&nbsp; Wars among themselves, for
+the supply of the Coast slave-trade, are said to have first set them
+in motion.&nbsp; The usual way in which they have advanced among the
+Manganja has been by slave-trading in a friendly way.&nbsp; Then, professing
+to wish to live as subjects, they have been welcomed as guests, and
+the Manganja, being great agriculturists, have been able to support
+considerable bodies of these visitors for a time.&nbsp; When the provisions
+became scarce, the guests began to steal from the fields; quarrels arose
+in consequence, and, the Ajawa having firearms, their hosts got the
+worst of it, and were expelled from village after village, and out of
+their own country.&nbsp; The Manganja were quite as bad in regard to
+slave-trading as the Ajawa, but had less enterprise, and were much more
+fond of the home pursuits of spinning, weaving, smelting iron, and cultivating
+the soil, than of foreign travel.&nbsp; The Ajawa had little of a mechanical
+turn, and not much love for agriculture, but were very keen traders
+and travellers.&nbsp; This party seemed to us to be in the first or
+friendly stage of intercourse with Katosa; and, as we afterwards found,
+he was fully alive to the danger.</p>
+<p>Our course was shaped towards the N.W., and we traversed a large
+fertile tract of rich soil extensively cultivated, but dotted with many
+gigantic thorny acacias which had proved too large for the little axes
+of the cultivators.&nbsp; After leaving Nkwinda, the first village we
+spent a night at in the district Ngabi was that of Chembi, and it had
+a stockade around it.&nbsp; The Azitu or Mazitu were said to be ravaging
+the country to the west of us, and no one was safe except in a stockade.&nbsp;
+We have so often, in travelling, heard of war in front, that we paid
+little attention to the assertion of Chembi, that the whole country
+to the N.W. was in flight before these Mazitu, under a chief with the
+rather formidable name of Mowhiriwhiri; we therefore resolved to go
+on to Chinsamba&rsquo;s, still further in the same direction, and hear
+what he said about it.</p>
+<p>The only instrument of husbandry here is the short-handled hoe; and
+about Tette the labour of tilling the soil, as represented in the woodcut,
+is performed entirely by female slaves.&nbsp; On the West Coast a double-handled
+hoe is employed.&nbsp; Here the small hoe is seen in the hands of both
+men and women.&nbsp; In other parts of Africa a hoe with a handle four
+feet long is used, but the plough is quite unknown.</p>
+<p>In illustration of the manner in which the native knowledge of agriculture
+strikes an honest intelligent observer, it may be mentioned that the
+first time good Bishop Mackenzie beheld how well the fields of the Manganja
+were cultivated on the hills, he remarked to Dr. Livingstone, then his
+fellow-traveller&mdash;&ldquo;When telling the people in England what
+were my objects in going out to Africa, I stated that, among other things,
+I meant to teach these people agriculture; but I now see that they know
+far more about it than I do.&rdquo;&nbsp; This, we take it, was an honest
+straightforward testimony, and we believe that every unprejudiced witness,
+who has an opportunity of forming an opinion of Africans who have never
+been debased by slavery, will rank them very much higher in the scale
+of intelligence, industry, and manhood, than others who know them only
+in a state of degradation.</p>
+<p>On coming near Chinsamba&rsquo;s two stockades, on the banks of the
+Lintipe, we were told that the Mazitu had been repulsed there the day
+before, and we had evidence of the truth of the report of the attack
+in the sad sight of the bodies of the slain.&nbsp; The Zulus had taken
+off large numbers of women laden with corn; and, when driven back, had
+cut off the ears of a male prisoner, as a sort of credential that he
+had been with the Mazitu, and with grim humour sent him to tell Chinsamba
+&ldquo;to take good care of the corn in the stockades, for they meant
+to return for it in a month or two.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>Chinsamba&rsquo;s people were drumming with might and main on our
+arrival, to express their joy at their deliverance from the Mazitu.&nbsp;
+The drum is the chief instrument of music among the Manganja, and with
+it they express both their joy and grief.&nbsp; They excel in beating
+time.&nbsp; Chinsamba called us into a very large hut, and presented
+us with a huge basket of beer.&nbsp; The glare of sunlight from which
+we had come enabled him, in diplomatic fashion, to have a good view
+of us before our eyes became enough accustomed to the dark inside to
+see him.&nbsp; He has a Jewish cast of countenance, or rather the ancient
+Assyrian face, as seen in the monuments brought to the British Museum
+by Mr. Layard.&nbsp; This form of face is very common in this country,
+and leads to the belief that the true type of the negro is not that
+met on the West Coast, from which most people have derived their ideas
+of the African.</p>
+<p>Chinsamba had many Abisa or Babisa in his stockade, and it was chiefly
+by the help of their muskets that he had repulsed the Mazitu: these
+Babisa are great travellers and traders.</p>
+<p>We liked Chinsamba very well, and found that he was decidedly opposed
+to our risking our lives by going further to the N.W.&nbsp; The Mazitu
+were believed to occupy all the hills in that direction, so we spent
+the 4th of September with him.</p>
+<p>It is rather a minute thing to mention, and it will only be understood
+by those who have children of their own, but the cries of the little
+ones, in their infant sorrows, are the same in tone, at different ages,
+here as all over the world.&nbsp; We have been perpetually reminded
+of home and family by the wailings which were once familiar to parental
+ears and heart, and felt thankful that to the sorrows of childhood our
+children would never have superadded the heartrending woes of the slave-trade.</p>
+<p>Taking Chinsamba&rsquo;s advice to avoid the Mazitu in their marauding,
+we started on the 5th September away to the N.E., and passed mile after
+mile of native cornfields, with an occasional cotton-patch.</p>
+<p>After a long march, we passed over a waterless plain about N.N.W.
+of the hills of Tsenga to a village on the Lake, and thence up its shores
+to Chitanda.&nbsp; The banks of the Lake were now crowded with fugitives,
+who had collected there for the poor protection which the reeds afforded.&nbsp;
+For miles along the water&rsquo;s edge was one continuous village of
+temporary huts.&nbsp; The people had brought a little corn with them;
+but they said, &ldquo;What shall we eat when that is done?&nbsp; When
+we plant corn, the wild beasts (Zinyama, as they call the Mazitu) come
+and take it.&nbsp; When we plant cassava, they do the same.&nbsp; How
+are we to live?&rdquo;&nbsp; A poor blind woman, thinking we were Mazitu,
+rushed off in front of us with outspread arms, lifting the feet high,
+in the manner peculiar to those who have lost their sight, and jumped
+into the reeds of a stream for safety.</p>
+<p>In our way along the shores we crossed several running rivulets of
+clear cold water, which, from having reeds at their confluences, had
+not been noticed in our previous exploration in the boat.&nbsp; One
+of these was called Mokola, and another had a strong odour of sulphuretted
+hydrogen.&nbsp; We reached Molamba on the 8th September, and found our
+old acquaintance, Nkomo, there still.&nbsp; One of the advantages of
+travelling along the shores of the Lake was, that we could bathe anywhere
+in its clear fresh water.&nbsp; To us, who had been obliged so often
+to restrain our inclination in the Zambesi and Shir&eacute; for fear
+of crocodiles, this was pleasant beyond measure.&nbsp; The water now
+was of the same temperature as it was on our former visit, or 72 degrees
+Fahr.&nbsp; The immense depth of the Lake prevents the rays of the sun
+from raising the temperature as high as that of the Shir&eacute; and
+Zambesi; and the crocodiles, having always clear water in the Lake,
+and abundance of fish, rarely attack man; many of these reptiles could
+be seen basking on the rocks.</p>
+<p>A day&rsquo;s march beyond Molamba brought us to the lakelet Chia,
+which lies parallel with the Lake.&nbsp; It is three or four miles long,
+by from one to one and a half broad, and communicates with the Lake
+by an arm of good depth, but with some rocks in it.&nbsp; As we passed
+up between the Lake and the eastern shore of this lakelet, we did not
+see any streams flowing into it.&nbsp; It is quite remarkable for the
+abundance of fish; and we saw upwards of fifty large canoes engaged
+in the fishery, which is carried on by means of hand-nets with side-frame
+poles about seven feet long.&nbsp; These nets are nearly identical with
+those now in use in Normandy&mdash;the difference being that the African
+net has a piece of stick lashed across the handle-ends of the side poles
+to keep them steady, which is a great improvement.&nbsp; The fish must
+be very abundant to be scooped out of the water in such quantities as
+we saw, and by so many canoes.&nbsp; There is quite a trade here in
+dried fish.</p>
+<p>The country around is elevated, undulating, and very extensively
+planted with cassava.&nbsp; The hoe in use has a handle of four feet
+in length, and the iron part is exactly of the same form as that in
+the country of the Bechuanas.&nbsp; The baskets here, which are so closely
+woven together as to hold beer, are the same with those employed to
+hold milk in Kaffirland&mdash;a thousand miles distant.</p>
+<p>Marching on foot is peculiarly conducive to meditation&mdash;one
+is glad of any subject to occupy the mind, and relieve the monotony
+of the weary treadmill-like trudge-trudging.&nbsp; This Chia net brought
+to our mind that the smith&rsquo;s bellows made here of a goatskin bag,
+with sticks along the open ends, are the same as those in use in the
+Bechuana country far to the south-west.&nbsp; These, with the long-handled
+hoe, may only show that each successive horde from north to south took
+inventions with it from the same original source.&nbsp; Where that source
+may have been is probably indicated by another pair of bellows, which
+we observed below the Victoria Falls, being found in Central India and
+among the Gipsies of Europe.</p>
+<p>Men in remote times may have had more highly-developed instincts,
+which enabled them to avoid or use poisons; but the late Archbishop
+Whately has proved, that wholly untaught savages never could invent
+anything, or even subsist at all.&nbsp; Abundant corroboration of his
+arguments is met with in this country, where the natives require but
+little in the way of clothing, and have remarkably hardy stomachs.&nbsp;
+Although possessing a knowledge of all the edible roots and fruits in
+the country, having hoes to dig with, and spears, bows, and arrows to
+kill the game,&mdash;we have seen that, notwithstanding all these appliances
+and means to boot, they have perished of absolute starvation.</p>
+<p>The art of making fire is the same in India as in Africa.&nbsp; The
+smelting furnaces, for reducing iron and copper from the ores, are also
+similar.&nbsp; Yellow h&aelig;matite, which bears not the smallest resemblance
+either in colour or weight to the metal, is employed near Kolobeng for
+the production of iron.&nbsp; Malachite, the precious green stone used
+in civilized life for vases, would never be suspected by the uninstructed
+to be a rich ore of copper, and yet it is extensively smelted for rings
+and other ornaments in the heart of Africa.&nbsp; A copper bar of native
+manufacture four feet long was offered to us for sale at Chinsamba&rsquo;s.&nbsp;
+These arts are monuments attesting the fact, that some instruction from
+above must at some time or other have been supplied to mankind; and,
+as Archbishop Whately says, &ldquo;the most probable conclusion is,
+that man when first created, or very shortly afterwards, was advanced,
+by the Creator Himself, to a state above that of a mere savage.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>The argument for an original revelation to man, though quite independent
+of the Bible history, tends to confirm that history.&nbsp; It is of
+the same nature with this, that man could not have <i>made</i> himself,
+and therefore must have had a Divine <i>Creator</i>.&nbsp; Mankind could
+not, in the first instance, have <i>civilized</i> themselves, and therefore
+must have had a superhuman <i>Instructor</i>.</p>
+<p>In connection with this subject, it is remarkable that throughout
+successive generations no change has taken place in the form of the
+various inventions.&nbsp; Hammers, tongs, hoes, axes, adzes, handles
+to them; needles, bows and arrows, with the mode of feathering the latter;
+spears, for killing game, with spear-heads having what is termed &ldquo;dish&rdquo;
+on both sides to give them, when thrown, the rotatory motion of rifle-balls;
+the arts of spinning and weaving, with that of pounding and steeping
+the inner bark of a tree till it serves as clothing; millstones for
+grinding corn into meal; the manufacture of the same kind of pots or
+<i>chatties</i> as in India; the art of cooking, of brewing beer and
+straining it as was done in ancient Egypt; fish-hooks, fishing and hunting
+nets, fish-baskets, and weirs, the same as in the Highlands of Scotland;
+traps for catching animals, etc., etc.,&mdash;have all been so very
+permanent from age to age, and some of them of identical patterns are
+so widely spread over the globe, as to render it probable that they
+were all, at least in some degree, derived from one Source.&nbsp; The
+African traditions, which seem possessed of the same unchangeability
+as the arts to which they relate, like those of all other nations refer
+their origin to a superior Being.&nbsp; And it is much more reasonable
+to receive the hints given in Genesis, concerning direct instruction
+from God to our first parents or their children in religious or moral
+duty, and probably in the knowledge of the arts of life, <a name="citation6"></a><a href="#footnote6">{6}</a>
+than to give credence to the theory that untaught savage man subsisted
+in a state which would prove fatal to all his descendants, and that
+in such helpless state he made many inventions which most of his progeny
+retained, but never improved upon during some thirty centuries.</p>
+<p>We crossed in canoes the arm of the Lake, which joins Chia to Nyassa,
+and spent the night on its northern bank.&nbsp; The whole country adjacent
+to the Lake, from this point up to Kota-kota Bay, is densely peopled
+by thousands who have fled from the forays of the Mazitu in hopes of
+protection from the Arabs who live there.&nbsp; In three running rivulets
+we saw the <i>Shuar&eacute;</i> palm, and an oil palm which is much
+inferior to that on the West Coast.&nbsp; Though somewhat similar in
+appearance, the fruit is not much larger than hazel-nuts, and the people
+do not use them, on account of the small quantity of oil which they
+afford.</p>
+<p>The idea of using oil for light never seems to have entered the African
+mind.&nbsp; Here a bundle of split and dried bamboo, tied together with
+creeping plants, as thick as a man&rsquo;s body, and about twenty feet
+in length, is employed in the canoes as a torch to attract the fish
+at night.&nbsp; It would be considered a piece of the most wasteful
+extravagance to burn the oil they obtain from the castor-oil bean and
+other seeds, and also from certain fish, or in fact to do anything with
+it but anoint their heads and bodies.</p>
+<p>We arrived at Kota-kota Bay in the afternoon of the 10th September,
+1863; and sat down under a magnificent wild fig-tree with leaves ten
+inches long, by five broad, about a quarter of a mile from the village
+of Juma ben Saidi, and Yakobe ben Arame, whom we had met on the River
+Kaomb&eacute;, a little north of this, in our first exploration of the
+Lake.&nbsp; We had rested but a short time when Juma, who is evidently
+the chief person here, followed by about fifty people, came to salute
+us and to invite us to take up our quarters in his village.&nbsp; The
+hut which, by mistake, was offered, was so small and dirty, that we
+preferred sleeping in an open space a few hundred yards off.</p>
+<p>Juma afterwards apologized for the mistake, and presented us with
+rice, meal, sugar-cane, and a piece of malachite.&nbsp; We returned
+his visit on the following day, and found him engaged in building a
+dhow or Arab vessel, to replace one which he said had been wrecked.&nbsp;
+This new one was fifty feet long, twelve feet broad, and five feet deep.&nbsp;
+The planks were of a wood like teak, here called Timbati, and the timbers
+of a closer grained wood called Msoro.&nbsp; The sight of this dhow
+gave us a hint which, had we previously received it, would have prevented
+our attempting to carry a vessel of iron past the Cataracts.&nbsp; The
+trees around Katosa&rsquo;s village were Timbati, and they would have
+yielded planks fifty feet long and thirty inches broad.&nbsp; With a
+few native carpenters a good vessel could be built on the Lake nearly
+as quickly as one could be carried past the Cataracts, and at a vastly
+less cost.&nbsp; Juma said that no money would induce him to part with
+this dhow.&nbsp; He was very busy in transporting slaves across the
+Lake by means of two boats, which we saw returning from a trip in the
+afternoon.&nbsp; As he did not know of our intention to visit him, we
+came upon several gangs of stout young men slaves, each secured by the
+neck to one common chain, waiting for exportation, and several more
+in slave-sticks.&nbsp; These were all civilly removed before our interview
+was over, because Juma knew that we did not relish the sight.</p>
+<p>When we met the same Arabs in 1861, they had but few attendants:
+according to their own account, they had now, in the village and adjacent
+country, 1500 souls.&nbsp; It is certain that tens of thousands had
+flocked to them for protection, and all their power and influence must
+be attributed to the possession of guns and gunpowder.&nbsp; This crowding
+of refugees to any point where there is a hope for security for life
+and property is very common in this region, and the knowledge of it
+made our hopes beat high for the success of a peaceful Mission on the
+shores of the Lake.&nbsp; The rate, however, in which the people here
+will perish by the next famine, or be exported by Juma and others, will,
+we fear, depopulate those parts which we have just described as crowded
+with people.&nbsp; Hunger will ere long compel them to sell each other.&nbsp;
+An intelligent man complained to us of the Arabs often seizing slaves,
+to whom they took a fancy, without the formality of purchase; but the
+price is so low&mdash;from two to four yards of calico&mdash;that one
+can scarcely think this seizure and exportation without payment worth
+their while.&nbsp; The boats were in constant employment, and, curiously
+enough, Ben Habib, whom we met at Linyanti in 1855, had been taken across
+the Lake, the day before our arrival at this Bay, on his way from Seshek&eacute;
+to Kilwa, and we became acquainted with a native servant of the Arabs,
+called Selel&eacute; Saidallah, who could speak the Makololo language
+pretty fairly from having once spent some months in the Barots&eacute;
+Valley.</p>
+<p>From boyhood upwards we have been accustomed, from time to time,
+to read in books of travels about the great advances annually made by
+Mohammedanism in Africa.&nbsp; The rate at which this religion spreads
+was said to be so rapid, that in after days, in our own pretty extensive
+travels, we have constantly been on the look out for the advancing wave
+from North to South, which, it was prophesied, would soon reduce the
+entire continent to the faith of the false prophet.&nbsp; The only foundation
+that we can discover for the assertions referred to, and for others
+of more recent date, is the fact that in a remote corner of North-Western
+Africa the Fulahs, and Mandingoes, and some others in Northern Africa,
+as mentioned by Dr. Barth, have made conquests of territory; but even
+they care so very little for the extension of their faith, that after
+the conquest no pains whatever are taken to indoctrinate the adults
+of the tribe.&nbsp; This is in exact accordance with the impression
+we have received from our intercourse with Mohammedans and Christians.&nbsp;
+The followers of Christ alone are anxious to propagate their faith.&nbsp;
+A <i>quasi</i> philanthropist would certainly never need to recommend
+the followers of Islam, whom we have met, to restrain their benevolence
+by preaching that &ldquo;Charity should begin at home.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>Though Selel&eacute; and his companions were bound to their masters
+by domestic ties, the only new idea they had imbibed from Mohammedanism
+was, that it would be wrong to eat meat killed by other people.&nbsp;
+They thought it would be &ldquo;unlucky.&rdquo;&nbsp; Just as the inhabitants
+of Kolobeng, before being taught the requirements of Christianity, refrained
+from hoeing their gardens on Sundays, lest they should reap an unlucky
+crop.&nbsp; So far as we could learn, no efforts had been made to convert
+the natives, though these two Arabs, and about a dozen half-castes,
+had been in the country for many years; and judging from our experience
+with a dozen Mohammedans in our employ at high wages for sixteen months,
+the Africans would be the better men in proportion as they retained
+their native faith.&nbsp; This may appear only a harsh judgment from
+a mind imbued with Christian prejudices; but without any pretention
+to that impartiality, which leaves it doubtful to which side the affections
+lean, the truth may be fairly stated by one who viewed all Mohammedans
+and Africans with the sincerest good will.</p>
+<p>Our twelve Mohammedans from Johanna were the least open of any of
+our party to impression from kindness.&nbsp; A marked difference in
+general conduct was apparent.&nbsp; The Makololo, and other natives
+of the country, whom we had with us, invariably shared with each other
+the food they had cooked, but the Johanna men partook of their meals
+at a distance.&nbsp; This, at first, we attributed to their Moslem prejudices;
+but when they saw the cooking process of the others nearly complete,
+they came, sat beside them, and ate the portion offered without ever
+remembering to return the compliment when their own turn came to be
+generous.&nbsp; The Makololo and the others grumbled at their greediness,
+yet always followed the common custom of Africans of sharing their food
+with all who sit around them.&nbsp; What vexed us most in the Johanna
+men was their indifference to the welfare of each other.&nbsp; Once,
+when they were all coming to the ship after sleeping ashore, one of
+them walked into the water with the intention of swimming off to the
+boat, and while yet hardly up to his knees was seized by a horrid crocodile
+and dragged under; the poor fellow gave a shriek, and held up his hand
+for aid, but none of his countrymen stirred to his assistance, and he
+was never seen again.&nbsp; On asking his brother-in-law why he did
+not help him, he replied, &ldquo;Well, no one told him to go into the
+water.&nbsp; It was his own fault that he was killed.&rdquo;&nbsp; The
+Makololo on the other hand rescued a woman at Senna by entering the
+water, and taking her out of the crocodile&rsquo;s mouth.</p>
+<p>It is not assumed that their religion had much to do in the matter.&nbsp;
+Many Mohammedans might contrast favourably with indifferent Christians;
+but, so far as our experience in East Africa goes, the moral tone of
+the follower of Mahomed is pitched at a lower key than that of the untutored
+African.&nbsp; The ancient zeal for propagating the tenets of the Koran
+has evaporated, and been replaced by the most intense selfishness and
+grossest sensuality.&nbsp; The only known efforts made by Mohammedans,
+namely, those in the North-West and North of the continent, are so linked
+with the acquisition of power and plunder, as not to deserve the name
+of religious propagandism; and the only religion that now makes proselytes
+is that of Jesus Christ.&nbsp; To those who are capable of taking a
+comprehensive view of this subject, nothing can be adduced of more telling
+significance than the well-attested fact, that while the Mohammedans,
+Fulahs, and others towards Central Africa, make a few proselytes by
+a process which gratifies their own covetousness, three small sections
+of the Christian converts, the Africans in the South, in the West Indies,
+and on the West Coast of Africa actually contribute for the support
+and spread of their religion upwards of &pound;15,000 annually. <a name="citation7"></a><a href="#footnote7">{7}</a>&nbsp;
+That religion which so far overcomes the selfishness of the human heart
+must be Divine.</p>
+<p>Leaving Kota-kota Bay, we turned away due West on the great slave
+route to Katanga&rsquo;s and Cazemb&eacute;&rsquo;s country in Londa.&nbsp;
+Juma lent us his servant, Selel&eacute;, to lead us the first day&rsquo;s
+march.&nbsp; He said that the traders from Kilwa and Iboe cross the
+Lake either at this bay, or at Tsenga, or at the southern end of the
+Lake; and that wherever they may cross they all go by this path to the
+interior.&nbsp; They have slaves with them to carry their goods, and
+when they reach a spot where they can easily buy others, they settle
+down and begin the traffic, and at once cultivate grain.&nbsp; So much
+of the land lies waste, that no objection is ever made to any one taking
+possession of as much as he needs; they can purchase a field of cassava
+for their present wants for very little, and they continue trading in
+the country for two or three years, and giving what weight their muskets
+possess to the chief who is most liberal to them.</p>
+<p>The first day&rsquo;s march led us over a rich, well-cultivated plain.&nbsp;
+This was succeeded by highlands, undulating, stony, and covered with
+scraggy trees.&nbsp; Many banks of well rounded shingle appear.&nbsp;
+The disintegration of the rocks, now going on, does not round off the
+angles; they are split up by the heat and cold into angular fragments.&nbsp;
+On these high downs we crossed the River Kaomb&eacute;.&nbsp; Beyond
+it we came among the upland vegetation&mdash;rhododendrons, proteas,
+the masuko, and molompi.&nbsp; At the foot of the hill, Kasuko-suko,
+we found the River Bua running north to join the Kaomb&eacute;.&nbsp;
+We had to go a mile out of our way for a ford; the stream is deep enough
+in parts for hippopotami.&nbsp; The various streams not previously noticed,
+crossed in this journey, had before this led us to the conclusion, independently
+of the testimony of the natives, that no large river ran into the north
+end of the Lake.&nbsp; No such affluent was needed to account for the
+Shir&eacute;&rsquo;s perennial flow.</p>
+<p>On September 15th we reached the top of the ascent which, from its
+many ups and downs, had often made us puff and blow as if broken-winded.&nbsp;
+The water of the streams we crossed was deliciously cold, and now that
+we had gained the summit at Ndonda, where the boiling-point of water
+showed an altitude of 3440 feet above the sea, the air was delightful.&nbsp;
+Looking back we had a magnificent view of the Lake, but the haze prevented
+our seeing beyond the sea horizon.&nbsp; The scene was beautiful, but
+it was impossible to dissociate the lovely landscape whose hills and
+dales had so sorely tried our legs and lungs, from the sad fact that
+this was part of the great slave route now actually in use.&nbsp; By
+this road many &ldquo;Ten thousands&rdquo; have here seen &ldquo;the
+Sea,&rdquo; &ldquo;the Sea,&rdquo; but with sinking hearts; for the
+universal idea among the captive gangs is, that they are going to be
+fattened and eaten by the whites.&nbsp; They cannot of course be so
+much shocked as we should be&mdash;their sensibilities are far from
+fine, their feelings are more obtuse than ours&mdash;in fact, &ldquo;the
+live eels are used to being skinned,&rdquo; perhaps they rather like
+it.&nbsp; We who are not philosophic, blessed the Providence which at
+Thermopyl&aelig; in ancient days rolled back the tide of Eastern conquest
+from the West, and so guided the course of events that light and liberty
+and gospel truth spread to our distant isle, and emancipating our race
+freed them from the fear of ever again having to climb fatiguing heights
+and descend wearisome hollows in a slave-gang, as we suppose they did
+when the fair English youths were exposed for sale at Rome.</p>
+<p>Looking westwards we perceived that, what from below had the appearance
+of mountains, was only the edge of a table-land which, though at first
+undulating, soon became smooth, and sloped towards the centre of the
+country.&nbsp; To the south a prominent mountain called Chipata, and
+to the south-west another named Ngalla, by which the Bua is said to
+rise, gave character to the landscape.&nbsp; In the north, masses of
+hills prevented our seeing more than eight or ten miles.</p>
+<p>The air which was so exhilarating to Europeans had an opposite effect
+on five men who had been born and reared in the malaria of the Delta
+of the Zambesi.&nbsp; No sooner did they reach the edge of the plateau
+at Ndonda, than they lay down prostrate, and complained of pains all
+over them.&nbsp; The temperature was not much lower than that on the
+shores of the Lake below, 76 degrees being the mean temperature of the
+day, 52 degrees the lowest, and 82 degrees the highest during the twenty-four
+hours; at the Lake it was about l0 degrees higher.&nbsp; Of the symptoms
+they complained of&mdash;pains everywhere&mdash;nothing could be made.&nbsp;
+And yet it was evident that they had good reason for saying that they
+were ill.&nbsp; They scarified almost every part of their bodies as
+a remedial measure; medicines, administered on the supposition that
+their malady was the effect of a sudden chill, had no effect, and in
+two days one of them actually died in consequence of, as far as we could
+judge, a change from a malarious to a purer and more rarefied atmosphere.</p>
+<p>As we were on the slave route, we found the people more churlish
+than usual.&nbsp; On being expostulated with about it, they replied,
+&ldquo;We have been made wary by those who come to buy slaves.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+The calamity of death having befallen our party, seemed, however, to
+awaken their sympathies.&nbsp; They pointed out their usual burying-place,
+lent us hoes, and helped to make the grave.&nbsp; When we offered to
+pay all expenses, they showed that they had not done these friendly
+offices without fully appreciating their value; for they enumerated
+the use of the hut, the mat on which the deceased had lain, the hoes,
+the labour, and the medicine which they had scattered over the place
+to make him rest in peace.</p>
+<p>The primitive African faith seems to be that there is one Almighty
+Maker of heaven and earth; that he has given the various plants of earth
+to man to be employed as mediators between him and the spirit world,
+where all who have ever been born and died continue to live; that sin
+consists in offences against their fellow-men, either here or among
+the departed, and that death is often a punishment of guilt, such as
+witchcraft.&nbsp; Their idea of moral evil differs in no respect from
+ours, but they consider themselves amenable only to inferior beings,
+not to the Supreme.&nbsp; Evil-speaking&mdash;lying&mdash;hatred&mdash;disobedience
+to parents&mdash;neglect of them&mdash;are said by the intelligent to
+have been all known to be sin, as well as theft, murder, or adultery,
+before they knew aught of Europeans or their teaching.&nbsp; The only
+new addition to their moral code is, that it is wrong to have more wives
+than one.&nbsp; This, until the arrival of Europeans, never entered
+into their minds even as a doubt.</p>
+<p>Everything not to be accounted for by common causes, whether of good
+or evil, is ascribed to the Deity.&nbsp; Men are inseparably connected
+with the spirits of the departed, and when one dies he is believed to
+have joined the hosts of his ancestors.&nbsp; All the Africans we have
+met with are as firmly persuaded of their future existence as of their
+present life.&nbsp; And we have found none in whom the belief in the
+Supreme Being was not rooted.&nbsp; He is so invariably referred to
+as the Author of everything supernatural, that, unless one is ignorant
+of their language, he cannot fail to notice this prominent feature of
+their faith.&nbsp; When they pass into the unseen world, they do not
+seem to be possessed with the fear of punishment.&nbsp; The utensils
+placed upon the grave are all broken as if to indicate that they will
+never be used by the departed again.&nbsp; The body is put into the
+grave in a sitting posture, and the hands are folded in front.&nbsp;
+In some parts of the country there are tales which we could translate
+into faint glimmerings of a resurrection; but whether these fables,
+handed down from age to age, convey that meaning to the natives themselves
+we cannot tell.&nbsp; The true tradition of faith is asserted to be
+&ldquo;though a man die he will live again;&rdquo; the false that when
+he dies he is dead for ever.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER XIV.</h3>
+<p>Important geographical discoveries in the Wabisa countries&mdash;Cruelty
+of the slave-trade&mdash;The Mazitu&mdash;Serious illness of Dr. Livingstone&mdash;Return
+to the ship.</p>
+<p>In our course westwards, we at first passed over a gently undulating
+country, with a reddish clayey soil, which, from the heavy crops, appeared
+to be very fertile.&nbsp; Many rivulets were crossed, some running southwards
+into the Bua, and others northwards into the Loangwa, a river which
+we formerly saw flowing into the Lake.&nbsp; Further on, the water was
+chiefly found in pools and wells.&nbsp; Then still further, in the same
+direction, some watercourses were said to flow into that same &ldquo;Loangwa
+of the Lake,&rdquo; and others into the Loangwa, which flows to the
+south-west, and enters the Zambesi at Zumbo, and is here called the
+&ldquo;Loangwa of the Maravi.&rdquo;&nbsp; The trees were in general
+scraggy, and covered, exactly as they are in the damp climate of the
+Coast, with lichens, resembling orchilla-weed.&nbsp; The maize, which
+loves rather a damp soil, had been planted on ridges to allow the superfluous
+moisture to run off.&nbsp; Everything indicated a very humid climate,
+and the people warned us that, as the rains were near, we were likely
+to be prevented from returning by the country becoming flooded and impassable.</p>
+<p>Villages, as usual encircled by euphorbia hedges, were numerous,
+and a great deal of grain had been cultivated around them.&nbsp; Domestic
+fowls, in plenty, and pigeons with dovecots like those in Egypt were
+seen.&nbsp; The people call themselves Matumboka, but the only difference
+between them and the rest of the Manganja is in the mode of tattooing
+the face.&nbsp; Their language is the same.&nbsp; Their distinctive
+mark consists of four tattooed lines diverging from the point between
+the eyebrows, which, in frowning, the muscles form into a furrow.&nbsp;
+The other lines of tattooing, as in all Manganja, run in long seams,
+which crossing each other at certain angles form a great number of triangular
+spaces on the breast, back, arms, and thighs.&nbsp; The cuticle is divided
+by a knife, and the edges of the incision are drawn apart till the true
+skin appears.&nbsp; By a repetition of this process, lines of raised
+cicatrices are formed, which are thought to give beauty, no matter how
+much pain the fashion gives.</p>
+<p>It would not be worth while to advert for a moment to the routine
+of travelling, or the little difficulties that beset every one who attempts
+to penetrate into a new country, were it not to show the great source
+of the power here possessed by slave-traders.&nbsp; We needed help in
+carrying our goods, while our men were ill, though still able to march.&nbsp;
+When we had settled with others for hire, we were often told, that the
+dealers in men had taken possession of some, and had taken them away
+altogether.&nbsp; Other things led us to believe that the slave-traders
+carry matters with a high hand; and no wonder, for the possession of
+gunpowder gives them almost absolute power.&nbsp; The mode by which
+tribes armed with bows and arrows carry on warfare, or defend themselves,
+is by ambuscade.&nbsp; They never come out in open fight, but wait for
+the enemy ensconced behind trees, or in the long grass of the country,
+and shoot at him unawares.&nbsp; Consequently, if men come against them
+with firearms, when, as is usually the case, the long grass is all burned
+off, the tribe attacked are as helpless as a wooden ship, possessing
+only signal guns, would be before an iron-clad steamer.&nbsp; The time
+of year selected for this kind of warfare is nearly always that in which
+the grass is actually burnt off, or is so dry as readily to take fire.&nbsp;
+The dry grass in Africa looks more like ripe English wheat late in the
+autumn, than anything else we can compare it to.&nbsp; Let us imagine
+an English village standing in a field of this sort, bounded only by
+the horizon, and enemies setting fire to a line of a mile or two, by
+running along with bunches of burning straw in their hands, touching
+here and there the inflammable material,&mdash;the wind blowing towards
+the doomed village&mdash;the inhabitants with only one or two old muskets,
+but ten to one no powder,&mdash;the long line of flames, leaping thirty
+feet into the air with dense masses of black smoke&mdash;and pieces
+of charred grass falling down in showers.&nbsp; Would not the stoutest
+English villager, armed only with the bow and arrow against the enemy&rsquo;s
+musket, quail at the idea of breaking through that wall of fire?&nbsp;
+When at a distance, we once saw a scene like this, and had the charred
+grass, literally as thick as flakes of black snow, falling around us,
+there was no difficulty in understanding the secret of the slave-trader&rsquo;s
+power.</p>
+<p>On the 21st of September, we arrived at the village of the chief
+Muasi, or Muazi; it is surrounded by a stockade, and embowered in very
+tall euphorbia-trees; their height, thirty or forty feet, shows that
+it has been inhabited for at least one generation.&nbsp; A visitation
+of disease or death causes the headmen to change the site of their villages,
+and plant new hedges; but, though Muazi has suffered from the attacks
+of the Mazitu, he has evidently clung to his birthplace.&nbsp; The village
+is situated about two miles south-west of a high hill called Kasungu,
+which gives the name to a district extending to the Loangwa of the Maravi.&nbsp;
+Several other detached granite hills have been shot up on the plain,
+and many stockaded villages, all owing allegiance to Muazi, are scattered
+over it.</p>
+<p>On our arrival, the chief was sitting in the smooth shady place,
+called Boalo, where all public business is transacted, with about two
+hundred men and boys around him.&nbsp; We paid our guides with due ostentation.&nbsp;
+Masiko, the tallest of our party, measured off the fathom of cloth agreed
+upon, and made it appear as long as possible, by facing round to the
+crowd, and cutting a few inches beyond what his outstretched arms could
+reach, to show that there was no deception.&nbsp; This was by way of
+advertisement.&nbsp; The people are mightily gratified at having a tall
+fellow to measure the cloth for them.&nbsp; It pleases them even better
+than cutting it by a tape-line&mdash;though very few men of six feet
+high can measure off their own length with their outstretched arms.&nbsp;
+Here, where Arab traders have been, the cubit called <i>mokono</i>,
+or elbow, begins to take the place of the fathom in use further south.&nbsp;
+The measure is taken from the point of the bent elbow to the end of
+the middle finger.</p>
+<p>We found, on visiting Muazi on the following day, that he was as
+frank and straightforward as could reasonably be expected.&nbsp; He
+did not wish us to go to the N.N.W., because he carries on a considerable
+trade in ivory there.&nbsp; We were anxious to get off the slave route,
+to people not visited before by traders; but Muazi naturally feared,
+that if we went to what is said to be a well-watered country, abounding
+in elephants, we might relieve him of the ivory which he now obtains
+at a cheap rate, and sells to the slave-traders as they pass Kasungu
+to the east; but at last he consented, warning us that &ldquo;great
+difficulty would be experienced in obtaining food&mdash;a district had
+been depopulated by slave wars&mdash;and a night or two must be spent
+in it; but he would give us good guides, who would go three days with
+us, before turning, and then further progress must depend on ourselves.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+Some of our men having been ill ever since we mounted this highland
+plain, we remained two days with Muazi.</p>
+<p>A herd of fine cattle showed that no tsetse existed in the district.&nbsp;
+They had the Indian hump, and were very fat, and very tame.&nbsp; The
+boys rode on both cows and bulls without fear, and the animals were
+so fat and lazy, that the old ones only made a feeble attempt to kick
+their young tormentors.&nbsp; Muazi never milks the cows; he complained
+that, but for the Mazitu having formerly captured some, he should now
+have had very many.&nbsp; They wander over the country at large, and
+certainly thrive.</p>
+<p>After leaving Muazi&rsquo;s, we passed over a flat country sparsely
+covered with the scraggy upland trees, but brightened with many fine
+flowers.&nbsp; The grass was short, reaching no higher than the knee,
+and growing in tufts with bare spaces between, though the trees were
+draped with many various lichens, and showed a moist climate.&nbsp;
+A high and very sharp wind blew over the flats; its piercing keenness
+was not caused by low temperature, for the thermometer stood at 80 degrees.</p>
+<p>We were now on the sources of the Loangwa of the Maravi, which enters
+the Zambesi at Zumbo, and were struck by the great resemblance which
+the boggy and sedgy streams here presented to the sources of the Leeba,
+an affluent of the Zambesi formerly observed in Londa, and of the Kasai,
+which some believe to be the principal branch of the Congo or Zair&eacute;.</p>
+<p>We had taken pains to ascertain from the travelled Babisa and Arabs
+as much as possible about the country in front, which, from the lessening
+time we had at our disposal, we feared we could scarcely reach, and
+had heard a good deal of a small lake called Bemba.&nbsp; As we proceeded
+west, we passed over the sources not only of the Loangwa, but of another
+stream, called Moitawa or Moitala, which was represented to be the main
+feeder of Lake Bemba.&nbsp; This would be of little importance, but
+for the fact that the considerable river Luapula, or Loapula is said
+to flow out of Bemba to the westward, and then to spread out into another
+and much larger lake, named Moero, or Moelo.&nbsp; Flowing still further
+in the same direction, the Loapula forms Lake Mofu&eacute;, or Mofu,
+and after this it is said to pass the town of Cazemb&eacute;, bend to
+the north, and enter Lake Tanganyika.&nbsp; Whither the water went after
+it entered the last lake, no one would venture an assertion.&nbsp; But
+that the course indicated is the true watershed of that part of the
+country, we believe from the unvarying opinion of native travellers.&nbsp;
+There could be no doubt that our informants had been in the country
+beyond Cazemb&eacute;&rsquo;s, for they knew and described chiefs whom
+we afterwards met about thirty-five or forty miles west of his town.&nbsp;
+The Lualaba is said to flow into the Loapula&mdash;and when, for the
+sake of testing the accuracy of the travelled, it was asserted that
+all the water of the region round the town of Cazemb&eacute; flowed
+into the Luambadzi, or Luambezi (Zambesi), they remarked with a smile,
+&ldquo;He says, that the Loapula flows into the Zambesi&mdash;did you
+ever hear such nonsense?&rdquo; or words to that effect.&nbsp; We were
+forced to admit, that according to native accounts, our previous impression
+of the Zambesi&rsquo;s draining the country about Cazemb&eacute;&rsquo;s
+had been a mistake.&nbsp; Their geographical opinions are now only stated,
+without any further comment than that the itinerary given by the Arabs
+and others shows that the Loapula is twice crossed on the way to Cazemb&eacute;&rsquo;s;
+and we may add that we have never found any difficulty from the alleged
+incapacity of the negro to tell which way a river flows.</p>
+<p>The boiling-point of water showed a descent, from the edge of the
+plateau to our furthest point west, of 170 feet; but this can only be
+considered as an approximation, and no dependence could have been placed
+on it, had we not had the courses of the streams to confirm this rather
+rough mode of ascertaining altitudes.&nbsp; The slope, as shown by the
+watershed, was to the &ldquo;Loangwa of the Maravi,&rdquo; and towards
+the Moitala, or south-west, west, and north-west.&nbsp; After we leave
+the feeders of Lake Nyassa, the water drains towards the centre of the
+continent.&nbsp; The course of the Kasai, a river seen during Dr. Livingstone&rsquo;s
+journey to the West Coast, and its feeders was to the north-east, or
+somewhat in the same direction.&nbsp; Whether the water thus drained
+off finds its way out by the Congo, or by the Nile, has not yet been
+ascertained.&nbsp; Some parts of the continent have been said to resemble
+an inverted dinner-plate.&nbsp; This portion seems more of the shape,
+if shape it has, of a wide-awake hat, with the crown a little depressed.&nbsp;
+The altitude of the brim in some parts is considerable; in others, as
+at Tette and the bottom of Murchison&rsquo;s Cataracts, it is so small
+that it could be ascertained only by eliminating the daily variations
+of the barometer, by simultaneous observations on the Coast, and at
+points some two or three hundred miles inland.&nbsp; So long as African
+rivers remain in what we may call the brim, they present no obstructions;
+but no sooner do they emerge from the higher lands than their utility
+is impaired by cataracts.&nbsp; The low lying belt is very irregular.&nbsp;
+At times sloping up in the manner of the rim of an inverted dinner-plate&mdash;while
+in other cases, a high ridge rises near the sea, to be succeeded by
+a lower district inland before we reach the central plateau.&nbsp; The
+breadth of the low lands is sometimes as much as three hundred miles,
+and that breadth determines the limits of navigation from the seaward.</p>
+<p>We made three long marches beyond Muazi&rsquo;s in a north-westerly
+direction; the people were civil enough, but refused to sell us any
+food.&nbsp; We were travelling too fast, they said; in fact, they were
+startled, and before they recovered their surprise, we were obliged
+to depart.&nbsp; We suspected that Muazi had sent them orders to refuse
+us food, that we might thus be prevented from going into the depopulated
+district; but this may have been mere suspicion, the result of our own
+uncharitable feelings.</p>
+<p>We spent one night at Machambw&eacute;&rsquo;s village, and another
+at Chimbuzi&rsquo;s.&nbsp; It is seldom that we can find the headman
+on first entering a village.&nbsp; He gets out of the way till he has
+heard all about the strangers, or he is actually out in the fields looking
+after his farms.&nbsp; We once thought that when the headman came in
+from a visit of inspection, with his spear, bow and arrows, they had
+been all taken up for the occasion, and that he had all the while been
+hidden in some hut slily watching till he heard that the strangers might
+be trusted; but on listening to the details given by these men of the
+appearances of the crops at different parts, and the astonishing minuteness
+of the speakers&rsquo; topography, we were persuaded that in some cases
+we were wrong, and felt rather humiliated.&nbsp; Every knoll, hill,
+mountain, and every peak on a range has a name; and so has every watercourse,
+dell, and plain.&nbsp; In fact, every feature and portion of the country
+is so minutely distinguished by appropriate names, that it would take
+a lifetime to decipher their meaning.&nbsp; It is not the want, but
+the superabundance of names that misleads travellers, and the terms
+used are so multifarious that good scholars will at times scarcely know
+more than the subject of conversation.&nbsp; Though it is a little apart
+from the topic of the attention which the headmen pay to agriculture,
+yet it may be here mentioned, while speaking of the fulness of the language,
+that we have heard about a score of words to indicate different varieties
+of gait&mdash;one walks leaning forward, or backward, swaying from side
+to side, loungingly, or smartly, swaggeringly, swinging the arms, or
+only one arm, head down or up, or otherwise; each of these modes of
+walking was expressed by a particular verb; and more words were used
+to designate the different varieties of fools than we ever tried to
+count.</p>
+<p>Mr. Moffat has translated the whole Bible into the language of the
+Bechuana, and has diligently studied this tongue for the last forty-four-years;
+and, though knowing far more of the language than any of the natives
+who have been reared on the Mission-station of Kuruman, he does not
+pretend to have mastered it fully even yet.&nbsp; However copious it
+may be in terms of which we do not feel the necessity, it is poor in
+others, as in abstract terms, and words used to describe mental operations.</p>
+<p>Our third day&rsquo;s march ended in the afternoon of the 27th September,
+1863, at the village of Chinanga on the banks of a branch of the Loangwa.&nbsp;
+A large, rounded mass of granite, a thousand feet high, called <i>&Ntilde;omb&eacute;
+rum&eacute;</i>, stand on the plain a few miles off.&nbsp; It is quite
+remarkable, because it has so little vegetation on it.&nbsp; Several
+other granitic hills stand near it, ornamented with trees, like most
+heights of this country, and a heap of blue mountains appears away in
+the north.</p>
+<p>The effect of the piercing winds upon the men had never been got
+rid of.&nbsp; Several had been unable to carry a load ever since we
+ascended to the highlands; we had lost one, and another poor lad was
+so ill as to cause us great anxiety.&nbsp; By waiting in this village,
+which was so old that it was full of vermin, all became worse.&nbsp;
+Our European food was entirely expended, and native meal, though finely
+ground, has so many sharp angular particles in it, that it brought back
+dysentery, from which we had suffered so much in May.&nbsp; We could
+scarcely obtain food for the men.&nbsp; The headman of this village
+of Chinanga was off in a foray against some people further north to
+supply slaves to the traders expected along the slave route we had just
+left; and was said, after having expelled the inhabitants, to be living
+in their stockade, and devouring their corn.&nbsp; The conquered tribe
+had purchased what was called a peace by presenting the conqueror with
+three women.</p>
+<p>This state of matters afforded us but a poor prospect of finding
+more provisions in that direction than we could with great difficulty
+and at enormous prices obtain here.&nbsp; But neither want of food,
+dysentery, nor slave wars would have prevented our working our way round
+the Lake in some other direction, had we had time; but we had received
+orders from the Foreign Office to take the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; down
+to the sea in the previous April.&nbsp; The salaries of all the men
+in her were positively &ldquo;in any case to cease by the 31st of December.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>We were said to be only ten days&rsquo; distant from Lake Bemba.&nbsp;
+We might speculate on a late rise of the river.&nbsp; A month or six
+weeks would secure a geographical feat, but the rains were near.&nbsp;
+We had been warned by different people that the rains were close at
+hand, and that we should then be bogged and unable to travel.&nbsp;
+The flood in the river might be an early one, or so small in volume
+as to give but one chance of the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; descending to
+the ocean.&nbsp; The Makololo too were becoming dispirited by sickness
+and want of food, and were naturally anxious to be back to their fields
+in time for sowing.&nbsp; But in addition to all this and more, it was
+felt that it would not be dealing honestly with the Government, were
+we, for the sake of a little &eacute;clat, to risk the detention of
+the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; up the river during another year; so we decided
+to return; and though we had afterwards the mortification to find that
+we were detained two full months at the ship waiting for the flood which
+we expected immediately after our arrival there, the chagrin was lessened
+by a consciousness of having acted in a fair, honest, above-board manner
+throughout.</p>
+<p>On the night of the 29th of September a thief came to the sleeping-place
+of our men and stole a leg of a goat.&nbsp; On complaining to the deputy
+headman, he said that the thief had fled, but would be caught.&nbsp;
+He suggested a fine, and offered a fowl and her eggs; but wishing that
+the thief alone should be punished, it was advised that <i>he</i> should
+be found and fined.&nbsp; The Makololo thought it best to take the fowl
+as a means of making the punishment certain.&nbsp; After settling this
+matter on the last day of September, we commenced our return journey.&nbsp;
+We had just the same time to go back to the ship, that we had spent
+in coming to this point, and there is not much to interest one in marching
+over the same ground a second time.</p>
+<p>While on our journey north-west, a cheery old woman, who had once
+been beautiful, but whose white hair now contrasted strongly with her
+dark complexion, was working briskly in her garden as we passed.&nbsp;
+She seemed to enjoy a hale, hearty old age.&nbsp; She saluted us with
+what elsewhere would be called a good address; and, evidently conscious
+that she deserved the epithet, &ldquo;dark but comely,&rdquo; answered
+each of us with a frank &ldquo;Yes, my child.&rdquo;&nbsp; Another motherly-looking
+woman, sitting by a well, began the conversation by &ldquo;You are going
+to visit Muazi, and you have come from afar, have you not?&rdquo;&nbsp;
+But in general women never speak to strangers unless spoken to, so anything
+said by them attracts attention.&nbsp; Muazi once presented us with
+a basket of corn.&nbsp; On hinting that we had no wife to grind our
+corn, his buxom spouse struck in with roguish glee, and said, &ldquo;I
+will grind it for you; and leave Muazi, to accompany and cook for you
+in the land of the setting sun.&rdquo;&nbsp; As a rule the women are
+modest and retiring in their demeanour, and, without being oppressed
+with toil, show a great deal of industry.&nbsp; The crops need about
+eight months&rsquo; attention.&nbsp; Then when the harvest is home,
+much labour is required to convert it into food as porridge, or beer.&nbsp;
+The corn is pounded in a large wooden mortar, like the ancient Egyptian
+one, with a pestle six feet long and about four inches thick.&nbsp;
+The pounding is performed by two or even three women at one mortar.&nbsp;
+Each, before delivering a blow with her pestle, gives an upward jerk
+of the body, so as to put strength into the stroke, and they keep exact
+time, so that two pestles are never in the mortar at the same moment.&nbsp;
+The measured thud, thud, thud, and the women standing at their vigorous
+work, are associations inseparable from a prosperous African village.&nbsp;
+By the operation of pounding, with the aid of a little water, the hard
+outside scale or husk of the grain is removed, and the corn is made
+fit for the millstone.&nbsp; The meal irritates the stomach unless cleared
+from the husk; without considerable energy in the operator, the husk
+sticks fast to the corn.&nbsp; Solomon thought that still more vigour
+than is required to separate the hard husk or bran from wheat would
+fail to separate &ldquo;a fool from his folly.&rdquo;&nbsp; &ldquo;Though
+thou shouldst bray a fool in a mortar among wheat with a pestle, <i>yet</i>
+will not his foolishness depart from him.&rdquo;&nbsp; The rainbow,
+in some parts, is called the &ldquo;pestle of the Barimo,&rdquo; or
+gods.&nbsp; Boys and girls, by constant practice with the pestle, are
+able to plant stakes in the ground by a somewhat similar action, in
+erecting a hut, so deftly that they never miss the first hole made.</p>
+<p>Let any one try by repeatedly jobbing a pole with all his force to
+make a deep hole in the ground, and he will understand how difficult
+it is always to strike it into the same spot.</p>
+<p>As we were sleeping one night outside a hut, but near enough to hear
+what was going on within, an anxious mother began to grind her corn
+about two o&rsquo;clock in the morning.&nbsp; &ldquo;Ma,&rdquo; inquired
+a little girl, &ldquo;why grind in the dark?&rdquo;&nbsp; Mamma advised
+sleep, and administered material for a sweet dream to her darling, by
+saying, &ldquo;I grind meal to buy a cloth from the strangers, which
+will make you look a little lady.&rdquo;&nbsp; An observer of these
+primitive races is struck continually with such little trivial touches
+of genuine human nature.</p>
+<p>The mill consists of a block of granite, syenite, or even mica schist,
+fifteen or eighteen inches square and five or six thick, with a piece
+of quartz or other hard rock about the size of a half brick, one side
+of which has a convex surface, and fits into a concave hollow in the
+larger and stationary stone.&nbsp; The workwoman kneeling, grasps this
+upper millstone with both hands, and works it backwards and forwards
+in the hollow of the lower millstone, in the same way that a baker works
+his dough, when pressing it and pushing from him.&nbsp; The weight of
+the person is brought to bear on the movable stone, and while it is
+pressed and pushed forwards and backwards, one hand supplies every now
+and then a little grain to be thus at first bruised and then ground
+on the lower stone, which is placed on the slope so that the meal when
+ground falls on to a skin or mat spread for the purpose.&nbsp; This
+is perhaps the most primitive form of mill, and anterior to that in
+oriental countries, where two women grind at one mill, and may have
+been that used by Sarah of old when she entertained the Angels.</p>
+<p>On 2nd October we applied to Muazi for guides to take us straight
+down to Chinsamba&rsquo;s at Mosapo, and thus cut off an angle, which
+we should otherwise make, by going back to Kota-kota Bay.&nbsp; He replied
+that his people knew the short way to Chinsamba&rsquo;s that we desired
+to go, but that they all were afraid to venture there, on account of
+the Zulus, or Mazitu.&nbsp; We therefore started back on our old route,
+and, after three hours&rsquo; march, found some Babisa in a village
+who promised to lead us to Chinsamba.</p>
+<p>We meet with these keen traders everywhere.&nbsp; They are easily
+known by a line of horizontal cicatrices, each half an inch long, down
+the middle of the forehead and chin.&nbsp; They often wear the hair
+collected in a mass on the upper and back part of the head, while it
+is all shaven off the forehead and temples.&nbsp; The Babisa and Waiau
+or Ajawa heads have more of the round bullet-shape than those of the
+Manganja, indicating a marked difference in character; the former people
+being great traders and travellers, the latter being attached to home
+and agriculture.&nbsp; The Manganja usually intrust their ivory to the
+Babisa to be sold at the Coast, and complain that the returns made never
+come up to the high prices which they hear so much about before it is
+sent.&nbsp; In fact, by the time the Babisa return, the expenses of
+the journey, in which they often spend a month or two at a place where
+food abounds, usually eat up all the profits.</p>
+<p>Our new companions were trading in tobacco, and had collected quantities
+of the round balls, about the size of nine pounder shot, into which
+it is formed.&nbsp; One of them owned a woman, whose child had been
+sold that morning for tobacco.&nbsp; The mother followed him, weeping
+silently, for hours along the way we went; she seemed to be well known,
+for at several hamlets, the women spoke to her with evident sympathy;
+we could do nothing to alleviate her sorrow&mdash;the child would be
+kept until some slave-trader passed, and then sold for calico.&nbsp;
+The different cases of slave-trading observed by us are mentioned, in
+order to give a fair idea of its details.</p>
+<p>We spent the first night, after leaving the slave route, at the village
+of Nkoma, among a section of Manganja, called Machewa, or Macheba, whose
+district extends to the Bua.</p>
+<p>The next village at which we slept was also that of a Manganja smith.&nbsp;
+It was a beautiful spot, shaded with tall euphorbia-trees.&nbsp; The
+people at first fled, but after a short time returned, and ordered us
+off to a stockade of Babisa, about a mile distant.&nbsp; We preferred
+to remain in the smooth shady spot outside the hamlet, to being pent
+up in a treeless stockade.&nbsp; Twenty or thirty men came dropping
+in, all fully armed with bows and arrows, some of them were at least
+six feet four in height, yet these giants were not ashamed to say, &ldquo;We
+thought that you were Mazitu, and, being afraid, ran away.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+Their orders to us were evidently inspired by terror, and so must the
+refusal of the headman to receive a cloth, or lend us a hut have been;
+but as we never had the opportunity of realizing what feelings a successful
+invasion would produce, we did not know whether to blame them or not.&nbsp;
+The headman, a tall old smith, with an enormous, well-made knife of
+his own workmanship, came quietly round, and, inspecting the shelter,
+which, from there being abundance of long grass and bushes near, our
+men put up for us in half an hour, gradually changed his tactics, and,
+in the evening, presented us with a huge pot of porridge and a deliciously
+well-cooked fowl, and made an apology for having been so rude to strangers,
+and a lamentation that he had been so foolish as to refuse the fine
+cloth we had offered.&nbsp; Another cloth was of course presented, and
+we had the pleasure of parting good friends next day.</p>
+<p>Our guide, who belonged to the stockade near to which we had slept,
+declined to risk himself further than his home.&nbsp; While waiting
+to hire another, Masiko attempted to purchase a goat, and had nearly
+concluded the bargain, when the wife of the would-be seller came forward,
+and said to her husband, &ldquo;You appear as if you were unmarried;
+selling a goat without consulting your wife; what an insult to a woman!&nbsp;
+What sort of man are you?&rdquo;&nbsp; Masiko urged the man, saying,
+&ldquo;Let us conclude the bargain, and never mind her;&rdquo; but he
+being better instructed, replied, &ldquo;No, I have raised a host against
+myself already,&rdquo; and refused.</p>
+<p>We now pushed on to the east, so as to get down to the shores of
+the Lake, and into the parts where we were known.&nbsp; The country
+was beautiful, well wooded, and undulating, but the villages were all
+deserted; and the flight of the people seemed to have been quite recent,
+for the grain was standing in the corn-safes untouched.&nbsp; The tobacco,
+though ripe, remained uncut in the gardens, and the whole country was
+painfully quiet: the oppressive stillness quite unbroken by the singing
+of birds, or the shrill calls of women watching their corn.</p>
+<p>On passing a beautiful village, called Bangw&eacute;, surrounded
+by shady trees, and placed in a valley among mountains, we were admiring
+the beauty of the situation, when some of the much dreaded Mazitu, with
+their shields, ran out of the hamlet, from which we were a mile distant.&nbsp;
+They began to scream to their companions to give us chase.&nbsp; Without
+quickening our pace we walked on, and soon were in a wood, through which
+the footpath we were following led.&nbsp; The first intimation we had
+of the approaching Mazitu was given by the Johanna man, Zachariah, who
+always lagged behind, running up, screaming as if for his life.&nbsp;
+The bundles were all put in one place to be defended; and Masiko and
+Dr. Livingstone walked a few paces back to meet the coming foe.&nbsp;
+Masiko knelt down anxious to fire, but was ordered not to do so.&nbsp;
+For a second or two dusky forms appeared among the trees, and the Mazitu
+were asked, in their own tongue, &ldquo;What do you want?&rdquo; Masiko
+adding, &ldquo;What do you say?&rdquo;&nbsp; No answer was given, but
+the dark shade in the forest vanished.&nbsp; They had evidently taken
+us for natives, and the sight of a white man was sufficient to put them
+to flight.&nbsp; Had we been nearer the Coast, where the people are
+accustomed to the slave-trade, we should have found this affair a more
+difficult one to deal with; but, as a rule, the people of the interior
+are much more mild in character than those on the confines of civilization.</p>
+<p>The above very small adventure was all the danger we were aware of
+in this journey; but a report was spread from the Portuguese villages
+on the Zambesi, similar to several rumours that had been raised before,
+that Dr. Livingstone had been murdered by the Makololo; and very unfortunately
+the report reached England before it could be contradicted.</p>
+<p>One benefit arose from the Mazitu adventure.&nbsp; Zachariah, and
+others who had too often to be reproved for lagging behind, now took
+their places in the front rank; and we had no difficulty in making very
+long marches for several days, for all believed that the Mazitu would
+follow our footsteps, and attack us while we slept.</p>
+<p>A party of Babisa tobacco-traders came from the N.W. to Molamba,
+while we were there; and one of them asserted several times that the
+Loapula, after emerging from Moelo, received the Lulua, and then flowed
+into Lake Mofu, and thence into Tanganyika; and from the last-named
+Lake into the sea.&nbsp; This is the native idea of the geography of
+the interior; and, to test the general knowledge of our informant, we
+asked him about our acquaintances in Londa; as Moen&eacute;, Katema,
+Shind&eacute; or Shint&eacute;, who live south-west of the rivers mentioned,
+and found that our friends there were perfectly well-known to him and
+to others of these travelled natives.&nbsp; In the evening two of the
+Babisa came in, and reported that the Mazitu had followed us to the
+village called Chigaragara, at which we slept at the bottom of the descent.&nbsp;
+The whole party of traders set off at once, though the sun had set.&nbsp;
+We ourselves had given rise to the report, for the women of Chigaragara,
+supposing us in the distance to be Mazitu, fled, with all their household
+utensils on their heads, and had no opportunity afterwards of finding
+out their mistake.&nbsp; We spent the night where we were, and next
+morning, declining Nkomo&rsquo;s entreaty to go and kill elephants,
+took our course along the shores of the Lake southwards.</p>
+<p>We have only been at the Lake at one season of the year: then the
+wind blows strongly from the east, and indeed this is its prevailing
+direction hence to the Orange River; a north or a south wind is rare,
+and seldom lasts more than three days.&nbsp; As the breeze now blew
+over a large body of water, towards us, it was delightful; but when
+facing it on the table-land it was so strong as materially to impede
+our progress, and added considerably to the labour of travelling.&nbsp;
+Here it brought large quantities of the plant (<i>Vallisneri&aelig;</i>),
+from which the natives extract salt by burning, and which, if chewed,
+at once shows its saline properties by the taste.&nbsp; Clouds of the
+kungo, or edible midges, floated on the Lake, and many rested on the
+bushes on land.</p>
+<p>The reeds along the shores of the Lake were still crowded with fugitives,
+and a great loss of life must since have taken place; for, after the
+corn they had brought with them was expended, famine would ensue.&nbsp;
+Even now we passed many women and children digging up the roots, about
+the size of peas, of an aromatic grass; and their wasted forms showed
+that this poor hard fare was to allay, if possible, the pangs of hunger.&nbsp;
+The babies at the breast crowed to us as we passed, their mothers kneeling
+and grubbing for the roots; the poor little things still drawing nourishment
+from the natural fountain were unconscious of that sinking of heart
+which their parents must have felt in knowing that the supply for the
+little ones must soon fail.&nbsp; No one would sell a bit of food to
+us: fishermen, even, would not part with the produce of their nets,
+except in exchange for some other kind of food.&nbsp; Numbers of newly-made
+graves showed that many had already perished, and hundreds were so emaciated
+that they had the appearance of human skeletons swathed in brown and
+wrinkled leather.&nbsp; In passing mile after mile, marked with these
+sad proofs that &ldquo;man&rsquo;s inhumanity to man makes countless
+thousands mourn,&rdquo; one experiences an overpowering sense of helplessness
+to alleviate human woe, and breathes a silent prayer to the Almighty
+to hasten the good time coming when &ldquo;man and man the world o&rsquo;er,
+shall brothers be for all that.&rdquo;&nbsp; One small redeeming consideration
+in all this misery could not but be felt; these ills were inflicted
+by heathen Mazitu, and not by, or for, those who say to Him who is higher
+than the highest, &ldquo;We believe that thou shalt come to be our Judge.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>We crossed the Mokol&eacute;, rested at Chitanda, and then left the
+Lake, and struck away N.W. to Chinsamba&rsquo;s.&nbsp; Our companions,
+who were so much oppressed by the rarefied air of the plateau, still
+showed signs of exhaustion, though now only 1300 feet above the sea,
+and did not recover flesh and spirits till we again entered the Lower
+Shir&eacute; Valley, which is of so small an altitude, that, without
+simultaneous observations with the barometer there and on the sea-coast,
+the difference would not be appreciable.</p>
+<p>On a large plain on which we spent one night, we had the company
+of eighty tobacco traders on their way from Kasungu to Chinsamba&rsquo;s.&nbsp;
+The Mazitu had attacked and killed two of them, near the spot where
+the Zulus fled from us without answering our questions.&nbsp; The traders
+were now so frightened that, instead of making a straight course with
+us, they set off by night to follow the shores of the Lake to Tsenga,
+and then turn west.&nbsp; It is the sight of shields, or guns that inspires
+terror.&nbsp; The bowmen feel perfectly helpless when the enemy comes
+with even the small protection the skin shield affords, or attacks them
+in the open field with guns.&nbsp; They may shoot a few arrows, but
+they are such poor shots that ten to one if they hit.&nbsp; The only
+thing that makes the arrow formidable is the poison; for if the poisoned
+barb goes in nothing can save the wounded.&nbsp; A bow is in use in
+the lower end of Lake Nyassa, but is more common in the Maravi country,
+from six to eight inches broad, which is intended to be used as a shield
+as well as a bow; but we never saw one with the mark on it of an enemy&rsquo;s
+arrow.&nbsp; It certainly is no match for the Zulu shield, which is
+between four and five feet long, of an oval shape, and about two feet
+broad.&nbsp; So great is the terror this shield inspires that we sometimes
+doubted whether the Mazitu here were Zulus at all, and suspected that
+the people of the country took advantage of that fear, and, assuming
+shields, pretended to belong to that nation.</p>
+<p>On the 11th October we arrived at the stockade of Chinsamba in Mosapo,
+and had reason to be very well satisfied with his kindness.&nbsp; A
+paraffin candle was in his eyes the height of luxury, and the ability
+to make a light instantaneously by a lucifer match, a marvel that struck
+him with wonder.&nbsp; He brought all his relatives in different groups
+to see the strange sights,&mdash;instantaneous fire-making, and a light,
+without the annoyance of having fire and smoke in the middle of the
+floor.&nbsp; When they wish to look for anything in the dark, a wisp
+of dried grass is lighted.</p>
+<p>Chinsamba gave us a great deal of his company during our visits.&nbsp;
+As we have often remarked in other cases, a chief has a great deal to
+attend to in guiding the affairs of his people.&nbsp; He is consulted
+on all occasions, and gives his advice in a stream of words, which show
+a very intimate acquaintance with the topography of his district; he
+knows every rood cultivated, every weir put in the river, every hunting-net,
+loom, gorge, and every child of his tribe.&nbsp; Any addition made to
+the number of these latter is notified to him; and he sends thanks and
+compliments to the parents.</p>
+<p>The presents which, following the custom of the country, we gave
+to every headman, where we either spent a night or a longer period,
+varied from four to eight yards of calico.&nbsp; We had some Manchester
+cloths made in imitation of the native manufactured robes of the West
+Coast, each worth five or six shillings.&nbsp; To the more important
+of the chiefs, for calico we substituted one of these strong gaudy dresses,
+iron spoons, a knife, needles, a tin dish, or pannikin, and found these
+presents to be valued more than three times their value in cloth would
+have been.&nbsp; Eight or ten shillings&rsquo; worth gave abundant satisfaction
+to the greediest; but this is to be understood as the prime cost of
+the articles, and a trader would sometimes have estimated similar generosity
+as equal to from &pound;30 to &pound;50.&nbsp; In some cases the presents
+we gave exceeded the value of what was received in return; in others
+the excess of generosity was on the native side.</p>
+<p>We never asked for leave to pass through the country; we simply told
+where we were going, and asked for guides; if they were refused, or
+if they demanded payment beforehand, we requested to be put into the
+beginning of the path, and said that we were sorry we could not agree
+about the guides, and usually they and we started together.&nbsp; Greater
+care would be required on entering the Mazitu or Zulu country, for there
+the Government extends over very large districts, while among the Manganja
+each little district is independent of every other.&nbsp; The people
+here have not adopted the exacting system of the Banyai, or of the people
+whose country was traversed by Speke and Grant.</p>
+<p>In our way back from Chinsamba&rsquo;s to Chembi&rsquo;s and from
+his village to Nkwinda&rsquo;s, and thence to Katosa&rsquo;s, we only
+saw the people working in their gardens, near to the stockades.&nbsp;
+These strongholds were strengthened with branches of acacias, covered
+with strong hooked thorns; and were all crowded with people.&nbsp; The
+air was now clearer than when we went north, and we could see the hills
+of Kirk&rsquo;s Range five or six miles to the west of our path.&nbsp;
+The sun struck very hot, and the men felt it most in their feet.&nbsp;
+Every one who could get a bit of goatskin made it into a pair of sandals.</p>
+<p>While sitting at Nkwinda&rsquo;s, a man behind the court hedge-wall
+said, with great apparent glee, that an Arab slaving party on the other
+side of the confluence of the Shir&eacute; and Lake were &ldquo;giving
+readily two fathoms of calico for a boy, and two and a half for a girl;
+never saw trade so brisk, no haggling at all.&rdquo;&nbsp; This party
+was purchasing for the supply of the ocean slave-trade.&nbsp; One of
+the evils of this traffic is that it profits by every calamity that
+happens in a country.&nbsp; The slave-trader naturally reaps advantage
+from every disorder, and though in the present case some lives may have
+been saved that otherwise would have perished, as a rule he intensifies
+hatreds, and aggravates wars between the tribes, because the more they
+fight and vanquish each other the richer his harvest becomes.&nbsp;
+Where slaving and cattle are unknown the people live in peace.&nbsp;
+As we sat leaning against that hedge, and listened to the harangue of
+the slave-trader&rsquo;s agent, it glanced across our mind that this
+was a terrible world; the best in it unable, from conscious imperfections,
+to say to the worst &ldquo;Stand by! for I am holier than thou.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+The slave-trader, imbued no doubt with certain kindly feelings, yet
+pursuing a calling which makes him a fair specimen of a human fiend,
+stands grouped with those by whom the slave-traders are employed, and
+with all the workers of sin and misery in more highly-favoured lands,
+an awful picture to the All-seing Eye.</p>
+<p>We arrived at Katosa&rsquo;s village on the 15th October, and found
+about thirty young men and boys in slave-sticks.&nbsp; They had been
+bought by other agents of the Arab slavers, still on the east side of
+the Shir&eacute;.&nbsp; They were resting in the village, and their
+owners soon removed them.&nbsp; The weight of the goree seemed very
+annoying when they tried to sleep.&nbsp; This taming instrument is kept
+on, until the party has crossed several rivers and all hope of escape
+has vanished from the captive&rsquo;s mind.</p>
+<p>On explaining to Katosa the injury he was doing in selling his people
+as slaves, he assured us that those whom we had seen belonged to the
+Arabs, and added that he had far too few people already.&nbsp; He said
+he had been living in peace at the lakelet Pamalomb&eacute;; that the
+Ajawa, or Machinga, under Kai&ntilde;ka and Karamba, and a body of Babisa,
+under Maonga, had induced him to ferry them over the Shir&eacute;; that
+they had lived for a considerable time at his expense, and at last stole
+his sheep, which induced him to make his escape to the place where he
+now dwelt, and in this flight he had lost many of his people.&nbsp;
+His account of the usual conduct of the Ajawa quite agrees with what
+these people have narrated themselves, and gives but a low idea of their
+moral tone.&nbsp; They have repeatedly broken all the laws of hospitality
+by living for months on the bounty of the Manganja, and then, by a sudden
+uprising, overcoming their hosts, and killing or chasing them out of
+their inheritances.&nbsp; The secret of their success is the possession
+of firearms.&nbsp; There were several of these Ajawa here again, and
+on our arrival they proposed to Katosa that they should leave; but he
+replied that they need not be afraid of us.&nbsp; They had red beads
+strung so thickly on their hair that at a little distance they appeared
+to have on red caps.&nbsp; It is curious that the taste for red hair
+should be so general among the Africans here and further north; in the
+south black mica, called <i>Sebilo</i>, and even soot are used to deepen
+the colour of the hair; here many smear the head with red-ochre, others
+plait the inner bark of a tree stained red into it; and a red powder
+called <i>Mukuru</i> is employed, which some say is obtained from the
+ground, and others from the roots of a tree.</p>
+<p>It having been doubted whether sugar-cane is indigenous to this country
+or not, we employed Katosa to procure the two varieties commonly cultivated,
+with the intention of conveying them to Johanna.&nbsp; One is yellow,
+and the other, like what we observed in the Barots&eacute; Valley, is
+variegated with dark red and yellow patches, or all red.&nbsp; We have
+seen it &ldquo;arrow,&rdquo; or blossom.&nbsp; Bamboos also run to seed,
+and the people are said to use the seed as food.&nbsp; The sugar-cane
+has native names, which would lead us to believe it to be indigenous.&nbsp;
+Here it is called <i>Zimbi</i>, further south <i>Mesari</i>, and in
+the centre of the country <i>Meshuati</i>.&nbsp; Anything introduced
+in recent times, as maize, superior cotton, or cassava, has a name implying
+its foreign origin.</p>
+<p>Katosa&rsquo;s village was embowered among gigantic trees of fine
+timber: several caffiaceous bushes, with berries closely resembling
+those of the common coffee, grew near, but no use had ever been made
+of them.&nbsp; There are several cinchonaceous trees also in the country;
+and some of the wild fruits are so good as to cause a feeling of regret
+that they have not been improved by cultivation, or whatever else brought
+ours to their present perfection.&nbsp; Katosa lamented that this locality
+was so inferior to his former place at Pamalomb&eacute;; there he had
+maize at the different stages of growth throughout the year.&nbsp; To
+us, however, he seemed, by digging holes, and taking advantage of the
+moisture beneath, to have succeeded pretty well in raising crops at
+this the driest time.&nbsp; The Makololo remarked that &ldquo;here the
+maize had no season,&rdquo;&mdash;meaning that the whole year was proper
+for its growth and ripening.&nbsp; By irrigation a succession of crops
+of grain might be raised anywhere within the south intertropical region
+of Africa.</p>
+<p>When we were with Motunda, on the 20th October, he told us frankly
+that all the native provisions were hidden in Kirk&rsquo;s Range, and
+his village being the last place where a supply of grain could be purchased
+before we reached the ship, we waited till he had sent to his hidden
+stores.&nbsp; The upland country, beyond the mountains now on our right,
+is called Deza, and is inhabited by Maravi, who are only another tribe
+of Manganja.&nbsp; The paramount chief is called Kabamb&eacute;, and
+he, having never been visited by war, lives in peace and plenty.&nbsp;
+Goats and sheep thrive; and Nyango, the chieftainess further to the
+south, has herds of horned cattle.&nbsp; The country being elevated
+is said to be cold, and there are large grassy plains on it which are
+destitute of trees.&nbsp; The Maravi are reported to be brave, and good
+marksmen with the bow; but, throughout all the country we have traversed,
+guns are enabling the trading tribes to overcome the agricultural and
+manufacturing classes.</p>
+<p>On the ascent at the end of the valley just opposite Mount Mvai,
+we looked back for a moment to impress the beauties of the grand vale
+on our memory.&nbsp; The heat of the sun was now excessive, and Masiko,
+thinking that it was overpowering, proposed to send forward to the ship
+and get a hammock, in which to carry any one who might knock up.&nbsp;
+He was truly kind and considerate.&nbsp; Dr. Livingstone having fallen
+asleep after a fatiguing march, a hole in the roof of the hut he was
+in allowed the sun to beat on his head, and caused a splitting headache
+and deafness: while he was nearly insensible, he felt Masiko repeatedly
+lift him back to the bed off which he had rolled, and cover him up.</p>
+<p>On the 24th we were again in Banda, at the village of Chasundu, and
+could now see clearly the hot valley in which the Shir&eacute; flows,
+and the mountains of the Manganja beyond to our south-east.&nbsp; Instead
+of following the road by which we had come, we resolved to go south
+along the Lesungw&eacute;, which rises at Zunj&eacute;, a peak on the
+same ridge as Mvai, and a part of Kirk&rsquo;s Range, which bounds the
+country of the Maravi on our west.&nbsp; This is about the limit of
+the beat of the Portuguese native traders, and it is but recently that,
+following our footsteps, they have come so far.&nbsp; It is not likely
+that their enterprise will lead them further north, for Chasundu informed
+us that the Babisa under-sell the agents from Tette.&nbsp; He had tried
+to deal with the latter when they first came; but they offered only
+ten fathoms of calico for a tusk, for which the Babisa gave him twenty
+fathoms and a little powder.&nbsp; Ivory was brought to us for sale
+again and again, and, as far as we could judge, the price expected would
+be about one yard of calico per pound, or possibly more, for there is
+no scale of prices known.&nbsp; The rule seems to be that buyer and
+seller shall spend a good deal of time in trying to cheat each other
+before coming to any conclusion over a bargain.</p>
+<p>We found the Lesungw&eacute; a fine stream near its source, and about
+forty feet wide and knee-deep, when joined by the Lekudzi, which comes
+down from the Maravi country.</p>
+<p>Guinea-fowl abounded, but no grain could be purchased, for the people
+had cultivated only the holmes along the banks with maize and pumpkins.&nbsp;
+Time enough had not elapsed since the slave-trader&rsquo;s invasion,
+and destruction of their stores, for them to raise crops of grain on
+the adjacent lands.&nbsp; To deal with them for a few heads of maize
+was the hungry bargaining with the famished, so we hastened on southwards
+as fast as the excessive heat would allow us.&nbsp; It was impossible
+to march in the middle of the day, the heat was so intolerable; and
+we could not go on at night, because, if we had chanced to meet any
+of the inhabitants, we should have been taken for marauders.</p>
+<p>We had now thunder every afternoon; but while occasional showers
+seemed to fall at different parts, none fell on us.&nbsp; The air was
+deliciously clear, and revealed all the landscape covered everywhere
+with forest, and bounded by beautiful mountains.&nbsp; On the 31st October
+we reached the Mukuru-Mads&eacute;, after having travelled 660 geographical
+miles, or 760 English miles in a straight line.&nbsp; This was accomplished
+in fifty-five travelling days, twelve miles per diem on an average.&nbsp;
+If the numerous bendings and windings, and ups and downs of the paths
+could have been measured too, the distance would have been found at
+least fifteen miles a day.</p>
+<p>The night we slept at the Mukuru-Mads&eacute; it thundered heavily,
+but, as this had been the case every afternoon, and no rain had followed,
+we erected no shelter, but during this night a pouring rain came on.&nbsp;
+When very tired a man feels determined to sleep in spite of everything,
+and the sound of dropping water is said to be conducive to slumber,
+but that does not refer to an African storm.&nbsp; If, when half asleep
+in spite of a heavy shower on the back of the head, he unconsciously
+turns on his side, the drops from the branches make such capital shots
+into his ear, that the brain rings again.</p>
+<p>We were off next morning, the 1st of November, as soon as the day
+dawned.&nbsp; In walking about seven miles to the ship, our clothes
+were thoroughly dried by the hot sun, and an attack of fever followed.&nbsp;
+We relate this little incident to point out the almost certain consequence
+of getting wet in this climate, and allowing the clothes to dry on the
+person.&nbsp; Even if we walk in the mornings when the dew is on the
+grass, and only get our feet and legs wet, a very uneasy feeling and
+partial fever with pains in the limbs ensue, and continue till the march
+onwards bathes them in perspiration.&nbsp; Had Bishop Mackenzie been
+aware of this, which, before experience alone had taught us, entailed
+many a severe lesson, we know no earthly reason why his valuable life
+might not have been spared.&nbsp; The difference between getting the
+clothes soaked in England and in Africa is this: in the cold climate
+the patient is compelled, or, at any rate, warned, by discomfort to
+resort at once to a change of raiment; while in Africa it is cooling
+and rather pleasant to allow the clothes to dry on the person.&nbsp;
+A Missionary in proportion as he possesses an athletic frame, hardened
+by manly exercises, in addition to his other qualifications, will excel
+him who is not favoured with such bodily endowments; but in a hot climate
+efficiency mainly depends on husbanding the resources.&nbsp; He must
+never forget that, in the tropics, he is an exotic plant.</p>
+<h3>CHAPTER XV.</h3>
+<p>Confidence of natives&mdash;Bishop Tozer&mdash;Withdrawal of the
+Mission party&mdash;The English leave&mdash;Hazardous voyage to Mosambique&mdash;Dr.
+Livingstone&rsquo;s voyage to Bombay&mdash;Return to England.</p>
+<p>We were delighted and thankful to find all those left at the ship
+in good health, and that from the employments in which they had been
+occupied they had suffered less from fever than usual during our absence.&nbsp;
+My companion, Thomas Ward, the steward, after having performed his part
+in the march right bravely, rejoined his comrades stronger than he had
+ever been before.</p>
+<p>An Ajawa chief, named Kapeni, had so much confidence in the English
+name that he, with most of his people, visited the ship; and asserted
+that nothing would give his countrymen greater pleasure than to receive
+the associates of Bishop Mackenzie as their teachers.&nbsp; This declaration,
+coupled with the subsequent conduct of the Ajawa, was very gratifying,
+inasmuch as it was clear that no umbrage had been taken at the check
+which the Bishop had given to their slaving; their consciences had told
+them that the course he had pursued was right.</p>
+<p>When we returned, the contrast between the vegetation about Muazi&rsquo;s
+and that near the ship was very striking.&nbsp; We had come so quickly
+down, that while on the plateau in latitude 12 degrees S., the young
+leaves had in many cases passed from the pink or other colour they have
+on first coming out to the light fresh green which succeeds it, here,
+on the borders of 16 degrees S., or from 150 to 180 miles distant, the
+trees were still bare, the grey colour of the bark predominating over
+every other hue.&nbsp; The trees in the tropics here have a very well-marked
+annual rest.&nbsp; On the Rovuma even, which is only about ten degrees
+from the equator, in September the slopes up from the river some sixty
+miles inland were of a light ashy-grey colour; and on ascending them,
+we found that the majority of the trees were without leaves; those of
+the bamboo even lay crisp and crumpled on the ground.&nbsp; As the sun
+is usually hot by day, even in the winter, this withering process may
+be owing to the cool nights; Africa differing so much from Central India
+in the fact that, in Africa, however hot the day may be, the air generally
+cools down sufficiently by the early morning watches to render a covering
+or even a blanket agreeable.</p>
+<p>The first fortnight after our return to the ship was employed in
+the delightful process of resting, to appreciate which a man must have
+gone through great exertions.&nbsp; In our case the muscles of the limbs
+were as hard as boards, and not an ounce of fat existed on any part
+of the body.&nbsp; We now had frequent showers; but, these being only
+the earlier rains, the result on the rise of the river was but a few
+inches.&nbsp; The effect of these rains on the surrounding scenery was
+beautiful in the extreme.&nbsp; All trace of the dry season was soon
+obliterated, and hills and mountains from base to summit were covered
+with a mantle of living green.&nbsp; The sun passed us on his way south
+without causing a flood, so all our hopes of a release were centred
+on his return towards the Equator, when, as a rule, the waters of inundation
+are made to flow.&nbsp; Up to this time the rains descended simply to
+water the earth, fill the pools, and make ready for the grand overflow
+for which we had still to wait six weeks.&nbsp; It is of no use to conceal
+that we waited with much chagrin; for had we not been forced to return
+from the highlands west of Nyassa we might have visited Lake Bemba;
+but unavailing regrets are poor employment for the mind; so we banished
+them to the best of our power.</p>
+<p>About the middle of December, 1863, we were informed that Bishop
+Mackenzie&rsquo;s successor, after spending a few months on the top
+of a mountain about as high as Ben Nevis in Scotland, at the mouth of
+the Shir&eacute;, where there were few or no people to be taught, had
+determined to leave the country.&nbsp; This unfortunate decision was
+communicated to us at the same time that six of the boys reared by Bishop
+Mackenzie were sent back into heathenism.&nbsp; The boys were taken
+to a place about seven miles from the ship, but immediately found their
+way up to us.&nbsp; We told them that if they wished to remain in the
+country they had better so arrange at once, for we were soon to leave.&nbsp;
+The sequel will show their choice.</p>
+<p>As soon as the death of Bishop Mackenzie was known at the Cape, Dr.
+Gray, the excellent Bishop there, proceeded at once to England, with
+a view of securing an early appointment of another head to the Mission,
+which in its origin owed so much to his zeal for the spread of the gospel
+among the heathen, and whose interests he had continually at heart.&nbsp;
+About the middle of 1862 we heard that Dr. Gray&rsquo;s efforts had
+been successful, and that another clergyman would soon take the place
+of our departed friend.&nbsp; This pleasing intelligence was exceedingly
+cheering to the Missionaries, and gratifying also to the members of
+the Expedition.&nbsp; About the beginning of 1863 the new Bishop arrived
+at the mouth of the river in a man-of-war, and after some delay proceeded
+inland.&nbsp; The Bishop of the Cape had taken a voyage home at considerable
+inconvenience to himself, for the sole object of promoting this Mission
+to the heathen; and it was somehow expected that the man he would secure
+would be an image of himself; and we must say, that whatever others,
+from the representations that have gone abroad, may think of his character,
+we invariably found Dr. Gray to be a true, warm-hearted promoter of
+the welfare of his fellow-men; a man whose courage and zeal have provoked
+very many to good works.</p>
+<p>It was hoped that the presence of a new head to the Mission would
+infuse new energy and life into the small band of Missionaries, whose
+ranks had been thinned by death; and who, though discouraged by the
+disasters which the slave war and famine had induced, and also dispirited
+by the depressing influences of a low and unhealthy position in the
+swampy Shir&eacute; Valley, were yet bravely holding out till the much-needed
+moral and material aid should arrive.</p>
+<p>We believe that we are uttering the sentiments of many devout members
+of different sections of Christians, when we say, it was a pity that
+the Mission of the Universities was abandoned.&nbsp; The ground had
+been consecrated in the truest sense by the lives of those brave men
+who first occupied it.&nbsp; In bare justice to Bishop Mackenzie, who
+was the first to fall, it must be said, that the repudiation of all
+he had done, and the sudden abandonment of all that had cost so much
+life and money to secure, was a serious line of conduct for one so unversed
+in Missionary operations as his successor, to inaugurate.&nbsp; It would
+have been no more than fair that Bishop Tozer, before winding up the
+affairs of the Mission, should actually have examined the highlands
+of the Upper Shir&eacute;; he would thus have gratified the associates
+of his predecessor, who believed that the highlands had never had a
+fair trial, and he would have gained from personal observation a more
+accurate knowledge of the country and the people than he could possibly
+have become possessed of by information gathered chiefly on the coast.&nbsp;
+With this examination, rather than with a stay of a few months on the
+humid, dripping top of misty Morambala, we should have felt much more
+satisfied.</p>
+<p>In January, 1864, the natives all confidently asserted that at next
+full moon the river would have its great and permanent flood.&nbsp;
+It had several times risen as much as a foot, but fell again as suddenly.&nbsp;
+It was curious that their observation coincided exactly with ours, that
+the flood of inundation happens when the sun comes overhead on his way
+back to the Equator.&nbsp; We mention this more minutely because, from
+the observation of several years, we believe that in this way the inundation
+of the Nile is to be explained.&nbsp; On the 19th the Shir&eacute; suddenly
+rose several feet, and we started at once; and stopping only for a short
+time at Chibisa&rsquo;s to bid adieu to the Ajawa and Makololo, who
+had been extremely useful to us of late in supplying maize and fresh
+provisions, we hastened on our way to the ocean.&nbsp; In order to keep
+a steerage way on the &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo; we had to go quicker than
+the stream, and unfortunately carried away her rudder in passing suddenly
+round a bank.&nbsp; The delay required for the repairs prevented our
+reaching Morambala till the 2nd of February.</p>
+<p>The flood-water ran into a marsh some miles above the mountain, and
+became as black as ink; and when it returned again to the river emitted
+so strong an effluvium of sulphuretted hydrogen, that one could not
+forget for an instant that the air was most offensive.&nbsp; The natives
+said this stench did not produce disease.&nbsp; We spent one night in
+it, and suffered no ill effects, though we fully expected an attack
+of fever.&nbsp; Next morning every particle of white paint on both ships
+was so deeply blackened, that it could not be cleaned by scrubbing with
+soap and water.&nbsp; The brass was all turned to a bronze colour, and
+even the iron and ropes had taken a new tint.&nbsp; This is an additional
+proof that malaria and offensive effluvia are not always companions.&nbsp;
+We did not suffer more from fever in the mangrove swamps, where we inhaled
+so much of the heavy mousey smell that it was distinguishable in the
+odour of our shirts and flannels, than we did elsewhere.</p>
+<p>We tarried in the foul and blackening emanations from the marsh because
+we had agreed to receive on board about thirty poor orphan boys and
+girls, and a few helpless widows whom Bishop Mackenzie had attached
+to his Mission.&nbsp; All who were able to support themselves had been
+encouraged by the Missionaries to do so by cultivating the ground, and
+they now formed a little free community.&nbsp; But the boys and girls
+who were only from seven to twelve years of age, and orphans without
+any one to help them, could not be abandoned without bringing odium
+on the English name.&nbsp; The effect of an outcry by some persons in
+England, who knew nothing of the circumstances in which Bishop Mackenzie
+was placed, and who certainly had not given up their own right of appeal
+to the sword of the magistrate, was, that the new head of the Mission
+had gone to extremes in the opposite direction from his predecessor;
+not even protesting against the one monstrous evil of the country, the
+slave-trade.&nbsp; We believed that we ought to leave the English name
+in the same good repute among the natives that we had found it; and
+in removing the poor creatures, who had lived with Mackenzie as children
+with a father, to a land where the education he began would be completed,
+we had the aid and sympathy of the best of the Portuguese, and of the
+whole population.&nbsp; The difference between shipping slaves and receiving
+these free orphans struck us as they came on board.&nbsp; As soon as
+permission to embark was given, the rush into the boat nearly swamped
+her&mdash;their eagerness to be safe on the &ldquo;Pioneer&rsquo;s&rdquo;
+deck had to be repressed.</p>
+<p>Bishop Tozer had already left for Quillimane when we took these people
+and the last of the Universities&rsquo; Missionaries on board and proceeded
+to the Zambesi.&nbsp; It was in high flood.&nbsp; We have always spoken
+of this river as if at its lowest, for fear lest we should convey an
+exaggerated impression of its capabilities for navigation.&nbsp; Instead
+of from five to fifteen feet, it was now from fifteen to thirty feet,
+or more, deep.&nbsp; All the sandbanks and many of the islands had disappeared,
+and before us rolled a river capable, as one of our naval friends thought,
+of carrying a gunboat.&nbsp; Some of the sandy islands are annually
+swept away, and the quantities of sand carried down are prodigious.</p>
+<p>The process by which a delta, extending eighty or one hundred miles
+from the sea, has been formed may be seen going on at the present day&mdash;the
+coarser particles of sand are driven out into the ocean, just in the
+same way as we see they are over banks in the beds of torrents.&nbsp;
+The finer portions are caught by the returning tide, and, accumulating
+by successive ebbs and flows, become, with the decaying vegetation,
+arrested by the mangrove roots.&nbsp; The influence of the tide in bringing
+back the finer particles gives the sea near the mouth of the Zambesi
+a clean and sandy bottom.&nbsp; This process has been going on for ages,
+and as the delta has enlarged eastwards, the river has always kept a
+channel for itself behind.&nbsp; Wherever we see an island all sand,
+or with only one layer of mud in it, we know it is one of recent formation,
+and that it may be swept away at any time by a flood; while those islands
+which are all of mud are the more ancient, having in fact existed ever
+since the time when the ebbing and flowing tides originally formed them
+as parts of the delta.&nbsp; This mud resists the action of the river
+wonderfully.&nbsp; It is a kind of clay on which the eroding power of
+water has little effect.&nbsp; Were maps made, showing which banks and
+which islands are liable to erosion, it would go far to settle where
+the annual change of the channel would take place; and, were a few stakes
+driven in year by year to guide the water in its course, the river might
+be made of considerable commercial value in the hands of any energetic
+European nation.&nbsp; No canal or railway would ever be thought of
+for this part of Africa.&nbsp; A few improvements would make the Zambesi
+a ready means of transit for all the trade that, with a population thinned
+by Portuguese slaving, will ever be developed in our day.&nbsp; Here
+there is no instance on record of the natives flocking in thousands
+to the colony, as they did at Natal, and even to the Arabs on Lake Nyassa.&nbsp;
+This keeping aloof renders it unlikely that in Portuguese hands the
+Zambesi will ever be of any more value to the world than it has been.</p>
+<p>After a hurried visit to Senna, in order to settle with Major Sicard
+and Senhor Ferr&atilde;o for supplies we had drawn thence after the
+depopulation of the Shir&eacute;, we proceeded down to the Zambesi&rsquo;s
+mouth, and were fortunate in meeting, on the 13th February, with H.M.S.
+&ldquo;Orestes.&rdquo;&nbsp; She was joined next day by H.M.S. &ldquo;Ariel.&rdquo;&nbsp;
+The &ldquo;Orestes&rdquo; took the &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo; and the &ldquo;Ariel&rdquo;
+the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; in tow, for Mosambique.&nbsp; On the 16th
+a circular storm proved the sea-going qualities of the &ldquo;Lady of
+the Lake;&rdquo; for on this day a hurricane struck the &ldquo;Ariel,&rdquo;
+and drove her nearly backwards at a rate of six knots.&nbsp; The towing
+hawser wound round her screw and stopped her engines.&nbsp; No sooner
+had she recovered from this shock than she was again taken aback on
+the other tack, and driven stem on towards the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rsquo;s&rdquo;
+broadside.&nbsp; We who were on board the little vessel saw no chance
+of escape unless the crew of the &ldquo;Ariel&rdquo; should think of
+heaving ropes when the big ship went over us; but she glided past our
+bow, and we breathed freely again.&nbsp; We had now an opportunity of
+witnessing man-of-war seamanship.&nbsp; Captain Chapman, though his
+engines were disabled, did not think of abandoning us in the heavy gale,
+but crossed the bows of the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; again and again,
+dropping a cask with a line by which to give us another hawser.&nbsp;
+We might never have picked it up, had not a Krooman jumped overboard
+and fastened a second line to the cask; and then we drew the hawser
+on board, and were again in tow.&nbsp; During the whole time of the
+hurricane the little vessel behaved admirably, and never shipped a single
+green sea.&nbsp; When the &ldquo;Ariel&rdquo; pitched forwards we could
+see a large part of her bottom, and when her stern went down we could
+see all her deck.&nbsp; A boat, hung at her stern davits, was stove
+in by the waves.&nbsp; The officers on board the &ldquo;Ariel&rdquo;
+thought that it was all over with us: we imagined that they were suffering
+more than we were.&nbsp; Nautical men may suppose that this was a serious
+storm only to landsmen; but the &ldquo;Orestes,&rdquo; which was once
+in sight, and at another time forty miles off during the same gale,
+split eighteen sails; and the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; had to be lightened
+of parts of a sugar-mill she was carrying; her round-house was washed
+away, and the cabin was frequently knee-deep in water.&nbsp; When the
+&ldquo;Orestes&rdquo; came into Mosambique harbour nine days after our
+arrival there, our vessel, not being anchored close to the &ldquo;Ariel,&rdquo;
+for we had run in under the lee of the fort, led to the surmise on board
+the &ldquo;Orestes&rdquo; that we had gone to the bottom.&nbsp; Captain
+Chapman and his officers pronounced the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; to
+be the finest little sea-boat they had ever seen.&nbsp; She certainly
+was a contrast to the &ldquo;Ma-Robert,&rdquo; and did great credit
+to her builders, Ted and Macgregor of Glasgow.&nbsp; We can but regret
+that she was not employed on the Lake after which she was named, and
+for which she was intended and was so well adapted.</p>
+<p>What struck us most, during the trip from the Zambesi to Mosambique,
+was the admirable way in which Captain Chapman handled the &ldquo;Ariel&rdquo;
+in the heavy sea of the hurricane; the promptitude and skill with which,
+when we had broken three hawsers, others were passed to us by the rapid
+evolutions of a big ship round a little one; and the ready appliance
+of means shown in cutting the hawser off the screw nine feet under water
+with long chisels made for the occasion; a task which it took three
+days to accomplish.&nbsp; Captain Chapman very kindly invited us on
+board the &ldquo;Ariel,&rdquo; and we accepted his hospitality after
+the weather had moderated.</p>
+<p>The little vessel was hauled through and against the huge seas with
+such force that two hawsers measuring eleven inches each in circumference
+parted.&nbsp; Many of the blows we received from the billows made every
+plate quiver from stem to stern, and the motion was so quick that we
+had to hold on continually to avoid being tossed from one side to the
+other or into the sea.&nbsp; Ten of the late Bishop&rsquo;s flock whom
+we had on board became so sick and helpless that do what we could to
+aid them they were so very much in the way that the idea broke in upon
+us, that the close packing resorted to by slavers is one of the necessities
+of the traffic.&nbsp; If this is so, it would account for the fact that
+even when the trade was legal the same injurious custom was common,
+if not universal.&nbsp; If, instead of ten such passengers, we had been
+carrying two hundred, with the wind driving the rain and spray, as by
+night it did, nearly as hard as hail against our faces, and nothing
+whatever to be seen to windward but the occasional gleam of the crest
+of a wave, and no sound heard save the whistling of the storm through
+the rigging, it would have been absolutely necessary for the working
+of the ship and safety of the whole that the live cargo should all have
+been stowed down below, whatever might have been the consequences.</p>
+<p>Having delivered the &ldquo;Pioneer&rdquo; over to the Navy, she
+was towed down to the Cape by Captain Forsyth of the &ldquo;Valorous,&rdquo;
+and after examination it was declared that with repairs to the amount
+of &pound;300 she would be as serviceable as ever.&nbsp; Those of the
+Bishop&rsquo;s flock whom we had on board were kindly allowed a passage
+to the Cape.&nbsp; The boys went in the &ldquo;Orestes,&rdquo; and we
+are glad of the opportunity to record our heartfelt thanks to Captains
+Forsyth, Gardner, and Chapman for rendering us, at various times, every
+aid in their power.&nbsp; Mr. Waller went in the &ldquo;Pioneer,&rdquo;
+and continued his generous services to all connected with the Mission,
+whether white or black, till they were no longer needed; and we must
+say that his conduct to them throughout was truly noble, and worthy
+of the highest praise.</p>
+<p>After beaching the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; at Cabo&ccedil;eira,
+opposite the house of a Portuguese gentleman well known to all Englishmen,
+Jo&atilde;o da Costa Soares, we put in brine cocks, and cleaned and
+painted her bottom.&nbsp; Mr. Soares appeared to us to have been very
+much vilified in a publication in England a few years ago; our experience
+proved him to be extremely kind and obliging.&nbsp; All the members
+of the Expedition who passed Mosambique were unanimous in extolling
+his generosity and, from the general testimony of English visitors in
+his favour, we very much regret that his character was so grievously
+misrepresented.&nbsp; To the authorities at Mosambique our thanks are
+also due for obliging accommodation; and though we differ entirely from
+the Portuguese officials as to the light in which we regard the slave-trade,
+we trust our exposure of the system, in which unfortunately they are
+engaged, will not be understood as indicating any want of kindly feeling
+and good will to them personally.&nbsp; Senhor Canto e Castro, who arrived
+at Mosambique two days after our departure to take the office of Governor-General,
+was well known to us in Angola.&nbsp; We lived two months in his house
+when he was Commandant of Golungo Alto; and, knowing him thoroughly,
+believe that no better man could have been selected for the office.&nbsp;
+We trust that his good principles may enable him to withstand the temptations
+of his position; but we should be sorry to have ours tried in a den
+of slave-traders with the miserable pittance he receives for his support.</p>
+<p>While at Mosambique, a species of Pedalia called by Mr. Soares Dadeleira,
+and by the natives&mdash;from its resemblance to Gerzilin, or sesamum&mdash;&ldquo;wild
+sesamum,&rdquo; was shown to us, and is said to be well known among
+native nurses as a very gentle and tasteless aperient for children.&nbsp;
+A few leaves of it are stirred in a cup of cold water for eight or nine
+seconds, and a couple of teaspoonfuls of the liquid given as a dose.&nbsp;
+The leaves form a sort of mucilage in the water by longer stirring,
+which is said to have diuretic properties besides.</p>
+<p>On the 16th April we steamed out from Mosambique; and, the currents
+being in our favour, in a week reached Zanzibar.&nbsp; Here we experienced
+much hospitality from our countrymen, and especially from Dr. Seward,
+then acting consul and political agent for Colonel Playfair.</p>
+<p>Dr. Seward was very doubtful if we could reach Bombay before what
+is called the break of the monsoon took place.&nbsp; This break occurs
+usually between the end of May and the 12th of June.&nbsp; The wind
+still blows from Africa to India, but with so much violence, and with
+such a murky atmosphere, that few or no observations for position can
+be taken.&nbsp; We were, however, at the time very anxious to dispose
+of the &ldquo;Lady Nyassa,&rdquo; and, the only market we could reach
+being Bombay, we resolved to run the risk of getting there before the
+stormy period commenced; and, after taking fourteen tons of coal on
+board, we started on the 30th April from Zanzibar.</p>
+<p>Our complement consisted of seven native Zambesians, two boys, and
+four Europeans; namely, one stoker, one sailor, one carpenter, whose
+names have been already mentioned, and Dr. Livingstone, as navigator.&nbsp;
+The &ldquo;Lady Nyassa&rdquo; had shown herself to be a good sea-boat.&nbsp;
+The natives had proved themselves capital sailors, though before volunteering
+not one of them had ever seen the sea.&nbsp; They were not picked men,
+but, on paying a dozen whom we had in our employment for fifteen months,
+they were taken at random from several hundreds who offered to accompany
+us.&nbsp; Their wages were ten shillings per mensem, and it was curious
+to observe, that so eager were they to do their duty, that only one
+of them lay down from sea-sickness during the whole voyage.&nbsp; They
+took in and set sail very cleverly in a short time, and would climb
+out along a boom, reeve a rope through the block, and come back with
+the rope in their teeth, though at each lurch the performer was dipped
+in the sea.&nbsp; The sailor and carpenter, though anxious to do their
+utmost, had a week&rsquo;s severe illness each, and were unfit for duty.</p>
+<p>It is pleasant enough to take the wheel for an hour or two, or even
+for a watch, but when it comes to be for every alternate four hours,
+it is utterly wearisome.&nbsp; We set our black men to steer, showing
+them which arm of the compass needle was to be kept towards the vessel&rsquo;s
+head, and soon three of them could manage very well, and they only needed
+watching.&nbsp; In going up the East Coast to take advantage of the
+current of one hundred miles a day, we would fain have gone into the
+Juba or Webbe River, the mouth of which is only 15 minutes south of
+the line, but we were too shorthanded.&nbsp; We passed up to about ten
+degrees north of the Equator, and then steamed out from the coast.&nbsp;
+Here Maury&rsquo;s wind chart showed that the calm-belt had long been
+passed, but we were in it still; and, instead of a current carrying
+us north, we had a contrary current which bore us every day four miles
+to the south.&nbsp; We steamed as long as we dared, knowing as we did
+that we must use the engines on the coast of India.</p>
+<p>After losing many days tossing on the silent sea, with innumerable
+dolphins, flying-fish, and sharks around us, we had six days of strong
+breezes, then calms again tried our patience; and the near approach
+of that period, &ldquo;the break of the monsoon,&rdquo; in which it
+was believed no boat could live, made us sometimes think our epitaph
+would be &ldquo;Left Zanzibar on 30th April, 1864, and never more heard
+of.&rdquo;&nbsp; At last, in the beginning of June, the chronometers
+showed that we were near the Indian coast.&nbsp; The black men believed
+it was true because we told them it was so, but only began to dance
+with joy when they saw sea-weed and serpents floating past.&nbsp; These
+serpents are peculiar to these parts, and are mentioned as poisonous
+in the sailing directions.&nbsp; We ventured to predict that we should
+see land next morning, and at midday the high coast hove in sight, wonderfully
+like Africa before the rains begin.&nbsp; Then a haze covered all the
+land, and a heavy swell beat towards it.&nbsp; A rock was seen, and
+a latitude showed it to be the Choule rock.&nbsp; Making that a fresh
+starting-point, we soon found the light-ship, and then the forest of
+masts loomed through the haze in Bombay harbour.&nbsp; We had sailed
+over 2500 miles.</p>
+<h3>FOOTNOTES</h3>
+<p><a name="footnote1"></a><a href="#citation1">{1}</a>&nbsp; A remedy
+composed of from six to eight grains of resin of jalap, the same of
+rhubarb, and three each of calomel and quinine, made up into four pills,
+with tincture of cardamoms, usually relieved all the symptoms in five
+or six hours.&nbsp; Four pills are a full dose for a man&mdash;one will
+suffice for a woman.&nbsp; They received from our men the name of &ldquo;rousers,&rdquo;
+from their efficacy in rousing up even those most prostrated.&nbsp;
+When their operation is delayed, a dessert-spoonful of Epsom salts should
+be given.&nbsp; Quinine after or during the operation of the pills,
+in large doses every two or three hours, until deafness or cinchonism
+ensued, completed the cure.&nbsp; The only cases in which, we found
+ourselves completely helpless, were those in which obstinate vomiting
+ensued.</p>
+<p><a name="footnote2"></a><a href="#citation2">{2}</a>&nbsp; The late
+Mr. Robson.</p>
+<p><a name="footnote3"></a><a href="#citation3">{3}</a>&nbsp; In 1865,
+four years after these forebodings were penned, we received intelligence
+that they had all come to pass.&nbsp; Sekeletu died in the beginning
+of 1864&mdash;a civil war broke out about the succession to the chieftainship;
+a large body of those opposed to the late chief&rsquo;s uncle, Impololo,
+being regent, departed with their cattle to Lake Ngami; an insurrection
+by the black tribes followed; Impololo was slain, and the kingdom, of
+which, under an able sagacious mission, a vast deal might have been
+made, has suffered the usual fate of African conquests.&nbsp; That fate
+we deeply deplore; for, whatever other faults the Makololo might justly
+be charged with, they did not belong to the class who buy and sell each
+other, and the tribes who have succeeded them do.</p>
+<p><a name="footnote4"></a><a href="#citation4">{4}</a>&nbsp; It was
+with sorrow that we learned by a letter from Mr. Moffat, in 1864, that
+poor Sekeletu was dead.&nbsp; As will be mentioned further on, men were
+sent with us to bring up more medicine.&nbsp; They preferred to remain
+on the Shir&eacute;, and, as they were free men, we could do no more
+than try and persuade them to hasten back to their chief with iodine
+and other remedies.&nbsp; They took the parcel, but there being only
+two real Makololo among them, these could neither return themselves
+alone or force their attendants to leave a part of the country where
+they were independent, and could support themselves with ease.&nbsp;
+Sekeletu, however, lived long enough to receive and acknowledge goods
+to the value of &pound;50, sent, in lieu of those which remained in
+Tette, by Robert Moffat, jun., since dead.</p>
+<p><a name="footnote5"></a><a href="#citation5">{5}</a> A brother, we
+believe, of one who accompanied Burke and Willis in the famous but unfortunate
+Australian Expedition.</p>
+<p><a name="footnote6"></a><a href="#citation6">{6}</a>&nbsp; Genesis,
+chap. iii., verses 21 and 23, &ldquo;make coats of skins, and clothed
+them&rdquo;&mdash;&ldquo;sent him forth from the garden of Eden to till
+the ground&rdquo; imply teaching.&nbsp; Vide Archbishop Whately&rsquo;s
+&ldquo;History of Religious Worship.&rdquo;&nbsp; John W. Parker, West
+Strand, London, 1849.</p>
+<p><a name="footnote7"></a><a href="#citation7">{7}</a>&nbsp; &ldquo;In
+1854 the native church at Sierra-Leone undertook to pay for their primary
+schools, and thereby effected a saving to the Church Missionary Society
+of &pound;800 per annum.&nbsp; In 1861 the contributions of this one
+section of native Christians had amounted to upwards of &pound;10,000.&rdquo;&mdash;&ldquo;Manual
+of Church Missionary Society&rsquo;s African Missions.&rdquo;</p>
+<p>***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A POPULAR ACCOUNT OF DR.</p>
+<pre>
+LIVINGSTONE'S EXPEDITION TO THE ZAMBESI AND ITS TRIBUTARIES***
+
+
+***** This file should be named 2519-h.htm or 2519-h.zip******
+
+
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/2/5/1/2519
+
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+https://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit:
+https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ https://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+</pre></body>
+</html>
diff --git a/2519.txt b/2519.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..373499e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/2519.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,12198 @@
+The Project Gutenberg eBook, A Popular Account of Dr. Livingstone's
+Expedition to the Zambesi and Its Tributaries, by David Livingstone
+
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+
+
+
+Title: A Popular Account of Dr. Livingstone's Expedition to the Zambesi and Its Tributaries
+ And of the Discovery of the Lakes Shirwa and Nyassa (1858-1864)
+
+
+Author: David Livingstone
+
+Release Date: May 13, 2005 [eBook #2519]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-646-US (US-ASCII)
+
+
+***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A POPULAR ACCOUNT OF DR.
+LIVINGSTONE'S EXPEDITION TO THE ZAMBESI AND ITS TRIBUTARIES***
+
+
+
+
+
+
+Transcribed from the 1894 John Murray edition by David Price, email
+ccx074@coventry.ac.uk
+
+
+
+
+
+A POPULAR ACCOUNT OF
+DR. LIVINGSTONE'S EXPEDITION TO THE ZAMBESI AND ITS TRIBUTARIES:
+AND THE DISCOVERY OF LAKES SHIRWA AND NYASSA
+1858-1864
+
+
+TO THE RIGHT HON. LORD PALMERSTON,
+K.G., G.C.B.
+
+My Lord,
+
+I beg leave to dedicate this Volume to your Lordship, as a tribute justly
+due to the great Statesman who has ever had at heart the amelioration of
+the African race; and as a token of admiration of the beneficial effects
+of that policy which he has so long laboured to establish on the West
+Coast of Africa; and which, in improving that region, has most forcibly
+shown the need of some similar system on the opposite side of the
+Continent.
+
+DAVID LIVINGSTONE.
+
+
+
+
+NOTICE TO THIS WORK.
+
+
+The name of the late Mr. Charles Livingstone takes a prominent place
+amongst those who acted under the leadership of Dr. Livingstone during
+the adventurous sojourn of the "Zambesi Expedition" in East Africa. In
+laying the result of their discoveries before the public, it was arranged
+that Mr. Charles Livingstone should place his voluminous notes at the
+disposal of his brother: they are incorporated in the present work, but
+in a necessarily abridged form.
+
+
+
+
+PREFACE.
+
+
+It has been my object in this work to give as clear an account as I was
+able of tracts of country previously unexplored, with their river
+systems, natural productions, and capabilities; and to bring before my
+countrymen, and all others interested in the cause of humanity, the
+misery entailed by the slave-trade in its inland phases; a subject on
+which I and my companions are the first who have had any opportunities of
+forming a judgment. The eight years spent in Africa, since my last work
+was published, have not, I fear, improved my power of writing English;
+but I hope that, whatever my descriptions want in clearness, or literary
+skill, may in a measure be compensated by the novelty of the scenes
+described, and the additional information afforded on that curse of
+Africa, and that shame, even now, in the 19th century, of an European
+nation,--the slave-trade.
+
+I took the "Lady Nyassa" to Bombay for the express purpose of selling
+her, and might without any difficulty have done so; but with the thought
+of parting with her arose, more strongly than ever, the feeling of
+disinclination to abandon the East Coast of Africa to the Portuguese and
+slave-trading, and I determined to run home and consult my friends before
+I allowed the little vessel to pass from my hands. After, therefore,
+having put two Ajawa lads, Chuma and Wakatani, to school under the
+eminent missionary the Rev. Dr. Wilson, and having provided
+satisfactorily for the native crew, I started homewards with the three
+white sailors, and reached London July 20th, 1864. Mr. and Mrs. Webb, my
+much-loved friends, wrote to Bombay inviting me, in the event of my
+coming to England, to make Newstead Abbey my headquarters, and on my
+arrival renewed their invitation: and though, when I accepted it, I had
+no intention of remaining so long with my kind-hearted generous friends,
+I stayed with them until April, 1865, and under their roof transcribed
+from my own and my brother's journal the whole of this present book. It
+is with heartfelt gratitude I would record their unwearied kindness. My
+acquaintance with Mr. Webb began in Africa, where he was a daring and
+successful hunter, and his continued friendship is most valuable because
+he has seen missionary work, and he would not accord his respect and
+esteem to me had he not believed that I, and my brethren also, were to be
+looked on as honest men earnestly trying to do our duty.
+
+The Government have supported the proposal of the Royal Geographical
+Society made by my friend Sir Roderick Murchison, and have united with
+that body to aid me in another attempt to open Africa to civilizing
+influences, and a valued private friend has given a thousand pounds for
+the same object. I propose to go inland, north of the territory which
+the Portuguese in Europe claim, and endeavour to commence that system on
+the East which has been so eminently successful on the West Coast; a
+system combining the repressive efforts of H.M. cruisers with lawful
+trade and Christian Missions--the moral and material results of which
+have been so gratifying. I hope to ascend the Rovuma, or some other
+river North of Cape Delgado, and, in addition to my other work, shall
+strive, by passing along the Northern end of Lake Nyassa and round the
+Southern end of Lake Tanganyika, to ascertain the watershed of that part
+of Africa. In so doing, I have no wish to unsettle what with so much
+toil and danger was accomplished by Speke and Grant, but rather to
+confirm their illustrious discoveries.
+
+I have to acknowledge the obliging readiness of Lord Russell in lending
+me the drawings taken by the artist who was in the first instance
+attached to the Expedition. These sketches, with photographs by Charles
+Livingstone and Dr. Kirk, have materially assisted in the illustrations.
+I would also very sincerely thank my friends Professor Owen and Mr.
+Oswell for many valuable hints and other aid in the preparation of this
+volume.
+
+Newstead Abbey,
+
+April 16, 1865.
+
+
+
+
+THE ZAMBESI AND ITS TRIBUTARIES.
+
+
+INTRODUCTION.
+
+
+Objects of the Expedition--Personal Interest shown by Naval
+Authorities--Members of the Zambesi Expedition.
+
+When first I determined on publishing the narrative of my "Missionary
+Travels," I had a great misgiving as to whether the criticism my
+endeavours might provoke would be friendly or the reverse, more
+particularly as I felt that I had then been so long a sojourner in the
+wilderness, as to be quite a stranger to the British public. But I am
+now in this, my second essay at authorship, cheered by the conviction
+that very many readers, who are personally unknown to me, will receive
+this narrative with the kindly consideration and allowances of friends;
+and that many more, under the genial influences of an innate love of
+liberty, and of a desire to see the same social and religious blessings
+they themselves enjoy, disseminated throughout the world, will sympathize
+with me in the efforts by which I have striven, however imperfectly, to
+elevate the position and character of our fellow-men in Africa. This
+knowledge makes me doubly anxious to render my narrative acceptable to
+all my readers; but, in the absence of any excellence in literary
+composition, the natural consequence of my pursuits, I have to offer only
+a simple account of a mission which, with respect to the objects proposed
+to be thereby accomplished, formed a noble contrast to some of the
+earlier expeditions to Eastern Africa. I believe that the information it
+will give, respecting the people visited and the countries traversed,
+will not be materially gainsaid by any future commonplace traveller like
+myself, who may be blest with fair health and a gleam of sunshine in his
+breast. This account is written in the earnest hope that it may
+contribute to that information which will yet cause the great and fertile
+continent of Africa to be no longer kept wantonly sealed, but made
+available as the scene of European enterprise, and will enable its people
+to take a place among the nations of the earth, thus securing the
+happiness and prosperity of tribes now sunk in barbarism or debased by
+slavery; and, above all, I cherish the hope that it may lead to the
+introduction of the blessings of the Gospel.
+
+In order that the following narrative may be clearly understood, it is
+necessary to call to mind some things which took place previous to the
+Zambesi Expedition being sent out. Most geographers are aware that,
+before the discovery of Lake Ngami and the well-watered country in which
+the Makololo dwell, the idea prevailed that a large part of the interior
+of Africa consisted of sandy deserts, into which rivers ran and were
+lost. During my journey in 1852-6, from sea to sea, across the south
+intertropical part of the continent, it was found to be a well-watered
+country, with large tracts of fine fertile soil covered with forest, and
+beautiful grassy valleys, occupied by a considerable population; and one
+of the most wonderful waterfalls in the world was brought to light. The
+peculiar form of the continent was then ascertained to be an elevated
+plateau, somewhat depressed in the centre, and with fissures in the sides
+by which the rivers escaped to the sea; and this great fact in physical
+geography can never be referred to without calling to mind the remarkable
+hypothesis by which the distinguished President of the Royal Geographical
+Society (Sir Roderick I. Murchison) clearly indicated this peculiarity,
+before it was verified by actual observation of the altitudes of the
+country and by the courses of the rivers. New light was thrown on other
+portions of the continent by the famous travels of Dr. Barth, by the
+researches of the Church of England missionaries Krapf, Erkhardt, and
+Rebman, by the persevering efforts of Dr. Baikie, the last martyr to the
+climate and English enterprise, by the journey of Francis Galton, and by
+the most interesting discoveries of Lakes Tanganyika and Victoria Nyanza
+by Captain Burton, and by Captain Speke, whose untimely end we all so
+deeply deplore. Then followed the researches of Van der Decken,
+Thornton, and others; and last of all the grand discovery of the main
+source of the Nile, which every Englishman must feel an honest pride in
+knowing was accomplished by our gallant countrymen, Speke and Grant. The
+fabulous torrid zone, of parched and burning sand, was now proved to be a
+well-watered region resembling North America in its fresh-water lakes,
+and India in its hot humid lowlands, jungles, ghauts, and cool highland
+plains.
+
+The main object of this Zambesi Expedition, as our instructions from Her
+Majesty's Government explicitly stated, was to extend the knowledge
+already attained of the geography and mineral and agricultural resources
+of Eastern and Central Africa--to improve our acquaintance with the
+inhabitants, and to endeavour to engage them to apply themselves to
+industrial pursuits and to the cultivation of their lands, with a view to
+the production of raw material to be exported to England in return for
+British manufactures; and it was hoped that, by encouraging the natives
+to occupy themselves in the development of the resources of the country,
+a considerable advance might be made towards the extinction of the slave-
+trade, as they would not be long in discovering that the former would
+eventually be a more certain source of profit than the latter. The
+Expedition was sent in accordance with the settled policy of the English
+Government; and the Earl of Clarendon, being then at the head of the
+Foreign Office, the Mission was organized under his immediate care. When
+a change of Government ensued, we experienced the same generous
+countenance and sympathy from the Earl of Malmesbury, as we had
+previously received from Lord Clarendon; and, on the accession of Earl
+Russell to the high office he has so long filled, we were always favoured
+with equally ready attention and the same prompt assistance. Thus the
+conviction was produced that our work embodied the principles, not of any
+one party, but of the hearts of the statesmen and of the people of
+England generally. The Expedition owes great obligations to the Lords of
+the Admiralty for their unvarying readiness to render us every assistance
+in their power; and to the warm-hearted and ever-obliging hydrographer to
+the Admiralty, the late Admiral Washington, as a subordinate, but most
+effective agent, our heartfelt gratitude is also due; and we must ever
+thankfully acknowledge that our efficiency was mainly due to the kind
+services of Admirals Sir Frederick Grey, Sir Baldwin Walker, and all the
+naval officers serving under them on the East Coast. Nor must I omit to
+record our obligations to Mr. Skead, R.N. The Luawe was carefully
+sounded and surveyed by this officer, whose skilful and zealous labours,
+both on that river, and afterwards on the Lower Zambesi, were deserving
+of all praise.
+
+In speaking of what has been done by the Expedition, it should always be
+understood that Dr. Kirk, Mr. Charles Livingstone, Mr. R. Thornton, and
+others composed it. In using the plural number they are meant, and I
+wish to bear testimony to the untiring zeal, energy, courage, and
+perseverance with which my companions laboured; undaunted by
+difficulties, dangers, or hard fare. It is my firm belief that, were
+their services required in any other capacity, they might be implicitly
+relied on to perform their duty like men. The reason why Dr. Kirk's name
+does not appear on the title-page of this narrative is, because it is
+hoped that he may give an account of the botany and natural history of
+the Expedition in a separate work from his own pen. He collected above
+four thousand species of plants, specimens of most of the valuable woods,
+of the different native manufactures, of the articles of food, and of the
+different kinds of cotton from every spot we visited, and a great variety
+of birds and insects; besides making meteorological observations, and
+affording, as our instructions required, medical assistance to the
+natives in every case where he could be of any use.
+
+Charles Livingstone was also fully occupied in his duties in following
+out the general objects of our mission, in encouraging the culture of
+cotton, in making many magnetic and meteorological observations, in
+photographing so long as the materials would serve, and in collecting a
+large number of birds, insects, and other objects of interest. The
+collections, being Government property, have been forwarded to the
+British Museum, and to the Royal Botanic, Gardens at Kew; and should Dr.
+Kirk undertake their description, three or four years will be required
+for the purpose.
+
+Though collections were made, it was always distinctly understood that,
+however desirable these and our explorations might be, "Her Majesty's
+Government attached more importance to the moral influence that might be
+exerted on the minds of the natives by a well-regulated and orderly
+household of Europeans setting an example of consistent moral conduct to
+all who might witness it; treating the people with kindness, and
+relieving their wants, teaching them to make experiments in agriculture,
+explaining to them the more simple arts, imparting to them religious
+instruction as far as they are capable of receiving it, and inculcating
+peace and good will to each other."
+
+It would be tiresome to enumerate in detail all the little acts which
+were performed by us while following out our instructions. As a rule,
+whenever the steamer stopped to take in wood, or for any other purpose,
+Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone went ashore to their duties: one of our
+party, who it was intended should navigate the vessel and lay down the
+geographical positions, having failed to answer the expectations formed
+of him, these duties fell chiefly to my share. They involved a
+considerable amount of night work, in which I was always cheerfully aided
+by my companions, and the results were regularly communicated to our warm
+and ever-ready friend, Sir Thomas Maclear of the Royal Observatory, Cape
+of Good Hope. While this work was going through the press, we were
+favoured with the longitudes of several stations determined from observed
+occultations of stars by the moon, and from eclipses and reappearances of
+Jupiter's satellites, by Mr. Mann, the able Assistant to the Cape
+Astronomer Royal; the lunars are still in the hands of Mr. G. W. H.
+Maclear of the same Observatory. In addition to these, the altitudes,
+variations of the compass, latitudes and longitudes, as calculated on the
+spot, appear in the map by Mr. Arrowsmith, and it is hoped may not differ
+much from the results of the same data in abler bands. The office of
+"skipper," which, rather than let the Expedition come to a stand, I
+undertook, required no great ability in one "not too old to learn:" it
+saved a salary, and, what was much more valuable than gold, saved the
+Expedition from the drawback of any one thinking that he was
+indispensable to its further progress. The office required attention to
+the vessel both at rest and in motion. It also involved considerable
+exposure to the sun; and to my regret kept me from much anticipated
+intercourse with the natives, and the formation of full vocabularies of
+their dialects.
+
+I may add that all wearisome repetitions are as much as possible avoided
+in the narrative; and, our movements and operations having previously
+been given in a series of despatches, the attempt is now made to give as
+fairly as possible just what would most strike any person of ordinary
+intelligence in passing through the country. For the sake of the
+freshness which usually attaches to first impressions, the Journal of
+Charles Livingstone has been incorporated in the narrative; and many
+remarks made by the natives, which ho put down at the moment of
+translation, will convey to others the same ideas as they did to
+ourselves. Some are no doubt trivial; but it is by the little acts and
+words of every-day life that character is truly and best known. And
+doubtless many will prefer to draw their own conclusions from them rather
+than to be schooled by us.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I.
+
+
+Arrival at the Zambesi--Rebel Warfare--Wild Animals--Shupanga--Hippopotamus
+Hunters--The Makololo--Crocodiles.
+
+The Expedition left England on the 10th of March, 1858, in Her Majesty's
+Colonial Steamer "Pearl," commanded by Captain Duncan; and, after
+enjoying the generous hospitality of our friends at Cape Town, with the
+obliging attentions of Sir George Grey, and receiving on board Mr.
+Francis Skead, R.N., as surveyor, we reached the East Coast in the
+following May.
+
+Our first object was to explore the Zambesi, its mouths and tributaries,
+with a view to their being used as highways for commerce and Christianity
+to pass into the vast interior of Africa. When we came within five or
+six miles of the land, the yellowish-green tinge of the sea in soundings
+was suddenly succeeded by muddy water with wrack, as of a river in flood.
+The two colours did not intermingle, but the line of contact was as
+sharply defined as when the ocean meets the land. It was observed that
+under the wrack--consisting of reeds, sticks, and leaves,--and even under
+floating cuttlefish bones and Portuguese "men-of-war" (Physalia), numbers
+of small fish screen themselves from the eyes of birds of prey, and from
+the rays of the torrid sun.
+
+We entered the river Luawe first, because its entrance is so smooth and
+deep, that the "Pearl," drawing 9 feet 7 inches, went in without a boat
+sounding ahead. A small steam launch having been brought out from
+England in three sections on the deck of the "Pearl" was hoisted out and
+screwed together at the anchorage, and with her aid the exploration was
+commenced. She was called the "Ma Robert," after Mrs. Livingstone, to
+whom the natives, according to their custom, gave the name Ma (mother) of
+her eldest son. The harbour is deep, but shut in by mangrove swamps; and
+though the water a few miles up is fresh, it is only a tidal river; for,
+after ascending some seventy miles, it was found to end in marshes
+blocked up with reeds and succulent aquatic plants. As the Luawe had
+been called "West Luabo," it was supposed to be a branch of the Zambesi,
+the main stream of which is called "Luabo," or "East Luabo." The "Ma
+Robert" and "Pearl" then went to what proved to be a real mouth of the
+river we sought.
+
+The Zambesi pours its waters into the ocean by four mouths, namely, the
+Milambe, which is the most westerly, the Kongone, the Luabo, and the
+Timbwe (or Muselo). When the river is in flood, a natural canal running
+parallel with the coast, and winding very much among the swamps, forms a
+secret way for conveying slaves from Quillimane to the bays Massangano
+and Nameara, or to the Zambesi itself. The Kwakwa, or river of
+Quillimane, some sixty miles distant from the mouth of the Zambesi, has
+long been represented as the principal entrance to the Zambesi, in order,
+as the Portuguese now maintain, that the English cruisers might be
+induced to watch the false mouth, while slaves were quietly shipped from
+the true one; and, strange to say, this error has lately been propagated
+by a map issued by the colonial minister of Portugal.
+
+After the examination of three branches by the able and energetic
+surveyor, Francis Skead, R.N., the Kongone was found to be the best
+entrance. The immense amount of sand brought down by the Zambesi has in
+the course of ages formed a sort of promontory, against which the long
+swell of the Indian Ocean, beating during the prevailing winds, has
+formed bars, which, acting against the waters of the delta, may have led
+to their exit sideways. The Kongone is one of those lateral branches,
+and the safest; inasmuch as the bar has nearly two fathoms on it at low
+water, and the rise at spring tides is from twelve to fourteen feet. The
+bar is narrow, the passage nearly straight, and, were it buoyed and a
+beacon placed on Pearl Island, would always be safe to a steamer. When
+the wind is from the east or north, the bar is smooth; if from the south
+and south-east, it has a heavy break on it, and is not to be attempted in
+boats. A strong current setting to the east when the tide is flowing,
+and to the west when ebbing, may drag a boat or ship into the breakers.
+If one is doubtful of his longitude and runs east, he will soon see the
+land at Timbwe disappear away to the north; and coming west again, he can
+easily make out East Luabo from its great size; and Kongone follows
+several miles west. East Luabo has a good but long bar, and not to be
+attempted unless the wind be north-east or east. It has sometimes been
+called "Barra Catrina," and was used in the embarkations of slaves. This
+may have been the "River of Good Signs," of Vasco da Gama, as the mouth
+is more easily seen from the seaward than any other; but the absence of
+the pillar dedicated by that navigator to "St. Raphael," leaves the
+matter in doubt. No Portuguese live within eighty miles of any mouth of
+the Zambesi.
+
+The Kongone is five miles east of the Milambe, or western branch, and
+seven miles west from East Luabo, which again is five miles from the
+Timbwe. We saw but few natives, and these, by escaping from their canoes
+into the mangrove thickets the moment they caught sight of us, gave
+unmistakeable indications that they had no very favourable opinion of
+white men. They were probably fugitives from Portuguese slavery. In the
+grassy glades buffaloes, wart-hogs, and three kinds of antelope were
+abundant, and the latter easily obtained. A few hours' hunting usually
+provided venison enough for a score of men for several days.
+
+On proceeding up the Kongone branch it was found that, by keeping well in
+the bends, which the current had worn deep, shoals were easily avoided.
+The first twenty miles are straight and deep; then a small and rather
+tortuous natural canal leads off to the right, and, after about five
+miles, during which the paddles almost touch the floating grass of the
+sides, ends in the broad Zambesi. The rest of the Kongone branch comes
+out of the main stream considerably higher up as the outgoing branch
+called Doto.
+
+The first twenty miles of the Kongone are enclosed in mangrove jungle;
+some of the trees are ornamented with orchilla weed, which appears never
+to have been gathered. Huge ferns, palm bushes, and occasionally wild
+date-palms peer out in the forest, which consists of different species of
+mangroves; the bunches of bright yellow, though scarcely edible fruit,
+contrasting prettily with the graceful green leaves. In some spots the
+Milola, an umbrageous hibiscus, with large yellowish flowers, grows in
+masses along the bank. Its bark is made into cordage, and is especially
+valuable for the manufacture of ropes attached to harpoons for killing
+the hippopotamus. The Pandanus or screw-palm, from which sugar bags are
+made in the Mauritius, also appears, and on coming out of the canal into
+the Zambesi many are so tall as in the distance to remind us of the
+steeples of our native land, and make us relish the remark of an old
+sailor, "that but one thing was wanting to complete the picture, and that
+was a 'grog-shop near the church.'" We find also a few guava and lime-
+trees growing wild, but the natives claim the crops. The dark woods
+resound with the lively and exultant song of the kinghunter (_Halcyon
+striolata_), as he sits perched on high among the trees. As the steamer
+moves on through the winding channel, a pretty little heron or bright
+kingfisher darts out in alarm from the edge of the bank, flies on ahead a
+short distance, and settles quietly down to be again frightened off in a
+few seconds as we approach. The magnificent fishhawk (_Halietus
+vocifer_) sits on the top of a mangrove-tree, digesting his morning meal
+of fresh fish, and is clearly unwilling to stir until the imminence of
+the danger compels him at last to spread his great wings for flight. The
+glossy ibis, acute of ear to a remarkable degree, hears from afar the
+unwonted sound of the paddles, and, springing from the mud where his
+family has been quietly feasting, is off, screaming out his loud, harsh,
+and defiant Ha! ha! ha! long before the danger is near.
+
+Several native huts now peep out from the bananas and cocoa-palms on the
+right bank; they stand on piles a few feet above the low damp ground, and
+their owners enter them by means of ladders. The soil is wonderfully
+rich, and the gardens are really excellent. Rice is cultivated largely;
+sweet potatoes, pumpkins, tomatoes, cabbages, onions (shalots), peas, a
+little cotton, and sugar-cane are also raised. It is said that English
+potatoes, when planted at Quillimane on soil resembling this, in the
+course of two years become in taste like sweet potatoes (_Convolvulus
+batatas_), and are like our potato frosted. The whole of the fertile
+region extending from the Kongone canal to beyond Mazaro, some eighty
+miles in length, and fifty in breadth, is admirably adapted for the
+growth of sugar-cane; and were it in the hands of our friends at the
+Cape, would supply all Europe with sugar. The remarkably few people seen
+appear to be tolerably well fed, but there was a dearth of clothing among
+them; all were blacks, and nearly all Portuguese "colonos" or serfs. They
+manifested no fear of white men, and stood in groups on the bank gazing
+in astonishment at the steamers, especially at the "Pearl," which
+accompanied us thus far up the river. One old man who came on board
+remarked that never before had he seen any vessel so large as the
+"Pearl," it was like a village, "Was it made out of one tree?" All were
+eager traders, and soon came off to the ship in light swift canoes with
+every kind of fruit and food they possessed; a few brought honey and
+beeswax, which are found in quantities in the mangrove forests. As the
+ships steamed off, many anxious sellers ran along the bank, holding up
+fowls, baskets of rice and meal, and shouting "Malonda, Malonda," "things
+for sale," while others followed in canoes, which they sent through the
+water with great velocity by means of short broad-bladed paddles.
+
+Finding the "Pearl's" draught too great for that part of the river near
+the island of Simbo, where the branch called the Doto is given off to the
+Kongone on the right bank, and another named Chinde departs to the secret
+canal already mentioned on the left, the goods belonging to the
+expedition were taken out of her, and placed on one of the grassy islands
+about forty miles from the bar. The "Pearl" then left us, and we had to
+part with our good friends Duncan and Skead; the former for Ceylon, the
+latter to return to his duties as Government Surveyor at the Cape.
+
+Of those who eventually did the work of the expedition the majority took
+a sober common-sense view of the enterprise in which we were engaged.
+Some remained on Expedition Island from the 18th June until the 13th
+August, while the launch and pinnace were carrying the goods up to
+Shupanga and Senna. The country was in a state of war, our luggage was
+in danger, and several of our party were exposed to disease from
+inactivity in the malaria of the delta. Here some had their first
+introduction to African life, and African fever. Those alone were safe
+who were actively employed with the vessels, and of course, remembering
+the perilous position of their fellows, they strained every nerve to
+finish the work and take them away.
+
+Large columns of smoke rose daily from different points of the horizon,
+showing that the natives were burning off the immense crops of tall
+grass, here a nuisance, however valuable elsewhere. A white cloud was
+often observed to rest on the head of the column, as if a current of hot
+damp air was sent up by the heat of the flames and its moisture was
+condensed at the top. Rain did not follow, though theorists have
+imagined that in such cases it ought.
+
+Large game, buffaloes, and zebras, were abundant abreast the island, but
+no men could be seen. On the mainland, over on the right bank of the
+river, we were amused by the eccentric gyrations and evolutions of flocks
+of small seed-eating birds, who in their flight wheeled into compact
+columns with such military precision as to give us the impression that
+they must be guided by a leader, and all directed by the same signal.
+Several other kinds of small birds now go in flocks, and among others the
+large Senegal swallow. The presence of this bird, being clearly in a
+state of migration from the north, while the common swallow of the
+country, and the brown kite are away beyond the equator, leads to the
+conjecture that there may be a double migration, namely, of birds from
+torrid climates to the more temperate, as this now is, as well as from
+severe winters to sunny regions; but this could not be verified by such
+birds of passage as ourselves.
+
+On reaching Mazaro, the mouth of a narrow creek which in floods
+communicates with the Quillimane river, we found that the Portuguese were
+at war with a half-caste named Mariano _alias_ Matakenya, from whom they
+had generally fled, and who, having built a stockade near the mouth of
+the Shire, owned all the country between that river and Mazaro. Mariano
+was best known by his native name Matakenya, which in their tongue means
+"trembling," or quivering as trees do in a storm. He was a keen slave-
+hunter, and kept a large number of men, well armed with muskets. It is
+an entire mistake to suppose that the slave trade is one of buying and
+selling alone; or that engagements can be made with labourers in Africa
+as they are in India; Mariano, like other Portuguese, had no labour to
+spare. He had been in the habit of sending out armed parties on slave-
+hunting forays among the helpless tribes to the north-east, and carrying
+down the kidnapped victims in chains to Quillimane, where they were sold
+by his brother-in-law Cruz Coimbra, and shipped as "Free emigrants" to
+the French island of Bourbon. So long as his robberies and murders were
+restricted to the natives at a distance, the authorities did not
+interfere; but his men, trained to deeds of violence and bloodshed in
+their slave forays, naturally began to practise on the people nearer at
+hand, though belonging to the Portuguese, and even in the village of
+Senna, under the guns of the fort. A gentleman of the highest standing
+told us that, while at dinner with his family, it was no uncommon event
+for a slave to rush into the room pursued by one of Mariano's men with
+spear in hand to murder him.
+
+The atrocities of this villain, aptly termed by the late governor of
+Quillimane a "notorious robber and murderer," became at length
+intolerable. All the Portuguese spoke of him as a rare monster of
+inhumanity. It is unaccountable why half-castes, such as he, are so much
+more cruel than the Portuguese, but such is undoubtedly the case.
+
+It was asserted that one of his favourite modes of creating an impression
+in the country, and making his name dreaded, was to spear his captives
+with his own hands. On one occasion he is reported to have thus killed
+forty poor wretches placed in a row before him. We did not at first
+credit these statements, and thought that they were merely exaggerations
+of the incensed Portuguese, who naturally enough were exasperated with
+him for stopping their trade, and harbouring their runaway slaves; but we
+learned afterwards from the natives, that the accounts given us by the
+Portuguese had not exceeded the truth; and that Mariano was quite as
+great a ruffian as they had described him. One expects slave-owners to
+treat their human chattels as well as men do other animals of value, but
+the slave-trade seems always to engender an unreasoning ferocity, if not
+blood-thirstiness.
+
+War was declared against Mariano, and a force sent to take him; he
+resisted for a time; but seeing that he was likely to get the worst of
+it, and knowing that the Portuguese governors have small salaries, and
+are therefore "disposed to be reasonable," he went down to Quillimane to
+"arrange" with the Governor, as it is termed here; but Colonel da Silva
+put him in prison, and then sent him for trial to Mozambique. When we
+came into the country, his people were fighting under his brother Bonga.
+The war had lasted six months and stopped all trade on the river during
+that period. On the 15th June we first came into contact with the
+"rebels." They appeared as a crowd of well-armed and
+fantastically-dressed people under the trees at Mazaro. On explaining
+that we were English, some at once came on board and called to those on
+shore to lay aside their arms. On landing among them we saw that many
+had the branded marks of slaves on their chests, but they warmly approved
+our objects, and knew well the distinctive character of our nation on the
+slave question. The shout at our departure contrasted strongly with the
+suspicious questioning on our approach. Hence-forward we were recognized
+as friends by both parties.
+
+At a later period we were taking in wood within a mile of the scene of
+action, but a dense fog prevented our hearing the noise of a battle at
+Mazaro; and on arriving there, immediately after, many natives and
+Portuguese appeared on the bank.
+
+Dr. Livingstone, landing to salute some of his old friends among the
+latter, found himself in the sickening smell, and among the mutilated
+bodies of the slain; he was requested to take the Governor, who was very
+ill of fever, across to Shupanga, and just as he gave his assent, the
+rebels renewed the fight, and the balls began to whistle about in all
+directions. After trying in vain to get some one to assist the Governor
+down to the steamer, and unwilling to leave him in such danger, as the
+officer sent to bring our Kroomen did not appear, he went into the hut,
+and dragged along his Excellency to the ship. He was a very tall man,
+and as he swayed hither and thither from weakness, weighing down Dr.
+Livingstone, it must have appeared like one drunken man helping another.
+Some of the Portuguese white soldiers stood fighting with great bravery
+against the enemy in front, while a few were coolly shooting at their own
+slaves for fleeing into the river behind. The rebels soon retired, and
+the Portuguese escaped to a sandbank in the Zambesi, and thence to an
+island opposite Shupanga, where they lay for some weeks, looking at the
+rebels on the mainland opposite. This state of inactivity on the part of
+the Portuguese could not well be helped, as they had expended all their
+ammunition and were waiting anxiously for supplies; hoping, no doubt
+sincerely, that the enemy might not hear that their powder had failed.
+Luckily their hopes were not disappointed; the rebels waited until a
+supply came, and were then repulsed after three-and-a-half hours' hard
+fighting. Two months afterwards Mariano's stockade was burned, the
+garrison having fled in a panic; and as Bonga declared that he did not
+wish to fight with this Governor, with whom he had no quarrel, the war
+soon came to an end. His Excellency meanwhile, being a disciple of
+Raspail, had taken nothing for the fever but a little camphor, and after
+he was taken to Shupanga became comatose. More potent remedies were
+administered to him, to his intense disgust, and he soon recovered. The
+Colonel in attendance, whom he never afterwards forgave, encouraged the
+treatment. "Give what is right; never mind him; he is very (_muito_)
+impertinent:" and all night long, with every draught of water the Colonel
+gave a quantity of quinine: the consequence was, next morning the patient
+was cinchonized and better.
+
+For sixty or seventy miles before reaching Mazaro, the scenery is tame
+and uninteresting. On either hand is a dreary uninhabited expanse, of
+the same level grassy plains, with merely a few trees to relieve the
+painful monotony. The round green top of the stately palm-tree looks at
+a distance, when its grey trunk cannot be seen, as though hung in mid-
+air. Many flocks of busy sand-martins, which here, and as far south as
+the Orange River, do not migrate, have perforated the banks two or three
+feet horizontally, in order to place their nests at the ends, and are now
+chasing on restless wing the myriads of tropical insects. The broad
+river has many low islands, on which are seen various kinds of waterfowl,
+such as geese, spoonbills, herons, and flamingoes. Repulsive crocodiles,
+as with open jaws they sleep and bask in the sun on the low banks, soon
+catch the sound of the revolving paddles and glide quietly into the
+stream. The hippopotamus, having selected some still reach of the river
+to spend the day, rises out of the bottom, where he has been enjoying his
+morning bath after the labours of the night on shore, blows a puff of
+spray from his nostrils, shakes the water out of his ears, puts his
+enormous snout up straight and yawns, sounding a loud alarm to the rest
+of the herd, with notes as of a monster bassoon.
+
+As we approach Mazaro the scenery improves. We see the well-wooded
+Shupanga ridge stretching to the left, and in front blue hills rise dimly
+far in the distance. There is no trade whatever on the Zambesi below
+Mazaro. All the merchandise of Senna and Tette is brought to that point
+in large canoes, and thence carried six miles across the country on men's
+heads to be reshipped on a small stream that flows into the Kwakwa, or
+Quillimane river, which is entirely distinct from the Zambesi. Only on
+rare occasions and during the highest floods can canoes pass from the
+Zambesi to the Quillimane river through the narrow natural canal _Mutu_.
+The natives of Maruru, or the country around Mazaro, the word Mazaro
+meaning the "mouth of the creek" Mutu, have a bad name among the
+Portuguese; they are said to be expert thieves, and the merchants
+sometimes suffer from their adroitness while the goods are in transit
+from one river to the other. In general they are trained canoe-men, and
+man many of the canoes that ply thence to Senna and Tette; their pay is
+small, and, not trusting the traders, they must always have it before
+they start. Africans being prone to assign plausible reasons for their
+conduct, like white men in more enlightened lands, it is possible they
+may be good-humouredly giving their reason for insisting on being
+invariably paid in advance in the words of their favourite canoe-song,
+"Uachingere, Uachingere Kale," "You cheated me of old;" or, "Thou art
+slippery slippery truly."
+
+The Landeens or Zulus are lords of the right bank of the Zambesi; and the
+Portuguese, by paying this fighting tribe a pretty heavy annual tribute,
+practically admit this. Regularly every year come the Zulus in force to
+Senna and Shupanga for the accustomed tribute. The few wealthy merchants
+of Senna groan under the burden, for it falls chiefly on them. They
+submit to pay annually 200 pieces of cloth, of sixteen yards each,
+besides beads and brass wire, knowing that refusal involves war, which
+might end in the loss of all they possess. The Zulus appear to keep as
+sharp a look out on the Senna and Shupanga people as ever landlord did on
+tenant; the more they cultivate, the more tribute they have to pay. On
+asking some of them why they did not endeavour to raise certain highly
+profitable products, we were answered, "What's the use of our cultivating
+any more than we do? the Landeens would only come down on us for more
+tribute."
+
+In the forests of Shupanga the Mokundu-kundu tree abounds; its bright
+yellow wood makes good boat-masts, and yields a strong bitter medicine
+for fever; the Gunda-tree attains to an immense size; its timber is hard,
+rather cross-grained, with masses of silica deposited in its substance;
+the large canoes, capable of carrying three or four tons, are made of its
+wood. For permission to cut these trees, a Portuguese gentleman of
+Quillimane was paying the Zulus, in 1858, two hundred dollars a year, and
+his successor now pays three hundred.
+
+At Shupanga, a one-storied stone house stands on the prettiest site on
+the river. In front a sloping lawn, with a fine mango orchard at its
+southern end, leads down to the broad Zambesi, whose green islands repose
+on the sunny bosom of the tranquil waters. Beyond, northwards, lie vast
+fields and forests of palm and tropical trees, with the massive mountain
+of Morambala towering amidst the white clouds; and further away more
+distant hills appear in the blue horizon. This beautifully situated
+house possesses a melancholy interest from having been associated in a
+most mournful manner with the history of two English expeditions. Here,
+in 1826, poor Kirkpatrick, of Captain Owen's Surveying Expedition, died
+of fever; and here, in 1862, died, of the same fatal disease, the beloved
+wife of Dr. Livingstone. A hundred yards east of the house, under a
+large Baobab-tree, far from their native land, both are buried.
+
+The Shupanga-house was the head-quarters of the Governor during the
+Mariano war. He told us that the province of Mosambique costs the Home
+Government between 5000_l_. and 6000_l_. annually, and East Africa yields
+no reward in return to the mother country. We met there several other
+influential Portuguese. All seemed friendly, and expressed their
+willingness to assist the expedition in every way in their power; and
+better still, Colonel Nunes and Major Sicard put their good-will into
+action, by cutting wood for the steamer and sending men to help in
+unloading. It was observable that not one of them knew anything about
+the Kongone Mouth; all thought that we had come in by the "Barra
+Catrina," or East Luabo. Dr. Kirk remained here a few weeks; and,
+besides exploring a small lake twenty miles to the south-west, had the
+sole medical care of the sick and wounded soldiers, for which valuable
+services he received the thanks of the Portuguese Government. We wooded
+up at this place with African ebony or black wood, and lignum vitae; the
+latter tree attains an immense size, sometimes as much as four feet in
+diameter; our engineer, knowing what ebony and lignum vitae cost at home,
+said it made his heart sore to burn wood so valuable. Though botanically
+different, they are extremely alike; the black wood as grown in some
+districts is superior, and the lignum vitae inferior in quality, to these
+timbers brought from other countries. Caoutchouc, or India-rubber, is
+found in abundance inland from Shupanga-house, and calumba-root is
+plentiful in the district; indigo, in quantities, propagates itself close
+to the banks of the Aver, and was probably at some time cultivated, for
+manufactured indigo was once exported. The India-rubber is made into
+balls for a game resembling "fives," and calumba-root is said to be used
+as a mordant for certain colours, but not as a dye itself.
+
+We started for Tette on the 17th August, 1858; the navigation was rather
+difficult, the Zambesi from Shupanga to Senna being wide and full of
+islands; our black pilot, John Scisssors, a serf, sometimes took the
+wrong channel and ran us aground. Nothing abashed, he would exclaim in
+an aggrieved tone, "This is not the path, it is back yonder." "Then why
+didn't you go yonder at first?" growled out our Kroomen, who had the work
+of getting the vessel off. When they spoke roughly to poor Scissors, the
+weak cringing slave-spirit came forth in, "Those men scold me so, I am
+ready to run away." This mode of finishing up an engagement is not at
+all uncommon on the Zambesi; several cases occurred, when we were on the
+river, of hired crews decamping with most of the goods in their charge.
+If the trader cannot redress his own wrongs, he has to endure them. The
+Landeens will not surrender a fugitive slave, even to his master. One
+belonging to Mr. Azevedo fled, and was, as a great favour only, returned
+after a present of much more than his value.
+
+We landed to wood at Shamoara, just below the confluence of the Shire.
+Its quartz hills are covered with trees and gigantic grasses; the buaze,
+a small forest-tree, grows abundantly; it is a species of polygala; its
+beautiful clusters of sweet-scented pinkish flowers perfume the air with
+a rich fragrance; its seeds produce a fine drying oil, and the bark of
+the smaller branches yields a fibre finer and stronger than flax; with
+which the natives make their nets for fishing. Bonga, the brother of the
+rebel Mariano, and now at the head of the revolted natives, with some of
+his principal men came to see us, and were perfectly friendly, though
+told of our having carried the sick Governor across to Shupanga, and of
+our having cured him of fever. On our acquainting Bonga with the object
+of the expedition, he remarked that we should suffer no hindrance from
+his people in our good work. He sent us a present of rice, two sheep,
+and a quantity of firewood. He never tried to make any use of us in the
+strife; the other side showed less confidence, by carefully
+cross-questioning our pilot whether we had sold any powder to the enemy.
+We managed, however, to keep on good terms with both rebels and
+Portuguese.
+
+Senna is built on a low plain, on the right bank of the Zambesi, with
+some pretty detached hills in the background; it is surrounded by a
+stockade of living trees to protect its inhabitants from their
+troublesome and rebellious neighbours. It contains a few large houses,
+some ruins of others, and a weather-beaten cross, where once stood a
+church; a mound shows the site of an ancient monastery, and a mud fort by
+the river is so dilapidated, that cows were grazing peacefully over its
+prostrate walls.
+
+The few Senna merchants, having little or no trade in the village, send
+parties of trusted slaves into the interior to hunt for and purchase
+ivory. It is a dull place, and very conducive to sleep. One is sure to
+take fever in Senna on the second day, if by chance one escapes it on the
+first day of a sojourn there; but no place is entirely bad. Senna has
+one redeeming feature: it is the native village of the large-hearted and
+hospitable Senhor H. A. Ferrao. The benevolence of this gentleman is
+unbounded. The poor black stranger passing through the town goes to him
+almost as a matter of course for food, and is never sent away hungry. In
+times of famine the starving natives are fed by his generosity; hundreds
+of his own people he never sees except on these occasions; and the only
+benefit derived from being their master is, that they lean on him as a
+patriarchal chief, and he has the satisfaction of settling their
+differences, and of saving their lives in seasons of drought and
+scarcity.
+
+Senhor Ferrao received us with his usual kindness, and gave us a
+bountiful breakfast. During the day the principal men of the place
+called, and were unanimously of opinion that the free natives would
+willingly cultivate large quantities of cotton, could they find
+purchasers. They had in former times exported largely both cotton and
+cloth to Manica and even to Brazil. "On their own soil," they declared,
+"the natives are willing to labour and trade, provided only they can do
+so to advantage: when it is for their interest, blacks work very hard."
+We often remarked subsequently that this was the opinion of men of
+energy; and that all settlers of activity, enterprise, and sober habits
+had become rich, while those who were much addicted to lying on their
+backs smoking, invariably complained of the laziness of the negroes, and
+were poor, proud, and despicable.
+
+Beyond Pita lies the little island Nyamotobsi, where we met a small
+fugitive tribe of hippopotamus hunters, who had been driven by war from
+their own island in front. All were busy at work; some were making
+gigantic baskets for grain, the men plaiting from the inside. With the
+civility so common among them the chief ordered a mat to be spread for us
+under a shed, and then showed us the weapon with which they kill the
+hippopotamus; it is a short iron harpoon inserted in the end of a long
+pole, but being intended to unship, it is made fast to a strong cord of
+milola, or hibiscus, bark, which is wound closely round the entire length
+of the shaft, and secured at its opposite end. Two men in a swift canoe
+steal quietly down on the sleeping animal. The bowman dashes the harpoon
+into the unconscious victim, while the quick steersman sweeps the light
+craft back with his broad paddle; the force of the blow separates the
+harpoon from its corded handle, which, appearing on the surface,
+sometimes with an inflated bladder attached, guides the hunters to where
+the wounded beast hides below until they despatch it.
+
+These hippopotamus hunters form a separate people, called Akombwi, or
+Mapodzo, and rarely--the women it is said never--intermarry with any
+other tribe. The reason for their keeping aloof from certain of the
+natives on the Zambesi is obvious enough, some having as great an
+abhorrence of hippopotamus meat as Mahomedans have of swine's flesh. Our
+pilot, Scissors, was one of this class; he would not even cook his food
+in a pot which had contained hippopotamus meat, preferring to go hungry
+till he could find another; and yet he traded eagerly in the animal's
+tusks, and ate with great relish the flesh of the foul-feeding marabout.
+These hunters go out frequently on long expeditions, taking in their
+canoes their wives and children, cooking-pots, and sleeping-mats. When
+they reach a good game district, they erect temporary huts on the bank,
+and there dry the meat they have killed. They are rather a
+comely-looking race, with very black smooth skins, and never disfigure
+themselves with the frightful ornaments of some of the other tribes. The
+chief declined to sell a harpoon, because they could not now get the
+milola bark from the coast on account of Mariano's war. He expressed
+some doubts about our being children of the same Almighty Father,
+remarking that "they could not become white, let them wash ever so much."
+We made him a present of a bit of cloth, and he very generously gave us
+in return some fine fresh fish and Indian corn.
+
+The heat of the weather steadily increases during this month (August),
+and foggy mornings are now rare. A strong breeze ending in a gale blows
+up stream every night. It came in the afternoon a few weeks ago, then
+later, and at present its arrival is near midnight; it makes our frail
+cabin-doors fly open before it, but continues only for a short time, and
+is succeeded by a dead calm. Game becomes more abundant; near our
+wooding-places we see herds of zebras, both Burchell's and the mountain
+variety, pallahs (_Antelope melampus_), waterbuck, and wild hogs, with
+the spoor of buffaloes and elephants.
+
+Shiramba Dembe, on the right bank, is deserted; a few old iron guns show
+where a rebel stockade once stood; near the river above this, stands a
+magnificent Baobab hollowed out into a good-sized hut, with bark inside
+as well as without. The old oaks in Sherwood Forest, when hollow, have
+the inside dead or rotten; but the Baobab, though stripped of its bark
+outside, and hollowed to a cavity inside, has the power of exuding new
+bark from its substance to both the outer and inner surfaces; so, a hut
+made like that in the oak called the "Forest Queen," in Sherwood, would
+soon all be lined with bark.
+
+The portions of the river called Shigogo and Shipanga are bordered by a
+low level expanse of marshy country, with occasional clumps of palm-trees
+and a few thorny acacias. The river itself spreads out to a width of
+from three to four miles, with many islands, among which it is difficult
+to navigate, except when the river is in flood. In front, a range of
+high hills from the north-east crosses and compresses it into a deep
+narrow channel, called the Lupata Gorge. The Portuguese thought the
+steamer would not stem the current here; but as it was not more than
+about three knots, and as there was a strong breeze in our favour, steam
+and sails got her through with ease. Heavy-laden canoes take two days to
+go up this pass. A current sweeps round the little rocky promontories
+Chifura and Kangomba, forming whirlpools and eddies dangerous for the
+clumsy craft, which are dragged past with long ropes.
+
+The paddlers place meal on these rocks as an offering to the turbulent
+deities, which they believe preside over spots fatal to many a large
+canoe. We were slily told that native Portuguese take off their hats to
+these river gods, and pass in solemn silence; when safely beyond the
+promontories, they fire muskets, and, as we ought to do, give the canoe-
+men grog. From the spoor of buffaloes and elephants it appears that
+these animals frequent Lupata in considerable numbers, and--we have often
+observed the association--the tsetse fly is common. A horse for the
+Governor of Tette was sent in a canoe from Quillimane; and, lest it
+should be wrecked on the Chifura and Kangomba rocks, it was put on shore
+and sent in the daytime through the pass. It was of course bitten by the
+tsetse, and died soon after; it was thought that the _air_ of Tette had
+not agreed with it. The currents above Lupata are stronger than those
+below; the country becomes more picturesque and hilly, and there is a
+larger population.
+
+The ship anchored in the stream, off Tette, on the 8th September, 1858,
+and Dr. Livingstone went ashore in the boat. No sooner did the Makololo
+recognize him, than they rushed to the water's edge, and manifested great
+joy at seeing him again. Some were hastening to embrace him, but others
+cried out, "Don't touch him, you will spoil his new clothes." The five
+headmen came on board and listened in quiet sadness to the story of poor
+Sekwebu, who died at the Mauritius on his way to England. "Men die in
+any country," they observed, and then told us that thirty of their own
+number had died of smallpox, having been bewitched by the people of
+Tette, who envied them because, during the first year, none of their
+party had died. Six of their young men, becoming tired of cutting
+firewood for a meagre pittance, proposed to go and dance for gain before
+some of the neighbouring chiefs. "Don't go," said the others, "we don't
+know the people of this country;" but the young men set out and visited
+an independent half-caste chief, a few miles to the north, named Chisaka,
+who some years ago burned all the Portuguese villas on the north bank of
+the river; afterwards the young men went to Bonga, son of another half-
+caste chief, who bade defiance to the Tette authorities, and had a
+stockade at the confluence of the Zambesi and Luenya, a few miles below
+that village. Asking the Makololo whence they came, Bonga rejoined, "Why
+do you come from my enemy to me? You have brought witchcraft medicine to
+kill me." In vain they protested that they did not belong to the
+country; they were strangers, and had come from afar with an Englishman.
+The superstitious savage put them all to death. "We do not grieve," said
+their companions, "for the thirty victims of the smallpox, who were taken
+away by Morimo (God); but our hearts are sore for the six youths who were
+murdered by Bonga." Any hope of obtaining justice on the murderer was
+out of the question. Bonga once caught a captain of the Portuguese army,
+and forced him to perform the menial labour of pounding maize in a wooden
+mortar. No punishment followed on this outrage. The Government of
+Lisbon has since given Bonga the honorary title of Captain, by way of
+coaxing him to own their authority; but he still holds his stockade.
+
+Tette stands on a succession of low sandstone ridges on the right bank of
+the Zambesi, which is here nearly a thousand yards wide (960 yards).
+Shallow ravines, running parallel with the river, form the streets, the
+houses being built on the ridges. The whole surface of the streets,
+except narrow footpaths, were overrun with self-sown indigo, and tons of
+it might have been collected. In fact indigo, senna, and stramonium,
+with a species of cassia, form the weeds of the place, which are annually
+hoed off and burned. A wall of stone and mud surrounds the village, and
+the native population live in huts outside. The fort and the church,
+near the river, are the strongholds; the natives having a salutary dread
+of the guns of the one, and a superstitious fear of the unknown power of
+the other. The number of white inhabitants is small, and rather select,
+many of them having been considerately sent out of Portugal "for their
+country's good." The military element preponderates in society; the
+convict and "incorrigible" class of soldiers, receiving very little pay,
+depend in great measure on the produce of the gardens of their black
+wives; the moral condition of the resulting population may be imagined.
+
+Droughts are of frequent occurrence at Tette, and the crops suffer
+severely. This may arise partly from the position of the town between
+the ranges of hills north and south, which appear to have a strong
+attraction for the rain-clouds. It is often seen to rain on these hills
+when not a drop falls at Tette. Our first season was one of drought.
+Thrice had the women planted their gardens in vain, the seed, after just
+vegetating, was killed by the intense dry heat. A fourth planting shared
+the same hard fate, and then some of the knowing ones discovered the
+cause of the clouds being frightened away: our unlucky rain-gauge in the
+garden. We got a bad name through that same rain-gauge, and were
+regarded by many as a species of evil omen. The Makololo in turn blamed
+the people of Tette for drought: "A number of witches live here, who
+won't let it rain." Africans in general are sufficiently superstitious,
+but those of Tette are in this particular pre-eminent above their
+fellows. Coming from many different tribes, all the rays of the separate
+superstitions converge into a focus at Tette, and burn out common sense
+from the minds of the mixed breed. They believe that many evil spirits
+live in the air, the earth, and the water. These invisible malicious
+beings are thought to inflict much suffering on the human race; but, as
+they have a weakness for beer and a craving for food, they may be
+propitiated from time to time by offerings of meat and drink. The
+serpent is an object of worship, and hideous little images are hung in
+the huts of the sick and dying. The uncontaminated Africans believe that
+Morungo, the Great Spirit who formed all things, lives above the stars;
+but they never pray to him, and know nothing of their relation to him, or
+of his interest in them. The spirits of their departed ancestors are all
+good, according to their ideas, and on special occasions aid them in
+their enterprises. When a man has his hair cut, he is careful to burn
+it, or bury it secretly, lest, falling into the hands of one who has an
+evil eye, or is a witch, it should be used as a charm to afflict him with
+headache. They believe, too, that they will live after the death of the
+body, but do not know anything of the state of the Barimo (gods, or
+departed spirits).
+
+The mango-tree grows luxuriantly above Lupata, and furnishes a grateful
+shade. Its delicious fruit is superior to that on the coast. For weeks
+the natives who have charge of the mangoes live entirely on the fruit,
+and, as some trees bear in November and some in March, while the main
+crop comes between, fruit in abundance may easily be obtained during four
+months of the year; but no native can be induced to plant a mango. A
+wide-spread superstition has become riveted in the native mind, that if
+any one plants this tree he will soon die. The Makololo, like other
+natives, were very fond of the fruit; but when told to take up some mango-
+stones, on their return, and plant them in their own country--they too
+having become deeply imbued with the belief that it was a suicidal act to
+do so--replied "they did not wish to die too soon." There is also a
+superstition even among the native Portuguese of Tette, that if a man
+plants coffee he will never afterwards be happy: they drink it, however,
+and seem the happier for it.
+
+The Portuguese of Tette have many slaves, with all the usual vices of
+their class, as theft, lying, and impurity. As a general rule the real
+Portuguese are tolerably humane masters and rarely treat a slave cruelly;
+this may be due as much to natural kindness of heart as to a fear of
+losing the slaves by their running away. When they purchase an adult
+slave they buy at the same time, if possible, all his relations along
+with him. They thus contrive to secure him to his new home by domestic
+ties. Running away then would be to forsake all who hold a place in his
+heart, for the mere chance of acquiring a freedom, which would probably
+be forfeited on his entrance into the first native village, for the chief
+might, without compunction, again sell him into slavery.
+
+A rather singular case of voluntary slavery came to our knowledge: a free
+black, an intelligent active young fellow, called Chibanti, who had been
+our pilot on the river, told us that he had sold himself into slavery. On
+asking why he had done this, he replied that he was all alone in the
+world, had neither father nor mother, nor any one else to give him water
+when sick, or food when hungry; so he sold himself to Major Sicard, a
+notoriously kind master, whose slaves had little to do, and plenty to
+eat. "And how much did you get for yourself?" we asked. "Three thirty-
+yard pieces of cotton cloth," he replied; "and I forthwith bought a man,
+a woman, and child, who cost me two of the pieces, and I had one piece
+left." This, at all events, showed a cool and calculating spirit; he
+afterwards bought more slaves, and in two years owned a sufficient number
+to man one of the large canoes. His master subsequently employed him in
+carrying ivory to Quillimane, and gave him cloth to hire mariners for the
+voyage; he took his own slaves, of course, and thus drove a thriving
+business; and was fully convinced that he had made a good speculation by
+the sale of himself, for had he been sick his master must have supported
+him. Occasionally some of the free blacks become slaves voluntarily by
+going through the simple but significant ceremony of breaking a spear in
+the presence of their future master. A Portuguese officer, since dead,
+persuaded one of the Makololo to remain in Tette, instead of returning to
+his own country, and tried also to induce him to break a spear before
+him, and thus acknowledge himself his slave, but the man was too shrewd
+for this; he was a great elephant doctor, who accompanied the hunters,
+told them when to attack the huge beast, and gave them medicine to ensure
+success. Unlike the real Portuguese, many of the half-castes are
+merciless slave-holders; their brutal treatment of the wretched slaves is
+notorious. What a humane native of Portugal once said of them is
+appropriate if not true: "God made white men, and God made black men, but
+the devil made half-castes."
+
+The officers and merchants send parties of slaves under faithful headmen
+to hunt elephants and to trade in ivory, providing them with a certain
+quantity of cloth, beads, etc., and requiring so much ivory in return.
+These slaves think that they have made a good thing of it, when they kill
+an elephant near a village, as the natives give them beer and meal in
+exchange for some of the elephant's meat, and over every tusk that is
+brought there is expended a vast amount of time, talk, and beer. Most of
+the Africans are natural-born traders, they love trade more for the sake
+of trading than for what they make by it. An intelligent gentleman of
+Tette told us that native traders often come to him with a tusk for sale,
+consider the price he offers, demand more, talk over it, retire to
+consult about it, and at length go away without selling it; next day they
+try another merchant, talk, consider, get puzzled and go off as on the
+previous day, and continue this course daily until they have perhaps seen
+every merchant in the village, and then at last end by selling the
+precious tusk to some one for even less than the first merchant had
+offered. Their love of dawdling in the transaction arises from the self-
+importance conferred on them by their being the object of the wheedling
+and coaxing of eager merchants, a feeling to which even the love of gain
+is subordinate.
+
+The native medical profession is reasonably well represented. In
+addition to the regular practitioners, who are a really useful class, and
+know something of their profession, and the nature and power of certain
+medicines, there are others who devote their talents to some speciality.
+The elephant doctor prepares a medicine which is considered indispensable
+to the hunters when attacking that noble and sagacious beast; no hunter
+is willing to venture out before investing in this precious nostrum. The
+crocodile doctor sells a charm which is believed to possess the singular
+virtue of protecting its owner from crocodiles. Unwittingly we offended
+the crocodile school of medicine while at Tette, by shooting one of these
+huge reptiles as it lay basking in the sun on a sandbank; the doctors
+came to the Makololo in wrath, clamouring to know why the white man had
+shot their crocodile.
+
+A shark's hook was baited one evening with a dog, of which the crocodile
+is said to be particularly fond; but the doctors removed the bait, on the
+principle that the more crocodiles the more demand for medicine, or
+perhaps because they preferred to eat the dog themselves. Many of the
+natives of this quarter are known, as in the South Seas, to eat the dog
+without paying any attention to its feeding. The dice doctor or diviner
+is an important member of the community, being consulted by Portuguese
+and natives alike. Part of his business is that of a detective, it being
+his duty to discover thieves. When goods are stolen, he goes and looks
+at the place, casts his dice, and waits a few days, and then, for a
+consideration, tells who is the thief: he is generally correct, for he
+trusts not to his dice alone; he has confidential agents all over the
+village, by whose inquiries and information he is enabled to detect the
+culprit. Since the introduction of muskets, gun doctors have sprung up,
+and they sell the medicine which professes to make good marksmen; others
+are rain doctors, etc., etc. The various schools deal in little charms,
+which are hung round the purchaser's neck to avert evil: some of them
+contain the medicine, others increase its power.
+
+Indigo, about three or four feet high, grows in great luxuriance in the
+streets of Tette, and so does the senna plant. The leaves are
+undistinguishable from those imported in England. A small amount of
+first-rate cotton is cultivated by the native population for the
+manufacture of a coarse cloth. A neighbouring tribe raises the sugar-
+cane, and makes a little sugar; but they use most primitive wooden
+rollers, and having no skill in mixing lime with the extracted juice, the
+product is of course of very inferior quality. Plenty of magnetic iron
+ore is found near Tette, and coal also to any amount; a single cliff-seam
+measuring twenty-five feet in thickness. It was found to burn well in
+the steamer on the first trial. Gold is washed for in the beds of
+rivers, within a couple of days of Tette. The natives are fully aware of
+its value, but seldom search for it, and never dig deeper than four or
+five feet. They dread lest the falling in of the sand of the river's bed
+should bury them. In former times, when traders went with hundreds of
+slaves to the washings, the produce was considerable. It is now
+insignificant. The gold-producing lands have always been in the hands of
+independent tribes. Deep cuttings near the sources of the gold-yielding
+streams seem never to have been tried here, as in California and
+Australia, nor has any machinery been used save common wooden basins for
+washing.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II.
+
+
+Kebrabasa Rapids--Tette--African fever--Exploration of the
+Shire--Discovery of Lake Shirwa.
+
+Our curiosity had been so much excited by the reports we had heard of the
+Kebrabasa rapids, that we resolved to make a short examination of them,
+and seized the opportunity of the Zambesi being unusually low, to
+endeavour to ascertain their character while uncovered by the water. We
+reached them on the 9th of November. The country between Tette and Panda
+Mokua, where navigation ends, is well wooded and hilly on both banks.
+Panda Mokua is a hill two miles below the rapids, capped with dolomite
+containing copper ore.
+
+Conspicuous among the trees, for its gigantic size, and bark coloured
+exactly like Egyptian syenite, is the burly Baobab. It often makes the
+other trees of the forest look like mere bushes in comparison. A hollow
+one, already mentioned, is 74 feet in circumference, another was 84, and
+some have been found on the West Coast which measure 100 feet. The lofty
+range of Kebrabasa, consisting chiefly of conical hills, covered with
+scraggy trees, crosses the Zambesi, and confines it within a narrow,
+rough, and rocky dell of about a quarter of a mile in breadth; over this,
+which may be called the flood-bed of the river, large masses of rock are
+huddled in indescribable confusion. The drawing, for the use of which,
+and of others, our thanks are due to Lord Russell, conveys but a faint
+idea of the scene, inasmuch as the hills which confine the river do not
+appear in the sketch. The chief rock is syenite, some portions of which
+have a beautiful blue tinge like _lapis lazuli_ diffused through them;
+others are grey. Blocks of granite also abound, of a pinkish tinge; and
+these with metamorphic rocks, contorted, twisted, and thrown into every
+conceivable position, afford a picture of dislocation or unconformability
+which would gladden a geological lecturer's heart; but at high flood this
+rough channel is all smoothed over, and it then conforms well with the
+river below it, which is half a mile wide. In the dry season the stream
+runs at the bottom of a narrow and deep groove, whose sides are polished
+and fluted by the boiling action of the water in flood, like the rims of
+ancient Eastern wells by the draw-ropes. The breadth of the groove is
+often not more than from forty to sixty yards, and it has some sharp
+turnings, double channels, and little cataracts in it. As we steamed up,
+the masts of the "Ma Robert," though some thirty feet high, did not reach
+the level of the flood-channel above, and the man in the chains sung out,
+"No bottom at ten fathoms." Huge pot-holes, as large as draw-wells, had
+been worn in the sides, and were so deep that in some instances, when
+protected from the sun by overhanging boulders, the water in them was
+quite cool. Some of these holes had been worn right through, and only
+the side next the rock remained; while the sides of the groove of the
+flood-channel were polished as smooth as if they had gone through the
+granite-mills of Aberdeen. The pressure of the water must be enormous to
+produce this polish. It had wedged round pebbles into chinks and
+crannies of the rocks so firmly that, though they looked quite loose,
+they could not be moved except with a hammer. The mighty power of the
+water here seen gave us an idea of what is going on in thousands of
+cataracts in the world. All the information we had been able to obtain
+from our Portuguese friends amounted to this, that some three or four
+detached rocks jutted out of the river in Kebrabasa, which, though
+dangerous to the cumbersome native canoes, could be easily passed by a
+steamer, and that if one or two of these obstructions were blasted away
+with gunpowder, no difficulty would hereafter be experienced. After we
+had painfully explored seven or eight miles of the rapid, we returned to
+the vessel satisfied that much greater labour was requisite for the mere
+examination of the cataracts than our friends supposed necessary to
+remove them; we therefore went down the river for fresh supplies, and
+made preparation for a more serious survey of this region.
+
+The steamer having returned from the bar, we set out on the 22nd of
+November to examine the rapids of Kebrabasa. We reached the foot of the
+hills again, late in the afternoon of the 24th, and anchored in the
+stream. Canoe-men never sleep on the river, but always spend the night
+on shore. The natives on the right bank, in the country called Shidima,
+who are Banyai, and even at this short distance from Tette, independent,
+and accustomed to lord it over Portuguese traders, wondered what could be
+our object in remaining afloat, and were naturally suspicious at our
+departing from the universal custom.
+
+They hailed us from the bank in the evening with "Why don't you come and
+sleep onshore like other people?"
+
+The answer they received from our Makololo, who now felt as independent
+as the Banyai, was, "We are held to the bottom with iron; you may see we
+are not like your Bazungu."
+
+This hint, a little amplified, saved us from the usual exactions. It is
+pleasant to give a present, but that pleasure the Banyai usually deny to
+strangers by making it a fine, and demanding it in such a supercilious
+way, that only a sorely cowed trader could bear it. They often refuse to
+touch what is offered--throw it down and leave it--sneer at the trader's
+slaves, and refuse a passage until the tribute is raised to the utmost
+extent of his means.
+
+Leaving the steamer next morning, we proceeded on foot, accompanied by a
+native Portuguese and his men and a dozen Makololo, who carried our
+baggage. The morning was pleasant, the hills on our right furnished for
+a time a delightful shade; but before long the path grew frightfully
+rough, and the hills no longer shielded us from the blazing sun. Scarcely
+a vestige of a track was now visible; and, indeed, had not our guide
+assured us to the contrary, we should have been innocent of even the
+suspicion of a way along the patches of soft yielding sand, and on the
+great rocks over which we so painfully clambered. These rocks have a
+singular appearance, from being dislocated and twisted in every
+direction, and covered with a thin black glaze, as if highly polished and
+coated with lamp-black varnish. This seems to have been deposited while
+the river was in flood, for it covers only those rocks which lie between
+the highest water-mark and a line about four feet above the lowest.
+Travellers who have visited the rapids of the Orinoco and the Congo say
+that the rocks there have a similar appearance, and it is attributed to
+some deposit from the water, formed only when the current is strong. This
+may account for it in part here, as it prevails only where the narrow
+river is confined between masses of rock, backed by high hills, and where
+the current in floods is known to be the strongest; and it does not exist
+where the rocks are only on one side, with a sandy beach opposite, and a
+broad expanse of river between. The hot rocks burnt the thick soles of
+our men's feet, and sorely fatigued ourselves. Our first day's march did
+not exceed four miles in a straight line, and that we found more than
+enough to be pleasant.
+
+The state of insecurity in which the Badema tribe live is indicated by
+the habit of hiding their provisions in the hills, and keeping only a
+small quantity in their huts; they strip a particular species of tree of
+its bitter bark, to which both mice and monkeys are known to have an
+antipathy, and, turning the bark inside out, sew it into cylindrical
+vessels for their grain, and bury them in holes and in crags on the
+wooded hill-sides. By this means, should a marauding party plunder their
+huts, they save a supply of corn. They "could give us no information,
+and they had no food; Chisaka's men had robbed them a few weeks before."
+
+"Never mind," said our native Portuguese, "they will sell you plenty when
+you return, they are afraid of you now, as yet they do not know who you
+are." We slept under trees in the open air, and suffered no
+inconvenience from either mosquitoes or dew: and no prowling wild beast
+troubled us; though one evening, while we were here, a native sitting
+with some others on the opposite bank was killed by a leopard.
+
+One of the Tette slaves, who wished to be considered a great traveller,
+gave us, as we sat by our evening fire, an interesting account of a
+strange race of men whom he had seen in the interior; they were only
+three feet high, and had horns growing out of their heads; they lived in
+a large town and had plenty of food. The Makololo pooh-poohed this
+story, and roundly told the narrator that he was telling a downright lie.
+"_We_ come from the interior," cried out a tall fellow, measuring some
+six feet four, "are _we_ dwarfs? have _we_ horns on our heads?" and thus
+they laughed the fellow to scorn. But he still stoutly maintained that
+he had seen these little people, and had actually been in their town;
+thus making himself the hero of the traditional story, which before and
+since the time of Herodotus has, with curious persistency, clung to the
+native mind. The mere fact that such absurd notions are permanent, even
+in the entire absence of literature, invests the religious ideas of these
+people also with importance, as fragments of the wreck of the primitive
+faith floating down the stream of time.
+
+We waded across the rapid Luia, which took us up to the waist, and was
+about forty yards wide. The water was discoloured at the time, and we
+were not without apprehension that a crocodile might chance to fancy a
+white man for dinner. Next day one of the men crawled over the black
+rocks to within ten yards of a sleeping hippopotamus, and shot him
+through the brain. The weather being warm, the body floated in a few
+hours, and some of us had our first trial of hippopotamus flesh. It is a
+cross-grained meat, something between pork and beef,--pretty good food
+when one is hungry and can get nothing better. When we reached the foot
+of the mountain named Chipereziwa, whose perpendicular rocky sides are
+clothed with many-coloured lichens, our Portuguese companion informed us
+there were no more obstructions to navigation, the river being all smooth
+above; he had hunted there and knew it well. Supposing that the object
+of our trip was accomplished we turned back; but two natives, who came to
+our camp at night, assured us that a cataract, called Morumbwa, did still
+exist in front. Drs. Livingstone and Kirk then decided to go forward
+with three Makololo and settle the question for themselves. It was as
+tough a bit of travel as they ever had in Africa, and after some painful
+marching the Badema guides refused to go further; "the Banyai," they
+said, "would be angry if they showed white men the country; and there was
+besides no practicable approach to the spot, neither elephant, nor
+hippopotamus, nor even a crocodile could reach the cataract." The slopes
+of the mountains on each side of the river, now not 300 yards wide, and
+without the flattish flood-channel and groove, were more than 3000 feet
+from the sky-line down, and were covered either with dense thornbush or
+huge black boulders; this deep trough-like shape caused the sun's rays to
+converge as into a focus, making the surface so hot that the soles of the
+feet of the Makololo became blistered. Around, and up and down, the
+party clambered among these heated blocks, at a pace not exceeding a mile
+an hour; the strain upon the muscles in jumping from crag to boulder, and
+wriggling round projections, took an enormous deal out of them, and they
+were often glad to cower in the shadow formed by one rock overhanging and
+resting on another; the shelter induced the peculiarly strong and
+overpowering inclination to sleep, which too much sun sometimes causes.
+This sleep is curative of what may be incipient sunstroke: in its first
+gentle touches, it caused the dream to flit over the boiling brain, that
+they had become lunatics and had been sworn in as members of the Alpine
+club; and then it became so heavy that it made them feel as if a portion
+of existence had been cut out from their lives. The sun is excessively
+hot, and feels sharp in Africa; but, probably from the greater dryness of
+the atmosphere, we never heard of a single case of sunstroke, so common
+in India. The Makololo told Dr. Livingstone they "always thought he had
+a heart, but now they believed he had none," and tried to persuade Dr.
+Kirk to return, on the ground that it must be evident that, in attempting
+to go where no living foot could tread, his leader had given
+unmistakeable signs of having gone mad. All their efforts of persuasion,
+however, were lost upon Dr. Kirk, as he had not yet learned their
+language, and his leader, knowing his companion to be equally anxious
+with himself to solve the problem of the navigableness of Kebrabasa, was
+not at pains to enlighten him. At one part a bare mountain spur barred
+the way, and had to be surmounted by a perilous and circuitous route,
+along which the crags were so hot that it was scarcely possible for the
+hand to hold on long enough to ensure safety in the passage; and had the
+foremost of the party lost his hold, he would have hurled all behind him
+into the river at the foot of the promontory; yet in this wild hot
+region, as they descended again to the river, they met a fisherman
+casting his hand-net into the boiling eddies, and he pointed out the
+cataract of Morumbwa; within an hour they were trying to measure it from
+an overhanging rock, at a height of about one hundred feet. When you
+stand facing the cataract, on the north bank, you see that it is situated
+in a sudden bend of the river, which is flowing in a short curve; the
+river above it is jammed between two mountains in a channel with
+perpendicular sides, and less than fifty yards wide; one or two masses of
+rock jut out, and then there is a sloping fall of perhaps twenty feet in
+a distance of thirty yards. It would stop all navigation, except during
+the highest floods; the rocks showed that the water then rises upwards of
+eighty feet perpendicularly.
+
+Still keeping the position facing the cataract, on its right side rises
+Mount Morumbwa from 2000 to 3000 feet high, which gives the name to the
+spot. On the left of the cataract stands a noticeable mountain which may
+be called onion-shaped, for it is partly conical and a large concave
+flake has peeled off, as granite often does, and left a broad, smooth
+convex face as if it were an enormous bulb. These two mountains extend
+their bases northwards about half a mile, and the river in that distance,
+still very narrow, is smooth, with a few detached rocks standing out from
+its bed. They climbed as high up the base of Mount Morumbwa, which
+touches the cataract, as they required. The rocks were all water-worn
+and smooth, with huge potholes, even at 100 feet above low water. When
+at a later period they climbed up the north-western base of this same
+mountain, the familiar face of the onion-shaped one opposite was at once
+recognised; one point of view on the talus of Mount Morumbwa was not more
+than 700 or 800 yards distant from the other, and they then completed the
+survey of Kebrabasa from end to end.
+
+They did not attempt to return by the way they came, but scaled the slope
+of the mountain on the north. It took them three hours' hard labour in
+cutting their way up through the dense thornbush which covered the
+ascent. The face of the slope was often about an angle of 70 degrees,
+yet their guide Shokumbenla, whose hard, horny soles, resembling those of
+elephants, showed that he was accustomed to this rough and hot work,
+carried a pot of water for them nearly all the way up. They slept that
+night at a well in a tufaceous rock on the N.W. of Chipereziwa, and never
+was sleep more sweet.
+
+A band of native musicians came to our camp one evening, on our own way
+down, and treated us with their wild and not unpleasant music on the
+Marimba, an instrument formed of bars of hard wood of varying breadth and
+thickness, laid on different-sized hollow calabashes, and tuned to give
+the notes; a few pieces of cloth pleased them, and they passed on.
+
+The rainy season of Tette differs a little from that of some of the other
+intertropical regions; the quantity of rain-fall being considerably less.
+It begins in November and ends in April. During our first season in that
+place, only a little over nineteen inches of rain fell. In an average
+year, and when the crops are good, the fall amounts to about thirty-five
+inches. On many days it does not rain at all, and rarely is it wet all
+day; some days have merely a passing shower, preceded and followed by hot
+sunshine; occasionally an interval of a week, or even a fortnight, passes
+without a drop of rain, and then the crops suffer from the sun. These
+partial droughts happen in December and January. The heat appears to
+increase to a certain point in the different latitudes so as to
+necessitate a change, by some law similar to that which regulates the
+intense cold in other countries. After several days of progressive heat
+here, on the hottest of which the thermometer probably reaches 103
+degrees in the shade, a break occurs in the weather, and a thunderstorm
+cools the air for a time. At Kuruman, when the thermometer stood above
+84 degrees, rain might be expected; at Kolobeng, the point at which we
+looked for a storm was 96 degrees. The Zambesi is in flood twice in the
+course of the year; the first flood, a partial one, attains its greatest
+height about the end of December or beginning of January; the second, and
+greatest, occurs after the river inundates the interior, in a manner
+similar to the overflow of the Nile, this rise not taking place at Tette
+until March. The Portuguese say that the greatest height which the March
+floods attain is thirty feet at Tette, and this happens only about every
+fourth year; their observations, however, have never been very accurate
+on anything but ivory, and they have in this case trusted to memory
+alone. The only fluviometer at Tette, or anywhere else on the river, was
+set up at our suggestion; and the first flood was at its greatest height
+of thirteen feet six inches on the 17th January, 1859, and then gradually
+fell a few feet, until succeeded by the greater flood of March. The
+river rises suddenly, the water is highly discoloured and impure, and
+there is a four-knot current in many places; but in a day or two after
+the first rush of waters is passed, the current becomes more equally
+spread over the whole bed of the river, and resumes its usual rate in the
+channel, although continuing in flood. The Zambesi water at other times
+is almost chemically pure, and the photographer would find that it is
+nearly as good as distilled water for the nitrate of silver bath.
+
+A third visit to Kebrabasa was made for the purpose of ascertaining
+whether it might be navigable when the Zambesi was in flood, the chief
+point of interest being of course Morumbwa; it was found that the rapids
+observed in our first trip had disappeared, and that while they were
+smoothed over, in a few places the current had increased in strength. As
+the river fell rapidly while we were on the journey, the cataract of
+Morumbwa did not differ materially from what it was when discovered. Some
+fishermen assured us that it was not visible when the river was at its
+fullest, and that the current was then not very strong. On this occasion
+we travelled on the right bank, and found it, with the additional
+inconvenience of rain, as rough and fatiguing as the left had been. Our
+progress was impeded by the tall wet grass and dripping boughs, and
+consequent fever. During the earlier part of the journey we came upon a
+few deserted hamlets only; but at last in a pleasant valley we met some
+of the people of the country, who were miserably poor and hungry. The
+women were gathering wild fruits in the woods. A young man having
+consented for two yards of cotton cloth to show us a short path to the
+cataract led us up a steep hill to a village perched on the edge of one
+of its precipices; a thunderstorm coming on at the time, the headman
+invited us to take shelter in a hut until it had passed. Our guide
+having informed him of what he knew and conceived to be our object, was
+favoured in return with a long reply in well-sounding blank verse; at the
+end of every line the guide, who listened with deep attention, responded
+with a grunt, which soon became so ludicrous that our men burst into a
+loud laugh. Neither the poet nor the responsive guide took the slightest
+notice of their rudeness, but kept on as energetically as ever to the
+end. The speech, or more probably our bad manners, made some impression
+on our guide, for he declined, although offered double pay, to go any
+further.
+
+A great deal of fever comes in with March and April; in March, if
+considerable intervals take place between the rainy days, and in April
+always, for then large surfaces of mud and decaying vegetation are
+exposed to the hot sun. In general an attack does not continue long, but
+it pulls one down quickly; though when the fever is checked the strength
+is as quickly restored. It had long been observed that those who were
+stationed for any length of time in one spot, and lived sedentary lives,
+suffered more from fever than others who moved about and had both mind
+and body occupied; but we could not all go in the small vessel when she
+made her trips, during which the change of place and scenery proved so
+conducive to health; and some of us were obliged to remain in charge of
+the expedition's property, making occasional branch trips to examine
+objects of interest in the vicinity. Whatever may be the cause of the
+fever, we observed that all were often affected at the same time, as if
+from malaria. This was particularly the case during a north wind: it was
+at first commonly believed that a daily dose of quinine would prevent the
+attack. For a number of months all our men, except two, took quinine
+regularly every morning. The fever some times attacked the believers in
+quinine, while the unbelievers in its prophylactic powers escaped.
+Whether we took it daily, or omitted it altogether for months, made no
+difference; the fever was impartial, and seized us on the days of quinine
+as regularly and as severely as when it remained undisturbed in the
+medicine chest, and we finally abandoned the use of it as a prophylactic
+altogether. The best preventive against fever is plenty of interesting
+work to do, and abundance of wholesome food to eat. To a man well housed
+and clothed, who enjoys these advantages, the fever at Tette will not
+prove a more formidable enemy than a common cold; but let one of these be
+wanting--let him be indolent, or guilty of excesses in eating or
+drinking, or have poor, scanty fare,--and the fever will probably become
+a more serious matter. It is of a milder type at Tette than at
+Quillimane or on the low sea-coast; and, as in this part of Africa one is
+as liable to fever as to colds in England, it would be advisable for
+strangers always to hasten from the coast to the high lands, in order
+that when the seizure does take place, it may be of the mildest type.
+Although quinine was not found to be a preventive, except possibly in the
+way of acting as a tonic, and rendering the system more able to resist
+the influence of malaria, it was found invaluable in the cure of the
+complaint, as soon as pains in the back, sore bones, headache, yawning,
+quick and sometimes intermittent pulse, noticeable pulsations of the
+jugulars, with suffused eyes, hot skin, and foul tongue, began. {1}
+
+Very curious are the effects of African fever on certain minds.
+Cheerfulness vanishes, and the whole mental horizon is overcast with
+black clouds of gloom and sadness. The liveliest joke cannot provoke
+even the semblance of a smile. The countenance is grave, the eyes
+suffused, and the few utterances are made in the piping voice of a
+wailing infant. An irritable temper is often the first symptom of
+approaching fever. At such times a man feels very much like a fool, if
+he does not act like one. Nothing is right, nothing pleases the fever-
+stricken victim. He is peevish, prone to find fault and to contradict,
+and think himself insulted, and is exactly what an Irish naval surgeon
+before a court-martial defined a drunken man to be: "a man unfit for
+society."
+
+Finding that it was impossible to take our steamer of only ten-horse
+power through Kebrabasa, and convinced that, in order to force a passage
+when the river was in flood, much greater power was required, due
+information was forwarded to Her Majesty's Government, and application
+made for a more suitable vessel. Our attention was in the mean time
+turned to the exploration of the river Shire, a northern tributary of the
+Zambesi, which joins it about a hundred miles from the sea. We could
+learn nothing satisfactory from the Portuguese regarding this affluent;
+no one, they said, had ever been up it, nor could they tell whence it
+came. Years ago a Portuguese expedition is said, however, to have
+attempted the ascent, but to have abandoned it on account of the
+impenetrable duckweed (_Pistia stratiotes_.) We could not learn from any
+record that the Shire had ever been ascended by Europeans. As far,
+therefore, as we were concerned, the exploration was absolutely new. All
+the Portuguese believed the Manganja to be brave but bloodthirsty
+savages; and on our return we found that soon after our departure a
+report was widely spread that our temerity had been followed by fatal
+results, Dr. Livingstone having been shot, and Dr. Kirk mortally wounded
+by poisoned arrows.
+
+Our first trip to the Shire was in January, 1859. A considerable
+quantity of weed floated down the river for the first twenty-five miles,
+but not sufficient to interrupt navigation with canoes or with any other
+craft. Nearly the whole of this aquatic plant proceeds from a marsh on
+the west, and comes into the river a little beyond a lofty hill called
+Mount Morambala. Above that there is hardly any. As we approached the
+villages, the natives collected in large numbers, armed with bows and
+poisoned arrows; and some, dodging behind trees, were observed taking aim
+as if on the point of shooting. All the women had been sent out of the
+way, and the men were evidently prepared to resist aggression. At the
+village of a chief named Tingane, at least five hundred natives collected
+and ordered us to stop. Dr. Livingstone went ashore; and on his
+explaining that we were English and had come neither to take slaves nor
+to fight, but only to open a path by which our countrymen might follow to
+purchase cotton, or whatever else they might have to sell, except slaves,
+Tingane became at once quite friendly. The presence of the steamer,
+which showed that they had an entirely new people to deal with, probably
+contributed to this result; for Tingane was notorious for being the
+barrier to all intercourse between the Portuguese black traders and the
+natives further inland; none were allowed to pass him either way. He was
+an elderly, well-made man, grey-headed, and over six feet high. Though
+somewhat excited by our presence, he readily complied with the request to
+call his people together, in order that all might know what our objects
+were.
+
+In commencing intercourse with any people we almost always referred to
+the English detestation of slavery. Most of them already possess some
+information respecting the efforts made by the English at sea to suppress
+the slave-trade; and our work being to induce them to raise and sell
+cotton, instead of capturing and selling their fellow-men, our errand
+appears quite natural; and as they all have clear ideas of their own self-
+interest, and are keen traders, the reasonableness of the proposal is at
+once admitted; and as a belief in a Supreme Being, the Maker and Ruler of
+all things, and in the continued existence of departed spirits, is
+universal, it becomes quite appropriate to explain that we possess a Book
+containing a Revelation of the will of Him to whom in their natural state
+they recognise no relationship. The fact that His Son appeared among
+men, and left His words in His Book, always awakens attention; but the
+great difficulty is to make them feel that they have any relationship to
+Him, and that He feels any interest in them. The numbness of moral
+perception exhibited, is often discouraging; but the mode of
+communication, either by interpreters, or by the imperfect knowledge of
+the language, which not even missionaries of talent can overcome save by
+the labour of many years, may, in part, account for the phenomenon.
+However, the idea of the Father of all being displeased with His
+children, for selling or killing each other, at once gains their ready
+assent: it harmonizes so exactly with their own ideas of right and wrong.
+But, as in our own case at home, nothing less than the instruction and
+example of many years will secure their moral elevation.
+
+The dialect spoken here closely resembles that used at Senna and Tette.
+We understood it at first only enough to know whether our interpreter was
+saying what we bade him, or was indulging in his own version. After
+stating pretty nearly what he was told, he had an inveterate tendency to
+wind up with "The Book says you are to grow cotton, and the English are
+to come and buy it," or with some joke of his own, which might have been
+ludicrous, had it not been seriously distressing.
+
+In the first ascent of the Shire our attention was chiefly directed to
+the river itself. The delight of threading out the meanderings of
+upwards of 200 miles of a hitherto unexplored river must be felt to be
+appreciated. All the lower part of the river was found to be at least
+two fathoms in depth. It became shallower higher up, where many
+departing and re-entering branches diminished the volume of water, but
+the absence of sandbanks made it easy of navigation. We had to exercise
+the greatest care lest anything we did should be misconstrued by the
+crowds who watched us. After having made, in a straight line, one
+hundred miles, although the windings of the river had fully doubled the
+distance, we found further progress with the steamer arrested, in 15
+degrees 55 minutes south, by magnificent cataracts, which we called, "The
+Murchison," after one whose name has already a world-wide fame, and whose
+generous kindness we can never repay. The native name of that figured in
+the woodcut is Mamvira. It is that at which the progress of the steamer
+was first stopped. The angle of descent is much smaller than that of the
+five cataracts above it; indeed, so small as compared with them, that
+after they were discovered this was not included in the number.
+
+A few days were spent here in the hope that there might be an opportunity
+of taking observations for longitude, but it rained most of the time, or
+the sky was overcast. It was deemed imprudent to risk a land journey
+whilst the natives were so very suspicious as to have a strong guard on
+the banks of the river night and day; the weather also was unfavourable.
+After sending presents and messages to two of the chiefs, we returned to
+Tette. In going down stream our progress was rapid, as we were aided by
+the current. The hippopotami never made a mistake, but got out of our
+way. The crocodiles, not so wise, sometimes rushed with great velocity
+at us, thinking that we were some huge animal swimming. They kept about
+a foot from the surface, but made three well-defined ripples from the
+feet and body, which marked their rapid progress; raising the head out of
+the water when only a few yards from the expected feast, down they went
+to the bottom like a stone, without touching the boat.
+
+In the middle of March of the same year (1859), we started again for a
+second trip on the Shire. The natives were now friendly, and readily
+sold us rice, fowls, and corn. We entered into amicable relations with
+the chief, Chibisa, whose village was about ten miles below the cataract.
+He had sent two men on our first visit to invite us to drink beer; but
+the steamer was such a terrible apparition to them, that, after shouting
+the invitation, they jumped ashore, and left their canoe to drift down
+the stream. Chibisa was a remarkably shrewd man, the very image, save
+his dark hue, of one of our most celebrated London actors, {2} and the
+most intelligent chief, by far, in this quarter. A great deal of
+fighting had fallen to his lot, he said; but it was always others who
+began; he was invariably in the right, and they alone were to blame. He
+was moreover a firm believer in the divine right of kings. He was an
+ordinary man, he said, when his father died, and left him the
+chieftainship; but directly he succeeded to the high office, he was
+conscious of power passing into his head, and down his back; he felt it
+enter, and knew that he was a chief, clothed with authority, and
+possessed of wisdom; and people then began to fear and reverence him. He
+mentioned this, as one would a fact of natural history, any doubt being
+quite out of the question. His people, too, believed in him, for they
+bathed in the river without the slightest fear of crocodiles, the chief
+having placed a powerful medicine there, which protected them from the
+bite of these terrible reptiles.
+
+Leaving the vessel opposite Chibisa's village, Drs. Livingstone and Kirk
+and a number of the Makololo started on foot for Lake Shirwa. They
+travelled in a northerly direction over a mountainous country. The
+people were far from being well-disposed to them, and some of their
+guides tried to mislead them, and could not be trusted. Masakasa, a
+Makololo headman, overheard some remarks which satisfied him that the
+guide was leading them into trouble. He was quiet till they reached a
+lonely spot, when he came up to Dr. Livingstone, and said, "That fellow
+is bad, he is taking us into mischief; my spear is sharp, and there is no
+one here; shall I cast him into the long grass?" Had the Doctor given
+the slightest token of assent, or even kept silence, never more would any
+one have been led by that guide, for in a twinkling he would have been
+where "the wicked cease from troubling." It was afterwards found that in
+this case there was no treachery at all, but a want of knowledge on their
+part of the language and of the country. They asked to be led to "Nyanja
+Mukulu," or Great Lake, meaning, by this, Lake Shirwa; and the guide took
+them round a terribly rough piece of mountainous country, gradually
+edging away towards a long marsh, which from the numbers of those animals
+we had seen there we had called the Elephant Marsh, but which was really
+the place known to him by the name "Nyanja Mukulu," or Great Lake. Nyanja
+or Nyanza means, generally, a marsh, lake, river, or even a mere rivulet.
+
+The party pushed on at last without guides, or only with crazy ones; for,
+oddly enough, they were often under great obligations to the madmen of
+the different villages: one of these honoured them, as they slept in the
+open air, by dancing and singing at their feet the whole night. These
+poor fellows sympathized with the explorers, probably in the belief that
+they belonged to their own class; and, uninfluenced by the general
+opinion of their countrymen, they really pitied, and took kindly to the
+strangers, and often guided them faithfully from place to place, when no
+sane man could be hired for love or money.
+
+The bearing of the Manganja at this time was very independent; a striking
+contrast to the cringing attitude they afterwards assumed, when the cruel
+scourge of slave-hunting passed over their country. Signals were given
+from the different villages by means of drums, and notes of defiance and
+intimidation were sounded in the travellers' ears by day; and
+occasionally they were kept awake the whole night, in expectation of an
+instant attack. Drs. Livingstone and Kirk were desirous that nothing
+should occur to make the natives regard them as enemies; Masakasa, on the
+other hand, was anxious to show what he could do in the way of fighting
+them.
+
+The perseverance of the party was finally crowned with success; for on
+the 18th of April they discovered Lake Shirwa, a considerable body of
+bitter water, containing leeches, fish, crocodiles, and hippopotami. From
+having probably no outlet, the water is slightly brackish, and it appears
+to be deep, with islands like hills rising out of it. Their point of
+view was at the base of Mount Pirimiti or Mopeu-peu, on its S.S.W. side.
+Thence the prospect northwards ended in a sea horizon with two small
+islands in the distance--a larger one, resembling a hill-top and covered
+with trees, rose more in the foreground. Ranges of hills appeared on the
+east; and on the west stood Mount Chikala, which seems to be connected
+with the great mountain-mass called Zomba.
+
+The shore, near which they spent two nights, was covered with reeds and
+papyrus. Wishing to obtain the latitude by the natural horizon, they
+waded into the water some distance towards what was reported to be a
+sandbank, but were so assaulted by leeches, they were fain to retreat;
+and a woman told them that in enticing them into the water the men only
+wanted to kill them. The information gathered was that this lake was
+nothing in size compared to another in the north, from which it is
+separated by only a tongue of land. The northern end of Shirwa has not
+been seen, though it has been passed; the length of the lake may probably
+be 60 or 80 miles, and about 20 broad. The height above the sea is 1800
+feet, and the taste of the water is like a weak solution of Epsom salts.
+The country around is very beautiful, and clothed with rich vegetation;
+and the waves, at the time they were there breaking and foaming over a
+rock on the south-eastern side, added to the beauty of the picture.
+Exceedingly lofty mountains, perhaps 8000 feet above the sea-level, stand
+near the eastern shore. When their lofty steep-sided summits appear,
+some above, some below the clouds, the scene is grand. This range is
+called Milanje; on the west stands Mount Zomba, 7000 feet in height, and
+some twenty miles long.
+
+Their object being rather to gain the confidence of the people by degrees
+than to explore, they considered that they had advanced far enough into
+the country for one trip; and believing that they could secure their end
+by a repetition of their visit, as they had done on the Shire, they
+decided to return to the vessel at Dakanamoio island; but, instead of
+returning by the way they came, they passed down southwards close by
+Mount Chiradzuru, among the relatives of Chibisa, and thence by the pass
+Zedi, down to the Shire. The Kroomen had, while we were away, cut a good
+supply of wood for steaming, and we soon proceeded down the river.
+
+The steamer reached Tette on the 23rd of June, and, after undergoing
+repairs, proceeded to the Kongone to receive provisions from one of H.M.
+cruisers. We had been very abundantly supplied with first-rate stores,
+but were unfortunate enough to lose a considerable portion of them, and
+had now to bear the privation as best we could. On the way down, we
+purchased a few gigantic cabbages and pumpkins at a native village below
+Mazaro. Our dinners had usually consisted of but a single course; but we
+were surprised the next day by our black cook from Sierra Leone bearing
+in a second course. "What have you got there?" was asked in wonder. "A
+tart, sir." "A tart! of what is it made?" "Of cabbage, sir." As we had
+no sugar, and could not "make believe," as in the days of boyhood, we did
+not enjoy the feast that Tom's genius had prepared. Her Majesty's brig
+"Persian," Lieutenant Saumarez commanding, called on her way to the Cape;
+and, though somewhat short of provisions herself, generously gave us all
+she could spare. We now parted with our Kroomen, as, from their
+inability to march, we could not use them in our land journeys. A crew
+was picked out from the Makololo, who, besides being good travellers,
+could cut wood, work the ship, and required only native food.
+
+While at the Kongone it was found necessary to beach the steamer for
+repairs. She was built of a newly invented sort of steel plates, only a
+sixteenth of an inch in thickness, patented, but unfortunately never
+tried before. To build an exploring ship of untried material was a
+mistake. Some chemical action on this preparation of steel caused a
+minute hole; from this point, branches like lichens, or the little ragged
+stars we sometimes see in thawing ice, radiated in all directions. Small
+holes went through wherever a bend occurred in these branches. The
+bottom very soon became like a sieve, completely full of minute holes,
+which leaked perpetually. The engineer stopped the larger ones, but the
+vessel was no sooner afloat, than new ones broke out. The first news of
+a morning was commonly the unpleasant announcement of another leak in the
+forward compartment, or in the middle, which was worse still.
+
+Frequent showers fell on our way up the Zambesi, in the beginning of
+August. On the 8th we had upwards of three inches of rain, which large
+quantity, more than falls in any single rainy day during the season at
+Tette, we owed to being near the sea. Sometimes the cabin was nearly
+flooded; for, in addition to the leakage from below, rain poured through
+the roof, and an umbrella had to be used whenever we wished to write: the
+mode of coupling the compartments, too, was a new one, and the action of
+the hinder compartment on the middle one pumped up the water of the
+river, and sent it in streams over the floor and lockers, where lay the
+cushions which did double duty as chairs and beds. In trying to form an
+opinion of the climate, it must be recollected that much of the fever,
+from which we suffered, was caused by sleeping on these wet cushions.
+Many of the botanical specimens, laboriously collected and carefully
+prepared by Dr. Kirk, were destroyed, or double work imposed, by their
+accidentally falling into wet places in the cabin.
+
+About the middle of August, after cutting wood at Shamoara, we again
+steamed up the Shire, with the intention of becoming better acquainted
+with the people, and making another and longer journey on foot to the
+north of Lake Shirwa, in search of Lake Nyassa, of which we had already
+received some information, under the name Nyinyesi (the stars). The
+Shire is much narrower than the Zambesi, but deeper, and more easily
+navigated. It drains a low and exceedingly fertile valley of from
+fifteen to twenty miles in breadth. Ranges of wooded hills bound this
+valley on both sides. For the first twenty miles the hills on the left
+bank are close to the river; then comes Morambala, a detached mountain
+500 yards from the river's brink, which rises, with steep sides on the
+west, to 4000 feet in height, and is about seven miles in length. It is
+wooded up to the very top, and very beautiful. The southern end, seen
+from a distance, has a fine gradual slope, and looks as if it might be of
+easy ascent; but the side which faces the Shire is steep and rocky,
+especially in the upper half. A small village peeps out about halfway up
+the mountain; it has a pure and bracing atmosphere; and is perched above
+mosquito range. The people on the summit have a very different climate
+and vegetation from those of the plains; but they have to spend a great
+portion of their existence amidst white fleecy clouds, which, in the
+rainy season, rest daily on the top of their favourite mountain. We were
+kindly treated by these mountaineers on our first ascent; before our
+second they were nearly all swept away by Mariano. Dr. Kirk found
+upwards of thirty species of ferns on this and other mountains, and even
+good-sized tree-ferns; though scarcely a single kind is to be met with on
+the plains. Lemon and orange trees grew wild, and pineapples had been
+planted by the people. Many large hornbills, hawks, monkeys, antelopes,
+and rhinoceroses found a home and food among the great trees round its
+base. A hot fountain boils up on the plain near the north end. It
+bubbles out of the earth, clear as crystal, at two points, or eyes, a few
+yards apart from each other, and sends off a fine flowing stream of hot
+water. The temperature was found to be 174 degrees Fahr., and it boiled
+an egg in about the usual time. Our guide threw in a small branch to
+show us how speedily the Madse-awira (boiling water) could kill the
+leaves. Unlucky lizards and insects did not seem to understand the
+nature of a hot-spring, as many of their remains were lying at the
+bottom. A large beetle had alighted on the water, and been killed before
+it had time to fold its wings. An incrustation, smelling of sulphur, has
+been deposited by the water on the stones. About a hundred feet from the
+eye of the fountain the mud is as hot as can be borne by the body. In
+taking a bath there, it makes the skin perfectly clean, and none of the
+mud adheres: it is strange that the Portuguese do not resort to it for
+the numerous cutaneous diseases with which they are so often afflicted.
+
+A few clumps of the palm and acacia trees appear west of Morambala, on
+the rich plain forming the tongue of land between the rivers Shire and
+Zambesi. This is a good place for all sorts of game. The Zambesi canoe-
+men were afraid to sleep on it from the idea of lions being there; they
+preferred to pass the night on an island. Some black men, who
+accompanied us as volunteer workmen from Shupanga, called out one evening
+that a lion stood on the bank. It was very dark, and we could only see
+two sparkling lights, said to be the lion's eyes looking at us; for here,
+as elsewhere, they have a theory that the lion's eyes always flash fire
+at night. Not being fireflies--as they did not move when a shot was
+fired in their direction--they were probably glowworms.
+
+Beyond Morambala the Shire comes winding through an extensive marsh. For
+many miles to the north a broad sea of fresh green grass extends, and is
+so level, that it might be used for taking the meridian altitude of the
+sun. Ten or fifteen miles north of Morambala, stands the dome-shaped
+mountain Makanga, or Chi-kanda; several others with granitic-looking
+peaks stretch away to the north, and form the eastern boundary of the
+valley; another range, but of metamorphic rocks, commencing opposite
+Senna, bounds the valley on the west. After streaming through a portion
+of this marsh, we came to a broad belt of palm and other trees, crossing
+the fine plain on the right bank. Marks of large game were abundant.
+Elephants had been feeding on the palm nuts, which have a pleasant fruity
+taste, and are used as food by man. Two pythons were observed coiled
+together among the branches of a large tree, and were both shot. The
+larger of the two, a female, was ten feet long. They are harmless, and
+said to be good eating. The Makololo having set fire to the grass where
+they were cutting wood, a solitary buffalo rushed out of the
+conflagration, and made a furious charge at an active young fellow named
+Mantlanyane. Never did his fleet limbs serve him better than during the
+few seconds of his fearful flight before the maddened animal. When he
+reached the bank, and sprang into the river, the infuriated beast was
+scarcely six feet behind him. Towards evening, after the day's labour in
+wood-cutting was over, some of the men went fishing. They followed the
+common African custom of agitating the water, by giving it a few sharp
+strokes with the top of the fishing-rod, immediately after throwing in
+the line, to attract the attention of the fish to the bait. Having
+caught nothing, the reason assigned was the same as would have been given
+in England under like circumstances, namely, that "the wind made the fish
+cold, and they would not bite." Many gardens of maize, pumpkins, and
+tobacco, fringed the marshy banks as we went on. They belong to natives
+of the hills, who come down in the dry season, and raise a crop on parts
+at other times flooded. While the crops are growing, large quantities of
+fish are caught, chiefly _Clarias capensis_, and _Mugil Africanus_; they
+are dried for sale or future consumption.
+
+As we ascended, we passed a deep stream about thirty yards wide, flowing
+in from a body of open water several miles broad. Numbers of men were
+busy at different parts of it, filling their canoes with the lotus root,
+called _Nyika_, which, when boiled or roasted, resembles our chestnuts,
+and is extensively used in Africa as food. Out of this lagoon, and by
+this stream, the chief part of the duckweed of the Shire flows. The
+lagoon itself is called Nyanja ea Motope (Lake of Mud). It is also named
+Nyanja Pangono (Little Lake), while the elephant marsh goes by the name
+of Nyanja Mukulu (Great Lake). It is evident from the shore line still
+to be observed on the adjacent hills, that in ancient times these were
+really lakes, and the traditional names thus preserved are only another
+evidence of the general desiccation which Africa has undergone.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+
+The Steamer in difficulties--Elephant hunting--Arrival at
+Chibisa's--Search for Lake Nyassa--The Manganja country--Weavers and
+smelters--Lake Pamalombe.
+
+Late in the afternoon of the first day's steaming, after we left the
+wooding-place, we called at the village of Chikanda-Kadze, a female
+chief, to purchase rice for our men; but we were now in the blissful
+region where time is absolutely of no account, and where men may sit down
+and rest themselves when tired; so they requested us to wait till next
+day, and they would then sell us some food. As our forty black men,
+however, had nothing to cook for supper, we were obliged to steam on to
+reach a village a few miles above. When we meet those who care not
+whether we purchase or let it alone, or who think men ought only to be in
+a hurry when fleeing from an enemy, our ideas about time being money, and
+the power of the purse, receives a shock. The state of eager
+competition, which in England wears out both mind and body, and makes
+life bitter, is here happily unknown. The cultivated spots are mere dots
+compared to the broad fields of rich soil which is never either grazed or
+tilled. Pity that the plenty in store for all, from our Father's
+bountiful hands, is not enjoyed by more.
+
+The wretched little steamer could not carry all the hands we needed; so,
+to lighten her, we put some into the boats and towed them astern. In the
+dark, one of the boats was capsized; but all in it, except one poor
+fellow who could not swim, were picked up. His loss threw a gloom over
+us all, and added to the chagrin we often felt at having been so
+ill-served in our sorry craft.
+
+Next day we arrived at the village of Mboma (16 degrees 56 minutes 30
+seconds S.), where the people raised large quantities of rice, and were
+eager traders; the rice was sold at wonderfully low rates, and we could
+not purchase a tithe of the food brought for sale.
+
+A native minstrel serenaded us in the evening, playing several quaint
+tunes on a species of one stringed fiddle, accompanied by wild, but not
+unmusical songs. He told the Makololo that he intended to play all night
+to induce us to give him a present. The nights being cold, the
+thermometer falling to 47 degrees, with occasional fogs, he was asked if
+he was not afraid of perishing from cold; but, with the genuine spirit of
+an Italian organ-grinder, he replied, "Oh, no; I shall spend the night
+with my white comrades in the big canoe; I have often heard of the white
+men, but have never seen them till now, and I must sing and play well to
+them." A small piece of cloth, however, bought him off, and he moved
+away in good humour. The water of the river was 70 degrees at sunrise,
+which was 23 degrees warmer than the air at the same time, and this
+caused fogs, which rose like steam off the river. When this is the case
+cold bathing in the mornings at this time of the year is improper, for,
+instead of a glow on coming out, one is apt to get a chill; the air being
+so much colder than the water.
+
+A range of hills, commencing opposite Senna, comes to within two or three
+miles of Mboma village, and then runs in a north-westerly direction; the
+principal hill is named Malawe; a number of villages stand on its tree-
+covered sides, and coal is found cropping out in the rocks. The country
+improves as we ascend, the rich valley becoming less swampy, and adorned
+with a number of trees.
+
+Both banks are dotted with hippopotamus traps, over every track which
+these animals have made in going up out of the water to graze. The
+hippopotamus feeds on grass alone, and, where there is any danger, only
+at night. Its enormous lips act like a mowing-machine, and form a path
+of short-cropped grass as it feeds. We never saw it eat aquatic plants
+or reeds. The tusks seem weapons of both offence and defence. The
+hippopotamus trap consists of a beam five or six feet long, armed with a
+spear-head or hard-wood spike, covered with poison, and suspended to a
+forked pole by a cord, which, coming down to the path, is held by a
+catch, to be set free when the beast treads on it. Being wary brutes,
+they are still very numerous. One got frightened by the ship, as she was
+steaming close to the bank. In its eager hurry to escape it rushed on
+shore, and ran directly under a trap, when down came the heavy beam on
+its back, driving the poisoned spear-head a foot deep into its flesh. In
+its agony it plunged back into the river, to die in a few hours, and
+afterwards furnished a feast for the natives. The poison on the spear-
+head does not affect the meat, except the part around the wound, and that
+is thrown away. In some places the descending beam is weighted with
+heavy stones, but here the hard heavy wood is sufficient.
+
+"She is leaking worse than ever forward, sir, and there is a foot of
+water in the hold," was our first salutation on the morning of the 20th.
+But we have become accustomed to these things now; the cabin-floor is
+always wet, and one is obliged to mop up the water many times a day,
+giving some countenance to the native idea that Englishmen live in or on
+the water, and have no houses but ships. The cabin is now a favourite
+breeding-place for mosquitoes, and we have to support both the ship-bred
+and shore-bred bloodsuckers, of which several species show us their
+irritating attentions. A large brown sort, called by the Portuguese
+_mansos_ (tame), flies straight to its victim, and goes to work at once,
+as though it were an invited guest. Some of the small kinds carry
+uncommonly sharp lancets, and very potent poison. "What would these
+insects eat, if we did not pass this way?" becomes a natural question.
+
+The juices of plants, and decaying vegetable matter in the mud, probably
+form the natural food of mosquitoes, and blood is not necessary for their
+existence. They appear so commonly at malarious spots, that their
+presence may be taken as a hint to man to be off to more healthy
+localities. None appear on the high lands. On the low lands they swarm
+in myriads. The females alone are furnished with the biting apparatus,
+and their number appears to be out of all proportion in excess of the
+males. At anchor, on a still evening, they were excessively annoying;
+and the sooner we took refuge under our mosquito curtains, the better.
+The miserable and sleepless night that only one mosquito inside the
+curtain can cause, is so well known, and has been so often described,
+that it is needless to describe it here. One soon learns, from
+experience, that to beat out the curtains thoroughly before entering
+them, so that not one of these pests can possibly be harboured within, is
+the only safeguard against such severe trials to one's tranquillity and
+temper.
+
+A few miles above Mboma we came again to the village (16 degrees 44
+minutes 30 seconds S.) of the chief Tingane, the beat of whose war-drums
+can speedily muster some hundreds of armed men. The bows and poisoned
+arrows here are of superior workmanship to those below. Mariano's slave-
+hunting parties stood in great awe of these barbed arrows, and long kept
+aloof from Tingane's villages. His people were friendly enough with us
+now, and covered the banks with a variety of articles for sale. The
+majestic mountain, Chipirone, to which we have given the name of Mount
+Clarendon, now looms in sight, and further to the N.W. the southern end
+of the grand Milanje range rises in the form of an unfinished sphinx
+looking down on Lake Shirwa. The Ruo (16 degrees 31 minutes 0 seconds
+S.) is said to have its source in the Milanje mountains, and flows to the
+S.W., to join the Shire some distance above Tingane's. A short way
+beyond the Ruo lies the Elephant marsh, or Nyanja Mukulu, which is
+frequented by vast herds of these animals. We believe that we counted
+eight hundred elephants in sight at once. In the choice of such a strong
+hold, they have shown their usual sagacity, for no hunter can get near
+them through the swamps. They now keep far from the steamer; but, when
+she first came up, we steamed into the midst of a herd, and some were
+shot from the ship's deck. A single lesson was sufficient to teach them
+that the steamer was a thing to be avoided; and at the first glimpse they
+are now off two or three miles to the midst of the marsh, which is
+furrowed in every direction by wandering branches of the Shire. A fine
+young elephant was here caught alive, as he was climbing up the bank to
+follow his retreating dam. When laid hold of, he screamed with so much
+energy that, to escape a visit from the enraged mother, we steamed off,
+and dragged him through the water by the proboscis. As the men were
+holding his trunk over the gunwale, Monga, a brave Makololo
+elephant-hunter, rushed aft, and drew his knife across it in a sort of
+frenzy peculiar to the chase. The wound was skilfully sewn up, and the
+young animal soon became quite tame, but, unfortunately the breathing
+prevented the cut from healing, and he died in a few days from loss of
+blood. Had he lived, and had we been able to bring him home, he would
+have been the first _African_ elephant ever seen in England. The African
+male elephant is from ten to a little over eleven feet in height, and
+differs from the Asiatic species more particularly in the convex shape of
+his forehead, and the enormous size of his ears. In Asia many of the
+males, and all the females, are without tusks, but in Africa both sexes
+are provided with these weapons. The enamel in the molar teeth is
+arranged differently in the two species. By an admirable provision, new
+teeth constantly come up at the part where in man the wisdom teeth
+appear, and these push the others along, and out at the front end of the
+jaws, thus keeping the molars sound by renewal, till the animal attains a
+very great age. The tusks of animals from dry rocky countries are very
+munch more dense and heavier than those from wet and marshy districts,
+but the latter attain much the larger size.
+
+The Shire marshes support prodigious numbers of many kinds of water-fowl.
+An hour at the mast-head unfolds novel views of life in an African marsh.
+Near the edge, and on the branches of some favourite tree, rest scores of
+plotuses and cormorants, which stretch their snake-like necks, and in
+mute amazement turn one eye and then another towards the approaching
+monster. By and-by the timid ones begin to fly off, or take "headers"
+into the stream; but a few of the bolder, or more composed, remain, only
+taking the precaution to spread their wings ready for instant flight. The
+pretty ardetta (_Herodias bubulcus_), of a light yellow colour when at
+rest, but seemingly of a pure white when flying, takes wing, and sweeps
+across the green grass in large numbers, often showing us where buffaloes
+and elephants are, by perching on their backs. Flocks of ducks, of which
+the kind called "Soriri" (_Dendrocygna personata_) is most abundant,
+being night feeders, meditate quietly by the small lagoons, until
+startled by the noise of the steam machinery. Pelicans glide over the
+water, catching fish, while the Scopus (_Scopus umbretta_) and large
+herons peer intently into pools. The large black and white spur-winged
+goose (a constant marauder of native gardens) springs up, and circles
+round to find out what the disturbance can be, and then settles down
+again with a splash. Hundreds of Linongolos (_Anastomus lamelligerus_)
+rise on the wing from the clumps of reeds, or low trees (the
+_Eschinomena_, from which pith hats are made), on which they build in
+colonies, and are speedily high in mid-air. Charming little red and
+yellow weavers (_Ploceidae_) remind one of butterflies, as they fly in
+and out of the tall grass, or hang to the mouths of their pendent nests,
+chattering briskly to their mates within. These weavers seem to have
+"cock nests," built with only a roof, and a perch beneath, with a doorway
+on each side. The natives say they are made to protect the bird from the
+rain. Though her husband is very attentive, we have seen the hen bird
+tearing her mate's nest to pieces, but why we cannot tell. Kites and
+vultures are busy overhead, beating the ground for their repast of
+carrion; and the solemn-looking, stately-stepping Marabout, with a taste
+for dead fish, or men, stalks slowly along the almost stagnant channels.
+Groups of men and boys are searching diligently in various places for
+lotus and other roots. Some are standing in canoes, on the weed-covered
+ponds, spearing fish, while others are punting over the small
+intersecting streams, to examine their sunken fish-baskets.
+
+Towards evening, hundreds of pretty little hawks (_Erythropus
+vespertinus_) are seen flying in a southerly direction, and feeding on
+dragon-flies and locusts. They come, apparently, from resting on the
+palm-trees during the heat of the day. Flocks of scissor-bills
+(_Rhyncops_) are then also on the wing, and in search of food, ploughing
+the water with their lower mandibles, which are nearly half an inch
+longer than the upper ones.
+
+At the north-eastern end of the marsh, and about three miles from the
+river, commences a great forest of palm-trees (_Borassus AEthiopium_). It
+extends many miles, and at one point comes close to the river. The grey
+trunks and green tops of this immense mass of trees give a pleasing tone
+of colour to the view. The mountain-range, which rises close behind the
+palms, is generally of a cheerful green, and has many trees, with patches
+of a lighter tint among them, as if spots of land had once been
+cultivated. The sharp angular rocks and dells on its sides have the
+appearance of a huge crystal broken; and this is so often the case in
+Africa, that one can guess pretty nearly at sight whether a range is of
+the old crystalline rocks or not. The Borassus, though not an
+oil-bearing palm, is a useful tree. The fibrous pulp round the large
+nuts is of a sweet fruity taste, and is eaten by men and elephants. The
+natives bury the nuts until the kernels begin to sprout; when dug up and
+broken, the inside resembles coarse potatoes, and is prized in times of
+scarcity as nutritious food. During several months of the year, palm-
+wine, or sura, is obtained in large quantities; when fresh, it is a
+pleasant drink, somewhat like champagne, and not at all intoxicating;
+though, after standing a few hours, it becomes highly so. Sticks, a foot
+long, are driven into notches in the hard outside of the tree--the inside
+being soft or hollow--to serve as a ladder; the top of the fruit-shoot is
+cut off, and the sap, pouring out at the fresh wound, is caught in an
+earthen pot, which is hung at the point. A thin slice is taken off the
+end, to open the pores, and make the juice flow every time the owner
+ascends to empty the pot. Temporary huts are erected in the forest, and
+men and boys remain by their respective trees day and night; the nuts,
+fish, and wine, being their sole food. The Portuguese use the palm-wine
+as yeast, and it makes bread so light, that it melts in the mouth like
+froth.
+
+Beyond the marsh the country is higher, and has a much larger population.
+We passed a long line of temporary huts, on a plain on the right bank,
+with crowds of men and women hard at work making salt. They obtain it by
+mixing the earth, which is here highly saline, with water, in a pot with
+a small hole in it, and then evaporating the liquid, which runs through,
+in the sun. From the number of women we saw carrying it off in bags, we
+concluded that vast quantities must be made at these works. It is worth
+observing that on soils like this, containing salt, the cotton is of
+larger and finer staple than elsewhere. We saw large tracts of this rich
+brackish soil both in the Shire and Zambesi valleys, and hence, probably,
+sea-island cotton would do well; a single plant of it, reared by Major
+Sicard, flourished and produced the long staple and peculiar tinge of
+this celebrated variety, though planted only in the street at Tette; and
+there also a salt efflorescence appears, probably from decomposition of
+the rock, off which the people scrape it for use.
+
+The large village of the chief, Mankokwe, occupies a site on the right
+bank; he owns a number of fertile islands, and is said to be the Rundo,
+or paramount chief, of a large district. Being of an unhappy suspicious
+disposition, he would not see us; so we thought it best to move on,
+rather than spend time in seeking his favour.
+
+On the 25th August we reached Dakanamoio island, opposite the
+perpendicular bluff on which Chibisa's village stands; he had gone, with
+most of his people, to live near the Zambesi, but his headman was civil,
+and promised us guides and whatever else we needed. A few of the men
+were busy cleaning, sorting, spinning, and weaving cotton. This is a
+common sight in nearly every village, and each family appears to have its
+patch of cotton, as our own ancestors in Scotland had each his patch of
+flax. Near sunset an immense flock of the large species of horn-bill
+(_Buceros cristatus_) came here to roost on the great trees which skirt
+the edge of the cliff. They leave early in the morning, often before
+sunrise, for their feeding-places, coming and going in pairs. They are
+evidently of a loving disposition, and strongly attached to each other,
+the male always nestling close beside his mate. A fine male fell to the
+ground, from fear, at the report of Dr. Kirk's gun; it was caught and
+kept on board; the female did not go off in the mornings to feed with the
+others, but flew round the ship, anxiously trying, by her plaintive
+calls, to induce her beloved one to follow her: she came again in the
+evenings to repeat the invitations. The poor disconsolate captive soon
+refused to eat, and in five days died of grief, because he could not have
+her company. No internal injury could be detected after death.
+
+Chibisa and his wife, with a natural show of parental feeling, had told
+the Doctor, on his previous visit, that a few years before some of
+Chisaka's men had kidnapped and sold their little daughter, and that she
+was now a slave to the padre at Tette. On his return to Tette, the
+Doctor tried hard to ransom and restore the girl to her parents, and
+offered twice the value of a slave; the padre seemed willing, but she
+could not be found. This padre was better than the average men of the
+country; and, being always civil and obliging, would probably have
+restored her gratuitously, but she had been sold, it might be to the
+distant tribe Bazizulu, or he could not tell where. Custom had rendered
+his feelings callous, and Chibisa had to be told that his child would
+never return. It is this callous state of mind which leads some of our
+own blood to quote Scripture in support of slavery. If we could afford
+to take a backward step in civilization, we might find men among
+ourselves who would in like manner prove Mormonism or any other enormity
+to be divine.
+
+We left the ship on the 28th of August, 1859, for the discovery of Lake
+Nyassa. Our party numbered forty-two in all--four whites, thirty-six
+Makololo, and two guides. We did not actually need so many, either for
+carriage or defence; but took them because we believed that, human nature
+being everywhere the same, blacks are as ready as whites to take
+advantage of the weak, and are as civil and respectful to the powerful.
+We armed our men with muskets, which gave us influence, although it did
+not add much to our strength, as most of the men had never drawn a
+trigger, and in any conflict would in all probability have been more
+dangerous to us than the enemy.
+
+Our path crossed the valley, in a north-easterly direction, up the course
+of a beautiful flowing stream. Many of the gardens had excellent cotton
+growing in them. An hour's march brought us to the foot of the Manganja
+hills, up which lay the toilsome road. The vegetation soon changed; as
+we rose bamboos appeared, and new trees and plants were met with, which
+gave such incessant employment to Dr. Kirk, that he travelled the
+distance three times over. Remarkably fine trees, one of which has oil-
+yielding seeds, and belongs to the mahogany family, grow well in the
+hollows along the rivulet courses. The ascent became very fatiguing, and
+we were glad of a rest. Looking back from an elevation of a thousand
+feet, we beheld a lovely prospect. The eye takes in at a glance the
+valley beneath, and the many windings of its silver stream Makubula, or
+Kubvula, from the shady hill-side, where it emerges in foaming haste, to
+where it slowly glides into the tranquil Shire; then the Shire itself is
+seen for many a mile above and below Chibisa's, and the great level
+country beyond, with its numerous green woods; until the prospect, west
+and north-west, is bounded far away by masses of peaked and dome-shaped
+blue mountains, that fringe the highlands of the Maravi country.
+
+After a weary march we halted at Makolongwi, the village of Chitimba. It
+stands in a woody hollow on the first of the three terraces of the
+Manganja hills, and, like all other Manganja villages, is surrounded by
+an impenetrable hedge of poisonous euphorbia. This tree casts a deep
+shade, which would render it difficult for bowmen to take aim at the
+villagers inside. The grass does not grow beneath it, and this may be
+the reason why it is so universally used, for when dry the grass would
+readily convey fire to the huts inside; moreover, the hedge acts as a
+fender to all flying sparks. As strangers are wont to do, we sat down
+under some fine trees near the entrance of the village. A couple of
+mats, made of split reeds, were spread for the white men to sit on; and
+the headman brought a seguati, or present, of a small goat and a basket
+of meal. The full value in beads and cotton cloth was handed to him in
+return. He measured the cloth, doubled it, and then measured that again.
+The beads were scrutinized; he had never seen beads of that colour
+before, and should like to consult with his comrades before accepting
+them, and this, after repeated examinations and much anxious talk, he
+concluded to do. Meal and peas were then brought for sale. A fathom of
+blue cotton cloth, a full dress for man or woman, was produced. Our
+Makololo headman, Sininyane, thinking a part of it was enough for the
+meal, was proceeding to tear it, when Chitimba remarked that it was a
+pity to cut such a nice dress for his wife, he would rather bring more
+meal. "All right," said Sininyane; "but look, the cloth is very wide, so
+see that the basket which carries the meal be wide too, and add a cock to
+make the meal taste nicely." A brisk trade sprang up at once, each being
+eager to obtain as fine things as his neighbour,--and all were in good
+humour. Women and girls began to pound and grind meal, and men and boys
+chased the screaming fowls over the village, until they ran them down. In
+a few hours the market was completely glutted with every sort of native
+food; the prices, however, rarely fell, as they could easily eat what was
+not sold.
+
+We slept under the trees, the air being pheasant, and no mosquitoes on
+the hills. According to our usual plan of marching, by early dawn our
+camp was in motion. After a cup of coffee and a bit of biscuit we were
+on the way. The air was deliciously cool, and the path a little easier
+than that of yesterday. We passed a number of villages, occupying very
+picturesque spots among the hills, and in a few hours gained the upper
+terrace, 3000 feet above the level of the sea. The plateau lies west of
+the Milanje mountains, and its north-eastern border slopes down to Lake
+Shirwa. We were all charmed with the splendid country, and looked with
+never-failing delight on its fertile plains, its numerous hills, and
+majestic mountains. In some of the passes we saw bramble-berries
+growing; and the many other flowers, though of great beauty, did not
+remind us of youth and of home like the ungainly thorny bramble-bushes.
+We were a week in crossing the highlands in a northerly direction; then
+we descended into the Upper Shire Valley, which is nearly 1200 feet above
+the level of the sea. This valley is wonderfully fertile, and supports a
+large population. After leaving the somewhat flat-topped southern
+portion, the most prominent mountain of the Zomba range is Njongone,
+which has a fine stream running past its northern base. We were detained
+at the end of the chain some days by one of our companions being laid up
+with fever. One night we were suddenly aroused by buffaloes rushing
+close by the sick-bed. We were encamped by a wood on the border of a
+marsh, but our patient soon recovered, notwithstanding the unfavourable
+situation, and the poor accommodation.
+
+The Manganja country is delightfully well watered. The clear, cool,
+gushing streams are very numerous. Once we passed seven fine brooks and
+a spring in a single hour, and this, too, near the close of the dry
+season. Mount Zomba, which is twenty miles long, and from 7000 to 8000
+feet high, has a beautiful stream flowing through a verdant valley on its
+summit, and running away down into Lake Shirwa. The highlands are well
+wooded, and many trees, admirable for their height and timber, grow on
+the various watercourses. "Is this country good for cattle?" we inquired
+of a Makololo herdsman, whose occupation had given him skill in
+pasturage. "Truly," he replied, "do you not see abundance of those
+grasses which the cattle love, and get fat upon?" Yet the people have
+but few goats, and fewer sheep. With the exception of an occasional
+leopard, there are no beasts of prey to disturb domestic animals. Wool-
+sheep would, without doubt, thrive on these highlands. Part of the Upper
+Shire valley has a lady paramount, named Nyango; and in her dominions
+women rank higher and receive more respectful treatment than their
+sisters on the hills.
+
+The hill chief, Mongazi, called his wife to take charge of a present we
+had given him. She dropped down on her knees, clapping her hands in
+reverence, before and after receiving our presents from his lordly hands.
+It was painful to see the abject manner in which the women of the hill
+tribes knelt beside the path as we passed; but a great difference took
+place when we got into Nyango's country.
+
+On entering a village, we proceeded, as all strangers do, at once to the
+Boalo: mats of split reeds or bamboo were usually spread for us to sit
+on. Our guides then told the men who might be there, who we were, whence
+we had come, whither we wanted to go, and what were our objects. This
+information was duly carried to the chief, who, if a sensible man, came
+at once; but, if he happened to be timid and suspicious, waited until he
+had used divination, and his warriors had time to come in from outlying
+hamlets. When he makes his appearance, all the people begin to clap
+their hands in unison, and continue doing so till he sits down opposite
+to us. His counsellors take their places beside him. He makes a remark
+or two, and is then silent for a few seconds. Our guides then sit down
+in front of the chief and his counsellors, and both parties lean forward,
+looking earnestly at each other; the chief repeats a word, such as
+"Ambuiatu" (our Father, or master)--or "moio" (life), and all clap their
+hands. Another word is followed by two claps, a third by still more
+clapping, when each touches the ground with both hands placed together.
+Then all rise and lean forward with measured clap, and sit down again
+with clap, clap, clap, fainter, and still fainter, till the last dies
+away, or is brought to an end by a smart loud clap from the chief. They
+keep perfect time in this species of court etiquette. Our guides now
+tell the chief, often in blank verse, all they have already told his
+people, with the addition perhaps of their own suspicions of the
+visitors. He asks some questions, and then converses with us through the
+guides. Direct communication between the chief and the head of the
+stranger party is not customary. In approaching they often ask who is
+the spokesman, and the spokesman of the chief addresses the person
+indicated exclusively. There is no lack of punctilious good manners. The
+accustomed presents are exchanged with civil ceremoniousness; until our
+men, wearied and hungry, call out, "English do not buy slaves, they buy
+food," and then the people bring meal, maize, fowls, batatas, yams,
+beans, beer, for sale.
+
+The Manganja are an industrious race; and in addition to working in iron,
+cotton, and basket-making, they cultivate the soil extensively. All the
+people of a village turn out to labour in the fields. It is no uncommon
+thing to see men, women, and children hard at work, with the baby lying
+close by beneath a shady bush. When a new piece of woodland is to be
+cleared, they proceed exactly as farmers do in America. The trees are
+cut down with their little axes of soft native iron; trunks and branches
+are piled up and burnt, and the ashes spread on the soil. The corn is
+planted among the standing stumps which are left to rot. If grass land
+is to be brought under cultivation, as much tall grass as the labourer
+can conveniently lay hold of is collected together and tied into a knot.
+He then strikes his hoe round the tufts to sever the roots, and leaving
+all standing, proceeds until the whole ground assumes the appearance of a
+field covered with little shocks of corn in harvest. A short time before
+the rains begin, these grass shocks are collected in small heaps, covered
+with earth, and burnt, the ashes and burnt soil being used to fertilize
+the ground. Large crops of the mapira, or Egyptian dura (_Holcus
+sorghum_), are raised, with millet, beans, and ground-nuts; also patches
+of yams, rice, pumpkins, cucumbers, cassava, sweet potatoes, tobacco, and
+hemp, or bang (_Cannabis setiva_). Maize is grown all the year round.
+Cotton is cultivated at almost every village. Three varieties of cotton
+have been found in the country, namely, two foreign and one native. The
+"tonje manga," or foreign cotton, the name showing that it has been
+introduced, is of excellent quality, and considered at Manchester to be
+nearly equal to the best New Orleans. It is perennial, but requires
+replanting once in three years. A considerable amount of this variety is
+grown in the Upper and Lower Shire valleys. Every family of any
+importance owns a cotton patch which, from the entire absence of weeds,
+seemed to be carefully cultivated. Most were small, none seen on this
+journey exceeding half an acre; but on the former trip some were observed
+of more than twice that size.
+
+The "tonje cadja," or indigenous cotton, is of shorter staple, and feels
+in the hand like wool. This kind has to be planted every season in the
+highlands; yet, because it makes stronger cloth, many of the people
+prefer it to the foreign cotton; the third variety is not found here. It
+was remarked to a number of men near the Shire Lakelet, a little further
+on towards Nyassa, "You should plant plenty of cotton, and probably the
+English will come and buy it." "Truly," replied a far-travelled Babisa
+trader to his fellows, "the country is full of cotton, and if these
+people come to buy they will enrich us." Our own observation on the
+cotton cultivated convinced us that this was no empty flourish, but a
+fact. Everywhere we met with it, and scarcely ever entered a village
+without finding a number of men cleaning, spinning, and weaving. It is
+first carefully separated from the seed by the fingers, or by an iron
+roller, on a little block of wood, and rove out into long soft bands
+without twist. Then it receives its first twist on the spindle, and
+becomes about the thickness of coarse candlewick; after being taken off
+and wound into a large ball, it is given the final hard twist, and spun
+into a firm cop on the spindle again: all the processes being painfully
+slow.
+
+Iron ore is dug out of the hills, and its manufacture is the staple trade
+of the southern highlands. Each village has its smelting-house, its
+charcoal-burners, and blacksmiths. They make good axes, spears, needles,
+arrowheads, bracelets and anklets, which, considering the entire absence
+of machinery, are sold at surprisingly low rates; a hoe over two pounds
+in weight is exchanged for calico of about the value of fourpence. In
+villages near Lake Shirwa and elsewhere, the inhabitants enter pretty
+largely into the manufacture of crockery, or pottery, making by hand all
+sorts of cooking, water, and grain pots, which they ornament with
+plumbago found in the hills. Some find employment in weaving neat
+baskets from split bamboos, and others collect the fibre of the buaze,
+which grows abundantly on the hills, and make it into fish-nets. These
+they either use themselves, or exchange with the fishermen on the river
+or lakes for dried fish and salt. A great deal of native trade is
+carried on between the villages, by means of barter in tobacco, salt,
+dried fish, skins, and iron. Many of the men are intelligent-looking,
+with well-shaped heads, agreeable faces, and high foreheads. We soon
+learned to forget colour, and we frequently saw countenances resembling
+those of white people we had known in England, which brought back the
+looks of forgotten ones vividly before the mind. The men take a good
+deal of pride in the arrangement of their hair; the varieties of style
+are endless. One trains his long locks till they take the admired form
+of the buffalo's horns; others prefer to let their hair hang in a thick
+coil down their backs, like that animal's tail; while another wears it in
+twisted cords, which, stiffened by fillets of the inner bark of a tree
+wound spirally round each curl, radiate from the head in all directions.
+Some have it hanging all round the shoulders in large masses; others
+shave it off altogether. Many shave part of it into ornamental figures,
+in which the fancy of the barber crops out conspicuously. About as many
+dandies run to seed among the blacks as among the whites. The Man ganja
+adorn their bodies extravagantly, wearing rings on their fingers and
+thumbs, besides throatlets, bracelets, and anklets of brass, copper, or
+iron. But the most wonderful of ornaments, if such it may be called, is
+the pelele, or upper-lip ring of the women. The middle of the upper lip
+of the girls is pierced close to the septum of the nose, and a small pin
+inserted to prevent the puncture closing up. After it has healed, the
+pin is taken out and a larger one is pressed into its place, and so on
+successively for weeks, and months, and years. The process of increasing
+the size of the lip goes on till its capacity becomes so great that a
+ring of two inches diameter can be introduced with ease. All the
+highland women wear the pelele, and it is common on the Upper and Lower
+Shire. The poorer classes make them of hollow or of solid bamboo, but
+the wealthier of ivory or tin. The tin pelele is often made in the form
+of a small dish. The ivory one is not unlike a napkin-ring. No woman
+ever appears in public without the pelele, except in times of mourning
+for the dead. It is frightfully ugly to see the upper lip projecting two
+inches beyond the tip of the nose. When an old wearer of a hollow bamboo
+ring smiles, by the action of the muscles of the cheeks, the ring and lip
+outside it are dragged back and thrown above the eyebrows. The nose is
+seen through the middle of the ring, amid the exposed teeth show how
+carefully they have been chipped to look like those of a cat or
+crocodile. The pelele of an old lady, Chikanda Kadze, a chieftainess,
+about twenty miles north of Morambala, hung down below her chin, with, of
+course, a piece of the upper lip around its border. The labial letters
+cannot be properly pronounced, but the under lip has to do its best for
+them, against the upper teeth and gum. Tell them it makes them ugly;
+they had better throw it away; they reply, "Kodi! Really! it is the
+fashion." How this hideous fashion originated is an enigma. Can thick
+lips ever have been thought beautiful, and this mode of artificial
+enlargement resorted to in consequence? The constant twiddling of the
+pelele with the tongue by the younger women suggested the irreverent idea
+that it might have been invented to give safe employment to that little
+member. "Why do the women wear these things?" we inquired of the old
+chief, Chinsunse. Evidently surprised at such a stupid question, he
+replied, "For beauty, to be sure! Men have beards and whiskers; women
+have none; and what kind of creature would a woman be without whiskers,
+and without the pelele? She would have a mouth like a man, and no beard;
+ha! ha! ha!" Afterwards on the Rovuma, we found men wearing the pelele,
+as well as women. An idea suggested itself on seeing the effects of the
+slight but constant pressure exerted on the upper gum and front teeth, of
+which our medical brethren will judge the value. In many cases the upper
+front teeth, instead of the natural curve outwards, which the row
+presents, had been pressed so as to appear as if the line of alveoli in
+which they were planted had an inward curve. As this was produced by the
+slight pressure of the pelele backwards, persons with too prominent teeth
+might by slight, but long-continued pressure, by some appliance only as
+elastic as the lip, have the upper gum and teeth depressed, especially in
+youth, more easily than is usually imagined. The pressure should be
+applied to the upper gum more than to the teeth.
+
+The Manganja are not a sober people: they brew large quantities of beer,
+and like it well. Having no hops, or other means of checking
+fermentation, they are obliged to drink the whole brew in a few days, or
+it becomes unfit for use. Great merry-makings take place on these
+occasions, and drinking, drumming, and dancing continue day and night,
+till the beer is gone. In crossing the hills we sometimes found whole
+villages enjoying this kind of mirth. The veteran traveller of the party
+remarked, that he had not seen so much drunkenness during all the sixteen
+years he had spent in Africa. As we entered a village one afternoon, not
+a man was to be seen; but some women were drinking beer under a tree. In
+a few moments the native doctor, one of the innocents, "nobody's enemy
+but his own," staggered out of a hut, with his cupping-horn dangling from
+his neck, and began to scold us for a breach of etiquette. "Is this the
+way to come into a man's village, without sending him word that you are
+coming?" Our men soon pacified the fuddled but good-humoured medico,
+who, entering his beer-cellar, called on two of them to help him to carry
+out a huge pot of beer, which he generously presented to us. While the
+"medical practitioner" was thus hospitably employed, the chief awoke in a
+fright, and shouted to the women to run away, or they would all be
+killed. The ladies laughed at the idea of their being able to run away,
+and remained beside the beer-pots. We selected a spot for our camp, our
+men cooked the dinner as usual, and we were quietly eating it, when
+scores of armed men, streaming with perspiration, came pouring into the
+village. They looked at us, then at each other, and turning to the chief
+upbraided him for so needlessly sending for them. "These people are
+peaceable; they do not hurt you; you are killed with beer:" so saying,
+they returned to their homes.
+
+Native beer has a pinkish colour, and the consistency of gruel. The
+grain is made to vegetate, dried in the sun, pounded into meal, and
+gently boiled. When only a day or two old, the beer is sweet, with a
+slight degree of acidity, which renders it a most grateful beverage in a
+hot climate, or when fever begets a sore craving for acid drinks. A
+single draught of it satisfies this craving at once. Only by deep and
+long-continued potations can intoxication be produced: the grain being in
+a minutely divided state, it is a good way of consuming it, and the
+decoction is very nutritious. At Tette a measure of beer is exchanged
+for an equal-sized pot full of grain. A present of this beer, so
+refreshing to our dark comrades, was brought to us in nearly every
+village. Beer-drinking does not appear to produce any disease, or to
+shorten life on the hills. Never before did we see so many old, grey-
+headed men and women; leaning on their staves they came with the others
+to see the white men. The aged chief, Muata Manga, could hardly have
+been less than ninety years of age; his venerable appearance struck the
+Makololo. "He is an old man," said they, "a very old man; his skin hangs
+in wrinkles, just like that on elephants' hips." "Did you never," he was
+asked, "have a fit of travelling come over you; a desire to see other
+lands and people?" No, he had never felt that, and had never been far
+from home in his life. For long life they are not indebted to frequent
+ablutions. An old man told us that he remembered to have washed once in
+his life, but it was so long since that he had forgotten how it felt.
+"Why do you wash?" asked Chinsunse's women of the Makololo; "our men
+never do."
+
+The superstitious ordeal, by drinking the poisonous muave, obtains credit
+here; and when a person is suspected of crime, this ordeal is resorted
+to. If the stomach rejects the poison, the accused is pronounced
+innocent; but if it is retained, guilt is believed to be demonstrated.
+Their faith is so firm in its discriminating power, that the supposed
+criminal offers of his own accord to drink it, and even chiefs are not
+exempted. Chibisa, relying on its efficacy, drank it several times, in
+order to vindicate his character. When asserting that all his wars had
+been just, it was hinted that, as every chief had the same tale of
+innocence to tell, we ought to suspend our judgment. "If you doubt my
+word," said he, "give me the muave to drink." A chief at the foot of
+Mount Zomba successfully went through the ordeal the day we reached his
+village; and his people manifested their joy at his deliverance by
+drinking beer, dancing, and drumming for two days and nights. It is
+possible that the native doctor, who mixes the ingredients of the
+poisoned bowl, may be able to save those whom he considers innocent; but
+it is difficult to get the natives to speak about the matter, and no one
+is willing to tell what the muave poison consists of. We have been shown
+trees said to be used, but had always reason to doubt the accuracy of our
+informants. We once found a tree in a village, with many pieces of the
+bark chipped off, closely allied to the Tangena or Tanghina, the ordeal
+poison tree of Madagascar; but we could not ascertain any particulars
+about it. Death is inflicted on those found guilty of witchcraft, by the
+muave.
+
+The women wail for the dead two days. Seated on the ground they chant a
+few plaintive words, and end each verse with the prolonged sound of a--a,
+or o--o, or ea-ea-ea--a. Whatever beer is in the house of the deceased,
+is poured out on the ground with the meal, and all cooking and water pots
+are broken, as being of no further use. Both men and women wear signs of
+mourning for their dead relatives. These consist of narrow strips of the
+palm-leaf wound round the head, the arms, legs, neck, and breasts, and
+worn till they drop off from decay. They believe in the existence of a
+supreme being, called Mpambe, and also Morungo, and in a future state.
+"We live only a few days here," said old Chinsunse, "but we live again
+after death: we do not know where, or in what condition, or with what
+companions, for the dead never return to tell us. Sometimes the dead do
+come back, and appear to us in dreams; but they never speak nor tell us
+where they have gone, nor how they fare."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+
+The Upper Shire--Discovery of Lake Nyassa--Distressing exploration--Return
+to Zambesi--Unpleasant visitors--Start for Sekeletu's Country in the
+interior.
+
+Our path followed the Shire above the cataracts, which is now a broad
+deep river, with but little current. It expands in one place into a
+lakelet, called Pamalombe, full of fine fish, and ten or twelve miles
+long by five or six in breadth. Its banks are low, and a dense wall of
+papyrus encircles it. On its western shore rises a range of hills
+running north. On reaching the village of the chief Muana-Moesi, and
+about a day's march distant from Nyassa, we were told that no lake had
+ever been heard of there; that the River Shire stretched on as we saw it
+now to a distance of "two months," and then came out from between
+perpendicular rocks, which towered almost to the skies. Our men looked
+blank at this piece of news, and said, "Let us go back to the ship, it is
+of no use trying to find the lake." "We shall go and see those wonderful
+rocks at any rate," said the Doctor. "And when you see them," replied
+Masakasa, "you will just want to see something else. But there _is_ a
+lake," rejoined Masakasa, "for all their denying it, for it is down in a
+book." Masakasa, having unbounded faith in whatever was in a book, went
+and scolded the natives for telling him an untruth. "There is a lake,"
+said he, "for how could the white men know about it in a book if it did
+not exist?" They then admitted that there was a lake a few miles off.
+Subsequent inquiries make it probable that the story of the
+"perpendicular rocks" may have had reference to a fissure, known to both
+natives and Arabs, in the north-eastern portion of the lake. The walls
+rise so high that the path along the bottom is said to be underground. It
+is probably a crack similar to that which made the Victoria Falls, and
+formed the Shire Valley.
+
+The chief brought a small present of meal in the evening, and sat with us
+for a few minutes. On leaving us he said that he wished we might sleep
+well. Scarce had he gone, when a wild sad cry arose from the river,
+followed by the shrieking of women. A crocodile had carried off his
+principal wife, as she was bathing. The Makololo snatched up their arms,
+and rushed to the bank, but it was too late, she was gone. The wailing
+of the women continued all night, and next morning we met others coming
+to the village to join in the general mourning. Their grief was
+evidently heartfelt, as we saw the tears coursing down their cheeks. In
+reporting this misfortune to his neighbours, Muana-Moesi said, "that
+white men came to his village; washed themselves at the place where his
+wife drew water and bathed; rubbed themselves with a white medicine
+(soap); and his wife, having gone to bathe afterwards, was taken by a
+crocodile; he did not know whether in consequence of the medicine used or
+not." This we could not find fault with. On our return we were viewed
+with awe, and all the men fled at our approach; the women remained; and
+this elicited the remark from our men, "The women have the advantage of
+men, in not needing to dread the spear." The practice of bathing, which
+our first contact with Chinsunse's people led us to believe was unknown
+to the natives, we afterwards found to be common in other parts of the
+Manganja country.
+
+We discovered Lake Nyassa a little before noon of the 16th September,
+1859. Its southern end is in 14 degrees 25 minutes S. Lat., and 35
+degrees 30 minutes E. Long. At this point the valley is about twelve
+miles wide. There are hills on both sides of the lake, but the haze from
+burning grass prevented us at the time from seeing far. A long time
+after our return from Nyassa, we received a letter from Captain R. B.
+Oldfield, R.N., then commanding H.M.S. "Lyra," with the information that
+Dr. Roscher, an enterprising German who unfortunately lost his life in
+his zeal for exploration, had also reached the Lake, but on the 19th
+November following our discovery; and on his arrival had been informed by
+the natives that a party of white men were at the southern extremity. On
+comparing dates (16th September and 19th November) we were about two
+months before Dr. Roscher.
+
+It is not known where Dr. Roscher first saw its waters; as the exact
+position of Nusseewa on the borders of the Lake, where he lived some
+time, is unknown. He was three days north-east of Nusseewa, and on the
+Arab road back to the usual crossing-place of the Rovuma, when he was
+murdered. The murderers were seized by one of the chiefs, sent to
+Zanzibar, and executed. He is said to have kept his discoveries to
+himself, with the intention of publishing in Europe the whole at once, in
+a splendid book of travels.
+
+The chief of the village near the confluence of the Lake and River Shire,
+an old man, called Mosauka, hearing that we were sitting under a tree,
+came and kindly invited us to his village. He took us to a magnificent
+banyan-tree, of which he seemed proud. The roots had been trained down
+to the ground into the form of a gigantic arm-chair, without the seat.
+Four of us slept in the space betwixt its arms. Mosauka brought us a
+present of a goat and basket of meal "to comfort our hearts." He told us
+that a large slave party, led by Arabs, were encamped close by. They had
+been up to Cazembe's country the past year, and were on their way back,
+with plenty of slaves, ivory, and malachite. In a few minutes half a
+dozen of the leaders came over to see us. They were armed with long
+muskets, and, to our mind, were a villanous-looking lot. They evidently
+thought the same of us, for they offered several young children for sale,
+but, when told that we were English, showed signs of fear, and decamped
+during the night. On our return to the Kongone, we found that H.M.S.
+"Lynx" had caught some of these very slaves in a dhow; for a woman told
+us she first saw us at Mosauka's, and that the Arabs had fled for fear of
+an _uncanny_ sort of Basungu.
+
+This is one of the great slave-paths from the interior, others cross the
+Shire a little below, and some on the lake itself. We might have
+released these slaves but did not know what to do with them afterwards.
+On meeting men, led in slave-sticks, the Doctor had to bear the
+reproaches of the Makololo, who never slave, "Ay, you call us bad, but
+are we yellow-hearted, like these fellows--why won't you let us choke
+them?" To liberate and leave them, would have done but little good, as
+the people of the surrounding villages would soon have seized them, and
+have sold them again into slavery. The Manganja chiefs sell their own
+people, for we met Ajawa and slave-dealers in several highland villages,
+who had certainly been encouraged to come among them for slaves. The
+chiefs always seemed ashamed of the traffic, and tried to excuse
+themselves. "We do not sell many, and only those who have committed
+crimes." As a rule the regular trade is supplied by the low and criminal
+classes, and hence the ugliness of slaves. Others are probably sold
+besides criminals, as on the accusation of witchcraft. Friendless
+orphans also sometimes disappear suddenly, and no one inquires what has
+become of them. The temptation to sell their people is peculiarly great,
+as there is but little ivory on the hills, and often the chief has
+nothing but human flesh with which to buy foreign goods. The Ajawa offer
+cloth, brass rings, pottery, and sometimes handsome young women, and
+agree to take the trouble of carrying off by night all those whom the
+chief may point out to them. They give four yards of cotton cloth for a
+man, three for a woman, and two for a boy or girl, to be taken to the
+Portuguese at Mozambique, Iboe, and Quillimane.
+
+The Manganja were more suspicious and less hospitable than the tribes on
+the Zambesi. They were slow to believe that our object in coming into
+their country was really what we professed it to be. They naturally
+judge us by the motives which govern themselves. A chief in the Upper
+Shire Valley, whose scared looks led our men to christen him Kitlabolawa
+(I shall be killed), remarked that parties had come before, with as
+plausible a story as ours, and, after a few days, had jumped up and
+carried off a number of his people as slaves. We were not allowed to
+enter some of the villages in the valley, nor would the inhabitants even
+sell us food; Zimika's men, for instance, stood at the entrance of the
+euphorbia hedge, and declared we should not pass in. We sat down under a
+tree close by. A young fellow made an angry oration, dancing from side
+to side with his bow and poisoned arrows, and gesticulating fiercely in
+our faces. He was stopped in the middle of his harangue by an old man,
+who ordered him to sit down, and not talk to strangers in that way; he
+obeyed reluctantly, scowling defiance, and thrusting out his large lips
+very significantly. The women were observed leaving the village; and,
+suspecting that mischief might ensue, we proceeded on our journey, to the
+great disgust of our men. They were very angry with the natives for
+their want of hospitality to strangers, and with us, because we would not
+allow them to give "the things a thrashing." "This is what comes of
+going with white men," they growled out; "had we been with our own chief,
+we should have eaten their goats to-night, and had some of themselves to
+carry the bundles for us to-morrow." On our return by a path which left
+his village on our right, Zimika sent to apologize, saying that "he was
+ill, and in another village at the time; it was not by his orders we were
+sent away; his men did not know that we were a party wishing the land to
+dwell in peace."
+
+We were not able, when hastening back to the men left in the ship, to
+remain in the villages belonging to this chief; but the people came after
+us with things for sale, and invited us to stop, and spend the night with
+them, urging, "Are we to have it said that white people passed through
+our country and we did not see them?" We rested by a rivulet to gratify
+these sight-seers. We appear to them to be red rather than white; and,
+though light colour is admired among themselves, our clothing renders us
+uncouth in aspect. Blue eyes appear savage, and a red beard hideous.
+From the numbers of aged persons we saw on the highlands, and the
+increase of mental and physical vigour we experienced on our ascent from
+the lowlands, we inferred that the climate was salubrious, and that our
+countrymen might there enjoy good health, and also be of signal benefit,
+by leading the multitude of industrious inhabitants to cultivate cotton,
+buaze, sugar, and other valuable produce, to exchange for goods of
+European manufacture; at the same time teaching them, by precept and
+example, the great truths of our Holy Religion.
+
+Our stay at the Lake was necessarily short. We had found that the best
+plan for allaying any suspicions, that might arise in the minds of a
+people accustomed only to slave-traders, was to pay a hasty visit, and
+then leave for a while, and allow the conviction to form among the people
+that, though our course of action was so different from that of others,
+we were not dangerous, but rather disposed to be friendly. We had also a
+party at the vessel, and any indiscretion on their part might have proved
+fatal to the character of the Expedition.
+
+The trade of Cazembe and Katanga's country, and of other parts of the
+interior, crosses Nyassa and the Shire, on its way to the Arab port,
+Kilwa, and the Portuguese ports of Iboe and Mozambique. At present,
+slaves, ivory, malachite, and copper ornaments, are the only articles of
+commerce. According to information collected by Colonel Rigby at
+Zanzibar, and from other sources, nearly all the slaves shipped from the
+above-mentioned ports come from the Nyassa district. By means of a small
+steamer, purchasing the ivory of the Lake and River above the cataracts,
+which together have a shore-line of at least 600 miles, the slave-trade
+in this quarter would be rendered unprofitable,--for it is only by the
+ivory being carried by the slaves, that the latter do not eat up all the
+profits of a trip. An influence would be exerted over an enormous area
+of country, for the Mazitu about the north end of the Lake will not allow
+slave-traders to pass round that way through their country. They would
+be most efficient allies to the English, and might themselves be
+benefited by more intercourse. As things are now, the native traders in
+ivory and malachite have to submit to heavy exactions; and if we could
+give them the same prices which they at present get after carrying their
+merchandise 300 miles beyond this to the Coast, it might induce them to
+return without going further. It is only by cutting off the supplies in
+the interior, that we can crush the slave-trade on the Coast. The plan
+proposed would stop the slave-trade from the Zambesi on one side and
+Kilwa on the other; and would leave, beyond this tract, only the
+Portuguese port of Inhambane on the south, and a portion of the Sultan of
+Zanzibar's dominion on the north, for our cruisers to look after. The
+Lake people grow abundance of cotton for their own consumption, and can
+sell it for a penny a pound or even less. Water-carriage exists by the
+Shire and Zambesi all the way to England, with the single exception of a
+portage of about thirty-five miles past the Murchison Cataracts, along
+which a road of less than forty miles could be made at a trifling
+expense; and it seems feasible that a legitimate and thriving trade
+might, in a short time, take the place of the present unlawful traffic.
+
+Colonel Rigby, Captains Wilson, Oldfield, and Chapman, and all the most
+intelligent officers on the Coast, were unanimous in the belief, that one
+small vessel on the Lake would have decidedly more influence, and do more
+good in suppressing the slave-trade, than half a dozen men-of-war on the
+ocean. By judicious operations, therefore, on a small scale inland,
+little expense would be incurred, and the English slave-trade policy on
+the East would have the same fair chance of success, as on the West
+Coast.
+
+After a land-journey of forty days, we returned to the ship on the 6th of
+October, 1859, in a somewhat exhausted condition, arising more from a
+sort of poisoning, than from the usual fatigue of travel. We had taken a
+little mulligatawney paste, for making soup, in case of want of time to
+cook other food. Late one afternoon, at the end of an unusually long
+march, we reached Mikena, near the base of Mount Njongone to the north of
+Zomba, and the cook was directed to use a couple of spoonfuls of the
+paste; but, instead of doing so, he put in the whole potful. The soup
+tasted rather hot, but we added boiled rice to it, and, being very
+hungry, partook freely of it; and, in consequence of the overdose, we
+were delayed several days in severe suffering, and some of the party did
+not recover till after our return to the ship. Our illness may partly
+have arisen from another cause. One kind of cassava (_Jatropha maligna_)
+is known to be, in its raw state, poisonous, but by boiling it carefully
+in two waters, which must be thrown off, the poison is extracted and the
+cassava rendered fit for food. The poisonous sort is easily known by
+raising a bit of the bark of the root, and putting the tongue to it. A
+bitter taste shows poison, but it is probable that even the sweet kind
+contains an injurious principle. The sap, which, like that of our
+potatoes, is injurious as an article of food, is used in the "Pepper-pot"
+of the West Indies, under the name of "Cassereep," as a perfect
+preservative of meat. This juice put into an earthen vessel with a
+little water and Chili pepper is said to keep meat, that is immersed in
+it, good for a great length of time; even for years. No iron or steel
+must touch the mixture, or it will become sour. This "Pepper-pot," of
+which we first heard from the late Archbishop Whately, is a most
+economical meat-safe in a hot climate; any beef, mutton, pork, or fowl
+that may be left at dinner, if put into the mixture and a little fresh
+cassereep added, keeps perfectly, though otherwise the heat of the
+climate or flies would spoil it. Our cook, however, boiled the cassava
+root as he was in the habit of cooking meat, namely, by filling the pot
+with it, and then pouring in water, which he allowed to stand on the fire
+until it had become absorbed and boiled away. This method did not expel
+the poisonous properties of the root, or render it wholesome; for,
+notwithstanding our systematic caution in purchasing only the harmless
+sort, we suffered daily from its effects, and it was only just before the
+end of our trip that this pernicious mode of boiling it was discovered by
+us.
+
+In ascending 3000 feet from the lowlands to the highlands, or on reaching
+the low valley of the Shire from the higher grounds, the change of
+climate was very marked. The heat was oppressive below, the thermometer
+standing at from 84 degrees to 103 degrees in the shade; and our spirits
+were as dull and languid as they had been exhilarated on the heights in a
+temperature cooler by some 20 degrees. The water of the river was
+sometimes 84 degrees or higher, whilst that we had been drinking in the
+hill streams was only 65 degrees.
+
+It was found necessary to send two of our number across from the Shire to
+Tette; and Dr. Kirk, with guides from Chibisa, and accompanied by Mr.
+Rae, the engineer, accomplished the journey. We had found the country to
+the north and east so very well watered, that no difficulty was
+anticipated in this respect in a march of less than a hundred miles; but
+on this occasion our friends suffered severely. The little water to be
+had at this time of the year, by digging in the beds of dry watercourses,
+was so brackish as to increase thirst--some of the natives indeed were
+making salt from it; and when at long intervals a less brackish supply
+was found, it was nauseous and muddy from the frequent visits of large
+game. The tsetse abounded. The country was level, and large tracts of
+it covered with mopane forest, the leaves of which afford but scanty
+shade to the baked earth, so that scarcely any grass grows upon it. The
+sun was so hot, that the men frequently jumped from the path, in the vain
+hope of cooling, for a moment, their scorched feet under the almost
+shadeless bushes; and the native who carried the provision of salt pork
+got lost, and came into Tette two days after the rest of the party, with
+nothing but the fibre of the meat left, the fat, melted by the blazing
+sun, having all run down his back. This path was soon made a highway for
+slaving parties by Captain Raposo, the Commandant. The journey nearly
+killed our two active young friends; and what the slaves must have since
+suffered on it no one can conceive; but slaving probably can never be
+conducted without enormous suffering and loss of life.
+
+Mankokwe now sent a message to say that he wished us to stop at his
+village on our way down. He came on board on our arrival there with a
+handsome present, and said that his young people had dissuaded him from
+visiting us before; but now he was determined to see what every one else
+was seeing. A bald square-headed man, who had been his Prime Minister
+when we came up, was now out of office, and another old man, who had
+taken his place accompanied the chief. In passing the Elephant Marsh, we
+saw nine large herds of elephants; they sometimes formed a line two miles
+long.
+
+On the 2nd of November we anchored off Shamoara, and sent the boat to
+Senna for biscuit and other provisions. Senhor Ferrao, with his wonted
+generosity, gave us a present of a bullock, which he sent to us in a
+canoe. Wishing to know if a second bullock would be acceptable to us, he
+consulted his Portuguese and English dictionary, and asked the sailor in
+charge if he would take _another_; but Jack, mistaking the Portuguese
+pronunciation of the letter h, replied, "Oh no, sir, thank you, I don't
+want an _otter_ in the boat, they are such terrible biters!"
+
+We had to ground the vessel on a shallow sandbank every night; she leaked
+so fast, that in deep water she would have sunk, and the pump had to be
+worked all day to keep her afloat. Heavy rains fell daily, producing the
+usual injurious effects in the cabin; and, unable to wait any longer for
+our associates, who had gone overland from the Shire to Tette, we ran
+down the Kongone and beached her for repairs. Her Majesty's ship "Lynx,"
+Lieut. Berkeley commanding, called shortly afterwards with supplies; the
+bar, which had been perfectly smooth for some time before, became rather
+rough just before her arrival, so that it was two or three days before
+she could communicate with us. Two of her boats tried to come in on the
+second day, and one of them, mistaking the passage, capsized in the heavy
+breakers abreast of the island. Mr. Hunt, gunner, the officer in charge
+of the second boat, behaved nobly, and by his skilful and gallant conduct
+succeeded in rescuing every one of the first boat's crew. Of course the
+things that they were bringing to us were lost, but we were thankful that
+all the men were saved. The loss of the mail-bags, containing Government
+despatches and our friends' letters for the past year, was felt severely,
+as we were on the point of starting on an expedition into the interior,
+which might require eight or nine months; and twenty months is a weary
+time to be without news of friends and family. In the repairing of our
+crazy craft, we received kind and efficient aid from Lieutenant Berkeley,
+and we were enabled to leave for Tette on December 16th.
+
+We had now frequent rains, and the river rose considerably; our progress
+up the stream was distressingly slow, and it was not until the 2nd of
+February, 1860, that we reached Tette. Mr. Thornton returned on the same
+day from a geological tour, by which some Portuguese expected that a
+fabulous silver-mine would be rediscovered. The tradition in the country
+is, that the Jesuits formerly knew and worked a precious lode at Chicova.
+Mr. Thornton had gone beyond Zumbo, in company with a trader of colour;
+he soon after this left the Zambesi and, joining the expedition of the
+Baron van der Decken, explored the snow mountain Kilimanjaro, north-west
+of Zanzibar. Mr. Thornton's companion, the trader, brought back much
+ivory, having found it both abundant and cheap. He was obliged, however,
+to pay heavy fines to the Banyai and other tribes, in the country which
+is coolly claimed in Europe as Portuguese. During this trip of six
+mouths 200 pieces of cotton cloth of sixteen yards each, besides beads
+and brass wire, were paid to the different chiefs, for leave to pass
+through their country. In addition to these sufficiently weighty
+exactions, the natives of _this dominion_ have got into the habit of
+imposing fines for alleged milandos, or crimes, which the traders' men
+may have unwittingly committed. The merchants, however, submit rather
+than run the risk of fighting.
+
+The general monotony of existence at Tette is sometimes relieved by an
+occasional death or wedding. When the deceased is a person of
+consequence, the quantity of gunpowder his slaves are allowed to expend
+is enormous. The expense may, in proportion to their means, resemble
+that incurred by foolishly gaudy funerals in England. When at Tette, we
+always joined with sympathizing hearts in aiding, by our presence at the
+last rites, to soothe the sorrows of the surviving relatives. We are
+sure that they would have done the same to us had we been the mourners.
+We never had to complain of want of hospitality. Indeed, the great
+kindness shown by many of whom we have often spoken, will never be
+effaced from our memory till our dying day. When we speak of their
+failings it is in sorrow, not in anger. Their trading in slaves is an
+enormous mistake. Their Government places them in a false position by
+cutting them off from the rest of the world; and of this they always
+speak with a bitterness which, were it heard, might alter the tone of the
+statesmen of Lisbon. But here there is no press, no booksellers' shops,
+and scarcely a schoolmaster. Had we been born in similar untoward
+circumstances--we tremble to think of it!
+
+The weddings are celebrated with as much jollity as weddings are
+anywhere. We witnessed one in the house of our friend the Padre. It
+being the marriage of his goddaughter, he kindly invited us to be
+partakers in his joy; and we there became acquainted with old Donna
+Engenia, who was a married wife and had children, when the slaves came
+from Cassange, before any of us were born. The whole merry-making was
+marked by good taste amid propriety.
+
+About the only interesting object in the vicinity of Tette is the coal a
+few miles to the north. There, in the feeders of the stream Revubue, it
+crops out in cliff sections. The seams are from four to seven feet in
+thickness; one measured was found to be twenty-five feet thick.
+
+Learning that it would be difficult for our party to obtain food beyond
+Kebrabasa before the new crop came in and knowing the difficulty of
+hunting for so many men in the wet season, we decided on deferring our
+departure for the interior until May, and in the mean time to run down
+once more to the Kongone, in the hopes of receiving letters and
+despatches from the man-of-war that was to call in March. We left Tette
+on the 10th, and at Senna heard that our lost mail had been picked up on
+the beach by natives, west of the Milambe; carried to Quillimane, sent
+thence to Senna, and, passing us somewhere on the river, on to Tette. At
+Shupanga the governor informed us that it was a very large mail; no great
+comfort, seeing it was away up the river.
+
+Mosquitoes were excessively troublesome at the harbour, and especially
+when a light breeze blew from the north over the mangroves. We lived for
+several weeks in small huts, built by our men. Those who did the hunting
+for the party always got wet, and were attacked by fever, but generally
+recovered in time to be out again before the meat was all consumed. No
+ship appearing, we started off on the 15th of March, and stopped to wood
+on the Luabo, near an encampment of hippopotamus hunters; our men heard
+again, through them, of the canoe path from this place to Quillimane, but
+they declined to point it out.
+
+We found our friend Major Sicard at Mazaro with picks, shovels, hurdles,
+and slaves, having come to build a fort and custom-house at the Kongone.
+As we had no good reason to hide the harbour, but many for its being made
+known, we supplied him with a chart of the tortuous branches, which,
+running among the mangroves, perplex the search; and with such directions
+as would enable him to find his way down to the river. He had brought
+the relics of our fugitive mail, and it was a disappointment to find that
+all had been lost, with the exception of a bundle of old newspapers, two
+photographs, and three letters, which had been written before we left
+England.
+
+The distance from Mazaro, on the Zambesi side, to the Kwakwa at Nterra,
+is about six miles, over a surprisingly rich dark soil. We passed the
+night in the long shed, erected at Nterra, on the banks of this river,
+for the use of travellers, who have often to wait several days for
+canoes; we tried to sleep, but the mosquitoes and rats were so
+troublesome as to render sleep impossible. The rats, or rather large
+mice, closely resembling _Mus pumilio_ (Smith), of this region, are quite
+facetious, and, having a great deal of fun in them, often laugh heartily.
+Again and again they woke us up by scampering over our faces, and then
+bursting into a loud laugh of He! he! he! at having performed the feat.
+Their sense of the ludicrous appears to be exquisite; they screamed with
+laughter at the attempts which disturbed and angry human nature made in
+the dark to bring their ill-timed merriment to a close. Unlike their
+prudent European cousins, which are said to leave a sinking ship, a party
+of these took up their quarters in our leaky and sinking vessel. Quiet
+and invisible by day, they emerged at night, and cut their funny pranks.
+No sooner were we all asleep, than they made a sudden dash over the
+lockers and across our faces for the cabin door, where all broke out into
+a loud He! he! he! he! he! he! showing how keenly they enjoyed the joke.
+They next went forward with as much delight, and scampered over the men.
+Every night they went fore and aft, rousing with impartial feet every
+sleeper, and laughing to scorn the aimless blows, growls, and deadly
+rushes of outraged humanity. We observed elsewhere a species of large
+mouse, nearly allied to _Euryotis unisulcatus_ (F. Cuvier), escaping up a
+rough and not very upright wall, with six young ones firmly attached to
+the perineum. They were old enough to be well covered with hair, and
+some were not detached by a blow which disabled the dam. We could not
+decide whether any involuntary muscles were brought into play in helping
+the young to adhere. Their weight seemed to require a sort of cataleptic
+state of the muscles of the jaw, to enable them to hold on.
+
+Scorpions, centipedes, and poisonous spiders also were not unfrequently
+brought into the ship with the wood, and occasionally found their way
+into our beds; but in every instance we were fortunate enough to discover
+and destroy them before they did any harm. Naval officers on this coast
+report that, when scorpions and centipedes remain a few weeks after being
+taken on board in a similar manner, their poison loses nearly all its
+virulence; but this we did not verify. Snakes sometimes came in with the
+wood, but oftener floated down the river to us, climbing on board with
+ease by the chain-cable, and some poisonous ones were caught in the
+cabin. A green snake lived with us several weeks, concealing himself
+behind the casing of the deckhouse in the daytime. To be aroused in the
+dark by five feet of cold green snake gliding over one's face is rather
+unpleasant, however rapid the movement may be. Myriads of two varieties
+of cockroaches infested the vessel; they not only ate round the roots of
+our nails, but even devoured and defiled our food, flannels, and boots.
+Vain were all our efforts to extirpate these destructive pests; if you
+kill one, say the sailors, a hundred come down to his funeral! In the
+work of Commodore Owen it is stated that cockroaches, pounded into a
+paste, form a powerful carminative; this has not been confirmed, but when
+monkeys are fed on them they are sure to become lean.
+
+On coming to Senna, we found that the Zulus had arrived in force for
+their annual tribute. These men are under good discipline, and never
+steal from the people. The tax is claimed on the ground of conquest, the
+Zulus having formerly completely overcome the Senna people, and chased
+them on to the islands in the Zambesi. Fifty-four of the Portuguese were
+slain on the occasion, and, notwithstanding the mud fort, the village has
+never recovered its former power. Fever was now very prevalent, and most
+of the Portuguese were down with it.
+
+For a good view of the adjacent scenery, the hill, Baramuana, behind the
+village, was ascended. A caution was given about the probability of an
+attack of fever from a plant that grows near the summit. Dr. Kirk
+discovered it to be the _Paedevia foetida_, which, when smelt, actually
+does give headache and fever. It has a nasty fetor, as its name
+indicates. This is one instance in which fever and a foul smell
+coincide. In a number of instances offensive effluvia and fever seems to
+have no connection. Owing to the abundant rains, the crops in the Senna
+district were plentiful; this was fortunate, after the partial failure of
+the past two years. It was the 25th of April, 1860, before we reached
+Tette; here also the crops were luxuriant, and the people said that they
+had not had such abundance since 1856, the year when Dr. Livingstone came
+down the river. It is astonishing to any one who has seen the works for
+irrigation in other countries, as at the Cape and in Egypt, that no
+attempt has ever been made to lead out the water either of the Zambesi or
+any of its tributaries; no machinery has ever been used to raise it even
+from the stream, but droughts and starvations are endured, as if they
+were inevitable dispensations of Providence, incapable of being
+mitigated.
+
+Feeling in honour bound to return with those who had been the faithful
+companions of Dr. Livingstone, in 1856, and to whose guardianship and
+services was due the accomplishment of a journey which all the Portuguese
+at Tette had previously pronounced impossible, the requisite steps were
+taken to convey them to their homes.
+
+We laid the ship alongside of the island Kanyimbe, opposite Tette; and,
+before starting for the country of the Makololo, obtained a small plot of
+land, to form a garden for the two English sailors who were to remain in
+charge during our absence. We furnished them with a supply of seeds, and
+they set to work with such zeal, that they certainly merited success.
+Their first attempt at African horticulture met with failure from a most
+unexpected source; every seed was dug up and the inside of it eaten by
+mice. "Yes," said an old native, next morning, on seeing the husks,
+"that is what happens this month; for it is the mouse month, and the seed
+should have been sown last mouth, when I sowed mine." The sailors,
+however, sowed more next day; and, being determined to outwit the mice,
+they this time covered the beds over with grass. The onions, with other
+seeds of plants cultivated by the Portuguese, are usually planted in the
+beginning of April, in order to have the advantage of the cold season;
+the wheat a little later, for the same reason. If sown at the beginning
+of the rainy season in November, it runs, as before remarked, entirely to
+straw; but as the rains are nearly over in May, advantage is taken of low-
+lying patches, which have been flooded by the river. A hole is made in
+the mud with a hoe, a few seeds dropped in, and the earth shoved back
+with the foot. If not favoured with certain misty showers, which, lower
+down the river, are simply fogs, water is borne from the river to the
+roots of the wheat in earthern pots; and in about four months the crop is
+ready for the sickle. The wheat of Tette is exported, as the best grown
+in the country; but a hollow spot at Maruru, close by Mazaro, yielded
+very good crops, though just at the level of the sea, as a few inches
+rise of tide shows.
+
+A number of days were spent in busy preparation for our journey; the
+cloth, beads, and brass wire, for the trip were sewn up in old canvas,
+and each package had the bearer's name printed on it. The Makololo, who
+had worked for the Expedition, were paid for their services, and every
+one who had come down with the Doctor from the interior received a
+present of cloth and ornaments, in order to protect them from the greater
+cold of their own country, and to show that they had not come in vain.
+Though called Makololo by courtesy, as they were proud of the name,
+Kanyata, the principal headman, was the only real Makololo of the party;
+and he, in virtue of his birth, had succeeded to the chief place on the
+death of Sekwebu. The others belonged to the conquered tribes of the
+Batoka, Bashubia, Ba-Selea, and Barotse. Some of these men had only
+added to their own vices those of the Tette slaves; others, by toiling
+during the first two years in navigating canoes, and hunting elephants,
+had often managed to save a little, to take back to their own country,
+but had to part with it all for food to support the rest in times of
+hunger, and, latterly, had fallen into the improvident habits of slaves,
+and spent their surplus earnings in beer and agua ardiente.
+
+Everything being ready on the 15th of May, we started at 2 p.m. from the
+village where the Makololo had dwelt. A number of the men did not leave
+with the goodwill which their talk for months before had led us to
+anticipate; but some proceeded upon being told that they were not
+compelled to go unless they liked, though others altogether declined
+moving. Many had taken up with slave-women, whom they assisted in
+hoeing, and in consuming the produce of their gardens. Some fourteen
+children had been born to them; and in consequence of now having no chief
+to order them, or to claim their services, they thought that they were
+about as well off as they had been in their own country. They knew and
+regretted that they could call neither wives nor children their own; the
+slave-owners claimed the whole; but their natural affections had been so
+enchained, that they clave to the domestic ties. By a law of Portugal
+the baptized children of slave women are all free; by the custom of the
+Zambesi that law is void. When it is referred to, the officers laugh and
+say, "These Lisbon-born laws are very stringent, but somehow, possibly
+from the heat of the climate, here they lose all their force." Only one
+woman joined our party--the wife of a Batoka man: she had been given to
+him, in consideration of his skilful dancing, by the chief, Chisaka. A
+merchant sent three of his men along with us, with a present for
+Sekeletu, and Major Sicard also lent us three more to assist us on our
+return, and two Portuguese gentleman kindly gave us the loan of a couple
+of donkeys. We slept four miles above Tette, and hearing that the
+Banyai, who levy heavy fines on the Portuguese traders, lived chiefly on
+the right bank, we crossed over to the left, as we could not fully trust
+our men. If the Banyai had come in a threatening manner, our followers
+might, perhaps, from having homes behind them, have even put down their
+bundles and run. Indeed, two of them at this point made up their minds
+to go no further, and turned back to Tette. Another, Monga, a Batoka,
+was much perplexed, and could not make out what course to pursue, as he
+had, three years previously, wounded Kanyata, the headman, with a spear.
+This is a capital offence among the Makololo, and he was afraid of being
+put to death for it on his return. He tried, in vain, to console himself
+with the facts that he had neither father, mother, sisters, nor brothers
+to mourn for him, and that he could die but once. He was good, and would
+go up to the stars to Yesu, and therefore did not care for death. In
+spite, however, of these reflections, he was much cast down, until
+Kanyata assured him that he would never mention his misdeed to the chief;
+indeed, he had never even mentioned it to the Doctor, which he would
+assuredly have done had it lain heavy on his heart. We were right glad
+of Monga's company, for he was a merry good-tempered fellow, and his
+lithe manly figure had always been in the front in danger; and, from
+being left-handed, had been easily recognized in the fight with
+elephants.
+
+We commenced, for a certain number of days, with short marches, walking
+gently until broken in to travel. This is of so much importance, that it
+occurs to us that more might be made out of soldiers if the first few
+days' marches were easy, and gradually increased in length and quickness.
+The nights were cold, with heavy dews and occasional showers, and we had
+several cases of fever. Some of the men deserted every night, and we
+fully expected that all who had children would prefer to return to Tette,
+for little ones are well known to prove the strongest ties, even to
+slaves. It was useless informing them, that if they wanted to return
+they had only to come and tell us so; we should not be angry with them
+for preferring Tette to their own country. Contact with slaves had
+destroyed their sense of honour; they would not go in daylight, but
+decamped in the night, only in one instance, however, taking our goods,
+though, in two more, they carried off their comrades' property. By the
+time we had got well into the Kebrabasa hills thirty men, nearly a third
+of the party, had turned back, and it became evident that, if many more
+left us, Sekeletu's goods could not be carried up. At last, when the
+refuse had fallen away, no more desertions took place.
+
+Stopping one afternoon at a Kebrabasa village, a man, who pretended to be
+able to change himself into a lion, came to salute us. Smelling the
+gunpowder from a gun which had been discharged, he went on one side to
+get out of the wind of the piece, trembling in a most artistic manner,
+but quite overacting his part. The Makololo explained to us that he was
+a Pondoro, or a man who can change his form at will, and added that he
+trembles when he smells gunpowder. "Do you not see how he is trembling
+now?" We told them to ask him to change himself at once into a lion, and
+we would give him a cloth for the performance. "Oh no," replied they;
+"if we tell him so, he may change himself and come when we are asleep and
+kill us." Having similar superstitions at home, they readily became as
+firm believers in the Pondoro as the natives of the village. We were
+told that he assumes the form of a lion and remains in the woods for
+days, and is sometimes absent for a whole month. His considerate wife
+had built him a hut or den, in which she places food and beer for her
+transformed lord, whose metamorphosis does not impair his human appetite.
+No one ever enters this hut except the Pondoro and his wife, and no
+stranger is allowed even to rest his gun against the baobab-tree beside
+it: the Mfumo, or petty chief, of another small village wished to fine
+our men for placing their muskets against an old tumble-down hut, it
+being that of the Pondoro. At times the Pondoro employs his acquired
+powers in hunting for the benefit of the village; and after an absence of
+a day or two, his wife smells the lion, takes a certain medicine, places
+it in the forest, and there quickly leaves it, lest the lion should kill
+even her. This medicine enables the Pondoro to change himself back into
+a man, return to the village, and say, "Go and get the game that I have
+killed for you." Advantage is of course taken of what a lion has done,
+and they go and bring home the buffalo or antelope killed when he was a
+lion, or rather found when he was patiently pursuing his course of
+deception in the forest. We saw the Pondoro of another village dressed
+in a fantastic style, with numerous charms hung round him, and followed
+by a troop of boys who were honouring him with rounds of shrill cheering.
+
+It is believed also that the souls of departed chiefs enter into lions,
+and render them sacred. On one occasion, when we had shot a buffalo in
+the path beyond the Kafue, a hungry lion, attracted probably by the smell
+of the meat, came close to our camp, and roused up all hands by his
+roaring. Tuba Mokoro, imbued with the popular belief that the beast was
+a chief in disguise, scolded him roundly during his brief intervals of
+silence. "You a chief, eh? You call yourself a chief, do you? What
+kind of chief are you to come sneaking about in the dark, trying to steal
+our buffalo meat! Are you not ashamed of yourself? A pretty chief
+truly; you are like the scavenger beetle, and think of yourself only. You
+have not the heart of a chief; why don't you kill your own beef? You
+must have a stone in your chest, and no heart at all, indeed!" Tuba
+Mokoro producing no impression on the transformed chief, one of the men,
+the most sedate of the party, who seldom spoke, took up the matter, and
+tried the lion in another strain. In his slow quiet way he expostulated
+with him on the impropriety of such conduct to strangers, who had never
+injured him. "We were travelling peaceably through the country back to
+our own chief. We never killed people, nor stole anything. The buffalo
+meat was ours, not his, and it did not become a great chief like him to
+be prowling round in the dark, trying, like a hyena, to steal the meat of
+strangers. He might go and hunt for himself, as there was plenty of game
+in the forest." The Pondoro, being deaf to reason, and only roaring the
+louder, the men became angry, and threatened to send a ball through him
+if he did not go away. They snatched up their guns to shoot him, but he
+prudently kept in the dark, outside the luminous circle made by our camp
+fires, and there they did not like to venture. A little strychnine was
+put into a piece of meat, and thrown to him, when he soon departed, and
+we heard no more of the majestic sneaker.
+
+The Kebrabasa people were now plumper and in better condition than on our
+former visits; the harvest had been abundant; they had plenty to eat and
+drink, and they were enjoying life as much as ever they could. At
+Defwe's village, near where the ship lay on her first ascent, we found
+two Mfumos or headmen, the son and son-in-law of the former chief. A
+sister's son has much more chance of succeeding to a chieftainship than
+the chief's own offspring, it being unquestionable that the sister's
+child has the family blood. The men are all marked across the nose and
+up the middle of the forehead with short horizontal bars or cicatrices;
+and a single brass earring of two or three inches diameter, like the
+ancient Egyptian, is worn by the men. Some wear the hair long like the
+ancient Assyrians and Egyptians, and a few have eyes with the downward
+and inward slant of the Chinese.
+
+After fording the rapid Luia, we left our former path on the banks of the
+Zambesi, and struck off in a N.W. direction behind one of the hill
+ranges, the eastern end of which is called Mongwa, the name of an acacia,
+having a peculiarly strong fetor, found on it. Our route wound up a
+valley along a small mountain-stream which was nearly dry, and then
+crossed the rocky spurs of some of the lofty hills. The country was all
+very dry at the time, and no water was found except in an occasional
+spring and a few wells dug in the beds of watercourses. The people were
+poor, and always anxious to convince travellers of the fact. The men,
+unlike those on the plains, spend a good deal of their time in hunting;
+this may be because they have but little ground on the hill-sides
+suitable for gardens, and but little certainty of reaping what may be
+sown in the valleys. No women came forward in the hamlet, east of
+Chiperiziwa, where we halted for the night. Two shots had been fired at
+guinea-fowl a little way off in the valley; the women fled into the
+woods, and the men came to know if war was meant, and a few of the old
+folks only returned after hearing that we were for peace. The headman,
+Kambira, apologized for not having a present ready, and afterwards
+brought us some meal, a roasted coney (_Hyrax capensis_), and a pot of
+beer; he wished to be thought poor. The beer had come to him from a
+distance; he had none of his own. Like the Manganja, these people salute
+by clapping their hands. When a man comes to a place where others are
+seated, before sitting down he claps his hands to each in succession, and
+they do the same to him. If he has anything to tell, both speaker and
+hearer clap their hands at the close of every paragraph, and then again
+vigorously at the end of the speech. The guide, whom the headman gave
+us, thus saluted each of his comrades before he started off with us.
+There is so little difference in the language, that all the tribes of
+this region are virtually of one family.
+
+We proceeded still in the same direction, and passed only two small
+hamlets during the day. Except the noise our men made on the march,
+everything was still around us: few birds were seen. The appearance of a
+whydahbird showed that he had not yet parted with his fine long plumes.
+We passed immense quantities of ebony and lignum-vitae, and the tree from
+whose smooth and bitter bark granaries are made for corn. The country
+generally is clothed with a forest of ordinary-sized trees. We slept in
+the little village near Sindabwe, where our men contrived to purchase
+plenty of beer, and were uncommonly boisterous all the evening. We
+breakfasted next morning under green wild date-palms, beside the fine
+flowery stream, which runs through the charming valley of Zibah. We now
+had Mount Chiperiziwa between us, and part of the river near Morumbwa,
+having in fact come north about in order to avoid the difficulties of our
+former path. The last of the deserters, a reputed thief, took French
+leave of us here. He left the bundle of cloth he was carrying in the
+path a hundred yards in front of where we halted, but made off with the
+musket and most of the brass rings and beads of his comrade Shirimba, who
+had unsuspectingly intrusted them to his care.
+
+Proceeding S.W. up this lovely valley, in about an hour's time we reached
+Sandia's village. The chief was said to be absent hunting, and they did
+not know when he would return. This is such a common answer to the
+inquiry after a headman, that one is inclined to think that it only means
+that they wish to know the stranger's object before exposing their
+superior to danger. As some of our men were ill, a halt was made here.
+
+As we were unable to march next morning, six of our young men, anxious to
+try their muskets, went off to hunt elephants. For several hours they
+saw nothing, and some of them, getting tired, proposed to go to a village
+and buy food. "No!" said Mantlanyane, "we came to hunt, so let us go
+on." In a short time they fell in with a herd of cow elephants and
+calves. As soon as the first cow caught sight of the hunters on the
+rocks above her, she, with true motherly instinct, placed her young one
+between her fore-legs for protection. The men were for scattering, and
+firing into the herd indiscriminately. "That won't do," cried
+Mantlanyane, "let us all fire at this one." The poor beast received a
+volley, and ran down into the plain, where another shot killed her; the
+young one escaped with the herd. The men were wild with excitement, and
+danced round the fallen queen of the forest, with loud shouts and
+exultant songs. They returned, bearing as trophies the tail and part of
+the trunk, and marched into camp as erect as soldiers, and evidently
+feeling that their stature had increased considerably since the morning.
+
+Sandia's wife was duly informed of their success, as here a law decrees
+that half the elephant belongs to the chief on whose ground it has been
+killed. The Portuguese traders always submit to this tax, and, were it
+of native origin, it could hardly be considered unjust. A chief must
+have some source of revenue; and, as many chiefs can raise none except
+from ivory or slaves, this tax is more free from objections than any
+other that a black Chancellor of the Exchequer could devise. It seems,
+however, to have originated with the Portuguese themselves, and then to
+have spread among the adjacent tribes. The Governors look sharply after
+any elephant that may be slain on the Crown lands, and demand one of the
+tusks from their vassals. We did not find the law in operation in any
+tribe beyond the range of Portuguese traders, or further than the sphere
+of travel of those Arabs who imitated Portuguese customs in trade. At
+the Kafue in 1855 the chiefs bought the meat we killed, and demanded
+nothing as their due; and so it was up the Shire during our visits. The
+slaves of the Portuguese, who are sent by their masters to shoot
+elephants, probably connive at the extension of this law, for they strive
+to get the good will of the chiefs to whose country they come, by
+advising them to make a demand of half of each elephant killed, and for
+this advice they are well paid in beer. When we found that the
+Portuguese argued in favour of this law, we told the natives that they
+might exact tusks from _them_, but that the English, being different,
+preferred the pure native custom. It was this which made Sandia, as
+afterwards mentioned, hesitate; but we did not care to insist on
+exemption in our favour, where the prevalence of the custom might have
+been held to justify the exaction.
+
+The cutting up of an elephant is quite a unique spectacle. The men stand
+remind the animal in dead silence, while the chief of the travelling
+party declares that, according to ancient law, the head and right hind-
+leg belong to him who killed the beast, that is, to him who inflicted the
+first wound; the left leg to bins who delivered the second, or first
+touched the animal after it fell. The meat around the eye to the
+English, or chief of the travellers, and different parts to the headmen
+of the different fires, or groups, of which the camp is composed; not
+forgetting to enjoin the preservation of the fat and bowels for a second
+distribution. This oration finished, the natives soon become excited,
+and scream wildly as they cut away at the carcass with a score of spears,
+whose long handles quiver in the air above their heads. Their excitement
+becomes momentarily more and more intense, and reaches the culminating
+point when, as denoted by a roar of gas, the huge mass is laid fairly
+open. Some jump inside, and roll about there in their eagerness to seize
+the precious fat, while others run off, screaming, with pieces of the
+bloody meat, throw it on the grass, and run back for more: all keep
+talking and shouting at the utmost pitch of their voices. Sometimes two
+or three, regardless of all laws, seize the same piece of meat, and have
+a brief fight of words over it. Occasionally an agonized yell bursts
+forth, and a native emerges out of the moving mass of dead elephant and
+wriggling humanity, with his hand badly cut by the spear of his excited
+friend and neighbour: this requires a rag and some soothing words to
+prevent bad blood. In an incredibly short time tons of meat are cut up,
+and placed in separate heaps around.
+
+Sandia arrived soon after the beast was divided: he is an elderly man,
+and wears a wig made of "ife" fibre (_sanseviera_) dyed black, and of a
+fine glossy appearance. This plant is allied to the aloes, and its thick
+fleshy leaves, in shape somewhat like our sedges, when bruised yield much
+fine strong fibre, which is made into ropes, nets, and wigs. It takes
+dyes readily, and the fibre might form a good article of commerce. "Ife"
+wigs, as we afterwards saw, are not uncommon in this country, though
+perhaps not so common as hair wigs at home. Sandia's mosamela, or small
+carved wooden pillow, exactly resembling the ancient Egyptian one, was
+hung from the back of his neck; this pillow and a sleeping mat are
+usually carried by natives when on hunting excursions.
+
+We had the elephant's fore-foot cooked for ourselves, in native fashion.
+A large hole was dug in the ground, in which a fire was made; and, when
+the inside was thoroughly heated, the entire foot was placed in it, and
+covered over with the hot ashes and soil; another fire was made above the
+whole, and kept burning all night. We had the foot thus cooked for
+breakfast next morning, and found it delicious. It is a whitish mass,
+slightly gelatinous, and sweet, like marrow. A long march, to prevent
+biliousness, is a wise precaution after a meal of elephant's foot.
+Elephant's trunk and tongue are also good, and, after long simmering,
+much resemble the hump of a buffalo and the tongue of an ox; but all the
+other meat is tough, and, from its peculiar flavour, only to be eaten by
+a hungry man. The quantities of meat our men devour is quite astounding.
+They boil as much as their pots will hold, and eat till it becomes
+physically impossible for them to stow away any more. An uproarious
+dance follows, accompanied with stentorian song; and as soon as they have
+shaken their first course down, and washed off the sweat and dust of the
+after performance, they go to work to roast more: a short snatch of sleep
+succeeds, and they are up and at it again; all night long it is boil and
+eat, roast and devour, with a few brief interludes of sleep. Like other
+carnivora, these men can endure hunger for a much longer period than the
+mere porridge-eating tribes. Our men can cook meat as well as any
+reasonable traveller could desire; and, boiled in earthen pots, like
+Indian chatties, it tastes much better than when cooked in iron ones.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V.
+
+
+Magnificent scenery--Method of marching--Hippopotamus killed--Lions and
+buffalo--Sequasha the ivory-trader.
+
+Sandia gave us two guides; and on the 4th of June we left the Elephant
+valley, taking a westerly course; and, after crossing a few ridges,
+entered the Chingerere or Paguruguru valley, through which, in the rainy
+season, runs the streamlet Pajodze. The mountains on our left, between
+us and the Zambesi, our guides told us have the same name as the valley,
+but that at the confluence of the Pajodze is called Morumbwa. We struck
+the river at less than half a mile to the north of the cataract Morumbwa.
+On climbing up the base of this mountain at Pajodze, we found that we
+were distant only the diameter of the mountain from the cataract. In
+measuring the cataract we formerly stood on its southern flank; now we
+were perched on its northern flank, and at once recognized the
+onion-shaped mountain, here called Zakavuma, whose smooth convex surface
+overlooks the broken water. Its bearing by compass was l80 degrees from
+the spot to which we had climbed, and 700 or 800 yards distant. We now,
+from this standing-point, therefore, completed our inspection of all
+Kebrabasa, and saw what, as a whole, was never before seen by Europeans
+so far as any records show.
+
+The remainder of the Kebrabasa path, on to Chicova, was close to the
+compressed and rocky river. Ranges of lofty tree-covered mountains, with
+deep narrow valleys, in which are dry watercourses, or flowing rivulets,
+stretch from the north-west, and are prolonged on the opposite side of
+the river in a south-easterly direction. Looking back, the mountain
+scenery in Kebrabasa was magnificent; conspicuous from their form and
+steep sides, are the two gigantic portals of the cataract; the vast
+forests still wore their many brilliant autumnal-coloured tints of green,
+yellow, red, purple, and brown, thrown into relief by the grey bark of
+the trunks in the background. Among these variegated trees were some
+conspicuous for their new livery of fresh light-green leaves, as though
+the winter of others was their spring. The bright sunshine in these
+mountain forests, and the ever-changing forms of the cloud shadows,
+gliding over portions of the surface, added fresh charms to scenes
+already surpassingly beautiful.
+
+From what we have seen of the Kebrabasa rocks and rapids, it appears too
+evident that they must always form a barrier to navigation at the
+ordinary low water of the river; but the rise of the water in this gorge
+being as much as eighty feet perpendicularly, it is probable that a
+steamer might be taken up at high flood, when all the rapids are smoothed
+over, to run on the Upper Zambesi. The most formidable cataract in it,
+Morumbwa, has only about twenty feet of fall, in a distance of thirty
+yards, and it must entirely disappear when the water stands eighty feet
+higher. Those of the Makololo who worked on board the ship were not
+sorry at the steamer being left below, as they had become heartily tired
+of cutting the wood that the insatiable furnace of the "Asthmatic"
+required. Mbia, who was a bit of a wag, laughingly exclaimed in broken
+English, "Oh, Kebrabasa good, very good; no let shippee up to Sekeletu,
+too muchee work, cuttee woodyee, cuttee woodyee: Kebrabasa good." It is
+currently reported, and commonly believed, that once upon a time a
+Portuguese named Jose Pedra,--by the natives called Nyamatimbira,--chief,
+or capitao mor, of Zumbo, a man of large enterprise and small
+humanity,--being anxious to ascertain if Kebrabasa could be navigated,
+made two slaves fast to a canoe, and launched it from Chicova into
+Kebrabasa, in order to see if it would come out at the other end. As
+neither slaves nor canoe ever appeared again, his Excellency concluded
+that Kebrabasa was unnavigable. A trader had a large canoe swept away by
+a sudden rise of the river, and it was found without damage below; but
+the most satisfactory information was that of old Sandia, who asserted
+that in flood all Kebrabasa became quite smooth, and he had often seen it
+so.
+
+We emerged from the thirty-five or forty miles of Kebrabasa hills into
+the Chicova plains on the 7th of June, 1860, having made short marches
+all the way. The cold nights caused some of our men to cough badly, and
+colds in this country almost invariably become fever. The Zambesi
+suddenly expands at Chicova, and assumes the size and appearance it has
+at Tette. Near this point we found a large seam of coal exposed in the
+left bank.
+
+We met with native travellers occasionally. Those on a long journey
+carry with them a sleeping-mat and wooden pillow, cooking-pot and bag of
+meal, pipe and tobacco-pouch, a knife, bow, and arrows, and two small
+sticks, of from two to three feet in length, for making fire, when
+obliged to sleep away from human habitations. Dry wood is always
+abundant, and they get fire by the following method. A notch is cut in
+one of the sticks, which, with a close-grained outside, has a small core
+of pith, and this notched stick is laid horizontally on a knife-blade on
+the ground; the operator squatting, places his great toes on each end to
+keep all steady, and taking the other wand which is of very hard wood cut
+to a blunt point, fits it into the notch at right angles; the upright
+wand is made to spin rapidly backwards and forwards between the palms of
+the hands, drill fashion, and at the same time is pressed downwards; the
+friction, in the course of a minute or so, ignites portions of the pith
+of the notched stick, which, rolling over like live charcoal on to the
+knife-blade, are lifted into a handful of fine dry grass, and carefully
+blown, by waving backwards and forwards in the air. It is hard work for
+the hands to procure fire by this process, as the vigorous drilling and
+downward pressure requisite soon blister soft palms.
+
+Having now entered a country where lions were numerous, our men began to
+pay greater attention to the arrangements of the camp at night. As they
+are accustomed to do with their chiefs, they place the white men in the
+centre; Kanyata, his men, and the two donkeys, camp on our right; Tuba
+Mokoro's party of Bashubia are in front; Masakasa, and Sininyane's body
+of Batoka, on the left; and in the rear six Tette men have their fires.
+In placing their fires they are careful to put them where the smoke will
+not blow in our faces. Soon after we halt, the spot for the English is
+selected, and all regulate their places accordingly, and deposit their
+burdens. The men take it by turns to cut some of the tall dry grass, and
+spread it for our beds on a spot, either naturally level, or smoothed by
+the hoe; some, appointed to carry our bedding, then bring our rugs and
+karosses, and place the three rugs in a row on the grass; Dr.
+Livingstone's being in the middle, Dr. Kirk's on the right, and Charles
+Livingstone's on the left. Our bags, rifles, and revolvers are carefully
+placed at our heads, and a fire made near our feet. We have no tent nor
+covering of any kind except the branches of the tree under which we may
+happen to lie; and it is a pretty sight to look up and see every branch,
+leaf, and twig of the tree stand out, reflected against the clear star-
+spangled and moonlit sky. The stars of the first magnitude have names
+which convey the same meaning over very wide tracts of country. Here
+when Venus comes out in the evenings, she is called Ntanda, the eldest or
+first-born, and Manjika, the first-born of morning, at other times: she
+has so much radiance when shining alone, that she casts a shadow. Sirius
+is named Kuewa usiko, "drawer of night," because supposed to draw the
+whole night after it. The moon has no evil influence in this country, so
+far as we know. We have lain and looked up at her, till sweet sleep
+closed our eyes, unharmed. Four or five of our men were affected with
+moon-blindness at Tette; though they had not slept out of doors there,
+they became so blind that their comrades had to guide their hands to the
+general dish of food; the affection is unknown in their own country. When
+our posterity shall have discovered what it is which, distinct from foul
+smells, causes fever, and what, apart from the moon, causes men to be
+moon-struck, they will pity our dulness of perception.
+
+The men cut a very small quantity of grass for themselves, and sleep in
+fumbas or sleeping-bags, which are double mats of palm-leaf, six feet
+long by four wide, and sewn together round three parts of the square, and
+left open only on one side. They are used as a protection from the cold,
+wet, and mosquitoes, and are entered as we should get into our beds, were
+the blankets nailed to the top, bottom, and one side of the bedstead.
+
+A dozen fires are nightly kindled in the camp; and these, being
+replenished from time to time by the men who are awakened by the cold,
+are kept burning until daylight. Abundance of dry hard wood is obtained
+with little trouble; and burns beautifully. After the great business of
+cooking and eating is over, all sit round the camp-fires, and engage in
+talking or singing. Every evening one of the Batoka plays his "sansa,"
+and continues at it until far into the night; he accompanies it with an
+extempore song, in which he rehearses their deeds ever since they left
+their own country. At times animated political discussions spring up,
+and the amount of eloquence expended on these occasions is amazing. The
+whole camp is aroused, and the men shout to one another from the
+different fires; whilst some, whose tongues are never heard on any other
+subject, burst forth into impassioned speech.
+
+As a specimen of our mode of marching, we rise about five, or as soon as
+dawn appears, take a cup of tea and a bit of biscuit; the servants fold
+up the blankets and stow them away in the bags they carry; the others tie
+their fumbas and cooking-pots to each end of their carrying-sticks, which
+are borne on the shoulder; the cook secures the dishes, and all are on
+the path by sunrise. If a convenient spot can be found we halt for
+breakfast about nine a.m. To save time, this meal is generally cooked
+the night before, and has only to be warmed. We continue the march after
+breakfast, rest a little in the middle of the day, and break off early in
+the afternoon. We average from two to two-and-a-half miles an hour in a
+straight line, or as the crow flies, and seldom have more than five or
+six hours a day of actual travel. This in a hot climate is as much as a
+man can accomplish without being oppressed; and we always tried to make
+our progress more a pleasure than a toil. To hurry over the ground,
+abuse, and look ferocious at one's native companions, merely for the
+foolish vanity of boasting how quickly a distance was accomplished, is a
+combination of silliness with absurdity quite odious; while kindly
+consideration for the feelings of even blacks, the pleasure of observing
+scenery and everything new as one moves on at an ordinary pace, and the
+participation in the most delicious rest with our fellows, render
+travelling delightful. Though not given to over haste, we were a little
+surprised to find that we could tire our men out; and even the headman,
+who carried but little more than we did, and never, as we often had to
+do, hunted in the afternoon, was no better than his comrades. Our
+experience tends to prove that the European constitution has a power of
+endurance, even in the tropics, greater than that of the hardiest of the
+meat-eating Africans.
+
+After pitching our camp, one or two of us usually go off to hunt, more as
+a matter of necessity than of pleasure, for the men, as well as
+ourselves, must have meat. We prefer to take a man with us to carry home
+the game, or lead the others to where it lies; but as they frequently
+grumble and complain of being tired, we do not particularly object to
+going alone, except that it involves the extra labour of our making a
+second trip to show the men where the animal that has been shot is to be
+found. When it is a couple of miles off it is rather fatiguing to have
+to go twice; more especially on the days when it is solely to supply
+their wants that, instead of resting ourselves, we go at all. Like those
+who perform benevolent deeds at home, the tired hunter, though trying
+hard to live in charity with all men, is strongly tempted to give it up
+by bringing only sufficient meat for the three whites and leaving the
+rest; thus sending the "idle ungrateful poor" supperless to bed. And yet
+it is only by continuance in well-doing, even to the length of what the
+worldly-wise call weakness, that the conviction is produced anywhere,
+that our motives are high enough to secure sincere respect.
+
+A jungle of mimosa, ebony, and "wait-a-bit" thorn lies between the
+Chicova flats and the cultivated plain, on which stand the villages of
+the chief, Chitora. He brought us a present of food and drink, because,
+as he, with the innate politeness of an African, said, he "did not wish
+us to sleep hungry: he had heard of the Doctor when he passed down, and
+had a great desire to see and converse with him; but he was a child then,
+and could not speak in the presence of great men. He was glad that he
+had seen the English now, and was sorry that his people were away, or he
+should have made them cook for us." All his subsequent conduct showed
+him to be sincere.
+
+Many of the African women are particular about the water they use for
+drinking and cooking, and prefer that which is filtered through sand. To
+secure this, they scrape holes in the sandbanks beside the stream, and
+scoop up the water, which slowly filters through, rather than take it
+from the equally clear and limpid river. This practice is common in the
+Zambesi, the Rovuma, and Lake Nyassa; and some of the Portuguese at Tette
+have adopted the native custom, and send canoes to a low island in the
+middle of the river for water. Chitora's people also obtained their
+supply from shallow wells in the sandy bed of a small rivulet close to
+the village. The habit may have arisen from observing the unhealthiness
+of the main stream at certain seasons. During nearly nine months in the
+year, ordure is deposited around countless villages along the thousands
+of miles drained by the Zambesi. When the heavy rains come down, and
+sweep the vast fetid accumulation into the torrents, the water is
+polluted with filth; and, but for the precaution mentioned, the natives
+would prove themselves as little fastidious as those in London who drink
+the abomination poured into the Thames by Reading and Oxford. It is no
+wonder that sailors suffered so much from fever after drinking African
+river water, before the present admirable system of condensing it was
+adopted in our navy.
+
+The scent of man is excessively terrible to game of all kinds, much more
+so, probably, than the sight of him. A herd of antelopes, a hundred
+yards off, gazed at us as we moved along the winding path, and timidly
+stood their ground until half our line had passed, but darted off the
+instant they "got the wind," or caught the flavour of those who had gone
+by. The sport is all up with the hunter who gets to the windward of the
+African beast, as it cannot stand even the distant aroma of the human
+race, so much dreaded by all wild animals. Is this the fear and the
+dread of man, which the Almighty said to Noah was to be upon every beast
+of the field? A lion may, while lying in wait for his prey, leap on a
+human being as he would on any other animal, save a rhinoceros or an
+elephant, that happened to pass; or a lioness, when she has cubs, might
+attack a man, who, passing "up the wind of her," had unconsciously, by
+his scent, alarmed her for the safety of her whelps; or buffaloes, amid
+other animals, might rush at a line of travellers, in apprehension of
+being surrounded by them; but neither beast nor snake will, as a general
+rule, turn on man except when wounded, or by mistake. If gorillas,
+unwounded, advance to do battle with him, and beat their breasts in
+defiance, they are an exception to all wild beasts known to us. From the
+way an elephant runs at the first glance of man, it is inferred that this
+huge brute, though really king of beasts, would run even from a child.
+
+Our two donkeys caused as much admiration as the three white men. Great
+was the astonishment when one of the donkeys began to bray. The timid
+jumped more than if a lion had roared beside them. All were startled,
+and stared in mute amazement at the harsh-voiced one, till the last
+broken note was uttered; then, on being assured that nothing in
+particular was meant, they looked at each other, and burst into a loud
+laugh at their common surprise. When one donkey stimulated the other to
+try his vocal powers, the interest felt by the startled visitors, must
+have equalled that of the Londoners, when they first crowded to see the
+famous hippopotamus.
+
+We were now, when we crossed the boundary rivulet Nyamatarara, out of
+Chicova and amongst sandstone rocks, similar to those which prevail
+between Lupata and Kebrabasa. In the latter gorge, as already mentioned,
+igneous and syenitic masses have been acted on by some great fiery
+convulsion of nature; the strata are thrown into a huddled heap of
+confusion. The coal has of course disappeared in Kebrabasa, but is found
+again in Chicova. Tette grey sandstone is common about Sinjere, and
+wherever it is seen with fossil wood upon it, coal lies beneath; and
+here, as at Chicova, some seams crop out on the banks of the Zambesi.
+Looking southwards, the country is open plain and woodland, with detached
+hills and mountains in the distance; but the latter are too far off, the
+natives say, for them to know their names. The principal hills on our
+right, as we look up stream, are from six to twelve miles away, and
+occasionally they send down spurs to the river, with brooks flowing
+through their narrow valleys. The banks of the Zambesi show two well-
+defined terraces; the first, or lowest, being usually narrow, and of
+great fertility, while the upper one is a dry grassy plain, a thorny
+jungle, or a mopane (_Bauhinia_) forest. One of these plains, near the
+Kafue, is covered with the large stumps and trunks of a petrified forest.
+We halted a couple of days by the fine stream Sinjere, which comes from
+the Chiroby-roby hills, about eight miles to the north. Many lumps of
+coal, brought down by the rapid current, lie in its channel. The natives
+never seem to have discovered that coal would burn, and, when informed of
+the fact, shook their heads, smiled incredulously, and said "_Kodi_"
+(really), evidently regarding it as a mere traveller's tale. They were
+astounded to see it burning freely on our fire of wood. They told us
+that plenty of it was seen among the hills; but, being long ago aware
+that we were now in an immense coalfield, we did not care to examine it
+further.
+
+A dyke of black basaltic rock, called Kakolole, crosses the river near
+the mouth of the Sinjere; but it has two open gateways in it of from
+sixty to eighty yards in breadth, and the channel is very deep.
+
+On a shallow sandbank, under the dyke, lay a herd of hippopotami in
+fancied security. The young ones were playing with each other like young
+puppies, climbing on the backs of their dams, trying to take hold of one
+another by the jaws and tumbling over into the water. Mbia, one of the
+Makololo, waded across to within a dozen yards of the drowsy beasts, and
+shot the father of the herd; who, being very fat, soon floated, and was
+secured at the village below. The headman of the village visited us
+while we were at breakfast. He wore a black "ife" wig and a printed
+shirt. After a short silence he said to Masakasa, "You are with the
+white people, so why do you not tell them to give me a cloth?" "We are
+strangers," answered Masakasa, "why do you not bring us some food?" He
+took the plain hint, and brought us two fowls, in order that we should
+not report that in passing him we got nothing to eat; and, as usual, we
+gave a cloth in return. In reference to the hippopotamus he would make
+no demand, but said he would take what we chose to give him. The men
+gorged themselves with meat for two days, and cut large quantities into
+long narrow strips, which they half-dried and half-roasted on wooden
+frames over the fire. Much game is taken in this neighbourhood in
+pitfalls. Sharp-pointed stakes are set in the bottom, on which the game
+tumbles and gets impaled. The natives are careful to warn strangers of
+these traps, and also of the poisoned beams suspended on the tall trees
+for the purpose of killing elephants and hippopotami. It is not
+difficult to detect the pitfalls after one's attention has been called to
+them; but in places where they are careful to carry the earth off to a
+distance, and a person is not thinking of such things, a sudden descent
+of nine feet is an experience not easily forgotten by the traveller. The
+sensations of one thus instantaneously swallowed up by the earth are
+peculiar. A momentary suspension of consciousness is followed by the
+rustling sound of a shower of sand and dry grass, and the half-bewildered
+thought of where he is, and how he came into darkness. Reason awakes to
+assure him that he must have come down through that small opening of
+daylight overhead, and that he is now where a hippopotamus ought to have
+been. The descent of a hippopotamus pitfall is easy, but to get out
+again into the upper air is a work of labour. The sides are smooth and
+treacherous, and the cross reeds, which support the covering, break in
+the attempt to get out by clutching them. A cry from the depths is
+unheard by those around, and it is only by repeated and most desperate
+efforts that the buried alive can regain the upper world. At Tette we
+are told of a white hunter, of unusually small stature, who plumped into
+a pit while stalking a guinea-fowl on a tree. It was the labour of an
+entire forenoon to get out; and he was congratulating himself on his
+escape, and brushing off the clay from his clothes, when down he went
+into a second pit, which happened, as is often the case, to be close
+beside the first, and it was evening before he could work himself out of
+_that_.
+
+Elephants and buffaloes seldom return to the river by the same path on
+two successive nights, they become so apprehensive of danger from this
+human art. An old elephant will walk in advance of the herd, and uncover
+the pits with his trunk, that the others may see the openings and tread
+on firm ground. Female elephants are generally the victims: more timid
+by nature than the males, and very motherly in their anxiety for their
+calves, they carry their trunks up, trying every breeze for fancied
+danger, which often in reality lies at their feet. The tusker, fearing
+less, keeps his trunk down, and, warned in time by that exquisitely
+sensitive organ, takes heed to his ways.
+
+Our camp on the Sinjere stood under a wide-spreading wild fig-tree. From
+the numbers of this family, of large size, dotted over the country, the
+fig or banyan species would seem to have been held sacred in Africa from
+the remotest times. The soil teemed with white ants, whose clay tunnels,
+formed to screen them from the eyes of birds, thread over the ground, up
+the trunks of trees, and along the branches, from which the little
+architects clear away all rotten or dead wood. Very often the exact
+shape of branches is left in tunnels on the ground and not a bit of the
+wood inside. The first night we passed here these destructive insects
+ate through our grass-beds, and attacked our blankets, and certain large
+red-headed ones even bit our flesh.
+
+On some days not a single white ant is to be seen abroad; and on others,
+and during certain hours, they appear out of doors in myriads, and work
+with extraordinary zeal and energy in carrying bits of dried grass down
+into their nests. During these busy reaping-fits the lizards and birds
+have a good time of it, and enjoy a rich feast at the expense of
+thousands of hapless workmen; and when they swarm they are caught in
+countless numbers by the natives, and their roasted bodies are spoken of
+in an unctuous manner as resembling grains of soft rice fried in
+delicious fresh oil.
+
+A strong marauding party of large black ants attacked a nest of white
+ones near the camp: as the contest took place beneath the surface, we
+could not see the order of the battle; but it soon became apparent that
+the blacks had gained the day, and sacked the white town, for they
+returned in triumph, bearing off the eggs, and choice bits of the bodies
+of the vanquished. A gift, analogous to that of language, has not been
+withheld from ants: if part of their building is destroyed, an official
+is seen coming out to examine the damage; and, after a careful survey of
+the ruins, he chirrups a few clear and distinct notes, and a crowd of
+workers begin at once to repair the breach. When the work is completed,
+another order is given, and the workmen retire, as will appear on
+removing the soft freshly-built portion. We tried to sleep one rainy
+might in a native hut, but could not because of attacks by the fighting
+battalions of a very small species of formica, not more than
+one-sixteenth of an inch in length. It soon became obvious that they
+were under regular discipline, and even attempting to carry out the
+skilful plans and stratagems of some eminent leader. Our hands and necks
+were the first objects of attack. Large bodies of these little pests
+were massed in silence round the point to be assaulted. We could hear
+the sharp shrill word of command two or three times repeated, though
+until then we had not believed in the vocal power of an ant; the instant
+after we felt the storming hosts range over head and neck, biting the
+tender skin, clinging with a death-grip to the hair, and parting with
+their jaws rather than quit their hold. On our lying down again in the
+hope of their having been driven off, no sooner was the light out, and
+all still, than the manoeuvre was repeated. Clear and audible orders
+were issued, and the assault renewed. It was as hard to sleep in that
+hut as in the trenches before Sebastopol. The white ant, being a
+vegetable feeder, devours articles of vegetable origin only, and leather,
+which, by tanning, is imbued with a vegetable flavour. "A man may be
+rich to-day and poor to-morrow, from the ravages of white ants," said a
+Portuguese merchant. "If he gets sick, and unable to look after his
+goods, his slaves neglect them, and they are soon destroyed by these
+insects." The reddish ant, in the west called drivers, crossed our path
+daily, in solid columns an inch wide, and never did the pugnacity of
+either man or beast exceed theirs. It is a sufficient cause of war if
+you only approach them, even by accident. Some turn out of the ranks and
+stand with open mandibles, or, charging with extended jaws, bite with
+savage ferocity. When hunting, we lighted among them too often; while we
+were intent on the game, and without a thought of ants, they quietly
+covered us from head to foot, then all began to bite at the same instant;
+seizing a piece of the skin with their powerful pincers, they twisted
+themselves round with it, as if determined to tear it out. Their bites
+are so terribly sharp that the bravest must run, and then strip to pick
+off those that still cling with their hooked jaws, as with steel forceps.
+This kind abounds in damp places, and is usually met with on the banks of
+streams. We have not heard of their actually killing any animal except
+the Python, and that only when gorged and quite lethargic, but they soon
+clear away any dead animal matter; this appears to be their principal
+food, and their use in the economy of nature is clearly in the scavenger
+line.
+
+We started from the Sinjere on the 12th of June, our men carrying with
+them bundles of hippopotamus meat for sale, and for future use. We
+rested for breakfast opposite the Kakolole dyke, which confines the
+channel, west of the Manyerere mountain. A rogue monkey, the largest by
+far that we ever saw, and very fat and tame, walked off leisurely from a
+garden as we approached. The monkey is a sacred animal in this region,
+and is never molested or killed, because the people believe devoutly that
+the souls of their ancestors now occupy these degraded forms, and
+anticipate that they themselves must, sooner or later, be transformed in
+like manner; a future as cheerless for the black as the spirit-rapper's
+heaven is for the whites. The gardens are separated from each other by a
+single row of small stones, a few handfuls of grass, or a slight furrow
+made by the hoe. Some are enclosed by a reed fence of the flimsiest
+construction, yet sufficient to keep out the ever wary hippopotamus, who
+dreads a trap. His extreme caution is taken advantage of by the women,
+who hang, as a miniature trap-beam, a kigelia fruit with a bit of stick
+in the end. This protects the maize, of which he is excessively fond.
+
+The quantity of hippopotamus meat eaten by our men made some of them ill,
+and our marches were necessarily short. After three hours' travel on the
+13th, we spent the remainder of the day at the village of Chasiribera, on
+a rivulet flowing through a beautiful valley to the north, which is
+bounded by magnificent mountain-ranges. Pinkwe, or Mbingwe, otherwise
+Moeu, forms the south-eastern angle of the range. On the 16th June we
+were at the flourishing village of Senga, under the headman Manyame,
+which lies at the foot of the mount Motemwa. Nearly all the mountains in
+this country are covered with open forest and grass, in colour, according
+to the season, green or yellow. Many are between 2000 and 3000 feet
+high, with the sky line fringed with trees; the rocks show just
+sufficiently for one to observe their stratification, or their granitic
+form, and though not covered with dense masses of climbing plants, like
+those in moister eastern climates, there is still the idea conveyed that
+most of the steep sides are fertile, and none give the impression of that
+barrenness which, in northern mountains, suggests the idea that the bones
+of the world are sticking through its skin.
+
+The villagers reported that we were on the footsteps of a Portuguese half-
+caste, who, at Senga, lately tried to purchase ivory, but, in consequence
+of his having murdered a chief near Zumbo and twenty of his men, the
+people declined to trade with him. He threatened to take the ivory by
+force, if they would not sell it; but that same night the ivory and the
+women were spirited out of the village, and only a large body of armed
+men remained. The trader, fearing that he might come off second best if
+it came to blows, immediately departed. Chikwanitsela, or Sekuanangila,
+is the paramount chief of some fifty miles of the northern bank of the
+Zambesi in this locality. He lives on the opposite, or southern side,
+and there his territory is still more extensive. We sent him a present
+from Senga, and were informed by a messenger next morning that he had a
+cough and could not come over to see us. "And has his present a cough
+too," remarked one of our party, "that it does not come to us? Is this
+the way your chief treats strangers, receives their present, and sends
+them no food in return?" Our men thought Chikwanitsela an uncommonly
+stingy fellow; but, as it was possible that some of them might yet wish
+to return this way, they did not like to scold him more than this, which
+was sufficiently to the point.
+
+Men and women were busily engaged in preparing the ground for the
+November planting. Large game was abundant; herds of elephants and
+buffaloes came down to the river in the night, but were a long way off by
+daylight. They soon adopt this habit in places where they are hunted.
+
+The plains we travel over are constantly varying in breadth, according as
+the furrowed and wooded hills approach or recede from the river. On the
+southern side we see the hill Bungwe, and the long, level, wooded ridge
+Nyangombe, the first of a series bending from the S.E. to the N.W. past
+the Zambesi. We shot an old pallah on the 16th, and found that the poor
+animal had been visited with more than the usual share of animal
+afflictions. He was stone-blind in both eyes, had several tumours, and a
+broken leg, which showed no symptoms of ever having begun to heal. Wild
+animals sometimes suffer a great deal from disease, and wearily drag on a
+miserable existence before relieved of it by some ravenous beast. Once
+we drove off a maneless lion and lioness from a dead buffalo, which had
+been in the last stage of a decline. They had watched him staggering to
+the river to quench his thirst, and sprang on him as he was crawling up
+the bank. One had caught him by the throat, and the other by his high
+projecting backbone, which was broken by the lion's powerful fangs. The
+struggle, if any, must have been short. They had only eaten the
+intestines when we frightened them off. It is curious that this is the
+part that wild animals always begin with, and that it is also the first
+choice of our men. Were it not a wise arrangement that only the
+strongest males should continue the breed, one could hardly help pitying
+the solitary buffalo expelled from the herd for some physical blemish, or
+on account of the weakness of approaching old age. Banished from female
+society, he naturally becomes morose and savage; the necessary
+watchfulness against enemies is now never shared by others; disgusted, he
+passes into a state of chronic war with all who enjoy life, and the
+sooner after his expulsion that he fills the lion's or the wild-dog's
+maw, the better for himself and for the peace of the country.
+
+We encamped on the 20th of June at a spot where Dr. Livingstone, on his
+journey from the West to the East Coast, was formerly menaced by a chief
+named Mpende. No offence had been committed against him, but he had
+firearms, and, with the express object of showing his power, he
+threatened to attack the strangers. Mpende's counsellors having,
+however, found out that Dr. Livingstone belonged to a tribe of whom they
+had heard that "they loved the black man and did not make slaves," his
+conduct at once changed from enmity to kindness, and, as the place was
+one well selected for defence, it was perhaps quite as well for Mpende
+that he decided as he did. Three of his counsellors now visited us, and
+we gave them a handsome present for their chief, who came himself next
+morning and made us a present of a goat, a basket of boiled maize, and
+another of vetches. A few miles above this the headman, Chilondo of
+Nyamasusa, apologized for not formerly lending us canoes. "He was
+absent, and his children were to blame for not telling him when the
+Doctor passed; he did not refuse the canoes." The sight of our men, now
+armed with muskets, had a great effect. Without any bullying, firearms
+command respect, and lead men to be reasonable who might otherwise feel
+disposed to be troublesome. Nothing, however, our fracas with Mpende
+excepted, could be more peaceful than our passage through this tract of
+country in 1856. We then had nothing to excite the cupidity of the
+people, and the men maintained themselves, either by selling elephant's
+meat, or by exhibiting feats of foreign dancing. Most of the people were
+very generous and friendly; but the Banyai, nearer to Tette than this,
+stopped our march with a threatening war-dance. One of our party,
+terrified at this, ran away, as we thought, insane, and could not, after
+a painful search of three days, be found. The Banyai, evidently touched
+by our distress, allowed us to proceed. Through a man we left on an
+island a little below Mpende's, we subsequently learned that poor
+Monaheng had fled thither, and had been murdered by the headman for no
+reason except that he was defenceless. This headman had since become
+odious to his countrymen, and had been put to death by them.
+
+On the 23rd of June we entered Pangola's principal village, which is
+upwards of a mile from the river. The ruins of a mud wall showed that a
+rude attempt had been made to imitate the Portuguese style of building.
+We established ourselves under a stately wild fig-tree, round whose trunk
+witchcraft medicine had been tied, to protect from thieves the honey of
+the wild bees, which had their hive in one of the limbs. This is a
+common device. The charm, or the medicine, is purchased of the dice
+doctors, and consists of a strip of palm-leaf smeared with something, and
+adorned with a few bits of grass, wood, or roots. It is tied round the
+tree, and is believed to have the power of inflicting disease and death
+on the thief who climbs over it. Superstition is thus not without its
+uses in certain states of society; it prevents many crimes and
+misdemeanours, which would occur but for the salutary fear that it
+produces.
+
+Pangola arrived, tipsy and talkative.--"We are friends, we are great
+friends; I have brought you a basket of green maize--here it is!" We
+thanked him, and handed him two fathoms of cotton cloth, four times the
+market-value of his present. No, he would not take so small a present;
+he wanted a double-barrelled rifle--one of Dixon's best. "We are
+friends, you know; we are all friends together." But although we were
+willing to admit that, we could not give him our best rifle, so he went
+off in high dudgeon. Early next morning, as we were commencing Divine
+service, Pangola returned, sober. We explained to him that we wished to
+worship God, and invited him to remain; he seemed frightened, and
+retired: but after service he again importuned us for the rifle. It was
+of no use telling him that we had a long journey before us, and needed it
+to kill game for ourselves.--"He too must obtain meat for himself and
+people, for they sometimes suffered from hunger." He then got sulky, and
+his people refused to sell food except at extravagant prices. Knowing
+that we had nothing to eat, they felt sure of starving us into
+compliance. But two of our young men, having gone off at sunrise, shot a
+fine waterbuck, and down came the provision market to the lower figure;
+they even became eager to sell, but our men were angry with them for
+trying compulsion, and would not buy. Black greed had outwitted itself,
+as happens often with white cupidity; and not only here did the traits of
+Africans remind us of Anglo-Saxons elsewhere: the notoriously ready world-
+wide disposition to take an unfair advantage of a man's necessities shows
+that the same mean motives are pretty widely diffused among all races. It
+may not be granted that the same blood flows in all veins, or that all
+have descended from the same stock; but the traveller has no doubt that,
+practically, the white rogue and black are men and brothers.
+
+Pangola is the child or vassal of Mpende. Sandia and Mpende are the only
+independent chiefs from Kebrabasa to Zumbo, and belong to the tribe
+Manganja. The country north of the mountains here in sight from the
+Zambesi is called Senga, and its inhabitants Asenga, or Basenga, but all
+appear to be of the same family as the rest of the Manganja and Maravi.
+Formerly all the Manganja were united under the government of their great
+chief, Undi, whose empire extended from Lake Shirwa to the River Loangwa;
+but after Undi's death it fell to pieces, and a large portion of it on
+the Zambesi was absorbed by their powerful southern neighbours the
+Banyai. This has been the inevitable fate of every African empire from
+time immemorial. A chief of more than ordinary ability arises and,
+subduing all his less powerful neighbours, founds a kingdom, which he
+governs more or less wisely till he dies. His successor not having the
+talents of the conqueror cannot retain the dominion, and some of the
+abler under-chiefs set up for themselves, and, in a few years, the
+remembrance only of the empire remains. This, which may be considered as
+the normal state of African society, gives rise to frequent and
+desolating wars, and the people long in vain for a power able to make all
+dwell in peace. In this light, a European colony would be considered by
+the natives as an inestimable boon to intertropical Africa. Thousands of
+industrious natives would gladly settle round it, and engage in that
+peaceful pursuit of agriculture and trade of which they are so fond, and,
+undistracted by wars or rumours of wars, might listen to the purifying
+and ennobling truths of the gospel of Jesus Christ. The Manganja on the
+Zambesi, like their countrymen on the Shire, are fond of agriculture;
+and, in addition to the usual varieties of food, cultivate tobacco and
+cotton in quantities more than equal to their wants. To the question,
+"Would they work for Europeans?" an affirmative answer may be given, if
+the Europeans belong to the class which can pay a reasonable price for
+labour, and not to that of adventurers who want employment for
+themselves. All were particularly well clothed from Sandia's to
+Pangola's; and it was noticed that all the cloth was of native
+manufacture, the product of their own looms. In Senga a great deal of
+iron is obtained from the ore and manufactured very cleverly.
+
+As is customary when a party of armed strangers visits the village,
+Pangola took the precaution of sleeping in one of the outlying hamlets.
+No one ever knows, or at any rate will tell, where the chief sleeps. He
+came not next morning, so we went our way; but in a few moments we saw
+the rifle-loving chief approaching with some armed men. Before meeting
+us, he left the path and drew up his "following" under a tree, expecting
+us to halt, and give him a chance of bothering us again; but, having
+already had enough of that, we held right on: he seemed dumbfoundered,
+and could hardly believe his own eyes. For a few seconds he was
+speechless, but at last recovered so far as to be able to say, "You are
+passing Pangola. Do you not see Pangola?" Mbia was just going by at the
+time with the donkey, and, proud of every opportunity of airing his small
+stock of English, shouted in reply, "All right! then get on." "Click,
+click, click."
+
+On the 26th June we breakfasted at Zumbo, on the left bank of the
+Loangwa, near the ruins of some ancient Portuguese houses. The Loangwa
+was too deep to be forded, and there were no canoes on our side. Seeing
+two small ones on the opposite shore, near a few recently erected huts of
+two half-castes from Tette, we halted for the ferry-men to come over.
+From their movements it was evident that they were in a state of
+rollicking drunkenness. Having a waterproof cloak, which could be
+inflated into a tiny boat, we sent Mantlanyane across in it. Three half-
+intoxicated slaves then brought us the shaky canoes, which we lashed
+together and manned with our own canoe-men. Five men were all that we
+could carry over at a time; and after four trips had been made the slaves
+began to clamour for drink; not receiving any, as we had none to give,
+they grew more insolent, and declared that not another man should cross
+that day. Sininyane was remonstrating with them, when a loaded musket
+was presented at him by one of the trio. In an instant the gun was out
+of the rascal's hands, a rattling shower of blows fell on his back, and
+he took an involuntary header into the river. He crawled up the bank a
+sad and sober man, and all three at once tumbled from the height of saucy
+swagger to a low depth of slavish abjectness. The musket was found to
+have an enormous charge, and might have blown our man to pieces, but for
+the promptitude with which his companions administered justice in a
+lawless land. We were all ferried safely across by 8 o'clock in the
+evening.
+
+In illustration of what takes place where no government, or law exists,
+the two half-castes, to whom these men belonged, left Tette, with four
+hundred slaves, armed with the old Sepoy Brown Bess, to hunt elephants
+and trade in ivory. On our way up, we heard from natives of their
+lawless deeds, and again, on our way down, from several, who had been
+eyewitnesses of the principal crime, and all reports substantially
+agreed. The story is a sad one. After the traders reached Zumbo, one of
+them, called by the natives Sequasha, entered into a plot with the
+disaffected headman, Namakusuru, to kill his chief, Mpangwe, in order
+that Namakusuru might seize upon the chieftainship; and for the murder of
+Mpangwe the trader agreed to receive ten large tusks of ivory. Sequasha,
+with a picked party of armed slaves, went to visit Mpangwe who received
+him kindly, and treated him with all the honour and hospitality usually
+shown to distinguished strangers, and the women busied themselves in
+cooking the best of their provisions for the repast to be set before him.
+Of this, and also of the beer, the half-caste partook heartily. Mpangwe
+was then asked by Sequasha to allow his men to fire their guns in
+amusement. Innocent of any suspicion of treachery, and anxious to hear
+the report of firearms, Mpangwe at once gave his consent; and the slaves
+rose and poured a murderous volley into the merry group of unsuspecting
+spectators, instantly killing the chief and twenty of his people. The
+survivors fled in horror. The children and young women were seized as
+slaves, and the village sacked. Sequasha sent the message to Namakusuru:
+"I have killed the lion that troubled you; come and let us talk over the
+matter." He came and brought the ivory. "No," said the half-caste, "let
+us divide the land:" and he took the larger share for himself, and
+compelled the would-be usurper to deliver up his bracelets, in token of
+subjection on becoming the child or vassal of Sequasha. These were sent
+in triumph to the authorities at Tette. The governor of Quillimane had
+told us that he had received orders from Lisbon to take advantage of our
+passing to re-establish Zumbo; and accordingly these traders had built a
+small stockade on the rich plain of the right bank of Loangwa, a mile
+above the site of the ancient mission church of Zumbo, as part of the
+royal policy. The bloodshed was quite unnecessary, because, the land at
+Zumbo having of old been purchased, the natives would have always of
+their own accord acknowledged the right thus acquired; they pointed it
+out to Dr. Livingstone in 1856 that, though they were cultivating it, is
+was not theirs, but white man's land. Sequasha and his mate had left
+their ivory in charge of some of their slaves, who, in the absence of
+their masters, were now having a gay time of it, and getting drunk every
+day with the produce of the sacked villages. The head slave came and
+begged for the musket of the delinquent ferryman, which was returned. He
+thought his master did perfectly right to kill Mpangwe, when asked to do
+it for the fee of ten tusks, and he even justified it thus: "If a man
+invites you to eat, will you not partake?"
+
+We continued our journey on the 28th of June. Game was extremely
+abundant, and there were many lions. Mbia drove one off from his feast
+on a wild pig, and appropriated what remained of the pork to his own use.
+Lions are particularly fond of the flesh of wild pigs and zebras, and
+contrive to kill a large number of these animals. In the afternoon we
+arrived at the village of the female chief, Ma-mburuma, but she herself
+was now living on the opposite side of the river. Some of her people
+called, and said she had been frightened by seeing her son and other
+children killed by Sequasha, and had fled to the other bank; but when her
+heart was healed, she would return and live in her own village, and among
+her own people. She constantly inquired of the black traders, who came
+up the river, if they had any news of the white man who passed with the
+oxen. "He has gone down into the sea," was their reply, "but we belong
+to the same people." "Oh no; you need not tell me that; he takes no
+slaves, but wishes peace: you are not of his tribe." This antislavery
+character excites such universal attention, that any missionary who
+winked at the gigantic evils involved in the slave-trade would certainly
+fail to produce any good impression on the native mind.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI.
+
+
+Illness--The Honey-guide--Abundance of game--The Baenda pezi--The Batoka.
+
+We left the river here, and proceeded up the valley which leads to the
+Mburuma or Mohango pass. The nights were cold, and on the 30th of June
+the thermometer was as low as 39 degrees at sunrise. We passed through a
+village of twenty large huts, which Sequasha had attacked on his return
+from the murder of the chief, Mpangwe. He caught the women and children
+for slaves, and carried off all the food, except a huge basket of bran,
+which the natives are wont to save against a time of famine. His slaves
+had broken all the water-pots and the millstones for grinding meal.
+
+The buaze-trees and bamboos are now seen on the hills; but the jujube or
+zisyphus, which has evidently been introduced from India, extends no
+further up the river. We had been eating this fruit, which, having
+somewhat the taste of apples, the Portuguese call Macaas, all the way
+from Tette; and here they were larger than usual, though immediately
+beyond they ceased to be found. No mango-tree either is to be met with
+beyond this point, because the Portuguese traders never established
+themselves anywhere beyond Zumbo. Tsetse flies are more numerous and
+troublesome than we have ever before found them. They accompany us on
+the march, often buzzing round our heads like a swarm of bees. They are
+very cunning, and when intending to bite, alight so gently that their
+presence is not perceived till they thrust in their lance-like proboscis.
+The bite is acute, but the pain is over in a moment; it is followed by a
+little of the disagreeable itching of the mosquito's bite. This fly
+invariably kills all domestic animals except goats and donkeys; man and
+the wild animals escape. We ourselves were severely bitten on this pass,
+and so were our donkeys, but neither suffered from any after effects.
+
+Water is scarce in the Mburuma pass, except during the rainy season. We
+however halted beside some fine springs in the bed of the now dry
+rivulet, Podebode, which is continued down to the end of the pass, and
+yields water at intervals in pools. Here we remained a couple of days in
+consequence of the severe illness of Dr. Kirk. He had several times been
+attacked by fever; and observed that when we were on the cool heights he
+was comfortable, but when we happened to descend from a high to a lower
+altitude, he felt chilly, though the temperature in the latter case was
+25 degrees higher than it was above; he had been trying different
+medicines of reputed efficacy with a view to ascertain whether other
+combinations might not be superior to the preparation we generally used;
+in halting by this water he suddenly became blind, and unable to stand
+from faintness. The men, with great alacrity, prepared a grassy bed, on
+which we laid our companion, with the sad forebodings which only those
+who have tended the sick in a wild country can realize. We feared that
+in experimenting he had over-drugged himself; but we gave him a dose of
+our fever pills; on the third day he rode the one of the two donkeys that
+would allow itself to be mounted, and on the sixth he marched as well as
+any of us. This case is mentioned in order to illustrate what we have
+often observed, that moving the patient from place to place is most
+conducive to the cure; and the more pluck a man has--the less he gives in
+to the disease--the less likely he is to die.
+
+Supplied with water by the pools in the Podebode, we again joined the
+Zambesi at the confluence of the rivulet. When passing through a dry
+district the native hunter knows where to expect water by the animals he
+sees. The presence of the gemsbuck, duiker or diver, springbucks, or
+elephants, is no proof that water is near; for these animals roam over
+vast tracts of country, and may be met scores of miles from it. Not so,
+however, the zebra, pallah, buffalo, and rhinoceros; their spoor gives
+assurance that water is not far off, as they never stray any distance
+from its neighbourhood. But when amidst the solemn stillness of the
+woods, the singing of joyous birds falls upon the ear, it is certain that
+water is close at hand.
+
+Our men in hunting came on an immense herd of buffaloes, quietly resting
+in the long dry grass, and began to blaze away furiously at the
+astonished animals. In the wild excitement of the hunt, which heretofore
+had been conducted with spears, some forgot to load with ball, and,
+firing away vigorously with powder only, wondered for the moment that the
+buffaloes did not fall. The slayer of the young elephant, having buried
+his four bullets in as many buffaloes, fired three charges of No. 1 shot
+he had for killing guinea-fowl. The quaint remarks and merriment after
+these little adventures seemed to the listener like the pleasant prattle
+of children. Mbia and Mantlanyane, however, killed one buffalo each;
+both the beasts were in prime condition; the meat was like really
+excellent beef, with a smack of venison. A troop of hungry, howling
+hyenas also thought the savour tempting, as they hung round the camp at
+night, anxious to partake of the feast. They are, fortunately, arrant
+cowards, and never attack either men or beasts except they can catch them
+asleep, sick, or at some other disadvantage. With a bright fire at our
+feet their presence excites no uneasiness. A piece of meat hung on a
+tree, high enough to make him jump to reach it, and a short spear, with
+its handle firmly planted in the ground beneath, are used as a device to
+induce the hyena to commit suicide by impalement.
+
+The honey-guide is an extraordinary bird; how is it that every member of
+its family has learned that all men, white or black, are fond of honey?
+The instant the little fellow gets a glimpse of a man, he hastens to
+greet him with the hearty invitation to come, as Mbia translated it, to a
+bees' hive, and take some honey. He flies on in the proper direction,
+perches on a tree, and looks back to see if you are following; then on to
+another and another, until he guides you to the spot. If you do not
+accept his first invitation he follows you with pressing importunities,
+quite as anxious to lure the stranger to the bees' hive as other birds
+are to draw him away from their own nest. Except while on the march, our
+men were sure to accept the invitation, and manifested the same by a
+peculiar responsive whistle, meaning, as they said, "All right, go ahead;
+we are coming." The bird never deceived them, but always guided them to
+a hive of bees, though some had but little honey in store. Has this
+peculiar habit of the honey-guide its origin, as the attachment of dogs,
+in friendship for man, or in love for the sweet pickings of the plunder
+left on the ground? Self-interest aiding in preservation from danger
+seems to be the rule in most cases, as, for instance, in the bird that
+guards the buffalo and rhinoceros. The grass is often so tall and dense
+that one could go close up to these animals quite unperceived; but the
+guardian bird, sitting on the beast, sees the approach of danger, flaps
+its wings and screams, which causes its bulky charge to rush off from a
+foe he has neither seen nor heard; for his reward the vigilant little
+watcher has the pick of the parasites on his fat friend. In other cases
+a chance of escape must be given even by the animal itself to its prey;
+as in the rattle-snake, which, when excited to strike, cannot avoid using
+his rattle, any more than the cat can resist curling its tail when
+excited in the chase of a mouse, or the cobra can refrain from inflating
+the loose skin of the neck and extending it laterally, before striking
+its poison fangs into its victim. There are many snakes in parts of this
+pass; they basked in the warm sunshine, but rustled off through the
+leaves as we approached. We observed one morning a small one of a deadly
+poisonous species, named Kakone, on a bush by the wayside, quietly
+resting in a horizontal position, digesting a lizard for breakfast.
+Though openly in view, its colours and curves so closely resembled a
+small branch that some failed to see it, even after being asked if they
+perceived anything on the bush. Here also one of our number had a glance
+at another species, rarely seen, and whose swift lightning-like motion
+has given rise to the native proverb, that when a man sees this snake he
+will forthwith become a rich man.
+
+We slept near the ruined village of the murdered chief, Mpangwe, a lovely
+spot, with the Zambesi in front, and extensive gardens behind, backed by
+a semicircle of hills receding up to lofty mountains. Our path kept
+these mountains on our right, and crossed several streamlets, which
+seemed to be perennial, and among others the Selole, which apparently
+flows past the prominent peak Chiarapela. These rivulets have often
+human dwellings on their banks; but the land can scarcely be said to be
+occupied. The number of all sorts of game increases wonderfully every
+day. As a specimen of what may be met with where there are no human
+habitations, and where no firearms have been introduced, we may mention
+what at times has actually been seen by us. On the morning of July 3rd a
+herd of elephants passed within fifty yards of our sleeping-place, going
+down to the river along the dry bed of a rivulet. Starting a few minutes
+before the main body, we come upon large flocks of guinea-fowl, shoot
+what may be wanted for dinner, or next morning's breakfast, and leave
+them in the path to be picked up by the cook and his mates behind. As we
+proceed, francolins of three varieties run across the path, and hundreds
+of turtle-doves rise, with great blatter of wing, and fly off to the
+trees. Guinea-fowls, francolins, turtle-doves, ducks, and geese are the
+game birds of this region. At sunrise a herd of pallahs, standing like a
+flock of sheep, allow the first man of our long Indian file to approach
+within about fifty yards; but having meat, we let them trot off leisurely
+and unmolested. Soon afterwards we come upon a herd of waterbucks, which
+here are very much darker in colour, and drier in flesh, than the same
+species near the sea. They look at us and we at them; and we pass on to
+see a herd of doe koodoos, with a magnificently horned buck or two,
+hurrying off to the dry hill-sides. We have ceased shooting antelopes,
+as our men have been so often gorged with meat that they have become fat
+and dainty. They say that they do not want more venison, it is so dry
+and tasteless, and ask why we do not give them shot to shoot the more
+savoury guinea-fowl.
+
+About eight o'clock the tsetse commence to buzz about us, and bite our
+hands and necks sharply. Just as we are thinking of breakfast, we meet
+some buffaloes grazing by the path; but they make off in a heavy gallop
+at the sight of man. We fire, and the foremost, badly wounded, separates
+from the herd, and is seen to stop amongst the trees; but, as it is a
+matter of great danger to follow a wounded buffalo, we hold on our way.
+It is this losing of wounded animals which makes firearms so annihilating
+to these beasts of the field, and will in time sweep them all away. The
+small Enfield bullet is worse than the old round one for this. It often
+goes through an animal without killing him, and he afterwards perishes,
+when he is of no value to man. After breakfast we draw near a pond of
+water; a couple of elephants stand on its bank, and, at a respectful
+distance behind these monarchs of the wilderness, is seen a herd of
+zebras, and another of waterbucks. On getting our wind the royal beasts
+make off at once; but the zebras remain till the foremost man is within
+eighty yards of them, when old and young canter gracefully away. The
+zebra has a great deal of curiosity; and this is often fatal to him, for
+he has the habit of stopping to look at the hunter. In this particular
+he is the exact opposite of the diver antelope, which rushes off like the
+wind, and never for a moment stops to look behind, after having once seen
+or smelt danger. The finest zebra of the herd is sometimes shot, our men
+having taken a sudden fancy to the flesh, which all declare to be the
+"king of good meat." On the plains of short grass between us and the
+river many antelopes of different species are calmly grazing, or
+reposing. Wild pigs are common, and walk abroad during the day; but are
+so shy as seldom to allow a close approach. On taking alarm they erect
+their slender tails in the air, and trot off swiftly in a straight line,
+keeping their bodies as steady as a locomotive on a railroad. A mile
+beyond the pool three cow buffaloes with their calves come from the
+woods, and move out into the plain. A troop of monkeys, on the edge of
+the forest, scamper back to its depths on hearing the loud song of
+Singeleka, and old surly fellows, catching sight of the human party,
+insult it with a loud and angry bark. Early in the afternoon we may see
+buffaloes again, or other animals. We camp on the dry higher ground,
+after, as has happened, driving off a solitary elephant. The nights are
+warmer now, and possess nearly as much of interest and novelty as the
+days. A new world awakes and comes forth, more numerous, if we may judge
+by the noise it makes, than that which is abroad by sunlight. Lions and
+hyenas roar around us, and sometimes come disagreeably near, though they
+have never ventured into our midst. Strange birds sing their agreeable
+songs, while others scream and call harshly as if in fear or anger.
+Marvellous insect-sounds fall upon the ear; one, said by natives to
+proceed from a large beetle, resembles a succession of measured musical
+blows upon an anvil, while many others are perfectly indescribable. A
+little lemur was once seen to leap about from branch to branch with the
+agility of a frog; it chirruped like a bird, and is not larger than a
+robin red-breast. Reptiles, though numerous, seldom troubled us; only
+two men suffered from stings, and that very slightly, during the entire
+journey, the one supposed that he was bitten by a snake, and the other
+was stung by a scorpion.
+
+Grass-burning has begun, and is producing the blue hazy atmosphere of the
+American Indian summer, which in Western Africa is called the "smokes."
+Miles of fire burn on the mountain-sides in the evenings, but go out
+during the night. From their height they resemble a broad zigzag line of
+fire in the heavens.
+
+We slept on the night of the 6th of July on the left bank of the Chongwe,
+which comes through a gap in the hills on our right, and is twenty yards
+wide. A small tribe of the Bazizulu, from the south, under Dadanga, have
+recently settled here and built a village. Some of their houses are
+square, and they seem to be on friendly terms with the Bakoa, who own the
+country. They, like the other natives, cultivate cotton, but of a
+different species from any we have yet seen in Africa, the staple being
+very long, and the boll larger than what is usually met with; the seeds
+cohere as in the Pernambuco kind. They brought the seed with them from
+their own country, the distant mountains of which in the south, still
+inhabited by their fellow-countrymen, who possess much cattle and use
+shields, can be seen from this high ground. These people profess to be
+children of the great paramount chief, Kwanyakarombe, who is said to be
+lord of all the Bazizulu. The name of this tribe is known to
+geographers, who derive their information from the Portuguese, as the
+_Morusurus_, and the hills mentioned above are said to have been the
+country of Changamira, the warrior-chief of history, whom no Portuguese
+ever dared to approach. The Bazizulu seem, by report, to be brave
+mountaineers; nearer the river, the Sidima inhabit the plains; just as on
+the north side, the Babimpe live on the heights, about two days off, and
+the Makoa on or near the river. The chief of the Bazizulu we were now
+with was hospitable and friendly. A herd of buffaloes came trampling
+through the gardens and roused up our men; a feat that roaring lions
+seldom achieved.
+
+Our course next day passed over the upper terrace and through a dense
+thorn jungle. Travelling is always difficult where there is no path, but
+it is even more perplexing where the forest is cut up by many
+game-tracks. Here we got separated from one another, and a rhinoceros
+with angry snort dashed at Dr. Livingstone as he stooped to pick up a
+specimen of the wild fruit morula; but she strangely stopped stock-still
+when less than her own length distant, and gave him time to escape; a
+branch pulled out his watch as he ran, and turning half round to grasp
+it, he got a distant glance of her and her calf still standing on the
+selfsame spot, as if arrested in the middle of her charge by an unseen
+hand. When about fifty yards off, thinking his companions close behind,
+he shouted "Look out there!" when off she rushed, snorting loudly, in
+another direction. The Doctor usually went unarmed before this, but
+never afterwards.
+
+A fine eland was shot by Dr. Kirk this afternoon, the first we have
+killed. It was in first-rate condition, and remarkably fat; but the
+meat, though so tempting in appearance, severely deranged all who partook
+of it heartily, especially those who ate of the fat. Natives who live in
+game countries, and are acquainted with the different kinds of wild
+animals, have a prejudice against the fat of the eland, the pallah, the
+zebra, hippopotamus, and pig; they never reject it, however, the climate
+making the desire for all animal food very strong; but they consider that
+it causes ulcers and leprosy, while the fat of sheep and of oxen never
+produces any bad effects, unless the animal is diseased.
+
+On the morning of the 9th, after passing four villages, we breakfasted at
+an old friend's, Tombanyama, who lives now on the mainland, having
+resigned the reedy island, where he was first seen, to the buffaloes,
+which used to take his crops and show fight to his men. He keeps a large
+flock of tame pigeons, and some fine fat capons, one of which he gave us,
+with a basket of meal. They have plenty of salt in this part of the
+country, obtaining it from the plains in the usual way.
+
+The half-caste partner of Sequasha and a number of his men were staying
+near. The fellow was very munch frightened when he saw us, and trembled
+so much when he spoke, that the Makololo and other natives noticed and
+remarked on it. His fears arose from a sense of guilt, as we said
+nothing to frighten him, and did not allude to the murder till a few
+minutes before starting; when it was remarked that Dr. Livingstone having
+been accredited to the murdered chief, it would be his duty to report on
+it; and that not even the Portuguese Government would approve of the
+deed. He defended it by saying that they had put in the right man, the
+other was a usurper. He was evidently greatly relieved when we departed.
+In the afternoon we came to an outlying hamlet of Kambadzo, whose own
+village is on an island, Nyampungo, or Nyangalule, at the confluence of
+the Kafue. The chief was on a visit here, and they had been enjoying a
+regular jollification. There had been much mirth, music, drinking, and
+dancing. The men, and women too, had taken "a wee drap too much," but
+had not passed the complimentary stage. The wife of the headman, after
+looking at us a few moments, called out to the others, "Black traders
+have come before, calling themselves Bazungu, or white men, but now, for
+the first time, have we seen the real Bazungu." Kambadzo also soon
+appeared; he was sorry that we had not come before the beer was all done,
+but he was going back to see if it was all really and entirely finished,
+and not one little potful left somewhere.
+
+This was, of course, mere characteristic politeness, as he was perfectly
+aware that every drop had been swallowed; so we proceeded on to the
+Kafue, or Kafuje, accompanied by the most intelligent of his headmen. A
+high ridge, just before we reached the confluence, commands a splendid
+view of the two great rivers, and the rich country beyond. Behind, on
+the north and east, is the high mountain-range, along whose base we have
+been travelling; the whole range is covered with trees, which appear even
+on the prominent peaks, Chiarapela, Morindi, and Chiava; at this last the
+chain bends away to the N.W., and we could see the distant mountains
+where the chief, Semalembue, gained all our hearts in 1856.
+
+On the 9th of July we tried to send Semalembue a present, but the people
+here refused to incur the responsibility of carrying it. We, who have
+the art of writing, cannot realize the danger one incurs of being accused
+of purloining a portion of goods sent from one person to another, when
+the carrier cannot prove that he delivered all committed to his charge.
+Rumours of a foray having been made, either by Makololo or Batoka, as far
+as the fork of the Kafue, were received here by our men with great
+indignation, as it looked as if the marauders were shutting up the
+country, which they had been trying so much to open. Below the junction
+of the rivers, on a shallow sandbank, lay a large herd of hippopotami,
+their bodies out of the water, like masses of black rock. Kambadzo's
+island, called Nyangalule, a name which occurs again at the mouth of the
+Zambesi, has many choice Motsikiri (_Trachelia_) trees on it; and four
+very conspicuous stately palms growing out of a single stem. The Kafue
+reminds us a little of the Shire, flowing between steep banks, with
+fertile land on both sides. It is a smaller river, and has less current.
+Here it seems to come from the west. The headman of the village, near
+which we encamped, brought a present of meal, fowls, and sweet potatoes.
+They have both the red and white varieties of this potato. We have, on
+several occasions during this journey, felt the want of vegetables, in a
+disagreeable craving which our diet of meat and native meal could not
+satisfy. It became worse and worse till we got a meal of potatoes, which
+allayed it at once. A great scarcity of vegetables prevails in these
+parts of Africa. The natives collect several kinds of wild plants in the
+woods, which they use no doubt for the purpose of driving off cravings
+similar to those we experienced.
+
+Owing to the strength of the wind, and the cranky state of the canoes, it
+was late in the afternoon of the 11th before our party was ferried over
+the Kafue. After crossing, we were in the Bawe country. Fishhooks here,
+of native workmanship, were observed to have barbs like the European
+hooks: elsewhere the point of the hook is merely bent in towards the
+shank, to have the same effect in keeping on the fish as the barb. We
+slept near a village a short distance above the ford. The people here
+are of Batoka origin, the same as many of our men, and call themselves
+Batonga (independents), or Balengi, and their language only differs
+slightly from that of the Bakoa, who live between the two rivers Kafue
+and Loangwa. The paramount chief of the district lives to the west of
+this place, and is called Nchomokela--an hereditary title: the family
+burying-place is on a small hill near this village. The women salute us
+by clapping their hands and lullilooing as we enter and leave a village,
+and the men, as they think, respectfully clap their hands on their hips.
+Immense crops of mapira (_holcus sorghum_) are raised; one species of it
+forms a natural bend on the seed-stalk, so that the massive ear hangs
+down. The grain was heaped up on wooden stages, and so was a variety of
+other products. The men are skilful hunters, and kill elephants and
+buffaloes with long heavy spears. We halted a few minutes on the morning
+of the 12th July, opposite the narrow island of Sikakoa, which has a
+village on its lower end. We were here told that Moselekatse's chief
+town is a month's distance from this place. They had heard, moreover,
+that the English had come to Moselekatse, and told him it was wrong to
+kill men; and he had replied that he was born to kill people, but would
+drop the habit; and, since the English came, he had sent out his men, not
+to kill as of yore, but to collect tribute of cloth and ivory. This
+report referred to the arrival of the Rev. R. Moffat, of Kuruman, who, we
+afterwards found, had established a mission. The statement is
+interesting as showing that, though imperfectly expressed, the purport of
+the missionaries' teaching had travelled, in a short time, over 300
+miles, and we know not how far the knowledge of the English operations on
+the coast spread inland.
+
+When abreast of the high wooded island Kalabi we came in contact with one
+of the game-laws of the country, which has come down from the most
+ancient times. An old buffalo crossed the path a few yards in front of
+us; our guide threw his small spear at its hip, and it was going off
+scarcely hurt, when three rifle balls knocked it over. "It is mine,"
+said the guide. He had wounded it first, and the established native game-
+law is that the animal belongs to the man who first draws blood; the two
+legs on one side, by the same law, belonged to us for killing it. This
+beast was very old, blind of one eye, and scabby; the horns, mere stumps,
+not a foot long, must have atrophied, when by age he lost the strength
+distinctive of his sex; some eighteen or twenty inches of horn could not
+well be worn down by mere rubbing against the trees. We saw many
+buffaloes next day, standing quietly amidst a thick thorn-jungle, through
+which we were passing. They often stood until we were within fifty or a
+hundred yards of them.
+
+On the 14th July we left the river at the mountain-range, which, lying
+north-east and south-west across the river, forms the Kariba gorge. Near
+the upper end of the Kariba rapids, the stream Sanyati enters from the
+south, and is reported to have Moselekatse's principal cattle-posts at
+its sources; our route went round the end of the mountains, and we
+encamped beside the village of the generous chief Moloi, who brought us
+three immense baskets of fine mapira meal, ten fowls, and two pots of
+beer. On receiving a present in return, he rose, and, with a few dancing
+gestures, said or sang, "Motota, Motota, Motota," which our men
+translated into "thanks." He had visited Moselekatse a few months before
+our arrival, and saw the English missionaries, living in their wagons.
+"They told Moselekatse," said he, "they were of his family, or friends,
+and would plough the land and live at their own expense;" and he had
+replied, "The land is before you, and I shall come and see you plough."
+This again was substantially what took place, when Mr. Moffat introduced
+the missionaries to his old friend, and shows still further that the
+notion of losing their country by admitting foreigners does not come as
+the first idea to the native mind. One might imagine that, as mechanical
+powers are unknown to the heathen, the almost magic operations of
+machinery, the discoveries of modern science and art, or the presence of
+the prodigious force which, for instance, is associated with the sight of
+a man-of-war, would have the effect which miracles once had of arresting
+the attention and inspiring awe. But, though we have heard the natives
+exclaim in admiration at the sight of even small illustrations of what
+science enables us to do--"Ye are gods, and not men"--the heart is
+unaffected. In attempting their moral elevation, it is always more
+conducive to the end desired, that the teacher should come unaccompanied
+by any power to cause either jealousy or fear. The heathen, who have not
+become aware of the greed and hate which too often characterize the
+advancing tide of emigration, listen with most attention to the message
+of Divine love when delivered by men who evidently possess the same human
+sympathies with themselves. A chief is rather envied his good fortune in
+first securing foreigners in his town. Jealousy of strangers belongs
+more to the Arab than to the African character; and if the women are let
+alone by the traveller, no danger need be apprehended from any save the
+slave-trading tribes, and not often even from them.
+
+We passed through a fertile country, covered with open forest,
+accompanied by the friendly Bawe. They are very hospitable; many of them
+were named, among themselves, "the Baenda pezi," or "Go-nakeds," their
+only clothing being a coat of red ochre. Occasionally stopping at their
+villages we were duly lullilooed, and regaled with sweet new-made beer,
+which, being yet unfermented, was not intoxicating. It is in this state
+called Liting or Makonde. Some of the men carry large shields of buffalo-
+hide, and all are well supplied with heavy spears. The vicinity of the
+villages is usually cleared and cultivated in large patches; but nowhere
+can the country be said to be stocked with people. At every village
+stands were erected, and piles of the native corn, still unthrashed,
+placed upon them; some had been beaten out, put into oblong parcels made
+of grass, and stacked in wooden frames.
+
+We crossed several rivulets in our course, as the Mandora, the Lofia, the
+Manzaia (with brackish water), the Rimbe, the Chibue, the Chezia, the
+Chilola (containing fragments of coal), which did little more than mark
+our progress. The island and rapid of Nakansalo, of which we had
+formerly heard, were of no importance, the rapid being but half a mile
+long, and only on one side of the island. The island Kaluzi marks one of
+the numerous places where astronomical observations were made; Mozia, a
+station where a volunteer poet left us; the island Mochenya, and Mpande
+island, at the mouth of the Zungwe rivulet, where we left the Zambesi.
+
+When favoured with the hospitality and company of the "Go-nakeds," we
+tried to discover if nudity were the badge of a particular order among
+the Bawe, but they could only refer to custom. Some among them had
+always liked it for no reason in particular: shame seemed to lie dormant,
+and the sense could not be aroused by our laughing and joking them on
+their appearance. They evidently felt no less decent than we did with
+our clothes on; but, whatever may be said in favour of nude statues, it
+struck us that man, in a state of nature, is a most ungainly animal.
+Could we see a number of the degraded of our own lower classes in like
+guise, it is probable that, without the black colour which acts somehow
+as a dress, they would look worse still.
+
+In domestic contentions the Bawe are careful not to kill each other; but,
+when one village goes to war with another, they are not so particular.
+The victorious party are said to quarter one of the bodies of the enemies
+they may have killed, and to perform certain ceremonies over the
+fragments. The vanquished call upon their conquerors to give them a
+portion also; and, when this request is complied with, they too perform
+the same ceremonies, and lament over their dead comrade, after which the
+late combatants may visit each other in peace. Sometimes the head of the
+slain is taken and buried in an ant-hill, till all the flesh is gone; and
+the lower jaw is then worn as a trophy by the slayer; but this we never
+saw, and the foregoing information was obtained only through an
+interpreter.
+
+We left the Zambesi at the mouth of the Zungwe or Mozama or Dela rivulet,
+up which we proceeded, first in a westerly and then in a north-westerly
+direction. The Zungwe at this time had no water in its sandy channel for
+the first eight or ten miles. Willows, however, grow on the banks, and
+water soon began to appear in the hollows; and a few miles further up it
+was a fine flowing stream deliciously cold. As in many other streams
+from Chicova to near Sinamane shale and coal crop out in the bank; and
+here the large roots of stigmaria or its allied plants were found. We
+followed the course of the Zungwe to the foot of the Batoka highlands, up
+whose steep and rugged sides of red and white quartz we climbed till we
+attained an altitude of upwards of 3000 feet. Here, on the cool and
+bracing heights, the exhilaration of mind and body was delightful, as we
+looked back at the hollow beneath covered with a hot sultry glare, not
+unpleasant now that we were in the mild radiance above. We had a noble
+view of the great valley in which the Zambesi flows. The cultivated
+portions are so small in comparison to the rest of the landscape that the
+valley appears nearly all forest, with a few grassy glades. We spent the
+night of the 28th July high above the level of the sea, by the rivulet
+Tyotyo, near Tabacheu or Chirebuechina, names both signifying white
+mountain; in the morning hoar frost covered the ground, and thin ice was
+on the pools. Skirting the southern flank of Tabacheu, we soon passed
+from the hills on to the portion of the vast table-land called Mataba,
+and looking back saw all the way across the Zambesi valley to the lofty
+ridge some thirty miles off, which, coming from the Mashona, a country in
+the S.E., runs to the N.W. to join the ridge at the angle of which are
+the Victoria Falls, and then bends far to the N.E. from the same point.
+Only a few years since these extensive highlands were peopled by the
+Batoka; numerous herds of cattle furnished abundance of milk, and the
+rich soil amply repaid the labour of the husbandman; now large herds of
+buffaloes, zebras, and antelopes fatten on the excellent pasture; and on
+that land, which formerly supported multitudes, not a man is to been
+seen. In travelling from Monday morning till late on Saturday afternoon,
+all the way from Tabacheu to Moachemba, which is only twenty-one miles of
+latitude from the Victoria Falls, and constantly passing the ruined sites
+of utterly deserted Botoka villages, we did not fall in with a single
+person. The Batoka were driven out of their noble country by the
+invasions of Moselekatse and Sebetuane. Several tribes of Bechuana and
+Basutu, fleeing from the Zulu or Matebele chief Moselekatse reached the
+Zambesi above the Falls. Coming from a land without rivers, none of them
+knew how to swim; and one tribe, called the Bamangwato, wishing to cross
+the Zambesi, was ferried over, men and women separately, to different
+islands, by one of the Batoka chiefs; the men were then left to starve
+and the women appropriated by the ferryman and his people. Sekomi, the
+present chief of the Bamangwato, then an infant in his mother's arms, was
+enabled, through the kindness of a private Batoka, to escape. This act
+seems to have made an indelible impression on Sekomi's heart, for though
+otherwise callous, he still never fails to inquire after the welfare of
+his benefactor.
+
+Sebetuane, with his wonted ability, outwitted the treacherous Batoka, by
+insisting in the politest manner on their chief remaining at his own side
+until the people and cattle were all carried safe across; the chief was
+then handsomely rewarded, both with cattle and brass rings off
+Sebetuane's own wives. No sooner were the Makololo, then called Basuto,
+safely over, than they were confronted by the whole Batoka nation; and to
+this day the Makololo point with pride to the spot on the Lekone, near to
+which they were encamped, where Sebetuane, with a mere handful of
+warriors in comparison to the vast horde that surrounded him, stood
+waiting the onslaught, the warriors in one small body, the women and
+children guarding the cattle behind them. The Batoka, of course, melted
+away before those who had been made veterans by years of continual
+fighting, and Sebetuane always justified his subsequent conquests in that
+country by alleging that the Batoka had come out to fight with a man
+fleeing for his life, who had never done them any wrong. They seem never
+to have been a warlike race; passing through their country, we once
+observed a large stone cairn, and our guide favoured us with the
+following account of it:--"Once upon a time, our forefathers were going
+to fight another tribe, and here they halted and sat down. After a long
+consultation, they came to the unanimous conclusion that, instead of
+proceeding to fight and kill their neighbours, and perhaps be killed
+themselves, it would be more like men to raise this heap of stones, as
+their protest against the wrong the other tribe had done them, which,
+having accomplished, they returned quietly home." Such men of peace
+could not stand before the Makololo, nor, of course, the more warlike
+Matebele, who coming afterwards, drove even their conquerors, the
+Makololo, out of the country. Sebetuane, however, profiting by the
+tactics which he had learned of the Batoka, inveigled a large body of
+this new enemy on to another island, and after due starvation there
+overcame the whole. A much greater army of "Moselekatse's own" followed
+with canoes, but were now baffled by Sebetuane's placing all his people
+and cattle on an island and so guarding it that none could approach.
+Dispirited, famished, borne down by fever, they returned to the Falls,
+and all except five were cut off.
+
+But though the Batoka appear never to have had much inclination to fight
+with men, they are decidedly brave hunters of buffaloes and elephants.
+They go fearlessly close up to these formidable animals, and kill them
+with large spears. The Banyai, who have long bullied all Portuguese
+traders, were amazed at the daring and bravery of the Batoka in coming at
+once to close quarters with the elephant; and Chisaka, a Portuguese
+rebel, having formerly induced a body of this tribe to settle with him,
+ravaged all the Portuguese villas around Tette. They bear the name of
+Basimilongwe, and some of our men found relations among them. Sininyane
+and Matenga also, two of our party, were once inveigled into a Portuguese
+expedition against Mariano, by the assertion that the Doctor had arrived
+and had sent for them to come down to Senna. On finding that they were
+entrapped to fight, they left, after seeing an officer with a large
+number of Tette slaves killed.
+
+The Batoka had attained somewhat civilized ideas, in planting and
+protecting various fruit and oil-seed yielding trees of the country. No
+other tribe either plants or abstains from cutting down fruit trees, but
+here we saw some which had been planted in regular rows, and the trunks
+of which were quite two feet in diameter. The grand old Mosibe, a tree
+yielding a bean with a thin red pellicle, said to be very fattening, had
+probably seen two hundred summers. Dr. Kirk found that the Mosibe is
+peculiar, in being allied to a species met with only in the West Indies.
+The Motsikiri, sometimes called Mafuta, yields a hard fat, and an oil
+which is exported from Inhambane. It is said that two ancient Batoka
+travellers went down as far as the Loangwa, and finding the Macaa tree
+(_jujube_ or _zisyphus_) in fruit, carried the seed all the way back to
+the great Falls, in order to plant them. Two of these trees are still to
+be seen there, the only specimens of the kind in that region.
+
+The Batoka had made a near approach to the custom of more refined nations
+and had permanent graveyards, either on the sides of hills, thus rendered
+sacred, or under large old shady trees; they reverence the tombs of their
+ancestors, and plant the largest elephants' tusks, as monuments at the
+head of the grave, or entirely enclose it with the choicest ivory. Some
+of the other tribes throw the dead body into the river to be devoured by
+crocodiles, or, sewing it up in a mat, place it on the branch of a
+baobab, or cast it in some lonely gloomy spot, surrounded by dense
+tropical vegetation, where it affords a meal to the foul hyenas; but the
+Batoka reverently bury their dead, and regard the spot henceforth as
+sacred. The ordeal by the poison of the muave is resorted to by the
+Batoka, as well as by the other tribes; but a cock is often made to stand
+proxy for the supposed witch. Near the confluence of the Kafue the
+Mambo, or chief, with some of his headmen, came to our sleeping-place
+with a present; their foreheads were smeared with white flour, and an
+unusual seriousness marked their demeanour. Shortly before our arrival
+they had been accused of witchcraft; conscious of innocence, they
+accepted the ordeal, and undertook to drink the poisoned muave. For this
+purpose they made a journey to the sacred hill of Nchomokela, on which
+repose the bodies of their ancestors; and, after a solemn appeal to the
+unseen spirits to attest the innocence of their children, they swallowed
+the muave, vomited, and were therefore declared not guilty. It is
+evident that they believe that the soul has a continued existence; and
+that the spirits of the departed know what those they have left behind
+them are doing, and are pleased or not according as their deeds are good
+or evil; this belief is universal. The owner of a large canoe refused to
+sell it, because it belonged to the spirit of his father, who helped him
+when he killed the hippopotamus. Another, when the bargain for his canoe
+was nearly completed, seeing a large serpent on a branch of the tree
+overhead, refused to complete the sale, alleging that this was the spirit
+of his father come to protest against it.
+
+Some of the Batoka chiefs must have been men of considerable enterprise;
+the land of one, in the western part of this country, was protected by
+the Zambesi on the S., and on the N. and E. lay an impassable reedy
+marsh, filled with water all the year round, leaving only his western
+border open to invasion: he conceived the idea of digging a broad and
+deep canal nearly a mile in length, from the reedy marsh to the Zambesi,
+and, having actually carried the scheme into execution, he formed a large
+island, on which his cattle grazed in safety, and his corn ripened from
+year to year secure from all marauders.
+
+Another chief, who died a number of years ago, believed that he had
+discovered a remedy for tsetse-bitten cattle; his son Moyara showed us a
+plant, which was new to our botanist, and likewise told us how the
+medicine was prepared; the bark of the root, and, what might please our
+homoeopathic friends, a dozen of the tsetse are dried, and ground
+together into a fine powder. This mixture is administered internally;
+and the cattle are fumigated by burning under them the rest of the plant
+collected. The treatment must be continued for weeks, whenever the
+symptoms of poison appear. This medicine, he frankly admitted, would not
+cure all the bitten cattle. "For," said he, "cattle, and men too, die in
+spite of medicine; but should a herd by accident stray into a tsetse
+district and be bitten, by this medicine of my father, Kampa-kampa, some
+of them could be saved, while, without it, all would inevitably die." He
+stipulated that we were not to show the medicine to other people, and if
+ever we needed it in this region we must employ him; but if we were far
+off we might make it ourselves; and when we saw it cure the cattle think
+of him, and send him a present.
+
+Our men made it known everywhere that we wished the tribes to live in
+peace, and would use our influence to induce Sekeletu to prevent the
+Batoka of Moshobotwane and the Makololo under-chiefs making forays into
+their country: they had already suffered severely, and their
+remonstrances with their countryman, Moshobotwane, evoked only the
+answer, "The Makololo have given me a spear; why should I not use it?"
+He, indeed, it was who, being remarkably swift of foot, first guided the
+Makololo in their conquest of the country. In the character of
+peacemakers, therefore, we experienced abundant hospitality; and, from
+the Kafue to the Falls, none of our party was allowed to suffer hunger.
+The natives sent to our sleeping-places generous presents of the finest
+white meal, and fat capons to give it a relish, great pots of beer to
+comfort our hearts, together with pumpkins, beans, and tobacco, so that
+we "should sleep neither hungry nor thirsty."
+
+In travelling from the Kafue to the Zungwe we frequently passed several
+villages in the course of a day's march. In the evening came deputies
+from the villages, at which we could not stay to sleep, with liberal
+presents of food. It would have pained them to have allowed strangers to
+pass without partaking of their hospitality; repeatedly were we hailed
+from huts, and asked to wait a moment and drink a little of the beer,
+which was brought with alacrity. Our march resembled a triumphant
+procession. We entered and left every village amidst the cheers of its
+inhabitants; the men clapping their hands, and the women lullilooing,
+with the shrill call, "Let us sleep," or "Peace." Passing through a
+hamlet one day, our guide called to the people, "Why do you not clap your
+hands and salute when you see men who are wishing to bring peace to the
+land?" When we halted for the night it was no uncommon thing for the
+people to prepare our camp entirely of their own accord; some with hoes
+quickly smoothed the ground for our beds, others brought dried grass and
+spread it carefully over the spot; some with their small axes speedily
+made a bush fence to shield us from the wind; and if, as occasionally
+happened, the water was a little distance off, others hastened and
+brought it with firewood to cook our food with. They are an industrious
+people, and very fond of agriculture. For hours together we marched
+through unbroken fields of mapira, or native corn, of a great width; but
+one can give no idea of the extent of land under the hoe as compared with
+any European country. The extent of surface is so great that the largest
+fields under culture, when viewed on a wide landscape, dwindle to mere
+spots. When taken in connection with the wants of the people, the
+cultivation on the whole is most creditable to their industry. They
+erect numerous granaries which give their villages the appearance of
+being large; and, when the water of the Zambesi has subsided, they place
+large quantities of grain, tied up in bundles of grass, and well
+plastered over with clay, on low sand islands for protection from the
+attacks of marauding mice and men. Owing to the ravages of the weevil,
+the native corn can hardly be preserved until the following crop comes
+in. However largely they may cultivate, and however abundant the
+harvest, it must all be consumed in a year. This may account for their
+making so much of it into beer. The beer these Batoka or Bawe brew is
+not the sour and intoxicating boala or pombe found among some other
+tribes, but sweet, and highly nutritive, with only a slight degree of
+acidity, sufficient to render it a pleasant drink. The people were all
+plump, and in good condition; and we never saw a single case of
+intoxication among them, though all drank abundance of this liting, or
+sweet beer. Both men and boys were eager to work for very small pay. Our
+men could hire any number of them to carry their burdens for a few beads
+a day. Our miserly and dirty ex-cook had an old pair of trousers that
+some one had given to him; after he had long worn them himself, with one
+of the sorely decayed legs he hired a man to carry his heavy load a whole
+day; a second man carried it the next day for the other leg, and what
+remained of the old garment, without the buttons, procured the labour of
+another man for the third day.
+
+Men of remarkable ability have risen up among the Africans from time to
+time, as amongst other portions of the human family. Some have attracted
+the attention, and excited the admiration of large districts by their
+wisdom. Others, apparently by the powers of ventriloquism, or by
+peculiar dexterity in throwing the spear, or shooting with the bow, have
+been the wonder of their generation; but the total absence of literature
+leads to the loss of all former experience, and the wisdom of the wise
+has not been handed down. They have had their minstrels too, but mere
+tradition preserves not their effusions. One of these, and apparently a
+genuine poet, attached himself to our party for several days, and
+whenever we halted, sang our praises to the villagers, in smooth and
+harmonious numbers. It was a sort of blank verse, and each line
+consisted of five syllables. The song was short when it first began, but
+each day he picked up more information about us, and added to the poem
+until our praises became an ode of respectable length. When distance
+from home compelled his return he expressed his regret at leaving us, and
+was, of course, paid for his useful and pleasant flatteries. Another,
+though a less gifted son of song, belonged to the Batoka of our own
+party. Every evening, while the others were cooking, talking, or
+sleeping, he rehearsed his songs, containing a history of everything he
+had seen in the land of the white men, and on the way back. In
+composing, extempore, any new piece, he was never at a loss; for if the
+right word did not come he halted not, but eked out the measure with a
+peculiar musical sound meaning nothing at all. He accompanied his
+recitations on the _sansa_, an instrument figured in the woodcut, the
+nine iron keys of which are played with the thumbs, while the fingers
+pass behind to hold it. The hollow end and ornaments face the breast of
+the player. Persons of a musical turn, if too poor to buy a sansa, may
+be seen playing vigorously on an instrument made with a number of thick
+corn-stalks sewn together, as a sansa frame, and keys of split bamboo,
+which, though making but little sound, seems to soothe the player
+himself. When the instrument is played with a calabash as a sounding
+board, it emits a greater volume of sound. Pieces of shells and tin are
+added to make a jingling accompaniment, and the calabash is also
+ornamented.
+
+After we had passed up, a party of slaves, belonging to the two native
+Portuguese who assassinated the chief, Mpangwe, and took possession of
+his lands at Zumbo, followed on our footsteps, and representing
+themselves to be our "children," bought great quantities of ivory from
+the Bawe, for a few coarse beads a tusk. They also purchased ten large
+new canoes to carry it, at the rate of six strings of red or white beads,
+or two fathoms of grey calico, for each canoe, and, at the same cheap
+rate, a number of good-looking girls.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII.
+
+
+The Victoria Falls of the Zambesi--Marvellous grandeur of the
+Cataracts--The Makololo's town--The Chief Sekeletu.
+
+During the time we remained at Motunta a splendid meteor was observed to
+lighten the whole heavens. The observer's back was turned to it, but on
+looking round the streak of light was seen to remain on its path some
+seconds. This streak is usually explained to be only the continuance of
+the impression made by the shining body on the retina. This cannot be,
+as in this case the meteor was not actually seen and yet the streak was
+clearly perceived. The rays of planets and stars also require another
+explanation than that usually given.
+
+Fruit-trees and gigantic wild fig-trees, and circles of stones on which
+corn safes were placed, with worn grindstones, point out where the
+villages once stood. The only reason now assigned for this fine country
+remaining desolate is the fear of fresh visitations by the Matebele. The
+country now slopes gradually to the west into the Makololo Valley. Two
+days' march from the Batoka village nearest the highlands, we met with
+some hunters who were burning the dry grass, in order to attract the game
+by the fresh vegetation which speedily springs up afterwards. The grass,
+as already remarked, is excellent for cattle. One species, with leaves
+having finely serrated edges, and of a reddish-brown colour, we noticed
+our men eating: it tastes exactly like liquorice-root, and is named kezu-
+kezu. The tsetse, known to the Batoka by the name "ndoka," does not
+exist here, though buffaloes and elephants abound.
+
+A small trap in the path, baited with a mouse, to catch spotted cats (_F.
+Genetta_), is usually the first indication that we are drawing near to a
+village; but when we get within the sounds of pounding corn, cockcrowing,
+or the merry shouts of children at play, we know that the huts are but a
+few yards off, though the trees conceal them from view. We reached, on
+the 4th of August, Moachemba, the first of the Batoka villages which now
+owe allegiance to Sekeletu, and could see distinctly with the naked eye,
+in the great valley spread out before us, the columns of vapour rising
+from the Victoria Falls, though upwards of 20 miles distant. We were
+informed that, the rains having failed this year, the corn crops had been
+lost, and great scarcity and much hunger prevailed from Sesheke to
+Linyanti. Some of the reports which the men had heard from the Batoka of
+the hills concerning their families, were here confirmed. Takelang's
+wife had been killed by Mashotlane, the headman at the Falls, on a
+charge, as usual, of witchcraft. Inchikola's two wives, believing him to
+be dead, had married again; and Masakasa was intensely disgusted to hear
+that two years ago his friends, upon a report of his death, threw his
+shield over the Falls, slaughtered all his oxen, and held a species of
+wild Irish wake, in honour of his memory: he said he meant to disown
+them, and to say, when they come to salute him, "I am dead. I am not
+here. I belong to another world, and should stink if I came among you."
+
+All the sad news we had previously heard, of the disastrous results which
+followed the attempt of a party of missionaries, under the Rev. H.
+Helmore, to plant the gospel at Linyanti, were here fully confirmed.
+Several of the missionaries and their native attendants, from Kuruman,
+had succumbed to the fever, and the survivors had retired some weeks
+before our arrival. We remained the whole of the 7th beside the village
+of the old Batoka chief, Moshobotwane, the stoutest man we have seen in
+Africa. The cause of our delay here was a severe attack of fever in
+Charles Livingstone. He took a dose of our fever pills; was better on
+the 8th, and marched three hours; then on the 9th marched eight miles to
+the Great Falls, and spent the rest of the day in the fatiguing exercise
+of sight-seeing. We were in the very same valley as Linyanti, and this
+was the same fever which treated, or rather maltreated, with only a
+little Dover's powder, proved so fatal to poor Helmore; the symptoms,
+too, were identical with those afterwards described by non-medical
+persons as those of poison.
+
+We gave Moshobotwane a present, and a pretty plain exposition of what we
+thought of his bloody forays among his Batoka brethren. A scolding does
+most good to the recipient, when put alongside some obliging act. He
+certainly did not take it ill, as was evident from what he gave us in
+return; which consisted of a liberal supply of meal, milk, and an ox. He
+has a large herd of cattle, and a tract of fine pasture-land on the
+beautiful stream Lekone. A home-feeling comes over one, even in the
+interior of Africa, at seeing once more cattle grazing peacefully in the
+meadows. The tsetse inhabits the trees which bound the pasture-land on
+the west; so, should the herdsman forget his duty, the cattle straying
+might be entirely lost. The women of this village were more numerous
+than the men, the result of the chief's marauding. The Batoko wife of
+Sima came up from the Falls, to welcome her husband back, bringing a
+present of the best fruits of the country. Her husband was the only one
+of the party who had brought a wife from Tette, namely, the girl whom he
+obtained from Chisaka for his feats of dancing. According to our ideas,
+his first wife could hardly have been pleased at seeing the second and
+younger one; but she took her away home with her, while the husband
+remained with us. In going down to the Fall village we met several of
+the real Makololo. They are lighter in colour than the other tribes,
+being of a rich warm brown; and they speak in a slow deliberate manner,
+distinctly pronouncing every word. On reaching the village opposite
+Kalai, we had an interview with the Makololo headman, Mashotlane: he came
+to the shed in which we were seated, a little boy carrying his low three-
+legged stool before him: on this he sat down with becoming dignity,
+looked round him for a few seconds, then at us, and, saluting us with
+"Rumela" (good morning, or hail), he gave us some boiled hippopotamus
+meat, took a piece himself, and then handed the rest to his attendants,
+who soon ate it up. He defended his forays on the ground that, when he
+went to collect tribute, the Batoka attacked him, and killed some of his
+attendants. The excuses made for their little wars are often the very
+same as those made by Caesar in his "Commentaries." Few admit, like old
+Moshobotwane, that they fought because they had the power, and a fair
+prospect of conquering. We found here Pitsane, who had accompanied the
+Doctor to St. Paul de Loanda. He had been sent by Sekeletu to purchase
+three horses from a trading party of Griquas from Kuruman, who charged
+nine large tusks apiece for very wretched animals.
+
+In the evening, when all was still, one of our men, Takelang, fired his
+musket, and cried out, "I am weeping for my wife: my court is desolate: I
+have no home;" and then uttered a loud wail of anguish.
+
+We proceeded next morning, 9th August, 1860, to see the Victoria Falls.
+Mosi-oa-tunya is the Makololo name and means smoke sounding; Seongo or
+Chongwe, meaning the Rainbow, or the place of the Rainbow, was the more
+ancient term they bore. We embarked in canoes, belonging to Tuba Mokoro,
+"smasher of canoes," an ominous name; but he alone, it seems, knew the
+medicine which insures one against shipwreck in the rapids above the
+Falls. For some miles the river was smooth and tranquil, and we glided
+pleasantly over water clear as crystal, and past lovely islands densely
+covered with a tropical vegetation. Noticeable among the many trees were
+the lofty Hyphaene and Borassus palms; the graceful wild date-palm, with
+its fruit in golden clusters, and the umbrageous mokononga, of cypress
+form, with its dark-green leaves and scarlet fruit. Many flowers peeped
+out near the water's edge, some entirely new to us, and others, as the
+convolvulus, old acquaintances.
+
+But our attention was quickly called from the charming islands to the
+dangerous rapids, down which Tuba might unintentionally shoot us. To
+confess the truth, the very ugly aspect of these roaring rapids could
+scarcely fail to cause some uneasiness in the minds of new-comers. It is
+only when the river is very low, as it was now, that any one durst
+venture to the island to which we were bound. If one went during the
+period of flood, and fortunately hit the island, he would be obliged to
+remain there till the water subsided again, if he lived so long. Both
+hippopotami and elephants have been known to be swept over the Falls, and
+of course smashed to pulp.
+
+Before entering the race of waters, we were requested not to speak, as
+our talking might diminish the virtue of the medicine; and no one with
+such boiling eddying rapids before his eyes, would think of disobeying
+the orders of a "canoe-smasher." It soon became evident that there was
+sound sense in this request of Tuba's, although the reason assigned was
+not unlike that of the canoe-man from Sesheke, who begged one of our
+party not to whistle, because whistling made the wind come. It was the
+duty of the man at the bow to look out ahead for the proper course, and
+when he saw a rock or snag, to call out to the steersman. Tuba doubtless
+thought that talking on board might divert the attention of his
+steersman, at a time when the neglect of an order, or a slight mistake,
+would be sure to spill us all into the chafing river. There were places
+where the utmost exertions of both men had to be put forth in order to
+force the canoe to the only safe part of the rapid, and to prevent it
+from sweeping down broadside on, where in a twinkling we should have
+found ourselves floundering among the plotuses and cormorants, which were
+engaged in diving for their breakfast of small fish. At times it seemed
+as if nothing could save us from dashing in our headlong race against the
+rocks which, now that the river was low, jutted out of the water; but
+just at the very nick of time, Tuba passed the word to the steersman, and
+then with ready pole turned the canoe a little aside, and we glided
+swiftly past the threatened danger. Never was canoe more admirably
+managed: once only did the medicine seem to have lost something of its
+efficacy. We were driving swiftly down, a black rock over which the
+white foam flew, lay directly in our path, the pole was planted against
+it as readily as ever, but it slipped, just as Tuba put forth his
+strength to turn the bow off. We struck hard, and were half-full of
+water in a moment; Tuba recovered himself as speedily, shoved off the
+bow, and shot the canoe into a still shallow place, to bale out the
+water. Here we were given to understand that it was not the medicine
+which was at fault; that had lost none of its virtue; the accident was
+owing entirely to Tuba having started without his breakfast. Need it be
+said we never let Tuba go without that meal again?
+
+We landed at the head of Garden Island, which is situated near the middle
+of the river and on the lip of the Falls. On reaching that lip, and
+peering over the giddy height, the wondrous and unique character of the
+magnificent cascade at once burst upon us.
+
+It is rather a hopeless task to endeavour to convey an idea of it in
+words, since, as was remarked on the spot, an accomplished painter, even
+by a number of views, could but impart a faint impression of the glorious
+scene. The probable mode of its formation may perhaps help to the
+conception of its peculiar shape. Niagara has been formed by a wearing
+back of the rock over which the river falls; and during a long course of
+ages, it has gradually receded, and left a broad, deep, and pretty
+straight trough in front. It goes on wearing back daily, and may yet
+discharge the lakes from which its river--the St. Lawrence--flows. But
+the Victoria Falls have been formed by a crack right across the river, in
+the hard, black, basaltic rock which there formed the bed of the Zambesi.
+The lips of the crack are still quite sharp, save about three feet of the
+edge over which the river rolls. The walls go sheer down from the lips
+without any projecting crag, or symptoms of stratification or
+dislocation. When the mighty rift occurred, no change of level took
+place in the two parts of the bed of the river thus rent asunder,
+consequently, in coming down the river to Garden Island, the water
+suddenly disappears, and we see the opposite side of the cleft, with
+grass and trees growing where once the river ran, on the same level as
+that part of its bed on which we sail. The first crack is, in length, a
+few yards more than the breadth of the Zambesi, which by measurement we
+found to be a little over 1860 yards, but this number we resolved to
+retain as indicating the year in which the Fall was for the first time
+carefully examined. The main stream here runs nearly north and south,
+and the cleft across it is nearly east and west. The depth of the rift
+was measured by lowering a line, to the end of which a few bullets and a
+foot of white cotton cloth were tied. One of us lay with his head over a
+projecting crag, and watched the descending calico, till, after his
+companions had paid out 310 feet, the weight rested on a sloping
+projection, probably 50 feet from the water below, the actual bottom
+being still further down. The white cloth now appeared the size of a
+crown-piece. On measuring the width of this deep cleft by sextant, it
+was found at Garden Island, its narrowest part, to be eighty yards, and
+at its broadest somewhat more. Into this chasm, of twice the depth of
+Niagara-fall, the river, a full mile wide, rolls with a deafening roar;
+and this is Mosi-oa-tunya, or the Victoria Falls.
+
+Looking from Garden Island, down to the bottom of the abyss, nearly half
+a mile of water, which has fallen over that portion of the Falls to our
+right, or west of our point of view, is seen collected in a narrow
+channel twenty or thirty yards wide, and flowing at exactly right angles
+to its previous course, to our left; while the other half, or that which
+fell over the eastern portion of the Falls, is seen in the left of the
+narrow channel below, coming towards our right. Both waters unite
+midway, in a fearful boiling whirlpool, and find an outlet by a crack
+situated at right angles to the fissure of the Falls. This outlet is
+about 1170 yards from the western end of the chasm, and some 600 from its
+eastern end; the whirlpool is at its commencement. The Zambesi, now
+apparently not more than twenty or thirty yards wide, rushes and surges
+south, through the narrow escape-channel for 130 yards; then enters a
+second chasm somewhat deeper, and nearly parallel with the first.
+Abandoning the bottom of the eastern half of this second chasm to the
+growth of large trees, it turns sharply off to the west, and forms a
+promontory, with the escape-channel at its point, of 1170 yards long, and
+416 yards broad at the base. After reaching this base, the river runs
+abruptly round the head of another promontory, and flows away to the
+east, in a third chasm; then glides round a third promontory, much
+narrower than the rest, and away back to the west, in a fourth chasm; and
+we could see in the distance that it appeared to round still another
+promontory, and bend once more in another chasm towards the east. In
+this gigantic, zigzag, yet narrow trough, the rocks are all so sharply
+cut and angular, that the idea at once arises that the hard basaltic trap
+must have been riven into its present shape by a force acting from
+beneath, and that this probably took place when the ancient inland seas
+were let off by similar fissures nearer the ocean.
+
+The land beyond, or on the south of the Falls, retains, as already
+remarked, the same level as before the rent was made. It is as if the
+trough below Niagara were bent right and left, several times before it
+reached the railway bridge. The land in the supposed bends being of the
+same height as that above the Fall, would give standing-places, or points
+of view, of the same nature as that from the railway-bridge, but the
+nearest would be only eighty yards, instead of two miles (the distance to
+the bridge) from the face of the cascade. The tops of the promontories
+are in general flat, smooth, and studded with trees. The first, with its
+base on the east, is at one place so narrow, that it would be dangerous
+to walk to its extremity. On the second, however, we found a broad
+rhinoceros path and a hut; but, unless the builder were a hermit, with a
+pet rhinoceros, we cannot conceive what beast or man ever went there for.
+On reaching the apex of this second eastern promontory we saw the great
+river, of a deep sea-green colour, now sorely compressed, gliding away,
+at least 400 feet below us.
+
+Garden Island, when the river is low, commands the best view of the Great
+Fall chasm, as also of the promontory opposite, with its grove of large
+evergreen trees, and brilliant rainbows of three-quarters of a circle,
+two, three, and sometimes even four in number, resting on the face of the
+vast perpendicular rock, down which tiny streams are always running to be
+swept again back by the upward rushing vapour. But as, at Niagara, one
+has to go over to the Canadian shore to see the chief wonder--the Great
+Horse-shoe Fall--so here we have to cross over to Moselekatse's side to
+the promontory of evergreens, for the best view of the principal Falls of
+Mosi-oa-tunya. Beginning, therefore, at the base of this promontory, and
+facing the Cataract, at the west end of the chasm, there is, first, a
+fall of thirty-six yards in breadth, and of course, as they all are,
+upwards of 310 feet in depth. Then Boaruka, a small island, intervenes,
+and next comes a great fall, with a breadth of 573 yards; a projecting
+rock separates this from a second grand fall of 325 yards broad; in all,
+upwards of 900 yards of perennial Falls. Further east stands Garden
+Island; then, as the river was at its lowest, came a good deal of the
+bare rock of its bed, with a score of narrow falls, which, at the time of
+flood, constitute one enormous cascade of nearly another half-mile. Near
+the east end of the chasm are two larger falls, but they are nothing at
+low water compared to those between the islands.
+
+The whole body of water rolls clear over, quite unbroken; but, after a
+descent of ten or more feet, the entire mass suddenly becomes like a huge
+sheet of driven snow. Pieces of water leap off it in the form of comets
+with tails streaming behind, till the whole snowy sheet becomes myriads
+of rushing, leaping, aqueous comets. This peculiarity was not observed
+by Charles Livingstone at Niagara, and here it happens, possibly from the
+dryness of the atmosphere, or whatever the cause may be which makes every
+drop of Zambesi water appear to possess a sort of individuality. It runs
+off the ends of the paddles, and glides in beads along the smooth
+surface, like drops of quicksilver on a table. Here we see them in a
+conglomeration, each with a train of pure white vapour, racing down till
+lost in clouds of spray. A stone dropped in became less and less to the
+eye, and at last disappeared in the dense mist below.
+
+Charles Livingstone had seen Niagara, and gave Mosi-oa-tunya the palm,
+though now at the end of a drought, and the river at its very lowest.
+Many feel a disappointment on first seeing the great American Falls, but
+Mosi-oa-tunya is so strange, it must ever cause wonder. In the amount of
+water, Niagara probably excels, though not during the months when the
+Zambesi is in flood. The vast body of water, separating in the comet-
+like forms described, necessarily encloses in its descent a large volume
+of air, which, forced into the cleft, to an unknown depth, rebounds, and
+rushes up loaded with vapour to form the three or even six columns, as if
+of steam, visible at the Batoka village Moachemba, twenty-one miles
+distant. On attaining a height of 200, or at most 300 feet from the
+level of the river above the cascade, this vapour becomes condensed into
+a perpetual shower of fine rain. Much of the spray, rising to the west
+of Garden Island, falls on the grove of evergreen trees opposite; and
+from their leaves, heavy drops are for ever falling, to form sundry
+little rills, which, in running down the steep face of rock, are blown
+off and turned back, or licked off their perpendicular bed, up into the
+column from which they have just descended.
+
+The morning sun gilds these columns of watery smoke with all the glowing
+colours of double or treble rainbows. The evening sun, from a hot yellow
+sky, imparts a sulphureous hue, and gives one the impression that the
+yawning gulf might resemble the mouth of the bottomless pit. No bird
+sits and sings on the branches of the grove of perpetual showers, or ever
+builds its nest there. We saw hornbills and flocks of little black
+weavers flying across from the mainland to the islands, and from the
+islands to the points of the promontories and back again, but they
+uniformly shunned the region of perpetual rain, occupied by the evergreen
+grove. The sunshine, elsewhere in this land so overpowering, never
+penetrates the deep gloom of that shade. In the presence of the strange
+Mosi-oa-tunya, we can sympathize with those who, when the world was
+young, peopled earth, air, and river, with beings not of mortal form.
+Sacred to what deity would be this awful chasm and that dark grove, over
+which hovers an ever-abiding "pillar of cloud"?
+
+The ancient Batoka chieftains used Kazeruka, now Garden Island, and
+Boaruka, the island further west, also on the lip of the Falls, as sacred
+spots for worshipping the Deity. It is no wonder that under the cloudy
+columns, and near the brilliant rainbows, with the ceaseless roar of the
+cataract, with the perpetual flow, as if pouring forth from the hand of
+the Almighty, their souls should be filled with reverential awe. It
+inspired wonder in the native mind throughout the interior. Among the
+first questions asked by Sebituane of Mr. Oswell and Dr. Livingstone, in
+1851, was, "Have you any smoke soundings in your country," and "what
+causes the smoke to rise for ever so high out of water?" In that year
+its fame was heard 200 miles off, and it was approached within two days;
+but it was seen by no European till 1855, when Dr. Livingstone visited it
+on his way to the East Coast. Being then accompanied as far as this Fall
+by Sekeletu and 200 followers, his stay was necessarily short; and the
+two days there were employed in observations for fixing the geographical
+position of the place, and turning the showers, that at times sweep from
+the columns of vapour across the island, to account, in teaching the
+Makololo arboriculture, and making that garden from which the natives
+named the island; so that he did not visit the opposite sides of the
+cleft, nor see the wonderful course of the river beyond the Falls. The
+hippopotami had destroyed the trees which were then planted; and, though
+a strong stockaded hedge was made again, and living orange-trees, cashew-
+nuts, and coffee seeds put in afresh, we fear that the perseverance of
+the hippopotami will overcome the obstacle of the hedge. It would
+require a resident missionary to rear European fruit-trees. The period
+at which the peach and apricot come into blossom is about the end of the
+dry season, and artificial irrigation is necessary. The Batoka, the only
+arboriculturists in the country, rear native fruit-trees alone--the
+mosibe, the motsikiri, the boma, and others. When a tribe takes an
+interest in trees, it becomes more attached to the spot on which they are
+planted, and they prove one of the civilizing influences.
+
+Where one Englishman goes, others are sure to follow. Mr. Baldwin, a
+gentleman from Natal, succeeded in reaching the Falls guided by his
+pocket-compass alone. On meeting the second subject of Her Majesty, who
+had ever beheld the greatest of African wonders, we found him a sort of
+prisoner at large. He had called on Mashotlane to ferry him over to the
+north side of the river, and, when nearly over, he took a bath, by
+jumping in and swimming ashore. "If," said Mashotlane, "he had been
+devoured by one of the crocodiles which abound there, the English would
+have blamed us for his death. He nearly inflicted a great injury upon
+us, therefore, we said, he must pay a fine." As Mr. Baldwin had nothing
+with him wherewith to pay, they were taking care of him till he should
+receive beads from his wagon, two days distant.
+
+Mashotlane's education had been received in the camp of Sebituane, where
+but little regard was paid to human life. He was not yet in his prime,
+and his fine open countenance presented to us no indication of the evil
+influences which unhappily, from infancy, had been at work on his mind.
+The native eye was more penetrating than ours; for the expression of our
+men was, "He has drunk the blood of men--you may see it in his eyes." He
+made no further difficulty about Mr. Baldwin; but the week after we left
+he inflicted a severe wound on the head of one of his wives with his
+rhinoceros-horn club. She, being of a good family, left him, and we
+subsequently met her and another of his wives proceeding up the country.
+
+The ground is strewn with agates for a number of miles above the Falls;
+but the fires, which burn off the grass yearly, have injured most of
+those on the surface. Our men were delighted to hear that they do as
+well as flints for muskets; and this with the new ideas of the value of
+gold (_dalama_) and malachite, that they had acquired at Tette, made them
+conceive that we were not altogether silly in picking up and looking at
+stones.
+
+Marching up the river, we crossed the Lekone at its confluence, about
+eight miles above the island Kalai, and went on to a village opposite the
+Island Chundu. Nambowe, the headman, is one of the Matebele or Zulus,
+who have had to flee from the anger of Moselekatse, to take refuge with
+the Makololo.
+
+We spent Sunday, the 12th, at the village of Molele, a tall old Batoka,
+who was proud of having formerly been a great favourite with Sebituane.
+In coming hither we passed through patches of forest abounding in all
+sorts of game. The elephants' tusks, placed over graves, are now allowed
+to decay, and the skulls, which the former Batoka stuck on poles to
+ornament their villages, not being renewed, now crumble into dust. Here
+the famine, of which we had heard, became apparent, Molele's people being
+employed in digging up the _tsitla_ root out of the marshes, and cutting
+out the soft core of the young palm-trees, for food.
+
+The village, situated on the side of a wooded ridge, commands an
+extensive view of a great expanse of meadow and marsh lying along the
+bank of the river. On these holmes herds of buffaloes and waterbucks
+daily graze in security, as they have in the reedy marshes a refuge into
+which they can run on the approach of danger. The pretty little tianyane
+or ourebi is abundant further on, and herds of blue weldebeests or
+brindled gnus (_Katoblepas Gorgon_) amused us by their fantastic capers.
+They present a much more ferocious aspect than the lion himself, but are
+quite timid. We never could, by waving a red handkerchief, according to
+the prescription, induce them to venture near to us. It may therefore be
+that the red colour excites their fury only when wounded or hotly
+pursued. Herds of lechee or lechwe now enliven the meadows; and they and
+their younger brother, the graceful poku, smaller, and of a rounder
+contour, race together towards the grassy fens. We venture to call the
+poku after the late Major Vardon, a noble-hearted African traveller; but
+fully anticipate that some aspiring Nimrod will prefer that his own name
+should go down to posterity on the back of this buck.
+
+Midway between Tabacheu and the Great Falls the streams begin to flow
+westward. On the other side they begin to flow east. Large round masses
+of granite, somewhat like old castles, tower aloft about the Kalomo. The
+country is an elevated plateau, and our men knew and named the different
+plains as we passed them by.
+
+On the 13th we met a party from Sekeletu, who was now at Sesheke. Our
+approach had been reported, and they had been sent to ask the Doctor what
+the price of a horse ought to be; and what he said, that they were to
+give and no more. In reply they were told that by their having given
+nine large tusks for one horse before the Doctor came, the Griquas would
+naturally imagine that the price was already settled. It was exceedingly
+amusing to witness the exact imitation they gave of the swagger of a
+certain white with whom they had been dealing, and who had, as they had
+perceived, evidently wished to assume an air of indifference. Holding up
+the head and scratching the beard it was hinted might indicate not
+indifference, but vermin. It is well that we do not always know what
+they say about us. The remarks are often not quite complimentary, and
+resemble closely what certain white travellers say about the blacks.
+
+We made our camp in the afternoon abreast of the large island called
+Mparira, opposite the mouth of the Chobe. Francolins, quails, and guinea-
+fowls, as well as larger game, were abundant. The Makololo headman,
+Mokompa, brought us a liberal present; and in the usual way, which is
+considered politeness, regretted he had no milk, as his cows were all
+dry. We got some honey here from the very small stingless bee, called,
+by the Batoka, moandi, and by others, the kokomatsane. This honey is
+slightly acid, and has an aromatic flavour. The bees are easily known
+from their habit of buzzing about the eyes, and tickling the skin by
+sucking it as common flies do. The hive has a tube of wax like a quill,
+for its entrance, and is usually in the hollows of trees.
+
+Mokompa feared that the tribe was breaking up, and lamented the condition
+into which they had fallen in consequence of Sekeletu's leprosy; he did
+not know what was to become of them. He sent two canoes to take us up to
+Sesheke; his best canoe had taken ivory up to the chief, to purchase
+goods of some native traders from Benguela. Above the Falls the paddlers
+always stand in the canoes, using long paddles, ten feet in length, and
+changing from side to side without losing the stroke.
+
+Mochokotsa, a messenger from Sekeletu, met us on the 17th, with another
+request for the Doctor to take ivory and purchase a horse. He again
+declined to interfere. None were to come up to Sekeletu but the Doctor;
+and all the men who had had smallpox at Tette, three years ago, were to
+go back to Moshobotwane, and he would sprinkle medicine over them, to
+drive away the infection, and prevent it spreading in the tribe.
+Mochokotsa was told to say to Sekeletu that the disease was known of old
+to white men, and we even knew the medicine to prevent it; and, were
+there any danger now, we should be the first to warn him of it. Why did
+not he go himself to have Moshobotwane sprinkle medicine to drive away
+his leprosy. We were not afraid of his disease, nor of the fever that
+had killed the teachers and many Makololo at Linyanti. As this attempt
+at quarantine was evidently the suggestion of native doctors to increase
+their own importance, we added that we had no food, and would hunt next
+day for game, and the day after; and, should we be still ordered
+purification by their medicine, we should then return to our own country.
+
+The message was not all of our dictation, our companions interlarded it
+with their own indignant protests, and said some strong things in the
+Tette dialect about these "doctor things" keeping them back from seeing
+their father; when to their surprise Mochokotsa told them he knew every
+word they were saying, as he was of the tribe Bazizulu, and defied them
+to deceive him by any dialect, either of the Mashona on the east, or of
+the Mambari on the west. Mochokotsa then repeated our message twice, to
+be sure that he had it every word, and went back again. These chiefs'
+messengers have most retentive memories; they carry messages of
+considerable length great distances, and deliver them almost word for
+word. Two or three usually go together, and when on the way the message
+is rehearsed every night, in order that the exact words may be kept to.
+One of the native objections to learning to write is, that these men
+answer the purpose of transmitting intelligence to a distance as well as
+a letter would; and, if a person wishes to communicate with any one in
+the town, the best way to do so is either to go to or send for him. And
+as for corresponding with friends very far off, that is all very well for
+white people, but the blacks have no friends to whom to write. The only
+effective argument for the learning to read is, that it is their duty to
+know the revelation from their Father in Heaven, as it stands in the
+Book.
+
+Our messenger returned on the evening of the following day with "You
+speak truly," says Sekeletu, "the disease is old, come on at once, do not
+sleep in the path; for I am greatly desirous (_tlologelecoe_) to see the
+Doctor."
+
+After Mochokotsa left us, we met some of Mokompa's men bringing back the
+ivory, as horses were preferred to the West-Coast goods. They were the
+bearers of instructions to Mokompa, and as these instructions illustrate
+the government of people who have learned scarcely anything from
+Europeans, they are inserted, though otherwise of no importance.
+Mashotlane had not behaved so civilly to Mr. Baldwin as Sekeletu had
+ordered him to do to all Englishmen. He had been very uncivil to the
+messengers sent by Moselekatse with letters from Mr. Moffat, treated them
+as spies, and would not land to take the bag until they moved off. On
+our speaking to him about this, he justified his conduct on the plea that
+he was set at the Falls for the very purpose of watching these, their
+natural enemies; and how was he to know that they had been sent by Mr.
+Moffat? Our men thereupon reported at head-quarters that Mashotlane had
+cursed the Doctor. The instructions to Mokompa, from Sekeletu, were to
+"go and tell Mashotlane that he had offended greatly. He had not cursed
+Monare (Dr. Livingstone) but Sebituane, as Monare was now in the place of
+Sebituane, and he reverenced him as he had done his father. Any fine
+taken from Mr. Baldwin was to be returned at once, as he was not a Boer
+but an Englishman. Sekeletu was very angry, and Mokompa must not conceal
+the message."
+
+On finding afterwards that Mashotlane's conduct had been most outrageous
+to the Batoka, Sekeletu sent for him to come to Sesheke, in order that he
+might have him more under his own eye; but Mashotlane, fearing that this
+meant the punishment of death, sent a polite answer, alleging that he was
+ill and unable to travel. Sekeletu tried again to remove Mashotlane from
+the Falls, but without success. In theory the chief is absolute and
+quite despotic; in practice his authority is limited, and he cannot,
+without occasionally putting refractory headmen to death, force his
+subordinates to do his will.
+
+Except the small rapids by Mparira island, near the mouth of the Chobe,
+the rest of the way to Sesheke by water is smooth. Herds of cattle of
+two or three varieties graze on the islands in the river: the Batoka
+possessed a very small breed of beautiful shape, and remarkably tame, and
+many may still be seen; a larger kind, many of which have horns pendent,
+and loose at the roots; and a still larger sort, with horns of
+extraordinary dimensions,--apparently a burden for the beast to carry.
+This breed was found in abundance at Lake Ngami. We stopped at noon at
+one of the cattle-posts of Mokompa, and had a refreshing drink of milk.
+Men of his standing have usually several herds placed at different spots,
+and the owner visits each in turn, while his head-quarters are at his
+village. His son, a boy of ten, had charge of the establishment during
+his father's absence. According to Makololo ideas, the cattle-post is
+the proper school in which sons should be brought up. Here they receive
+the right sort of education--the knowledge of pasture and how to manage
+cattle.
+
+Strong easterly winds blow daily from noon till midnight, and continue
+till the October or November rains set in. Whirlwinds, raising huge
+pillars of smoke from burning grass and weeds, are common in the
+forenoon. We were nearly caught in an immense one. It crossed about
+twenty yards in front of us, the wind apparently rushing into it from all
+points of the compass. Whirling round and round in great eddies, it
+swept up hundreds of feet into the air a continuous dense dark cloud of
+the black pulverized soil, mixed with dried grass, off the plain. Herds
+of the new antelopes, lechwe, and poku, with the kokong, or gnus, and
+zebras stood gazing at us as we passed. The mirage lifted them at times
+halfway to the clouds, and twisted them and the clumps of palms into
+strange unearthly forms. The extensive and rich level plains by the
+banks, along the sides of which we paddled, would support a vast
+population, and might be easily irrigated from the Zambesi. If watered,
+they would yield crops all the year round, and never suffer loss by
+drought. The hippopotamus is killed here with long lance-like spears. We
+saw two men, in a light canoe, stealing noiselessly down on one of these
+animals thought to be asleep; but it was on the alert, and they had
+quickly to retreat. Comparatively few of these animals now remain
+between Sesheke and the Falls, and they are uncommonly wary, as it is
+certain death for one to be caught napping in the daytime.
+
+On the 18th we entered Sesheke. The old town, now in ruins, stands on
+the left bank of the river. The people have built another on the same
+side, a quarter of a mile higher up, since their headman Moriantsiane was
+put to death for bewitching the chief with leprosy. Sekeletu was on the
+right bank, near a number of temporary huts. A man hailed us from the
+chiefs quarters, and requested us to rest under the old Kotla, or public
+meeting-place tree. A young Makololo, with the large thighs which Zulus
+and most of this tribe have, crossed over to receive orders from the
+chief, who had not shown himself to the people since he was affected with
+leprosy. On returning he ran for Mokele, the headman of the new town,
+who, after going over to Sekeletu, came back and conducted us to a small
+but good hut, and afterwards brought us a fine fat ox, as a present from
+the chief. "This is a time of hunger," he said, "and we have no meat,
+but we expect some soon from the Barotse Valley." We were entirely out
+of food when we reached Sesheke. Never was better meat than that of the
+ox Sekeletu sent, and infinitely above the flesh of all kinds of game is
+beef!
+
+A constant stream of visitors rolled in on us the day after our arrival.
+Several of them, who had suffered affliction during the Doctor's absence,
+seemed to be much affected on seeing him again. All were in low spirits.
+A severe drought had cut off the crops, and destroyed the pasture of
+Linyanti, and the people were scattered over the country in search of
+wild fruits, and the hospitality of those whose ground-nuts (_Arachis
+hypogoea_) had not failed. Sekeletu's leprosy brought troops of evils in
+its train. Believing himself bewitched, he had suspected a number of his
+chief men, and had put some, with their families, to death; others had
+fled to distant tribes, and were living in exile. The chief had shut
+himself up, and allowed no one to come into his presence but his uncle
+Mamire. Ponwane, who had been as "head and eyes" to him, had just died;
+evidence, he thought, of the potent spells of those who hated all who
+loved the chief. The country was suffering grievously, and Sebituane's
+grand empire was crumbling to pieces. A large body of young Barotse had
+revolted and fled to the north; killing a man by the way, in order to put
+a blood-feud between Masiko, the chief to whom they were going, and
+Sekeletu. The Batoka under Sinamane, and Muemba, were independent, and
+Mashotlane at the Falls was setting Sekeletu's authority virtually at
+defiance. Sebituane's wise policy in treating the conquered tribes on
+equal terms with his own Makololo, as all children of the chief, and
+equally eligible to the highest honours, had been abandoned by his son,
+who married none but Makololo women, and appointed to office none but
+Makololo men. He had become unpopular among the black tribes, conquered
+by the spear but more effectually won by the subsequent wise and just
+government of his father.
+
+Strange rumours were afloat respecting the unseen Sekeletu; his fingers
+were said to have grown like eagle's claws, and his face so frightfully
+distorted that no one could recognize him. Some had begun to hint that
+he might not really be the son of the great Sebituane, the founder of the
+nation, strong in battle, and wise in the affairs of state. "In the days
+of the Great Lion" (Sebituane), said his only sister, Moriantsiane's
+widow, whose husband Sekeletu had killed, "we had chiefs and little
+chiefs and elders to carry on the government, and the great chief,
+Sebituane, knew them all, and everything they did, and the whole country
+was wisely ruled; but now Sekeletu knows nothing of what his underlings
+do, and they care not for him, and the Makololo power is fast passing
+away." {3}
+
+The native doctors had given the case of Sekeletu up. They could not
+cure him, and pronounced the disease incurable. An old doctress from the
+Manyeti tribe had come to see what she could do for him, and on her skill
+he now hung his last hopes. She allowed no one to see him, except his
+mother and uncle, making entire seclusion from society an essential
+condition of the much longed-for cure. He sent, notwithstanding, for the
+Doctor; and on the following day we all three were permitted to see him.
+He was sitting in a covered wagon, which was enclosed by a high wall of
+close-set reeds; his face was only slightly disfigured by the thickening
+of the skin in parts, where the leprosy had passed over it; and the only
+peculiarity about his hands was the extreme length of his finger-nails,
+which, however, was nothing very much out of the way, as all the Makololo
+gentlemen wear them uncommonly long. He has the quiet, unassuming
+manners of his father, Sebituane, speaks distinctly, in a low pleasant
+voice, and appears to be a sensible man, except perhaps on the subject of
+his having been bewitched; and in this, when alluded to, he exhibits as
+firm a belief as if it were his monomania. "Moriantsiane, my aunt's
+husband, tried the bewitching medicine first on his wife, and she is
+leprous, and so is her head-servant; then, seeing that it succeeded, he
+gave me a stronger dose in the cooked flesh of a goat, and I have had the
+disease ever since. They have lately killed Ponwane, and, as you see,
+are now killing me." Ponwane had died of fever a short time previously.
+Sekeletu asked us for medicine and medical attendance, but we did not
+like to take the case out of the hands of the female physician already
+employed, it being bad policy to appear to undervalue any of the
+profession; and she, being anxious to go on with her remedies, said "she
+had not given him up yet, but would try for another month; if he was not
+cured by that time, then she would hand him over to the white doctors."
+But we intended to leave the country before a month was up; so Mamire,
+with others, induced the old lady to suspend her treatment for a little.
+She remained, as the doctors stipulated, in the chief's establishment,
+and on full pay.
+
+Sekeletu was told plainly that the disease was unknown in our country,
+and was thought exceedingly obstinate of cure; that we did not believe in
+his being bewitched, and we were willing to do all we could to help him.
+This was a case for disinterested benevolence; no pay was expected, but
+considerable risk incurred; yet we could not decline it, as we had the
+trading in horses. Having, however, none of the medicines usually
+employed in skin diseases with us, we tried the local application of
+lunar caustic, and hydriodate of potash internally; and with such
+gratifying results, that Mamire wished the patient to be smeared all over
+with a solution of lunar caustic, which he believed to be of the same
+nature as the blistering fluid formerly applied to his own knee by Mr.
+Oswell. _Its_ power he considered irresistible, and he would fain have
+had anything like it tried on Sekeletu.
+
+It was a time of great scarcity and hunger, but Sekeletu treated us
+hospitably, preparing tea for us at every visit we paid him. With the
+tea we had excellent American biscuit and preserved fruits, which had
+been brought to him all the way from Benguela. The fruits he most
+relished were those preserved in their own juices; plums, apples, pears,
+strawberries, and peaches, which we have seen only among Portuguese and
+Spaniards. It made us anxious to plant the fruit-tree seeds we had
+brought, and all were pleased with the idea of having these same fruits
+in their own country.
+
+Mokele, the headman of Sesheke, and Sebituane's sister, Manchunyane, were
+ordered to provide us with food, as Sekeletu's wives, to whom this duty
+properly belonged, were at Linyanti. We found a black trader from the
+West Coast, and some Griqua traders from the South, both in search of
+ivory. Ivory is dear at Sesheke; but cheaper in the Batoka country, from
+Sinamane's to the Kafue, than anywhere else. The trader from Benguela
+took orders for goods for his next year's trip, and offered to bring tea,
+coffee, and sugar at cent. per cent. prices. As, in consequence of a
+hint formerly given, the Makololo had secured all the ivory in the Batoga
+country to the east, by purchasing it with hoes, the Benguela traders
+found it unprofitable to go thither for slaves. They assured us that
+without ivory the trade in slaves did not pay. In this way, and by the
+orders of Sekeletu, an extensive slave-mart was closed. These orders
+were never infringed except secretly. We discovered only two or three
+cases of their infraction.
+
+Sekeletu was well pleased with the various articles we brought for him,
+and inquired if a ship could not bring his sugar-mill and the other goods
+we had been obliged to leave behind at Tette. On hearing that there was
+a possibility of a powerful steamer ascending as far as Sinamane's, but
+never above the Grand Victoria Falls, he asked, with charming simplicity,
+if a cannon could not blow away the Falls, so as to allow the vessel to
+come up to Sesheke.
+
+To save the tribe from breaking up, by the continual loss of real
+Makololo, it ought at once to remove to the healthy Batoka highlands,
+near the Kafue. Fully aware of this, Sekeletu remarked that all his
+people, save two, were convinced that, if they remained in the lowlands,
+a few years would suffice to cut off all the real Makololo; they came
+originally from the healthy South, near the confluence of the Likwa and
+Namagari, where fever is almost unknown, and its ravages had been as
+frightful among them here, as amongst Europeans on the Coast. Sebituane's
+sister described its first appearance among the tribe, after their
+settling in the Barotse Valley on the Zambesi. Many of them were seized
+with a shivering sickness, as if from excessive cold; they had never seen
+the like before. They made great fires, and laid the shivering wretches
+down before them; but, pile on wood as they might, they could not raise
+heat enough to drive the cold out of the bodies of the sufferers, and
+they shivered on till they died. But, though all preferred the
+highlands, they were afraid to go there, lest the Matebele should come
+and rob them of their much-loved cattle. Sebituane, with all his
+veterans, could not withstand that enemy; and how could they be resisted,
+now that most of the brave warriors were dead? The young men would
+break, and run away the moment they saw the terrible Matebele, being as
+much afraid of them as the black conquered tribes are of the Makololo.
+"But if the Doctor and his wife," said the chiefs and counsellors, "would
+come and live with us, we would remove to the highlands at once, as
+Moselekatse would not attack a place where the daughter of his friend,
+Moffat, was living."
+
+The Makololo are by far the most intelligent and enterprising of the
+tribes we have met. None but brave and daring men remained long with
+Sebituane, his stern discipline soon eradicated cowardice from his army.
+Death was the inevitable doom of the coward. If the chief saw a man
+running away from the fight, he rushed after him with amazing speed, and
+cut him down; or waited till he returned to the town, and then summoned
+the deserter into his presence. "You did not wish to die on the field,
+you wished to die at home, did you? you shall have your wish!" and he was
+instantly led off and executed. The present race of young men are
+inferior in most respects to their fathers. The old Makololo had many
+manly virtues; they were truthful, and never stole, excepting in what
+they considered the honourable way of lifting cattle in fair fight. But
+this can hardly be said of their sons; who, having been brought up among
+the subjected tribes, have acquired some of the vices peculiar to a
+menial and degraded race. A few of the old Makololo cautioned us not to
+leave any of our property exposed, as the blacks were great thieves; and
+some of our own men advised us to be on our guard, as the Makololo also
+would steal. A very few trifling articles were stolen by a young
+Makololo; and he, on being spoken to on the subject, showed great
+ingenuity in excusing himself, by a plausible and untruthful story. The
+Makololo of old were hard workers, and did not consider labour as beneath
+them; but their sons never work, regarding it as fit only for the Mashona
+and Makalaka servants. Sebituane, seeing that the rival tribes had the
+advantage over his, in knowing how to manage canoes, had his warriors
+taught to navigate; and his own son, with his companions, paddled the
+chief's canoe. All the dishes, baskets, stools, and canoes are made by
+the black tribes called Manyeti and Matlotlora. The houses are built by
+the women and servants. The Makololo women are vastly superior to any we
+have yet seen. They are of a light warm brown complexion, have pleasant
+countenances, and are remarkably quick of apprehension. They dress
+neatly, wearing a kilt and mantle, and have many ornaments. Sebituane's
+sister, the head lady of Sesheke, wore eighteen solid brass rings, as
+thick as one's finger, on each leg, and three of copper under each knee;
+nineteen brass rings on her left arm, and eight of brass and copper on
+her right, also a large ivory ring above each elbow. She had a pretty
+bead necklace, and a bead sash encircled her waist. The weight of the
+bright brass rings round her legs impeded her walking, and chafed her
+ankles; but, as it was the fashion, she did not mind the inconvenience,
+and guarded against the pain by putting soft rag round the lower rings.
+
+Justice appears upon the whole to be pretty fairly administered among the
+Makololo. A headman took some beads and a blanket from one of his men
+who had been with us; the matter was brought before the chief, and he
+immediately ordered the goods to be restored, and decreed, moreover, that
+no headman should take the property of the men who had returned. In
+theory, all the goods brought back belonged to the chief; the men laid
+them at his feet, and made a formal offer of them all; he looked at the
+articles, and told the men to keep them. This is almost invariably the
+case. Tuba Mokoro, however, fearing lest Sekeletu might take a fancy to
+some of his best goods, exhibited only a few of his old and least
+valuable acquisitions. Masakasa had little to show; he had committed
+some breach of native law in one of the villages on the way, and paid a
+heavy fine rather than have the matter brought to the Doctor's ears. Each
+carrier is entitled to a portion of the goods in his bundle, though
+purchased by the chief's ivory, and they never hesitate to claim their
+rights; but no wages can be demanded from the chief, if he fails to
+respond to the first application.
+
+Our men, accustomed to our ways, thought that the English system of
+paying a man for his labour was the only correct one, and some even said
+it would be better to live under a government where life and labour were
+more secure and valuable than here. While with us, they always conducted
+themselves with propriety during Divine service, and not only maintained
+decorum themselves, but insisted on other natives who might be present
+doing the same. When Moshobotwane, the Batoka chief, came on one
+occasion with a number of his men, they listened in silence to the
+reading of the Bible in the Makololo tongue; but, as soon as we all knelt
+down to pray, they commenced a vigorous clapping of hands, their mode of
+asking a favour. Our indignant Makololo soon silenced their noisy
+accompaniment, and looked with great contempt on this display of
+ignorance. Nearly all our men had learned to repeat the Lord's Prayer
+and the Apostles' Creed in their own language, and felt rather proud of
+being able to do so; and when they reached home, they liked to recite
+them to groups of admiring friends. Their ideas of right and wrong
+differ in no respect from our own, except in their professed inability to
+see how it can be improper for a man to have more than one wife. A year
+or two ago several of the wives of those who had been absent with us
+petitioned the chief for leave to marry again. They thought that it was
+of no use waiting any longer, their husbands must be dead; but Sekeletu
+refused permission; he himself had bet a number of oxen that the Doctor
+would return with their husbands, and he had promised the absent men that
+their wives should be kept for them. The impatient spouses had therefore
+to wait a little longer. Some of them, however, eloped with other men;
+the wife of Mantlanyane, for instance, ran off and left his little boy
+among strangers. Mantlanyane was very angry when he heard of it, not
+that he cared much about her deserting him, for he had two other wives at
+Tette, but he was indignant at her abandoning his boy.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII.
+
+
+Life amongst the Makololo--Return journey--Native hospitality--A canoe
+voyage on the Zambesi.
+
+While we were at Sesheke, an ox was killed by a crocodile; a man found
+the carcass floating in the river, and appropriated the meat. When the
+owner heard of this, he requested him to come before the chief, as he
+meant to complain of him; rather than go, the delinquent settled the
+matter by giving one of his own oxen in lieu of the lost one. A headman
+from near Linyanti came with a complaint that all his people had run off,
+owing to the "hunger." Sekeletu said, "You must not be left to grow lean
+alone, some of them must come back to you." He had thus an order to
+compel their return, if he chose to put it in force. Families frequently
+leave their own headman and flee to another village, and sometimes a
+whole village decamps by night, leaving the headman by himself. Sekeletu
+rarely interfered with the liberty of the subject to choose his own
+headman, and, as it is often the fault of the latter which causes the
+people to depart, it is punishment enough for him to be left alone.
+Flagrant disobedience to the chief's orders is punished with death. A
+Moshubia man was ordered to cut some reeds for Sekeletu: he went off, and
+hid himself for two days instead. For this he was doomed to die, and was
+carried in a canoe to the middle of the river, choked, and tossed into
+the stream. The spectators hooted the executioners, calling out to them
+that they too would soon be carried out and strangled. Occasionally when
+a man is sent to beat an offender, he tells him his object, returns, and
+assures the chief he has nearly killed him. The transgressor then keeps
+for a while out of sight, and the matter is forgotten. The river here
+teems with monstrous crocodiles, and women are frequently, while drawing
+water, carried off by these reptiles.
+
+We met a venerable warrior, sole survivor, probably, of the Mantatee host
+which threatened to invade the colony in 1824. He retained a vivid
+recollection of their encounter with the Griquas: "As we looked at the
+men and horses, puffs of smoke arose, and some of us dropped down dead!"
+"Never saw anything like it in my life, a man's brains lying in one place
+and his body in another!" They could not understand what was killing
+them; a ball struck a man's shield at an angle; knocked his arm out of
+joint at the shoulder; and leaving a mark, or burn, as he said, on the
+shield, killed another man close by. We saw the man with his shoulder
+still dislocated. Sebetuane was present at the fight, and had an exalted
+opinion of the power of white people ever afterwards.
+
+The ancient costume of the Makololo consisted of the skin of a lamb, kid,
+jackal, ocelot, or other small animal, worn round and below the loins:
+and in cold weather a kaross, or skin mantle, was thrown over the
+shoulders. The kaross is now laid aside, and the young men of fashion
+wear a monkey-jacket and a skin round the hips; but no trousers,
+waistcoat, or shirt. The river and lake tribes are in general very
+cleanly, bathing several times a day. The Makololo women use water
+rather sparingly, rubbing themselves with melted butter instead: this
+keeps off parasites, but gives their clothes a rancid odour. One stage
+of civilization often leads of necessity to another--the possession of
+clothes creates a demand for soap; give a man a needle, and he is soon
+back to you for thread.
+
+This being a time of mourning, on account of the illness of the chief,
+the men were negligent of their persons, they did not cut their hair, or
+have merry dances, or carry spear and shield when they walked abroad. The
+wife of Pitsane was busy making a large hut, while we were in the town:
+she informed us that the men left house-building entirely to the women
+and servants. A round tower of stakes and reeds, nine or ten feet high,
+is raised and plastered; a floor is next made of soft tufa, or ant-hill
+material and cowdung. This plaster prevents the poisonous insects,
+called tumpans, whose bite causes fever in some, and painful sores in
+all, from harbouring in the cracks or soil. The roof, which is much
+larger in diameter than the tower, is made on the ground, and then, many
+persons assisting, lifted up and placed on the tower, and thatched. A
+plastered reed fence is next built up to meet the outer part of the roof,
+which still projects a little over this fence, and a space of three feet
+remains between it and the tower. We slept in this space, instead of in
+the tower, as the inner door of the hut we occupied was uncomfortably
+small, being only nineteen inches high, and twenty-two inches wide at the
+floor. A foot from the bottom it measured seventeen inches in breadth,
+and close to the top only twelve inches, so it was a difficult matter to
+get through it. The tower has no light or ventilation, except through
+this small door. The reason a lady assigned for having the doors so very
+small was to keep out the mice!
+
+The children have merry times, especially in the cool of the evening. One
+of their games consists of a little girl being carried on the shoulders
+of two others. She sits with outstretched arms, as they walk about with
+her, and all the rest clap their hands, and stopping before each hut sing
+pretty airs, some beating time on their little kilts of cowskin, others
+making a curious humming sound between the songs. Excepting this and the
+skipping-rope, the play of the girls consists in imitation of the serious
+work of their mothers, building little huts, making small pots, and
+cooking, pounding corn in miniature mortars, or hoeing tiny gardens. The
+boys play with spears of reeds pointed with wood, and small shields, or
+bows and arrows; or amuse themselves in making little cattle-pens, or in
+moulding cattle in clay; they show great ingenuity in the imitation of
+various-shaped horns. Some too are said to use slings, but as soon as
+they can watch the goats, or calves, they are sent to the field. We saw
+many boys riding on the calves they had in charge, but this is an
+innovation since the arrival of the English with their horses. Tselane,
+one of the ladies, on observing Dr. Livingstone noting observations on
+the wet and dry bulb thermometers, thought that he too was engaged in
+play; for on receiving no reply to her question, which was rather
+difficult to answer, as the native tongue has no scientific terms, she
+said with roguish glee, "Poor thing, playing like a little child!"
+
+Like other Africans, the Makololo have great faith in the power of
+medicine; they believe that there is an especial medicine for every ill
+that flesh is heir to. Mamire is anxious to have children; he has six
+wives, and only one boy, and he begs earnestly for "child medicine." The
+mother of Sekeletu came from the Barotse Valley to see her son. Thinks
+she has lost flesh since Dr. Livingstone was here before, and asks for
+"the medicine of fatness." The Makololo consider plumpness an essential
+part of beauty in women, but the extreme stoutness, mentioned by Captain
+Speke, in the north, would be considered hideous here, for the men have
+been overheard speaking of a lady whom we call "inclined to
+_embonpoint_," as "fat unto ugliness."
+
+Two packages from the Kuruman, containing letters and newspapers, reached
+Linyanti previous to our arrival, and Sekeletu, not knowing when we were
+coming, left them there; but now at once sent a messenger for them. This
+man returned on the seventh day, having travelled 240 geographical miles.
+One of the packages was too heavy for him, and he left it behind. As the
+Doctor wished to get some more medicine and papers out of the wagon left
+at Linyanti in 1853, he decided upon going thither himself. The chief
+gave him his own horse, now about twelve years old, and some men. He
+found everything in his wagon as safe as when he left it seven years
+before. The headmen, Mosale and Pekonyane, received him cordially, and
+lamented that they had so little to offer him. Oh! had he only arrived
+the year previous, when there was abundance of milk and corn and beer.
+
+Very early the next morning the old town-crier, Ma-Pulenyane, of his own
+accord made a public proclamation, which, in the perfect stillness of the
+town long before dawn, was striking: "I have dreamed! I have dreamed! I
+have dreamed! Thou Mosale and thou Pekonyane, my lords, be not faint-
+hearted, nor let your hearts be sore, but believe all the words of Monare
+(the Doctor) for his heart is white as milk towards the Makololo. I
+dreamed that he was coming, and that the tribe would live, if you prayed
+to God and give heed to the word of Monare." Ma-Pulenyane showed Dr.
+Livingstone the burying-place where poor Helmore and seven others were
+laid, distinguishing those whom he had put to rest, and those for whom
+Mafale had performed that last office. Nothing whatever marked the spot,
+and with the native idea of _hiding_ the dead, it was said, "it will soon
+be all overgrown with bushes, for no one will cultivate there." None but
+Ma-Pulenyane approached the place, the others stood at a respectful
+distance; they invariably avoid everything connected with the dead, and
+no such thing as taking portions of human bodies to make charms of, as is
+the custom further north, has ever been known among the Makololo.
+
+Sekeletu's health improved greatly during our visit, the melancholy
+foreboding left his spirits, and he became cheerful, but resolutely
+refused to leave his den, and appear in public till he was perfectly
+cured, and had regained what he considered his good looks. He also
+feared lest some of those who had bewitched him originally might still be
+among the people, and neutralize our remedies. {4}
+
+As we expected another steamer to be at Kongone in November, it was
+impossible for us to remain in Sesheke more than one month. Before our
+departure, the chief and his principal men expressed in a formal manner
+their great desire to have English people settled on the Batoka
+highlands. At one time he proposed to go as far as Phori, in order to
+select a place of residence; but as he afterwards saw reasons for
+remaining where he was, till his cure was completed, he gave orders to
+those sent with us, in the event of our getting, on our return, past the
+rapids near Tette, not to bring us to Sesheke, but to send forward a
+messenger, and he with the whole tribe would come to us. Dr. Kirk being
+of the same age, Sekeletu was particularly anxious that he should come
+and live with him. He said that he would cut off a section of the
+country for the special use of the English; and on being told that in all
+probability their descendants would cause disturbance in his country, he
+replied, "These would be only domestic feuds, and of no importance." The
+great extent of uncultivated land on the cool and now unpeopled highlands
+has but to be seen to convince the spectator how much room there is, and
+to spare, for a vastly greater population than ever, in our day, can be
+congregated there.
+
+On the last occasion of our holding Divine service at Sesheke, the men
+were invited to converse on the subject on which they had been addressed.
+So many of them had died since we were here before, that not much
+probability existed of our all meeting again, and this had naturally led
+to the subject of a future state. They replied that they did not wish to
+offend the speaker, but they could not believe that all the dead would
+rise again: "Can those who have been killed in the field and devoured by
+the vultures; or those who have been eaten by the hyenas or lions; or
+those who have been tossed into the river, and eaten by more than one
+crocodile,--can they all be raised again to life?" They were told that
+men could take a leaden bullet, change it into a salt (acetate of lead),
+which could be dissolved as completely in water as our bodies in the
+stomachs of animals, and then reconvert it into lead; or that the bullet
+could be transformed into the red and white paint of our wagons, and
+again be reconverted into the original lead; and that if men exactly like
+themselves could do so much, how much more could He do who has made the
+eye to see, and the ear to hear! We added, however, that we believed in
+a resurrection, not because we understood how it would be brought about,
+but because our Heavenly Father assured us of it in His Book. The
+reference to the truth of the Book and its Author seems always to have
+more influence on the native mind than the cleverness of the
+illustration. The knowledge of the people is scanty, but their reasoning
+is generally clear as far as their information goes.
+
+We left Sesheke on the 17th September, 1860, convoyed by Pitsane and
+Leshore with their men. Pitsane was ordered by Sekeletu to make a hedge
+round the garden at the Falls, to protect the seeds we had brought; and
+also to collect some of the tobacco tribute below the Falls. Leshore,
+besides acting as a sort of guard of honour to us, was sent on a
+diplomatic mission to Sinamane. No tribute was exacted by Sekeletu from
+Sinamane; but, as he had sent in his adhesion, he was expected to act as
+a guard in case of the Matebele wishing to cross and attack the Makololo.
+As we intended to purchase canoes of Sinamane in which to descend the
+river, Leshore was to commend us to whatever help this Batoka chief could
+render. It must be confessed that Leshore's men, who were all of the
+black subject tribes, really needed to be viewed by us in the most
+charitable light; for Leshore, on entering any village, called out to the
+inhabitants, "Look out for your property, and see that my thieves don't
+steal it."
+
+Two young Makololo with their Batoka servants accompanied us to see if
+Kebrabasa could be surmounted, and to bring a supply of medicine for
+Sekeletu's leprosy; and half a dozen able canoe-men, under Mobito, who
+had previously gone with Dr. Livingstone to Loanda, were sent to help us
+in our river navigation. Some men on foot drove six oxen which Sekeletu
+had given us as provisions for the journey. It was, as before remarked,
+a time of scarcity; and, considering the dearth of food, our treatment
+had been liberal.
+
+By day the canoe-men are accustomed to keep close under the river's bank
+from fear of the hippopotami; by night, however, they keep in the middle
+of the stream, as then those animals are usually close to the bank on
+their way to their grazing grounds. Our progress was considerably
+impeded by the high winds, which at this season of the year begin about
+eight in the morning, and blow strongly up the river all day. The canoes
+were poor leaky affairs, and so low in parts of the gunwale, that the
+paddlers were afraid to follow the channel when it crossed the river,
+lest the waves might swamp us. A rough sea is dreaded by all these
+inland canoe-men; but though timid, they are by no means unskilful at
+their work. The ocean rather astonished them afterwards; and also the
+admirable way that the Nyassa men managed their canoes on a rough lake,
+and even amongst the breakers, where no small boat could possibly live.
+
+On the night of the 17th we slept on the left bank of the Majeele, after
+having had all the men ferried across. An ox was slaughtered, and not an
+ounce of it was left next morning. Our two young Makololo companions,
+Maloka and Ramakukane, having never travelled before, naturally clung to
+some of the luxuries they had been accustomed to at home. When they lay
+down to sleep, their servants were called to spread their blankets over
+their august persons, not forgetting their feet. This seems to be the
+duty of the Makololo wife to her husband, and strangers sometimes receive
+the honour. One of our party, having wandered, slept at the village of
+Nambowe. When he laid down, to his surprise two of Nambowe's wives came
+at once, and carefully and kindly spread his kaross over him.
+
+A beautiful silvery fish with reddish fins, called Ngwesi, is very
+abundant in the river; large ones weigh fifteen or twenty pounds each.
+Its teeth are exposed, and so arranged that, when they meet, the edges
+cut a hook like nippers. The Ngwesi seems to be a very ravenous fish. It
+often gulps down the Konokono, a fish armed with serrated bones more than
+an inch in length in the pectoral and dorsal fins, which, fitting into a
+notch at the roots, can be put by the fish on full cock or straight
+out,--they cannot be folded down, without its will, and even break in
+resisting. The name "Konokono," elbow-elbow, is given it from a
+resemblance its extended fins are supposed to bear to a man's elbows
+stuck out from his body. It often performs the little trick of cocking
+its fins in the stomach of the Ngwesi, and, the elbows piercing its
+enemy's sides, he is frequently found floating dead. The fin bones seem
+to have an acrid secretion on them, for the wound they make is
+excessively painful. The Konokono barks distinctly when landed with the
+hook. Our canoe-men invariably picked up every dead fish they saw on the
+surface of the water, however far gone. An unfragrant odour was no
+objection; the fish was boiled and eaten, and the water drunk as soup. It
+is a curious fact that many of the Africans keep fish as we do woodcocks,
+until they are extremely offensive, before they consider them fit to eat.
+Our paddlers informed us on our way down that iguanas lay their eggs in
+July and August, and crocodiles in September. The eggs remain a month or
+two under the sand where they are laid, and the young come out when the
+rains have fairly commenced. The canoe-men were quite positive that
+crocodiles frequently stun men by striking them with their tails, and
+then squat on them till they are drowned. We once caught a young
+crocodile, which certainly did use its tail to inflict sharp blows, and
+led us to conclude that the native opinion is correct. They believed
+also that, if a person shuts the beast's eyes, it lets go its hold.
+Crocodiles have been known to unite and kill a large one of their own
+species and eat it. Some fishermen throw the bones of the fish into the
+river but in most of the fishing villages there are heaps of them in
+various places. The villagers can walk over them without getting them
+into their feet; but the Makololo, from having softer soles, are unable
+to do so. The explanation offered was, that the fishermen have a
+medicine against fish-bones, but that they will not reveal it to the
+Makololo.
+
+We spent a night on Mparira island, which is four miles long and about
+one mile broad. Mokompa, the headman, was away hunting elephants. His
+wife sent for him on our arrival, and he returned next morning before we
+left. Taking advantage of the long-continued drought, he had set fire to
+the reeds between the Chobe and Zambesi, in such a manner as to drive the
+game out at one corner, where his men laid in wait with their spears. He
+had killed five elephants and three buffaloes, wounding several others
+which escaped.
+
+On our land party coming up, we were told that the oxen were bitten by
+the tsetse: they could see a great difference in their looks. One was
+already eaten, and they now wished to slaughter another. A third fell
+into a buffalo-pit next day, so our stock was soon reduced.
+
+The Batoka chief, Moshobotwane, again treated us with his usual
+hospitality, giving us an ox, some meal, and milk. We took another view
+of the grand Mosi-oa-tunya, and planted a quantity of seeds in the garden
+on the island; but, as no one will renew the hedge, the hippopotami will,
+doubtless, soon destroy what we planted. Mashotlane assisted us. So
+much power was allowed to this under-chief, that he appeared as if he had
+cast off the authority of Sekeletu altogether. He did not show much
+courtesy to his messengers; instead of giving them food, as is customary,
+he took the meat out of a pot in their presence, and handed it to his own
+followers. This may have been because Sekeletu's men bore an order to
+him to remove to Linyanti. He had not only insulted Baldwin, but had
+also driven away the Griqua traders; but this may all end in nothing.
+Some of the natives here, and at Sesheke, know a few of the low tricks of
+more civilized traders. A pot of milk was brought to us one evening,
+which was more indebted to the Zambesi than to any cow. Baskets of fine-
+looking white meal, elsewhere, had occasionally the lower half filled
+with bran. Eggs are always a perilous investment. The native idea of a
+good egg differs as widely from our own as is possible on such a trifling
+subject. An egg is eaten here with apparent relish, though an embryo
+chick be inside.
+
+We left Mosi-oa-tunya on the 27th, and slept close to the village of
+Bakwini. It is built on a ridge of loose red soil, which produces great
+crops of mapira and ground-nuts; many magnificent mosibe-trees stand near
+the village. Machimisi, the headman of the village, possesses a herd of
+cattle and a large heart; he kept us company for a couple of days to
+guide us on our way.
+
+We had heard a good deal of a stronghold some miles below the Falls,
+called Kalunda. Our return path was much nearer the Zambesi than that of
+our ascent,--in fact, as near as the rough country would allow,--but we
+left it twice before we reached Sinamane's, in order to see Kalunda and a
+Fall called Moomba, or Moamba. The Makololo had once dispossessed the
+Batoka of Kalunda, but we could not see the fissure, or whatever it is,
+that rendered it a place of security, as it was on the southern bank. The
+crack of the Great Falls was here continued: the rocks are the same as
+further up, but perhaps less weather-worn--and now partially stratified
+in great thick masses. The country through which we were travelling was
+covered with a cindery-looking volcanic tufa, and might be called
+"Katakaumena."
+
+The description we received of the Moamba Falls seemed to promise
+something grand. They were said to send up "smoke" in the wet season,
+like Mosi-oa-tunya; but when we looked down into the cleft, in which the
+dark-green narrow river still rolls, we saw, about 800 or 1000 feet below
+us, what, after Mosi-oa-tunya, seemed two insignificant cataracts. It
+was evident that Pitsane, observing our delight at the Victoria Falls,
+wished to increase our pleasure by a second wonder. One Mosi-oa-tunya,
+however, is quite enough for a continent.
+
+We had now an opportunity of seeing more of the Batoka, than we had on
+the highland route to our north. They did not wait till the evening
+before offering food to the strangers. The aged wife of the headman of a
+hamlet, where we rested at midday, at once kindled a fire, and put on the
+cooking-pot to make porridge. Both men and women are to be distinguished
+by greater roundness of feature than the other natives, and the custom of
+knocking out the upper front teeth gives at once a distinctive character
+to the face. Their colour attests the greater altitude of the country in
+which many of them formerly lived. Some, however, are as dark as the
+Bashubia and Barotse of the great valley to their west, in which stands
+Sesheke, formerly the capital of the Balui, or Bashubia.
+
+The assertion may seem strange, yet it is none the less true, that in all
+the tribes we have visited we never saw a really black person. Different
+shades of brown prevail, and often with a bright bronze tint, which no
+painter, except Mr. Angus, seems able to catch. Those who inhabit
+elevated, dry situations, and who are not obliged to work much in the
+sun, are frequently of a light warm brown, "dark but comely." Darkness
+of colour is probably partly caused by the sun, and partly by something
+in the climate or soil which we do not yet know. We see something of the
+same sort in trout and other fish which take their colour from the ponds
+or streams in which they live. The members of our party were much less
+embrowned by free exposure to the sun for years than Dr. Livingstone and
+his family were by passing once from Kuruman to Cape Town, a journey
+which occupied only a couple of months.
+
+We encamped on the Kalomo, on the 1st of October, and found the weather
+very much warmer than when we crossed this stream in August. At 3 p.m.
+the thermometer, four feet from the ground, was 101 degrees in the shade;
+the wet bulb only 61 degrees: a difference of 40 degrees. Yet,
+notwithstanding this extreme dryness of the atmosphere, without a drop of
+rain having fallen for months, and scarcely any dew, many of the shrubs
+and trees were putting forth fresh leaves of various hues, while others
+made a profuse display of lovely blossoms.
+
+Two old and very savage buffaloes were shot for our companions on the 3rd
+October. Our Volunteers may feel an interest in knowing that balls
+sometimes have but little effect: one buffalo fell, on receiving a
+Jacob's shell; it was hit again twice, and lost a large amount of blood;
+and yet it sprang up, and charged a native, who, by great agility, had
+just time to climb a tree, before the maddened beast struck it, battering-
+ram fashion, hard enough almost to have split both head and tree. It
+paused a few seconds--drew back several paces--glared up at the man--and
+then dashed at the tree again and again, as if determined to shake him
+out of it. It took two more Jacob's shells, and five other large solid
+rifle-balls to finish the beast at last. These old surly buffaloes had
+been wandering about in a sort of miserable fellowship; their skins were
+diseased and scabby, as if leprous, and their horns atrophied or worn
+down to stumps--the first was killed outright, by one Jacob's shell, the
+second died hard. There is so much difference in the tenacity of life in
+wounded animals of the same species, that the inquiry is suggested where
+the seat of life can be?--We have seen a buffalo live long enough, after
+a large bullet had passed right through the heart, to allow firm adherent
+clots to be formed in the two holes.
+
+One day's journey above Sinamane's, a mass of mountain called Gorongue,
+or Golongwe, is said to cross the river, and the rent through which the
+river passes is, by native report, quite fearful to behold. The country
+round it is so rocky, that our companions dreaded the fatigue, and were
+not much to blame, if, as is probably the case, the way be worse than
+that over which we travelled. As we trudged along over the black slag-
+like rocks, the almost leafless trees affording no shade, the heat was
+quite as great as Europeans could bear. It was 102 degrees in the shade,
+and a thermometer placed under the tongue or armpit showed that our blood
+was 99.5 degrees, or 1.5 degrees hotter than that of the natives, which
+stood at 98 degrees. Our shoes, however, enable us to pass over the hot
+burning soil better than they can. Many of those who wear sandals have
+corns on the sides of the feet, and on the heels, where the straps pass.
+We have seen instances, too, where neither sandals nor shoes were worn,
+of corns on the soles of the feet. It is, moreover, not at all uncommon
+to see toes cocked up, as if pressed out of their proper places; at home,
+we should have unhesitatingly ascribed this to the vicious fashions
+perversely followed by our shoemakers.
+
+On the 5th, after crossing some hills, we rested at the village of
+Simariango. The bellows of the blacksmith here were somewhat different
+from the common goatskin bags, and more like those seen in Madagascar.
+They consisted of two wooden vessels, like a lady's bandbox of small
+dimensions, the upper ends of which were covered with leather, and looked
+something like the heads of drums, except that the leather bagged in the
+centre. They were fitted with long nozzles, through which the air was
+driven by working the loose covering of the tops up and down by means of
+a small piece of wood attached to their centres. The blacksmith said
+that tin was obtained from a people in the north, called Marendi, and
+that he had made it into bracelets; we had never heard before of tin
+being found in the country.
+
+Our course then lay down the bed of a rivulet, called Mapatizia, in which
+there was much calc spar, with calcareous schist, and then the Tette grey
+sandstone, which usually overlies coal. On the 6th we arrived at the
+islet Chilombe, belonging to Sinamane, where the Zambesi runs broad and
+smooth again, and were well received by Sinamane himself. Never was
+Sunday more welcome to the weary than this, the last we were to spend
+with our convoy.
+
+We now saw many good-looking young men and women. The dresses of the
+ladies are identical with those of Nubian women in Upper Egypt. To a
+belt on the waist a great number of strings are attached to hang all
+round the person. These fringes are about six or eight inches long. The
+matrons wear in addition a skin cut like the tails of the coatee formerly
+worn by our dragoons. The younger girls wear the waist-belt exhibited in
+the woodcut, ornamented with shells, and have the fringes only in front.
+Marauding parties of Batoka, calling themselves Makololo, have for some
+time had a wholesome dread of Sinamane's "long spears." Before going to
+Tette our Batoka friend, Masakasa, was one of a party that came to steal
+some of the young women; but Sinamane, to their utter astonishment,
+attacked them so furiously that the survivors barely escaped with their
+lives. Masakasa had to flee so fast that he threw away his shield, his
+spear, and his clothes, and returned home a wiser and a sadder man.
+
+Sinamane's people cultivate large quantities of tobacco, which they
+manufacture into balls for the Makololo market. Twenty balls, weighing
+about three-quarters of a pound each, are sold for a hoe. The tobacco is
+planted on low moist spots on the banks of the Zambesi; and was in flower
+at the time we were there, in October. Sinamane's people appear to have
+abundance of food, and are all in good condition. He could sell us only
+two of his canoes; but lent us three more to carry us as far as Moemba's,
+where he thought others might be purchased. They were manned by his own
+canoe-men, who were to bring them back. The river is about 250 yards
+wide, and flows serenely between high banks towards the North-east. Below
+Sinamane's the banks are often worn down fifty feet, and composed of
+shingle and gravel of igneous rocks, sometimes set in a ferruginous
+matrix. The bottom is all gravel and shingle, how formed we cannot
+imagine, unless in pot-holes in the deep fissure above. The bottom above
+the Falls, save a few rocks close by them, is generally sandy or of soft
+tufa. Every damp spot is covered with maize, pumpkins, water-melons,
+tobacco, and hemp. There is a pretty numerous Batoka population on both
+sides of the river. As we sailed slowly down, the people saluted us from
+the banks, by clapping their hands. A headman even hailed us, and
+brought a generous present of corn and pumpkins.
+
+Moemba owns a rich island, called Mosanga, a mile in length, on which his
+village stands. He has the reputation of being a brave warrior, and is
+certainly a great talker; but he gave us strangers something better than
+a stream of words. We received a handsome present of corn, and the
+fattest goat we had ever seen; it resembled mutton. His people were as
+liberal as their chief. They brought two large baskets of corn, and a
+lot of tobacco, as a sort of general contribution to the travellers. One
+of Sinamane's canoe-men, after trying to get his pay, deserted here, and
+went back before the stipulated time, with the story, that the Englishman
+had stolen the canoes. Shortly after sunrise next morning, Sinamane came
+into the village with fifty of his "long spears," evidently determined to
+retake his property by force; he saw at a glance that his man had
+deceived him. Moemba rallied him for coming on a wildgoose chase. "Here
+are your canoes left with me, your men have all been paid, and the
+Englishmen are now asking me to sell my canoes." Sinamane said little to
+us; only observing that he had been deceived by his follower. A single
+remark of his chief's caused the foolish fellow to leave suddenly,
+evidently much frightened and crestfallen. Sinamane had been very kind
+to us, and, as he was looking on when we gave our present to Moemba, we
+made him also an additional offering of some beads, and parted good
+friends. Moemba, having heard that we had called the people of Sinamane
+together to tell them about our Saviour's mission to man, and to pray
+with them, associated the idea of Sunday with the meeting, and, before
+anything of the sort was proposed, came and asked that he and his people
+might be "sundayed" as well as his neighbours; and be given a little seed
+wheat, and fruit-tree seeds; with which request of course we very
+willingly complied. The idea of praying direct to the Supreme Being,
+though not quite new to all, seems to strike their minds so forcibly that
+it will not be forgotten. Sinamane said that he prayed to God, Morungo,
+and made drink-offerings to him. Though he had heard of us, he had never
+seen white men before.
+
+Beautiful crowned cranes, named from their note "ma-wang," were seen
+daily, and were beginning to pair. Large flocks of spur-winged geese, or
+machikwe, were common. This goose is said to lay her eggs in March. We
+saw also pairs of Egyptian geese, as well as a few of the knob-nosed, or,
+as they are called in India, combed geese. When the Egyptian geese, as
+at the present time, have young, the goslings keep so steadily in the
+wake of their mother, that they look as if they were a part of her tail;
+and both parents, when on land, simulate lameness quite as well as our
+plovers, to draw off pursuers. The ostrich also adopts the lapwing
+fashion, but no quadrupeds do: they show fight to defend their young
+instead. In some places the steep banks were dotted with the holes which
+lead into the nests of bee-eaters. These birds came out in hundreds as
+we passed. When the red-breasted species settle on the trees, they give
+them the appearance of being covered with red foliage.
+
+On the morning of the 12th October we passed through a wild, hilly
+country, with fine wooded scenery on both sides, but thinly inhabited.
+The largest trees were usually thorny acacias, of great size and
+beautiful forms. As we sailed by several villages without touching, the
+people became alarmed, and ran along the banks, spears in hand. We
+employed one to go forward and tell Mpande of our coming. This allayed
+their fears, and we went ashore, and took breakfast near the large island
+with two villages on it, opposite the mouth of the Zungwe, where we had
+left the Zambesi on our way up. Mpande was sorry that he had no canoes
+of his own to sell, but he would lend us two. He gave us cooked pumpkins
+and a water-melon. His servant had lateral curvature of the spine. We
+have often seen cases of humpback, but this was the only case of this
+kind of curvature we had met with. Mpande accompanied us himself in his
+own vessel, till we had an opportunity of purchasing a fine large canoe
+elsewhere. We paid what was considered a large price for it: twelve
+strings of blue cut glass neck beads, an equal number of large blue ones
+of the size of marbles, and two yards of grey calico. Had the beads been
+coarser, they would have been more valued, because such were in fashion.
+Before concluding the bargain the owner said "his bowels yearned for his
+canoe, and we must give a little more to stop their yearning." This was
+irresistible. The trading party of Sequasha, which we now met, had
+purchased ten large new canoes for six strings of cheap coarse white
+beads each, or their equivalent, four yards of calico, and had bought for
+the merest trifle ivory enough to load them all. They were driving a
+trade in slaves also, which was something new in this part of Africa, and
+likely soon to change the character of the inhabitants. These men had
+been living in clover, and were uncommonly fat and plump. When sent to
+trade, slaves wisely never stint themselves of beer or anything else,
+which their master's goods can buy.
+
+The temperature of the Zambesi had increased 10 degrees since August,
+being now 80 degrees. The air was as high as 96 degrees after sunset;
+and, the vicinity of the water being the coolest part, we usually made
+our beds close by the river's brink, though there in danger of
+crocodiles. Africa differs from India in the air always becoming cool
+and refreshing long before the sun returns, and there can be no doubt
+that we can in this country bear exposure to the sun, which would be
+fatal in India. It is probably owing to the greater dryness of the
+African atmosphere that sunstroke is so rarely met with. In twenty-two
+years Dr. Livingstone never met or heard of a single case, though the
+protective head-dresses of India are rarely seen.
+
+When the water is nearly at its lowest, we occasionally meet with small
+rapids which are probably not in existence during the rest of the year.
+Having slept opposite the rivulet Bume, which comes from the south, we
+passed the island of Nakansalo, and went down the rapids of the same name
+on the 17th, and came on the morning of the 19th to the more serious ones
+of Nakabele, at the entrance to Kariba. The Makololo guided the canoes
+admirably through the opening in the dyke. When we entered the gorge we
+came on upwards of thirty hippopotami: a bank near the entrance stretches
+two-thirds across the narrowed river, and in the still place behind it
+they were swimming about. Several were in the channel, and our canoe-men
+were afraid to venture down among them, because, as they affirm, there is
+commonly an ill-natured one in a herd, which takes a malignant pleasure
+in upsetting canoes. Two or three boys on the rocks opposite amused
+themselves by throwing stones at the frightened animals, and hit several
+on the head. It would have been no difficult matter to have shot the
+whole herd. We fired a few shots to drive them off; the balls often
+glance off the skull, and no more harm is done than when a schoolboy gets
+a bloody nose; we killed one, which floated away down the rapid current,
+followed by a number of men on the bank. A native called to us from the
+left bank, and said that a man on his side knew how to pray to the Kariba
+gods, and advised us to hire him to pray for our safety, while we were
+going down the rapids, or we should certainly all be drowned. No one
+ever risked his life in Kariba without first paying the river-doctor, or
+priest, for his prayers. Our men asked if there was a cataract in front,
+but he declined giving any information; they were not on his side of the
+river; if they would come over, then he might be able to tell them. We
+crossed, but he went off to the village. We then landed and walked over
+the hills to have a look at Karaba before trusting our canoes in it. The
+current was strong, and there was broken water in some places, but the
+channel was nearly straight, and had no cataract, so we determined to
+risk it. Our men visited the village while we were gone, and were
+treated to beer and tobacco. The priest who knows how to pray to the god
+that rules the rapids followed us with several of his friends, and they
+were rather surprised to see us pass down in safety, without the aid of
+his intercession. The natives who followed the dead hippopotamus caught
+it a couple of miles below, and, having made it fast to a rock, were
+sitting waiting for us on the bank beside the dead animal. As there was
+a considerable current there, and the rocky banks were unfit for our
+beds, we took the hippopotamus in tow, telling the villagers to follow,
+and we would give them most of the meat. The crocodiles tugged so hard
+at the carcass, that we were soon obliged to cast it adrift, to float
+down in the current, to avoid upsetting the canoe. We had to go on so
+far before finding a suitable spot to spend the night in, that the
+natives concluded we did not intend to share the meat with them, and
+returned to the village. We slept two nights at the place where the
+hippopotamus was cut up. The crocodiles had a busy time of it in the
+dark, tearing away at what was left in the river, and thrashing the water
+furiously with their powerful tails. The hills on both sides of Kariba
+are much like those of Kebrabasa, the strata tilted and twisted in every
+direction, with no level ground.
+
+Although the hills confine the Zambesi within a narrow channel for a
+number of miles, there are no rapids beyond those near the entrance. The
+river is smooth and apparently very deep. Only one single human being
+was seen in the gorge, the country being too rough for culture. Some
+rocks in the water, near the outlet of Kariba, at a distance look like a
+fort; and such large masses dislocated, bent, and even twisted to a
+remarkable degree, at once attest some tremendous upheaving and
+convulsive action of nature, which probably caused Kebrabasa, Kariba, and
+the Victoria Falls to assume their present forms; it took place after the
+formation of the coal, that mineral having then been tilted up. We have
+probably nothing equal to it in the present quiet operations of nature.
+
+On emerging we pitched our camp by a small stream, the Pendele, a few
+miles below the gorge. The Palabi mountain stands on the western side of
+the lower end of the Kariba strait; the range to which it belongs crosses
+the river, and runs to the south-east. Chikumbula, a hospitable old
+headman, under Nchomokela, the paramount chief of a large district, whom
+we did not see, brought us next morning a great basket of meal, and four
+fowls, with some beer, and a cake of salt, "to make it taste good."
+Chikumbula said that the elephants plagued them, by eating up the cotton-
+plants; but his people seem to be well off.
+
+A few days before we came, they caught three buffaloes in pitfalls in one
+night, and, unable to eat them all, left one to rot. During the night
+the wind changed and blew from the dead buffalo to our sleeping-place;
+and a hungry lion, not at all dainty in his food, stirred up the putrid
+mass, and growled and gloated over his feast, to the disturbance of our
+slumbers. Game of all kinds is in most extraordinary abundance,
+especially from this point to below the Kafue, and so it is on
+Moselekatso's side, where there are no inhabitants. The drought drives
+all the game to the river to drink. An hour's walk on the right bank,
+morning or evening, reveals a country swarming with wild animals: vast
+herds of pallahs, many waterbucks, koodoos, buffaloes, wild pigs, elands,
+zebras, and monkeys appear; francolins, guinea-fowls, and myriads of
+turtledoves attract the eye in the covers, with the fresh spoor of
+elephants and rhinoceroses, which had been at the river during the night.
+Every few miles we came upon a school of hippopotami, asleep on some
+shallow sandbank; their bodies, nearly all out of the water, appeared
+like masses of black rock in the river. When these animals are hunted
+much, they become proportionably wary, but here no hunter ever troubles
+them, and they repose in security, always however taking the precaution
+of sleeping just above the deep channel, into which they can plunge when
+alarmed. When a shot is fired into a sleeping herd, all start up on
+their feet, and stare with peculiar stolid looks of hippopotamic
+surprise, and wait for another shot before dashing into deep water. A
+few miles below Chikumbula's we saw a white hippopotamus in a herd. Our
+men had never seen one like it before. It was of a pinkish white,
+exactly like the colour of the Albino. It seemed to be the father of a
+number of others, for there were many marked with large light patches.
+The so-called _white_ elephant is just such a pinkish Albino as this
+hippopotamus. A few miles above Kariba we observed that, in two small
+hamlets, many of the inhabitants had a similar affection of the skin. The
+same influence appeared to have affected man and beast. A dark coloured
+hippopotamus stood alone, as if expelled from the herd, and bit the
+water, shaking his head from side to side in a most frantic manner. When
+the female has twins, she is said to kill one of them.
+
+We touched at the beautiful tree-covered island of Kalabi, opposite where
+Tuba-mokoro lectured the lion in our way up. The ancestors of the people
+who now inhabit this island possessed cattle. The tsetse has taken
+possession of the country since "the beeves were lifted." No one knows
+where these insects breed; at a certain season all disappear, and as
+suddenly come back, no one knows whence. The natives are such close
+observers of nature, that their ignorance in this case surprised us. A
+solitary hippopotamus had selected the little bay in which we landed, and
+where the women drew water, for his dwelling-place. Pretty little
+lizards, with light blue and red tails, run among the rocks, catching
+flies and other insects. These harmless--though to new-comers
+repulsive--creatures sometimes perform good service to man, by eating
+great numbers of the destructive white ants.
+
+At noon on the 24th October, we found Sequasha in a village below the
+Kafue, with the main body of his people. He said that 210 elephants had
+been killed during his trip; many of his men being excellent hunters. The
+numbers of animals we saw renders this possible. He reported that, after
+reaching the Kafue, he went northwards into the country of the Zulus,
+whose ancestors formerly migrated from the south and set up a sort of
+Republican form of government. Sequasha is the greatest Portuguese
+traveller we ever became acquainted with, and he boasts that he is able
+to speak a dozen different dialects; yet, unfortunately, he can give but
+a very meagre account of the countries and people he has seen, and his
+statements are not very much to be relied on. But considering the
+influence among which he has been reared, and the want of the means of
+education at Tette, it is a wonder that he possesses the good traits that
+he sometimes exhibits. Among his wares were several cheap American
+clocks; a useless investment rather, for a part of Africa where no one
+cares for the artificial measurement of time. These clocks got him into
+trouble among the Banyai: he set them all agoing in the presence of a
+chief, who became frightened at the strange sounds they made, and looked
+upon them as so many witchcraft agencies at work to bring all manner of
+evils upon himself and his people. Sequasha, it was decided, had been
+guilty of a milando, or crime, and he had to pay a heavy fine of cloth
+and beads for his exhibition. He alluded to our having heard that he had
+killed Mpangwe, and he denied having actually done so; but in his absence
+his name had got mixed up in the affair, in consequence of his slaves,
+while drinking beer one night with Namakusuru, the man who succeeded
+Mpangwe, saying that they would kill the chief for him. His partner had
+not thought of this when we saw him on the way up, for he tried to excuse
+the murder, by saying that now they had put the right man into the
+chieftainship.
+
+After three hours' sail, on the morning of the 29th, the river was
+narrowed again by the mountains of Mburuma, called Karivua, into one
+channel, and another rapid dimly appeared. It was formed by two currents
+guided by rocks to the centre. In going down it, the men sent by
+Sekeletu behaved very nobly. The canoes entered without previous survey,
+and the huge jobbling waves of mid-current began at once to fill them.
+With great presence of mind, and without a moment's hesitation, two men
+lightened each by jumping overboard; they then ordered a Botoka man to do
+the same, as "the white men must be saved." "I cannot swim," said the
+Batoka. "Jump out, then, and hold on to the canoe;" which he instantly
+did. Swimming alongside, they guided the swamping canoes down the swift
+current to the foot of the rapid, and then ran them ashore to bale them
+out. A boat could have passed down safely, but our canoes were not a
+foot above the water at the gunwales.
+
+Thanks to the bravery of these poor fellows, nothing was lost, although
+everything was well soaked. This rapid is nearly opposite the west end
+of the Mburuma mountains or Karivua. Another soon begins below it. They
+are said to be all smoothed over when the river rises. The canoes had to
+be unloaded at this the worst rapid, and the goods carried about a
+hundred yards. By taking the time in which a piece of stick floated past
+100 feet, we found the current to be running six knots, by far the
+greatest velocity noted in the river. As the men were bringing the last
+canoe down close to the shore, the stern swung round into the current,
+and all except one man let go, rather than be dragged off. He clung to
+the bow, and was swept out into the middle of the stream. Having held on
+when he ought to have let go, he next put his life in jeopardy by letting
+go when he ought to have held on; and was in a few seconds swallowed up
+by a fearful whirlpool. His comrades launched out a canoe below, and
+caught him as he rose the third time to the surface, and saved him,
+though much exhausted and very cold.
+
+The scenery of this pass reminded us of Kebrabasa, although it is much
+inferior. A band of the same black shining glaze runs along the rocks
+about two feet from the water's edge. There was not a blade of grass on
+some of the hills, it being the end of the usual dry season succeeding a
+previous severe drought; yet the hill-sides were dotted over with
+beautiful green trees. A few antelopes were seen on the rugged slopes,
+where some people too appeared lying down, taking a cup of beer. The
+Karivua narrows are about thirty miles in length. They end at the
+mountain Roganora. Two rocks, twelve or fifteen feet above the water at
+the time we were there, may in flood be covered and dangerous. Our chief
+danger was the wind, a very slight ripple being sufficient to swamp
+canoes.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX.
+
+
+The waterbuck--Disaster in Kebrabasa rapids--The "Ma Robert"
+founders--Arrival of the "Pioneer" and Bishop Mackenzie's
+party--Portuguese slave-trade--Interference and liberation.
+
+We arrived at Zumbo, at the mouth of the Loangwa, on the 1st of November.
+The water being scarcely up to the knee, our land party waded this river
+with ease. A buffalo was shot on an island opposite Pangola's, the ball
+lodging in the spleen. It was found to have been wounded in the same
+organ previously, for an iron bullet was imbedded in it, and the wound
+entirely healed. A great deal of the plant _Pistia stratiotes_ was seen
+floating in the river. Many people inhabit the right bank about this
+part, yet the game is very abundant.
+
+As we were taking our breakfast on the morning of the 2nd, the Mambo
+Kazai, of whom we knew nothing, and his men came with their muskets and
+large powder-horns to levy a fine, and obtain payment for the wood we
+used in cooking. But on our replying to his demand that we were English,
+"Oh! are you?" he said; "I thought you were Bazungu (Portuguese). They
+are the people I take payments from:" and he apologized for his mistake.
+Bazungu, or Azungu, is a term applied to all foreigners of a light
+colour, and to Arabs; even to trading slaves if clothed; it probably
+means foreigners, or visitors,--from _zunga_, to visit or wander,--and
+the Portuguese were the only foreigners these men had ever seen. As we
+had no desire to pass for people of that nation--quite the contrary--we
+usually made a broad line of demarcation by saying that we were English,
+and the English neither bought, sold, nor held black people as slaves,
+but wished to put a stop to the slave-trade altogether.
+
+We called upon our friend, Mpende, in passing. He provided a hut for us,
+with new mats spread on the floor. Having told him that we were hurrying
+on because the rains were near, "Are they near?" eagerly inquired an old
+counsellor, "and are we to have plenty of rain this year?" We could only
+say that it was about the usual time for the rains to commence; and that
+there were the usual indications in great abundance of clouds floating
+westwards, but that we knew nothing more than they did themselves.
+
+The hippopotami are more wary here than higher up, as the natives hunt
+them with guns. Having shot one on a shallow sandbank, our men undertook
+to bring it over to the left bank, in order to cut it up with greater
+ease. It was a fine fat one, and all rejoiced in the hope of eating the
+fat for butter, with our hard dry cakes of native meal. Our cook was
+sent over to cut a choice piece for dinner, but returned with the
+astonishing intelligence that the carcass was gone. They had been
+hoodwinked, and were very much ashamed of themselves. A number of Banyai
+came to assist in rolling it ashore, and asserted that it was all shallow
+water. They rolled it over and over towards the land, and, finding the
+rope we had made fast to it, as they said, an encumbrance, it was
+unloosed. All were shouting and talking as loud as they could bawl, when
+suddenly our expected feast plumped into a deep hole, as the Banyai
+intended it should do. When sinking, all the Makololo jumped in after
+it. One caught frantically at the tail; another grasped a foot; a third
+seized the hip; "but, by Sebituane, it would go down in spite of all that
+we could do." Instead of a fat hippopotamus we had only a lean fowl for
+dinner, and were glad enough to get even that. The hippopotamus,
+however, floated during the night, and was found about a mile below. The
+Banyai then assembled on the bank, and disputed our right to the beast:
+"It might have been shot by somebody else." Our men took a little of it
+and then left it, rather than come into collision with them.
+
+A fine waterbuck was shot in the Kakolole narrows, at Mount Manyerere; it
+dropped beside the creek where it was feeding; an enormous crocodile,
+that had been watching it at the moment, seized and dragged it into the
+water, which was not very deep. The mortally wounded animal made a
+desperate plunge, and hauling the crocodile several yards tore itself out
+of the hideous jaws. To escape the hunter, the waterbuck jumped into the
+river, and was swimming across, when another crocodile gave chase, but a
+ball soon sent it to the bottom. The waterbuck swam a little longer, the
+fine head dropped, the body turned over, and one of the canoes dragged it
+ashore. Below Kakolole, and still at the base of Manyerere mountain,
+several coal-seams, not noticed on our ascent, were now seen to crop out
+on the right bank of the Zambesi.
+
+Chitora, of Chicova, treated us with his former hospitality. Our men
+were all much pleased with his kindness, and certainly did not look upon
+it as a proof of weakness. They meant to return his friendliness when
+they came this way on a marauding expedition to eat the sheep of the
+Banyai, for insulting them in the affair of the hippopotamus; they would
+then send word to Chitora not to run away, for they, being his friends,
+would do such a good-hearted man no harm.
+
+We entered Kebrabasa rapids, at the east end of Chicova, in the canoes,
+and went down a number of miles, until the river narrowed into a groove
+of fifty or sixty yards wide, of which we have already spoken in
+describing the flood-bed and channel of low water. The navigation then
+became difficult and dangerous. A fifteen feet fall of the water in our
+absence had developed many cataracts. Two of our canoes passed safely
+down a narrow channel, which, bifurcating, had an ugly whirlpool at the
+rocky partition between the two branches, the deep hole in the whirls at
+times opening and then shutting. The Doctor's canoe came next, and
+seemed to be drifting broadside into the open vortex, in spite of the
+utmost exertions of the paddlers. The rest were expecting to have to
+pull to the rescue; the men saying, "Look where these people are
+going!--look, look!"--when a loud crash burst on our ears. Dr. Kirk's
+canoe was dashed on a projection of the perpendicular rocks, by a sudden
+and mysterious boiling up of the river, which occurs at irregular
+intervals. Dr. Kirk was seen resisting the sucking-down action of the
+water, which must have been fifteen fathoms deep, and raising himself by
+his arms on to the ledge, while his steersman, holding on to the same
+rocks, saved the canoe; but nearly all its contents were swept away down
+the stream. Dr. Livingstone's canoe, meanwhile, which had distracted the
+men's attention, was saved by the cavity in the whirlpool filling up as
+the frightful eddy was reached. A few of the things in Dr. Kirk's canoe
+were left; but all that was valuable, including a chronometer, a
+barometer, and, to our great sorrow, his notes of the journey and
+botanical drawings of the fruit-trees of the interior, perished.
+
+We now left the river, and proceeded on foot, sorry that we had not done
+so the day before. The men were thoroughly frightened, they had never
+seen such perilous navigation. They would carry all the loads, rather
+than risk Kebrabasa any longer; but the fatigue of a day's march over the
+hot rocks and burning sand changed their tune before night; and then they
+regretted having left the canoes; they thought they should have dragged
+them past the dangerous places, and then launched them again. One of the
+two donkeys died from exhaustion near the Luia. Though the men eat
+zebras and quaggas, blood relations of the donkey, they were shocked at
+the idea of eating the ass; "it would be like eating man himself, because
+the donkey lives with man, and is his bosom companion." We met two large
+trading parties of Tette slaves on their way to Zumbo, leading, to be
+sold for ivory, a number of Manganja women, with ropes round their necks,
+and all made fast to one long rope.
+
+Panzo, the headman of the village east of Kebrabasa, received us with
+great kindness. After the usual salutation he went up the hill, and, in
+a loud voice, called across the valley to the women of several hamlets to
+cook supper for us. About eight in the evening he returned, followed by
+a procession of women, bringing the food. There were eight dishes of
+nsima, or porridge, six of different sorts of very good wild vegetables,
+with dishes of beans and fowls; all deliciously well cooked, and
+scrupulously clean. The wooden dishes were nearly as white as the meal
+itself: food also was brought for our men. Ripe mangoes, which usually
+indicate the vicinity of the Portuguese, were found on the 21st November;
+and we reached Tette early on the 23rd, having been absent a little over
+six months.
+
+The two English sailors, left in charge of the steamer, were well, had
+behaved well, and had enjoyed excellent health all the time we were away.
+Their farm had been a failure. We left a few sheep, to be slaughtered
+when they wished for fresh meat, and two dozen fowls. Purchasing more,
+they soon had double the number of the latter, and anticipated a good
+supply of eggs; but they also bought two monkeys, and _they_ ate all the
+eggs. A hippopotamus came up one night, and laid waste their vegetable
+garden; the sheep broke into their cotton patch, when it was in flower,
+and ate it all, except the stems; then the crocodiles carried off the
+sheep, and the natives stole the fowls. Nor were they more successful as
+gun-smiths: a Portuguese trader, having an exalted opinion of the
+ingenuity of English sailors, showed them a double-barrelled rifle, and
+inquired if they could put on the _browning_, which had rusted off. "I
+think I knows how," said one, whose father was a blacksmith, "it's very
+easy; you have only to put the barrels in the fire." A great fire of
+wood was made on shore, and the unlucky barrels put over it, to secure
+the handsome rifle colour. To Jack's utter amazement the barrels came
+asunder. To get out of the scrape, his companion and he stuck the pieces
+together with resin, and sent it to the owner, with the message, "It was
+all they could do for it, and they would not charge him anything for the
+job!" They had also invented an original mode of settling a bargain;
+having ascertained the market price of provisions, they paid that, but no
+more. If the traders refused to leave the ship till the price was
+increased, a chameleon, of which the natives have a mortal dread, was
+brought out of the cabin; and the moment the natives saw the creature,
+they at once sprang overboard. The chameleon settled every dispute in a
+twinkling.
+
+But besides their good-humoured intercourse, they showed humanity worthy
+of English sailors. A terrible scream roused them up one night, and they
+pushed off in a boat to the rescue. A crocodile had caught a woman, and
+was dragging her across a shallow sandbank. Just as they came up to her,
+she gave a fearful shriek: the horrid reptile had snapped off her leg at
+the knee. They took her on board, bandaged the limb as well as they
+could, and, not thinking of any better way of showing their sympathy,
+gave her a glass of rum, and carried her to a hut in the village. Next
+morning they found the bandages torn off, and the unfortunate creature
+left to die. "I believe," remarked Rowe, one of the sailors, "her master
+was angry with us for saving her life, seeing as how she had lost her
+leg."
+
+The Zambesi being unusually low, we remained at Tette till it rose a
+little, and then left on the 3rd of December for the Kongone. It was
+hard work to keep the vessel afloat; indeed, we never expected her to
+remain above water. New leaks broke out every day; the engine pump gave
+way; the bridge broke down; three compartments filled at night; except
+the cabin and front compartment all was flooded; and in a few days we
+were assured by Rowe that "she can't be worse than she is, sir." He and
+Hutchins had spent much of their time, while we were away, in patching
+her bottom, puddling it with clay, and shoring it, and it was chiefly to
+please them that we again attempted to make use of her. We had long been
+fully convinced that the steel plates were thoroughly unsuitable. On the
+morning of the 21st the uncomfortable "Asthmatic" grounded on a sandbank
+and filled. She could neither be emptied nor got off. The river rose
+during the night, and all that was visible of the worn-out craft next day
+was about six feet of her two masts. Most of the property we had on
+board was saved; and we spent the Christmas of 1860 encamped on the
+island of Chimba. Canoes were sent for from Senna; and we reached it on
+the 27th, to be again hospitably entertained by our friend, Senhor
+Ferrao.
+
+We reached the Kongone on the 4th of January, 1861. A flagstaff and a
+Custom-house had been erected during our absence; a hut, also, for a
+black lance-corporal and three privates. By the kind permission of the
+lance-corporal, who came to see us as soon as he had got into his
+trousers and shirt, we took up our quarters in the Custom-house, which,
+like the other buildings, is a small square floorless hut of mangrove
+stakes overlaid with reeds. The soldiers complained of hunger, they had
+nothing to eat but a little mapira, and were making palm wine to deaden
+their cravings. While waiting for a ship, we had leisure to read the
+newspapers and periodicals we found in the mail which was waiting our
+arrival at Tette. Several were a year and a half old.
+
+Our provisions began to run short; and towards the end of the month there
+was nothing left but a little bad biscuit and a few ounces of sugar.
+Coffee and tea were expended, but scarcely missed, as our sailors
+discovered a pretty good substitute in roasted mapira. Fresh meat was
+obtained in abundance from our antelope preserves on the large island
+made by a creek between the Kongone and East Luabo.
+
+In this focus of decaying vegetation, nothing is so much to be dreaded as
+inactivity. We had, therefore, to find what exercise and amusement we
+could, when hunting was not required, in peering about in the fetid
+swamps; to have gone mooning about, in listless idleness, would have
+ensured fever in its worst form, and probably with fatal results.
+
+A curious little blenny-fish swarms in the numerous creeks which
+intersect the mangrove topes. When alarmed, it hurries across the
+surface of the water in a series of leaps. It may be considered
+amphibious, as it lives as much out of the water as in it, and its most
+busy time is during low water. Then it appears on the sand or mud, near
+the little pools left by the retiring tide; it raises itself on its
+pectoral fins into something of a standing attitude, and with its large
+projecting eyes keeps a sharp look-out for the light-coloured fly, on
+which it feeds. Should the fly alight at too great a distance for even a
+second leap, the blenny moves slowly towards it like a cat to its prey,
+or like a jumping spider; and, as soon as it gets within two or three
+inches of the insect, by a sudden spring contrives to pop its underset
+mouth directly over the unlucky victim. He is, moreover, a pugnacious
+little fellow; and rather prolonged fights may be observed between him
+and his brethren. One, in fleeing from an apparent danger, jumped into a
+pool a foot square, which the other evidently regarded as his by right of
+prior discovery; in a twinkling the owner, with eyes flashing fury, and
+with dorsal fin bristling up in rage, dashed at the intruding foe. The
+fight waxed furious, no tempest in a teapot ever equalled the storm of
+that miniature sea. The warriors were now in the water, and anon out of
+it, for the battle raged on sea and shore. They struck hard, they bit
+each other; until, becoming exhausted, they seized each other by the jaws
+like two bull-dogs, then paused for breath, and at it again as fiercely
+as before, until the combat ended by the precipitate retreat of the
+invader.
+
+The muddy ground under the mangrove-trees is covered with soldier-crabs,
+which quickly slink into their holes on any symptom of danger. When the
+ebbing tide retires, myriads of minute crabs emerge from their
+underground quarters, and begin to work like so many busy bees. Soon
+many miles of the smooth sand become rough with the results of their
+labour. They are toiling for their daily bread: a round bit of moist
+sand appears at the little labourer's mouth, and is quickly brushed off
+by one of the claws; a second bit follows the first; and another, and
+still another come as fast as they can be laid aside. As these pellets
+accumulate, the crab moves sideways, and the work continues. The first
+impression one receives is, that the little creature has swallowed a
+great deal of sand, and is getting rid of it as speedily as possible: a
+habit he indulges in of darting into his hole at intervals, as if for
+fresh supplies, tends to strengthen this idea; but the size of the heaps
+formed in a few seconds shows that this cannot be the case, and leads to
+the impression that, although not readily seen, at the distance at which
+he chooses to keep the observer, yet that possibly he raises the sand to
+his mouth, where whatever animalcule it may contain is sifted out of it,
+and the remainder rejected in the manner described. At times the larger
+species of crabs perform a sort of concert; and from each subterranean
+abode strange sounds arise, as if, in imitation of the songsters of the
+groves, for very joy they sang!
+
+We found some natives pounding the woody stems of a poisonous climbing-
+plant (_Dirca palustris_) called Busungu, or poison, which grows
+abundantly in the swamps. When a good quantity was bruised, it was tied
+up in bundles. The stream above and below was obstructed with bushes,
+and with a sort of rinsing motion the poison was diffused through the
+water. Many fish were soon affected, swain in shore, and died, others
+were only stupefied. The plant has pink, pea-shaped blossoms, and
+smooth, pointed, glossy leaves, and the brown bark is covered with minute
+white points. The knowledge of it might prove of use to a shipwrecked
+party by enabling them to catch the fish.
+
+The poison is said to be deleterious to man if the water is drunk; but
+not when the fish is cooked. The Busungu is repulsive to some insects,
+and is smeared round the shoots of the palm-trees to prevent the ants
+from getting into the palm wine while it is dropping from the tops of the
+palm-trees into the little pots suspended to collect it.
+
+We were in the habit of walking from our beds into the salt water at
+sunrise, for a bath, till a large crocodile appeared at the
+bathing-place, and from that time forth we took our dip in the sea, away
+from the harbour, about midday. This is said to be unwholesome, but we
+did not find it so. It is certainly better not to bathe in the mornings,
+when the air is colder than the water--for then, on returning to the
+cooler air, one is apt to get a chill and fever. In the mouth of the
+river, many saw-fish are found. Rowe saw one while bathing--caught it by
+the tail, and shoved it, "snout on," ashore. The saw is from a foot to
+eighteen inches long. We never heard of any one being wounded by this
+fish; nor, though it goes hundreds of miles up the river in fresh water,
+could we learn that it was eaten by the people. The hippopotami
+delighted to spend the day among the breakers, and seemed to enjoy the
+fun as much as we did.
+
+Severe gales occurred during our stay on the Coast, and many small sea-
+birds (_Prion Banksii_, Smith) perished: the beach was strewn with their
+dead bodies, and some were found hundreds of yards inland; many were so
+emaciated as to dry up without putrefying. We were plagued with myriads
+of mosquitoes, and had some touches of fever; the men we brought from
+malarious regions of the interior suffered almost as much from it here as
+we did ourselves. This gives strength to the idea that the civilized
+withstand the evil influences of strange climates better than the
+uncivilized. When negroes return to their own country from healthy
+lands, they suffer as severely as foreigners ever do.
+
+On the 31st of January, 1861, our new ship, the "Pioneer," arrived from
+England, and anchored outside the bar; but the weather was stormy, and
+she did not venture in till the 4th of February.
+
+Two of H.M. cruisers came at the same time, bringing Bishop Mackenzie,
+and the Oxford and Cambridge Mission to the tribes of the Shire and Lake
+Nyassa. The Mission consisted of six Englishmen, and five coloured men
+from the Cape. It was a puzzle to know what to do with so many men. The
+estimable Bishop, anxious to commence his work without delay, wished the
+"Pioneer" to carry the Mission up the Shire, as far as Chibisa's, and
+there leave them. But there were grave objections to this. The
+"Pioneer" was under orders to explore the Rovuma, as the Portuguese
+Government had refused to open the Zambesi to the ships of other nations,
+and their officials were very effectually pursuing a system, which, by
+abstracting the labour, was rendering the country of no value either to
+foreigners or to themselves. She was already two months behind her time,
+and the rainy season was half over. Then, if the party were taken to
+Chibisa's, the Mission would he left without a medical attendant, in an
+unhealthy region, at the beginning of the most sickly season of the year,
+and without means of reaching the healthy highlands, or of returning to
+the sea. We dreaded that, in the absence of medical aid and all
+knowledge of the treatment of fever, there might be a repetition of the
+sorrowful fate which befell the similar non-medical Mission at Linyanti.
+
+On the 25th of February the "Pioneer" anchored in the mouth of the
+Rovuma, which, unlike most African rivers, has a magnificent bay and no
+bar. We wooded, and then waited for the Bishop till the 9th of March,
+when he came in the "Lyra." On the 11th we proceeded up the river, and
+saw that it had fallen four or five feet during our detention. The
+scenery on the lower part of the Rovuma is superior to that on the
+Zambesi, for we can see the highlands from the sea. Eight miles from the
+mouth the mangroves are left behind, and a beautiful range of well-wooded
+hills on each bank begins. On these ridges the tree resembling African
+blackwood, of finer grain than ebony, grows abundantly, and attains a
+large size. Few people were seen, and those were of Arab breed, and did
+not appear to be very well off. The current of the Rovuma was now as
+strong as that of the Zambesi, but the volume of water is very much less.
+Several of the crossings had barely water enough for our ship, drawing
+five feet, to pass. When we were thirty miles up the river, the water
+fell suddenly seven inches in twenty-four hours. As the March flood is
+the last of the season, and it appeared to be expended, it was thought
+prudent to avoid the chance of a year's detention, by getting the ship
+back to the sea without delay. Had the Expedition been alone, we would
+have pushed up in boats, or afoot, and done what we could towards the
+exploration of the river and upper end of the lake; but, though the
+Mission was a private one, and entirely distinct from our own, a public
+one, the objects of both being similar, we felt anxious to aid our
+countrymen in their noble enterprise; and, rather than follow our own
+inclination, decided to return to the Shire, see the Mission party
+settled safely, and afterwards explore Lake Nyassa and the Rovuma, from
+the Lake downwards. Fever broke out on board the "Pioneer," at the mouth
+of the Rovuma, as we thought from our having anchored close to a creek
+coming out of the mangroves; and it remained in her until we completely
+isolated the engine-room from the rest of the ship. The coal-dust
+rotting sent out strong effluvia, and kept up the disease for more than a
+twelvemonth.
+
+Soon after we started the fever put the "Pioneer" almost entirely into
+the hands of the original Zambesi Expedition, and not long afterwards the
+leader had to navigate the ocean as well as the river. The habit of
+finding the geographical positions on land renders it an easy task to
+steer a steamer with only three or four sails at sea; where, if one does
+not run ashore, no one follows to find out an error, and where a current
+affords a ready excuse for every blunder.
+
+Touching at Mohilla, one of the Comoro Islands, on our return, we found a
+mixed race of Arabs, Africans, and their conquerors, the natives of
+Madagascar. Being Mahometans, they have mosques and schools, in which we
+were pleased to see girls as well as boys taught to read the Koran. The
+teacher said he was paid by the job, and received ten dollars for
+teaching each child to read. The clever ones learn in six months; but
+the dull ones take a couple of years. We next went over to Johanna for
+our friends; and, after a sojourn of a few days at the beautiful Comoro
+Islands, we sailed for the Kongone mouth of the Zambesi with Bishop
+Mackenzie and his party. We reached the coast in seven days, and passed
+up the Zambesi to the Shire.
+
+The "Pioneer," constructed under the skilful supervision of Admiral Sir
+Baldwin Walker and the late Admiral Washington, warm-hearted and highly
+esteemed friends of the Expedition, was a very superior vessel, and well
+suited for our work in every respect, except in her draught of water.
+Five feet were found to be too much for the navigation of the upper part
+of the Shire. Designed to draw three feet only, the weight necessary to
+impart extra strength, and fit her for the ocean, brought her down two
+feet more, and caused us a great deal of hard and vexatious work, in
+laying out anchors, and toiling at the capstan to get her off sandbanks.
+We should not have minded this much, but for the heavy loss of time which
+might have been more profitably, and infinitely more pleasantly, spent in
+intercourse with the people, exploring new regions, and otherwise
+carrying out the objects of the Expedition. Once we were a fortnight on
+a bank of soft yielding sand, having only two or three inches less water
+than the ship drew; this delay was occasioned by the anchors coming home,
+and the current swinging the ship broadside on the bank, which,
+immediately on our touching, always formed behind us. We did not like to
+leave the ship short of Chibisa's, lest the crew should suffer from the
+malaria of the lowland around; and it would have been difficult to have
+got the Mission goods carried up. We were daily visited by crowds of
+natives, who brought us abundance of provisions far beyond our ability to
+consume. In hauling the "Pioneer" over the shallow places, the Bishop,
+with Horace Waller and Mr. Scudamore, were ever ready and anxious to lend
+a hand, and worked as hard as any on board. Had our fine little ship
+drawn but three feet, she could have run up and down the river at any
+time of the year with the greatest ease, but as it was, having once
+passed up over a few shallow banks, it was impossible to take her down
+again until the river rose in December. She could go up over a bank, but
+not come down over it, as a heap of sand always formed instantly astern,
+while the current washed it away from under her bows.
+
+On at last reaching Chibisa's, we heard that there was war in the
+Manganja country, and the slave-trade was going on briskly. A deputation
+from a chief near Mount Zomba had just passed on its way to Chibisa, who
+was in a distant village, to implore him to come himself, or send
+medicine, to drive off the Waiao, Waiau, or Ajawa, whose marauding
+parties were desolating the land. A large gang of recently enslaved
+Manganja crossed the river, on their way to Tette, a few days before we
+got the ship up. Chibisa's deputy was civil, and readily gave us
+permission to hire as many men to carry the Bishop's goods up to the
+hills as were willing to go. With a sufficient number, therefore, we
+started for the highlands on the 15th of July, to show the Bishop the
+country, which, from its altitude and coolness, was most suitable for a
+station. Our first day's march was a long and fatiguing one. The few
+hamlets we passed were poor, and had no food for our men, and we were
+obliged to go on till 4 p.m., when we entered the small village of
+Chipindu. The inhabitants complained of hunger, and said they had no
+food to sell, and no hut for us to sleep in; but, if we would only go on
+a little further, we should come to a village where they had plenty to
+eat; but we had travelled far enough, and determined to remain where we
+were. Before sunset as much food was brought as we cared to purchase,
+and, as it threatened to rain, huts were provided for the whole party.
+
+Next forenoon we halted at the village of our old friend Mbame, to obtain
+new carriers, because Chibisa's men, never before having been hired, and
+not having yet learned to trust us, did not choose to go further. After
+resting a little, Mbame told us that a slave party on its way to Tette
+would presently pass through his village. "Shall we interfere?" we
+inquired of each other. We remembered that all our valuable private
+baggage was in Tette, which, if we freed the slaves, might, together with
+some Government property, be destroyed in retaliation; but this system of
+slave-hunters dogging us where previously they durst not venture, and, on
+pretence of being "our children," setting one tribe against another, to
+furnish themselves with slaves, would so inevitably thwart all the
+efforts, for which we had the sanction of the Portuguese Government, that
+we resolved to run all risks, and put a stop, if possible, to the slave-
+trade, which had now followed on the footsteps of our discoveries. A few
+minutes after Mbame had spoken to us, the slave party, a long line of
+manacled men, women, and children, came wending their way round the hill
+and into the valley, on the side of which the village stood. The black
+drivers, armed with muskets, and bedecked with various articles of
+finery, marched jauntily in the front, middle, and rear of the line; some
+of them blowing exultant notes out of long tin horns. They seemed to
+feel that they were doing a very noble thing, and might proudly march
+with an air of triumph. But the instant the fellows caught a glimpse of
+the English, they darted off like mad into the forest; so fast, indeed,
+that we caught but a glimpse of their red caps and the soles of their
+feet. The chief of the party alone remained; and he, from being in
+front, had his hand tightly grasped by a Makololo! He proved to be a
+well-known slave of the late Commandant at Tette, and for some time our
+own attendant while there. On asking him how he obtained these captives,
+he replied he had bought them; but on our inquiring of the people
+themselves, all, save four, said they had been captured in war. While
+this inquiry was going on, he bolted too. The captives knelt down, and,
+in their way of expressing thanks, clapped their hands with great energy.
+They were thus left entirely on our hands, and knives were soon busy at
+work cutting the women and children loose. It was more difficult to cut
+the men adrift, as each had his neck in the fork of a stout stick, six or
+seven feet long, and was kept in by an iron rod which was riveted at both
+ends across the throat. With a saw, luckily in the Bishop's baggage, one
+by one the men were sawn out into freedom. The women, on being told to
+take the meal they were carrying and cook breakfast for themselves and
+the children, seemed to consider the news too good to be true; but after
+a little coaxing went at it with alacrity, and made a capital fire by
+which to boil their pots with the slave sticks and bonds, their old
+acquaintances through many a sad night and weary day. Many were mere
+children about five years of age and under. One little boy, with the
+simplicity of childhood, said to our men, "The others tied and starved
+us, you cut the ropes and tell us to eat; what sort of people are
+you?--Where did you come from?" Two of the women had been shot the day
+before for attempting to untie the thongs. This, the rest were told, was
+to prevent them from attempting to escape. One woman had her infant's
+brains knocked out, because she could not carry her load and it. And a
+man was dispatched with an axe, because he had broken down with fatigue.
+Self-interest would have set a watch over the whole rather than commit
+murder; but in this traffic we invariably find self-interest overcome by
+contempt of human life and by bloodthirstiness.
+
+The Bishop was not present at this scene, having gone to bathe in a
+little stream below the village; but on his return he warmly approved of
+what had been done; he at first had doubts, but now felt that, had he
+been present, he would have joined us in the good work. Logic is out of
+place when the question with a true-hearted man is, whether his brother
+man is to be saved or not. Eighty-four, chiefly women and children, were
+liberated; and on being told that they were now free, and might go where
+they pleased, or remain with us, they all chose to stay; and the Bishop
+wisely attached them to his Mission, to be educated as members of a
+Christian family. In this way a great difficulty in the commencement of
+a Mission was overcome. Years are usually required before confidence is
+so far instilled into the natives' mind as to induce them, young or old,
+to submit to the guidance of strangers professing to be actuated by
+motives the reverse of worldly wisdom, and inculcating customs strange
+and unknown to them and their fathers.
+
+We proceeded next morning to Soche's with our liberated party, the men
+cheerfully carrying the Bishop's goods. As we had begun, it was of no
+use to do things by halves, so eight others were freed in a hamlet on our
+path; but a party of traders, with nearly a hundred slaves, fled from
+Soche's on hearing of our proceedings. Dr. Kirk and four Makololo
+followed them with great energy, but they made clear off to Tette. Six
+more captives were liberated at Mongazi's, and two slave-traders detained
+for the night, to prevent them from carrying information to a large party
+still in front. Of their own accord they volunteered the information
+that the Governor's servants had charge of the next party; but we did not
+choose to be led by them, though they offered to guide us to his
+Excellency's own agents. Two of the Bishop's black men from the Cape,
+having once been slaves, were now zealous emancipators, and volunteered
+to guard the prisoners during the night. So anxious were our heroes to
+keep them safe, that instead of relieving each other, by keeping watch
+and watch, both kept watch together, till towards four o'clock in the
+morning, when sleep stole gently over them both; and the wakeful
+prisoners, seizing the opportunity, escaped: one of the guards,
+perceiving the loss, rushed out of the hut, shouting, "They are gone, the
+prisoners are off, and they have taken my rifle with them, and the women
+too! Fire! everybody fire!" The rifle and the women, however, were all
+safe enough, the slave-traders being only too glad to escape alone. Fifty
+more slaves were freed next day in another village; and, the whole party
+being stark-naked, cloth enough was left to clothe them, better probably
+than they had ever been clothed before. The head of this gang, whom we
+knew as the agent of one of the principal merchants of Tette, said that
+they had the license of the Governor for all they did. This we were
+fully aware of without his stating it. It is quite impossible for any
+enterprise to be undertaken there without the Governor's knowledge and
+connivance.
+
+The portion of the highlands which the Bishop wished to look at before
+deciding on a settlement belonged to Chiwawa, or Chibaba, the most manly
+and generous Manganja chief we had met with on our previous journey. On
+reaching Nsambo's, near Mount Chiradzuru, we heard that Chibaba was dead,
+and that Chigunda was chief instead. Chigunda, apparently of his own
+accord, though possibly he may have learnt that the Bishop intended to
+settle somewhere in the country, asked him to come and live with him at
+Magomero, adding that there was room enough for both. This hearty and
+spontaneous invitation had considerable influence on the Bishop's mind,
+and seemed to decide the question. A place nearer the Shire would have
+been chosen had he expected his supplies to come up that river; but the
+Portuguese, claiming the river Shire, though never occupying even its
+mouth, had closed it, as well as the Zambesi.
+
+Our hopes were turned to the Rovuma, as a free highway into Lake Nyassa
+and the vast interior. A steamer was already ordered for the Lake, and
+the Bishop, seeing the advantageous nature of the highlands which stretch
+an immense way to the north, was more anxious to be near the Lake and the
+Rovuma, than the Shire. When he decided to settle at Magomero, it was
+thought desirable, to prevent the country from being depopulated, to
+visit the Ajawa chief, and to try and persuade him to give up his slaving
+and kidnapping courses, and turn the energies of his people to peaceful
+pursuits.
+
+On the morning of the 22nd we were informed that the Ajawa were near, and
+were burning a village a few miles off. Leaving the rescued slaves, we
+moved off to seek an interview with these scourges of the country. On
+our way we met crowds of Manganja fleeing from the war in front. These
+poor fugitives from the slave hunt had, as usual, to leave all the food
+they possessed, except the little they could carry on their heads. We
+passed field after field of Indian corn or beans, standing ripe for
+harvesting, but the owners were away. The villages were all deserted:
+one where we breakfasted two years before, and saw a number of men
+peacefully weaving cloth, and, among ourselves, called it the "Paisley of
+the hills," was burnt; the stores of corn were poured out in cartloads,
+and scattered all over the plain, and all along the paths, neither
+conquerors nor conquered having been able to convey it away. About two
+o'clock we saw the smoke of burning villages, and heard triumphant
+shouts, mingled with the wail of the Manganja women, lamenting over their
+slain. The Bishop then engaged us in fervent prayer; and, on rising from
+our knees, we saw a long line of Ajawa warriors, with their captives,
+coming round the hill-side. The first of the returning conquerors were
+entering their own village below, and we heard women welcoming them back
+with "lillilooings." The Ajawa headman left the path on seeing us, and
+stood on an anthill to obtain a complete view of our party. We called
+out that we had come to have an interview with them, but some of the
+Manganja who followed us shouted "Our Chibisa is come:" Chibisa being
+well known as a great conjurer and general. The Ajawa ran off yelling
+and screaming, "Nkondo! Nkondo!" (War! War!) We heard the words of the
+Manganja, but they did not strike us at the moment as neutralizing all
+our assertions of peace. The captives threw down their loads on the
+path, and fled to the hills: and a large body of armed men came running
+up from the village, and in a few seconds they were all around us, though
+mostly concealed by the projecting rocks and long grass. In vain we
+protested that we had not come to fight, but to talk with them. They
+would not listen, having, as we remembered afterwards, good reason, in
+the cry of "Our Chibisa." Flushed with recent victory over three
+villages, and confident of an easy triumph over a mere handful of men,
+they began to shoot their poisoned arrows, sending them with great force
+upwards of a hundred yards, and wounding one of our followers through the
+arm. Our retiring slowly up the ascent from the village only made them
+more eager to prevent our escape; and, in the belief that this retreat
+was evidence of fear, they closed upon us in bloodthirsty fury. Some
+came within fifty yards, dancing hideously; others having quite
+surrounded us, and availing themselves of the rocks and long grass hard
+by, were intent on cutting us off, while others made off with their women
+and a large body of slaves. Four were armed with muskets, and we were
+obliged in self-defence to return their fire and drive them off. When
+they saw the range of rifles, they very soon desisted, and ran away; but
+some shouted to us from the hills the consoling intimation, that they
+would follow, and kill us where we slept. Only two of the captives
+escaped to us, but probably most of those made prisoners that day fled
+elsewhere in the confusion. We returned to the village which we had left
+in the morning, after a hungry, fatiguing, and most unpleasant day.
+
+Though we could not blame ourselves for the course we had followed, we
+felt sorry for what had happened. It was the first time we had ever been
+attacked by the natives or come into collision with them; though we had
+always taken it for granted that we might be called upon to act in self-
+defence, we were on this occasion less prepared than usual, no game
+having been expected here. The men had only a single round of cartridge
+each; their leader had no revolver, and the rifle he usually fired with
+was left at the ship to save it from the damp of the season. Had we
+known better the effect of slavery and murder on the temper of these
+bloodthirsty marauders, we should have tried messages and presents before
+going near them.
+
+The old chief, Chinsunse, came on a visit to us next day, and pressed the
+Bishop to come and live with him. "Chigunda," he said, "is but a child,
+and the Bishop ought to live with the father rather than with the child."
+But the old man's object was so evidently to have the Mission as a shield
+against the Ajawa, that his invitation was declined. While begging us to
+drive away the marauders, that he might live in peace, he adopted the
+stratagem of causing a number of his men to rush into the village, in
+breathless haste, with the news that the Ajawa were close upon us. And
+having been reminded that we never fought, unless attacked, as we were
+the day before, and that we had come among them for the purpose of
+promoting peace, and of teaching them to worship the Supreme, to give up
+selling His children, and to cultivate other objects for barter than each
+other, he replied, in a huff, "Then I am dead already."
+
+The Bishop, feeling, as most Englishmen would, at the prospect of the
+people now in his charge being swept off into slavery by hordes of men-
+stealers, proposed to go at once to the rescue of the captive Manganja,
+and drive the marauding Ajawa out of the country. All were warmly in
+favour of this, save Dr. Livingstone, who opposed it on the ground that
+it would be better for the Bishop to wait, and see the effect of the
+check the slave-hunters had just experienced. The Ajawa were evidently
+goaded on by Portuguese agents from Tette, and there was no bond of union
+among the Manganja on which to work. It was possible that the Ajawa
+might be persuaded to something better, though, from having long been in
+the habit of slaving for the Quillimane market, it was not very probable.
+But the Manganja could easily be overcome piecemeal by any enemy; old
+feuds made them glad to see calamities befall their next neighbours. We
+counselled them to unite against the common enemies of their country, and
+added distinctly that we English would on no account enter into their
+quarrels. On the Bishop inquiring whether, in the event of the Manganja
+again asking aid against the Ajawa, it would be his duty to accede to
+their request,--"No," replied Dr. Livingstone, "you will be oppressed by
+their importunities, but do not interfere in native quarrels." This
+advice the good man honourably mentions in his journal. We have been
+rather minute in relating what occurred during the few days of our
+connection with the Mission of the English Universities, on the hills,
+because, the recorded advice having been discarded, blame was thrown on
+Dr. Livingstone's shoulders, as if the missionaries had no individual
+responsibility for their subsequent conduct. This, unquestionably, good
+Bishop Mackenzie had too much manliness to have allowed. The connection
+of the members of the Zambesi Expedition, with the acts of the Bishop's
+Mission, now ceased, for we returned to the ship and prepared for our
+journey to Lake Nyassa. We cheerfully, if necessary, will bear all
+responsibility up to this point; and if the Bishop afterwards made
+mistakes in certain collisions with the slavers, he had the votes of all
+his party with him, and those who best knew the peculiar circumstances,
+and the loving disposition of this good-hearted man, will blame him
+least. In this position, and in these circumstances, we left our friends
+at the Mission Station.
+
+As a temporary measure the Bishop decided to place his Mission Station on
+a small promontory formed by the windings of the little, clear stream of
+Magomero, which was so cold that the limbs were quite benumbed by washing
+in it in the July mornings. The site chosen was a pleasant spot to the
+eye, and completely surrounded by stately, shady trees. It was expected
+to serve for a residence, till the Bishop had acquired an accurate
+knowledge of the adjacent country, and of the political relations of the
+people, and could select a healthy and commanding situation, as a
+permanent centre of Christian civilization. Everything promised fairly.
+The weather was delightful, resembling the pleasantest part of an English
+summer; provisions poured in very cheap and in great abundance. The
+Bishop, with characteristic ardour, commenced learning the language, Mr.
+Waller began building, and Mr. Scudamore improvised a sort of infant
+school for the children, than which there is no better means for
+acquiring an unwritten tongue.
+
+On the 6th of August, 1861, a few days after returning from Magomero,
+Drs. Livingstone and Kirk, and Charles Livingstone started for Nyassa
+with a light four-oared gig, a white sailor, and a score of attendants.
+We hired people along the path to carry the boat past the forty miles of
+the Murchison Cataracts for a cubit of cotton cloth a day. This being
+deemed great wages, more than twice the men required eagerly offered
+their services. The chief difficulty was in limiting their numbers.
+Crowds followed us; and, had we not taken down in the morning the names
+of the porters engaged, in the evening claims would have been made by
+those who only helped during the last ten minutes of the journey. The
+men of one village carried the boat to the next, and all we had to do was
+to tell the headman that we wanted fresh men in the morning. He saw us
+pay the first party, and had his men ready at the time appointed, so
+there was no delay in waiting for carriers. They often make a loud noise
+when carrying heavy loads, but talking and bawling does not put them out
+of breath. The country was rough and with little soil on it, but covered
+with grass and open forest. A few small trees were cut down to clear a
+path for our shouting assistants, who were good enough to consider the
+boat as a certificate of peaceful intentions at least to them. Several
+small streams were passed, the largest of which were the Mukuru-Madse and
+Lesungwe. The inhabitants on both banks were now civil and obliging. Our
+possession of a boat, and consequent power of crossing independently of
+the canoes, helped to develop their good manners, which were not apparent
+on our previous visit.
+
+There is often a surprising contrast between neighbouring villages. One
+is well off and thriving, having good huts, plenty of food, and native
+cloth; and its people are frank, trusty, generous, and eager to sell
+provisions; while in the next the inhabitants may be ill-housed,
+disobliging, suspicious, ill-fed, and scantily clad, and with nothing for
+sale, though the land around is as fertile as that of their wealthier
+neighbours. We followed the river for the most part to avail ourselves
+of the still reaches for sailing; but a comparatively smooth country lies
+further inland, over which a good road could be made. Some of the five
+main cataracts are very grand, the river falling 1200 feet in the 40
+miles. After passing the last of the cataracts, we launched our boat for
+good on the broad and deep waters of the Upper Shire, and were virtually
+on the lake, for the gentle current shows but little difference of level.
+The bed is broad and deep, but the course is rather tortuous at first,
+and makes a long bend to the east till it comes within five or six miles
+of the base of Mount Zomba. The natives regarded the Upper Shire as a
+prolongation of Lake Nyassa; for where what we called the river
+approaches Lake Shirwa, a little north of the mountains, they said that
+the hippopotami, "which are great night travellers," pass from _one lake
+into the other_. There the land is flat, and only a short land journey
+would be necessary. Seldom does the current here exceed a knot an hour,
+while that of the Lower Shire is from two to two-and-a-half knots. Our
+land party of Makololo accompanied us along the right bank, and passed
+thousands of Manganja fugitives living in temporary huts on that side,
+who had recently been driven from their villages on the opposite hills by
+the Ajawa.
+
+The soil was dry and hard, and covered with mopane-trees; but some of the
+Manganja were busy hoeing the ground and planting the little corn they
+had brought with them. The effects of hunger were already visible on
+those whose food had been seized or burned by the Ajawa and Portuguese
+slave-traders. The spokesman or prime minister of one of the chiefs,
+named Kalonjere, was a humpbacked dwarf, a fluent speaker, who tried hard
+to make us go over and drive off the Ajawa; but he could not deny that by
+selling people Kalonjere had invited these slave-hunters to the country.
+This is the second humpbacked dwarf we have found occupying the like
+important post, the other was the prime minister of a Batonga chief on
+the Zambesi.
+
+As we sailed along, we disturbed many white-breasted cormorants; we had
+seen the same species fishing between the cataracts. Here, with many
+other wild-fowls, they find subsistence on the smooth water by night, and
+sit sleepily on trees and in the reeds by day. Many hippopotami were
+seen in the river, and one of them stretched its wide jaws, as if to
+swallow the whole stern of the boat, close to Dr. Kirk's back; the animal
+was so near that, in opening its mouth, it lashed a quantity of water on
+to the stern-sheets, but did no damage. To avoid large marauding parties
+of Ajawa, on the left bank of the Shire, we continued on the right, or
+western side, with our land party, along the shore of the small lake
+Pamalombe. This lakelet is ten or twelve miles in length, and five or
+six broad. It is nearly surrounded by a broad belt of papyrus, so dense
+that we could scarcely find an opening to the shore. The plants, ten or
+twelve feet high, grew so closely together that air was excluded, and so
+much sulphuretted hydrogen gas evolved that by one night's exposure the
+bottom of the boat was blackened. Myriads of mosquitoes showed, as
+probably they always do, the presence of malaria.
+
+We hastened from this sickly spot, trying to take the attentions of the
+mosquitoes as hints to seek more pleasant quarters on the healthy shores
+of Lake Nyassa; and when we sailed into it, on the 2nd September, we felt
+refreshed by the greater coolness of the air off this large body of
+water. The depth was the first point of interest. This is indicated by
+the colour of the water, which, on a belt along the shore, varying from a
+quarter to half a mile in breadth, is light green, and this is met by the
+deep blue or indigo tint of the Indian Ocean, which is the colour of the
+great body of Nyassa. We found the Upper Shire from nine to fifteen feet
+in depth; but skirting the western side of the lake about a mile from the
+shore the water deepened from nine to fifteen fathoms; then, as we
+rounded the grand mountainous promontory, which we named Cape Maclear,
+after our excellent friend the Astronomer Royal at the Cape of Good Hope,
+we could get no bottom with our lead-line of thirty-five fathoms. We
+pulled along the western shore, which was a succession of bays, and found
+that where the bottom was sandy near the beach, and to a mile out, the
+depth varied from six to fourteen fathoms. In a rocky bay about latitude
+11 degrees 40 minutes we had soundings at 100 fathoms, though outside the
+same bay we found none with a fishing-line of 116 fathoms; but this cast
+was unsatisfactory, as the line broke in coming up. According to our
+present knowledge, a ship could anchor only near the shore.
+
+Looking back to the southern end of Lake Nyassa, the arm from which the
+Shire flows was found to be about thirty miles long and from ten to
+twelve broad. Rounding Cape Maclear, and looking to the south-west, we
+have another arm, which stretches some eighteen miles southward, and is
+from six to twelve miles in breadth. These arms give the southern end a
+forked appearance, and with the help of a little imagination it may be
+likened to the "boot-shape" of Italy. The narrowest part is about the
+ankle, eighteen or twenty miles. From this it widens to the north, and
+in the upper third or fourth it is fifty or sixty miles broad. The
+length is over 200 miles. The direction in which it lies is as near as
+possible due north and south. Nothing of the great bend to the west,
+shown in all the previous maps, could be detected by either compass or
+chronometer, and the watch we used was an excellent one. The season of
+the year was very unfavourable. The "smokes" filled the air with an
+impenetrable haze, and the equinoctial gales made it impossible for us to
+cross to the eastern side. When we caught a glimpse of the sun rising
+from behind the mountains to the east, we made sketches and bearings of
+them at different latitudes, which enabled us to secure approximate
+measurements of the width. These agreed with the times taken by the
+natives at the different crossing-places--as Tsenga and Molamba. About
+the beginning of the upper third the lake is crossed by taking advantage
+of the island Chizumara, which name in the native tongue means the
+"ending;" further north they go round the end instead, though that takes
+several days.
+
+The lake appeared to be surrounded by mountains, but it was afterwards
+found that these beautiful tree-covered heights were, on the west, only
+the edges of high table-lands. Like all narrow seas encircled by
+highlands, it is visited by sudden and tremendous storms. We were on it
+in September and October, perhaps the stormiest season of the year, and
+were repeatedly detained by gales. At times, while sailing pleasantly
+over the blue water with a gentle breeze, suddenly and without any
+warning was heard the sound of a coming storm, roaring on with crowds of
+angry waves in its wake. We were caught one morning with the sea
+breaking all around us, and, unable either to advance or recede, anchored
+a mile from shore, in seven fathoms. The furious surf on the beach would
+have shivered our boat to atoms, had we tried to land. The waves most
+dreaded came rolling on in threes, with their crests, driven into spray,
+streaming behind them. A short lull followed each triple charge. Had
+one of these seas struck our boat, nothing could have saved us; for they
+came on with resistless force; seaward, in shore, and on either side of
+us, they broke in foam, but we escaped. For six weary hours we faced
+those terrible trios. A low, dark, detached, oddly shaped cloud came
+slowly from the mountains, and hung for hours directly over our heads. A
+flock of night-jars (_Cometornis vexillarius_), which on no other
+occasion come out by day, soared above us in the gale, like birds of evil
+omen. Our black crew became sea-sick and unable to sit up or keep the
+boat's head to the sea. The natives and our land party stood on the high
+cliffs looking at us and exclaiming, as the waves seemed to swallow up
+the boat, "They are lost! they are all dead!" When at last the gale
+moderated and we got safely ashore, they saluted us warmly, as after a
+long absence. From this time we trusted implicitly to the opinions of
+our seaman, John Neil, who, having been a fisherman on the coast of
+Ireland, understood boating on a stormy coast, and by his advice we often
+sat cowering on the land for days together waiting for the surf to go
+down. He had never seen such waves before. We had to beach the boat
+every night to save her from being swamped at anchor; and, did we not
+believe the gales to be peculiar to one season of the year, would call
+Nyassa the "Lake of Storms."
+
+Distinct white marks on the rocks showed that, for some time during the
+rainy season, the water of the lake is three feet above the point to
+which it falls towards the close of the dry period of the year. The
+rains begin here in November, and the permanent rise of the Shire does
+not take place till January. The western side of Lake Nyassa, with the
+exception of the great harbour to the west of Cape Maclear, is, as has
+been said before, a succession of small bays of nearly similar form, each
+having an open sandy beach and pebbly shore, and being separated from its
+neighbour by a rocky headland, with detached rocks extending some
+distance out to sea. The great south-western bay referred to would form
+a magnificent harbour, the only really good one we saw to the west.
+
+The land immediately adjacent to the lake is low and fertile, though in
+some places marshy and tenanted by large flocks of ducks, geese, herons,
+crowned cranes, and other birds. In the southern parts we have sometimes
+ten or a dozen miles of rich plains, bordered by what seem high ranges of
+well-wooded hills, running nearly parallel with the lake. Northwards the
+mountains become loftier and present some magnificent views, range
+towering beyond range, until the dim, lofty outlines projected against
+the sky bound the prospect. Still further north the plain becomes more
+narrow, until, near where we turned, it disappears altogether, and the
+mountains rise abruptly out of the lake, forming the north-east boundary
+of what was described to us as an extensive table-land; well suited for
+pasturage and agriculture, and now only partially occupied by a tribe of
+Zulus, who came from the south some years ago. These people own large
+herds of cattle, and are constantly increasing in numbers by annexing
+other tribes.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X.
+
+
+The Lake tribes--The Mazitu--Quantities of elephants--Distressing
+journey--Detention on the Shire.
+
+Never before in Africa have we seen anything like the dense population on
+the shores of Lake Nyassa. In the southern part there was an almost
+unbroken chain of villages. On the beach of wellnigh of every little
+sandy bay, dark crowds were standing, gazing at the novel sight of a boat
+under sail; and wherever we landed we were surrounded in a few seconds by
+hundreds of men, women, and children, who hastened to have a stare at the
+"chirombo" (wild animals).
+
+During a portion of the year, the northern dwellers on the lake have a
+harvest which furnishes a singular sort of food. As we approached our
+limit in that direction, clouds, as of smoke rising from miles of burning
+grass, were observed bending in a south-easterly direction, and we
+thought that the unseen land on the opposite side was closing in, and
+that we were near the end of the lake. But next morning we sailed
+through one of the clouds on our own side, and discovered that it was
+neither smoke nor haze, but countless millions of minute midges called
+"kungo" (a cloud or fog). They filled the air to an immense height, and
+swarmed upon the water, too light to sink in it. Eyes and mouth had to
+be kept closed while passing through this living cloud: they struck upon
+the face like fine drifting snow. Thousands lay in the boat when she
+emerged from the cloud of midges. The people gather these minute insects
+by night, and boil them into thick cakes, to be used as a relish--millions
+of midges in a cake. A kungo cake, an inch thick, and as large as the
+blue bonnet of a Scotch ploughman, was offered to us; it was very dark in
+colour, and tasted not unlike caviare, or salted locusts.
+
+Abundance of excellent fish is found in the lake, and nearly all were new
+to us. The mpasa, or sanjika, found by Dr. Kirk to be a kind of carp,
+was running up the rivers to spawn, like our salmon at home: the largest
+we saw was over two feet in length; it is a splendid fish, and the best
+we have ever eaten in Africa. They were ascending the rivers in August
+and September, and furnished active and profitable employment to many
+fishermen, who did not mind their being out of season. Weirs were
+constructed full of sluices, in each of which was set a large
+basket-trap, through whose single tortuous opening the fish once in has
+but small chance of escape. A short distance below the weir, nets are
+stretched across from bank to bank, so that it seemed a marvel how the
+most sagacious sanjika could get up at all without being taken. Possibly
+a passage up the river is found at night; but this is not the country of
+Sundays or "close times" for either men or fish. The lake fish are
+caught chiefly in nets, although men, and even women with babies on their
+backs, are occasionally seen fishing from the rocks with hooks.
+
+A net with small meshes is used for catching the young fry of a silvery
+kind like pickerel, when they are about two inches long; thousands are
+often taken in a single haul. We had a present of a large bucketful one
+day for dinner: they tasted as if they had been cooked with a little
+quinine, probably from their gall-bladders being left in. In deep water,
+some sorts are taken by lowering fish-baskets attached by a long cord to
+a float, around which is often tied a mass of grass or weeds, as an
+alluring shade for the deep-sea fish. Fleets of fine canoes are engaged
+in the fisheries. The men have long paddles, and stand erect while using
+them. They sometimes venture out when a considerable sea is running. Our
+Makololo acknowledge that, in handling canoes, the Lake men beat them;
+they were unwilling to cross the Zambesi even, when the wind blew fresh.
+
+Though there are many crocodiles in the lake, and some of an
+extraordinary size, the fishermen say that it is a rare thing for any one
+to be carried off by these reptiles. When crocodiles can easily obtain
+abundance of fish--their natural food--they seldom attack men; but when
+unable to see to catch their prey, from the muddiness of the water in
+floods, they are very dangerous.
+
+Many men and boys are employed in gathering the buaze, in preparing the
+fibre, and in making it into long nets. The knot of the net is different
+from ours, for they invariably use what sailors call the reef knot, but
+they net with a needle like that we use. From the amount of native
+cotton cloth worn in many of the southern villages, it is evident that a
+great number of hands and heads must be employed in the cultivation of
+cotton, and in the various slow processes through which it has to pass,
+before the web is finished in the native loom. In addition to this
+branch of industry, an extensive manufacture of cloth, from the inner
+bark of an undescribed tree, of the botanical group, _Caesalpineae_, is
+ever going on, from one end of the lake to the other; and both toil and
+time are required to procure the bark, and to prepare it by pounding and
+steeping it to render it soft and pliable. The prodigious amount of the
+bark clothing worn indicates the destruction of an immense number of
+trees every year; yet the adjacent heights seem still well covered with
+timber.
+
+The Lake people are by no means handsome: the women are _very_ plain; and
+really make themselves hideous by the means they adopt to render
+themselves attractive. The _pelele_, or ornament for the upper lip, is
+universally worn by the ladies; the most valuable is of pure tin,
+hammered into the shape of a small dish; some are made of white quartz,
+and give the wearer the appearance of having an inch or more of one of
+Price's patent candles thrust through the lip, and projecting beyond the
+tip of the nose.
+
+In character, the Lake tribes are very much like other people; there are
+decent men among them, while a good many are no better than they should
+be. They are open-handed enough: if one of us, as was often the case,
+went to see a net drawn, a fish was always offered. Sailing one day past
+a number of men, who had just dragged their nets ashore, at one of the
+fine fisheries at Pamalombe, we were hailed and asked to stop, and
+received a liberal donation of beautiful fish. Arriving late one
+afternoon at a small village on the lake, a number of the inhabitants
+manned two canoes, took out their seine, dragged it, and made us a
+present of the entire haul. The northern chief, Marenga, a tall handsome
+man, with a fine aquiline nose, whom we found living in his stockade in a
+forest about twenty miles north of the mountain Kowirwe, behaved like a
+gentleman to us. His land extended from Dambo to the north of Makuza
+hill. He was specially generous, and gave us bountiful presents of food
+and beer. "Do they wear such things in your country?" he asked, pointing
+to his iron bracelet, which was studded with copper, and highly prized.
+The Doctor said he had never seen such in his country, whereupon Marenga
+instantly took it off, and presented it to him, and his wife also did the
+same with hers. On our return south from the mountains near the north
+end of the lake, we reached Marenga's on the 7th October. When he could
+not prevail upon us to forego the advantage of a fair wind for his
+invitation to "spend the whole day drinking his beer, which was," he
+said, "quite ready," he loaded us with provisions, all of which he sent
+for before we gave him any present. In allusion to the boat's sail, his
+people said that they had no Bazimo, or none worth having, seeing they
+had never invented the like for them. The chief, Mankambira, likewise
+treated us with kindness; but wherever the slave-trade is carried on, the
+people are dishonest and uncivil; that invariably leaves a blight and a
+curse in its path. The first question put to us at the lake crossing-
+places, was, "Have you come to buy slaves?" On hearing that we were
+English, and never purchased slaves, the questioners put on a
+supercilious air, and sometimes refused to sell us food. This want of
+respect to us may have been owing to the impressions conveyed to them by
+the Arabs, whose dhows have sometimes been taken by English cruisers when
+engaged in lawful trade. Much foreign cloth, beads, and brass-wire were
+worn by these ferrymen--and some had muskets.
+
+By Chitanda, near one of the slave crossing-places, we were robbed for
+the first time in Africa, and learned by experience that these people,
+like more civilized nations, have expert thieves among them. It might be
+only a coincidence; but we never suffered from impudence, loss of
+property, or were endangered, unless among people familiar with slaving.
+We had such a general sense of security, that never, save when we
+suspected treachery, did we set a watch at night. Our native companions
+had, on this occasion, been carousing on beer, and had removed to a
+distance of some thirty yards, that we might not overhear their free and
+easy after-dinner remarks, and two of us had a slight touch of fever;
+between three and four o'clock in the morning some thieves came, while we
+slept ingloriously--rifles and revolvers all ready,--and relieved us of
+most of our goods. The boat's sail, under which we slept, was open all
+around, so the feat was easy.
+
+Awaking as honest men do, at the usual hour, the loss of one was
+announced by "My bag is gone--with all my clothes; and my boots too!"
+"And mine!" responded a second. "And mine also!" chimed in the third,
+"with the bag of beads, and the rice!" "Is the cloth taken?" was the
+eager inquiry, as that would have been equivalent to all our money. It
+had been used for a pillow that night, and thus saved. The rogues left
+on the beach, close to our beds, the Aneroid Barometer and a pair of
+boots, thinking possibly that they might be of use to us, or, at least,
+that they could be of none to them. They shoved back some dried plants
+and fishes into one bag, but carried off many other specimens we had
+collected; some of our notes also, and nearly all our clothing.
+
+We could not suspect the people of the village near which we lay. We had
+probably been followed for days by the thieves watching for an
+opportunity. And our suspicions fell on some persons who had come from
+the East Coast; but having no evidence, and expecting to hear if our
+goods were exposed for sale in the vicinity, we made no fuss about it,
+and began to make new clothing. That our rifles and revolvers were left
+untouched was greatly to our advantage: yet we felt it was most
+humiliating for armed men to have been so thoroughly fleeced by a few
+black rascals.
+
+Some of the best fisheries appear to be private property. We found
+shelter from a storm one morning in a spacious lagoon, which communicated
+with the lake by a narrow passage. Across this strait stakes were driven
+in, leaving only spaces for the basket fish-traps. A score of men were
+busily engaged in taking out the fish. We tried to purchase some, but
+they refused to sell. The fish did not belong to them, they would send
+for the proprietor of the place. The proprietor arrived in a short time,
+and readily sold what we wanted.
+
+Some of the burying-grounds are very well arranged, and well cared for;
+this was noticed at Chitanda, and more particularly at a village on the
+southern shore of the fine harbour at Cape Maclear. Wide and neat paths
+were made in the burying-ground on its eastern and southern sides. A
+grand old fig-tree stood at the north-east corner, and its wide-spreading
+branches threw their kindly shade over the last resting-place of the
+dead. Several other magnificent trees grew around the hallowed spot.
+Mounds were raised as they are at home, but all lay north and south, the
+heads apparently north. The graves of the sexes were distinguished by
+the various implements which the buried dead had used in their different
+employments during life; but they were all broken, as if to be employed
+no more. A piece of fishing-net and a broken paddle told where a
+fisherman lay. The graves of the women had the wooden mortar, and the
+heavy pestle used in pounding the corn, and the basket in which the meal
+is sifted, while all had numerous broken calabashes and pots arranged
+around them. The idea that the future life is like the present does not
+appear to prevail; yet a banana-tree had been carefully planted at the
+head of several of the graves; the fruit might be considered an offering
+to those who still possess human tastes. The people of the neighbouring
+villages were friendly and obliging, and willingly brought us food for
+sale.
+
+Pursuing our exploration, we found that the northern part of the lake was
+the abode of lawlessness and bloodshed. The Mazite, or Mazitu, live on
+the highlands, and make sudden swoops on the villages of the plains. They
+are Zulus who came originally from the south, inland of Sofalla and
+Inhambane; and are of the same family as those who levy annual tribute
+from the Portuguese on the Zambesi. All the villages north of
+Mankambira's (lat. 11 degrees 44 minutes south) had been recently
+destroyed by these terrible marauders, but they were foiled in their
+attacks upon that chief and Marenga. The thickets and stockades round
+their villages enabled the bowmen to pick off the Mazitu in security,
+while they were afraid to venture near any place where they could not use
+their shields. Beyond Mankambira's we saw burned villages, and the
+putrid bodies of many who had fallen by Mazitu spears only a few days
+before. Our land party were afraid to go further. This reluctance to
+proceed without the presence of a white man was very natural, because
+bands of the enemy who had ravaged the country were supposed to be still
+roaming about; and if these marauders saw none but men of their own
+colour, our party might forthwith be attacked. Compliance with their
+request led to an event which might have been attended by very serious
+consequences. Dr. Livingstone got separated from the party in the boat
+for four days. Having taken the first morning's journey along with them,
+and directing the boat to call for him in a bay in sight, both parties
+proceeded north. In an hour Dr. Livingstone and his party struck inland,
+on approaching the foot of the mountains which rise abruptly from the
+lake. Supposing that they had heard of a path behind the high range
+which there forms the shore, those in the boat held on their course; but
+it soon began to blow so fresh that they had to run ashore for safety.
+While delayed a couple of hours, two men were sent up the hills to look
+for the land party, but they could see nothing of them, and the boat
+party sailed as soon as it was safe to put to sea, with the conviction
+that the missing ones would regain the lake in front.
+
+In a short time a small island or mass of rocks was passed, on which were
+a number of armed Mazitu with some young women, apparently their wives.
+The headman said that he had been wounded in the foot by Mankambira, and
+that they were staying there till he could walk to his chief, who lived
+over the hills. They had several large canoes, and it was evident that
+this was a nest of lake pirates, who sallied out by night to kill and
+plunder. They reported a path behind the hills, and, the crew being
+reassured, the boat sailed on. A few miles further, another and still
+larger band of pirates were fallen in with, and hundreds of crows and
+kites hovered over and round the rocks on which they lived. Dr. Kirk and
+Charles Livingstone, though ordered in a voice of authority to come
+ashore, kept on their course. A number of canoes then shot out from the
+rocks and chased them. One with nine strong paddlers persevered for some
+time after all the others gave up the chase. A good breeze, however,
+enabled the gig to get away from them with ease. After sailing twelve or
+fifteen miles, north of the point where Dr. Livingstone had left them, it
+was decided that he must be behind; but no sooner had the boat's head
+been turned south, than another gale compelled her to seek shelter in a
+bay. Here a number of wretched fugitives from the slave-trade on the
+opposite shore of the lake were found; the original inhabitants of the
+place had all been swept off the year before by the Mazitu. In the
+deserted gardens beautiful cotton was seen growing, much of it had the
+staple an inch and a half long, and of very fine quality. Some of the
+plants were uncommonly large, deserving to be ranked with trees.
+
+On their trying to purchase food, the natives had nothing to sell except
+a little dried cassava-root, and a few fish: and they demanded two yards
+of calico for the head only of a large fish. When the gale admitted of
+their return, their former pursuers tried to draw them ashore by
+asserting that they had quantities of ivory for sale. Owing to a
+succession of gales, it was the fourth day from parting that the boat was
+found by Dr. Livingstone, who was coming on in search of it with only two
+of his companions.
+
+After proceeding a short distance up the path in which they had been lost
+sight of, they learned that it would take several days to go round the
+mountains, and rejoin the lake; and they therefore turned down to the
+bay, expecting to find the boat, but only saw it disappearing away to the
+north. They pushed on as briskly as possible after it, but the mountain
+flank which forms the coast proved excessively tedious and fatiguing;
+travelling all day, the distance made, in a straight line, was under five
+miles. As soon as day dawned, the march was resumed; and, after hearing
+at the first inhabited rock that their companions had passed it the day
+before, a goat was slaughtered out of the four which they had with them,
+when suddenly, to the evident consternation of the men, seven Mazitu
+appeared armed with spears and shields, with their heads dressed
+fantastically with feathers. To hold a parley, Dr. Livingstone and
+Moloka, a Makololo man who spoke Zulu, went unarmed to meet them. On Dr.
+Livingstone approaching them, they ordered him to stop, and sit down in
+the sun, while they sat in the shade. "No, no!" was the reply, "if you
+sit in the shade, so will we." They then rattled their shields with
+their clubs, a proceeding which usually inspires terror; but Moloka
+remarked, "It is not the first time we have heard shields rattled." And
+all sat down together. They asked for a present, to show their chief
+that they had actually met strangers--something as evidence of having
+seen men who were not Arabs. And they were requested in turn to take
+these strangers to the boat, or to their chief. All the goods were in
+the boat, and to show that no present such as they wanted was in his
+pockets, Dr. Livingstone emptied them, turning out, among other things, a
+note-book: thinking it was a pistol they started up, and said, "Put that
+in again." The younger men then became boisterous, and demanded a goat.
+That could not be spared, as they were the sole provisions. When they
+insisted, they were asked how many of the party they had killed, that
+they thus began to divide the spoil; this evidently made them ashamed.
+The elders were more reasonable; they dreaded treachery, and were as much
+afraid of Dr. Livingstone and his party as his men were of them; for on
+leaving they sped away up the hills like frightened deer. One of them,
+and probably the leader, was married, as seen by portions of his hair
+sewn into a ring; all were observed by their teeth to be people of the
+country, who had been incorporated into the Zulu tribe.
+
+The way still led over a succession of steep ridges with ravines of from
+500 to 1000 feet in depth; some of the sides had to be scaled on hands
+and knees, and no sooner was the top reached than the descent began
+again. Each ravine had a running stream; and the whole country, though
+so very rugged, had all been cultivated, and densely peopled. Many
+banana-trees, uncared for patches of corn, and Congo-bean bushes attested
+former cultivation. The population had all been swept away; ruined
+villages, broken utensils, and human skeletons, met with at every turn,
+told a sad tale. So numerous were the slain, that it was thought the
+inhabitants had been slaughtered in consequence of having made raids on
+the Zulus for cattle.
+
+Continuing the journey that night as long as light served, they slept
+unconsciously on the edge of a deep precipice, without fire, lest the
+Mazitu should see it. Next morning most of the men were tired out, the
+dread of the apparition of the day before tending probably to increase
+the lameness of which they complained. When told, however, that all
+might return to Mankambira's save two, Moloka and Charlie, they would
+not, till assured that the act would not be considered one of cowardice.
+Giving them one of the goats as provision, another was slaughtered for
+the remainder of the party who, having found on the rocks a canoe which
+had belonged to one of the deserted villages, determined to put to sea
+again; but the craft was very small, and the remaining goat, spite of
+many a threat of having its throat cut, jumped and rolled about so, as
+nearly to capsize it; so Dr. Livingstone took to the shore again, and
+after another night spent without fire, except just for cooking, was
+delighted to see the boat coming back.
+
+We pulled that day to Mankambira's, a distance that on shore, with the
+most heartbreaking toil, had taken three days to travel. This was the
+last latitude taken, 11 degrees 44 minutes S. The boat had gone about 24
+minutes further to the north, the land party probably half that distance,
+but fever prevented the instruments being used. Dr. Kirk and Charles
+Livingstone were therefore furthest up the lake, and they saw about 20
+minutes beyond their turning-point, say into the tenth degree of south
+latitude. From the heights of at least a thousand feet, over which the
+land party toiled, the dark mountain masses on both sides of the lake
+were seen closing in. At this elevation the view extended at least as
+far as that from the boats, and it is believed the end of the lake lies
+on the southern borders of 10 degrees, or the northern limits of 11
+degrees south latitude.
+
+Elephants are numerous on the borders of the lake, and surprisingly tame,
+being often found close to the villages. Hippopotami swarm very much at
+their ease in the creeks and lagoons, and herds are sometimes seen in the
+lake itself. Their tameness arises from the fact that poisoned arrows
+have no effect on either elephant or hippopotamus. Five of each were
+shot for food during our journey. Two of the elephants were females, and
+had only a single tusk apiece, and were each killed by the first shot. It
+is always a case of famine or satiety when depending on the rifle for
+food--a glut of meat or none at all. Most frequently it is scanty fare,
+except when game is abundant, as it is far up the Zambesi. We had one
+morning two hippopotami and an elephant, perhaps in all some eight tons
+of meat, and two days after the last of a few sardines only for dinner.
+
+One morning when sailing past a pretty thickly-inhabited part, we were
+surprised at seeing nine large bull-elephants standing near the beach
+quietly flapping their gigantic ears. Glad of an opportunity of getting
+some fresh meat, we landed and fired into one. They all retreated into a
+marshy piece of ground between two villages. Our men gave chase, and
+fired into the herd. Standing on a sand hummock, we could see the
+bleeding animals throwing showers of water with their trunks over their
+backs. The herd was soon driven back upon us, and a wounded one turned
+to bay. Yet neither this one, nor any of the others, ever attempted to
+charge. Having broken his legs with a rifle-ball, we fired into him at
+forty yards as rapidly as we could load and discharge the rifles. He
+simply shook his head at each shot, and received at least sixty Enfield
+balls before he fell. Our excellent sailor from the north of Ireland
+happened to fire the last, and, as soon as he saw the animal fall, he
+turned with an air of triumph to the Doctor and exclaimed, "It was _my_
+shot that done it, sir!"
+
+In a few minutes upwards of a thousand natives were round the prostrate
+king of beasts; and, after our men had taken all they wanted, an
+invitation was given to the villagers to take the remainder. They rushed
+at it like hungry hyenas, and in an incredibly short time every inch of
+it was carried off. It was only by knowing that the meat would all be
+used that we felt justified in the slaughter of this noble creature. The
+tusks weighed 62 lbs. each. A large amount of ivory might be obtained
+from the people of Nyassa, and we were frequently told of their having it
+in their huts.
+
+While detained by a storm on the 17th October at the mouth of the Kaombe,
+we were visited by several men belonging to an Arab who had been for
+fourteen years in the interior at Katanga's, south of Cazembe's. They
+had just brought down ivory, malachite, copper rings, and slaves to
+exchange for cloth at the lake. The malachite was said to be dug out of
+a large vein on the side of a hill near Katanga's. They knew Lake
+Tanganyika well, but had not heard of the Zambesi. They spoke quite
+positively, saying that the water of Lake Tanganyika flowed out by the
+opposite end to that of Nyassa. As they had seen neither of the
+overflows, we took it simply as a piece of Arab geography. We passed
+their establishment of long sheds next day, and were satisfied that the
+Arabs must be driving a good trade.
+
+The Lake slave-trade was going on at a terrible rate. Two enterprising
+Arabs had built a dhow, and were running her, crowded with slaves,
+regularly across the Lake. We were told she sailed the day before we
+reached their head-quarters. This establishment is in the latitude of
+the Portuguese slave-exporting town of Iboe, and partly supplies that
+vile market; but the greater number of the slaves go to Kilwa. We did
+not see much evidence of a wish to barter. Some ivory was offered for
+sale; but the chief traffic was in human chattels. Would that we could
+give a comprehensive account of the horrors of the slave-trade, with an
+approximation to the number of lives it yearly destroys! for we feel sure
+that were even half the truth told and recognized, the feelings of men
+would be so thoroughly roused, that this devilish traffic in human flesh
+would be put down at all risks; but neither we, nor any one else, have
+the statistics necessary for a work of this kind. Let us state what we
+do know of one portion of Africa, and then every reader who believes our
+tale can apply the ratio of the known misery to find out the unknown. We
+were informed by Colonel Rigby, late H.M. Political Agent, and Consul at
+Zanzibar, that 19,000 slaves from this Nyassa country alone pass annually
+through the Custom-house of that island. This is exclusive of course of
+those sent to Portuguese slave-ports. Let it not be supposed for an
+instant that this number, 19,000, represents all the victims. Those
+taken out of the country are but a very small section of the sufferers.
+We never realized the atrocious nature of the traffic, until we saw it at
+the fountain-head. There truly "Satan has his seat." Besides those
+actually captured, thousands are killed and die of their wounds and
+famine, driven from their villages by the slave raid proper. Thousands
+perish in internecine war waged for slaves with their own clansmen and
+neighbours, slain by the lust of gain, which is stimulated, be it
+remembered always, by the slave purchasers of Cuba and elsewhere. The
+many skeletons we have seen, amongst rocks and woods, by the little
+pools, and along the paths of the wilderness, attest the awful sacrifice
+of human life, which must be attributed, directly or indirectly, to this
+trade of hell. We would ask our countrymen to believe us when we say, as
+we conscientiously can, that it is our deliberate opinion, from what we
+know and have seen, that not one-fifth of the victims of the slave-trade
+ever become slaves. Taking the Shire Valley as an average, we should say
+not even one-tenth arrive at their destination. As the system,
+therefore, involves such an awful waste of human life,--or shall we say
+of human labour?--and moreover tends directly to perpetuate the barbarism
+of those who remain in the country, the argument for the continuance of
+this wasteful course because, forsooth, a fraction of the enslaved may
+find good masters, seems of no great value. This reasoning, if not the
+result of ignorance, may be of maudlin philanthropy. A small armed
+steamer on Lake Nyassa could easily, by exercising a control, and
+furnishing goods in exchange for ivory and other products, break the neck
+of this infamous traffic in that quarter; for nearly all must cross the
+Lake or the Upper Shire.
+
+Our exploration of the Lake extended from the 2nd September to the 27th
+October, 1861; and, having expended or lost most of the goods we had
+brought, it was necessary to go back to the ship. When near the southern
+end, on our return, we were told that a very large slave-party had just
+crossed to the eastern side. We heard the fire of three guns in the
+evening, and judged by the report that they must be at least
+six-pounders. They were said to belong to an Ajawa chief named Mukata.
+
+In descending the Shire, we found concealed in the broad belt of papyrus
+round the lakelet Pamalombe, into which the river expands, a number of
+Manganja families who had been driven from their homes by the Ajawa
+raids. So thickly did the papyrus grow, that when beat down it supported
+their small temporary huts, though when they walked from one hut to
+another, it heaved and bent beneath their feet as thin ice does at home.
+
+A dense and impenetrable forest of the papyrus was left standing between
+them and the land, and no one passing by on the same side would ever have
+suspected that human beings lived there. They came to this spot from the
+south by means of their canoes, which enabled them to obtain a living
+from the fine fish which abound in the lakelet. They had a large
+quantity of excellent salt sewed up in bark, some of which we bought, our
+own having run out. We anchored for the night off their floating camp,
+and were visited by myriads of mosquitoes. Some of the natives show a
+love of country quite surprising. We saw fugitives on the mountains, in
+the north of the lake, who were persisting in clinging to the haunts of
+their boyhood and youth, in spite of starvation and the continual danger
+of being put to death by the Mazitu.
+
+A few miles below the lakelet is the last of the great slave-crossings.
+Since the Ajawa invasion the villages on the left bank had been
+abandoned, and the people, as we saw in our ascent, were living on the
+right or western bank.
+
+As we were resting for a few minutes opposite the valuable fishery at
+Movunguti, a young effeminate-looking man from some sea-coast tribe came
+in great state to have a look at us. He walked under a large umbrella,
+and was followed by five handsome damsels gaily dressed and adorned with
+a view to attract purchasers. One was carrying his pipe for smoking
+bang, here called "chamba;" another his bow and arrows; a third his
+battle-axe; a fourth one of his robes; while the last was ready to take
+his umbrella when he felt tired. This show of his merchandise was to
+excite the cupidity of any chief who had ivory, and may be called the
+lawful way of carrying on the slave-trade. What proportion it bears to
+the other ways in which we have seen this traffic pursued, we never found
+means of forming a judgment. He sat and looked at us for a few minutes,
+the young ladies kneeling behind him; and having satisfied himself that
+we were not likely to be customers, he departed.
+
+On our first trip we met, at the landing opposite this place, a middle-
+aged woman of considerable intelligence, and possessing more knowledge of
+the country than any of the men. Our first definite information about
+Lake Nyassa was obtained from her. Seeing us taking notes, she remarked
+that she had been to the sea, and had there seen white men writing. She
+had seen camels also, probably among the Arabs. She was the only
+Manganja woman we ever met who was ashamed of wearing the "pelele," or
+lip-ring. She retired to her hut, took it out, and kept her hand before
+her mouth to hide the hideous hole in the lip while conversing with us.
+All the villagers respected her, and even the headmen took a secondary
+place in her presence. On inquiring for her now, we found that she was
+dead. We never obtained sufficient materials to estimate the relative
+mortality of the highlands and lowlands; but, from many very old white-
+headed blacks having been seen on the highlands, we think it probable
+that even native races are longer lived the higher their dwelling-places
+are.
+
+We landed below at Mikena's and took observations for longitude, to
+verify those taken two years before. The village was deserted, Mikena
+and his people having fled to the other side of the river. A few had
+come across this morning to work in their old gardens. After completing
+the observations we had breakfast; and, as the last of the things were
+being carried into the boat, a Manganja man came running down to his
+canoe, crying out, "The Ajawa have just killed my comrade!" We shoved
+off, and in two minutes the advanced guard of a large marauding party
+were standing with their muskets on the spot where we had taken
+breakfast. They were evidently surprised at seeing us there, and halted;
+as did also the main body of perhaps a thousand men. "Kill them," cried
+the Manganja; "they are going up to the hills to kill the English,"
+meaning the missionaries we had left at Magomero. But having no prospect
+of friendly communication with them, nor confidence in Manganja's
+testimony, we proceeded down the river; leaving the Ajawa sitting under a
+large baobab, and the Manganja cursing them most energetically across the
+river.
+
+On our way up, we had seen that the people of Zimika had taken refuge on
+a long island in the Shire, where they had placed stores of grain to
+prevent it falling into the hands of the Ajawa; supposing afterwards that
+the invasion and war were past, they had removed back again to the
+mainland on the east, and were living in fancied security. On
+approaching the chief's village, which was built in the midst of a
+beautiful grove of lofty wild-fig and palm trees, sounds of revelry fell
+upon our ears. The people were having a merry time--drumming, dancing,
+and drinking beer--while a powerful enemy was close at hand, bringing
+death or slavery to every one in the village. One of our men called out
+to several who came to the bank to look at us, that the Ajawa were coming
+and were even now at Mikena's village; but they were dazed with drinking,
+and took no notice of the warning.
+
+Crowds of carriers offered their services after we left the river.
+Several sets of them placed so much confidence in us, as to decline
+receiving payment at the end of the first day; they wished to work
+another day, and so receive both days' wages in one piece. The young
+headman of a new village himself came on with his men. The march was a
+pretty long one, and one of the men proposed to lay the burdens down
+beside a hut a mile or more from the next village. The headman scolded
+the fellow for his meanness in wishing to get rid of our goods where we
+could not procure carriers, and made him carry them on. The village, at
+the foot of the cataracts, had increased very much in size and wealth
+since we passed it on our way up. A number of large new huts had been
+built; and the people had a good stock of cloth and beads. We could not
+account for this sudden prosperity, until we saw some fine large canoes,
+instead of the two old, leaky things which lay there before. This had
+become a crossing-place for the slaves that the Portuguese agents were
+carrying to Tette, because they were afraid to take them across nearer to
+where the ship lay, about seven miles off. Nothing was more
+disheartening than this conduct of the Manganja, in profiting by the
+entire breaking up of their nation.
+
+We reached the ship on the 8th of November, 1861, in a very weak
+condition, having suffered more from hunger than on any previous trip.
+Heavy rains commenced on the 9th, and continued several days; the river
+rose rapidly, and became highly discoloured. Bishop Mackenzie came down
+to the ship on the 14th, with some of the "Pioneer's" men, who had been
+at Magomero for the benefit of their health, and also for the purpose of
+assisting the Mission. The Bishop appeared to be in excellent spirits,
+and thought that the future promised fair for peace and usefulness. The
+Ajawa having been defeated and driven off while we were on the Lake, had
+sent word that they desired to live at peace with the English. Many of
+the Manganja had settled round Magomero, in order to be under the
+protection of the Bishop; and it was hoped that the slave-trade would
+soon cease in the highlands, and the people be left in the secure
+enjoyment of their industry. The Mission, it was also anticipated, might
+soon become, to a considerable degree, self-supporting, and raise certain
+kinds of food, like the Portuguese of Senna and Quillimane. Mr. Burrup,
+an energetic young man, had arrived at Chibisa's the day before the
+Bishop, having come up the Shire in a canoe. A surgeon and a lay brother
+followed behind in another canoe. The "Pioneer's" draught being too much
+for the upper part of the Shire, it was not deemed advisable to bring her
+up, on the next trip, further than the Ruo; the Bishop, therefore,
+resolved to explore the country from Magomero to the mouth of that river,
+and to meet the ship with his sisters and Mrs. Burrup, in January. This
+was arranged before parting, and then the good Bishop and Burrup, whom we
+were never to meet again, left us; they gave and received three hearty
+English cheers as they went to the shore, and we steamed off.
+
+The rains ceased on the 14th, and the waters of the Shire fell, even more
+rapidly than they had risen. A shoal, twenty miles below Chibisa's,
+checked our further progress, and we lay there five weary weeks, till the
+permanent rise of the river took place. During this detention, with a
+large marsh on each side, the first death occurred in the Expedition
+which had now been three-and-a-half years in the country. The
+carpenter's mate, a fine healthy young man, was seized with fever. The
+usual remedies had no effect; he died suddenly while we were at evening
+prayers, and was buried on shore. He came out in the "Pioneer," and,
+with the exception of a slight touch of fever at the mouth of the Rovuma,
+had enjoyed perfect health all the time he had been with us. The
+Portuguese are of opinion that the European who has immunity from this
+disease for any length of time after he enters the country is more likely
+to be cut off by it when it does come, than the man who has it frequently
+at first.
+
+The rains became pretty general towards the close of December, and the
+Shire was in flood in the beginning of January, 1862. At our wooding-
+place, a mile above the Ruo, the water was three feet higher than it was
+when we were here in June; and on the night of the 6th it rose eighteen
+inches more, and swept down an immense amount of brushwood and logs which
+swarmed with beetles and the two kinds of shells which are common all
+over the African continent. Natives in canoes were busy spearing fish in
+the meadows and creeks, and appeared to be taking them in great numbers.
+Spur-winged geese, and others of the knob-nosed species, took advantage
+of the low gardens being flooded, and came to pilfer the beans. As we
+passed the Ruo, on the 7th, and saw nothing of the Bishop, we concluded
+that he had heard from his surgeon of our detention, and had deferred his
+journey. He arrived there five days after, on the 12th.
+
+After paying our Senna men, as they wished to go home, we landed them
+here. All were keen traders, and had invested largely in native iron-
+hoes, axes, and ornaments. Many of the hoes and spears had been taken
+from the slaving parties whose captives we liberated; for on these
+occasions our Senna friends were always uncommonly zealous and active.
+The remainder had been purchased with the old clothes we had given them
+and their store of hippopotamus meat: they had no fear of losing them, or
+of being punished for aiding us. The system, in which they had been
+trained, had eradicated the idea of personal responsibility from their
+minds. The Portuguese slaveholders would blame the English alone, they
+said; they were our servants at the time. No white man on board could
+purchase so cheaply as these men could. Many a time had their eloquence
+persuaded a native trader to sell for a bit of dirty worn cloth things
+for which he had, but a little before, refused twice the amount of clean
+new calico. "Scissors" being troubled with a cough at night, received a
+present of a quilted coverlet, which had seen a good deal of service. A
+few days afterwards, a good chance of investing in hoes offering itself,
+he ripped off both sides, tore them into a dozen pieces, and purchased
+about a dozen hoes with them.
+
+We entered the Zambesi on the 11th of January, and steamed down towards
+the coast, taking the side on which we had come up; but the channel had
+changed to the other side during the summer, as it sometimes does, and we
+soon grounded. A Portuguese gentleman, formerly a lieutenant in the
+army, and now living on Sangwisa, one of the islands of the Zambesi, came
+over with his slaves, to aid us in getting the ship off. He said
+frankly, that his people were all great thieves, and we must be on our
+guard not to leave anything about. He next made a short speech to his
+men, told them he knew what thieves they were, but implored them not to
+steal from us, as we would give them a present of cloth when the work was
+done. "The natives of this country," he remarked to us, "think only of
+three things, what they shall eat and drink, how many wives they can
+have, and what they may steal from their master, if not how they may
+murder him." He always slept with a loaded musket by his side. This
+opinion may apply to slaves, but decidedly does not in our experience
+apply to freemen. We paid his men for helping us, and believe that even
+they, being paid, stole nothing from us. Our friend farms pretty
+extensively the large island called Sangwisa,--lent him for nothing by
+Senhor Ferrao,--and raises large quantities of mapira and beans, and also
+beautiful white rice, grown from seed brought a few years ago from South
+Carolina. He furnished us with some, which was very acceptable; for
+though not in absolute want, we were living on beans, salt pork, and
+fowls, all the biscuit and flour on board having been expended.
+
+We fully expected that the owners of the captives we had liberated would
+show their displeasure, at least by their tongues; but they seemed
+ashamed; only one ventured a remark, and he, in the course of common
+conversation, said, with a smile, "You took the Governor's slaves, didn't
+you?" "Yes, we did free several gangs that we met in the Manganja
+country." The Portuguese of Tette, from the Governor downwards, were
+extensively engaged in slaving. The trade is partly internal and partly
+external: they send some of the captives, and those bought, into the
+interior, up the Zambesi: some of these we actually met on their way up
+the river. The young women were sold there for ivory: an
+ordinary-looking one brought two arrobas, sixty-four pounds weight, and
+an extra beauty brought twice that amount. The men and boys were kept as
+carriers, to take the ivory down from the interior to Tette, or were
+retained on farms on the Zambesi, ready for export if a slaver should
+call: of this last mode of slaving we were witnesses also. The slaves
+were sent down the river chained, and in large canoes. This went on
+openly at Tette, and more especially so while the French "Free
+Emigration" system was in full operation. This double mode of disposing
+of the captives pays better than the single system of sending them down
+to the coast for exportation. One merchant at Tette, with whom we were
+well acquainted, sent into the interior three hundred Manganja women to
+be sold for ivory, and another sent a hundred and fifty.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI.
+
+
+Arrival of H.M.S. "Gorgon"--Dr. Livingstone's new steamer and Mrs.
+Livingstone--Death of Mrs. Livingstone--Voyage to Johanna and the
+Rovuma--An attack upon the "Pioneer's" boats.
+
+We anchored on the Great Luabo mouth of the Zambesi, because wood was
+much more easily obtained there than at the Kongone.
+
+On the 30th, H.M.S. "Gorgon" arrived, towing the brig which brought Mrs.
+Livingstone, some ladies about to join their relatives in the
+Universities' Mission, and the twenty-four sections of a new iron steamer
+intended for the navigation of Lake Nyassa. The "Pioneer" steamed out,
+and towed the brig into the Kongone harbour. The new steamer was called
+the "Lady of the Lake," or the "Lady Nyassa," and as much as could be
+carried of her in one trip was placed, by the help of the officers and
+men of the "Gorgon," on board the "Pioneer," and the two large paddle-box
+boats of H.M.'s ship. We steamed off for Ruo on the 10th of February,
+having on board Captain Wilson, with a number of his officers and men to
+help us to discharge the cargo. Our progress up was distressingly slow.
+The river was in flood, and we had a three-knot current against us in
+many places. These delays kept us six months in the delta, instead of,
+as we anticipated, only six days; for, finding it impossible to carry the
+sections up to the Ruo without great loss of time, it was thought best to
+land them at Shupanga, and, putting the hull of the "Lady Nyassa"
+together there, to tow her up to the foot of the Murchison Cataracts.
+
+A few days before the "Pioneer" reached Shupanga, Captain Wilson, seeing
+the hopeless state of affairs, generously resolved to hasten with the
+Mission ladies up to those who, we thought, were anxiously awaiting their
+arrival, and therefore started in his gig for the Ruo, taking Miss
+Mackenzie, Mrs. Burrup, and his surgeon, Dr. Ramsay. They were
+accompanied by Dr. Kirk and Mr. Sewell, paymaster of the "Gorgon," in the
+whale-boat of the "Lady Nyassa." As our slow-paced-launch, "Ma Robert,"
+had formerly gone up to the foot of the cataracts in nine days' steaming,
+it was supposed that the boats might easily reach the expected meeting-
+place at the Ruo in a week; but the Shire was now in flood, and in its
+most rapid state; and they were longer in getting up about half the
+distance, than it was hoped they would be in the whole navigable part of
+the river. They could hear nothing of the Bishop from the chief of the
+island, Malo, at the mouth of the Ruo. "No white man had ever come to
+his village," he said. They proceeded on to Chibisa's, suffering
+terribly from mosquitoes at night. Their toil in stemming the rapid
+current made them estimate the distance, by the windings, as nearer 300
+than 200 miles. The Makololo who had remained at Chibisa's told them the
+sad news of the death of the good Bishop and of Mr. Burrup. Other
+information received there awakened fresh anxiety on behalf of the
+survivors; so, leaving the ladies with Dr. Ramsay and the Makololo,
+Captain Wilson and Dr. Kirk went up the hills, in hopes of being able to
+render assistance, and on the way they met some of the Mission party at
+Soche's. The excessive fatigue that our friends had undergone in the
+voyage up to Chibisa's in no wise deterred them from this further attempt
+for the benefit of their countrymen, but the fresh labour, with
+diminished rations, was too much for their strength. They were reduced
+to a diet of native beans and an occasional fowl. Both became very ill
+of fever, Captain Wilson so dangerously that his fellow-sufferer lost all
+hopes of his recovery. His strong able-bodied cockswain did good service
+in cheerfully carrying his much-loved Commander, and they managed to
+return to the boat, and brought the two bereaved and sorrow-stricken
+ladies back to the "Pioneer."
+
+We learnt that the Bishop, wishing to find a shorter route down to the
+Shire, had sent two men to explore the country between Magomero and the
+junction of the Ruo; and in December Messrs. Proctor and Scudamore, with
+a number of Manganja carriers, left Magomero for the same purpose. They
+were to go close to Mount Choro, and then skirt the Elephant Marsh, with
+Mount Clarendon on their left. Their guides seem to have led them away
+to the east, instead of south; to the upper waters of the Ruo in the
+Shirwa valley, instead of to its mouth. Entering an Anguru slave-trading
+village, they soon began to suspect that the people meant mischief, and
+just before sunset a woman told some of their men that if they slept
+there they would all be killed. On their preparing to leave, the Anguru
+followed them and shot their arrows at the retreating party. Two of the
+carriers were captured, and all the goods were taken by these robbers. An
+arrow-head struck deep into the stock of Proctor's gun; and the two
+missionaries, barely escaping with their lives, swam a deep river at
+night, and returned to Magomero famished and exhausted.
+
+The wives of the captive carriers came to the Bishop day after day
+weeping and imploring him to rescue their husbands from slavery. The men
+had been caught while in his service, no one else could be entreated;
+there was no public law nor any power superior to his own, to which an
+appeal could be made; for in him Church and State were, in the
+disorganized state of the country, virtually united. It seemed to him to
+be clearly his duty to try and rescue these kidnapped members of the
+Mission family. He accordingly invited the veteran Makololo to go with
+him on this somewhat hazardous errand. Nothing could have been proposed
+to them which they would have liked better, and they went with alacrity
+to eat the sheep of the Anguru, only regretting that the enemy did not
+keep cattle as well. Had the matter been left entirely in their hands,
+they would have made a clean sweep of that part of the country; but the
+Bishop restrained them, and went in an open manner, thus commending the
+measure to all the natives, as one of justice. This deliberation,
+however, gave the delinquents a chance of escape.
+
+The missionaries were successful; the offending village was burned, and a
+few sheep and goats were secured which could not be considered other than
+a very mild punishment for the offence committed; the headman,
+Muana-somba, afraid to retain the prisoners any longer, forthwith
+liberated them, and they returned to their homes. This incident took
+place at the time we were at the Ruo and during the rains, and proved
+very trying to the health of the missionaries; they were frequently
+wetted, and had hardly any food but roasted maize. Mr. Scudamore was
+never well afterwards. Directly on their return to Magomero, the Bishop
+and Mr. Burrup, both suffering from diarrhoea in consequence of wet,
+hunger, and exposure, started for Chibisa's to go down to the Ruo by the
+Shire. So fully did the Bishop expect a renewal of the soaking wet from
+which he had just returned, that on leaving Magomero he walked through
+the stream. The rivulets were so swollen that it took five days to do a
+journey that would otherwise have occupied only two days and a half.
+
+None of the Manganja being willing to take them down the river during the
+flood, three Makololo canoe-men agreed to go with them. After paddling
+till near sunset, they decided to stop and sleep on shore; but the
+mosquitoes were so numerous that they insisted on going on again; the
+Bishop, being a week behind the time he had engaged to be at the Ruo,
+reluctantly consented, and in the darkness the canoe was upset in one of
+the strong eddies or whirlpools, which suddenly boil up in flood time
+near the outgoing branches of the river; clothing, medicines, tea,
+coffee, and sugar were all lost. Wet and weary, and tormented by
+mosquitoes, they lay in the canoe till morning dawned, and then proceeded
+to Malo, an island at the mouth of the Ruo, where the Bishop was at once
+seized with fever.
+
+Had they been in their usual health, they would doubtless have pushed on
+to Shupanga, or to the ship; but fever rapidly prostrates the energies,
+and induces a drowsy stupor, from which, if not roused by medicine, the
+patient gradually sinks into the sleep of death. Still mindful, however,
+of his office, the Bishop consoled himself by thinking that he might gain
+the friendship of the chief, which would be of essential service to him
+in his future labours. That heartless man, however, probably suspicious
+of all foreigners from the knowledge he had acquired of white
+slave-traders, wanted to turn the dying Bishop out of the hut, as he
+required it for his corn, but yielded to the expostulations of the
+Makololo. Day after day for three weeks did these faithful fellows
+remain beside his mat on the floor; till, without medicine or even proper
+food, he died. They dug his grave on the edge of the deep dark forest
+where the natives buried their dead. Mr. Burrup, himself far gone with
+dysentery, staggered from the hut, and, as in the dusk of evening they
+committed the Bishop's body to the grave, repeated from memory portions
+of our beautiful service for the Burial of the Dead--"earth to earth,
+ashes to ashes, dust to dust; in sure and certain hope of the
+resurrection of the dead through our Lord Jesus Christ." And in this sad
+way ended the earthly career of one, of whom it can safely be said that
+for unselfish goodness of heart, and earnest devotion to the noble work
+he had undertaken, none of the commendations of his friends can exceed
+the reality. The grave in which his body rests is about a hundred yards
+from the confluence of the Ruo, on the left bank of the Shire, and
+opposite the island of Malo. The Makololo then took Mr. Burrup up in the
+canoe as far as they could, and, making a litter of branches, carried him
+themselves, or got others to carry him, all the way back to his
+countrymen at Magomero. They hurried him on lest he should die in their
+hands, and blame be attached to them. Soon after his return he expired,
+from the disease which was on him when he started to meet his wife.
+
+Captain Wilson arrived at Shupanga on the 11th of March, having been
+three weeks on the Shire. On the 15th the "Pioneer" steamed down to the
+Kongone. The "Gorgon" had been driven out to sea in a gale, and had gone
+to Johanna for provisions, and it was the 2nd of April before she
+returned. It was fortunate for us that she had obtained a supply, as our
+provisions were exhausted, and we had to buy some from the master of the
+brig. The "Gorgon" left for the Cape on the 4th, taking all, except one,
+of the Mission party who had come in January. We take this opportunity
+of expressing our heartfelt gratitude to the gallant Captain I. C. Wilson
+and his officers for innumerable acts of kindness and hearty
+co-operation. Our warmest thanks are also due to Captain R. B. Oldfield
+and the other officers from the Admiral downwards, and we beg to assure
+them that nothing could be more encouraging to us in our difficulties and
+trials, than the knowledge that we possessed their friendship and
+sympathy in our labours.
+
+The Rev. James Stewart, of the Free Church of Scotland, arrived in the
+"Gorgon." He had wisely come out to inspect the country, before deciding
+on the formation of a Mission in the interior. To this object he devoted
+many months of earnest labour. This Mission was intended to embrace both
+the industrial and the religious element; and as the route by the Zambesi
+and Shire forms the only one at present known, with but a couple of days'
+land journey to the highlands, which stretch to an unknown distance into
+the continent, and as no jealousy was likely to be excited in the mind of
+a man of Bishop Mackenzie's enlarged views--there being moreover room for
+hundreds of Missions--we gladly extended the little aid in our power to
+an envoy from the energetic body above mentioned, but recommended him to
+examine the field with his own eyes.
+
+During our subsequent detention at Shupanga, he proceeded as far up the
+Shire as the Upper Cataracts, and saw the mere remnants of that dense
+population, which we at first had found living in peace and plenty, but
+which was now scattered and destroyed by famine and slave-hunting. The
+land, which both before and after we found so fair and fruitful, was
+burned up by a severe drought; in fact, it was at its very worst. With
+most praiseworthy energy, and in spite of occasional attacks of fever, he
+then ascended the Zambesi as far as Kebrabasa; and, what may be of
+interest to some, compared it, in parts, to the Danube. His estimate of
+the highlands would naturally be lower than ours. The main drawbacks in
+his opinion, however, were the slave-trade, and the power allowed the
+effete Portuguese of shutting up the country from all except a few
+convicts of their own nation. The time of his coming was inopportune;
+the disasters which, from inexperience, had befallen the Mission of the
+Universities, had a depressing effect on the minds of many at home, and
+rendered a new attempt unadvisable; though, had the Scotch perseverance
+and energy been introduced, it is highly probable that they would have
+reacted, most beneficially, on the zeal of our English brethren, and
+desertion would never have been heard of. After examining the country,
+Mr. Stewart descended the Zambesi in the beginning of the following year,
+and proceeded homewards with his report, by Mosambique and the Cape.
+
+On the 7th of April we had only one man fit for duty; all the rest were
+down with fever, or with the vile spirit secretly sold to them by the
+Portuguese officer of customs, in spite of our earnest request to him to
+refrain from the pernicious traffic.
+
+We started on the 11th for Shupanga with another load of the "Lady
+Nyassa." As we steamed up the delta, we observed many of the natives
+wearing strips of palm-leaf, the signs of sickness and mourning; for they
+too suffer from fever. This is the unhealthy season; the rains are over,
+and the hot sun draws up malaria from the decayed vegetation; disease
+seemed peculiarly severe this year. On our way up we met Mr. Waller, who
+had come from Magomero for provisions; the missionaries were suffering
+severely from want of food; the liberated people were starving, and dying
+of diarrhoea, and loathsome sores. The Ajawa, stimulated in their slave
+raids by supplies of ammunition and cloth from the Portuguese, had
+destroyed the large crops of the past year; a drought had followed, and
+little or no food could be bought. With his usual energy, Mr. Waller
+hired canoes, loaded them with stores, and took them up the long weary
+way to Chibisa's. Before he arrived he was informed that the Mission of
+the Universities, now deprived of its brave leader, had retired from the
+highlands down to the Low Shire Valley. This appeared to us, who knew
+the danger of leading a sedentary life, the greatest mistake they could
+have made, and was the result of no other counsel or responsibility than
+their own. Waller would have reascended at once to the higher altitude,
+but various objections stood in the way. The loss of poor Scudamore and
+Dickinson, in this low-lying situation, but added to the regret that the
+highlands had not received a fair trial.
+
+When the news of the Bishop's unfortunate collisions with the natives,
+and of his untimely end, reached England, much blame was imputed to him.
+The policy, which with the formal sanction of all his companions he had
+adopted, being directly contrary to the advice which Dr. Livingstone
+tendered, and to the assurances of the peaceable nature of the Mission
+which the Doctor had given to the natives, a friendly disapproval of a
+bishop's engaging in war was ventured on, when we met him at Chibisa's in
+November. But when we found his conduct regarded with so much bitterness
+in England, whether from a disposition to "stand by the down man," or
+from having an intimate knowledge of the peculiar circumstances of the
+country in which he was placed, or from the thorough confidence which
+intimacy caused us to repose in his genuine piety, and devout service of
+God, we came to think much more leniently of his proceedings, than his
+assailants did. He never seemed to doubt but that he had done his duty;
+and throughout he had always been supported by his associates.
+
+The question whether a Bishop, in the event of his flock being torn from
+his bosom, may make war to rescue them, requires serious consideration.
+It seems to narrow itself into whether a Christian man may lawfully use
+the civil power or the sword at all in defensive war, as police or
+otherwise. We would do almost anything to avoid a collision with
+degraded natives; but in case of an invasion--our blood boils at the very
+thought of our wives, daughters, or sisters being touched--we, as men
+with human feelings, would unhesitatingly fight to the death, with all
+the fury in our power.
+
+The good Bishop was as intensely averse to using arms, before he met the
+slave-hunters, as any man in England. In the course he pursued he may
+have made a mistake, but it is a mistake which very few Englishmen on
+meeting bands of helpless captives, or members of his family in bonds,
+would have failed to commit likewise.
+
+During unhealthy April, the fever was more severe in Shupanga and Mazaro
+than usual. We had several cases on board--they were quickly cured, but,
+from our being in the delta, as quickly returned. About the middle of
+the month Mrs. Livingstone was prostrated by this disease; and it was
+accompanied by obstinate vomiting. Nothing is yet known that can allay
+this distressing symptom, which of course renders medicine of no avail,
+as it is instantly rejected. She received whatever medical aid could be
+rendered from Dr. Kirk, but became unconscious, and her eyes were closed
+in the sleep of death as the sunset on the evening of the Christian
+Sabbath, the 27th April, 1862. A coffin was made during the night, a
+grave was dug next day under the branches of the great baobab-tree, and
+with sympathizing hearts the little band of his countrymen assisted the
+bereaved husband in burying his dead. At his request, the Rev. James
+Stewart read the burial-service; and the seamen kindly volunteered to
+mount guard for some nights at the spot where her body rests in hope.
+Those who are not aware how this brave, good, English wife made a
+delightful home at Kolobeng, a thousand miles inland from the Cape, and
+as the daughter of Moffat and a Christian lady exercised most beneficial
+influence over the rude tribes of the interior, may wonder that she
+should have braved the dangers and toils of this down-trodden land. She
+knew them all, and, in the disinterested and dutiful attempt to renew her
+labours, was called to her rest instead. "_Fiat, Domine, voluntas tua_!"
+
+On the 5th of May Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone started in the boat
+for Tette, in order to see the property of the Expedition brought down in
+canoes. They took four Mazaro canoe-men to manage the boat, and a white
+sailor to cook for them; but, unfortunately, he caught fever the very day
+after leaving the ship, and was ill most of the trip; so they had to cook
+for themselves, and to take care of him besides.
+
+We now proceeded with preparations for the launch of the "Lady Nyassa."
+Ground was levelled on the bank at Shupanga, for the purpose of arranging
+the compartments in order: she was placed on palm-trees which were
+brought from a place lower down the river for ways, and the engineer and
+his assistants were soon busily engaged; about a fortnight after they
+were all brought from Kongone, the sections were screwed together. The
+blacks are more addicted to stealing where slavery exists than elsewhere.
+We were annoyed by thieves who carried off the iron screw-bolts, but were
+gratified to find that strychnine saved us from the man-thief as well as
+the hyena-thief. A hyena was killed by it, and after the natives saw the
+dead animal and knew how we had destroyed it, they concluded that it was
+not safe to steal from men who possessed a medicine so powerful. The
+half-caste, who kept Shupanga-house, said he wished to have some to give
+to the Zulus, of whom he was mortally afraid, and to whom he had to pay
+an unwilling tribute.
+
+The "Pioneer" made several trips to the Kongone, and returned with the
+last load on the 12th of June. On the 23rd the "Lady Nyassa" was safely
+launched, the work of putting her together having been interrupted by
+fever and dysentery, and many other causes which it would only weary the
+reader to narrate in detail. Natives from all parts of the country came
+to see the launch, most of them quite certain that, being made of iron,
+she must go to the bottom as soon as she entered the water. Earnest
+discussions had taken place among them with regard to the propriety of
+using iron for ship-building. The majority affirmed that it would never
+answer. They said, "If we put a hoe into the water, or the smallest bit
+of iron, it sinks immediately. How then can such a mass of iron float?
+it must go to the bottom." The minority answered that this might be true
+with them, but white men had medicine for everything. "They could even
+make a woman, all except the speaking; look at that one on the figure-
+head of the vessel." The unbelievers were astonished, and could hardly
+believe their eyes, when they saw the ship float lightly and gracefully
+on the river, instead of going to the bottom, as they so confidently
+predicted. "Truly," they said, "these men have powerful medicine."
+
+Birds are numerous on the Shupanga estate. Some kinds remain all the
+year round, while many others are there only for a few months. Flocks of
+green pigeons come in April to feed on the young fruit of the wild fig-
+trees, which is also eaten by a large species of bat in the evenings. The
+pretty little black weaver, with yellow shoulders, appears to enjoy life
+intensely after assuming his wooing dress. A hearty breakfast is eaten
+in the mornings and then come the hours for making merry. A select party
+of three or four perch on the bushes which skirt a small grassy plain,
+and cheer themselves with the music of their own quiet and
+self-complacent song. A playful performance on the wind succeeds.
+Expanding his soft velvet-like plumage, one glides with quivering pinions
+to the centre of the open space, singing as he flies, then turns with a
+rapid whirring sound from his wings--somewhat like a child's rattle--and
+returns to his place again. One by one the others perform the same feat,
+and continue the sport for hours, striving which can produce the loudest
+brattle while turning. These games are only played during the season of
+courting and of the gay feathers; the merriment seems never to be thought
+of while the bird wears his winter suit of sober brown.
+
+We received two mules from the Cape to aid us in transporting the pieces
+of the "Lady Nyassa" past the cataracts and landed them at Shupanga, but
+they soon perished. A Portuguese gentleman kindly informed us, _after_
+both the mules were dead, that he knew they would die; for the land there
+had been often tried, and nothing would live on it--not even a pig. He
+said he had not told us so before, because he did not like to appear
+officious!
+
+By the time everything had been placed on board the "Lady Nyassa," the
+waters of the Zambesi and the Shire had fallen so low that it was useless
+to attempt taking her up to the cataracts before the rains in December.
+Draught oxen and provisions also were required, and could not be obtained
+nearer than the Island of Johanna. The Portuguese, without refusing
+positively to let trade enter the Zambesi, threw impediments in the way;
+they only wanted a small duty! They were about to establish a river
+police, and rearrange the Crown lands, which have long since become Zulu
+lands; meanwhile they were making the Zambesi, by slaving, of no value to
+any one.
+
+The Rovuma, which was reported to come from Lake Nyassa, being out of
+their claims and a free river, we determined to explore it in our boats
+immediately on our return from Johanna, for which place, after some delay
+at the Kongone, in repairing engines, paddle-wheel, and rudder, we sailed
+on the 6th of August. A store of naval provisions had been formed on a
+hulk in Pomone Bay of that island for the supply of the cruisers, and was
+in charge of Mr. Sunley, the Consul, from whom we always received the
+kindest attentions and assistance. He now obliged us by parting with six
+oxen, trained for his own use in sugar-making. Though sadly hampered in
+his undertaking by being obliged to employ slave labour, he has by
+indomitable energy overcome obstacles under which most persons would have
+sunk. He has done all that under the circumstances could be done to
+infuse a desire for freedom, by paying regular wages; and has established
+a large factory, and brought 300 acres of rich soil under cultivation
+with sugar-cane. We trust he will realize the fortune which he so well
+deserves to earn. Had Mr. Sunley performed the same experiment on the
+mainland, where people would have flocked to him for the wages he now
+gives, he would certainly have inaugurated a new era on the East Coast of
+Africa. On a small island where the slaveholders have complete power
+over the slaves, and where there is no free soil such as is everywhere
+met with in Africa, the experiment ought not to be repeated. Were Mr.
+Sunley commencing again, it should neither be in Zanzibar nor Johanna,
+but on African soil, where, if even a slave is ill-treated, he can easily
+by flight become free. On an island under native rule a joint
+manufacture by Arabs and Englishmen might only mean that the latter were
+to escape the odium of flogging the slaves.
+
+On leaving Johanna and our oxen for a time, H.M.S. "Orestes" towed us
+thence to the mouth of the Rovuma at the beginning of September. Captain
+Gardner, her commander, and several of his officers, accompanied us up
+the river for two days in the gig and cutter. The water was unusually
+low, and it was rather dull work for a few hours in the morning; but the
+scene became livelier and more animated when the breeze began to blow.
+Our four boats they swept on under full sail, the men on the look out in
+the gig and cutter calling, "Port, sir!" "Starboard, sir!" "As you go,
+sir!" while the black men in the bows of the others shouted the practical
+equivalents, "Pagombe! Pagombe!" "Enda quete!" "Berane! Berane!"
+Presently the leading-boat touches on a sandbank; down comes the
+fluttering sail; the men jump out to shove her off, and the other boats,
+shunning the obstruction, shoot on ahead to be brought up each in its
+turn by mistaking a sandbank for the channel, which had often but a very
+little depth of water.
+
+A drowsy herd of hippopotami were suddenly startled by a score of rifle-
+shots, and stared in amazement at the strange objects which had invaded
+their peaceful domains, until a few more bullets compelled them to seek
+refuge at the bottom of the deep pool, near which they had been quietly
+reposing. On our return, one of the herd retaliated. He followed the
+boat, came up under it, and twice tried to tear the bottom out of it; but
+fortunately it was too flat for his jaws to get a good grip, so he merely
+damaged one of the planks with his tusks, though he lifted the boat right
+up, with ten men and a ton of ebony in it.
+
+We slept, one of the two nights Captain Gardner was with us, opposite the
+lakelet Chidia, which is connected with the river in flood time, and is
+nearly surrounded by hills some 500 or 600 feet high, dotted over with
+trees. A few small groups of huts stood on the hill-sides, with gardens
+off which the usual native produce had been reaped. The people did not
+seem much alarmed by the presence of the large party which had drawn up
+on the sandbanks below their dwellings. There is abundance of large
+ebony in the neighbourhood. The pretty little antelope (_Cephalophus
+caeruleus_), about the size of a hare, seemed to abound, as many of their
+skins were offered for sale. Neat figured date-leaf mats of various
+colours are woven here, the different dyes being obtained from the barks
+of trees. Cattle could not live on the banks of the Rovuma on account of
+the tsetse, which are found from near the mouth, up as far as we could
+take the boats. The navigation did not improve as we ascended; snags,
+brought down by the floods, were common, and left in the channel on the
+sudden subsidence of the water. In many places, where the river divided
+into two or three channels, there was not water enough in any of them for
+a boat drawing three feet, so we had to drag ours over the shoals; but we
+saw the river at its very lowest, and it may be years before it is so
+dried up again.
+
+The valley of the Rovuma, bounded on each side by a range of highlands,
+is from two to four miles in width, and comes in a pretty straight course
+from the W.S.W.; but the channel of the river is winding, and now at its
+lowest zigzagged so perversely, that frequently the boats had to pass
+over three miles to make one in a straight line. With a full stream it
+must of course be much easier work. Few natives were seen during the
+first week. Their villages are concealed in the thick jungle on the hill-
+sides, for protection from marauding slave-parties. Not much of interest
+was observed on this part of the silent and shallow river. Though
+feeling convinced that it was unfit for navigation, except for eight
+months of the year, we pushed on, resolved to see if, further inland, the
+accounts we had received from different naval officers of its great
+capabilities would prove correct; or if, by communication with Lake
+Nyassa, even the upper part could be turned to account. Our exploration
+showed us that the greatest precaution is required in those who visit new
+countries.
+
+The reports we received from gentlemen, who had entered the river and
+were well qualified to judge, were that the Rovuma was infinitely
+superior to the Zambesi, in the absence of any bar at its mouth, in its
+greater volume of water, and in the beauty of the adjacent lands. We
+probably came at a different season from that in which they visited it,
+and our account ought to be taken with theirs to arrive at the truth. It
+might be available as a highway for commerce during three quarters of
+each year; but casual visitors, like ourselves and others, are all ill
+able to decide. The absence of animal life was remarkable. Occasionally
+we saw pairs of the stately jabirus, or adjutant-looking marabouts,
+wading among the shoals, and spur-winged geese, and other water-fowl, but
+there was scarcely a crocodile or a hippopotamus to be seen.
+
+At the end of the first week, an old man called at our camp, and said he
+would send a present from his village, which was up among the hills. He
+appeared next morning with a number of his people, bringing meal, cassava-
+root, and yams. The language differs considerably from that on the
+Zambesi, but it is of the same family. The people are Makonde, and are
+on friendly terms with the Mabiha, and the Makoa, who live south of the
+Rovuma. When taking a walk up the slopes of the north bank, we found a
+great variety of trees we had seen nowhere else. Those usually met with
+far inland seem here to approach the coast. African ebony, generally
+named _mpingu_, is abundant within eight miles of the sea; it attains a
+larger size, and has more of the interior black wood than usual. A good
+timber tree called _mosoko_ is also found; and we saw half-caste Arabs
+near the coast cutting up a large log of it into planks. Before reaching
+the top of the rise we were in a forest of bamboos. On the plateau
+above, large patches were cleared and cultivated. A man invited us to
+take a cup of beer; on our complying with his request, the fear
+previously shown by the bystanders vanished. Our Mazaro men could hardly
+understand what they said. Some of them waded in the river and caught a
+curious fish in holes in the claybank. Its ventral fin is peculiar,
+being unusually large, and of a circular shape, like boys' playthings
+called "suckers." We were told that this fish is found also in the
+Zambesi, and is called Chirire. Though all its fins are large, it is
+asserted that it rarely ventures out into the stream, but remains near
+its hole, where it is readily caught by the hand.
+
+The Zambesi men thoroughly understood the characteristic marks of deep or
+shallow water, and showed great skill in finding out the proper channel.
+The Molimo is the steersman at the helm, the Mokadamo is the head canoe-
+man, and he stands erect on the bows with a long pole in his hands, and
+directs the steersman where to go, aiding the rudder, if necessary, with
+his pole. The others preferred to stand and punt our boat, rather than
+row with our long oars, being able to shove her ahead faster than they
+could pull her. They are accustomed to short paddles. Our Mokadamo was
+affected with moon-blindness, and could not see at all at night. His
+comrades then led him about, and handed him his food. They thought that
+it was only because his eyes rested all night, that he could see the
+channel so well by day. At difficult places the Mokadamo sometimes,
+however, made mistakes, and ran us aground; and the others, evidently
+imbued with the spirit of resistance to constituted authority, and led by
+Joao an aspirant for the office, jeered him for his stupidity. "Was he
+asleep? Why did he allow the boat to come there? Could he not see the
+channel was somewhere else?" At last the Mokadamo threw down the pole in
+disgust, and told Joao he might be a Mokadamo himself. The office was
+accepted with alacrity; but in a few minutes he too ran us into a worse
+difficulty than his predecessor ever did, and was at once disrated amidst
+the derision of his comrades.
+
+On the 16th September, we arrived at the inhabited island of Kichokomane.
+The usual way of approaching an unknown people is to call out in a
+cheerful tone "Malonda!" Things for sale, or do you want to sell
+anything? If we can obtain a man from the last village, he is employed,
+though only useful in explaining to the next that we come in a friendly
+way. The people here were shy of us at first, and could not be induced
+to sell any food; until a woman, more adventurous than the rest, sold us
+a fowl. This opened the market, and crowds came with fowls and meal, far
+beyond our wants. The women are as ugly as those on Lake Nyassa, for who
+can be handsome wearing the pelele, or upper-lip ring, of large
+dimensions? We were once surprised to see young men wearing the pelele,
+and were told that in the tribe of the Mabiha, on the south bank, men as
+well as women wore them.
+
+Along the left bank, above Kichokomane, is an exceedingly fertile plain,
+nearly two miles broad, and studded with a number of deserted villages.
+The inhabitants were living in temporary huts on low naked sandbanks; and
+we found this to be the case as far as we went. They leave most of their
+property and food behind, because they are not afraid of these being
+stolen, but only fear being stolen themselves. The great slave-route
+from Nyassa to Kilwa passes to N.E. from S.W., just beyond them; and it
+is dangerous to remain in their villages at this time of year, when the
+kidnappers are abroad. In one of the temporary villages, we saw, in
+passing, two human heads lying on the ground. We slept a couple of miles
+above this village.
+
+Before sunrise next morning, a large party armed with bows and arrows and
+muskets came to the camp, two or three of them having a fowl each, which
+we refused to purchase, having bought enough the day before. They
+followed us all the morning, and after breakfast those on the left bank
+swam across and joined the main party on the other side. It was
+evidently their intention to attack us at a chosen spot, where we had to
+pass close to a high bank, but their plan was frustrated by a stiff
+breeze sweeping the boat past, before the majority could get to the
+place. They disappeared then, but came out again ahead of us, on a high
+wooded bank, walking rapidly to the bend, near which we were obliged to
+sail. An arrow was shot at the foremost boat; and seeing the force at
+the bend, we pushed out from the side, as far as the shoal water would
+permit, and tried to bring them to a parley, by declaring that we had not
+come to fight, but to see the river. "Why did you fire a gun, a little
+while ago?" they asked. "We shot a large puff-adder, to prevent it from
+killing men; you may see it lying dead on the beach." With great
+courage, our Mokadamo waded to within thirty yards of the bank, and spoke
+with much earnestness, assuring them that we were a peaceable party, and
+had not come for war, but to see the river. We were friends, and our
+countrymen bought cotton and ivory, and wished to come and trade with
+them. All we wanted was to go up quietly to look at the river, and then
+return to the sea. While he was talking with those on the shore, the old
+rogue, who appeared to be the ringleader, stole up the bank, and with a
+dozen others, waded across to the island, near which the boats lay, and
+came down behind us. Wild with excitement, they rushed into the water,
+and danced in our rear, with drawn bows, taking aim, and making various
+savage gesticulations. Their leader urged them to get behind some snags,
+and then shoot at us. The party on the bank in front had many
+muskets--and those of them, who had bows, held them with arrows ready set
+in the bowstrings. They had a mass of thick bush and trees behind them,
+into which they could in a moment dart, after discharging their muskets
+and arrows, and be completely hidden from our sight; a circumstance that
+always gives people who use bows and arrows the greatest confidence.
+Notwithstanding these demonstrations, we were exceedingly loath to come
+to blows. We spent a full half-hour exposed at any moment to be struck
+by a bullet or poisoned arrow. We explained that we were better armed
+than they were, and had plenty of ammunition, the suspected want of which
+often inspires them with courage, but that we did not wish to shed the
+blood of the children of the same Great Father with ourselves; that if we
+must fight, the guilt would be all theirs.
+
+This being a common mode of expostulation among themselves, we so far
+succeeded, that with great persuasion the leader and others laid down
+their arms, and waded over from the bank to the boats to talk the matter
+over. "This was their river; they did not allow white men to use it. We
+must pay toll for leave to pass." It was somewhat humiliating to do so,
+but it was pay or fight; and, rather than fight, we submitted to the
+humiliation of paying for their friendship, and gave them thirty yards of
+cloth. They pledged themselves to be our friends ever afterwards, and
+said they would have food cooked for us on our return. We then hoisted
+sail, and proceeded, glad that the affair had been amicably settled.
+Those on shore walked up to the bend above to look at the boat, as we
+supposed; but the moment she was abreast of them, they gave us a volley
+of musket-balls and poisoned arrows, without a word of warning.
+Fortunately we were so near, that all the arrows passed clear over us,
+but four musket-balls went through the sail just above our heads. All
+our assailants bolted into the bushes and long grass the instant after
+firing, save two, one of whom was about to discharge a musket and the
+other an arrow, when arrested by the fire of the second boat. Not one of
+them showed their faces again, till we were a thousand yards away. A few
+shots were then fired over their heads, to give them an idea of the range
+of our rifles, and they all fled into the woods. Those on the sandbank
+rushed off too, with the utmost speed; but as they had not shot at us, we
+did not molest them, and they went off safely with their cloth. They
+probably expected to kill one of our number, and in the confusion rob the
+boats. It is only where the people are slavers that the natives of this
+part of Africa are bloodthirsty.
+
+These people have a bad name in the country in front, even among their
+own tribe. A slave-trading Arab we met above, thinking we were then on
+our way down the river, advised us not to land at the villages, but to
+stay in the boats, as the inhabitants were treacherous, and attacked at
+once, without any warning or provocation. Our experience of their
+conduct fully confirmed the truth of what he said. There was no trade on
+the river where they lived, but beyond that part there was a brisk canoe-
+trade in rice and salt; those further in the interior cultivating rice,
+and sending it down the river to be exchanged for salt, which is
+extracted from the earth in certain places on the banks. Our assailants
+hardly anticipated resistance, and told a neighbouring chief that, if
+they had known who we were, they would not have attacked English, who can
+"bite hard." They offered no molestations on our way down, though we
+were an hour in passing their village. Our canoe-men plucked up courage
+on finding that we had come off unhurt. One of them, named Chiku,
+acknowledging that he had been terribly frightened, said. "His fear was
+not the kind which makes a man jump overboard and run away; but that
+which brings the heart up to the mouth, and renders the man powerless,
+and no more able to fight than a woman."
+
+In the country of Chonga Michi, about 80 or 90 miles up the river, we
+found decent people, though of the same tribe, who treated strangers with
+civility. A body of Makoa had come from their own country in the south,
+and settled here. The Makoa are known by a cicatrice in the forehead
+shaped like the new moon with the horns turned downwards. The tribe
+possesses all the country west of Mosambique; and they will not allow any
+of the Portuguese to pass into their country more than two hours'
+distance from the fort. A hill some ten or twelve miles distant, called
+Pau, has been visited during the present generation only by one
+Portuguese and one English officer, and this visit was accomplished only
+by the influence of the private friendship of a chief for this Portuguese
+gentleman. Our allies have occupied the Fort of Mosambique for three
+hundred years, but in this, as in all other cases, have no power further
+than they can see from a gun-carriage.
+
+The Makoa chief, Matingula, was hospitable and communicative, telling us
+all he knew of the river and country beyond. He had been once to Iboe
+and once at Mosambique with slaves. Our men understood his language
+easily. A useless musket he had bought at one of the above places was
+offered us for a little cloth. Having received a present of food from
+him, a railway rug was handed to him: he looked at it--had never seen
+cloth like that before--did not approve of it, and would rather have
+cotton cloth. "But this will keep you warm at night."--"Oh, I do not
+wish to be kept warm at night."--We gave him a bit of cotton cloth, not
+one-third the value of the rug, but it was more highly prized. His
+people refused to sell their fowls for our splendid prints and drab
+cloths. They had probably been taken in with gaudy-patterned sham prints
+before. They preferred a very cheap, plain, blue stuff of which they had
+experience. A great quantity of excellent honey is collected all along
+the river, by bark hives being placed for the bees on the high trees on
+both banks. Large pots of it, very good and clear, were offered in
+exchange for a very little cloth. No wax was brought for sale; there
+being no market for this commodity, it is probably thrown away as
+useless.
+
+At Michi we lose the tableland which, up to this point, bounds the view
+on both sides of the river, as it were, with ranges of flat-topped hills,
+600 or 800 feet high; and to this plateau a level fertile plain succeeds,
+on which stand detached granite hills. That portion of the tableland on
+the right bank seems to bend away to the south, still preserving the
+appearance of a hill range. The height opposite extends a few miles
+further west, and then branches off in a northerly direction. A few
+small pieces of coal were picked up on the sandbanks, showing that this
+useful mineral exists on the Rovuma, or on some of its tributaries: the
+natives know that it will burn. At the lakelet Chidia, we noticed the
+same sandstone rock, with fossil wood on it, which we have on the
+Zambesi, and knew to be a sure evidence of coal beneath. We mentioned
+this at the time to Captain Gardner, and our finding coal now seemed a
+verification of what we then said; the coal-field probably extends from
+the Zambesi to the Rovuma, if not beyond it. Some of the rocks lower
+down have the permanent water-line three feet above the present height of
+the water.
+
+A few miles west of the Makoa of Matingula, we came again among the
+Makonde, but now of good repute. War and slavery have driven them to
+seek refuge on the sand-banks. A venerable-looking old man hailed us as
+we passed, and asked us if we were going by without speaking. We landed,
+and he laid down his gun and came to us; he was accompanied by his
+brother, who shook hands with every one in the boat, as he had seen
+people do at Kilwa. "Then you have seen white men before?" we said.
+"Yes," replied the polite African, "but never people of your quality."
+These men were very black, and wore but little clothing. A young woman,
+dressed in the highest style of Makonde fashion, punting as dexterously
+as a man could, brought a canoe full of girls to see us. She wore an
+ornamental head-dress of red beads tied to her hair on one side of her
+head, a necklace of fine beads of various colours, two bright figured
+brass bracelets on her left arm, and scarcely a farthing's worth of
+cloth, though it was at its cheapest.
+
+As we pushed on westwards, we found that the river makes a little
+southing, and some reaches were deeper than any near the sea; but when we
+had ascended about 140 miles by the river's course from the sea, soft
+tufa rocks began to appear; ten miles beyond, the river became more
+narrow and rocky, and when, according to our measurement, we had ascended
+156 miles, our further progress was arrested. We were rather less than
+two degrees in a straight line from the Coast. The incidents worth
+noticing were but few: seven canoes with loads of salt and rice kept
+company with us for some days, and the further we went inland, the more
+civil the people became.
+
+When we came to a stand, just below the island of Nyamatolo, Long. 38
+degrees 36 minutes E., and Lat. 11 degrees 53 minutes, the river was
+narrow, and full of rocks. Near the island there is a rocky rapid with
+narrow passages fit only for native canoes; the fall is small, and the
+banks quite low; but these rocks were an effectual barrier to all further
+progress in boats. Previous reports represented the navigable part of
+this river as extending to the distance of a month's sail from its mouth;
+we found that, at the ordinary heights of the water, a boat might reach
+the obstructions which seem peculiar to all African rivers in six or
+eight days. The Rovuma is remarkable for the high lands that flank it
+for some eighty miles from the ocean. The cataracts of other rivers
+occur in mountains, those of the Rovuma are found in a level part, with
+hills only in the distance. Far away in the west and north we could see
+high blue heights, probably of igneous origin from their forms, rising
+out of a plain.
+
+The distance from Ngomano, a spot thirty miles further up, to the Arab
+crossing-places of Lake Nyassa Tsenga or Kotakota was said to be twelve
+days. The way we had discovered to Lake Nyassa by Murchison's Cataracts
+had so much less land carriage, that we considered it best to take our
+steamer thither, by the route in which we were well known, instead of
+working where we were strangers; and accordingly we made up our minds to
+return.
+
+The natives reported a worse place above our turning-point--the passage
+being still narrower than this. An Arab, they said, once built a boat
+above the rapids, and sent it down full of slaves; but it was broken to
+pieces in these upper narrows. Many still maintained that the Rovuma
+came from Nyassa, and that it is very narrow as it issues out of the
+lake. One man declared that he had seen it with his own eyes as it left
+the lake, and seemed displeased at being cross-questioned, as if we
+doubted his veracity.
+
+More satisfactory information, as it appeared to us, was obtained from
+others. Two days, or thirty miles, beyond where we turned back, the
+Rovuma is joined by the Liende, which, coming from the south-west, rises
+in the mountains on the east side of Nyassa. The great slave route to
+Kilwa runs up the banks of this river, which is only ankle-deep at the
+dry season of the year. The Rovuma itself comes from the W.N.W., and
+after the traveller passes the confluence of the Liende at Ngomano or
+"meeting-place," the chief of which part is named Ndonde, he finds the
+river narrow, and the people Ajawa.
+
+Crocodiles in the Rovuma have a sorry time of it. Never before were
+reptiles so persecuted and snubbed. They are hunted with spears, and
+spring traps are set for them. If one of them enters an inviting pool
+after fish, he soon finds a fence thrown round it, and a spring trap set
+in the only path out of the enclosure. Their flesh is eaten, and
+relished. The banks, on which the female lays her eggs by night, are
+carefully searched by day, and all the eggs dug out and devoured. The
+fish-hawk makes havoc among the few young ones that escape their other
+enemies. Our men were constantly on the look-out for crocodiles' nests.
+One was found containing thirty-five newly-laid eggs, and they declared
+that the crocodile would lay as many more the second night in another
+place. The eggs were a foot deep in the sand on the top of a bank ten
+feet high. The animal digs a hole with its foot, covers the eggs, and
+leaves them till the river rises over the nest in about three months
+afterwards, when she comes back, and assists the young ones out. We once
+saw opposite Tette young crocodiles in December, swimming beside an
+island in company with an old one. The yolk of the egg is nearly as
+white as the real white. In taste they resemble hen's eggs with perhaps
+a smack of custard, and would be as highly relished by whites as by
+blacks, were it not for their unsavoury origin in men-eaters.
+
+Hunting the Senze (_Aulacodus Swindernianus_), an animal the size of a
+large cat, but in shape more like a pig, was the chief business of men
+and boys as we passed the reedy banks and low islands. They set fire to
+a mass of reeds, and, armed with sticks, spears, bows and arrows, stand
+in groups guarding the outlets through which the seared Senze may run
+from the approaching flames. Dark dense volumes of impenetrable smoke
+now roll over on the lee side of the islet, and shroud the hunters. At
+times vast sheets of lurid flames bursting forth, roaring, crackling and
+exploding, leap wildly far above the tall reeds. Out rush the terrified
+animals, and amid the smoke are seen the excited hunters dancing about
+with frantic gesticulations, and hurling stick, spear, and arrow at their
+burned out victims. Kites hover over the smoke, ready to pounce on the
+mantis and locusts as they spring from the fire. Small crows and
+hundreds of swallows are on eager wing, darting into the smoke and out
+again, seizing fugitive flies. Scores of insects, in their haste to
+escape from the fire, jump into the river, and the active fish enjoy a
+rare feast.
+
+We returned to the "Pioneer" on the 9th of October, having been away one
+month. The ship's company had used distilled water, a condenser having
+been sent out from England; and there had not been a single case of
+sickness on board since we left, though there were so many cases of fever
+the few days she lay in the same spot last year. Our boat party drank
+the water of the river, and the three white sailors, who had never been
+in an African river before, had some slight attacks of fever.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII.
+
+
+Return to the Zambesi--Bishop Mackenzie's grave--Frightful scenes with
+crocodiles--Death of Mr. Thornton--African poisons--Recall of the
+Expedition.
+
+We put to sea on the 18th of October, and, again touching at Johanna,
+obtained a crew of Johanna men and some oxen, and sailed for the Zambesi;
+but our fuel failing before we reached it, and the wind being contrary,
+we ran into Quillimane for wood.
+
+Quillimane must have been built solely for the sake of carrying on the
+slave-trade, for no man in his senses would ever have dreamed of placing
+a village on such a low, muddy, fever-haunted, and mosquito-swarming
+site, had it not been for the facilities it afforded for slaving. The
+bar may at springs and floods be easily crossed by sailing-vessels, but,
+being far from the land, it is always dangerous for boats. Slaves, under
+the name of "free emigrants," have gone by thousands from Quillimane,
+during the last six years, to the ports a little to the south,
+particularly to Massangano. Some excellent brick-houses still stand in
+the place, and the owners are generous and hospitable: among them our
+good friend, Colonel Nunez. His disinterested kindness to us and to all
+our countrymen can never be forgotten. He is a noble example of what
+energy and uprightness may accomplish even here. He came out as a cabin-
+boy, and, without a single friend to help him, he has persevered in an
+honourable course until he is the richest man on the East Coast. When
+Dr. Livingstone came down the Zambesi in 1856, Colonel Nunez was the
+chief of the only four honourable, trustworthy men in the country. But
+while he has risen a whole herd has sunk, making loud lamentations,
+through puffs of cigar-smoke, over negro laziness; they might add, their
+own.
+
+All agricultural enterprise is virtually discouraged by Quillimane
+Government. A man must purchase a permit from the Governor, when he
+wishes to visit his country farm; and this tax, in a country where labour
+is unpopular, causes the farms to be almost entirely left in the hands of
+a head slave, who makes returns to his master as interest or honesty
+prompts him. A passport must also be bought whenever a man wishes to go
+up the river to Mazaro, Senna, or Tette, or even to reside for a month at
+Quillimane. With a soil and a climate well suited for the growth of the
+cane, abundance of slave labour, and water communication to any market in
+the world, they have never made their own sugar. All they use is
+imported from Bombay. "The people of Quillimane have no enterprise,"
+said a young European Portuguese, "they do nothing, and are always
+wasting their time in suffering, or in recovering from fever."
+
+We entered the Zambesi about the end of November and found it unusually
+low, so we did not get up to Shupanga till the 19th of December. The
+friends of our Mazaro men, who had now become good sailors and very
+attentive servants, turned out and gave them a hearty welcome back from
+the perils of the sea: they had begun to fear that they would never
+return. We hired them at a sixteen-yard piece of cloth a month--about
+ten shillings' worth, the Portuguese market-price of the cloth being then
+sevenpence halfpenny a yard,--and paid them five pieces each, for four-
+and-a-half months' work. A merchant at the same time paid other Mazaro
+men three pieces for seven months, and they were with him in the
+interior. If the merchants do not prosper, it is not because labour is
+dear, but because it is scarce, and because they are so eager on every
+occasion to sell the workmen out of the country. Our men had also
+received quantities of good clothes from the sailors of the "Pioneer" and
+of the "Orestes," and were now regarded by their neighbours and by
+themselves as men of importance. Never before had they possessed so much
+wealth: they believed that they might settle in life, being now of
+sufficient standing to warrant their entering the married state; and a
+wife and a hut were among their first investments. Sixteen yards were
+paid to the wife's parents, and a hut cost four yards. We should have
+liked to have kept them in the ship, for they were well-behaved and had
+learned a great deal of the work required. Though they would not
+themselves go again, they engaged others for us; and brought twice as
+many as we could take, of their brothers and cousins, who were eager to
+join the ship and go with us up the Shire, or anywhere else. They all
+agreed to take half-pay until they too had learned to work; and we found
+no scarcity of labour, though all that could be exported is now out of
+the country.
+
+There had been a drought of unusual severity during the past season in
+the country between Lupata and Kebrabasa, and it had extended north-east
+to the Manganja highlands. All the Tette slaves, except a very few
+household ones, had been driven away by hunger, and were now far off in
+the woods, and wherever wild fruit, or the prospect of obtaining anything
+whatever to keep the breath of life in them, was to be found. Their
+masters were said never to expect to see them again. There have been two
+years of great hunger at Tette since we have been in the country, and a
+famine like the present prevailed in 1854, when thousands died of
+starvation. If men like the Cape farmers owned this country, their
+energy and enterprise would soon render the crops independent of rain.
+There being plenty of slope or fall, the land could be easily irrigated
+from the Zambesi and its tributary streams. A Portuguese colony can
+never prosper: it is used as a penal settlement, and everything must be
+done military fashion. "What do I care for this country?" said the most
+enterprising of the Tette merchants, "all I want is to make money as soon
+possible, and then go to Bombay and enjoy it." All business at Tette was
+now suspended. Carriers could not be found to take the goods into the
+interior, and the merchants could barely obtain food for their own
+families. At Mazaro more rain had fallen, and a tolerable crop followed.
+The people of Shupanga were collecting and drying different wild fruits,
+nearly all of which are far from palatable to a European taste. The root
+of a small creeper called "bise" is dug up and eaten. In appearance it
+is not unlike the small white sweet potato, and has a little of the
+flavour of our potato. It would be very good, if it were only a little
+larger. From another tuber, called "ulanga," very good starch can be
+made. A few miles from Shupanga there is an abundance of large game, but
+the people here, though fond enough of meat, are not a hunting race, and
+seldom kill any.
+
+The Shire having risen, we steamed off on the 10th of January, 1863, with
+the "Lady Nyassa" in tow. It was not long before we came upon the
+ravages of the notorious Mariano. The survivors of a small hamlet, at
+the foot of Morambala, were in a state of starvation, having lost their
+food by one of his marauding parties. The women were in the fields
+collecting insects, roots, wild fruits, and whatever could be eaten, in
+order to drag on their lives, if possible, till the next crop should be
+ripe. Two canoes passed us, that had been robbed by Mariano's band of
+everything they had in them; the owners were gathering palm-nuts for
+their subsistence. They wore palm-leaf aprons, as the robbers had
+stripped them of their clothing and ornaments. Dead bodies floated past
+us daily, and in the mornings the paddles had to be cleared of corpses,
+caught by the floats during the night. For scores of miles the entire
+population of the valley was swept away by this scourge Mariano, who is
+again, as he was before, the great Portuguese slave-agent. It made the
+heart ache to see the widespread desolation; the river-banks, once so
+populous, all silent; the villages burned down, and an oppressive
+stillness reigning where formerly crowds of eager sellers appeared with
+the various products of their industry. Here and there might be seen on
+the bank a small dreary deserted shed, where had sat, day after day, a
+starving fisherman, until the rising waters drove the fish from their
+wonted haunts, and left him to die. Tingane had been defeated; his
+people had been killed, kidnapped, and forced to flee from their
+villages. There were a few wretched survivors in a village above the
+Ruo; but the majority of the population was dead. The sight and smell of
+dead bodies was everywhere. Many skeletons lay beside the path, where in
+their weakness they had fallen and expired. Ghastly living forms of boys
+and girls, with dull dead eyes, were crouching beside some of the huts. A
+few more miserable days of their terrible hunger, and they would be with
+the dead.
+
+Oppressed with the shocking scenes around, we visited the Bishop's grave;
+and though it matters little where a good Christian's ashes rest, yet it
+was with sadness that we thought over the hopes which had clustered
+around him, as he left the classic grounds of Cambridge, all now buried
+in this wild place. How it would have torn his kindly heart to witness
+the sights we now were forced to see!
+
+In giving vent to the natural feelings of regret, that a man so eminently
+endowed and learned, as was Bishop Mackenzie, should have been so soon
+cut off, some have expressed an opinion that it was wrong to use an
+instrument so valuable _merely_ to convert the heathen. If the attempt
+is to be made at all, it is "penny wise and pound foolish" to employ any
+but the very best men, and those who are specially educated for the work.
+An ordinary clergyman, however well suited for a parish, will not,
+without special training, make a Missionary; and as to their comparative
+usefulness, it is like that of the man who builds an hospital, as
+compared with that of the surgeon who in after years only administers for
+a time the remedies which the founder had provided in perpetuity. Had
+the Bishop succeeded in introducing Christianity, his converts might have
+been few, but they would have formed a continuous roll for all time to
+come.
+
+The Shire fell two feet, before we reached the shallow crossing where we
+had formerly such difficulty, and we had now two ships to take up. A
+hippopotamus was shot two miles above a bank on which the ship lay a
+fortnight: it floated in three hours. As the boat was towing it down,
+the crocodiles were attracted by the dead beast, and several shots had to
+be fired to keep them off. The bullet had not entered the brain of the
+animal, but driven a splinter of bone into it. A little moisture with
+some gas issued from the wound, and this was all that could tell the
+crocodiles down the stream of a dead hippopotamus; and yet they came up
+from miles below. Their sense of smell must be as acute as their
+hearing; both are quite extraordinary. Dozens fed on the meat we left.
+Our Krooman, Jumbo, used to assert that the crocodile never eats fresh
+meat, but always keeps it till it is high and tender--and the stronger it
+smells the better he likes it. There seems to be some truth in this.
+They can swallow but small pieces at a time, and find it difficult to
+tear fresh meat. In the act of swallowing, which is like that of a dog,
+the head is raised out of the water. We tried to catch some, and one was
+soon hooked; it required half-a-dozen hands to haul him up the river, and
+the shark-hook straightened, and he got away. A large iron hook was next
+made, but, as the creatures could not swallow it, their jaws soon pressed
+it straight--and our crocodile-fishing was a failure. As one might
+expect,--from the power even of a salmon--the tug of a crocodile was
+terribly strong.
+
+The corpse of a boy floated past the ship; a monstrous crocodile rushed
+at it with the speed of a greyhound, caught it and shook it, as a terrier
+dog does a rat. Others dashed at the prey, each with his powerful tail
+causing the water to churn and froth, as he furiously tore off a piece.
+In a few seconds it was all gone. The sight was frightful to behold. The
+Shire swarmed with crocodiles; we counted sixty-seven of these repulsive
+reptiles on a single bank, but they are not as fierce as they are in some
+rivers. "Crocodiles," says Captain Tuckey, "are so plentiful in the
+Congo, near the rapids, and so frequently carry off the women, who at
+daylight go down to the river for water, that, while they are filling
+their calabashes, one of the party is usually employed in throwing large
+stones into the water outside." Here, either a calabash on a long pole
+is used in drawing water, or a fence is planted. The natives eat the
+crocodile, but to us the idea of tasting the musky-scented, fishy-looking
+flesh carried the idea of cannibalism. Humboldt remarks, that in South
+America the alligators of some rivers are more dangerous than in others.
+Alligators differ from crocodiles in the fourth or canine tooth going
+into a hole or socket in the upper jaw, while in the crocodile it fits
+into a notch. The forefoot of the crocodile has five toes not webbed,
+the hindfoot has four toes which are webbed; in the alligator the web is
+altogether wanting. They are so much alike that they would no doubt
+breed together.
+
+One of the crocodiles which was shot had a piece snapped off the end of
+his tail, another had lost a forefoot in fighting; we saw actual leeches
+between the teeth, such as are mentioned by Herodotus, but we never
+witnessed the plover picking them out. Their greater fierceness in one
+part of the country than another is doubtless owing to a scarcity of
+fish; in fact, Captain Tuckey says, of that part of the Congo, mentioned
+above, "There are no fish here but catfish," and we found that the lake
+crocodiles, living in clear water, and with plenty of fish, scarcely ever
+attacked man. The Shire teems with fish of many different kinds. The
+only time, as already remarked, when its crocodiles are particularly to
+be dreaded, is when the river is in flood. Then the fish are driven from
+their usual haunts, and no game comes down to the river to drink, water
+being abundant in pools inland. Hunger now impels the crocodile to lie
+in wait for the women who come to draw water, and on the Zambesi numbers
+are carried off every year. The danger is not so great at other seasons;
+though it is never safe to bathe, or to stoop to drink, where one cannot
+see the bottom, especially in the evening. One of the Makololo ran down
+in the dusk of the river; and, as he was busy tossing the water to his
+mouth with his hand, in the manner peculiar to the natives, a crocodile
+rose suddenly from the bottom, and caught him by the hand. The limb of a
+tree was fortunately within reach, and he had presence of mind to lay
+hold of it. Both tugged and pulled; the crocodile for his dinner, and
+the man for dear life. For a time it appeared doubtful whether a dinner
+or a life was to be sacrificed; but the man held on, and the monster let
+the hand go, leaving the deep marks of his ugly teeth in it.
+
+During our detention, in expectation of the permanent rise of the river
+in March, Dr. Kirk and Mr. C. Livingstone collected numbers of the wading-
+birds of the marshes--and made pleasant additions to our salted
+provisions, in geese, ducks, and hippopotamus flesh. One of the comb or
+knob-nosed geese, on being strangled in order to have its skin preserved
+without injury, continued to breathe audibly by the broken humerus, or
+wing-bone, and other means had to be adopted to put it out of pain. This
+was as if a man on the gallows were to continue to breathe by a broken
+armbone, and afforded us an illustration of the fact, that in birds, the
+vital air penetrates every part of the interior of their bodies. The
+breath passes through and round about the lungs--bathes the surfaces of
+the viscera, and enters the cavities of the bones; it even penetrates
+into some spaces between the muscles of the neck--and thus not only is
+the most perfect oxygenation of the blood secured, but, the temperature
+of the blood being very high, the air in every part is rarefied, and the
+great lightness and vigour provided for, that the habits of birds
+require. Several birds were found by Dr. Kirk to have marrow in the
+tibiae, though these bones are generally described as hollow.
+
+During the period of our detention on the shallow part of the river in
+March, Mr. Thornton came up to us from Shupanga: he had, as before
+narrated, left the Expedition in 1859, and joined Baron van der Decken,
+in the journey to Kilimanjaro, when, by an ascent of the mountain to the
+height of 8000 feet, it was first proved to be covered with perpetual
+snow, and the previous information respecting it, given by the Church of
+England Missionaries, Krapf and Rebman, confirmed. It is now well known
+that the Baron subsequently ascended the Kilimanjaro to 14,000 feet, and
+ascertained its highest peak to be at least 20,000 feet above the sea.
+Mr. Thornton made the map of the first journey, at Shupanga, from
+materials collected when with the Baron; and when that work was
+accomplished, followed us. He was then directed to examine geologically
+the Cataract district, but not to expose himself to contact with the
+Ajawa until the feelings of that tribe should be ascertained.
+
+The members of Bishop Mackenzie's party, on the loss of their head, fell
+back from Magomero on the highlands, to Chibisa's, in the low-lying Shire
+Valley; and Thornton, finding them suffering from want of animal food,
+kindly volunteered to go across thence to Tette, and bring a supply of
+goats and sheep. We were not aware of this step, to which the generosity
+of his nature prompted him, till two days after he had started. In
+addition to securing supplies for the Universities' Mission, he brought
+some for the Expedition, and took bearings, by which he hoped to connect
+his former work at Tette with the mountains in the Shire district. The
+toil of this journey was too much for his strength, as with the addition
+of great scarcity of water, it had been for that of Dr. Kirk and Rae, and
+he returned in a sadly haggard and exhausted condition; diarrhoea
+supervened, and that ended in dysentery and fever, which terminated
+fatally on the 21st of April, 1863. He received the unremitting
+attentions of Dr. Kirk, and Dr. Meller, surgeon of the "Pioneer," during
+the fortnight of his illness; and as he had suffered very little from
+fever, or any other disease, in Africa, we had entertained strong hopes
+that his youth and unimpaired constitution would have carried him
+through. During the night of the 20th his mind wandered so much, that we
+could not ascertain his last wishes; and on the morning of the 21st, to
+our great sorrow, he died. He was buried on the 22nd, near a large tree
+on the right bank of the Shire, about five hundred yards from the lowest
+of the Murchison Cataracts--and close to a rivulet, at which the "Lady
+Nyassa" and "Pioneer" lay.
+
+No words can convey an adequate idea of the scene of widespread
+desolation which the once pleasant Shire Valley now presented. Instead
+of smiling villages and crowds of people coming with things for sale,
+scarcely a soul was to be seen; and, when by chance one lighted on a
+native, his frame bore the impress of hunger, and his countenance the
+look of a cringing broken-spiritedness. A drought had visited the land
+after the slave-hunting panic swept over it. Had it been possible to
+conceive the thorough depopulation which had ensued, we should have
+avoided coming up the river. Large masses of the people had fled down to
+the Shire, only anxious to get the river between them and their enemies.
+Most of the food had been left behind; and famine and starvation had cut
+off so many, that the remainder were too few to bury the dead. The
+corpses we saw floating down the river were only a remnant of those that
+had perished, whom their friends, from weakness, could not bury, nor over-
+gorged crocodiles devour. It is true that famine caused a great portion
+of this waste of human life: but the slave-trade must be deemed the chief
+agent in the ruin, because, as we were informed, in former droughts all
+the people flocked from the hills down to the marshes, which are capable
+of yielding crops of maize in less than three months, at any time of the
+year, and now they were afraid to do so. A few, encouraged by the
+Mission in the attempt to cultivate, had their little patches robbed as
+successive swarms of fugitives came from the hills. Who can blame these
+outcasts from house and home for stealing to save their wretched lives,
+or wonder that the owners protected the little all, on which their own
+lives depended, with club and spear? We were informed by Mr. Waller of
+the dreadful blight which had befallen the once smiling Shire Valley. His
+words, though strong, failed to impress us with the reality. In fact,
+they were received, as some may accept our own, as tinged with
+exaggeration; but when our eyes beheld the last mere driblets of this cup
+of woe, we for the first time felt that the enormous wrongs inflicted on
+our fellow-men by slaving are beyond exaggeration.
+
+Wherever we took a walk, human skeletons were seen in every direction,
+and it was painfully interesting to observe the different postures in
+which the poor wretches had breathed their last. A whole heap had been
+thrown down a slope behind a village, where the fugitives often crossed
+the river from the east; and in one hut of the same village no fewer than
+twenty drums had been collected, probably the ferryman's fees. Many had
+ended their misery under shady trees--others under projecting crags in
+the hills--while others lay in their huts, with closed doors, which when
+opened disclosed the mouldering corpse with the poor rags round the
+loins--the skull fallen off the pillow--the little skeleton of the child,
+that had perished first, rolled up in a mat between two large skeletons.
+The sight of this desert, but eighteen months ago a well peopled valley,
+now literally strewn with human bones, forced the conviction upon us,
+that the destruction of human life in the middle passage, however great,
+constitutes but a small portion of the waste, and made us feel that
+unless the slave-trade--that monster iniquity, which has so long brooded
+over Africa--is put down, lawful commerce cannot be established.
+
+We believed that, if it were possible to get a steamer upon the Lake, we
+could by her means put a check on the slavers from the East Coast; and
+aid more effectually still in the suppression of the slave-trade, by
+introducing, by way of the Rovuma, a lawful traffic in ivory. We
+therefore unscrewed the "Lady Nyassa" at a rivulet about five hundred
+yards below the first cataract, and began to make a road over the thirty-
+five or forty miles of land portage, by which to carry her up piecemeal.
+After mature consideration, we could not imagine a more noble work of
+benevolence, than thus to introduce light and liberty into a quarter of
+this fair earth, which human lust has converted into the nearest possible
+resemblance of what we conceive the infernal regions to be--and we
+sacrificed much of our private resources as an offering for the promotion
+of so good a cause.
+
+The chief part of the labour of road-making consisted in cutting down
+trees and removing stones. The country being covered with open forest, a
+small tree had to be cut about every fifty or sixty yards. The land near
+the river was so very much intersected by ravines, that search had to be
+made, a mile from its banks, for more level ground. Experienced
+Hottentot drivers would have taken Cape wagons without any other trouble
+than that of occasionally cutting down a tree. No tsetse infested this
+district, and the cattle brought from Johanna flourished on the abundant
+pasture. The first half-mile of road led up, by a gradual slope, to an
+altitude of two hundred feet above the ship, and a sensible difference of
+climate was felt even there. For the remainder of the distance the
+height increased,--till, at the uppermost cataract, we were more than
+1200 feet above the sea. The country here, having recovered from the
+effects of the drought, was bright with young green woodland, and
+mountains of the same refreshing hue. But the absence of the crowds,
+which had attended us as we carried up the boat, when the women followed
+us for miles with fine meal, vegetables, and fat fowls for sale, and the
+boys were ever ready for a little job--and the oppressive stillness bore
+heavily on our spirits. The Portuguese of Tette had very effectually
+removed our labourers. Not an ounce of fresh provisions could be
+obtained, except what could be shot, and even the food for our native
+crew had to be brought one hundred and fifty miles from the Zambesi.
+
+The diet of salt provisions and preserved meats without vegetables, with
+the depression of spirits caused by seeing how effectually a few wretched
+convicts, aided by the connivance of officials, of whom better might have
+been hoped, could counteract our best efforts, and turn intended good to
+certain evil, brought on attacks of dysentery, which went the round of
+the Expedition--and, Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone having suffered
+most severely, it was deemed advisable that they should go home. This
+measure was necessary, though much to the regret of all--for having done
+so much, they were naturally anxious to be present, when, by the
+establishing ourselves on the Lake, all our efforts should be crowned
+with success. After it had been decided that these two officers, and all
+the whites who could be spared, should be sent down to the sea for a
+passage to England, Dr. Livingstone was seized in May with a severe
+attack of dysentery, which continued for a month, and reduced him to a
+shadow. Dr. Kirk kindly remained in attendance till the worst was
+passed. The parting took place on the 19th of May.
+
+After a few miles of road were completed, and the oxen broken in, we
+resolved to try and render ourselves independent of the south for fresh
+provisions, by going in a boat up the Shire, above the Cataracts, to the
+tribes at the foot of Lake Nyassa, who were still untouched by the Ajawa
+invasion. In furtherance of this plan Dr. Livingstone and Mr. Rae
+determined to walk up to examine, and, if need be, mend the boat which
+had been left two seasons previously hung up to the limb of a large shady
+tree, before attempting to carry another past the Cataracts. The
+"Pioneer," which was to be left in charge of our active and most
+trustworthy gunner, Mr. Edward D. Young, R.N., was thoroughly roofed over
+with euphorbia branches and grass, so as completely to protect her decks
+from the sun: she also received daily a due amount of man-of-war
+scrubbing and washing; and, besides having everything put in shipshape
+fashion, was every evening swung out into the middle of the river, for
+the sake of the greater amount of air which circulated there. In
+addition to their daily routine work of the ship, the three stokers, one
+sailor, and one carpenter--now our complement--were encouraged to hunt
+for guinea-fowl, which in June, when the water inland is dried up, come
+in large flocks to the river's banks, and roost on the trees at night.
+Everything that can be done to keep mind and body employed tends to
+prevent fever.
+
+While we were employed in these operations, some of the poor starved
+people about had been in the habit of crossing the river, and reaping the
+self-sown mapira, in the old gardens of their countrymen. In the
+afternoon of the 9th, a canoe came floating down empty, and shortly after
+a woman was seen swimming near the other side, which was about two
+hundred yards distant from us. Our native crew manned the boat, and
+rescued her; when brought on board, she was found to have an arrow-head,
+eight or ten inches long, in her back, below the ribs, and slanting up
+through the diaphragm and left lung, towards the heart--she had been shot
+from behind when stooping. Air was coming out of the wound, and, there
+being but an inch of the barbed arrow-head visible, it was thought better
+not to run the risk of her dying under the operation necessary for its
+removal; so we carried her up to her own hut. One of her relatives was
+less scrupulous, for he cut out the arrow and part of the lung. Mr.
+Young sent her occasionally portions of native corn, and strange to say
+found that she not only became well, but stout. The constitution of
+these people seems to have a wonderful power of self-repair--and it could
+be no slight privation which had cut off the many thousands that we saw
+dead around us.
+
+We regretted that, in consequence of Dr. Meller having now sole medical
+charge, we could not have his company in our projected trip; but he found
+employment in botany and natural history, after the annual sickly season
+of March, April, and May was over; and his constant presence was not so
+much required at the ship. Later in the year, when he could be well
+spared, he went down the river to take up an appointment he had been
+offered in Madagascar; but unfortunately was so severely tried by illness
+while detained at the coast, that for nearly two years he was not able to
+turn his abilities as a naturalist to account by proceeding to that
+island. We have no doubt but he will yet distinguish himself in that
+untrodden field.
+
+On the 16th of June we started for the Upper Cataracts, with a mule-cart,
+our road lying a distance of a mile west from the river. We saw many of
+the deserted dwellings of the people who formerly came to us; and were
+very much struck by the extent of land under cultivation, though that,
+compared with the whole country, is very small. Large patches of mapira
+continued to grow,--as it is said it does from the roots for three years.
+The mapira was mixed with tall bushes of the Congo-bean, castor-oil
+plants, and cotton. The largest patch of this kind we paced, and found
+it to be six hundred and thirty paces on one side--the rest were from one
+acre to three, and many not more than one-third of an acre. The
+cotton--of very superior quality--was now dropping off the bushes, to be
+left to rot--there was no one to gather what would have been of so much
+value in Lancashire. The huts, in the different villages we entered,
+were standing quite perfect. The mortars for pounding corn--the stones
+for grinding it--the water and beer pots--the empty corn-safes and
+kitchen utensils, were all untouched; and most of the doors were shut, as
+if the starving owners had gone out to wander in search of roots or
+fruits in the forest, and had never returned. When opened, several huts
+revealed a ghastly sight of human skeletons. Some were seen in such
+unnatural positions, as to give the idea that they had expired in a
+faint, when trying to reach something to allay the gnawings of hunger.
+
+We took several of the men as far as the Mukuru-Madse for the sake of the
+change of air and for occupation, and also to secure for the ships a
+supply of buffalo meat--as those animals were reported to be in abundance
+on that stream. But though it was evident from the tracks that the
+report was true, it was impossible to get a glimpse of them. The grass
+being taller than we were, and pretty thickly planted, they always knew
+of our approach before we saw them. And the first intimation we had of
+their being near was the sound they made in rushing over the stones,
+breaking the branches, and knocking their horns against each other. Once,
+when seeking a ford for the cart, at sunrise, we saw a herd slowly
+wending up the hill-side from the water. Sending for a rifle, and
+stalking with intense eagerness for a fat beefsteak, instead of our usual
+fare of salted provisions, we got so near that we could hear the bulls
+uttering their hoarse deep low, but could see nothing except the mass of
+yellow grass in front; suddenly the buffalo-birds sounded their alarm-
+whistle, and away dashed the troop, and we got sight of neither birds nor
+beasts. This would be no country for a sportsman except when the grass
+is short. The animals are wary, from the dread they have of the poisoned
+arrows. Those of the natives who do hunt are deeply imbued with the
+hunting spirit, and follow the game with a stealthy perseverance and
+cunning, quite extraordinary. The arrow making no noise, the herd is
+followed up until the poison takes effect, and the wounded animal falls
+out. It is then patiently watched till it drops--a portion of meat round
+the wound is cut away, and all the rest eaten.
+
+Poisoned arrows are made in two pieces. An iron barb is firmly fastened
+to one end of a small wand of wood, ten inches or a foot long, the other
+end of which, fined down to a long point, is nicely fitted, though not
+otherwise secured, in the hollow of the reed, which forms the arrow
+shaft. The wood immediately below the iron head is smeared with the
+poison. When the arrow is shot into an animal, the reed either falls to
+the ground at once, or is very soon brushed off by the bushes; but the
+iron barb and poisoned upper part of the wood remain in the wound. If
+made in one piece, the arrow would often be torn out, head and all, by
+the long shaft catching in the underwood, or striking against trees. The
+poison used here, and called _kombi_, is obtained from a species of
+_strophanthus_, and is very virulent. Dr. Kirk found by an accidental
+experiment on himself that it acts by lowering the pulse. In using his
+tooth-brush, which had been in a pocket containing a little of the
+poison, he noticed a bitter taste, but attributed it to his having
+sometimes used, the handle in taking quinine. Though the quantity was
+small, it immediately showed its power by lowering his pulse which at the
+time had been raised by a cold, and next day he was perfectly restored.
+Not much can be inferred from a single case of this kind, but it is
+possible that the kombi may turn out a valuable remedy; and as Professor
+Sharpey has conducted a series of experiments with this substance, we
+look with interest for the results. An alkaloid has been obtained from
+it similar to strychnine. There is no doubt that all kinds of wild
+animals die from the effects of poisoned arrows, except the elephant and
+hippopotamus. The amount of poison that this little weapon can convey
+into their systems being too small to kill those huge beasts, the hunters
+resort to the beam trap instead.
+
+Another kind of poison was met with on Lake Nyassa, which was said to be
+used exclusively for killing men. It was put on small wooden
+arrow-heads, and carefully protected by a piece of maize-leaf tied round
+it. It caused numbness of the tongue when the smallest particle was
+tasted. The Bushmen of the northern part of the Kalahari were seen
+applying the entrails of a small caterpillar which they termed 'Nga to
+their arrows. This venom was declared to be so powerful in producing
+delirium, that a man in dying returned in imagination to a state of
+infancy, and would call for his mother's breast. Lions when shot with it
+are said to perish in agonies. The poisonous ingredient in this case may
+be derived from the plant on which the caterpillar feeds. It is
+difficult to conceive by what sort of experiments the properties of these
+poisons, known for generations, were proved. Probably the animal
+instincts, which have become so obtuse by civilization, that children in
+England eat the berries of the deadly nightshade (_Atropa belladonna_)
+without suspicion, were in the early uncivilized state much more keen. In
+some points instinct is still retained among savages. It is related that
+in the celebrated voyage of the French navigator, Bougainville, a young
+lady, who had assumed the male attire, performed all the hard duties
+incident to the calling of a common sailor; and, even as servant to the
+geologist, carried a bag of stones and specimens over hills and dales
+without a complaint, and without having her sex suspected by her
+associates; but on landing among the savages of one of the South Sea
+Islands, she was instantly recognized as a female. They began to show
+their impressions in a way that compelled her to confess her sex, and
+throw herself on the protection of the commander, which of course was
+granted. In like manner, the earlier portions of the human family may
+have had their instincts as to plants more highly developed than any of
+their descendants--if indeed much more knowledge than we usually suppose
+be not the effect of direct revelation from above.
+
+The Mukuru-Madse has a deep rocky bed. The water is generally about four
+feet deep, and fifteen or twenty yards broad. Before reaching it, we
+passed five or six gullies; but beyond it the country, for two or three
+miles from the river, was comparatively smooth. The long grass was
+overrunning all the native paths, and one species (_sanu_), which has a
+sharp barbed seed a quarter of an inch in length, enters every pore of
+woollen clothing and highly irritates the skin. From its hard, sharp
+point a series of minute barbs are laid back, and give the seed a hold
+wherever it enters: the slightest touch gives it an entering motion, and
+the little hooks prevent its working out. These seeds are so abundant in
+some spots, that the inside of the stocking becomes worse than the
+roughest hair shirt. It is, however, an excellent self-sower, and fine
+fodder; it rises to the height of common meadow-grass in England, and
+would be a capital plant for spreading over a new country not so
+abundantly supplied with grasses as this is.
+
+We have sometimes noticed two or three leaves together pierced through by
+these seeds, and thus made, as it were, into wings to carry them to any
+soil suited to their growth.
+
+We always follow the native paths, though they are generally not more
+than fifteen inches broad, and so often have deep little holes in them,
+made for the purpose of setting traps for small animals, and are so much
+obscured by the long grass, that one has to keep one's eyes on the ground
+more than is pleasant. In spite, however, of all drawbacks, it is vastly
+more easy to travel on these tracks than to go straight over uncultivated
+ground, or virgin forest. A path usually leads to some village, though
+sometimes it turns out to be a mere game track leading nowhere.
+
+In going north, we came into a part called Mpemba where Chibisa was owned
+as chief, but the people did not know that he had been assassinated by
+the Portuguese Terera. A great deal of grain was lying round the hut,
+where we spent the night. Very large numbers of turtledoves feasted
+undisturbed on the tall stalked mapira ears, and we easily secured plenty
+of fine fat guinea-fowls--now allowed to feed leisurely in the deserted
+gardens. The reason assigned for all this listless improvidence was
+"There are no women to grind the corn--all are dead."
+
+The cotton patches in all cases seemed to have been so well cared for,
+and kept so free of weeds formerly, that, though now untended, but few
+weeds had sprung up; and the bushes were thus preserved in the annual
+grass burnings. Many baobab-trees grow in different spots, and the few
+people seen were using the white pulp found between the seeds to make a
+pleasant subacid drink.
+
+On passing Malango, near the uppermost cataract, not a soul was to be
+seen; but, as we rested opposite a beautiful tree-covered island, the
+merry voices of children at play fell on our ears--the parents had fled
+thither for protection from the slave-hunting Ajawa, still urged on by
+the occasional visits of the Portuguese agents from Tette. The Ajawa,
+instead of passing below the Cataracts, now avoided us, and crossed over
+to the east side near to the tree on which we had hung the boat. Those
+of the Manganja, to whom we could make ourselves known, readily came to
+us; but the majority had lost all confidence in themselves, in each
+other, and in every one else. The boat had been burned about three
+months previously, and the Manganja were very anxious that we should
+believe that this had been the act of the Ajawa; but on scanning the spot
+we saw that it was more likely to have caught fire in the grass-burning
+of the country. Had we intended to be so long in returning to it, we
+should have hoisted it bottom upwards; for, as it was, it is probable
+that a quantity of dried leaves lay inside, and a spark ignited the
+whole. All the trees within fifty yards were scorched and killed, and
+the nails, iron, and copper sheathing, all lay undisturbed beneath. Had
+the Ajawa done the deed, they would have taken away the copper and iron.
+
+Our hopes of rendering ourselves independent of the south for provisions,
+by means of this boat, being thus disappointed, we turned back with the
+intention of carrying another up to the same spot; and, in order to find
+level ground for this, we passed across from the Shire at Malango to the
+upper part of the stream Lesungwe. A fine, active, intelligent fellow,
+called Pekila, guided us, and was remarkable as almost the only one of
+the population left with any spirit in him. The depressing effect which
+the slave-hunting scourge has upon the native mind, though little to be
+wondered at, is sad, very sad to witness. Musical instruments, mats,
+pillows, mortars for pounding meal, were lying about unused, and becoming
+the prey of the white ants. With all their little comforts destroyed,
+the survivors were thrown still further back into barbarism.
+
+It is of little importance perhaps to any but travellers to notice that
+in occupying one night a well-built hut, which had been shut up for some
+time, the air inside at once gave us a chill, and an attack of fever;
+both of which vanished when the place was well-ventilated by means of a
+fire. We have frequently observed that lighting a fire early in the
+mornings, even in the hottest time of the year, gives freshness to the
+whole house, and removes that feeling of closeness and langour, which a
+hot climate induces.
+
+On the night of the 1st July, 1863, several loud peals of thunder awoke
+us; the moon was shining brightly, and not a cloud to be seen. All the
+natives remarked on the clearness of the sky at the time, and next
+morning said, "We thought it was God" (Morungo).
+
+On arriving at the ship on the 2nd July, we found a despatch from Earl
+Russell, containing instructions for the withdrawal of the Expedition.
+The devastation caused by slave-hunting and famine lay all around. The
+labour had been as completely swept away from the Great Shire Valley, as
+it had been from the Zambesi, wherever Portuguese intrigue or power
+extended. The continual forays of Mariano had spread ruin and desolation
+on our south-east as far as Mount Clarendon.
+
+While this was going on in our rear, the Tette slave-hunters from the
+West had stimulated the Ajawa to sweep all the Manganja off the hills on
+our East; and slaving parties for this purpose were still passing the
+Shire above the Cataracts. In addition to the confession of the Governor
+of Tette, of an intention to go on with this slaving in accordance with
+the counsel of his elder brother at Mosambique, we had reason to believe
+that slavery went on under the eye of his Excellency, the
+Governor-General himself; and this was subsequently corroborated by our
+recognizing two women at Mosambique who had lived within a hundred yards
+of the Mission-station at Magomero. They were well known to our
+attendants, and had formed a part of a gang of several hundreds taken to
+Mosambique by the Ajawa at the very time when his Excellency was
+entertaining English officers with anti-slavery palavers. To any one who
+understands how minute the information is, which Portuguese governors
+possess by means of their own slaves, and through gossiping traders who
+seek to curry their favour, it is idle to assert that all this slaving
+goes on without their approval and connivance.
+
+If more had been wanted to prove the hopelessness of producing any change
+in the system which has prevailed ever since our allies, the Portuguese,
+entered the country, we had it in the impunity with which the freebooter,
+Terera, who had murdered Chibisa, was allowed to carry on his forays.
+Belchoir, another marauder, had been checked, but was still allowed to
+make war, as they term slave-hunting.
+
+Mr. Horace Waller was living for some five months on Mount Morambala, a
+position from which the whole process of the slave-trade, and
+depopulation of the country around could be well noted. The mountain
+overlooks the Shire, the beautiful meanderings of which are distinctly
+seen, on clear days, for thirty miles. This river was for some time
+supposed to be closed against Mariano, who, as a mere matter of form, was
+declared a rebel against the Portuguese flag. When, however, it became
+no longer possible to keep up the sham, the river was thrown open to him;
+and Mr. Waller has seen in a single day from fifteen to twenty canoes of
+different sizes going down, laden with slaves, to the Portuguese
+settlements from the so-called rebel camp. These cargoes were composed
+entirely of women and children. For three months this traffic was
+incessant, and at last, so completely was the mask thrown off, that one
+of the officials came to pay a visit to Bishop Tozer on another part of
+the same mountain, and, combining business with pleasure, collected
+payment for some canoe work done for the Missionary party, and with this
+purchased slaves from the rebels, who had only to be hailed from the bank
+of the river. When he had concluded the bargain he trotted the slaves
+out for inspection in Mr. Waller's presence. This official, Senhor
+Mesquita, was the only officer who could be forced to live at the
+Kongone. From certain circumstances in his life, he had fallen under the
+power of the local Government; all the other Custom-house officers
+refused to go to Kongone, so here poor Mesquita must live on a miserable
+pittance--must live, and perhaps slave, sorely against his will. His
+name is not brought forward with a view of throwing any odium on his
+character. The disinterested kindness which he showed to Dr. Meller, and
+others, forbids that he should be mentioned by us with anything like
+unkindness.
+
+Under all these considerations, with the fact that we had not found the
+Rovuma so favourable for navigation at the time of our visit as we
+expected, it was impossible not to coincide in the wisdom of our
+withdrawal; but we deeply regretted that we had ever given credit to the
+Portuguese Government for any desire to ameliorate the condition of the
+African race; for, with half the labour and expense anywhere else, we
+should have made an indelible mark of improvement on a section of the
+Continent. Viewing Portuguese statesmen in the light of the laws they
+have passed for the suppression of slavery and the slave-trade, and by
+the standard of the high character of our own public men, it cannot be
+considered weakness to have believed in the sincerity of the anxiety to
+aid our enterprise, professed by the Lisbon Ministry. We hoped to
+benefit both Portuguese and Africans by introducing free-trade and
+Christianity. Our allies, unfortunately, cannot see the slightest
+benefit in any measure that does not imply raising themselves up by
+thrusting others down. The official paper of the Lisbon Government has
+since let us know "that their policy was directed to frustrating the
+grasping designs of the British Government to the dominion of Eastern
+Africa." We, who were on the spot, and behind the scenes, knew that
+feelings of private benevolence had the chief share in the operations
+undertaken for introducing the reign of peace and good will on the Lakes
+and central regions, which for ages have been the abodes of violence and
+bloodshed. But that great change was not to be accomplished. The narrow-
+minded would ascribe all that was attempted to the grasping propensity of
+the English. But the motives that actuate many in England, both in
+public and private life, are much more noble than the world gives them
+credit for.
+
+Seeing, then, that we were not yet arrived at "the good time coming," and
+that it was quite impossible to take the "Pioneer" down to the sea till
+the floods of December, we made arrangements to screw the "Lady Nyassa"
+together; and, in order to improve the time intervening, we resolved to
+carry a boat past the Cataracts a second time, sail along the eastern
+shore of the Lake, and round the northern end, and also collect data by
+which to verify the information collected by Colonel Rigby, that the
+19,000 slaves, who go through the Custom-house of Zanzibar annually, are
+chiefly drawn from Lake Nyassa and the Valley of the Shire.
+
+Our party consisted of twenty natives, some of whom were Johanna men, and
+were supposed to be capable of managing the six oxen which drew the small
+wagon with a boat on it. A team of twelve Cape oxen, with a Hottentot
+driver and leader, would have taken the wagon over the country we had to
+pass through with the greatest ease; but no sooner did we get beyond the
+part of the road already made, than our drivers encountered obstructions
+in the way of trees and gullies, which it would have been a waste of time
+to have overcome by felling timber and hauling out the wagon by block and
+tackle purchases. The Ajawa and Manganja settled at Chibisa's were
+therefore sent for, and they took the boat on their shoulders and carried
+it briskly, in a few days, past all the Cataracts except one; then coming
+to a comparatively still reach of the river, they took advantage of it to
+haul her up a couple of miles. The Makololo had her then entirely in
+charge; for, being accustomed to rapids in their own country, no better
+boatmen could be desired. The river here is very narrow, and even in
+what are called still places, the current is very strong, and often
+obliged them to haul the boat along by the reeds on the banks, or to hand
+a tow-rope ashore. The reeds are full of cowitch (_Dolichos pruriens_),
+the pods of which are covered with what looks a fine velvety down, but is
+in reality a multitude of fine prickles, which go in by the million, and
+caused an itching and stinging in the naked bodies of those who were
+pulling the tow-rope, that made them wriggle as if stung by a whole bed
+of nettles. Those on board required to be men of ready resource with
+oars and punting-poles, and such they were. But, nevertheless, they
+found, after attempting to pass by a rock, round which the water rushed
+in whirls, that the wiser plan would be to take the boat ashore, and
+carry her past the last Cataract. When this was reported, the carriers
+were called from the various shady trees under which they had taken
+refuge from the sun. This was midwinter, but the sun is always hot by
+day here, though the nights are cold. Five Zambesi men, who had been all
+their lives accustomed to great heavy canoes,--the chief recommendation
+of which is said to be, that they can be run against a rock with the full
+force of the current without injury--were very desirous to show how much
+better they could manage our boat than the Makololo; three jumped into
+her when our backs were turned, and two hauled her up a little way; the
+tide caught her bow, we heard a shout of distress, the rope was out of
+their hands in a moment, and there she was, bottom upwards; a turn or two
+in an eddy, and away she went, like an arrow, down the Cataracts. One of
+the men in swimming ashore saved a rifle. The whole party ran with all
+their might along the bank, but never more did we see our boat.
+
+The five performers in this catastrophe approached with penitential
+looks. They had nothing to say, nor had we. They bent down slowly, and
+touched our feet with both hands. "Ku kuata moendo"--"to catch the
+foot"--is their way of asking forgiveness. It was so like what we have
+seen a little child do--try to bring a dish unbidden to its papa, and
+letting it fall, burst into a cry of distress--that they were only
+sentenced to go back to the ship, get provisions, and, in the ensuing
+journey on foot, carry as much as they could, and thus make up for the
+loss of the boat.
+
+It was excessively annoying to lose all this property, and be deprived of
+the means of doing the work proposed, on the east and north of the Lake;
+but it would have been like crying over spilt milk to do otherwise now
+than make the best use we could of our legs. The men were sent back to
+the ship for provisions, cloth, and beads; and while they are gone, we
+may say a little of the Cataracts which proved so fatal to our boating
+plan.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII.
+
+
+Dr. Livingstone's further explorations--Effects of slave-trade--Kirk's
+range--Ajawa migration--Native fishermen--Arab slave-crossing--Splendid
+highlands.
+
+The Murchison Cataracts of the Shire river begin in 15 degrees 20 minutes
+S., and end in lat. 15 degrees 55 minutes S., the difference of latitude
+is therefore 35 minutes. The river runs in this space nearly north and
+south, till we pass Malango; so the entire distance is under 40 miles.
+The principal Cataracts are five in number, and are called Pamofunda or
+Pamozima, Morewa, Panoreba or Tedzane, Pampatamanga, and Papekira.
+Besides these, three or four smaller ones might be mentioned; as, for
+instance, Mamvira, where in our ascent we first met the broken water, and
+heard that gushing sound which, from the interminable windings of some
+200 miles of river below, we had come to believe the tranquil Shire could
+never make. While these lesser cataracts descend at an angle of scarcely
+20 degrees, the greater fall 100 feet in 100 yards, at an angle of about
+45 degrees, and one at an angle of 70 degrees. One part of Pamozima is
+perpendicular, and, when the river is in flood, causes a cloud of vapour
+to ascend, which, in our journey to Lake Shirwa, we saw at a distance of
+at least eight miles. The entire descent from the Upper to the Lower
+Shire is 1200 feet. Only on one spot in all that distance is the current
+moderate--namely, above Tedzane. The rest is all rapid, and much of it
+being only fifty or eighty yards wide, and rushing like a mill-race, it
+gives the impression of water-power, sufficient to drive all the mills in
+Manchester, running to waste. Pamofunda, or Pamozima, has a deep shady
+grove on its right bank. When we were walking alone through its dark
+shade, we were startled by a shocking smell like that of a dissecting-
+room; and on looking up saw dead bodies in mats suspended from the
+branches of the trees, a mode of burial somewhat similar to that which we
+subsequently saw practised by the Parsees in their "towers of silence" at
+Poonah, near Bombay. The name Pamozima means, "the departed spirits or
+gods"--a fit name for a place over which, according to the popular
+belief, the disembodied souls continually hover.
+
+The rock lowest down in the series is dark reddish-grey syenite. This
+seems to have been an upheaving agent, for the mica schists above it are
+much disturbed. Dark trappean rocks full of hornblende have in many
+places burst through these schists, and appear in nodules on the surface.
+The highest rock seen is a fine sandstone of closer grain than that at
+Tette, and quite metamorphosed where it comes into contact with the
+igneous rocks below it. It sometimes gives place to quartz and reddish
+clay schists, much baked by heat. This is the usual geological condition
+on the right bank of the Cataracts. On the other side we pass over
+masses of porphyritic trap, in contact with the same mica schists, and
+these probably give to the soil the great fertility we observed. The
+great body of the mountains is syenite. So much mica is washed into the
+river, that on looking attentively on the stream one sees myriads of
+particles floating and glancing in the sun; and this, too, even at low
+water.
+
+It was the 15th of August before the men returned from the ship,
+accompanied by Mr. Rae and the steward of the "Pioneer." They brought
+two oxen, one of which was instantly slaughtered to put courage into all
+hearts, and some bottles of wine, a present from Waller and Alington. We
+never carried wine before, but this was precious as an expression of
+kindheartedness on the part of the donors. If one attempted to carry
+either wine or spirits, as a beverage, he would require a whole troop of
+followers for nothing else. Our greatest luxury in travelling was tea or
+coffee. We never once carried sugar enough to last a journey, but coffee
+is always good, while the sugarless tea is only bearable, because of the
+unbearable gnawing feeling of want and sinking which ensues if we begin
+to travel in the mornings without something warm in the stomach. Our
+drink generally was water, and if cool, nothing can equal it in a hot
+climate. We usually carried a bottle of brandy rolled up in our
+blankets, but that was used only as a medicine; a spoonful in hot water
+before going to bed, to fend off a chill and fever. Spirits always do
+harm, if the fever has fairly begun; and it is probable that brandy-and-
+water has to answer for a good many of the deaths in Africa.
+
+Mr. Rae had made gratifying progress in screwing together the "Lady
+Nyassa." He had the zealous co-operation of three as fine steady workmen
+as ever handled tools; and, as they were noble specimens of English
+sailors, we would fain mention the names of men who are an honour to the
+British navy--John Reid, John Pennell, and Richard Wilson. The reader
+will excuse our doing so, but we desire to record how much they were
+esteemed, and how thankful we felt for their good behaviour. The weather
+was delightfully cool; and, with full confidence in those left behind, it
+was with light hearts we turned our faces north. Mr. Rae accompanied us
+a day in front; and, as all our party had earnestly advised that at least
+two Europeans should be associated together on the journey, the steward
+was at the last moment taken. Mr. Rae returned to get the "Lady Nyassa"
+ready for sea; and, as she drew less water than the "Pioneer," take her
+down to the ocean in October. One reason for taking the steward is worth
+recording. Both he and a man named King, {5} who, though only a leading
+stoker in the Navy, had been a promising student in the University of
+Aberdeen, had got into that weak bloodless-looking state which residence
+in the lowlands without much to do or think about often induces. The
+best thing for this is change and an active life. A couple of days'
+march only as far as the Mukuru-Madse, infused so much vigour into King
+that he was able to walk briskly back. Consideration for the steward's
+health led to his being selected for this northern journey, and the
+measure was so completely successful that it was often, in the hard
+march, a subject of regret that King had not been taken too. A removal
+of only a hundred yards is sometimes so beneficial that it ought in
+severe cases never to be omitted.
+
+Our object now was to get away to the N.N.W., proceed parallel with Lake
+Nyassa, but at a considerable distance west of it, and thus pass by the
+Mazitu or Zulus near its northern end without contact--ascertain whether
+any large river flowed into the Lake from the west--visit Lake Moelo, if
+time permitted, and collect information about the trade on the great
+slave route, which crosses the Lake at its southern end, and at Tsenga
+and Kota-kota. The Makololo were eager to travel fast, because they
+wanted to be back in time to hoe their fields before the rains, and also
+because their wives needed looking after.
+
+In going in the first instance N.E. from the uppermost Cataract, we
+followed in a measure the great bend of the river towards the foot of
+Mount Zomba. Here we had a view of its most imposing side, the west,
+with the plateau some 3000 feet high, stretching away to its south, and
+Mounts Chiradzuru and Mochiru towering aloft to the sky. From that
+goodly highland station, it was once hoped by the noble Mackenzie, who,
+for largeness of heart and loving disposition, really deserved to be
+called the "Bishop of Central Africa," that light and liberty would
+spread to all the interior. We still think it may be a centre for
+civilizing influences; for any one descending from these cool heights,
+and stepping into a boat on the Upper Shire, can sail three hundred miles
+without a check into the heart of Africa.
+
+We passed through a tract of country covered with mopane trees, where the
+hard baked soil refused to let the usual thick crops of grass grow; and
+here we came upon very many tracks of buffaloes, elephants, antelopes,
+and the spoor of one lion. An ox we drove along with us, as provision
+for the way, was sorely bitten by the tsetse. The effect of the bite
+was, as usual, quite apparent two days afterwards, in the general
+flaccidity of the muscles, the drooping ears, and looks of illness. It
+always excited our wonder that we, who were frequently much bitten too by
+the same insects, felt no harm from their attacks. Man shares the
+immunity of the wild animals.
+
+Finding a few people on the evening of the 20th of August, who were
+supporting a wretched existence on tamarinds and mice, we ascertained
+that there was no hope of our being able to buy food anywhere nearer than
+the Lakelet Pamalombe, where the Ajawa chief, Kainka, was now living; but
+that plenty could be found with the Maravi female chief, Nyango. We
+turned away north-westwards, and struck the stream Ribve-ribve, or Rivi-
+rivi, which rises in the Maravi range, and flows into the Shire.
+
+As the Rivi-rivi came from the N.W. we continued to travel along its
+banks, until we came to people who had successfully defended themselves
+against the hordes of the Ajawa. By employing the men of one village to
+go forward and explain who we were to the next, we managed to prevent the
+frightened inhabitants from considering us a fresh party of Ajawa, or of
+Portuguese slaving agents. Here they had cultivated maize, and were
+willing to sell, but no persuasion could induce them to give us guides to
+the chieftainess, Nyango. They evidently felt that we were not to be
+trusted; though, as we had to certify to our own character, our
+companions did not fail "to blow our own trumpet," with blasts in which
+modesty was quite out of the question. To allay suspicion, we had at
+last to refrain from mentioning the lady's name.
+
+It would be wearisome to repeat the names of the villages we passed on
+our way to the north-west. One was the largest we ever saw in Africa,
+and quite deserted, with the usual sad sight of many skeletons lying
+about. Another was called Tette. We know three places of this name,
+which fact shows it to be a native word; it seems to mean a place where
+the water rushes over rocks. A third village was called Chipanga (a
+great work), a name identical with the Shupanga of the Portuguese. This
+repetition of names may indicate that the same people first took these
+epithets in their traditional passage from north to south.
+
+At this season of the year the nights are still cold, and the people,
+having no crops to occupy their attention, do not stir out till long
+after the sun is up. At other times they are off to their fields before
+the day dawns, and the first sound one hears is the loud talking of men
+and women, in which they usually indulge in the dark to scare off beasts
+by the sound of the human voice. When no work is to be done, the first
+warning of approaching day is the hemp-smoker's loud ringing cough.
+
+Having been delayed one morning by some negotiation about guides, who
+were used chiefly to introduce us to other villages, we two whites walked
+a little way ahead, taking the direction of the stream. The men having
+been always able to find out our route by the prints of our shoes, we
+went on for a number of miles. This time, however, they lost our track,
+and failed to follow us. The path was well marked by elephants, hyenas,
+pallahs, and zebras, but for many a day no human foot had trod it. When
+the sun went down a deserted hamlet was reached, where we made
+comfortable beds for ourselves of grass. Firing muskets to attract the
+attention of those who have strayed is the usual resource in these cases.
+On this occasion the sound of firearms tended to mislead us; for, hearing
+shots next morning, a long weary march led us only to some native
+hunters, who had been shooting buffaloes. Returning to a small village,
+we met with some people who remembered our passing up to the Lake in the
+boat; they were as kind as they could be. The only food they possessed
+was tamarinds, prepared with ashes, and a little cowitch meal. The
+cowitch, as mentioned before, has a velvety brown covering of minute
+prickles, which, if touched, enter the pores of the skin and cause a
+painful tingling. The women in times of scarcity collect the pods,
+kindle a fire of grass over them to destroy the prickles, then steep the
+beans till they begin to sprout, wash them in pure water, and either boil
+them or pound them into meal, which resembles our bean-meal. This plant
+climbs up the long grass, and abounds in all reedy parts, and, though a
+plague to the traveller who touches its pods, it performs good service in
+times of famine by saving many a life from starvation. Its name here is
+Kitedzi.
+
+Having travelled at least twenty miles in search of our party that day,
+our rest on a mat in the best hut of the village was very sweet. We had
+dined the evening before on a pigeon each, and had eaten only a handful
+of kitedzi porridge this afternoon. The good wife of the village took a
+little corn which she had kept for seed, ground it after dark, and made
+it into porridge. This, and a cup of wild vegetables of a sweetish taste
+for a relish, a little boy brought in and put down, with several vigorous
+claps of his hands, in the manner which is esteemed polite, and which is
+strictly enjoined on all children.
+
+On the third day of separation, Akosanjere, the headman of this village,
+conducted us forward to our party who had gone on to Nseze, a district to
+the westward. This incident is mentioned, not for any interest it
+possesses, apart from the idea of the people it conveys. We were
+completely separated from our men for nearly three days, and had nothing
+wherewith to purchase food. The people were sorely pressed by famine and
+war, and their hospitality, poor as it was, did them great credit, and
+was most grateful to us. Our own men had become confused and wandered,
+but had done their utmost to find us; on our rejoining them, the ox was
+slain, and all, having been on short commons, rejoiced in this "day of
+slaughter." Akosanjere was, of course, rewarded to his heart's content.
+
+As we pursued our way, we came close up to a range of mountains, the most
+prominent peak of which is called Mvai. This is a great, bare, rounded
+block of granite shooting up from the rest of the chain. It and several
+other masses of rock are of a light grey colour, with white patches, as
+if of lichens; the sides and summits are generally thinly covered with
+rather scraggy trees. There are several other prominent peaks--one, for
+instance, still further north, called Chirobve. Each has a name, but we
+could never ascertain that there was an appellation which applied to the
+whole. This fact, and our wish to commemorate the name of Dr. Kirk,
+induced us afterwards, when we could not discover a particular peak
+mentioned to us formerly as Molomo-ao-koku, or Cock's-bill, to call the
+whole chain from the west of the Cataracts up to the north end of the
+Lake, "Kirk's Range." The part we slept at opposite Mvai was named
+Paudio, and was evidently a continuation of the district of one of our
+stations on the Shire, at which observations for latitude were formerly
+taken.
+
+Leaving Paudio, we had Kirk's Range close on our left and at least 3000
+feet above us, and probably not less than 5000 feet above the sea. Far
+to our right extended a long green wooded country rising gradually up to
+a ridge, ornamented with several detached mountains, which bounded the
+Shire Valley. In front, northwards, lay a valley as rich and lovely as
+we ever saw anywhere, terminating at the mountains, which, stretched away
+some thirty miles beyond our range of vision and ended at Cape Maclear.
+The groups of trees had never been subjected to the landscape gardener's
+art; but had been cut down mercilessly, just as suited the convenience of
+the cultivator; yet the various combinations of open forest, sloping
+woodland, grassy lawns, and massive clumps of dark green foliage along
+the running streams, formed as beautiful a landscape as could be seen on
+the Thames. This valley is named Goa or Gova, and as we moved through it
+we found that what was smooth to the eye was very much furrowed by
+running streams winding round innumerable knolls. These little brooklets
+came down from the range on our left, and the water was deliciously cool.
+
+When we came abreast of the peak Chirobve, the people would no longer
+give us guides. They were afraid of their enemies, whose dwellings we
+now had on our east; and, proceeding without any one to lead us, or to
+introduce us to the inhabitants, we were perplexed by all the paths
+running zigzag across instead of along the valley. They had been made by
+the villagers going from the hamlets on the slopes to their gardens in
+the meadows below. To add to our difficulties, the rivulets and mountain-
+torrents had worn gullies some thirty or forty feet deep, with steep
+sides that could not be climbed except at certain points. The remaining
+inhabitants on the flank of the range when they saw strangers winding
+from side to side, and often attempting to cross these torrent beds at
+impossible places, screamed out their shrill war-alarm, and made the
+valley ring with their wild outcries. It was war, and war alone, and we
+were too deep down in the valley to make our voices heard in explanation.
+Fortunately, they had burned off the long grass to a great extent. It
+only here and there hid them from us. Selecting an open spot, we spent a
+night regarded by all around us as slave-hunters, but were undisturbed,
+though the usual way of treating an enemy in this part of the country is
+by night attack.
+
+The nights at the altitude of the valley were cool, the lowest
+temperature shown being 37 degrees; at 9 a.m. and 9 p.m. it was 58
+degrees, about the average temperature of the day; at mid-day 82 degrees,
+and sunset 70 degrees. Our march was very much hindered by the
+imperfectly burned corn and grass stalks having fallen across the paths.
+To a reader in England this will seem a very small obstacle. But he must
+fancy the grass stems as thick as his little finger, and the corn-stalks
+like so many walkingsticks lying in one direction, and so supporting each
+other that one has to lift his feet up as when wading through deep high
+heather. The stems of grass showed the causes of certain explosions as
+loud as pistols, which are heard when the annual fires come roaring over
+the land. The heated air inside expanding bursts the stalk with a loud
+report, and strews the fragments on the ground.
+
+A very great deal of native corn had been cultivated here, and we saw
+buffaloes feeding in the deserted gardens, and some women, who ran away
+very much faster than the beasts did.
+
+On the 29th, seeing some people standing under a tree by a village, we
+sat down, and sent Masego, one of our party, to communicate. The
+headman, Matunda, came back with him, bearing a calabash with water for
+us. He said that all the people had fled from the Ajawa, who had only
+just desisted from their career of pillage on being paid five persons as
+a fine for some offence for which they had commenced the invasion.
+Matunda had plenty of grain to sell, and all the women were soon at work
+grinding it into meal. We secured an abundant supply, and four milk
+goats. The Manganja goat is of a very superior breed to the general
+African animal, being short in the legs and having a finely-shaped broad
+body. By promising the Makololo that, when we no longer needed the milk,
+they should have the goats to improve the breed of their own at home,
+they were induced to take the greatest possible care of both goats and
+kids in driving and pasturing.
+
+After leaving Matunda, we came to the end of the highland valley; and,
+before descending a steep declivity of a thousand feet towards the part
+which may be called the heel of the Lake, we had the bold mountains of
+Cape Maclear on our right, with the blue water at their base, the hills
+of Tsenga in the distance in front, and Kirk's Range on our left,
+stretching away northwards, and apparently becoming lower. As we came
+down into a fine rich undulating valley, many perennial streams running
+to the east from the hills on our left were crossed, while all those
+behind us on the higher ground seemed to unite in one named Lekue, which
+flowed into the Lake.
+
+After a long day's march in the valley of the Lake, where the temperature
+was very much higher than in that we had just left, we entered the
+village of Katosa, which is situated on the bank of a stream among
+gigantic timber trees, and found there a large party of Ajawa--Waiau,
+they called themselves--all armed with muskets. We sat down among them,
+and were soon called to the chiefs court, and presented with an ample
+mess of porridge, buffalo meat, and beer. Katosa was more frank than any
+Manganja chief we had met, and complimented us by saying that "we must be
+his 'Bazimo' (good spirits of his ancestors); for when he lived at
+Pamalombe, we lighted upon him from above--men the like of whom he had
+never seen before, and coming he knew not whence." He gave us one of his
+own large and clean huts to sleep in; and we may take this opportunity of
+saying that the impression we received, from our first journey on the
+hills among the villages of Chisunse, of the excessive dirtiness of the
+Manganja, was erroneous. This trait was confined to the cool highlands.
+Here crowds of men and women were observed to perform their ablutions
+daily in the stream that ran past their villages; and this we have
+observed elsewhere to be a common custom with both Manganja and Ajawa.
+
+Before we started on the morning of the 1st September, Katosa sent an
+enormous calabash of beer, containing at least three gallons, and then
+came and wished us to "stop a day and eat with him." On explaining to
+him the reasons for our haste, he said that he was in the way by which
+travellers usually passed, he never stopped them in their journeys, but
+would like to look at us for a day. On our promising to rest a little
+with him on our return, he gave us about two pecks of rice, and three
+guides to conduct us to a subordinate female chief, Nkwinda, living on
+the borders of the Lake in front.
+
+The Ajawa, from having taken slaves down to Quillimane and Mosambique,
+knew more of us than Katosa did. Their muskets were carefully polished,
+and never out of these slaver's hands for a moment, though in the chiefs
+presence. We naturally felt apprehensive that we should never see Katosa
+again. A migratory afflatus seems to have come over the Ajawa tribes.
+Wars among themselves, for the supply of the Coast slave-trade, are said
+to have first set them in motion. The usual way in which they have
+advanced among the Manganja has been by slave-trading in a friendly way.
+Then, professing to wish to live as subjects, they have been welcomed as
+guests, and the Manganja, being great agriculturists, have been able to
+support considerable bodies of these visitors for a time. When the
+provisions became scarce, the guests began to steal from the fields;
+quarrels arose in consequence, and, the Ajawa having firearms, their
+hosts got the worst of it, and were expelled from village after village,
+and out of their own country. The Manganja were quite as bad in regard
+to slave-trading as the Ajawa, but had less enterprise, and were much
+more fond of the home pursuits of spinning, weaving, smelting iron, and
+cultivating the soil, than of foreign travel. The Ajawa had little of a
+mechanical turn, and not much love for agriculture, but were very keen
+traders and travellers. This party seemed to us to be in the first or
+friendly stage of intercourse with Katosa; and, as we afterwards found,
+he was fully alive to the danger.
+
+Our course was shaped towards the N.W., and we traversed a large fertile
+tract of rich soil extensively cultivated, but dotted with many gigantic
+thorny acacias which had proved too large for the little axes of the
+cultivators. After leaving Nkwinda, the first village we spent a night
+at in the district Ngabi was that of Chembi, and it had a stockade around
+it. The Azitu or Mazitu were said to be ravaging the country to the west
+of us, and no one was safe except in a stockade. We have so often, in
+travelling, heard of war in front, that we paid little attention to the
+assertion of Chembi, that the whole country to the N.W. was in flight
+before these Mazitu, under a chief with the rather formidable name of
+Mowhiriwhiri; we therefore resolved to go on to Chinsamba's, still
+further in the same direction, and hear what he said about it.
+
+The only instrument of husbandry here is the short-handled hoe; and about
+Tette the labour of tilling the soil, as represented in the woodcut, is
+performed entirely by female slaves. On the West Coast a double-handled
+hoe is employed. Here the small hoe is seen in the hands of both men and
+women. In other parts of Africa a hoe with a handle four feet long is
+used, but the plough is quite unknown.
+
+In illustration of the manner in which the native knowledge of
+agriculture strikes an honest intelligent observer, it may be mentioned
+that the first time good Bishop Mackenzie beheld how well the fields of
+the Manganja were cultivated on the hills, he remarked to Dr.
+Livingstone, then his fellow-traveller--"When telling the people in
+England what were my objects in going out to Africa, I stated that, among
+other things, I meant to teach these people agriculture; but I now see
+that they know far more about it than I do." This, we take it, was an
+honest straightforward testimony, and we believe that every unprejudiced
+witness, who has an opportunity of forming an opinion of Africans who
+have never been debased by slavery, will rank them very much higher in
+the scale of intelligence, industry, and manhood, than others who know
+them only in a state of degradation.
+
+On coming near Chinsamba's two stockades, on the banks of the Lintipe, we
+were told that the Mazitu had been repulsed there the day before, and we
+had evidence of the truth of the report of the attack in the sad sight of
+the bodies of the slain. The Zulus had taken off large numbers of women
+laden with corn; and, when driven back, had cut off the ears of a male
+prisoner, as a sort of credential that he had been with the Mazitu, and
+with grim humour sent him to tell Chinsamba "to take good care of the
+corn in the stockades, for they meant to return for it in a month or
+two."
+
+Chinsamba's people were drumming with might and main on our arrival, to
+express their joy at their deliverance from the Mazitu. The drum is the
+chief instrument of music among the Manganja, and with it they express
+both their joy and grief. They excel in beating time. Chinsamba called
+us into a very large hut, and presented us with a huge basket of beer.
+The glare of sunlight from which we had come enabled him, in diplomatic
+fashion, to have a good view of us before our eyes became enough
+accustomed to the dark inside to see him. He has a Jewish cast of
+countenance, or rather the ancient Assyrian face, as seen in the
+monuments brought to the British Museum by Mr. Layard. This form of face
+is very common in this country, and leads to the belief that the true
+type of the negro is not that met on the West Coast, from which most
+people have derived their ideas of the African.
+
+Chinsamba had many Abisa or Babisa in his stockade, and it was chiefly by
+the help of their muskets that he had repulsed the Mazitu: these Babisa
+are great travellers and traders.
+
+We liked Chinsamba very well, and found that he was decidedly opposed to
+our risking our lives by going further to the N.W. The Mazitu were
+believed to occupy all the hills in that direction, so we spent the 4th
+of September with him.
+
+It is rather a minute thing to mention, and it will only be understood by
+those who have children of their own, but the cries of the little ones,
+in their infant sorrows, are the same in tone, at different ages, here as
+all over the world. We have been perpetually reminded of home and family
+by the wailings which were once familiar to parental ears and heart, and
+felt thankful that to the sorrows of childhood our children would never
+have superadded the heartrending woes of the slave-trade.
+
+Taking Chinsamba's advice to avoid the Mazitu in their marauding, we
+started on the 5th September away to the N.E., and passed mile after mile
+of native cornfields, with an occasional cotton-patch.
+
+After a long march, we passed over a waterless plain about N.N.W. of the
+hills of Tsenga to a village on the Lake, and thence up its shores to
+Chitanda. The banks of the Lake were now crowded with fugitives, who had
+collected there for the poor protection which the reeds afforded. For
+miles along the water's edge was one continuous village of temporary
+huts. The people had brought a little corn with them; but they said,
+"What shall we eat when that is done? When we plant corn, the wild
+beasts (Zinyama, as they call the Mazitu) come and take it. When we
+plant cassava, they do the same. How are we to live?" A poor blind
+woman, thinking we were Mazitu, rushed off in front of us with outspread
+arms, lifting the feet high, in the manner peculiar to those who have
+lost their sight, and jumped into the reeds of a stream for safety.
+
+In our way along the shores we crossed several running rivulets of clear
+cold water, which, from having reeds at their confluences, had not been
+noticed in our previous exploration in the boat. One of these was called
+Mokola, and another had a strong odour of sulphuretted hydrogen. We
+reached Molamba on the 8th September, and found our old acquaintance,
+Nkomo, there still. One of the advantages of travelling along the shores
+of the Lake was, that we could bathe anywhere in its clear fresh water.
+To us, who had been obliged so often to restrain our inclination in the
+Zambesi and Shire for fear of crocodiles, this was pleasant beyond
+measure. The water now was of the same temperature as it was on our
+former visit, or 72 degrees Fahr. The immense depth of the Lake prevents
+the rays of the sun from raising the temperature as high as that of the
+Shire and Zambesi; and the crocodiles, having always clear water in the
+Lake, and abundance of fish, rarely attack man; many of these reptiles
+could be seen basking on the rocks.
+
+A day's march beyond Molamba brought us to the lakelet Chia, which lies
+parallel with the Lake. It is three or four miles long, by from one to
+one and a half broad, and communicates with the Lake by an arm of good
+depth, but with some rocks in it. As we passed up between the Lake and
+the eastern shore of this lakelet, we did not see any streams flowing
+into it. It is quite remarkable for the abundance of fish; and we saw
+upwards of fifty large canoes engaged in the fishery, which is carried on
+by means of hand-nets with side-frame poles about seven feet long. These
+nets are nearly identical with those now in use in Normandy--the
+difference being that the African net has a piece of stick lashed across
+the handle-ends of the side poles to keep them steady, which is a great
+improvement. The fish must be very abundant to be scooped out of the
+water in such quantities as we saw, and by so many canoes. There is
+quite a trade here in dried fish.
+
+The country around is elevated, undulating, and very extensively planted
+with cassava. The hoe in use has a handle of four feet in length, and
+the iron part is exactly of the same form as that in the country of the
+Bechuanas. The baskets here, which are so closely woven together as to
+hold beer, are the same with those employed to hold milk in Kaffirland--a
+thousand miles distant.
+
+Marching on foot is peculiarly conducive to meditation--one is glad of
+any subject to occupy the mind, and relieve the monotony of the weary
+treadmill-like trudge-trudging. This Chia net brought to our mind that
+the smith's bellows made here of a goatskin bag, with sticks along the
+open ends, are the same as those in use in the Bechuana country far to
+the south-west. These, with the long-handled hoe, may only show that
+each successive horde from north to south took inventions with it from
+the same original source. Where that source may have been is probably
+indicated by another pair of bellows, which we observed below the
+Victoria Falls, being found in Central India and among the Gipsies of
+Europe.
+
+Men in remote times may have had more highly-developed instincts, which
+enabled them to avoid or use poisons; but the late Archbishop Whately has
+proved, that wholly untaught savages never could invent anything, or even
+subsist at all. Abundant corroboration of his arguments is met with in
+this country, where the natives require but little in the way of
+clothing, and have remarkably hardy stomachs. Although possessing a
+knowledge of all the edible roots and fruits in the country, having hoes
+to dig with, and spears, bows, and arrows to kill the game,--we have seen
+that, notwithstanding all these appliances and means to boot, they have
+perished of absolute starvation.
+
+The art of making fire is the same in India as in Africa. The smelting
+furnaces, for reducing iron and copper from the ores, are also similar.
+Yellow haematite, which bears not the smallest resemblance either in
+colour or weight to the metal, is employed near Kolobeng for the
+production of iron. Malachite, the precious green stone used in
+civilized life for vases, would never be suspected by the uninstructed to
+be a rich ore of copper, and yet it is extensively smelted for rings and
+other ornaments in the heart of Africa. A copper bar of native
+manufacture four feet long was offered to us for sale at Chinsamba's.
+These arts are monuments attesting the fact, that some instruction from
+above must at some time or other have been supplied to mankind; and, as
+Archbishop Whately says, "the most probable conclusion is, that man when
+first created, or very shortly afterwards, was advanced, by the Creator
+Himself, to a state above that of a mere savage."
+
+The argument for an original revelation to man, though quite independent
+of the Bible history, tends to confirm that history. It is of the same
+nature with this, that man could not have _made_ himself, and therefore
+must have had a Divine _Creator_. Mankind could not, in the first
+instance, have _civilized_ themselves, and therefore must have had a
+superhuman _Instructor_.
+
+In connection with this subject, it is remarkable that throughout
+successive generations no change has taken place in the form of the
+various inventions. Hammers, tongs, hoes, axes, adzes, handles to them;
+needles, bows and arrows, with the mode of feathering the latter; spears,
+for killing game, with spear-heads having what is termed "dish" on both
+sides to give them, when thrown, the rotatory motion of rifle-balls; the
+arts of spinning and weaving, with that of pounding and steeping the
+inner bark of a tree till it serves as clothing; millstones for grinding
+corn into meal; the manufacture of the same kind of pots or _chatties_ as
+in India; the art of cooking, of brewing beer and straining it as was
+done in ancient Egypt; fish-hooks, fishing and hunting nets,
+fish-baskets, and weirs, the same as in the Highlands of Scotland; traps
+for catching animals, etc., etc.,--have all been so very permanent from
+age to age, and some of them of identical patterns are so widely spread
+over the globe, as to render it probable that they were all, at least in
+some degree, derived from one Source. The African traditions, which seem
+possessed of the same unchangeability as the arts to which they relate,
+like those of all other nations refer their origin to a superior Being.
+And it is much more reasonable to receive the hints given in Genesis,
+concerning direct instruction from God to our first parents or their
+children in religious or moral duty, and probably in the knowledge of the
+arts of life, {6} than to give credence to the theory that untaught
+savage man subsisted in a state which would prove fatal to all his
+descendants, and that in such helpless state he made many inventions
+which most of his progeny retained, but never improved upon during some
+thirty centuries.
+
+We crossed in canoes the arm of the Lake, which joins Chia to Nyassa, and
+spent the night on its northern bank. The whole country adjacent to the
+Lake, from this point up to Kota-kota Bay, is densely peopled by
+thousands who have fled from the forays of the Mazitu in hopes of
+protection from the Arabs who live there. In three running rivulets we
+saw the _Shuare_ palm, and an oil palm which is much inferior to that on
+the West Coast. Though somewhat similar in appearance, the fruit is not
+much larger than hazel-nuts, and the people do not use them, on account
+of the small quantity of oil which they afford.
+
+The idea of using oil for light never seems to have entered the African
+mind. Here a bundle of split and dried bamboo, tied together with
+creeping plants, as thick as a man's body, and about twenty feet in
+length, is employed in the canoes as a torch to attract the fish at
+night. It would be considered a piece of the most wasteful extravagance
+to burn the oil they obtain from the castor-oil bean and other seeds, and
+also from certain fish, or in fact to do anything with it but anoint
+their heads and bodies.
+
+We arrived at Kota-kota Bay in the afternoon of the 10th September, 1863;
+and sat down under a magnificent wild fig-tree with leaves ten inches
+long, by five broad, about a quarter of a mile from the village of Juma
+ben Saidi, and Yakobe ben Arame, whom we had met on the River Kaombe, a
+little north of this, in our first exploration of the Lake. We had
+rested but a short time when Juma, who is evidently the chief person
+here, followed by about fifty people, came to salute us and to invite us
+to take up our quarters in his village. The hut which, by mistake, was
+offered, was so small and dirty, that we preferred sleeping in an open
+space a few hundred yards off.
+
+Juma afterwards apologized for the mistake, and presented us with rice,
+meal, sugar-cane, and a piece of malachite. We returned his visit on the
+following day, and found him engaged in building a dhow or Arab vessel,
+to replace one which he said had been wrecked. This new one was fifty
+feet long, twelve feet broad, and five feet deep. The planks were of a
+wood like teak, here called Timbati, and the timbers of a closer grained
+wood called Msoro. The sight of this dhow gave us a hint which, had we
+previously received it, would have prevented our attempting to carry a
+vessel of iron past the Cataracts. The trees around Katosa's village
+were Timbati, and they would have yielded planks fifty feet long and
+thirty inches broad. With a few native carpenters a good vessel could be
+built on the Lake nearly as quickly as one could be carried past the
+Cataracts, and at a vastly less cost. Juma said that no money would
+induce him to part with this dhow. He was very busy in transporting
+slaves across the Lake by means of two boats, which we saw returning from
+a trip in the afternoon. As he did not know of our intention to visit
+him, we came upon several gangs of stout young men slaves, each secured
+by the neck to one common chain, waiting for exportation, and several
+more in slave-sticks. These were all civilly removed before our
+interview was over, because Juma knew that we did not relish the sight.
+
+When we met the same Arabs in 1861, they had but few attendants:
+according to their own account, they had now, in the village and adjacent
+country, 1500 souls. It is certain that tens of thousands had flocked to
+them for protection, and all their power and influence must be attributed
+to the possession of guns and gunpowder. This crowding of refugees to
+any point where there is a hope for security for life and property is
+very common in this region, and the knowledge of it made our hopes beat
+high for the success of a peaceful Mission on the shores of the Lake. The
+rate, however, in which the people here will perish by the next famine,
+or be exported by Juma and others, will, we fear, depopulate those parts
+which we have just described as crowded with people. Hunger will ere
+long compel them to sell each other. An intelligent man complained to us
+of the Arabs often seizing slaves, to whom they took a fancy, without the
+formality of purchase; but the price is so low--from two to four yards of
+calico--that one can scarcely think this seizure and exportation without
+payment worth their while. The boats were in constant employment, and,
+curiously enough, Ben Habib, whom we met at Linyanti in 1855, had been
+taken across the Lake, the day before our arrival at this Bay, on his way
+from Sesheke to Kilwa, and we became acquainted with a native servant of
+the Arabs, called Selele Saidallah, who could speak the Makololo language
+pretty fairly from having once spent some months in the Barotse Valley.
+
+From boyhood upwards we have been accustomed, from time to time, to read
+in books of travels about the great advances annually made by
+Mohammedanism in Africa. The rate at which this religion spreads was
+said to be so rapid, that in after days, in our own pretty extensive
+travels, we have constantly been on the look out for the advancing wave
+from North to South, which, it was prophesied, would soon reduce the
+entire continent to the faith of the false prophet. The only foundation
+that we can discover for the assertions referred to, and for others of
+more recent date, is the fact that in a remote corner of North-Western
+Africa the Fulahs, and Mandingoes, and some others in Northern Africa, as
+mentioned by Dr. Barth, have made conquests of territory; but even they
+care so very little for the extension of their faith, that after the
+conquest no pains whatever are taken to indoctrinate the adults of the
+tribe. This is in exact accordance with the impression we have received
+from our intercourse with Mohammedans and Christians. The followers of
+Christ alone are anxious to propagate their faith. A _quasi_
+philanthropist would certainly never need to recommend the followers of
+Islam, whom we have met, to restrain their benevolence by preaching that
+"Charity should begin at home."
+
+Though Selele and his companions were bound to their masters by domestic
+ties, the only new idea they had imbibed from Mohammedanism was, that it
+would be wrong to eat meat killed by other people. They thought it would
+be "unlucky." Just as the inhabitants of Kolobeng, before being taught
+the requirements of Christianity, refrained from hoeing their gardens on
+Sundays, lest they should reap an unlucky crop. So far as we could
+learn, no efforts had been made to convert the natives, though these two
+Arabs, and about a dozen half-castes, had been in the country for many
+years; and judging from our experience with a dozen Mohammedans in our
+employ at high wages for sixteen months, the Africans would be the better
+men in proportion as they retained their native faith. This may appear
+only a harsh judgment from a mind imbued with Christian prejudices; but
+without any pretention to that impartiality, which leaves it doubtful to
+which side the affections lean, the truth may be fairly stated by one who
+viewed all Mohammedans and Africans with the sincerest good will.
+
+Our twelve Mohammedans from Johanna were the least open of any of our
+party to impression from kindness. A marked difference in general
+conduct was apparent. The Makololo, and other natives of the country,
+whom we had with us, invariably shared with each other the food they had
+cooked, but the Johanna men partook of their meals at a distance. This,
+at first, we attributed to their Moslem prejudices; but when they saw the
+cooking process of the others nearly complete, they came, sat beside
+them, and ate the portion offered without ever remembering to return the
+compliment when their own turn came to be generous. The Makololo and the
+others grumbled at their greediness, yet always followed the common
+custom of Africans of sharing their food with all who sit around them.
+What vexed us most in the Johanna men was their indifference to the
+welfare of each other. Once, when they were all coming to the ship after
+sleeping ashore, one of them walked into the water with the intention of
+swimming off to the boat, and while yet hardly up to his knees was seized
+by a horrid crocodile and dragged under; the poor fellow gave a shriek,
+and held up his hand for aid, but none of his countrymen stirred to his
+assistance, and he was never seen again. On asking his brother-in-law
+why he did not help him, he replied, "Well, no one told him to go into
+the water. It was his own fault that he was killed." The Makololo on
+the other hand rescued a woman at Senna by entering the water, and taking
+her out of the crocodile's mouth.
+
+It is not assumed that their religion had much to do in the matter. Many
+Mohammedans might contrast favourably with indifferent Christians; but,
+so far as our experience in East Africa goes, the moral tone of the
+follower of Mahomed is pitched at a lower key than that of the untutored
+African. The ancient zeal for propagating the tenets of the Koran has
+evaporated, and been replaced by the most intense selfishness and
+grossest sensuality. The only known efforts made by Mohammedans, namely,
+those in the North-West and North of the continent, are so linked with
+the acquisition of power and plunder, as not to deserve the name of
+religious propagandism; and the only religion that now makes proselytes
+is that of Jesus Christ. To those who are capable of taking a
+comprehensive view of this subject, nothing can be adduced of more
+telling significance than the well-attested fact, that while the
+Mohammedans, Fulahs, and others towards Central Africa, make a few
+proselytes by a process which gratifies their own covetousness, three
+small sections of the Christian converts, the Africans in the South, in
+the West Indies, and on the West Coast of Africa actually contribute for
+the support and spread of their religion upwards of 15,000 pounds
+annually. {7} That religion which so far overcomes the selfishness of
+the human heart must be Divine.
+
+Leaving Kota-kota Bay, we turned away due West on the great slave route
+to Katanga's and Cazembe's country in Londa. Juma lent us his servant,
+Selele, to lead us the first day's march. He said that the traders from
+Kilwa and Iboe cross the Lake either at this bay, or at Tsenga, or at the
+southern end of the Lake; and that wherever they may cross they all go by
+this path to the interior. They have slaves with them to carry their
+goods, and when they reach a spot where they can easily buy others, they
+settle down and begin the traffic, and at once cultivate grain. So much
+of the land lies waste, that no objection is ever made to any one taking
+possession of as much as he needs; they can purchase a field of cassava
+for their present wants for very little, and they continue trading in the
+country for two or three years, and giving what weight their muskets
+possess to the chief who is most liberal to them.
+
+The first day's march led us over a rich, well-cultivated plain. This
+was succeeded by highlands, undulating, stony, and covered with scraggy
+trees. Many banks of well rounded shingle appear. The disintegration of
+the rocks, now going on, does not round off the angles; they are split up
+by the heat and cold into angular fragments. On these high downs we
+crossed the River Kaombe. Beyond it we came among the upland
+vegetation--rhododendrons, proteas, the masuko, and molompi. At the foot
+of the hill, Kasuko-suko, we found the River Bua running north to join
+the Kaombe. We had to go a mile out of our way for a ford; the stream is
+deep enough in parts for hippopotami. The various streams not previously
+noticed, crossed in this journey, had before this led us to the
+conclusion, independently of the testimony of the natives, that no large
+river ran into the north end of the Lake. No such affluent was needed to
+account for the Shire's perennial flow.
+
+On September 15th we reached the top of the ascent which, from its many
+ups and downs, had often made us puff and blow as if broken-winded. The
+water of the streams we crossed was deliciously cold, and now that we had
+gained the summit at Ndonda, where the boiling-point of water showed an
+altitude of 3440 feet above the sea, the air was delightful. Looking
+back we had a magnificent view of the Lake, but the haze prevented our
+seeing beyond the sea horizon. The scene was beautiful, but it was
+impossible to dissociate the lovely landscape whose hills and dales had
+so sorely tried our legs and lungs, from the sad fact that this was part
+of the great slave route now actually in use. By this road many "Ten
+thousands" have here seen "the Sea," "the Sea," but with sinking hearts;
+for the universal idea among the captive gangs is, that they are going to
+be fattened and eaten by the whites. They cannot of course be so much
+shocked as we should be--their sensibilities are far from fine, their
+feelings are more obtuse than ours--in fact, "the live eels are used to
+being skinned," perhaps they rather like it. We who are not philosophic,
+blessed the Providence which at Thermopylae in ancient days rolled back
+the tide of Eastern conquest from the West, and so guided the course of
+events that light and liberty and gospel truth spread to our distant
+isle, and emancipating our race freed them from the fear of ever again
+having to climb fatiguing heights and descend wearisome hollows in a
+slave-gang, as we suppose they did when the fair English youths were
+exposed for sale at Rome.
+
+Looking westwards we perceived that, what from below had the appearance
+of mountains, was only the edge of a table-land which, though at first
+undulating, soon became smooth, and sloped towards the centre of the
+country. To the south a prominent mountain called Chipata, and to the
+south-west another named Ngalla, by which the Bua is said to rise, gave
+character to the landscape. In the north, masses of hills prevented our
+seeing more than eight or ten miles.
+
+The air which was so exhilarating to Europeans had an opposite effect on
+five men who had been born and reared in the malaria of the Delta of the
+Zambesi. No sooner did they reach the edge of the plateau at Ndonda,
+than they lay down prostrate, and complained of pains all over them. The
+temperature was not much lower than that on the shores of the Lake below,
+76 degrees being the mean temperature of the day, 52 degrees the lowest,
+and 82 degrees the highest during the twenty-four hours; at the Lake it
+was about l0 degrees higher. Of the symptoms they complained of--pains
+everywhere--nothing could be made. And yet it was evident that they had
+good reason for saying that they were ill. They scarified almost every
+part of their bodies as a remedial measure; medicines, administered on
+the supposition that their malady was the effect of a sudden chill, had
+no effect, and in two days one of them actually died in consequence of,
+as far as we could judge, a change from a malarious to a purer and more
+rarefied atmosphere.
+
+As we were on the slave route, we found the people more churlish than
+usual. On being expostulated with about it, they replied, "We have been
+made wary by those who come to buy slaves." The calamity of death having
+befallen our party, seemed, however, to awaken their sympathies. They
+pointed out their usual burying-place, lent us hoes, and helped to make
+the grave. When we offered to pay all expenses, they showed that they
+had not done these friendly offices without fully appreciating their
+value; for they enumerated the use of the hut, the mat on which the
+deceased had lain, the hoes, the labour, and the medicine which they had
+scattered over the place to make him rest in peace.
+
+The primitive African faith seems to be that there is one Almighty Maker
+of heaven and earth; that he has given the various plants of earth to man
+to be employed as mediators between him and the spirit world, where all
+who have ever been born and died continue to live; that sin consists in
+offences against their fellow-men, either here or among the departed, and
+that death is often a punishment of guilt, such as witchcraft. Their
+idea of moral evil differs in no respect from ours, but they consider
+themselves amenable only to inferior beings, not to the Supreme. Evil-
+speaking--lying--hatred--disobedience to parents--neglect of them--are
+said by the intelligent to have been all known to be sin, as well as
+theft, murder, or adultery, before they knew aught of Europeans or their
+teaching. The only new addition to their moral code is, that it is wrong
+to have more wives than one. This, until the arrival of Europeans, never
+entered into their minds even as a doubt.
+
+Everything not to be accounted for by common causes, whether of good or
+evil, is ascribed to the Deity. Men are inseparably connected with the
+spirits of the departed, and when one dies he is believed to have joined
+the hosts of his ancestors. All the Africans we have met with are as
+firmly persuaded of their future existence as of their present life. And
+we have found none in whom the belief in the Supreme Being was not
+rooted. He is so invariably referred to as the Author of everything
+supernatural, that, unless one is ignorant of their language, he cannot
+fail to notice this prominent feature of their faith. When they pass
+into the unseen world, they do not seem to be possessed with the fear of
+punishment. The utensils placed upon the grave are all broken as if to
+indicate that they will never be used by the departed again. The body is
+put into the grave in a sitting posture, and the hands are folded in
+front. In some parts of the country there are tales which we could
+translate into faint glimmerings of a resurrection; but whether these
+fables, handed down from age to age, convey that meaning to the natives
+themselves we cannot tell. The true tradition of faith is asserted to be
+"though a man die he will live again;" the false that when he dies he is
+dead for ever.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV.
+
+
+Important geographical discoveries in the Wabisa countries--Cruelty of
+the slave-trade--The Mazitu--Serious illness of Dr. Livingstone--Return
+to the ship.
+
+In our course westwards, we at first passed over a gently undulating
+country, with a reddish clayey soil, which, from the heavy crops,
+appeared to be very fertile. Many rivulets were crossed, some running
+southwards into the Bua, and others northwards into the Loangwa, a river
+which we formerly saw flowing into the Lake. Further on, the water was
+chiefly found in pools and wells. Then still further, in the same
+direction, some watercourses were said to flow into that same "Loangwa of
+the Lake," and others into the Loangwa, which flows to the south-west,
+and enters the Zambesi at Zumbo, and is here called the "Loangwa of the
+Maravi." The trees were in general scraggy, and covered, exactly as they
+are in the damp climate of the Coast, with lichens, resembling orchilla-
+weed. The maize, which loves rather a damp soil, had been planted on
+ridges to allow the superfluous moisture to run off. Everything
+indicated a very humid climate, and the people warned us that, as the
+rains were near, we were likely to be prevented from returning by the
+country becoming flooded and impassable.
+
+Villages, as usual encircled by euphorbia hedges, were numerous, and a
+great deal of grain had been cultivated around them. Domestic fowls, in
+plenty, and pigeons with dovecots like those in Egypt were seen. The
+people call themselves Matumboka, but the only difference between them
+and the rest of the Manganja is in the mode of tattooing the face. Their
+language is the same. Their distinctive mark consists of four tattooed
+lines diverging from the point between the eyebrows, which, in frowning,
+the muscles form into a furrow. The other lines of tattooing, as in all
+Manganja, run in long seams, which crossing each other at certain angles
+form a great number of triangular spaces on the breast, back, arms, and
+thighs. The cuticle is divided by a knife, and the edges of the incision
+are drawn apart till the true skin appears. By a repetition of this
+process, lines of raised cicatrices are formed, which are thought to give
+beauty, no matter how much pain the fashion gives.
+
+It would not be worth while to advert for a moment to the routine of
+travelling, or the little difficulties that beset every one who attempts
+to penetrate into a new country, were it not to show the great source of
+the power here possessed by slave-traders. We needed help in carrying
+our goods, while our men were ill, though still able to march. When we
+had settled with others for hire, we were often told, that the dealers in
+men had taken possession of some, and had taken them away altogether.
+Other things led us to believe that the slave-traders carry matters with
+a high hand; and no wonder, for the possession of gunpowder gives them
+almost absolute power. The mode by which tribes armed with bows and
+arrows carry on warfare, or defend themselves, is by ambuscade. They
+never come out in open fight, but wait for the enemy ensconced behind
+trees, or in the long grass of the country, and shoot at him unawares.
+Consequently, if men come against them with firearms, when, as is usually
+the case, the long grass is all burned off, the tribe attacked are as
+helpless as a wooden ship, possessing only signal guns, would be before
+an iron-clad steamer. The time of year selected for this kind of warfare
+is nearly always that in which the grass is actually burnt off, or is so
+dry as readily to take fire. The dry grass in Africa looks more like
+ripe English wheat late in the autumn, than anything else we can compare
+it to. Let us imagine an English village standing in a field of this
+sort, bounded only by the horizon, and enemies setting fire to a line of
+a mile or two, by running along with bunches of burning straw in their
+hands, touching here and there the inflammable material,--the wind
+blowing towards the doomed village--the inhabitants with only one or two
+old muskets, but ten to one no powder,--the long line of flames, leaping
+thirty feet into the air with dense masses of black smoke--and pieces of
+charred grass falling down in showers. Would not the stoutest English
+villager, armed only with the bow and arrow against the enemy's musket,
+quail at the idea of breaking through that wall of fire? When at a
+distance, we once saw a scene like this, and had the charred grass,
+literally as thick as flakes of black snow, falling around us, there was
+no difficulty in understanding the secret of the slave-trader's power.
+
+On the 21st of September, we arrived at the village of the chief Muasi,
+or Muazi; it is surrounded by a stockade, and embowered in very tall
+euphorbia-trees; their height, thirty or forty feet, shows that it has
+been inhabited for at least one generation. A visitation of disease or
+death causes the headmen to change the site of their villages, and plant
+new hedges; but, though Muazi has suffered from the attacks of the
+Mazitu, he has evidently clung to his birthplace. The village is
+situated about two miles south-west of a high hill called Kasungu, which
+gives the name to a district extending to the Loangwa of the Maravi.
+Several other detached granite hills have been shot up on the plain, and
+many stockaded villages, all owing allegiance to Muazi, are scattered
+over it.
+
+On our arrival, the chief was sitting in the smooth shady place, called
+Boalo, where all public business is transacted, with about two hundred
+men and boys around him. We paid our guides with due ostentation.
+Masiko, the tallest of our party, measured off the fathom of cloth agreed
+upon, and made it appear as long as possible, by facing round to the
+crowd, and cutting a few inches beyond what his outstretched arms could
+reach, to show that there was no deception. This was by way of
+advertisement. The people are mightily gratified at having a tall fellow
+to measure the cloth for them. It pleases them even better than cutting
+it by a tape-line--though very few men of six feet high can measure off
+their own length with their outstretched arms. Here, where Arab traders
+have been, the cubit called _mokono_, or elbow, begins to take the place
+of the fathom in use further south. The measure is taken from the point
+of the bent elbow to the end of the middle finger.
+
+We found, on visiting Muazi on the following day, that he was as frank
+and straightforward as could reasonably be expected. He did not wish us
+to go to the N.N.W., because he carries on a considerable trade in ivory
+there. We were anxious to get off the slave route, to people not visited
+before by traders; but Muazi naturally feared, that if we went to what is
+said to be a well-watered country, abounding in elephants, we might
+relieve him of the ivory which he now obtains at a cheap rate, and sells
+to the slave-traders as they pass Kasungu to the east; but at last he
+consented, warning us that "great difficulty would be experienced in
+obtaining food--a district had been depopulated by slave wars--and a
+night or two must be spent in it; but he would give us good guides, who
+would go three days with us, before turning, and then further progress
+must depend on ourselves." Some of our men having been ill ever since we
+mounted this highland plain, we remained two days with Muazi.
+
+A herd of fine cattle showed that no tsetse existed in the district. They
+had the Indian hump, and were very fat, and very tame. The boys rode on
+both cows and bulls without fear, and the animals were so fat and lazy,
+that the old ones only made a feeble attempt to kick their young
+tormentors. Muazi never milks the cows; he complained that, but for the
+Mazitu having formerly captured some, he should now have had very many.
+They wander over the country at large, and certainly thrive.
+
+After leaving Muazi's, we passed over a flat country sparsely covered
+with the scraggy upland trees, but brightened with many fine flowers. The
+grass was short, reaching no higher than the knee, and growing in tufts
+with bare spaces between, though the trees were draped with many various
+lichens, and showed a moist climate. A high and very sharp wind blew
+over the flats; its piercing keenness was not caused by low temperature,
+for the thermometer stood at 80 degrees.
+
+We were now on the sources of the Loangwa of the Maravi, which enters the
+Zambesi at Zumbo, and were struck by the great resemblance which the
+boggy and sedgy streams here presented to the sources of the Leeba, an
+affluent of the Zambesi formerly observed in Londa, and of the Kasai,
+which some believe to be the principal branch of the Congo or Zaire.
+
+We had taken pains to ascertain from the travelled Babisa and Arabs as
+much as possible about the country in front, which, from the lessening
+time we had at our disposal, we feared we could scarcely reach, and had
+heard a good deal of a small lake called Bemba. As we proceeded west, we
+passed over the sources not only of the Loangwa, but of another stream,
+called Moitawa or Moitala, which was represented to be the main feeder of
+Lake Bemba. This would be of little importance, but for the fact that
+the considerable river Luapula, or Loapula is said to flow out of Bemba
+to the westward, and then to spread out into another and much larger
+lake, named Moero, or Moelo. Flowing still further in the same
+direction, the Loapula forms Lake Mofue, or Mofu, and after this it is
+said to pass the town of Cazembe, bend to the north, and enter Lake
+Tanganyika. Whither the water went after it entered the last lake, no
+one would venture an assertion. But that the course indicated is the
+true watershed of that part of the country, we believe from the unvarying
+opinion of native travellers. There could be no doubt that our
+informants had been in the country beyond Cazembe's, for they knew and
+described chiefs whom we afterwards met about thirty-five or forty miles
+west of his town. The Lualaba is said to flow into the Loapula--and
+when, for the sake of testing the accuracy of the travelled, it was
+asserted that all the water of the region round the town of Cazembe
+flowed into the Luambadzi, or Luambezi (Zambesi), they remarked with a
+smile, "He says, that the Loapula flows into the Zambesi--did you ever
+hear such nonsense?" or words to that effect. We were forced to admit,
+that according to native accounts, our previous impression of the
+Zambesi's draining the country about Cazembe's had been a mistake. Their
+geographical opinions are now only stated, without any further comment
+than that the itinerary given by the Arabs and others shows that the
+Loapula is twice crossed on the way to Cazembe's; and we may add that we
+have never found any difficulty from the alleged incapacity of the negro
+to tell which way a river flows.
+
+The boiling-point of water showed a descent, from the edge of the plateau
+to our furthest point west, of 170 feet; but this can only be considered
+as an approximation, and no dependence could have been placed on it, had
+we not had the courses of the streams to confirm this rather rough mode
+of ascertaining altitudes. The slope, as shown by the watershed, was to
+the "Loangwa of the Maravi," and towards the Moitala, or south-west,
+west, and north-west. After we leave the feeders of Lake Nyassa, the
+water drains towards the centre of the continent. The course of the
+Kasai, a river seen during Dr. Livingstone's journey to the West Coast,
+and its feeders was to the north-east, or somewhat in the same direction.
+Whether the water thus drained off finds its way out by the Congo, or by
+the Nile, has not yet been ascertained. Some parts of the continent have
+been said to resemble an inverted dinner-plate. This portion seems more
+of the shape, if shape it has, of a wide-awake hat, with the crown a
+little depressed. The altitude of the brim in some parts is
+considerable; in others, as at Tette and the bottom of Murchison's
+Cataracts, it is so small that it could be ascertained only by
+eliminating the daily variations of the barometer, by simultaneous
+observations on the Coast, and at points some two or three hundred miles
+inland. So long as African rivers remain in what we may call the brim,
+they present no obstructions; but no sooner do they emerge from the
+higher lands than their utility is impaired by cataracts. The low lying
+belt is very irregular. At times sloping up in the manner of the rim of
+an inverted dinner-plate--while in other cases, a high ridge rises near
+the sea, to be succeeded by a lower district inland before we reach the
+central plateau. The breadth of the low lands is sometimes as much as
+three hundred miles, and that breadth determines the limits of navigation
+from the seaward.
+
+We made three long marches beyond Muazi's in a north-westerly direction;
+the people were civil enough, but refused to sell us any food. We were
+travelling too fast, they said; in fact, they were startled, and before
+they recovered their surprise, we were obliged to depart. We suspected
+that Muazi had sent them orders to refuse us food, that we might thus be
+prevented from going into the depopulated district; but this may have
+been mere suspicion, the result of our own uncharitable feelings.
+
+We spent one night at Machambwe's village, and another at Chimbuzi's. It
+is seldom that we can find the headman on first entering a village. He
+gets out of the way till he has heard all about the strangers, or he is
+actually out in the fields looking after his farms. We once thought that
+when the headman came in from a visit of inspection, with his spear, bow
+and arrows, they had been all taken up for the occasion, and that he had
+all the while been hidden in some hut slily watching till he heard that
+the strangers might be trusted; but on listening to the details given by
+these men of the appearances of the crops at different parts, and the
+astonishing minuteness of the speakers' topography, we were persuaded
+that in some cases we were wrong, and felt rather humiliated. Every
+knoll, hill, mountain, and every peak on a range has a name; and so has
+every watercourse, dell, and plain. In fact, every feature and portion
+of the country is so minutely distinguished by appropriate names, that it
+would take a lifetime to decipher their meaning. It is not the want, but
+the superabundance of names that misleads travellers, and the terms used
+are so multifarious that good scholars will at times scarcely know more
+than the subject of conversation. Though it is a little apart from the
+topic of the attention which the headmen pay to agriculture, yet it may
+be here mentioned, while speaking of the fulness of the language, that we
+have heard about a score of words to indicate different varieties of
+gait--one walks leaning forward, or backward, swaying from side to side,
+loungingly, or smartly, swaggeringly, swinging the arms, or only one arm,
+head down or up, or otherwise; each of these modes of walking was
+expressed by a particular verb; and more words were used to designate the
+different varieties of fools than we ever tried to count.
+
+Mr. Moffat has translated the whole Bible into the language of the
+Bechuana, and has diligently studied this tongue for the last forty-four-
+years; and, though knowing far more of the language than any of the
+natives who have been reared on the Mission-station of Kuruman, he does
+not pretend to have mastered it fully even yet. However copious it may
+be in terms of which we do not feel the necessity, it is poor in others,
+as in abstract terms, and words used to describe mental operations.
+
+Our third day's march ended in the afternoon of the 27th September, 1863,
+at the village of Chinanga on the banks of a branch of the Loangwa. A
+large, rounded mass of granite, a thousand feet high, called _Nombe
+rume_, stand on the plain a few miles off. It is quite remarkable,
+because it has so little vegetation on it. Several other granitic hills
+stand near it, ornamented with trees, like most heights of this country,
+and a heap of blue mountains appears away in the north.
+
+The effect of the piercing winds upon the men had never been got rid of.
+Several had been unable to carry a load ever since we ascended to the
+highlands; we had lost one, and another poor lad was so ill as to cause
+us great anxiety. By waiting in this village, which was so old that it
+was full of vermin, all became worse. Our European food was entirely
+expended, and native meal, though finely ground, has so many sharp
+angular particles in it, that it brought back dysentery, from which we
+had suffered so much in May. We could scarcely obtain food for the men.
+The headman of this village of Chinanga was off in a foray against some
+people further north to supply slaves to the traders expected along the
+slave route we had just left; and was said, after having expelled the
+inhabitants, to be living in their stockade, and devouring their corn.
+The conquered tribe had purchased what was called a peace by presenting
+the conqueror with three women.
+
+This state of matters afforded us but a poor prospect of finding more
+provisions in that direction than we could with great difficulty and at
+enormous prices obtain here. But neither want of food, dysentery, nor
+slave wars would have prevented our working our way round the Lake in
+some other direction, had we had time; but we had received orders from
+the Foreign Office to take the "Pioneer" down to the sea in the previous
+April. The salaries of all the men in her were positively "in any case
+to cease by the 31st of December."
+
+We were said to be only ten days' distant from Lake Bemba. We might
+speculate on a late rise of the river. A month or six weeks would secure
+a geographical feat, but the rains were near. We had been warned by
+different people that the rains were close at hand, and that we should
+then be bogged and unable to travel. The flood in the river might be an
+early one, or so small in volume as to give but one chance of the
+"Pioneer" descending to the ocean. The Makololo too were becoming
+dispirited by sickness and want of food, and were naturally anxious to be
+back to their fields in time for sowing. But in addition to all this and
+more, it was felt that it would not be dealing honestly with the
+Government, were we, for the sake of a little eclat, to risk the
+detention of the "Pioneer" up the river during another year; so we
+decided to return; and though we had afterwards the mortification to find
+that we were detained two full months at the ship waiting for the flood
+which we expected immediately after our arrival there, the chagrin was
+lessened by a consciousness of having acted in a fair, honest,
+above-board manner throughout.
+
+On the night of the 29th of September a thief came to the sleeping-place
+of our men and stole a leg of a goat. On complaining to the deputy
+headman, he said that the thief had fled, but would be caught. He
+suggested a fine, and offered a fowl and her eggs; but wishing that the
+thief alone should be punished, it was advised that _he_ should be found
+and fined. The Makololo thought it best to take the fowl as a means of
+making the punishment certain. After settling this matter on the last
+day of September, we commenced our return journey. We had just the same
+time to go back to the ship, that we had spent in coming to this point,
+and there is not much to interest one in marching over the same ground a
+second time.
+
+While on our journey north-west, a cheery old woman, who had once been
+beautiful, but whose white hair now contrasted strongly with her dark
+complexion, was working briskly in her garden as we passed. She seemed
+to enjoy a hale, hearty old age. She saluted us with what elsewhere
+would be called a good address; and, evidently conscious that she
+deserved the epithet, "dark but comely," answered each of us with a frank
+"Yes, my child." Another motherly-looking woman, sitting by a well,
+began the conversation by "You are going to visit Muazi, and you have
+come from afar, have you not?" But in general women never speak to
+strangers unless spoken to, so anything said by them attracts attention.
+Muazi once presented us with a basket of corn. On hinting that we had no
+wife to grind our corn, his buxom spouse struck in with roguish glee, and
+said, "I will grind it for you; and leave Muazi, to accompany and cook
+for you in the land of the setting sun." As a rule the women are modest
+and retiring in their demeanour, and, without being oppressed with toil,
+show a great deal of industry. The crops need about eight months'
+attention. Then when the harvest is home, much labour is required to
+convert it into food as porridge, or beer. The corn is pounded in a
+large wooden mortar, like the ancient Egyptian one, with a pestle six
+feet long and about four inches thick. The pounding is performed by two
+or even three women at one mortar. Each, before delivering a blow with
+her pestle, gives an upward jerk of the body, so as to put strength into
+the stroke, and they keep exact time, so that two pestles are never in
+the mortar at the same moment. The measured thud, thud, thud, and the
+women standing at their vigorous work, are associations inseparable from
+a prosperous African village. By the operation of pounding, with the aid
+of a little water, the hard outside scale or husk of the grain is
+removed, and the corn is made fit for the millstone. The meal irritates
+the stomach unless cleared from the husk; without considerable energy in
+the operator, the husk sticks fast to the corn. Solomon thought that
+still more vigour than is required to separate the hard husk or bran from
+wheat would fail to separate "a fool from his folly." "Though thou
+shouldst bray a fool in a mortar among wheat with a pestle, _yet_ will
+not his foolishness depart from him." The rainbow, in some parts, is
+called the "pestle of the Barimo," or gods. Boys and girls, by constant
+practice with the pestle, are able to plant stakes in the ground by a
+somewhat similar action, in erecting a hut, so deftly that they never
+miss the first hole made.
+
+Let any one try by repeatedly jobbing a pole with all his force to make a
+deep hole in the ground, and he will understand how difficult it is
+always to strike it into the same spot.
+
+As we were sleeping one night outside a hut, but near enough to hear what
+was going on within, an anxious mother began to grind her corn about two
+o'clock in the morning. "Ma," inquired a little girl, "why grind in the
+dark?" Mamma advised sleep, and administered material for a sweet dream
+to her darling, by saying, "I grind meal to buy a cloth from the
+strangers, which will make you look a little lady." An observer of these
+primitive races is struck continually with such little trivial touches of
+genuine human nature.
+
+The mill consists of a block of granite, syenite, or even mica schist,
+fifteen or eighteen inches square and five or six thick, with a piece of
+quartz or other hard rock about the size of a half brick, one side of
+which has a convex surface, and fits into a concave hollow in the larger
+and stationary stone. The workwoman kneeling, grasps this upper
+millstone with both hands, and works it backwards and forwards in the
+hollow of the lower millstone, in the same way that a baker works his
+dough, when pressing it and pushing from him. The weight of the person
+is brought to bear on the movable stone, and while it is pressed and
+pushed forwards and backwards, one hand supplies every now and then a
+little grain to be thus at first bruised and then ground on the lower
+stone, which is placed on the slope so that the meal when ground falls on
+to a skin or mat spread for the purpose. This is perhaps the most
+primitive form of mill, and anterior to that in oriental countries, where
+two women grind at one mill, and may have been that used by Sarah of old
+when she entertained the Angels.
+
+On 2nd October we applied to Muazi for guides to take us straight down to
+Chinsamba's at Mosapo, and thus cut off an angle, which we should
+otherwise make, by going back to Kota-kota Bay. He replied that his
+people knew the short way to Chinsamba's that we desired to go, but that
+they all were afraid to venture there, on account of the Zulus, or
+Mazitu. We therefore started back on our old route, and, after three
+hours' march, found some Babisa in a village who promised to lead us to
+Chinsamba.
+
+We meet with these keen traders everywhere. They are easily known by a
+line of horizontal cicatrices, each half an inch long, down the middle of
+the forehead and chin. They often wear the hair collected in a mass on
+the upper and back part of the head, while it is all shaven off the
+forehead and temples. The Babisa and Waiau or Ajawa heads have more of
+the round bullet-shape than those of the Manganja, indicating a marked
+difference in character; the former people being great traders and
+travellers, the latter being attached to home and agriculture. The
+Manganja usually intrust their ivory to the Babisa to be sold at the
+Coast, and complain that the returns made never come up to the high
+prices which they hear so much about before it is sent. In fact, by the
+time the Babisa return, the expenses of the journey, in which they often
+spend a month or two at a place where food abounds, usually eat up all
+the profits.
+
+Our new companions were trading in tobacco, and had collected quantities
+of the round balls, about the size of nine pounder shot, into which it is
+formed. One of them owned a woman, whose child had been sold that
+morning for tobacco. The mother followed him, weeping silently, for
+hours along the way we went; she seemed to be well known, for at several
+hamlets, the women spoke to her with evident sympathy; we could do
+nothing to alleviate her sorrow--the child would be kept until some slave-
+trader passed, and then sold for calico. The different cases of slave-
+trading observed by us are mentioned, in order to give a fair idea of its
+details.
+
+We spent the first night, after leaving the slave route, at the village
+of Nkoma, among a section of Manganja, called Machewa, or Macheba, whose
+district extends to the Bua.
+
+The next village at which we slept was also that of a Manganja smith. It
+was a beautiful spot, shaded with tall euphorbia-trees. The people at
+first fled, but after a short time returned, and ordered us off to a
+stockade of Babisa, about a mile distant. We preferred to remain in the
+smooth shady spot outside the hamlet, to being pent up in a treeless
+stockade. Twenty or thirty men came dropping in, all fully armed with
+bows and arrows, some of them were at least six feet four in height, yet
+these giants were not ashamed to say, "We thought that you were Mazitu,
+and, being afraid, ran away." Their orders to us were evidently inspired
+by terror, and so must the refusal of the headman to receive a cloth, or
+lend us a hut have been; but as we never had the opportunity of realizing
+what feelings a successful invasion would produce, we did not know
+whether to blame them or not. The headman, a tall old smith, with an
+enormous, well-made knife of his own workmanship, came quietly round,
+and, inspecting the shelter, which, from there being abundance of long
+grass and bushes near, our men put up for us in half an hour, gradually
+changed his tactics, and, in the evening, presented us with a huge pot of
+porridge and a deliciously well-cooked fowl, and made an apology for
+having been so rude to strangers, and a lamentation that he had been so
+foolish as to refuse the fine cloth we had offered. Another cloth was of
+course presented, and we had the pleasure of parting good friends next
+day.
+
+Our guide, who belonged to the stockade near to which we had slept,
+declined to risk himself further than his home. While waiting to hire
+another, Masiko attempted to purchase a goat, and had nearly concluded
+the bargain, when the wife of the would-be seller came forward, and said
+to her husband, "You appear as if you were unmarried; selling a goat
+without consulting your wife; what an insult to a woman! What sort of
+man are you?" Masiko urged the man, saying, "Let us conclude the
+bargain, and never mind her;" but he being better instructed, replied,
+"No, I have raised a host against myself already," and refused.
+
+We now pushed on to the east, so as to get down to the shores of the
+Lake, and into the parts where we were known. The country was beautiful,
+well wooded, and undulating, but the villages were all deserted; and the
+flight of the people seemed to have been quite recent, for the grain was
+standing in the corn-safes untouched. The tobacco, though ripe, remained
+uncut in the gardens, and the whole country was painfully quiet: the
+oppressive stillness quite unbroken by the singing of birds, or the
+shrill calls of women watching their corn.
+
+On passing a beautiful village, called Bangwe, surrounded by shady trees,
+and placed in a valley among mountains, we were admiring the beauty of
+the situation, when some of the much dreaded Mazitu, with their shields,
+ran out of the hamlet, from which we were a mile distant. They began to
+scream to their companions to give us chase. Without quickening our pace
+we walked on, and soon were in a wood, through which the footpath we were
+following led. The first intimation we had of the approaching Mazitu was
+given by the Johanna man, Zachariah, who always lagged behind, running
+up, screaming as if for his life. The bundles were all put in one place
+to be defended; and Masiko and Dr. Livingstone walked a few paces back to
+meet the coming foe. Masiko knelt down anxious to fire, but was ordered
+not to do so. For a second or two dusky forms appeared among the trees,
+and the Mazitu were asked, in their own tongue, "What do you want?"
+Masiko adding, "What do you say?" No answer was given, but the dark
+shade in the forest vanished. They had evidently taken us for natives,
+and the sight of a white man was sufficient to put them to flight. Had
+we been nearer the Coast, where the people are accustomed to the slave-
+trade, we should have found this affair a more difficult one to deal
+with; but, as a rule, the people of the interior are much more mild in
+character than those on the confines of civilization.
+
+The above very small adventure was all the danger we were aware of in
+this journey; but a report was spread from the Portuguese villages on the
+Zambesi, similar to several rumours that had been raised before, that Dr.
+Livingstone had been murdered by the Makololo; and very unfortunately the
+report reached England before it could be contradicted.
+
+One benefit arose from the Mazitu adventure. Zachariah, and others who
+had too often to be reproved for lagging behind, now took their places in
+the front rank; and we had no difficulty in making very long marches for
+several days, for all believed that the Mazitu would follow our
+footsteps, and attack us while we slept.
+
+A party of Babisa tobacco-traders came from the N.W. to Molamba, while we
+were there; and one of them asserted several times that the Loapula,
+after emerging from Moelo, received the Lulua, and then flowed into Lake
+Mofu, and thence into Tanganyika; and from the last-named Lake into the
+sea. This is the native idea of the geography of the interior; and, to
+test the general knowledge of our informant, we asked him about our
+acquaintances in Londa; as Moene, Katema, Shinde or Shinte, who live
+south-west of the rivers mentioned, and found that our friends there were
+perfectly well-known to him and to others of these travelled natives. In
+the evening two of the Babisa came in, and reported that the Mazitu had
+followed us to the village called Chigaragara, at which we slept at the
+bottom of the descent. The whole party of traders set off at once,
+though the sun had set. We ourselves had given rise to the report, for
+the women of Chigaragara, supposing us in the distance to be Mazitu,
+fled, with all their household utensils on their heads, and had no
+opportunity afterwards of finding out their mistake. We spent the night
+where we were, and next morning, declining Nkomo's entreaty to go and
+kill elephants, took our course along the shores of the Lake southwards.
+
+We have only been at the Lake at one season of the year: then the wind
+blows strongly from the east, and indeed this is its prevailing direction
+hence to the Orange River; a north or a south wind is rare, and seldom
+lasts more than three days. As the breeze now blew over a large body of
+water, towards us, it was delightful; but when facing it on the table-
+land it was so strong as materially to impede our progress, and added
+considerably to the labour of travelling. Here it brought large
+quantities of the plant (_Vallisneriae_), from which the natives extract
+salt by burning, and which, if chewed, at once shows its saline
+properties by the taste. Clouds of the kungo, or edible midges, floated
+on the Lake, and many rested on the bushes on land.
+
+The reeds along the shores of the Lake were still crowded with fugitives,
+and a great loss of life must since have taken place; for, after the corn
+they had brought with them was expended, famine would ensue. Even now we
+passed many women and children digging up the roots, about the size of
+peas, of an aromatic grass; and their wasted forms showed that this poor
+hard fare was to allay, if possible, the pangs of hunger. The babies at
+the breast crowed to us as we passed, their mothers kneeling and grubbing
+for the roots; the poor little things still drawing nourishment from the
+natural fountain were unconscious of that sinking of heart which their
+parents must have felt in knowing that the supply for the little ones
+must soon fail. No one would sell a bit of food to us: fishermen, even,
+would not part with the produce of their nets, except in exchange for
+some other kind of food. Numbers of newly-made graves showed that many
+had already perished, and hundreds were so emaciated that they had the
+appearance of human skeletons swathed in brown and wrinkled leather. In
+passing mile after mile, marked with these sad proofs that "man's
+inhumanity to man makes countless thousands mourn," one experiences an
+overpowering sense of helplessness to alleviate human woe, and breathes a
+silent prayer to the Almighty to hasten the good time coming when "man
+and man the world o'er, shall brothers be for all that." One small
+redeeming consideration in all this misery could not but be felt; these
+ills were inflicted by heathen Mazitu, and not by, or for, those who say
+to Him who is higher than the highest, "We believe that thou shalt come
+to be our Judge."
+
+We crossed the Mokole, rested at Chitanda, and then left the Lake, and
+struck away N.W. to Chinsamba's. Our companions, who were so much
+oppressed by the rarefied air of the plateau, still showed signs of
+exhaustion, though now only 1300 feet above the sea, and did not recover
+flesh and spirits till we again entered the Lower Shire Valley, which is
+of so small an altitude, that, without simultaneous observations with the
+barometer there and on the sea-coast, the difference would not be
+appreciable.
+
+On a large plain on which we spent one night, we had the company of
+eighty tobacco traders on their way from Kasungu to Chinsamba's. The
+Mazitu had attacked and killed two of them, near the spot where the Zulus
+fled from us without answering our questions. The traders were now so
+frightened that, instead of making a straight course with us, they set
+off by night to follow the shores of the Lake to Tsenga, and then turn
+west. It is the sight of shields, or guns that inspires terror. The
+bowmen feel perfectly helpless when the enemy comes with even the small
+protection the skin shield affords, or attacks them in the open field
+with guns. They may shoot a few arrows, but they are such poor shots
+that ten to one if they hit. The only thing that makes the arrow
+formidable is the poison; for if the poisoned barb goes in nothing can
+save the wounded. A bow is in use in the lower end of Lake Nyassa, but
+is more common in the Maravi country, from six to eight inches broad,
+which is intended to be used as a shield as well as a bow; but we never
+saw one with the mark on it of an enemy's arrow. It certainly is no
+match for the Zulu shield, which is between four and five feet long, of
+an oval shape, and about two feet broad. So great is the terror this
+shield inspires that we sometimes doubted whether the Mazitu here were
+Zulus at all, and suspected that the people of the country took advantage
+of that fear, and, assuming shields, pretended to belong to that nation.
+
+On the 11th October we arrived at the stockade of Chinsamba in Mosapo,
+and had reason to be very well satisfied with his kindness. A paraffin
+candle was in his eyes the height of luxury, and the ability to make a
+light instantaneously by a lucifer match, a marvel that struck him with
+wonder. He brought all his relatives in different groups to see the
+strange sights,--instantaneous fire-making, and a light, without the
+annoyance of having fire and smoke in the middle of the floor. When they
+wish to look for anything in the dark, a wisp of dried grass is lighted.
+
+Chinsamba gave us a great deal of his company during our visits. As we
+have often remarked in other cases, a chief has a great deal to attend to
+in guiding the affairs of his people. He is consulted on all occasions,
+and gives his advice in a stream of words, which show a very intimate
+acquaintance with the topography of his district; he knows every rood
+cultivated, every weir put in the river, every hunting-net, loom, gorge,
+and every child of his tribe. Any addition made to the number of these
+latter is notified to him; and he sends thanks and compliments to the
+parents.
+
+The presents which, following the custom of the country, we gave to every
+headman, where we either spent a night or a longer period, varied from
+four to eight yards of calico. We had some Manchester cloths made in
+imitation of the native manufactured robes of the West Coast, each worth
+five or six shillings. To the more important of the chiefs, for calico
+we substituted one of these strong gaudy dresses, iron spoons, a knife,
+needles, a tin dish, or pannikin, and found these presents to be valued
+more than three times their value in cloth would have been. Eight or ten
+shillings' worth gave abundant satisfaction to the greediest; but this is
+to be understood as the prime cost of the articles, and a trader would
+sometimes have estimated similar generosity as equal to from 30 to 50
+pounds. In some cases the presents we gave exceeded the value of what
+was received in return; in others the excess of generosity was on the
+native side.
+
+We never asked for leave to pass through the country; we simply told
+where we were going, and asked for guides; if they were refused, or if
+they demanded payment beforehand, we requested to be put into the
+beginning of the path, and said that we were sorry we could not agree
+about the guides, and usually they and we started together. Greater care
+would be required on entering the Mazitu or Zulu country, for there the
+Government extends over very large districts, while among the Manganja
+each little district is independent of every other. The people here have
+not adopted the exacting system of the Banyai, or of the people whose
+country was traversed by Speke and Grant.
+
+In our way back from Chinsamba's to Chembi's and from his village to
+Nkwinda's, and thence to Katosa's, we only saw the people working in
+their gardens, near to the stockades. These strongholds were
+strengthened with branches of acacias, covered with strong hooked thorns;
+and were all crowded with people. The air was now clearer than when we
+went north, and we could see the hills of Kirk's Range five or six miles
+to the west of our path. The sun struck very hot, and the men felt it
+most in their feet. Every one who could get a bit of goatskin made it
+into a pair of sandals.
+
+While sitting at Nkwinda's, a man behind the court hedge-wall said, with
+great apparent glee, that an Arab slaving party on the other side of the
+confluence of the Shire and Lake were "giving readily two fathoms of
+calico for a boy, and two and a half for a girl; never saw trade so
+brisk, no haggling at all." This party was purchasing for the supply of
+the ocean slave-trade. One of the evils of this traffic is that it
+profits by every calamity that happens in a country. The slave-trader
+naturally reaps advantage from every disorder, and though in the present
+case some lives may have been saved that otherwise would have perished,
+as a rule he intensifies hatreds, and aggravates wars between the tribes,
+because the more they fight and vanquish each other the richer his
+harvest becomes. Where slaving and cattle are unknown the people live in
+peace. As we sat leaning against that hedge, and listened to the
+harangue of the slave-trader's agent, it glanced across our mind that
+this was a terrible world; the best in it unable, from conscious
+imperfections, to say to the worst "Stand by! for I am holier than thou."
+The slave-trader, imbued no doubt with certain kindly feelings, yet
+pursuing a calling which makes him a fair specimen of a human fiend,
+stands grouped with those by whom the slave-traders are employed, and
+with all the workers of sin and misery in more highly-favoured lands, an
+awful picture to the All-seing Eye.
+
+We arrived at Katosa's village on the 15th October, and found about
+thirty young men and boys in slave-sticks. They had been bought by other
+agents of the Arab slavers, still on the east side of the Shire. They
+were resting in the village, and their owners soon removed them. The
+weight of the goree seemed very annoying when they tried to sleep. This
+taming instrument is kept on, until the party has crossed several rivers
+and all hope of escape has vanished from the captive's mind.
+
+On explaining to Katosa the injury he was doing in selling his people as
+slaves, he assured us that those whom we had seen belonged to the Arabs,
+and added that he had far too few people already. He said he had been
+living in peace at the lakelet Pamalombe; that the Ajawa, or Machinga,
+under Kainka and Karamba, and a body of Babisa, under Maonga, had induced
+him to ferry them over the Shire; that they had lived for a considerable
+time at his expense, and at last stole his sheep, which induced him to
+make his escape to the place where he now dwelt, and in this flight he
+had lost many of his people. His account of the usual conduct of the
+Ajawa quite agrees with what these people have narrated themselves, and
+gives but a low idea of their moral tone. They have repeatedly broken
+all the laws of hospitality by living for months on the bounty of the
+Manganja, and then, by a sudden uprising, overcoming their hosts, and
+killing or chasing them out of their inheritances. The secret of their
+success is the possession of firearms. There were several of these Ajawa
+here again, and on our arrival they proposed to Katosa that they should
+leave; but he replied that they need not be afraid of us. They had red
+beads strung so thickly on their hair that at a little distance they
+appeared to have on red caps. It is curious that the taste for red hair
+should be so general among the Africans here and further north; in the
+south black mica, called _Sebilo_, and even soot are used to deepen the
+colour of the hair; here many smear the head with red-ochre, others plait
+the inner bark of a tree stained red into it; and a red powder called
+_Mukuru_ is employed, which some say is obtained from the ground, and
+others from the roots of a tree.
+
+It having been doubted whether sugar-cane is indigenous to this country
+or not, we employed Katosa to procure the two varieties commonly
+cultivated, with the intention of conveying them to Johanna. One is
+yellow, and the other, like what we observed in the Barotse Valley, is
+variegated with dark red and yellow patches, or all red. We have seen it
+"arrow," or blossom. Bamboos also run to seed, and the people are said
+to use the seed as food. The sugar-cane has native names, which would
+lead us to believe it to be indigenous. Here it is called _Zimbi_,
+further south _Mesari_, and in the centre of the country _Meshuati_.
+Anything introduced in recent times, as maize, superior cotton, or
+cassava, has a name implying its foreign origin.
+
+Katosa's village was embowered among gigantic trees of fine timber:
+several caffiaceous bushes, with berries closely resembling those of the
+common coffee, grew near, but no use had ever been made of them. There
+are several cinchonaceous trees also in the country; and some of the wild
+fruits are so good as to cause a feeling of regret that they have not
+been improved by cultivation, or whatever else brought ours to their
+present perfection. Katosa lamented that this locality was so inferior
+to his former place at Pamalombe; there he had maize at the different
+stages of growth throughout the year. To us, however, he seemed, by
+digging holes, and taking advantage of the moisture beneath, to have
+succeeded pretty well in raising crops at this the driest time. The
+Makololo remarked that "here the maize had no season,"--meaning that the
+whole year was proper for its growth and ripening. By irrigation a
+succession of crops of grain might be raised anywhere within the south
+intertropical region of Africa.
+
+When we were with Motunda, on the 20th October, he told us frankly that
+all the native provisions were hidden in Kirk's Range, and his village
+being the last place where a supply of grain could be purchased before we
+reached the ship, we waited till he had sent to his hidden stores. The
+upland country, beyond the mountains now on our right, is called Deza,
+and is inhabited by Maravi, who are only another tribe of Manganja. The
+paramount chief is called Kabambe, and he, having never been visited by
+war, lives in peace and plenty. Goats and sheep thrive; and Nyango, the
+chieftainess further to the south, has herds of horned cattle. The
+country being elevated is said to be cold, and there are large grassy
+plains on it which are destitute of trees. The Maravi are reported to be
+brave, and good marksmen with the bow; but, throughout all the country we
+have traversed, guns are enabling the trading tribes to overcome the
+agricultural and manufacturing classes.
+
+On the ascent at the end of the valley just opposite Mount Mvai, we
+looked back for a moment to impress the beauties of the grand vale on our
+memory. The heat of the sun was now excessive, and Masiko, thinking that
+it was overpowering, proposed to send forward to the ship and get a
+hammock, in which to carry any one who might knock up. He was truly kind
+and considerate. Dr. Livingstone having fallen asleep after a fatiguing
+march, a hole in the roof of the hut he was in allowed the sun to beat on
+his head, and caused a splitting headache and deafness: while he was
+nearly insensible, he felt Masiko repeatedly lift him back to the bed off
+which he had rolled, and cover him up.
+
+On the 24th we were again in Banda, at the village of Chasundu, and could
+now see clearly the hot valley in which the Shire flows, and the
+mountains of the Manganja beyond to our south-east. Instead of following
+the road by which we had come, we resolved to go south along the
+Lesungwe, which rises at Zunje, a peak on the same ridge as Mvai, and a
+part of Kirk's Range, which bounds the country of the Maravi on our west.
+This is about the limit of the beat of the Portuguese native traders, and
+it is but recently that, following our footsteps, they have come so far.
+It is not likely that their enterprise will lead them further north, for
+Chasundu informed us that the Babisa under-sell the agents from Tette. He
+had tried to deal with the latter when they first came; but they offered
+only ten fathoms of calico for a tusk, for which the Babisa gave him
+twenty fathoms and a little powder. Ivory was brought to us for sale
+again and again, and, as far as we could judge, the price expected would
+be about one yard of calico per pound, or possibly more, for there is no
+scale of prices known. The rule seems to be that buyer and seller shall
+spend a good deal of time in trying to cheat each other before coming to
+any conclusion over a bargain.
+
+We found the Lesungwe a fine stream near its source, and about forty feet
+wide and knee-deep, when joined by the Lekudzi, which comes down from the
+Maravi country.
+
+Guinea-fowl abounded, but no grain could be purchased, for the people had
+cultivated only the holmes along the banks with maize and pumpkins. Time
+enough had not elapsed since the slave-trader's invasion, and destruction
+of their stores, for them to raise crops of grain on the adjacent lands.
+To deal with them for a few heads of maize was the hungry bargaining with
+the famished, so we hastened on southwards as fast as the excessive heat
+would allow us. It was impossible to march in the middle of the day, the
+heat was so intolerable; and we could not go on at night, because, if we
+had chanced to meet any of the inhabitants, we should have been taken for
+marauders.
+
+We had now thunder every afternoon; but while occasional showers seemed
+to fall at different parts, none fell on us. The air was deliciously
+clear, and revealed all the landscape covered everywhere with forest, and
+bounded by beautiful mountains. On the 31st October we reached the
+Mukuru-Madse, after having travelled 660 geographical miles, or 760
+English miles in a straight line. This was accomplished in fifty-five
+travelling days, twelve miles per diem on an average. If the numerous
+bendings and windings, and ups and downs of the paths could have been
+measured too, the distance would have been found at least fifteen miles a
+day.
+
+The night we slept at the Mukuru-Madse it thundered heavily, but, as this
+had been the case every afternoon, and no rain had followed, we erected
+no shelter, but during this night a pouring rain came on. When very
+tired a man feels determined to sleep in spite of everything, and the
+sound of dropping water is said to be conducive to slumber, but that does
+not refer to an African storm. If, when half asleep in spite of a heavy
+shower on the back of the head, he unconsciously turns on his side, the
+drops from the branches make such capital shots into his ear, that the
+brain rings again.
+
+We were off next morning, the 1st of November, as soon as the day dawned.
+In walking about seven miles to the ship, our clothes were thoroughly
+dried by the hot sun, and an attack of fever followed. We relate this
+little incident to point out the almost certain consequence of getting
+wet in this climate, and allowing the clothes to dry on the person. Even
+if we walk in the mornings when the dew is on the grass, and only get our
+feet and legs wet, a very uneasy feeling and partial fever with pains in
+the limbs ensue, and continue till the march onwards bathes them in
+perspiration. Had Bishop Mackenzie been aware of this, which, before
+experience alone had taught us, entailed many a severe lesson, we know no
+earthly reason why his valuable life might not have been spared. The
+difference between getting the clothes soaked in England and in Africa is
+this: in the cold climate the patient is compelled, or, at any rate,
+warned, by discomfort to resort at once to a change of raiment; while in
+Africa it is cooling and rather pleasant to allow the clothes to dry on
+the person. A Missionary in proportion as he possesses an athletic
+frame, hardened by manly exercises, in addition to his other
+qualifications, will excel him who is not favoured with such bodily
+endowments; but in a hot climate efficiency mainly depends on husbanding
+the resources. He must never forget that, in the tropics, he is an
+exotic plant.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV.
+
+
+Confidence of natives--Bishop Tozer--Withdrawal of the Mission party--The
+English leave--Hazardous voyage to Mosambique--Dr. Livingstone's voyage
+to Bombay--Return to England.
+
+We were delighted and thankful to find all those left at the ship in good
+health, and that from the employments in which they had been occupied
+they had suffered less from fever than usual during our absence. My
+companion, Thomas Ward, the steward, after having performed his part in
+the march right bravely, rejoined his comrades stronger than he had ever
+been before.
+
+An Ajawa chief, named Kapeni, had so much confidence in the English name
+that he, with most of his people, visited the ship; and asserted that
+nothing would give his countrymen greater pleasure than to receive the
+associates of Bishop Mackenzie as their teachers. This declaration,
+coupled with the subsequent conduct of the Ajawa, was very gratifying,
+inasmuch as it was clear that no umbrage had been taken at the check
+which the Bishop had given to their slaving; their consciences had told
+them that the course he had pursued was right.
+
+When we returned, the contrast between the vegetation about Muazi's and
+that near the ship was very striking. We had come so quickly down, that
+while on the plateau in latitude 12 degrees S., the young leaves had in
+many cases passed from the pink or other colour they have on first coming
+out to the light fresh green which succeeds it, here, on the borders of
+16 degrees S., or from 150 to 180 miles distant, the trees were still
+bare, the grey colour of the bark predominating over every other hue. The
+trees in the tropics here have a very well-marked annual rest. On the
+Rovuma even, which is only about ten degrees from the equator, in
+September the slopes up from the river some sixty miles inland were of a
+light ashy-grey colour; and on ascending them, we found that the majority
+of the trees were without leaves; those of the bamboo even lay crisp and
+crumpled on the ground. As the sun is usually hot by day, even in the
+winter, this withering process may be owing to the cool nights; Africa
+differing so much from Central India in the fact that, in Africa, however
+hot the day may be, the air generally cools down sufficiently by the
+early morning watches to render a covering or even a blanket agreeable.
+
+The first fortnight after our return to the ship was employed in the
+delightful process of resting, to appreciate which a man must have gone
+through great exertions. In our case the muscles of the limbs were as
+hard as boards, and not an ounce of fat existed on any part of the body.
+We now had frequent showers; but, these being only the earlier rains, the
+result on the rise of the river was but a few inches. The effect of
+these rains on the surrounding scenery was beautiful in the extreme. All
+trace of the dry season was soon obliterated, and hills and mountains
+from base to summit were covered with a mantle of living green. The sun
+passed us on his way south without causing a flood, so all our hopes of a
+release were centred on his return towards the Equator, when, as a rule,
+the waters of inundation are made to flow. Up to this time the rains
+descended simply to water the earth, fill the pools, and make ready for
+the grand overflow for which we had still to wait six weeks. It is of no
+use to conceal that we waited with much chagrin; for had we not been
+forced to return from the highlands west of Nyassa we might have visited
+Lake Bemba; but unavailing regrets are poor employment for the mind; so
+we banished them to the best of our power.
+
+About the middle of December, 1863, we were informed that Bishop
+Mackenzie's successor, after spending a few months on the top of a
+mountain about as high as Ben Nevis in Scotland, at the mouth of the
+Shire, where there were few or no people to be taught, had determined to
+leave the country. This unfortunate decision was communicated to us at
+the same time that six of the boys reared by Bishop Mackenzie were sent
+back into heathenism. The boys were taken to a place about seven miles
+from the ship, but immediately found their way up to us. We told them
+that if they wished to remain in the country they had better so arrange
+at once, for we were soon to leave. The sequel will show their choice.
+
+As soon as the death of Bishop Mackenzie was known at the Cape, Dr. Gray,
+the excellent Bishop there, proceeded at once to England, with a view of
+securing an early appointment of another head to the Mission, which in
+its origin owed so much to his zeal for the spread of the gospel among
+the heathen, and whose interests he had continually at heart. About the
+middle of 1862 we heard that Dr. Gray's efforts had been successful, and
+that another clergyman would soon take the place of our departed friend.
+This pleasing intelligence was exceedingly cheering to the Missionaries,
+and gratifying also to the members of the Expedition. About the
+beginning of 1863 the new Bishop arrived at the mouth of the river in a
+man-of-war, and after some delay proceeded inland. The Bishop of the
+Cape had taken a voyage home at considerable inconvenience to himself,
+for the sole object of promoting this Mission to the heathen; and it was
+somehow expected that the man he would secure would be an image of
+himself; and we must say, that whatever others, from the representations
+that have gone abroad, may think of his character, we invariably found
+Dr. Gray to be a true, warm-hearted promoter of the welfare of his fellow-
+men; a man whose courage and zeal have provoked very many to good works.
+
+It was hoped that the presence of a new head to the Mission would infuse
+new energy and life into the small band of Missionaries, whose ranks had
+been thinned by death; and who, though discouraged by the disasters which
+the slave war and famine had induced, and also dispirited by the
+depressing influences of a low and unhealthy position in the swampy Shire
+Valley, were yet bravely holding out till the much-needed moral and
+material aid should arrive.
+
+We believe that we are uttering the sentiments of many devout members of
+different sections of Christians, when we say, it was a pity that the
+Mission of the Universities was abandoned. The ground had been
+consecrated in the truest sense by the lives of those brave men who first
+occupied it. In bare justice to Bishop Mackenzie, who was the first to
+fall, it must be said, that the repudiation of all he had done, and the
+sudden abandonment of all that had cost so much life and money to secure,
+was a serious line of conduct for one so unversed in Missionary
+operations as his successor, to inaugurate. It would have been no more
+than fair that Bishop Tozer, before winding up the affairs of the
+Mission, should actually have examined the highlands of the Upper Shire;
+he would thus have gratified the associates of his predecessor, who
+believed that the highlands had never had a fair trial, and he would have
+gained from personal observation a more accurate knowledge of the country
+and the people than he could possibly have become possessed of by
+information gathered chiefly on the coast. With this examination, rather
+than with a stay of a few months on the humid, dripping top of misty
+Morambala, we should have felt much more satisfied.
+
+In January, 1864, the natives all confidently asserted that at next full
+moon the river would have its great and permanent flood. It had several
+times risen as much as a foot, but fell again as suddenly. It was
+curious that their observation coincided exactly with ours, that the
+flood of inundation happens when the sun comes overhead on his way back
+to the Equator. We mention this more minutely because, from the
+observation of several years, we believe that in this way the inundation
+of the Nile is to be explained. On the 19th the Shire suddenly rose
+several feet, and we started at once; and stopping only for a short time
+at Chibisa's to bid adieu to the Ajawa and Makololo, who had been
+extremely useful to us of late in supplying maize and fresh provisions,
+we hastened on our way to the ocean. In order to keep a steerage way on
+the "Pioneer," we had to go quicker than the stream, and unfortunately
+carried away her rudder in passing suddenly round a bank. The delay
+required for the repairs prevented our reaching Morambala till the 2nd of
+February.
+
+The flood-water ran into a marsh some miles above the mountain, and
+became as black as ink; and when it returned again to the river emitted
+so strong an effluvium of sulphuretted hydrogen, that one could not
+forget for an instant that the air was most offensive. The natives said
+this stench did not produce disease. We spent one night in it, and
+suffered no ill effects, though we fully expected an attack of fever.
+Next morning every particle of white paint on both ships was so deeply
+blackened, that it could not be cleaned by scrubbing with soap and water.
+The brass was all turned to a bronze colour, and even the iron and ropes
+had taken a new tint. This is an additional proof that malaria and
+offensive effluvia are not always companions. We did not suffer more
+from fever in the mangrove swamps, where we inhaled so much of the heavy
+mousey smell that it was distinguishable in the odour of our shirts and
+flannels, than we did elsewhere.
+
+We tarried in the foul and blackening emanations from the marsh because
+we had agreed to receive on board about thirty poor orphan boys and
+girls, and a few helpless widows whom Bishop Mackenzie had attached to
+his Mission. All who were able to support themselves had been encouraged
+by the Missionaries to do so by cultivating the ground, and they now
+formed a little free community. But the boys and girls who were only
+from seven to twelve years of age, and orphans without any one to help
+them, could not be abandoned without bringing odium on the English name.
+The effect of an outcry by some persons in England, who knew nothing of
+the circumstances in which Bishop Mackenzie was placed, and who certainly
+had not given up their own right of appeal to the sword of the
+magistrate, was, that the new head of the Mission had gone to extremes in
+the opposite direction from his predecessor; not even protesting against
+the one monstrous evil of the country, the slave-trade. We believed that
+we ought to leave the English name in the same good repute among the
+natives that we had found it; and in removing the poor creatures, who had
+lived with Mackenzie as children with a father, to a land where the
+education he began would be completed, we had the aid and sympathy of the
+best of the Portuguese, and of the whole population. The difference
+between shipping slaves and receiving these free orphans struck us as
+they came on board. As soon as permission to embark was given, the rush
+into the boat nearly swamped her--their eagerness to be safe on the
+"Pioneer's" deck had to be repressed.
+
+Bishop Tozer had already left for Quillimane when we took these people
+and the last of the Universities' Missionaries on board and proceeded to
+the Zambesi. It was in high flood. We have always spoken of this river
+as if at its lowest, for fear lest we should convey an exaggerated
+impression of its capabilities for navigation. Instead of from five to
+fifteen feet, it was now from fifteen to thirty feet, or more, deep. All
+the sandbanks and many of the islands had disappeared, and before us
+rolled a river capable, as one of our naval friends thought, of carrying
+a gunboat. Some of the sandy islands are annually swept away, and the
+quantities of sand carried down are prodigious.
+
+The process by which a delta, extending eighty or one hundred miles from
+the sea, has been formed may be seen going on at the present day--the
+coarser particles of sand are driven out into the ocean, just in the same
+way as we see they are over banks in the beds of torrents. The finer
+portions are caught by the returning tide, and, accumulating by
+successive ebbs and flows, become, with the decaying vegetation, arrested
+by the mangrove roots. The influence of the tide in bringing back the
+finer particles gives the sea near the mouth of the Zambesi a clean and
+sandy bottom. This process has been going on for ages, and as the delta
+has enlarged eastwards, the river has always kept a channel for itself
+behind. Wherever we see an island all sand, or with only one layer of
+mud in it, we know it is one of recent formation, and that it may be
+swept away at any time by a flood; while those islands which are all of
+mud are the more ancient, having in fact existed ever since the time when
+the ebbing and flowing tides originally formed them as parts of the
+delta. This mud resists the action of the river wonderfully. It is a
+kind of clay on which the eroding power of water has little effect. Were
+maps made, showing which banks and which islands are liable to erosion,
+it would go far to settle where the annual change of the channel would
+take place; and, were a few stakes driven in year by year to guide the
+water in its course, the river might be made of considerable commercial
+value in the hands of any energetic European nation. No canal or railway
+would ever be thought of for this part of Africa. A few improvements
+would make the Zambesi a ready means of transit for all the trade that,
+with a population thinned by Portuguese slaving, will ever be developed
+in our day. Here there is no instance on record of the natives flocking
+in thousands to the colony, as they did at Natal, and even to the Arabs
+on Lake Nyassa. This keeping aloof renders it unlikely that in
+Portuguese hands the Zambesi will ever be of any more value to the world
+than it has been.
+
+After a hurried visit to Senna, in order to settle with Major Sicard and
+Senhor Ferrao for supplies we had drawn thence after the depopulation of
+the Shire, we proceeded down to the Zambesi's mouth, and were fortunate
+in meeting, on the 13th February, with H.M.S. "Orestes." She was joined
+next day by H.M.S. "Ariel." The "Orestes" took the "Pioneer," and the
+"Ariel" the "Lady Nyassa" in tow, for Mosambique. On the 16th a circular
+storm proved the sea-going qualities of the "Lady of the Lake;" for on
+this day a hurricane struck the "Ariel," and drove her nearly backwards
+at a rate of six knots. The towing hawser wound round her screw and
+stopped her engines. No sooner had she recovered from this shock than
+she was again taken aback on the other tack, and driven stem on towards
+the "Lady Nyassa's" broadside. We who were on board the little vessel
+saw no chance of escape unless the crew of the "Ariel" should think of
+heaving ropes when the big ship went over us; but she glided past our
+bow, and we breathed freely again. We had now an opportunity of
+witnessing man-of-war seamanship. Captain Chapman, though his engines
+were disabled, did not think of abandoning us in the heavy gale, but
+crossed the bows of the "Lady Nyassa" again and again, dropping a cask
+with a line by which to give us another hawser. We might never have
+picked it up, had not a Krooman jumped overboard and fastened a second
+line to the cask; and then we drew the hawser on board, and were again in
+tow. During the whole time of the hurricane the little vessel behaved
+admirably, and never shipped a single green sea. When the "Ariel"
+pitched forwards we could see a large part of her bottom, and when her
+stern went down we could see all her deck. A boat, hung at her stern
+davits, was stove in by the waves. The officers on board the "Ariel"
+thought that it was all over with us: we imagined that they were
+suffering more than we were. Nautical men may suppose that this was a
+serious storm only to landsmen; but the "Orestes," which was once in
+sight, and at another time forty miles off during the same gale, split
+eighteen sails; and the "Pioneer" had to be lightened of parts of a sugar-
+mill she was carrying; her round-house was washed away, and the cabin was
+frequently knee-deep in water. When the "Orestes" came into Mosambique
+harbour nine days after our arrival there, our vessel, not being anchored
+close to the "Ariel," for we had run in under the lee of the fort, led to
+the surmise on board the "Orestes" that we had gone to the bottom.
+Captain Chapman and his officers pronounced the "Lady Nyassa" to be the
+finest little sea-boat they had ever seen. She certainly was a contrast
+to the "Ma-Robert," and did great credit to her builders, Ted and
+Macgregor of Glasgow. We can but regret that she was not employed on the
+Lake after which she was named, and for which she was intended and was so
+well adapted.
+
+What struck us most, during the trip from the Zambesi to Mosambique, was
+the admirable way in which Captain Chapman handled the "Ariel" in the
+heavy sea of the hurricane; the promptitude and skill with which, when we
+had broken three hawsers, others were passed to us by the rapid
+evolutions of a big ship round a little one; and the ready appliance of
+means shown in cutting the hawser off the screw nine feet under water
+with long chisels made for the occasion; a task which it took three days
+to accomplish. Captain Chapman very kindly invited us on board the
+"Ariel," and we accepted his hospitality after the weather had moderated.
+
+The little vessel was hauled through and against the huge seas with such
+force that two hawsers measuring eleven inches each in circumference
+parted. Many of the blows we received from the billows made every plate
+quiver from stem to stern, and the motion was so quick that we had to
+hold on continually to avoid being tossed from one side to the other or
+into the sea. Ten of the late Bishop's flock whom we had on board became
+so sick and helpless that do what we could to aid them they were so very
+much in the way that the idea broke in upon us, that the close packing
+resorted to by slavers is one of the necessities of the traffic. If this
+is so, it would account for the fact that even when the trade was legal
+the same injurious custom was common, if not universal. If, instead of
+ten such passengers, we had been carrying two hundred, with the wind
+driving the rain and spray, as by night it did, nearly as hard as hail
+against our faces, and nothing whatever to be seen to windward but the
+occasional gleam of the crest of a wave, and no sound heard save the
+whistling of the storm through the rigging, it would have been absolutely
+necessary for the working of the ship and safety of the whole that the
+live cargo should all have been stowed down below, whatever might have
+been the consequences.
+
+Having delivered the "Pioneer" over to the Navy, she was towed down to
+the Cape by Captain Forsyth of the "Valorous," and after examination it
+was declared that with repairs to the amount of 300 pounds she would be
+as serviceable as ever. Those of the Bishop's flock whom we had on board
+were kindly allowed a passage to the Cape. The boys went in the
+"Orestes," and we are glad of the opportunity to record our heartfelt
+thanks to Captains Forsyth, Gardner, and Chapman for rendering us, at
+various times, every aid in their power. Mr. Waller went in the
+"Pioneer," and continued his generous services to all connected with the
+Mission, whether white or black, till they were no longer needed; and we
+must say that his conduct to them throughout was truly noble, and worthy
+of the highest praise.
+
+After beaching the "Lady Nyassa" at Caboceira, opposite the house of a
+Portuguese gentleman well known to all Englishmen, Joao da Costa Soares,
+we put in brine cocks, and cleaned and painted her bottom. Mr. Soares
+appeared to us to have been very much vilified in a publication in
+England a few years ago; our experience proved him to be extremely kind
+and obliging. All the members of the Expedition who passed Mosambique
+were unanimous in extolling his generosity and, from the general
+testimony of English visitors in his favour, we very much regret that his
+character was so grievously misrepresented. To the authorities at
+Mosambique our thanks are also due for obliging accommodation; and though
+we differ entirely from the Portuguese officials as to the light in which
+we regard the slave-trade, we trust our exposure of the system, in which
+unfortunately they are engaged, will not be understood as indicating any
+want of kindly feeling and good will to them personally. Senhor Canto e
+Castro, who arrived at Mosambique two days after our departure to take
+the office of Governor-General, was well known to us in Angola. We lived
+two months in his house when he was Commandant of Golungo Alto; and,
+knowing him thoroughly, believe that no better man could have been
+selected for the office. We trust that his good principles may enable
+him to withstand the temptations of his position; but we should be sorry
+to have ours tried in a den of slave-traders with the miserable pittance
+he receives for his support.
+
+While at Mosambique, a species of Pedalia called by Mr. Soares Dadeleira,
+and by the natives--from its resemblance to Gerzilin, or sesamum--"wild
+sesamum," was shown to us, and is said to be well known among native
+nurses as a very gentle and tasteless aperient for children. A few
+leaves of it are stirred in a cup of cold water for eight or nine
+seconds, and a couple of teaspoonfuls of the liquid given as a dose. The
+leaves form a sort of mucilage in the water by longer stirring, which is
+said to have diuretic properties besides.
+
+On the 16th April we steamed out from Mosambique; and, the currents being
+in our favour, in a week reached Zanzibar. Here we experienced much
+hospitality from our countrymen, and especially from Dr. Seward, then
+acting consul and political agent for Colonel Playfair.
+
+Dr. Seward was very doubtful if we could reach Bombay before what is
+called the break of the monsoon took place. This break occurs usually
+between the end of May and the 12th of June. The wind still blows from
+Africa to India, but with so much violence, and with such a murky
+atmosphere, that few or no observations for position can be taken. We
+were, however, at the time very anxious to dispose of the "Lady Nyassa,"
+and, the only market we could reach being Bombay, we resolved to run the
+risk of getting there before the stormy period commenced; and, after
+taking fourteen tons of coal on board, we started on the 30th April from
+Zanzibar.
+
+Our complement consisted of seven native Zambesians, two boys, and four
+Europeans; namely, one stoker, one sailor, one carpenter, whose names
+have been already mentioned, and Dr. Livingstone, as navigator. The
+"Lady Nyassa" had shown herself to be a good sea-boat. The natives had
+proved themselves capital sailors, though before volunteering not one of
+them had ever seen the sea. They were not picked men, but, on paying a
+dozen whom we had in our employment for fifteen months, they were taken
+at random from several hundreds who offered to accompany us. Their wages
+were ten shillings per mensem, and it was curious to observe, that so
+eager were they to do their duty, that only one of them lay down from sea-
+sickness during the whole voyage. They took in and set sail very
+cleverly in a short time, and would climb out along a boom, reeve a rope
+through the block, and come back with the rope in their teeth, though at
+each lurch the performer was dipped in the sea. The sailor and
+carpenter, though anxious to do their utmost, had a week's severe illness
+each, and were unfit for duty.
+
+It is pleasant enough to take the wheel for an hour or two, or even for a
+watch, but when it comes to be for every alternate four hours, it is
+utterly wearisome. We set our black men to steer, showing them which arm
+of the compass needle was to be kept towards the vessel's head, and soon
+three of them could manage very well, and they only needed watching. In
+going up the East Coast to take advantage of the current of one hundred
+miles a day, we would fain have gone into the Juba or Webbe River, the
+mouth of which is only 15 minutes south of the line, but we were too
+shorthanded. We passed up to about ten degrees north of the Equator, and
+then steamed out from the coast. Here Maury's wind chart showed that the
+calm-belt had long been passed, but we were in it still; and, instead of
+a current carrying us north, we had a contrary current which bore us
+every day four miles to the south. We steamed as long as we dared,
+knowing as we did that we must use the engines on the coast of India.
+
+After losing many days tossing on the silent sea, with innumerable
+dolphins, flying-fish, and sharks around us, we had six days of strong
+breezes, then calms again tried our patience; and the near approach of
+that period, "the break of the monsoon," in which it was believed no boat
+could live, made us sometimes think our epitaph would be "Left Zanzibar
+on 30th April, 1864, and never more heard of." At last, in the beginning
+of June, the chronometers showed that we were near the Indian coast. The
+black men believed it was true because we told them it was so, but only
+began to dance with joy when they saw sea-weed and serpents floating
+past. These serpents are peculiar to these parts, and are mentioned as
+poisonous in the sailing directions. We ventured to predict that we
+should see land next morning, and at midday the high coast hove in sight,
+wonderfully like Africa before the rains begin. Then a haze covered all
+the land, and a heavy swell beat towards it. A rock was seen, and a
+latitude showed it to be the Choule rock. Making that a fresh starting-
+point, we soon found the light-ship, and then the forest of masts loomed
+through the haze in Bombay harbour. We had sailed over 2500 miles.
+
+
+
+FOOTNOTES
+
+
+{1} A remedy composed of from six to eight grains of resin of jalap, the
+same of rhubarb, and three each of calomel and quinine, made up into four
+pills, with tincture of cardamoms, usually relieved all the symptoms in
+five or six hours. Four pills are a full dose for a man--one will
+suffice for a woman. They received from our men the name of "rousers,"
+from their efficacy in rousing up even those most prostrated. When their
+operation is delayed, a dessert-spoonful of Epsom salts should be given.
+Quinine after or during the operation of the pills, in large doses every
+two or three hours, until deafness or cinchonism ensued, completed the
+cure. The only cases in which, we found ourselves completely helpless,
+were those in which obstinate vomiting ensued.
+
+{2} The late Mr. Robson.
+
+{3} In 1865, four years after these forebodings were penned, we received
+intelligence that they had all come to pass. Sekeletu died in the
+beginning of 1864--a civil war broke out about the succession to the
+chieftainship; a large body of those opposed to the late chief's uncle,
+Impololo, being regent, departed with their cattle to Lake Ngami; an
+insurrection by the black tribes followed; Impololo was slain, and the
+kingdom, of which, under an able sagacious mission, a vast deal might
+have been made, has suffered the usual fate of African conquests. That
+fate we deeply deplore; for, whatever other faults the Makololo might
+justly be charged with, they did not belong to the class who buy and sell
+each other, and the tribes who have succeeded them do.
+
+{4} It was with sorrow that we learned by a letter from Mr. Moffat, in
+1864, that poor Sekeletu was dead. As will be mentioned further on, men
+were sent with us to bring up more medicine. They preferred to remain on
+the Shire, and, as they were free men, we could do no more than try and
+persuade them to hasten back to their chief with iodine and other
+remedies. They took the parcel, but there being only two real Makololo
+among them, these could neither return themselves alone or force their
+attendants to leave a part of the country where they were independent,
+and could support themselves with ease. Sekeletu, however, lived long
+enough to receive and acknowledge goods to the value of 50 pounds, sent,
+in lieu of those which remained in Tette, by Robert Moffat, jun., since
+dead.
+
+{5} A brother, we believe, of one who accompanied Burke and Willis in the
+famous but unfortunate Australian Expedition.
+
+{6} Genesis, chap. iii., verses 21 and 23, "make coats of skins, and
+clothed them"--"sent him forth from the garden of Eden to till the
+ground" imply teaching. Vide Archbishop Whately's "History of Religious
+Worship." John W. Parker, West Strand, London, 1849.
+
+{7} "In 1854 the native church at Sierra-Leone undertook to pay for
+their primary schools, and thereby effected a saving to the Church
+Missionary Society of 800 pounds per annum. In 1861 the contributions of
+this one section of native Christians had amounted to upwards of 10,000
+pounds."--"Manual of Church Missionary Society's African Missions."
+
+
+
+***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A POPULAR ACCOUNT OF DR.
+LIVINGSTONE'S EXPEDITION TO THE ZAMBESI AND ITS TRIBUTARIES***
+
+
+******* This file should be named 2519.txt or 2519.zip *******
+
+
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/2/5/1/2519
+
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+https://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit:
+https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ https://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
diff --git a/2519.zip b/2519.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bcc4e6e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/2519.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..41bf3bb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #2519 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/2519)
diff --git a/old/zambs10.txt b/old/zambs10.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1913167
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/zambs10.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,12719 @@
+The Project Gutenberg Etext of The Zambesi Expedition by David Livingstone
+#2 in our series by David Livingstone
+
+
+Copyright laws are changing all over the world, be sure to check
+the copyright laws for your country before posting these files!!
+
+Please take a look at the important information in this header.
+We encourage you to keep this file on your own disk, keeping an
+electronic path open for the next readers. Do not remove this.
+
+
+**Welcome To The World of Free Plain Vanilla Electronic Texts**
+
+**Etexts Readable By Both Humans and By Computers, Since 1971**
+
+*These Etexts Prepared By Hundreds of Volunteers and Donations*
+
+Information on contacting Project Gutenberg to get Etexts, and
+further information is included below. We need your donations.
+
+
+A Popular Account of Dr. Livingstone's Expedition to the
+Zambesi and Its Tributaries: And of the Discovery of the
+Lakes Shirwa and Nyassa (1858-1864)
+
+by David Livingstone
+
+February, 2001 [Etext #2519]
+
+
+The Project Gutenberg Etext of The Zambesi Expedition by David Livingstone
+******This file should be named zambs10.txt or zambs10.zip******
+
+Corrected EDITIONS of our etexts get a new NUMBER, zambs11.txt
+VERSIONS based on separate sources get new LETTER, zambs10a.txt
+
+
+This etext was prepared by David Price, email ccx074@coventry.ac.uk
+from the 1894 John Murray edition.
+
+Project Gutenberg Etexts are usually created from multiple editions,
+all of which are in the Public Domain in the United States, unless a
+copyright notice is included. Therefore, we do usually do NOT! keep
+these books in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+We are now trying to release all our books one month in advance
+of the official release dates, leaving time for better editing.
+
+Please note: neither this list nor its contents are final till
+midnight of the last day of the month of any such announcement.
+The official release date of all Project Gutenberg Etexts is at
+Midnight, Central Time, of the last day of the stated month. A
+preliminary version may often be posted for suggestion, comment
+and editing by those who wish to do so. To be sure you have an
+up to date first edition [xxxxx10x.xxx] please check file sizes
+in the first week of the next month. Since our ftp program has
+a bug in it that scrambles the date [tried to fix and failed] a
+look at the file size will have to do, but we will try to see a
+new copy has at least one byte more or less.
+
+
+Information about Project Gutenberg (one page)
+
+We produce about two million dollars for each hour we work. The
+time it takes us, a rather conservative estimate, is fifty hours
+to get any etext selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright
+searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. This
+projected audience is one hundred million readers. If our value
+per text is nominally estimated at one dollar then we produce $2
+million dollars per hour this year as we release thirty-six text
+files per month, or 432 more Etexts in 1999 for a total of 2000+
+If these reach just 10% of the computerized population, then the
+total should reach over 200 billion Etexts given away this year.
+
+The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away One Trillion Etext
+Files by December 31, 2001. [10,000 x 100,000,000 = 1 Trillion]
+This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers,
+which is only ~5% of the present number of computer users.
+
+At our revised rates of production, we will reach only one-third
+of that goal by the end of 2001, or about 3,333 Etexts unless we
+manage to get some real funding; currently our funding is mostly
+from Michael Hart's salary at Carnegie-Mellon University, and an
+assortment of sporadic gifts; this salary is only good for a few
+more years, so we are looking for something to replace it, as we
+don't want Project Gutenberg to be so dependent on one person.
+
+We need your donations more than ever!
+
+
+All donations should be made to "Project Gutenberg/CMU": and are
+tax deductible to the extent allowable by law. (CMU = Carnegie-
+Mellon University).
+
+For these and other matters, please mail to:
+
+Project Gutenberg
+P. O. Box 2782
+Champaign, IL 61825
+
+When all other email fails. . .try our Executive Director:
+Michael S. Hart <hart@pobox.com>
+hart@pobox.com forwards to hart@prairienet.org and archive.org
+if your mail bounces from archive.org, I will still see it, if
+it bounces from prairienet.org, better resend later on. . . .
+
+We would prefer to send you this information by email.
+
+******
+
+To access Project Gutenberg etexts, use any Web browser
+to view http://promo.net/pg. This site lists Etexts by
+author and by title, and includes information about how
+to get involved with Project Gutenberg. You could also
+download our past Newsletters, or subscribe here. This
+is one of our major sites, please email hart@pobox.com,
+for a more complete list of our various sites.
+
+To go directly to the etext collections, use FTP or any
+Web browser to visit a Project Gutenberg mirror (mirror
+sites are available on 7 continents; mirrors are listed
+at http://promo.net/pg).
+
+Mac users, do NOT point and click, typing works better.
+
+Example FTP session:
+
+ftp metalab.unc.edu
+login: anonymous
+password: your@login
+cd pub/docs/books/gutenberg
+cd etext90 through etext99 etext00 etext01
+dir [to see files]
+get or mget [to get files. . .set bin for zip files]
+GET GUTINDEX.?? [to get a year's listing of books, e.g., GUTINDEX.99]
+GET GUTINDEX.ALL [to get a listing of ALL books]
+
+***
+
+**Information prepared by the Project Gutenberg legal advisor**
+
+(Three Pages)
+
+
+***START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN ETEXTS**START***
+Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers.
+They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with
+your copy of this etext, even if you got it for free from
+someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our
+fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement
+disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how
+you can distribute copies of this etext if you want to.
+
+*BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS ETEXT
+By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
+etext, you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept
+this "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive
+a refund of the money (if any) you paid for this etext by
+sending a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person
+you got it from. If you received this etext on a physical
+medium (such as a disk), you must return it with your request.
+
+ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM ETEXTS
+This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm etext, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-
+tm etexts, is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor
+Michael S. Hart through the Project Gutenberg Association at
+Carnegie-Mellon University (the "Project"). Among other
+things, this means that no one owns a United States copyright
+on or for this work, so the Project (and you!) can copy and
+distribute it in the United States without permission and
+without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth
+below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute this etext
+under the Project's "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark.
+
+To create these etexts, the Project expends considerable
+efforts to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain
+works. Despite these efforts, the Project's etexts and any
+medium they may be on may contain "Defects". Among other
+things, Defects may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
+intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged
+disk or other etext medium, a computer virus, or computer
+codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment.
+
+LIMITED WARRANTY; DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES
+But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below,
+[1] the Project (and any other party you may receive this
+etext from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm etext) disclaims all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including
+legal fees, and [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR
+UNDER STRICT LIABILITY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT,
+INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE
+OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE
+POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
+
+If you discover a Defect in this etext within 90 days of
+receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any)
+you paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that
+time to the person you received it from. If you received it
+on a physical medium, you must return it with your note, and
+such person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement
+copy. If you received it electronically, such person may
+choose to alternatively give you a second opportunity to
+receive it electronically.
+
+THIS ETEXT IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS
+TO THE ETEXT OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT
+LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A
+PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
+
+Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or
+the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the
+above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you
+may have other legal rights.
+
+INDEMNITY
+You will indemnify and hold the Project, its directors,
+officers, members and agents harmless from all liability, cost
+and expense, including legal fees, that arise directly or
+indirectly from any of the following that you do or cause:
+[1] distribution of this etext, [2] alteration, modification,
+or addition to the etext, or [3] any Defect.
+
+DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm"
+You may distribute copies of this etext electronically, or by
+disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this
+"Small Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg,
+or:
+
+[1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this
+ requires that you do not remove, alter or modify the
+ etext or this "small print!" statement. You may however,
+ if you wish, distribute this etext in machine readable
+ binary, compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form,
+ including any form resulting from conversion by word pro-
+ cessing or hypertext software, but only so long as
+ *EITHER*:
+
+ [*] The etext, when displayed, is clearly readable, and
+ does *not* contain characters other than those
+ intended by the author of the work, although tilde
+ (~), asterisk (*) and underline (_) characters may
+ be used to convey punctuation intended by the
+ author, and additional characters may be used to
+ indicate hypertext links; OR
+
+ [*] The etext may be readily converted by the reader at
+ no expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent
+ form by the program that displays the etext (as is
+ the case, for instance, with most word processors);
+ OR
+
+ [*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at
+ no additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the
+ etext in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC
+ or other equivalent proprietary form).
+
+[2] Honor the etext refund and replacement provisions of this
+ "Small Print!" statement.
+
+[3] Pay a trademark license fee to the Project of 20% of the
+ net profits you derive calculated using the method you
+ already use to calculate your applicable taxes. If you
+ don't derive profits, no royalty is due. Royalties are
+ payable to "Project Gutenberg Association/Carnegie-Mellon
+ University" within the 60 days following each
+ date you prepare (or were legally required to prepare)
+ your annual (or equivalent periodic) tax return.
+
+WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO?
+The Project gratefully accepts contributions in money, time,
+scanning machines, OCR software, public domain etexts, royalty
+free copyright licenses, and every other sort of contribution
+you can think of. Money should be paid to "Project Gutenberg
+Association / Carnegie-Mellon University".
+
+*END*THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN ETEXTS*Ver.04.29.93*END*
+
+
+
+
+A POPULAR ACCOUNT OF DR. LIVINGSTONE'S EXPEDITION TO THE
+ZAMBESI AND ITS TRIBUTARIES AND THE DISCOVERY OF LAKES
+SHIRWA AND NYASSA 1858-1864
+
+
+
+
+TO THE RIGHT HON. LORD PALMERSTON,
+K.G., G.C.B.
+
+My Lord,
+
+I beg leave to dedicate this Volume to your Lordship, as a tribute
+justly due to the great Statesman who has ever had at heart the
+amelioration of the African race; and as a token of admiration of the
+beneficial effects of that policy which he has so long laboured to
+establish on the West Coast of Africa; and which, in improving that
+region, has most forcibly shown the need of some similar system on
+the opposite side of the Continent.
+
+DAVID LIVINGSTONE.
+
+
+
+NOTICE TO THIS WORK.
+
+
+
+The name of the late Mr. Charles Livingstone takes a prominent place
+amongst those who acted under the leadership of Dr. Livingstone
+during the adventurous sojourn of the "Zambesi Expedition" in East
+Africa. In laying the result of their discoveries before the public,
+it was arranged that Mr. Charles Livingstone should place his
+voluminous notes at the disposal of his brother: they are
+incorporated in the present work, but in a necessarily abridged form.
+
+
+
+PREFACE.
+
+
+
+It has been my object in this work to give as clear an account as I
+was able of tracts of country previously unexplored, with their river
+systems, natural productions, and capabilities; and to bring before
+my countrymen, and all others interested in the cause of humanity,
+the misery entailed by the slave-trade in its inland phases; a
+subject on which I and my companions are the first who have had any
+opportunities of forming a judgment. The eight years spent in
+Africa, since my last work was published, have not, I fear, improved
+my power of writing English; but I hope that, whatever my
+descriptions want in clearness, or literary skill, may in a measure
+be compensated by the novelty of the scenes described, and the
+additional information afforded on that curse of Africa, and that
+shame, even now, in the 19th century, of an European nation,--the
+slave-trade.
+
+I took the "Lady Nyassa" to Bombay for the express purpose of selling
+her, and might without any difficulty have done so; but with the
+thought of parting with her arose, more strongly than ever, the
+feeling of disinclination to abandon the East Coast of Africa to the
+Portuguese and slave-trading, and I determined to run home and
+consult my friends before I allowed the little vessel to pass from my
+hands. After, therefore, having put two Ajawa lads, Chuma and
+Wakatani, to school under the eminent missionary the Rev. Dr. Wilson,
+and having provided satisfactorily for the native crew, I started
+homewards with the three white sailors, and reached London July 20th,
+1864. Mr. and Mrs. Webb, my much-loved friends, wrote to Bombay
+inviting me, in the event of my coming to England, to make Newstead
+Abbey my headquarters, and on my arrival renewed their invitation:
+and though, when I accepted it, I had no intention of remaining so
+long with my kind-hearted generous friends, I stayed with them until
+April, 1865, and under their roof transcribed from my own and my
+brother's journal the whole of this present book. It is with
+heartfelt gratitude I would record their unwearied kindness. My
+acquaintance with Mr. Webb began in Africa, where he was a daring and
+successful hunter, and his continued friendship is most valuable
+because he has seen missionary work, and he would not accord his
+respect and esteem to me had he not believed that I, and my brethren
+also, were to be looked on as honest men earnestly trying to do our
+duty.
+
+The Government have supported the proposal of the Royal Geographical
+Society made by my friend Sir Roderick Murchison, and have united
+with that body to aid me in another attempt to open Africa to
+civilizing influences, and a valued private friend has given a
+thousand pounds for the same object. I propose to go inland, north
+of the territory which the Portuguese in Europe claim, and endeavour
+to commence that system on the East which has been so eminently
+successful on the West Coast; a system combining the repressive
+efforts of H.M. cruisers with lawful trade and Christian Missions--
+the moral and material results of which have been so gratifying. I
+hope to ascend the Rovuma, or some other river North of Cape Delgado,
+and, in addition to my other work, shall strive, by passing along the
+Northern end of Lake Nyassa and round the Southern end of Lake
+Tanganyika, to ascertain the watershed of that part of Africa. In so
+doing, I have no wish to unsettle what with so much toil and danger
+was accomplished by Speke and Grant, but rather to confirm their
+illustrious discoveries.
+
+I have to acknowledge the obliging readiness of Lord Russell in
+lending me the drawings taken by the artist who was in the first
+instance attached to the Expedition. These sketches, with
+photographs by Charles Livingstone and Dr. Kirk, have materially
+assisted in the illustrations. I would also very sincerely thank my
+friends Professor Owen and Mr. Oswell for many valuable hints and
+other aid in the preparation of this volume.
+
+Newstead Abbey,
+April 16, 1865.
+
+
+
+
+THE ZAMBESI AND ITS TRIBUTARIES.
+
+
+
+
+INTRODUCTION.
+
+
+
+Objects of the Expedition--Personal Interest shown by Naval
+Authorities--Members of the Zambesi Expedition.
+
+When first I determined on publishing the narrative of my "Missionary
+Travels," I had a great misgiving as to whether the criticism my
+endeavours might provoke would be friendly or the reverse, more
+particularly as I felt that I had then been so long a sojourner in
+the wilderness, as to be quite a stranger to the British public. But
+I am now in this, my second essay at authorship, cheered by the
+conviction that very many readers, who are personally unknown to me,
+will receive this narrative with the kindly consideration and
+allowances of friends; and that many more, under the genial
+influences of an innate love of liberty, and of a desire to see the
+same social and religious blessings they themselves enjoy,
+disseminated throughout the world, will sympathize with me in the
+efforts by which I have striven, however imperfectly, to elevate the
+position and character of our fellow-men in Africa. This knowledge
+makes me doubly anxious to render my narrative acceptable to all my
+readers; but, in the absence of any excellence in literary
+composition, the natural consequence of my pursuits, I have to offer
+only a simple account of a mission which, with respect to the objects
+proposed to be thereby accomplished, formed a noble contrast to some
+of the earlier expeditions to Eastern Africa. I believe that the
+information it will give, respecting the people visited and the
+countries traversed, will not be materially gainsaid by any future
+commonplace traveller like myself, who may be blest with fair health
+and a gleam of sunshine in his breast. This account is written in
+the earnest hope that it may contribute to that information which
+will yet cause the great and fertile continent of Africa to be no
+longer kept wantonly sealed, but made available as the scene of
+European enterprise, and will enable its people to take a place among
+the nations of the earth, thus securing the happiness and prosperity
+of tribes now sunk in barbarism or debased by slavery; and, above
+all, I cherish the hope that it may lead to the introduction of the
+blessings of the Gospel.
+
+In order that the following narrative may be clearly understood, it
+is necessary to call to mind some things which took place previous to
+the Zambesi Expedition being sent out. Most geographers are aware
+that, before the discovery of Lake Ngami and the well-watered country
+in which the Makololo dwell, the idea prevailed that a large part of
+the interior of Africa consisted of sandy deserts, into which rivers
+ran and were lost. During my journey in 1852-6, from sea to sea,
+across the south intertropical part of the continent, it was found to
+be a well-watered country, with large tracts of fine fertile soil
+covered with forest, and beautiful grassy valleys, occupied by a
+considerable population; and one of the most wonderful waterfalls in
+the world was brought to light. The peculiar form of the continent
+was then ascertained to be an elevated plateau, somewhat depressed in
+the centre, and with fissures in the sides by which the rivers
+escaped to the sea; and this great fact in physical geography can
+never be referred to without calling to mind the remarkable
+hypothesis by which the distinguished President of the Royal
+Geographical Society (Sir Roderick I. Murchison) clearly indicated
+this peculiarity, before it was verified by actual observation of the
+altitudes of the country and by the courses of the rivers. New light
+was thrown on other portions of the continent by the famous travels
+of Dr. Barth, by the researches of the Church of England missionaries
+Krapf, Erkhardt, and Rebman, by the persevering efforts of Dr.
+Baikie, the last martyr to the climate and English enterprise, by the
+journey of Francis Galton, and by the most interesting discoveries of
+Lakes Tanganyika and Victoria Nyanza by Captain Burton, and by
+Captain Speke, whose untimely end we all so deeply deplore. Then
+followed the researches of Van der Decken, Thornton, and others; and
+last of all the grand discovery of the main source of the Nile, which
+every Englishman must feel an honest pride in knowing was
+accomplished by our gallant countrymen, Speke and Grant. The
+fabulous torrid zone, of parched and burning sand, was now proved to
+be a well-watered region resembling North America in its fresh-water
+lakes, and India in its hot humid lowlands, jungles, ghauts, and cool
+highland plains.
+
+The main object of this Zambesi Expedition, as our instructions from
+Her Majesty's Government explicitly stated, was to extend the
+knowledge already attained of the geography and mineral and
+agricultural resources of Eastern and Central Africa--to improve our
+acquaintance with the inhabitants, and to endeavour to engage them to
+apply themselves to industrial pursuits and to the cultivation of
+their lands, with a view to the production of raw material to be
+exported to England in return for British manufactures; and it was
+hoped that, by encouraging the natives to occupy themselves in the
+development of the resources of the country, a considerable advance
+might be made towards the extinction of the slave-trade, as they
+would not be long in discovering that the former would eventually be
+a more certain source of profit than the latter. The Expedition was
+sent in accordance with the settled policy of the English Government;
+and the Earl of Clarendon, being then at the head of the Foreign
+Office, the Mission was organized under his immediate care. When a
+change of Government ensued, we experienced the same generous
+countenance and sympathy from the Earl of Malmesbury, as we had
+previously received from Lord Clarendon; and, on the accession of
+Earl Russell to the high office he has so long filled, we were always
+favoured with equally ready attention and the same prompt assistance.
+Thus the conviction was produced that our work embodied the
+principles, not of any one party, but of the hearts of the statesmen
+and of the people of England generally. The Expedition owes great
+obligations to the Lords of the Admiralty for their unvarying
+readiness to render us every assistance in their power; and to the
+warm-hearted and ever-obliging hydrographer to the Admiralty, the
+late Admiral Washington, as a subordinate, but most effective agent,
+our heartfelt gratitude is also due; and we must ever thankfully
+acknowledge that our efficiency was mainly due to the kind services
+of Admirals Sir Frederick Grey, Sir Baldwin Walker, and all the naval
+officers serving under them on the East Coast. Nor must I omit to
+record our obligations to Mr. Skead, R.N. The Luawe was carefully
+sounded and surveyed by this officer, whose skilful and zealous
+labours, both on that river, and afterwards on the Lower Zambesi,
+were deserving of all praise.
+
+In speaking of what has been done by the Expedition, it should always
+be understood that Dr. Kirk, Mr. Charles Livingstone, Mr. R.
+Thornton, and others composed it. In using the plural number they
+are meant, and I wish to bear testimony to the untiring zeal, energy,
+courage, and perseverance with which my companions laboured;
+undaunted by difficulties, dangers, or hard fare. It is my firm
+belief that, were their services required in any other capacity, they
+might be implicitly relied on to perform their duty like men. The
+reason why Dr. Kirk's name does not appear on the title-page of this
+narrative is, because it is hoped that he may give an account of the
+botany and natural history of the Expedition in a separate work from
+his own pen. He collected above four thousand species of plants,
+specimens of most of the valuable woods, of the different native
+manufactures, of the articles of food, and of the different kinds of
+cotton from every spot we visited, and a great variety of birds and
+insects; besides making meteorological observations, and affording,
+as our instructions required, medical assistance to the natives in
+every case where he could be of any use.
+
+Charles Livingstone was also fully occupied in his duties in
+following out the general objects of our mission, in encouraging the
+culture of cotton, in making many magnetic and meteorological
+observations, in photographing so long as the materials would serve,
+and in collecting a large number of birds, insects, and other objects
+of interest. The collections, being Government property, have been
+forwarded to the British Museum, and to the Royal Botanic, Gardens at
+Kew; and should Dr. Kirk undertake their description, three or four
+years will be required for the purpose.
+
+Though collections were made, it was always distinctly understood
+that, however desirable these and our explorations might be, "Her
+Majesty's Government attached more importance to the moral influence
+that might be exerted on the minds of the natives by a well-regulated
+and orderly household of Europeans setting an example of consistent
+moral conduct to all who might witness it; treating the people with
+kindness, and relieving their wants, teaching them to make
+experiments in agriculture, explaining to them the more simple arts,
+imparting to them religious instruction as far as they are capable of
+receiving it, and inculcating peace and good will to each other."
+
+It would be tiresome to enumerate in detail all the little acts which
+were performed by us while following out our instructions. As a
+rule, whenever the steamer stopped to take in wood, or for any other
+purpose, Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone went ashore to their
+duties: one of our party, who it was intended should navigate the
+vessel and lay down the geographical positions, having failed to
+answer the expectations formed of him, these duties fell chiefly to
+my share. They involved a considerable amount of night work, in
+which I was always cheerfully aided by my companions, and the results
+were regularly communicated to our warm and ever-ready friend, Sir
+Thomas Maclear of the Royal Observatory, Cape of Good Hope. While
+this work was going through the press, we were favoured with the
+longitudes of several stations determined from observed occultations
+of stars by the moon, and from eclipses and reappearances of
+Jupiter's satellites, by Mr. Mann, the able Assistant to the Cape
+Astronomer Royal; the lunars are still in the hands of Mr. G. W. H.
+Maclear of the same Observatory. In addition to these, the
+altitudes, variations of the compass, latitudes and longitudes, as
+calculated on the spot, appear in the map by Mr. Arrowsmith, and it
+is hoped may not differ much from the results of the same data in
+abler bands. The office of "skipper," which, rather than let the
+Expedition come to a stand, I undertook, required no great ability in
+one "not too old to learn:" it saved a salary, and, what was much
+more valuable than gold, saved the Expedition from the drawback of
+any one thinking that he was indispensable to its further progress.
+The office required attention to the vessel both at rest and in
+motion. It also involved considerable exposure to the sun; and to my
+regret kept me from much anticipated intercourse with the natives,
+and the formation of full vocabularies of their dialects.
+
+I may add that all wearisome repetitions are as much as possible
+avoided in the narrative; and, our movements and operations having
+previously been given in a series of despatches, the attempt is now
+made to give as fairly as possible just what would most strike any
+person of ordinary intelligence in passing through the country. For
+the sake of the freshness which usually attaches to first
+impressions, the Journal of Charles Livingstone has been incorporated
+in the narrative; and many remarks made by the natives, which ho put
+down at the moment of translation, will convey to others the same
+ideas as they did to ourselves. Some are no doubt trivial; but it is
+by the little acts and words of every-day life that character is
+truly and best known. And doubtless many will prefer to draw their
+own conclusions from them rather than to be schooled by us.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I.
+
+
+
+Arrival at the Zambesi--Rebel Warfare--Wild Animals--Shupanga--
+Hippopotamus Hunters--The Makololo--Crocodiles.
+
+The Expedition left England on the 10th of March, 1858, in Her
+Majesty's Colonial Steamer "Pearl," commanded by Captain Duncan; and,
+after enjoying the generous hospitality of our friends at Cape Town,
+with the obliging attentions of Sir George Grey, and receiving on
+board Mr. Francis Skead, R.N., as surveyor, we reached the East Coast
+in the following May.
+
+Our first object was to explore the Zambesi, its mouths and
+tributaries, with a view to their being used as highways for commerce
+and Christianity to pass into the vast interior of Africa. When we
+came within five or six miles of the land, the yellowish-green tinge
+of the sea in soundings was suddenly succeeded by muddy water with
+wrack, as of a river in flood. The two colours did not intermingle,
+but the line of contact was as sharply defined as when the ocean
+meets the land. It was observed that under the wrack--consisting of
+reeds, sticks, and leaves.--and even under floating cuttlefish bones
+and Portuguese "men-of-war" (Physalia), numbers of small fish screen
+themselves from the eyes of birds of prey, and from the rays of the
+torrid sun.
+
+We entered the river Luawe first, because its entrance is so smooth
+and deep, that the "Pearl," drawing 9 feet 7 inches, went in without
+a boat sounding ahead. A small steam launch having been brought out
+from England in three sections on the deck of the "Pearl" was hoisted
+out and screwed together at the anchorage, and with her aid the
+exploration was commenced. She was called the "Ma Robert," after
+Mrs. Livingstone, to whom the natives, according to their custom,
+gave the name Ma (mother) of her eldest son. The harbour is deep,
+but shut in by mangrove swamps; and though the water a few miles up
+is fresh, it is only a tidal river; for, after ascending some seventy
+miles, it was found to end in marshes blocked up with reeds and
+succulent aquatic plants. As the Luawe had been called "West Luabo,"
+it was supposed to be a branch of the Zambesi, the main stream of
+which is called "Luabo," or "East Luabo." The "Ma Robert" and
+"Pearl" then went to what proved to be a real mouth of the river we
+sought.
+
+The Zambesi pours its waters into the ocean by four mouths, namely,
+the Milambe, which is the most westerly, the Kongone, the Luabo, and
+the Timbwe (or Muselo). When the river is in flood, a natural canal
+running parallel with the coast, and winding very much among the
+swamps, forms a secret way for conveying slaves from Quillimane to
+the bays Massangano and Nameara, or to the Zambesi itself. The
+Kwakwa, or river of Quillimane, some sixty miles distant from the
+mouth of the Zambesi, has long been represented as the principal
+entrance to the Zambesi, in order, as the Portuguese now maintain,
+that the English cruisers might be induced to watch the false mouth,
+while slaves were quietly shipped from the true one; and, strange to
+say, this error has lately been propagated by a map issued by the
+colonial minister of Portugal.
+
+After the examination of three branches by the able and energetic
+surveyor, Francis Skead, R.N., the Kongone was found to be the best
+entrance. The immense amount of sand brought down by the Zambesi has
+in the course of ages formed a sort of promontory, against which the
+long swell of the Indian Ocean, beating during the prevailing winds,
+has formed bars, which, acting against the waters of the delta, may
+have led to their exit sideways. The Kongone is one of those lateral
+branches, and the safest; inasmuch as the bar has nearly two fathoms
+on it at low water, and the rise at spring tides is from twelve to
+fourteen feet. The bar is narrow, the passage nearly straight, and,
+were it buoyed and a beacon placed on Pearl Island, would always be
+safe to a steamer. When the wind is from the east or north, the bar
+is smooth; if from the south and south-east, it has a heavy break on
+it, and is not to be attempted in boats. A strong current setting to
+the east when the tide is flowing, and to the west when ebbing, may
+drag a boat or ship into the breakers. If one is doubtful of his
+longitude and runs east, he will soon see the land at Timbwe
+disappear away to the north; and coming west again, he can easily
+make out East Luabo from its great size; and Kongone follows several
+miles west. East Luabo has a good but long bar, and not to be
+attempted unless the wind be north-east or east. It has sometimes
+been called "Barra Catrina," and was used in the embarkations of
+slaves. This may have been the "River of Good Signs," of Vasco da
+Gama, as the mouth is more easily seen from the seaward than any
+other; but the absence of the pillar dedicated by that navigator to
+"St. Raphael," leaves the matter in doubt. No Portuguese live within
+eighty miles of any mouth of the Zambesi.
+
+The Kongone is five miles east of the Milambe, or western branch, and
+seven miles west from East Luabo, which again is five miles from the
+Timbwe. We saw but few natives, and these, by escaping from their
+canoes into the mangrove thickets the moment they caught sight of us,
+gave unmistakeable indications that they had no very favourable
+opinion of white men. They were probably fugitives from Portuguese
+slavery. In the grassy glades buffaloes, wart-hogs, and three kinds
+of antelope were abundant, and the latter easily obtained. A few
+hours' hunting usually provided venison enough for a score of men for
+several days.
+
+On proceeding up the Kongone branch it was found that, by keeping
+well in the bends, which the current had worn deep, shoals were
+easily avoided. The first twenty miles are straight and deep; then a
+small and rather tortuous natural canal leads off to the right, and,
+after about five miles, during which the paddles almost touch the
+floating grass of the sides, ends in the broad Zambesi. The rest of
+the Kongone branch comes out of the main stream considerably higher
+up as the outgoing branch called Doto.
+
+The first twenty miles of the Kongone are enclosed in mangrove
+jungle; some of the trees are ornamented with orchilla weed, which
+appears never to have been gathered. Huge ferns, palm bushes, and
+occasionally wild date-palms peer out in the forest, which consists
+of different species of mangroves; the bunches of bright yellow,
+though scarcely edible fruit, contrasting prettily with the graceful
+green leaves. In some spots the Milola, an umbrageous hibiscus, with
+large yellowish flowers, grows in masses along the bank. Its bark is
+made into cordage, and is especially valuable for the manufacture of
+ropes attached to harpoons for killing the hippopotamus. The
+Pandanus or screw-palm, from which sugar bags are made in the
+Mauritius, also appears, and on coming out of the canal into the
+Zambesi many are so tall as in the distance to remind us of the
+steeples of our native land, and make us relish the remark of an old
+sailor, "that but one thing was wanting to complete the picture, and
+that was a 'grog-shop near the church.'" We find also a few guava
+and lime-trees growing wild, but the natives claim the crops. The
+dark woods resound with the lively and exultant song of the
+kinghunter (Halcyon striolata), as he sits perched on high among the
+trees. As the steamer moves on through the winding channel, a pretty
+little heron or bright kingfisher darts out in alarm from the edge of
+the bank, flies on ahead a short distance, and settles quietly down
+to be again frightened off in a few seconds as we approach. The
+magnificent fishhawk (Halietus vocifer) sits on the top of a
+mangrove-tree, digesting his morning meal of fresh fish, and is
+clearly unwilling to stir until the imminence of the danger compels
+him at last to spread his great wings for flight. The glossy ibis,
+acute of ear to a remarkable degree, hears from afar the unwonted
+sound of the paddles, and, springing from the mud where his family
+has been quietly feasting, is off, screaming out his loud, harsh, and
+defiant Ha! ha! ha! long before the danger is near.
+
+Several native huts now peep out from the bananas and cocoa-palms on
+the right bank; they stand on piles a few feet above the low damp
+ground, and their owners enter them by means of ladders. The soil is
+wonderfully rich, and the gardens are really excellent. Rice is
+cultivated largely; sweet potatoes, pumpkins, tomatoes, cabbages,
+onions (shalots), peas, a little cotton, and sugar-cane are also
+raised. It is said that English potatoes, when planted at Quillimane
+on soil resembling this, in the course of two years become in taste
+like sweet potatoes (Convolvulus batatas), and are like our potato
+frosted. The whole of the fertile region extending from the Kongone
+canal to beyond Mazaro, some eighty miles in length, and fifty in
+breadth, is admirably adapted for the growth of sugar-cane; and were
+it in the hands of our friends at the Cape, would supply all Europe
+with sugar. The remarkably few people seen appear to be tolerably
+well fed, but there was a dearth of clothing among them; all were
+blacks, and nearly all Portuguese "colonos" or serfs. They
+manifested no fear of white men, and stood in groups on the bank
+gazing in astonishment at the steamers, especially at the "Pearl,"
+which accompanied us thus far up the river. One old man who came on
+board remarked that never before had he seen any vessel so large as
+the "Pearl," it was like a village, "Was it made out of one tree?"
+All were eager traders, and soon came off to the ship in light swift
+canoes with every kind of fruit and food they possessed; a few
+brought honey and beeswax, which are found in quantities in the
+mangrove forests. As the ships steamed off, many anxious sellers ran
+along the bank, holding up fowls, baskets of rice and meal, and
+shouting "Malonda, Malonda," "things for sale," while others followed
+in canoes, which they sent through the water with great velocity by
+means of short broad-bladed paddles.
+
+Finding the "Pearl's" draught too great for that part of the river
+near the island of Simbo, where the branch called the Doto is given
+off to the Kongone on the right bank, and another named Chinde
+departs to the secret canal already mentioned on the left, the goods
+belonging to the expedition were taken out of her, and placed on one
+of the grassy islands about forty miles from the bar. The "Pearl"
+then left us, and we had to part with our good friends Duncan and
+Skead; the former for Ceylon, the latter to return to his duties as
+Government Surveyor at the Cape.
+
+Of those who eventually did the work of the expedition the majority
+took a sober common-sense view of the enterprise in which we were
+engaged. Some remained on Expedition Island from the 18th June until
+the 13th August, while the launch and pinnace were carrying the goods
+up to Shupanga and Senna. The country was in a state of war, our
+luggage was in danger, and several of our party were exposed to
+disease from inactivity in the malaria of the delta. Here some had
+their first introduction to African life, and African fever. Those
+alone were safe who were actively employed with the vessels, and of
+course, remembering the perilous position of their fellows, they
+strained every nerve to finish the work and take them away.
+
+Large columns of smoke rose daily from different points of the
+horizon, showing that the natives were burning off the immense crops
+of tall grass, here a nuisance, however valuable elsewhere. A white
+cloud was often observed to rest on the head of the column, as if a
+current of hot damp air was sent up by the heat of the flames and its
+moisture was condensed at the top. Rain did not follow, though
+theorists have imagined that in such cases it ought.
+
+Large game, buffaloes, and zebras, were abundant abreast the island,
+but no men could be seen. On the mainland, over on the right bank of
+the river, we were amused by the eccentric gyrations and evolutions
+of flocks of small seed-eating birds, who in their flight wheeled
+into compact columns with such military precision as to give us the
+impression that they must be guided by a leader, and all directed by
+the same signal. Several other kinds of small birds now go in
+flocks, and among others the large Senegal swallow. The presence of
+this bird, being clearly in a state of migration from the north,
+while the common swallow of the country, and the brown kite are away
+beyond the equator, leads to the conjecture that there may be a
+double migration, namely, of birds from torrid climates to the more
+temperate, as this now is, as well as from severe winters to sunny
+regions; but this could not be verified by such birds of passage as
+ourselves.
+
+On reaching Mazaro, the mouth of a narrow creek which in floods
+communicates with the Quillimane river, we found that the Portuguese
+were at war with a half-caste named Mariano alias Matakenya, from
+whom they had generally fled, and who, having built a stockade near
+the mouth of the Shire, owned all the country between that river and
+Mazaro. Mariano was best known by his native name Matakenya, which
+in their tongue means "trembling," or quivering as trees do in a
+storm. He was a keen slave-hunter, and kept a large number of men,
+well armed with muskets. It is an entire mistake to suppose that the
+slave trade is one of buying and selling alone; or that engagements
+can be made with labourers in Africa as they are in India; Mariano,
+like other Portuguese, had no labour to spare. He had been in the
+habit of sending out armed parties on slave-hunting forays among the
+helpless tribes to the north-east, and carrying down the kidnapped
+victims in chains to Quillimane, where they were sold by his brother-
+in-law Cruz Coimbra, and shipped as "Free emigrants" to the French
+island of Bourbon. So long as his robberies and murders were
+restricted to the natives at a distance, the authorities did not
+interfere; but his men, trained to deeds of violence and bloodshed in
+their slave forays, naturally began to practise on the people nearer
+at hand, though belonging to the Portuguese, and even in the village
+of Senna, under the guns of the fort. A gentleman of the highest
+standing told us that, while at dinner with his family, it was no
+uncommon event for a slave to rush into the room pursued by one of
+Mariano's men with spear in hand to murder him.
+
+The atrocities of this villain, aptly termed by the late governor of
+Quillimane a "notorious robber and murderer," became at length
+intolerable. All the Portuguese spoke of him as a rare monster of
+inhumanity. It is unaccountable why half-castes, such as he, are so
+much more cruel than the Portuguese, but such is undoubtedly the
+case.
+
+It was asserted that one of his favourite modes of creating an
+impression in the country, and making his name dreaded, was to spear
+his captives with his own hands. On one occasion he is reported to
+have thus killed forty poor wretches placed in a row before him. We
+did not at first credit these statements, and thought that they were
+merely exaggerations of the incensed Portuguese, who naturally enough
+were exasperated with him for stopping their trade, and harbouring
+their runaway slaves; but we learned afterwards from the natives,
+that the accounts given us by the Portuguese had not exceeded the
+truth; and that Mariano was quite as great a ruffian as they had
+described him. One expects slave-owners to treat their human
+chattels as well as men do other animals of value, but the slave-
+trade seems always to engender an unreasoning ferocity, if not blood-
+thirstiness.
+
+War was declared against Mariano, and a force sent to take him; he
+resisted for a time; but seeing that he was likely to get the worst
+of it, and knowing that the Portuguese governors have small salaries,
+and are therefore "disposed to be reasonable," he went down to
+Quillimane to "arrange" with the Governor, as it is termed here; but
+Colonel da Silva put him in prison, and then sent him for trial to
+Mozambique. When we came into the country, his people were fighting
+under his brother Bonga. The war had lasted six months and stopped
+all trade on the river during that period. On the 15th June we first
+came into contact with the "rebels." They appeared as a crowd of
+well-armed and fantastically-dressed people under the trees at
+Mazaro. On explaining that we were English, some at once came on
+board and called to those on shore to lay aside their arms. On
+landing among them we saw that many had the branded marks of slaves
+on their chests, but they warmly approved our objects, and knew well
+the distinctive character of our nation on the slave question. The
+shout at our departure contrasted strongly with the suspicious
+questioning on our approach. Hence-forward we were recognized as
+friends by both parties.
+
+At a later period we were taking in wood within a mile of the scene
+of action, but a dense fog prevented our hearing the noise of a
+battle at Mazaro; and on arriving there, immediately after, many
+natives and Portuguese appeared on the bank.
+
+Dr. Livingstone, landing to salute some of his old friends among the
+latter, found himself in the sickening smell, and among the mutilated
+bodies of the slain; he was requested to take the Governor, who was
+very ill of fever, across to Shupanga, and just as he gave his
+assent, the rebels renewed the fight, and the balls began to whistle
+about in all directions. After trying in vain to get some one to
+assist the Governor down to the steamer, and unwilling to leave him
+in such danger, as the officer sent to bring our Kroomen did not
+appear, he went into the hut, and dragged along his Excellency to the
+ship. He was a very tall man, and as he swayed hither and thither
+from weakness, weighing down Dr. Livingstone, it must have appeared
+like one drunken man helping another. Some of the Portuguese white
+soldiers stood fighting with great bravery against the enemy in
+front, while a few were coolly shooting at their own slaves for
+fleeing into the river behind. The rebels soon retired, and the
+Portuguese escaped to a sandbank in the Zambesi, and thence to an
+island opposite Shupanga, where they lay for some weeks, looking at
+the rebels on the mainland opposite. This state of inactivity on the
+part of the Portuguese could not well be helped, as they had expended
+all their ammunition and were waiting anxiously for supplies; hoping,
+no doubt sincerely, that the enemy might not hear that their powder
+had failed. Luckily their hopes were not disappointed; the rebels
+waited until a supply came, and were then repulsed after three-and-a-
+half hours' hard fighting. Two months afterwards Mariano's stockade
+was burned, the garrison having fled in a panic; and as Bonga
+declared that he did not wish to fight with this Governor, with whom
+he had no quarrel, the war soon came to an end. His Excellency
+meanwhile, being a disciple of Raspail, had taken nothing for the
+fever but a little camphor, and after he was taken to Shupanga became
+comatose. More potent remedies were administered to him, to his
+intense disgust, and he soon recovered. The Colonel in attendance,
+whom he never afterwards forgave, encouraged the treatment. "Give
+what is right; never mind him; he is very (muito) impertinent:" and
+all night long, with every draught of water the Colonel gave a
+quantity of quinine: the consequence was, next morning the patient
+was cinchonized and better.
+
+For sixty or seventy miles before reaching Mazaro, the scenery is
+tame and uninteresting. On either hand is a dreary uninhabited
+expanse, of the same level grassy plains, with merely a few trees to
+relieve the painful monotony. The round green top of the stately
+palm-tree looks at a distance, when its grey trunk cannot be seen, as
+though hung in mid-air. Many flocks of busy sand-martins, which
+here, and as far south as the Orange River, do not migrate, have
+perforated the banks two or three feet horizontally, in order to
+place their nests at the ends, and are now chasing on restless wing
+the myriads of tropical insects. The broad river has many low
+islands, on which are seen various kinds of waterfowl, such as geese,
+spoonbills, herons, and flamingoes. Repulsive crocodiles, as with
+open jaws they sleep and bask in the sun on the low banks, soon catch
+the sound of the revolving paddles and glide quietly into the stream.
+The hippopotamus, having selected some still reach of the river to
+spend the day, rises out of the bottom, where he has been enjoying
+his morning bath after the labours of the night on shore, blows a
+puff of spray from his nostrils, shakes the water out of his ears,
+puts his enormous snout up straight and yawns, sounding a loud alarm
+to the rest of the herd, with notes as of a monster bassoon.
+
+As we approach Mazaro the scenery improves. We see the well-wooded
+Shupanga ridge stretching to the left, and in front blue hills rise
+dimly far in the distance. There is no trade whatever on the Zambesi
+below Mazaro. All the merchandise of Senna and Tette is brought to
+that point in large canoes, and thence carried six miles across the
+country on men's heads to be reshipped on a small stream that flows
+into the Kwakwa, or Quillimane river, which is entirely distinct from
+the Zambesi. Only on rare occasions and during the highest floods
+can canoes pass from the Zambesi to the Quillimane river through the
+narrow natural canal Mutu. The natives of Maruru, or the country
+around Mazaro, the word Mazaro meaning the "mouth of the creek" Mutu,
+have a bad name among the Portuguese; they are said to be expert
+thieves, and the merchants sometimes suffer from their adroitness
+while the goods are in transit from one river to the other. In
+general they are trained canoe-men, and man many of the canoes that
+ply thence to Senna and Tette; their pay is small, and, not trusting
+the traders, they must always have it before they start. Africans
+being prone to assign plausible reasons for their conduct, like white
+men in more enlightened lands, it is possible they may be good-
+humouredly giving their reason for insisting on being invariably paid
+in advance in the words of their favourite canoe-song, "Uachingere,
+Uachingere Kale," "You cheated me of old;" or, "Thou art slippery
+slippery truly."
+
+The Landeens or Zulus are lords of the right bank of the Zambesi; and
+the Portuguese, by paying this fighting tribe a pretty heavy annual
+tribute, practically admit this. Regularly every year come the Zulus
+in force to Senna and Shupanga for the accustomed tribute. The few
+wealthy merchants of Senna groan under the burden, for it falls
+chiefly on them. They submit to pay annually 200 pieces of cloth, of
+sixteen yards each, besides beads and brass wire, knowing that
+refusal involves war, which might end in the loss of all they
+possess. The Zulus appear to keep as sharp a look out on the Senna
+and Shupanga people as ever landlord did on tenant; the more they
+cultivate, the more tribute they have to pay. On asking some of them
+why they did not endeavour to raise certain highly profitable
+products, we were answered, "What's the use of our cultivating any
+more than we do? the Landeens would only come down on us for more
+tribute."
+
+In the forests of Shupanga the Mokundu-kundu tree abounds; its bright
+yellow wood makes good boat-masts, and yields a strong bitter
+medicine for fever; the Gunda-tree attains to an immense size; its
+timber is hard, rather cross-grained, with masses of silica deposited
+in its substance; the large canoes, capable of carrying three or four
+tons, are made of its wood. For permission to cut these trees, a
+Portuguese gentleman of Quillimane was paying the Zulus, in 1858, two
+hundred dollars a year, and his successor now pays three hundred.
+
+At Shupanga, a one-storied stone house stands on the prettiest site
+on the river. In front a sloping lawn, with a fine mango orchard at
+its southern end, leads down to the broad Zambesi, whose green
+islands repose on the sunny bosom of the tranquil waters. Beyond,
+northwards, lie vast fields and forests of palm and tropical trees,
+with the massive mountain of Morambala towering amidst the white
+clouds; and further away more distant hills appear in the blue
+horizon. This beautifully situated house possesses a melancholy
+interest from having been associated in a most mournful manner with
+the history of two English expeditions. Here, in 1826, poor
+Kirkpatrick, of Captain Owen's Surveying Expedition, died of fever;
+and here, in 1862, died, of the same fatal disease, the beloved wife
+of Dr. Livingstone. A hundred yards east of the house, under a large
+Baobab-tree, far from their native land, both are buried.
+
+The Shupanga-house was the head-quarters of the Governor during the
+Mariano war. He told us that the province of Mosambique costs the
+Home Government between 5000l. and 6000l. annually, and East Africa
+yields no reward in return to the mother country. We met there
+several other influential Portuguese. All seemed friendly, and
+expressed their willingness to assist the expedition in every way in
+their power; and better still, Colonel Nunes and Major Sicard put
+their good-will into action, by cutting wood for the steamer and
+sending men to help in unloading. It was observable that not one of
+them knew anything about the Kongone Mouth; all thought that we had
+come in by the "Barra Catrina," or East Luabo. Dr. Kirk remained
+here a few weeks; and, besides exploring a small lake twenty miles to
+the south-west, had the sole medical care of the sick and wounded
+soldiers, for which valuable services he received the thanks of the
+Portuguese Government. We wooded up at this place with African ebony
+or black wood, and lignum vitae; the latter tree attains an immense
+size, sometimes as much as four feet in diameter; our engineer,
+knowing what ebony and lignum vitae cost at home, said it made his
+heart sore to burn wood so valuable. Though botanically different,
+they are extremely alike; the black wood as grown in some districts
+is superior, and the lignum vitae inferior in quality, to these
+timbers brought from other countries. Caoutchouc, or India-rubber,
+is found in abundance inland from Shupanga-house, and calumba-root is
+plentiful in the district; indigo, in quantities, propagates itself
+close to the banks of the Aver, and was probably at some time
+cultivated, for manufactured indigo was once exported. The India-
+rubber is made into balls for a game resembling "fives," and calumba-
+root is said to be used as a mordant for certain colours, but not as
+a dye itself.
+
+We started for Tette on the 17th August, 1858; the navigation was
+rather difficult, the Zambesi from Shupanga to Senna being wide and
+full of islands; our black pilot, John Scisssors, a serf, sometimes
+took the wrong channel and ran us aground. Nothing abashed, he would
+exclaim in an aggrieved tone, "This is not the path, it is back
+yonder." "Then why didn't you go yonder at first?" growled out our
+Kroomen, who had the work of getting the vessel off. When they spoke
+roughly to poor Scissors, the weak cringing slave-spirit came forth
+in, "Those men scold me so, I am ready to run away." This mode of
+finishing up an engagement is not at all uncommon on the Zambesi;
+several cases occurred, when we were on the river, of hired crews
+decamping with most of the goods in their charge. If the trader
+cannot redress his own wrongs, he has to endure them. The Landeens
+will not surrender a fugitive slave, even to his master. One
+belonging to Mr. Azevedo fled, and was, as a great favour only,
+returned after a present of much more than his value.
+
+We landed to wood at Shamoara, just below the confluence of the
+Shire. Its quartz hills are covered with trees and gigantic grasses;
+the buaze, a small forest-tree, grows abundantly; it is a species of
+polygala; its beautiful clusters of sweet-scented pinkish flowers
+perfume the air with a rich fragrance; its seeds produce a fine
+drying oil, and the bark of the smaller branches yields a fibre finer
+and stronger than flax; with which the natives make their nets for
+fishing. Bonga, the brother of the rebel Mariano, and now at the
+head of the revolted natives, with some of his principal men came to
+see us, and were perfectly friendly, though told of our having
+carried the sick Governor across to Shupanga, and of our having cured
+him of fever. On our acquainting Bonga with the object of the
+expedition, he remarked that we should suffer no hindrance from his
+people in our good work. He sent us a present of rice, two sheep,
+and a quantity of firewood. He never tried to make any use of us in
+the strife; the other side showed less confidence, by carefully
+cross-questioning our pilot whether we had sold any powder to the
+enemy. We managed, however, to keep on good terms with both rebels
+and Portuguese.
+
+Senna is built on a low plain, on the right bank of the Zambesi, with
+some pretty detached hills in the background; it is surrounded by a
+stockade of living trees to protect its inhabitants from their
+troublesome and rebellious neighbours. It contains a few large
+houses, some ruins of others, and a weather-beaten cross, where once
+stood a church; a mound shows the site of an ancient monastery, and a
+mud fort by the river is so dilapidated, that cows were grazing
+peacefully over its prostrate walls.
+
+The few Senna merchants, having little or no trade in the village,
+send parties of trusted slaves into the interior to hunt for and
+purchase ivory. It is a dull place, and very conducive to sleep.
+One is sure to take fever in Senna on the second day, if by chance
+one escapes it on the first day of a sojourn there; but no place is
+entirely bad. Senna has one redeeming feature: it is the native
+village of the large-hearted and hospitable Senhor H. A. Ferrao. The
+benevolence of this gentleman is unbounded. The poor black stranger
+passing through the town goes to him almost as a matter of course for
+food, and is never sent away hungry. In times of famine the starving
+natives are fed by his generosity; hundreds of his own people he
+never sees except on these occasions; and the only benefit derived
+from being their master is, that they lean on him as a patriarchal
+chief, and he has the satisfaction of settling their differences, and
+of saving their lives in seasons of drought and scarcity.
+
+Senhor Ferrao received us with his usual kindness, and gave us a
+bountiful breakfast. During the day the principal men of the place
+called, and were unanimously of opinion that the free natives would
+willingly cultivate large quantities of cotton, could they find
+purchasers. They had in former times exported largely both cotton
+and cloth to Manica and even to Brazil. "On their own soil," they
+declared, "the natives are willing to labour and trade, provided only
+they can do so to advantage: when it is for their interest, blacks
+work very hard." We often remarked subsequently that this was the
+opinion of men of energy; and that all settlers of activity,
+enterprise, and sober habits had become rich, while those who were
+much addicted to lying on their backs smoking, invariably complained
+of the laziness of the negroes, and were poor, proud, and despicable.
+
+Beyond Pita lies the little island Nyamotobsi, where we met a small
+fugitive tribe of hippopotamus hunters, who had been driven by war
+from their own island in front. All were busy at work; some were
+making gigantic baskets for grain, the men plaiting from the inside.
+With the civility so common among them the chief ordered a mat to be
+spread for us under a shed, and then showed us the weapon with which
+they kill the hippopotamus; it is a short iron harpoon inserted in
+the end of a long pole, but being intended to unship, it is made fast
+to a strong cord of milola, or hibiscus, bark, which is wound closely
+round the entire length of the shaft, and secured at its opposite
+end. Two men in a swift canoe steal quietly down on the sleeping
+animal. The bowman dashes the harpoon into the unconscious victim,
+while the quick steersman sweeps the light craft back with his broad
+paddle; the force of the blow separates the harpoon from its corded
+handle, which, appearing on the surface, sometimes with an inflated
+bladder attached, guides the hunters to where the wounded beast hides
+below until they despatch it.
+
+These hippopotamus hunters form a separate people, called Akombwi, or
+Mapodzo, and rarely--the women it is said never--intermarry with any
+other tribe. The reason for their keeping aloof from certain of the
+natives on the Zambesi is obvious enough, some having as great an
+abhorrence of hippopotamus meat as Mahomedans have of swine's flesh.
+Our pilot, Scissors, was one of this class; he would not even cook
+his food in a pot which had contained hippopotamus meat, preferring
+to go hungry till he could find another; and yet he traded eagerly in
+the animal's tusks, and ate with great relish the flesh of the foul-
+feeding marabout. These hunters go out frequently on long
+expeditions, taking in their canoes their wives and children,
+cooking-pots, and sleeping-mats. When they reach a good game
+district, they erect temporary huts on the bank, and there dry the
+meat they have killed. They are rather a comely-looking race, with
+very black smooth skins, and never disfigure themselves with the
+frightful ornaments of some of the other tribes. The chief declined
+to sell a harpoon, because they could not now get the milola bark
+from the coast on account of Mariano's war. He expressed some doubts
+about our being children of the same Almighty Father, remarking that
+"they could not become white, let them wash ever so much." We made
+him a present of a bit of cloth, and he very generously gave us in
+return some fine fresh fish and Indian corn.
+
+The heat of the weather steadily increases during this month
+(August), and foggy mornings are now rare. A strong breeze ending in
+a gale blows up stream every night. It came in the afternoon a few
+weeks ago, then later, and at present its arrival is near midnight;
+it makes our frail cabin-doors fly open before it, but continues only
+for a short time, and is succeeded by a dead calm. Game becomes more
+abundant; near our wooding-places we see herds of zebras, both
+Burchell's and the mountain variety, pallahs (Antelope melampus),
+waterbuck, and wild hogs, with the spoor of buffaloes and elephants.
+
+Shiramba Dembe, on the right bank, is deserted; a few old iron guns
+show where a rebel stockade once stood; near the river above this,
+stands a magnificent Baobab hollowed out into a good-sized hut, with
+bark inside as well as without. The old oaks in Sherwood Forest,
+when hollow, have the inside dead or rotten; but the Baobab, though
+stripped of its bark outside, and hollowed to a cavity inside, has
+the power of exuding new bark from its substance to both the outer
+and inner surfaces; so, a hut made like that in the oak called the
+"Forest Queen," in Sherwood, would soon all be lined with bark.
+
+The portions of the river called Shigogo and Shipanga are bordered by
+a low level expanse of marshy country, with occasional clumps of
+palm-trees and a few thorny acacias. The river itself spreads out to
+a width of from three to four miles, with many islands, among which
+it is difficult to navigate, except when the river is in flood. In
+front, a range of high hills from the north-east crosses and
+compresses it into a deep narrow channel, called the Lupata Gorge.
+The Portuguese thought the steamer would not stem the current here;
+but as it was not more than about three knots, and as there was a
+strong breeze in our favour, steam and sails got her through with
+ease. Heavy-laden canoes take two days to go up this pass. A
+current sweeps round the little rocky promontories Chifura and
+Kangomba, forming whirlpools and eddies dangerous for the clumsy
+craft, which are dragged past with long ropes.
+
+The paddlers place meal on these rocks as an offering to the
+turbulent deities, which they believe preside over spots fatal to
+many a large canoe. We were slily told that native Portuguese take
+off their hats to these river gods, and pass in solemn silence; when
+safely beyond the promontories, they fire muskets, and, as we ought
+to do, give the canoe-men grog. From the spoor of buffaloes and
+elephants it appears that these animals frequent Lupata in
+considerable numbers, and--we have often observed the association--
+the tsetse fly is common. A horse for the Governor of Tette was sent
+in a canoe from Quillimane; and, lest it should be wrecked on the
+Chifura and Kangomba rocks, it was put on shore and sent in the
+daytime through the pass. It was of course bitten by the tsetse, and
+died soon after; it was thought that the AIR of Tette had not agreed
+with it. The currents above Lupata are stronger than those below;
+the country becomes more picturesque and hilly, and there is a larger
+population.
+
+The ship anchored in the stream, off Tette, on the 8th September,
+1858, and Dr. Livingstone went ashore in the boat. No sooner did the
+Makololo recognize him, than they rushed to the water's edge, and
+manifested great joy at seeing him again. Some were hastening to
+embrace him, but others cried out, "Don't touch him, you will spoil
+his new clothes." The five headmen came on board and listened in
+quiet sadness to the story of poor Sekwebu, who died at the Mauritius
+on his way to England. "Men die in any country," they observed, and
+then told us that thirty of their own number had died of smallpox,
+having been bewitched by the people of Tette, who envied them
+because, during the first year, none of their party had died. Six of
+their young men, becoming tired of cutting firewood for a meagre
+pittance, proposed to go and dance for gain before some of the
+neighbouring chiefs. "Don't go," said the others, "we don't know the
+people of this country;" but the young men set out and visited an
+independent half-caste chief, a few miles to the north, named
+Chisaka, who some years ago burned all the Portuguese villas on the
+north bank of the river; afterwards the young men went to Bonga, son
+of another half-caste chief, who bade defiance to the Tette
+authorities, and had a stockade at the confluence of the Zambesi and
+Luenya, a few miles below that village. Asking the Makololo whence
+they came, Bonga rejoined, "Why do you come from my enemy to me? You
+have brought witchcraft medicine to kill me." In vain they protested
+that they did not belong to the country; they were strangers, and had
+come from afar with an Englishman. The superstitious savage put them
+all to death. "We do not grieve," said their companions, "for the
+thirty victims of the smallpox, who were taken away by Morimo (God);
+but our hearts are sore for the six youths who were murdered by
+Bonga." Any hope of obtaining justice on the murderer was out of the
+question. Bonga once caught a captain of the Portuguese army, and
+forced him to perform the menial labour of pounding maize in a wooden
+mortar. No punishment followed on this outrage. The Government of
+Lisbon has since given Bonga the honorary title of Captain, by way of
+coaxing him to own their authority; but he still holds his stockade.
+
+Tette stands on a succession of low sandstone ridges on the right
+bank of the Zambesi, which is here nearly a thousand yards wide (960
+yards). Shallow ravines, running parallel with the river, form the
+streets, the houses being built on the ridges. The whole surface of
+the streets, except narrow footpaths, were overrun with self-sown
+indigo, and tons of it might have been collected. In fact indigo,
+senna, and stramonium, with a species of cassia, form the weeds of
+the place, which are annually hoed off and burned. A wall of stone
+and mud surrounds the village, and the native population live in huts
+outside. The fort and the church, near the river, are the
+strongholds; the natives having a salutary dread of the guns of the
+one, and a superstitious fear of the unknown power of the other. The
+number of white inhabitants is small, and rather select, many of them
+having been considerately sent out of Portugal "for their country's
+good." The military element preponderates in society; the convict
+and "incorrigible" class of soldiers, receiving very little pay,
+depend in great measure on the produce of the gardens of their black
+wives; the moral condition of the resulting population may be
+imagined.
+
+Droughts are of frequent occurrence at Tette, and the crops suffer
+severely. This may arise partly from the position of the town
+between the ranges of hills north and south, which appear to have a
+strong attraction for the rain-clouds. It is often seen to rain on
+these hills when not a drop falls at Tette. Our first season was one
+of drought. Thrice had the women planted their gardens in vain, the
+seed, after just vegetating, was killed by the intense dry heat. A
+fourth planting shared the same hard fate, and then some of the
+knowing ones discovered the cause of the clouds being frightened
+away: our unlucky rain-gauge in the garden. We got a bad name
+through that same rain-gauge, and were regarded by many as a species
+of evil omen. The Makololo in turn blamed the people of Tette for
+drought: "A number of witches live here, who won't let it rain."
+Africans in general are sufficiently superstitious, but those of
+Tette are in this particular pre-eminent above their fellows. Coming
+from many different tribes, all the rays of the separate
+superstitions converge into a focus at Tette, and burn out common
+sense from the minds of the mixed breed. They believe that many evil
+spirits live in the air, the earth, and the water. These invisible
+malicious beings are thought to inflict much suffering on the human
+race; but, as they have a weakness for beer and a craving for food,
+they may be propitiated from time to time by offerings of meat and
+drink. The serpent is an object of worship, and hideous little
+images are hung in the huts of the sick and dying. The
+uncontaminated Africans believe that Morungo, the Great Spirit who
+formed all things, lives above the stars; but they never pray to him,
+and know nothing of their relation to him, or of his interest in
+them. The spirits of their departed ancestors are all good,
+according to their ideas, and on special occasions aid them in their
+enterprises. When a man has his hair cut, he is careful to burn it,
+or bury it secretly, lest, falling into the hands of one who has an
+evil eye, or is a witch, it should be used as a charm to afflict him
+with headache. They believe, too, that they will live after the
+death of the body, but do not know anything of the state of the
+Barimo (gods, or departed spirits).
+
+The mango-tree grows luxuriantly above Lupata, and furnishes a
+grateful shade. Its delicious fruit is superior to that on the
+coast. For weeks the natives who have charge of the mangoes live
+entirely on the fruit, and, as some trees bear in November and some
+in March, while the main crop comes between, fruit in abundance may
+easily be obtained during four months of the year; but no native can
+be induced to plant a mango. A wide-spread superstition has become
+riveted in the native mind, that if any one plants this tree he will
+soon die. The Makololo, like other natives, were very fond of the
+fruit; but when told to take up some mango-stones, on their return,
+and plant them in their own country--they too having become deeply
+imbued with the belief that it was a suicidal act to do so--replied
+"they did not wish to die too soon." There is also a superstition
+even among the native Portuguese of Tette, that if a man plants
+coffee he will never afterwards be happy: they drink it, however,
+and seem the happier for it.
+
+The Portuguese of Tette have many slaves, with all the usual vices of
+their class, as theft, lying, and impurity. As a general rule the
+real Portuguese are tolerably humane masters and rarely treat a slave
+cruelly; this may be due as much to natural kindness of heart as to a
+fear of losing the slaves by their running away. When they purchase
+an adult slave they buy at the same time, if possible, all his
+relations along with him. They thus contrive to secure him to his
+new home by domestic ties. Running away then would be to forsake all
+who hold a place in his heart, for the mere chance of acquiring a
+freedom, which would probably be forfeited on his entrance into the
+first native village, for the chief might, without compunction, again
+sell him into slavery.
+
+A rather singular case of voluntary slavery came to our knowledge: a
+free black, an intelligent active young fellow, called Chibanti, who
+had been our pilot on the river, told us that he had sold himself
+into slavery. On asking why he had done this, he replied that he was
+all alone in the world, had neither father nor mother, nor any one
+else to give him water when sick, or food when hungry; so he sold
+himself to Major Sicard, a notoriously kind master, whose slaves had
+little to do, and plenty to eat. "And how much did you get for
+yourself?" we asked. "Three thirty-yard pieces of cotton cloth," he
+replied; "and I forthwith bought a man, a woman, and child, who cost
+me two of the pieces, and I had one piece left." This, at all
+events, showed a cool and calculating spirit; he afterwards bought
+more slaves, and in two years owned a sufficient number to man one of
+the large canoes. His master subsequently employed him in carrying
+ivory to Quillimane, and gave him cloth to hire mariners for the
+voyage; he took his own slaves, of course, and thus drove a thriving
+business; and was fully convinced that he had made a good speculation
+by the sale of himself, for had he been sick his master must have
+supported him. Occasionally some of the free blacks become slaves
+voluntarily by going through the simple but significant ceremony of
+breaking a spear in the presence of their future master. A
+Portuguese officer, since dead, persuaded one of the Makololo to
+remain in Tette, instead of returning to his own country, and tried
+also to induce him to break a spear before him, and thus acknowledge
+himself his slave, but the man was too shrewd for this; he was a
+great elephant doctor, who accompanied the hunters, told them when to
+attack the huge beast, and gave them medicine to ensure success.
+Unlike the real Portuguese, many of the half-castes are merciless
+slave-holders; their brutal treatment of the wretched slaves is
+notorious. What a humane native of Portugal once said of them is
+appropriate if not true: "God made white men, and God made black
+men, but the devil made half-castes."
+
+The officers and merchants send parties of slaves under faithful
+headmen to hunt elephants and to trade in ivory, providing them with
+a certain quantity of cloth, beads, etc., and requiring so much ivory
+in return. These slaves think that they have made a good thing of
+it, when they kill an elephant near a village, as the natives give
+them beer and meal in exchange for some of the elephant's meat, and
+over every tusk that is brought there is expended a vast amount of
+time, talk, and beer. Most of the Africans are natural-born traders,
+they love trade more for the sake of trading than for what they make
+by it. An intelligent gentleman of Tette told us that native traders
+often come to him with a tusk for sale, consider the price he offers,
+demand more, talk over it, retire to consult about it, and at length
+go away without selling it; next day they try another merchant, talk,
+consider, get puzzled and go off as on the previous day, and continue
+this course daily until they have perhaps seen every merchant in the
+village, and then at last end by selling the precious tusk to some
+one for even less than the first merchant had offered. Their love of
+dawdling in the transaction arises from the self-importance conferred
+on them by their being the object of the wheedling and coaxing of
+eager merchants, a feeling to which even the love of gain is
+subordinate.
+
+The native medical profession is reasonably well represented. In
+addition to the regular practitioners, who are a really useful class,
+and know something of their profession, and the nature and power of
+certain medicines, there are others who devote their talents to some
+speciality. The elephant doctor prepares a medicine which is
+considered indispensable to the hunters when attacking that noble and
+sagacious beast; no hunter is willing to venture out before investing
+in this precious nostrum. The crocodile doctor sells a charm which
+is believed to possess the singular virtue of protecting its owner
+from crocodiles. Unwittingly we offended the crocodile school of
+medicine while at Tette, by shooting one of these huge reptiles as it
+lay basking in the sun on a sandbank; the doctors came to the
+Makololo in wrath, clamouring to know why the white man had shot
+their crocodile.
+
+A shark's hook was baited one evening with a dog, of which the
+crocodile is said to be particularly fond; but the doctors removed
+the bait, on the principle that the more crocodiles the more demand
+for medicine, or perhaps because they preferred to eat the dog
+themselves. Many of the natives of this quarter are known, as in the
+South Seas, to eat the dog without paying any attention to its
+feeding. The dice doctor or diviner is an important member of the
+community, being consulted by Portuguese and natives alike. Part of
+his business is that of a detective, it being his duty to discover
+thieves. When goods are stolen, he goes and looks at the place,
+casts his dice, and waits a few days, and then, for a consideration,
+tells who is the thief: he is generally correct, for he trusts not
+to his dice alone; he has confidential agents all over the village,
+by whose inquiries and information he is enabled to detect the
+culprit. Since the introduction of muskets, gun doctors have sprung
+up, and they sell the medicine which professes to make good marksmen;
+others are rain doctors, etc., etc. The various schools deal in
+little charms, which are hung round the purchaser's neck to avert
+evil: some of them contain the medicine, others increase its power.
+
+Indigo, about three or four feet high, grows in great luxuriance in
+the streets of Tette, and so does the senna plant. The leaves are
+undistinguishable from those imported in England. A small amount of
+first-rate cotton is cultivated by the native population for the
+manufacture of a coarse cloth. A neighbouring tribe raises the
+sugar-cane, and makes a little sugar; but they use most primitive
+wooden rollers, and having no skill in mixing lime with the extracted
+juice, the product is of course of very inferior quality. Plenty of
+magnetic iron ore is found near Tette, and coal also to any amount; a
+single cliff-seam measuring twenty-five feet in thickness. It was
+found to burn well in the steamer on the first trial. Gold is washed
+for in the beds of rivers, within a couple of days of Tette. The
+natives are fully aware of its value, but seldom search for it, and
+never dig deeper than four or five feet. They dread lest the falling
+in of the sand of the river's bed should bury them. In former times,
+when traders went with hundreds of slaves to the washings, the
+produce was considerable. It is now insignificant. The gold-
+producing lands have always been in the hands of independent tribes.
+Deep cuttings near the sources of the gold-yielding streams seem
+never to have been tried here, as in California and Australia, nor
+has any machinery been used save common wooden basins for washing.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II.
+
+
+
+Kebrabasa Rapids--Tette--African fever--Exploration of the Shire--
+Discovery of Lake Shirwa.
+
+Our curiosity had been so much excited by the reports we had heard of
+the Kebrabasa rapids, that we resolved to make a short examination of
+them, and seized the opportunity of the Zambesi being unusually low,
+to endeavour to ascertain their character while uncovered by the
+water. We reached them on the 9th of November. The country between
+Tette and Panda Mokua, where navigation ends, is well wooded and
+hilly on both banks. Panda Mokua is a hill two miles below the
+rapids, capped with dolomite containing copper ore.
+
+Conspicuous among the trees, for its gigantic size, and bark coloured
+exactly like Egyptian syenite, is the burly Baobab. It often makes
+the other trees of the forest look like mere bushes in comparison. A
+hollow one, already mentioned, is 74 feet in circumference, another
+was 84, and some have been found on the West Coast which measure 100
+feet. The lofty range of Kebrabasa, consisting chiefly of conical
+hills, covered with scraggy trees, crosses the Zambesi, and confines
+it within a narrow, rough, and rocky dell of about a quarter of a
+mile in breadth; over this, which may be called the flood-bed of the
+river, large masses of rock are huddled in indescribable confusion.
+The drawing, for the use of which, and of others, our thanks are due
+to Lord Russell, conveys but a faint idea of the scene, inasmuch as
+the hills which confine the river do not appear in the sketch. The
+chief rock is syenite, some portions of which have a beautiful blue
+tinge like lapis lazuli diffused through them; others are grey.
+Blocks of granite also abound, of a pinkish tinge; and these with
+metamorphic rocks, contorted, twisted, and thrown into every
+conceivable position, afford a picture of dislocation or
+unconformability which would gladden a geological lecturer's heart;
+but at high flood this rough channel is all smoothed over, and it
+then conforms well with the river below it, which is half a mile
+wide. In the dry season the stream runs at the bottom of a narrow
+and deep groove, whose sides are polished and fluted by the boiling
+action of the water in flood, like the rims of ancient Eastern wells
+by the draw-ropes. The breadth of the groove is often not more than
+from forty to sixty yards, and it has some sharp turnings, double
+channels, and little cataracts in it. As we steamed up, the masts of
+the "Ma Robert," though some thirty feet high, did not reach the
+level of the flood-channel above, and the man in the chains sung out,
+"No bottom at ten fathoms." Huge pot-holes, as large as draw-wells,
+had been worn in the sides, and were so deep that in some instances,
+when protected from the sun by overhanging boulders, the water in
+them was quite cool. Some of these holes had been worn right
+through, and only the side next the rock remained; while the sides of
+the groove of the flood-channel were polished as smooth as if they
+had gone through the granite-mills of Aberdeen. The pressure of the
+water must be enormous to produce this polish. It had wedged round
+pebbles into chinks and crannies of the rocks so firmly that, though
+they looked quite loose, they could not be moved except with a
+hammer. The mighty power of the water here seen gave us an idea of
+what is going on in thousands of cataracts in the world. All the
+information we had been able to obtain from our Portuguese friends
+amounted to this, that some three or four detached rocks jutted out
+of the river in Kebrabasa, which, though dangerous to the cumbersome
+native canoes, could be easily passed by a steamer, and that if one
+or two of these obstructions were blasted away with gunpowder, no
+difficulty would hereafter be experienced. After we had painfully
+explored seven or eight miles of the rapid, we returned to the vessel
+satisfied that much greater labour was requisite for the mere
+examination of the cataracts than our friends supposed necessary to
+remove them; we therefore went down the river for fresh supplies, and
+made preparation for a more serious survey of this region.
+
+The steamer having returned from the bar, we set out on the 22nd of
+November to examine the rapids of Kebrabasa. We reached the foot of
+the hills again, late in the afternoon of the 24th, and anchored in
+the stream. Canoe-men never sleep on the river, but always spend the
+night on shore. The natives on the right bank, in the country called
+Shidima, who are Banyai, and even at this short distance from Tette,
+independent, and accustomed to lord it over Portuguese traders,
+wondered what could be our object in remaining afloat, and were
+naturally suspicious at our departing from the universal custom.
+
+They hailed us from the bank in the evening with "Why don't you come
+and sleep onshore like other people?"
+
+The answer they received from our Makololo, who now felt as
+independent as the Banyai, was, "We are held to the bottom with iron;
+you may see we are not like your Bazungu."
+
+This hint, a little amplified, saved us from the usual exactions. It
+is pleasant to give a present, but that pleasure the Banyai usually
+deny to strangers by making it a fine, and demanding it in such a
+supercilious way, that only a sorely cowed trader could bear it.
+They often refuse to touch what is offered--throw it down and leave
+it--sneer at the trader's slaves, and refuse a passage until the
+tribute is raised to the utmost extent of his means.
+
+Leaving the steamer next morning, we proceeded on foot, accompanied
+by a native Portuguese and his men and a dozen Makololo, who carried
+our baggage. The morning was pleasant, the hills on our right
+furnished for a time a delightful shade; but before long the path
+grew frightfully rough, and the hills no longer shielded us from the
+blazing sun. Scarcely a vestige of a track was now visible; and,
+indeed, had not our guide assured us to the contrary, we should have
+been innocent of even the suspicion of a way along the patches of
+soft yielding sand, and on the great rocks over which we so painfully
+clambered. These rocks have a singular appearance, from being
+dislocated and twisted in every direction, and covered with a thin
+black glaze, as if highly polished and coated with lamp-black
+varnish. This seems to have been deposited while the river was in
+flood, for it covers only those rocks which lie between the highest
+water-mark and a line about four feet above the lowest. Travellers
+who have visited the rapids of the Orinoco and the Congo say that the
+rocks there have a similar appearance, and it is attributed to some
+deposit from the water, formed only when the current is strong. This
+may account for it in part here, as it prevails only where the narrow
+river is confined between masses of rock, backed by high hills, and
+where the current in floods is known to be the strongest; and it does
+not exist where the rocks are only on one side, with a sandy beach
+opposite, and a broad expanse of river between. The hot rocks burnt
+the thick soles of our men's feet, and sorely fatigued ourselves.
+Our first day's march did not exceed four miles in a straight line,
+and that we found more than enough to be pleasant.
+
+The state of insecurity in which the Badema tribe live is indicated
+by the habit of hiding their provisions in the hills, and keeping
+only a small quantity in their huts; they strip a particular species
+of tree of its bitter bark, to which both mice and monkeys are known
+to have an antipathy, and, turning the bark inside out, sew it into
+cylindrical vessels for their grain, and bury them in holes and in
+crags on the wooded hill-sides. By this means, should a marauding
+party plunder their huts, they save a supply of corn. They "could
+give us no information, and they had no food; Chisaka's men had
+robbed them a few weeks before."
+
+"Never mind," said our native Portuguese, "they will sell you plenty
+when you return, they are afraid of you now, as yet they do not know
+who you are." We slept under trees in the open air, and suffered no
+inconvenience from either mosquitoes or dew: and no prowling wild
+beast troubled us; though one evening, while we were here, a native
+sitting with some others on the opposite bank was killed by a
+leopard.
+
+One of the Tette slaves, who wished to be considered a great
+traveller, gave us, as we sat by our evening fire, an interesting
+account of a strange race of men whom he had seen in the interior;
+they were only three feet high, and had horns growing out of their
+heads; they lived in a large town and had plenty of food. The
+Makololo pooh-poohed this story, and roundly told the narrator that
+he was telling a downright lie. "WE come from the interior," cried
+out a tall fellow, measuring some six feet four, "are WE dwarfs? have
+WE horns on our heads?" and thus they laughed the fellow to scorn.
+But he still stoutly maintained that he had seen these little people,
+and had actually been in their town; thus making himself the hero of
+the traditional story, which before and since the time of Herodotus
+has, with curious persistency, clung to the native mind. The mere
+fact that such absurd notions are permanent, even in the entire
+absence of literature, invests the religious ideas of these people
+also with importance, as fragments of the wreck of the primitive
+faith floating down the stream of time.
+
+We waded across the rapid Luia, which took us up to the waist, and
+was about forty yards wide. The water was discoloured at the time,
+and we were not without apprehension that a crocodile might chance to
+fancy a white man for dinner. Next day one of the men crawled over
+the black rocks to within ten yards of a sleeping hippopotamus, and
+shot him through the brain. The weather being warm, the body floated
+in a few hours, and some of us had our first trial of hippopotamus
+flesh. It is a cross-grained meat, something between pork and beef,-
+-pretty good food when one is hungry and can get nothing better.
+When we reached the foot of the mountain named Chipereziwa, whose
+perpendicular rocky sides are clothed with many-coloured lichens, our
+Portuguese companion informed us there were no more obstructions to
+navigation, the river being all smooth above; he had hunted there and
+knew it well. Supposing that the object of our trip was accomplished
+we turned back; but two natives, who came to our camp at night,
+assured us that a cataract, called Morumbwa, did still exist in
+front. Drs. Livingstone and Kirk then decided to go forward with
+three Makololo and settle the question for themselves. It was as
+tough a bit of travel as they ever had in Africa, and after some
+painful marching the Badema guides refused to go further; "the
+Banyai," they said, "would be angry if they showed white men the
+country; and there was besides no practicable approach to the spot,
+neither elephant, nor hippopotamus, nor even a crocodile could reach
+the cataract." The slopes of the mountains on each side of the
+river, now not 300 yards wide, and without the flattish flood-channel
+and groove, were more than 3000 feet from the sky-line down, and were
+covered either with dense thornbush or huge black boulders; this deep
+trough-like shape caused the sun's rays to converge as into a focus,
+making the surface so hot that the soles of the feet of the Makololo
+became blistered. Around, and up and down, the party clambered among
+these heated blocks, at a pace not exceeding a mile an hour; the
+strain upon the muscles in jumping from crag to boulder, and
+wriggling round projections, took an enormous deal out of them, and
+they were often glad to cower in the shadow formed by one rock
+overhanging and resting on another; the shelter induced the
+peculiarly strong and overpowering inclination to sleep, which too
+much sun sometimes causes. This sleep is curative of what may be
+incipient sunstroke: in its first gentle touches, it caused the
+dream to flit over the boiling brain, that they had become lunatics
+and had been sworn in as members of the Alpine club; and then it
+became so heavy that it made them feel as if a portion of existence
+had been cut out from their lives. The sun is excessively hot, and
+feels sharp in Africa; but, probably from the greater dryness of the
+atmosphere, we never heard of a single case of sunstroke, so common
+in India. The Makololo told Dr. Livingstone they "always thought he
+had a heart, but now they believed he had none," and tried to
+persuade Dr. Kirk to return, on the ground that it must be evident
+that, in attempting to go where no living foot could tread, his
+leader had given unmistakeable signs of having gone mad. All their
+efforts of persuasion, however, were lost upon Dr. Kirk, as he had
+not yet learned their language, and his leader, knowing his companion
+to be equally anxious with himself to solve the problem of the
+navigableness of Kebrabasa, was not at pains to enlighten him. At
+one part a bare mountain spur barred the way, and had to be
+surmounted by a perilous and circuitous route, along which the crags
+were so hot that it was scarcely possible for the hand to hold on
+long enough to ensure safety in the passage; and had the foremost of
+the party lost his hold, he would have hurled all behind him into the
+river at the foot of the promontory; yet in this wild hot region, as
+they descended again to the river, they met a fisherman casting his
+hand-net into the boiling eddies, and he pointed out the cataract of
+Morumbwa; within an hour they were trying to measure it from an
+overhanging rock, at a height of about one hundred feet. When you
+stand facing the cataract, on the north bank, you see that it is
+situated in a sudden bend of the river, which is flowing in a short
+curve; the river above it is jammed between two mountains in a
+channel with perpendicular sides, and less than fifty yards wide; one
+or two masses of rock jut out, and then there is a sloping fall of
+perhaps twenty feet in a distance of thirty yards. It would stop all
+navigation, except during the highest floods; the rocks showed that
+the water then rises upwards of eighty feet perpendicularly.
+
+Still keeping the position facing the cataract, on its right side
+rises Mount Morumbwa from 2000 to 3000 feet high, which gives the
+name to the spot. On the left of the cataract stands a noticeable
+mountain which may be called onion-shaped, for it is partly conical
+and a large concave flake has peeled off, as granite often does, and
+left a broad, smooth convex face as if it were an enormous bulb.
+These two mountains extend their bases northwards about half a mile,
+and the river in that distance, still very narrow, is smooth, with a
+few detached rocks standing out from its bed. They climbed as high
+up the base of Mount Morumbwa, which touches the cataract, as they
+required. The rocks were all water-worn and smooth, with huge
+potholes, even at 100 feet above low water. When at a later period
+they climbed up the north-western base of this same mountain, the
+familiar face of the onion-shaped one opposite was at once
+recognised; one point of view on the talus of Mount Morumbwa was not
+more than 700 or 800 yards distant from the other, and they then
+completed the survey of Kebrabasa from end to end.
+
+They did not attempt to return by the way they came, but scaled the
+slope of the mountain on the north. It took them three hours' hard
+labour in cutting their way up through the dense thornbush which
+covered the ascent. The face of the slope was often about an angle
+of 70 degrees, yet their guide Shokumbenla, whose hard, horny soles,
+resembling those of elephants, showed that he was accustomed to this
+rough and hot work, carried a pot of water for them nearly all the
+way up. They slept that night at a well in a tufaceous rock on the
+N.W. of Chipereziwa, and never was sleep more sweet.
+
+A band of native musicians came to our camp one evening, on our own
+way down, and treated us with their wild and not unpleasant music on
+the Marimba, an instrument formed of bars of hard wood of varying
+breadth and thickness, laid on different-sized hollow calabashes, and
+tuned to give the notes; a few pieces of cloth pleased them, and they
+passed on.
+
+The rainy season of Tette differs a little from that of some of the
+other intertropical regions; the quantity of rain-fall being
+considerably less. It begins in November and ends in April. During
+our first season in that place, only a little over nineteen inches of
+rain fell. In an average year, and when the crops are good, the fall
+amounts to about thirty-five inches. On many days it does not rain
+at all, and rarely is it wet all day; some days have merely a passing
+shower, preceded and followed by hot sunshine; occasionally an
+interval of a week, or even a fortnight, passes without a drop of
+rain, and then the crops suffer from the sun. These partial droughts
+happen in December and January. The heat appears to increase to a
+certain point in the different latitudes so as to necessitate a
+change, by some law similar to that which regulates the intense cold
+in other countries. After several days of progressive heat here, on
+the hottest of which the thermometer probably reaches 103 degrees in
+the shade, a break occurs in the weather, and a thunderstorm cools
+the air for a time. At Kuruman, when the thermometer stood above 84
+degrees, rain might be expected; at Kolobeng, the point at which we
+looked for a storm was 96 degrees. The Zambesi is in flood twice in
+the course of the year; the first flood, a partial one, attains its
+greatest height about the end of December or beginning of January;
+the second, and greatest, occurs after the river inundates the
+interior, in a manner similar to the overflow of the Nile, this rise
+not taking place at Tette until March. The Portuguese say that the
+greatest height which the March floods attain is thirty feet at
+Tette, and this happens only about every fourth year; their
+observations, however, have never been very accurate on anything but
+ivory, and they have in this case trusted to memory alone. The only
+fluviometer at Tette, or anywhere else on the river, was set up at
+our suggestion; and the first flood was at its greatest height of
+thirteen feet six inches on the 17th January, 1859, and then
+gradually fell a few feet, until succeeded by the greater flood of
+March. The river rises suddenly, the water is highly discoloured and
+impure, and there is a four-knot current in many places; but in a day
+or two after the first rush of waters is passed, the current becomes
+more equally spread over the whole bed of the river, and resumes its
+usual rate in the channel, although continuing in flood. The Zambesi
+water at other times is almost chemically pure, and the photographer
+would find that it is nearly as good as distilled water for the
+nitrate of silver bath.
+
+A third visit to Kebrabasa was made for the purpose of ascertaining
+whether it might be navigable when the Zambesi was in flood, the
+chief point of interest being of course Morumbwa; it was found that
+the rapids observed in our first trip had disappeared, and that while
+they were smoothed over, in a few places the current had increased in
+strength. As the river fell rapidly while we were on the journey,
+the cataract of Morumbwa did not differ materially from what it was
+when discovered. Some fishermen assured us that it was not visible
+when the river was at its fullest, and that the current was then not
+very strong. On this occasion we travelled on the right bank, and
+found it, with the additional inconvenience of rain, as rough and
+fatiguing as the left had been. Our progress was impeded by the tall
+wet grass and dripping boughs, and consequent fever. During the
+earlier part of the journey we came upon a few deserted hamlets only;
+but at last in a pleasant valley we met some of the people of the
+country, who were miserably poor and hungry. The women were
+gathering wild fruits in the woods. A young man having consented for
+two yards of cotton cloth to show us a short path to the cataract led
+us up a steep hill to a village perched on the edge of one of its
+precipices; a thunderstorm coming on at the time, the headman invited
+us to take shelter in a hut until it had passed. Our guide having
+informed him of what he knew and conceived to be our object, was
+favoured in return with a long reply in well-sounding blank verse; at
+the end of every line the guide, who listened with deep attention,
+responded with a grunt, which soon became so ludicrous that our men
+burst into a loud laugh. Neither the poet nor the responsive guide
+took the slightest notice of their rudeness, but kept on as
+energetically as ever to the end. The speech, or more probably our
+bad manners, made some impression on our guide, for he declined,
+although offered double pay, to go any further.
+
+A great deal of fever comes in with March and April; in March, if
+considerable intervals take place between the rainy days, and in
+April always, for then large surfaces of mud and decaying vegetation
+are exposed to the hot sun. In general an attack does not continue
+long, but it pulls one down quickly; though when the fever is checked
+the strength is as quickly restored. It had long been observed that
+those who were stationed for any length of time in one spot, and
+lived sedentary lives, suffered more from fever than others who moved
+about and had both mind and body occupied; but we could not all go in
+the small vessel when she made her trips, during which the change of
+place and scenery proved so conducive to health; and some of us were
+obliged to remain in charge of the expedition's property, making
+occasional branch trips to examine objects of interest in the
+vicinity. Whatever may be the cause of the fever, we observed that
+all were often affected at the same time, as if from malaria. This
+was particularly the case during a north wind: it was at first
+commonly believed that a daily dose of quinine would prevent the
+attack. For a number of months all our men, except two, took quinine
+regularly every morning. The fever some times attacked the believers
+in quinine, while the unbelievers in its prophylactic powers escaped.
+Whether we took it daily, or omitted it altogether for months, made
+no difference; the fever was impartial, and seized us on the days of
+quinine as regularly and as severely as when it remained undisturbed
+in the medicine chest, and we finally abandoned the use of it as a
+prophylactic altogether. The best preventive against fever is plenty
+of interesting work to do, and abundance of wholesome food to eat.
+To a man well housed and clothed, who enjoys these advantages, the
+fever at Tette will not prove a more formidable enemy than a common
+cold; but let one of these be wanting--let him be indolent, or guilty
+of excesses in eating or drinking, or have poor, scanty fare,--and
+the fever will probably become a more serious matter. It is of a
+milder type at Tette than at Quillimane or on the low sea-coast; and,
+as in this part of Africa one is as liable to fever as to colds in
+England, it would be advisable for strangers always to hasten from
+the coast to the high lands, in order that when the seizure does take
+place, it may be of the mildest type. Although quinine was not found
+to be a preventive, except possibly in the way of acting as a tonic,
+and rendering the system more able to resist the influence of
+malaria, it was found invaluable in the cure of the complaint, as
+soon as pains in the back, sore bones, headache, yawning, quick and
+sometimes intermittent pulse, noticeable pulsations of the jugulars,
+with suffused eyes, hot skin, and foul tongue, began. {1}
+
+Very curious are the effects of African fever on certain minds.
+Cheerfulness vanishes, and the whole mental horizon is overcast with
+black clouds of gloom and sadness. The liveliest joke cannot provoke
+even the semblance of a smile. The countenance is grave, the eyes
+suffused, and the few utterances are made in the piping voice of a
+wailing infant. An irritable temper is often the first symptom of
+approaching fever. At such times a man feels very much like a fool,
+if he does not act like one. Nothing is right, nothing pleases the
+fever-stricken victim. He is peevish, prone to find fault and to
+contradict, and think himself insulted, and is exactly what an Irish
+naval surgeon before a court-martial defined a drunken man to be: "a
+man unfit for society."
+
+Finding that it was impossible to take our steamer of only ten-horse
+power through Kebrabasa, and convinced that, in order to force a
+passage when the river was in flood, much greater power was required,
+due information was forwarded to Her Majesty's Government, and
+application made for a more suitable vessel. Our attention was in
+the mean time turned to the exploration of the river Shire, a
+northern tributary of the Zambesi, which joins it about a hundred
+miles from the sea. We could learn nothing satisfactory from the
+Portuguese regarding this affluent; no one, they said, had ever been
+up it, nor could they tell whence it came. Years ago a Portuguese
+expedition is said, however, to have attempted the ascent, but to
+have abandoned it on account of the impenetrable duckweed (Pistia
+stratiotes.) We could not learn from any record that the Shire had
+ever been ascended by Europeans. As far, therefore, as we were
+concerned, the exploration was absolutely new. All the Portuguese
+believed the Manganja to be brave but bloodthirsty savages; and on
+our return we found that soon after our departure a report was widely
+spread that our temerity had been followed by fatal results, Dr.
+Livingstone having been shot, and Dr. Kirk mortally wounded by
+poisoned arrows.
+
+Our first trip to the Shire was in January, 1859. A considerable
+quantity of weed floated down the river for the first twenty-five
+miles, but not sufficient to interrupt navigation with canoes or with
+any other craft. Nearly the whole of this aquatic plant proceeds
+from a marsh on the west, and comes into the river a little beyond a
+lofty hill called Mount Morambala. Above that there is hardly any.
+As we approached the villages, the natives collected in large
+numbers, armed with bows and poisoned arrows; and some, dodging
+behind trees, were observed taking aim as if on the point of
+shooting. All the women had been sent out of the way, and the men
+were evidently prepared to resist aggression. At the village of a
+chief named Tingane, at least five hundred natives collected and
+ordered us to stop. Dr. Livingstone went ashore; and on his
+explaining that we were English and had come neither to take slaves
+nor to fight, but only to open a path by which our countrymen might
+follow to purchase cotton, or whatever else they might have to sell,
+except slaves, Tingane became at once quite friendly. The presence
+of the steamer, which showed that they had an entirely new people to
+deal with, probably contributed to this result; for Tingane was
+notorious for being the barrier to all intercourse between the
+Portuguese black traders and the natives further inland; none were
+allowed to pass him either way. He was an elderly, well-made man,
+grey-headed, and over six feet high. Though somewhat excited by our
+presence, he readily complied with the request to call his people
+together, in order that all might know what our objects were.
+
+In commencing intercourse with any people we almost always referred
+to the English detestation of slavery. Most of them already possess
+some information respecting the efforts made by the English at sea to
+suppress the slave-trade; and our work being to induce them to raise
+and sell cotton, instead of capturing and selling their fellow-men,
+our errand appears quite natural; and as they all have clear ideas of
+their own self-interest, and are keen traders, the reasonableness of
+the proposal is at once admitted; and as a belief in a Supreme Being,
+the Maker and Ruler of all things, and in the continued existence of
+departed spirits, is universal, it becomes quite appropriate to
+explain that we possess a Book containing a Revelation of the will of
+Him to whom in their natural state they recognise no relationship.
+The fact that His Son appeared among men, and left His words in His
+Book, always awakens attention; but the great difficulty is to make
+them feel that they have any relationship to Him, and that He feels
+any interest in them. The numbness of moral perception exhibited, is
+often discouraging; but the mode of communication, either by
+interpreters, or by the imperfect knowledge of the language, which
+not even missionaries of talent can overcome save by the labour of
+many years, may, in part, account for the phenomenon. However, the
+idea of the Father of all being displeased with His children, for
+selling or killing each other, at once gains their ready assent: it
+harmonizes so exactly with their own ideas of right and wrong. But,
+as in our own case at home, nothing less than the instruction and
+example of many years will secure their moral elevation.
+
+The dialect spoken here closely resembles that used at Senna and
+Tette. We understood it at first only enough to know whether our
+interpreter was saying what we bade him, or was indulging in his own
+version. After stating pretty nearly what he was told, he had an
+inveterate tendency to wind up with "The Book says you are to grow
+cotton, and the English are to come and buy it," or with some joke of
+his own, which might have been ludicrous, had it not been seriously
+distressing.
+
+In the first ascent of the Shire our attention was chiefly directed
+to the river itself. The delight of threading out the meanderings of
+upwards of 200 miles of a hitherto unexplored river must be felt to
+be appreciated. All the lower part of the river was found to be at
+least two fathoms in depth. It became shallower higher up, where
+many departing and re-entering branches diminished the volume of
+water, but the absence of sandbanks made it easy of navigation. We
+had to exercise the greatest care lest anything we did should be
+misconstrued by the crowds who watched us. After having made, in a
+straight line, one hundred miles, although the windings of the river
+had fully doubled the distance, we found further progress with the
+steamer arrested, in 15 degrees 55 minutes south, by magnificent
+cataracts, which we called, "The Murchison," after one whose name has
+already a world-wide fame, and whose generous kindness we can never
+repay. The native name of that figured in the woodcut is Mamvira.
+It is that at which the progress of the steamer was first stopped.
+The angle of descent is much smaller than that of the five cataracts
+above it; indeed, so small as compared with them, that after they
+were discovered this was not included in the number.
+
+A few days were spent here in the hope that there might be an
+opportunity of taking observations for longitude, but it rained most
+of the time, or the sky was overcast. It was deemed imprudent to
+risk a land journey whilst the natives were so very suspicious as to
+have a strong guard on the banks of the river night and day; the
+weather also was unfavourable. After sending presents and messages
+to two of the chiefs, we returned to Tette. In going down stream our
+progress was rapid, as we were aided by the current. The hippopotami
+never made a mistake, but got out of our way. The crocodiles, not so
+wise, sometimes rushed with great velocity at us, thinking that we
+were some huge animal swimming. They kept about a foot from the
+surface, but made three well-defined ripples from the feet and body,
+which marked their rapid progress; raising the head out of the water
+when only a few yards from the expected feast, down they went to the
+bottom like a stone, without touching the boat.
+
+In the middle of March of the same year (1859), we started again for
+a second trip on the Shire. The natives were now friendly, and
+readily sold us rice, fowls, and corn. We entered into amicable
+relations with the chief, Chibisa, whose village was about ten miles
+below the cataract. He had sent two men on our first visit to invite
+us to drink beer; but the steamer was such a terrible apparition to
+them, that, after shouting the invitation, they jumped ashore, and
+left their canoe to drift down the stream. Chibisa was a remarkably
+shrewd man, the very image, save his dark hue, of one of our most
+celebrated London actors, {2} and the most intelligent chief, by far,
+in this quarter. A great deal of fighting had fallen to his lot, he
+said; but it was always others who began; he was invariably in the
+right, and they alone were to blame. He was moreover a firm believer
+in the divine right of kings. He was an ordinary man, he said, when
+his father died, and left him the chieftainship; but directly he
+succeeded to the high office, he was conscious of power passing into
+his head, and down his back; he felt it enter, and knew that he was a
+chief, clothed with authority, and possessed of wisdom; and people
+then began to fear and reverence him. He mentioned this, as one
+would a fact of natural history, any doubt being quite out of the
+question. His people, too, believed in him, for they bathed in the
+river without the slightest fear of crocodiles, the chief having
+placed a powerful medicine there, which protected them from the bite
+of these terrible reptiles.
+
+Leaving the vessel opposite Chibisa's village, Drs. Livingstone and
+Kirk and a number of the Makololo started on foot for Lake Shirwa.
+They travelled in a northerly direction over a mountainous country.
+The people were far from being well-disposed to them, and some of
+their guides tried to mislead them, and could not be trusted.
+Masakasa, a Makololo headman, overheard some remarks which satisfied
+him that the guide was leading them into trouble. He was quiet till
+they reached a lonely spot, when he came up to Dr. Livingstone, and
+said, "That fellow is bad, he is taking us into mischief; my spear is
+sharp, and there is no one here; shall I cast him into the long
+grass?" Had the Doctor given the slightest token of assent, or even
+kept silence, never more would any one have been led by that guide,
+for in a twinkling he would have been where "the wicked cease from
+troubling." It was afterwards found that in this case there was no
+treachery at all, but a want of knowledge on their part of the
+language and of the country. They asked to be led to "Nyanja
+Mukulu," or Great Lake, meaning, by this, Lake Shirwa; and the guide
+took them round a terribly rough piece of mountainous country,
+gradually edging away towards a long marsh, which from the numbers of
+those animals we had seen there we had called the Elephant Marsh, but
+which was really the place known to him by the name "Nyanja Mukulu,"
+or Great Lake. Nyanja or Nyanza means, generally, a marsh, lake,
+river, or even a mere rivulet.
+
+The party pushed on at last without guides, or only with crazy ones;
+for, oddly enough, they were often under great obligations to the
+madmen of the different villages: one of these honoured them, as
+they slept in the open air, by dancing and singing at their feet the
+whole night. These poor fellows sympathized with the explorers,
+probably in the belief that they belonged to their own class; and,
+uninfluenced by the general opinion of their countrymen, they really
+pitied, and took kindly to the strangers, and often guided them
+faithfully from place to place, when no sane man could be hired for
+love or money.
+
+The bearing of the Manganja at this time was very independent; a
+striking contrast to the cringing attitude they afterwards assumed,
+when the cruel scourge of slave-hunting passed over their country.
+Signals were given from the different villages by means of drums, and
+notes of defiance and intimidation were sounded in the travellers'
+ears by day; and occasionally they were kept awake the whole night,
+in expectation of an instant attack. Drs. Livingstone and Kirk were
+desirous that nothing should occur to make the natives regard them as
+enemies; Masakasa, on the other hand, was anxious to show what he
+could do in the way of fighting them.
+
+The perseverance of the party was finally crowned with success; for
+on the 18th of April they discovered Lake Shirwa, a considerable body
+of bitter water, containing leeches, fish, crocodiles, and
+hippopotami. From having probably no outlet, the water is slightly
+brackish, and it appears to be deep, with islands like hills rising
+out of it. Their point of view was at the base of Mount Pirimiti or
+Mopeu-peu, on its S.S.W. side. Thence the prospect northwards ended
+in a sea horizon with two small islands in the distance--a larger
+one, resembling a hill-top and covered with trees, rose more in the
+foreground. Ranges of hills appeared on the east; and on the west
+stood Mount Chikala, which seems to be connected with the great
+mountain-mass called Zomba.
+
+The shore, near which they spent two nights, was covered with reeds
+and papyrus. Wishing to obtain the latitude by the natural horizon,
+they waded into the water some distance towards what was reported to
+be a sand-bank, but were so assaulted by leeches, they were fain to
+retreat; and a woman told them that in enticing them into the water
+the men only wanted to kill them. The information gathered was that
+this lake was nothing in size compared to another in the north, from
+which it is separated by only a tongue of land. The northern end of
+Shirwa has not been seen, though it has been passed; the length of
+the lake may probably be 60 or 80 miles, and about 20 broad. The
+height above the sea is 1800 feet, and the taste of the water is like
+a weak solution of Epsom salts. The country around is very
+beautiful, and clothed with rich vegetation; and the waves, at the
+time they were there breaking and foaming over a rock on the south-
+eastern side, added to the beauty of the picture. Exceedingly lofty
+mountains, perhaps 8000 feet above the sea-level, stand near the
+eastern shore. When their lofty steep-sided summits appear, some
+above, some below the clouds, the scene is grand. This range is
+called Milanje; on the west stands Mount Zomba, 7000 feet in height,
+and some twenty miles long.
+
+Their object being rather to gain the confidence of the people by
+degrees than to explore, they considered that they had advanced far
+enough into the country for one trip; and believing that they could
+secure their end by a repetition of their visit, as they had done on
+the Shire, they decided to return to the vessel at Dakanamoio island;
+but, instead of returning by the way they came, they passed down
+southwards close by Mount Chiradzuru, among the relatives of Chibisa,
+and thence by the pass Zedi, down to the Shire. The Kroomen had,
+while we were away, cut a good supply of wood for steaming, and we
+soon proceeded down the river.
+
+The steamer reached Tette on the 23rd of June, and, after undergoing
+repairs, proceeded to the Kongone to receive provisions from one of
+H.M. cruisers. We had been very abundantly supplied with first-rate
+stores, but were unfortunate enough to lose a considerable portion of
+them, and had now to bear the privation as best we could. On the way
+down, we purchased a few gigantic cabbages and pumpkins at a native
+village below Mazaro. Our dinners had usually consisted of but a
+single course; but we were surprised the next day by our black cook
+from Sierra Leone bearing in a second course. "What have you got
+there?" was asked in wonder. "A tart, sir." "A tart! of what is it
+made?" "Of cabbage, sir." As we had no sugar, and could not "make
+believe," as in the days of boyhood, we did not enjoy the feast that
+Tom's genius had prepared. Her Majesty's brig "Persian," Lieutenant
+Saumarez commanding, called on her way to the Cape; and, though
+somewhat short of provisions herself, generously gave us all she
+could spare. We now parted with our Kroomen, as, from their
+inability to march, we could not use them in our land journeys. A
+crew was picked out from the Makololo, who, besides being good
+travellers, could cut wood, work the ship, and required only native
+food.
+
+While at the Kongone it was found necessary to beach the steamer for
+repairs. She was built of a newly invented sort of steel plates,
+only a sixteenth of an inch in thickness, patented, but unfortunately
+never tried before. To build an exploring ship of untried material
+was a mistake. Some chemical action on this preparation of steel
+caused a minute hole; from this point, branches like lichens, or the
+little ragged stars we sometimes see in thawing ice, radiated in all
+directions. Small holes went through wherever a bend occurred in
+these branches. The bottom very soon became like a sieve, completely
+full of minute holes, which leaked perpetually. The engineer stopped
+the larger ones, but the vessel was no sooner afloat, than new ones
+broke out. The first news of a morning was commonly the unpleasant
+announcement of another leak in the forward compartment, or in the
+middle, which was worse still.
+
+Frequent showers fell on our way up the Zambesi, in the beginning of
+August. On the 8th we had upwards of three inches of rain, which
+large quantity, more than falls in any single rainy day during the
+season at Tette, we owed to being near the sea. Sometimes the cabin
+was nearly flooded; for, in addition to the leakage from below, rain
+poured through the roof, and an umbrella had to be used whenever we
+wished to write: the mode of coupling the compartments, too, was a
+new one, and the action of the hinder compartment on the middle one
+pumped up the water of the river, and sent it in streams over the
+floor and lockers, where lay the cushions which did double duty as
+chairs and beds. In trying to form an opinion of the climate, it
+must be recollected that much of the fever, from which we suffered,
+was caused by sleeping on these wet cushions. Many of the botanical
+specimens, laboriously collected and carefully prepared by Dr. Kirk,
+were destroyed, or double work imposed, by their accidentally falling
+into wet places in the cabin.
+
+About the middle of August, after cutting wood at Shamoara, we again
+steamed up the Shire, with the intention of becoming better
+acquainted with the people, and making another and longer journey on
+foot to the north of Lake Shirwa, in search of Lake Nyassa, of which
+we had already received some information, under the name Nyinyesi
+(the stars). The Shire is much narrower than the Zambesi, but
+deeper, and more easily navigated. It drains a low and exceedingly
+fertile valley of from fifteen to twenty miles in breadth. Ranges of
+wooded hills bound this valley on both sides. For the first twenty
+miles the hills on the left bank are close to the river; then comes
+Morambala, a detached mountain 500 yards from the river's brink,
+which rises, with steep sides on the west, to 4000 feet in height,
+and is about seven miles in length. It is wooded up to the very top,
+and very beautiful. The southern end, seen from a distance, has a
+fine gradual slope, and looks as if it might be of easy ascent; but
+the side which faces the Shire is steep and rocky, especially in the
+upper half. A small village peeps out about halfway up the mountain;
+it has a pure and bracing atmosphere; and is perched above mosquito
+range. The people on the summit have a very different climate and
+vegetation from those of the plains; but they have to spend a great
+portion of their existence amidst white fleecy clouds, which, in the
+rainy season, rest daily on the top of their favourite mountain. We
+were kindly treated by these mountaineers on our first ascent; before
+our second they were nearly all swept away by Mariano. Dr. Kirk
+found upwards of thirty species of ferns on this and other mountains,
+and even good-sized tree-ferns; though scarcely a single kind is to
+be met with on the plains. Lemon and orange trees grew wild, and
+pineapples had been planted by the people. Many large hornbills,
+hawks, monkeys, antelopes, and rhinoceroses found a home and food
+among the great trees round its base. A hot fountain boils up on the
+plain near the north end. It bubbles out of the earth, clear as
+crystal, at two points, or eyes, a few yards apart from each other,
+and sends off a fine flowing stream of hot water. The temperature
+was found to be 174 degrees Fahr., and it boiled an egg in about the
+usual time. Our guide threw in a small branch to show us how
+speedily the Madse-awira (boiling water) could kill the leaves.
+Unlucky lizards and insects did not seem to understand the nature of
+a hot-spring, as many of their remains were lying at the bottom. A
+large beetle had alighted on the water, and been killed before it had
+time to fold its wings. An incrustation, smelling of sulphur, has
+been deposited by the water on the stones. About a hundred feet from
+the eye of the fountain the mud is as hot as can be borne by the
+body. In taking a bath there, it makes the skin perfectly clean, and
+none of the mud adheres: it is strange that the Portuguese do not
+resort to it for the numerous cutaneous diseases with which they are
+so often afflicted.
+
+A few clumps of the palm and acacia trees appear west of Morambala,
+on the rich plain forming the tongue of land between the rivers Shire
+and Zambesi. This is a good place for all sorts of game. The
+Zambesi canoe-men were afraid to sleep on it from the idea of lions
+being there; they preferred to pass the night on an island. Some
+black men, who accompanied us as volunteer workmen from Shupanga,
+called out one evening that a lion stood on the bank. It was very
+dark, and we could only see two sparkling lights, said to be the
+lion's eyes looking at us; for here, as elsewhere, they have a theory
+that the lion's eyes always flash fire at night. Not being
+fireflies--as they did not move when a shot was fired in their
+direction--they were probably glowworms.
+
+Beyond Morambala the Shire comes winding through an extensive marsh.
+For many miles to the north a broad sea of fresh green grass extends,
+and is so level, that it might be used for taking the meridian
+altitude of the sun. Ten or fifteen miles north of Morambala, stands
+the dome-shaped mountain Makanga, or Chi-kanda; several others with
+granitic-looking peaks stretch away to the north, and form the
+eastern boundary of the valley; another range, but of metamorphic
+rocks, commencing opposite Senna, bounds the valley on the west.
+After streaming through a portion of this marsh, we came to a broad
+belt of palm and other trees, crossing the fine plain on the right
+bank. Marks of large game were abundant. Elephants had been feeding
+on the palm nuts, which have a pleasant fruity taste, and are used as
+food by man. Two pythons were observed coiled together among the
+branches of a large tree, and were both shot. The larger of the two,
+a female, was ten feet long. They are harmless, and said to be good
+eating. The Makololo having set fire to the grass where they were
+cutting wood, a solitary buffalo rushed out of the conflagration, and
+made a furious charge at an active young fellow named Mantlanyane.
+Never did his fleet limbs serve him better than during the few
+seconds of his fearful flight before the maddened animal. When he
+reached the bank, and sprang into the river, the infuriated beast was
+scarcely six feet behind him. Towards evening, after the day's
+labour in wood-cutting was over, some of the men went fishing. They
+followed the common African custom of agitating the water, by giving
+it a few sharp strokes with the top of the fishing-rod, immediately
+after throwing in the line, to attract the attention of the fish to
+the bait. Having caught nothing, the reason assigned was the same as
+would have been given in England under like circumstances, namely,
+that "the wind made the fish cold, and they would not bite." Many
+gardens of maize, pumpkins, and tobacco, fringed the marshy banks as
+we went on. They belong to natives of the hills, who come down in
+the dry season, and raise a crop on parts at other times flooded.
+While the crops are growing, large quantities of fish are caught,
+chiefly Clarias capensis, and Mugil Africanus; they are dried for
+sale or future consumption.
+
+As we ascended, we passed a deep stream about thirty yards wide,
+flowing in from a body of open water several miles broad. Numbers of
+men were busy at different parts of it, filling their canoes with the
+lotus root, called Nyika, which, when boiled or roasted, resembles
+our chestnuts, and is extensively used in Africa as food. Out of
+this lagoon, and by this stream, the chief part of the duckweed of
+the Shire flows. The lagoon itself is called Nyanja ea Motope (Lake
+of Mud). It is also named Nyanja Pangono (Little Lake), while the
+elephant marsh goes by the name of Nyanja Mukulu (Great Lake). It is
+evident from the shore line still to be observed on the adjacent
+hills, that in ancient times these were really lakes, and the
+traditional names thus preserved are only another evidence of the
+general desiccation which Africa has undergone.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+
+
+The Steamer in difficulties--Elephant hunting--Arrival at Chibisa's--
+Search for Lake Nyassa--The Manganja country--Weavers and smelters--
+Lake Pamalombe.
+
+Late in the afternoon of the first day's steaming, after we left the
+wooding-place, we called at the village of Chikanda-Kadze, a female
+chief, to purchase rice for our men; but we were now in the blissful
+region where time is absolutely of no account, and where men may sit
+down and rest themselves when tired; so they requested us to wait
+till next day, and they would then sell us some food. As our forty
+black men, however, had nothing to cook for supper, we were obliged
+to steam on to reach a village a few miles above. When we meet those
+who care not whether we purchase or let it alone, or who think men
+ought only to be in a hurry when fleeing from an enemy, our ideas
+about time being money, and the power of the purse, receives a shock.
+The state of eager competition, which in England wears out both mind
+and body, and makes life bitter, is here happily unknown. The
+cultivated spots are mere dots compared to the broad fields of rich
+soil which is never either grazed or tilled. Pity that the plenty in
+store for all, from our Father's bountiful hands, is not enjoyed by
+more.
+
+The wretched little steamer could not carry all the hands we needed;
+so, to lighten her, we put some into the boats and towed them astern.
+In the dark, one of the boats was capsized; but all in it, except one
+poor fellow who could not swim, were picked up. His loss threw a
+gloom over us all, and added to the chagrin we often felt at having
+been so ill-served in our sorry craft.
+
+Next day we arrived at the village of Mboma (16 degrees 56 minutes 30
+seconds S.), where the people raised large quantities of rice, and
+were eager traders; the rice was sold at wonderfully low rates, and
+we could not purchase a tithe of the food brought for sale.
+
+A native minstrel serenaded us in the evening, playing several quaint
+tunes on a species of one stringed fiddle, accompanied by wild, but
+not unmusical songs. He told the Makololo that he intended to play
+all night to induce us to give him a present. The nights being cold,
+the thermometer falling to 47 degrees, with occasional fogs, he was
+asked if he was not afraid of perishing from cold; but, with the
+genuine spirit of an Italian organ-grinder, he replied, "Oh, no; I
+shall spend the night with my white comrades in the big canoe; I have
+often heard of the white men, but have never seen them till now, and
+I must sing and play well to them." A small piece of cloth, however,
+bought him off, and he moved away in good humour. The water of the
+river was 70 degrees at sunrise, which was 23 degrees warmer than the
+air at the same time, and this caused fogs, which rose like steam off
+the river. When this is the case cold bathing in the mornings at
+this time of the year is improper, for, instead of a glow on coming
+out, one is apt to get a chill; the air being so much colder than the
+water.
+
+A range of hills, commencing opposite Senna, comes to within two or
+three miles of Mboma village, and then runs in a north-westerly
+direction; the principal hill is named Malawe; a number of villages
+stand on its tree-covered sides, and coal is found cropping out in
+the rocks. The country improves as we ascend, the rich valley
+becoming less swampy, and adorned with a number of trees.
+
+Both banks are dotted with hippopotamus traps, over every track which
+these animals have made in going up out of the water to graze. The
+hippopotamus feeds on grass alone, and, where there is any danger,
+only at night. Its enormous lips act like a mowing-machine, and form
+a path of short-cropped grass as it feeds. We never saw it eat
+aquatic plants or reeds. The tusks seem weapons of both offence and
+defence. The hippopotamus trap consists of a beam five or six feet
+long, armed with a spear-head or hard-wood spike, covered with
+poison, and suspended to a forked pole by a cord, which, coming down
+to the path, is held by a catch, to be set free when the beast treads
+on it. Being wary brutes, they are still very numerous. One got
+frightened by the ship, as she was steaming close to the bank. In
+its eager hurry to escape it rushed on shore, and ran directly under
+a trap, when down came the heavy beam on its back, driving the
+poisoned spear-head a foot deep into its flesh. In its agony it
+plunged back into the river, to die in a few hours, and afterwards
+furnished a feast for the natives. The poison on the spear-head does
+not affect the meat, except the part around the wound, and that is
+thrown away. In some places the descending beam is weighted with
+heavy stones, but here the hard heavy wood is sufficient.
+
+"She is leaking worse than ever forward, sir, and there is a foot of
+water in the hold," was our first salutation on the morning of the
+20th. But we have become accustomed to these things now; the cabin-
+floor is always wet, and one is obliged to mop up the water many
+times a day, giving some countenance to the native idea that
+Englishmen live in or on the water, and have no houses but ships.
+The cabin is now a favourite breeding-place for mosquitoes, and we
+have to support both the ship-bred and shore-bred bloodsuckers, of
+which several species show us their irritating attentions. A large
+brown sort, called by the Portuguese mansos (tame), flies straight to
+its victim, and goes to work at once, as though it were an invited
+guest. Some of the small kinds carry uncommonly sharp lancets, and
+very potent poison. "What would these insects eat, if we did not
+pass this way?" becomes a natural question.
+
+The juices of plants, and decaying vegetable matter in the mud,
+probably form the natural food of mosquitoes, and blood is not
+necessary for their existence. They appear so commonly at malarious
+spots, that their presence may be taken as a hint to man to be off to
+more healthy localities. None appear on the high lands. On the low
+lands they swarm in myriads. The females alone are furnished with
+the biting apparatus, and their number appears to be out of all
+proportion in excess of the males. At anchor, on a still evening,
+they were excessively annoying; and the sooner we took refuge under
+our mosquito curtains, the better. The miserable and sleepless night
+that only one mosquito inside the curtain can cause, is so well
+known, and has been so often described, that it is needless to
+describe it here. One soon learns, from experience, that to beat out
+the curtains thoroughly before entering them, so that not one of
+these pests can possibly be harboured within, is the only safeguard
+against such severe trials to one's tranquillity and temper.
+
+A few miles above Mboma we came again to the village (16 degrees 44
+minutes 30 seconds S.) of the chief Tingane, the beat of whose war-
+drums can speedily muster some hundreds of armed men. The bows and
+poisoned arrows here are of superior workmanship to those below.
+Mariano's slave-hunting parties stood in great awe of these barbed
+arrows, and long kept aloof from Tingane's villages. His people were
+friendly enough with us now, and covered the banks with a variety of
+articles for sale. The majestic mountain, Chipirone, to which we
+have given the name of Mount Clarendon, now looms in sight, and
+further to the N.W. the southern end of the grand Milanje range rises
+in the form of an unfinished sphinx looking down on Lake Shirwa. The
+Ruo (16 degrees 31 minutes 0 seconds S.) is said to have its source
+in the Milanje mountains, and flows to the S.W., to join the Shire
+some distance above Tingane's. A short way beyond the Ruo lies the
+Elephant marsh, or Nyanja Mukulu, which is frequented by vast herds
+of these animals. We believe that we counted eight hundred elephants
+in sight at once. In the choice of such a strong hold, they have
+shown their usual sagacity, for no hunter can get near them through
+the swamps. They now keep far from the steamer; but, when she first
+came up, we steamed into the midst of a herd, and some were shot from
+the ship's deck. A single lesson was sufficient to teach them that
+the steamer was a thing to be avoided; and at the first glimpse they
+are now off two or three miles to the midst of the marsh, which is
+furrowed in every direction by wandering branches of the Shire. A
+fine young elephant was here caught alive, as he was climbing up the
+bank to follow his retreating dam. When laid hold of, he screamed
+with so much energy that, to escape a visit from the enraged mother,
+we steamed off, and dragged him through the water by the proboscis.
+As the men were holding his trunk over the gunwale, Monga, a brave
+Makololo elephant-hunter, rushed aft, and drew his knife across it in
+a sort of frenzy peculiar to the chase. The wound was skilfully sewn
+up, and the young animal soon became quite tame, but, unfortunately
+the breathing prevented the cut from healing, and he died in a few
+days from loss of blood. Had he lived, and had we been able to bring
+him home, he would have been the first AFRICAN elephant ever seen in
+England. The African male elephant is from ten to a little over
+eleven feet in height, and differs from the Asiatic species more
+particularly in the convex shape of his forehead, and the enormous
+size of his ears. In Asia many of the males, and all the females,
+are without tusks, but in Africa both sexes are provided with these
+weapons. The enamel in the molar teeth is arranged differently in
+the two species. By an admirable provision, new teeth constantly
+come up at the part where in man the wisdom teeth appear, and these
+push the others along, and out at the front end of the jaws, thus
+keeping the molars sound by renewal, till the animal attains a very
+great age. The tusks of animals from dry rocky countries are very
+munch more dense and heavier than those from wet and marshy
+districts, but the latter attain much the larger size.
+
+The Shire marshes support prodigious numbers of many kinds of water-
+fowl. An hour at the mast-head unfolds novel views of life in an
+African marsh. Near the edge, and on the branches of some favourite
+tree, rest scores of plotuses and cormorants, which stretch their
+snake-like necks, and in mute amazement turn one eye and then another
+towards the approaching monster. By and-by the timid ones begin to
+fly off, or take "headers" into the stream; but a few of the bolder,
+or more composed, remain, only taking the precaution to spread their
+wings ready for instant flight. The pretty ardetta (Herodias
+bubulcus), of a light yellow colour when at rest, but seemingly of a
+pure white when flying, takes wing, and sweeps across the green grass
+in large numbers, often showing us where buffaloes and elephants are,
+by perching on their backs. Flocks of ducks, of which the kind
+called "Soriri" (Dendrocygna personata) is most abundant, being night
+feeders, meditate quietly by the small lagoons, until startled by the
+noise of the steam machinery. Pelicans glide over the water,
+catching fish, while the Scopus (Scopus umbretta) and large herons
+peer intently into pools. The large black and white spur-winged
+goose (a constant marauder of native gardens) springs up, and circles
+round to find out what the disturbance can be, and then settles down
+again with a splash. Hundreds of Linongolos (Anastomus lamelligerus)
+rise on the wing from the clumps of reeds, or low trees (the
+Eschinomena, from which pith hats are made), on which they build in
+colonies, and are speedily high in mid-air. Charming little red and
+yellow weavers (Ploceidae) remind one of butterflies, as they fly in
+and out of the tall grass, or hang to the mouths of their pendent
+nests, chattering briskly to their mates within. These weavers seem
+to have "cock nests," built with only a roof, and a perch beneath,
+with a doorway on each side. The natives say they are made to
+protect the bird from the rain. Though her husband is very
+attentive, we have seen the hen bird tearing her mate's nest to
+pieces, but why we cannot tell. Kites and vultures are busy
+overhead, beating the ground for their repast of carrion; and the
+solemn-looking, stately-stepping Marabout, with a taste for dead
+fish, or men, stalks slowly along the almost stagnant channels.
+Groups of men and boys are searching diligently in various places for
+lotus and other roots. Some are standing in canoes, on the weed-
+covered ponds, spearing fish, while others are punting over the small
+intersecting streams, to examine their sunken fish-baskets.
+
+Towards evening, hundreds of pretty little hawks (Erythropus
+vespertinus) are seen flying in a southerly direction, and feeding on
+dragon-flies and locusts. They come, apparently, from resting on the
+palm-trees during the heat of the day. Flocks of scissor-bills
+(Rhyncops) are then also on the wing, and in search of food,
+ploughing the water with their lower mandibles, which are nearly half
+an inch longer than the upper ones.
+
+At the north-eastern end of the marsh, and about three miles from the
+river, commences a great forest of palm-trees (Borassus Aethiopium).
+It extends many miles, and at one point comes close to the river.
+The grey trunks and green tops of this immense mass of trees give a
+pleasing tone of colour to the view. The mountain-range, which rises
+close behind the palms, is generally of a cheerful green, and has
+many trees, with patches of a lighter tint among them, as if spots of
+land had once been cultivated. The sharp angular rocks and dells on
+its sides have the appearance of a huge crystal broken; and this is
+so often the case in Africa, that one can guess pretty nearly at
+sight whether a range is of the old crystalline rocks or not. The
+Borassus, though not an oil-bearing palm, is a useful tree. The
+fibrous pulp round the large nuts is of a sweet fruity taste, and is
+eaten by men and elephants. The natives bury the nuts until the
+kernels begin to sprout; when dug up and broken, the inside resembles
+coarse potatoes, and is prized in times of scarcity as nutritious
+food. During several months of the year, palm-wine, or sura, is
+obtained in large quantities; when fresh, it is a pleasant drink,
+somewhat like champagne, and not at all intoxicating; though, after
+standing a few hours, it becomes highly so. Sticks, a foot long, are
+driven into notches in the hard outside of the tree--the inside being
+soft or hollow--to serve as a ladder; the top of the fruit-shoot is
+cut off, and the sap, pouring out at the fresh wound, is caught in an
+earthen pot, which is hung at the point. A thin slice is taken off
+the end, to open the pores, and make the juice flow every time the
+owner ascends to empty the pot. Temporary huts are erected in the
+forest, and men and boys remain by their respective trees day and
+night; the nuts, fish, and wine, being their sole food. The
+Portuguese use the palm-wine as yeast, and it makes bread so light,
+that it melts in the mouth like froth.
+
+Beyond the marsh the country is higher, and has a much larger
+population. We passed a long line of temporary huts, on a plain on
+the right bank, with crowds of men and women hard at work making
+salt. They obtain it by mixing the earth, which is here highly
+saline, with water, in a pot with a small hole in it, and then
+evaporating the liquid, which runs through, in the sun. From the
+number of women we saw carrying it off in bags, we concluded that
+vast quantities must be made at these works. It is worth observing
+that on soils like this, containing salt, the cotton is of larger and
+finer staple than elsewhere. We saw large tracts of this rich
+brackish soil both in the Shire and Zambesi valleys, and hence,
+probably, sea-island cotton would do well; a single plant of it,
+reared by Major Sicard, flourished and produced the long staple and
+peculiar tinge of this celebrated variety, though planted only in the
+street at Tette; and there also a salt efflorescence appears,
+probably from decomposition of the rock, off which the people scrape
+it for use.
+
+The large village of the chief, Mankokwe, occupies a site on the
+right bank; he owns a number of fertile islands, and is said to be
+the Rundo, or paramount chief, of a large district. Being of an
+unhappy suspicious disposition, he would not see us; so we thought it
+best to move on, rather than spend time in seeking his favour.
+
+On the 25th August we reached Dakanamoio island, opposite the
+perpendicular bluff on which Chibisa's village stands; he had gone,
+with most of his people, to live near the Zambesi, but his headman
+was civil, and promised us guides and whatever else we needed. A few
+of the men were busy cleaning, sorting, spinning, and weaving cotton.
+This is a common sight in nearly every village, and each family
+appears to have its patch of cotton, as our own ancestors in Scotland
+had each his patch of flax. Near sunset an immense flock of the
+large species of horn-bill (Buceros cristatus) came here to roost on
+the great trees which skirt the edge of the cliff. They leave early
+in the morning, often before sunrise, for their feeding-places,
+coming and going in pairs. They are evidently of a loving
+disposition, and strongly attached to each other, the male always
+nestling close beside his mate. A fine male fell to the ground, from
+fear, at the report of Dr. Kirk's gun; it was caught and kept on
+board; the female did not go off in the mornings to feed with the
+others, but flew round the ship, anxiously trying, by her plaintive
+calls, to induce her beloved one to follow her: she came again in
+the evenings to repeat the invitations. The poor disconsolate
+captive soon refused to eat, and in five days died of grief, because
+he could not have her company. No internal injury could be detected
+after death.
+
+Chibisa and his wife, with a natural show of parental feeling, had
+told the Doctor, on his previous visit, that a few years before some
+of Chisaka's men had kidnapped and sold their little daughter, and
+that she was now a slave to the padre at Tette. On his return to
+Tette, the Doctor tried hard to ransom and restore the girl to her
+parents, and offered twice the value of a slave; the padre seemed
+willing, but she could not be found. This padre was better than the
+average men of the country; and, being always civil and obliging,
+would probably have restored her gratuitously, but she had been sold,
+it might be to the distant tribe Bazizulu, or he could not tell
+where. Custom had rendered his feelings callous, and Chibisa had to
+be told that his child would never return. It is this callous state
+of mind which leads some of our own blood to quote Scripture in
+support of slavery. If we could afford to take a backward step in
+civilization, we might find men among ourselves who would in like
+manner prove Mormonism or any other enormity to be divine.
+
+We left the ship on the 28th of August, 1859, for the discovery of
+Lake Nyassa. Our party numbered forty-two in all--four whites,
+thirty-six Makololo, and two guides. We did not actually need so
+many, either for carriage or defence; but took them because we
+believed that, human nature being everywhere the same, blacks are as
+ready as whites to take advantage of the weak, and are as civil and
+respectful to the powerful. We armed our men with muskets, which
+gave us influence, although it did not add much to our strength, as
+most of the men had never drawn a trigger, and in any conflict would
+in all probability have been more dangerous to us than the enemy.
+
+Our path crossed the valley, in a north-easterly direction, up the
+course of a beautiful flowing stream. Many of the gardens had
+excellent cotton growing in them. An hour's march brought us to the
+foot of the Manganja hills, up which lay the toilsome road. The
+vegetation soon changed; as we rose bamboos appeared, and new trees
+and plants were met with, which gave such incessant employment to Dr.
+Kirk, that he travelled the distance three times over. Remarkably
+fine trees, one of which has oil-yielding seeds, and belongs to the
+mahogany family, grow well in the hollows along the rivulet courses.
+The ascent became very fatiguing, and we were glad of a rest.
+Looking back from an elevation of a thousand feet, we beheld a lovely
+prospect. The eye takes in at a glance the valley beneath, and the
+many windings of its silver stream Makubula, or Kubvula, from the
+shady hill-side, where it emerges in foaming haste, to where it
+slowly glides into the tranquil Shire; then the Shire itself is seen
+for many a mile above and below Chibisa's, and the great level
+country beyond, with its numerous green woods; until the prospect,
+west and north-west, is bounded far away by masses of peaked and
+dome-shaped blue mountains, that fringe the highlands of the Maravi
+country.
+
+After a weary march we halted at Makolongwi, the village of Chitimba.
+It stands in a woody hollow on the first of the three terraces of the
+Manganja hills, and, like all other Manganja villages, is surrounded
+by an impenetrable hedge of poisonous euphorbia. This tree casts a
+deep shade, which would render it difficult for bowmen to take aim at
+the villagers inside. The grass does not grow beneath it, and this
+may be the reason why it is so universally used, for when dry the
+grass would readily convey fire to the huts inside; moreover, the
+hedge acts as a fender to all flying sparks. As strangers are wont
+to do, we sat down under some fine trees near the entrance of the
+village. A couple of mats, made of split reeds, were spread for the
+white men to sit on; and the headman brought a seguati, or present,
+of a small goat and a basket of meal. The full value in beads and
+cotton cloth was handed to him in return. He measured the cloth,
+doubled it, and then measured that again. The beads were
+scrutinized; he had never seen beads of that colour before, and
+should like to consult with his comrades before accepting them, and
+this, after repeated examinations and much anxious talk, he concluded
+to do. Meal and peas were then brought for sale. A fathom of blue
+cotton cloth, a full dress for man or woman, was produced. Our
+Makololo headman, Sininyane, thinking a part of it was enough for the
+meal, was proceeding to tear it, when Chitimba remarked that it was a
+pity to cut such a nice dress for his wife, he would rather bring
+more meal. "All right," said Sininyane; "but look, the cloth is very
+wide, so see that the basket which carries the meal be wide too, and
+add a cock to make the meal taste nicely." A brisk trade sprang up
+at once, each being eager to obtain as fine things as his neighbour,-
+-and all were in good humour. Women and girls began to pound and
+grind meal, and men and boys chased the screaming fowls over the
+village, until they ran them down. In a few hours the market was
+completely glutted with every sort of native food; the prices,
+however, rarely fell, as they could easily eat what was not sold.
+
+We slept under the trees, the air being pheasant, and no mosquitoes
+on the hills. According to our usual plan of marching, by early dawn
+our camp was in motion. After a cup of coffee and a bit of biscuit
+we were on the way. The air was deliciously cool, and the path a
+little easier than that of yesterday. We passed a number of
+villages, occupying very picturesque spots among the hills, and in a
+few hours gained the upper terrace, 3000 feet above the level of the
+sea. The plateau lies west of the Milanje mountains, and its north-
+eastern border slopes down to Lake Shirwa. We were all charmed with
+the splendid country, and looked with never-failing delight on its
+fertile plains, its numerous hills, and majestic mountains. In some
+of the passes we saw bramble-berries growing; and the many other
+flowers, though of great beauty, did not remind us of youth and of
+home like the ungainly thorny bramble-bushes. We were a week in
+crossing the high-lands in a northerly direction; then we descended
+into the Upper Shire Valley, which is nearly 1200 feet above the
+level of the sea. This valley is wonderfully fertile, and supports a
+large population. After leaving the somewhat flat-topped southern
+portion, the most prominent mountain of the Zomba range is Njongone,
+which has a fine stream running past its northern base. We were
+detained at the end of the chain some days by one of our companions
+being laid up with fever. One night we were suddenly aroused by
+buffaloes rushing close by the sick-bed. We were encamped by a wood
+on the border of a marsh, but our patient soon recovered,
+notwithstanding the unfavourable situation, and the poor
+accommodation.
+
+The Manganja country is delightfully well watered. The clear, cool,
+gushing streams are very numerous. Once we passed seven fine brooks
+and a spring in a single hour, and this, too, near the close of the
+dry season. Mount Zomba, which is twenty miles long, and from 7000
+to 8000 feet high, has a beautiful stream flowing through a verdant
+valley on its summit, and running away down into Lake Shirwa. The
+highlands are well wooded, and many trees, admirable for their height
+and timber, grow on the various watercourses. "Is this country good
+for cattle?" we inquired of a Makololo herdsman, whose occupation had
+given him skill in pasturage. "Truly," he replied, "do you not see
+abundance of those grasses which the cattle love, and get fat upon?"
+Yet the people have but few goats, and fewer sheep. With the
+exception of an occasional leopard, there are no beasts of prey to
+disturb domestic animals. Wool-sheep would, without doubt, thrive on
+these highlands. Part of the Upper Shire valley has a lady
+paramount, named Nyango; and in her dominions women rank higher and
+receive more respectful treatment than their sisters on the hills.
+
+The hill chief, Mongazi, called his wife to take charge of a present
+we had given him. She dropped down on her knees, clapping her hands
+in reverence, before and after receiving our presents from his lordly
+hands. It was painful to see the abject manner in which the women of
+the hill tribes knelt beside the path as we passed; but a great
+difference took place when we got into Nyango's country.
+
+On entering a village, we proceeded, as all strangers do, at once to
+the Boalo: mats of split reeds or bamboo were usually spread for us
+to sit on. Our guides then told the men who might be there, who we
+were, whence we had come, whither we wanted to go, and what were our
+objects. This information was duly carried to the chief, who, if a
+sensible man, came at once; but, if he happened to be timid and
+suspicious, waited until he had used divination, and his warriors had
+time to come in from outlying hamlets. When he makes his appearance,
+all the people begin to clap their hands in unison, and continue
+doing so till he sits down opposite to us. His counsellors take
+their places beside him. He makes a remark or two, and is then
+silent for a few seconds. Our guides then sit down in front of the
+chief and his counsellors, and both parties lean forward, looking
+earnestly at each other; the chief repeats a word, such as "Ambuiatu"
+(our Father, or master)--or "moio" (life), and all clap their hands.
+Another word is followed by two claps, a third by still more
+clapping, when each touches the ground with both hands placed
+together. Then all rise and lean forward with measured clap, and sit
+down again with clap, clap, clap, fainter, and still fainter, till
+the last dies away, or is brought to an end by a smart loud clap from
+the chief. They keep perfect time in this species of court
+etiquette. Our guides now tell the chief, often in blank verse, all
+they have already told his people, with the addition perhaps of their
+own suspicions of the visitors. He asks some questions, and then
+converses with us through the guides. Direct communication between
+the chief and the head of the stranger party is not customary. In
+approaching they often ask who is the spokesman, and the spokesman of
+the chief addresses the person indicated exclusively. There is no
+lack of punctilious good manners. The accustomed presents are
+exchanged with civil ceremoniousness; until our men, wearied and
+hungry, call out, "English do not buy slaves, they buy food," and
+then the people bring meal, maize, fowls, batatas, yams, beans, beer,
+for sale.
+
+The Manganja are an industrious race; and in addition to working in
+iron, cotton, and basket-making, they cultivate the soil extensively.
+All the people of a village turn out to labour in the fields. It is
+no uncommon thing to see men, women, and children hard at work, with
+the baby lying close by beneath a shady bush. When a new piece of
+woodland is to be cleared, they proceed exactly as farmers do in
+America. The trees are cut down with their little axes of soft
+native iron; trunks and branches are piled up and burnt, and the
+ashes spread on the soil. The corn is planted among the standing
+stumps which are left to rot. If grass land is to be brought under
+cultivation, as much tall grass as the labourer can conveniently lay
+hold of is collected together and tied into a knot. He then strikes
+his hoe round the tufts to sever the roots, and leaving all standing,
+proceeds until the whole ground assumes the appearance of a field
+covered with little shocks of corn in harvest. A short time before
+the rains begin, these grass shocks are collected in small heaps,
+covered with earth, and burnt, the ashes and burnt soil being used to
+fertilize the ground. Large crops of the mapira, or Egyptian dura
+(Holcus sorghum), are raised, with millet, beans, and ground-nuts;
+also patches of yams, rice, pumpkins, cucumbers, cassava, sweet
+potatoes, tobacco, and hemp, or bang (Cannabis setiva). Maize is
+grown all the year round. Cotton is cultivated at almost every
+village. Three varieties of cotton have been found in the country,
+namely, two foreign and one native. The "tonje manga," or foreign
+cotton, the name showing that it has been introduced, is of excellent
+quality, and considered at Manchester to be nearly equal to the best
+New Orleans. It is perennial, but requires replanting once in three
+years. A considerable amount of this variety is grown in the Upper
+and Lower Shire valleys. Every family of any importance owns a
+cotton patch which, from the entire absence of weeds, seemed to be
+carefully cultivated. Most were small, none seen on this journey
+exceeding half an acre; but on the former trip some were observed of
+more than twice that size.
+
+The "tonje cadja," or indigenous cotton, is of shorter staple, and
+feels in the hand like wool. This kind has to be planted every
+season in the highlands; yet, because it makes stronger cloth, many
+of the people prefer it to the foreign cotton; the third variety is
+not found here. It was remarked to a number of men near the Shire
+Lakelet, a little further on towards Nyassa, "You should plant plenty
+of cotton, and probably the English will come and buy it." "Truly,"
+replied a far-travelled Babisa trader to his fellows, "the country is
+full of cotton, and if these people come to buy they will enrich us."
+Our own observation on the cotton cultivated convinced us that this
+was no empty flourish, but a fact. Everywhere we met with it, and
+scarcely ever entered a village without finding a number of men
+cleaning, spinning, and weaving. It is first carefully separated
+from the seed by the fingers, or by an iron roller, on a little block
+of wood, and rove out into long soft bands without twist. Then it
+receives its first twist on the spindle, and becomes about the
+thickness of coarse candlewick; after being taken off and wound into
+a large ball, it is given the final hard twist, and spun into a firm
+cop on the spindle again: all the processes being painfully slow.
+
+Iron ore is dug out of the hills, and its manufacture is the staple
+trade of the southern highlands. Each village has its smelting-
+house, its charcoal-burners, and blacksmiths. They make good axes,
+spears, needles, arrowheads, bracelets and anklets, which,
+considering the entire absence of machinery, are sold at surprisingly
+low rates; a hoe over two pounds in weight is exchanged for calico of
+about the value of fourpence. In villages near Lake Shirwa and
+elsewhere, the inhabitants enter pretty largely into the manufacture
+of crockery, or pottery, making by hand all sorts of cooking, water,
+and grain pots, which they ornament with plumbago found in the hills.
+Some find employment in weaving neat baskets from split bamboos, and
+others collect the fibre of the buaze, which grows abundantly on the
+hills, and make it into fish-nets. These they either use themselves,
+or exchange with the fishermen on the river or lakes for dried fish
+and salt. A great deal of native trade is carried on between the
+villages, by means of barter in tobacco, salt, dried fish, skins, and
+iron. Many of the men are intelligent-looking, with well-shaped
+heads, agreeable faces, and high foreheads. We soon learned to
+forget colour, and we frequently saw countenances resembling those of
+white people we had known in England, which brought back the looks of
+forgotten ones vividly before the mind. The men take a good deal of
+pride in the arrangement of their hair; the varieties of style are
+endless. One trains his long locks till they take the admired form
+of the buffalo's horns; others prefer to let their hair hang in a
+thick coil down their backs, like that animal's tail; while another
+wears it in twisted cords, which, stiffened by fillets of the inner
+bark of a tree wound spirally round each curl, radiate from the head
+in all directions. Some have it hanging all round the shoulders in
+large masses; others shave it off altogether. Many shave part of it
+into ornamental figures, in which the fancy of the barber crops out
+conspicuously. About as many dandies run to seed among the blacks as
+among the whites. The Man ganja adorn their bodies extravagantly,
+wearing rings on their fingers and thumbs, besides throatlets,
+bracelets, and anklets of brass, copper, or iron. But the most
+wonderful of ornaments, if such it may be called, is the pelele, or
+upper-lip ring of the women. The middle of the upper lip of the
+girls is pierced close to the septum of the nose, and a small pin
+inserted to prevent the puncture closing up. After it has healed,
+the pin is taken out and a larger one is pressed into its place, and
+so on successively for weeks, and months, and years. The process of
+increasing the size of the lip goes on till its capacity becomes so
+great that a ring of two inches diameter can be introduced with ease.
+All the highland women wear the pelele, and it is common on the Upper
+and Lower Shire. The poorer classes make them of hollow or of solid
+bamboo, but the wealthier of ivory or tin. The tin pelele is often
+made in the form of a small dish. The ivory one is not unlike a
+napkin-ring. No woman ever appears in public without the pelele,
+except in times of mourning for the dead. It is frightfully ugly to
+see the upper lip projecting two inches beyond the tip of the nose.
+When an old wearer of a hollow bamboo ring smiles, by the action of
+the muscles of the cheeks, the ring and lip outside it are dragged
+back and thrown above the eyebrows. The nose is seen through the
+middle of the ring, amid the exposed teeth show how carefully they
+have been chipped to look like those of a cat or crocodile. The
+pelele of an old lady, Chikanda Kadze, a chieftainess, about twenty
+miles north of Morambala, hung down below her chin, with, of course,
+a piece of the upper lip around its border. The labial letters
+cannot be properly pronounced, but the under lip has to do its best
+for them, against the upper teeth and gum. Tell them it makes them
+ugly; they had better throw it away; they reply, "Kodi! Really! it
+is the fashion." How this hideous fashion originated is an enigma.
+Can thick lips ever have been thought beautiful, and this mode of
+artificial enlargement resorted to in consequence? The constant
+twiddling of the pelele with the tongue by the younger women
+suggested the irreverent idea that it might have been invented to
+give safe employment to that little member. "Why do the women wear
+these things?" we inquired of the old chief, Chinsunse. Evidently
+surprised at such a stupid question, he replied, "For beauty, to be
+sure! Men have beards and whiskers; women have none; and what kind
+of creature would a woman be without whiskers, and without the
+pelele? She would have a mouth like a man, and no beard; ha! ha!
+ha!" Afterwards on the Rovuma, we found men wearing the pelele, as
+well as women. An idea suggested itself on seeing the effects of the
+slight but constant pressure exerted on the upper gum and front
+teeth, of which our medical brethren will judge the value. In many
+cases the upper front teeth, instead of the natural curve outwards,
+which the row presents, had been pressed so as to appear as if the
+line of alveoli in which they were planted had an inward curve. As
+this was produced by the slight pressure of the pelele backwards,
+persons with too prominent teeth might by slight, but long-continued
+pressure, by some appliance only as elastic as the lip, have the
+upper gum and teeth depressed, especially in youth, more easily than
+is usually imagined. The pressure should be applied to the upper gum
+more than to the teeth.
+
+The Manganja are not a sober people: they brew large quantities of
+beer, and like it well. Having no hops, or other means of checking
+fermentation, they are obliged to drink the whole brew in a few days,
+or it becomes unfit for use. Great merry-makings take place on these
+occasions, and drinking, drumming, and dancing continue day and
+night, till the beer is gone. In crossing the hills we sometimes
+found whole villages enjoying this kind of mirth. The veteran
+traveller of the party remarked, that he had not seen so much
+drunkenness during all the sixteen years he had spent in Africa. As
+we entered a village one afternoon, not a man was to be seen; but
+some women were drinking beer under a tree. In a few moments the
+native doctor, one of the innocents, "nobody's enemy but his own,"
+staggered out of a hut, with his cupping-horn dangling from his neck,
+and began to scold us for a breach of etiquette. "Is this the way to
+come into a man's village, without sending him word that you are
+coming?" Our men soon pacified the fuddled but good-humoured medico,
+who, entering his beer-cellar, called on two of them to help him to
+carry out a huge pot of beer, which he generously presented to us.
+While the "medical practitioner" was thus hospitably employed, the
+chief awoke in a fright, and shouted to the women to run away, or
+they would all be killed. The ladies laughed at the idea of their
+being able to run away, and remained beside the beer-pots. We
+selected a spot for our camp, our men cooked the dinner as usual, and
+we were quietly eating it, when scores of armed men, streaming with
+perspiration, came pouring into the village. They looked at us, then
+at each other, and turning to the chief upbraided him for so
+needlessly sending for them. "These people are peaceable; they do
+not hurt you; you are killed with beer:" so saying, they returned to
+their homes.
+
+Native beer has a pinkish colour, and the consistency of gruel. The
+grain is made to vegetate, dried in the sun, pounded into meal, and
+gently boiled. When only a day or two old, the beer is sweet, with a
+slight degree of acidity, which renders it a most grateful beverage
+in a hot climate, or when fever begets a sore craving for acid
+drinks. A single draught of it satisfies this craving at once. Only
+by deep and long-continued potations can intoxication be produced:
+the grain being in a minutely divided state, it is a good way of
+consuming it, and the decoction is very nutritious. At Tette a
+measure of beer is exchanged for an equal-sized pot full of grain. A
+present of this beer, so refreshing to our dark comrades, was brought
+to us in nearly every village. Beer-drinking does not appear to
+produce any disease, or to shorten life on the hills. Never before
+did we see so many old, grey-headed men and women; leaning on their
+staves they came with the others to see the white men. The aged
+chief, Muata Manga, could hardly have been less than ninety years of
+age; his venerable appearance struck the Makololo. "He is an old
+man," said they, "a very old man; his skin hangs in wrinkles, just
+like that on elephants' hips." "Did you never," he was asked, "have
+a fit of travelling come over you; a desire to see other lands and
+people?" No, he had never felt that, and had never been far from
+home in his life. For long life they are not indebted to frequent
+ablutions. An old man told us that he remembered to have washed once
+in his life, but it was so long since that he had forgotten how it
+felt. "Why do you wash?" asked Chinsunse's women of the Makololo;
+"our men never do."
+
+The superstitious ordeal, by drinking the poisonous muave, obtains
+credit here; and when a person is suspected of crime, this ordeal is
+resorted to. If the stomach rejects the poison, the accused is
+pronounced innocent; but if it is retained, guilt is believed to be
+demonstrated. Their faith is so firm in its discriminating power,
+that the supposed criminal offers of his own accord to drink it, and
+even chiefs are not exempted. Chibisa, relying on its efficacy,
+drank it several times, in order to vindicate his character. When
+asserting that all his wars had been just, it was hinted that, as
+every chief had the same tale of innocence to tell, we ought to
+suspend our judgment. "If you doubt my word," said he, "give me the
+muave to drink." A chief at the foot of Mount Zomba successfully
+went through the ordeal the day we reached his village; and his
+people manifested their joy at his deliverance by drinking beer,
+dancing, and drumming for two days and nights. It is possible that
+the native doctor, who mixes the ingredients of the poisoned bowl,
+may be able to save those whom he considers innocent; but it is
+difficult to get the natives to speak about the matter, and no one is
+willing to tell what the muave poison consists of. We have been
+shown trees said to be used, but had always reason to doubt the
+accuracy of our informants. We once found a tree in a village, with
+many pieces of the bark chipped off, closely allied to the Tangena or
+Tanghina, the ordeal poison tree of Madagascar; but we could not
+ascertain any particulars about it. Death is inflicted on those
+found guilty of witchcraft, by the muave.
+
+The women wail for the dead two days. Seated on the ground they
+chant a few plaintive words, and end each verse with the prolonged
+sound of a-a, or o-o, or ea-ea-ea--a. Whatever beer is in the house
+of the deceased, is poured out on the ground with the meal, and all
+cooking and water pots are broken, as being of no further use. Both
+men and women wear signs of mourning for their dead relatives. These
+consist of narrow strips of the palm-leaf wound round the head, the
+arms, legs, neck, and breasts, and worn till they drop off from
+decay. They believe in the existence of a supreme being, called
+Mpambe, and also Morungo, and in a future state. "We live only a few
+days here," said old Chinsunse, "but we live again after death: we
+do not know where, or in what condition, or with what companions, for
+the dead never return to tell us. Sometimes the dead do come back,
+and appear to us in dreams; but they never speak nor tell us where
+they have gone, nor how they fare."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+
+
+The Upper Shire--Discovery of Lake Nyassa--Distressing exploration--
+Return to Zambesi--Unpleasant visitors--Start for Sekeletu's Country
+in the interior.
+
+Our path followed the Shire above the cataracts, which is now a broad
+deep river, with but little current. It expands in one place into a
+lakelet, called Pamalombe, full of fine fish, and ten or twelve miles
+long by five or six in breadth. Its banks are low, and a dense wall
+of papyrus encircles it. On its western shore rises a range of hills
+running north. On reaching the village of the chief Muana-Moesi, and
+about a day's march distant from Nyassa, we were told that no lake
+had ever been heard of there; that the River Shire stretched on as we
+saw it now to a distance of "two months," and then came out from
+between perpendicular rocks, which towered almost to the skies. Our
+men looked blank at this piece of news, and said, "Let us go back to
+the ship, it is of no use trying to find the lake." "We shall go and
+see those wonderful rocks at any rate," said the Doctor. "And when
+you see them," replied Masakasa, "you will just want to see something
+else. But there IS a lake," rejoined Masakasa, "for all their
+denying it, for it is down in a book." Masakasa, having unbounded
+faith in whatever was in a book, went and scolded the natives for
+telling him an untruth. "There is a lake," said he, "for how could
+the white men know about it in a book if it did not exist?" They
+then admitted that there was a lake a few miles off. Subsequent
+inquiries make it probable that the story of the "perpendicular
+rocks" may have had reference to a fissure, known to both natives and
+Arabs, in the north-eastern portion of the lake. The walls rise so
+high that the path along the bottom is said to be underground. It is
+probably a crack similar to that which made the Victoria Falls, and
+formed the Shire Valley.
+
+The chief brought a small present of meal in the evening, and sat
+with us for a few minutes. On leaving us he said that he wished we
+might sleep well. Scarce had he gone, when a wild sad cry arose from
+the river, followed by the shrieking of women. A crocodile had
+carried off his principal wife, as she was bathing. The Makololo
+snatched up their arms, and rushed to the bank, but it was too late,
+she was gone. The wailing of the women continued all night, and next
+morning we met others coming to the village to join in the general
+mourning. Their grief was evidently heartfelt, as we saw the tears
+coursing down their cheeks. In reporting this misfortune to his
+neighbours, Muana-Moesi said, "that white men came to his village;
+washed themselves at the place where his wife drew water and bathed;
+rubbed themselves with a white medicine (soap); and his wife, having
+gone to bathe afterwards, was taken by a crocodile; he did not know
+whether in consequence of the medicine used or not." This we could
+not find fault with. On our return we were viewed with awe, and all
+the men fled at our approach; the women remained; and this elicited
+the remark from our men, "The women have the advantage of men, in not
+needing to dread the spear." The practice of bathing, which our
+first contact with Chinsunse's people led us to believe was unknown
+to the natives, we afterwards found to be common in other parts of
+the Manganja country.
+
+We discovered Lake Nyassa a little before noon of the 16th September,
+1859. Its southern end is in 14 degrees 25 minutes S. Lat., and 35
+degrees 30 minutes E. Long. At this point the valley is about twelve
+miles wide. There are hills on both sides of the lake, but the haze
+from burning grass prevented us at the time from seeing far. A long
+time after our return from Nyassa, we received a letter from Captain
+R. B. Oldfield, R.N., then commanding H.M.S. "Lyra," with the
+information that Dr. Roscher, an enterprising German who
+unfortunately lost his life in his zeal for exploration, had also
+reached the Lake, but on the 19th November following our discovery;
+and on his arrival had been informed by the natives that a party of
+white men were at the southern extremity. On comparing dates (16th
+September and 19th November) we were about two months before Dr.
+Roscher.
+
+It is not known where Dr. Roscher first saw its waters; as the exact
+position of Nusseewa on the borders of the Lake, where he lived some
+time, is unknown. He was three days north-east of Nusseewa, and on
+the Arab road back to the usual crossing-place of the Rovuma, when he
+was murdered. The murderers were seized by one of the chiefs, sent
+to Zanzibar, and executed. He is said to have kept his discoveries
+to himself, with the intention of publishing in Europe the whole at
+once, in a splendid book of travels.
+
+The chief of the village near the confluence of the Lake and River
+Shire, an old man, called Mosauka, hearing that we were sitting under
+a tree, came and kindly invited us to his village. He took us to a
+magnificent banyan-tree, of which he seemed proud. The roots had
+been trained down to the ground into the form of a gigantic arm-
+chair, without the seat. Four of us slept in the space betwixt its
+arms. Mosauka brought us a present of a goat and basket of meal "to
+comfort our hearts." He told us that a large slave party, led by
+Arabs, were encamped close by. They had been up to Cazembe's country
+the past year, and were on their way back, with plenty of slaves,
+ivory, and malachite. In a few minutes half a dozen of the leaders
+came over to see us. They were armed with long muskets, and, to our
+mind, were a villanous-looking lot. They evidently thought the same
+of us, for they offered several young children for sale, but, when
+told that we were English, showed signs of fear, and decamped during
+the night. On our return to the Kongone, we found that H.M.S. "Lynx"
+had caught some of these very slaves in a dhow; for a woman told us
+she first saw us at Mosauka's, and that the Arabs had fled for fear
+of an UNCANNY sort of Basungu.
+
+This is one of the great slave-paths from the interior, others cross
+the Shire a little below, and some on the lake itself. We might have
+released these slaves but did not know what to do with them
+afterwards. On meeting men, led in slave-sticks, the Doctor had to
+bear the reproaches of the Makololo, who never slave, "Ay, you call
+us bad, but are we yellow-hearted, like these fellows--why won't you
+let us choke them?" To liberate and leave them, would have done but
+little good, as the people of the surrounding villages would soon
+have seized them, and have sold them again into slavery. The
+Manganja chiefs sell their own people, for we met Ajawa and slave-
+dealers in several highland villages, who had certainly been
+encouraged to come among them for slaves. The chiefs always seemed
+ashamed of the traffic, and tried to excuse themselves. "We do not
+sell many, and only those who have committed crimes." As a rule the
+regular trade is supplied by the low and criminal classes, and hence
+the ugliness of slaves. Others are probably sold besides criminals,
+as on the accusation of witchcraft. Friendless orphans also
+sometimes disappear suddenly, and no one inquires what has become of
+them. The temptation to sell their people is peculiarly great, as
+there is but little ivory on the hills, and often the chief has
+nothing but human flesh with which to buy foreign goods. The Ajawa
+offer cloth, brass rings, pottery, and sometimes handsome young
+women, and agree to take the trouble of carrying off by night all
+those whom the chief may point out to them. They give four yards of
+cotton cloth for a man, three for a woman, and two for a boy or girl,
+to be taken to the Portuguese at Mozambique, Iboe, and Quillimane.
+
+The Manganja were more suspicious and less hospitable than the tribes
+on the Zambesi. They were slow to believe that our object in coming
+into their country was really what we professed it to be. They
+naturally judge us by the motives which govern themselves. A chief
+in the Upper Shire Valley, whose scared looks led our men to christen
+him Kitlabolawa (I shall be killed), remarked that parties had come
+before, with as plausible a story as ours, and, after a few days, had
+jumped up and carried off a number of his people as slaves. We were
+not allowed to enter some of the villages in the valley, nor would
+the inhabitants even sell us food; Zimika's men, for instance, stood
+at the entrance of the euphorbia hedge, and declared we should not
+pass in. We sat down under a tree close by. A young fellow made an
+angry oration, dancing from side to side with his bow and poisoned
+arrows, and gesticulating fiercely in our faces. He was stopped in
+the middle of his harangue by an old man, who ordered him to sit
+down, and not talk to strangers in that way; he obeyed reluctantly,
+scowling defiance, and thrusting out his large lips very
+significantly. The women were observed leaving the village; and,
+suspecting that mischief might ensue, we proceeded on our journey, to
+the great disgust of our men. They were very angry with the natives
+for their want of hospitality to strangers, and with us, because we
+would not allow them to give "the things a thrashing." "This is what
+comes of going with white men," they growled out; "had we been with
+our own chief, we should have eaten their goats to-night, and had
+some of themselves to carry the bundles for us to-morrow." On our
+return by a path which left his village on our right, Zimika sent to
+apologize, saying that "he was ill, and in another village at the
+time; it was not by his orders we were sent away; his men did not
+know that we were a party wishing the land to dwell in peace."
+
+We were not able, when hastening back to the men left in the ship, to
+remain in the villages belonging to this chief; but the people came
+after us with things for sale, and invited us to stop, and spend the
+night with them, urging, "Are we to have it said that white people
+passed through our country and we did not see them?" We rested by a
+rivulet to gratify these sight-seers. We appear to them to be red
+rather than white; and, though light colour is admired among
+themselves, our clothing renders us uncouth in aspect. Blue eyes
+appear savage, and a red beard hideous. From the numbers of aged
+persons we saw on the highlands, and the increase of mental and
+physical vigour we experienced on our ascent from the lowlands, we
+inferred that the climate was salubrious, and that our countrymen
+might there enjoy good health, and also be of signal benefit, by
+leading the multitude of industrious inhabitants to cultivate cotton,
+buaze, sugar, and other valuable produce, to exchange for goods of
+European manufacture; at the same time teaching them, by precept and
+example, the great truths of our Holy Religion.
+
+Our stay at the Lake was necessarily short. We had found that the
+best plan for allaying any suspicions, that might arise in the minds
+of a people accustomed only to slave-traders, was to pay a hasty
+visit, and then leave for a while, and allow the conviction to form
+among the people that, though our course of action was so different
+from that of others, we were not dangerous, but rather disposed to be
+friendly. We had also a party at the vessel, and any indiscretion on
+their part might have proved fatal to the character of the
+Expedition.
+
+The trade of Cazembe and Katanga's country, and of other parts of the
+interior, crosses Nyassa and the Shire, on its way to the Arab port,
+Kilwa, and the Portuguese ports of Iboe and Mozambique. At present,
+slaves, ivory, malachite, and copper ornaments, are the only articles
+of commerce. According to information collected by Colonel Rigby at
+Zanzibar, and from other sources, nearly all the slaves shipped from
+the above-mentioned ports come from the Nyassa district. By means of
+a small steamer, purchasing the ivory of the Lake and River above the
+cataracts, which together have a shore-line of at least 600 miles,
+the slave-trade in this quarter would be rendered unprofitable,--for
+it is only by the ivory being carried by the slaves, that the latter
+do not eat up all the profits of a trip. An influence would be
+exerted over an enormous area of country, for the Mazitu about the
+north end of the Lake will not allow slave-traders to pass round that
+way through their country. They would be most efficient allies to
+the English, and might themselves be benefited by more intercourse.
+As things are now, the native traders in ivory and malachite have to
+submit to heavy exactions; and if we could give them the same prices
+which they at present get after carrying their merchandise 300 miles
+beyond this to the Coast, it might induce them to return without
+going further. It is only by cutting off the supplies in the
+interior, that we can crush the slave-trade on the Coast. The plan
+proposed would stop the slave-trade from the Zambesi on one side and
+Kilwa on the other; and would leave, beyond this tract, only the
+Portuguese port of Inhambane on the south, and a portion of the
+Sultan of Zanzibar's dominion on the north, for our cruisers to look
+after. The Lake people grow abundance of cotton for their own
+consumption, and can sell it for a penny a pound or even less.
+Water-carriage exists by the Shire and Zambesi all the way to
+England, with the single exception of a portage of about thirty-five
+miles past the Murchison Cataracts, along which a road of less than
+forty miles could be made at a trifling expense; and it seems
+feasible that a legitimate and thriving trade might, in a short time,
+take the place of the present unlawful traffic.
+
+Colonel Rigby, Captains Wilson, Oldfield, and Chapman, and all the
+most intelligent officers on the Coast, were unanimous in the belief,
+that one small vessel on the Lake would have decidedly more
+influence, and do more good in suppressing the slave-trade, than half
+a dozen men-of-war on the ocean. By judicious operations, therefore,
+on a small scale inland, little expense would be incurred, and the
+English slave-trade policy on the East would have the same fair
+chance of success, as on the West Coast.
+
+After a land-journey of forty days, we returned to the ship on the
+6th of October, 1859, in a somewhat exhausted condition, arising more
+from a sort of poisoning, than from the usual fatigue of travel. We
+had taken a little mulligatawney paste, for making soup, in case of
+want of time to cook other food. Late one afternoon, at the end of
+an unusually long march, we reached Mikena, near the base of Mount
+Njongone to the north of Zomba, and the cook was directed to use a
+couple of spoonfuls of the paste; but, instead of doing so, he put in
+the whole potful. The soup tasted rather hot, but we added boiled
+rice to it, and, being very hungry, partook freely of it; and, in
+consequence of the overdose, we were delayed several days in severe
+suffering, and some of the party did not recover till after our
+return to the ship. Our illness may partly have arisen from another
+cause. One kind of cassava (Jatropha maligna) is known to be, in its
+raw state, poisonous, but by boiling it carefully in two waters,
+which must be thrown off, the poison is extracted and the cassava
+rendered fit for food. The poisonous sort is easily known by raising
+a bit of the bark of the root, and putting the tongue to it. A
+bitter taste shows poison, but it is probable that even the sweet
+kind contains an injurious principle. The sap, which, like that of
+our potatoes, is injurious as an article of food, is used in the
+"Pepper-pot" of the West Indies, under the name of "Cassereep," as a
+perfect preservative of meat. This juice put into an earthen vessel
+with a little water and Chili pepper is said to keep meat, that is
+immersed in it, good for a great length of time; even for years. No
+iron or steel must touch the mixture, or it will become sour. This
+"Pepper-pot," of which we first heard from the late Archbishop
+Whately, is a most economical meat-safe in a hot climate; any beef,
+mutton, pork, or fowl that may be left at dinner, if put into the
+mixture and a little fresh cassereep added, keeps perfectly, though
+otherwise the heat of the climate or flies would spoil it. Our cook,
+however, boiled the cassava root as he was in the habit of cooking
+meat, namely, by filling the pot with it, and then pouring in water,
+which he allowed to stand on the fire until it had become absorbed
+and boiled away. This method did not expel the poisonous properties
+of the root, or render it wholesome; for, notwithstanding our
+systematic caution in purchasing only the harmless sort, we suffered
+daily from its effects, and it was only just before the end of our
+trip that this pernicious mode of boiling it was discovered by us.
+
+In ascending 3000 feet from the lowlands to the highlands, or on
+reaching the low valley of the Shire from the higher grounds, the
+change of climate was very marked. The heat was oppressive below,
+the thermometer standing at from 84 degrees to 103 degrees in the
+shade; and our spirits were as dull and languid as they had been
+exhilarated on the heights in a temperature cooler by some 20
+degrees. The water of the river was sometimes 84 degrees or higher,
+whilst that we had been drinking in the hill streams was only 65
+degrees.
+
+It was found necessary to send two of our number across from the
+Shire to Tette; and Dr. Kirk, with guides from Chibisa, and
+accompanied by Mr. Rae, the engineer, accomplished the journey. We
+had found the country to the north and east so very well watered,
+that no difficulty was anticipated in this respect in a march of less
+than a hundred miles; but on this occasion our friends suffered
+severely. The little water to be had at this time of the year, by
+digging in the beds of dry watercourses, was so brackish as to
+increase thirst--some of the natives indeed were making salt from it;
+and when at long intervals a less brackish supply was found, it was
+nauseous and muddy from the frequent visits of large game. The
+tsetse abounded. The country was level, and large tracts of it
+covered with mopane forest, the leaves of which afford but scanty
+shade to the baked earth, so that scarcely any grass grows upon it.
+The sun was so hot, that the men frequently jumped from the path, in
+the vain hope of cooling, for a moment, their scorched feet under the
+almost shadeless bushes; and the native who carried the provision of
+salt pork got lost, and came into Tette two days after the rest of
+the party, with nothing but the fibre of the meat left, the fat,
+melted by the blazing sun, having all run down his back. This path
+was soon made a highway for slaving parties by Captain Raposo, the
+Commandant. The journey nearly killed our two active young friends;
+and what the slaves must have since suffered on it no one can
+conceive; but slaving probably can never be conducted without
+enormous suffering and loss of life.
+
+Mankokwe now sent a message to say that he wished us to stop at his
+village on our way down. He came on board on our arrival there with
+a handsome present, and said that his young people had dissuaded him
+from visiting us before; but now he was determined to see what every
+one else was seeing. A bald square-headed man, who had been his
+Prime Minister when we came up, was now out of office, and another
+old man, who had taken his place accompanied the chief. In passing
+the Elephant Marsh, we saw nine large herds of elephants; they
+sometimes formed a line two miles long.
+
+On the 2nd of November we anchored off Shamoara, and sent the boat to
+Senna for biscuit and other provisions. Senhor Ferrao, with his
+wonted generosity, gave us a present of a bullock, which he sent to
+us in a canoe. Wishing to know if a second bullock would be
+acceptable to us, he consulted his Portuguese and English dictionary,
+and asked the sailor in charge if he would take ANOTHER; but Jack,
+mistaking the Portuguese pronunciation of the letter h, replied, "Oh
+no, sir, thank you, I don't want an OTTER in the boat, they are such
+terrible biters!"
+
+We had to ground the vessel on a shallow sandbank every night; she
+leaked so fast, that in deep water she would have sunk, and the pump
+had to be worked all day to keep her afloat. Heavy rains fell daily,
+producing the usual injurious effects in the cabin; and, unable to
+wait any longer for our associates, who had gone overland from the
+Shire to Tette, we ran down the Kongone and beached her for repairs.
+Her Majesty's ship "Lynx," Lieut. Berkeley commanding, called shortly
+afterwards with supplies; the bar, which had been perfectly smooth
+for some time before, became rather rough just before her arrival, so
+that it was two or three days before she could communicate with us.
+Two of her boats tried to come in on the second day, and one of them,
+mistaking the passage, capsized in the heavy breakers abreast of the
+island. Mr. Hunt, gunner, the officer in charge of the second boat,
+behaved nobly, and by his skilful and gallant conduct succeeded in
+rescuing every one of the first boat's crew. Of course the things
+that they were bringing to us were lost, but we were thankful that
+all the men were saved. The loss of the mail-bags, containing
+Government despatches and our friends' letters for the past year, was
+felt severely, as we were on the point of starting on an expedition
+into the interior, which might require eight or nine months; and
+twenty months is a weary time to be without news of friends and
+family. In the repairing of our crazy craft, we received kind and
+efficient aid from Lieutenant Berkeley, and we were enabled to leave
+for Tette on December 16th.
+
+We had now frequent rains, and the river rose considerably; our
+progress up the stream was distressingly slow, and it was not until
+the 2nd of February, 1860, that we reached Tette. Mr. Thornton
+returned on the same day from a geological tour, by which some
+Portuguese expected that a fabulous silver-mine would be
+rediscovered. The tradition in the country is, that the Jesuits
+formerly knew and worked a precious lode at Chicova. Mr. Thornton
+had gone beyond Zumbo, in company with a trader of colour; he soon
+after this left the Zambesi and, joining the expedition of the Baron
+van der Decken, explored the snow mountain Kilimanjaro, north-west of
+Zanzibar. Mr. Thornton's companion, the trader, brought back much
+ivory, having found it both abundant and cheap. He was obliged,
+however, to pay heavy fines to the Banyai and other tribes, in the
+country which is coolly claimed in Europe as Portuguese. During this
+trip of six mouths 200 pieces of cotton cloth of sixteen yards each,
+besides beads and brass wire, were paid to the different chiefs, for
+leave to pass through their country. In addition to these
+sufficiently weighty exactions, the natives of THIS DOMINION have got
+into the habit of imposing fines for alleged milandos, or crimes,
+which the traders' men may have unwittingly committed. The
+merchants, however, submit rather than run the risk of fighting.
+
+The general monotony of existence at Tette is sometimes relieved by
+an occasional death or wedding. When the deceased is a person of
+consequence, the quantity of gunpowder his slaves are allowed to
+expend is enormous. The expense may, in proportion to their means,
+resemble that incurred by foolishly gaudy funerals in England. When
+at Tette, we always joined with sympathizing hearts in aiding, by our
+presence at the last rites, to soothe the sorrows of the surviving
+relatives. We are sure that they would have done the same to us had
+we been the mourners. We never had to complain of want of
+hospitality. Indeed, the great kindness shown by many of whom we
+have often spoken, will never be effaced from our memory till our
+dying day. When we speak of their failings it is in sorrow, not in
+anger. Their trading in slaves is an enormous mistake. Their
+Government places them in a false position by cutting them off from
+the rest of the world; and of this they always speak with a
+bitterness which, were it heard, might alter the tone of the
+statesmen of Lisbon. But here there is no press, no booksellers'
+shops, and scarcely a schoolmaster. Had we been born in similar
+untoward circumstances--we tremble to think of it!
+
+The weddings are celebrated with as much jollity as weddings are
+anywhere. We witnessed one in the house of our friend the Padre. It
+being the marriage of his goddaughter, he kindly invited us to be
+partakers in his joy; and we there became acquainted with old Donna
+Engenia, who was a married wife and had children, when the slaves
+came from Cassange, before any of us were born. The whole merry-
+making was marked by good taste amid propriety.
+
+About the only interesting object in the vicinity of Tette is the
+coal a few miles to the north. There, in the feeders of the stream
+Revubue, it crops out in cliff sections. The seams are from four to
+seven feet in thickness; one measured was found to be twenty-five
+feet thick.
+
+Learning that it would be difficult for our party to obtain food
+beyond Kebrabasa before the new crop came in and knowing the
+difficulty of hunting for so many men in the wet season, we decided
+on deferring our departure for the interior until May, and in the
+mean time to run down once more to the Kongone, in the hopes of
+receiving letters and despatches from the man-of-war that was to call
+in March. We left Tette on the 10th, and at Senna heard that our
+lost mail had been picked up on the beach by natives, west of the
+Milambe; carried to Quillimane, sent thence to Senna, and, passing us
+somewhere on the river, on to Tette. At Shupanga the governor
+informed us that it was a very large mail; no great comfort, seeing
+it was away up the river.
+
+Mosquitoes were excessively troublesome at the harbour, and
+especially when a light breeze blew from the north over the
+mangroves. We lived for several weeks in small huts, built by our
+men. Those who did the hunting for the party always got wet, and
+were attacked by fever, but generally recovered in time to be out
+again before the meat was all consumed. No ship appearing, we
+started off on the 15th of March, and stopped to wood on the Luabo,
+near an encampment of hippopotamus hunters; our men heard again,
+through them, of the canoe path from this place to Quillimane, but
+they declined to point it out.
+
+We found our friend Major Sicard at Mazaro with picks, shovels,
+hurdles, and slaves, having come to build a fort and custom-house at
+the Kongone. As we had no good reason to hide the harbour, but many
+for its being made known, we supplied him with a chart of the
+tortuous branches, which, running among the mangroves, perplex the
+search; and with such directions as would enable him to find his way
+down to the river. He had brought the relics of our fugitive mail,
+and it was a disappointment to find that all had been lost, with the
+exception of a bundle of old newspapers, two photographs, and three
+letters, which had been written before we left England.
+
+The distance from Mazaro, on the Zambesi side, to the Kwakwa at
+Nterra, is about six miles, over a surprisingly rich dark soil. We
+passed the night in the long shed, erected at Nterra, on the banks of
+this river, for the use of travellers, who have often to wait several
+days for canoes; we tried to sleep, but the mosquitoes and rats were
+so troublesome as to render sleep impossible. The rats, or rather
+large mice, closely resembling Mus pumilio (Smith), of this region,
+are quite facetious, and, having a great deal of fun in them, often
+laugh heartily. Again and again they woke us up by scampering over
+our faces, and then bursting into a loud laugh of He! he! he! at
+having performed the feat. Their sense of the ludicrous appears to
+be exquisite; they screamed with laughter at the attempts which
+disturbed and angry human nature made in the dark to bring their ill-
+timed merriment to a close. Unlike their prudent European cousins,
+which are said to leave a sinking ship, a party of these took up
+their quarters in our leaky and sinking vessel. Quiet and invisible
+by day, they emerged at night, and cut their funny pranks. No sooner
+were we all asleep, than they made a sudden dash over the lockers and
+across our faces for the cabin door, where all broke out into a loud
+He! he! he! he! he! he! showing how keenly they enjoyed the joke.
+They next went forward with as much delight, and scampered over the
+men. Every night they went fore and aft, rousing with impartial feet
+every sleeper, and laughing to scorn the aimless blows, growls, and
+deadly rushes of outraged humanity. We observed elsewhere a species
+of large mouse, nearly allied to Euryotis unisulcatus (F. Cuvier),
+escaping up a rough and not very upright wall, with six young ones
+firmly attached to the perineum. They were old enough to be well
+covered with hair, and some were not detached by a blow which
+disabled the dam. We could not decide whether any involuntary
+muscles were brought into play in helping the young to adhere. Their
+weight seemed to require a sort of cataleptic state of the muscles of
+the jaw, to enable them to hold on.
+
+Scorpions, centipedes, and poisonous spiders also were not
+unfrequently brought into the ship with the wood, and occasionally
+found their way into our beds; but in every instance we were
+fortunate enough to discover and destroy them before they did any
+harm. Naval officers on this coast report that, when scorpions and
+centipedes remain a few weeks after being taken on board in a similar
+manner, their poison loses nearly all its virulence; but this we did
+not verify. Snakes sometimes came in with the wood, but oftener
+floated down the river to us, climbing on board with ease by the
+chain-cable, and some poisonous ones were caught in the cabin. A
+green snake lived with us several weeks, concealing himself behind
+the casing of the deckhouse in the daytime. To be aroused in the
+dark by five feet of cold green snake gliding over one's face is
+rather unpleasant, however rapid the movement may be. Myriads of two
+varieties of cockroaches infested the vessel; they not only ate round
+the roots of our nails, but even devoured and defiled our food,
+flannels, and boots. Vain were all our efforts to extirpate these
+destructive pests; if you kill one, say the sailors, a hundred come
+down to his funeral! In the work of Commodore Owen it is stated that
+cockroaches, pounded into a paste, form a powerful carminative; this
+has not been confirmed, but when monkeys are fed on them they are
+sure to become lean.
+
+On coming to Senna, we found that the Zulus had arrived in force for
+their annual tribute. These men are under good discipline, and never
+steal from the people. The tax is claimed on the ground of conquest,
+the Zulus having formerly completely overcome the Senna people, and
+chased them on to the islands in the Zambesi. Fifty-four of the
+Portuguese were slain on the occasion, and, notwithstanding the mud
+fort, the village has never recovered its former power. Fever was
+now very prevalent, and most of the Portuguese were down with it.
+
+For a good view of the adjacent scenery, the hill, Baramuana, behind
+the village, was ascended. A caution was given about the probability
+of an attack of fever from a plant that grows near the summit. Dr.
+Kirk discovered it to be the Paedevia foetida, which, when smelt,
+actually does give headache and fever. It has a nasty fetor, as its
+name indicates. This is one instance in which fever and a foul smell
+coincide. In a number of instances offensive effluvia and fever
+seems to have no connection. Owing to the abundant rains, the crops
+in the Senna district were plentiful; this was fortunate, after the
+partial failure of the past two years. It was the 25th of April,
+1860, before we reached Tette; here also the crops were luxuriant,
+and the people said that they had not had such abundance since 1856,
+the year when Dr. Livingstone came down the river. It is astonishing
+to any one who has seen the works for irrigation in other countries,
+as at the Cape and in Egypt, that no attempt has ever been made to
+lead out the water either of the Zambesi or any of its tributaries;
+no machinery has ever been used to raise it even from the stream, but
+droughts and starvations are endured, as if they were inevitable
+dispensations of Providence, incapable of being mitigated.
+
+Feeling in honour bound to return with those who had been the
+faithful companions of Dr. Livingstone, in 1856, and to whose
+guardianship and services was due the accomplishment of a journey
+which all the Portuguese at Tette had previously pronounced
+impossible, the requisite steps were taken to convey them to their
+homes.
+
+We laid the ship alongside of the island Kanyimbe, opposite Tette;
+and, before starting for the country of the Makololo, obtained a
+small plot of land, to form a garden for the two English sailors who
+were to remain in charge during our absence. We furnished them with
+a supply of seeds, and they set to work with such zeal, that they
+certainly merited success. Their first attempt at African
+horticulture met with failure from a most unexpected source; every
+seed was dug up and the inside of it eaten by mice. "Yes," said an
+old native, next morning, on seeing the husks, "that is what happens
+this month; for it is the mouse month, and the seed should have been
+sown last mouth, when I sowed mine." The sailors, however, sowed
+more next day; and, being determined to outwit the mice, they this
+time covered the beds over with grass. The onions, with other seeds
+of plants cultivated by the Portuguese, are usually planted in the
+beginning of April, in order to have the advantage of the cold
+season; the wheat a little later, for the same reason. If sown at
+the beginning of the rainy season in November, it runs, as before
+remarked, entirely to straw; but as the rains are nearly over in May,
+advantage is taken of low-lying patches, which have been flooded by
+the river. A hole is made in the mud with a hoe, a few seeds dropped
+in, and the earth shoved back with the foot. If not favoured with
+certain misty showers, which, lower down the river, are simply fogs,
+water is borne from the river to the roots of the wheat in earthern
+pots; and in about four months the crop is ready for the sickle. The
+wheat of Tette is exported, as the best grown in the country; but a
+hollow spot at Maruru, close by Mazaro, yielded very good crops,
+though just at the level of the sea, as a few inches rise of tide
+shows.
+
+A number of days were spent in busy preparation for our journey; the
+cloth, beads, and brass wire, for the trip were sewn up in old
+canvas, and each package had the bearer's name printed on it. The
+Makololo, who had worked for the Expedition, were paid for their
+services, and every one who had come down with the Doctor from the
+interior received a present of cloth and ornaments, in order to
+protect them from the greater cold of their own country, and to show
+that they had not come in vain. Though called Makololo by courtesy,
+as they were proud of the name, Kanyata, the principal headman, was
+the only real Makololo of the party; and he, in virtue of his birth,
+had succeeded to the chief place on the death of Sekwebu. The others
+belonged to the conquered tribes of the Batoka, Bashubia, Ba-Selea,
+and Barotse. Some of these men had only added to their own vices
+those of the Tette slaves; others, by toiling during the first two
+years in navigating canoes, and hunting elephants, had often managed
+to save a little, to take back to their own country, but had to part
+with it all for food to support the rest in times of hunger, and,
+latterly, had fallen into the improvident habits of slaves, and spent
+their surplus earnings in beer and agua ardiente.
+
+Everything being ready on the 15th of May, we started at 2 p.m. from
+the village where the Makololo had dwelt. A number of the men did
+not leave with the goodwill which their talk for months before had
+led us to anticipate; but some proceeded upon being told that they
+were not compelled to go unless they liked, though others altogether
+declined moving. Many had taken up with slave-women, whom they
+assisted in hoeing, and in consuming the produce of their gardens.
+Some fourteen children had been born to them; and in consequence of
+now having no chief to order them, or to claim their services, they
+thought that they were about as well off as they had been in their
+own country. They knew and regretted that they could call neither
+wives nor children their own; the slave-owners claimed the whole; but
+their natural affections had been so enchained, that they clave to
+the domestic ties. By a law of Portugal the baptized children of
+slave women are all free; by the custom of the Zambesi that law is
+void. When it is referred to, the officers laugh and say, "These
+Lisbon-born laws are very stringent, but somehow, possibly from the
+heat of the climate, here they lose all their force." Only one woman
+joined our party--the wife of a Batoka man: she had been given to
+him, in consideration of his skilful dancing, by the chief, Chisaka.
+A merchant sent three of his men along with us, with a present for
+Sekeletu, and Major Sicard also lent us three more to assist us on
+our return, and two Portuguese gentleman kindly gave us the loan of a
+couple of donkeys. We slept four miles above Tette, and hearing that
+the Banyai, who levy heavy fines on the Portuguese traders, lived
+chiefly on the right bank, we crossed over to the left, as we could
+not fully trust our men. If the Banyai had come in a threatening
+manner, our followers might, perhaps, from having homes behind them,
+have even put down their bundles and run. Indeed, two of them at
+this point made up their minds to go no further, and turned back to
+Tette. Another, Monga, a Batoka, was much perplexed, and could not
+make out what course to pursue, as he had, three years previously,
+wounded Kanyata, the headman, with a spear. This is a capital
+offence among the Makololo, and he was afraid of being put to death
+for it on his return. He tried, in vain, to console himself with the
+facts that he had neither father, mother, sisters, nor brothers to
+mourn for him, and that he could die but once. He was good, and
+would go up to the stars to Yesu, and therefore did not care for
+death. In spite, however, of these reflections, he was much cast
+down, until Kanyata assured him that he would never mention his
+misdeed to the chief; indeed, he had never even mentioned it to the
+Doctor, which he would assuredly have done had it lain heavy on his
+heart. We were right glad of Monga's company, for he was a merry
+good-tempered fellow, and his lithe manly figure had always been in
+the front in danger; and, from being left-handed, had been easily
+recognized in the fight with elephants.
+
+We commenced, for a certain number of days, with short marches,
+walking gently until broken in to travel. This is of so much
+importance, that it occurs to us that more might be made out of
+soldiers if the first few days' marches were easy, and gradually
+increased in length and quickness. The nights were cold, with heavy
+dews and occasional showers, and we had several cases of fever. Some
+of the men deserted every night, and we fully expected that all who
+had children would prefer to return to Tette, for little ones are
+well known to prove the strongest ties, even to slaves. It was
+useless informing them, that if they wanted to return they had only
+to come and tell us so; we should not be angry with them for
+preferring Tette to their own country. Contact with slaves had
+destroyed their sense of honour; they would not go in daylight, but
+decamped in the night, only in one instance, however, taking our
+goods, though, in two more, they carried off their comrades'
+property. By the time we had got well into the Kebrabasa hills
+thirty men, nearly a third of the party, had turned back, and it
+became evident that, if many more left us, Sekeletu's goods could not
+be carried up. At last, when the refuse had fallen away, no more
+desertions took place.
+
+Stopping one afternoon at a Kebrabasa village, a man, who pretended
+to be able to change himself into a lion, came to salute us.
+Smelling the gunpowder from a gun which had been discharged, he went
+on one side to get out of the wind of the piece, trembling in a most
+artistic manner, but quite overacting his part. The Makololo
+explained to us that he was a Pondoro, or a man who can change his
+form at will, and added that he trembles when he smells gunpowder.
+"Do you not see how he is trembling now?" We told them to ask him to
+change himself at once into a lion, and we would give him a cloth for
+the performance. "Oh no," replied they; "if we tell him so, he may
+change himself and come when we are asleep and kill us." Having
+similar superstitions at home, they readily became as firm believers
+in the Pondoro as the natives of the village. We were told that he
+assumes the form of a lion and remains in the woods for days, and is
+sometimes absent for a whole month. His considerate wife had built
+him a hut or den, in which she places food and beer for her
+transformed lord, whose metamorphosis does not impair his human
+appetite. No one ever enters this hut except the Pondoro and his
+wife, and no stranger is allowed even to rest his gun against the
+baobab-tree beside it: the Mfumo, or petty chief, of another small
+village wished to fine our men for placing their muskets against an
+old tumble-down hut, it being that of the Pondoro. At times the
+Pondoro employs his acquired powers in hunting for the benefit of the
+village; and after an absence of a day or two, his wife smells the
+lion, takes a certain medicine, places it in the forest, and there
+quickly leaves it, lest the lion should kill even her. This medicine
+enables the Pondoro to change himself back into a man, return to the
+village, and say, "Go and get the game that I have killed for you."
+Advantage is of course taken of what a lion has done, and they go and
+bring home the buffalo or antelope killed when he was a lion, or
+rather found when he was patiently pursuing his course of deception
+in the forest. We saw the Pondoro of another village dressed in a
+fantastic style, with numerous charms hung round him, and followed by
+a troop of boys who were honouring him with rounds of shrill
+cheering.
+
+It is believed also that the souls of departed chiefs enter into
+lions, and render them sacred. On one occasion, when we had shot a
+buffalo in the path beyond the Kafue, a hungry lion, attracted
+probably by the smell of the meat, came close to our camp, and roused
+up all hands by his roaring. Tuba Mokoro, imbued with the popular
+belief that the beast was a chief in disguise, scolded him roundly
+during his brief intervals of silence. "You a chief, eh? You call
+yourself a chief, do you? What kind of chief are you to come
+sneaking about in the dark, trying to steal our buffalo meat! Are
+you not ashamed of yourself? A pretty chief truly; you are like the
+scavenger beetle, and think of yourself only. You have not the heart
+of a chief; why don't you kill your own beef? You must have a stone
+in your chest, and no heart at all, indeed!" Tuba Mokoro producing
+no impression on the transformed chief, one of the men, the most
+sedate of the party, who seldom spoke, took up the matter, and tried
+the lion in another strain. In his slow quiet way he expostulated
+with him on the impropriety of such conduct to strangers, who had
+never injured him. "We were travelling peaceably through the country
+back to our own chief. We never killed people, nor stole anything.
+The buffalo meat was ours, not his, and it did not become a great
+chief like him to be prowling round in the dark, trying, like a
+hyena, to steal the meat of strangers. He might go and hunt for
+himself, as there was plenty of game in the forest." The Pondoro,
+being deaf to reason, and only roaring the louder, the men became
+angry, and threatened to send a ball through him if he did not go
+away. They snatched up their guns to shoot him, but he prudently
+kept in the dark, outside the luminous circle made by our camp fires,
+and there they did not like to venture. A little strychnine was put
+into a piece of meat, and thrown to him, when he soon departed, and
+we heard no more of the majestic sneaker.
+
+The Kebrabasa people were now plumper and in better condition than on
+our former visits; the harvest had been abundant; they had plenty to
+eat and drink, and they were enjoying life as much as ever they
+could. At Defwe's village, near where the ship lay on her first
+ascent, we found two Mfumos or headmen, the son and son-in-law of the
+former chief. A sister's son has much more chance of succeeding to a
+chieftainship than the chief's own offspring, it being unquestionable
+that the sister's child has the family blood. The men are all marked
+across the nose and up the middle of the forehead with short
+horizontal bars or cicatrices; and a single brass earring of two or
+three inches diameter, like the ancient Egyptian, is worn by the men.
+Some wear the hair long like the ancient Assyrians and Egyptians, and
+a few have eyes with the downward and inward slant of the Chinese.
+
+After fording the rapid Luia, we left our former path on the banks of
+the Zambesi, and struck off in a N.W. direction behind one of the
+hill ranges, the eastern end of which is called Mongwa, the name of
+an acacia, having a peculiarly strong fetor, found on it. Our route
+wound up a valley along a small mountain-stream which was nearly dry,
+and then crossed the rocky spurs of some of the lofty hills. The
+country was all very dry at the time, and no water was found except
+in an occasional spring and a few wells dug in the beds of
+watercourses. The people were poor, and always anxious to convince
+travellers of the fact. The men, unlike those on the plains, spend a
+good deal of their time in hunting; this may be because they have but
+little ground on the hill-sides suitable for gardens, and but little
+certainty of reaping what may be sown in the valleys. No women came
+forward in the hamlet, east of Chiperiziwa, where we halted for the
+night. Two shots had been fired at guinea-fowl a little way off in
+the valley; the women fled into the woods, and the men came to know
+if war was meant, and a few of the old folks only returned after
+hearing that we were for peace. The headman, Kambira, apologized for
+not having a present ready, and afterwards brought us some meal, a
+roasted coney (Hyrax capensis), and a pot of beer; he wished to be
+thought poor. The beer had come to him from a distance; he had none
+of his own. Like the Manganja, these people salute by clapping their
+hands. When a man comes to a place where others are seated, before
+sitting down he claps his hands to each in succession, and they do
+the same to him. If he has anything to tell, both speaker and hearer
+clap their hands at the close of every paragraph, and then again
+vigorously at the end of the speech. The guide, whom the headman
+gave us, thus saluted each of his comrades before he started off with
+us. There is so little difference in the language, that all the
+tribes of this region are virtually of one family.
+
+We proceeded still in the same direction, and passed only two small
+hamlets during the day. Except the noise our men made on the march,
+everything was still around us: few birds were seen. The appearance
+of a whydahbird showed that he had not yet parted with his fine long
+plumes. We passed immense quantities of ebony and lignum-vitae, and
+the tree from whose smooth and bitter bark granaries are made for
+corn. The country generally is clothed with a forest of ordinary-
+sized trees. We slept in the little village near Sindabwe, where our
+men contrived to purchase plenty of beer, and were uncommonly
+boisterous all the evening. We breakfasted next morning under green
+wild date-palms, beside the fine flowery stream, which runs through
+the charming valley of Zibah. We now had Mount Chiperiziwa between
+us, and part of the river near Morumbwa, having in fact come north
+about in order to avoid the difficulties of our former path. The
+last of the deserters, a reputed thief, took French leave of us here.
+He left the bundle of cloth he was carrying in the path a hundred
+yards in front of where we halted, but made off with the musket and
+most of the brass rings and beads of his comrade Shirimba, who had
+unsuspectingly intrusted them to his care.
+
+Proceeding S.W. up this lovely valley, in about an hour's time we
+reached Sandia's village. The chief was said to be absent hunting,
+and they did not know when he would return. This is such a common
+answer to the inquiry after a headman, that one is inclined to think
+that it only means that they wish to know the stranger's object
+before exposing their superior to danger. As some of our men were
+ill, a halt was made here.
+
+As we were unable to march next morning, six of our young men,
+anxious to try their muskets, went off to hunt elephants. For
+several hours they saw nothing, and some of them, getting tired,
+proposed to go to a village and buy food. "No!" said Mantlanyane,
+"we came to hunt, so let us go on." In a short time they fell in
+with a herd of cow elephants and calves. As soon as the first cow
+caught sight of the hunters on the rocks above her, she, with true
+motherly instinct, placed her young one between her fore-legs for
+protection. The men were for scattering, and firing into the herd
+indiscriminately. "That won't do," cried Mantlanyane, "let us all
+fire at this one." The poor beast received a volley, and ran down
+into the plain, where another shot killed her; the young one escaped
+with the herd. The men were wild with excitement, and danced round
+the fallen queen of the forest, with loud shouts and exultant songs.
+They returned, bearing as trophies the tail and part of the trunk,
+and marched into camp as erect as soldiers, and evidently feeling
+that their stature had increased considerably since the morning.
+
+Sandia's wife was duly informed of their success, as here a law
+decrees that half the elephant belongs to the chief on whose ground
+it has been killed. The Portuguese traders always submit to this
+tax, and, were it of native origin, it could hardly be considered
+unjust. A chief must have some source of revenue; and, as many
+chiefs can raise none except from ivory or slaves, this tax is more
+free from objections than any other that a black Chancellor of the
+Exchequer could devise. It seems, however, to have originated with
+the Portuguese themselves, and then to have spread among the adjacent
+tribes. The Governors look sharply after any elephant that may be
+slain on the Crown lands, and demand one of the tusks from their
+vassals. We did not find the law in operation in any tribe beyond
+the range of Portuguese traders, or further than the sphere of travel
+of those Arabs who imitated Portuguese customs in trade. At the
+Kafue in 1855 the chiefs bought the meat we killed, and demanded
+nothing as their due; and so it was up the Shire during our visits.
+The slaves of the Portuguese, who are sent by their masters to shoot
+elephants, probably connive at the extension of this law, for they
+strive to get the good will of the chiefs to whose country they come,
+by advising them to make a demand of half of each elephant killed,
+and for this advice they are well paid in beer. When we found that
+the Portuguese argued in favour of this law, we told the natives that
+they might exact tusks from THEM, but that the English, being
+different, preferred the pure native custom. It was this which made
+Sandia, as afterwards mentioned, hesitate; but we did not care to
+insist on exemption in our favour, where the prevalence of the custom
+might have been held to justify the exaction.
+
+The cutting up of an elephant is quite a unique spectacle. The men
+stand remind the animal in dead silence, while the chief of the
+travelling party declares that, according to ancient law, the head
+and right hind-leg belong to him who killed the beast, that is, to
+him who inflicted the first wound; the left leg to bins who delivered
+the second, or first touched the animal after it fell. The meat
+around the eye to the English, or chief of the travellers, and
+different parts to the headmen of the different fires, or groups, of
+which the camp is composed; not forgetting to enjoin the preservation
+of the fat and bowels for a second distribution. This oration
+finished, the natives soon become excited, and scream wildly as they
+cut away at the carcass with a score of spears, whose long handles
+quiver in the air above their heads. Their excitement becomes
+momentarily more and more intense, and reaches the culminating point
+when, as denoted by a roar of gas, the huge mass is laid fairly open.
+Some jump inside, and roll about there in their eagerness to seize
+the precious fat, while others run off, screaming, with pieces of the
+bloody meat, throw it on the grass, and run back for more: all keep
+talking and shouting at the utmost pitch of their voices. Sometimes
+two or three, regardless of all laws, seize the same piece of meat,
+and have a brief fight of words over it. Occasionally an agonized
+yell bursts forth, and a native emerges out of the moving mass of
+dead elephant and wriggling humanity, with his hand badly cut by the
+spear of his excited friend and neighbour: this requires a rag and
+some soothing words to prevent bad blood. In an incredibly short
+time tons of meat are cut up, and placed in separate heaps around.
+
+Sandia arrived soon after the beast was divided: he is an elderly
+man, and wears a wig made of "ife" fibre (sanseviera) dyed black, and
+of a fine glossy appearance. This plant is allied to the aloes, and
+its thick fleshy leaves, in shape somewhat like our sedges, when
+bruised yield much fine strong fibre, which is made into ropes, nets,
+and wigs. It takes dyes readily, and the fibre might form a good
+article of commerce. "Ife" wigs, as we afterwards saw, are not
+uncommon in this country, though perhaps not so common as hair wigs
+at home. Sandia's mosamela, or small carved wooden pillow, exactly
+resembling the ancient Egyptian one, was hung from the back of his
+neck; this pillow and a sleeping mat are usually carried by natives
+when on hunting excursions.
+
+We had the elephant's fore-foot cooked for ourselves, in native
+fashion. A large hole was dug in the ground, in which a fire was
+made; and, when the inside was thoroughly heated, the entire foot was
+placed in it, and covered over with the hot ashes and soil; another
+fire was made above the whole, and kept burning all night. We had
+the foot thus cooked for breakfast next morning, and found it
+delicious. It is a whitish mass, slightly gelatinous, and sweet,
+like marrow. A long march, to prevent biliousness, is a wise
+precaution after a meal of elephant's foot. Elephant's trunk and
+tongue are also good, and, after long simmering, much resemble the
+hump of a buffalo and the tongue of an ox; but all the other meat is
+tough, and, from its peculiar flavour, only to be eaten by a hungry
+man. The quantities of meat our men devour is quite astounding.
+They boil as much as their pots will hold, and eat till it becomes
+physically impossible for them to stow away any more. An uproarious
+dance follows, accompanied with stentorian song; and as soon as they
+have shaken their first course down, and washed off the sweat and
+dust of the after performance, they go to work to roast more: a
+short snatch of sleep succeeds, and they are up and at it again; all
+night long it is boil and eat, roast and devour, with a few brief
+interludes of sleep. Like other carnivora, these men can endure
+hunger for a much longer period than the mere porridge-eating tribes.
+Our men can cook meat as well as any reasonable traveller could
+desire; and, boiled in earthen pots, like Indian chatties, it tastes
+much better than when cooked in iron ones.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V.
+
+
+
+Magnificent scenery--Method of marching--Hippopotamus killed--Lions
+and buffalo--Sequasha the ivory-trader.
+
+Sandia gave us two guides; and on the 4th of June we left the
+Elephant valley, taking a westerly course; and, after crossing a few
+ridges, entered the Chingerere or Paguruguru valley, through which,
+in the rainy season, runs the streamlet Pajodze. The mountains on
+our left, between us and the Zambesi, our guides told us have the
+same name as the valley, but that at the confluence of the Pajodze is
+called Morumbwa. We struck the river at less than half a mile to the
+north of the cataract Morumbwa. On climbing up the base of this
+mountain at Pajodze, we found that we were distant only the diameter
+of the mountain from the cataract. In measuring the cataract we
+formerly stood on its southern flank; now we were perched on its
+northern flank, and at once recognized the onion-shaped mountain,
+here called Zakavuma, whose smooth convex surface overlooks the
+broken water. Its bearing by compass was l80 degrees from the spot
+to which we had climbed, and 700 or 800 yards distant. We now, from
+this standing-point, therefore, completed our inspection of all
+Kebrabasa, and saw what, as a whole, was never before seen by
+Europeans so far as any records show.
+
+The remainder of the Kebrabasa path, on to Chicova, was close to the
+compressed and rocky river. Ranges of lofty tree-covered mountains,
+with deep narrow valleys, in which are dry watercourses, or flowing
+rivulets, stretch from the north-west, and are prolonged on the
+opposite side of the river in a south-easterly direction. Looking
+back, the mountain scenery in Kebrabasa was magnificent; conspicuous
+from their form and steep sides, are the two gigantic portals of the
+cataract; the vast forests still wore their many brilliant autumnal-
+coloured tints of green, yellow, red, purple, and brown, thrown into
+relief by the grey bark of the trunks in the background. Among these
+variegated trees were some conspicuous for their new livery of fresh
+light-green leaves, as though the winter of others was their spring.
+The bright sunshine in these mountain forests, and the ever-changing
+forms of the cloud shadows, gliding over portions of the surface,
+added fresh charms to scenes already surpassingly beautiful.
+
+From what we have seen of the Kebrabasa rocks and rapids, it appears
+too evident that they must always form a barrier to navigation at the
+ordinary low water of the river; but the rise of the water in this
+gorge being as much as eighty feet perpendicularly, it is probable
+that a steamer might be taken up at high flood, when all the rapids
+are smoothed over, to run on the Upper Zambesi. The most formidable
+cataract in it, Morumbwa, has only about twenty feet of fall, in a
+distance of thirty yards, and it must entirely disappear when the
+water stands eighty feet higher. Those of the Makololo who worked on
+board the ship were not sorry at the steamer being left below, as
+they had become heartily tired of cutting the wood that the
+insatiable furnace of the "Asthmatic" required. Mbia, who was a bit
+of a wag, laughingly exclaimed in broken English, "Oh, Kebrabasa
+good, very good; no let shippee up to Sekeletu, too muchee work,
+cuttee woodyee, cuttee woodyee: Kebrabasa good." It is currently
+reported, and commonly believed, that once upon a time a Portuguese
+named Jose Pedra,--by the natives called Nyamatimbira,--chief, or
+capitao mor, of Zumbo, a man of large enterprise and small humanity,-
+-being anxious to ascertain if Kebrabasa could be navigated, made two
+slaves fast to a canoe, and launched it from Chicova into Kebrabasa,
+in order to see if it would come out at the other end. As neither
+slaves nor canoe ever appeared again, his Excellency concluded that
+Kebrabasa was unnavigable. A trader had a large canoe swept away by
+a sudden rise of the river, and it was found without damage below;
+but the most satisfactory information was that of old Sandia, who
+asserted that in flood all Kebrabasa became quite smooth, and he had
+often seen it so.
+
+We emerged from the thirty-five or forty miles of Kebrabasa hills
+into the Chicova plains on the 7th of June, 1860, having made short
+marches all the way. The cold nights caused some of our men to cough
+badly, and colds in this country almost invariably become fever. The
+Zambesi suddenly expands at Chicova, and assumes the size and
+appearance it has at Tette. Near this point we found a large seam of
+coal exposed in the left bank.
+
+We met with native travellers occasionally. Those on a long journey
+carry with them a sleeping-mat and wooden pillow, cooking-pot and bag
+of meal, pipe and tobacco-pouch, a knife, bow, and arrows, and two
+small sticks, of from two to three feet in length, for making fire,
+when obliged to sleep away from human habitations. Dry wood is
+always abundant, and they get fire by the following method. A notch
+is cut in one of the sticks, which, with a close-grained outside, has
+a small core of pith, and this notched stick is laid horizontally on
+a knife-blade on the ground; the operator squatting, places his great
+toes on each end to keep all steady, and taking the other wand which
+is of very hard wood cut to a blunt point, fits it into the notch at
+right angles; the upright wand is made to spin rapidly backwards and
+forwards between the palms of the hands, drill fashion, and at the
+same time is pressed downwards; the friction, in the course of a
+minute or so, ignites portions of the pith of the notched stick,
+which, rolling over like live charcoal on to the knife-blade, are
+lifted into a handful of fine dry grass, and carefully blown, by
+waving backwards and forwards in the air. It is hard work for the
+hands to procure fire by this process, as the vigorous drilling and
+downward pressure requisite soon blister soft palms.
+
+Having now entered a country where lions were numerous, our men began
+to pay greater attention to the arrangements of the camp at night.
+As they are accustomed to do with their chiefs, they place the white
+men in the centre; Kanyata, his men, and the two donkeys, camp on our
+right; Tuba Mokoro's party of Bashubia are in front; Masakasa, and
+Sininyane's body of Batoka, on the left; and in the rear six Tette
+men have their fires. In placing their fires they are careful to put
+them where the smoke will not blow in our faces. Soon after we halt,
+the spot for the English is selected, and all regulate their places
+accordingly, and deposit their burdens. The men take it by turns to
+cut some of the tall dry grass, and spread it for our beds on a spot,
+either naturally level, or smoothed by the hoe; some, appointed to
+carry our bedding, then bring our rugs and karosses, and place the
+three rugs in a row on the grass; Dr. Livingstone's being in the
+middle, Dr. Kirk's on the right, and Charles Livingstone's on the
+left. Our bags, rifles, and revolvers are carefully placed at our
+heads, and a fire made near our feet. We have no tent nor covering
+of any kind except the branches of the tree under which we may happen
+to lie; and it is a pretty sight to look up and see every branch,
+leaf, and twig of the tree stand out, reflected against the clear
+star-spangled and moonlit sky. The stars of the first magnitude have
+names which convey the same meaning over very wide tracts of country.
+Here when Venus comes out in the evenings, she is called Ntanda, the
+eldest or first-born, and Manjika, the first-born of morning, at
+other times: she has so much radiance when shining alone, that she
+casts a shadow. Sirius is named Kuewa usiko, "drawer of night,"
+because supposed to draw the whole night after it. The moon has no
+evil influence in this country, so far as we know. We have lain and
+looked up at her, till sweet sleep closed our eyes, unharmed. Four
+or five of our men were affected with moon-blindness at Tette; though
+they had not slept out of doors there, they became so blind that
+their comrades had to guide their hands to the general dish of food;
+the affection is unknown in their own country. When our posterity
+shall have discovered what it is which, distinct from foul smells,
+causes fever, and what, apart from the moon, causes men to be moon-
+struck, they will pity our dulness of perception.
+
+The men cut a very small quantity of grass for themselves, and sleep
+in fumbas or sleeping-bags, which are double mats of palm-leaf, six
+feet long by four wide, and sewn together round three parts of the
+square, and left open only on one side. They are used as a
+protection from the cold, wet, and mosquitoes, and are entered as we
+should get into our beds, were the blankets nailed to the top,
+bottom, and one side of the bedstead.
+
+A dozen fires are nightly kindled in the camp; and these, being
+replenished from time to time by the men who are awakened by the
+cold, are kept burning until daylight. Abundance of dry hard wood is
+obtained with little trouble; and burns beautifully. After the great
+business of cooking and eating is over, all sit round the camp-fires,
+and engage in talking or singing. Every evening one of the Batoka
+plays his "sansa," and continues at it until far into the night; he
+accompanies it with an extempore song, in which he rehearses their
+deeds ever since they left their own country. At times animated
+political discussions spring up, and the amount of eloquence expended
+on these occasions is amazing. The whole camp is aroused, and the
+men shout to one another from the different fires; whilst some, whose
+tongues are never heard on any other subject, burst forth into
+impassioned speech.
+
+As a specimen of our mode of marching, we rise about five, or as soon
+as dawn appears, take a cup of tea and a bit of biscuit; the servants
+fold up the blankets and stow them away in the bags they carry; the
+others tie their fumbas and cooking-pots to each end of their
+carrying-sticks, which are borne on the shoulder; the cook secures
+the dishes, and all are on the path by sunrise. If a convenient spot
+can be found we halt for breakfast about nine a.m. To save time,
+this meal is generally cooked the night before, and has only to be
+warmed. We continue the march after breakfast, rest a little in the
+middle of the day, and break off early in the afternoon. We average
+from two to two-and-a-half miles an hour in a straight line, or as
+the crow flies, and seldom have more than five or six hours a day of
+actual travel. This in a hot climate is as much as a man can
+accomplish without being oppressed; and we always tried to make our
+progress more a pleasure than a toil. To hurry over the ground,
+abuse, and look ferocious at one's native companions, merely for the
+foolish vanity of boasting how quickly a distance was accomplished,
+is a combination of silliness with absurdity quite odious; while
+kindly consideration for the feelings of even blacks, the pleasure of
+observing scenery and everything new as one moves on at an ordinary
+pace, and the participation in the most delicious rest with our
+fellows, render travelling delightful. Though not given to over
+haste, we were a little surprised to find that we could tire our men
+out; and even the headman, who carried but little more than we did,
+and never, as we often had to do, hunted in the afternoon, was no
+better than his comrades. Our experience tends to prove that the
+European constitution has a power of endurance, even in the tropics,
+greater than that of the hardiest of the meat-eating Africans.
+
+After pitching our camp, one or two of us usually go off to hunt,
+more as a matter of necessity than of pleasure, for the men, as well
+as ourselves, must have meat. We prefer to take a man with us to
+carry home the game, or lead the others to where it lies; but as they
+frequently grumble and complain of being tired, we do not
+particularly object to going alone, except that it involves the extra
+labour of our making a second trip to show the men where the animal
+that has been shot is to be found. When it is a couple of miles off
+it is rather fatiguing to have to go twice; more especially on the
+days when it is solely to supply their wants that, instead of resting
+ourselves, we go at all. Like those who perform benevolent deeds at
+home, the tired hunter, though trying hard to live in charity with
+all men, is strongly tempted to give it up by bringing only
+sufficient meat for the three whites and leaving the rest; thus
+sending the "idle ungrateful poor" supperless to bed. And yet it is
+only by continuance in well-doing, even to the length of what the
+worldly-wise call weakness, that the conviction is produced anywhere,
+that our motives are high enough to secure sincere respect.
+
+A jungle of mimosa, ebony, and "wait-a-bit" thorn lies between the
+Chicova flats and the cultivated plain, on which stand the villages
+of the chief, Chitora. He brought us a present of food and drink,
+because, as he, with the innate politeness of an African, said, he
+"did not wish us to sleep hungry: he had heard of the Doctor when he
+passed down, and had a great desire to see and converse with him; but
+he was a child then, and could not speak in the presence of great
+men. He was glad that he had seen the English now, and was sorry
+that his people were away, or he should have made them cook for us."
+All his subsequent conduct showed him to be sincere.
+
+Many of the African women are particular about the water they use for
+drinking and cooking, and prefer that which is filtered through sand.
+To secure this, they scrape holes in the sandbanks beside the stream,
+and scoop up the water, which slowly filters through, rather than
+take it from the equally clear and limpid river. This practice is
+common in the Zambesi, the Rovuma, and Lake Nyassa; and some of the
+Portuguese at Tette have adopted the native custom, and send canoes
+to a low island in the middle of the river for water. Chitora's
+people also obtained their supply from shallow wells in the sandy bed
+of a small rivulet close to the village. The habit may have arisen
+from observing the unhealthiness of the main stream at certain
+seasons. During nearly nine months in the year, ordure is deposited
+around countless villages along the thousands of miles drained by the
+Zambesi. When the heavy rains come down, and sweep the vast fetid
+accumulation into the torrents, the water is polluted with filth;
+and, but for the precaution mentioned, the natives would prove
+themselves as little fastidious as those in London who drink the
+abomination poured into the Thames by Reading and Oxford. It is no
+wonder that sailors suffered so much from fever after drinking
+African river water, before the present admirable system of
+condensing it was adopted in our navy.
+
+The scent of man is excessively terrible to game of all kinds, much
+more so, probably, than the sight of him. A herd of antelopes, a
+hundred yards off, gazed at us as we moved along the winding path,
+and timidly stood their ground until half our line had passed, but
+darted off the instant they "got the wind," or caught the flavour of
+those who had gone by. The sport is all up with the hunter who gets
+to the windward of the African beast, as it cannot stand even the
+distant aroma of the human race, so much dreaded by all wild animals.
+Is this the fear and the dread of man, which the Almighty said to
+Noah was to be upon every beast of the field? A lion may, while
+lying in wait for his prey, leap on a human being as he would on any
+other animal, save a rhinoceros or an elephant, that happened to
+pass; or a lioness, when she has cubs, might attack a man, who,
+passing "up the wind of her," had unconsciously, by his scent,
+alarmed her for the safety of her whelps; or buffaloes, amid other
+animals, might rush at a line of travellers, in apprehension of being
+surrounded by them; but neither beast nor snake will, as a general
+rule, turn on man except when wounded, or by mistake. If gorillas,
+unwounded, advance to do battle with him, and beat their breasts in
+defiance, they are an exception to all wild beasts known to us. From
+the way an elephant runs at the first glance of man, it is inferred
+that this huge brute, though really king of beasts, would run even
+from a child.
+
+Our two donkeys caused as much admiration as the three white men.
+Great was the astonishment when one of the donkeys began to bray.
+The timid jumped more than if a lion had roared beside them. All
+were startled, and stared in mute amazement at the harsh-voiced one,
+till the last broken note was uttered; then, on being assured that
+nothing in particular was meant, they looked at each other, and burst
+into a loud laugh at their common surprise. When one donkey
+stimulated the other to try his vocal powers, the interest felt by
+the startled visitors, must have equalled that of the Londoners, when
+they first crowded to see the famous hippopotamus.
+
+We were now, when we crossed the boundary rivulet Nyamatarara, out of
+Chicova and amongst sandstone rocks, similar to those which prevail
+between Lupata and Kebrabasa. In the latter gorge, as already
+mentioned, igneous and syenitic masses have been acted on by some
+great fiery convulsion of nature; the strata are thrown into a
+huddled heap of confusion. The coal has of course disappeared in
+Kebrabasa, but is found again in Chicova. Tette grey sandstone is
+common about Sinjere, and wherever it is seen with fossil wood upon
+it, coal lies beneath; and here, as at Chicova, some seams crop out
+on the banks of the Zambesi. Looking southwards, the country is open
+plain and woodland, with detached hills and mountains in the
+distance; but the latter are too far off, the natives say, for them
+to know their names. The principal hills on our right, as we look up
+stream, are from six to twelve miles away, and occasionally they send
+down spurs to the river, with brooks flowing through their narrow
+valleys. The banks of the Zambesi show two well-defined terraces;
+the first, or lowest, being usually narrow, and of great fertility,
+while the upper one is a dry grassy plain, a thorny jungle, or a
+mopane (Bauhinia) forest. One of these plains, near the Kafue, is
+covered with the large stumps and trunks of a petrified forest. We
+halted a couple of days by the fine stream Sinjere, which comes from
+the Chiroby-roby hills, about eight miles to the north. Many lumps
+of coal, brought down by the rapid current, lie in its channel. The
+natives never seem to have discovered that coal would burn, and, when
+informed of the fact, shook their heads, smiled incredulously, and
+said "Kodi" (really), evidently regarding it as a mere traveller's
+tale. They were astounded to see it burning freely on our fire of
+wood. They told us that plenty of it was seen among the hills; but,
+being long ago aware that we were now in an immense coalfield, we did
+not care to examine it further.
+
+A dyke of black basaltic rock, called Kakolole, crosses the river
+near the mouth of the Sinjere; but it has two open gateways in it of
+from sixty to eighty yards in breadth, and the channel is very deep.
+
+On a shallow sandbank, under the dyke, lay a herd of hippopotami in
+fancied security. The young ones were playing with each other like
+young puppies, climbing on the backs of their dams, trying to take
+hold of one another by the jaws and tumbling over into the water.
+Mbia, one of the Makololo, waded across to within a dozen yards of
+the drowsy beasts, and shot the father of the herd; who, being very
+fat, soon floated, and was secured at the village below. The headman
+of the village visited us while we were at breakfast. He wore a
+black "ife" wig and a printed shirt. After a short silence he said
+to Masakasa, "You are with the white people, so why do you not tell
+them to give me a cloth?" "We are strangers," answered Masakasa,
+"why do you not bring us some food?" He took the plain hint, and
+brought us two fowls, in order that we should not report that in
+passing him we got nothing to eat; and, as usual, we gave a cloth in
+return. In reference to the hippopotamus he would make no demand,
+but said he would take what we chose to give him. The men gorged
+themselves with meat for two days, and cut large quantities into long
+narrow strips, which they half-dried and half-roasted on wooden
+frames over the fire. Much game is taken in this neighbourhood in
+pitfalls. Sharp-pointed stakes are set in the bottom, on which the
+game tumbles and gets impaled. The natives are careful to warn
+strangers of these traps, and also of the poisoned beams suspended on
+the tall trees for the purpose of killing elephants and hippopotami.
+It is not difficult to detect the pitfalls after one's attention has
+been called to them; but in places where they are careful to carry
+the earth off to a distance, and a person is not thinking of such
+things, a sudden descent of nine feet is an experience not easily
+forgotten by the traveller. The sensations of one thus
+instantaneously swallowed up by the earth are peculiar. A momentary
+suspension of consciousness is followed by the rustling sound of a
+shower of sand and dry grass, and the half-bewildered thought of
+where he is, and how he came into darkness. Reason awakes to assure
+him that he must have come down through that small opening of
+daylight overhead, and that he is now where a hippopotamus ought to
+have been. The descent of a hippopotamus pitfall is easy, but to get
+out again into the upper air is a work of labour. The sides are
+smooth and treacherous, and the cross reeds, which support the
+covering, break in the attempt to get out by clutching them. A cry
+from the depths is unheard by those around, and it is only by
+repeated and most desperate efforts that the buried alive can regain
+the upper world. At Tette we are told of a white hunter, of
+unusually small stature, who plumped into a pit while stalking a
+guinea-fowl on a tree. It was the labour of an entire forenoon to
+get out; and he was congratulating himself on his escape, and
+brushing off the clay from his clothes, when down he went into a
+second pit, which happened, as is often the case, to be close beside
+the first, and it was evening before he could work himself out of
+THAT.
+
+Elephants and buffaloes seldom return to the river by the same path
+on two successive nights, they become so apprehensive of danger from
+this human art. An old elephant will walk in advance of the herd,
+and uncover the pits with his trunk, that the others may see the
+openings and tread on firm ground. Female elephants are generally
+the victims: more timid by nature than the males, and very motherly
+in their anxiety for their calves, they carry their trunks up, trying
+every breeze for fancied danger, which often in reality lies at their
+feet. The tusker, fearing less, keeps his trunk down, and, warned in
+time by that exquisitely sensitive organ, takes heed to his ways.
+
+Our camp on the Sinjere stood under a wide-spreading wild fig-tree.
+From the numbers of this family, of large size, dotted over the
+country, the fig or banyan species would seem to have been held
+sacred in Africa from the remotest times. The soil teemed with white
+ants, whose clay tunnels, formed to screen them from the eyes of
+birds, thread over the ground, up the trunks of trees, and along the
+branches, from which the little architects clear away all rotten or
+dead wood. Very often the exact shape of branches is left in tunnels
+on the ground and not a bit of the wood inside. The first night we
+passed here these destructive insects ate through our grass-beds, and
+attacked our blankets, and certain large red-headed ones even bit our
+flesh.
+
+On some days not a single white ant is to be seen abroad; and on
+others, and during certain hours, they appear out of doors in
+myriads, and work with extraordinary zeal and energy in carrying bits
+of dried grass down into their nests. During these busy reaping-fits
+the lizards and birds have a good time of it, and enjoy a rich feast
+at the expense of thousands of hapless workmen; and when they swarm
+they are caught in countless numbers by the natives, and their
+roasted bodies are spoken of in an unctuous manner as resembling
+grains of soft rice fried in delicious fresh oil.
+
+A strong marauding party of large black ants attacked a nest of white
+ones near the camp: as the contest took place beneath the surface,
+we could not see the order of the battle; but it soon became apparent
+that the blacks had gained the day, and sacked the white town, for
+they returned in triumph, bearing off the eggs, and choice bits of
+the bodies of the vanquished. A gift, analogous to that of language,
+has not been withheld from ants: if part of their building is
+destroyed, an official is seen coming out to examine the damage; and,
+after a careful survey of the ruins, he chirrups a few clear and
+distinct notes, and a crowd of workers begin at once to repair the
+breach. When the work is completed, another order is given, and the
+workmen retire, as will appear on removing the soft freshly-built
+portion. We tried to sleep one rainy might in a native hut, but
+could not because of attacks by the fighting battalions of a very
+small species of formica, not more than one-sixteenth of an inch in
+length. It soon became obvious that they were under regular
+discipline, and even attempting to carry out the skilful plans and
+stratagems of some eminent leader. Our hands and necks were the
+first objects of attack. Large bodies of these little pests were
+massed in silence round the point to be assaulted. We could hear the
+sharp shrill word of command two or three times repeated, though
+until then we had not believed in the vocal power of an ant; the
+instant after we felt the storming hosts range over head and neck,
+biting the tender skin, clinging with a death-grip to the hair, and
+parting with their jaws rather than quit their hold. On our lying
+down again in the hope of their having been driven off, no sooner was
+the light out, and all still, than the manoeuvre was repeated. Clear
+and audible orders were issued, and the assault renewed. It was as
+hard to sleep in that hut as in the trenches before Sebastopol. The
+white ant, being a vegetable feeder, devours articles of vegetable
+origin only, and leather, which, by tanning, is imbued with a
+vegetable flavour. "A man may be rich to-day and poor to-morrow,
+from the ravages of white ants," said a Portuguese merchant. "If he
+gets sick, and unable to look after his goods, his slaves neglect
+them, and they are soon destroyed by these insects." The reddish
+ant, in the west called drivers, crossed our path daily, in solid
+columns an inch wide, and never did the pugnacity of either man or
+beast exceed theirs. It is a sufficient cause of war if you only
+approach them, even by accident. Some turn out of the ranks and
+stand with open mandibles, or, charging with extended jaws, bite with
+savage ferocity. When hunting, we lighted among them too often;
+while we were intent on the game, and without a thought of ants, they
+quietly covered us from head to foot, then all began to bite at the
+same instant; seizing a piece of the skin with their powerful
+pincers, they twisted themselves round with it, as if determined to
+tear it out. Their bites are so terribly sharp that the bravest must
+run, and then strip to pick off those that still cling with their
+hooked jaws, as with steel forceps. This kind abounds in damp
+places, and is usually met with on the banks of streams. We have not
+heard of their actually killing any animal except the Python, and
+that only when gorged and quite lethargic, but they soon clear away
+any dead animal matter; this appears to be their principal food, and
+their use in the economy of nature is clearly in the scavenger line.
+
+We started from the Sinjere on the 12th of June, our men carrying
+with them bundles of hippopotamus meat for sale, and for future use.
+We rested for breakfast opposite the Kakolole dyke, which confines
+the channel, west of the Manyerere mountain. A rogue monkey, the
+largest by far that we ever saw, and very fat and tame, walked off
+leisurely from a garden as we approached. The monkey is a sacred
+animal in this region, and is never molested or killed, because the
+people believe devoutly that the souls of their ancestors now occupy
+these degraded forms, and anticipate that they themselves must,
+sooner or later, be transformed in like manner; a future as cheerless
+for the black as the spirit-rapper's heaven is for the whites. The
+gardens are separated from each other by a single row of small
+stones, a few handfuls of grass, or a slight furrow made by the hoe.
+Some are enclosed by a reed fence of the flimsiest construction, yet
+sufficient to keep out the ever wary hippopotamus, who dreads a trap.
+His extreme caution is taken advantage of by the women, who hang, as
+a miniature trap-beam, a kigelia fruit with a bit of stick in the
+end. This protects the maize, of which he is excessively fond.
+
+The quantity of hippopotamus meat eaten by our men made some of them
+ill, and our marches were necessarily short. After three hours'
+travel on the 13th, we spent the remainder of the day at the village
+of Chasiribera, on a rivulet flowing through a beautiful valley to
+the north, which is bounded by magnificent mountain-ranges. Pinkwe,
+or Mbingwe, otherwise Moeu, forms the south-eastern angle of the
+range. On the 16th June we were at the flourishing village of Senga,
+under the headman Manyame, which lies at the foot of the mount
+Motemwa. Nearly all the mountains in this country are covered with
+open forest and grass, in colour, according to the season, green or
+yellow. Many are between 2000 and 3000 feet high, with the sky line
+fringed with trees; the rocks show just sufficiently for one to
+observe their stratification, or their granitic form, and though not
+covered with dense masses of climbing plants, like those in moister
+eastern climates, there is still the idea conveyed that most of the
+steep sides are fertile, and none give the impression of that
+barrenness which, in northern mountains, suggests the idea that the
+bones of the world are sticking through its skin.
+
+The villagers reported that we were on the footsteps of a Portuguese
+half-caste, who, at Senga, lately tried to purchase ivory, but, in
+consequence of his having murdered a chief near Zumbo and twenty of
+his men, the people declined to trade with him. He threatened to
+take the ivory by force, if they would not sell it; but that same
+night the ivory and the women were spirited out of the village, and
+only a large body of armed men remained. The trader, fearing that he
+might come off second best if it came to blows, immediately departed.
+Chikwanitsela, or Sekuanangila, is the paramount chief of some fifty
+miles of the northern bank of the Zambesi in this locality. He lives
+on the opposite, or southern side, and there his territory is still
+more extensive. We sent him a present from Senga, and were informed
+by a messenger next morning that he had a cough and could not come
+over to see us. "And has his present a cough too," remarked one of
+our party, "that it does not come to us? Is this the way your chief
+treats strangers, receives their present, and sends them no food in
+return?" Our men thought Chikwanitsela an uncommonly stingy fellow;
+but, as it was possible that some of them might yet wish to return
+this way, they did not like to scold him more than this, which was
+sufficiently to the point.
+
+Men and women were busily engaged in preparing the ground for the
+November planting. Large game was abundant; herds of elephants and
+buffaloes came down to the river in the night, but were a long way
+off by daylight. They soon adopt this habit in places where they are
+hunted.
+
+The plains we travel over are constantly varying in breadth,
+according as the furrowed and wooded hills approach or recede from
+the river. On the southern side we see the hill Bungwe, and the
+long, level, wooded ridge Nyangombe, the first of a series bending
+from the S.E. to the N.W. past the Zambesi. We shot an old pallah on
+the 16th, and found that the poor animal had been visited with more
+than the usual share of animal afflictions. He was stone-blind in
+both eyes, had several tumours, and a broken leg, which showed no
+symptoms of ever having begun to heal. Wild animals sometimes suffer
+a great deal from disease, and wearily drag on a miserable existence
+before relieved of it by some ravenous beast. Once we drove off a
+maneless lion and lioness from a dead buffalo, which had been in the
+last stage of a decline. They had watched him staggering to the
+river to quench his thirst, and sprang on him as he was crawling up
+the bank. One had caught him by the throat, and the other by his
+high projecting backbone, which was broken by the lion's powerful
+fangs. The struggle, if any, must have been short. They had only
+eaten the intestines when we frightened them off. It is curious that
+this is the part that wild animals always begin with, and that it is
+also the first choice of our men. Were it not a wise arrangement
+that only the strongest males should continue the breed, one could
+hardly help pitying the solitary buffalo expelled from the herd for
+some physical blemish, or on account of the weakness of approaching
+old age. Banished from female society, he naturally becomes morose
+and savage; the necessary watchfulness against enemies is now never
+shared by others; disgusted, he passes into a state of chronic war
+with all who enjoy life, and the sooner after his expulsion that he
+fills the lion's or the wild-dog's maw, the better for himself and
+for the peace of the country.
+
+We encamped on the 20th of June at a spot where Dr. Livingstone, on
+his journey from the West to the East Coast, was formerly menaced by
+a chief named Mpende. No offence had been committed against him, but
+he had firearms, and, with the express object of showing his power,
+he threatened to attack the strangers. Mpende's counsellors having,
+however, found out that Dr. Livingstone belonged to a tribe of whom
+they had heard that "they loved the black man and did not make
+slaves," his conduct at once changed from enmity to kindness, and, as
+the place was one well selected for defence, it was perhaps quite as
+well for Mpende that he decided as he did. Three of his counsellors
+now visited us, and we gave them a handsome present for their chief,
+who came himself next morning and made us a present of a goat, a
+basket of boiled maize, and another of vetches. A few miles above
+this the headman, Chilondo of Nyamasusa, apologized for not formerly
+lending us canoes. "He was absent, and his children were to blame
+for not telling him when the Doctor passed; he did not refuse the
+canoes." The sight of our men, now armed with muskets, had a great
+effect. Without any bullying, firearms command respect, and lead men
+to be reasonable who might otherwise feel disposed to be troublesome.
+Nothing, however, our fracas with Mpende excepted, could be more
+peaceful than our passage through this tract of country in 1856. We
+then had nothing to excite the cupidity of the people, and the men
+maintained themselves, either by selling elephant's meat, or by
+exhibiting feats of foreign dancing. Most of the people were very
+generous and friendly; but the Banyai, nearer to Tette than this,
+stopped our march with a threatening war-dance. One of our party,
+terrified at this, ran away, as we thought, insane, and could not,
+after a painful search of three days, be found. The Banyai,
+evidently touched by our distress, allowed us to proceed. Through a
+man we left on an island a little below Mpende's, we subsequently
+learned that poor Monaheng had fled thither, and had been murdered by
+the headman for no reason except that he was defenceless. This
+headman had since become odious to his countrymen, and had been put
+to death by them.
+
+On the 23rd of June we entered Pangola's principal village, which is
+upwards of a mile from the river. The ruins of a mud wall showed
+that a rude attempt had been made to imitate the Portuguese style of
+building. We established ourselves under a stately wild fig-tree,
+round whose trunk witchcraft medicine had been tied, to protect from
+thieves the honey of the wild bees, which had their hive in one of
+the limbs. This is a common device. The charm, or the medicine, is
+purchased of the dice doctors, and consists of a strip of palm-leaf
+smeared with something, and adorned with a few bits of grass, wood,
+or roots. It is tied round the tree, and is believed to have the
+power of inflicting disease and death on the thief who climbs over
+it. Superstition is thus not without its uses in certain states of
+society; it prevents many crimes and misdemeanours, which would occur
+but for the salutary fear that it produces.
+
+Pangola arrived, tipsy and talkative.--"We are friends, we are great
+friends; I have brought you a basket of green maize--here it is!" We
+thanked him, and handed him two fathoms of cotton cloth, four times
+the market-value of his present. No, he would not take so small a
+present; he wanted a double-barrelled rifle--one of Dixon's best.
+"We are friends, you know; we are all friends together." But
+although we were willing to admit that, we could not give him our
+best rifle, so he went off in high dudgeon. Early next morning, as
+we were commencing Divine service, Pangola returned, sober. We
+explained to him that we wished to worship God, and invited him to
+remain; he seemed frightened, and retired: but after service he
+again importuned us for the rifle. It was of no use telling him that
+we had a long journey before us, and needed it to kill game for
+ourselves.--"He too must obtain meat for himself and people, for they
+sometimes suffered from hunger." He then got sulky, and his people
+refused to sell food except at extravagant prices. Knowing that we
+had nothing to eat, they felt sure of starving us into compliance.
+But two of our young men, having gone off at sunrise, shot a fine
+water-buck, and down came the provision market to the lower figure;
+they even became eager to sell, but our men were angry with them for
+trying compulsion, and would not buy. Black greed had outwitted
+itself, as happens often with white cupidity; and not only here did
+the traits of Africans remind us of Anglo-Saxons elsewhere: the
+notoriously ready world-wide disposition to take an unfair advantage
+of a man's necessities shows that the same mean motives are pretty
+widely diffused among all races. It may not be granted that the same
+blood flows in all veins, or that all have descended from the same
+stock; but the traveller has no doubt that, practically, the white
+rogue and black are men and brothers.
+
+Pangola is the child or vassal of Mpende. Sandia and Mpende are the
+only independent chiefs from Kebrabasa to Zumbo, and belong to the
+tribe Manganja. The country north of the mountains here in sight
+from the Zambesi is called Senga, and its inhabitants Asenga, or
+Basenga, but all appear to be of the same family as the rest of the
+Manganja and Maravi. Formerly all the Manganja were united under the
+government of their great chief, Undi, whose empire extended from
+Lake Shirwa to the River Loangwa; but after Undi's death it fell to
+pieces, and a large portion of it on the Zambesi was absorbed by
+their powerful southern neighbours the Banyai. This has been the
+inevitable fate of every African empire from time immemorial. A
+chief of more than ordinary ability arises and, subduing all his less
+powerful neighbours, founds a kingdom, which he governs more or less
+wisely till he dies. His successor not having the talents of the
+conqueror cannot retain the dominion, and some of the abler under-
+chiefs set up for themselves, and, in a few years, the remembrance
+only of the empire remains. This, which may be considered as the
+normal state of African society, gives rise to frequent and
+desolating wars, and the people long in vain for a power able to make
+all dwell in peace. In this light, a European colony would be
+considered by the natives as an inestimable boon to intertropical
+Africa. Thousands of industrious natives would gladly settle round
+it, and engage in that peaceful pursuit of agriculture and trade of
+which they are so fond, and, undistracted by wars or rumours of wars,
+might listen to the purifying and ennobling truths of the gospel of
+Jesus Christ. The Manganja on the Zambesi, like their countrymen on
+the Shire, are fond of agriculture; and, in addition to the usual
+varieties of food, cultivate tobacco and cotton in quantities more
+than equal to their wants. To the question, "Would they work for
+Europeans?" an affirmative answer may be given, if the Europeans
+belong to the class which can pay a reasonable price for labour, and
+not to that of adventurers who want employment for themselves. All
+were particularly well clothed from Sandia's to Pangola's; and it was
+noticed that all the cloth was of native manufacture, the product of
+their own looms. In Senga a great deal of iron is obtained from the
+ore and manufactured very cleverly.
+
+As is customary when a party of armed strangers visits the village,
+Pangola took the precaution of sleeping in one of the outlying
+hamlets. No one ever knows, or at any rate will tell, where the
+chief sleeps. He came not next morning, so we went our way; but in a
+few moments we saw the rifle-loving chief approaching with some armed
+men. Before meeting us, he left the path and drew up his "following"
+under a tree, expecting us to halt, and give him a chance of
+bothering us again; but, having already had enough of that, we held
+right on: he seemed dumbfoundered, and could hardly believe his own
+eyes. For a few seconds he was speechless, but at last recovered so
+far as to be able to say, "You are passing Pangola. Do you not see
+Pangola?" Mbia was just going by at the time with the donkey, and,
+proud of every opportunity of airing his small stock of English,
+shouted in reply, "All right! then get on." "Click, click, click."
+
+On the 26th June we breakfasted at Zumbo, on the left bank of the
+Loangwa, near the ruins of some ancient Portuguese houses. The
+Loangwa was too deep to be forded, and there were no canoes on our
+side. Seeing two small ones on the opposite shore, near a few
+recently erected huts of two half-castes from Tette, we halted for
+the ferry-men to come over. From their movements it was evident that
+they were in a state of rollicking drunkenness. Having a waterproof
+cloak, which could be inflated into a tiny boat, we sent Mantlanyane
+across in it. Three half-intoxicated slaves then brought us the
+shaky canoes, which we lashed together and manned with our own canoe-
+men. Five men were all that we could carry over at a time; and after
+four trips had been made the slaves began to clamour for drink; not
+receiving any, as we had none to give, they grew more insolent, and
+declared that not another man should cross that day. Sininyane was
+remonstrating with them, when a loaded musket was presented at him by
+one of the trio. In an instant the gun was out of the rascal's
+hands, a rattling shower of blows fell on his back, and he took an
+involuntary header into the river. He crawled up the bank a sad and
+sober man, and all three at once tumbled from the height of saucy
+swagger to a low depth of slavish abjectness. The musket was found
+to have an enormous charge, and might have blown our man to pieces,
+but for the promptitude with which his companions administered
+justice in a lawless land. We were all ferried safely across by 8
+o'clock in the evening.
+
+In illustration of what takes place where no government, or law
+exists, the two half-castes, to whom these men belonged, left Tette,
+with four hundred slaves, armed with the old Sepoy Brown Bess, to
+hunt elephants and trade in ivory. On our way up, we heard from
+natives of their lawless deeds, and again, on our way down, from
+several, who had been eyewitnesses of the principal crime, and all
+reports substantially agreed. The story is a sad one. After the
+traders reached Zumbo, one of them, called by the natives Sequasha,
+entered into a plot with the disaffected headman, Namakusuru, to kill
+his chief, Mpangwe, in order that Namakusuru might seize upon the
+chieftainship; and for the murder of Mpangwe the trader agreed to
+receive ten large tusks of ivory. Sequasha, with a picked party of
+armed slaves, went to visit Mpangwe who received him kindly, and
+treated him with all the honour and hospitality usually shown to
+distinguished strangers, and the women busied themselves in cooking
+the best of their provisions for the repast to be set before him. Of
+this, and also of the beer, the half-caste partook heartily. Mpangwe
+was then asked by Sequasha to allow his men to fire their guns in
+amusement. Innocent of any suspicion of treachery, and anxious to
+hear the report of firearms, Mpangwe at once gave his consent; and
+the slaves rose and poured a murderous volley into the merry group of
+unsuspecting spectators, instantly killing the chief and twenty of
+his people. The survivors fled in horror. The children and young
+women were seized as slaves, and the village sacked. Sequasha sent
+the message to Namakusuru: "I have killed the lion that troubled
+you; come and let us talk over the matter." He came and brought the
+ivory. "No," said the half-caste, "let us divide the land:" and he
+took the larger share for himself, and compelled the would-be usurper
+to deliver up his bracelets, in token of subjection on becoming the
+child or vassal of Sequasha. These were sent in triumph to the
+authorities at Tette. The governor of Quillimane had told us that he
+had received orders from Lisbon to take advantage of our passing to
+re-establish Zumbo; and accordingly these traders had built a small
+stockade on the rich plain of the right bank of Loangwa, a mile above
+the site of the ancient mission church of Zumbo, as part of the royal
+policy. The bloodshed was quite unnecessary, because, the land at
+Zumbo having of old been purchased, the natives would have always of
+their own accord acknowledged the right thus acquired; they pointed
+it out to Dr. Livingstone in 1856 that, though they were cultivating
+it, is was not theirs, but white man's land. Sequasha and his mate
+had left their ivory in charge of some of their slaves, who, in the
+absence of their masters, were now having a gay time of it, and
+getting drunk every day with the produce of the sacked villages. The
+head slave came and begged for the musket of the delinquent ferryman,
+which was returned. He thought his master did perfectly right to
+kill Mpangwe, when asked to do it for the fee of ten tusks, and he
+even justified it thus: "If a man invites you to eat, will you not
+partake?"
+
+We continued our journey on the 28th of June. Game was extremely
+abundant, and there were many lions. Mbia drove one off from his
+feast on a wild pig, and appropriated what remained of the pork to
+his own use. Lions are particularly fond of the flesh of wild pigs
+and zebras, and contrive to kill a large number of these animals. In
+the afternoon we arrived at the village of the female chief, Ma-
+mburuma, but she herself was now living on the opposite side of the
+river. Some of her people called, and said she had been frightened
+by seeing her son and other children killed by Sequasha, and had fled
+to the other bank; but when her heart was healed, she would return
+and live in her own village, and among her own people. She
+constantly inquired of the black traders, who came up the river, if
+they had any news of the white man who passed with the oxen. "He has
+gone down into the sea," was their reply, "but we belong to the same
+people." "Oh no; you need not tell me that; he takes no slaves, but
+wishes peace: you are not of his tribe." This antislavery character
+excites such universal attention, that any missionary who winked at
+the gigantic evils involved in the slave-trade would certainly fail
+to produce any good impression on the native mind.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI.
+
+
+
+Illness--The Honey-guide--Abundance of game--The Baenda pezi--The
+Batoka.
+
+We left the river here, and proceeded up the valley which leads to
+the Mburuma or Mohango pass. The nights were cold, and on the 30th
+of June the thermometer was as low as 39 degrees at sunrise. We
+passed through a village of twenty large huts, which Sequasha had
+attacked on his return from the murder of the chief, Mpangwe. He
+caught the women and children for slaves, and carried off all the
+food, except a huge basket of bran, which the natives are wont to
+save against a time of famine. His slaves had broken all the water-
+pots and the millstones for grinding meal.
+
+The buaze-trees and bamboos are now seen on the hills; but the jujube
+or zisyphus, which has evidently been introduced from India, extends
+no further up the river. We had been eating this fruit, which,
+having somewhat the taste of apples, the Portuguese call Macaas, all
+the way from Tette; and here they were larger than usual, though
+immediately beyond they ceased to be found. No mango-tree either is
+to be met with beyond this point, because the Portuguese traders
+never established themselves anywhere beyond Zumbo. Tsetse flies are
+more numerous and troublesome than we have ever before found them.
+They accompany us on the march, often buzzing round our heads like a
+swarm of bees. They are very cunning, and when intending to bite,
+alight so gently that their presence is not perceived till they
+thrust in their lance-like proboscis. The bite is acute, but the
+pain is over in a moment; it is followed by a little of the
+disagreeable itching of the mosquito's bite. This fly invariably
+kills all domestic animals except goats and donkeys; man and the wild
+animals escape. We ourselves were severely bitten on this pass, and
+so were our donkeys, but neither suffered from any after effects.
+
+Water is scarce in the Mburuma pass, except during the rainy season.
+We however halted beside some fine springs in the bed of the now dry
+rivulet, Podebode, which is continued down to the end of the pass,
+and yields water at intervals in pools. Here we remained a couple of
+days in consequence of the severe illness of Dr. Kirk. He had
+several times been attacked by fever; and observed that when we were
+on the cool heights he was comfortable, but when we happened to
+descend from a high to a lower altitude, he felt chilly, though the
+temperature in the latter case was 25 degrees higher than it was
+above; he had been trying different medicines of reputed efficacy
+with a view to ascertain whether other combinations might not be
+superior to the preparation we generally used; in halting by this
+water he suddenly became blind, and unable to stand from faintness.
+The men, with great alacrity, prepared a grassy bed, on which we laid
+our companion, with the sad forebodings which only those who have
+tended the sick in a wild country can realize. We feared that in
+experimenting he had over-drugged himself; but we gave him a dose of
+our fever pills; on the third day he rode the one of the two donkeys
+that would allow itself to be mounted, and on the sixth he marched as
+well as any of us. This case is mentioned in order to illustrate
+what we have often observed, that moving the patient from place to
+place is most conducive to the cure; and the more pluck a man has--
+the less he gives in to the disease--the less likely he is to die.
+
+Supplied with water by the pools in the Podebode, we again joined the
+Zambesi at the confluence of the rivulet. When passing through a dry
+district the native hunter knows where to expect water by the animals
+he sees. The presence of the gemsbuck, duiker or diver, springbucks,
+or elephants, is no proof that water is near; for these animals roam
+over vast tracts of country, and may be met scores of miles from it.
+Not so, however, the zebra, pallah, buffalo, and rhinoceros; their
+spoor gives assurance that water is not far off, as they never stray
+any distance from its neighbourhood. But when amidst the solemn
+stillness of the woods, the singing of joyous birds falls upon the
+ear, it is certain that water is close at hand.
+
+Our men in hunting came on an immense herd of buffaloes, quietly
+resting in the long dry grass, and began to blaze away furiously at
+the astonished animals. In the wild excitement of the hunt, which
+heretofore had been conducted with spears, some forgot to load with
+ball, and, firing away vigorously with powder only, wondered for the
+moment that the buffaloes did not fall. The slayer of the young
+elephant, having buried his four bullets in as many buffaloes, fired
+three charges of No. 1 shot he had for killing guinea-fowl. The
+quaint remarks and merriment after these little adventures seemed to
+the listener like the pleasant prattle of children. Mbia and
+Mantlanyane, however, killed one buffalo each; both the beasts were
+in prime condition; the meat was like really excellent beef, with a
+smack of venison. A troop of hungry, howling hyenas also thought the
+savour tempting, as they hung round the camp at night, anxious to
+partake of the feast. They are, fortunately, arrant cowards, and
+never attack either men or beasts except they can catch them asleep,
+sick, or at some other disadvantage. With a bright fire at our feet
+their presence excites no uneasiness. A piece of meat hung on a
+tree, high enough to make him jump to reach it, and a short spear,
+with its handle firmly planted in the ground beneath, are used as a
+device to induce the hyena to commit suicide by impalement.
+
+The honey-guide is an extraordinary bird; how is it that every member
+of its family has learned that all men, white or black, are fond of
+honey? The instant the little fellow gets a glimpse of a man, he
+hastens to greet him with the hearty invitation to come, as Mbia
+translated it, to a bees' hive, and take some honey. He flies on in
+the proper direction, perches on a tree, and looks back to see if you
+are following; then on to another and another, until he guides you to
+the spot. If you do not accept his first invitation he follows you
+with pressing importunities, quite as anxious to lure the stranger to
+the bees' hive as other birds are to draw him away from their own
+nest. Except while on the march, our men were sure to accept the
+invitation, and manifested the same by a peculiar responsive whistle,
+meaning, as they said, "All right, go ahead; we are coming." The
+bird never deceived them, but always guided them to a hive of bees,
+though some had but little honey in store. Has this peculiar habit
+of the honey-guide its origin, as the attachment of dogs, in
+friendship for man, or in love for the sweet pickings of the plunder
+left on the ground? Self-interest aiding in preservation from danger
+seems to be the rule in most cases, as, for instance, in the bird
+that guards the buffalo and rhinoceros. The grass is often so tall
+and dense that one could go close up to these animals quite
+unperceived; but the guardian bird, sitting on the beast, sees the
+approach of danger, flaps its wings and screams, which causes its
+bulky charge to rush off from a foe he has neither seen nor heard;
+for his reward the vigilant little watcher has the pick of the
+parasites on his fat friend. In other cases a chance of escape must
+be given even by the animal itself to its prey; as in the rattle-
+snake, which, when excited to strike, cannot avoid using his rattle,
+any more than the cat can resist curling its tail when excited in the
+chase of a mouse, or the cobra can refrain from inflating the loose
+skin of the neck and extending it laterally, before striking its
+poison fangs into its victim. There are many snakes in parts of this
+pass; they basked in the warm sunshine, but rustled off through the
+leaves as we approached. We observed one morning a small one of a
+deadly poisonous species, named Kakone, on a bush by the wayside,
+quietly resting in a horizontal position, digesting a lizard for
+breakfast. Though openly in view, its colours and curves so closely
+resembled a small branch that some failed to see it, even after being
+asked if they perceived anything on the bush. Here also one of our
+number had a glance at another species, rarely seen, and whose swift
+lightning-like motion has given rise to the native proverb, that when
+a man sees this snake he will forthwith become a rich man.
+
+We slept near the ruined village of the murdered chief, Mpangwe, a
+lovely spot, with the Zambesi in front, and extensive gardens behind,
+backed by a semicircle of hills receding up to lofty mountains. Our
+path kept these mountains on our right, and crossed several
+streamlets, which seemed to be perennial, and among others the
+Selole, which apparently flows past the prominent peak Chiarapela.
+These rivulets have often human dwellings on their banks; but the
+land can scarcely be said to be occupied. The number of all sorts of
+game increases wonderfully every day. As a specimen of what may be
+met with where there are no human habitations, and where no firearms
+have been introduced, we may mention what at times has actually been
+seen by us. On the morning of July 3rd a herd of elephants passed
+within fifty yards of our sleeping-place, going down to the river
+along the dry bed of a rivulet. Starting a few minutes before the
+main body, we come upon large flocks of guinea-fowl, shoot what may
+be wanted for dinner, or next morning's breakfast, and leave them in
+the path to be picked up by the cook and his mates behind. As we
+proceed, francolins of three varieties run across the path, and
+hundreds of turtle-doves rise, with great blatter of wing, and fly
+off to the trees. Guinea-fowls, francolins, turtle-doves, ducks, and
+geese are the game birds of this region. At sunrise a herd of
+pallahs, standing like a flock of sheep, allow the first man of our
+long Indian file to approach within about fifty yards; but having
+meat, we let them trot off leisurely and unmolested. Soon afterwards
+we come upon a herd of waterbucks, which here are very much darker in
+colour, and drier in flesh, than the same species near the sea. They
+look at us and we at them; and we pass on to see a herd of doe
+koodoos, with a magnificently horned buck or two, hurrying off to the
+dry hill-sides. We have ceased shooting antelopes, as our men have
+been so often gorged with meat that they have become fat and dainty.
+They say that they do not want more venison, it is so dry and
+tasteless, and ask why we do not give them shot to shoot the more
+savoury guinea-fowl.
+
+About eight o'clock the tsetse commence to buzz about us, and bite
+our hands and necks sharply. Just as we are thinking of breakfast,
+we meet some buffaloes grazing by the path; but they make off in a
+heavy gallop at the sight of man. We fire, and the foremost, badly
+wounded, separates from the herd, and is seen to stop amongst the
+trees; but, as it is a matter of great danger to follow a wounded
+buffalo, we hold on our way. It is this losing of wounded animals
+which makes firearms so annihilating to these beasts of the field,
+and will in time sweep them all away. The small Enfield bullet is
+worse than the old round one for this. It often goes through an
+animal without killing him, and he afterwards perishes, when he is of
+no value to man. After breakfast we draw near a pond of water; a
+couple of elephants stand on its bank, and, at a respectful distance
+behind these monarchs of the wilderness, is seen a herd of zebras,
+and another of waterbucks. On getting our wind the royal beasts make
+off at once; but the zebras remain till the foremost man is within
+eighty yards of them, when old and young canter gracefully away. The
+zebra has a great deal of curiosity; and this is often fatal to him,
+for he has the habit of stopping to look at the hunter. In this
+particular he is the exact opposite of the diver antelope, which
+rushes off like the wind, and never for a moment stops to look
+behind, after having once seen or smelt danger. The finest zebra of
+the herd is sometimes shot, our men having taken a sudden fancy to
+the flesh, which all declare to be the "king of good meat." On the
+plains of short grass between us and the river many antelopes of
+different species are calmly grazing, or reposing. Wild pigs are
+common, and walk abroad during the day; but are so shy as seldom to
+allow a close approach. On taking alarm they erect their slender
+tails in the air, and trot off swiftly in a straight line, keeping
+their bodies as steady as a locomotive on a railroad. A mile beyond
+the pool three cow buffaloes with their calves come from the woods,
+and move out into the plain. A troop of monkeys, on the edge of the
+forest, scamper back to its depths on hearing the loud song of
+Singeleka, and old surly fellows, catching sight of the human party,
+insult it with a loud and angry bark. Early in the afternoon we may
+see buffaloes again, or other animals. We camp on the dry higher
+ground, after, as has happened, driving off a solitary elephant. The
+nights are warmer now, and possess nearly as much of interest and
+novelty as the days. A new world awakes and comes forth, more
+numerous, if we may judge by the noise it makes, than that which is
+abroad by sunlight. Lions and hyenas roar around us, and sometimes
+come disagreeably near, though they have never ventured into our
+midst. Strange birds sing their agreeable songs, while others scream
+and call harshly as if in fear or anger. Marvellous insect-sounds
+fall upon the ear; one, said by natives to proceed from a large
+beetle, resembles a succession of measured musical blows upon an
+anvil, while many others are perfectly indescribable. A little lemur
+was once seen to leap about from branch to branch with the agility of
+a frog; it chirruped like a bird, and is not larger than a robin red-
+breast. Reptiles, though numerous, seldom troubled us; only two men
+suffered from stings, and that very slightly, during the entire
+journey, the one supposed that he was bitten by a snake, and the
+other was stung by a scorpion.
+
+Grass-burning has begun, and is producing the blue hazy atmosphere of
+the American Indian summer, which in Western Africa is called the
+"smokes." Miles of fire burn on the mountain-sides in the evenings,
+but go out during the night. From their height they resemble a broad
+zigzag line of fire in the heavens.
+
+We slept on the night of the 6th of July on the left bank of the
+Chongwe, which comes through a gap in the hills on our right, and is
+twenty yards wide. A small tribe of the Bazizulu, from the south,
+under Dadanga, have recently settled here and built a village. Some
+of their houses are square, and they seem to be on friendly terms
+with the Bakoa, who own the country. They, like the other natives,
+cultivate cotton, but of a different species from any we have yet
+seen in Africa, the staple being very long, and the boll larger than
+what is usually met with; the seeds cohere as in the Pernambuco kind.
+They brought the seed with them from their own country, the distant
+mountains of which in the south, still inhabited by their fellow-
+countrymen, who possess much cattle and use shields, can be seen from
+this high ground. These people profess to be children of the great
+paramount chief, Kwanyakarombe, who is said to be lord of all the
+Bazizulu. The name of this tribe is known to geographers, who derive
+their information from the Portuguese, as the Morusurus, and the
+hills mentioned above are said to have been the country of
+Changamira, the warrior-chief of history, whom no Portuguese ever
+dared to approach. The Bazizulu seem, by report, to be brave
+mountaineers; nearer the river, the Sidima inhabit the plains; just
+as on the north side, the Babimpe live on the heights, about two days
+off, and the Makoa on or near the river. The chief of the Bazizulu
+we were now with was hospitable and friendly. A herd of buffaloes
+came trampling through the gardens and roused up our men; a feat that
+roaring lions seldom achieved.
+
+Our course next day passed over the upper terrace and through a dense
+thorn jungle. Travelling is always difficult where there is no path,
+but it is even more perplexing where the forest is cut up by many
+game-tracks. Here we got separated from one another, and a
+rhinoceros with angry snort dashed at Dr. Livingstone as he stooped
+to pick up a specimen of the wild fruit morula; but she strangely
+stopped stock-still when less than her own length distant, and gave
+him time to escape; a branch pulled out his watch as he ran, and
+turning half round to grasp it, he got a distant glance of her and
+her calf still standing on the selfsame spot, as if arrested in the
+middle of her charge by an unseen hand. When about fifty yards off,
+thinking his companions close behind, he shouted "Look out there!"
+when off she rushed, snorting loudly, in another direction. The
+Doctor usually went unarmed before this, but never afterwards.
+
+A fine eland was shot by Dr. Kirk this afternoon, the first we have
+killed. It was in first-rate condition, and remarkably fat; but the
+meat, though so tempting in appearance, severely deranged all who
+partook of it heartily, especially those who ate of the fat. Natives
+who live in game countries, and are acquainted with the different
+kinds of wild animals, have a prejudice against the fat of the eland,
+the pallah, the zebra, hippopotamus, and pig; they never reject it,
+however, the climate making the desire for all animal food very
+strong; but they consider that it causes ulcers and leprosy, while
+the fat of sheep and of oxen never produces any bad effects, unless
+the animal is diseased.
+
+On the morning of the 9th, after passing four villages, we
+breakfasted at an old friend's, Tombanyama, who lives now on the
+mainland, having resigned the reedy island, where he was first seen,
+to the buffaloes, which used to take his crops and show fight to his
+men. He keeps a large flock of tame pigeons, and some fine fat
+capons, one of which he gave us, with a basket of meal. They have
+plenty of salt in this part of the country, obtaining it from the
+plains in the usual way.
+
+The half-caste partner of Sequasha and a number of his men were
+staying near. The fellow was very munch frightened when he saw us,
+and trembled so much when he spoke, that the Makololo and other
+natives noticed and remarked on it. His fears arose from a sense of
+guilt, as we said nothing to frighten him, and did not allude to the
+murder till a few minutes before starting; when it was remarked that
+Dr. Livingstone having been accredited to the murdered chief, it
+would be his duty to report on it; and that not even the Portuguese
+Government would approve of the deed. He defended it by saying that
+they had put in the right man, the other was a usurper. He was
+evidently greatly relieved when we departed. In the afternoon we
+came to an outlying hamlet of Kambadzo, whose own village is on an
+island, Nyampungo, or Nyangalule, at the confluence of the Kafue.
+The chief was on a visit here, and they had been enjoying a regular
+jollification. There had been much mirth, music, drinking, and
+dancing. The men, and women too, had taken "a wee drap too much,"
+but had not passed the complimentary stage. The wife of the headman,
+after looking at us a few moments, called out to the others, "Black
+traders have come before, calling themselves Bazungu, or white men,
+but now, for the first time, have we seen the real Bazungu."
+Kambadzo also soon appeared; he was sorry that we had not come before
+the beer was all done, but he was going back to see if it was all
+really and entirely finished, and not one little potful left
+somewhere.
+
+This was, of course, mere characteristic politeness, as he was
+perfectly aware that every drop had been swallowed; so we proceeded
+on to the Kafue, or Kafuje, accompanied by the most intelligent of
+his headmen. A high ridge, just before we reached the confluence,
+commands a splendid view of the two great rivers, and the rich
+country beyond. Behind, on the north and east, is the high mountain-
+range, along whose base we have been travelling; the whole range is
+covered with trees, which appear even on the prominent peaks,
+Chiarapela, Morindi, and Chiava; at this last the chain bends away to
+the N.W., and we could see the distant mountains where the chief,
+Semalembue, gained all our hearts in 1856.
+
+On the 9th of July we tried to send Semalembue a present, but the
+people here refused to incur the responsibility of carrying it. We,
+who have the art of writing, cannot realize the danger one incurs of
+being accused of purloining a portion of goods sent from one person
+to another, when the carrier cannot prove that he delivered all
+committed to his charge. Rumours of a foray having been made, either
+by Makololo or Batoka, as far as the fork of the Kafue, were received
+here by our men with great indignation, as it looked as if the
+marauders were shutting up the country, which they had been trying so
+much to open. Below the junction of the rivers, on a shallow
+sandbank, lay a large herd of hippopotami, their bodies out of the
+water, like masses of black rock. Kambadzo's island, called
+Nyangalule, a name which occurs again at the mouth of the Zambesi,
+has many choice Motsikiri (Trachelia) trees on it; and four very
+conspicuous stately palms growing out of a single stem. The Kafue
+reminds us a little of the Shire, flowing between steep banks, with
+fertile land on both sides. It is a smaller river, and has less
+current. Here it seems to come from the west. The headman of the
+village, near which we encamped, brought a present of meal, fowls,
+and sweet potatoes. They have both the red and white varieties of
+this potato. We have, on several occasions during this journey, felt
+the want of vegetables, in a disagreeable craving which our diet of
+meat and native meal could not satisfy. It became worse and worse
+till we got a meal of potatoes, which allayed it at once. A great
+scarcity of vegetables prevails in these parts of Africa. The
+natives collect several kinds of wild plants in the woods, which they
+use no doubt for the purpose of driving off cravings similar to those
+we experienced.
+
+Owing to the strength of the wind, and the cranky state of the
+canoes, it was late in the afternoon of the 11th before our party was
+ferried over the Kafue. After crossing, we were in the Bawe country.
+Fishhooks here, of native workmanship, were observed to have barbs
+like the European hooks: elsewhere the point of the hook is merely
+bent in towards the shank, to have the same effect in keeping on the
+fish as the barb. We slept near a village a short distance above the
+ford. The people here are of Batoka origin, the same as many of our
+men, and call themselves Batonga (independents), or Balengi, and
+their language only differs slightly from that of the Bakoa, who live
+between the two rivers Kafue and Loangwa. The paramount chief of the
+district lives to the west of this place, and is called Nchomokela--
+an hereditary title: the family burying-place is on a small hill
+near this village. The women salute us by clapping their hands and
+lullilooing as we enter and leave a village, and the men, as they
+think, respectfully clap their hands on their hips. Immense crops of
+mapira (holcus sorghum) are raised; one species of it forms a natural
+bend on the seed-stalk, so that the massive ear hangs down. The
+grain was heaped up on wooden stages, and so was a variety of other
+products. The men are skilful hunters, and kill elephants and
+buffaloes with long heavy spears. We halted a few minutes on the
+morning of the 12th July, opposite the narrow island of Sikakoa,
+which has a village on its lower end. We were here told that
+Moselekatse's chief town is a month's distance from this place. They
+had heard, moreover, that the English had come to Moselekatse, and
+told him it was wrong to kill men; and he had replied that he was
+born to kill people, but would drop the habit; and, since the English
+came, he had sent out his men, not to kill as of yore, but to collect
+tribute of cloth and ivory. This report referred to the arrival of
+the Rev. R. Moffat, of Kuruman, who, we afterwards found, had
+established a mission. The statement is interesting as showing that,
+though imperfectly expressed, the purport of the missionaries'
+teaching had travelled, in a short time, over 300 miles, and we know
+not how far the knowledge of the English operations on the coast
+spread inland.
+
+When abreast of the high wooded island Kalabi we came in contact with
+one of the game-laws of the country, which has come down from the
+most ancient times. An old buffalo crossed the path a few yards in
+front of us; our guide threw his small spear at its hip, and it was
+going off scarcely hurt, when three rifle balls knocked it over. "It
+is mine," said the guide. He had wounded it first, and the
+established native game-law is that the animal belongs to the man who
+first draws blood; the two legs on one side, by the same law,
+belonged to us for killing it. This beast was very old, blind of one
+eye, and scabby; the horns, mere stumps, not a foot long, must have
+atrophied, when by age he lost the strength distinctive of his sex;
+some eighteen or twenty inches of horn could not well be worn down by
+mere rubbing against the trees. We saw many buffaloes next day,
+standing quietly amidst a thick thorn-jungle, through which we were
+passing. They often stood until we were within fifty or a hundred
+yards of them.
+
+On the 14th July we left the river at the mountain-range, which,
+lying north-east and south-west across the river, forms the Kariba
+gorge. Near the upper end of the Kariba rapids, the stream Sanyati
+enters from the south, and is reported to have Moselekatse's
+principal cattle-posts at its sources; our route went round the end
+of the mountains, and we encamped beside the village of the generous
+chief Moloi, who brought us three immense baskets of fine mapira
+meal, ten fowls, and two pots of beer. On receiving a present in
+return, he rose, and, with a few dancing gestures, said or sang,
+"Motota, Motota, Motota," which our men translated into "thanks." He
+had visited Moselekatse a few months before our arrival, and saw the
+English missionaries, living in their wagons. "They told
+Moselekatse," said he, "they were of his family, or friends, and
+would plough the land and live at their own expense;" and he had
+replied, "The land is before you, and I shall come and see you
+plough." This again was substantially what took place, when Mr.
+Moffat introduced the missionaries to his old friend, and shows still
+further that the notion of losing their country by admitting
+foreigners does not come as the first idea to the native mind. One
+might imagine that, as mechanical powers are unknown to the heathen,
+the almost magic operations of machinery, the discoveries of modern
+science and art, or the presence of the prodigious force which, for
+instance, is associated with the sight of a man-of-war, would have
+the effect which miracles once had of arresting the attention and
+inspiring awe. But, though we have heard the natives exclaim in
+admiration at the sight of even small illustrations of what science
+enables us to do--"Ye are gods, and not men"--the heart is
+unaffected. In attempting their moral elevation, it is always more
+conducive to the end desired, that the teacher should come
+unaccompanied by any power to cause either jealousy or fear. The
+heathen, who have not become aware of the greed and hate which too
+often characterize the advancing tide of emigration, listen with most
+attention to the message of Divine love when delivered by men who
+evidently possess the same human sympathies with themselves. A chief
+is rather envied his good fortune in first securing foreigners in his
+town. Jealousy of strangers belongs more to the Arab than to the
+African character; and if the women are let alone by the traveller,
+no danger need be apprehended from any save the slave-trading tribes,
+and not often even from them.
+
+We passed through a fertile country, covered with open forest,
+accompanied by the friendly Bawe. They are very hospitable; many of
+them were named, among themselves, "the Baenda pezi," or "Go-nakeds,"
+their only clothing being a coat of red ochre. Occasionally stopping
+at their villages we were duly lullilooed, and regaled with sweet
+new-made beer, which, being yet unfermented, was not intoxicating.
+It is in this state called Liting or Makonde. Some of the men carry
+large shields of buffalo-hide, and all are well supplied with heavy
+spears. The vicinity of the villages is usually cleared and
+cultivated in large patches; but nowhere can the country be said to
+be stocked with people. At every village stands were erected, and
+piles of the native corn, still unthrashed, placed upon them; some
+had been beaten out, put into oblong parcels made of grass, and
+stacked in wooden frames.
+
+We crossed several rivulets in our course, as the Mandora, the Lofia,
+the Manzaia (with brackish water), the Rimbe, the Chibue, the Chezia,
+the Chilola (containing fragments of coal), which did little more
+than mark our progress. The island and rapid of Nakansalo, of which
+we had formerly heard, were of no importance, the rapid being but
+half a mile long, and only on one side of the island. The island
+Kaluzi marks one of the numerous places where astronomical
+observations were made; Mozia, a station where a volunteer poet left
+us; the island Mochenya, and Mpande island, at the mouth of the
+Zungwe rivulet, where we left the Zambesi.
+
+When favoured with the hospitality and company of the "Go-nakeds," we
+tried to discover if nudity were the badge of a particular order
+among the Bawe, but they could only refer to custom. Some among them
+had always liked it for no reason in particular: shame seemed to lie
+dormant, and the sense could not be aroused by our laughing and
+joking them on their appearance. They evidently felt no less decent
+than we did with our clothes on; but, whatever may be said in favour
+of nude statues, it struck us that man, in a state of nature, is a
+most ungainly animal. Could we see a number of the degraded of our
+own lower classes in like guise, it is probable that, without the
+black colour which acts somehow as a dress, they would look worse
+still.
+
+In domestic contentions the Bawe are careful not to kill each other;
+but, when one village goes to war with another, they are not so
+particular. The victorious party are said to quarter one of the
+bodies of the enemies they may have killed, and to perform certain
+ceremonies over the fragments. The vanquished call upon their
+conquerors to give them a portion also; and, when this request is
+complied with, they too perform the same ceremonies, and lament over
+their dead comrade, after which the late combatants may visit each
+other in peace. Sometimes the head of the slain is taken and buried
+in an ant-hill, till all the flesh is gone; and the lower jaw is then
+worn as a trophy by the slayer; but this we never saw, and the
+foregoing information was obtained only through an interpreter.
+
+We left the Zambesi at the mouth of the Zungwe or Mozama or Dela
+rivulet, up which we proceeded, first in a westerly and then in a
+north-westerly direction. The Zungwe at this time had no water in
+its sandy channel for the first eight or ten miles. Willows,
+however, grow on the banks, and water soon began to appear in the
+hollows; and a few miles further up it was a fine flowing stream
+deliciously cold. As in many other streams from Chicova to near
+Sinamane shale and coal crop out in the bank; and here the large
+roots of stigmaria or its allied plants were found. We followed the
+course of the Zungwe to the foot of the Batoka highlands, up whose
+steep and rugged sides of red and white quartz we climbed till we
+attained an altitude of upwards of 3000 feet. Here, on the cool and
+bracing heights, the exhilaration of mind and body was delightful, as
+we looked back at the hollow beneath covered with a hot sultry glare,
+not unpleasant now that we were in the mild radiance above. We had a
+noble view of the great valley in which the Zambesi flows. The
+cultivated portions are so small in comparison to the rest of the
+landscape that the valley appears nearly all forest, with a few
+grassy glades. We spent the night of the 28th July high above the
+level of the sea, by the rivulet Tyotyo, near Tabacheu or
+Chirebuechina, names both signifying white mountain; in the morning
+hoar frost covered the ground, and thin ice was on the pools.
+Skirting the southern flank of Tabacheu, we soon passed from the
+hills on to the portion of the vast table-land called Mataba, and
+looking back saw all the way across the Zambesi valley to the lofty
+ridge some thirty miles off, which, coming from the Mashona, a
+country in the S.E., runs to the N.W. to join the ridge at the angle
+of which are the Victoria Falls, and then bends far to the N.E. from
+the same point. Only a few years since these extensive highlands
+were peopled by the Batoka; numerous herds of cattle furnished
+abundance of milk, and the rich soil amply repaid the labour of the
+husbandman; now large herds of buffaloes, zebras, and antelopes
+fatten on the excellent pasture; and on that land, which formerly
+supported multitudes, not a man is to been seen. In travelling from
+Monday morning till late on Saturday afternoon, all the way from
+Tabacheu to Moachemba, which is only twenty-one miles of latitude
+from the Victoria Falls, and constantly passing the ruined sites of
+utterly deserted Botoka villages, we did not fall in with a single
+person. The Batoka were driven out of their noble country by the
+invasions of Moselekatse and Sebetuane. Several tribes of Bechuana
+and Basutu, fleeing from the Zulu or Matebele chief Moselekatse
+reached the Zambesi above the Falls. Coming from a land without
+rivers, none of them knew how to swim; and one tribe, called the
+Bamangwato, wishing to cross the Zambesi, was ferried over, men and
+women separately, to different islands, by one of the Batoka chiefs;
+the men were then left to starve and the women appropriated by the
+ferryman and his people. Sekomi, the present chief of the
+Bamangwato, then an infant in his mother's arms, was enabled, through
+the kindness of a private Batoka, to escape. This act seems to have
+made an indelible impression on Sekomi's heart, for though otherwise
+callous, he still never fails to inquire after the welfare of his
+benefactor.
+
+Sebetuane, with his wonted ability, outwitted the treacherous Batoka,
+by insisting in the politest manner on their chief remaining at his
+own side until the people and cattle were all carried safe across;
+the chief was then handsomely rewarded, both with cattle and brass
+rings off Sebetuane's own wives. No sooner were the Makololo, then
+called Basuto, safely over, than they were confronted by the whole
+Batoka nation; and to this day the Makololo point with pride to the
+spot on the Lekone, near to which they were encamped, where
+Sebetuane, with a mere handful of warriors in comparison to the vast
+horde that surrounded him, stood waiting the onslaught, the warriors
+in one small body, the women and children guarding the cattle behind
+them. The Batoka, of course, melted away before those who had been
+made veterans by years of continual fighting, and Sebetuane always
+justified his subsequent conquests in that country by alleging that
+the Batoka had come out to fight with a man fleeing for his life, who
+had never done them any wrong. They seem never to have been a
+warlike race; passing through their country, we once observed a large
+stone cairn, and our guide favoured us with the following account of
+it:- "Once upon a time, our forefathers were going to fight another
+tribe, and here they halted and sat down. After a long consultation,
+they came to the unanimous conclusion that, instead of proceeding to
+fight and kill their neighbours, and perhaps be killed themselves, it
+would be more like men to raise this heap of stones, as their protest
+against the wrong the other tribe had done them, which, having
+accomplished, they returned quietly home." Such men of peace could
+not stand before the Makololo, nor, of course, the more warlike
+Matebele, who coming afterwards, drove even their conquerors, the
+Makololo, out of the country. Sebetuane, however, profiting by the
+tactics which he had learned of the Batoka, inveigled a large body of
+this new enemy on to another island, and after due starvation there
+overcame the whole. A much greater army of "Moselekatse's own"
+followed with canoes, but were now baffled by Sebetuane's placing all
+his people and cattle on an island and so guarding it that none could
+approach. Dispirited, famished, borne down by fever, they returned
+to the Falls, and all except five were cut off.
+
+But though the Batoka appear never to have had much inclination to
+fight with men, they are decidedly brave hunters of buffaloes and
+elephants. They go fearlessly close up to these formidable animals,
+and kill them with large spears. The Banyai, who have long bullied
+all Portuguese traders, were amazed at the daring and bravery of the
+Batoka in coming at once to close quarters with the elephant; and
+Chisaka, a Portuguese rebel, having formerly induced a body of this
+tribe to settle with him, ravaged all the Portuguese villas around
+Tette. They bear the name of Basimilongwe, and some of our men found
+relations among them. Sininyane and Matenga also, two of our party,
+were once inveigled into a Portuguese expedition against Mariano, by
+the assertion that the Doctor had arrived and had sent for them to
+come down to Senna. On finding that they were entrapped to fight,
+they left, after seeing an officer with a large number of Tette
+slaves killed.
+
+The Batoka had attained somewhat civilized ideas, in planting and
+protecting various fruit and oil-seed yielding trees of the country.
+No other tribe either plants or abstains from cutting down fruit
+trees, but here we saw some which had been planted in regular rows,
+and the trunks of which were quite two feet in diameter. The grand
+old Mosibe, a tree yielding a bean with a thin red pellicle, said to
+be very fattening, had probably seen two hundred summers. Dr. Kirk
+found that the Mosibe is peculiar, in being allied to a species met
+with only in the West Indies. The Motsikiri, sometimes called
+Mafuta, yields a hard fat, and an oil which is exported from
+Inhambane. It is said that two ancient Batoka travellers went down
+as far as the Loangwa, and finding the Macaa tree (jujube or
+zisyphus) in fruit, carried the seed all the way back to the great
+Falls, in order to plant them. Two of these trees are still to be
+seen there, the only specimens of the kind in that region.
+
+The Batoka had made a near approach to the custom of more refined
+nations and had permanent graveyards, either on the sides of hills,
+thus rendered sacred, or under large old shady trees; they reverence
+the tombs of their ancestors, and plant the largest elephants' tusks,
+as monuments at the head of the grave, or entirely enclose it with
+the choicest ivory. Some of the other tribes throw the dead body
+into the river to be devoured by crocodiles, or, sewing it up in a
+mat, place it on the branch of a baobab, or cast it in some lonely
+gloomy spot, surrounded by dense tropical vegetation, where it
+affords a meal to the foul hyenas; but the Batoka reverently bury
+their dead, and regard the spot henceforth as sacred. The ordeal by
+the poison of the muave is resorted to by the Batoka, as well as by
+the other tribes; but a cock is often made to stand proxy for the
+supposed witch. Near the confluence of the Kafue the Mambo, or
+chief, with some of his headmen, came to our sleeping-place with a
+present; their foreheads were smeared with white flour, and an
+unusual seriousness marked their demeanour. Shortly before our
+arrival they had been accused of witchcraft; conscious of innocence,
+they accepted the ordeal, and undertook to drink the poisoned muave.
+For this purpose they made a journey to the sacred hill of
+Nchomokela, on which repose the bodies of their ancestors; and, after
+a solemn appeal to the unseen spirits to attest the innocence of
+their children, they swallowed the muave, vomited, and were therefore
+declared not guilty. It is evident that they believe that the soul
+has a continued existence; and that the spirits of the departed know
+what those they have left behind them are doing, and are pleased or
+not according as their deeds are good or evil; this belief is
+universal. The owner of a large canoe refused to sell it, because it
+belonged to the spirit of his father, who helped him when he killed
+the hippopotamus. Another, when the bargain for his canoe was nearly
+completed, seeing a large serpent on a branch of the tree overhead,
+refused to complete the sale, alleging that this was the spirit of
+his father come to protest against it.
+
+Some of the Batoka chiefs must have been men of considerable
+enterprise; the land of one, in the western part of this country, was
+protected by the Zambesi on the S., and on the N. and E. lay an
+impassable reedy marsh, filled with water all the year round, leaving
+only his western border open to invasion: he conceived the idea of
+digging a broad and deep canal nearly a mile in length, from the
+reedy marsh to the Zambesi, and, having actually carried the scheme
+into execution, he formed a large island, on which his cattle grazed
+in safety, and his corn ripened from year to year secure from all
+marauders.
+
+Another chief, who died a number of years ago, believed that he had
+discovered a remedy for tsetse-bitten cattle; his son Moyara showed
+us a plant, which was new to our botanist, and likewise told us how
+the medicine was prepared; the bark of the root, and, what might
+please our homoeopathic friends, a dozen of the tsetse are dried, and
+ground together into a fine powder. This mixture is administered
+internally; and the cattle are fumigated by burning under them the
+rest of the plant collected. The treatment must be continued for
+weeks, whenever the symptoms of poison appear. This medicine, he
+frankly admitted, would not cure all the bitten cattle. "For," said
+he, "cattle, and men too, die in spite of medicine; but should a herd
+by accident stray into a tsetse district and be bitten, by this
+medicine of my father, Kampa-kampa, some of them could be saved,
+while, without it, all would inevitably die." He stipulated that we
+were not to show the medicine to other people, and if ever we needed
+it in this region we must employ him; but if we were far off we might
+make it ourselves; and when we saw it cure the cattle think of him,
+and send him a present.
+
+Our men made it known everywhere that we wished the tribes to live in
+peace, and would use our influence to induce Sekeletu to prevent the
+Batoka of Moshobotwane and the Makololo under-chiefs making forays
+into their country: they had already suffered severely, and their
+remonstrances with their countryman, Moshobotwane, evoked only the
+answer, "The Makololo have given me a spear; why should I not use
+it?" He, indeed, it was who, being remarkably swift of foot, first
+guided the Makololo in their conquest of the country. In the
+character of peacemakers, therefore, we experienced abundant
+hospitality; and, from the Kafue to the Falls, none of our party was
+allowed to suffer hunger. The natives sent to our sleeping-places
+generous presents of the finest white meal, and fat capons to give it
+a relish, great pots of beer to comfort our hearts, together with
+pumpkins, beans, and tobacco, so that we "should sleep neither hungry
+nor thirsty."
+
+In travelling from the Kafue to the Zungwe we frequently passed
+several villages in the course of a day's march. In the evening came
+deputies from the villages, at which we could not stay to sleep, with
+liberal presents of food. It would have pained them to have allowed
+strangers to pass without partaking of their hospitality; repeatedly
+were we hailed from huts, and asked to wait a moment and drink a
+little of the beer, which was brought with alacrity. Our march
+resembled a triumphant procession. We entered and left every village
+amidst the cheers of its inhabitants; the men clapping their hands,
+and the women lullilooing, with the shrill call, "Let us sleep," or
+"Peace." Passing through a hamlet one day, our guide called to the
+people, "Why do you not clap your hands and salute when you see men
+who are wishing to bring peace to the land?" When we halted for the
+night it was no uncommon thing for the people to prepare our camp
+entirely of their own accord; some with hoes quickly smoothed the
+ground for our beds, others brought dried grass and spread it
+carefully over the spot; some with their small axes speedily made a
+bush fence to shield us from the wind; and if, as occasionally
+happened, the water was a little distance off, others hastened and
+brought it with firewood to cook our food with. They are an
+industrious people, and very fond of agriculture. For hours together
+we marched through unbroken fields of mapira, or native corn, of a
+great width; but one can give no idea of the extent of land under the
+hoe as compared with any European country. The extent of surface is
+so great that the largest fields under culture, when viewed on a wide
+landscape, dwindle to mere spots. When taken in connection with the
+wants of the people, the cultivation on the whole is most creditable
+to their industry. They erect numerous granaries which give their
+villages the appearance of being large; and, when the water of the
+Zambesi has subsided, they place large quantities of grain, tied up
+in bundles of grass, and well plastered over with clay, on low sand
+islands for protection from the attacks of marauding mice and men.
+Owing to the ravages of the weevil, the native corn can hardly be
+preserved until the following crop comes in. However largely they
+may cultivate, and however abundant the harvest, it must all be
+consumed in a year. This may account for their making so much of it
+into beer. The beer these Batoka or Bawe brew is not the sour and
+intoxicating boala or pombe found among some other tribes, but sweet,
+and highly nutritive, with only a slight degree of acidity,
+sufficient to render it a pleasant drink. The people were all plump,
+and in good condition; and we never saw a single case of intoxication
+among them, though all drank abundance of this liting, or sweet beer.
+Both men and boys were eager to work for very small pay. Our men
+could hire any number of them to carry their burdens for a few beads
+a day. Our miserly and dirty ex-cook had an old pair of trousers
+that some one had given to him; after he had long worn them himself,
+with one of the sorely decayed legs he hired a man to carry his heavy
+load a whole day; a second man carried it the next day for the other
+leg, and what remained of the old garment, without the buttons,
+procured the labour of another man for the third day.
+
+Men of remarkable ability have risen up among the Africans from time
+to time, as amongst other portions of the human family. Some have
+attracted the attention, and excited the admiration of large
+districts by their wisdom. Others, apparently by the powers of
+ventriloquism, or by peculiar dexterity in throwing the spear, or
+shooting with the bow, have been the wonder of their generation; but
+the total absence of literature leads to the loss of all former
+experience, and the wisdom of the wise has not been handed down.
+They have had their minstrels too, but mere tradition preserves not
+their effusions. One of these, and apparently a genuine poet,
+attached himself to our party for several days, and whenever we
+halted, sang our praises to the villagers, in smooth and harmonious
+numbers. It was a sort of blank verse, and each line consisted of
+five syllables. The song was short when it first began, but each day
+he picked up more information about us, and added to the poem until
+our praises became an ode of respectable length. When distance from
+home compelled his return he expressed his regret at leaving us, and
+was, of course, paid for his useful and pleasant flatteries.
+Another, though a less gifted son of song, belonged to the Batoka of
+our own party. Every evening, while the others were cooking,
+talking, or sleeping, he rehearsed his songs, containing a history of
+everything he had seen in the land of the white men, and on the way
+back. In composing, extempore, any new piece, he was never at a
+loss; for if the right word did not come he halted not, but eked out
+the measure with a peculiar musical sound meaning nothing at all. He
+accompanied his recitations on the sansa, an instrument figured in
+the woodcut, the nine iron keys of which are played with the thumbs,
+while the fingers pass behind to hold it. The hollow end and
+ornaments face the breast of the player. Persons of a musical turn,
+if too poor to buy a sansa, may be seen playing vigorously on an
+instrument made with a number of thick corn-stalks sewn together, as
+a sansa frame, and keys of split bamboo, which, though making but
+little sound, seems to soothe the player himself. When the
+instrument is played with a calabash as a sounding board, it emits a
+greater volume of sound. Pieces of shells and tin are added to make
+a jingling accompaniment, and the calabash is also ornamented.
+
+After we had passed up, a party of slaves, belonging to the two
+native Portuguese who assassinated the chief, Mpangwe, and took
+possession of his lands at Zumbo, followed on our footsteps, and
+representing themselves to be our "children," bought great quantities
+of ivory from the Bawe, for a few coarse beads a tusk. They also
+purchased ten large new canoes to carry it, at the rate of six
+strings of red or white beads, or two fathoms of grey calico, for
+each canoe, and, at the same cheap rate, a number of good-looking
+girls.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII.
+
+
+
+The Victoria Falls of the Zambesi--Marvellous grandeur of the
+Cataracts--The Makololo's town--The Chief Sekeletu.
+
+During the time we remained at Motunta a splendid meteor was observed
+to lighten the whole heavens. The observer's back was turned to it,
+but on looking round the streak of light was seen to remain on its
+path some seconds. This streak is usually explained to be only the
+continuance of the impression made by the shining body on the retina.
+This cannot be, as in this case the meteor was not actually seen and
+yet the streak was clearly perceived. The rays of planets and stars
+also require another explanation than that usually given.
+
+Fruit-trees and gigantic wild fig-trees, and circles of stones on
+which corn safes were placed, with worn grindstones, point out where
+the villages once stood. The only reason now assigned for this fine
+country remaining desolate is the fear of fresh visitations by the
+Matebele. The country now slopes gradually to the west into the
+Makololo Valley. Two days' march from the Batoka village nearest the
+highlands, we met with some hunters who were burning the dry grass,
+in order to attract the game by the fresh vegetation which speedily
+springs up afterwards. The grass, as already remarked, is excellent
+for cattle. One species, with leaves having finely serrated edges,
+and of a reddish-brown colour, we noticed our men eating: it tastes
+exactly like liquorice-root, and is named kezu-kezu. The tsetse,
+known to the Batoka by the name "ndoka," does not exist here, though
+buffaloes and elephants abound.
+
+A small trap in the path, baited with a mouse, to catch spotted cats
+(F. Genetta), is usually the first indication that we are drawing
+near to a village; but when we get within the sounds of pounding
+corn, cockcrowing, or the merry shouts of children at play, we know
+that the huts are but a few yards off, though the trees conceal them
+from view. We reached, on the 4th of August, Moachemba, the first of
+the Batoka villages which now owe allegiance to Sekeletu, and could
+see distinctly with the naked eye, in the great valley spread out
+before us, the columns of vapour rising from the Victoria Falls,
+though upwards of 20 miles distant. We were informed that, the rains
+having failed this year, the corn crops had been lost, and great
+scarcity and much hunger prevailed from Sesheke to Linyanti. Some of
+the reports which the men had heard from the Batoka of the hills
+concerning their families, were here confirmed. Takelang's wife had
+been killed by Mashotlane, the headman at the Falls, on a charge, as
+usual, of witchcraft. Inchikola's two wives, believing him to be
+dead, had married again; and Masakasa was intensely disgusted to hear
+that two years ago his friends, upon a report of his death, threw his
+shield over the Falls, slaughtered all his oxen, and held a species
+of wild Irish wake, in honour of his memory: he said he meant to
+disown them, and to say, when they come to salute him, "I am dead. I
+am not here. I belong to another world, and should stink if I came
+among you."
+
+All the sad news we had previously heard, of the disastrous results
+which followed the attempt of a party of missionaries, under the Rev.
+H. Helmore, to plant the gospel at Linyanti, were here fully
+confirmed. Several of the missionaries and their native attendants,
+from Kuruman, had succumbed to the fever, and the survivors had
+retired some weeks before our arrival. We remained the whole of the
+7th beside the village of the old Batoka chief, Moshobotwane, the
+stoutest man we have seen in Africa. The cause of our delay here was
+a severe attack of fever in Charles Livingstone. He took a dose of
+our fever pills; was better on the 8th, and marched three hours; then
+on the 9th marched eight miles to the Great Falls, and spent the rest
+of the day in the fatiguing exercise of sight-seeing. We were in the
+very same valley as Linyanti, and this was the same fever which
+treated, or rather maltreated, with only a little Dover's powder,
+proved so fatal to poor Helmore; the symptoms, too, were identical
+with those afterwards described by non-medical persons as those of
+poison.
+
+We gave Moshobotwane a present, and a pretty plain exposition of what
+we thought of his bloody forays among his Batoka brethren. A
+scolding does most good to the recipient, when put alongside some
+obliging act. He certainly did not take it ill, as was evident from
+what he gave us in return; which consisted of a liberal supply of
+meal, milk, and an ox. He has a large herd of cattle, and a tract of
+fine pasture-land on the beautiful stream Lekone. A home-feeling
+comes over one, even in the interior of Africa, at seeing once more
+cattle grazing peacefully in the meadows. The tsetse inhabits the
+trees which bound the pasture-land on the west; so, should the
+herdsman forget his duty, the cattle straying might be entirely lost.
+The women of this village were more numerous than the men, the result
+of the chief's marauding. The Batoko wife of Sima came up from the
+Falls, to welcome her husband back, bringing a present of the best
+fruits of the country. Her husband was the only one of the party who
+had brought a wife from Tette, namely, the girl whom he obtained from
+Chisaka for his feats of dancing. According to our ideas, his first
+wife could hardly have been pleased at seeing the second and younger
+one; but she took her away home with her, while the husband remained
+with us. In going down to the Fall village we met several of the
+real Makololo. They are lighter in colour than the other tribes,
+being of a rich warm brown; and they speak in a slow deliberate
+manner, distinctly pronouncing every word. On reaching the village
+opposite Kalai, we had an interview with the Makololo headman,
+Mashotlane: he came to the shed in which we were seated, a little
+boy carrying his low three-legged stool before him: on this he sat
+down with becoming dignity, looked round him for a few seconds, then
+at us, and, saluting us with "Rumela" (good morning, or hail), he
+gave us some boiled hippopotamus meat, took a piece himself, and then
+handed the rest to his attendants, who soon ate it up. He defended
+his forays on the ground that, when he went to collect tribute, the
+Batoka attacked him, and killed some of his attendants. The excuses
+made for their little wars are often the very same as those made by
+Caesar in his "Commentaries." Few admit, like old Moshobotwane, that
+they fought because they had the power, and a fair prospect of
+conquering. We found here Pitsane, who had accompanied the Doctor to
+St. Paul de Loanda. He had been sent by Sekeletu to purchase three
+horses from a trading party of Griquas from Kuruman, who charged nine
+large tusks apiece for very wretched animals.
+
+In the evening, when all was still, one of our men, Takelang, fired
+his musket, and cried out, "I am weeping for my wife: my court is
+desolate: I have no home;" and then uttered a loud wail of anguish.
+
+We proceeded next morning, 9th August, 1860, to see the Victoria
+Falls. Mosi-oa-tunya is the Makololo name and means smoke sounding;
+Seongo or Chongwe, meaning the Rainbow, or the place of the Rainbow,
+was the more ancient term they bore. We embarked in canoes,
+belonging to Tuba Mokoro, "smasher of canoes," an ominous name; but
+he alone, it seems, knew the medicine which insures one against
+shipwreck in the rapids above the Falls. For some miles the river
+was smooth and tranquil, and we glided pleasantly over water clear as
+crystal, and past lovely islands densely covered with a tropical
+vegetation. Noticeable among the many trees were the lofty Hyphaene
+and Borassus palms; the graceful wild date-palm, with its fruit in
+golden clusters, and the umbrageous mokononga, of cypress form, with
+its dark-green leaves and scarlet fruit. Many flowers peeped out
+near the water's edge, some entirely new to us, and others, as the
+convolvulus, old acquaintances.
+
+But our attention was quickly called from the charming islands to the
+dangerous rapids, down which Tuba might unintentionally shoot us. To
+confess the truth, the very ugly aspect of these roaring rapids could
+scarcely fail to cause some uneasiness in the minds of new-comers.
+It is only when the river is very low, as it was now, that any one
+durst venture to the island to which we were bound. If one went
+during the period of flood, and fortunately hit the island, he would
+be obliged to remain there till the water subsided again, if he lived
+so long. Both hippopotami and elephants have been known to be swept
+over the Falls, and of course smashed to pulp.
+
+Before entering the race of waters, we were requested not to speak,
+as our talking might diminish the virtue of the medicine; and no one
+with such boiling eddying rapids before his eyes, would think of
+disobeying the orders of a "canoe-smasher." It soon became evident
+that there was sound sense in this request of Tuba's, although the
+reason assigned was not unlike that of the canoe-man from Sesheke,
+who begged one of our party not to whistle, because whistling made
+the wind come. It was the duty of the man at the bow to look out
+ahead for the proper course, and when he saw a rock or snag, to call
+out to the steersman. Tuba doubtless thought that talking on board
+might divert the attention of his steersman, at a time when the
+neglect of an order, or a slight mistake, would be sure to spill us
+all into the chafing river. There were places where the utmost
+exertions of both men had to be put forth in order to force the canoe
+to the only safe part of the rapid, and to prevent it from sweeping
+down broadside on, where in a twinkling we should have found
+ourselves floundering among the plotuses and cormorants, which were
+engaged in diving for their breakfast of small fish. At times it
+seemed as if nothing could save us from dashing in our headlong race
+against the rocks which, now that the river was low, jutted out of
+the water; but just at the very nick of time, Tuba passed the word to
+the steersman, and then with ready pole turned the canoe a little
+aside, and we glided swiftly past the threatened danger. Never was
+canoe more admirably managed: once only did the medicine seem to
+have lost something of its efficacy. We were driving swiftly down, a
+black rock over which the white foam flew, lay directly in our path,
+the pole was planted against it as readily as ever, but it slipped,
+just as Tuba put forth his strength to turn the bow off. We struck
+hard, and were half-full of water in a moment; Tuba recovered himself
+as speedily, shoved off the bow, and shot the canoe into a still
+shallow place, to bale out the water. Here we were given to
+understand that it was not the medicine which was at fault; that had
+lost none of its virtue; the accident was owing entirely to Tuba
+having started without his breakfast. Need it be said we never let
+Tuba go without that meal again?
+
+We landed at the head of Garden Island, which is situated near the
+middle of the river and on the lip of the Falls. On reaching that
+lip, and peering over the giddy height, the wondrous and unique
+character of the magnificent cascade at once burst upon us.
+
+It is rather a hopeless task to endeavour to convey an idea of it in
+words, since, as was remarked on the spot, an accomplished painter,
+even by a number of views, could but impart a faint impression of the
+glorious scene. The probable mode of its formation may perhaps help
+to the conception of its peculiar shape. Niagara has been formed by
+a wearing back of the rock over which the river falls; and during a
+long course of ages, it has gradually receded, and left a broad,
+deep, and pretty straight trough in front. It goes on wearing back
+daily, and may yet discharge the lakes from which its river--the St.
+Lawrence--flows. But the Victoria Falls have been formed by a crack
+right across the river, in the hard, black, basaltic rock which there
+formed the bed of the Zambesi. The lips of the crack are still quite
+sharp, save about three feet of the edge over which the river rolls.
+The walls go sheer down from the lips without any projecting crag, or
+symptoms of stratification or dislocation. When the mighty rift
+occurred, no change of level took place in the two parts of the bed
+of the river thus rent asunder, consequently, in coming down the
+river to Garden Island, the water suddenly disappears, and we see the
+opposite side of the cleft, with grass and trees growing where once
+the river ran, on the same level as that part of its bed on which we
+sail. The first crack is, in length, a few yards more than the
+breadth of the Zambesi, which by measurement we found to be a little
+over 1860 yards, but this number we resolved to retain as indicating
+the year in which the Fall was for the first time carefully examined.
+The main stream here runs nearly north and south, and the cleft
+across it is nearly east and west. The depth of the rift was
+measured by lowering a line, to the end of which a few bullets and a
+foot of white cotton cloth were tied. One of us lay with his head
+over a projecting crag, and watched the descending calico, till,
+after his companions had paid out 310 feet, the weight rested on a
+sloping projection, probably 50 feet from the water below, the actual
+bottom being still further down. The white cloth now appeared the
+size of a crown-piece. On measuring the width of this deep cleft by
+sextant, it was found at Garden Island, its narrowest part, to be
+eighty yards, and at its broadest somewhat more. Into this chasm, of
+twice the depth of Niagara-fall, the river, a full mile wide, rolls
+with a deafening roar; and this is Mosi-oa-tunya, or the Victoria
+Falls.
+
+Looking from Garden Island, down to the bottom of the abyss, nearly
+half a mile of water, which has fallen over that portion of the Falls
+to our right, or west of our point of view, is seen collected in a
+narrow channel twenty or thirty yards wide, and flowing at exactly
+right angles to its previous course, to our left; while the other
+half, or that which fell over the eastern portion of the Falls, is
+seen in the left of the narrow channel below, coming towards our
+right. Both waters unite midway, in a fearful boiling whirlpool, and
+find an outlet by a crack situated at right angles to the fissure of
+the Falls. This outlet is about 1170 yards from the western end of
+the chasm, and some 600 from its eastern end; the whirlpool is at its
+commencement. The Zambesi, now apparently not more than twenty or
+thirty yards wide, rushes and surges south, through the narrow
+escape-channel for 130 yards; then enters a second chasm somewhat
+deeper, and nearly parallel with the first. Abandoning the bottom of
+the eastern half of this second chasm to the growth of large trees,
+it turns sharply off to the west, and forms a promontory, with the
+escape-channel at its point, of 1170 yards long, and 416 yards broad
+at the base. After reaching this base, the river runs abruptly round
+the head of another promontory, and flows away to the east, in a
+third chasm; then glides round a third promontory, much narrower than
+the rest, and away back to the west, in a fourth chasm; and we could
+see in the distance that it appeared to round still another
+promontory, and bend once more in another chasm towards the east. In
+this gigantic, zigzag, yet narrow trough, the rocks are all so
+sharply cut and angular, that the idea at once arises that the hard
+basaltic trap must have been riven into its present shape by a force
+acting from beneath, and that this probably took place when the
+ancient inland seas were let off by similar fissures nearer the
+ocean.
+
+The land beyond, or on the south of the Falls, retains, as already
+remarked, the same level as before the rent was made. It is as if
+the trough below Niagara were bent right and left, several times
+before it reached the railway bridge. The land in the supposed bends
+being of the same height as that above the Fall, would give standing-
+places, or points of view, of the same nature as that from the
+railway-bridge, but the nearest would be only eighty yards, instead
+of two miles (the distance to the bridge) from the face of the
+cascade. The tops of the promontories are in general flat, smooth,
+and studded with trees. The first, with its base on the east, is at
+one place so narrow, that it would be dangerous to walk to its
+extremity. On the second, however, we found a broad rhinoceros path
+and a hut; but, unless the builder were a hermit, with a pet
+rhinoceros, we cannot conceive what beast or man ever went there for.
+On reaching the apex of this second eastern promontory we saw the
+great river, of a deep sea-green colour, now sorely compressed,
+gliding away, at least 400 feet below us.
+
+Garden Island, when the river is low, commands the best view of the
+Great Fall chasm, as also of the promontory opposite, with its grove
+of large evergreen trees, and brilliant rainbows of three-quarters of
+a circle, two, three, and sometimes even four in number, resting on
+the face of the vast perpendicular rock, down which tiny streams are
+always running to be swept again back by the upward rushing vapour.
+But as, at Niagara, one has to go over to the Canadian shore to see
+the chief wonder--the Great Horse-shoe Fall--so here we have to cross
+over to Moselekatse's side to the promontory of evergreens, for the
+best view of the principal Falls of Mosi-oa-tunya. Beginning,
+therefore, at the base of this promontory, and facing the Cataract,
+at the west end of the chasm, there is, first, a fall of thirty-six
+yards in breadth, and of course, as they all are, upwards of 310 feet
+in depth. Then Boaruka, a small island, intervenes, and next comes a
+great fall, with a breadth of 573 yards; a projecting rock separates
+this from a second grand fall of 325 yards broad; in all, upwards of
+900 yards of perennial Falls. Further east stands Garden Island;
+then, as the river was at its lowest, came a good deal of the bare
+rock of its bed, with a score of narrow falls, which, at the time of
+flood, constitute one enormous cascade of nearly another half-mile.
+Near the east end of the chasm are two larger falls, but they are
+nothing at low water compared to those between the islands.
+
+The whole body of water rolls clear over, quite unbroken; but, after
+a descent of ten or more feet, the entire mass suddenly becomes like
+a huge sheet of driven snow. Pieces of water leap off it in the form
+of comets with tails streaming behind, till the whole snowy sheet
+becomes myriads of rushing, leaping, aqueous comets. This
+peculiarity was not observed by Charles Livingstone at Niagara, and
+here it happens, possibly from the dryness of the atmosphere, or
+whatever the cause may be which makes every drop of Zambesi water
+appear to possess a sort of individuality. It runs off the ends of
+the paddles, and glides in beads along the smooth surface, like drops
+of quicksilver on a table. Here we see them in a conglomeration,
+each with a train of pure white vapour, racing down till lost in
+clouds of spray. A stone dropped in became less and less to the eye,
+and at last disappeared in the dense mist below.
+
+Charles Livingstone had seen Niagara, and gave Mosi-oa-tunya the
+palm, though now at the end of a drought, and the river at its very
+lowest. Many feel a disappointment on first seeing the great
+American Falls, but Mosi-oa-tunya is so strange, it must ever cause
+wonder. In the amount of water, Niagara probably excels, though not
+during the months when the Zambesi is in flood. The vast body of
+water, separating in the comet-like forms described, necessarily
+encloses in its descent a large volume of air, which, forced into the
+cleft, to an unknown depth, rebounds, and rushes up loaded with
+vapour to form the three or even six columns, as if of steam, visible
+at the Batoka village Moachemba, twenty-one miles distant. On
+attaining a height of 200, or at most 300 feet from the level of the
+river above the cascade, this vapour becomes condensed into a
+perpetual shower of fine rain. Much of the spray, rising to the west
+of Garden Island, falls on the grove of evergreen trees opposite; and
+from their leaves, heavy drops are for ever falling, to form sundry
+little rills, which, in running down the steep face of rock, are
+blown off and turned back, or licked off their perpendicular bed, up
+into the column from which they have just descended.
+
+The morning sun gilds these columns of watery smoke with all the
+glowing colours of double or treble rainbows. The evening sun, from
+a hot yellow sky, imparts a sulphureous hue, and gives one the
+impression that the yawning gulf might resemble the mouth of the
+bottomless pit. No bird sits and sings on the branches of the grove
+of perpetual showers, or ever builds its nest there. We saw
+hornbills and flocks of little black weavers flying across from the
+mainland to the islands, and from the islands to the points of the
+promontories and back again, but they uniformly shunned the region of
+perpetual rain, occupied by the evergreen grove. The sunshine,
+elsewhere in this land so overpowering, never penetrates the deep
+gloom of that shade. In the presence of the strange Mosi-oa-tunya,
+we can sympathize with those who, when the world was young, peopled
+earth, air, and river, with beings not of mortal form. Sacred to
+what deity would be this awful chasm and that dark grove, over which
+hovers an ever-abiding "pillar of cloud"?
+
+The ancient Batoka chieftains used Kazeruka, now Garden Island, and
+Boaruka, the island further west, also on the lip of the Falls, as
+sacred spots for worshipping the Deity. It is no wonder that under
+the cloudy columns, and near the brilliant rainbows, with the
+ceaseless roar of the cataract, with the perpetual flow, as if
+pouring forth from the hand of the Almighty, their souls should be
+filled with reverential awe. It inspired wonder in the native mind
+throughout the interior. Among the first questions asked by
+Sebituane of Mr. Oswell and Dr. Livingstone, in 1851, was, "Have you
+any smoke soundings in your country," and "what causes the smoke to
+rise for ever so high out of water?" In that year its fame was heard
+200 miles off, and it was approached within two days; but it was seen
+by no European till 1855, when Dr. Livingstone visited it on his way
+to the East Coast. Being then accompanied as far as this Fall by
+Sekeletu and 200 followers, his stay was necessarily short; and the
+two days there were employed in observations for fixing the
+geographical position of the place, and turning the showers, that at
+times sweep from the columns of vapour across the island, to account,
+in teaching the Makololo arboriculture, and making that garden from
+which the natives named the island; so that he did not visit the
+opposite sides of the cleft, nor see the wonderful course of the
+river beyond the Falls. The hippopotami had destroyed the trees
+which were then planted; and, though a strong stockaded hedge was
+made again, and living orange-trees, cashew-nuts, and coffee seeds
+put in afresh, we fear that the perseverance of the hippopotami will
+overcome the obstacle of the hedge. It would require a resident
+missionary to rear European fruit-trees. The period at which the
+peach and apricot come into blossom is about the end of the dry
+season, and artificial irrigation is necessary. The Batoka, the only
+arboriculturists in the country, rear native fruit-trees alone--the
+mosibe, the motsikiri, the boma, and others. When a tribe takes an
+interest in trees, it becomes more attached to the spot on which they
+are planted, and they prove one of the civilizing influences.
+
+Where one Englishman goes, others are sure to follow. Mr. Baldwin, a
+gentleman from Natal, succeeded in reaching the Falls guided by his
+pocket-compass alone. On meeting the second subject of Her Majesty,
+who had ever beheld the greatest of African wonders, we found him a
+sort of prisoner at large. He had called on Mashotlane to ferry him
+over to the north side of the river, and, when nearly over, he took a
+bath, by jumping in and swimming ashore. "If," said Mashotlane, "he
+had been devoured by one of the crocodiles which abound there, the
+English would have blamed us for his death. He nearly inflicted a
+great injury upon us, therefore, we said, he must pay a fine." As
+Mr. Baldwin had nothing with him wherewith to pay, they were taking
+care of him till he should receive beads from his wagon, two days
+distant.
+
+Mashotlane's education had been received in the camp of Sebituane,
+where but little regard was paid to human life. He was not yet in
+his prime, and his fine open countenance presented to us no
+indication of the evil influences which unhappily, from infancy, had
+been at work on his mind. The native eye was more penetrating than
+ours; for the expression of our men was, "He has drunk the blood of
+men--you may see it in his eyes." He made no further difficulty
+about Mr. Baldwin; but the week after we left he inflicted a severe
+wound on the head of one of his wives with his rhinoceros-horn club.
+She, being of a good family, left him, and we subsequently met her
+and another of his wives proceeding up the country.
+
+The ground is strewn with agates for a number of miles above the
+Falls; but the fires, which burn off the grass yearly, have injured
+most of those on the surface. Our men were delighted to hear that
+they do as well as flints for muskets; and this with the new ideas of
+the value of gold (dalama) and malachite, that they had acquired at
+Tette, made them conceive that we were not altogether silly in
+picking up and looking at stones.
+
+Marching up the river, we crossed the Lekone at its confluence, about
+eight miles above the island Kalai, and went on to a village opposite
+the Island Chundu. Nambowe, the headman, is one of the Matebele or
+Zulus, who have had to flee from the anger of Moselekatse, to take
+refuge with the Makololo.
+
+We spent Sunday, the 12th, at the village of Molele, a tall old
+Batoka, who was proud of having formerly been a great favourite with
+Sebituane. In coming hither we passed through patches of forest
+abounding in all sorts of game. The elephants' tusks, placed over
+graves, are now allowed to decay, and the skulls, which the former
+Batoka stuck on poles to ornament their villages, not being renewed,
+now crumble into dust. Here the famine, of which we had heard,
+became apparent, Molele's people being employed in digging up the
+tsitla root out of the marshes, and cutting out the soft core of the
+young palm-trees, for food.
+
+The village, situated on the side of a wooded ridge, commands an
+extensive view of a great expanse of meadow and marsh lying along the
+bank of the river. On these holmes herds of buffaloes and waterbucks
+daily graze in security, as they have in the reedy marshes a refuge
+into which they can run on the approach of danger. The pretty little
+tianyane or ourebi is abundant further on, and herds of blue
+weldebeests or brindled gnus (Katoblepas Gorgon) amused us by their
+fantastic capers. They present a much more ferocious aspect than the
+lion himself, but are quite timid. We never could, by waving a red
+handkerchief, according to the prescription, induce them to venture
+near to us. It may therefore be that the red colour excites their
+fury only when wounded or hotly pursued. Herds of lechee or lechwe
+now enliven the meadows; and they and their younger brother, the
+graceful poku, smaller, and of a rounder contour, race together
+towards the grassy fens. We venture to call the poku after the late
+Major Vardon, a noble-hearted African traveller; but fully anticipate
+that some aspiring Nimrod will prefer that his own name should go
+down to posterity on the back of this buck.
+
+Midway between Tabacheu and the Great Falls the streams begin to flow
+westward. On the other side they begin to flow east. Large round
+masses of granite, somewhat like old castles, tower aloft about the
+Kalomo. The country is an elevated plateau, and our men knew and
+named the different plains as we passed them by.
+
+On the 13th we met a party from Sekeletu, who was now at Sesheke.
+Our approach had been reported, and they had been sent to ask the
+Doctor what the price of a horse ought to be; and what he said, that
+they were to give and no more. In reply they were told that by their
+having given nine large tusks for one horse before the Doctor came,
+the Griquas would naturally imagine that the price was already
+settled. It was exceedingly amusing to witness the exact imitation
+they gave of the swagger of a certain white with whom they had been
+dealing, and who had, as they had perceived, evidently wished to
+assume an air of indifference. Holding up the head and scratching
+the beard it was hinted might indicate not indifference, but vermin.
+It is well that we do not always know what they say about us. The
+remarks are often not quite complimentary, and resemble closely what
+certain white travellers say about the blacks.
+
+We made our camp in the afternoon abreast of the large island called
+Mparira, opposite the mouth of the Chobe. Francolins, quails, and
+guinea-fowls, as well as larger game, were abundant. The Makololo
+headman, Mokompa, brought us a liberal present; and in the usual way,
+which is considered politeness, regretted he had no milk, as his cows
+were all dry. We got some honey here from the very small stingless
+bee, called, by the Batoka, moandi, and by others, the kokomatsane.
+This honey is slightly acid, and has an aromatic flavour. The bees
+are easily known from their habit of buzzing about the eyes, and
+tickling the skin by sucking it as common flies do. The hive has a
+tube of wax like a quill, for its entrance, and is usually in the
+hollows of trees.
+
+Mokompa feared that the tribe was breaking up, and lamented the
+condition into which they had fallen in consequence of Sekeletu's
+leprosy; he did not know what was to become of them. He sent two
+canoes to take us up to Sesheke; his best canoe had taken ivory up to
+the chief, to purchase goods of some native traders from Benguela.
+Above the Falls the paddlers always stand in the canoes, using long
+paddles, ten feet in length, and changing from side to side without
+losing the stroke.
+
+Mochokotsa, a messenger from Sekeletu, met us on the 17th, with
+another request for the Doctor to take ivory and purchase a horse.
+He again declined to interfere. None were to come up to Sekeletu but
+the Doctor; and all the men who had had smallpox at Tette, three
+years ago, were to go back to Moshobotwane, and he would sprinkle
+medicine over them, to drive away the infection, and prevent it
+spreading in the tribe. Mochokotsa was told to say to Sekeletu that
+the disease was known of old to white men, and we even knew the
+medicine to prevent it; and, were there any danger now, we should be
+the first to warn him of it. Why did not he go himself to have
+Moshobotwane sprinkle medicine to drive away his leprosy. We were
+not afraid of his disease, nor of the fever that had killed the
+teachers and many Makololo at Linyanti. As this attempt at
+quarantine was evidently the suggestion of native doctors to increase
+their own importance, we added that we had no food, and would hunt
+next day for game, and the day after; and, should we be still ordered
+purification by their medicine, we should then return to our own
+country.
+
+The message was not all of our dictation, our companions interlarded
+it with their own indignant protests, and said some strong things in
+the Tette dialect about these "doctor things" keeping them back from
+seeing their father; when to their surprise Mochokotsa told them he
+knew every word they were saying, as he was of the tribe Bazizulu,
+and defied them to deceive him by any dialect, either of the Mashona
+on the east, or of the Mambari on the west. Mochokotsa then repeated
+our message twice, to be sure that he had it every word, and went
+back again. These chiefs' messengers have most retentive memories;
+they carry messages of considerable length great distances, and
+deliver them almost word for word. Two or three usually go together,
+and when on the way the message is rehearsed every night, in order
+that the exact words may be kept to. One of the native objections to
+learning to write is, that these men answer the purpose of
+transmitting intelligence to a distance as well as a letter would;
+and, if a person wishes to communicate with any one in the town, the
+best way to do so is either to go to or send for him. And as for
+corresponding with friends very far off, that is all very well for
+white people, but the blacks have no friends to whom to write. The
+only effective argument for the learning to read is, that it is their
+duty to know the revelation from their Father in Heaven, as it stands
+in the Book.
+
+Our messenger returned on the evening of the following day with "You
+speak truly," says Sekeletu, "the disease is old, come on at once, do
+not sleep in the path; for I am greatly desirous (tlologelecoe) to
+see the Doctor."
+
+After Mochokotsa left us, we met some of Mokompa's men bringing back
+the ivory, as horses were preferred to the West-Coast goods. They
+were the bearers of instructions to Mokompa, and as these
+instructions illustrate the government of people who have learned
+scarcely anything from Europeans, they are inserted, though otherwise
+of no importance. Mashotlane had not behaved so civilly to Mr.
+Baldwin as Sekeletu had ordered him to do to all Englishmen. He had
+been very uncivil to the messengers sent by Moselekatse with letters
+from Mr. Moffat, treated them as spies, and would not land to take
+the bag until they moved off. On our speaking to him about this, he
+justified his conduct on the plea that he was set at the Falls for
+the very purpose of watching these, their natural enemies; and how
+was he to know that they had been sent by Mr. Moffat? Our men
+thereupon reported at head-quarters that Mashotlane had cursed the
+Doctor. The instructions to Mokompa, from Sekeletu, were to "go and
+tell Mashotlane that he had offended greatly. He had not cursed
+Monare (Dr. Livingstone) but Sebituane, as Monare was now in the
+place of Sebituane, and he reverenced him as he had done his father.
+Any fine taken from Mr. Baldwin was to be returned at once, as he was
+not a Boer but an Englishman. Sekeletu was very angry, and Mokompa
+must not conceal the message."
+
+On finding afterwards that Mashotlane's conduct had been most
+outrageous to the Batoka, Sekeletu sent for him to come to Sesheke,
+in order that he might have him more under his own eye; but
+Mashotlane, fearing that this meant the punishment of death, sent a
+polite answer, alleging that he was ill and unable to travel.
+Sekeletu tried again to remove Mashotlane from the Falls, but without
+success. In theory the chief is absolute and quite despotic; in
+practice his authority is limited, and he cannot, without
+occasionally putting refractory headmen to death, force his
+subordinates to do his will.
+
+Except the small rapids by Mparira island, near the mouth of the
+Chobe, the rest of the way to Sesheke by water is smooth. Herds of
+cattle of two or three varieties graze on the islands in the river:
+the Batoka possessed a very small breed of beautiful shape, and
+remarkably tame, and many may still be seen; a larger kind, many of
+which have horns pendent, and loose at the roots; and a still larger
+sort, with horns of extraordinary dimensions,--apparently a burden
+for the beast to carry. This breed was found in abundance at Lake
+Ngami. We stopped at noon at one of the cattle-posts of Mokompa, and
+had a refreshing drink of milk. Men of his standing have usually
+several herds placed at different spots, and the owner visits each in
+turn, while his head-quarters are at his village. His son, a boy of
+ten, had charge of the establishment during his father's absence.
+According to Makololo ideas, the cattle-post is the proper school in
+which sons should be brought up. Here they receive the right sort of
+education--the knowledge of pasture and how to manage cattle.
+
+Strong easterly winds blow daily from noon till midnight, and
+continue till the October or November rains set in. Whirlwinds,
+raising huge pillars of smoke from burning grass and weeds, are
+common in the forenoon. We were nearly caught in an immense one. It
+crossed about twenty yards in front of us, the wind apparently
+rushing into it from all points of the compass. Whirling round and
+round in great eddies, it swept up hundreds of feet into the air a
+continuous dense dark cloud of the black pulverized soil, mixed with
+dried grass, off the plain. Herds of the new antelopes, lechwe, and
+poku, with the kokong, or gnus, and zebras stood gazing at us as we
+passed. The mirage lifted them at times halfway to the clouds, and
+twisted them and the clumps of palms into strange unearthly forms.
+The extensive and rich level plains by the banks, along the sides of
+which we paddled, would support a vast population, and might be
+easily irrigated from the Zambesi. If watered, they would yield
+crops all the year round, and never suffer loss by drought. The
+hippopotamus is killed here with long lance-like spears. We saw two
+men, in a light canoe, stealing noiselessly down on one of these
+animals thought to be asleep; but it was on the alert, and they had
+quickly to retreat. Comparatively few of these animals now remain
+between Sesheke and the Falls, and they are uncommonly wary, as it is
+certain death for one to be caught napping in the daytime.
+
+On the 18th we entered Sesheke. The old town, now in ruins, stands
+on the left bank of the river. The people have built another on the
+same side, a quarter of a mile higher up, since their headman
+Moriantsiane was put to death for bewitching the chief with leprosy.
+Sekeletu was on the right bank, near a number of temporary huts. A
+man hailed us from the chiefs quarters, and requested us to rest
+under the old Kotla, or public meeting-place tree. A young Makololo,
+with the large thighs which Zulus and most of this tribe have,
+crossed over to receive orders from the chief, who had not shown
+himself to the people since he was affected with leprosy. On
+returning he ran for Mokele, the headman of the new town, who, after
+going over to Sekeletu, came back and conducted us to a small but
+good hut, and afterwards brought us a fine fat ox, as a present from
+the chief. "This is a time of hunger," he said, "and we have no
+meat, but we expect some soon from the Barotse Valley." We were
+entirely out of food when we reached Sesheke. Never was better meat
+than that of the ox Sekeletu sent, and infinitely above the flesh of
+all kinds of game is beef!
+
+A constant stream of visitors rolled in on us the day after our
+arrival. Several of them, who had suffered affliction during the
+Doctor's absence, seemed to be much affected on seeing him again.
+All were in low spirits. A severe drought had cut off the crops, and
+destroyed the pasture of Linyanti, and the people were scattered over
+the country in search of wild fruits, and the hospitality of those
+whose ground-nuts (Arachis hypogoea) had not failed. Sekeletu's
+leprosy brought troops of evils in its train. Believing himself
+bewitched, he had suspected a number of his chief men, and had put
+some, with their families, to death; others had fled to distant
+tribes, and were living in exile. The chief had shut himself up, and
+allowed no one to come into his presence but his uncle Mamire.
+Ponwane, who had been as "head and eyes" to him, had just died;
+evidence, he thought, of the potent spells of those who hated all who
+loved the chief. The country was suffering grievously, and
+Sebituane's grand empire was crumbling to pieces. A large body of
+young Barotse had revolted and fled to the north; killing a man by
+the way, in order to put a blood-feud between Masiko, the chief to
+whom they were going, and Sekeletu. The Batoka under Sinamane, and
+Muemba, were independent, and Mashotlane at the Falls was setting
+Sekeletu's authority virtually at defiance. Sebituane's wise policy
+in treating the conquered tribes on equal terms with his own
+Makololo, as all children of the chief, and equally eligible to the
+highest honours, had been abandoned by his son, who married none but
+Makololo women, and appointed to office none but Makololo men. He
+had become unpopular among the black tribes, conquered by the spear
+but more effectually won by the subsequent wise and just government
+of his father.
+
+Strange rumours were afloat respecting the unseen Sekeletu; his
+fingers were said to have grown like eagle's claws, and his face so
+frightfully distorted that no one could recognize him. Some had
+begun to hint that he might not really be the son of the great
+Sebituane, the founder of the nation, strong in battle, and wise in
+the affairs of state. "In the days of the Great Lion" (Sebituane),
+said his only sister, Moriantsiane's widow, whose husband Sekeletu
+had killed, "we had chiefs and little chiefs and elders to carry on
+the government, and the great chief, Sebituane, knew them all, and
+everything they did, and the whole country was wisely ruled; but now
+Sekeletu knows nothing of what his underlings do, and they care not
+for him, and the Makololo power is fast passing away." {3}
+
+The native doctors had given the case of Sekeletu up. They could not
+cure him, and pronounced the disease incurable. An old doctress from
+the Manyeti tribe had come to see what she could do for him, and on
+her skill he now hung his last hopes. She allowed no one to see him,
+except his mother and uncle, making entire seclusion from society an
+essential condition of the much longed-for cure. He sent,
+notwithstanding, for the Doctor; and on the following day we all
+three were permitted to see him. He was sitting in a covered wagon,
+which was enclosed by a high wall of close-set reeds; his face was
+only slightly disfigured by the thickening of the skin in parts,
+where the leprosy had passed over it; and the only peculiarity about
+his hands was the extreme length of his finger-nails, which, however,
+was nothing very much out of the way, as all the Makololo gentlemen
+wear them uncommonly long. He has the quiet, unassuming manners of
+his father, Sebituane, speaks distinctly, in a low pleasant voice,
+and appears to be a sensible man, except perhaps on the subject of
+his having been bewitched; and in this, when alluded to, he exhibits
+as firm a belief as if it were his monomania. "Moriantsiane, my
+aunt's husband, tried the bewitching medicine first on his wife, and
+she is leprous, and so is her head-servant; then, seeing that it
+succeeded, he gave me a stronger dose in the cooked flesh of a goat,
+and I have had the disease ever since. They have lately killed
+Ponwane, and, as you see, are now killing me." Ponwane had died of
+fever a short time previously. Sekeletu asked us for medicine and
+medical attendance, but we did not like to take the case out of the
+hands of the female physician already employed, it being bad policy
+to appear to undervalue any of the profession; and she, being anxious
+to go on with her remedies, said "she had not given him up yet, but
+would try for another month; if he was not cured by that time, then
+she would hand him over to the white doctors." But we intended to
+leave the country before a month was up; so Mamire, with others,
+induced the old lady to suspend her treatment for a little. She
+remained, as the doctors stipulated, in the chief's establishment,
+and on full pay.
+
+Sekeletu was told plainly that the disease was unknown in our
+country, and was thought exceedingly obstinate of cure; that we did
+not believe in his being bewitched, and we were willing to do all we
+could to help him. This was a case for disinterested benevolence; no
+pay was expected, but considerable risk incurred; yet we could not
+decline it, as we had the trading in horses. Having, however, none
+of the medicines usually employed in skin diseases with us, we tried
+the local application of lunar caustic, and hydriodate of potash
+internally; and with such gratifying results, that Mamire wished the
+patient to be smeared all over with a solution of lunar caustic,
+which he believed to be of the same nature as the blistering fluid
+formerly applied to his own knee by Mr. Oswell. ITS power he
+considered irresistible, and he would fain have had anything like it
+tried on Sekeletu.
+
+It was a time of great scarcity and hunger, but Sekeletu treated us
+hospitably, preparing tea for us at every visit we paid him. With
+the tea we had excellent American biscuit and preserved fruits, which
+had been brought to him all the way from Benguela. The fruits he
+most relished were those preserved in their own juices; plums,
+apples, pears, strawberries, and peaches, which we have seen only
+among Portuguese and Spaniards. It made us anxious to plant the
+fruit-tree seeds we had brought, and all were pleased with the idea
+of having these same fruits in their own country.
+
+Mokele, the headman of Sesheke, and Sebituane's sister, Manchunyane,
+were ordered to provide us with food, as Sekeletu's wives, to whom
+this duty properly belonged, were at Linyanti. We found a black
+trader from the West Coast, and some Griqua traders from the South,
+both in search of ivory. Ivory is dear at Sesheke; but cheaper in
+the Batoka country, from Sinamane's to the Kafue, than anywhere else.
+The trader from Benguela took orders for goods for his next year's
+trip, and offered to bring tea, coffee, and sugar at cent. per cent.
+prices. As, in consequence of a hint formerly given, the Makololo
+had secured all the ivory in the Batoga country to the east, by
+purchasing it with hoes, the Benguela traders found it unprofitable
+to go thither for slaves. They assured us that without ivory the
+trade in slaves did not pay. In this way, and by the orders of
+Sekeletu, an extensive slave-mart was closed. These orders were
+never infringed except secretly. We discovered only two or three
+cases of their infraction.
+
+Sekeletu was well pleased with the various articles we brought for
+him, and inquired if a ship could not bring his sugar-mill and the
+other goods we had been obliged to leave behind at Tette. On hearing
+that there was a possibility of a powerful steamer ascending as far
+as Sinamane's, but never above the Grand Victoria Falls, he asked,
+with charming simplicity, if a cannon could not blow away the Falls,
+so as to allow the vessel to come up to Sesheke.
+
+To save the tribe from breaking up, by the continual loss of real
+Makololo, it ought at once to remove to the healthy Batoka highlands,
+near the Kafue. Fully aware of this, Sekeletu remarked that all his
+people, save two, were convinced that, if they remained in the
+lowlands, a few years would suffice to cut off all the real Makololo;
+they came originally from the healthy South, near the confluence of
+the Likwa and Namagari, where fever is almost unknown, and its
+ravages had been as frightful among them here, as amongst Europeans
+on the Coast. Sebituane's sister described its first appearance
+among the tribe, after their settling in the Barotse Valley on the
+Zambesi. Many of them were seized with a shivering sickness, as if
+from excessive cold; they had never seen the like before. They made
+great fires, and laid the shivering wretches down before them; but,
+pile on wood as they might, they could not raise heat enough to drive
+the cold out of the bodies of the sufferers, and they shivered on
+till they died. But, though all preferred the highlands, they were
+afraid to go there, lest the Matebele should come and rob them of
+their much-loved cattle. Sebituane, with all his veterans, could not
+withstand that enemy; and how could they be resisted, now that most
+of the brave warriors were dead? The young men would break, and run
+away the moment they saw the terrible Matebele, being as much afraid
+of them as the black conquered tribes are of the Makololo. "But if
+the Doctor and his wife," said the chiefs and counsellors, "would
+come and live with us, we would remove to the highlands at once, as
+Moselekatse would not attack a place where the daughter of his
+friend, Moffat, was living."
+
+The Makololo are by far the most intelligent and enterprising of the
+tribes we have met. None but brave and daring men remained long with
+Sebituane, his stern discipline soon eradicated cowardice from his
+army. Death was the inevitable doom of the coward. If the chief saw
+a man running away from the fight, he rushed after him with amazing
+speed, and cut him down; or waited till he returned to the town, and
+then summoned the deserter into his presence. "You did not wish to
+die on the field, you wished to die at home, did you? you shall have
+your wish!" and he was instantly led off and executed. The present
+race of young men are inferior in most respects to their fathers.
+The old Makololo had many manly virtues; they were truthful, and
+never stole, excepting in what they considered the honourable way of
+lifting cattle in fair fight. But this can hardly be said of their
+sons; who, having been brought up among the subjected tribes, have
+acquired some of the vices peculiar to a menial and degraded race. A
+few of the old Makololo cautioned us not to leave any of our property
+exposed, as the blacks were great thieves; and some of our own men
+advised us to be on our guard, as the Makololo also would steal. A
+very few trifling articles were stolen by a young Makololo; and he,
+on being spoken to on the subject, showed great ingenuity in excusing
+himself, by a plausible and untruthful story. The Makololo of old
+were hard workers, and did not consider labour as beneath them; but
+their sons never work, regarding it as fit only for the Mashona and
+Makalaka servants. Sebituane, seeing that the rival tribes had the
+advantage over his, in knowing how to manage canoes, had his warriors
+taught to navigate; and his own son, with his companions, paddled the
+chief's canoe. All the dishes, baskets, stools, and canoes are made
+by the black tribes called Manyeti and Matlotlora. The houses are
+built by the women and servants. The Makololo women are vastly
+superior to any we have yet seen. They are of a light warm brown
+complexion, have pleasant countenances, and are remarkably quick of
+apprehension. They dress neatly, wearing a kilt and mantle, and have
+many ornaments. Sebituane's sister, the head lady of Sesheke, wore
+eighteen solid brass rings, as thick as one's finger, on each leg,
+and three of copper under each knee; nineteen brass rings on her left
+arm, and eight of brass and copper on her right, also a large ivory
+ring above each elbow. She had a pretty bead necklace, and a bead
+sash encircled her waist. The weight of the bright brass rings round
+her legs impeded her walking, and chafed her ankles; but, as it was
+the fashion, she did not mind the inconvenience, and guarded against
+the pain by putting soft rag round the lower rings.
+
+Justice appears upon the whole to be pretty fairly administered among
+the Makololo. A headman took some beads and a blanket from one of
+his men who had been with us; the matter was brought before the
+chief, and he immediately ordered the goods to be restored, and
+decreed, moreover, that no headman should take the property of the
+men who had returned. In theory, all the goods brought back belonged
+to the chief; the men laid them at his feet, and made a formal offer
+of them all; he looked at the articles, and told the men to keep
+them. This is almost invariably the case. Tuba Mokoro, however,
+fearing lest Sekeletu might take a fancy to some of his best goods,
+exhibited only a few of his old and least valuable acquisitions.
+Masakasa had little to show; he had committed some breach of native
+law in one of the villages on the way, and paid a heavy fine rather
+than have the matter brought to the Doctor's ears. Each carrier is
+entitled to a portion of the goods in his bundle, though purchased by
+the chief's ivory, and they never hesitate to claim their rights; but
+no wages can be demanded from the chief, if he fails to respond to
+the first application.
+
+Our men, accustomed to our ways, thought that the English system of
+paying a man for his labour was the only correct one, and some even
+said it would be better to live under a government where life and
+labour were more secure and valuable than here. While with us, they
+always conducted themselves with propriety during Divine service, and
+not only maintained decorum themselves, but insisted on other natives
+who might be present doing the same. When Moshobotwane, the Batoka
+chief, came on one occasion with a number of his men, they listened
+in silence to the reading of the Bible in the Makololo tongue; but,
+as soon as we all knelt down to pray, they commenced a vigorous
+clapping of hands, their mode of asking a favour. Our indignant
+Makololo soon silenced their noisy accompaniment, and looked with
+great contempt on this display of ignorance. Nearly all our men had
+learned to repeat the Lord's Prayer and the Apostles' Creed in their
+own language, and felt rather proud of being able to do so; and when
+they reached home, they liked to recite them to groups of admiring
+friends. Their ideas of right and wrong differ in no respect from
+our own, except in their professed inability to see how it can be
+improper for a man to have more than one wife. A year or two ago
+several of the wives of those who had been absent with us petitioned
+the chief for leave to marry again. They thought that it was of no
+use waiting any longer, their husbands must be dead; but Sekeletu
+refused permission; he himself had bet a number of oxen that the
+Doctor would return with their husbands, and he had promised the
+absent men that their wives should be kept for them. The impatient
+spouses had therefore to wait a little longer. Some of them,
+however, eloped with other men; the wife of Mantlanyane, for
+instance, ran off and left his little boy among strangers.
+Mantlanyane was very angry when he heard of it, not that he cared
+much about her deserting him, for he had two other wives at Tette,
+but he was indignant at her abandoning his boy.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII.
+
+
+
+Life amongst the Makololo--Return journey--Native hospitality--A
+canoe voyage on the Zambesi.
+
+While we were at Sesheke, an ox was killed by a crocodile; a man
+found the carcass floating in the river, and appropriated the meat.
+When the owner heard of this, he requested him to come before the
+chief, as he meant to complain of him; rather than go, the delinquent
+settled the matter by giving one of his own oxen in lieu of the lost
+one. A headman from near Linyanti came with a complaint that all his
+people had run off, owing to the "hunger." Sekeletu said, "You must
+not be left to grow lean alone, some of them must come back to you."
+He had thus an order to compel their return, if he chose to put it in
+force. Families frequently leave their own headman and flee to
+another village, and sometimes a whole village decamps by night,
+leaving the headman by himself. Sekeletu rarely interfered with the
+liberty of the subject to choose his own headman, and, as it is often
+the fault of the latter which causes the people to depart, it is
+punishment enough for him to be left alone. Flagrant disobedience to
+the chief's orders is punished with death. A Moshubia man was
+ordered to cut some reeds for Sekeletu: he went off, and hid himself
+for two days instead. For this he was doomed to die, and was carried
+in a canoe to the middle of the river, choked, and tossed into the
+stream. The spectators hooted the executioners, calling out to them
+that they too would soon be carried out and strangled. Occasionally
+when a man is sent to beat an offender, he tells him his object,
+returns, and assures the chief he has nearly killed him. The
+transgressor then keeps for a while out of sight, and the matter is
+forgotten. The river here teems with monstrous crocodiles, and women
+are frequently, while drawing water, carried off by these reptiles.
+
+We met a venerable warrior, sole survivor, probably, of the Mantatee
+host which threatened to invade the colony in 1824. He retained a
+vivid recollection of their encounter with the Griquas: "As we
+looked at the men and horses, puffs of smoke arose, and some of us
+dropped down dead!" "Never saw anything like it in my life, a man's
+brains lying in one place and his body in another!" They could not
+understand what was killing them; a ball struck a man's shield at an
+angle; knocked his arm out of joint at the shoulder; and leaving a
+mark, or burn, as he said, on the shield, killed another man close
+by. We saw the man with his shoulder still dislocated. Sebetuane
+was present at the fight, and had an exalted opinion of the power of
+white people ever afterwards.
+
+The ancient costume of the Makololo consisted of the skin of a lamb,
+kid, jackal, ocelot, or other small animal, worn round and below the
+loins: and in cold weather a kaross, or skin mantle, was thrown over
+the shoulders. The kaross is now laid aside, and the young men of
+fashion wear a monkey-jacket and a skin round the hips; but no
+trousers, waistcoat, or shirt. The river and lake tribes are in
+general very cleanly, bathing several times a day. The Makololo
+women use water rather sparingly, rubbing themselves with melted
+butter instead: this keeps off parasites, but gives their clothes a
+rancid odour. One stage of civilization often leads of necessity to
+another--the possession of clothes creates a demand for soap; give a
+man a needle, and he is soon back to you for thread.
+
+This being a time of mourning, on account of the illness of the
+chief, the men were negligent of their persons, they did not cut
+their hair, or have merry dances, or carry spear and shield when they
+walked abroad. The wife of Pitsane was busy making a large hut,
+while we were in the town: she informed us that the men left house-
+building entirely to the women and servants. A round tower of stakes
+and reeds, nine or ten feet high, is raised and plastered; a floor is
+next made of soft tufa, or ant-hill material and cowdung. This
+plaster prevents the poisonous insects, called tumpans, whose bite
+causes fever in some, and painful sores in all, from harbouring in
+the cracks or soil. The roof, which is much larger in diameter than
+the tower, is made on the ground, and then, many persons assisting,
+lifted up and placed on the tower, and thatched. A plastered reed
+fence is next built up to meet the outer part of the roof, which
+still projects a little over this fence, and a space of three feet
+remains between it and the tower. We slept in this space, instead of
+in the tower, as the inner door of the hut we occupied was
+uncomfortably small, being only nineteen inches high, and twenty-two
+inches wide at the floor. A foot from the bottom it measured
+seventeen inches in breadth, and close to the top only twelve inches,
+so it was a difficult matter to get through it. The tower has no
+light or ventilation, except through this small door. The reason a
+lady assigned for having the doors so very small was to keep out the
+mice!
+
+The children have merry times, especially in the cool of the evening.
+One of their games consists of a little girl being carried on the
+shoulders of two others. She sits with outstretched arms, as they
+walk about with her, and all the rest clap their hands, and stopping
+before each hut sing pretty airs, some beating time on their little
+kilts of cowskin, others making a curious humming sound between the
+songs. Excepting this and the skipping-rope, the play of the girls
+consists in imitation of the serious work of their mothers, building
+little huts, making small pots, and cooking, pounding corn in
+miniature mortars, or hoeing tiny gardens. The boys play with spears
+of reeds pointed with wood, and small shields, or bows and arrows; or
+amuse themselves in making little cattle-pens, or in moulding cattle
+in clay; they show great ingenuity in the imitation of various-shaped
+horns. Some too are said to use slings, but as soon as they can
+watch the goats, or calves, they are sent to the field. We saw many
+boys riding on the calves they had in charge, but this is an
+innovation since the arrival of the English with their horses.
+Tselane, one of the ladies, on observing Dr. Livingstone noting
+observations on the wet and dry bulb thermometers, thought that he
+too was engaged in play; for on receiving no reply to her question,
+which was rather difficult to answer, as the native tongue has no
+scientific terms, she said with roguish glee, "Poor thing, playing
+like a little child!"
+
+Like other Africans, the Makololo have great faith in the power of
+medicine; they believe that there is an especial medicine for every
+ill that flesh is heir to. Mamire is anxious to have children; he
+has six wives, and only one boy, and he begs earnestly for "child
+medicine." The mother of Sekeletu came from the Barotse Valley to
+see her son. Thinks she has lost flesh since Dr. Livingstone was
+here before, and asks for "the medicine of fatness." The Makololo
+consider plumpness an essential part of beauty in women, but the
+extreme stoutness, mentioned by Captain Speke, in the north, would be
+considered hideous here, for the men have been overheard speaking of
+a lady whom we call "inclined to embonpoint," as "fat unto ugliness."
+
+Two packages from the Kuruman, containing letters and newspapers,
+reached Linyanti previous to our arrival, and Sekeletu, not knowing
+when we were coming, left them there; but now at once sent a
+messenger for them. This man returned on the seventh day, having
+travelled 240 geographical miles. One of the packages was too heavy
+for him, and he left it behind. As the Doctor wished to get some
+more medicine and papers out of the wagon left at Linyanti in 1853,
+he decided upon going thither himself. The chief gave him his own
+horse, now about twelve years old, and some men. He found everything
+in his wagon as safe as when he left it seven years before. The
+headmen, Mosale and Pekonyane, received him cordially, and lamented
+that they had so little to offer him. Oh! had he only arrived the
+year previous, when there was abundance of milk and corn and beer.
+
+Very early the next morning the old town-crier, Ma-Pulenyane, of his
+own accord made a public proclamation, which, in the perfect
+stillness of the town long before dawn, was striking: "I have
+dreamed! I have dreamed! I have dreamed! Thou Mosale and thou
+Pekonyane, my lords, be not faint-hearted, nor let your hearts be
+sore, but believe all the words of Monare (the Doctor) for his heart
+is white as milk towards the Makololo. I dreamed that he was coming,
+and that the tribe would live, if you prayed to God and give heed to
+the word of Monare." Ma-Pulenyane showed Dr. Livingstone the
+burying-place where poor Helmore and seven others were laid,
+distinguishing those whom he had put to rest, and those for whom
+Mafale had performed that last office. Nothing whatever marked the
+spot, and with the native idea of HIDING the dead, it was said, "it
+will soon be all overgrown with bushes, for no one will cultivate
+there." None but Ma-Pulenyane approached the place, the others stood
+at a respectful distance; they invariably avoid everything connected
+with the dead, and no such thing as taking portions of human bodies
+to make charms of, as is the custom further north, has ever been
+known among the Makololo.
+
+Sekeletu's health improved greatly during our visit, the melancholy
+foreboding left his spirits, and he became cheerful, but resolutely
+refused to leave his den, and appear in public till he was perfectly
+cured, and had regained what he considered his good looks. He also
+feared lest some of those who had bewitched him originally might
+still be among the people, and neutralize our remedies. {4}
+
+As we expected another steamer to be at Kongone in November, it was
+impossible for us to remain in Sesheke more than one month. Before
+our departure, the chief and his principal men expressed in a formal
+manner their great desire to have English people settled on the
+Batoka highlands. At one time he proposed to go as far as Phori, in
+order to select a place of residence; but as he afterwards saw
+reasons for remaining where he was, till his cure was completed, he
+gave orders to those sent with us, in the event of our getting, on
+our return, past the rapids near Tette, not to bring us to Sesheke,
+but to send forward a messenger, and he with the whole tribe would
+come to us. Dr. Kirk being of the same age, Sekeletu was
+particularly anxious that he should come and live with him. He said
+that he would cut off a section of the country for the special use of
+the English; and on being told that in all probability their
+descendants would cause disturbance in his country, he replied,
+"These would be only domestic feuds, and of no importance." The
+great extent of uncultivated land on the cool and now unpeopled
+highlands has but to be seen to convince the spectator how much room
+there is, and to spare, for a vastly greater population than ever, in
+our day, can be congregated there.
+
+On the last occasion of our holding Divine service at Sesheke, the
+men were invited to converse on the subject on which they had been
+addressed. So many of them had died since we were here before, that
+not much probability existed of our all meeting again, and this had
+naturally led to the subject of a future state. They replied that
+they did not wish to offend the speaker, but they could not believe
+that all the dead would rise again: "Can those who have been killed
+in the field and devoured by the vultures; or those who have been
+eaten by the hyenas or lions; or those who have been tossed into the
+river, and eaten by more than one crocodile,--can they all be raised
+again to life?" They were told that men could take a leaden bullet,
+change it into a salt (acetate of lead), which could be dissolved as
+completely in water as our bodies in the stomachs of animals, and
+then reconvert it into lead; or that the bullet could be transformed
+into the red and white paint of our wagons, and again be reconverted
+into the original lead; and that if men exactly like themselves could
+do so much, how much more could He do who has made the eye to see,
+and the ear to hear! We added, however, that we believed in a
+resurrection, not because we understood how it would be brought
+about, but because our Heavenly Father assured us of it in His Book.
+The reference to the truth of the Book and its Author seems always to
+have more influence on the native mind than the cleverness of the
+illustration. The knowledge of the people is scanty, but their
+reasoning is generally clear as far as their information goes.
+
+We left Sesheke on the 17th September, 1860, convoyed by Pitsane and
+Leshore with their men. Pitsane was ordered by Sekeletu to make a
+hedge round the garden at the Falls, to protect the seeds we had
+brought; and also to collect some of the tobacco tribute below the
+Falls. Leshore, besides acting as a sort of guard of honour to us,
+was sent on a diplomatic mission to Sinamane. No tribute was exacted
+by Sekeletu from Sinamane; but, as he had sent in his adhesion, he
+was expected to act as a guard in case of the Matebele wishing to
+cross and attack the Makololo. As we intended to purchase canoes of
+Sinamane in which to descend the river, Leshore was to commend us to
+whatever help this Batoka chief could render. It must be confessed
+that Leshore's men, who were all of the black subject tribes, really
+needed to be viewed by us in the most charitable light; for Leshore,
+on entering any village, called out to the inhabitants, "Look out for
+your property, and see that my thieves don't steal it."
+
+Two young Makololo with their Batoka servants accompanied us to see
+if Kebrabasa could be surmounted, and to bring a supply of medicine
+for Sekeletu's leprosy; and half a dozen able canoe-men, under
+Mobito, who had previously gone with Dr. Livingstone to Loanda, were
+sent to help us in our river navigation. Some men on foot drove six
+oxen which Sekeletu had given us as provisions for the journey. It
+was, as before remarked, a time of scarcity; and, considering the
+dearth of food, our treatment had been liberal.
+
+By day the canoe-men are accustomed to keep close under the river's
+bank from fear of the hippopotami; by night, however, they keep in
+the middle of the stream, as then those animals are usually close to
+the bank on their way to their grazing grounds. Our progress was
+considerably impeded by the high winds, which at this season of the
+year begin about eight in the morning, and blow strongly up the river
+all day. The canoes were poor leaky affairs, and so low in parts of
+the gunwale, that the paddlers were afraid to follow the channel when
+it crossed the river, lest the waves might swamp us. A rough sea is
+dreaded by all these inland canoe-men; but though timid, they are by
+no means unskilful at their work. The ocean rather astonished them
+afterwards; and also the admirable way that the Nyassa men managed
+their canoes on a rough lake, and even amongst the breakers, where no
+small boat could possibly live.
+
+On the night of the 17th we slept on the left bank of the Majeele,
+after having had all the men ferried across. An ox was slaughtered,
+and not an ounce of it was left next morning. Our two young Makololo
+companions, Maloka and Ramakukane, having never travelled before,
+naturally clung to some of the luxuries they had been accustomed to
+at home. When they lay down to sleep, their servants were called to
+spread their blankets over their august persons, not forgetting their
+feet. This seems to be the duty of the Makololo wife to her husband,
+and strangers sometimes receive the honour. One of our party, having
+wandered, slept at the village of Nambowe. When he laid down, to his
+surprise two of Nambowe's wives came at once, and carefully and
+kindly spread his kaross over him.
+
+A beautiful silvery fish with reddish fins, called Ngwesi, is very
+abundant in the river; large ones weigh fifteen or twenty pounds
+each. Its teeth are exposed, and so arranged that, when they meet,
+the edges cut a hook like nippers. The Ngwesi seems to be a very
+ravenous fish. It often gulps down the Konokono, a fish armed with
+serrated bones more than an inch in length in the pectoral and dorsal
+fins, which, fitting into a notch at the roots, can be put by the
+fish on full cock or straight out,--they cannot be folded down,
+without its will, and even break in resisting. The name "Konokono,"
+elbow-elbow, is given it from a resemblance its extended fins are
+supposed to bear to a man's elbows stuck out from his body. It often
+performs the little trick of cocking its fins in the stomach of the
+Ngwesi, and, the elbows piercing its enemy's sides, he is frequently
+found floating dead. The fin bones seem to have an acrid secretion
+on them, for the wound they make is excessively painful. The
+Konokono barks distinctly when landed with the hook. Our canoe-men
+invariably picked up every dead fish they saw on the surface of the
+water, however far gone. An unfragrant odour was no objection; the
+fish was boiled and eaten, and the water drunk as soup. It is a
+curious fact that many of the Africans keep fish as we do woodcocks,
+until they are extremely offensive, before they consider them fit to
+eat. Our paddlers informed us on our way down that iguanas lay their
+eggs in July and August, and crocodiles in September. The eggs
+remain a month or two under the sand where they are laid, and the
+young come out when the rains have fairly commenced. The canoe-men
+were quite positive that crocodiles frequently stun men by striking
+them with their tails, and then squat on them till they are drowned.
+We once caught a young crocodile, which certainly did use its tail to
+inflict sharp blows, and led us to conclude that the native opinion
+is correct. They believed also that, if a person shuts the beast's
+eyes, it lets go its hold. Crocodiles have been known to unite and
+kill a large one of their own species and eat it. Some fishermen
+throw the bones of the fish into the river but in most of the fishing
+villages there are heaps of them in various places. The villagers
+can walk over them without getting them into their feet; but the
+Makololo, from having softer soles, are unable to do so. The
+explanation offered was, that the fishermen have a medicine against
+fish-bones, but that they will not reveal it to the Makololo.
+
+We spent a night on Mparira island, which is four miles long and
+about one mile broad. Mokompa, the headman, was away hunting
+elephants. His wife sent for him on our arrival, and he returned
+next morning before we left. Taking advantage of the long-continued
+drought, he had set fire to the reeds between the Chobe and Zambesi,
+in such a manner as to drive the game out at one corner, where his
+men laid in wait with their spears. He had killed five elephants and
+three buffaloes, wounding several others which escaped.
+
+On our land party coming up, we were told that the oxen were bitten
+by the tsetse: they could see a great difference in their looks.
+One was already eaten, and they now wished to slaughter another. A
+third fell into a buffalo-pit next day, so our stock was soon
+reduced.
+
+The Batoka chief, Moshobotwane, again treated us with his usual
+hospitality, giving us an ox, some meal, and milk. We took another
+view of the grand Mosi-oa-tunya, and planted a quantity of seeds in
+the garden on the island; but, as no one will renew the hedge, the
+hippopotami will, doubtless, soon destroy what we planted.
+Mashotlane assisted us. So much power was allowed to this under-
+chief, that he appeared as if he had cast off the authority of
+Sekeletu altogether. He did not show much courtesy to his
+messengers; instead of giving them food, as is customary, he took the
+meat out of a pot in their presence, and handed it to his own
+followers. This may have been because Sekeletu's men bore an order
+to him to remove to Linyanti. He had not only insulted Baldwin, but
+had also driven away the Griqua traders; but this may all end in
+nothing. Some of the natives here, and at Sesheke, know a few of the
+low tricks of more civilized traders. A pot of milk was brought to
+us one evening, which was more indebted to the Zambesi than to any
+cow. Baskets of fine-looking white meal, elsewhere, had occasionally
+the lower half filled with bran. Eggs are always a perilous
+investment. The native idea of a good egg differs as widely from our
+own as is possible on such a trifling subject. An egg is eaten here
+with apparent relish, though an embryo chick be inside.
+
+We left Mosi-oa-tunya on the 27th, and slept close to the village of
+Bakwini. It is built on a ridge of loose red soil, which produces
+great crops of mapira and ground-nuts; many magnificent mosibe-trees
+stand near the village. Machimisi, the headman of the village,
+possesses a herd of cattle and a large heart; he kept us company for
+a couple of days to guide us on our way.
+
+We had heard a good deal of a stronghold some miles below the Falls,
+called Kalunda. Our return path was much nearer the Zambesi than
+that of our ascent,--in fact, as near as the rough country would
+allow,--but we left it twice before we reached Sinamane's, in order
+to see Kalunda and a Fall called Moomba, or Moamba. The Makololo had
+once dispossessed the Batoka of Kalunda, but we could not see the
+fissure, or whatever it is, that rendered it a place of security, as
+it was on the southern bank. The crack of the Great Falls was here
+continued: the rocks are the same as further up, but perhaps less
+weather-worn--and now partially stratified in great thick masses.
+The country through which we were travelling was covered with a
+cindery-looking volcanic tufa, and might be called "Katakaumena."
+
+The description we received of the Moamba Falls seemed to promise
+something grand. They were said to send up "smoke" in the wet
+season, like Mosi-oa-tunya; but when we looked down into the cleft,
+in which the dark-green narrow river still rolls, we saw, about 800
+or 1000 feet below us, what, after Mosi-oa-tunya, seemed two
+insignificant cataracts. It was evident that Pitsane, observing our
+delight at the Victoria Falls, wished to increase our pleasure by a
+second wonder. One Mosi-oa-tunya, however, is quite enough for a
+continent.
+
+We had now an opportunity of seeing more of the Batoka, than we had
+on the highland route to our north. They did not wait till the
+evening before offering food to the strangers. The aged wife of the
+headman of a hamlet, where we rested at midday, at once kindled a
+fire, and put on the cooking-pot to make porridge. Both men and
+women are to be distinguished by greater roundness of feature than
+the other natives, and the custom of knocking out the upper front
+teeth gives at once a distinctive character to the face. Their
+colour attests the greater altitude of the country in which many of
+them formerly lived. Some, however, are as dark as the Bashubia and
+Barotse of the great valley to their west, in which stands Sesheke,
+formerly the capital of the Balui, or Bashubia.
+
+The assertion may seem strange, yet it is none the less true, that in
+all the tribes we have visited we never saw a really black person.
+Different shades of brown prevail, and often with a bright bronze
+tint, which no painter, except Mr. Angus, seems able to catch. Those
+who inhabit elevated, dry situations, and who are not obliged to work
+much in the sun, are frequently of a light warm brown, "dark but
+comely." Darkness of colour is probably partly caused by the sun,
+and partly by something in the climate or soil which we do not yet
+know. We see something of the same sort in trout and other fish
+which take their colour from the ponds or streams in which they live.
+The members of our party were much less embrowned by free exposure to
+the sun for years than Dr. Livingstone and his family were by passing
+once from Kuruman to Cape Town, a journey which occupied only a
+couple of months.
+
+We encamped on the Kalomo, on the 1st of October, and found the
+weather very much warmer than when we crossed this stream in August.
+At 3 p.m. the thermometer, four feet from the ground, was 101 degrees
+in the shade; the wet bulb only 61 degrees: a difference of 40
+degrees. Yet, notwithstanding this extreme dryness of the
+atmosphere, without a drop of rain having fallen for months, and
+scarcely any dew, many of the shrubs and trees were putting forth
+fresh leaves of various hues, while others made a profuse display of
+lovely blossoms.
+
+Two old and very savage buffaloes were shot for our companions on the
+3rd October. Our Volunteers may feel an interest in knowing that
+balls sometimes have but little effect: one buffalo fell, on
+receiving a Jacob's shell; it was hit again twice, and lost a large
+amount of blood; and yet it sprang up, and charged a native, who, by
+great agility, had just time to climb a tree, before the maddened
+beast struck it, battering-ram fashion, hard enough almost to have
+split both head and tree. It paused a few seconds--drew back several
+paces--glared up at the man--and then dashed at the tree again and
+again, as if determined to shake him out of it. It took two more
+Jacob's shells, and five other large solid rifle-balls to finish the
+beast at last. These old surly buffaloes had been wandering about in
+a sort of miserable fellowship; their skins were diseased and scabby,
+as if leprous, and their horns atrophied or worn down to stumps--the
+first was killed outright, by one Jacob's shell, the second died
+hard. There is so much difference in the tenacity of life in wounded
+animals of the same species, that the inquiry is suggested where the
+seat of life can be?--We have seen a buffalo live long enough, after
+a large bullet had passed right through the heart, to allow firm
+adherent clots to be formed in the two holes.
+
+One day's journey above Sinamane's, a mass of mountain called
+Gorongue, or Golongwe, is said to cross the river, and the rent
+through which the river passes is, by native report, quite fearful to
+behold. The country round it is so rocky, that our companions
+dreaded the fatigue, and were not much to blame, if, as is probably
+the case, the way be worse than that over which we travelled. As we
+trudged along over the black slag-like rocks, the almost leafless
+trees affording no shade, the heat was quite as great as Europeans
+could bear. It was 102 degrees in the shade, and a thermometer
+placed under the tongue or armpit showed that our blood was 99.5
+degrees, or 1.5 degrees hotter than that of the natives, which stood
+at 98 degrees. Our shoes, however, enable us to pass over the hot
+burning soil better than they can. Many of those who wear sandals
+have corns on the sides of the feet, and on the heels, where the
+straps pass. We have seen instances, too, where neither sandals nor
+shoes were worn, of corns on the soles of the feet. It is, moreover,
+not at all uncommon to see toes cocked up, as if pressed out of their
+proper places; at home, we should have unhesitatingly ascribed this
+to the vicious fashions perversely followed by our shoemakers.
+
+On the 5th, after crossing some hills, we rested at the village of
+Simariango. The bellows of the blacksmith here were somewhat
+different from the common goatskin bags, and more like those seen in
+Madagascar. They consisted of two wooden vessels, like a lady's
+bandbox of small dimensions, the upper ends of which were covered
+with leather, and looked something like the heads of drums, except
+that the leather bagged in the centre. They were fitted with long
+nozzles, through which the air was driven by working the loose
+covering of the tops up and down by means of a small piece of wood
+attached to their centres. The blacksmith said that tin was obtained
+from a people in the north, called Marendi, and that he had made it
+into bracelets; we had never heard before of tin being found in the
+country.
+
+Our course then lay down the bed of a rivulet, called Mapatizia, in
+which there was much calc spar, with calcareous schist, and then the
+Tette grey sandstone, which usually overlies coal. On the 6th we
+arrived at the islet Chilombe, belonging to Sinamane, where the
+Zambesi runs broad and smooth again, and were well received by
+Sinamane himself. Never was Sunday more welcome to the weary than
+this, the last we were to spend with our convoy.
+
+We now saw many good-looking young men and women. The dresses of the
+ladies are identical with those of Nubian women in Upper Egypt. To a
+belt on the waist a great number of strings are attached to hang all
+round the person. These fringes are about six or eight inches long.
+The matrons wear in addition a skin cut like the tails of the coatee
+formerly worn by our dragoons. The younger girls wear the waist-belt
+exhibited in the woodcut, ornamented with shells, and have the
+fringes only in front. Marauding parties of Batoka, calling
+themselves Makololo, have for some time had a wholesome dread of
+Sinamane's "long spears." Before going to Tette our Batoka friend,
+Masakasa, was one of a party that came to steal some of the young
+women; but Sinamane, to their utter astonishment, attacked them so
+furiously that the survivors barely escaped with their lives.
+Masakasa had to flee so fast that he threw away his shield, his
+spear, and his clothes, and returned home a wiser and a sadder man.
+
+Sinamane's people cultivate large quantities of tobacco, which they
+manufacture into balls for the Makololo market. Twenty balls,
+weighing about three-quarters of a pound each, are sold for a hoe.
+The tobacco is planted on low moist spots on the banks of the
+Zambesi; and was in flower at the time we were there, in October.
+Sinamane's people appear to have abundance of food, and are all in
+good condition. He could sell us only two of his canoes; but lent us
+three more to carry us as far as Moemba's, where he thought others
+might be purchased. They were manned by his own canoe-men, who were
+to bring them back. The river is about 250 yards wide, and flows
+serenely between high banks towards the North-east. Below Sinamane's
+the banks are often worn down fifty feet, and composed of shingle and
+gravel of igneous rocks, sometimes set in a ferruginous matrix. The
+bottom is all gravel and shingle, how formed we cannot imagine,
+unless in pot-holes in the deep fissure above. The bottom above the
+Falls, save a few rocks close by them, is generally sandy or of soft
+tufa. Every damp spot is covered with maize, pumpkins, water-melons,
+tobacco, and hemp. There is a pretty numerous Batoka population on
+both sides of the river. As we sailed slowly down, the people
+saluted us from the banks, by clapping their hands. A headman even
+hailed us, and brought a generous present of corn and pumpkins.
+
+Moemba owns a rich island, called Mosanga, a mile in length, on which
+his village stands. He has the reputation of being a brave warrior,
+and is certainly a great talker; but he gave us strangers something
+better than a stream of words. We received a handsome present of
+corn, and the fattest goat we had ever seen; it resembled mutton.
+His people were as liberal as their chief. They brought two large
+baskets of corn, and a lot of tobacco, as a sort of general
+contribution to the travellers. One of Sinamane's canoe-men, after
+trying to get his pay, deserted here, and went back before the
+stipulated time, with the story, that the Englishman had stolen the
+canoes. Shortly after sunrise next morning, Sinamane came into the
+village with fifty of his "long spears," evidently determined to
+retake his property by force; he saw at a glance that his man had
+deceived him. Moemba rallied him for coming on a wildgoose chase.
+"Here are your canoes left with me, your men have all been paid, and
+the Englishmen are now asking me to sell my canoes." Sinamane said
+little to us; only observing that he had been deceived by his
+follower. A single remark of his chief's caused the foolish fellow
+to leave suddenly, evidently much frightened and crestfallen.
+Sinamane had been very kind to us, and, as he was looking on when we
+gave our present to Moemba, we made him also an additional offering
+of some beads, and parted good friends. Moemba, having heard that we
+had called the people of Sinamane together to tell them about our
+Saviour's mission to man, and to pray with them, associated the idea
+of Sunday with the meeting, and, before anything of the sort was
+proposed, came and asked that he and his people might be "sundayed"
+as well as his neighbours; and be given a little seed wheat, and
+fruit-tree seeds; with which request of course we very willingly
+complied. The idea of praying direct to the Supreme Being, though
+not quite new to all, seems to strike their minds so forcibly that it
+will not be forgotten. Sinamane said that he prayed to God, Morungo,
+and made drink-offerings to him. Though he had heard of us, he had
+never seen white men before.
+
+Beautiful crowned cranes, named from their note "ma-wang," were seen
+daily, and were beginning to pair. Large flocks of spur-winged
+geese, or machikwe, were common. This goose is said to lay her eggs
+in March. We saw also pairs of Egyptian geese, as well as a few of
+the knob-nosed, or, as they are called in India, combed geese. When
+the Egyptian geese, as at the present time, have young, the goslings
+keep so steadily in the wake of their mother, that they look as if
+they were a part of her tail; and both parents, when on land,
+simulate lameness quite as well as our plovers, to draw off pursuers.
+The ostrich also adopts the lapwing fashion, but no quadrupeds do:
+they show fight to defend their young instead. In some places the
+steep banks were dotted with the holes which lead into the nests of
+bee-eaters. These birds came out in hundreds as we passed. When the
+red-breasted species settle on the trees, they give them the
+appearance of being covered with red foliage.
+
+On the morning of the 12th October we passed through a wild, hilly
+country, with fine wooded scenery on both sides, but thinly
+inhabited. The largest trees were usually thorny acacias, of great
+size and beautiful forms. As we sailed by several villages without
+touching, the people became alarmed, and ran along the banks, spears
+in hand. We employed one to go forward and tell Mpande of our
+coming. This allayed their fears, and we went ashore, and took
+breakfast near the large island with two villages on it, opposite the
+mouth of the Zungwe, where we had left the Zambesi on our way up.
+Mpande was sorry that he had no canoes of his own to sell, but he
+would lend us two. He gave us cooked pumpkins and a water-melon.
+His servant had lateral curvature of the spine. We have often seen
+cases of humpback, but this was the only case of this kind of
+curvature we had met with. Mpande accompanied us himself in his own
+vessel, till we had an opportunity of purchasing a fine large canoe
+elsewhere. We paid what was considered a large price for it: twelve
+strings of blue cut glass neck beads, an equal number of large blue
+ones of the size of marbles, and two yards of grey calico. Had the
+beads been coarser, they would have been more valued, because such
+were in fashion. Before concluding the bargain the owner said "his
+bowels yearned for his canoe, and we must give a little more to stop
+their yearning." This was irresistible. The trading party of
+Sequasha, which we now met, had purchased ten large new canoes for
+six strings of cheap coarse white beads each, or their equivalent,
+four yards of calico, and had bought for the merest trifle ivory
+enough to load them all. They were driving a trade in slaves also,
+which was something new in this part of Africa, and likely soon to
+change the character of the inhabitants. These men had been living
+in clover, and were uncommonly fat and plump. When sent to trade,
+slaves wisely never stint themselves of beer or anything else, which
+their master's goods can buy.
+
+The temperature of the Zambesi had increased 10 degrees since August,
+being now 80 degrees. The air was as high as 96 degrees after
+sunset; and, the vicinity of the water being the coolest part, we
+usually made our beds close by the river's brink, though there in
+danger of crocodiles. Africa differs from India in the air always
+becoming cool and refreshing long before the sun returns, and there
+can be no doubt that we can in this country bear exposure to the sun,
+which would be fatal in India. It is probably owing to the greater
+dryness of the African atmosphere that sunstroke is so rarely met
+with. In twenty-two years Dr. Livingstone never met or heard of a
+single case, though the protective head-dresses of India are rarely
+seen.
+
+When the water is nearly at its lowest, we occasionally meet with
+small rapids which are probably not in existence during the rest of
+the year. Having slept opposite the rivulet Bume, which comes from
+the south, we passed the island of Nakansalo, and went down the
+rapids of the same name on the 17th, and came on the morning of the
+19th to the more serious ones of Nakabele, at the entrance to Kariba.
+The Makololo guided the canoes admirably through the opening in the
+dyke. When we entered the gorge we came on upwards of thirty
+hippopotami: a bank near the entrance stretches two-thirds across
+the narrowed river, and in the still place behind it they were
+swimming about. Several were in the channel, and our canoe-men were
+afraid to venture down among them, because, as they affirm, there is
+commonly an ill-natured one in a herd, which takes a malignant
+pleasure in upsetting canoes. Two or three boys on the rocks
+opposite amused themselves by throwing stones at the frightened
+animals, and hit several on the head. It would have been no
+difficult matter to have shot the whole herd. We fired a few shots
+to drive them off; the balls often glance off the skull, and no more
+harm is done than when a schoolboy gets a bloody nose; we killed one,
+which floated away down the rapid current, followed by a number of
+men on the bank. A native called to us from the left bank, and said
+that a man on his side knew how to pray to the Kariba gods, and
+advised us to hire him to pray for our safety, while we were going
+down the rapids, or we should certainly all be drowned. No one ever
+risked his life in Kariba without first paying the river-doctor, or
+priest, for his prayers. Our men asked if there was a cataract in
+front, but he declined giving any information; they were not on his
+side of the river; if they would come over, then he might be able to
+tell them. We crossed, but he went off to the village. We then
+landed and walked over the hills to have a look at Karaba before
+trusting our canoes in it. The current was strong, and there was
+broken water in some places, but the channel was nearly straight, and
+had no cataract, so we determined to risk it. Our men visited the
+village while we were gone, and were treated to beer and tobacco.
+The priest who knows how to pray to the god that rules the rapids
+followed us with several of his friends, and they were rather
+surprised to see us pass down in safety, without the aid of his
+intercession. The natives who followed the dead hippopotamus caught
+it a couple of miles below, and, having made it fast to a rock, were
+sitting waiting for us on the bank beside the dead animal. As there
+was a considerable current there, and the rocky banks were unfit for
+our beds, we took the hippopotamus in tow, telling the villagers to
+follow, and we would give them most of the meat. The crocodiles
+tugged so hard at the carcass, that we were soon obliged to cast it
+adrift, to float down in the current, to avoid upsetting the canoe.
+We had to go on so far before finding a suitable spot to spend the
+night in, that the natives concluded we did not intend to share the
+meat with them, and returned to the village. We slept two nights at
+the place where the hippopotamus was cut up. The crocodiles had a
+busy time of it in the dark, tearing away at what was left in the
+river, and thrashing the water furiously with their powerful tails.
+The hills on both sides of Kariba are much like those of Kebrabasa,
+the strata tilted and twisted in every direction, with no level
+ground.
+
+Although the hills confine the Zambesi within a narrow channel for a
+number of miles, there are no rapids beyond those near the entrance.
+The river is smooth and apparently very deep. Only one single human
+being was seen in the gorge, the country being too rough for culture.
+Some rocks in the water, near the outlet of Kariba, at a distance
+look like a fort; and such large masses dislocated, bent, and even
+twisted to a remarkable degree, at once attest some tremendous
+upheaving and convulsive action of nature, which probably caused
+Kebrabasa, Kariba, and the Victoria Falls to assume their present
+forms; it took place after the formation of the coal, that mineral
+having then been tilted up. We have probably nothing equal to it in
+the present quiet operations of nature.
+
+On emerging we pitched our camp by a small stream, the Pendele, a few
+miles below the gorge. The Palabi mountain stands on the western
+side of the lower end of the Kariba strait; the range to which it
+belongs crosses the river, and runs to the south-east. Chikumbula, a
+hospitable old headman, under Nchomokela, the paramount chief of a
+large district, whom we did not see, brought us next morning a great
+basket of meal, and four fowls, with some beer, and a cake of salt,
+"to make it taste good." Chikumbula said that the elephants plagued
+them, by eating up the cotton-plants; but his people seem to be well
+off.
+
+A few days before we came, they caught three buffaloes in pitfalls in
+one night, and, unable to eat them all, left one to rot. During the
+night the wind changed and blew from the dead buffalo to our
+sleeping-place; and a hungry lion, not at all dainty in his food,
+stirred up the putrid mass, and growled and gloated over his feast,
+to the disturbance of our slumbers. Game of all kinds is in most
+extraordinary abundance, especially from this point to below the
+Kafue, and so it is on Moselekatso's side, where there are no
+inhabitants. The drought drives all the game to the river to drink.
+An hour's walk on the right bank, morning or evening, reveals a
+country swarming with wild animals: vast herds of pallahs, many
+waterbucks, koodoos, buffaloes, wild pigs, elands, zebras, and
+monkeys appear; francolins, guinea-fowls, and myriads of turtledoves
+attract the eye in the covers, with the fresh spoor of elephants and
+rhinoceroses, which had been at the river during the night. Every
+few miles we came upon a school of hippopotami, asleep on some
+shallow sandbank; their bodies, nearly all out of the water, appeared
+like masses of black rock in the river. When these animals are
+hunted much, they become proportionably wary, but here no hunter ever
+troubles them, and they repose in security, always however taking the
+precaution of sleeping just above the deep channel, into which they
+can plunge when alarmed. When a shot is fired into a sleeping herd,
+all start up on their feet, and stare with peculiar stolid looks of
+hippopotamic surprise, and wait for another shot before dashing into
+deep water. A few miles below Chikumbula's we saw a white
+hippopotamus in a herd. Our men had never seen one like it before.
+It was of a pinkish white, exactly like the colour of the Albino. It
+seemed to be the father of a number of others, for there were many
+marked with large light patches. The so-called WHITE elephant is
+just such a pinkish Albino as this hippopotamus. A few miles above
+Kariba we observed that, in two small hamlets, many of the
+inhabitants had a similar affection of the skin. The same influence
+appeared to have affected man and beast. A dark coloured
+hippopotamus stood alone, as if expelled from the herd, and bit the
+water, shaking his head from side to side in a most frantic manner.
+When the female has twins, she is said to kill one of them.
+
+We touched at the beautiful tree-covered island of Kalabi, opposite
+where Tuba-mokoro lectured the lion in our way up. The ancestors of
+the people who now inhabit this island possessed cattle. The tsetse
+has taken possession of the country since "the beeves were lifted."
+No one knows where these insects breed; at a certain season all
+disappear, and as suddenly come back, no one knows whence. The
+natives are such close observers of nature, that their ignorance in
+this case surprised us. A solitary hippopotamus had selected the
+little bay in which we landed, and where the women drew water, for
+his dwelling-place. Pretty little lizards, with light blue and red
+tails, run among the rocks, catching flies and other insects. These
+harmless--though to new-comers repulsive--creatures sometimes perform
+good service to man, by eating great numbers of the destructive white
+ants.
+
+At noon on the 24th October, we found Sequasha in a village below the
+Kafue, with the main body of his people. He said that 210 elephants
+had been killed during his trip; many of his men being excellent
+hunters. The numbers of animals we saw renders this possible. He
+reported that, after reaching the Kafue, he went northwards into the
+country of the Zulus, whose ancestors formerly migrated from the
+south and set up a sort of Republican form of government. Sequasha
+is the greatest Portuguese traveller we ever became acquainted with,
+and he boasts that he is able to speak a dozen different dialects;
+yet, unfortunately, he can give but a very meagre account of the
+countries and people he has seen, and his statements are not very
+much to be relied on. But considering the influence among which he
+has been reared, and the want of the means of education at Tette, it
+is a wonder that he possesses the good traits that he sometimes
+exhibits. Among his wares were several cheap American clocks; a
+useless investment rather, for a part of Africa where no one cares
+for the artificial measurement of time. These clocks got him into
+trouble among the Banyai: he set them all agoing in the presence of
+a chief, who became frightened at the strange sounds they made, and
+looked upon them as so many witchcraft agencies at work to bring all
+manner of evils upon himself and his people. Sequasha, it was
+decided, had been guilty of a milando, or crime, and he had to pay a
+heavy fine of cloth and beads for his exhibition. He alluded to our
+having heard that he had killed Mpangwe, and he denied having
+actually done so; but in his absence his name had got mixed up in the
+affair, in consequence of his slaves, while drinking beer one night
+with Namakusuru, the man who succeeded Mpangwe, saying that they
+would kill the chief for him. His partner had not thought of this
+when we saw him on the way up, for he tried to excuse the murder, by
+saying that now they had put the right man into the chieftainship.
+
+After three hours' sail, on the morning of the 29th, the river was
+narrowed again by the mountains of Mburuma, called Karivua, into one
+channel, and another rapid dimly appeared. It was formed by two
+currents guided by rocks to the centre. In going down it, the men
+sent by Sekeletu behaved very nobly. The canoes entered without
+previous survey, and the huge jobbling waves of mid-current began at
+once to fill them. With great presence of mind, and without a
+moment's hesitation, two men lightened each by jumping overboard;
+they then ordered a Botoka man to do the same, as "the white men must
+be saved." "I cannot swim," said the Batoka. "Jump out, then, and
+hold on to the canoe;" which he instantly did. Swimming alongside,
+they guided the swamping canoes down the swift current to the foot of
+the rapid, and then ran them ashore to bale them out. A boat could
+have passed down safely, but our canoes were not a foot above the
+water at the gunwales.
+
+Thanks to the bravery of these poor fellows, nothing was lost,
+although everything was well soaked. This rapid is nearly opposite
+the west end of the Mburuma mountains or Karivua. Another soon
+begins below it. They are said to be all smoothed over when the
+river rises. The canoes had to be unloaded at this the worst rapid,
+and the goods carried about a hundred yards. By taking the time in
+which a piece of stick floated past 100 feet, we found the current to
+be running six knots, by far the greatest velocity noted in the
+river. As the men were bringing the last canoe down close to the
+shore, the stern swung round into the current, and all except one man
+let go, rather than be dragged off. He clung to the bow, and was
+swept out into the middle of the stream. Having held on when he
+ought to have let go, he next put his life in jeopardy by letting go
+when he ought to have held on; and was in a few seconds swallowed up
+by a fearful whirlpool. His comrades launched out a canoe below, and
+caught him as he rose the third time to the surface, and saved him,
+though much exhausted and very cold.
+
+The scenery of this pass reminded us of Kebrabasa, although it is
+much inferior. A band of the same black shining glaze runs along the
+rocks about two feet from the water's edge. There was not a blade of
+grass on some of the hills, it being the end of the usual dry season
+succeeding a previous severe drought; yet the hill-sides were dotted
+over with beautiful green trees. A few antelopes were seen on the
+rugged slopes, where some people too appeared lying down, taking a
+cup of beer. The Karivua narrows are about thirty miles in length.
+They end at the mountain Roganora. Two rocks, twelve or fifteen feet
+above the water at the time we were there, may in flood be covered
+and dangerous. Our chief danger was the wind, a very slight ripple
+being sufficient to swamp canoes.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX.
+
+
+
+The waterbuck--Disaster in Kebrabasa rapids--The "Ma Robert"
+founders--Arrival of the "Pioneer" and Bishop Mackenzie's party--
+Portuguese slave-trade--Interference and liberation.
+
+We arrived at Zumbo, at the mouth of the Loangwa, on the 1st of
+November. The water being scarcely up to the knee, our land party
+waded this river with ease. A buffalo was shot on an island opposite
+Pangola's, the ball lodging in the spleen. It was found to have been
+wounded in the same organ previously, for an iron bullet was imbedded
+in it, and the wound entirely healed. A great deal of the plant
+Pistia stratiotes was seen floating in the river. Many people
+inhabit the right bank about this part, yet the game is very
+abundant.
+
+As we were taking our breakfast on the morning of the 2nd, the Mambo
+Kazai, of whom we knew nothing, and his men came with their muskets
+and large powder-horns to levy a fine, and obtain payment for the
+wood we used in cooking. But on our replying to his demand that we
+were English, "Oh! are you?" he said; "I thought you were Bazungu
+(Portuguese). They are the people I take payments from:" and he
+apologized for his mistake. Bazungu, or Azungu, is a term applied to
+all foreigners of a light colour, and to Arabs; even to trading
+slaves if clothed; it probably means foreigners, or visitors,--from
+zunga, to visit or wander,--and the Portuguese were the only
+foreigners these men had ever seen. As we had no desire to pass for
+people of that nation--quite the contrary--we usually made a broad
+line of demarcation by saying that we were English, and the English
+neither bought, sold, nor held black people as slaves, but wished to
+put a stop to the slave-trade altogether.
+
+We called upon our friend, Mpende, in passing. He provided a hut for
+us, with new mats spread on the floor. Having told him that we were
+hurrying on because the rains were near, "Are they near?" eagerly
+inquired an old counsellor, "and are we to have plenty of rain this
+year?" We could only say that it was about the usual time for the
+rains to commence; and that there were the usual indications in great
+abundance of clouds floating westwards, but that we knew nothing more
+than they did themselves.
+
+The hippopotami are more wary here than higher up, as the natives
+hunt them with guns. Having shot one on a shallow sandbank, our men
+undertook to bring it over to the left bank, in order to cut it up
+with greater ease. It was a fine fat one, and all rejoiced in the
+hope of eating the fat for butter, with our hard dry cakes of native
+meal. Our cook was sent over to cut a choice piece for dinner, but
+returned with the astonishing intelligence that the carcass was gone.
+They had been hoodwinked, and were very much ashamed of themselves.
+A number of Banyai came to assist in rolling it ashore, and asserted
+that it was all shallow water. They rolled it over and over towards
+the land, and, finding the rope we had made fast to it, as they said,
+an encumbrance, it was unloosed. All were shouting and talking as
+loud as they could bawl, when suddenly our expected feast plumped
+into a deep hole, as the Banyai intended it should do. When sinking,
+all the Makololo jumped in after it. One caught frantically at the
+tail; another grasped a foot; a third seized the hip; "but, by
+Sebituane, it would go down in spite of all that we could do."
+Instead of a fat hippopotamus we had only a lean fowl for dinner, and
+were glad enough to get even that. The hippopotamus, however,
+floated during the night, and was found about a mile below. The
+Banyai then assembled on the bank, and disputed our right to the
+beast: "It might have been shot by somebody else." Our men took a
+little of it and then left it, rather than come into collision with
+them.
+
+A fine waterbuck was shot in the Kakolole narrows, at Mount
+Manyerere; it dropped beside the creek where it was feeding; an
+enormous crocodile, that had been watching it at the moment, seized
+and dragged it into the water, which was not very deep. The mortally
+wounded animal made a desperate plunge, and hauling the crocodile
+several yards tore itself out of the hideous jaws. To escape the
+hunter, the waterbuck jumped into the river, and was swimming across,
+when another crocodile gave chase, but a ball soon sent it to the
+bottom. The waterbuck swam a little longer, the fine head dropped,
+the body turned over, and one of the canoes dragged it ashore. Below
+Kakolole, and still at the base of Manyerere mountain, several coal-
+seams, not noticed on our ascent, were now seen to crop out on the
+right bank of the Zambesi.
+
+Chitora, of Chicova, treated us with his former hospitality. Our men
+were all much pleased with his kindness, and certainly did not look
+upon it as a proof of weakness. They meant to return his
+friendliness when they came this way on a marauding expedition to eat
+the sheep of the Banyai, for insulting them in the affair of the
+hippopotamus; they would then send word to Chitora not to run away,
+for they, being his friends, would do such a good-hearted man no
+harm.
+
+We entered Kebrabasa rapids, at the east end of Chicova, in the
+canoes, and went down a number of miles, until the river narrowed
+into a groove of fifty or sixty yards wide, of which we have already
+spoken in describing the flood-bed and channel of low water. The
+navigation then became difficult and dangerous. A fifteen feet fall
+of the water in our absence had developed many cataracts. Two of our
+canoes passed safely down a narrow channel, which, bifurcating, had
+an ugly whirlpool at the rocky partition between the two branches,
+the deep hole in the whirls at times opening and then shutting. The
+Doctor's canoe came next, and seemed to be drifting broadside into
+the open vortex, in spite of the utmost exertions of the paddlers.
+The rest were expecting to have to pull to the rescue; the men
+saying, "Look where these people are going!--look, look!"--when a
+loud crash burst on our ears. Dr. Kirk's canoe was dashed on a
+projection of the perpendicular rocks, by a sudden and mysterious
+boiling up of the river, which occurs at irregular intervals. Dr.
+Kirk was seen resisting the sucking-down action of the water, which
+must have been fifteen fathoms deep, and raising himself by his arms
+on to the ledge, while his steersman, holding on to the same rocks,
+saved the canoe; but nearly all its contents were swept away down the
+stream. Dr. Livingstone's canoe, meanwhile, which had distracted the
+men's attention, was saved by the cavity in the whirlpool filling up
+as the frightful eddy was reached. A few of the things in Dr. Kirk's
+canoe were left; but all that was valuable, including a chronometer,
+a barometer, and, to our great sorrow, his notes of the journey and
+botanical drawings of the fruit-trees of the interior, perished.
+
+We now left the river, and proceeded on foot, sorry that we had not
+done so the day before. The men were thoroughly frightened, they had
+never seen such perilous navigation. They would carry all the loads,
+rather than risk Kebrabasa any longer; but the fatigue of a day's
+march over the hot rocks and burning sand changed their tune before
+night; and then they regretted having left the canoes; they thought
+they should have dragged them past the dangerous places, and then
+launched them again. One of the two donkeys died from exhaustion
+near the Luia. Though the men eat zebras and quaggas, blood
+relations of the donkey, they were shocked at the idea of eating the
+ass; "it would be like eating man himself, because the donkey lives
+with man, and is his bosom companion." We met two large trading
+parties of Tette slaves on their way to Zumbo, leading, to be sold
+for ivory, a number of Manganja women, with ropes round their necks,
+and all made fast to one long rope.
+
+Panzo, the headman of the village east of Kebrabasa, received us with
+great kindness. After the usual salutation he went up the hill, and,
+in a loud voice, called across the valley to the women of several
+hamlets to cook supper for us. About eight in the evening he
+returned, followed by a procession of women, bringing the food.
+There were eight dishes of nsima, or porridge, six of different sorts
+of very good wild vegetables, with dishes of beans and fowls; all
+deliciously well cooked, and scrupulously clean. The wooden dishes
+were nearly as white as the meal itself: food also was brought for
+our men. Ripe mangoes, which usually indicate the vicinity of the
+Portuguese, were found on the 21st November; and we reached Tette
+early on the 23rd, having been absent a little over six months.
+
+The two English sailors, left in charge of the steamer, were well,
+had behaved well, and had enjoyed excellent health all the time we
+were away. Their farm had been a failure. We left a few sheep, to
+be slaughtered when they wished for fresh meat, and two dozen fowls.
+Purchasing more, they soon had double the number of the latter, and
+anticipated a good supply of eggs; but they also bought two monkeys,
+and THEY ate all the eggs. A hippopotamus came up one night, and
+laid waste their vegetable garden; the sheep broke into their cotton
+patch, when it was in flower, and ate it all, except the stems; then
+the crocodiles carried off the sheep, and the natives stole the
+fowls. Nor were they more successful as gun-smiths: a Portuguese
+trader, having an exalted opinion of the ingenuity of English
+sailors, showed them a double-barrelled rifle, and inquired if they
+could put on the BROWNING, which had rusted off. "I think I knows
+how," said one, whose father was a blacksmith, "it's very easy; you
+have only to put the barrels in the fire." A great fire of wood was
+made on shore, and the unlucky barrels put over it, to secure the
+handsome rifle colour. To Jack's utter amazement the barrels came
+asunder. To get out of the scrape, his companion and he stuck the
+pieces together with resin, and sent it to the owner, with the
+message, "It was all they could do for it, and they would not charge
+him anything for the job!" They had also invented an original mode
+of settling a bargain; having ascertained the market price of
+provisions, they paid that, but no more. If the traders refused to
+leave the ship till the price was increased, a chameleon, of which
+the natives have a mortal dread, was brought out of the cabin; and
+the moment the natives saw the creature, they at once sprang
+overboard. The chameleon settled every dispute in a twinkling.
+
+But besides their good-humoured intercourse, they showed humanity
+worthy of English sailors. A terrible scream roused them up one
+night, and they pushed off in a boat to the rescue. A crocodile had
+caught a woman, and was dragging her across a shallow sandbank. Just
+as they came up to her, she gave a fearful shriek: the horrid
+reptile had snapped off her leg at the knee. They took her on board,
+bandaged the limb as well as they could, and, not thinking of any
+better way of showing their sympathy, gave her a glass of rum, and
+carried her to a hut in the village. Next morning they found the
+bandages torn off, and the unfortunate creature left to die. "I
+believe," remarked Rowe, one of the sailors, "her master was angry
+with us for saving her life, seeing as how she had lost her leg."
+
+The Zambesi being unusually low, we remained at Tette till it rose a
+little, and then left on the 3rd of December for the Kongone. It was
+hard work to keep the vessel afloat; indeed, we never expected her to
+remain above water. New leaks broke out every day; the engine pump
+gave way; the bridge broke down; three compartments filled at night;
+except the cabin and front compartment all was flooded; and in a few
+days we were assured by Rowe that "she can't be worse than she is,
+sir." He and Hutchins had spent much of their time, while we were
+away, in patching her bottom, puddling it with clay, and shoring it,
+and it was chiefly to please them that we again attempted to make use
+of her. We had long been fully convinced that the steel plates were
+thoroughly unsuitable. On the morning of the 21st the uncomfortable
+"Asthmatic" grounded on a sandbank and filled. She could neither be
+emptied nor got off. The river rose during the night, and all that
+was visible of the worn-out craft next day was about six feet of her
+two masts. Most of the property we had on board was saved; and we
+spent the Christmas of 1860 encamped on the island of Chimba. Canoes
+were sent for from Senna; and we reached it on the 27th, to be again
+hospitably entertained by our friend, Senhor Ferrao.
+
+We reached the Kongone on the 4th of January, 1861. A flagstaff and
+a Custom-house had been erected during our absence; a hut, also, for
+a black lance-corporal and three privates. By the kind permission of
+the lance-corporal, who came to see us as soon as he had got into his
+trousers and shirt, we took up our quarters in the Custom-house,
+which, like the other buildings, is a small square floorless hut of
+mangrove stakes overlaid with reeds. The soldiers complained of
+hunger, they had nothing to eat but a little mapira, and were making
+palm wine to deaden their cravings. While waiting for a ship, we had
+leisure to read the newspapers and periodicals we found in the mail
+which was waiting our arrival at Tette. Several were a year and a
+half old.
+
+Our provisions began to run short; and towards the end of the month
+there was nothing left but a little bad biscuit and a few ounces of
+sugar. Coffee and tea were expended, but scarcely missed, as our
+sailors discovered a pretty good substitute in roasted mapira. Fresh
+meat was obtained in abundance from our antelope preserves on the
+large island made by a creek between the Kongone and East Luabo.
+
+In this focus of decaying vegetation, nothing is so much to be
+dreaded as inactivity. We had, therefore, to find what exercise and
+amusement we could, when hunting was not required, in peering about
+in the fetid swamps; to have gone mooning about, in listless
+idleness, would have ensured fever in its worst form, and probably
+with fatal results.
+
+A curious little blenny-fish swarms in the numerous creeks which
+intersect the mangrove topes. When alarmed, it hurries across the
+surface of the water in a series of leaps. It may be considered
+amphibious, as it lives as much out of the water as in it, and its
+most busy time is during low water. Then it appears on the sand or
+mud, near the little pools left by the retiring tide; it raises
+itself on its pectoral fins into something of a standing attitude,
+and with its large projecting eyes keeps a sharp look-out for the
+light-coloured fly, on which it feeds. Should the fly alight at too
+great a distance for even a second leap, the blenny moves slowly
+towards it like a cat to its prey, or like a jumping spider; and, as
+soon as it gets within two or three inches of the insect, by a sudden
+spring contrives to pop its underset mouth directly over the unlucky
+victim. He is, moreover, a pugnacious little fellow; and rather
+prolonged fights may be observed between him and his brethren. One,
+in fleeing from an apparent danger, jumped into a pool a foot square,
+which the other evidently regarded as his by right of prior
+discovery; in a twinkling the owner, with eyes flashing fury, and
+with dorsal fin bristling up in rage, dashed at the intruding foe.
+The fight waxed furious, no tempest in a teapot ever equalled the
+storm of that miniature sea. The warriors were now in the water, and
+anon out of it, for the battle raged on sea and shore. They struck
+hard, they bit each other; until, becoming exhausted, they seized
+each other by the jaws like two bull-dogs, then paused for breath,
+and at it again as fiercely as before, until the combat ended by the
+precipitate retreat of the invader.
+
+The muddy ground under the mangrove-trees is covered with soldier-
+crabs, which quickly slink into their holes on any symptom of danger.
+When the ebbing tide retires, myriads of minute crabs emerge from
+their underground quarters, and begin to work like so many busy bees.
+Soon many miles of the smooth sand become rough with the results of
+their labour. They are toiling for their daily bread: a round bit
+of moist sand appears at the little labourer's mouth, and is quickly
+brushed off by one of the claws; a second bit follows the first; and
+another, and still another come as fast as they can be laid aside.
+As these pellets accumulate, the crab moves sideways, and the work
+continues. The first impression one receives is, that the little
+creature has swallowed a great deal of sand, and is getting rid of it
+as speedily as possible: a habit he indulges in of darting into his
+hole at intervals, as if for fresh supplies, tends to strengthen this
+idea; but the size of the heaps formed in a few seconds shows that
+this cannot be the case, and leads to the impression that, although
+not readily seen, at the distance at which he chooses to keep the
+observer, yet that possibly he raises the sand to his mouth, where
+whatever animalcule it may contain is sifted out of it, and the
+remainder rejected in the manner described. At times the larger
+species of crabs perform a sort of concert; and from each
+subterranean abode strange sounds arise, as if, in imitation of the
+songsters of the groves, for very joy they sang!
+
+We found some natives pounding the woody stems of a poisonous
+climbing-plant (Dirca palustris) called Busungu, or poison, which
+grows abundantly in the swamps. When a good quantity was bruised, it
+was tied up in bundles. The stream above and below was obstructed
+with bushes, and with a sort of rinsing motion the poison was
+diffused through the water. Many fish were soon affected, swain in
+shore, and died, others were only stupefied. The plant has pink,
+pea-shaped blossoms, and smooth, pointed, glossy leaves, and the
+brown bark is covered with minute white points. The knowledge of it
+might prove of use to a shipwrecked party by enabling them to catch
+the fish.
+
+The poison is said to be deleterious to man if the water is drunk;
+but not when the fish is cooked. The Busungu is repulsive to some
+insects, and is smeared round the shoots of the palm-trees to prevent
+the ants from getting into the palm wine while it is dropping from
+the tops of the palm-trees into the little pots suspended to collect
+it.
+
+We were in the habit of walking from our beds into the salt water at
+sunrise, for a bath, till a large crocodile appeared at the bathing-
+place, and from that time forth we took our dip in the sea, away from
+the harbour, about midday. This is said to be unwholesome, but we
+did not find it so. It is certainly better not to bathe in the
+mornings, when the air is colder than the water--for then, on
+returning to the cooler air, one is apt to get a chill and fever. In
+the mouth of the river, many saw-fish are found. Rowe saw one while
+bathing--caught it by the tail, and shoved it, "snout on," ashore.
+The saw is from a foot to eighteen inches long. We never heard of
+any one being wounded by this fish; nor, though it goes hundreds of
+miles up the river in fresh water, could we learn that it was eaten
+by the people. The hippopotami delighted to spend the day among the
+breakers, and seemed to enjoy the fun as much as we did.
+
+Severe gales occurred during our stay on the Coast, and many small
+sea-birds (Prion Banksii, Smith) perished: the beach was strewn with
+their dead bodies, and some were found hundreds of yards inland; many
+were so emaciated as to dry up without putrefying. We were plagued
+with myriads of mosquitoes, and had some touches of fever; the men we
+brought from malarious regions of the interior suffered almost as
+much from it here as we did ourselves. This gives strength to the
+idea that the civilized withstand the evil influences of strange
+climates better than the uncivilized. When negroes return to their
+own country from healthy lands, they suffer as severely as foreigners
+ever do.
+
+On the 31st of January, 1861, our new ship, the "Pioneer," arrived
+from England, and anchored outside the bar; but the weather was
+stormy, and she did not venture in till the 4th of February.
+
+Two of H.M. cruisers came at the same time, bringing Bishop
+Mackenzie, and the Oxford and Cambridge Mission to the tribes of the
+Shire and Lake Nyassa. The Mission consisted of six Englishmen, and
+five coloured men from the Cape. It was a puzzle to know what to do
+with so many men. The estimable Bishop, anxious to commence his work
+without delay, wished the "Pioneer" to carry the Mission up the
+Shire, as far as Chibisa's, and there leave them. But there were
+grave objections to this. The "Pioneer" was under orders to explore
+the Rovuma, as the Portuguese Government had refused to open the
+Zambesi to the ships of other nations, and their officials were very
+effectually pursuing a system, which, by abstracting the labour, was
+rendering the country of no value either to foreigners or to
+themselves. She was already two months behind her time, and the
+rainy season was half over. Then, if the party were taken to
+Chibisa's, the Mission would he left without a medical attendant, in
+an unhealthy region, at the beginning of the most sickly season of
+the year, and without means of reaching the healthy highlands, or of
+returning to the sea. We dreaded that, in the absence of medical aid
+and all knowledge of the treatment of fever, there might be a
+repetition of the sorrowful fate which befell the similar non-medical
+Mission at Linyanti.
+
+On the 25th of February the "Pioneer" anchored in the mouth of the
+Rovuma, which, unlike most African rivers, has a magnificent bay and
+no bar. We wooded, and then waited for the Bishop till the 9th of
+March, when he came in the "Lyra." On the 11th we proceeded up the
+river, and saw that it had fallen four or five feet during our
+detention. The scenery on the lower part of the Rovuma is superior
+to that on the Zambesi, for we can see the highlands from the sea.
+Eight miles from the mouth the mangroves are left behind, and a
+beautiful range of well-wooded hills on each bank begins. On these
+ridges the tree resembling African blackwood, of finer grain than
+ebony, grows abundantly, and attains a large size. Few people were
+seen, and those were of Arab breed, and did not appear to be very
+well off. The current of the Rovuma was now as strong as that of the
+Zambesi, but the volume of water is very much less. Several of the
+crossings had barely water enough for our ship, drawing five feet, to
+pass. When we were thirty miles up the river, the water fell
+suddenly seven inches in twenty-four hours. As the March flood is
+the last of the season, and it appeared to be expended, it was
+thought prudent to avoid the chance of a year's detention, by getting
+the ship back to the sea without delay. Had the Expedition been
+alone, we would have pushed up in boats, or afoot, and done what we
+could towards the exploration of the river and upper end of the lake;
+but, though the Mission was a private one, and entirely distinct from
+our own, a public one, the objects of both being similar, we felt
+anxious to aid our countrymen in their noble enterprise; and, rather
+than follow our own inclination, decided to return to the Shire, see
+the Mission party settled safely, and afterwards explore Lake Nyassa
+and the Rovuma, from the Lake downwards. Fever broke out on board
+the "Pioneer," at the mouth of the Rovuma, as we thought from our
+having anchored close to a creek coming out of the mangroves; and it
+remained in her until we completely isolated the engine-room from the
+rest of the ship. The coal-dust rotting sent out strong effluvia,
+and kept up the disease for more than a twelvemonth.
+
+Soon after we started the fever put the "Pioneer" almost entirely
+into the hands of the original Zambesi Expedition, and not long
+afterwards the leader had to navigate the ocean as well as the river.
+The habit of finding the geographical positions on land renders it an
+easy task to steer a steamer with only three or four sails at sea;
+where, if one does not run ashore, no one follows to find out an
+error, and where a current affords a ready excuse for every blunder.
+
+Touching at Mohilla, one of the Comoro Islands, on our return, we
+found a mixed race of Arabs, Africans, and their conquerors, the
+natives of Madagascar. Being Mahometans, they have mosques and
+schools, in which we were pleased to see girls as well as boys taught
+to read the Koran. The teacher said he was paid by the job, and
+received ten dollars for teaching each child to read. The clever
+ones learn in six months; but the dull ones take a couple of years.
+We next went over to Johanna for our friends; and, after a sojourn of
+a few days at the beautiful Comoro Islands, we sailed for the Kongone
+mouth of the Zambesi with Bishop Mackenzie and his party. We reached
+the coast in seven days, and passed up the Zambesi to the Shire.
+
+The "Pioneer," constructed under the skilful supervision of Admiral
+Sir Baldwin Walker and the late Admiral Washington, warm-hearted and
+highly esteemed friends of the Expedition, was a very superior
+vessel, and well suited for our work in every respect, except in her
+draught of water. Five feet were found to be too much for the
+navigation of the upper part of the Shire. Designed to draw three
+feet only, the weight necessary to impart extra strength, and fit her
+for the ocean, brought her down two feet more, and caused us a great
+deal of hard and vexatious work, in laying out anchors, and toiling
+at the capstan to get her off sandbanks. We should not have minded
+this much, but for the heavy loss of time which might have been more
+profitably, and infinitely more pleasantly, spent in intercourse with
+the people, exploring new regions, and otherwise carrying out the
+objects of the Expedition. Once we were a fortnight on a bank of
+soft yielding sand, having only two or three inches less water than
+the ship drew; this delay was occasioned by the anchors coming home,
+and the current swinging the ship broadside on the bank, which,
+immediately on our touching, always formed behind us. We did not
+like to leave the ship short of Chibisa's, lest the crew should
+suffer from the malaria of the lowland around; and it would have been
+difficult to have got the Mission goods carried up. We were daily
+visited by crowds of natives, who brought us abundance of provisions
+far beyond our ability to consume. In hauling the "Pioneer" over the
+shallow places, the Bishop, with Horace Waller and Mr. Scudamore,
+were ever ready and anxious to lend a hand, and worked as hard as any
+on board. Had our fine little ship drawn but three feet, she could
+have run up and down the river at any time of the year with the
+greatest ease, but as it was, having once passed up over a few
+shallow banks, it was impossible to take her down again until the
+river rose in December. She could go up over a bank, but not come
+down over it, as a heap of sand always formed instantly astern, while
+the current washed it away from under her bows.
+
+On at last reaching Chibisa's, we heard that there was war in the
+Manganja country, and the slave-trade was going on briskly. A
+deputation from a chief near Mount Zomba had just passed on its way
+to Chibisa, who was in a distant village, to implore him to come
+himself, or send medicine, to drive off the Waiao, Waiau, or Ajawa,
+whose marauding parties were desolating the land. A large gang of
+recently enslaved Manganja crossed the river, on their way to Tette,
+a few days before we got the ship up. Chibisa's deputy was civil,
+and readily gave us permission to hire as many men to carry the
+Bishop's goods up to the hills as were willing to go. With a
+sufficient number, therefore, we started for the highlands on the
+15th of July, to show the Bishop the country, which, from its
+altitude and coolness, was most suitable for a station. Our first
+day's march was a long and fatiguing one. The few hamlets we passed
+were poor, and had no food for our men, and we were obliged to go on
+till 4 p.m., when we entered the small village of Chipindu. The
+inhabitants complained of hunger, and said they had no food to sell,
+and no hut for us to sleep in; but, if we would only go on a little
+further, we should come to a village where they had plenty to eat;
+but we had travelled far enough, and determined to remain where we
+were. Before sunset as much food was brought as we cared to
+purchase, and, as it threatened to rain, huts were provided for the
+whole party.
+
+Next forenoon we halted at the village of our old friend Mbame, to
+obtain new carriers, because Chibisa's men, never before having been
+hired, and not having yet learned to trust us, did not choose to go
+further. After resting a little, Mbame told us that a slave party on
+its way to Tette would presently pass through his village. "Shall we
+interfere?" we inquired of each other. We remembered that all our
+valuable private baggage was in Tette, which, if we freed the slaves,
+might, together with some Government property, be destroyed in
+retaliation; but this system of slave-hunters dogging us where
+previously they durst not venture, and, on pretence of being "our
+children," setting one tribe against another, to furnish themselves
+with slaves, would so inevitably thwart all the efforts, for which we
+had the sanction of the Portuguese Government, that we resolved to
+run all risks, and put a stop, if possible, to the slave-trade, which
+had now followed on the footsteps of our discoveries. A few minutes
+after Mbame had spoken to us, the slave party, a long line of
+manacled men, women, and children, came wending their way round the
+hill and into the valley, on the side of which the village stood.
+The black drivers, armed with muskets, and bedecked with various
+articles of finery, marched jauntily in the front, middle, and rear
+of the line; some of them blowing exultant notes out of long tin
+horns. They seemed to feel that they were doing a very noble thing,
+and might proudly march with an air of triumph. But the instant the
+fellows caught a glimpse of the English, they darted off like mad
+into the forest; so fast, indeed, that we caught but a glimpse of
+their red caps and the soles of their feet. The chief of the party
+alone remained; and he, from being in front, had his hand tightly
+grasped by a Makololo! He proved to be a well-known slave of the
+late Commandant at Tette, and for some time our own attendant while
+there. On asking him how he obtained these captives, he replied he
+had bought them; but on our inquiring of the people themselves, all,
+save four, said they had been captured in war. While this inquiry
+was going on, he bolted too. The captives knelt down, and, in their
+way of expressing thanks, clapped their hands with great energy.
+They were thus left entirely on our hands, and knives were soon busy
+at work cutting the women and children loose. It was more difficult
+to cut the men adrift, as each had his neck in the fork of a stout
+stick, six or seven feet long, and was kept in by an iron rod which
+was riveted at both ends across the throat. With a saw, luckily in
+the Bishop's baggage, one by one the men were sawn out into freedom.
+The women, on being told to take the meal they were carrying and cook
+breakfast for themselves and the children, seemed to consider the
+news too good to be true; but after a little coaxing went at it with
+alacrity, and made a capital fire by which to boil their pots with
+the slave sticks and bonds, their old acquaintances through many a
+sad night and weary day. Many were mere children about five years of
+age and under. One little boy, with the simplicity of childhood,
+said to our men, "The others tied and starved us, you cut the ropes
+and tell us to eat; what sort of people are you?--Where did you come
+from?" Two of the women had been shot the day before for attempting
+to untie the thongs. This, the rest were told, was to prevent them
+from attempting to escape. One woman had her infant's brains knocked
+out, because she could not carry her load and it. And a man was
+dispatched with an axe, because he had broken down with fatigue.
+Self-interest would have set a watch over the whole rather than
+commit murder; but in this traffic we invariably find self-interest
+overcome by contempt of human life and by bloodthirstiness.
+
+The Bishop was not present at this scene, having gone to bathe in a
+little stream below the village; but on his return he warmly approved
+of what had been done; he at first had doubts, but now felt that, had
+he been present, he would have joined us in the good work. Logic is
+out of place when the question with a true-hearted man is, whether
+his brother man is to be saved or not. Eighty-four, chiefly women
+and children, were liberated; and on being told that they were now
+free, and might go where they pleased, or remain with us, they all
+chose to stay; and the Bishop wisely attached them to his Mission, to
+be educated as members of a Christian family. In this way a great
+difficulty in the commencement of a Mission was overcome. Years are
+usually required before confidence is so far instilled into the
+natives' mind as to induce them, young or old, to submit to the
+guidance of strangers professing to be actuated by motives the
+reverse of worldly wisdom, and inculcating customs strange and
+unknown to them and their fathers.
+
+We proceeded next morning to Soche's with our liberated party, the
+men cheerfully carrying the Bishop's goods. As we had begun, it was
+of no use to do things by halves, so eight others were freed in a
+hamlet on our path; but a party of traders, with nearly a hundred
+slaves, fled from Soche's on hearing of our proceedings. Dr. Kirk
+and four Makololo followed them with great energy, but they made
+clear off to Tette. Six more captives were liberated at Mongazi's,
+and two slave-traders detained for the night, to prevent them from
+carrying information to a large party still in front. Of their own
+accord they volunteered the information that the Governor's servants
+had charge of the next party; but we did not choose to be led by
+them, though they offered to guide us to his Excellency's own agents.
+Two of the Bishop's black men from the Cape, having once been slaves,
+were now zealous emancipators, and volunteered to guard the prisoners
+during the night. So anxious were our heroes to keep them safe, that
+instead of relieving each other, by keeping watch and watch, both
+kept watch together, till towards four o'clock in the morning, when
+sleep stole gently over them both; and the wakeful prisoners, seizing
+the opportunity, escaped: one of the guards, perceiving the loss,
+rushed out of the hut, shouting, "They are gone, the prisoners are
+off, and they have taken my rifle with them, and the women too!
+Fire! everybody fire!" The rifle and the women, however, were all
+safe enough, the slave-traders being only too glad to escape alone.
+Fifty more slaves were freed next day in another village; and, the
+whole party being stark-naked, cloth enough was left to clothe them,
+better probably than they had ever been clothed before. The head of
+this gang, whom we knew as the agent of one of the principal
+merchants of Tette, said that they had the license of the Governor
+for all they did. This we were fully aware of without his stating
+it. It is quite impossible for any enterprise to be undertaken there
+without the Governor's knowledge and connivance.
+
+The portion of the highlands which the Bishop wished to look at
+before deciding on a settlement belonged to Chiwawa, or Chibaba, the
+most manly and generous Manganja chief we had met with on our
+previous journey. On reaching Nsambo's, near Mount Chiradzuru, we
+heard that Chibaba was dead, and that Chigunda was chief instead.
+Chigunda, apparently of his own accord, though possibly he may have
+learnt that the Bishop intended to settle somewhere in the country,
+asked him to come and live with him at Magomero, adding that there
+was room enough for both. This hearty and spontaneous invitation had
+considerable influence on the Bishop's mind, and seemed to decide the
+question. A place nearer the Shire would have been chosen had he
+expected his supplies to come up that river; but the Portuguese,
+claiming the river Shire, though never occupying even its mouth, had
+closed it, as well as the Zambesi.
+
+Our hopes were turned to the Rovuma, as a free highway into Lake
+Nyassa and the vast interior. A steamer was already ordered for the
+Lake, and the Bishop, seeing the advantageous nature of the highlands
+which stretch an immense way to the north, was more anxious to be
+near the Lake and the Rovuma, than the Shire. When he decided to
+settle at Magomero, it was thought desirable, to prevent the country
+from being depopulated, to visit the Ajawa chief, and to try and
+persuade him to give up his slaving and kidnapping courses, and turn
+the energies of his people to peaceful pursuits.
+
+On the morning of the 22nd we were informed that the Ajawa were near,
+and were burning a village a few miles off. Leaving the rescued
+slaves, we moved off to seek an interview with these scourges of the
+country. On our way we met crowds of Manganja fleeing from the war
+in front. These poor fugitives from the slave hunt had, as usual, to
+leave all the food they possessed, except the little they could carry
+on their heads. We passed field after field of Indian corn or beans,
+standing ripe for harvesting, but the owners were away. The villages
+were all deserted: one where we breakfasted two years before, and
+saw a number of men peacefully weaving cloth, and, among ourselves,
+called it the "Paisley of the hills," was burnt; the stores of corn
+were poured out in cartloads, and scattered all over the plain, and
+all along the paths, neither conquerors nor conquered having been
+able to convey it away. About two o'clock we saw the smoke of
+burning villages, and heard triumphant shouts, mingled with the wail
+of the Manganja women, lamenting over their slain. The Bishop then
+engaged us in fervent prayer; and, on rising from our knees, we saw a
+long line of Ajawa warriors, with their captives, coming round the
+hill-side. The first of the returning conquerors were entering their
+own village below, and we heard women welcoming them back with
+"lillilooings." The Ajawa headman left the path on seeing us, and
+stood on an anthill to obtain a complete view of our party. We
+called out that we had come to have an interview with them, but some
+of the Manganja who followed us shouted "Our Chibisa is come:"
+Chibisa being well known as a great conjurer and general. The Ajawa
+ran off yelling and screaming, "Nkondo! Nkondo!" (War! War!) We
+heard the words of the Manganja, but they did not strike us at the
+moment as neutralizing all our assertions of peace. The captives
+threw down their loads on the path, and fled to the hills: and a
+large body of armed men came running up from the village, and in a
+few seconds they were all around us, though mostly concealed by the
+projecting rocks and long grass. In vain we protested that we had
+not come to fight, but to talk with them. They would not listen,
+having, as we remembered afterwards, good reason, in the cry of "Our
+Chibisa." Flushed with recent victory over three villages, and
+confident of an easy triumph over a mere handful of men, they began
+to shoot their poisoned arrows, sending them with great force upwards
+of a hundred yards, and wounding one of our followers through the
+arm. Our retiring slowly up the ascent from the village only made
+them more eager to prevent our escape; and, in the belief that this
+retreat was evidence of fear, they closed upon us in bloodthirsty
+fury. Some came within fifty yards, dancing hideously; others having
+quite surrounded us, and availing themselves of the rocks and long
+grass hard by, were intent on cutting us off, while others made off
+with their women and a large body of slaves. Four were armed with
+muskets, and we were obliged in self-defence to return their fire and
+drive them off. When they saw the range of rifles, they very soon
+desisted, and ran away; but some shouted to us from the hills the
+consoling intimation, that they would follow, and kill us where we
+slept. Only two of the captives escaped to us, but probably most of
+those made prisoners that day fled elsewhere in the confusion. We
+returned to the village which we had left in the morning, after a
+hungry, fatiguing, and most unpleasant day.
+
+Though we could not blame ourselves for the course we had followed,
+we felt sorry for what had happened. It was the first time we had
+ever been attacked by the natives or come into collision with them;
+though we had always taken it for granted that we might be called
+upon to act in self-defence, we were on this occasion less prepared
+than usual, no game having been expected here. The men had only a
+single round of cartridge each; their leader had no revolver, and the
+rifle he usually fired with was left at the ship to save it from the
+damp of the season. Had we known better the effect of slavery and
+murder on the temper of these bloodthirsty marauders, we should have
+tried messages and presents before going near them.
+
+The old chief, Chinsunse, came on a visit to us next day, and pressed
+the Bishop to come and live with him. "Chigunda," he said, "is but a
+child, and the Bishop ought to live with the father rather than with
+the child." But the old man's object was so evidently to have the
+Mission as a shield against the Ajawa, that his invitation was
+declined. While begging us to drive away the marauders, that he
+might live in peace, he adopted the stratagem of causing a number of
+his men to rush into the village, in breathless haste, with the news
+that the Ajawa were close upon us. And having been reminded that we
+never fought, unless attacked, as we were the day before, and that we
+had come among them for the purpose of promoting peace, and of
+teaching them to worship the Supreme, to give up selling His
+children, and to cultivate other objects for barter than each other,
+he replied, in a huff, "Then I am dead already."
+
+The Bishop, feeling, as most Englishmen would, at the prospect of the
+people now in his charge being swept off into slavery by hordes of
+men-stealers, proposed to go at once to the rescue of the captive
+Manganja, and drive the marauding Ajawa out of the country. All were
+warmly in favour of this, save Dr. Livingstone, who opposed it on the
+ground that it would be better for the Bishop to wait, and see the
+effect of the check the slave-hunters had just experienced. The
+Ajawa were evidently goaded on by Portuguese agents from Tette, and
+there was no bond of union among the Manganja on which to work. It
+was possible that the Ajawa might be persuaded to something better,
+though, from having long been in the habit of slaving for the
+Quillimane market, it was not very probable. But the Manganja could
+easily be overcome piecemeal by any enemy; old feuds made them glad
+to see calamities befall their next neighbours. We counselled them
+to unite against the common enemies of their country, and added
+distinctly that we English would on no account enter into their
+quarrels. On the Bishop inquiring whether, in the event of the
+Manganja again asking aid against the Ajawa, it would be his duty to
+accede to their request,--"No," replied Dr. Livingstone, "you will be
+oppressed by their importunities, but do not interfere in native
+quarrels." This advice the good man honourably mentions in his
+journal. We have been rather minute in relating what occurred during
+the few days of our connection with the Mission of the English
+Universities, on the hills, because, the recorded advice having been
+discarded, blame was thrown on Dr. Livingstone's shoulders, as if the
+missionaries had no individual responsibility for their subsequent
+conduct. This, unquestionably, good Bishop Mackenzie had too much
+manliness to have allowed. The connection of the members of the
+Zambesi Expedition, with the acts of the Bishop's Mission, now
+ceased, for we returned to the ship and prepared for our journey to
+Lake Nyassa. We cheerfully, if necessary, will bear all
+responsibility up to this point; and if the Bishop afterwards made
+mistakes in certain collisions with the slavers, he had the votes of
+all his party with him, and those who best knew the peculiar
+circumstances, and the loving disposition of this good-hearted man,
+will blame him least. In this position, and in these circumstances,
+we left our friends at the Mission Station.
+
+As a temporary measure the Bishop decided to place his Mission
+Station on a small promontory formed by the windings of the little,
+clear stream of Magomero, which was so cold that the limbs were quite
+benumbed by washing in it in the July mornings. The site chosen was
+a pleasant spot to the eye, and completely surrounded by stately,
+shady trees. It was expected to serve for a residence, till the
+Bishop had acquired an accurate knowledge of the adjacent country,
+and of the political relations of the people, and could select a
+healthy and commanding situation, as a permanent centre of Christian
+civilization. Everything promised fairly. The weather was
+delightful, resembling the pleasantest part of an English summer;
+provisions poured in very cheap and in great abundance. The Bishop,
+with characteristic ardour, commenced learning the language, Mr.
+Waller began building, and Mr. Scudamore improvised a sort of infant
+school for the children, than which there is no better means for
+acquiring an unwritten tongue.
+
+On the 6th of August, 1861, a few days after returning from Magomero,
+Drs. Livingstone and Kirk, and Charles Livingstone started for Nyassa
+with a light four-oared gig, a white sailor, and a score of
+attendants. We hired people along the path to carry the boat past
+the forty miles of the Murchison Cataracts for a cubit of cotton
+cloth a day. This being deemed great wages, more than twice the men
+required eagerly offered their services. The chief difficulty was in
+limiting their numbers. Crowds followed us; and, had we not taken
+down in the morning the names of the porters engaged, in the evening
+claims would have been made by those who only helped during the last
+ten minutes of the journey. The men of one village carried the boat
+to the next, and all we had to do was to tell the headman that we
+wanted fresh men in the morning. He saw us pay the first party, and
+had his men ready at the time appointed, so there was no delay in
+waiting for carriers. They often make a loud noise when carrying
+heavy loads, but talking and bawling does not put them out of breath.
+The country was rough and with little soil on it, but covered with
+grass and open forest. A few small trees were cut down to clear a
+path for our shouting assistants, who were good enough to consider
+the boat as a certificate of peaceful intentions at least to them.
+Several small streams were passed, the largest of which were the
+Mukuru-Madse and Lesungwe. The inhabitants on both banks were now
+civil and obliging. Our possession of a boat, and consequent power
+of crossing independently of the canoes, helped to develop their good
+manners, which were not apparent on our previous visit.
+
+There is often a surprising contrast between neighbouring villages.
+One is well off and thriving, having good huts, plenty of food, and
+native cloth; and its people are frank, trusty, generous, and eager
+to sell provisions; while in the next the inhabitants may be ill-
+housed, disobliging, suspicious, ill-fed, and scantily clad, and with
+nothing for sale, though the land around is as fertile as that of
+their wealthier neighbours. We followed the river for the most part
+to avail ourselves of the still reaches for sailing; but a
+comparatively smooth country lies further inland, over which a good
+road could be made. Some of the five main cataracts are very grand,
+the river falling 1200 feet in the 40 miles. After passing the last
+of the cataracts, we launched our boat for good on the broad and deep
+waters of the Upper Shire, and were virtually on the lake, for the
+gentle current shows but little difference of level. The bed is
+broad and deep, but the course is rather tortuous at first, and makes
+a long bend to the east till it comes within five or six miles of the
+base of Mount Zomba. The natives regarded the Upper Shire as a
+prolongation of Lake Nyassa; for where what we called the river
+approaches Lake Shirwa, a little north of the mountains, they said
+that the hippopotami, "which are great night travellers," pass from
+ONE LAKE INTO THE OTHER. There the land is flat, and only a short
+land journey would be necessary. Seldom does the current here exceed
+a knot an hour, while that of the Lower Shire is from two to two-and-
+a-half knots. Our land party of Makololo accompanied us along the
+right bank, and passed thousands of Manganja fugitives living in
+temporary huts on that side, who had recently been driven from their
+villages on the opposite hills by the Ajawa.
+
+The soil was dry and hard, and covered with mopane-trees; but some of
+the Manganja were busy hoeing the ground and planting the little corn
+they had brought with them. The effects of hunger were already
+visible on those whose food had been seized or burned by the Ajawa
+and Portuguese slave-traders. The spokesman or prime minister of one
+of the chiefs, named Kalonjere, was a humpbacked dwarf, a fluent
+speaker, who tried hard to make us go over and drive off the Ajawa;
+but he could not deny that by selling people Kalonjere had invited
+these slave-hunters to the country. This is the second humpbacked
+dwarf we have found occupying the like important post, the other was
+the prime minister of a Batonga chief on the Zambesi.
+
+As we sailed along, we disturbed many white-breasted cormorants; we
+had seen the same species fishing between the cataracts. Here, with
+many other wild-fowls, they find subsistence on the smooth water by
+night, and sit sleepily on trees and in the reeds by day. Many
+hippopotami were seen in the river, and one of them stretched its
+wide jaws, as if to swallow the whole stern of the boat, close to Dr.
+Kirk's back; the animal was so near that, in opening its mouth, it
+lashed a quantity of water on to the stern-sheets, but did no damage.
+To avoid large marauding parties of Ajawa, on the left bank of the
+Shire, we continued on the right, or western side, with our land
+party, along the shore of the small lake Pamalombe. This lakelet is
+ten or twelve miles in length, and five or six broad. It is nearly
+surrounded by a broad belt of papyrus, so dense that we could
+scarcely find an opening to the shore. The plants, ten or twelve
+feet high, grew so closely together that air was excluded, and so
+much sulphuretted hydrogen gas evolved that by one night's exposure
+the bottom of the boat was blackened. Myriads of mosquitoes showed,
+as probably they always do, the presence of malaria.
+
+We hastened from this sickly spot, trying to take the attentions of
+the mosquitoes as hints to seek more pleasant quarters on the healthy
+shores of Lake Nyassa; and when we sailed into it, on the 2nd
+September, we felt refreshed by the greater coolness of the air off
+this large body of water. The depth was the first point of interest.
+This is indicated by the colour of the water, which, on a belt along
+the shore, varying from a quarter to half a mile in breadth, is light
+green, and this is met by the deep blue or indigo tint of the Indian
+Ocean, which is the colour of the great body of Nyassa. We found the
+Upper Shire from nine to fifteen feet in depth; but skirting the
+western side of the lake about a mile from the shore the water
+deepened from nine to fifteen fathoms; then, as we rounded the grand
+mountainous promontory, which we named Cape Maclear, after our
+excellent friend the Astronomer Royal at the Cape of Good Hope, we
+could get no bottom with our lead-line of thirty-five fathoms. We
+pulled along the western shore, which was a succession of bays, and
+found that where the bottom was sandy near the beach, and to a mile
+out, the depth varied from six to fourteen fathoms. In a rocky bay
+about latitude 11 degrees 40 minutes we had soundings at 100 fathoms,
+though outside the same bay we found none with a fishing-line of 116
+fathoms; but this cast was unsatisfactory, as the line broke in
+coming up. According to our present knowledge, a ship could anchor
+only near the shore.
+
+Looking back to the southern end of Lake Nyassa, the arm from which
+the Shire flows was found to be about thirty miles long and from ten
+to twelve broad. Rounding Cape Maclear, and looking to the south-
+west, we have another arm, which stretches some eighteen miles
+southward, and is from six to twelve miles in breadth. These arms
+give the southern end a forked appearance, and with the help of a
+little imagination it may be likened to the "boot-shape" of Italy.
+The narrowest part is about the ankle, eighteen or twenty miles.
+From this it widens to the north, and in the upper third or fourth it
+is fifty or sixty miles broad. The length is over 200 miles. The
+direction in which it lies is as near as possible due north and
+south. Nothing of the great bend to the west, shown in all the
+previous maps, could be detected by either compass or chronometer,
+and the watch we used was an excellent one. The season of the year
+was very unfavourable. The "smokes" filled the air with an
+impenetrable haze, and the equinoctial gales made it impossible for
+us to cross to the eastern side. When we caught a glimpse of the sun
+rising from behind the mountains to the east, we made sketches and
+bearings of them at different latitudes, which enabled us to secure
+approximate measurements of the width. These agreed with the times
+taken by the natives at the different crossing-places--as Tsenga and
+Molamba. About the beginning of the upper third the lake is crossed
+by taking advantage of the island Chizumara, which name in the native
+tongue means the "ending;" further north they go round the end
+instead, though that takes several days.
+
+The lake appeared to be surrounded by mountains, but it was
+afterwards found that these beautiful tree-covered heights were, on
+the west, only the edges of high table-lands. Like all narrow seas
+encircled by highlands, it is visited by sudden and tremendous
+storms. We were on it in September and October, perhaps the
+stormiest season of the year, and were repeatedly detained by gales.
+At times, while sailing pleasantly over the blue water with a gentle
+breeze, suddenly and without any warning was heard the sound of a
+coming storm, roaring on with crowds of angry waves in its wake. We
+were caught one morning with the sea breaking all around us, and,
+unable either to advance or recede, anchored a mile from shore, in
+seven fathoms. The furious surf on the beach would have shivered our
+boat to atoms, had we tried to land. The waves most dreaded came
+rolling on in threes, with their crests, driven into spray, streaming
+behind them. A short lull followed each triple charge. Had one of
+these seas struck our boat, nothing could have saved us; for they
+came on with resistless force; seaward, in shore, and on either side
+of us, they broke in foam, but we escaped. For six weary hours we
+faced those terrible trios. A low, dark, detached, oddly shaped
+cloud came slowly from the mountains, and hung for hours directly
+over our heads. A flock of night-jars (Cometornis vexillarius),
+which on no other occasion come out by day, soared above us in the
+gale, like birds of evil omen. Our black crew became sea-sick and
+unable to sit up or keep the boat's head to the sea. The natives and
+our land party stood on the high cliffs looking at us and exclaiming,
+as the waves seemed to swallow up the boat, "They are lost! they are
+all dead!" When at last the gale moderated and we got safely ashore,
+they saluted us warmly, as after a long absence. From this time we
+trusted implicitly to the opinions of our seaman, John Neil, who,
+having been a fisherman on the coast of Ireland, understood boating
+on a stormy coast, and by his advice we often sat cowering on the
+land for days together waiting for the surf to go down. He had never
+seen such waves before. We had to beach the boat every night to save
+her from being swamped at anchor; and, did we not believe the gales
+to be peculiar to one season of the year, would call Nyassa the "Lake
+of Storms."
+
+Distinct white marks on the rocks showed that, for some time during
+the rainy season, the water of the lake is three feet above the point
+to which it falls towards the close of the dry period of the year.
+The rains begin here in November, and the permanent rise of the Shire
+does not take place till January. The western side of Lake Nyassa,
+with the exception of the great harbour to the west of Cape Maclear,
+is, as has been said before, a succession of small bays of nearly
+similar form, each having an open sandy beach and pebbly shore, and
+being separated from its neighbour by a rocky headland, with detached
+rocks extending some distance out to sea. The great south-western
+bay referred to would form a magnificent harbour, the only really
+good one we saw to the west.
+
+The land immediately adjacent to the lake is low and fertile, though
+in some places marshy and tenanted by large flocks of ducks, geese,
+herons, crowned cranes, and other birds. In the southern parts we
+have sometimes ten or a dozen miles of rich plains, bordered by what
+seem high ranges of well-wooded hills, running nearly parallel with
+the lake. Northwards the mountains become loftier and present some
+magnificent views, range towering beyond range, until the dim, lofty
+outlines projected against the sky bound the prospect. Still further
+north the plain becomes more narrow, until, near where we turned, it
+disappears altogether, and the mountains rise abruptly out of the
+lake, forming the north-east boundary of what was described to us as
+an extensive table-land; well suited for pasturage and agriculture,
+and now only partially occupied by a tribe of Zulus, who came from
+the south some years ago. These people own large herds of cattle,
+and are constantly increasing in numbers by annexing other tribes.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X.
+
+
+
+The Lake tribes--The Mazitu--Quantities of elephants--Distressing
+journey--Detention on the Shire.
+
+Never before in Africa have we seen anything like the dense
+population on the shores of Lake Nyassa. In the southern part there
+was an almost unbroken chain of villages. On the beach of wellnigh
+of every little sandy bay, dark crowds were standing, gazing at the
+novel sight of a boat under sail; and wherever we landed we were
+surrounded in a few seconds by hundreds of men, women, and children,
+who hastened to have a stare at the "chirombo" (wild animals).
+
+During a portion of the year, the northern dwellers on the lake have
+a harvest which furnishes a singular sort of food. As we approached
+our limit in that direction, clouds, as of smoke rising from miles of
+burning grass, were observed bending in a south-easterly direction,
+and we thought that the unseen land on the opposite side was closing
+in, and that we were near the end of the lake. But next morning we
+sailed through one of the clouds on our own side, and discovered that
+it was neither smoke nor haze, but countless millions of minute
+midges called "kungo" (a cloud or fog). They filled the air to an
+immense height, and swarmed upon the water, too light to sink in it.
+Eyes and mouth had to be kept closed while passing through this
+living cloud: they struck upon the face like fine drifting snow.
+Thousands lay in the boat when she emerged from the cloud of midges.
+The people gather these minute insects by night, and boil them into
+thick cakes, to be used as a relish--millions of midges in a cake. A
+kungo cake, an inch thick, and as large as the blue bonnet of a
+Scotch ploughman, was offered to us; it was very dark in colour, and
+tasted not unlike caviare, or salted locusts.
+
+Abundance of excellent fish is found in the lake, and nearly all were
+new to us. The mpasa, or sanjika, found by Dr. Kirk to be a kind of
+carp, was running up the rivers to spawn, like our salmon at home:
+the largest we saw was over two feet in length; it is a splendid
+fish, and the best we have ever eaten in Africa. They were ascending
+the rivers in August and September, and furnished active and
+profitable employment to many fishermen, who did not mind their being
+out of season. Weirs were constructed full of sluices, in each of
+which was set a large basket-trap, through whose single tortuous
+opening the fish once in has but small chance of escape. A short
+distance below the weir, nets are stretched across from bank to bank,
+so that it seemed a marvel how the most sagacious sanjika could get
+up at all without being taken. Possibly a passage up the river is
+found at night; but this is not the country of Sundays or "close
+times" for either men or fish. The lake fish are caught chiefly in
+nets, although men, and even women with babies on their backs, are
+occasionally seen fishing from the rocks with hooks.
+
+A net with small meshes is used for catching the young fry of a
+silvery kind like pickerel, when they are about two inches long;
+thousands are often taken in a single haul. We had a present of a
+large bucketful one day for dinner: they tasted as if they had been
+cooked with a little quinine, probably from their gall-bladders being
+left in. In deep water, some sorts are taken by lowering fish-
+baskets attached by a long cord to a float, around which is often
+tied a mass of grass or weeds, as an alluring shade for the deep-sea
+fish. Fleets of fine canoes are engaged in the fisheries. The men
+have long paddles, and stand erect while using them. They sometimes
+venture out when a considerable sea is running. Our Makololo
+acknowledge that, in handling canoes, the Lake men beat them; they
+were unwilling to cross the Zambesi even, when the wind blew fresh.
+
+Though there are many crocodiles in the lake, and some of an
+extraordinary size, the fishermen say that it is a rare thing for any
+one to be carried off by these reptiles. When crocodiles can easily
+obtain abundance of fish--their natural food--they seldom attack men;
+but when unable to see to catch their prey, from the muddiness of the
+water in floods, they are very dangerous.
+
+Many men and boys are employed in gathering the buaze, in preparing
+the fibre, and in making it into long nets. The knot of the net is
+different from ours, for they invariably use what sailors call the
+reef knot, but they net with a needle like that we use. From the
+amount of native cotton cloth worn in many of the southern villages,
+it is evident that a great number of hands and heads must be employed
+in the cultivation of cotton, and in the various slow processes
+through which it has to pass, before the web is finished in the
+native loom. In addition to this branch of industry, an extensive
+manufacture of cloth, from the inner bark of an undescribed tree, of
+the botanical group, Caesalpineae, is ever going on, from one end of
+the lake to the other; and both toil and time are required to procure
+the bark, and to prepare it by pounding and steeping it to render it
+soft and pliable. The prodigious amount of the bark clothing worn
+indicates the destruction of an immense number of trees every year;
+yet the adjacent heights seem still well covered with timber.
+
+The Lake people are by no means handsome: the women are VERY plain;
+and really make themselves hideous by the means they adopt to render
+themselves attractive. The pelele, or ornament for the upper lip, is
+universally worn by the ladies; the most valuable is of pure tin,
+hammered into the shape of a small dish; some are made of white
+quartz, and give the wearer the appearance of having an inch or more
+of one of Price's patent candles thrust through the lip, and
+projecting beyond the tip of the nose.
+
+In character, the Lake tribes are very much like other people; there
+are decent men among them, while a good many are no better than they
+should be. They are open-handed enough: if one of us, as was often
+the case, went to see a net drawn, a fish was always offered.
+Sailing one day past a number of men, who had just dragged their nets
+ashore, at one of the fine fisheries at Pamalombe, we were hailed and
+asked to stop, and received a liberal donation of beautiful fish.
+Arriving late one afternoon at a small village on the lake, a number
+of the inhabitants manned two canoes, took out their seine, dragged
+it, and made us a present of the entire haul. The northern chief,
+Marenga, a tall handsome man, with a fine aquiline nose, whom we
+found living in his stockade in a forest about twenty miles north of
+the mountain Kowirwe, behaved like a gentleman to us. His land
+extended from Dambo to the north of Makuza hill. He was specially
+generous, and gave us bountiful presents of food and beer. "Do they
+wear such things in your country?" he asked, pointing to his iron
+bracelet, which was studded with copper, and highly prized. The
+Doctor said he had never seen such in his country, whereupon Marenga
+instantly took it off, and presented it to him, and his wife also did
+the same with hers. On our return south from the mountains near the
+north end of the lake, we reached Marenga's on the 7th October. When
+he could not prevail upon us to forego the advantage of a fair wind
+for his invitation to "spend the whole day drinking his beer, which
+was," he said, "quite ready," he loaded us with provisions, all of
+which he sent for before we gave him any present. In allusion to the
+boat's sail, his people said that they had no Bazimo, or none worth
+having, seeing they had never invented the like for them. The chief,
+Mankambira, likewise treated us with kindness; but wherever the
+slave-trade is carried on, the people are dishonest and uncivil; that
+invariably leaves a blight and a curse in its path. The first
+question put to us at the lake crossing-places, was, "Have you come
+to buy slaves?" On hearing that we were English, and never purchased
+slaves, the questioners put on a supercilious air, and sometimes
+refused to sell us food. This want of respect to us may have been
+owing to the impressions conveyed to them by the Arabs, whose dhows
+have sometimes been taken by English cruisers when engaged in lawful
+trade. Much foreign cloth, beads, and brass-wire were worn by these
+ferrymen--and some had muskets.
+
+By Chitanda, near one of the slave crossing-places, we were robbed
+for the first time in Africa, and learned by experience that these
+people, like more civilized nations, have expert thieves among them.
+It might be only a coincidence; but we never suffered from impudence,
+loss of property, or were endangered, unless among people familiar
+with slaving. We had such a general sense of security, that never,
+save when we suspected treachery, did we set a watch at night. Our
+native companions had, on this occasion, been carousing on beer, and
+had removed to a distance of some thirty yards, that we might not
+overhear their free and easy after-dinner remarks, and two of us had
+a slight touch of fever; between three and four o'clock in the
+morning some thieves came, while we slept ingloriously--rifles and
+revolvers all ready,--and relieved us of most of our goods. The
+boat's sail, under which we slept, was open all around, so the feat
+was easy.
+
+Awaking as honest men do, at the usual hour, the loss of one was
+announced by "My bag is gone--with all my clothes; and my boots too!"
+"And mine!" responded a second. "And mine also!" chimed in the
+third, "with the bag of beads, and the rice!" "Is the cloth taken?"
+was the eager inquiry, as that would have been equivalent to all our
+money. It had been used for a pillow that night, and thus saved.
+The rogues left on the beach, close to our beds, the Aneroid
+Barometer and a pair of boots, thinking possibly that they might be
+of use to us, or, at least, that they could be of none to them. They
+shoved back some dried plants and fishes into one bag, but carried
+off many other specimens we had collected; some of our notes also,
+and nearly all our clothing.
+
+We could not suspect the people of the village near which we lay. We
+had probably been followed for days by the thieves watching for an
+opportunity. And our suspicions fell on some persons who had come
+from the East Coast; but having no evidence, and expecting to hear if
+our goods were exposed for sale in the vicinity, we made no fuss
+about it, and began to make new clothing. That our rifles and
+revolvers were left untouched was greatly to our advantage: yet we
+felt it was most humiliating for armed men to have been so thoroughly
+fleeced by a few black rascals.
+
+Some of the best fisheries appear to be private property. We found
+shelter from a storm one morning in a spacious lagoon, which
+communicated with the lake by a narrow passage. Across this strait
+stakes were driven in, leaving only spaces for the basket fish-traps.
+A score of men were busily engaged in taking out the fish. We tried
+to purchase some, but they refused to sell. The fish did not belong
+to them, they would send for the proprietor of the place. The
+proprietor arrived in a short time, and readily sold what we wanted.
+
+Some of the burying-grounds are very well arranged, and well cared
+for; this was noticed at Chitanda, and more particularly at a village
+on the southern shore of the fine harbour at Cape Maclear. Wide and
+neat paths were made in the burying-ground on its eastern and
+southern sides. A grand old fig-tree stood at the north-east corner,
+and its wide-spreading branches threw their kindly shade over the
+last resting-place of the dead. Several other magnificent trees grew
+around the hallowed spot. Mounds were raised as they are at home,
+but all lay north and south, the heads apparently north. The graves
+of the sexes were distinguished by the various implements which the
+buried dead had used in their different employments during life; but
+they were all broken, as if to be employed no more. A piece of
+fishing-net and a broken paddle told where a fisherman lay. The
+graves of the women had the wooden mortar, and the heavy pestle used
+in pounding the corn, and the basket in which the meal is sifted,
+while all had numerous broken calabashes and pots arranged around
+them. The idea that the future life is like the present does not
+appear to prevail; yet a banana-tree had been carefully planted at
+the head of several of the graves; the fruit might be considered an
+offering to those who still possess human tastes. The people of the
+neighbouring villages were friendly and obliging, and willingly
+brought us food for sale.
+
+Pursuing our exploration, we found that the northern part of the lake
+was the abode of lawlessness and bloodshed. The Mazite, or Mazitu,
+live on the highlands, and make sudden swoops on the villages of the
+plains. They are Zulus who came originally from the south, inland of
+Sofalla and Inhambane; and are of the same family as those who levy
+annual tribute from the Portuguese on the Zambesi. All the villages
+north of Mankambira's (lat. 11 degrees 44 minutes south) had been
+recently destroyed by these terrible marauders, but they were foiled
+in their attacks upon that chief and Marenga. The thickets and
+stockades round their villages enabled the bowmen to pick off the
+Mazitu in security, while they were afraid to venture near any place
+where they could not use their shields. Beyond Mankambira's we saw
+burned villages, and the putrid bodies of many who had fallen by
+Mazitu spears only a few days before. Our land party were afraid to
+go further. This reluctance to proceed without the presence of a
+white man was very natural, because bands of the enemy who had
+ravaged the country were supposed to be still roaming about; and if
+these marauders saw none but men of their own colour, our party might
+forthwith be attacked. Compliance with their request led to an event
+which might have been attended by very serious consequences. Dr.
+Livingstone got separated from the party in the boat for four days.
+Having taken the first morning's journey along with them, and
+directing the boat to call for him in a bay in sight, both parties
+proceeded north. In an hour Dr. Livingstone and his party struck
+inland, on approaching the foot of the mountains which rise abruptly
+from the lake. Supposing that they had heard of a path behind the
+high range which there forms the shore, those in the boat held on
+their course; but it soon began to blow so fresh that they had to run
+ashore for safety. While delayed a couple of hours, two men were
+sent up the hills to look for the land party, but they could see
+nothing of them, and the boat party sailed as soon as it was safe to
+put to sea, with the conviction that the missing ones would regain
+the lake in front.
+
+In a short time a small island or mass of rocks was passed, on which
+were a number of armed Mazitu with some young women, apparently their
+wives. The headman said that he had been wounded in the foot by
+Mankambira, and that they were staying there till he could walk to
+his chief, who lived over the hills. They had several large canoes,
+and it was evident that this was a nest of lake pirates, who sallied
+out by night to kill and plunder. They reported a path behind the
+hills, and, the crew being reassured, the boat sailed on. A few
+miles further, another and still larger band of pirates were fallen
+in with, and hundreds of crows and kites hovered over and round the
+rocks on which they lived. Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone, though
+ordered in a voice of authority to come ashore, kept on their course.
+A number of canoes then shot out from the rocks and chased them. One
+with nine strong paddlers persevered for some time after all the
+others gave up the chase. A good breeze, however, enabled the gig to
+get away from them with ease. After sailing twelve or fifteen miles,
+north of the point where Dr. Livingstone had left them, it was
+decided that he must be behind; but no sooner had the boat's head
+been turned south, than another gale compelled her to seek shelter in
+a bay. Here a number of wretched fugitives from the slave-trade on
+the opposite shore of the lake were found; the original inhabitants
+of the place had all been swept off the year before by the Mazitu.
+In the deserted gardens beautiful cotton was seen growing, much of it
+had the staple an inch and a half long, and of very fine quality.
+Some of the plants were uncommonly large, deserving to be ranked with
+trees.
+
+On their trying to purchase food, the natives had nothing to sell
+except a little dried cassava-root, and a few fish: and they
+demanded two yards of calico for the head only of a large fish. When
+the gale admitted of their return, their former pursuers tried to
+draw them ashore by asserting that they had quantities of ivory for
+sale. Owing to a succession of gales, it was the fourth day from
+parting that the boat was found by Dr. Livingstone, who was coming on
+in search of it with only two of his companions.
+
+After proceeding a short distance up the path in which they had been
+lost sight of, they learned that it would take several days to go
+round the mountains, and rejoin the lake; and they therefore turned
+down to the bay, expecting to find the boat, but only saw it
+disappearing away to the north. They pushed on as briskly as
+possible after it, but the mountain flank which forms the coast
+proved excessively tedious and fatiguing; travelling all day, the
+distance made, in a straight line, was under five miles. As soon as
+day dawned, the march was resumed; and, after hearing at the first
+inhabited rock that their companions had passed it the day before, a
+goat was slaughtered out of the four which they had with them, when
+suddenly, to the evident consternation of the men, seven Mazitu
+appeared armed with spears and shields, with their heads dressed
+fantastically with feathers. To hold a parley, Dr. Livingstone and
+Moloka, a Makololo man who spoke Zulu, went unarmed to meet them. On
+Dr. Livingstone approaching them, they ordered him to stop, and sit
+down in the sun, while they sat in the shade. No, no!" was the
+reply, "if you sit in the shade, so will we." They then rattled
+their shields with their clubs, a proceeding which usually inspires
+terror; but Moloka remarked, "It is not the first time we have heard
+shields rattled." And all sat down together. They asked for a
+present, to show their chief that they had actually met strangers--
+something as evidence of having seen men who were not Arabs. And
+they were requested in turn to take these strangers to the boat, or
+to their chief. All the goods were in the boat, and to show that no
+present such as they wanted was in his pockets, Dr. Livingstone
+emptied them, turning out, among other things, a note-book: thinking
+it was a pistol they started up, and said, "Put that in again." The
+younger men then became boisterous, and demanded a goat. That could
+not be spared, as they were the sole provisions. When they insisted,
+they were asked how many of the party they had killed, that they thus
+began to divide the spoil; this evidently made them ashamed. The
+elders were more reasonable; they dreaded treachery, and were as much
+afraid of Dr. Livingstone and his party as his men were of them; for
+on leaving they sped away up the hills like frightened deer. One of
+them, and probably the leader, was married, as seen by portions of
+his hair sewn into a ring; all were observed by their teeth to be
+people of the country, who had been incorporated into the Zulu tribe.
+
+The way still led over a succession of steep ridges with ravines of
+from 500 to 1000 feet in depth; some of the sides had to be scaled on
+hands and knees, and no sooner was the top reached than the descent
+began again. Each ravine had a running stream; and the whole
+country, though so very rugged, had all been cultivated, and densely
+peopled. Many banana-trees, uncared for patches of corn, and Congo-
+bean bushes attested former cultivation. The population had all been
+swept away; ruined villages, broken utensils, and human skeletons,
+met with at every turn, told a sad tale. So numerous were the slain,
+that it was thought the inhabitants had been slaughtered in
+consequence of having made raids on the Zulus for cattle.
+
+Continuing the journey that night as long as light served, they slept
+unconsciously on the edge of a deep precipice, without fire, lest the
+Mazitu should see it. Next morning most of the men were tired out,
+the dread of the apparition of the day before tending probably to
+increase the lameness of which they complained. When told, however,
+that all might return to Mankambira's save two, Moloka and Charlie,
+they would not, till assured that the act would not be considered one
+of cowardice. Giving them one of the goats as provision, another was
+slaughtered for the remainder of the party who, having found on the
+rocks a canoe which had belonged to one of the deserted villages,
+determined to put to sea again; but the craft was very small, and the
+remaining goat, spite of many a threat of having its throat cut,
+jumped and rolled about so, as nearly to capsize it; so Dr.
+Livingstone took to the shore again, and after another night spent
+without fire, except just for cooking, was delighted to see the boat
+coming back.
+
+We pulled that day to Mankambira's, a distance that on shore, with
+the most heartbreaking toil, had taken three days to travel. This
+was the last latitude taken, 11 degrees 44 minutes S. The boat had
+gone about 24 minutes further to the north, the land party probably
+half that distance, but fever prevented the instruments being used.
+Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone were therefore furthest up the lake,
+and they saw about 20 minutes beyond their turning-point, say into
+the tenth degree of south latitude. From the heights of at least a
+thousand feet, over which the land party toiled, the dark mountain
+masses on both sides of the lake were seen closing in. At this
+elevation the view extended at least as far as that from the boats,
+and it is believed the end of the lake lies on the southern borders
+of 10 degrees, or the northern limits of 11 degrees south latitude.
+
+Elephants are numerous on the borders of the lake, and surprisingly
+tame, being often found close to the villages. Hippopotami swarm
+very much at their ease in the creeks and lagoons, and herds are
+sometimes seen in the lake itself. Their tameness arises from the
+fact that poisoned arrows have no effect on either elephant or
+hippopotamus. Five of each were shot for food during our journey.
+Two of the elephants were females, and had only a single tusk apiece,
+and were each killed by the first shot. It is always a case of
+famine or satiety when depending on the rifle for food--a glut of
+meat or none at all. Most frequently it is scanty fare, except when
+game is abundant, as it is far up the Zambesi. We had one morning
+two hippopotami and an elephant, perhaps in all some eight tons of
+meat, and two days after the last of a few sardines only for dinner.
+
+One morning when sailing past a pretty thickly-inhabited part, we
+were surprised at seeing nine large bull-elephants standing near the
+beach quietly flapping their gigantic ears. Glad of an opportunity
+of getting some fresh meat, we landed and fired into one. They all
+retreated into a marshy piece of ground between two villages. Our
+men gave chase, and fired into the herd. Standing on a sand hummock,
+we could see the bleeding animals throwing showers of water with
+their trunks over their backs. The herd was soon driven back upon
+us, and a wounded one turned to bay. Yet neither this one, nor any
+of the others, ever attempted to charge. Having broken his legs with
+a rifle-ball, we fired into him at forty yards as rapidly as we could
+load and discharge the rifles. He simply shook his head at each
+shot, and received at least sixty Enfield balls before he fell. Our
+excellent sailor from the north of Ireland happened to fire the last,
+and, as soon as he saw the animal fall, he turned with an air of
+triumph to the Doctor and exclaimed, "It was MY shot that done it,
+sir!"
+
+In a few minutes upwards of a thousand natives were round the
+prostrate king of beasts; and, after our men had taken all they
+wanted, an invitation was given to the villagers to take the
+remainder. They rushed at it like hungry hyenas, and in an
+incredibly short time every inch of it was carried off. It was only
+by knowing that the meat would all be used that we felt justified in
+the slaughter of this noble creature. The tusks weighed 62 lbs.
+each. A large amount of ivory might be obtained from the people of
+Nyassa, and we were frequently told of their having it in their huts.
+
+While detained by a storm on the 17th October at the mouth of the
+Kaombe, we were visited by several men belonging to an Arab who had
+been for fourteen years in the interior at Katanga's, south of
+Cazembe's. They had just brought down ivory, malachite, copper
+rings, and slaves to exchange for cloth at the lake. The malachite
+was said to be dug out of a large vein on the side of a hill near
+Katanga's. They knew Lake Tanganyika well, but had not heard of the
+Zambesi. They spoke quite positively, saying that the water of Lake
+Tanganyika flowed out by the opposite end to that of Nyassa. As they
+had seen neither of the overflows, we took it simply as a piece of
+Arab geography. We passed their establishment of long sheds next
+day, and were satisfied that the Arabs must be driving a good trade.
+
+The Lake slave-trade was going on at a terrible rate. Two
+enterprising Arabs had built a dhow, and were running her, crowded
+with slaves, regularly across the Lake. We were told she sailed the
+day before we reached their head-quarters. This establishment is in
+the latitude of the Portuguese slave-exporting town of Iboe, and
+partly supplies that vile market; but the greater number of the
+slaves go to Kilwa. We did not see much evidence of a wish to
+barter. Some ivory was offered for sale; but the chief traffic was
+in human chattels. Would that we could give a comprehensive account
+of the horrors of the slave-trade, with an approximation to the
+number of lives it yearly destroys! for we feel sure that were even
+half the truth told and recognized, the feelings of men would be so
+thoroughly roused, that this devilish traffic in human flesh would be
+put down at all risks; but neither we, nor any one else, have the
+statistics necessary for a work of this kind. Let us state what we
+do know of one portion of Africa, and then every reader who believes
+our tale can apply the ratio of the known misery to find out the
+unknown. We were informed by Colonel Rigby, late H.M. Political
+Agent, and Consul at Zanzibar, that 19,000 slaves from this Nyassa
+country alone pass annually through the Custom-house of that island.
+This is exclusive of course of those sent to Portuguese slave-ports.
+Let it not be supposed for an instant that this number, 19,000,
+represents all the victims. Those taken out of the country are but a
+very small section of the sufferers. We never realized the atrocious
+nature of the traffic, until we saw it at the fountain-head. There
+truly "Satan has his seat." Besides those actually captured,
+thousands are killed and die of their wounds and famine, driven from
+their villages by the slave raid proper. Thousands perish in
+internecine war waged for slaves with their own clansmen and
+neighbours, slain by the lust of gain, which is stimulated, be it
+remembered always, by the slave purchasers of Cuba and elsewhere.
+The many skeletons we have seen, amongst rocks and woods, by the
+little pools, and along the paths of the wilderness, attest the awful
+sacrifice of human life, which must be attributed, directly or
+indirectly, to this trade of hell. We would ask our countrymen to
+believe us when we say, as we conscientiously can, that it is our
+deliberate opinion, from what we know and have seen, that not one-
+fifth of the victims of the slave-trade ever become slaves. Taking
+the Shire Valley as an average, we should say not even one-tenth
+arrive at their destination. As the system, therefore, involves such
+an awful waste of human life,--or shall we say of human labour?--and
+moreover tends directly to perpetuate the barbarism of those who
+remain in the country, the argument for the continuance of this
+wasteful course because, forsooth, a fraction of the enslaved may
+find good masters, seems of no great value. This reasoning, if not
+the result of ignorance, may be of maudlin philanthropy. A small
+armed steamer on Lake Nyassa could easily, by exercising a control,
+and furnishing goods in exchange for ivory and other products, break
+the neck of this infamous traffic in that quarter; for nearly all
+must cross the Lake or the Upper Shire.
+
+Our exploration of the Lake extended from the 2nd September to the
+27th October, 1861; and, having expended or lost most of the goods we
+had brought, it was necessary to go back to the ship. When near the
+southern end, on our return, we were told that a very large slave-
+party had just crossed to the eastern side. We heard the fire of
+three guns in the evening, and judged by the report that they must be
+at least six-pounders. They were said to belong to an Ajawa chief
+named Mukata.
+
+In descending the Shire, we found concealed in the broad belt of
+papyrus round the lakelet Pamalombe, into which the river expands, a
+number of Manganja families who had been driven from their homes by
+the Ajawa raids. So thickly did the papyrus grow, that when beat
+down it supported their small temporary huts, though when they walked
+from one hut to another, it heaved and bent beneath their feet as
+thin ice does at home.
+
+A dense and impenetrable forest of the papyrus was left standing
+between them and the land, and no one passing by on the same side
+would ever have suspected that human beings lived there. They came
+to this spot from the south by means of their canoes, which enabled
+them to obtain a living from the fine fish which abound in the
+lakelet. They had a large quantity of excellent salt sewed up in
+bark, some of which we bought, our own having run out. We anchored
+for the night off their floating camp, and were visited by myriads of
+mosquitoes. Some of the natives show a love of country quite
+surprising. We saw fugitives on the mountains, in the north of the
+lake, who were persisting in clinging to the haunts of their boyhood
+and youth, in spite of starvation and the continual danger of being
+put to death by the Mazitu.
+
+A few miles below the lakelet is the last of the great slave-
+crossings. Since the Ajawa invasion the villages on the left bank
+had been abandoned, and the people, as we saw in our ascent, were
+living on the right or western bank.
+
+As we were resting for a few minutes opposite the valuable fishery at
+Movunguti, a young effeminate-looking man from some sea-coast tribe
+came in great state to have a look at us. He walked under a large
+umbrella, and was followed by five handsome damsels gaily dressed and
+adorned with a view to attract purchasers. One was carrying his pipe
+for smoking bang, here called "chamba;" another his bow and arrows; a
+third his battle-axe; a fourth one of his robes; while the last was
+ready to take his umbrella when he felt tired. This show of his
+merchandise was to excite the cupidity of any chief who had ivory,
+and may be called the lawful way of carrying on the slave-trade.
+What proportion it bears to the other ways in which we have seen this
+traffic pursued, we never found means of forming a judgment. He sat
+and looked at us for a few minutes, the young ladies kneeling behind
+him; and having satisfied himself that we were not likely to be
+customers, he departed.
+
+On our first trip we met, at the landing opposite this place, a
+middle-aged woman of considerable intelligence, and possessing more
+knowledge of the country than any of the men. Our first definite
+information about Lake Nyassa was obtained from her. Seeing us
+taking notes, she remarked that she had been to the sea, and had
+there seen white men writing. She had seen camels also, probably
+among the Arabs. She was the only Manganja woman we ever met who was
+ashamed of wearing the "pelele," or lip-ring. She retired to her
+hut, took it out, and kept her hand before her mouth to hide the
+hideous hole in the lip while conversing with us. All the villagers
+respected her, and even the headmen took a secondary place in her
+presence. On inquiring for her now, we found that she was dead. We
+never obtained sufficient materials to estimate the relative
+mortality of the highlands and lowlands; but, from many very old
+white-headed blacks having been seen on the highlands, we think it
+probable that even native races are longer lived the higher their
+dwelling-places are.
+
+We landed below at Mikena's and took observations for longitude, to
+verify those taken two years before. The village was deserted,
+Mikena and his people having fled to the other side of the river. A
+few had come across this morning to work in their old gardens. After
+completing the observations we had breakfast; and, as the last of the
+things were being carried into the boat, a Manganja man came running
+down to his canoe, crying out, "The Ajawa have just killed my
+comrade!" We shoved off, and in two minutes the advanced guard of a
+large marauding party were standing with their muskets on the spot
+where we had taken breakfast. They were evidently surprised at
+seeing us there, and halted; as did also the main body of perhaps a
+thousand men. "Kill them," cried the Manganja; "they are going up to
+the hills to kill the English," meaning the missionaries we had left
+at Magomero. But having no prospect of friendly communication with
+them, nor confidence in Manganja's testimony, we proceeded down the
+river; leaving the Ajawa sitting under a large baobab, and the
+Manganja cursing them most energetically across the river.
+
+On our way up, we had seen that the people of Zimika had taken refuge
+on a long island in the Shire, where they had placed stores of grain
+to prevent it falling into the hands of the Ajawa; supposing
+afterwards that the invasion and war were past, they had removed back
+again to the mainland on the east, and were living in fancied
+security. On approaching the chief's village, which was built in the
+midst of a beautiful grove of lofty wild-fig and palm trees, sounds
+of revelry fell upon our ears. The people were having a merry time--
+drumming, dancing, and drinking beer--while a powerful enemy was
+close at hand, bringing death or slavery to every one in the village.
+One of our men called out to several who came to the bank to look at
+us, that the Ajawa were coming and were even now at Mikena's village;
+but they were dazed with drinking, and took no notice of the warning.
+
+Crowds of carriers offered their services after we left the river.
+Several sets of them placed so much confidence in us, as to decline
+receiving payment at the end of the first day; they wished to work
+another day, and so receive both days' wages in one piece. The young
+headman of a new village himself came on with his men. The march was
+a pretty long one, and one of the men proposed to lay the burdens
+down beside a hut a mile or more from the next village. The headman
+scolded the fellow for his meanness in wishing to get rid of our
+goods where we could not procure carriers, and made him carry them
+on. The village, at the foot of the cataracts, had increased very
+much in size and wealth since we passed it on our way up. A number
+of large new huts had been built; and the people had a good stock of
+cloth and beads. We could not account for this sudden prosperity,
+until we saw some fine large canoes, instead of the two old, leaky
+things which lay there before. This had become a crossing-place for
+the slaves that the Portuguese agents were carrying to Tette, because
+they were afraid to take them across nearer to where the ship lay,
+about seven miles off. Nothing was more disheartening than this
+conduct of the Manganja, in profiting by the entire breaking up of
+their nation.
+
+We reached the ship on the 8th of November, 1861, in a very weak
+condition, having suffered more from hunger than on any previous
+trip. Heavy rains commenced on the 9th, and continued several days;
+the river rose rapidly, and became highly discoloured. Bishop
+Mackenzie came down to the ship on the 14th, with some of the
+"Pioneer's" men, who had been at Magomero for the benefit of their
+health, and also for the purpose of assisting the Mission. The
+Bishop appeared to be in excellent spirits, and thought that the
+future promised fair for peace and usefulness. The Ajawa having been
+defeated and driven off while we were on the Lake, had sent word that
+they desired to live at peace with the English. Many of the Manganja
+had settled round Magomero, in order to be under the protection of
+the Bishop; and it was hoped that the slave-trade would soon cease in
+the highlands, and the people be left in the secure enjoyment of
+their industry. The Mission, it was also anticipated, might soon
+become, to a considerable degree, self-supporting, and raise certain
+kinds of food, like the Portuguese of Senna and Quillimane. Mr.
+Burrup, an energetic young man, had arrived at Chibisa's the day
+before the Bishop, having come up the Shire in a canoe. A surgeon
+and a lay brother followed behind in another canoe. The "Pioneer's"
+draught being too much for the upper part of the Shire, it was not
+deemed advisable to bring her up, on the next trip, further than the
+Ruo; the Bishop, therefore, resolved to explore the country from
+Magomero to the mouth of that river, and to meet the ship with his
+sisters and Mrs. Burrup, in January. This was arranged before
+parting, and then the good Bishop and Burrup, whom we were never to
+meet again, left us; they gave and received three hearty English
+cheers as they went to the shore, and we steamed off.
+
+The rains ceased on the 14th, and the waters of the Shire fell, even
+more rapidly than they had risen. A shoal, twenty miles below
+Chibisa's, checked our further progress, and we lay there five weary
+weeks, till the permanent rise of the river took place. During this
+detention, with a large marsh on each side, the first death occurred
+in the Expedition which had now been three-and-a-half years in the
+country. The carpenter's mate, a fine healthy young man, was seized
+with fever. The usual remedies had no effect; he died suddenly while
+we were at evening prayers, and was buried on shore. He came out in
+the "Pioneer," and, with the exception of a slight touch of fever at
+the mouth of the Rovuma, had enjoyed perfect health all the time he
+had been with us. The Portuguese are of opinion that the European
+who has immunity from this disease for any length of time after he
+enters the country is more likely to be cut off by it when it does
+come, than the man who has it frequently at first.
+
+The rains became pretty general towards the close of December, and
+the Shire was in flood in the beginning of January, 1862. At our
+wooding-place, a mile above the Ruo, the water was three feet higher
+than it was when we were here in June; and on the night of the 6th it
+rose eighteen inches more, and swept down an immense amount of
+brushwood and logs which swarmed with beetles and the two kinds of
+shells which are common all over the African continent. Natives in
+canoes were busy spearing fish in the meadows and creeks, and
+appeared to be taking them in great numbers. Spur-winged geese, and
+others of the knob-nosed species, took advantage of the low gardens
+being flooded, and came to pilfer the beans. As we passed the Ruo,
+on the 7th, and saw nothing of the Bishop, we concluded that he had
+heard from his surgeon of our detention, and had deferred his
+journey. He arrived there five days after, on the 12th.
+
+After paying our Senna men, as they wished to go home, we landed them
+here. All were keen traders, and had invested largely in native
+iron-hoes, axes, and ornaments. Many of the hoes and spears had been
+taken from the slaving parties whose captives we liberated; for on
+these occasions our Senna friends were always uncommonly zealous and
+active. The remainder had been purchased with the old clothes we had
+given them and their store of hippopotamus meat: they had no fear of
+losing them, or of being punished for aiding us. The system, in
+which they had been trained, had eradicated the idea of personal
+responsibility from their minds. The Portuguese slaveholders would
+blame the English alone, they said; they were our servants at the
+time. No white man on board could purchase so cheaply as these men
+could. Many a time had their eloquence persuaded a native trader to
+sell for a bit of dirty worn cloth things for which he had, but a
+little before, refused twice the amount of clean new calico.
+"Scissors" being troubled with a cough at night, received a present
+of a quilted coverlet, which had seen a good deal of service. A few
+days afterwards, a good chance of investing in hoes offering itself,
+he ripped off both sides, tore them into a dozen pieces, and
+purchased about a dozen hoes with them.
+
+We entered the Zambesi on the 11th of January, and steamed down
+towards the coast, taking the side on which we had come up; but the
+channel had changed to the other side during the summer, as it
+sometimes does, and we soon grounded. A Portuguese gentleman,
+formerly a lieutenant in the army, and now living on Sangwisa, one of
+the islands of the Zambesi, came over with his slaves, to aid us in
+getting the ship off. He said frankly, that his people were all
+great thieves, and we must be on our guard not to leave anything
+about. He next made a short speech to his men, told them he knew
+what thieves they were, but implored them not to steal from us, as we
+would give them a present of cloth when the work was done. "The
+natives of this country," he remarked to us, "think only of three
+things, what they shall eat and drink, how many wives they can have,
+and what they may steal from their master, if not how they may murder
+him." He always slept with a loaded musket by his side. This
+opinion may apply to slaves, but decidedly does not in our experience
+apply to freemen. We paid his men for helping us, and believe that
+even they, being paid, stole nothing from us. Our friend farms
+pretty extensively the large island called Sangwisa,--lent him for
+nothing by Senhor Ferrao,--and raises large quantities of mapira and
+beans, and also beautiful white rice, grown from seed brought a few
+years ago from South Carolina. He furnished us with some, which was
+very acceptable; for though not in absolute want, we were living on
+beans, salt pork, and fowls, all the biscuit and flour on board
+having been expended.
+
+We fully expected that the owners of the captives we had liberated
+would show their displeasure, at least by their tongues; but they
+seemed ashamed; only one ventured a remark, and he, in the course of
+common conversation, said, with a smile, "You took the Governor's
+slaves, didn't you?" "Yes, we did free several gangs that we met in
+the Manganja country." The Portuguese of Tette, from the Governor
+downwards, were extensively engaged in slaving. The trade is partly
+internal and partly external: they send some of the captives, and
+those bought, into the interior, up the Zambesi: some of these we
+actually met on their way up the river. The young women were sold
+there for ivory: an ordinary-looking one brought two arrobas, sixty-
+four pounds weight, and an extra beauty brought twice that amount.
+The men and boys were kept as carriers, to take the ivory down from
+the interior to Tette, or were retained on farms on the Zambesi,
+ready for export if a slaver should call: of this last mode of
+slaving we were witnesses also. The slaves were sent down the river
+chained, and in large canoes. This went on openly at Tette, and more
+especially so while the French "Free Emigration" system was in full
+operation. This double mode of disposing of the captives pays better
+than the single system of sending them down to the coast for
+exportation. One merchant at Tette, with whom we were well
+acquainted, sent into the interior three hundred Manganja women to be
+sold for ivory, and another sent a hundred and fifty.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI.
+
+
+
+Arrival of H.M.S. "Gorgon"--Dr. Livingstone's new steamer and Mrs.
+Livingstone--Death of Mrs. Livingstone--Voyage to Johanna and the
+Rovuma--An attack upon the "Pioneer's" boats.
+
+We anchored on the Great Luabo mouth of the Zambesi, because wood was
+much more easily obtained there than at the Kongone.
+
+On the 30th, H.M.S. "Gorgon" arrived, towing the brig which brought
+Mrs. Livingstone, some ladies about to join their relatives in the
+Universities' Mission, and the twenty-four sections of a new iron
+steamer intended for the navigation of Lake Nyassa. The "Pioneer"
+steamed out, and towed the brig into the Kongone harbour. The new
+steamer was called the "Lady of the Lake," or the "Lady Nyassa," and
+as much as could be carried of her in one trip was placed, by the
+help of the officers and men of the "Gorgon," on board the "Pioneer,"
+and the two large paddle-box boats of H.M.'s ship. We steamed off
+for Ruo on the 10th of February, having on board Captain Wilson, with
+a number of his officers and men to help us to discharge the cargo.
+Our progress up was distressingly slow. The river was in flood, and
+we had a three-knot current against us in many places. These delays
+kept us six months in the delta, instead of, as we anticipated, only
+six days; for, finding it impossible to carry the sections up to the
+Ruo without great loss of time, it was thought best to land them at
+Shupanga, and, putting the hull of the "Lady Nyassa" together there,
+to tow her up to the foot of the Murchison Cataracts.
+
+A few days before the "Pioneer" reached Shupanga, Captain Wilson,
+seeing the hopeless state of affairs, generously resolved to hasten
+with the Mission ladies up to those who, we thought, were anxiously
+awaiting their arrival, and therefore started in his gig for the Ruo,
+taking Miss Mackenzie, Mrs. Burrup, and his surgeon, Dr. Ramsay.
+They were accompanied by Dr. Kirk and Mr. Sewell, paymaster of the
+"Gorgon," in the whale-boat of the "Lady Nyassa." As our slow-paced-
+launch, "Ma Robert," had formerly gone up to the foot of the
+cataracts in nine days' steaming, it was supposed that the boats
+might easily reach the expected meeting-place at the Ruo in a week;
+but the Shire was now in flood, and in its most rapid state; and they
+were longer in getting up about half the distance, than it was hoped
+they would be in the whole navigable part of the river. They could
+hear nothing of the Bishop from the chief of the island, Malo, at the
+mouth of the Ruo. "No white man had ever come to his village," he
+said. They proceeded on to Chibisa's, suffering terribly from
+mosquitoes at night. Their toil in stemming the rapid current made
+them estimate the distance, by the windings, as nearer 300 than 200
+miles. The Makololo who had remained at Chibisa's told them the sad
+news of the death of the good Bishop and of Mr. Burrup. Other
+information received there awakened fresh anxiety on behalf of the
+survivors; so, leaving the ladies with Dr. Ramsay and the Makololo,
+Captain Wilson and Dr. Kirk went up the hills, in hopes of being able
+to render assistance, and on the way they met some of the Mission
+party at Soche's. The excessive fatigue that our friends had
+undergone in the voyage up to Chibisa's in no wise deterred them from
+this further attempt for the benefit of their countrymen, but the
+fresh labour, with diminished rations, was too much for their
+strength. They were reduced to a diet of native beans and an
+occasional fowl. Both became very ill of fever, Captain Wilson so
+dangerously that his fellow-sufferer lost all hopes of his recovery.
+His strong able-bodied cockswain did good service in cheerfully
+carrying his much-loved Commander, and they managed to return to the
+boat, and brought the two bereaved and sorrow-stricken ladies back to
+the "Pioneer."
+
+We learnt that the Bishop, wishing to find a shorter route down to
+the Shire, had sent two men to explore the country between Magomero
+and the junction of the Ruo; and in December Messrs. Proctor and
+Scudamore, with a number of Manganja carriers, left Magomero for the
+same purpose. They were to go close to Mount Choro, and then skirt
+the Elephant Marsh, with Mount Clarendon on their left. Their guides
+seem to have led them away to the east, instead of south; to the
+upper waters of the Ruo in the Shirwa valley, instead of to its
+mouth. Entering an Anguru slave-trading village, they soon began to
+suspect that the people meant mischief, and just before sunset a
+woman told some of their men that if they slept there they would all
+be killed. On their preparing to leave, the Anguru followed them and
+shot their arrows at the retreating party. Two of the carriers were
+captured, and all the goods were taken by these robbers. An arrow-
+head struck deep into the stock of Proctor's gun; and the two
+missionaries, barely escaping with their lives, swam a deep river at
+night, and returned to Magomero famished and exhausted.
+
+The wives of the captive carriers came to the Bishop day after day
+weeping and imploring him to rescue their husbands from slavery. The
+men had been caught while in his service, no one else could be
+entreated; there was no public law nor any power superior to his own,
+to which an appeal could be made; for in him Church and State were,
+in the disorganized state of the country, virtually united. It
+seemed to him to be clearly his duty to try and rescue these
+kidnapped members of the Mission family. He accordingly invited the
+veteran Makololo to go with him on this somewhat hazardous errand.
+Nothing could have been proposed to them which they would have liked
+better, and they went with alacrity to eat the sheep of the Anguru,
+only regretting that the enemy did not keep cattle as well. Had the
+matter been left entirely in their hands, they would have made a
+clean sweep of that part of the country; but the Bishop restrained
+them, and went in an open manner, thus commending the measure to all
+the natives, as one of justice. This deliberation, however, gave the
+delinquents a chance of escape.
+
+The missionaries were successful; the offending village was burned,
+and a few sheep and goats were secured which could not be considered
+other than a very mild punishment for the offence committed; the
+headman, Muana-somba, afraid to retain the prisoners any longer,
+forthwith liberated them, and they returned to their homes. This
+incident took place at the time we were at the Ruo and during the
+rains, and proved very trying to the health of the missionaries; they
+were frequently wetted, and had hardly any food but roasted maize.
+Mr. Scudamore was never well afterwards. Directly on their return to
+Magomero, the Bishop and Mr. Burrup, both suffering from diarrhoea in
+consequence of wet, hunger, and exposure, started for Chibisa's to go
+down to the Ruo by the Shire. So fully did the Bishop expect a
+renewal of the soaking wet from which he had just returned, that on
+leaving Magomero he walked through the stream. The rivulets were so
+swollen that it took five days to do a journey that would otherwise
+have occupied only two days and a half.
+
+None of the Manganja being willing to take them down the river during
+the flood, three Makololo canoe-men agreed to go with them. After
+paddling till near sunset, they decided to stop and sleep on shore;
+but the mosquitoes were so numerous that they insisted on going on
+again; the Bishop, being a week behind the time he had engaged to be
+at the Ruo, reluctantly consented, and in the darkness the canoe was
+upset in one of the strong eddies or whirlpools, which suddenly boil
+up in flood time near the outgoing branches of the river; clothing,
+medicines, tea, coffee, and sugar were all lost. Wet and weary, and
+tormented by mosquitoes, they lay in the canoe till morning dawned,
+and then proceeded to Malo, an island at the mouth of the Ruo, where
+the Bishop was at once seized with fever.
+
+Had they been in their usual health, they would doubtless have pushed
+on to Shupanga, or to the ship; but fever rapidly prostrates the
+energies, and induces a drowsy stupor, from which, if not roused by
+medicine, the patient gradually sinks into the sleep of death. Still
+mindful, however, of his office, the Bishop consoled himself by
+thinking that he might gain the friendship of the chief, which would
+be of essential service to him in his future labours. That heartless
+man, however, probably suspicious of all foreigners from the
+knowledge he had acquired of white slave-traders, wanted to turn the
+dying Bishop out of the hut, as he required it for his corn, but
+yielded to the expostulations of the Makololo. Day after day for
+three weeks did these faithful fellows remain beside his mat on the
+floor; till, without medicine or even proper food, he died. They dug
+his grave on the edge of the deep dark forest where the natives
+buried their dead. Mr. Burrup, himself far gone with dysentery,
+staggered from the hut, and, as in the dusk of evening they committed
+the Bishop's body to the grave, repeated from memory portions of our
+beautiful service for the Burial of the Dead--"earth to earth, ashes
+to ashes, dust to dust; in sure and certain hope of the resurrection
+of the dead through our Lord Jesus Christ." And in this sad way
+ended the earthly career of one, of whom it can safely be said that
+for unselfish goodness of heart, and earnest devotion to the noble
+work he had undertaken, none of the commendations of his friends can
+exceed the reality. The grave in which his body rests is about a
+hundred yards from the confluence of the Ruo, on the left bank of the
+Shire, and opposite the island of Malo. The Makololo then took Mr.
+Burrup up in the canoe as far as they could, and, making a litter of
+branches, carried him themselves, or got others to carry him, all the
+way back to his countrymen at Magomero. They hurried him on lest he
+should die in their hands, and blame be attached to them. Soon after
+his return he expired, from the disease which was on him when he
+started to meet his wife.
+
+Captain Wilson arrived at Shupanga on the 11th of March, having been
+three weeks on the Shire. On the 15th the "Pioneer" steamed down to
+the Kongone. The "Gorgon" had been driven out to sea in a gale, and
+had gone to Johanna for provisions, and it was the 2nd of April
+before she returned. It was fortunate for us that she had obtained a
+supply, as our provisions were exhausted, and we had to buy some from
+the master of the brig. The "Gorgon" left for the Cape on the 4th,
+taking all, except one, of the Mission party who had come in January.
+We take this opportunity of expressing our heartfelt gratitude to the
+gallant Captain I. C. Wilson and his officers for innumerable acts of
+kindness and hearty co-operation. Our warmest thanks are also due to
+Captain R. B. Oldfield and the other officers from the Admiral
+downwards, and we beg to assure them that nothing could be more
+encouraging to us in our difficulties and trials, than the knowledge
+that we possessed their friendship and sympathy in our labours.
+
+The Rev. James Stewart, of the Free Church of Scotland, arrived in
+the "Gorgon." He had wisely come out to inspect the country, before
+deciding on the formation of a Mission in the interior. To this
+object he devoted many months of earnest labour. This Mission was
+intended to embrace both the industrial and the religious element;
+and as the route by the Zambesi and Shire forms the only one at
+present known, with but a couple of days' land journey to the
+highlands, which stretch to an unknown distance into the continent,
+and as no jealousy was likely to be excited in the mind of a man of
+Bishop Mackenzie's enlarged views--there being moreover room for
+hundreds of Missions--we gladly extended the little aid in our power
+to an envoy from the energetic body above mentioned, but recommended
+him to examine the field with his own eyes.
+
+During our subsequent detention at Shupanga, he proceeded as far up
+the Shire as the Upper Cataracts, and saw the mere remnants of that
+dense population, which we at first had found living in peace and
+plenty, but which was now scattered and destroyed by famine and
+slave-hunting. The land, which both before and after we found so
+fair and fruitful, was burned up by a severe drought; in fact, it was
+at its very worst. With most praiseworthy energy, and in spite of
+occasional attacks of fever, he then ascended the Zambesi as far as
+Kebrabasa; and, what may be of interest to some, compared it, in
+parts, to the Danube. His estimate of the highlands would naturally
+be lower than ours. The main drawbacks in his opinion, however, were
+the slave-trade, and the power allowed the effete Portuguese of
+shutting up the country from all except a few convicts of their own
+nation. The time of his coming was inopportune; the disasters which,
+from inexperience, had befallen the Mission of the Universities, had
+a depressing effect on the minds of many at home, and rendered a new
+attempt unadvisable; though, had the Scotch perseverance and energy
+been introduced, it is highly probable that they would have reacted,
+most beneficially, on the zeal of our English brethren, and desertion
+would never have been heard of. After examining the country, Mr.
+Stewart descended the Zambesi in the beginning of the following year,
+and proceeded homewards with his report, by Mosambique and the Cape.
+
+On the 7th of April we had only one man fit for duty; all the rest
+were down with fever, or with the vile spirit secretly sold to them
+by the Portuguese officer of customs, in spite of our earnest request
+to him to refrain from the pernicious traffic.
+
+We started on the 11th for Shupanga with another load of the "Lady
+Nyassa." As we steamed up the delta, we observed many of the natives
+wearing strips of palm-leaf, the signs of sickness and mourning; for
+they too suffer from fever. This is the unhealthy season; the rains
+are over, and the hot sun draws up malaria from the decayed
+vegetation; disease seemed peculiarly severe this year. On our way
+up we met Mr. Waller, who had come from Magomero for provisions; the
+missionaries were suffering severely from want of food; the liberated
+people were starving, and dying of diarrhoea, and loathsome sores.
+The Ajawa, stimulated in their slave raids by supplies of ammunition
+and cloth from the Portuguese, had destroyed the large crops of the
+past year; a drought had followed, and little or no food could be
+bought. With his usual energy, Mr. Waller hired canoes, loaded them
+with stores, and took them up the long weary way to Chibisa's.
+Before he arrived he was informed that the Mission of the
+Universities, now deprived of its brave leader, had retired from the
+highlands down to the Low Shire Valley. This appeared to us, who
+knew the danger of leading a sedentary life, the greatest mistake
+they could have made, and was the result of no other counsel or
+responsibility than their own. Waller would have reascended at once
+to the higher altitude, but various objections stood in the way. The
+loss of poor Scudamore and Dickinson, in this low-lying situation,
+but added to the regret that the highlands had not received a fair
+trial.
+
+When the news of the Bishop's unfortunate collisions with the
+natives, and of his untimely end, reached England, much blame was
+imputed to him. The policy, which with the formal sanction of all
+his companions he had adopted, being directly contrary to the advice
+which Dr. Livingstone tendered, and to the assurances of the
+peaceable nature of the Mission which the Doctor had given to the
+natives, a friendly disapproval of a bishop's engaging in war was
+ventured on, when we met him at Chibisa's in November. But when we
+found his conduct regarded with so much bitterness in England,
+whether from a disposition to "stand by the down man," or from having
+an intimate knowledge of the peculiar circumstances of the country in
+which he was placed, or from the thorough confidence which intimacy
+caused us to repose in his genuine piety, and devout service of God,
+we came to think much more leniently of his proceedings, than his
+assailants did. He never seemed to doubt but that he had done his
+duty; and throughout he had always been supported by his associates.
+
+The question whether a Bishop, in the event of his flock being torn
+from his bosom, may make war to rescue them, requires serious
+consideration. It seems to narrow itself into whether a Christian
+man may lawfully use the civil power or the sword at all in defensive
+war, as police or otherwise. We would do almost anything to avoid a
+collision with degraded natives; but in case of an invasion--our
+blood boils at the very thought of our wives, daughters, or sisters
+being touched--we, as men with human feelings, would unhesitatingly
+fight to the death, with all the fury in our power.
+
+The good Bishop was as intensely averse to using arms, before he met
+the slave-hunters, as any man in England. In the course he pursued
+he may have made a mistake, but it is a mistake which very few
+Englishmen on meeting bands of helpless captives, or members of his
+family in bonds, would have failed to commit likewise.
+
+During unhealthy April, the fever was more severe in Shupanga and
+Mazaro than usual. We had several cases on board--they were quickly
+cured, but, from our being in the delta, as quickly returned. About
+the middle of the month Mrs. Livingstone was prostrated by this
+disease; and it was accompanied by obstinate vomiting. Nothing is
+yet known that can allay this distressing symptom, which of course
+renders medicine of no avail, as it is instantly rejected. She
+received whatever medical aid could be rendered from Dr. Kirk, but
+became unconscious, and her eyes were closed in the sleep of death as
+the sunset on the evening of the Christian Sabbath, the 27th April,
+1862. A coffin was made during the night, a grave was dug next day
+under the branches of the great baobab-tree, and with sympathizing
+hearts the little band of his countrymen assisted the bereaved
+husband in burying his dead. At his request, the Rev. James Stewart
+read the burial-service; and the seamen kindly volunteered to mount
+guard for some nights at the spot where her body rests in hope.
+Those who are not aware how this brave, good, English wife made a
+delightful home at Kolobeng, a thousand miles inland from the Cape,
+and as the daughter of Moffat and a Christian lady exercised most
+beneficial influence over the rude tribes of the interior, may wonder
+that she should have braved the dangers and toils of this down-
+trodden land. She knew them all, and, in the disinterested and
+dutiful attempt to renew her labours, was called to her rest instead.
+"Fiat, Domine, voluntas tua!"
+
+On the 5th of May Dr. Kirk and Charles Livingstone started in the
+boat for Tette, in order to see the property of the Expedition
+brought down in canoes. They took four Mazaro canoe-men to manage
+the boat, and a white sailor to cook for them; but, unfortunately, he
+caught fever the very day after leaving the ship, and was ill most of
+the trip; so they had to cook for themselves, and to take care of him
+besides.
+
+We now proceeded with preparations for the launch of the "Lady
+Nyassa." Ground was levelled on the bank at Shupanga, for the
+purpose of arranging the compartments in order: she was placed on
+palm-trees which were brought from a place lower down the river for
+ways, and the engineer and his assistants were soon busily engaged;
+about a fortnight after they were all brought from Kongone, the
+sections were screwed together. The blacks are more addicted to
+stealing where slavery exists than elsewhere. We were annoyed by
+thieves who carried off the iron screw-bolts, but were gratified to
+find that strychnine saved us from the man-thief as well as the
+hyena-thief. A hyena was killed by it, and after the natives saw the
+dead animal and knew how we had destroyed it, they concluded that it
+was not safe to steal from men who possessed a medicine so powerful.
+The half-caste, who kept Shupanga-house, said he wished to have some
+to give to the Zulus, of whom he was mortally afraid, and to whom he
+had to pay an unwilling tribute.
+
+The "Pioneer" made several trips to the Kongone, and returned with
+the last load on the 12th of June. On the 23rd the "Lady Nyassa" was
+safely launched, the work of putting her together having been
+interrupted by fever and dysentery, and many other causes which it
+would only weary the reader to narrate in detail. Natives from all
+parts of the country came to see the launch, most of them quite
+certain that, being made of iron, she must go to the bottom as soon
+as she entered the water. Earnest discussions had taken place among
+them with regard to the propriety of using iron for ship-building.
+The majority affirmed that it would never answer. They said, "If we
+put a hoe into the water, or the smallest bit of iron, it sinks
+immediately. How then can such a mass of iron float? it must go to
+the bottom." The minority answered that this might be true with
+them, but white men had medicine for everything. "They could even
+make a woman, all except the speaking; look at that one on the
+figure-head of the vessel." The unbelievers were astonished, and
+could hardly believe their eyes, when they saw the ship float lightly
+and gracefully on the river, instead of going to the bottom, as they
+so confidently predicted. "Truly," they said, "these men have
+powerful medicine."
+
+Birds are numerous on the Shupanga estate. Some kinds remain all the
+year round, while many others are there only for a few months.
+Flocks of green pigeons come in April to feed on the young fruit of
+the wild fig-trees, which is also eaten by a large species of bat in
+the evenings. The pretty little black weaver, with yellow shoulders,
+appears to enjoy life intensely after assuming his wooing dress. A
+hearty breakfast is eaten in the mornings and then come the hours for
+making merry. A select party of three or four perch on the bushes
+which skirt a small grassy plain, and cheer themselves with the music
+of their own quiet and self-complacent song. A playful performance
+on the wind succeeds. Expanding his soft velvet-like plumage, one
+glides with quivering pinions to the centre of the open space,
+singing as he flies, then turns with a rapid whirring sound from his
+wings--somewhat like a child's rattle--and returns to his place
+again. One by one the others perform the same feat, and continue the
+sport for hours, striving which can produce the loudest brattle while
+turning. These games are only played during the season of courting
+and of the gay feathers; the merriment seems never to be thought of
+while the bird wears his winter suit of sober brown.
+
+We received two mules from the Cape to aid us in transporting the
+pieces of the "Lady Nyassa" past the cataracts and landed them at
+Shupanga, but they soon perished. A Portuguese gentleman kindly
+informed us, AFTER both the mules were dead, that he knew they would
+die; for the land there had been often tried, and nothing would live
+on it--not even a pig. He said he had not told us so before, because
+he did not like to appear officious!
+
+By the time everything had been placed on board the "Lady Nyassa,"
+the waters of the Zambesi and the Shire had fallen so low that it was
+useless to attempt taking her up to the cataracts before the rains in
+December. Draught oxen and provisions also were required, and could
+not be obtained nearer than the Island of Johanna. The Portuguese,
+without refusing positively to let trade enter the Zambesi, threw
+impediments in the way; they only wanted a small duty! They were
+about to establish a river police, and rearrange the Crown lands,
+which have long since become Zulu lands; meanwhile they were making
+the Zambesi, by slaving, of no value to any one.
+
+The Rovuma, which was reported to come from Lake Nyassa, being out of
+their claims and a free river, we determined to explore it in our
+boats immediately on our return from Johanna, for which place, after
+some delay at the Kongone, in repairing engines, paddle-wheel, and
+rudder, we sailed on the 6th of August. A store of naval provisions
+had been formed on a hulk in Pomone Bay of that island for the supply
+of the cruisers, and was in charge of Mr. Sunley, the Consul, from
+whom we always received the kindest attentions and assistance. He
+now obliged us by parting with six oxen, trained for his own use in
+sugar-making. Though sadly hampered in his undertaking by being
+obliged to employ slave labour, he has by indomitable energy overcome
+obstacles under which most persons would have sunk. He has done all
+that under the circumstances could be done to infuse a desire for
+freedom, by paying regular wages; and has established a large
+factory, and brought 300 acres of rich soil under cultivation with
+sugar-cane. We trust he will realize the fortune which he so well
+deserves to earn. Had Mr. Sunley performed the same experiment on
+the mainland, where people would have flocked to him for the wages he
+now gives, he would certainly have inaugurated a new era on the East
+Coast of Africa. On a small island where the slaveholders have
+complete power over the slaves, and where there is no free soil such
+as is everywhere met with in Africa, the experiment ought not to be
+repeated. Were Mr. Sunley commencing again, it should neither be in
+Zanzibar nor Johanna, but on African soil, where, if even a slave is
+ill-treated, he can easily by flight become free. On an island under
+native rule a joint manufacture by Arabs and Englishmen might only
+mean that the latter were to escape the odium of flogging the slaves.
+
+On leaving Johanna and our oxen for a time, H.M.S. "Orestes" towed us
+thence to the mouth of the Rovuma at the beginning of September.
+Captain Gardner, her commander, and several of his officers,
+accompanied us up the river for two days in the gig and cutter. The
+water was unusually low, and it was rather dull work for a few hours
+in the morning; but the scene became livelier and more animated when
+the breeze began to blow. Our four boats they swept on under full
+sail, the men on the look out in the gig and cutter calling, "Port,
+sir!" "Starboard, sir!" "As you go, sir!" while the black men in
+the bows of the others shouted the practical equivalents, "Pagombe!
+Pagombe!" "Enda quete!" "Berane! Berane!" Presently the leading-
+boat touches on a sandbank; down comes the fluttering sail; the men
+jump out to shove her off, and the other boats, shunning the
+obstruction, shoot on ahead to be brought up each in its turn by
+mistaking a sandbank for the channel, which had often but a very
+little depth of water.
+
+A drowsy herd of hippopotami were suddenly startled by a score of
+rifle-shots, and stared in amazement at the strange objects which had
+invaded their peaceful domains, until a few more bullets compelled
+them to seek refuge at the bottom of the deep pool, near which they
+had been quietly reposing. On our return, one of the herd
+retaliated. He followed the boat, came up under it, and twice tried
+to tear the bottom out of it; but fortunately it was too flat for his
+jaws to get a good grip, so he merely damaged one of the planks with
+his tusks, though he lifted the boat right up, with ten men and a ton
+of ebony in it.
+
+We slept, one of the two nights Captain Gardner was with us, opposite
+the lakelet Chidia, which is connected with the river in flood time,
+and is nearly surrounded by hills some 500 or 600 feet high, dotted
+over with trees. A few small groups of huts stood on the hill-sides,
+with gardens off which the usual native produce had been reaped. The
+people did not seem much alarmed by the presence of the large party
+which had drawn up on the sandbanks below their dwellings. There is
+abundance of large ebony in the neighbourhood. The pretty little
+antelope (Cephalophus caeruleus), about the size of a hare, seemed to
+abound, as many of their skins were offered for sale. Neat figured
+date-leaf mats of various colours are woven here, the different dyes
+being obtained from the barks of trees. Cattle could not live on the
+banks of the Rovuma on account of the tsetse, which are found from
+near the mouth, up as far as we could take the boats. The navigation
+did not improve as we ascended; snags, brought down by the floods,
+were common, and left in the channel on the sudden subsidence of the
+water. In many places, where the river divided into two or three
+channels, there was not water enough in any of them for a boat
+drawing three feet, so we had to drag ours over the shoals; but we
+saw the river at its very lowest, and it may be years before it is so
+dried up again.
+
+The valley of the Rovuma, bounded on each side by a range of
+highlands, is from two to four miles in width, and comes in a pretty
+straight course from the W.S.W.; but the channel of the river is
+winding, and now at its lowest zigzagged so perversely, that
+frequently the boats had to pass over three miles to make one in a
+straight line. With a full stream it must of course be much easier
+work. Few natives were seen during the first week. Their villages
+are concealed in the thick jungle on the hill-sides, for protection
+from marauding slave-parties. Not much of interest was observed on
+this part of the silent and shallow river. Though feeling convinced
+that it was unfit for navigation, except for eight months of the
+year, we pushed on, resolved to see if, further inland, the accounts
+we had received from different naval officers of its great
+capabilities would prove correct; or if, by communication with Lake
+Nyassa, even the upper part could be turned to account. Our
+exploration showed us that the greatest precaution is required in
+those who visit new countries.
+
+The reports we received from gentlemen, who had entered the river and
+were well qualified to judge, were that the Rovuma was infinitely
+superior to the Zambesi, in the absence of any bar at its mouth, in
+its greater volume of water, and in the beauty of the adjacent lands.
+We probably came at a different season from that in which they
+visited it, and our account ought to be taken with theirs to arrive
+at the truth. It might be available as a highway for commerce during
+three quarters of each year; but casual visitors, like ourselves and
+others, are all ill able to decide. The absence of animal life was
+remarkable. Occasionally we saw pairs of the stately jabirus, or
+adjutant-looking marabouts, wading among the shoals, and spur-winged
+geese, and other water-fowl, but there was scarcely a crocodile or a
+hippopotamus to be seen.
+
+At the end of the first week, an old man called at our camp, and said
+he would send a present from his village, which was up among the
+hills. He appeared next morning with a number of his people,
+bringing meal, cassava-root, and yams. The language differs
+considerably from that on the Zambesi, but it is of the same family.
+The people are Makonde, and are on friendly terms with the Mabiha,
+and the Makoa, who live south of the Rovuma. When taking a walk up
+the slopes of the north bank, we found a great variety of trees we
+had seen nowhere else. Those usually met with far inland seem here
+to approach the coast. African ebony, generally named mpingu, is
+abundant within eight miles of the sea; it attains a larger size, and
+has more of the interior black wood than usual. A good timber tree
+called mosoko is also found; and we saw half-caste Arabs near the
+coast cutting up a large log of it into planks. Before reaching the
+top of the rise we were in a forest of bamboos. On the plateau
+above, large patches were cleared and cultivated. A man invited us
+to take a cup of beer; on our complying with his request, the fear
+previously shown by the bystanders vanished. Our Mazaro men could
+hardly understand what they said. Some of them waded in the river
+and caught a curious fish in holes in the claybank. Its ventral fin
+is peculiar, being unusually large, and of a circular shape, like
+boys' playthings called "suckers." We were told that this fish is
+found also in the Zambesi, and is called Chirire. Though all its
+fins are large, it is asserted that it rarely ventures out into the
+stream, but remains near its hole, where it is readily caught by the
+hand.
+
+The Zambesi men thoroughly understood the characteristic marks of
+deep or shallow water, and showed great skill in finding out the
+proper channel. The Molimo is the steersman at the helm, the
+Mokadamo is the head canoe-man, and he stands erect on the bows with
+a long pole in his hands, and directs the steersman where to go,
+aiding the rudder, if necessary, with his pole. The others preferred
+to stand and punt our boat, rather than row with our long oars, being
+able to shove her ahead faster than they could pull her. They are
+accustomed to short paddles. Our Mokadamo was affected with moon-
+blindness, and could not see at all at night. His comrades then led
+him about, and handed him his food. They thought that it was only
+because his eyes rested all night, that he could see the channel so
+well by day. At difficult places the Mokadamo sometimes, however,
+made mistakes, and ran us aground; and the others, evidently imbued
+with the spirit of resistance to constituted authority, and led by
+Joao an aspirant for the office, jeered him for his stupidity. "Was
+he asleep? Why did he allow the boat to come there? Could he not
+see the channel was somewhere else?" At last the Mokadamo threw down
+the pole in disgust, and told Joao he might be a Mokadamo himself.
+The office was accepted with alacrity; but in a few minutes he too
+ran us into a worse difficulty than his predecessor ever did, and was
+at once disrated amidst the derision of his comrades.
+
+On the 16th September, we arrived at the inhabited island of
+Kichokomane. The usual way of approaching an unknown people is to
+call out in a cheerful tone "Malonda!" Things for sale, or do you
+want to sell anything? If we can obtain a man from the last village,
+he is employed, though only useful in explaining to the next that we
+come in a friendly way. The people here were shy of us at first, and
+could not be induced to sell any food; until a woman, more
+adventurous than the rest, sold us a fowl. This opened the market,
+and crowds came with fowls and meal, far beyond our wants. The women
+are as ugly as those on Lake Nyassa, for who can be handsome wearing
+the pelele, or upper-lip ring, of large dimensions? We were once
+surprised to see young men wearing the pelele, and were told that in
+the tribe of the Mabiha, on the south bank, men as well as women wore
+them.
+
+Along the left bank, above Kichokomane, is an exceedingly fertile
+plain, nearly two miles broad, and studded with a number of deserted
+villages. The inhabitants were living in temporary huts on low naked
+sandbanks; and we found this to be the case as far as we went. They
+leave most of their property and food behind, because they are not
+afraid of these being stolen, but only fear being stolen themselves.
+The great slave-route from Nyassa to Kilwa passes to N.E. from S.W.,
+just beyond them; and it is dangerous to remain in their villages at
+this time of year, when the kidnappers are abroad. In one of the
+temporary villages, we saw, in passing, two human heads lying on the
+ground. We slept a couple of miles above this village.
+
+Before sunrise next morning, a large party armed with bows and arrows
+and muskets came to the camp, two or three of them having a fowl
+each, which we refused to purchase, having bought enough the day
+before. They followed us all the morning, and after breakfast those
+on the left bank swam across and joined the main party on the other
+side. It was evidently their intention to attack us at a chosen
+spot, where we had to pass close to a high bank, but their plan was
+frustrated by a stiff breeze sweeping the boat past, before the
+majority could get to the place. They disappeared then, but came out
+again ahead of us, on a high wooded bank, walking rapidly to the
+bend, near which we were obliged to sail. An arrow was shot at the
+foremost boat; and seeing the force at the bend, we pushed out from
+the side, as far as the shoal water would permit, and tried to bring
+them to a parley, by declaring that we had not come to fight, but to
+see the river. "Why did you fire a gun, a little while ago?" they
+asked. "We shot a large puff-adder, to prevent it from killing men;
+you may see it lying dead on the beach." With great courage, our
+Mokadamo waded to within thirty yards of the bank, and spoke with
+much earnestness, assuring them that we were a peaceable party, and
+had not come for war, but to see the river. We were friends, and our
+countrymen bought cotton and ivory, and wished to come and trade with
+them. All we wanted was to go up quietly to look at the river, and
+then return to the sea. While he was talking with those on the
+shore, the old rogue, who appeared to be the ringleader, stole up the
+bank, and with a dozen others, waded across to the island, near which
+the boats lay, and came down behind us. Wild with excitement, they
+rushed into the water, and danced in our rear, with drawn bows,
+taking aim, and making various savage gesticulations. Their leader
+urged them to get behind some snags, and then shoot at us. The party
+on the bank in front had many muskets--and those of them, who had
+bows, held them with arrows ready set in the bowstrings. They had a
+mass of thick bush and trees behind them, into which they could in a
+moment dart, after discharging their muskets and arrows, and be
+completely hidden from our sight; a circumstance that always gives
+people who use bows and arrows the greatest confidence.
+Notwithstanding these demonstrations, we were exceedingly loath to
+come to blows. We spent a full half-hour exposed at any moment to be
+struck by a bullet or poisoned arrow. We explained that we were
+better armed than they were, and had plenty of ammunition, the
+suspected want of which often inspires them with courage, but that we
+did not wish to shed the blood of the children of the same Great
+Father with ourselves; that if we must fight, the guilt would be all
+theirs.
+
+This being a common mode of expostulation among themselves, we so far
+succeeded, that with great persuasion the leader and others laid down
+their arms, and waded over from the bank to the boats to talk the
+matter over. "This was their river; they did not allow white men to
+use it. We must pay toll for leave to pass." It was somewhat
+humiliating to do so, but it was pay or fight; and, rather than
+fight, we submitted to the humiliation of paying for their
+friendship, and gave them thirty yards of cloth. They pledged
+themselves to be our friends ever afterwards, and said they would
+have food cooked for us on our return. We then hoisted sail, and
+proceeded, glad that the affair had been amicably settled. Those on
+shore walked up to the bend above to look at the boat, as we
+supposed; but the moment she was abreast of them, they gave us a
+volley of musket-balls and poisoned arrows, without a word of
+warning. Fortunately we were so near, that all the arrows passed
+clear over us, but four musket-balls went through the sail just above
+our heads. All our assailants bolted into the bushes and long grass
+the instant after firing, save two, one of whom was about to
+discharge a musket and the other an arrow, when arrested by the fire
+of the second boat. Not one of them showed their faces again, till
+we were a thousand yards away. A few shots were then fired over
+their heads, to give them an idea of the range of our rifles, and
+they all fled into the woods. Those on the sandbank rushed off too,
+with the utmost speed; but as they had not shot at us, we did not
+molest them, and they went off safely with their cloth. They
+probably expected to kill one of our number, and in the confusion rob
+the boats. It is only where the people are slavers that the natives
+of this part of Africa are bloodthirsty.
+
+These people have a bad name in the country in front, even among
+their own tribe. A slave-trading Arab we met above, thinking we were
+then on our way down the river, advised us not to land at the
+villages, but to stay in the boats, as the inhabitants were
+treacherous, and attacked at once, without any warning or
+provocation. Our experience of their conduct fully confirmed the
+truth of what he said. There was no trade on the river where they
+lived, but beyond that part there was a brisk canoe-trade in rice and
+salt; those further in the interior cultivating rice, and sending it
+down the river to be exchanged for salt, which is extracted from the
+earth in certain places on the banks. Our assailants hardly
+anticipated resistance, and told a neighbouring chief that, if they
+had known who we were, they would not have attacked English, who can
+"bite hard." They offered no molestations on our way down, though we
+were an hour in passing their village. Our canoe-men plucked up
+courage on finding that we had come off unhurt. One of them, named
+Chiku, acknowledging that he had been terribly frightened, said.
+"His fear was not the kind which makes a man jump overboard and run
+away; but that which brings the heart up to the mouth, and renders
+the man powerless, and no more able to fight than a woman."
+
+In the country of Chonga Michi, about 80 or 90 miles up the river, we
+found decent people, though of the same tribe, who treated strangers
+with civility. A body of Makoa had come from their own country in
+the south, and settled here. The Makoa are known by a cicatrice in
+the forehead shaped like the new moon with the horns turned
+downwards. The tribe possesses all the country west of Mosambique;
+and they will not allow any of the Portuguese to pass into their
+country more than two hours' distance from the fort. A hill some ten
+or twelve miles distant, called Pau, has been visited during the
+present generation only by one Portuguese and one English officer,
+and this visit was accomplished only by the influence of the private
+friendship of a chief for this Portuguese gentleman. Our allies have
+occupied the Fort of Mosambique for three hundred years, but in this,
+as in all other cases, have no power further than they can see from a
+gun-carriage.
+
+The Makoa chief, Matingula, was hospitable and communicative, telling
+us all he knew of the river and country beyond. He had been once to
+Iboe and once at Mosambique with slaves. Our men understood his
+language easily. A useless musket he had bought at one of the above
+places was offered us for a little cloth. Having received a present
+of food from him, a railway rug was handed to him: he looked at it--
+had never seen cloth like that before--did not approve of it, and
+would rather have cotton cloth. "But this will keep you warm at
+night."--"Oh, I do not wish to be kept warm at night."--We gave him a
+bit of cotton cloth, not one-third the value of the rug, but it was
+more highly prized. His people refused to sell their fowls for our
+splendid prints and drab cloths. They had probably been taken in
+with gaudy-patterned sham prints before. They preferred a very
+cheap, plain, blue stuff of which they had experience. A great
+quantity of excellent honey is collected all along the river, by bark
+hives being placed for the bees on the high trees on both banks.
+Large pots of it, very good and clear, were offered in exchange for a
+very little cloth. No wax was brought for sale; there being no
+market for this commodity, it is probably thrown away as useless.
+
+At Michi we lose the tableland which, up to this point, bounds the
+view on both sides of the river, as it were, with ranges of flat-
+topped hills, 600 or 800 feet high; and to this plateau a level
+fertile plain succeeds, on which stand detached granite hills. That
+portion of the tableland on the right bank seems to bend away to the
+south, still preserving the appearance of a hill range. The height
+opposite extends a few miles further west, and then branches off in a
+northerly direction. A few small pieces of coal were picked up on
+the sandbanks, showing that this useful mineral exists on the Rovuma,
+or on some of its tributaries: the natives know that it will burn.
+At the lakelet Chidia, we noticed the same sandstone rock, with
+fossil wood on it, which we have on the Zambesi, and knew to be a
+sure evidence of coal beneath. We mentioned this at the time to
+Captain Gardner, and our finding coal now seemed a verification of
+what we then said; the coal-field probably extends from the Zambesi
+to the Rovuma, if not beyond it. Some of the rocks lower down have
+the permanent water-line three feet above the present height of the
+water.
+
+A few miles west of the Makoa of Matingula, we came again among the
+Makonde, but now of good repute. War and slavery have driven them to
+seek refuge on the sand-banks. A venerable-looking old man hailed us
+as we passed, and asked us if we were going by without speaking. We
+landed, and he laid down his gun and came to us; he was accompanied
+by his brother, who shook hands with every one in the boat, as he had
+seen people do at Kilwa. "Then you have seen white men before?" we
+said. "Yes," replied the polite African, "but never people of your
+quality." These men were very black, and wore but little clothing.
+A young woman, dressed in the highest style of Makonde fashion,
+punting as dexterously as a man could, brought a canoe full of girls
+to see us. She wore an ornamental head-dress of red beads tied to
+her hair on one side of her head, a necklace of fine beads of various
+colours, two bright figured brass bracelets on her left arm, and
+scarcely a farthing's worth of cloth, though it was at its cheapest.
+
+As we pushed on westwards, we found that the river makes a little
+southing, and some reaches were deeper than any near the sea; but
+when we had ascended about 140 miles by the river's course from the
+sea, soft tufa rocks began to appear; ten miles beyond, the river
+became more narrow and rocky, and when, according to our measurement,
+we had ascended 156 miles, our further progress was arrested. We
+were rather less than two degrees in a straight line from the Coast.
+The incidents worth noticing were but few: seven canoes with loads
+of salt and rice kept company with us for some days, and the further
+we went inland, the more civil the people became.
+
+When we came to a stand, just below the island of Nyamatolo, Long. 38
+degrees 36 minutes E., and Lat. 11 degrees 53 minutes, the river was
+narrow, and full of rocks. Near the island there is a rocky rapid
+with narrow passages fit only for native canoes; the fall is small,
+and the banks quite low; but these rocks were an effectual barrier to
+all further progress in boats. Previous reports represented the
+navigable part of this river as extending to the distance of a
+month's sail from its mouth; we found that, at the ordinary heights
+of the water, a boat might reach the obstructions which seem peculiar
+to all African rivers in six or eight days. The Rovuma is remarkable
+for the high lands that flank it for some eighty miles from the
+ocean. The cataracts of other rivers occur in mountains, those of
+the Rovuma are found in a level part, with hills only in the
+distance. Far away in the west and north we could see high blue
+heights, probably of igneous origin from their forms, rising out of a
+plain.
+
+The distance from Ngomano, a spot thirty miles further up, to the
+Arab crossing-places of Lake Nyassa Tsenga or Kotakota was said to be
+twelve days. The way we had discovered to Lake Nyassa by Murchison's
+Cataracts had so much less land carriage, that we considered it best
+to take our steamer thither, by the route in which we were well
+known, instead of working where we were strangers; and accordingly we
+made up our minds to return.
+
+The natives reported a worse place above our turning-point--the
+passage being still narrower than this. An Arab, they said, once
+built a boat above the rapids, and sent it down full of slaves; but
+it was broken to pieces in these upper narrows. Many still
+maintained that the Rovuma came from Nyassa, and that it is very
+narrow as it issues out of the lake. One man declared that he had
+seen it with his own eyes as it left the lake, and seemed displeased
+at being cross-questioned, as if we doubted his veracity.
+
+More satisfactory information, as it appeared to us, was obtained
+from others. Two days, or thirty miles, beyond where we turned back,
+the Rovuma is joined by the Liende, which, coming from the south-
+west, rises in the mountains on the east side of Nyassa. The great
+slave route to Kilwa runs up the banks of this river, which is only
+ankle-deep at the dry season of the year. The Rovuma itself comes
+from the W.N.W., and after the traveller passes the confluence of the
+Liende at Ngomano or "meeting-place," the chief of which part is
+named Ndonde, he finds the river narrow, and the people Ajawa.
+
+Crocodiles in the Rovuma have a sorry time of it. Never before were
+reptiles so persecuted and snubbed. They are hunted with spears, and
+spring traps are set for them. If one of them enters an inviting
+pool after fish, he soon finds a fence thrown round it, and a spring
+trap set in the only path out of the enclosure. Their flesh is
+eaten, and relished. The banks, on which the female lays her eggs by
+night, are carefully searched by day, and all the eggs dug out and
+devoured. The fish-hawk makes havoc among the few young ones that
+escape their other enemies. Our men were constantly on the look-out
+for crocodiles' nests. One was found containing thirty-five newly-
+laid eggs, and they declared that the crocodile would lay as many
+more the second night in another place. The eggs were a foot deep in
+the sand on the top of a bank ten feet high. The animal digs a hole
+with its foot, covers the eggs, and leaves them till the river rises
+over the nest in about three months afterwards, when she comes back,
+and assists the young ones out. We once saw opposite Tette young
+crocodiles in December, swimming beside an island in company with an
+old one. The yolk of the egg is nearly as white as the real white.
+In taste they resemble hen's eggs with perhaps a smack of custard,
+and would be as highly relished by whites as by blacks, were it not
+for their unsavoury origin in men-eaters.
+
+Hunting the Senze (Aulacodus Swindernianus), an animal the size of a
+large cat, but in shape more like a pig, was the chief business of
+men and boys as we passed the reedy banks and low islands. They set
+fire to a mass of reeds, and, armed with sticks, spears, bows and
+arrows, stand in groups guarding the outlets through which the seared
+Senze may run from the approaching flames. Dark dense volumes of
+impenetrable smoke now roll over on the lee side of the islet, and
+shroud the hunters. At times vast sheets of lurid flames bursting
+forth, roaring, crackling and exploding, leap wildly far above the
+tall reeds. Out rush the terrified animals, and amid the smoke are
+seen the excited hunters dancing about with frantic gesticulations,
+and hurling stick, spear, and arrow at their burned out victims.
+Kites hover over the smoke, ready to pounce on the mantis and locusts
+as they spring from the fire. Small crows and hundreds of swallows
+are on eager wing, darting into the smoke and out again, seizing
+fugitive flies. Scores of insects, in their haste to escape from the
+fire, jump into the river, and the active fish enjoy a rare feast.
+
+We returned to the "Pioneer" on the 9th of October, having been away
+one month. The ship's company had used distilled water, a condenser
+having been sent out from England; and there had not been a single
+case of sickness on board since we left, though there were so many
+cases of fever the few days she lay in the same spot last year. Our
+boat party drank the water of the river, and the three white sailors,
+who had never been in an African river before, had some slight
+attacks of fever.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII.
+
+
+
+Return to the Zambesi--Bishop Mackenzie's grave--Frightful scenes
+with crocodiles--Death of Mr. Thornton--African poisons--Recall of
+the Expedition.
+
+We put to sea on the 18th of October, and, again touching at Johanna,
+obtained a crew of Johanna men and some oxen, and sailed for the
+Zambesi; but our fuel failing before we reached it, and the wind
+being contrary, we ran into Quillimane for wood.
+
+Quillimane must have been built solely for the sake of carrying on
+the slave-trade, for no man in his senses would ever have dreamed of
+placing a village on such a low, muddy, fever-haunted, and mosquito-
+swarming site, had it not been for the facilities it afforded for
+slaving. The bar may at springs and floods be easily crossed by
+sailing-vessels, but, being far from the land, it is always dangerous
+for boats. Slaves, under the name of "free emigrants," have gone by
+thousands from Quillimane, during the last six years, to the ports a
+little to the south, particularly to Massangano. Some excellent
+brick-houses still stand in the place, and the owners are generous
+and hospitable: among them our good friend, Colonel Nunez. His
+disinterested kindness to us and to all our countrymen can never be
+forgotten. He is a noble example of what energy and uprightness may
+accomplish even here. He came out as a cabin-boy, and, without a
+single friend to help him, he has persevered in an honourable course
+until he is the richest man on the East Coast. When Dr. Livingstone
+came down the Zambesi in 1856, Colonel Nunez was the chief of the
+only four honourable, trustworthy men in the country. But while he
+has risen a whole herd has sunk, making loud lamentations, through
+puffs of cigar-smoke, over negro laziness; they might add, their own.
+
+All agricultural enterprise is virtually discouraged by Quillimane
+Government. A man must purchase a permit from the Governor, when he
+wishes to visit his country farm; and this tax, in a country where
+labour is unpopular, causes the farms to be almost entirely left in
+the hands of a head slave, who makes returns to his master as
+interest or honesty prompts him. A passport must also be bought
+whenever a man wishes to go up the river to Mazaro, Senna, or Tette,
+or even to reside for a month at Quillimane. With a soil and a
+climate well suited for the growth of the cane, abundance of slave
+labour, and water communication to any market in the world, they have
+never made their own sugar. All they use is imported from Bombay.
+"The people of Quillimane have no enterprise," said a young European
+Portuguese, "they do nothing, and are always wasting their time in
+suffering, or in recovering from fever."
+
+We entered the Zambesi about the end of November and found it
+unusually low, so we did not get up to Shupanga till the 19th of
+December. The friends of our Mazaro men, who had now become good
+sailors and very attentive servants, turned out and gave them a
+hearty welcome back from the perils of the sea: they had begun to
+fear that they would never return. We hired them at a sixteen-yard
+piece of cloth a month--about ten shillings' worth, the Portuguese
+market-price of the cloth being then sevenpence halfpenny a yard,--
+and paid them five pieces each, for four-and-a-half months' work. A
+merchant at the same time paid other Mazaro men three pieces for
+seven months, and they were with him in the interior. If the
+merchants do not prosper, it is not because labour is dear, but
+because it is scarce, and because they are so eager on every occasion
+to sell the workmen out of the country. Our men had also received
+quantities of good clothes from the sailors of the "Pioneer" and of
+the "Orestes," and were now regarded by their neighbours and by
+themselves as men of importance. Never before had they possessed so
+much wealth: they believed that they might settle in life, being now
+of sufficient standing to warrant their entering the married state;
+and a wife and a hut were among their first investments. Sixteen
+yards were paid to the wife's parents, and a hut cost four yards. We
+should have liked to have kept them in the ship, for they were well-
+behaved and had learned a great deal of the work required. Though
+they would not themselves go again, they engaged others for us; and
+brought twice as many as we could take, of their brothers and
+cousins, who were eager to join the ship and go with us up the Shire,
+or anywhere else. They all agreed to take half-pay until they too
+had learned to work; and we found no scarcity of labour, though all
+that could be exported is now out of the country.
+
+There had been a drought of unusual severity during the past season
+in the country between Lupata and Kebrabasa, and it had extended
+north-east to the Manganja highlands. All the Tette slaves, except a
+very few household ones, had been driven away by hunger, and were now
+far off in the woods, and wherever wild fruit, or the prospect of
+obtaining anything whatever to keep the breath of life in them, was
+to be found. Their masters were said never to expect to see them
+again. There have been two years of great hunger at Tette since we
+have been in the country, and a famine like the present prevailed in
+1854, when thousands died of starvation. If men like the Cape
+farmers owned this country, their energy and enterprise would soon
+render the crops independent of rain. There being plenty of slope or
+fall, the land could be easily irrigated from the Zambesi and its
+tributary streams. A Portuguese colony can never prosper: it is
+used as a penal settlement, and everything must be done military
+fashion. "What do I care for this country?" said the most
+enterprising of the Tette merchants, "all I want is to make money as
+soon possible, and then go to Bombay and enjoy it." All business at
+Tette was now suspended. Carriers could not be found to take the
+goods into the interior, and the merchants could barely obtain food
+for their own families. At Mazaro more rain had fallen, and a
+tolerable crop followed. The people of Shupanga were collecting and
+drying different wild fruits, nearly all of which are far from
+palatable to a European taste. The root of a small creeper called
+"bise" is dug up and eaten. In appearance it is not unlike the small
+white sweet potato, and has a little of the flavour of our potato.
+It would be very good, if it were only a little larger. From another
+tuber, called "ulanga," very good starch can be made. A few miles
+from Shupanga there is an abundance of large game, but the people
+here, though fond enough of meat, are not a hunting race, and seldom
+kill any.
+
+The Shire having risen, we steamed off on the 10th of January, 1863,
+with the "Lady Nyassa" in tow. It was not long before we came upon
+the ravages of the notorious Mariano. The survivors of a small
+hamlet, at the foot of Morambala, were in a state of starvation,
+having lost their food by one of his marauding parties. The women
+were in the fields collecting insects, roots, wild fruits, and
+whatever could be eaten, in order to drag on their lives, if
+possible, till the next crop should be ripe. Two canoes passed us,
+that had been robbed by Mariano's band of everything they had in
+them; the owners were gathering palm-nuts for their subsistence.
+They wore palm-leaf aprons, as the robbers had stripped them of their
+clothing and ornaments. Dead bodies floated past us daily, and in
+the mornings the paddles had to be cleared of corpses, caught by the
+floats during the night. For scores of miles the entire population
+of the valley was swept away by this scourge Mariano, who is again,
+as he was before, the great Portuguese slave-agent. It made the
+heart ache to see the widespread desolation; the river-banks, once so
+populous, all silent; the villages burned down, and an oppressive
+stillness reigning where formerly crowds of eager sellers appeared
+with the various products of their industry. Here and there might be
+seen on the bank a small dreary deserted shed, where had sat, day
+after day, a starving fisherman, until the rising waters drove the
+fish from their wonted haunts, and left him to die. Tingane had been
+defeated; his people had been killed, kidnapped, and forced to flee
+from their villages. There were a few wretched survivors in a
+village above the Ruo; but the majority of the population was dead.
+The sight and smell of dead bodies was everywhere. Many skeletons
+lay beside the path, where in their weakness they had fallen and
+expired. Ghastly living forms of boys and girls, with dull dead
+eyes, were crouching beside some of the huts. A few more miserable
+days of their terrible hunger, and they would be with the dead.
+
+Oppressed with the shocking scenes around, we visited the Bishop's
+grave; and though it matters little where a good Christian's ashes
+rest, yet it was with sadness that we thought over the hopes which
+had clustered around him, as he left the classic grounds of
+Cambridge, all now buried in this wild place. How it would have torn
+his kindly heart to witness the sights we now were forced to see!
+
+In giving vent to the natural feelings of regret, that a man so
+eminently endowed and learned, as was Bishop Mackenzie, should have
+been so soon cut off, some have expressed an opinion that it was
+wrong to use an instrument so valuable MERELY to convert the heathen.
+If the attempt is to be made at all, it is "penny wise and pound
+foolish" to employ any but the very best men, and those who are
+specially educated for the work. An ordinary clergyman, however well
+suited for a parish, will not, without special training, make a
+Missionary; and as to their comparative usefulness, it is like that
+of the man who builds an hospital, as compared with that of the
+surgeon who in after years only administers for a time the remedies
+which the founder had provided in perpetuity. Had the Bishop
+succeeded in introducing Christianity, his converts might have been
+few, but they would have formed a continuous roll for all time to
+come.
+
+The Shire fell two feet, before we reached the shallow crossing where
+we had formerly such difficulty, and we had now two ships to take up.
+A hippopotamus was shot two miles above a bank on which the ship lay
+a fortnight: it floated in three hours. As the boat was towing it
+down, the crocodiles were attracted by the dead beast, and several
+shots had to be fired to keep them off. The bullet had not entered
+the brain of the animal, but driven a splinter of bone into it. A
+little moisture with some gas issued from the wound, and this was all
+that could tell the crocodiles down the stream of a dead
+hippopotamus; and yet they came up from miles below. Their sense of
+smell must be as acute as their hearing; both are quite
+extraordinary. Dozens fed on the meat we left. Our Krooman, Jumbo,
+used to assert that the crocodile never eats fresh meat, but always
+keeps it till it is high and tender--and the stronger it smells the
+better he likes it. There seems to be some truth in this. They can
+swallow but small pieces at a time, and find it difficult to tear
+fresh meat. In the act of swallowing, which is like that of a dog,
+the head is raised out of the water. We tried to catch some, and one
+was soon hooked; it required half-a-dozen hands to haul him up the
+river, and the shark-hook straightened, and he got away. A large
+iron hook was next made, but, as the creatures could not swallow it,
+their jaws soon pressed it straight--and our crocodile-fishing was a
+failure. As one might expect,--from the power even of a salmon--the
+tug of a crocodile was terribly strong.
+
+The corpse of a boy floated past the ship; a monstrous crocodile
+rushed at it with the speed of a greyhound, caught it and shook it,
+as a terrier dog does a rat. Others dashed at the prey, each with
+his powerful tail causing the water to churn and froth, as he
+furiously tore off a piece. In a few seconds it was all gone. The
+sight was frightful to behold. The Shire swarmed with crocodiles; we
+counted sixty-seven of these repulsive reptiles on a single bank, but
+they are not as fierce as they are in some rivers. "Crocodiles,"
+says Captain Tuckey, "are so plentiful in the Congo, near the rapids,
+and so frequently carry off the women, who at daylight go down to the
+river for water, that, while they are filling their calabashes, one
+of the party is usually employed in throwing large stones into the
+water outside." Here, either a calabash on a long pole is used in
+drawing water, or a fence is planted. The natives eat the crocodile,
+but to us the idea of tasting the musky-scented, fishy-looking flesh
+carried the idea of cannibalism. Humboldt remarks, that in South
+America the alligators of some rivers are more dangerous than in
+others. Alligators differ from crocodiles in the fourth or canine
+tooth going into a hole or socket in the upper jaw, while in the
+crocodile it fits into a notch. The forefoot of the crocodile has
+five toes not webbed, the hindfoot has four toes which are webbed; in
+the alligator the web is altogether wanting. They are so much alike
+that they would no doubt breed together.
+
+One of the crocodiles which was shot had a piece snapped off the end
+of his tail, another had lost a forefoot in fighting; we saw actual
+leeches between the teeth, such as are mentioned by Herodotus, but we
+never witnessed the plover picking them out. Their greater
+fierceness in one part of the country than another is doubtless owing
+to a scarcity of fish; in fact, Captain Tuckey says, of that part of
+the Congo, mentioned above, "There are no fish here but catfish," and
+we found that the lake crocodiles, living in clear water, and with
+plenty of fish, scarcely ever attacked man. The Shire teems with
+fish of many different kinds. The only time, as already remarked,
+when its crocodiles are particularly to be dreaded, is when the river
+is in flood. Then the fish are driven from their usual haunts, and
+no game comes down to the river to drink, water being abundant in
+pools inland. Hunger now impels the crocodile to lie in wait for the
+women who come to draw water, and on the Zambesi numbers are carried
+off every year. The danger is not so great at other seasons; though
+it is never safe to bathe, or to stoop to drink, where one cannot see
+the bottom, especially in the evening. One of the Makololo ran down
+in the dusk of the river; and, as he was busy tossing the water to
+his mouth with his hand, in the manner peculiar to the natives, a
+crocodile rose suddenly from the bottom, and caught him by the hand.
+The limb of a tree was fortunately within reach, and he had presence
+of mind to lay hold of it. Both tugged and pulled; the crocodile for
+his dinner, and the man for dear life. For a time it appeared
+doubtful whether a dinner or a life was to be sacrificed; but the man
+held on, and the monster let the hand go, leaving the deep marks of
+his ugly teeth in it.
+
+During our detention, in expectation of the permanent rise of the
+river in March, Dr. Kirk and Mr. C. Livingstone collected numbers of
+the wading-birds of the marshes--and made pleasant additions to our
+salted provisions, in geese, ducks, and hippopotamus flesh. One of
+the comb or knob-nosed geese, on being strangled in order to have its
+skin preserved without injury, continued to breathe audibly by the
+broken humerus, or wing-bone, and other means had to be adopted to
+put it out of pain. This was as if a man on the gallows were to
+continue to breathe by a broken armbone, and afforded us an
+illustration of the fact, that in birds, the vital air penetrates
+every part of the interior of their bodies. The breath passes
+through and round about the lungs--bathes the surfaces of the
+viscera, and enters the cavities of the bones; it even penetrates
+into some spaces between the muscles of the neck--and thus not only
+is the most perfect oxygenation of the blood secured, but, the
+temperature of the blood being very high, the air in every part is
+rarefied, and the great lightness and vigour provided for, that the
+habits of birds require. Several birds were found by Dr. Kirk to
+have marrow in the tibiae, though these bones are generally described
+as hollow.
+
+During the period of our detention on the shallow part of the river
+in March, Mr. Thornton came up to us from Shupanga: he had, as
+before narrated, left the Expedition in 1859, and joined Baron van
+der Decken, in the journey to Kilimanjaro, when, by an ascent of the
+mountain to the height of 8000 feet, it was first proved to be
+covered with perpetual snow, and the previous information respecting
+it, given by the Church of England Missionaries, Krapf and Rebman,
+confirmed. It is now well known that the Baron subsequently ascended
+the Kilimanjaro to 14,000 feet, and ascertained its highest peak to
+be at least 20,000 feet above the sea. Mr. Thornton made the map of
+the first journey, at Shupanga, from materials collected when with
+the Baron; and when that work was accomplished, followed us. He was
+then directed to examine geologically the Cataract district, but not
+to expose himself to contact with the Ajawa until the feelings of
+that tribe should be ascertained.
+
+The members of Bishop Mackenzie's party, on the loss of their head,
+fell back from Magomero on the highlands, to Chibisa's, in the low-
+lying Shire Valley; and Thornton, finding them suffering from want of
+animal food, kindly volunteered to go across thence to Tette, and
+bring a supply of goats and sheep. We were not aware of this step,
+to which the generosity of his nature prompted him, till two days
+after he had started. In addition to securing supplies for the
+Universities' Mission, he brought some for the Expedition, and took
+bearings, by which he hoped to connect his former work at Tette with
+the mountains in the Shire district. The toil of this journey was
+too much for his strength, as with the addition of great scarcity of
+water, it had been for that of Dr. Kirk and Rae, and he returned in a
+sadly haggard and exhausted condition; diarrhoea supervened, and that
+ended in dysentery and fever, which terminated fatally on the 21st of
+April, 1863. He received the unremitting attentions of Dr. Kirk, and
+Dr. Meller, surgeon of the "Pioneer," during the fortnight of his
+illness; and as he had suffered very little from fever, or any other
+disease, in Africa, we had entertained strong hopes that his youth
+and unimpaired constitution would have carried him through. During
+the night of the 20th his mind wandered so much, that we could not
+ascertain his last wishes; and on the morning of the 21st, to our
+great sorrow, he died. He was buried on the 22nd, near a large tree
+on the right bank of the Shire, about five hundred yards from the
+lowest of the Murchison Cataracts--and close to a rivulet, at which
+the "Lady Nyassa" and "Pioneer" lay.
+
+No words can convey an adequate idea of the scene of widespread
+desolation which the once pleasant Shire Valley now presented.
+Instead of smiling villages and crowds of people coming with things
+for sale, scarcely a soul was to be seen; and, when by chance one
+lighted on a native, his frame bore the impress of hunger, and his
+countenance the look of a cringing broken-spiritedness. A drought
+had visited the land after the slave-hunting panic swept over it.
+Had it been possible to conceive the thorough depopulation which had
+ensued, we should have avoided coming up the river. Large masses of
+the people had fled down to the Shire, only anxious to get the river
+between them and their enemies. Most of the food had been left
+behind; and famine and starvation had cut off so many, that the
+remainder were too few to bury the dead. The corpses we saw floating
+down the river were only a remnant of those that had perished, whom
+their friends, from weakness, could not bury, nor over-gorged
+crocodiles devour. It is true that famine caused a great portion of
+this waste of human life: but the slave-trade must be deemed the
+chief agent in the ruin, because, as we were informed, in former
+droughts all the people flocked from the hills down to the marshes,
+which are capable of yielding crops of maize in less than three
+months, at any time of the year, and now they were afraid to do so.
+A few, encouraged by the Mission in the attempt to cultivate, had
+their little patches robbed as successive swarms of fugitives came
+from the hills. Who can blame these outcasts from house and home for
+stealing to save their wretched lives, or wonder that the owners
+protected the little all, on which their own lives depended, with
+club and spear? We were informed by Mr. Waller of the dreadful
+blight which had befallen the once smiling Shire Valley. His words,
+though strong, failed to impress us with the reality. In fact, they
+were received, as some may accept our own, as tinged with
+exaggeration; but when our eyes beheld the last mere driblets of this
+cup of woe, we for the first time felt that the enormous wrongs
+inflicted on our fellow-men by slaving are beyond exaggeration.
+
+Wherever we took a walk, human skeletons were seen in every
+direction, and it was painfully interesting to observe the different
+postures in which the poor wretches had breathed their last. A whole
+heap had been thrown down a slope behind a village, where the
+fugitives often crossed the river from the east; and in one hut of
+the same village no fewer than twenty drums had been collected,
+probably the ferryman's fees. Many had ended their misery under
+shady trees--others under projecting crags in the hills--while others
+lay in their huts, with closed doors, which when opened disclosed the
+mouldering corpse with the poor rags round the loins--the skull
+fallen off the pillow--the little skeleton of the child, that had
+perished first, rolled up in a mat between two large skeletons. The
+sight of this desert, but eighteen months ago a well peopled valley,
+now literally strewn with human bones, forced the conviction upon us,
+that the destruction of human life in the middle passage, however
+great, constitutes but a small portion of the waste, and made us feel
+that unless the slave-trade--that monster iniquity, which has so long
+brooded over Africa--is put down, lawful commerce cannot be
+established.
+
+We believed that, if it were possible to get a steamer upon the Lake,
+we could by her means put a check on the slavers from the East Coast;
+and aid more effectually still in the suppression of the slave-trade,
+by introducing, by way of the Rovuma, a lawful traffic in ivory. We
+therefore unscrewed the "Lady Nyassa" at a rivulet about five hundred
+yards below the first cataract, and began to make a road over the
+thirty-five or forty miles of land portage, by which to carry her up
+piecemeal. After mature consideration, we could not imagine a more
+noble work of benevolence, than thus to introduce light and liberty
+into a quarter of this fair earth, which human lust has converted
+into the nearest possible resemblance of what we conceive the
+infernal regions to be--and we sacrificed much of our private
+resources as an offering for the promotion of so good a cause.
+
+The chief part of the labour of road-making consisted in cutting down
+trees and removing stones. The country being covered with open
+forest, a small tree had to be cut about every fifty or sixty yards.
+The land near the river was so very much intersected by ravines, that
+search had to be made, a mile from its banks, for more level ground.
+Experienced Hottentot drivers would have taken Cape wagons without
+any other trouble than that of occasionally cutting down a tree. No
+tsetse infested this district, and the cattle brought from Johanna
+flourished on the abundant pasture. The first half-mile of road led
+up, by a gradual slope, to an altitude of two hundred feet above the
+ship, and a sensible difference of climate was felt even there. For
+the remainder of the distance the height increased,--till, at the
+uppermost cataract, we were more than 1200 feet above the sea. The
+country here, having recovered from the effects of the drought, was
+bright with young green woodland, and mountains of the same
+refreshing hue. But the absence of the crowds, which had attended us
+as we carried up the boat, when the women followed us for miles with
+fine meal, vegetables, and fat fowls for sale, and the boys were ever
+ready for a little job--and the oppressive stillness bore heavily on
+our spirits. The Portuguese of Tette had very effectually removed
+our labourers. Not an ounce of fresh provisions could be obtained,
+except what could be shot, and even the food for our native crew had
+to be brought one hundred and fifty miles from the Zambesi.
+
+The diet of salt provisions and preserved meats without vegetables,
+with the depression of spirits caused by seeing how effectually a few
+wretched convicts, aided by the connivance of officials, of whom
+better might have been hoped, could counteract our best efforts, and
+turn intended good to certain evil, brought on attacks of dysentery,
+which went the round of the Expedition--and, Dr. Kirk and Charles
+Livingstone having suffered most severely, it was deemed advisable
+that they should go home. This measure was necessary, though much to
+the regret of all--for having done so much, they were naturally
+anxious to be present, when, by the establishing ourselves on the
+Lake, all our efforts should be crowned with success. After it had
+been decided that these two officers, and all the whites who could be
+spared, should be sent down to the sea for a passage to England, Dr.
+Livingstone was seized in May with a severe attack of dysentery,
+which continued for a month, and reduced him to a shadow. Dr. Kirk
+kindly remained in attendance till the worst was passed. The parting
+took place on the 19th of May.
+
+After a few miles of road were completed, and the oxen broken in, we
+resolved to try and render ourselves independent of the south for
+fresh provisions, by going in a boat up the Shire, above the
+Cataracts, to the tribes at the foot of Lake Nyassa, who were still
+untouched by the Ajawa invasion. In furtherance of this plan Dr.
+Livingstone and Mr. Rae determined to walk up to examine, and, if
+need be, mend the boat which had been left two seasons previously
+hung up to the limb of a large shady tree, before attempting to carry
+another past the Cataracts. The "Pioneer," which was to be left in
+charge of our active and most trustworthy gunner, Mr. Edward D.
+Young, R.N., was thoroughly roofed over with euphorbia branches and
+grass, so as completely to protect her decks from the sun: she also
+received daily a due amount of man-of-war scrubbing and washing; and,
+besides having everything put in shipshape fashion, was every evening
+swung out into the middle of the river, for the sake of the greater
+amount of air which circulated there. In addition to their daily
+routine work of the ship, the three stokers, one sailor, and one
+carpenter--now our complement--were encouraged to hunt for guinea-
+fowl, which in June, when the water inland is dried up, come in large
+flocks to the river's banks, and roost on the trees at night.
+Everything that can be done to keep mind and body employed tends to
+prevent fever.
+
+While we were employed in these operations, some of the poor starved
+people about had been in the habit of crossing the river, and reaping
+the self-sown mapira, in the old gardens of their countrymen. In the
+afternoon of the 9th, a canoe came floating down empty, and shortly
+after a woman was seen swimming near the other side, which was about
+two hundred yards distant from us. Our native crew manned the boat,
+and rescued her; when brought on board, she was found to have an
+arrow-head, eight or ten inches long, in her back, below the ribs,
+and slanting up through the diaphragm and left lung, towards the
+heart--she had been shot from behind when stooping. Air was coming
+out of the wound, and, there being but an inch of the barbed arrow-
+head visible, it was thought better not to run the risk of her dying
+under the operation necessary for its removal; so we carried her up
+to her own hut. One of her relatives was less scrupulous, for he cut
+out the arrow and part of the lung. Mr. Young sent her occasionally
+portions of native corn, and strange to say found that she not only
+became well, but stout. The constitution of these people seems to
+have a wonderful power of self-repair--and it could be no slight
+privation which had cut off the many thousands that we saw dead
+around us.
+
+We regretted that, in consequence of Dr. Meller having now sole
+medical charge, we could not have his company in our projected trip;
+but he found employment in botany and natural history, after the
+annual sickly season of March, April, and May was over; and his
+constant presence was not so much required at the ship. Later in the
+year, when he could be well spared, he went down the river to take up
+an appointment he had been offered in Madagascar; but unfortunately
+was so severely tried by illness while detained at the coast, that
+for nearly two years he was not able to turn his abilities as a
+naturalist to account by proceeding to that island. We have no doubt
+but he will yet distinguish himself in that untrodden field.
+
+On the 16th of June we started for the Upper Cataracts, with a mule-
+cart, our road lying a distance of a mile west from the river. We
+saw many of the deserted dwellings of the people who formerly came to
+us; and were very much struck by the extent of land under
+cultivation, though that, compared with the whole country, is very
+small. Large patches of mapira continued to grow,--as it is said it
+does from the roots for three years. The mapira was mixed with tall
+bushes of the Congo-bean, castor-oil plants, and cotton. The largest
+patch of this kind we paced, and found it to be six hundred and
+thirty paces on one side--the rest were from one acre to three, and
+many not more than one-third of an acre. The cotton--of very
+superior quality--was now dropping off the bushes, to be left to rot-
+-there was no one to gather what would have been of so much value in
+Lancashire. The huts, in the different villages we entered, were
+standing quite perfect. The mortars for pounding corn--the stones
+for grinding it--the water and beer pots--the empty corn-safes and
+kitchen utensils, were all untouched; and most of the doors were
+shut, as if the starving owners had gone out to wander in search of
+roots or fruits in the forest, and had never returned. When opened,
+several huts revealed a ghastly sight of human skeletons. Some were
+seen in such unnatural positions, as to give the idea that they had
+expired in a faint, when trying to reach something to allay the
+gnawings of hunger.
+
+We took several of the men as far as the Mukuru-Madse for the sake of
+the change of air and for occupation, and also to secure for the
+ships a supply of buffalo meat--as those animals were reported to be
+in abundance on that stream. But though it was evident from the
+tracks that the report was true, it was impossible to get a glimpse
+of them. The grass being taller than we were, and pretty thickly
+planted, they always knew of our approach before we saw them. And
+the first intimation we had of their being near was the sound they
+made in rushing over the stones, breaking the branches, and knocking
+their horns against each other. Once, when seeking a ford for the
+cart, at sunrise, we saw a herd slowly wending up the hill-side from
+the water. Sending for a rifle, and stalking with intense eagerness
+for a fat beefsteak, instead of our usual fare of salted provisions,
+we got so near that we could hear the bulls uttering their hoarse
+deep low, but could see nothing except the mass of yellow grass in
+front; suddenly the buffalo-birds sounded their alarm-whistle, and
+away dashed the troop, and we got sight of neither birds nor beasts.
+This would be no country for a sportsman except when the grass is
+short. The animals are wary, from the dread they have of the
+poisoned arrows. Those of the natives who do hunt are deeply imbued
+with the hunting spirit, and follow the game with a stealthy
+perseverance and cunning, quite extraordinary. The arrow making no
+noise, the herd is followed up until the poison takes effect, and the
+wounded animal falls out. It is then patiently watched till it
+drops--a portion of meat round the wound is cut away, and all the
+rest eaten.
+
+Poisoned arrows are made in two pieces. An iron barb is firmly
+fastened to one end of a small wand of wood, ten inches or a foot
+long, the other end of which, fined down to a long point, is nicely
+fitted, though not otherwise secured, in the hollow of the reed,
+which forms the arrow shaft. The wood immediately below the iron
+head is smeared with the poison. When the arrow is shot into an
+animal, the reed either falls to the ground at once, or is very soon
+brushed off by the bushes; but the iron barb and poisoned upper part
+of the wood remain in the wound. If made in one piece, the arrow
+would often be torn out, head and all, by the long shaft catching in
+the underwood, or striking against trees. The poison used here, and
+called kombi, is obtained from a species of strophanthus, and is very
+virulent. Dr. Kirk found by an accidental experiment on himself that
+it acts by lowering the pulse. In using his tooth-brush, which had
+been in a pocket containing a little of the poison, he noticed a
+bitter taste, but attributed it to his having sometimes used, the
+handle in taking quinine. Though the quantity was small, it
+immediately showed its power by lowering his pulse which at the time
+had been raised by a cold, and next day he was perfectly restored.
+Not much can be inferred from a single case of this kind, but it is
+possible that the kombi may turn out a valuable remedy; and as
+Professor Sharpey has conducted a series of experiments with this
+substance, we look with interest for the results. An alkaloid has
+been obtained from it similar to strychnine. There is no doubt that
+all kinds of wild animals die from the effects of poisoned arrows,
+except the elephant and hippopotamus. The amount of poison that this
+little weapon can convey into their systems being too small to kill
+those huge beasts, the hunters resort to the beam trap instead.
+
+Another kind of poison was met with on Lake Nyassa, which was said to
+be used exclusively for killing men. It was put on small wooden
+arrow-heads, and carefully protected by a piece of maize-leaf tied
+round it. It caused numbness of the tongue when the smallest
+particle was tasted. The Bushmen of the northern part of the
+Kalahari were seen applying the entrails of a small caterpillar which
+they termed 'Nga to their arrows. This venom was declared to be so
+powerful in producing delirium, that a man in dying returned in
+imagination to a state of infancy, and would call for his mother's
+breast. Lions when shot with it are said to perish in agonies. The
+poisonous ingredient in this case may be derived from the plant on
+which the caterpillar feeds. It is difficult to conceive by what
+sort of experiments the properties of these poisons, known for
+generations, were proved. Probably the animal instincts, which have
+become so obtuse by civilization, that children in England eat the
+berries of the deadly nightshade (Atropa belladonna) without
+suspicion, were in the early uncivilized state much more keen. In
+some points instinct is still retained among savages. It is related
+that in the celebrated voyage of the French navigator, Bougainville,
+a young lady, who had assumed the male attire, performed all the hard
+duties incident to the calling of a common sailor; and, even as
+servant to the geologist, carried a bag of stones and specimens over
+hills and dales without a complaint, and without having her sex
+suspected by her associates; but on landing among the savages of one
+of the South Sea Islands, she was instantly recognized as a female.
+They began to show their impressions in a way that compelled her to
+confess her sex, and throw herself on the protection of the
+commander, which of course was granted. In like manner, the earlier
+portions of the human family may have had their instincts as to
+plants more highly developed than any of their descendants--if indeed
+much more knowledge than we usually suppose be not the effect of
+direct revelation from above.
+
+The Mukuru-Madse has a deep rocky bed. The water is generally about
+four feet deep, and fifteen or twenty yards broad. Before reaching
+it, we passed five or six gullies; but beyond it the country, for two
+or three miles from the river, was comparatively smooth. The long
+grass was overrunning all the native paths, and one species (sanu),
+which has a sharp barbed seed a quarter of an inch in length, enters
+every pore of woollen clothing and highly irritates the skin. From
+its hard, sharp point a series of minute barbs are laid back, and
+give the seed a hold wherever it enters: the slightest touch gives
+it an entering motion, and the little hooks prevent its working out.
+These seeds are so abundant in some spots, that the inside of the
+stocking becomes worse than the roughest hair shirt. It is, however,
+an excellent self-sower, and fine fodder; it rises to the height of
+common meadow-grass in England, and would be a capital plant for
+spreading over a new country not so abundantly supplied with grasses
+as this is.
+
+We have sometimes noticed two or three leaves together pierced
+through by these seeds, and thus made, as it were, into wings to
+carry them to any soil suited to their growth.
+
+We always follow the native paths, though they are generally not more
+than fifteen inches broad, and so often have deep little holes in
+them, made for the purpose of setting traps for small animals, and
+are so much obscured by the long grass, that one has to keep one's
+eyes on the ground more than is pleasant. In spite, however, of all
+drawbacks, it is vastly more easy to travel on these tracks than to
+go straight over uncultivated ground, or virgin forest. A path
+usually leads to some village, though sometimes it turns out to be a
+mere game track leading nowhere.
+
+In going north, we came into a part called Mpemba where Chibisa was
+owned as chief, but the people did not know that he had been
+assassinated by the Portuguese Terera. A great deal of grain was
+lying round the hut, where we spent the night. Very large numbers of
+turtledoves feasted undisturbed on the tall stalked mapira ears, and
+we easily secured plenty of fine fat guinea-fowls--now allowed to
+feed leisurely in the deserted gardens. The reason assigned for all
+this listless improvidence was "There are no women to grind the corn-
+-all are dead."
+
+The cotton patches in all cases seemed to have been so well cared
+for, and kept so free of weeds formerly, that, though now untended,
+but few weeds had sprung up; and the bushes were thus preserved in
+the annual grass burnings. Many baobab-trees grow in different
+spots, and the few people seen were using the white pulp found
+between the seeds to make a pleasant subacid drink.
+
+On passing Malango, near the uppermost cataract, not a soul was to be
+seen; but, as we rested opposite a beautiful tree-covered island, the
+merry voices of children at play fell on our ears--the parents had
+fled thither for protection from the slave-hunting Ajawa, still urged
+on by the occasional visits of the Portuguese agents from Tette. The
+Ajawa, instead of passing below the Cataracts, now avoided us, and
+crossed over to the east side near to the tree on which we had hung
+the boat. Those of the Manganja, to whom we could make ourselves
+known, readily came to us; but the majority had lost all confidence
+in themselves, in each other, and in every one else. The boat had
+been burned about three months previously, and the Manganja were very
+anxious that we should believe that this had been the act of the
+Ajawa; but on scanning the spot we saw that it was more likely to
+have caught fire in the grass-burning of the country. Had we
+intended to be so long in returning to it, we should have hoisted it
+bottom upwards; for, as it was, it is probable that a quantity of
+dried leaves lay inside, and a spark ignited the whole. All the
+trees within fifty yards were scorched and killed, and the nails,
+iron, and copper sheathing, all lay undisturbed beneath. Had the
+Ajawa done the deed, they would have taken away the copper and iron.
+
+Our hopes of rendering ourselves independent of the south for
+provisions, by means of this boat, being thus disappointed, we turned
+back with the intention of carrying another up to the same spot; and,
+in order to find level ground for this, we passed across from the
+Shire at Malango to the upper part of the stream Lesungwe. A fine,
+active, intelligent fellow, called Pekila, guided us, and was
+remarkable as almost the only one of the population left with any
+spirit in him. The depressing effect which the slave-hunting scourge
+has upon the native mind, though little to be wondered at, is sad,
+very sad to witness. Musical instruments, mats, pillows, mortars for
+pounding meal, were lying about unused, and becoming the prey of the
+white ants. With all their little comforts destroyed, the survivors
+were thrown still further back into barbarism.
+
+It is of little importance perhaps to any but travellers to notice
+that in occupying one night a well-built hut, which had been shut up
+for some time, the air inside at once gave us a chill, and an attack
+of fever; both of which vanished when the place was well-ventilated
+by means of a fire. We have frequently observed that lighting a fire
+early in the mornings, even in the hottest time of the year, gives
+freshness to the whole house, and removes that feeling of closeness
+and langour, which a hot climate induces.
+
+On the night of the 1st July, 1863, several loud peals of thunder
+awoke us; the moon was shining brightly, and not a cloud to be seen.
+All the natives remarked on the clearness of the sky at the time, and
+next morning said, "We thought it was God" (Morungo).
+
+On arriving at the ship on the 2nd July, we found a despatch from
+Earl Russell, containing instructions for the withdrawal of the
+Expedition. The devastation caused by slave-hunting and famine lay
+all around. The labour had been as completely swept away from the
+Great Shire Valley, as it had been from the Zambesi, wherever
+Portuguese intrigue or power extended. The continual forays of
+Mariano had spread ruin and desolation on our south-east as far as
+Mount Clarendon.
+
+While this was going on in our rear, the Tette slave-hunters from the
+West had stimulated the Ajawa to sweep all the Manganja off the hills
+on our East; and slaving parties for this purpose were still passing
+the Shire above the Cataracts. In addition to the confession of the
+Governor of Tette, of an intention to go on with this slaving in
+accordance with the counsel of his elder brother at Mosambique, we
+had reason to believe that slavery went on under the eye of his
+Excellency, the Governor-General himself; and this was subsequently
+corroborated by our recognizing two women at Mosambique who had lived
+within a hundred yards of the Mission-station at Magomero. They were
+well known to our attendants, and had formed a part of a gang of
+several hundreds taken to Mosambique by the Ajawa at the very time
+when his Excellency was entertaining English officers with anti-
+slavery palavers. To any one who understands how minute the
+information is, which Portuguese governors possess by means of their
+own slaves, and through gossiping traders who seek to curry their
+favour, it is idle to assert that all this slaving goes on without
+their approval and connivance.
+
+If more had been wanted to prove the hopelessness of producing any
+change in the system which has prevailed ever since our allies, the
+Portuguese, entered the country, we had it in the impunity with which
+the freebooter, Terera, who had murdered Chibisa, was allowed to
+carry on his forays. Belchoir, another marauder, had been checked,
+but was still allowed to make war, as they term slave-hunting.
+
+Mr. Horace Waller was living for some five months on Mount Morambala,
+a position from which the whole process of the slave-trade, and
+depopulation of the country around could be well noted. The mountain
+overlooks the Shire, the beautiful meanderings of which are
+distinctly seen, on clear days, for thirty miles. This river was for
+some time supposed to be closed against Mariano, who, as a mere
+matter of form, was declared a rebel against the Portuguese flag.
+When, however, it became no longer possible to keep up the sham, the
+river was thrown open to him; and Mr. Waller has seen in a single day
+from fifteen to twenty canoes of different sizes going down, laden
+with slaves, to the Portuguese settlements from the so-called rebel
+camp. These cargoes were composed entirely of women and children.
+For three months this traffic was incessant, and at last, so
+completely was the mask thrown off, that one of the officials came to
+pay a visit to Bishop Tozer on another part of the same mountain,
+and, combining business with pleasure, collected payment for some
+canoe work done for the Missionary party, and with this purchased
+slaves from the rebels, who had only to be hailed from the bank of
+the river. When he had concluded the bargain he trotted the slaves
+out for inspection in Mr. Waller's presence. This official, Senhor
+Mesquita, was the only officer who could be forced to live at the
+Kongone. From certain circumstances in his life, he had fallen under
+the power of the local Government; all the other Custom-house
+officers refused to go to Kongone, so here poor Mesquita must live on
+a miserable pittance--must live, and perhaps slave, sorely against
+his will. His name is not brought forward with a view of throwing
+any odium on his character. The disinterested kindness which he
+showed to Dr. Meller, and others, forbids that he should be mentioned
+by us with anything like unkindness.
+
+Under all these considerations, with the fact that we had not found
+the Rovuma so favourable for navigation at the time of our visit as
+we expected, it was impossible not to coincide in the wisdom of our
+withdrawal; but we deeply regretted that we had ever given credit to
+the Portuguese Government for any desire to ameliorate the condition
+of the African race; for, with half the labour and expense anywhere
+else, we should have made an indelible mark of improvement on a
+section of the Continent. Viewing Portuguese statesmen in the light
+of the laws they have passed for the suppression of slavery and the
+slave-trade, and by the standard of the high character of our own
+public men, it cannot be considered weakness to have believed in the
+sincerity of the anxiety to aid our enterprise, professed by the
+Lisbon Ministry. We hoped to benefit both Portuguese and Africans by
+introducing free-trade and Christianity. Our allies, unfortunately,
+cannot see the slightest benefit in any measure that does not imply
+raising themselves up by thrusting others down. The official paper
+of the Lisbon Government has since let us know "that their policy was
+directed to frustrating the grasping designs of the British
+Government to the dominion of Eastern Africa." We, who were on the
+spot, and behind the scenes, knew that feelings of private
+benevolence had the chief share in the operations undertaken for
+introducing the reign of peace and good will on the Lakes and central
+regions, which for ages have been the abodes of violence and
+bloodshed. But that great change was not to be accomplished. The
+narrow-minded would ascribe all that was attempted to the grasping
+propensity of the English. But the motives that actuate many in
+England, both in public and private life, are much more noble than
+the world gives them credit for.
+
+Seeing, then, that we were not yet arrived at "the good time coming,"
+and that it was quite impossible to take the "Pioneer" down to the
+sea till the floods of December, we made arrangements to screw the
+"Lady Nyassa" together; and, in order to improve the time
+intervening, we resolved to carry a boat past the Cataracts a second
+time, sail along the eastern shore of the Lake, and round the
+northern end, and also collect data by which to verify the
+information collected by Colonel Rigby, that the 19,000 slaves, who
+go through the Custom-house of Zanzibar annually, are chiefly drawn
+from Lake Nyassa and the Valley of the Shire.
+
+Our party consisted of twenty natives, some of whom were Johanna men,
+and were supposed to be capable of managing the six oxen which drew
+the small wagon with a boat on it. A team of twelve Cape oxen, with
+a Hottentot driver and leader, would have taken the wagon over the
+country we had to pass through with the greatest ease; but no sooner
+did we get beyond the part of the road already made, than our drivers
+encountered obstructions in the way of trees and gullies, which it
+would have been a waste of time to have overcome by felling timber
+and hauling out the wagon by block and tackle purchases. The Ajawa
+and Manganja settled at Chibisa's were therefore sent for, and they
+took the boat on their shoulders and carried it briskly, in a few
+days, past all the Cataracts except one; then coming to a
+comparatively still reach of the river, they took advantage of it to
+haul her up a couple of miles. The Makololo had her then entirely in
+charge; for, being accustomed to rapids in their own country, no
+better boatmen could be desired. The river here is very narrow, and
+even in what are called still places, the current is very strong, and
+often obliged them to haul the boat along by the reeds on the banks,
+or to hand a tow-rope ashore. The reeds are full of cowitch
+(Dolichos pruriens), the pods of which are covered with what looks a
+fine velvety down, but is in reality a multitude of fine prickles,
+which go in by the million, and caused an itching and stinging in the
+naked bodies of those who were pulling the tow-rope, that made them
+wriggle as if stung by a whole bed of nettles. Those on board
+required to be men of ready resource with oars and punting-poles, and
+such they were. But, nevertheless, they found, after attempting to
+pass by a rock, round which the water rushed in whirls, that the
+wiser plan would be to take the boat ashore, and carry her past the
+last Cataract. When this was reported, the carriers were called from
+the various shady trees under which they had taken refuge from the
+sun. This was midwinter, but the sun is always hot by day here,
+though the nights are cold. Five Zambesi men, who had been all their
+lives accustomed to great heavy canoes,--the chief recommendation of
+which is said to be, that they can be run against a rock with the
+full force of the current without injury--were very desirous to show
+how much better they could manage our boat than the Makololo; three
+jumped into her when our backs were turned, and two hauled her up a
+little way; the tide caught her bow, we heard a shout of distress,
+the rope was out of their hands in a moment, and there she was,
+bottom upwards; a turn or two in an eddy, and away she went, like an
+arrow, down the Cataracts. One of the men in swimming ashore saved a
+rifle. The whole party ran with all their might along the bank, but
+never more did we see our boat.
+
+The five performers in this catastrophe approached with penitential
+looks. They had nothing to say, nor had we. They bent down slowly,
+and touched our feet with both hands. "Ku kuata moendo"--"to catch
+the foot"--is their way of asking forgiveness. It was so like what
+we have seen a little child do--try to bring a dish unbidden to its
+papa, and letting it fall, burst into a cry of distress--that they
+were only sentenced to go back to the ship, get provisions, and, in
+the ensuing journey on foot, carry as much as they could, and thus
+make up for the loss of the boat.
+
+It was excessively annoying to lose all this property, and be
+deprived of the means of doing the work proposed, on the east and
+north of the Lake; but it would have been like crying over spilt milk
+to do otherwise now than make the best use we could of our legs. The
+men were sent back to the ship for provisions, cloth, and beads; and
+while they are gone, we may say a little of the Cataracts which
+proved so fatal to our boating plan.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII.
+
+
+
+Dr. Livingstone's further explorations--Effects of slave-trade--
+Kirk's range--Ajawa migration--Native fishermen--Arab slave-crossing-
+-Splendid highlands.
+
+The Murchison Cataracts of the Shire river begin in 15 degrees 20
+minutes S., and end in lat. 15 degrees 55 minutes S., the difference
+of latitude is therefore 35 minutes. The river runs in this space
+nearly north and south, till we pass Malango; so the entire distance
+is under 40 miles. The principal Cataracts are five in number, and
+are called Pamofunda or Pamozima, Morewa, Panoreba or Tedzane,
+Pampatamanga, and Papekira. Besides these, three or four smaller
+ones might be mentioned; as, for instance, Mamvira, where in our
+ascent we first met the broken water, and heard that gushing sound
+which, from the interminable windings of some 200 miles of river
+below, we had come to believe the tranquil Shire could never make.
+While these lesser cataracts descend at an angle of scarcely 20
+degrees, the greater fall 100 feet in 100 yards, at an angle of about
+45 degrees, and one at an angle of 70 degrees. One part of Pamozima
+is perpendicular, and, when the river is in flood, causes a cloud of
+vapour to ascend, which, in our journey to Lake Shirwa, we saw at a
+distance of at least eight miles. The entire descent from the Upper
+to the Lower Shire is 1200 feet. Only on one spot in all that
+distance is the current moderate--namely, above Tedzane. The rest is
+all rapid, and much of it being only fifty or eighty yards wide, and
+rushing like a mill-race, it gives the impression of water-power,
+sufficient to drive all the mills in Manchester, running to waste.
+Pamofunda, or Pamozima, has a deep shady grove on its right bank.
+When we were walking alone through its dark shade, we were startled
+by a shocking smell like that of a dissecting-room; and on looking up
+saw dead bodies in mats suspended from the branches of the trees, a
+mode of burial somewhat similar to that which we subsequently saw
+practised by the Parsees in their "towers of silence" at Poonah, near
+Bombay. The name Pamozima means, "the departed spirits or gods"--a
+fit name for a place over which, according to the popular belief, the
+disembodied souls continually hover.
+
+The rock lowest down in the series is dark reddish-grey syenite.
+This seems to have been an upheaving agent, for the mica schists
+above it are much disturbed. Dark trappean rocks full of hornblende
+have in many places burst through these schists, and appear in
+nodules on the surface. The highest rock seen is a fine sandstone of
+closer grain than that at Tette, and quite metamorphosed where it
+comes into contact with the igneous rocks below it. It sometimes
+gives place to quartz and reddish clay schists, much baked by heat.
+This is the usual geological condition on the right bank of the
+Cataracts. On the other side we pass over masses of porphyritic
+trap, in contact with the same mica schists, and these probably give
+to the soil the great fertility we observed. The great body of the
+mountains is syenite. So much mica is washed into the river, that on
+looking attentively on the stream one sees myriads of particles
+floating and glancing in the sun; and this, too, even at low water.
+
+It was the 15th of August before the men returned from the ship,
+accompanied by Mr. Rae and the steward of the "Pioneer." They
+brought two oxen, one of which was instantly slaughtered to put
+courage into all hearts, and some bottles of wine, a present from
+Waller and Alington. We never carried wine before, but this was
+precious as an expression of kindheartedness on the part of the
+donors. If one attempted to carry either wine or spirits, as a
+beverage, he would require a whole troop of followers for nothing
+else. Our greatest luxury in travelling was tea or coffee. We never
+once carried sugar enough to last a journey, but coffee is always
+good, while the sugarless tea is only bearable, because of the
+unbearable gnawing feeling of want and sinking which ensues if we
+begin to travel in the mornings without something warm in the
+stomach. Our drink generally was water, and if cool, nothing can
+equal it in a hot climate. We usually carried a bottle of brandy
+rolled up in our blankets, but that was used only as a medicine; a
+spoonful in hot water before going to bed, to fend off a chill and
+fever. Spirits always do harm, if the fever has fairly begun; and it
+is probable that brandy-and-water has to answer for a good many of
+the deaths in Africa.
+
+Mr. Rae had made gratifying progress in screwing together the "Lady
+Nyassa." He had the zealous co-operation of three as fine steady
+workmen as ever handled tools; and, as they were noble specimens of
+English sailors, we would fain mention the names of men who are an
+honour to the British navy--John Reid, John Pennell, and Richard
+Wilson. The reader will excuse our doing so, but we desire to record
+how much they were esteemed, and how thankful we felt for their good
+behaviour. The weather was delightfully cool; and, with full
+confidence in those left behind, it was with light hearts we turned
+our faces north. Mr. Rae accompanied us a day in front; and, as all
+our party had earnestly advised that at least two Europeans should be
+associated together on the journey, the steward was at the last
+moment taken. Mr. Rae returned to get the "Lady Nyassa" ready for
+sea; and, as she drew less water than the "Pioneer," take her down to
+the ocean in October. One reason for taking the steward is worth
+recording. Both he and a man named King, {5} who, though only a
+leading stoker in the Navy, had been a promising student in the
+University of Aberdeen, had got into that weak bloodless-looking
+state which residence in the lowlands without much to do or think
+about often induces. The best thing for this is change and an active
+life. A couple of days' march only as far as the Mukuru-Madse,
+infused so much vigour into King that he was able to walk briskly
+back. Consideration for the steward's health led to his being
+selected for this northern journey, and the measure was so completely
+successful that it was often, in the hard march, a subject of regret
+that King had not been taken too. A removal of only a hundred yards
+is sometimes so beneficial that it ought in severe cases never to be
+omitted.
+
+Our object now was to get away to the N.N.W., proceed parallel with
+Lake Nyassa, but at a considerable distance west of it, and thus pass
+by the Mazitu or Zulus near its northern end without contact--
+ascertain whether any large river flowed into the Lake from the west-
+-visit Lake Moelo, if time permitted, and collect information about
+the trade on the great slave route, which crosses the Lake at its
+southern end, and at Tsenga and Kota-kota. The Makololo were eager
+to travel fast, because they wanted to be back in time to hoe their
+fields before the rains, and also because their wives needed looking
+after.
+
+In going in the first instance N.E. from the uppermost Cataract, we
+followed in a measure the great bend of the river towards the foot of
+Mount Zomba. Here we had a view of its most imposing side, the west,
+with the plateau some 3000 feet high, stretching away to its south,
+and Mounts Chiradzuru and Mochiru towering aloft to the sky. From
+that goodly highland station, it was once hoped by the noble
+Mackenzie, who, for largeness of heart and loving disposition, really
+deserved to be called the "Bishop of Central Africa," that light and
+liberty would spread to all the interior. We still think it may be a
+centre for civilizing influences; for any one descending from these
+cool heights, and stepping into a boat on the Upper Shire, can sail
+three hundred miles without a check into the heart of Africa.
+
+We passed through a tract of country covered with mopane trees, where
+the hard baked soil refused to let the usual thick crops of grass
+grow; and here we came upon very many tracks of buffaloes, elephants,
+antelopes, and the spoor of one lion. An ox we drove along with us,
+as provision for the way, was sorely bitten by the tsetse. The
+effect of the bite was, as usual, quite apparent two days afterwards,
+in the general flaccidity of the muscles, the drooping ears, and
+looks of illness. It always excited our wonder that we, who were
+frequently much bitten too by the same insects, felt no harm from
+their attacks. Man shares the immunity of the wild animals.
+
+Finding a few people on the evening of the 20th of August, who were
+supporting a wretched existence on tamarinds and mice, we ascertained
+that there was no hope of our being able to buy food anywhere nearer
+than the Lakelet Pamalombe, where the Ajawa chief, Kainka, was now
+living; but that plenty could be found with the Maravi female chief,
+Nyango. We turned away north-westwards, and struck the stream Ribve-
+ribve, or Rivi-rivi, which rises in the Maravi range, and flows into
+the Shire.
+
+As the Rivi-rivi came from the N.W. we continued to travel along its
+banks, until we came to people who had successfully defended
+themselves against the hordes of the Ajawa. By employing the men of
+one village to go forward and explain who we were to the next, we
+managed to prevent the frightened inhabitants from considering us a
+fresh party of Ajawa, or of Portuguese slaving agents. Here they had
+cultivated maize, and were willing to sell, but no persuasion could
+induce them to give us guides to the chieftainess, Nyango. They
+evidently felt that we were not to be trusted; though, as we had to
+certify to our own character, our companions did not fail "to blow
+our own trumpet," with blasts in which modesty was quite out of the
+question. To allay suspicion, we had at last to refrain from
+mentioning the lady's name.
+
+It would be wearisome to repeat the names of the villages we passed
+on our way to the north-west. One was the largest we ever saw in
+Africa, and quite deserted, with the usual sad sight of many
+skeletons lying about. Another was called Tette. We know three
+places of this name, which fact shows it to be a native word; it
+seems to mean a place where the water rushes over rocks. A third
+village was called Chipanga (a great work), a name identical with the
+Shupanga of the Portuguese. This repetition of names may indicate
+that the same people first took these epithets in their traditional
+passage from north to south.
+
+At this season of the year the nights are still cold, and the people,
+having no crops to occupy their attention, do not stir out till long
+after the sun is up. At other times they are off to their fields
+before the day dawns, and the first sound one hears is the loud
+talking of men and women, in which they usually indulge in the dark
+to scare off beasts by the sound of the human voice. When no work is
+to be done, the first warning of approaching day is the hemp-smoker's
+loud ringing cough.
+
+Having been delayed one morning by some negotiation about guides, who
+were used chiefly to introduce us to other villages, we two whites
+walked a little way ahead, taking the direction of the stream. The
+men having been always able to find out our route by the prints of
+our shoes, we went on for a number of miles. This time, however,
+they lost our track, and failed to follow us. The path was well
+marked by elephants, hyenas, pallahs, and zebras, but for many a day
+no human foot had trod it. When the sun went down a deserted hamlet
+was reached, where we made comfortable beds for ourselves of grass.
+Firing muskets to attract the attention of those who have strayed is
+the usual resource in these cases. On this occasion the sound of
+firearms tended to mislead us; for, hearing shots next morning, a
+long weary march led us only to some native hunters, who had been
+shooting buffaloes. Returning to a small village, we met with some
+people who remembered our passing up to the Lake in the boat; they
+were as kind as they could be. The only food they possessed was
+tamarinds, prepared with ashes, and a little cowitch meal. The
+cowitch, as mentioned before, has a velvety brown covering of minute
+prickles, which, if touched, enter the pores of the skin and cause a
+painful tingling. The women in times of scarcity collect the pods,
+kindle a fire of grass over them to destroy the prickles, then steep
+the beans till they begin to sprout, wash them in pure water, and
+either boil them or pound them into meal, which resembles our bean-
+meal. This plant climbs up the long grass, and abounds in all reedy
+parts, and, though a plague to the traveller who touches its pods, it
+performs good service in times of famine by saving many a life from
+starvation. Its name here is Kitedzi.
+
+Having travelled at least twenty miles in search of our party that
+day, our rest on a mat in the best hut of the village was very sweet.
+We had dined the evening before on a pigeon each, and had eaten only
+a handful of kitedzi porridge this afternoon. The good wife of the
+village took a little corn which she had kept for seed, ground it
+after dark, and made it into porridge. This, and a cup of wild
+vegetables of a sweetish taste for a relish, a little boy brought in
+and put down, with several vigorous claps of his hands, in the manner
+which is esteemed polite, and which is strictly enjoined on all
+children.
+
+On the third day of separation, Akosanjere, the headman of this
+village, conducted us forward to our party who had gone on to Nseze,
+a district to the westward. This incident is mentioned, not for any
+interest it possesses, apart from the idea of the people it conveys.
+We were completely separated from our men for nearly three days, and
+had nothing wherewith to purchase food. The people were sorely
+pressed by famine and war, and their hospitality, poor as it was, did
+them great credit, and was most grateful to us. Our own men had
+become confused and wandered, but had done their utmost to find us;
+on our rejoining them, the ox was slain, and all, having been on
+short commons, rejoiced in this "day of slaughter." Akosanjere was,
+of course, rewarded to his heart's content.
+
+As we pursued our way, we came close up to a range of mountains, the
+most prominent peak of which is called Mvai. This is a great, bare,
+rounded block of granite shooting up from the rest of the chain. It
+and several other masses of rock are of a light grey colour, with
+white patches, as if of lichens; the sides and summits are generally
+thinly covered with rather scraggy trees. There are several other
+prominent peaks--one, for instance, still further north, called
+Chirobve. Each has a name, but we could never ascertain that there
+was an appellation which applied to the whole. This fact, and our
+wish to commemorate the name of Dr. Kirk, induced us afterwards, when
+we could not discover a particular peak mentioned to us formerly as
+Molomo-ao-koku, or Cock's-bill, to call the whole chain from the west
+of the Cataracts up to the north end of the Lake, "Kirk's Range."
+The part we slept at opposite Mvai was named Paudio, and was
+evidently a continuation of the district of one of our stations on
+the Shire, at which observations for latitude were formerly taken.
+
+Leaving Paudio, we had Kirk's Range close on our left and at least
+3000 feet above us, and probably not less than 5000 feet above the
+sea. Far to our right extended a long green wooded country rising
+gradually up to a ridge, ornamented with several detached mountains,
+which bounded the Shire Valley. In front, northwards, lay a valley
+as rich and lovely as we ever saw anywhere, terminating at the
+mountains, which, stretched away some thirty miles beyond our range
+of vision and ended at Cape Maclear. The groups of trees had never
+been subjected to the landscape gardener's art; but had been cut down
+mercilessly, just as suited the convenience of the cultivator; yet
+the various combinations of open forest, sloping woodland, grassy
+lawns, and massive clumps of dark green foliage along the running
+streams, formed as beautiful a landscape as could be seen on the
+Thames. This valley is named Goa or Gova, and as we moved through it
+we found that what was smooth to the eye was very much furrowed by
+running streams winding round innumerable knolls. These little
+brooklets came down from the range on our left, and the water was
+deliciously cool.
+
+When we came abreast of the peak Chirobve, the people would no longer
+give us guides. They were afraid of their enemies, whose dwellings
+we now had on our east; and, proceeding without any one to lead us,
+or to introduce us to the inhabitants, we were perplexed by all the
+paths running zigzag across instead of along the valley. They had
+been made by the villagers going from the hamlets on the slopes to
+their gardens in the meadows below. To add to our difficulties, the
+rivulets and mountain-torrents had worn gullies some thirty or forty
+feet deep, with steep sides that could not be climbed except at
+certain points. The remaining inhabitants on the flank of the range
+when they saw strangers winding from side to side, and often
+attempting to cross these torrent beds at impossible places, screamed
+out their shrill war-alarm, and made the valley ring with their wild
+outcries. It was war, and war alone, and we were too deep down in
+the valley to make our voices heard in explanation. Fortunately,
+they had burned off the long grass to a great extent. It only here
+and there hid them from us. Selecting an open spot, we spent a night
+regarded by all around us as slave-hunters, but were undisturbed,
+though the usual way of treating an enemy in this part of the country
+is by night attack.
+
+The nights at the altitude of the valley were cool, the lowest
+temperature shown being 37 degrees; at 9 a.m. and 9 p.m. it was 58
+degrees, about the average temperature of the day; at mid-day 82
+degrees, and sunset 70 degrees. Our march was very much hindered by
+the imperfectly burned corn and grass stalks having fallen across the
+paths. To a reader in England this will seem a very small obstacle.
+But he must fancy the grass stems as thick as his little finger, and
+the corn-stalks like so many walkingsticks lying in one direction,
+and so supporting each other that one has to lift his feet up as when
+wading through deep high heather. The stems of grass showed the
+causes of certain explosions as loud as pistols, which are heard when
+the annual fires come roaring over the land. The heated air inside
+expanding bursts the stalk with a loud report, and strews the
+fragments on the ground.
+
+A very great deal of native corn had been cultivated here, and we saw
+buffaloes feeding in the deserted gardens, and some women, who ran
+away very much faster than the beasts did.
+
+On the 29th, seeing some people standing under a tree by a village,
+we sat down, and sent Masego, one of our party, to communicate. The
+headman, Matunda, came back with him, bearing a calabash with water
+for us. He said that all the people had fled from the Ajawa, who had
+only just desisted from their career of pillage on being paid five
+persons as a fine for some offence for which they had commenced the
+invasion. Matunda had plenty of grain to sell, and all the women
+were soon at work grinding it into meal. We secured an abundant
+supply, and four milk goats. The Manganja goat is of a very superior
+breed to the general African animal, being short in the legs and
+having a finely-shaped broad body. By promising the Makololo that,
+when we no longer needed the milk, they should have the goats to
+improve the breed of their own at home, they were induced to take the
+greatest possible care of both goats and kids in driving and
+pasturing.
+
+After leaving Matunda, we came to the end of the highland valley;
+and, before descending a steep declivity of a thousand feet towards
+the part which may be called the heel of the Lake, we had the bold
+mountains of Cape Maclear on our right, with the blue water at their
+base, the hills of Tsenga in the distance in front, and Kirk's Range
+on our left, stretching away northwards, and apparently becoming
+lower. As we came down into a fine rich undulating valley, many
+perennial streams running to the east from the hills on our left were
+crossed, while all those behind us on the higher ground seemed to
+unite in one named Lekue, which flowed into the Lake.
+
+After a long day's march in the valley of the Lake, where the
+temperature was very much higher than in that we had just left, we
+entered the village of Katosa, which is situated on the bank of a
+stream among gigantic timber trees, and found there a large party of
+Ajawa--Waiau, they called themselves--all armed with muskets. We sat
+down among them, and were soon called to the chiefs court, and
+presented with an ample mess of porridge, buffalo meat, and beer.
+Katosa was more frank than any Manganja chief we had met, and
+complimented us by saying that "we must be his 'Bazimo' (good spirits
+of his ancestors); for when he lived at Pamalombe, we lighted upon
+him from above--men the like of whom he had never seen before, and
+coming he knew not whence." He gave us one of his own large and
+clean huts to sleep in; and we may take this opportunity of saying
+that the impression we received, from our first journey on the hills
+among the villages of Chisunse, of the excessive dirtiness of the
+Manganja, was erroneous. This trait was confined to the cool
+highlands. Here crowds of men and women were observed to perform
+their ablutions daily in the stream that ran past their villages; and
+this we have observed elsewhere to be a common custom with both
+Manganja and Ajawa.
+
+Before we started on the morning of the 1st September, Katosa sent an
+enormous calabash of beer, containing at least three gallons, and
+then came and wished us to "stop a day and eat with him." On
+explaining to him the reasons for our haste, he said that he was in
+the way by which travellers usually passed, he never stopped them in
+their journeys, but would like to look at us for a day. On our
+promising to rest a little with him on our return, he gave us about
+two pecks of rice, and three guides to conduct us to a subordinate
+female chief, Nkwinda, living on the borders of the Lake in front.
+
+The Ajawa, from having taken slaves down to Quillimane and
+Mosambique, knew more of us than Katosa did. Their muskets were
+carefully polished, and never out of these slaver's hands for a
+moment, though in the chiefs presence. We naturally felt
+apprehensive that we should never see Katosa again. A migratory
+afflatus seems to have come over the Ajawa tribes. Wars among
+themselves, for the supply of the Coast slave-trade, are said to have
+first set them in motion. The usual way in which they have advanced
+among the Manganja has been by slave-trading in a friendly way.
+Then, professing to wish to live as subjects, they have been welcomed
+as guests, and the Manganja, being great agriculturists, have been
+able to support considerable bodies of these visitors for a time.
+When the provisions became scarce, the guests began to steal from the
+fields; quarrels arose in consequence, and, the Ajawa having
+firearms, their hosts got the worst of it, and were expelled from
+village after village, and out of their own country. The Manganja
+were quite as bad in regard to slave-trading as the Ajawa, but had
+less enterprise, and were much more fond of the home pursuits of
+spinning, weaving, smelting iron, and cultivating the soil, than of
+foreign travel. The Ajawa had little of a mechanical turn, and not
+much love for agriculture, but were very keen traders and travellers.
+This party seemed to us to be in the first or friendly stage of
+intercourse with Katosa; and, as we afterwards found, he was fully
+alive to the danger.
+
+Our course was shaped towards the N.W., and we traversed a large
+fertile tract of rich soil extensively cultivated, but dotted with
+many gigantic thorny acacias which had proved too large for the
+little axes of the cultivators. After leaving Nkwinda, the first
+village we spent a night at in the district Ngabi was that of Chembi,
+and it had a stockade around it. The Azitu or Mazitu were said to be
+ravaging the country to the west of us, and no one was safe except in
+a stockade. We have so often, in travelling, heard of war in front,
+that we paid little attention to the assertion of Chembi, that the
+whole country to the N.W. was in flight before these Mazitu, under a
+chief with the rather formidable name of Mowhiriwhiri; we therefore
+resolved to go on to Chinsamba's, still further in the same
+direction, and hear what he said about it.
+
+The only instrument of husbandry here is the short-handled hoe; and
+about Tette the labour of tilling the soil, as represented in the
+woodcut, is performed entirely by female slaves. On the West Coast a
+double-handled hoe is employed. Here the small hoe is seen in the
+hands of both men and women. In other parts of Africa a hoe with a
+handle four feet long is used, but the plough is quite unknown.
+
+In illustration of the manner in which the native knowledge of
+agriculture strikes an honest intelligent observer, it may be
+mentioned that the first time good Bishop Mackenzie beheld how well
+the fields of the Manganja were cultivated on the hills, he remarked
+to Dr. Livingstone, then his fellow-traveller--"When telling the
+people in England what were my objects in going out to Africa, I
+stated that, among other things, I meant to teach these people
+agriculture; but I now see that they know far more about it than I
+do." This, we take it, was an honest straightforward testimony, and
+we believe that every unprejudiced witness, who has an opportunity of
+forming an opinion of Africans who have never been debased by
+slavery, will rank them very much higher in the scale of
+intelligence, industry, and manhood, than others who know them only
+in a state of degradation.
+
+On coming near Chinsamba's two stockades, on the banks of the
+Lintipe, we were told that the Mazitu had been repulsed there the day
+before, and we had evidence of the truth of the report of the attack
+in the sad sight of the bodies of the slain. The Zulus had taken off
+large numbers of women laden with corn; and, when driven back, had
+cut off the ears of a male prisoner, as a sort of credential that he
+had been with the Mazitu, and with grim humour sent him to tell
+Chinsamba "to take good care of the corn in the stockades, for they
+meant to return for it in a month or two."
+
+Chinsamba's people were drumming with might and main on our arrival,
+to express their joy at their deliverance from the Mazitu. The drum
+is the chief instrument of music among the Manganja, and with it they
+express both their joy and grief. They excel in beating time.
+Chinsamba called us into a very large hut, and presented us with a
+huge basket of beer. The glare of sunlight from which we had come
+enabled him, in diplomatic fashion, to have a good view of us before
+our eyes became enough accustomed to the dark inside to see him. He
+has a Jewish cast of countenance, or rather the ancient Assyrian
+face, as seen in the monuments brought to the British Museum by Mr.
+Layard. This form of face is very common in this country, and leads
+to the belief that the true type of the negro is not that met on the
+West Coast, from which most people have derived their ideas of the
+African.
+
+Chinsamba had many Abisa or Babisa in his stockade, and it was
+chiefly by the help of their muskets that he had repulsed the Mazitu:
+these Babisa are great travellers and traders.
+
+We liked Chinsamba very well, and found that he was decidedly opposed
+to our risking our lives by going further to the N.W. The Mazitu
+were believed to occupy all the hills in that direction, so we spent
+the 4th of September with him.
+
+It is rather a minute thing to mention, and it will only be
+understood by those who have children of their own, but the cries of
+the little ones, in their infant sorrows, are the same in tone, at
+different ages, here as all over the world. We have been perpetually
+reminded of home and family by the wailings which were once familiar
+to parental ears and heart, and felt thankful that to the sorrows of
+childhood our children would never have superadded the heartrending
+woes of the slave-trade.
+
+Taking Chinsamba's advice to avoid the Mazitu in their marauding, we
+started on the 5th September away to the N.E., and passed mile after
+mile of native cornfields, with an occasional cotton-patch.
+
+After a long march, we passed over a waterless plain about N.N.W. of
+the hills of Tsenga to a village on the Lake, and thence up its
+shores to Chitanda. The banks of the Lake were now crowded with
+fugitives, who had collected there for the poor protection which the
+reeds afforded. For miles along the water's edge was one continuous
+village of temporary huts. The people had brought a little corn with
+them; but they said, "What shall we eat when that is done? When we
+plant corn, the wild beasts (Zinyama, as they call the Mazitu) come
+and take it. When we plant cassava, they do the same. How are we to
+live?" A poor blind woman, thinking we were Mazitu, rushed off in
+front of us with outspread arms, lifting the feet high, in the manner
+peculiar to those who have lost their sight, and jumped into the
+reeds of a stream for safety.
+
+In our way along the shores we crossed several running rivulets of
+clear cold water, which, from having reeds at their confluences, had
+not been noticed in our previous exploration in the boat. One of
+these was called Mokola, and another had a strong odour of
+sulphuretted hydrogen. We reached Molamba on the 8th September, and
+found our old acquaintance, Nkomo, there still. One of the
+advantages of travelling along the shores of the Lake was, that we
+could bathe anywhere in its clear fresh water. To us, who had been
+obliged so often to restrain our inclination in the Zambesi and Shire
+for fear of crocodiles, this was pleasant beyond measure. The water
+now was of the same temperature as it was on our former visit, or 72
+degrees Fahr. The immense depth of the Lake prevents the rays of the
+sun from raising the temperature as high as that of the Shire and
+Zambesi; and the crocodiles, having always clear water in the Lake,
+and abundance of fish, rarely attack man; many of these reptiles
+could be seen basking on the rocks.
+
+A day's march beyond Molamba brought us to the lakelet Chia, which
+lies parallel with the Lake. It is three or four miles long, by from
+one to one and a half broad, and communicates with the Lake by an arm
+of good depth, but with some rocks in it. As we passed up between
+the Lake and the eastern shore of this lakelet, we did not see any
+streams flowing into it. It is quite remarkable for the abundance of
+fish; and we saw upwards of fifty large canoes engaged in the
+fishery, which is carried on by means of hand-nets with side-frame
+poles about seven feet long. These nets are nearly identical with
+those now in use in Normandy--the difference being that the African
+net has a piece of stick lashed across the handle-ends of the side
+poles to keep them steady, which is a great improvement. The fish
+must be very abundant to be scooped out of the water in such
+quantities as we saw, and by so many canoes. There is quite a trade
+here in dried fish.
+
+The country around is elevated, undulating, and very extensively
+planted with cassava. The hoe in use has a handle of four feet in
+length, and the iron part is exactly of the same form as that in the
+country of the Bechuanas. The baskets here, which are so closely
+woven together as to hold beer, are the same with those employed to
+hold milk in Kaffirland--a thousand miles distant.
+
+Marching on foot is peculiarly conducive to meditation--one is glad
+of any subject to occupy the mind, and relieve the monotony of the
+weary treadmill-like trudge-trudging. This Chia net brought to our
+mind that the smith's bellows made here of a goatskin bag, with
+sticks along the open ends, are the same as those in use in the
+Bechuana country far to the south-west. These, with the long-handled
+hoe, may only show that each successive horde from north to south
+took inventions with it from the same original source. Where that
+source may have been is probably indicated by another pair of
+bellows, which we observed below the Victoria Falls, being found in
+Central India and among the Gipsies of Europe.
+
+Men in remote times may have had more highly-developed instincts,
+which enabled them to avoid or use poisons; but the late Archbishop
+Whately has proved, that wholly untaught savages never could invent
+anything, or even subsist at all. Abundant corroboration of his
+arguments is met with in this country, where the natives require but
+little in the way of clothing, and have remarkably hardy stomachs.
+Although possessing a knowledge of all the edible roots and fruits in
+the country, having hoes to dig with, and spears, bows, and arrows to
+kill the game,--we have seen that, notwithstanding all these
+appliances and means to boot, they have perished of absolute
+starvation.
+
+The art of making fire is the same in India as in Africa. The
+smelting furnaces, for reducing iron and copper from the ores, are
+also similar. Yellow haematite, which bears not the smallest
+resemblance either in colour or weight to the metal, is employed near
+Kolobeng for the production of iron. Malachite, the precious green
+stone used in civilized life for vases, would never be suspected by
+the uninstructed to be a rich ore of copper, and yet it is
+extensively smelted for rings and other ornaments in the heart of
+Africa. A copper bar of native manufacture four feet long was
+offered to us for sale at Chinsamba's. These arts are monuments
+attesting the fact, that some instruction from above must at some
+time or other have been supplied to mankind; and, as Archbishop
+Whately says, "the most probable conclusion is, that man when first
+created, or very shortly afterwards, was advanced, by the Creator
+Himself, to a state above that of a mere savage."
+
+The argument for an original revelation to man, though quite
+independent of the Bible history, tends to confirm that history. It
+is of the same nature with this, that man could not have MADE
+himself, and therefore must have had a Divine CREATOR. Mankind could
+not, in the first instance, have CIVILIZED themselves, and therefore
+must have had a superhuman INSTRUCTOR.
+
+In connection with this subject, it is remarkable that throughout
+successive generations no change has taken place in the form of the
+various inventions. Hammers, tongs, hoes, axes, adzes, handles to
+them; needles, bows and arrows, with the mode of feathering the
+latter; spears, for killing game, with spear-heads having what is
+termed "dish" on both sides to give them, when thrown, the rotatory
+motion of rifle-balls; the arts of spinning and weaving, with that of
+pounding and steeping the inner bark of a tree till it serves as
+clothing; millstones for grinding corn into meal; the manufacture of
+the same kind of pots or chatties as in India; the art of cooking, of
+brewing beer and straining it as was done in ancient Egypt; fish-
+hooks, fishing and hunting nets, fish-baskets, and weirs, the same as
+in the Highlands of Scotland; traps for catching animals, etc.,
+etc.,--have all been so very permanent from age to age, and some of
+them of identical patterns are so widely spread over the globe, as to
+render it probable that they were all, at least in some degree,
+derived from one Source. The African traditions, which seem
+possessed of the same unchangeability as the arts to which they
+relate, like those of all other nations refer their origin to a
+superior Being. And it is much more reasonable to receive the hints
+given in Genesis, concerning direct instruction from God to our first
+parents or their children in religious or moral duty, and probably in
+the knowledge of the arts of life, {6} than to give credence to the
+theory that untaught savage man subsisted in a state which would
+prove fatal to all his descendants, and that in such helpless state
+he made many inventions which most of his progeny retained, but never
+improved upon during some thirty centuries.
+
+We crossed in canoes the arm of the Lake, which joins Chia to Nyassa,
+and spent the night on its northern bank. The whole country adjacent
+to the Lake, from this point up to Kota-kota Bay, is densely peopled
+by thousands who have fled from the forays of the Mazitu in hopes of
+protection from the Arabs who live there. In three running rivulets
+we saw the Shuare palm, and an oil palm which is much inferior to
+that on the West Coast. Though somewhat similar in appearance, the
+fruit is not much larger than hazel-nuts, and the people do not use
+them, on account of the small quantity of oil which they afford.
+
+The idea of using oil for light never seems to have entered the
+African mind. Here a bundle of split and dried bamboo, tied together
+with creeping plants, as thick as a man's body, and about twenty feet
+in length, is employed in the canoes as a torch to attract the fish
+at night. It would be considered a piece of the most wasteful
+extravagance to burn the oil they obtain from the castor-oil bean and
+other seeds, and also from certain fish, or in fact to do anything
+with it but anoint their heads and bodies.
+
+We arrived at Kota-kota Bay in the afternoon of the 10th September,
+1863; and sat down under a magnificent wild fig-tree with leaves ten
+inches long, by five broad, about a quarter of a mile from the
+village of Juma ben Saidi, and Yakobe ben Arame, whom we had met on
+the River Kaombe, a little north of this, in our first exploration of
+the Lake. We had rested but a short time when Juma, who is evidently
+the chief person here, followed by about fifty people, came to salute
+us and to invite us to take up our quarters in his village. The hut
+which, by mistake, was offered, was so small and dirty, that we
+preferred sleeping in an open space a few hundred yards off.
+
+Juma afterwards apologized for the mistake, and presented us with
+rice, meal, sugar-cane, and a piece of malachite. We returned his
+visit on the following day, and found him engaged in building a dhow
+or Arab vessel, to replace one which he said had been wrecked. This
+new one was fifty feet long, twelve feet broad, and five feet deep.
+The planks were of a wood like teak, here called Timbati, and the
+timbers of a closer grained wood called Msoro. The sight of this
+dhow gave us a hint which, had we previously received it, would have
+prevented our attempting to carry a vessel of iron past the
+Cataracts. The trees around Katosa's village were Timbati, and they
+would have yielded planks fifty feet long and thirty inches broad.
+With a few native carpenters a good vessel could be built on the Lake
+nearly as quickly as one could be carried past the Cataracts, and at
+a vastly less cost. Juma said that no money would induce him to part
+with this dhow. He was very busy in transporting slaves across the
+Lake by means of two boats, which we saw returning from a trip in the
+afternoon. As he did not know of our intention to visit him, we came
+upon several gangs of stout young men slaves, each secured by the
+neck to one common chain, waiting for exportation, and several more
+in slave-sticks. These were all civilly removed before our interview
+was over, because Juma knew that we did not relish the sight.
+
+When we met the same Arabs in 1861, they had but few attendants:
+according to their own account, they had now, in the village and
+adjacent country, 1500 souls. It is certain that tens of thousands
+had flocked to them for protection, and all their power and influence
+must be attributed to the possession of guns and gunpowder. This
+crowding of refugees to any point where there is a hope for security
+for life and property is very common in this region, and the
+knowledge of it made our hopes beat high for the success of a
+peaceful Mission on the shores of the Lake. The rate, however, in
+which the people here will perish by the next famine, or be exported
+by Juma and others, will, we fear, depopulate those parts which we
+have just described as crowded with people. Hunger will ere long
+compel them to sell each other. An intelligent man complained to us
+of the Arabs often seizing slaves, to whom they took a fancy, without
+the formality of purchase; but the price is so low--from two to four
+yards of calico--that one can scarcely think this seizure and
+exportation without payment worth their while. The boats were in
+constant employment, and, curiously enough, Ben Habib, whom we met at
+Linyanti in 1855, had been taken across the Lake, the day before our
+arrival at this Bay, on his way from Sesheke to Kilwa, and we became
+acquainted with a native servant of the Arabs, called Selele
+Saidallah, who could speak the Makololo language pretty fairly from
+having once spent some months in the Barotse Valley.
+
+From boyhood upwards we have been accustomed, from time to time, to
+read in books of travels about the great advances annually made by
+Mohammedanism in Africa. The rate at which this religion spreads was
+said to be so rapid, that in after days, in our own pretty extensive
+travels, we have constantly been on the look out for the advancing
+wave from North to South, which, it was prophesied, would soon reduce
+the entire continent to the faith of the false prophet. The only
+foundation that we can discover for the assertions referred to, and
+for others of more recent date, is the fact that in a remote corner
+of North-Western Africa the Fulahs, and Mandingoes, and some others
+in Northern Africa, as mentioned by Dr. Barth, have made conquests of
+territory; but even they care so very little for the extension of
+their faith, that after the conquest no pains whatever are taken to
+indoctrinate the adults of the tribe. This is in exact accordance
+with the impression we have received from our intercourse with
+Mohammedans and Christians. The followers of Christ alone are
+anxious to propagate their faith. A quasi philanthropist would
+certainly never need to recommend the followers of Islam, whom we
+have met, to restrain their benevolence by preaching that "Charity
+should begin at home."
+
+Though Selele and his companions were bound to their masters by
+domestic ties, the only new idea they had imbibed from Mohammedanism
+was, that it would be wrong to eat meat killed by other people. They
+thought it would be "unlucky." Just as the inhabitants of Kolobeng,
+before being taught the requirements of Christianity, refrained from
+hoeing their gardens on Sundays, lest they should reap an unlucky
+crop. So far as we could learn, no efforts had been made to convert
+the natives, though these two Arabs, and about a dozen half-castes,
+had been in the country for many years; and judging from our
+experience with a dozen Mohammedans in our employ at high wages for
+sixteen months, the Africans would be the better men in proportion as
+they retained their native faith. This may appear only a harsh
+judgment from a mind imbued with Christian prejudices; but without
+any pretention to that impartiality, which leaves it doubtful to
+which side the affections lean, the truth may be fairly stated by one
+who viewed all Mohammedans and Africans with the sincerest good will.
+
+Our twelve Mohammedans from Johanna were the least open of any of our
+party to impression from kindness. A marked difference in general
+conduct was apparent. The Makololo, and other natives of the
+country, whom we had with us, invariably shared with each other the
+food they had cooked, but the Johanna men partook of their meals at a
+distance. This, at first, we attributed to their Moslem prejudices;
+but when they saw the cooking process of the others nearly complete,
+they came, sat beside them, and ate the portion offered without ever
+remembering to return the compliment when their own turn came to be
+generous. The Makololo and the others grumbled at their greediness,
+yet always followed the common custom of Africans of sharing their
+food with all who sit around them. What vexed us most in the Johanna
+men was their indifference to the welfare of each other. Once, when
+they were all coming to the ship after sleeping ashore, one of them
+walked into the water with the intention of swimming off to the boat,
+and while yet hardly up to his knees was seized by a horrid crocodile
+and dragged under; the poor fellow gave a shriek, and held up his
+hand for aid, but none of his countrymen stirred to his assistance,
+and he was never seen again. On asking his brother-in-law why he did
+not help him, he replied, "Well, no one told him to go into the
+water. It was his own fault that he was killed." The Makololo on
+the other hand rescued a woman at Senna by entering the water, and
+taking her out of the crocodile's mouth.
+
+It is not assumed that their religion had much to do in the matter.
+Many Mohammedans might contrast favourably with indifferent
+Christians; but, so far as our experience in East Africa goes, the
+moral tone of the follower of Mahomed is pitched at a lower key than
+that of the untutored African. The ancient zeal for propagating the
+tenets of the Koran has evaporated, and been replaced by the most
+intense selfishness and grossest sensuality. The only known efforts
+made by Mohammedans, namely, those in the North-West and North of the
+continent, are so linked with the acquisition of power and plunder,
+as not to deserve the name of religious propagandism; and the only
+religion that now makes proselytes is that of Jesus Christ. To those
+who are capable of taking a comprehensive view of this subject,
+nothing can be adduced of more telling significance than the well-
+attested fact, that while the Mohammedans, Fulahs, and others towards
+Central Africa, make a few proselytes by a process which gratifies
+their own covetousness, three small sections of the Christian
+converts, the Africans in the South, in the West Indies, and on the
+West Coast of Africa actually contribute for the support and spread
+of their religion upwards of 15,000 pounds annually. {7} That
+religion which so far overcomes the selfishness of the human heart
+must be Divine.
+
+Leaving Kota-kota Bay, we turned away due West on the great slave
+route to Katanga's and Cazembe's country in Londa. Juma lent us his
+servant, Selele, to lead us the first day's march. He said that the
+traders from Kilwa and Iboe cross the Lake either at this bay, or at
+Tsenga, or at the southern end of the Lake; and that wherever they
+may cross they all go by this path to the interior. They have slaves
+with them to carry their goods, and when they reach a spot where they
+can easily buy others, they settle down and begin the traffic, and at
+once cultivate grain. So much of the land lies waste, that no
+objection is ever made to any one taking possession of as much as he
+needs; they can purchase a field of cassava for their present wants
+for very little, and they continue trading in the country for two or
+three years, and giving what weight their muskets possess to the
+chief who is most liberal to them.
+
+The first day's march led us over a rich, well-cultivated plain.
+This was succeeded by highlands, undulating, stony, and covered with
+scraggy trees. Many banks of well rounded shingle appear. The
+disintegration of the rocks, now going on, does not round off the
+angles; they are split up by the heat and cold into angular
+fragments. On these high downs we crossed the River Kaombe. Beyond
+it we came among the upland vegetation--rhododendrons, proteas, the
+masuko, and molompi. At the foot of the hill, Kasuko-suko, we found
+the River Bua running north to join the Kaombe. We had to go a mile
+out of our way for a ford; the stream is deep enough in parts for
+hippopotami. The various streams not previously noticed, crossed in
+this journey, had before this led us to the conclusion, independently
+of the testimony of the natives, that no large river ran into the
+north end of the Lake. No such affluent was needed to account for
+the Shire's perennial flow.
+
+On September 15th we reached the top of the ascent which, from its
+many ups and downs, had often made us puff and blow as if broken-
+winded. The water of the streams we crossed was deliciously cold,
+and now that we had gained the summit at Ndonda, where the boiling-
+point of water showed an altitude of 3440 feet above the sea, the air
+was delightful. Looking back we had a magnificent view of the Lake,
+but the haze prevented our seeing beyond the sea horizon. The scene
+was beautiful, but it was impossible to dissociate the lovely
+landscape whose hills and dales had so sorely tried our legs and
+lungs, from the sad fact that this was part of the great slave route
+now actually in use. By this road many "Ten thousands" have here
+seen "the Sea," "the Sea," but with sinking hearts; for the universal
+idea among the captive gangs is, that they are going to be fattened
+and eaten by the whites. They cannot of course be so much shocked as
+we should be--their sensibilities are far from fine, their feelings
+are more obtuse than ours--in fact, "the live eels are used to being
+skinned," perhaps they rather like it. We who are not philosophic,
+blessed the Providence which at Thermopylae in ancient days rolled
+back the tide of Eastern conquest from the West, and so guided the
+course of events that light and liberty and gospel truth spread to
+our distant isle, and emancipating our race freed them from the fear
+of ever again having to climb fatiguing heights and descend wearisome
+hollows in a slave-gang, as we suppose they did when the fair English
+youths were exposed for sale at Rome.
+
+Looking westwards we perceived that, what from below had the
+appearance of mountains, was only the edge of a table-land which,
+though at first undulating, soon became smooth, and sloped towards
+the centre of the country. To the south a prominent mountain called
+Chipata, and to the south-west another named Ngalla, by which the Bua
+is said to rise, gave character to the landscape. In the north,
+masses of hills prevented our seeing more than eight or ten miles.
+
+The air which was so exhilarating to Europeans had an opposite effect
+on five men who had been born and reared in the malaria of the Delta
+of the Zambesi. No sooner did they reach the edge of the plateau at
+Ndonda, than they lay down prostrate, and complained of pains all
+over them. The temperature was not much lower than that on the
+shores of the Lake below, 76 degrees being the mean temperature of
+the day, 52 degrees the lowest, and 82 degrees the highest during the
+twenty-four hours; at the Lake it was about l0 degrees higher. Of
+the symptoms they complained of--pains everywhere--nothing could be
+made. And yet it was evident that they had good reason for saying
+that they were ill. They scarified almost every part of their bodies
+as a remedial measure; medicines, administered on the supposition
+that their malady was the effect of a sudden chill, had no effect,
+and in two days one of them actually died in consequence of, as far
+as we could judge, a change from a malarious to a purer and more
+rarefied atmosphere.
+
+As we were on the slave route, we found the people more churlish than
+usual. On being expostulated with about it, they replied, "We have
+been made wary by those who come to buy slaves." The calamity of
+death having befallen our party, seemed, however, to awaken their
+sympathies. They pointed out their usual burying-place, lent us
+hoes, and helped to make the grave. When we offered to pay all
+expenses, they showed that they had not done these friendly offices
+without fully appreciating their value; for they enumerated the use
+of the hut, the mat on which the deceased had lain, the hoes, the
+labour, and the medicine which they had scattered over the place to
+make him rest in peace.
+
+The primitive African faith seems to be that there is one Almighty
+Maker of heaven and earth; that he has given the various plants of
+earth to man to be employed as mediators between him and the spirit
+world, where all who have ever been born and died continue to live;
+that sin consists in offences against their fellow-men, either here
+or among the departed, and that death is often a punishment of guilt,
+such as witchcraft. Their idea of moral evil differs in no respect
+from ours, but they consider themselves amenable only to inferior
+beings, not to the Supreme. Evil-speaking--lying--hatred--
+disobedience to parents--neglect of them--are said by the intelligent
+to have been all known to be sin, as well as theft, murder, or
+adultery, before they knew aught of Europeans or their teaching. The
+only new addition to their moral code is, that it is wrong to have
+more wives than one. This, until the arrival of Europeans, never
+entered into their minds even as a doubt.
+
+Everything not to be accounted for by common causes, whether of good
+or evil, is ascribed to the Deity. Men are inseparably connected
+with the spirits of the departed, and when one dies he is believed to
+have joined the hosts of his ancestors. All the Africans we have met
+with are as firmly persuaded of their future existence as of their
+present life. And we have found none in whom the belief in the
+Supreme Being was not rooted. He is so invariably referred to as the
+Author of everything supernatural, that, unless one is ignorant of
+their language, he cannot fail to notice this prominent feature of
+their faith. When they pass into the unseen world, they do not seem
+to be possessed with the fear of punishment. The utensils placed
+upon the grave are all broken as if to indicate that they will never
+be used by the departed again. The body is put into the grave in a
+sitting posture, and the hands are folded in front. In some parts of
+the country there are tales which we could translate into faint
+glimmerings of a resurrection; but whether these fables, handed down
+from age to age, convey that meaning to the natives themselves we
+cannot tell. The true tradition of faith is asserted to be "though a
+man die he will live again;" the false that when he dies he is dead
+for ever.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV.
+
+
+
+Important geographical discoveries in the Wabisa countries--Cruelty
+of the slave-trade--The Mazitu--Serious illness of Dr. Livingstone--
+Return to the ship.
+
+In our course westwards, we at first passed over a gently undulating
+country, with a reddish clayey soil, which, from the heavy crops,
+appeared to be very fertile. Many rivulets were crossed, some
+running southwards into the Bua, and others northwards into the
+Loangwa, a river which we formerly saw flowing into the Lake.
+Further on, the water was chiefly found in pools and wells. Then
+still further, in the same direction, some watercourses were said to
+flow into that same "Loangwa of the Lake," and others into the
+Loangwa, which flows to the south-west, and enters the Zambesi at
+Zumbo, and is here called the "Loangwa of the Maravi." The trees
+were in general scraggy, and covered, exactly as they are in the damp
+climate of the Coast, with lichens, resembling orchilla-weed. The
+maize, which loves rather a damp soil, had been planted on ridges to
+allow the superfluous moisture to run off. Everything indicated a
+very humid climate, and the people warned us that, as the rains were
+near, we were likely to be prevented from returning by the country
+becoming flooded and impassable.
+
+Villages, as usual encircled by euphorbia hedges, were numerous, and
+a great deal of grain had been cultivated around them. Domestic
+fowls, in plenty, and pigeons with dovecots like those in Egypt were
+seen. The people call themselves Matumboka, but the only difference
+between them and the rest of the Manganja is in the mode of tattooing
+the face. Their language is the same. Their distinctive mark
+consists of four tattooed lines diverging from the point between the
+eyebrows, which, in frowning, the muscles form into a furrow. The
+other lines of tattooing, as in all Manganja, run in long seams,
+which crossing each other at certain angles form a great number of
+triangular spaces on the breast, back, arms, and thighs. The cuticle
+is divided by a knife, and the edges of the incision are drawn apart
+till the true skin appears. By a repetition of this process, lines
+of raised cicatrices are formed, which are thought to give beauty, no
+matter how much pain the fashion gives.
+
+It would not be worth while to advert for a moment to the routine of
+travelling, or the little difficulties that beset every one who
+attempts to penetrate into a new country, were it not to show the
+great source of the power here possessed by slave-traders. We needed
+help in carrying our goods, while our men were ill, though still able
+to march. When we had settled with others for hire, we were often
+told, that the dealers in men had taken possession of some, and had
+taken them away altogether. Other things led us to believe that the
+slave-traders carry matters with a high hand; and no wonder, for the
+possession of gunpowder gives them almost absolute power. The mode
+by which tribes armed with bows and arrows carry on warfare, or
+defend themselves, is by ambuscade. They never come out in open
+fight, but wait for the enemy ensconced behind trees, or in the long
+grass of the country, and shoot at him unawares. Consequently, if
+men come against them with firearms, when, as is usually the case,
+the long grass is all burned off, the tribe attacked are as helpless
+as a wooden ship, possessing only signal guns, would be before an
+iron-clad steamer. The time of year selected for this kind of
+warfare is nearly always that in which the grass is actually burnt
+off, or is so dry as readily to take fire. The dry grass in Africa
+looks more like ripe English wheat late in the autumn, than anything
+else we can compare it to. Let us imagine an English village
+standing in a field of this sort, bounded only by the horizon, and
+enemies setting fire to a line of a mile or two, by running along
+with bunches of burning straw in their hands, touching here and there
+the inflammable material,--the wind blowing towards the doomed
+village--the inhabitants with only one or two old muskets, but ten to
+one no powder,--the long line of flames, leaping thirty feet into the
+air with dense masses of black smoke--and pieces of charred grass
+falling down in showers. Would not the stoutest English villager,
+armed only with the bow and arrow against the enemy's musket, quail
+at the idea of breaking through that wall of fire? When at a
+distance, we once saw a scene like this, and had the charred grass,
+literally as thick as flakes of black snow, falling around us, there
+was no difficulty in understanding the secret of the slave-trader's
+power.
+
+On the 21st of September, we arrived at the village of the chief
+Muasi, or Muazi; it is surrounded by a stockade, and embowered in
+very tall euphorbia-trees; their height, thirty or forty feet, shows
+that it has been inhabited for at least one generation. A visitation
+of disease or death causes the headmen to change the site of their
+villages, and plant new hedges; but, though Muazi has suffered from
+the attacks of the Mazitu, he has evidently clung to his birthplace.
+The village is situated about two miles south-west of a high hill
+called Kasungu, which gives the name to a district extending to the
+Loangwa of the Maravi. Several other detached granite hills have
+been shot up on the plain, and many stockaded villages, all owing
+allegiance to Muazi, are scattered over it.
+
+On our arrival, the chief was sitting in the smooth shady place,
+called Boalo, where all public business is transacted, with about two
+hundred men and boys around him. We paid our guides with due
+ostentation. Masiko, the tallest of our party, measured off the
+fathom of cloth agreed upon, and made it appear as long as possible,
+by facing round to the crowd, and cutting a few inches beyond what
+his outstretched arms could reach, to show that there was no
+deception. This was by way of advertisement. The people are
+mightily gratified at having a tall fellow to measure the cloth for
+them. It pleases them even better than cutting it by a tape-line--
+though very few men of six feet high can measure off their own length
+with their outstretched arms. Here, where Arab traders have been,
+the cubit called mokono, or elbow, begins to take the place of the
+fathom in use further south. The measure is taken from the point of
+the bent elbow to the end of the middle finger.
+
+We found, on visiting Muazi on the following day, that he was as
+frank and straightforward as could reasonably be expected. He did
+not wish us to go to the N.N.W., because he carries on a considerable
+trade in ivory there. We were anxious to get off the slave route, to
+people not visited before by traders; but Muazi naturally feared,
+that if we went to what is said to be a well-watered country,
+abounding in elephants, we might relieve him of the ivory which he
+now obtains at a cheap rate, and sells to the slave-traders as they
+pass Kasungu to the east; but at last he consented, warning us that
+"great difficulty would be experienced in obtaining food--a district
+had been depopulated by slave wars--and a night or two must be spent
+in it; but he would give us good guides, who would go three days with
+us, before turning, and then further progress must depend on
+ourselves." Some of our men having been ill ever since we mounted
+this highland plain, we remained two days with Muazi.
+
+A herd of fine cattle showed that no tsetse existed in the district.
+They had the Indian hump, and were very fat, and very tame. The boys
+rode on both cows and bulls without fear, and the animals were so fat
+and lazy, that the old ones only made a feeble attempt to kick their
+young tormentors. Muazi never milks the cows; he complained that,
+but for the Mazitu having formerly captured some, he should now have
+had very many. They wander over the country at large, and certainly
+thrive.
+
+After leaving Muazi's, we passed over a flat country sparsely covered
+with the scraggy upland trees, but brightened with many fine flowers.
+The grass was short, reaching no higher than the knee, and growing in
+tufts with bare spaces between, though the trees were draped with
+many various lichens, and showed a moist climate. A high and very
+sharp wind blew over the flats; its piercing keenness was not caused
+by low temperature, for the thermometer stood at 80 degrees.
+
+We were now on the sources of the Loangwa of the Maravi, which enters
+the Zambesi at Zumbo, and were struck by the great resemblance which
+the boggy and sedgy streams here presented to the sources of the
+Leeba, an affluent of the Zambesi formerly observed in Londa, and of
+the Kasai, which some believe to be the principal branch of the Congo
+or Zaire.
+
+We had taken pains to ascertain from the travelled Babisa and Arabs
+as much as possible about the country in front, which, from the
+lessening time we had at our disposal, we feared we could scarcely
+reach, and had heard a good deal of a small lake called Bemba. As we
+proceeded west, we passed over the sources not only of the Loangwa,
+but of another stream, called Moitawa or Moitala, which was
+represented to be the main feeder of Lake Bemba. This would be of
+little importance, but for the fact that the considerable river
+Luapula, or Loapula is said to flow out of Bemba to the westward, and
+then to spread out into another and much larger lake, named Moero, or
+Moelo. Flowing still further in the same direction, the Loapula
+forms Lake Mofue, or Mofu, and after this it is said to pass the town
+of Cazembe, bend to the north, and enter Lake Tanganyika. Whither
+the water went after it entered the last lake, no one would venture
+an assertion. But that the course indicated is the true watershed of
+that part of the country, we believe from the unvarying opinion of
+native travellers. There could be no doubt that our informants had
+been in the country beyond Cazembe's, for they knew and described
+chiefs whom we afterwards met about thirty-five or forty miles west
+of his town. The Lualaba is said to flow into the Loapula--and when,
+for the sake of testing the accuracy of the travelled, it was
+asserted that all the water of the region round the town of Cazembe
+flowed into the Luambadzi, or Luambezi (Zambesi), they remarked with
+a smile, "He says, that the Loapula flows into the Zambesi--did you
+ever hear such nonsense?" or words to that effect. We were forced to
+admit, that according to native accounts, our previous impression of
+the Zambesi's draining the country about Cazembe's had been a
+mistake. Their geographical opinions are now only stated, without
+any further comment than that the itinerary given by the Arabs and
+others shows that the Loapula is twice crossed on the way to
+Cazembe's; and we may add that we have never found any difficulty
+from the alleged incapacity of the negro to tell which way a river
+flows.
+
+The boiling-point of water showed a descent, from the edge of the
+plateau to our furthest point west, of 170 feet; but this can only be
+considered as an approximation, and no dependence could have been
+placed on it, had we not had the courses of the streams to confirm
+this rather rough mode of ascertaining altitudes. The slope, as
+shown by the watershed, was to the "Loangwa of the Maravi," and
+towards the Moitala, or south-west, west, and north-west. After we
+leave the feeders of Lake Nyassa, the water drains towards the centre
+of the continent. The course of the Kasai, a river seen during Dr.
+Livingstone's journey to the West Coast, and its feeders was to the
+north-east, or somewhat in the same direction. Whether the water
+thus drained off finds its way out by the Congo, or by the Nile, has
+not yet been ascertained. Some parts of the continent have been said
+to resemble an inverted dinner-plate. This portion seems more of the
+shape, if shape it has, of a wide-awake hat, with the crown a little
+depressed. The altitude of the brim in some parts is considerable;
+in others, as at Tette and the bottom of Murchison's Cataracts, it is
+so small that it could be ascertained only by eliminating the daily
+variations of the barometer, by simultaneous observations on the
+Coast, and at points some two or three hundred miles inland. So long
+as African rivers remain in what we may call the brim, they present
+no obstructions; but no sooner do they emerge from the higher lands
+than their utility is impaired by cataracts. The low lying belt is
+very irregular. At times sloping up in the manner of the rim of an
+inverted dinner-plate--while in other cases, a high ridge rises near
+the sea, to be succeeded by a lower district inland before we reach
+the central plateau. The breadth of the low lands is sometimes as
+much as three hundred miles, and that breadth determines the limits
+of navigation from the seaward.
+
+We made three long marches beyond Muazi's in a north-westerly
+direction; the people were civil enough, but refused to sell us any
+food. We were travelling too fast, they said; in fact, they were
+startled, and before they recovered their surprise, we were obliged
+to depart. We suspected that Muazi had sent them orders to refuse us
+food, that we might thus be prevented from going into the depopulated
+district; but this may have been mere suspicion, the result of our
+own uncharitable feelings.
+
+We spent one night at Machambwe's village, and another at Chimbuzi's.
+It is seldom that we can find the headman on first entering a
+village. He gets out of the way till he has heard all about the
+strangers, or he is actually out in the fields looking after his
+farms. We once thought that when the headman came in from a visit of
+inspection, with his spear, bow and arrows, they had been all taken
+up for the occasion, and that he had all the while been hidden in
+some hut slily watching till he heard that the strangers might be
+trusted; but on listening to the details given by these men of the
+appearances of the crops at different parts, and the astonishing
+minuteness of the speakers' topography, we were persuaded that in
+some cases we were wrong, and felt rather humiliated. Every knoll,
+hill, mountain, and every peak on a range has a name; and so has
+every watercourse, dell, and plain. In fact, every feature and
+portion of the country is so minutely distinguished by appropriate
+names, that it would take a lifetime to decipher their meaning. It
+is not the want, but the superabundance of names that misleads
+travellers, and the terms used are so multifarious that good scholars
+will at times scarcely know more than the subject of conversation.
+Though it is a little apart from the topic of the attention which the
+headmen pay to agriculture, yet it may be here mentioned, while
+speaking of the fulness of the language, that we have heard about a
+score of words to indicate different varieties of gait--one walks
+leaning forward, or backward, swaying from side to side, loungingly,
+or smartly, swaggeringly, swinging the arms, or only one arm, head
+down or up, or otherwise; each of these modes of walking was
+expressed by a particular verb; and more words were used to designate
+the different varieties of fools than we ever tried to count.
+
+Mr. Moffat has translated the whole Bible into the language of the
+Bechuana, and has diligently studied this tongue for the last forty-
+four-years; and, though knowing far more of the language than any of
+the natives who have been reared on the Mission-station of Kuruman,
+he does not pretend to have mastered it fully even yet. However
+copious it may be in terms of which we do not feel the necessity, it
+is poor in others, as in abstract terms, and words used to describe
+mental operations.
+
+Our third day's march ended in the afternoon of the 27th September,
+1863, at the village of Chinanga on the banks of a branch of the
+Loangwa. A large, rounded mass of granite, a thousand feet high,
+called Nombe rume, stand on the plain a few miles off. It is quite
+remarkable, because it has so little vegetation on it. Several other
+granitic hills stand near it, ornamented with trees, like most
+heights of this country, and a heap of blue mountains appears away in
+the north.
+
+The effect of the piercing winds upon the men had never been got rid
+of. Several had been unable to carry a load ever since we ascended
+to the highlands; we had lost one, and another poor lad was so ill as
+to cause us great anxiety. By waiting in this village, which was so
+old that it was full of vermin, all became worse. Our European food
+was entirely expended, and native meal, though finely ground, has so
+many sharp angular particles in it, that it brought back dysentery,
+from which we had suffered so much in May. We could scarcely obtain
+food for the men. The headman of this village of Chinanga was off in
+a foray against some people further north to supply slaves to the
+traders expected along the slave route we had just left; and was
+said, after having expelled the inhabitants, to be living in their
+stockade, and devouring their corn. The conquered tribe had
+purchased what was called a peace by presenting the conqueror with
+three women.
+
+This state of matters afforded us but a poor prospect of finding more
+provisions in that direction than we could with great difficulty and
+at enormous prices obtain here. But neither want of food, dysentery,
+nor slave wars would have prevented our working our way round the
+Lake in some other direction, had we had time; but we had received
+orders from the Foreign Office to take the "Pioneer" down to the sea
+in the previous April. The salaries of all the men in her were
+positively "in any case to cease by the 31st of December."
+
+We were said to be only ten days' distant from Lake Bemba. We might
+speculate on a late rise of the river. A month or six weeks would
+secure a geographical feat, but the rains were near. We had been
+warned by different people that the rains were close at hand, and
+that we should then be bogged and unable to travel. The flood in the
+river might be an early one, or so small in volume as to give but one
+chance of the "Pioneer" descending to the ocean. The Makololo too
+were becoming dispirited by sickness and want of food, and were
+naturally anxious to be back to their fields in time for sowing. But
+in addition to all this and more, it was felt that it would not be
+dealing honestly with the Government, were we, for the sake of a
+little eclat, to risk the detention of the "Pioneer" up the river
+during another year; so we decided to return; and though we had
+afterwards the mortification to find that we were detained two full
+months at the ship waiting for the flood which we expected
+immediately after our arrival there, the chagrin was lessened by a
+consciousness of having acted in a fair, honest, above-board manner
+throughout.
+
+On the night of the 29th of September a thief came to the sleeping-
+place of our men and stole a leg of a goat. On complaining to the
+deputy headman, he said that the thief had fled, but would be caught.
+He suggested a fine, and offered a fowl and her eggs; but wishing
+that the thief alone should be punished, it was advised that HE
+should be found and fined. The Makololo thought it best to take the
+fowl as a means of making the punishment certain. After settling
+this matter on the last day of September, we commenced our return
+journey. We had just the same time to go back to the ship, that we
+had spent in coming to this point, and there is not much to interest
+one in marching over the same ground a second time.
+
+While on our journey north-west, a cheery old woman, who had once
+been beautiful, but whose white hair now contrasted strongly with her
+dark complexion, was working briskly in her garden as we passed. She
+seemed to enjoy a hale, hearty old age. She saluted us with what
+elsewhere would be called a good address; and, evidently conscious
+that she deserved the epithet, "dark but comely," answered each of us
+with a frank "Yes, my child." Another motherly-looking woman,
+sitting by a well, began the conversation by "You are going to visit
+Muazi, and you have come from afar, have you not?" But in general
+women never speak to strangers unless spoken to, so anything said by
+them attracts attention. Muazi once presented us with a basket of
+corn. On hinting that we had no wife to grind our corn, his buxom
+spouse struck in with roguish glee, and said, "I will grind it for
+you; and leave Muazi, to accompany and cook for you in the land of
+the setting sun." As a rule the women are modest and retiring in
+their demeanour, and, without being oppressed with toil, show a great
+deal of industry. The crops need about eight months' attention.
+Then when the harvest is home, much labour is required to convert it
+into food as porridge, or beer. The corn is pounded in a large
+wooden mortar, like the ancient Egyptian one, with a pestle six feet
+long and about four inches thick. The pounding is performed by two
+or even three women at one mortar. Each, before delivering a blow
+with her pestle, gives an upward jerk of the body, so as to put
+strength into the stroke, and they keep exact time, so that two
+pestles are never in the mortar at the same moment. The measured
+thud, thud, thud, and the women standing at their vigorous work, are
+associations inseparable from a prosperous African village. By the
+operation of pounding, with the aid of a little water, the hard
+outside scale or husk of the grain is removed, and the corn is made
+fit for the millstone. The meal irritates the stomach unless cleared
+from the husk; without considerable energy in the operator, the husk
+sticks fast to the corn. Solomon thought that still more vigour than
+is required to separate the hard husk or bran from wheat would fail
+to separate "a fool from his folly." "Though thou shouldst bray a
+fool in a mortar among wheat with a pestle, YET will not his
+foolishness depart from him." The rainbow, in some parts, is called
+the "pestle of the Barimo," or gods. Boys and girls, by constant
+practice with the pestle, are able to plant stakes in the ground by a
+somewhat similar action, in erecting a hut, so deftly that they never
+miss the first hole made.
+
+Let any one try by repeatedly jobbing a pole with all his force to
+make a deep hole in the ground, and he will understand how difficult
+it is always to strike it into the same spot.
+
+As we were sleeping one night outside a hut, but near enough to hear
+what was going on within, an anxious mother began to grind her corn
+about two o'clock in the morning. "Ma," inquired a little girl, "why
+grind in the dark?" Mamma advised sleep, and administered material
+for a sweet dream to her darling, by saying, "I grind meal to buy a
+cloth from the strangers, which will make you look a little lady."
+An observer of these primitive races is struck continually with such
+little trivial touches of genuine human nature.
+
+The mill consists of a block of granite, syenite, or even mica
+schist, fifteen or eighteen inches square and five or six thick, with
+a piece of quartz or other hard rock about the size of a half brick,
+one side of which has a convex surface, and fits into a concave
+hollow in the larger and stationary stone. The workwoman kneeling,
+grasps this upper millstone with both hands, and works it backwards
+and forwards in the hollow of the lower millstone, in the same way
+that a baker works his dough, when pressing it and pushing from him.
+The weight of the person is brought to bear on the movable stone, and
+while it is pressed and pushed forwards and backwards, one hand
+supplies every now and then a little grain to be thus at first
+bruised and then ground on the lower stone, which is placed on the
+slope so that the meal when ground falls on to a skin or mat spread
+for the purpose. This is perhaps the most primitive form of mill,
+and anterior to that in oriental countries, where two women grind at
+one mill, and may have been that used by Sarah of old when she
+entertained the Angels.
+
+On 2nd October we applied to Muazi for guides to take us straight
+down to Chinsamba's at Mosapo, and thus cut off an angle, which we
+should otherwise make, by going back to Kota-kota Bay. He replied
+that his people knew the short way to Chinsamba's that we desired to
+go, but that they all were afraid to venture there, on account of the
+Zulus, or Mazitu. We therefore started back on our old route, and,
+after three hours' march, found some Babisa in a village who promised
+to lead us to Chinsamba.
+
+We meet with these keen traders everywhere. They are easily known by
+a line of horizontal cicatrices, each half an inch long, down the
+middle of the forehead and chin. They often wear the hair collected
+in a mass on the upper and back part of the head, while it is all
+shaven off the forehead and temples. The Babisa and Waiau or Ajawa
+heads have more of the round bullet-shape than those of the Manganja,
+indicating a marked difference in character; the former people being
+great traders and travellers, the latter being attached to home and
+agriculture. The Manganja usually intrust their ivory to the Babisa
+to be sold at the Coast, and complain that the returns made never
+come up to the high prices which they hear so much about before it is
+sent. In fact, by the time the Babisa return, the expenses of the
+journey, in which they often spend a month or two at a place where
+food abounds, usually eat up all the profits.
+
+Our new companions were trading in tobacco, and had collected
+quantities of the round balls, about the size of nine pounder shot,
+into which it is formed. One of them owned a woman, whose child had
+been sold that morning for tobacco. The mother followed him, weeping
+silently, for hours along the way we went; she seemed to be well
+known, for at several hamlets, the women spoke to her with evident
+sympathy; we could do nothing to alleviate her sorrow--the child
+would be kept until some slave-trader passed, and then sold for
+calico. The different cases of slave-trading observed by us are
+mentioned, in order to give a fair idea of its details.
+
+We spent the first night, after leaving the slave route, at the
+village of Nkoma, among a section of Manganja, called Machewa, or
+Macheba, whose district extends to the Bua.
+
+The next village at which we slept was also that of a Manganja smith.
+It was a beautiful spot, shaded with tall euphorbia-trees. The
+people at first fled, but after a short time returned, and ordered us
+off to a stockade of Babisa, about a mile distant. We preferred to
+remain in the smooth shady spot outside the hamlet, to being pent up
+in a treeless stockade. Twenty or thirty men came dropping in, all
+fully armed with bows and arrows, some of them were at least six feet
+four in height, yet these giants were not ashamed to say, "We thought
+that you were Mazitu, and, being afraid, ran away." Their orders to
+us were evidently inspired by terror, and so must the refusal of the
+headman to receive a cloth, or lend us a hut have been; but as we
+never had the opportunity of realizing what feelings a successful
+invasion would produce, we did not know whether to blame them or not.
+The headman, a tall old smith, with an enormous, well-made knife of
+his own workmanship, came quietly round, and, inspecting the shelter,
+which, from there being abundance of long grass and bushes near, our
+men put up for us in half an hour, gradually changed his tactics,
+and, in the evening, presented us with a huge pot of porridge and a
+deliciously well-cooked fowl, and made an apology for having been so
+rude to strangers, and a lamentation that he had been so foolish as
+to refuse the fine cloth we had offered. Another cloth was of course
+presented, and we had the pleasure of parting good friends next day.
+
+Our guide, who belonged to the stockade near to which we had slept,
+declined to risk himself further than his home. While waiting to
+hire another, Masiko attempted to purchase a goat, and had nearly
+concluded the bargain, when the wife of the would-be seller came
+forward, and said to her husband, "You appear as if you were
+unmarried; selling a goat without consulting your wife; what an
+insult to a woman! What sort of man are you?" Masiko urged the man,
+saying, "Let us conclude the bargain, and never mind her;" but he
+being better instructed, replied, "No, I have raised a host against
+myself already," and refused.
+
+We now pushed on to the east, so as to get down to the shores of the
+Lake, and into the parts where we were known. The country was
+beautiful, well wooded, and undulating, but the villages were all
+deserted; and the flight of the people seemed to have been quite
+recent, for the grain was standing in the corn-safes untouched. The
+tobacco, though ripe, remained uncut in the gardens, and the whole
+country was painfully quiet: the oppressive stillness quite unbroken
+by the singing of birds, or the shrill calls of women watching their
+corn.
+
+On passing a beautiful village, called Bangwe, surrounded by shady
+trees, and placed in a valley among mountains, we were admiring the
+beauty of the situation, when some of the much dreaded Mazitu, with
+their shields, ran out of the hamlet, from which we were a mile
+distant. They began to scream to their companions to give us chase.
+Without quickening our pace we walked on, and soon were in a wood,
+through which the footpath we were following led. The first
+intimation we had of the approaching Mazitu was given by the Johanna
+man, Zachariah, who always lagged behind, running up, screaming as if
+for his life. The bundles were all put in one place to be defended;
+and Masiko and Dr. Livingstone walked a few paces back to meet the
+coming foe. Masiko knelt down anxious to fire, but was ordered not
+to do so. For a second or two dusky forms appeared among the trees,
+and the Mazitu were asked, in their own tongue, "What do you want?"
+Masiko adding, "What do you say?" No answer was given, but the dark
+shade in the forest vanished. They had evidently taken us for
+natives, and the sight of a white man was sufficient to put them to
+flight. Had we been nearer the Coast, where the people are
+accustomed to the slave-trade, we should have found this affair a
+more difficult one to deal with; but, as a rule, the people of the
+interior are much more mild in character than those on the confines
+of civilization.
+
+The above very small adventure was all the danger we were aware of in
+this journey; but a report was spread from the Portuguese villages on
+the Zambesi, similar to several rumours that had been raised before,
+that Dr. Livingstone had been murdered by the Makololo; and very
+unfortunately the report reached England before it could be
+contradicted.
+
+One benefit arose from the Mazitu adventure. Zachariah, and others
+who had too often to be reproved for lagging behind, now took their
+places in the front rank; and we had no difficulty in making very
+long marches for several days, for all believed that the Mazitu would
+follow our footsteps, and attack us while we slept.
+
+A party of Babisa tobacco-traders came from the N.W. to Molamba,
+while we were there; and one of them asserted several times that the
+Loapula, after emerging from Moelo, received the Lulua, and then
+flowed into Lake Mofu, and thence into Tanganyika; and from the last-
+named Lake into the sea. This is the native idea of the geography of
+the interior; and, to test the general knowledge of our informant, we
+asked him about our acquaintances in Londa; as Moene, Katema, Shinde
+or Shinte, who live south-west of the rivers mentioned, and found
+that our friends there were perfectly well-known to him and to others
+of these travelled natives. In the evening two of the Babisa came
+in, and reported that the Mazitu had followed us to the village
+called Chigaragara, at which we slept at the bottom of the descent.
+The whole party of traders set off at once, though the sun had set.
+We ourselves had given rise to the report, for the women of
+Chigaragara, supposing us in the distance to be Mazitu, fled, with
+all their household utensils on their heads, and had no opportunity
+afterwards of finding out their mistake. We spent the night where we
+were, and next morning, declining Nkomo's entreaty to go and kill
+elephants, took our course along the shores of the Lake southwards.
+
+We have only been at the Lake at one season of the year: then the
+wind blows strongly from the east, and indeed this is its prevailing
+direction hence to the Orange River; a north or a south wind is rare,
+and seldom lasts more than three days. As the breeze now blew over a
+large body of water, towards us, it was delightful; but when facing
+it on the table-land it was so strong as materially to impede our
+progress, and added considerably to the labour of travelling. Here
+it brought large quantities of the plant (Vallisneriae), from which
+the natives extract salt by burning, and which, if chewed, at once
+shows its saline properties by the taste. Clouds of the kungo, or
+edible midges, floated on the Lake, and many rested on the bushes on
+land.
+
+The reeds along the shores of the Lake were still crowded with
+fugitives, and a great loss of life must since have taken place; for,
+after the corn they had brought with them was expended, famine would
+ensue. Even now we passed many women and children digging up the
+roots, about the size of peas, of an aromatic grass; and their wasted
+forms showed that this poor hard fare was to allay, if possible, the
+pangs of hunger. The babies at the breast crowed to us as we passed,
+their mothers kneeling and grubbing for the roots; the poor little
+things still drawing nourishment from the natural fountain were
+unconscious of that sinking of heart which their parents must have
+felt in knowing that the supply for the little ones must soon fail.
+No one would sell a bit of food to us: fishermen, even, would not
+part with the produce of their nets, except in exchange for some
+other kind of food. Numbers of newly-made graves showed that many
+had already perished, and hundreds were so emaciated that they had
+the appearance of human skeletons swathed in brown and wrinkled
+leather. In passing mile after mile, marked with these sad proofs
+that "man's inhumanity to man makes countless thousands mourn," one
+experiences an overpowering sense of helplessness to alleviate human
+woe, and breathes a silent prayer to the Almighty to hasten the good
+time coming when "man and man the world o'er, shall brothers be for
+all that." One small redeeming consideration in all this misery
+could not but be felt; these ills were inflicted by heathen Mazitu,
+and not by, or for, those who say to Him who is higher than the
+highest, "We believe that thou shalt come to be our Judge."
+
+We crossed the Mokole, rested at Chitanda, and then left the Lake,
+and struck away N.W. to Chinsamba's. Our companions, who were so
+much oppressed by the rarefied air of the plateau, still showed signs
+of exhaustion, though now only 1300 feet above the sea, and did not
+recover flesh and spirits till we again entered the Lower Shire
+Valley, which is of so small an altitude, that, without simultaneous
+observations with the barometer there and on the sea-coast, the
+difference would not be appreciable.
+
+On a large plain on which we spent one night, we had the company of
+eighty tobacco traders on their way from Kasungu to Chinsamba's. The
+Mazitu had attacked and killed two of them, near the spot where the
+Zulus fled from us without answering our questions. The traders were
+now so frightened that, instead of making a straight course with us,
+they set off by night to follow the shores of the Lake to Tsenga, and
+then turn west. It is the sight of shields, or guns that inspires
+terror. The bowmen feel perfectly helpless when the enemy comes with
+even the small protection the skin shield affords, or attacks them in
+the open field with guns. They may shoot a few arrows, but they are
+such poor shots that ten to one if they hit. The only thing that
+makes the arrow formidable is the poison; for if the poisoned barb
+goes in nothing can save the wounded. A bow is in use in the lower
+end of Lake Nyassa, but is more common in the Maravi country, from
+six to eight inches broad, which is intended to be used as a shield
+as well as a bow; but we never saw one with the mark on it of an
+enemy's arrow. It certainly is no match for the Zulu shield, which
+is between four and five feet long, of an oval shape, and about two
+feet broad. So great is the terror this shield inspires that we
+sometimes doubted whether the Mazitu here were Zulus at all, and
+suspected that the people of the country took advantage of that fear,
+and, assuming shields, pretended to belong to that nation.
+
+On the 11th October we arrived at the stockade of Chinsamba in
+Mosapo, and had reason to be very well satisfied with his kindness.
+A paraffin candle was in his eyes the height of luxury, and the
+ability to make a light instantaneously by a lucifer match, a marvel
+that struck him with wonder. He brought all his relatives in
+different groups to see the strange sights,--instantaneous fire-
+making, and a light, without the annoyance of having fire and smoke
+in the middle of the floor. When they wish to look for anything in
+the dark, a wisp of dried grass is lighted.
+
+Chinsamba gave us a great deal of his company during our visits. As
+we have often remarked in other cases, a chief has a great deal to
+attend to in guiding the affairs of his people. He is consulted on
+all occasions, and gives his advice in a stream of words, which show
+a very intimate acquaintance with the topography of his district; he
+knows every rood cultivated, every weir put in the river, every
+hunting-net, loom, gorge, and every child of his tribe. Any addition
+made to the number of these latter is notified to him; and he sends
+thanks and compliments to the parents.
+
+The presents which, following the custom of the country, we gave to
+every headman, where we either spent a night or a longer period,
+varied from four to eight yards of calico. We had some Manchester
+cloths made in imitation of the native manufactured robes of the West
+Coast, each worth five or six shillings. To the more important of
+the chiefs, for calico we substituted one of these strong gaudy
+dresses, iron spoons, a knife, needles, a tin dish, or pannikin, and
+found these presents to be valued more than three times their value
+in cloth would have been. Eight or ten shillings' worth gave
+abundant satisfaction to the greediest; but this is to be understood
+as the prime cost of the articles, and a trader would sometimes have
+estimated similar generosity as equal to from 30 to 50 pounds. In
+some cases the presents we gave exceeded the value of what was
+received in return; in others the excess of generosity was on the
+native side.
+
+We never asked for leave to pass through the country; we simply told
+where we were going, and asked for guides; if they were refused, or
+if they demanded payment beforehand, we requested to be put into the
+beginning of the path, and said that we were sorry we could not agree
+about the guides, and usually they and we started together. Greater
+care would be required on entering the Mazitu or Zulu country, for
+there the Government extends over very large districts, while among
+the Manganja each little district is independent of every other. The
+people here have not adopted the exacting system of the Banyai, or of
+the people whose country was traversed by Speke and Grant.
+
+In our way back from Chinsamba's to Chembi's and from his village to
+Nkwinda's, and thence to Katosa's, we only saw the people working in
+their gardens, near to the stockades. These strongholds were
+strengthened with branches of acacias, covered with strong hooked
+thorns; and were all crowded with people. The air was now clearer
+than when we went north, and we could see the hills of Kirk's Range
+five or six miles to the west of our path. The sun struck very hot,
+and the men felt it most in their feet. Every one who could get a
+bit of goatskin made it into a pair of sandals.
+
+While sitting at Nkwinda's, a man behind the court hedge-wall said,
+with great apparent glee, that an Arab slaving party on the other
+side of the confluence of the Shire and Lake were "giving readily two
+fathoms of calico for a boy, and two and a half for a girl; never saw
+trade so brisk, no haggling at all." This party was purchasing for
+the supply of the ocean slave-trade. One of the evils of this
+traffic is that it profits by every calamity that happens in a
+country. The slave-trader naturally reaps advantage from every
+disorder, and though in the present case some lives may have been
+saved that otherwise would have perished, as a rule he intensifies
+hatreds, and aggravates wars between the tribes, because the more
+they fight and vanquish each other the richer his harvest becomes.
+Where slaving and cattle are unknown the people live in peace. As we
+sat leaning against that hedge, and listened to the harangue of the
+slave-trader's agent, it glanced across our mind that this was a
+terrible world; the best in it unable, from conscious imperfections,
+to say to the worst "Stand by! for I am holier than thou." The
+slave-trader, imbued no doubt with certain kindly feelings, yet
+pursuing a calling which makes him a fair specimen of a human fiend,
+stands grouped with those by whom the slave-traders are employed, and
+with all the workers of sin and misery in more highly-favoured lands,
+an awful picture to the All-seing Eye.
+
+We arrived at Katosa's village on the 15th October, and found about
+thirty young men and boys in slave-sticks. They had been bought by
+other agents of the Arab slavers, still on the east side of the
+Shire. They were resting in the village, and their owners soon
+removed them. The weight of the goree seemed very annoying when they
+tried to sleep. This taming instrument is kept on, until the party
+has crossed several rivers and all hope of escape has vanished from
+the captive's mind.
+
+On explaining to Katosa the injury he was doing in selling his people
+as slaves, he assured us that those whom we had seen belonged to the
+Arabs, and added that he had far too few people already. He said he
+had been living in peace at the lakelet Pamalombe; that the Ajawa, or
+Machinga, under Kainka and Karamba, and a body of Babisa, under
+Maonga, had induced him to ferry them over the Shire; that they had
+lived for a considerable time at his expense, and at last stole his
+sheep, which induced him to make his escape to the place where he now
+dwelt, and in this flight he had lost many of his people. His
+account of the usual conduct of the Ajawa quite agrees with what
+these people have narrated themselves, and gives but a low idea of
+their moral tone. They have repeatedly broken all the laws of
+hospitality by living for months on the bounty of the Manganja, and
+then, by a sudden uprising, overcoming their hosts, and killing or
+chasing them out of their inheritances. The secret of their success
+is the possession of firearms. There were several of these Ajawa
+here again, and on our arrival they proposed to Katosa that they
+should leave; but he replied that they need not be afraid of us.
+They had red beads strung so thickly on their hair that at a little
+distance they appeared to have on red caps. It is curious that the
+taste for red hair should be so general among the Africans here and
+further north; in the south black mica, called Sebilo, and even soot
+are used to deepen the colour of the hair; here many smear the head
+with red-ochre, others plait the inner bark of a tree stained red
+into it; and a red powder called Mukuru is employed, which some say
+is obtained from the ground, and others from the roots of a tree.
+
+It having been doubted whether sugar-cane is indigenous to this
+country or not, we employed Katosa to procure the two varieties
+commonly cultivated, with the intention of conveying them to Johanna.
+One is yellow, and the other, like what we observed in the Barotse
+Valley, is variegated with dark red and yellow patches, or all red.
+We have seen it "arrow," or blossom. Bamboos also run to seed, and
+the people are said to use the seed as food. The sugar-cane has
+native names, which would lead us to believe it to be indigenous.
+Here it is called Zimbi, further south Mesari, and in the centre of
+the country Meshuati. Anything introduced in recent times, as maize,
+superior cotton, or cassava, has a name implying its foreign origin.
+
+Katosa's village was embowered among gigantic trees of fine timber:
+several caffiaceous bushes, with berries closely resembling those of
+the common coffee, grew near, but no use had ever been made of them.
+There are several cinchonaceous trees also in the country; and some
+of the wild fruits are so good as to cause a feeling of regret that
+they have not been improved by cultivation, or whatever else brought
+ours to their present perfection. Katosa lamented that this locality
+was so inferior to his former place at Pamalombe; there he had maize
+at the different stages of growth throughout the year. To us,
+however, he seemed, by digging holes, and taking advantage of the
+moisture beneath, to have succeeded pretty well in raising crops at
+this the driest time. The Makololo remarked that "here the maize had
+no season,"--meaning that the whole year was proper for its growth
+and ripening. By irrigation a succession of crops of grain might be
+raised anywhere within the south intertropical region of Africa.
+
+When we were with Motunda, on the 20th October, he told us frankly
+that all the native provisions were hidden in Kirk's Range, and his
+village being the last place where a supply of grain could be
+purchased before we reached the ship, we waited till he had sent to
+his hidden stores. The upland country, beyond the mountains now on
+our right, is called Deza, and is inhabited by Maravi, who are only
+another tribe of Manganja. The paramount chief is called Kabambe,
+and he, having never been visited by war, lives in peace and plenty.
+Goats and sheep thrive; and Nyango, the chieftainess further to the
+south, has herds of horned cattle. The country being elevated is
+said to be cold, and there are large grassy plains on it which are
+destitute of trees. The Maravi are reported to be brave, and good
+marksmen with the bow; but, throughout all the country we have
+traversed, guns are enabling the trading tribes to overcome the
+agricultural and manufacturing classes.
+
+On the ascent at the end of the valley just opposite Mount Mvai, we
+looked back for a moment to impress the beauties of the grand vale on
+our memory. The heat of the sun was now excessive, and Masiko,
+thinking that it was overpowering, proposed to send forward to the
+ship and get a hammock, in which to carry any one who might knock up.
+He was truly kind and considerate. Dr. Livingstone having fallen
+asleep after a fatiguing march, a hole in the roof of the hut he was
+in allowed the sun to beat on his head, and caused a splitting
+headache and deafness: while he was nearly insensible, he felt
+Masiko repeatedly lift him back to the bed off which he had rolled,
+and cover him up.
+
+On the 24th we were again in Banda, at the village of Chasundu, and
+could now see clearly the hot valley in which the Shire flows, and
+the mountains of the Manganja beyond to our south-east. Instead of
+following the road by which we had come, we resolved to go south
+along the Lesungwe, which rises at Zunje, a peak on the same ridge as
+Mvai, and a part of Kirk's Range, which bounds the country of the
+Maravi on our west. This is about the limit of the beat of the
+Portuguese native traders, and it is but recently that, following our
+footsteps, they have come so far. It is not likely that their
+enterprise will lead them further north, for Chasundu informed us
+that the Babisa under-sell the agents from Tette. He had tried to
+deal with the latter when they first came; but they offered only ten
+fathoms of calico for a tusk, for which the Babisa gave him twenty
+fathoms and a little powder. Ivory was brought to us for sale again
+and again, and, as far as we could judge, the price expected would be
+about one yard of calico per pound, or possibly more, for there is no
+scale of prices known. The rule seems to be that buyer and seller
+shall spend a good deal of time in trying to cheat each other before
+coming to any conclusion over a bargain.
+
+We found the Lesungwe a fine stream near its source, and about forty
+feet wide and knee-deep, when joined by the Lekudzi, which comes down
+from the Maravi country.
+
+Guinea-fowl abounded, but no grain could be purchased, for the people
+had cultivated only the holmes along the banks with maize and
+pumpkins. Time enough had not elapsed since the slave-trader's
+invasion, and destruction of their stores, for them to raise crops of
+grain on the adjacent lands. To deal with them for a few heads of
+maize was the hungry bargaining with the famished, so we hastened on
+southwards as fast as the excessive heat would allow us. It was
+impossible to march in the middle of the day, the heat was so
+intolerable; and we could not go on at night, because, if we had
+chanced to meet any of the inhabitants, we should have been taken for
+marauders.
+
+We had now thunder every afternoon; but while occasional showers
+seemed to fall at different parts, none fell on us. The air was
+deliciously clear, and revealed all the landscape covered everywhere
+with forest, and bounded by beautiful mountains. On the 31st October
+we reached the Mukuru-Madse, after having travelled 660 geographical
+miles, or 760 English miles in a straight line. This was
+accomplished in fifty-five travelling days, twelve miles per diem on
+an average. If the numerous bendings and windings, and ups and downs
+of the paths could have been measured too, the distance would have
+been found at least fifteen miles a day.
+
+The night we slept at the Mukuru-Madse it thundered heavily, but, as
+this had been the case every afternoon, and no rain had followed, we
+erected no shelter, but during this night a pouring rain came on.
+When very tired a man feels determined to sleep in spite of
+everything, and the sound of dropping water is said to be conducive
+to slumber, but that does not refer to an African storm. If, when
+half asleep in spite of a heavy shower on the back of the head, he
+unconsciously turns on his side, the drops from the branches make
+such capital shots into his ear, that the brain rings again.
+
+We were off next morning, the 1st of November, as soon as the day
+dawned. In walking about seven miles to the ship, our clothes were
+thoroughly dried by the hot sun, and an attack of fever followed. We
+relate this little incident to point out the almost certain
+consequence of getting wet in this climate, and allowing the clothes
+to dry on the person. Even if we walk in the mornings when the dew
+is on the grass, and only get our feet and legs wet, a very uneasy
+feeling and partial fever with pains in the limbs ensue, and continue
+till the march onwards bathes them in perspiration. Had Bishop
+Mackenzie been aware of this, which, before experience alone had
+taught us, entailed many a severe lesson, we know no earthly reason
+why his valuable life might not have been spared. The difference
+between getting the clothes soaked in England and in Africa is this:
+in the cold climate the patient is compelled, or, at any rate,
+warned, by discomfort to resort at once to a change of raiment; while
+in Africa it is cooling and rather pleasant to allow the clothes to
+dry on the person. A Missionary in proportion as he possesses an
+athletic frame, hardened by manly exercises, in addition to his other
+qualifications, will excel him who is not favoured with such bodily
+endowments; but in a hot climate efficiency mainly depends on
+husbanding the resources. He must never forget that, in the tropics,
+he is an exotic plant.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV.
+
+
+
+Confidence of natives--Bishop Tozer--Withdrawal of the Mission party-
+-The English leave--Hazardous voyage to Mosambique--Dr. Livingstone's
+voyage to Bombay--Return to England.
+
+We were delighted and thankful to find all those left at the ship in
+good health, and that from the employments in which they had been
+occupied they had suffered less from fever than usual during our
+absence. My companion, Thomas Ward, the steward, after having
+performed his part in the march right bravely, rejoined his comrades
+stronger than he had ever been before.
+
+An Ajawa chief, named Kapeni, had so much confidence in the English
+name that he, with most of his people, visited the ship; and asserted
+that nothing would give his countrymen greater pleasure than to
+receive the associates of Bishop Mackenzie as their teachers. This
+declaration, coupled with the subsequent conduct of the Ajawa, was
+very gratifying, inasmuch as it was clear that no umbrage had been
+taken at the check which the Bishop had given to their slaving; their
+consciences had told them that the course he had pursued was right.
+
+When we returned, the contrast between the vegetation about Muazi's
+and that near the ship was very striking. We had come so quickly
+down, that while on the plateau in latitude 12 degrees S., the young
+leaves had in many cases passed from the pink or other colour they
+have on first coming out to the light fresh green which succeeds it,
+here, on the borders of 16 degrees S., or from 150 to 180 miles
+distant, the trees were still bare, the grey colour of the bark
+predominating over every other hue. The trees in the tropics here
+have a very well-marked annual rest. On the Rovuma even, which is
+only about ten degrees from the equator, in September the slopes up
+from the river some sixty miles inland were of a light ashy-grey
+colour; and on ascending them, we found that the majority of the
+trees were without leaves; those of the bamboo even lay crisp and
+crumpled on the ground. As the sun is usually hot by day, even in
+the winter, this withering process may be owing to the cool nights;
+Africa differing so much from Central India in the fact that, in
+Africa, however hot the day may be, the air generally cools down
+sufficiently by the early morning watches to render a covering or
+even a blanket agreeable.
+
+The first fortnight after our return to the ship was employed in the
+delightful process of resting, to appreciate which a man must have
+gone through great exertions. In our case the muscles of the limbs
+were as hard as boards, and not an ounce of fat existed on any part
+of the body. We now had frequent showers; but, these being only the
+earlier rains, the result on the rise of the river was but a few
+inches. The effect of these rains on the surrounding scenery was
+beautiful in the extreme. All trace of the dry season was soon
+obliterated, and hills and mountains from base to summit were covered
+with a mantle of living green. The sun passed us on his way south
+without causing a flood, so all our hopes of a release were centred
+on his return towards the Equator, when, as a rule, the waters of
+inundation are made to flow. Up to this time the rains descended
+simply to water the earth, fill the pools, and make ready for the
+grand overflow for which we had still to wait six weeks. It is of no
+use to conceal that we waited with much chagrin; for had we not been
+forced to return from the highlands west of Nyassa we might have
+visited Lake Bemba; but unavailing regrets are poor employment for
+the mind; so we banished them to the best of our power.
+
+About the middle of December, 1863, we were informed that Bishop
+Mackenzie's successor, after spending a few months on the top of a
+mountain about as high as Ben Nevis in Scotland, at the mouth of the
+Shire, where there were few or no people to be taught, had determined
+to leave the country. This unfortunate decision was communicated to
+us at the same time that six of the boys reared by Bishop Mackenzie
+were sent back into heathenism. The boys were taken to a place about
+seven miles from the ship, but immediately found their way up to us.
+We told them that if they wished to remain in the country they had
+better so arrange at once, for we were soon to leave. The sequel
+will show their choice.
+
+As soon as the death of Bishop Mackenzie was known at the Cape, Dr.
+Gray, the excellent Bishop there, proceeded at once to England, with
+a view of securing an early appointment of another head to the
+Mission, which in its origin owed so much to his zeal for the spread
+of the gospel among the heathen, and whose interests he had
+continually at heart. About the middle of 1862 we heard that Dr.
+Gray's efforts had been successful, and that another clergyman would
+soon take the place of our departed friend. This pleasing
+intelligence was exceedingly cheering to the Missionaries, and
+gratifying also to the members of the Expedition. About the
+beginning of 1863 the new Bishop arrived at the mouth of the river in
+a man-of-war, and after some delay proceeded inland. The Bishop of
+the Cape had taken a voyage home at considerable inconvenience to
+himself, for the sole object of promoting this Mission to the
+heathen; and it was somehow expected that the man he would secure
+would be an image of himself; and we must say, that whatever others,
+from the representations that have gone abroad, may think of his
+character, we invariably found Dr. Gray to be a true, warm-hearted
+promoter of the welfare of his fellow-men; a man whose courage and
+zeal have provoked very many to good works.
+
+It was hoped that the presence of a new head to the Mission would
+infuse new energy and life into the small band of Missionaries, whose
+ranks had been thinned by death; and who, though discouraged by the
+disasters which the slave war and famine had induced, and also
+dispirited by the depressing influences of a low and unhealthy
+position in the swampy Shire Valley, were yet bravely holding out
+till the much-needed moral and material aid should arrive.
+
+We believe that we are uttering the sentiments of many devout members
+of different sections of Christians, when we say, it was a pity that
+the Mission of the Universities was abandoned. The ground had been
+consecrated in the truest sense by the lives of those brave men who
+first occupied it. In bare justice to Bishop Mackenzie, who was the
+first to fall, it must be said, that the repudiation of all he had
+done, and the sudden abandonment of all that had cost so much life
+and money to secure, was a serious line of conduct for one so
+unversed in Missionary operations as his successor, to inaugurate.
+It would have been no more than fair that Bishop Tozer, before
+winding up the affairs of the Mission, should actually have examined
+the highlands of the Upper Shire; he would thus have gratified the
+associates of his predecessor, who believed that the highlands had
+never had a fair trial, and he would have gained from personal
+observation a more accurate knowledge of the country and the people
+than he could possibly have become possessed of by information
+gathered chiefly on the coast. With this examination, rather than
+with a stay of a few months on the humid, dripping top of misty
+Morambala, we should have felt much more satisfied.
+
+In January, 1864, the natives all confidently asserted that at next
+full moon the river would have its great and permanent flood. It had
+several times risen as much as a foot, but fell again as suddenly.
+It was curious that their observation coincided exactly with ours,
+that the flood of inundation happens when the sun comes overhead on
+his way back to the Equator. We mention this more minutely because,
+from the observation of several years, we believe that in this way
+the inundation of the Nile is to be explained. On the 19th the Shire
+suddenly rose several feet, and we started at once; and stopping only
+for a short time at Chibisa's to bid adieu to the Ajawa and Makololo,
+who had been extremely useful to us of late in supplying maize and
+fresh provisions, we hastened on our way to the ocean. In order to
+keep a steerage way on the "Pioneer," we had to go quicker than the
+stream, and unfortunately carried away her rudder in passing suddenly
+round a bank. The delay required for the repairs prevented our
+reaching Morambala till the 2nd of February.
+
+The flood-water ran into a marsh some miles above the mountain, and
+became as black as ink; and when it returned again to the river
+emitted so strong an effluvium of sulphuretted hydrogen, that one
+could not forget for an instant that the air was most offensive. The
+natives said this stench did not produce disease. We spent one night
+in it, and suffered no ill effects, though we fully expected an
+attack of fever. Next morning every particle of white paint on both
+ships was so deeply blackened, that it could not be cleaned by
+scrubbing with soap and water. The brass was all turned to a bronze
+colour, and even the iron and ropes had taken a new tint. This is an
+additional proof that malaria and offensive effluvia are not always
+companions. We did not suffer more from fever in the mangrove
+swamps, where we inhaled so much of the heavy mousey smell that it
+was distinguishable in the odour of our shirts and flannels, than we
+did elsewhere.
+
+We tarried in the foul and blackening emanations from the marsh
+because we had agreed to receive on board about thirty poor orphan
+boys and girls, and a few helpless widows whom Bishop Mackenzie had
+attached to his Mission. All who were able to support themselves had
+been encouraged by the Missionaries to do so by cultivating the
+ground, and they now formed a little free community. But the boys
+and girls who were only from seven to twelve years of age, and
+orphans without any one to help them, could not be abandoned without
+bringing odium on the English name. The effect of an outcry by some
+persons in England, who knew nothing of the circumstances in which
+Bishop Mackenzie was placed, and who certainly had not given up their
+own right of appeal to the sword of the magistrate, was, that the new
+head of the Mission had gone to extremes in the opposite direction
+from his predecessor; not even protesting against the one monstrous
+evil of the country, the slave-trade. We believed that we ought to
+leave the English name in the same good repute among the natives that
+we had found it; and in removing the poor creatures, who had lived
+with Mackenzie as children with a father, to a land where the
+education he began would be completed, we had the aid and sympathy of
+the best of the Portuguese, and of the whole population. The
+difference between shipping slaves and receiving these free orphans
+struck us as they came on board. As soon as permission to embark was
+given, the rush into the boat nearly swamped her--their eagerness to
+be safe on the "Pioneer's" deck had to be repressed.
+
+Bishop Tozer had already left for Quillimane when we took these
+people and the last of the Universities' Missionaries on board and
+proceeded to the Zambesi. It was in high flood. We have always
+spoken of this river as if at its lowest, for fear lest we should
+convey an exaggerated impression of its capabilities for navigation.
+Instead of from five to fifteen feet, it was now from fifteen to
+thirty feet, or more, deep. All the sandbanks and many of the
+islands had disappeared, and before us rolled a river capable, as one
+of our naval friends thought, of carrying a gunboat. Some of the
+sandy islands are annually swept away, and the quantities of sand
+carried down are prodigious.
+
+The process by which a delta, extending eighty or one hundred miles
+from the sea, has been formed may be seen going on at the present
+day--the coarser particles of sand are driven out into the ocean,
+just in the same way as we see they are over banks in the beds of
+torrents. The finer portions are caught by the returning tide, and,
+accumulating by successive ebbs and flows, become, with the decaying
+vegetation, arrested by the mangrove roots. The influence of the
+tide in bringing back the finer particles gives the sea near the
+mouth of the Zambesi a clean and sandy bottom. This process has been
+going on for ages, and as the delta has enlarged eastwards, the river
+has always kept a channel for itself behind. Wherever we see an
+island all sand, or with only one layer of mud in it, we know it is
+one of recent formation, and that it may be swept away at any time by
+a flood; while those islands which are all of mud are the more
+ancient, having in fact existed ever since the time when the ebbing
+and flowing tides originally formed them as parts of the delta. This
+mud resists the action of the river wonderfully. It is a kind of
+clay on which the eroding power of water has little effect. Were
+maps made, showing which banks and which islands are liable to
+erosion, it would go far to settle where the annual change of the
+channel would take place; and, were a few stakes driven in year by
+year to guide the water in its course, the river might be made of
+considerable commercial value in the hands of any energetic European
+nation. No canal or railway would ever be thought of for this part
+of Africa. A few improvements would make the Zambesi a ready means
+of transit for all the trade that, with a population thinned by
+Portuguese slaving, will ever be developed in our day. Here there is
+no instance on record of the natives flocking in thousands to the
+colony, as they did at Natal, and even to the Arabs on Lake Nyassa.
+This keeping aloof renders it unlikely that in Portuguese hands the
+Zambesi will ever be of any more value to the world than it has been.
+
+After a hurried visit to Senna, in order to settle with Major Sicard
+and Senhor Ferrao for supplies we had drawn thence after the
+depopulation of the Shire, we proceeded down to the Zambesi's mouth,
+and were fortunate in meeting, on the 13th February, with H.M.S.
+"Orestes." She was joined next day by H.M.S. "Ariel." The "Orestes"
+took the "Pioneer," and the "Ariel" the "Lady Nyassa" in tow, for
+Mosambique. On the 16th a circular storm proved the sea-going
+qualities of the "Lady of the Lake;" for on this day a hurricane
+struck the "Ariel," and drove her nearly backwards at a rate of six
+knots. The towing hawser wound round her screw and stopped her
+engines. No sooner had she recovered from this shock than she was
+again taken aback on the other tack, and driven stem on towards the
+"Lady Nyassa's" broadside. We who were on board the little vessel
+saw no chance of escape unless the crew of the "Ariel" should think
+of heaving ropes when the big ship went over us; but she glided past
+our bow, and we breathed freely again. We had now an opportunity of
+witnessing man-of-war seamanship. Captain Chapman, though his
+engines were disabled, did not think of abandoning us in the heavy
+gale, but crossed the bows of the "Lady Nyassa" again and again,
+dropping a cask with a line by which to give us another hawser. We
+might never have picked it up, had not a Krooman jumped overboard and
+fastened a second line to the cask; and then we drew the hawser on
+board, and were again in tow. During the whole time of the hurricane
+the little vessel behaved admirably, and never shipped a single green
+sea. When the "Ariel" pitched forwards we could see a large part of
+her bottom, and when her stern went down we could see all her deck.
+A boat, hung at her stern davits, was stove in by the waves. The
+officers on board the "Ariel" thought that it was all over with us:
+we imagined that they were suffering more than we were. Nautical men
+may suppose that this was a serious storm only to landsmen; but the
+"Orestes," which was once in sight, and at another time forty miles
+off during the same gale, split eighteen sails; and the "Pioneer" had
+to be lightened of parts of a sugar-mill she was carrying; her round-
+house was washed away, and the cabin was frequently knee-deep in
+water. When the "Orestes" came into Mosambique harbour nine days
+after our arrival there, our vessel, not being anchored close to the
+"Ariel," for we had run in under the lee of the fort, led to the
+surmise on board the "Orestes" that we had gone to the bottom.
+Captain Chapman and his officers pronounced the "Lady Nyassa" to be
+the finest little sea-boat they had ever seen. She certainly was a
+contrast to the "Ma-Robert," and did great credit to her builders,
+Ted and Macgregor of Glasgow. We can but regret that she was not
+employed on the Lake after which she was named, and for which she was
+intended and was so well adapted.
+
+What struck us most, during the trip from the Zambesi to Mosambique,
+was the admirable way in which Captain Chapman handled the "Ariel" in
+the heavy sea of the hurricane; the promptitude and skill with which,
+when we had broken three hawsers, others were passed to us by the
+rapid evolutions of a big ship round a little one; and the ready
+appliance of means shown in cutting the hawser off the screw nine
+feet under water with long chisels made for the occasion; a task
+which it took three days to accomplish. Captain Chapman very kindly
+invited us on board the "Ariel," and we accepted his hospitality
+after the weather had moderated.
+
+The little vessel was hauled through and against the huge seas with
+such force that two hawsers measuring eleven inches each in
+circumference parted. Many of the blows we received from the billows
+made every plate quiver from stem to stern, and the motion was so
+quick that we had to hold on continually to avoid being tossed from
+one side to the other or into the sea. Ten of the late Bishop's
+flock whom we had on board became so sick and helpless that do what
+we could to aid them they were so very much in the way that the idea
+broke in upon us, that the close packing resorted to by slavers is
+one of the necessities of the traffic. If this is so, it would
+account for the fact that even when the trade was legal the same
+injurious custom was common, if not universal. If, instead of ten
+such passengers, we had been carrying two hundred, with the wind
+driving the rain and spray, as by night it did, nearly as hard as
+hail against our faces, and nothing whatever to be seen to windward
+but the occasional gleam of the crest of a wave, and no sound heard
+save the whistling of the storm through the rigging, it would have
+been absolutely necessary for the working of the ship and safety of
+the whole that the live cargo should all have been stowed down below,
+whatever might have been the consequences.
+
+Having delivered the "Pioneer" over to the Navy, she was towed down
+to the Cape by Captain Forsyth of the "Valorous," and after
+examination it was declared that with repairs to the amount of 300
+pounds she would be as serviceable as ever. Those of the Bishop's
+flock whom we had on board were kindly allowed a passage to the Cape.
+The boys went in the "Orestes," and we are glad of the opportunity to
+record our heartfelt thanks to Captains Forsyth, Gardner, and Chapman
+for rendering us, at various times, every aid in their power. Mr.
+Waller went in the "Pioneer," and continued his generous services to
+all connected with the Mission, whether white or black, till they
+were no longer needed; and we must say that his conduct to them
+throughout was truly noble, and worthy of the highest praise.
+
+After beaching the "Lady Nyassa" at Caboceira, opposite the house of
+a Portuguese gentleman well known to all Englishmen, Joao da Costa
+Soares, we put in brine cocks, and cleaned and painted her bottom.
+Mr. Soares appeared to us to have been very much vilified in a
+publication in England a few years ago; our experience proved him to
+be extremely kind and obliging. All the members of the Expedition
+who passed Mosambique were unanimous in extolling his generosity and,
+from the general testimony of English visitors in his favour, we very
+much regret that his character was so grievously misrepresented. To
+the authorities at Mosambique our thanks are also due for obliging
+accommodation; and though we differ entirely from the Portuguese
+officials as to the light in which we regard the slave-trade, we
+trust our exposure of the system, in which unfortunately they are
+engaged, will not be understood as indicating any want of kindly
+feeling and good will to them personally. Senhor Canto e Castro, who
+arrived at Mosambique two days after our departure to take the office
+of Governor-General, was well known to us in Angola. We lived two
+months in his house when he was Commandant of Golungo Alto; and,
+knowing him thoroughly, believe that no better man could have been
+selected for the office. We trust that his good principles may
+enable him to withstand the temptations of his position; but we
+should be sorry to have ours tried in a den of slave-traders with the
+miserable pittance he receives for his support.
+
+While at Mosambique, a species of Pedalia called by Mr. Soares
+Dadeleira, and by the natives--from its resemblance to Gerzilin, or
+sesamum--"wild sesamum," was shown to us, and is said to be well
+known among native nurses as a very gentle and tasteless aperient for
+children. A few leaves of it are stirred in a cup of cold water for
+eight or nine seconds, and a couple of teaspoonfuls of the liquid
+given as a dose. The leaves form a sort of mucilage in the water by
+longer stirring, which is said to have diuretic properties besides.
+
+On the 16th April we steamed out from Mosambique; and, the currents
+being in our favour, in a week reached Zanzibar. Here we experienced
+much hospitality from our countrymen, and especially from Dr. Seward,
+then acting consul and political agent for Colonel Playfair.
+
+Dr. Seward was very doubtful if we could reach Bombay before what is
+called the break of the monsoon took place. This break occurs
+usually between the end of May and the 12th of June. The wind still
+blows from Africa to India, but with so much violence, and with such
+a murky atmosphere, that few or no observations for position can be
+taken. We were, however, at the time very anxious to dispose of the
+"Lady Nyassa," and, the only market we could reach being Bombay, we
+resolved to run the risk of getting there before the stormy period
+commenced; and, after taking fourteen tons of coal on board, we
+started on the 30th April from Zanzibar.
+
+Our complement consisted of seven native Zambesians, two boys, and
+four Europeans; namely, one stoker, one sailor, one carpenter, whose
+names have been already mentioned, and Dr. Livingstone, as navigator.
+The "Lady Nyassa" had shown herself to be a good sea-boat. The
+natives had proved themselves capital sailors, though before
+volunteering not one of them had ever seen the sea. They were not
+picked men, but, on paying a dozen whom we had in our employment for
+fifteen months, they were taken at random from several hundreds who
+offered to accompany us. Their wages were ten shillings per mensem,
+and it was curious to observe, that so eager were they to do their
+duty, that only one of them lay down from sea-sickness during the
+whole voyage. They took in and set sail very cleverly in a short
+time, and would climb out along a boom, reeve a rope through the
+block, and come back with the rope in their teeth, though at each
+lurch the performer was dipped in the sea. The sailor and carpenter,
+though anxious to do their utmost, had a week's severe illness each,
+and were unfit for duty.
+
+It is pleasant enough to take the wheel for an hour or two, or even
+for a watch, but when it comes to be for every alternate four hours,
+it is utterly wearisome. We set our black men to steer, showing them
+which arm of the compass needle was to be kept towards the vessel's
+head, and soon three of them could manage very well, and they only
+needed watching. In going up the East Coast to take advantage of the
+current of one hundred miles a day, we would fain have gone into the
+Juba or Webbe River, the mouth of which is only 15 minutes south of
+the line, but we were too shorthanded. We passed up to about ten
+degrees north of the Equator, and then steamed out from the coast.
+Here Maury's wind chart showed that the calm-belt had long been
+passed, but we were in it still; and, instead of a current carrying
+us north, we had a contrary current which bore us every day four
+miles to the south. We steamed as long as we dared, knowing as we
+did that we must use the engines on the coast of India.
+
+After losing many days tossing on the silent sea, with innumerable
+dolphins, flying-fish, and sharks around us, we had six days of
+strong breezes, then calms again tried our patience; and the near
+approach of that period, "the break of the monsoon," in which it was
+believed no boat could live, made us sometimes think our epitaph
+would be "Left Zanzibar on 30th April, 1864, and never more heard
+of." At last, in the beginning of June, the chronometers showed that
+we were near the Indian coast. The black men believed it was true
+because we told them it was so, but only began to dance with joy when
+they saw sea-weed and serpents floating past. These serpents are
+peculiar to these parts, and are mentioned as poisonous in the
+sailing directions. We ventured to predict that we should see land
+next morning, and at midday the high coast hove in sight, wonderfully
+like Africa before the rains begin. Then a haze covered all the
+land, and a heavy swell beat towards it. A rock was seen, and a
+latitude showed it to be the Choule rock. Making that a fresh
+starting-point, we soon found the light-ship, and then the forest of
+masts loomed through the haze in Bombay harbour. We had sailed over
+2500 miles.
+
+
+
+Footnotes:
+
+{1} A remedy composed of from six to eight grains of resin of jalap,
+the same of rhubarb, and three each of calomel and quinine, made up
+into four pills, with tincture of cardamoms, usually relieved all the
+symptoms in five or six hours. Four pills are a full dose for a man-
+-one will suffice for a woman. They received from our men the name
+of "rousers," from their efficacy in rousing up even those most
+prostrated. When their operation is delayed, a dessert-spoonful of
+Epsom salts should be given. Quinine after or during the operation
+of the pills, in large doses every two or three hours, until deafness
+or cinchonism ensued, completed the cure. The only cases in which,
+we found ourselves completely helpless, were those in which obstinate
+vomiting ensued.
+
+{2} The late Mr. Robson.
+
+{3} In 1865, four years after these forebodings were penned, we
+received intelligence that they had all come to pass. Sekeletu died
+in the beginning of 1864--a civil war broke out about the succession
+to the chieftainship; a large body of those opposed to the late
+chief's uncle, Impololo, being regent, departed with their cattle to
+Lake Ngami; an insurrection by the black tribes followed; Impololo
+was slain, and the kingdom, of which, under an able sagacious
+mission, a vast deal might have been made, has suffered the usual
+fate of African conquests. That fate we deeply deplore; for,
+whatever other faults the Makololo might justly be charged with, they
+did not belong to the class who buy and sell each other, and the
+tribes who have succeeded them do.
+
+{4} It was with sorrow that we learned by a letter from Mr. Moffat,
+in 1864, that poor Sekeletu was dead. As will be mentioned further
+on, men were sent with us to bring up more medicine. They preferred
+to remain on the Shire, and, as they were free men, we could do no
+more than try and persuade them to hasten back to their chief with
+iodine and other remedies. They took the parcel, but there being
+only two real Makololo among them, these could neither return
+themselves alone or force their attendants to leave a part of the
+country where they were independent, and could support themselves
+with ease. Sekeletu, however, lived long enough to receive and
+acknowledge goods to the value of 50 pounds, sent, in lieu of those
+which remained in Tette, by Robert Moffat, jun., since dead.
+
+{5} A brother, we believe, of one who accompanied Burke and Willis in
+the famous but unfortunate Australian Expedition.
+
+{6} Genesis, chap. iii., verses 21 and 23, "make coats of skins, and
+clothed them"--"sent him forth from the garden of Eden to till the
+ground" imply teaching. Vide Archbishop Whately's "History of
+Religious Worship." John W. Parker, West Strand, London, 1849.
+
+{7} "In 1854 the native church at Sierra-Leone undertook to pay for
+their primary schools, and thereby effected a saving to the Church
+Missionary Society of 800 pounds per annum. In 1861 the
+contributions of this one section of native Christians had amounted
+to upwards of 10,000 pounds."--"Manual of Church Missionary Society's
+African Missions."
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg eText The Zambesi and Its Tributaries
diff --git a/old/zambs10.zip b/old/zambs10.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..aa9f171
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/zambs10.zip
Binary files differ